summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 05:31:02 -0700
committerRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 05:31:02 -0700
commit84c497ae815a38a36d5ef76e5601d1fbc92342f9 (patch)
treeba502222a9e9a6ea7cb604ee183fcd93da0cf321
initial commit of ebook 8155HEADmain
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--8155-0.txt13347
-rw-r--r--8155-0.zipbin0 -> 259218 bytes
-rw-r--r--8155-h.zipbin0 -> 271893 bytes
-rw-r--r--8155-h/8155-h.htm15423
-rw-r--r--8155.txt13346
-rw-r--r--8155.zipbin0 -> 258219 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/thorn10.txt13937
-rw-r--r--old/thorn10.zipbin0 -> 265246 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/thorn10h.zipbin0 -> 268433 bytes
12 files changed, 56069 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/8155-0.txt b/8155-0.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9a6e867
--- /dev/null
+++ b/8155-0.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,13347 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of Colonel Thorndyke's Secret, by G. A. Henty
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: Colonel Thorndyke's Secret
+
+Author: G. A. Henty
+
+Release Date: May, 2005 [EBook #8155]
+Posting Date: July 23, 2009
+Last Updated: October 22, 2016
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: UTF-8
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Martin Robb
+
+
+
+
+
+COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET
+
+
+By G. A. Henty.
+
+
+
+
+PUBLISHER'S INTRODUCTION.
+
+
+“Colonel Thorndyke's Secret” is a story so far out of the ordinary that
+it will not be inappropriate to speak a few words regarding the tale and
+its unusually successful author, Mr. George Alfred Henty.
+
+The plot of the story hinges upon the possession of a valuable bracelet,
+of diamonds, stolen from a Hindoo idol by a British soldier in India.
+This bracelet falls into the possession of Colonel Thorndyke, who,
+shortly afterward, is sent home to England because of his wounds. The
+secret concerning the bracelet is told to the Colonel's brother, a
+country squire, and the treasure is left to younger members of the
+Thorndyke family.
+
+As is well known today, the theft of anything from a Hindoo temple is
+considered an extraordinary crime in India, and when this occurs it
+becomes a religious duty for one or more persons to hunt down the thief
+and bring back the property taken from the heathen god.
+
+The members of the Thorndyke family soon learn that they are being
+watched. But this is at a time when highwaymen are numerous in this part
+of England, and they cannot determine whether the work is that of the
+“knights of the roads” or that of the Lascars after the famous bracelet.
+A mysterious death follows, and the younger members of the family are
+almost stunned, not knowing what will happen next. They would give the
+bracelet up, but do not know where it is hidden, the secret having been
+in the sole possession of the member now dead. In this quandary the
+young hero of the tale rises to the occasion and determines to join the
+London police force and become a detective, with the hope of ultimately
+clearing up the mystery. Thrilling adventures of a most unusual kind
+follow, and at last something of the mystery is explained. The bracelet
+and other jewelry are unearthed, and it is decided to take the bracelet
+to Amsterdam and offer it to the diamond cutters at that place. But
+the carrying of the bracelet is both difficult and dangerous. How the
+mission is brought to a conclusion, and what part the Lascars played in
+the final adventure, will be found in the pages that follow.
+
+It can truthfully be said that Mr. Henty is easily the most popular of
+all English story tellers, his books for boys enjoying a circulation of
+from a hundred and fifty thousand to two hundred and fifty thousand per
+year. His tales are all clean, and although some are full of exciting
+situations and thrilling to the last degree, they are of a high moral
+tone, while the English employed is of the best.
+
+The present story is of peculiar value as giving a good insight into
+country and town life in England over a hundred years ago, when railways
+and telegraph lines were unknown and when the “knights of the road” were
+apt to hold up any stagecoach that happened to come along. It also gives
+a truthful picture of the dark and underhanded work accomplished at
+times by those of East Indian blood, especially when on what they
+consider a religious mission.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I.
+
+
+Squire Thorndyke, of the Manor House of Crawley, was, on the 1st of
+September; 1782, walking up and down the little terrace in front of the
+quaint old house in an unusually disturbed mood. He was a man of forty
+three or four, stoutly and strongly built, and inclined to be portly.
+Save the loss of his wife four years before, there had been but little
+to ruffle the easy tenor of his life. A younger son, he had, at his
+mother's death, when he was three and twenty, come in for the small
+estate at Crawley, which had been her jointure.
+
+For ten years he had led a life resembling that of most of his
+neighbors; he had hunted and shot, been a regular attendant at any
+main of cocks that was fought within fifteen miles of Crawley, had
+occasionally been up to London for a week or two to see the gay doings
+there. Of an evening he had generally gone down to the inn, where he
+talked over, with two or three of his own condition and a few of the
+better class of farmers, the news of the day, the war with the French,
+the troubles in Scotland, the alarming march of the Young Pretender, and
+his defeat at Culloden--with no very keen interest in the result, for
+the Southern gentry and yeomen, unlike those in the North, had no strong
+leanings either way. They had a dull dislike for Hanoverian George, but
+no great love for the exiled Stuarts, whose patron, the King of France,
+was an enemy of England.
+
+More often, however, their thoughts turned upon local topics--the
+holding up of the coach of Sir James Harris or Squire Hamilton by
+highwaymen; the affray between the French smugglers and the Revenue men
+near Selsea Bill or Shoreham; the delinquencies of the poaching gangs;
+the heaviness of the taxes, and the price of corn.
+
+At the age of thirty-three Squire Thorndyke married the daughter of
+a neighboring landowner; a son was born and three years later Mrs.
+Thorndyke died. Since then the Squire had led a more retired life; he
+still went down to smoke his pipe at the inn parlor, but he gave up his
+visits to town; and cock fights, and even bull baiting, were no longer
+attractions to him. He was known as a good landlord to the three or four
+farmers who held land under him; was respected and liked in the village,
+where he was always ready to assist in cases of real distress; was of an
+easygoing disposition and on good terms with all his neighbors.
+
+But today he was unusually disturbed in his mind. A messenger had ridden
+up two hours before with a letter from London. It was as follows:
+
+“MY DEAR BROTHER JOHN:
+
+“You will be surprised indeed at this letter from me, who, doubtless,
+you suppose to be fighting in India. I have done with fighting, and
+am nearly done with life. I was shot in the battle of Buxar, eighteen
+months ago. For a time the surgeons thought that it was going to be
+fatal; then I rallied, and for some months it seemed that, in spite of
+the ball that they were never able to find, I was going to get over it,
+and should be fit for service again. Then I got worse; first it was
+a cough, then the blood used to come up, and they said that the only
+chance for me was to come home. I did not believe it would be of any
+use, but I thought that I would rather die at home than in India, so
+home I came, and have now been a week in London.
+
+“I thought at first of going down to my place at Reigate, and having
+you and your boy there with me; but as I have certainly not many weeks,
+perhaps not many days, to live, I thought I would come down to you; so
+the day after you receive this letter I shall be with you. I shall not
+bring my little girl down; I have left her in good hands, and I shall
+only bring with me my Hindoo servant. He will give you no trouble--a mat
+to sleep on, and a little rice to eat, will satisfy his wants; and he
+will take the trouble of me a good deal off your hands. He was a Sepoy
+in my regiment, and has always evinced the greatest devotion for me.
+More than once in battle he has saved my life, and has, for the last
+three years, been my servant, and has nursed me since I have been ill
+as tenderly as a woman could have done. As I shall have time to tell you
+everything when I arrive, I will say no more now.”
+
+The news had much affected John Thorndyke. His brother George was five
+years his senior, and had gone out as a cadet in the company's service
+when John was but thirteen, and this was his first home coming. Had it
+not been for a portrait that had been taken of him in his uniform just
+before he sailed, John would have had but little remembrance of him. In
+that he was represented as a thin, spare youth, with an expression of
+quiet determination in his face. From his father John had, of course,
+heard much about him.
+
+“Nothing would satisfy him but to go out to India, John. There was, of
+course, no occasion for it, as he would have this place after me--a
+fine estate and a good position: what could he want more? But he was a
+curious fellow. Once he formed an opinion there was no persuading him to
+change it. He was always getting ideas such as no one else would think
+of; he did not care for anything that other people cared for; never
+hunted nor shot. He used to puzzle me altogether with his ways, and,
+'pon my word, I was not sorry when he said he would go to India, for
+there was no saying how he might have turned out if he had stopped here.
+He never could do anything like anybody else: nothing that he could have
+done would have surprised me.
+
+“If he had told me that he intended to be a play actor, or a Jockey, or
+a private, or a book writer, I should not have been surprised. Upon my
+word, it was rather a relief to me when he said, 'I have made up my mind
+to go into the East India Service, father. I suppose you can get me
+a cadetship?' At least that was an honorable profession; and I knew,
+anyhow, that when he once said 'I have made up my mind, father,' no
+arguments would move him, and that if I did not get him a cadetship he
+was perfectly capable of running away, going up to London, and enlisting
+in one of their white regiments.”
+
+John Thorndyke's own remembrances were that his brother had always
+been good natured to him, that he had often told him long stories about
+Indian adventures, and that a short time before he went away, having
+heard that he had been unmercifully beaten by the schoolmaster at
+Reigate for some trifling fault, he had gone down to the town, and had
+so battered the man that the school had to be closed for a fortnight.
+They had always kept up a correspondence. When he received the news of
+his father's death George had written to him, begging him to go down to
+Reigate, and to manage the estate for him.
+
+“Of course,” he said, “you will draw its income as long as you are
+there. I mayn't be back for another twenty years; one gets rich out here
+fast, what with plunder and presents and one thing and another, and it
+is no use to have money accumulating at home, so just live on the place
+as if it were your own, until I come home to turn you out.”
+
+John had declined the offer.
+
+“I am very well where I am,” he wrote, “and the care of the estate would
+be a horrible worry to me; besides, I have just married, and if I ever
+have any children they would be brought up beyond their station. I
+have done what I can for you. I have seen the family lawyers, who have
+engaged a man who has been steward to Sir John Hieover, and looked after
+the estate during his son's minority. But the young blade, on coming of
+age, set to work to make ducks and drakes of the property, and Newman
+could not bear to see the estate going to the Jews, so, as luck would
+have it, he resigned a month ago, and has been appointed steward at
+Reigate. Of course, if you don't like the arrangement you must write and
+say so. It will be a year before I get your answer, and he has only been
+engaged for certain for that time; it must lie with you as to permanent
+arrangement.”
+
+So Newman had taken charge of the Reigate estate, and had continued
+to manage it ever since, although George had written home in great
+displeasure at his offer being refused.
+
+Inside the Manor the bustle of preparations was going on; the spare
+room, which had not been used for many years, was being turned out, and
+a great fire lighted to air it. John Thorndyke had sent a letter by the
+returning messenger to a friend in town, begging him to go at once to
+Leadenhall Street and send down a supply of Indian condiments for his
+brother's use, and had then betaken himself to the garden to think the
+matter over. The next day a post chaise arrived, bringing the invalid
+and his colored servant, whose complexion and Indian garb struck the
+maids with an awe not unmingled with alarm. John Thorndyke could hardly
+believe that the bent and emaciated figure was that of his brother, but
+he remembered the voice when the latter said, holding out his hand to
+him:
+
+“Well, brother John, here I am, what is left of me. Gracious, man,
+who would have thought that you were going to grow up such a fine tall
+fellow? You are more fitted to be a soldier than I am. No, don't try
+to help me out; Ramoo will do that--he is accustomed to my ways, and I
+would as soon trust myself to a rogue elephant as to you.”
+
+“I am sorry to see you looking so bad, brother George.”
+
+“What must be must. I have had my fling; and after thirty years of
+marching and fighting, I have no right to grumble if I am laid upon my
+back at last.”
+
+Leaning on Ramoo's arm, Colonel Thorndyke made his way into the house,
+and when the Hindoo had arranged the cushions of the sofa, took his
+place there in a half reclining position.
+
+“I am not always as bad as this, John,” he said; “the jolting of your
+confounded roads has been too much for me. If I were the King I would
+hang every fellow who had anything to do with them--contractors, boards
+of county magistrates, and the whole lot. If I had known what it was
+going to be like I would have hired a sedan chair, and had myself
+carried down. That is what I have been doing in London; but I would
+rather have had an Indian palkee, that one could have lain down
+comfortably in.”
+
+“What shall I get you first, George? I have got some lemons.”
+
+“I want something better than lemons, John. Have you any Burgundy
+handy?”
+
+“Yes, plenty.”
+
+“If you give a bottle to Ramoo he will know how much water I want.”
+
+Here the servants entered with a tray with a chicken and a dish of
+kidneys.
+
+“I sent up yesterday for some of the Indian things that you are
+accustomed to, George, but they have not come down yet.”
+
+“I brought a store down with me. This will do capitally for the present.
+Ramoo will do the cooking for me in future. He need not go into the
+kitchen to scare the maids. I could see they looked at him as if he had
+been his infernal majesty, as he came in. He can do it anywhere; all he
+wants is an iron pot with some holes in it, and some charcoal. He can
+squat out there on the veranda, or, if it is bad weather, any shed will
+do for him.
+
+“Well, it is nice to be home again, John,” he went on, after he had
+eaten a few mouthfuls of chicken and drunk a tumbler of Burgundy and
+water. “I am glad to be back, now I am here, though I dare say I should
+not have come home for another ten years if it had not been for this
+rascally bullet. Where is your boy?”
+
+“He is away at school.”
+
+“Well, I think I will go up to bed at once, if you don't mind, John. I
+shall be fitter to talk in the morning.”
+
+The next day, indeed, Colonel Thorndyke was materially better. His voice
+was stronger and more cheery, and when he came down after breakfast he
+took his seat in an easy chair instead of on the sofa.
+
+“Now, brother,” he said, “we will have a cozy chat. There are several
+things I want done, but the chief of these is that when I am gone you
+should go down to Reigate, as I wanted you to do ten years ago. I want
+you to seem to be its master, as well as be its master, until Millicent
+comes of age, if not longer. Her name is Millicent Conyers Thorndyke. I
+wish her to be called Millicent Conyers, and to appear as your ward, and
+not as your niece and heiress of the property. If there is one thing in
+the world I have a greater horror of than another, it is of a girl being
+married for her money. I don't suppose that anyone knows that I have a
+daughter--at any rate, none beyond a few Indian chums. She was sent home
+with an ayah under the charge of the widow of a comrade of mine. I had
+been away for months, and only went back to Calcutta in time to see her
+mother die. So that is all right.”
+
+“I could not do such a thing as that, George. I should be living under
+false colors. It is not that I mind so much leaving here and looking
+after the child's interest at Reigate, but I could not possibly take
+possession of the place as its owner when I should not be so. Besides,
+there are other objections. Mark would grow up supposing himself to be
+the heir.”
+
+“Mark will be all right. I have, since I have been in London, signed a
+will, leaving the rest of my fortune between them. I had it drawn up by
+our father's solicitors, relying upon your consent to do what I asked
+you. I have explained the matter to them, and given them the assignment,
+or whatever they call it, of the Reigate estate to you, until my
+daughter comes of age, appointing them her guardians should you die
+before that. Thus, you will be placed in a proper position; and should
+it be known by any means that the child is my daughter, that deed will
+still be a proof that you are carrying out my wishes, and are absolute
+master of the estate until she comes of age.”
+
+“I must think it all over, George. It is a singular proposal, and I own
+I would rather things went on in their regular course.”
+
+“Yes, yes, I understand that, John; but you see I have altogether set
+my mind on this matter. I want to know that my girl is not going to be
+married for her money; and, at any rate, that deed makes you master of
+the Reigate estates for the next thirteen years; so the only thing that
+I really want of you is to let the girl be called your ward instead of
+your niece, and that she and everyone else shall be in ignorance that
+she is an heiress. So far from doing the girl a wrong, you will be doing
+her a benefit; and as I have explained the whole matter to our lawyers,
+no one can possibly think that the thing has been done from any motive
+whatever except that of affording me satisfaction.”
+
+“I will think the matter over,” John repeated. “Of course, brother, it
+has been in your mind for some time, but it comes altogether fresh to
+me, and I must look at it in every light. For myself, I have no wish at
+all to become master of our father's estate. I have been going in one
+groove for the last twenty years, and don't care about changing it. You
+wished me to do so ten years ago, and I declined then, and the ten years
+have not made me more desirous of change than I was before.”
+
+“All right; think it over. Please send Ramoo in to me; I have tired
+myself in talking.”
+
+John Thorndyke smoked many churchwarden pipes in the little arbor in his
+garden that day. In the afternoon his brother was so weak and tired that
+the subject of the conversation was not reverted to. At eight o'clock
+the Colonel went off to bed. The next morning, after breakfast, he was
+brighter again.
+
+“Well, John, what has come of your thinking?” he asked.
+
+“I don't like it, George.”
+
+“You mayn't like it, John, but you will do it. I am not going to have my
+girl run after by ruined spendthrifts who want her money to repair their
+fortunes; and I tell you frankly, if you refuse I shall go up to town
+tomorrow, and I shall make a new will, leaving all my property to your
+son, subject to a life annuity of 200 pounds a year to the child, and
+ordering that, in the event of his dying before he comes of age, or of
+refusing to accept the provisions of the will, or handing any of the
+property or money over to my daughter, the whole estate, money, jewels,
+and all, shall go to the London hospitals, subject, as before, to the
+annuity.
+
+“Don't be an ass, brother John. Do you think that I don't know what I
+am doing? I have seen enough of the evils of marrying for money out in
+India. Every ship that comes out brings so many girls sent out to some
+relation to be put on the marriage market, and marrying men old enough
+to be pretty nearly their grandfathers, with the natural consequence
+that there is the devil to pay before they have been married a year or
+two. Come, you know you will do it; why not give in at once, and have
+done with it? It is not a bad thing for you, it will be a good thing for
+your boy, it will save my girl from fortune hunters, and enable me to
+die quietly and comfortably.”
+
+“All right, George, I will do it. Mind, I don't do it willingly, but I
+do it for your sake.”
+
+“That is right,” Colonel Thorndyke said, holding out his thin bronzed
+hand to his brother; “that is off my mind. Now, there is only one other
+thing--those confounded jewels. But I won't talk about them now.”
+
+It was not indeed till three or four days later that the Colonel again
+spoke to his brother on any than ordinary matters. He had indeed been
+very weak and ailing. After breakfast, when, as usual, he was a little
+stronger and brighter than later in the day, he said to his brother
+suddenly:--
+
+“I suppose there are no hiding places in this room?”
+
+“Hiding places! What do you mean, George?”
+
+“Places where a fellow could hide up and hear what we are talking
+about.”
+
+“No, I don't think so,” the Squire replied, looking round vaguely. “Such
+an idea never occurred to me. Why do you ask?”
+
+“Because, John, if there is such a thing as a hiding place, someone will
+be sure to be hiding there. Where does that door lead to?”
+
+“It doesn't lead anywhere; it used to lead into the next room, but it
+was closed up before my time, and turned into a cupboard, and this door
+is permanently closed.”
+
+“Do you mind stepping round into the next room and seeing if anyone is
+in the cupboard?”
+
+Thinking that his brother was a little light headed, John Thorndyke went
+into the next room, and returned, saying gravely that no one was there.
+
+“Will you look behind the curtains, John, and under this sofa, and
+everywhere else where even a cat could be hidden? That seems all right,”
+ the Colonel went on, as his brother continued the search. “You know
+there is a saying that walls have ears, and I am not sure that it is
+not so. I have been haunted with the feeling that everything I did was
+watched, and that everything I said was listened to for years; and I can
+tell you it is a devilishly unpleasant thought. Draw your chair quite
+close to me. It is about my jewels, John. I always had a fancy for
+jewels--not to wear them, but to own them. In my time I have had good
+opportunities in that way, both in the Madras Presidency and in the
+Carnatic. In the first place, I have never cared for taking presents in
+money, but I have never refused jewels; and what with Rajahs and Nabobs
+and Ministers that one had helped or done a good turn to somehow, a good
+deal came to me that way.
+
+“Then I always made a point of carrying money with me, and after a
+defeat of the enemy or a successful siege, there was always lots of
+loot, and the soldiers were glad enough to sell anything in the way of
+jewels for a tithe of their value in gold. I should say if I put the
+value of the jewels at 50,000 pounds I am not much wide of the mark.
+That is all right, there is no bother about them; the trouble came
+from a diamond bracelet that I got from a soldier. We were in camp near
+Tanjore. I was officer of the day. I had made my rounds, and was coming
+back to my quarters, when I saw a soldier coming out of a tent thirty
+or forty yards away. It was a moonlight night, and the tent was one
+belonging to a white Madras regiment. Suddenly, I saw another figure,
+that had been lying down outside the tent, rise. I saw the flash of the
+moonlight on steel; then there was a blow, and the soldier fell. I drew
+my sword and rushed forward.
+
+“The native--for I could see that it was a native--was bending over the
+man he had stabbed. His back was towards me, and on the sandy soil he
+did not hear my footsteps until I was close to him; then he sprang up
+with a cry of fury, and leaped on me like a tiger. I was so taken by
+surprise that before I could use my sword the fellow had given me a
+nasty stab on the shoulder; but before he could strike again I had
+run him through. By this time several other, men ran out of the tent,
+uttering exclamations of rage at seeing their fallen comrade.
+
+“'What is it, sir?' they asked me.
+
+“'This scoundrel, here, has stabbed your comrade,' I said. 'He did not
+see me coming, and I ran up just as he was, I think, rifling him for
+booty. He came at me like a wild cat, and has given me a nasty stab.
+However, I have put an end to his game. Is your comrade dead?'
+
+“'No, sir, he is breathing still; but I fancy there is little chance for
+him.'
+
+“'You had better carry him to the hospital tent at once; I will send a
+surgeon there.'
+
+“I called the regimental surgeon up, and went with him to the hospital
+tent, telling him what had happened. He shook his head after examining
+the man's wound, which was fairly between the shoulders.
+
+“'He may live a few hours, but there is no chance of his getting
+better.'
+
+“'Now,' I said, 'you may as well have a look at my wound, for the
+villain stabbed me too.'
+
+“'You have had a pretty narrow escape of it,' he said, as he examined
+it. 'If he had struck an inch or two nearer the shoulder the knife would
+have gone right into you; but you see I expect he was springing as he
+struck, and the blow fell nearly perpendicularly, and it glanced down
+over your ribs, and made a gash six inches long. There is no danger. I
+will bandage it now, and tomorrow morning I will sew the edges together,
+and make a proper job of it.'
+
+“In the morning one of the hospital attendants came to me and said the
+soldier who had been wounded wanted to speak to me. The doctor said he
+would not live long. I went across to him. He was on a bed some little
+distance from any of the others, for it was the healthy season, and
+there were only three or four others in the tent.
+
+“'I hear, Major Thorndyke,' he said in a low voice, 'that you killed
+that fellow who gave me this wound, and that you yourself were stabbed.'
+
+“'Mine is not a serious business, my man,' I said. 'I wish you had got
+off as easily.'
+
+“'I have been expecting it, sir,' he said; 'and how I came to be fool
+enough to go outside the tent by myself I cannot think. I was uneasy,
+and could not sleep; I felt hot and feverish, and came out for a breath
+of fresh air. I will tell you what caused it, sir. About two years ago
+a cousin of mine, in one of the King's regiments, who was dying, they
+said, of fever (but I know the doctors thought he had been poisoned),
+said to me, “Here are some things that will make your fortune if ever
+you get to England; but I tell you beforehand, they are dangerous things
+to keep about you. I fancy that they have something to do with my being
+like this now. A year ago I went with some others into one of their
+great temples on a feast day. Well, the god had got on all his trinkets,
+and among them was a bracelet with the biggest diamonds I ever saw. I
+did not think so much of it at the time, but I kept on thinking of them
+afterwards, and it happened that some months after our visit we took the
+place by storm. I made straight for the temple, and I got the jewels. It
+don't matter how I got them--I got them. Well, since that I have never
+had any peace; pretty near every night one or other of our tents was
+turned topsy turvy, all the kits turned out, and even the ground dug
+up with knives. You know how silently Indian thieves can work. However,
+nothing was ever stolen, and as for the diamonds, at the end of every
+day's march I always went out as soon as it was quite dark, and buried
+the bracelet between the tent pegs; it did not take a minute to do. When
+we moved, of course, I took it up again. At last I gave that up, for
+however early I turned out in the morning there was sure to be a native
+about. I took then to dropping it down the barrel of my gun; that way I
+beat them. Still, I have always somehow felt myself watched, and my tent
+has been disturbed a great deal oftener than any of the others. I have
+had half a mind to throw the things away many a time, but I could not
+bring myself to do it.”
+
+“'Well, sir, I have carried the bracelet ever since. I have done as he
+did, and always had it in my musket barrel--When we had fighting to do I
+would drop it out into my hand and slip it into my ammunition pouch;
+but I know that I have always been followed, just as Bill was. I suppose
+they found out that I went to see him before he died. Anyhow, my tent
+has been rummaged again and again. I have no doubt that fellow whom you
+killed last night had been watching me all the time, and thought that I
+had come out to hide the things. However, there they are, sir. One of my
+mates brought my musket here a quarter of an hour ago, and emptied the
+barrel out for me. Now, sir, you did your best to save my life last
+night, and you killed that fellow who did for me, and you pretty nearly
+got killed yourself. I have got no one else I could give the things to,
+and if I were to give them to one of my mates in the regiment they would
+probably cost him his life, as they have cost me mine. But you will know
+what to do with the things; they are worth a lot of money if you can get
+them home. Mind, sir, you have got to be careful. I have heard tales of
+how those priests will follow up a temple jewel that has been lost for
+years, and never give it up until they get it back again.'
+
+“'I ought to give it up,' I said.
+
+“'You don't know where it came from, sir,' he replied. 'I was one of a
+party of convalescents who were sent up just before that fight, and my
+own regiment was not there: it might have been here, and it might have
+been in the Carnatic. Bill never told me, and I have no more idea than a
+babe unborn.'
+
+“The gems were certainly magnificent; and though I knew well enough that
+these untiring Brahmins would not be long in guessing that the things
+had come into my possession, I took the bracelet. I thought, anyhow,
+that I might have a few hours' start; the fellow I had killed might, of
+course, have one or two others with him, but I had to risk that. I got
+leave an hour later, and went down to Madras, and got them put into
+a place of safety. That I was watched all the time I was in India
+afterwards I have no doubt, but no attempts were made to assassinate
+me. They would have known that I went straight away, but whether I had
+buried them somewhere on the road, or had given them to someone's care
+at Madras they could not know, and there was, therefore, nothing for
+them to do but to wait till I made a move.
+
+“I have no doubt whatever that they came over in the same ship with me.
+Two or three times during the week I was in London I saw colored men in
+the street outside the hotel. Once it was a Lascar seaman, another time
+a dark looking sailor in European clothes: he might pass for a Spaniard.
+Several times as I was going about in a sedan chair I looked out
+suddenly, and each time there was a dark face somewhere in the street
+behind. I had a letter this morning from the lawyer, and he mentioned
+that two days ago his offices had been broken into, and every strong box
+and drawer forced open, but that, curiously enough, they could not find
+that anything had been stolen, though in the cashier's box there were 30
+pounds in gold. Of course it was my friends. I have no doubt that one or
+two of them have followed me down here; and for anything I know they may
+be lurking somewhere in your garden at the present moment--that is, if
+they are not standing beside us in this room.”
+
+John Thorndyke looked round with an uncomfortable feeling.
+
+“How do you mean, George?”
+
+“I mean some of those Indian fellows can do all sorts of wonderful
+conjuring tricks. I have seen them go up into the air on a rope and
+never come down again, and for aught I know they may be able to render
+themselves invisible. Seriously, I think that it is likely as not.”
+
+“Well, and where are the things to be found now, George?”
+
+“That I won't tell you, John. Before I go I will whisper it in your ear,
+and give you the means of finding them, but not till then. No, I will
+write it down on a piece of paper, and slip it into your hand. As soon
+as you get out of the room you glance at it, and then put the piece of
+paper into your mouth, chew it up and swallow it. I tell you I dare not
+even whisper it; but whatever you do, take no steps in the matter until
+your son comes of age.”
+
+“There can surely be no danger in another twelve years, George; they
+will have given up the search long before that.”
+
+
+“Not they,” the Colonel said emphatically. “If they die others will take
+their places: it is a sacred business with them. My advice to you is,
+either sell them directly you get them into your hands, or go straight
+to Amsterdam and sell them there to one of the diamond cutters, who will
+turn them out so that they will be altered beyond all recognition. Don't
+sell more than two stones at most to any one man; then they will never
+come out as a bracelet again, and the hunt will be over.”
+
+
+“I would almost rather leave them alone altogether, George.”
+
+“Well, they are worth 50,000 pounds if they are worth a penny, and a
+great deal more I should say; but you cannot leave them alone without
+leaving everything alone, for all my gems are with them, and 52,000
+pounds in gold. Of course, if you like you can, when you get the box,
+pick those diamonds out and chuck them away, but if you do you must do
+it openly, so that anyone watching you may see you do it, otherwise the
+search will go on.”
+
+Two days later, as Ramoo was helping the Colonel to the sofa, the latter
+was seized with a violent fit of coughing, then a rush of blood poured
+from his lips. His brother and Ramoo laid him on the sofa almost
+insensible.
+
+“Run and get some water, Ramoo,” John Thorndyke said.
+
+As Ramoo left the room the Colonel feebly placed his snuffbox in his
+brother's hand with a significant glance; then he made several desperate
+efforts to speak, and tried to struggle up into a sitting position;
+another gush of blood poured from him, and as it ceased he fell back
+dead.
+
+John Thorndyke was bitterly grieved at the death of his brother, and it
+was not until he went up to his room that night that he thought of the
+snuffbox that he had dropped into his pocket as his brother handed it
+to him. He had no doubt that it contained the instructions as to the
+treasure. It was of Indian manufacture. He emptied the snuff from it,
+but it contained nothing else. He was convinced that the secret must be
+hidden there, and after in vain endeavoring to find a spring, he took
+a poker and hammered it, and as it bent a spring gave way, and showed a
+very shallow false bottom.
+
+In this was a thin gold coin, evidently of considerable antiquity, and a
+small piece of paper, on which was written the word “Masulipatam.” John
+Thorndyke looked at it in bewilderment; that it was connected with the
+secret he felt certain, but alone it was absolutely useless. Doubtless
+his brother had intended to give him the key of the riddle, when he had
+so desperately striven to speak. After in vain thinking the matter over
+he said:
+
+“Well, thank goodness; there is nothing to be done about the matter for
+another thirteen or fourteen years; it is of no use worrying about it
+now.” He went to an old fashioned cabinet, and placed the coin and piece
+of paper in a very cunningly devised secret drawer. The next morning
+he went out into the garden and dropped the battered snuffbox into the
+well, and then dismissed the subject from his mind.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+
+Standing some two miles out of Reigate is the village of Crowswood, a
+quiet place and fairly well to do, thanks in no small degree to Squire
+Thorndyke, who owned the whole of the parish, and by whom and his
+tenants the greater portion of the village were employed. Greatly had
+the closing of the Manor House, after the death of old Squire Thorndyke,
+been felt. There were no more jellies, soups, and other comforts to
+be looked for in time of sickness, no abatement of rent when the
+breadwinner was sick or disabled, no check to the drunkards, whom the
+knowledge that they would be turned out of their cottage at a week's
+notice kept in some sort of order. When, therefore, after ten years
+of absence of all government, John Thorndyke, after the death of his
+brother, the Colonel, came down and took possession, he found the place
+sadly changed from what it had been when he had left it twenty years
+before. His first act was to dismiss Newman; who, completely unchecked,
+had, he found, been sadly mismanaging affairs. It was not long, however,
+before his hand made itself felt. Two out of the three public houses
+were shut up in six months, a score of their habitual frequenters had,
+weeks before, been turned out of their houses, an order had been issued
+that unless a cottage was kept in good order and the garden bright and
+blooming with flowers in the summer a fresh tenant would be found for
+it. Every child must be sent to the village school; the Squire was
+ready to do what there was to be done in the way of thatching and
+whitewashing, repairing palings and painting doors and windows, but,
+as he told the people, the village had to be kept clean and decent,
+and anyone who would not conform to the rules was at liberty to leave
+without a day's notice.
+
+Many of the villagers grumbled under their breath, but public opinion
+was, on the whole, favorable. There was someone to look after them now,
+someone who would see that the greater portion of the wages was not
+spent at the alehouse, who would take an interest in the people, and
+would lend a helping hand in bad times. There was a feeling of regret
+that the Squire was a widower, but the post of visitor and almoner was
+well supplied by the lady who acted as companion and governess to the
+Squire's little ward and regulated the affairs of his household.
+
+John Thorndyke had never had much occasion for the display of energy
+before, but he had an abundance of it, although hitherto latent. He
+had come into this business against his will, but he took it up with
+a determination to do well in it. The income was legally his until his
+niece came of age, but he was determined he would take nothing out of
+the estate beyond the necessary expenses of the position, and that all
+surplus should be expended in improving it in every way possible,
+so that he could hand it over to her in the most perfect condition.
+Therefore, when he came into possession he made a close inspection of
+the farms, with their houses, barns, and other tenements. Where he saw
+that the men were doing their best, that the hedges and fields were in
+good order, he did everything that was necessary without a word; but
+where there were slovenly farming and signs of neglect and carelessness,
+he spoke out his mind sharply.
+
+“This has all got to be amended,” he said. “What must be done I will
+do, but unless I see things well kept up, the fences in good order, the
+hedges cut, the cattle in good condition, and everything going on as
+it ought to be, out you go next Christmas. The estate at present is a
+disgrace to the county, but it shall not be so any longer if I can help
+it. I shall do my share, and anyone who is not prepared to do the same
+had better look out for another holding at once.”
+
+No one rejoiced more at the coming home of the Squire than Mr. Bastow,
+the Rector. He had had a pleasant time of it during the life of the old
+Squire. He was always a welcome guest at the house; Mr. Thorndyke had
+been ever ready to put his hand into his pocket for any repairs needed
+for the church, and bore on his shoulders almost the entire expense of
+the village school. In the latter respect there had been no falling off,
+he having given explicit instructions to his solicitors to pay his usual
+annual subscriptions to the school until his son's return from India.
+But with the death of the Squire the Rector had gradually lost all
+authority in the village.
+
+For a time force of habit had had its effect, but as this wore out and
+the people recognized that he had no real authority things went from bad
+to worse. Drunken men would shout jeeringly as they passed the Rectory
+on their way home from the alehouse; women no longer feared reproof for
+the untidiness of their houses and children; the school was half emptied
+and the church almost wholly so.
+
+For seven or eight years Mr. Bastow had a hard time of it. It was, then,
+both with pleasure as an old friend, and with renewed hopefulness for
+the village, that he visited John Thorndyke on his return. The change
+in the state of affairs was almost instantaneous. As soon as it became
+known that the Rector was backed, heart and soul, by the Squire's
+authority, and that a complaint from him was followed the next day by a
+notice to quit at the end of a week, his own authority was established
+as firmly as it had been in the old Squire's time, and in a couple of
+years Crowswood became quite a model village. Every garden blossomed
+with flowers; roses and eglantine clustered over the cottages, neatness
+and order prevailed everywhere.
+
+The children were tidily dressed and respectful in manner, the women
+bright and cheerful, and the solitary alehouse remaining had but few
+customers, and those few were never allowed to transgress the bounds of
+moderation. The Squire had a talk with the landlord a fortnight after
+his arrival.
+
+“I am not going to turn you out, Peters,” he said. “I hear that you make
+some efforts to keep your house decently; the other two I shall send
+packing directly their terms are up. Whether you remain permanently must
+depend upon yourself. I will do up your house for you, and build a bar
+parlor alongside, where quiet men can sit and smoke their pipes and talk
+and take their beer in comfort, and have liberty to enjoy themselves as
+long as their enjoyment does not cause annoyance to other people or keep
+their wives and children in rags. I will do anything for you if I
+find the place well conducted; but I warn you that I will have no
+drunkenness. A man who, to my knowledge, gets drunk twice, will not get
+drunk a third time in this parish, and if you let men get drunk here it
+is your fault as much as theirs. Now we understand each other.”
+
+Things once placed on a satisfactory footing, the Squire had but little
+more trouble, and it soon came to be understood that he was not to be
+trifled with, and that Crowswood was no longer a place for the idle or
+shiftless. Two or three of the farmers left at the termination of their
+year, but better men took their places, and John Thorndyke, having
+settled matters to his satisfaction, now began to attend more to other
+affairs. He had been, when he first came back, welcomed with great
+heartiness by all the gentry of the neighborhood; his father had been a
+popular man, and young Thorndyke had been regarded as a pleasant young
+fellow, and would in any case have been welcomed, if only because
+Crowswood had become a nuisance to the whole district. It was, indeed,
+a sort of rendezvous for poachers and bad characters, it was more than
+suspected that gangs of thieves and burglars made it their headquarters,
+and that even highwaymen found it a convenient and quiet resort.
+
+Thus, then, the transformation effected within a few months of Mr.
+Thorndyke's return caused general and lively satisfaction, and a year
+later he was put on the Commission of the Peace, and became one of the
+most regular attendants at the Bench of Magistrates. Reluctantly as
+he had taken up his present position, he found it, as time went on, a
+pleasant one. He had not been conscious before that time hung somewhat
+heavily on his hands, but here he had duties to perform and ample
+employment. His nature was naturally somewhat a masterful one, and
+both as a magistrate and a landlord he had scope and power of action.
+Occasionally he went up to London, always driving his gig, with a pair
+of fast trotting horses, and was known to the frequenters of the
+coffee houses chiefly patronized by country gentlemen. Altogether, John
+Thorndyke became quite a notable person in the district, and men were
+inclined to congratulate themselves upon the fact that he, and not the
+Indian officer, his brother, had come into the estate.
+
+The idea of an old Indian officer in those days was that he was almost
+of necessity an invalid, and an irritable one, with a liver hopelessly
+deranged, a yellow complexion, and a hatred of the English climate. The
+fact that, instead of leaving the army and coming home at his father's
+death, George Thorndyke had chosen to remain abroad and leave the estate
+to the management of agents, had specially prejudiced him in the eyes of
+the people of that part, and had heightened the warmth with which they
+had received his brother. John Thorndyke had upon the occasion, of his
+first visit to the family solicitors spoken his mind with much freedom
+as to the manner in which Newman had been allowed a free hand.
+
+“Another ten years,” he said, “and there would not have been a cottage
+habitable on the estate, nor a farm worth cultivating. He did absolutely
+nothing beyond collecting the rents. He let the whole place go to rack
+and ruin. The first day I arrived I sent him out of the house, with a
+talking to that he won't forget as long as he lives.”
+
+“We never heard any complaints about him, Mr. Thorndyke, except that I
+think we did once hear from the Rector of the place that his conduct was
+not satisfactory. I remember that we wrote to him about it, and he
+said that the Rector was a malignant fellow, on bad terms with all his
+parishioners.”
+
+“If I had the scoundrel here,” John Thorndyke said with indignation, “I
+would let him have a taste of the lash of my dog whip. You should not
+have taken the fellow's word; you should have sent down someone to find
+out the true state of things. Why, the place has been an eyesore to the
+whole neighborhood, the resort of poaching, thieving rascals; by gad,
+if my brother George had gone down there I don't know what would
+have happened! It will cost a couple of years' rent to get things put
+straight.”
+
+When the Squire was at home there was scarce an evening when the Rector
+did not come up to smoke a pipe and take his glass of old Jamaica or
+Hollands with him.
+
+“Look here, Bastow,” the latter said, some three years after his return,
+“what are you going to do with that boy of yours? I hear bad reports of
+him from everyone; he gets into broils at the alehouse, and I hear
+that he consorts with a bad lot of fellows down at Reigate. One of my
+tenants--I won't mention names--complained to me that he had persecuted
+his daughter with his attentions. They say, he was recognized among that
+poaching gang that had an affray with Sir James Hartrop's keepers. The
+thing is becoming a gross scandal.”
+
+“I don't know what to do about him, Squire; the boy has always been a
+trouble to me. You see, before you came home, he got into bad hands in
+the village here. Of course they have all gone, but several of them only
+moved as far as Reigate, and he kept up their acquaintance. I thrashed
+him again and again, but he has got beyond that now, you see; he is
+nearly eighteen, and openly scoffs at my authority. Upon my word, I
+don't know what to do in the matter.”
+
+“He is growing up a thorough young ruffian,” the Squire said
+indignantly, “and one of these mornings I expect to see him brought up
+before us charged with some serious offense. We had to fine him last
+week for being drunk and making a disturbance down at Reigate. Why do
+you let him have money? You may have no authority over him; but at least
+you should refuse to open your purse to him. Don't you see that this
+sort of thing is not only a disgrace to him, but very prejudicial to
+the village? What authority can you have for speaking against vice and
+drunkenness, when your son is constantly intoxicated?”
+
+“I see that, Squire--none better; and I have thought of resigning my
+cure.”
+
+“Stuff and nonsense, Parson! If the young fellow persists in his present
+course he must leave the village, that is clear enough; but that is no
+reason why you should. The question is what is to be done with him? The
+best thing he could do would be to enlist. He might be of some service
+to his country, in India or the American Colonies, but so far as I can
+see he is only qualifying himself for a jail here.”
+
+“I have told him as much, Squire,” Mr. Bastow said, in a depressed
+voice, “and he has simply laughed in my face, and said that he was very
+comfortable where he was, and had no idea whatever of moving.”
+
+“What time does he go out in the morning?” John Thorndyke asked
+abruptly.
+
+“He never gets up till twelve o'clock, and has his breakfast when I take
+my dinner.”
+
+“Well, I will come in tomorrow morning and have a talk with him myself.”
+
+The next day the Squire rode up to the door of the Rectory soon after
+one o'clock. Mr. Bastow had just finished his meal; his son, a young
+fellow of between seventeen and eighteen, was lolling in an easy chair.
+
+“I have come in principally to speak to you, young sir,” John Thorndyke
+said quietly. “I have been asking your father what you intend to do with
+yourself. He says he does not know.”
+
+The young fellow looked up with an air of insolent effrontery.
+
+“I don't know that it is any business of yours, Mr. Thorndyke, what I do
+with myself.”
+
+“Oh, yes, it is,” the Squire replied. “This village and the people in it
+are mine. You are disturbing the village with your blackguard conduct;
+you are annoying some of the girls on the estate, and altogether you are
+making yourself a nuisance. I stopped at the alehouse as I came here,
+and have ordered the landlord to draw no more liquor for you, and unless
+you amend your conduct, and that quickly, I will have you out of the
+village altogether.”
+
+“I fancy, Mr. Thorndyke, that, even as a justice of the peace, you have
+not the power to dictate to my father who shall be the occupant of this
+house.”
+
+“What you say is perfectly true; but as you make your father's life a
+burden to him, and he is desirous of your absence, I can and will
+order the village constable to remove you from his house by force, if
+necessary.”
+
+The young fellow cast an evil glance at his father. “He has not been
+complaining, has he?” he said, with a sneer.
+
+“He has not, sir,” John Thorndyke said indignantly. “It is I who have
+been complaining to him, and he admits that you are altogether beyond
+his authority. I have pointed out to him that he is in no way obliged
+to support you at your age in idleness and dissipation, and that it were
+best for him and all concerned that he should close his doors to you. I
+don't want to have to send the son of my old friend to prison, but I can
+see well enough that that is what it will come to if you don't give up
+your evil courses. I should think you know by this time that I am a man
+of my word. I have taken some pains to purge this village of all bad
+characters, and I do not intend to have an exception made of the son of
+the clergyman, who, in his family as well as in his own person, is bound
+to set an example.”
+
+“Well, Mr. Thorndyke, I utterly decline to obey your orders or to be
+guided by your advice.”
+
+“Very well, sir,” the magistrate said sternly. “Mr. Bastow, do I
+understand that you desire that your son shall no longer remain an
+inmate of your house?”
+
+“I do,” the clergyman said firmly; “and if he does so I have no other
+course before me but to resign my living; my position here has become
+absolutely unbearable.”
+
+“Very well, sir, then you will please lock your doors tonight, and if he
+attempts to enter, I, as a magistrate, should know how to deal with
+him. Now, young sir, you understand your position; you may not take my
+advice, nevertheless, I shall give it you. The best thing you can do
+is to take your place for town on the outside of the coach that comes
+through Reigate this afternoon, and tomorrow morning proceed either to
+the recruiting officer for His Majesty's service, or to that for the
+East India Company's. You have health and strength, you will get rid at
+once of your bad associates, and will start afresh in a life in which
+you may redeem your past and be useful to your king and country.”
+
+Young Bastow smiled.
+
+“Thanks,” he said sarcastically. “I have my own plans, and shall follow
+them.”
+
+“I would think, Mr. Bastow,” the Squire said quietly, “it would just
+be as well for you to come home with me. I don't think that the leave
+taking is likely to be an affectionate one.”
+
+The Rector rose at once.
+
+“I will come with you, Squire. I may tell you now, what I have not told
+you before, that my son has more than once raised his hand against me,
+and that I do not care to be left alone with him.”
+
+“I judged him capable even of that, Mr. Bastow.”
+
+“Goodby, Arthur,” his father said. “My heart is ready to break that it
+has come to this; but for both our sakes it is better so. Goodby, my
+son, and may Heaven lead you to better ways! If ever you come to me and
+say, 'Father, I have turned over a new leaf, and heartily repent the
+trouble I have caused you,' you will receive a hearty welcome from me,
+and no words of reproach for the past.”
+
+The young man paid no attention to the offered hand, but laughed
+scornfully.
+
+“You have not got rid of me yet,” he said. “As for you, Squire
+Thorndyke, I shall not forget your meddlesome interference, and some
+day, maybe, you will be sorry for it.”
+
+“I think not,” John Thorndyke said gravely. “I am doing my duty to the
+village, and still more I am doing my duty to an old friend, and I am
+not likely ever to feel any regret that I have so acted. Now, Parson,
+let's be off.”
+
+After leaving the house with the clergyman, the Squire stopped at the
+house of Knapp, the village constable; and said a few words to him,
+then, leading his horse, walked home with Mr. Bastow.
+
+“Don't be cast down, old friend,” he said. “It is a terrible trial to
+you; but it is one sharp wrench, and then it will be over. Anything is
+better than what you must have been suffering for some time.”
+
+“I quite feel that, Squire; my life has indeed been intolerable of late.
+I had a painful time before, but always looked forward with hope to your
+brother coming home. Since you returned, and matters in the parish have
+been put straight, this trouble has come in to take the place of the
+other, and I have felt that I would rather resign and beg for charity
+than see my son going from bad to worse, a scandal to the parish, and a
+hindrance to all good work.”
+
+“It is a bad business, Bastow, and it seems to me that two or three
+years in prison would be the best thing for him, as he will not take up
+the only trade open to him. At any rate, it would separate him from his
+evil associates, and give you peace while he is behind the bars. Where
+does he get his money?”
+
+“That I know not, Squire. He takes some from me--it used to be done
+secretly, now it is done with threats, and, as I told you, with
+violence--but that would not account for his always having money. He
+must get it somewhere else, for when I have paid my bills, as I always
+do the hour that I receive money, there is but little over for him
+to take. He is often away all night, sometimes for two or three days
+together, and I dare not think what he does with himself; but certainly
+he gets money somehow, and I am afraid that I cannot hope it is honestly
+obtained.”
+
+“I do not well see how it can be,” the Squire agreed.
+
+“If I had before known as much as you tell me now, I would have taken
+some steps to have him watched, and to nip the matter before it went too
+far. Do you think that he will take your notice, and come no more to the
+house?”
+
+Mr. Bastow shook his head.
+
+“I fear that the only effect will be to make him worse, even when he was
+quite a small boy punishment only had that effect with him. He will come
+back tonight probably half drunk, and certainly furious at my having
+ventured to lay the case before you.”
+
+“You must lock the doors and bar the windows.”
+
+“I did that when he first took to being out at night, but he always
+managed to get in somehow.”
+
+“Well, it must be all put a stop to, Bastow; and I will come back with
+you this evening, and if this young rascal breaks into the house I will
+have him down at Reigate tomorrow on the charge of house breaking; or,
+at any rate, I will threaten to do so if he does not give a promise that
+he will in future keep away from you altogether.”
+
+“I shall be glad, at any rate, if you will come down, Squire, for, to
+say the truth, I feel uneasy as to the steps he may take in his fury at
+our conversation just now.”
+
+John Thorndyke took down from a wall a heavy hunting whip, as he went
+out with the parson at nine o'clock. He had in vain endeavored to cheer
+his old friend as they sat over their steaming glasses of Jamaica. The
+parson had never been a strong man; he was of a kindly disposition, and
+an unwearied worker when there was an opportunity for work, but he had
+always shrunk from unpleasantness, and was ready to yield rather than
+bring about trouble. He had for a long time suffered in silence, and
+had not the Squire himself approached the subject of his son's
+delinquencies, he would have never opened his mouth about it. Now,
+however, that he had done so, and the Squire had taken the matter in
+hand, and had laid down what was to be done, though he trembled at the
+prospect, he did not even think of opposing his plan, and indeed could
+think of no alternative for it.
+
+“I have told John Knapp to be here,” the Squire said, as they reached
+the house. “It is just as well that he should be present if your son
+comes back again. He is a quiet, trustworthy fellow, and will keep his
+mouth shut if I tell him.”
+
+Mr. Bastow made no reply. It was terrible to him that there should be
+another witness to his son's conduct, but he saw that the Squire was
+right. An old woman opened the door.
+
+“Are all the shutters closed and barred?” John Thorndyke asked her.
+
+“Yes, sir; I always sees to that as soon as it gets dark.”
+
+“Very well; you can go to bed now, Elisa,” her master said. “Is John
+Knapp here?”
+
+“Yes, he came an hour ago, and is sitting in the kitchen.”
+
+“I will call him in myself when I want to speak to him.”
+
+As soon as the old servant had gone upstairs the Squire went into the
+kitchen, Mr. Bastow having gone to the cellar to fetch up a bottle of
+old brandy that was part of a two dozen case given to him by the old
+Squire fifteen years before.
+
+“Do you go round the house, John, and see that everything is properly
+fastened up. I see that you have got a jug of beer there. You had better
+get a couple of hours' sleep on that settle. I shall keep watch, till I
+am sleepy, and then I will call you. Let me know if you find any of the
+doors or windows unbarred.”
+
+Five minutes later the constable knocked at the door of the parlor. “The
+door opening into the stable yard was unbarred, Squire.”
+
+“I thought it likely that it would be so, Knapp. You have made it fast
+now, I suppose? That is right. Now lie down and get an hour or two of
+sleep; it is scarce likely that he will be back until late.
+
+“That was the old woman, of course,” he went on to his companion, when
+the door closed behind the constable. “I thought it likely enough that
+he might tell her to leave a way for him to come in. You told me that
+she had been with you a good many years. I dare say she has left that
+door unbarred for him many a time. I should advise you to get a man to
+sleep in the house regularly; there are plenty of fellows who will be
+glad to do it for a shilling or two a week, and I do not think that it
+is safe for you to be here alone.”
+
+An hour later he said to the Rector: “Now, Bastow, you had best go
+to bed. I have taken the matter into my own hands, and will carry
+it through. However, I won't have him taken away without your being
+present, and will call you when we want you. Of course, if he will give
+a solemn promise not to molest you, and, even if he won't enlist, to
+leave this part of the country altogether, I shall let him off.”
+
+“There is one thing, Mr. Thorndyke, that I have not told you,” the
+Rector said hesitatingly. “Sometimes, when he comes home late, he brings
+someone with him; I have heard voices downstairs. I have never seen who
+it was--for what could I have done if I went down?--but I have heard
+horses brought round to the stable yard, and heard them ride away:”
+
+“It is just as well you told me,” the Squire said dryly. “If you had
+told me this evening at the house, I would have dropped a brace of
+pistols into my pocket. However, this hunting crop is a good weapon;
+but I don't suppose they will show fight, even if anyone is with him.
+Besides, Knapp has a stout oaken cudgel with him--I noticed it standing
+against his chair as I went in--and as he is a strong active fellow, and
+we shall have the advantage of a surprise, I fancy we should be a match
+even for three or four of them.”
+
+At one o'clock the Squire roused John Knapp. “It is one o'clock, John;
+now take off your boots. I don't want him to know that there is anyone
+in the house till we get hold of him. I am going to lie down on the sofa
+in the parlor. The moment you hear footsteps you come and wake me.”
+
+The clock in the kitchen had just struck two when the constable shook
+John Thorndyke. “There are two horses just coming into the yard.”
+
+“All right. I opened a window in the room looking down into the yard
+before I lay down. I will go up and see what they are going to do. If
+they try to break in anywhere down here, do you come at once quietly up
+to me.”
+
+The Squire had taken off his boots before he lay down, and, holding his
+heavy hunting crop in his hand, he went quietly upstairs. As he went to
+the window he heard Arthur Bastow say angrily:
+
+“Confound the old woman! she has locked the door; she has never played
+me that trick before. There is a ladder in the stable, and I will get in
+at that window up there and open it for you. Or you may as well come up
+that way, too, and then you can stow the things away in my room at once,
+and have done with it.”
+
+The Squire went hastily down.
+
+“Come upstairs, Knapp,” he whispered to the constable. “There are three
+of them, and I fancy the two mounted men are highwaymen. Let them all
+get in, keeping yourself well back from the window. The moon is round on
+the other side of the house, but it will be light enough for us to see
+them as they get in. I will take the last fellow, and I will warrant
+that he will give no trouble; then I will fall upon the second, and do
+you spring on young Bastow. The two highwaymen are sure to have pistols,
+and he may have some also. Give him a clip with that cudgel of yours
+first, then spring on him, and hold his arms tightly by his side. If I
+call you give him a back heel and throw him smartly, and then come to
+my aid. I don't think I shall want it, but it is as well to prepare for
+everything.”
+
+They went upstairs and took their places, one on each side of the
+window, standing three or four feet back. Just as they took up their
+positions the top of the stable ladder appeared above the sill of the
+window. Half a minute later young Bastow's head appeared, and he threw
+up the sash still higher, and stepped into the room; then he turned and
+helped two men in, one after the other.
+
+“Follow me,” he said, “then you won't tumble over the furniture.”
+
+As they turned, the heavy handle of John's Thorndyke's whip fell with
+tremendous force on the head of the last man.
+
+“What the devil is that?” the other exclaimed, snatching out a pistol
+and turning round, as the falling body struck him, but he got no
+further. Again the heavy whip descended, this time on his right arm;
+it dropped useless by his side, and the pistol fell from his hand. Then
+John Thorndyke fell upon him and bore him to the ground, snatched the
+other pistol from his belt, and held it to his head.
+
+“Now, my man,” he said quietly, “if you don't surrender I will blow out
+your brains.”
+
+“I surrender,” the man moaned. “I believe that you have broken my arm.
+Curse you, whoever you are.”
+
+The struggle between John Knapp and young Bastow was soon over.
+The young fellow was lithe and sinewy, but he was no match for the
+constable, who, indeed, had almost overpowered him before he was aware
+what had happened.
+
+“Has he got pistols, Knapp?” the Squire asked.
+
+“Yes, sir, a brace of them; I have got them both safely in my pocket.
+There,” he went on, as a sharp click was heard, “I have got the darbys
+on him. Now shall I help you, sir?”
+
+“You had better run downstairs first and light a couple of candles at
+the kitchen fire: you will find a pair standing on the parlor table.
+Don't be long about it; the first fellow I hit was stunned, and he may
+come round any moment.”
+
+“I will make sure of him before I go, Squire. I have got another pair of
+darbys in my pocket.”
+
+As soon as he had fastened these upon the wrists of the insensible man
+he ran downstairs, and in a minute returned with the candles.
+
+“I am glad that you are back,” the Squire said. “I was afraid that young
+rascal would try to escape.”
+
+“I took good care of that, Squire; you see I put one of his arms round
+the bedpost before I slipped the darbys on, and he cannot get away
+unless he takes the whole bed with him; and as I don't think he would
+get it out either by the window or the door, he is as safe here as he
+would be in Newgate. What is the next thing to do, Squire?”
+
+“You had better tie this fellow's legs. I will leave you a candle here,
+and you can keep guard over them while I go and wake Mr. Bastow.”
+
+The Rector needed no waking; he was walking up and down his room in
+great distress. He had not undressed, but had thrown himself upon his
+bed.
+
+“What has happened, Thorndyke?” he asked as the Squire entered. “I heard
+two heavy falls, and I felt that something terrible had taken place.”
+
+“Well, it has been a serious matter--very serious. That unfortunate
+son of yours is not hurt, but I don't know but that the best thing that
+could have happened would have been for him to have got a bullet through
+his head. He brought home with him two men who are, I have little doubt,
+highwaymen; anyhow, they each had a brace of pistols in their belt, and
+from what he said I think they have been stopping a coach. At any rate,
+they have something with them that they were going to hide here, and
+I fancy it is not the first time that it has been done. I don't expect
+your son had anything to do with the robbery, though he was carrying a
+brace of pistols, too; however, we have got them all three.
+
+“Now, you see, Bastow, this takes the affair altogether out of our
+hands. I had hoped that when we caught your son in the act of breaking
+into your house after you had ordered him from it, we should be able to
+frighten him into enlisting, or, at any rate, into promising to disturb
+you no more, for even if we had taken him before the bench, nothing
+could have been done to him, for under such circumstances his
+re-entering the house could not be looked upon as an act of burglary. As
+it is, the affair is altogether changed. Even if I wished to do so, as a
+magistrate I could not release those two highwaymen; they must appear as
+prisoners in court. I shall hear down in the town tomorrow morning what
+coach has been stopped, and I have no doubt that they have on them the
+proceeds of the robbery. Your son was consorting with and aiding them,
+and acting as a receiver of stolen goods, and as you have heard horses
+here before it is probable that when his room is thoroughly searched we
+shall come upon a number of articles of the same sort. I am sorry that
+I ever meddled in the matter; but it is too late for that now. You had
+better come downstairs with me, and we will take a turn in the garden,
+and try to see what had best be done.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+
+John Thorndyke opened the shutters of the parlor window, and stepped out
+into the garden alone, for the Rector was too unnerved and shattered to
+go out with him, but threw himself on the sofa, completely prostrated.
+Half an hour later the Squire re-entered the room. The morning was just
+beginning to break. Mr. Bastow raised his head and looked sadly at him.
+
+“I can see no way out of it, old friend. Were it not that he is in
+charge of the constable, I should have said that your only course was
+to aid your son to escape; but Knapp is a shrewd fellow as well as
+an honest one. You cannot possibly get your son away without his
+assistance, for he is handcuffed to the bed, and Knapp, in so serious a
+matter as this, would not, I am sure, lend himself to an escape. I have
+no doubt that with my influence with the other magistrates, and, indeed,
+on the circumstances of the case, they will commit him on a minor charge
+only, as the passengers of the coach will, I hope, give evidence that it
+was stopped by mounted men alone. I think, therefore, that he would
+only be charged with consorting with and aiding the highwaymen after the
+event, and of aiding them to conceal stolen goods--that is, if any are
+found in his room.
+
+“That much stolen property has been hidden there, there is little reason
+to doubt, but it may have been removed shortly afterwards. It was, of
+course, very convenient for them to have some place where they could
+take things at once, and then ride on quietly to London the next day,
+for, if arrested; nothing would be found upon them, and it would be
+impossible to connect them with the robbery. Later on they might come
+back again and get them from him. Of course, if nothing is found in his
+room, we get rid of the charge of receiving altogether, and there would
+be nothing but harboring, aiding, and abetting--a much less serious
+business. Look here, old friend, I will strain a point. I will go out
+into the garden again and walk about for an hour, and while I am out, if
+you should take advantage of my absence to creep up to your son's room
+and to search it thoroughly, examining every board of the floor to see
+if it is loose, and should you find anything concealed, to take it and
+hide it, of course I cannot help it. The things, if there are any, might
+secretly be packed up by you in a box and sent up to Bow Street, with a
+line inside, saying that they are proceeds of robbery, and that you hope
+the owners will be traced and their property restored to them. Not, of
+course, in your own hand, and without a signature. There might be some
+little trouble in managing it, but it could, no doubt, be done.”
+
+John Thorndyke went out into the garden without another word. The hour
+was nearly up when Mr. Bastow came out; he looked ten years older than
+he had done on the previous day. He wrung his friend's hand.
+
+“Thank God I have been up there,” he said. “I do not think they will
+find anything.”
+
+“Say nothing about it, Bastow; I don't want to know whether you found
+anything. Now I am going to fetch two or three of the men from the
+village, to get them to aid the constable in keeping guard, and another
+to go up to the house at once and order a groom to saddle one of my
+horses and bring it here.”
+
+As it was now past five o'clock, and the Squire found most of the men
+getting up, he sent one off to the house with the message, and returned
+with two others to the Rectory. He told them briefly that two highwaymen
+had been arrested during the night, and that as young Mr. Bastow was in
+their company at the time, it had been necessary as a matter of form to
+arrest him also. He went upstairs with them.
+
+“I have brought up two men to sit with you, Knapp, until the Reigate
+constables come up. You can take those handcuffs off Mr. Bastow, but
+see that he does not leave the room, and do you yourself sit in a chair
+against the door, and place one of these men at the window. How about
+others?”
+
+“The man you hit first, Squire, did not move until a quarter of an hour
+ago; he has been muttering to himself since, but I don't think he is
+sensible. The other one has been quiet enough, but there is no doubt
+that his arm is broken.”
+
+“I am going to ride down to Reigate at once, and will bring back a
+surgeon with me.”
+
+“You will repent this night's business, Thorndyke!” Arthur Bastow said
+threateningly.
+
+“I fancy that you will repent it more than I shall, Bastow; it is likely
+that you will have plenty of time to do so.”
+
+It was not long before the groom with the horse arrived. John Thorndyke
+rode at a gallop down to Reigate, and first called on the head
+constable.
+
+“Dawney,” he said, as the man came down, partially dressed, at his
+summons, “has anything taken place during the night?”
+
+“Yes, Squire, the up coach was stopped a mile before it got here, and
+the passengers robbed. It was due here at one, and did not come in till
+half an hour later. Of course I was sent for. The guard was shot. There
+were two of the fellows. He let fly with his blunderbuss, but he does
+not seem to have hit either of them, and one rode up and shot him dead;
+then they robbed all the passengers. They got six gold watches, some
+rings, and, adding up the amounts taken from all the passengers, about a
+hundred and fifty pounds in money.”
+
+“Well, I fancy I have got your two highwaymen safe, _Dawney_.”
+
+“You have, sir?” the constable said in astonishment.
+
+“Yes. I happened to be at the Rectory. Mr. Bastow had had a quarrel with
+his son, and had forbidden him the house.”
+
+The constable shook his head. “I am afraid he is a very bad one, that
+young chap.”
+
+“I am afraid he is, Dawney. However, his father was afraid that he might
+come in during the night and make a scene, so I said I would stop with
+him, and I took our village constable with me. At two o'clock this
+morning the young fellow came with two mounted men, who, I have no
+doubt, were highwaymen. We had locked up down below. Bastow took a
+ladder, and the three got in at a bedroom window on the first floor.
+Knapp and I were waiting for them there, and, taking them by surprise,
+succeeded in capturing them before the highwaymen could use their
+pistols. The constable and two men are looking after them, but as one
+has not got over a knock I gave him on the head, and the other has a
+broken arm, there is little fear of their making their escape. You had
+better go up with two of your men, and take a light cart with you with
+some straw in the bottom, and bring them all down here. I will ride
+round myself to Mr. Chetwynde, Sir Charles Harris, and Mr. Merchison,
+and we will sit at twelve o'clock. You can send round a constable with
+the usual letters to the others, but those three will be quite enough
+for the preliminary examination.”
+
+“Well, Squire, that is good news indeed. We have had the coach held up
+so often within five miles of this place during the past three months,
+that we have been getting quite a bad name. And to think that young
+Bastow was in it! I have heard some queer stories about him, and fancied
+before long I should have to put my hand upon his shoulder; but I didn't
+expect this.”
+
+“There is not a shadow of proof that he had anything to do with the
+robbery, Dawney, but he will have difficulty in proving that he did not
+afterwards abet them. It is serious enough as it is, and I am terribly
+grieved for his father's sake.”
+
+“Yes, sir; I have always heard him spoken of as a kind gentleman, and
+one who took a lot of trouble whenever anyone was sick. Well, sir, I
+will be off in twenty minutes. I will run round at once and send Dr.
+Hewett up to the Rectory, and a man shall start on horseback at seven
+o'clock with the summons to the other magistrates.”
+
+John Thorndyke rode round to his three fellow magistrates, who, living
+nearest to the town, were most regular in their attendance at the
+meetings. They all listened in surprise to his narrative, and expressed
+great pleasure at hearing that the men who had been such a pest to
+the neighborhood, and had caused them all personally a great deal of
+trouble, had been captured. All had heard tales, too, to Arthur Bastow's
+disadvantage, and expressed great commiseration for his father. They
+agreed to meet at the court half an hour before business began, to talk
+the matter over together.
+
+“It is out of the question that we can release him on bail,” the
+gentleman who was chairman of the bench said. “Quite so,” John Thorndyke
+agreed. “In the first place, the matter is too serious; and in the
+next, he certainly would not be able to find bail; and lastly, for his
+father's sake, it is unadvisable that he should be let out. At the same
+time, it appears to me that there is a broad distinction between his
+case and the others. I fear that there can be no question that he had
+prior acquaintance with these men, and that he was cognizant of the
+whole business; something I heard him say, and which, to my regret, I
+shall have to repeat in court, almost proves that he was so. Still, let
+us hope none of the stolen property will be found upon him; whether they
+had intended to pass it over to his care or not is immaterial. If they
+had not done so, I doubt whether he could be charged with receiving
+stolen goods, and we might make the charge simply one of aiding these
+two criminals, and of being so far an accessory after the crime.
+
+“If we could soften it down still further I should, for his father's
+sake, be glad; but as far as he himself is concerned, I would do nothing
+to lighten his punishment. He is about as bad a specimen of human nature
+as I ever came across. His father is in bodily fear of him. I saw the
+young fellow yesterday, and urged him to enlist, in order to break
+himself loose from the bad companionship he had fallen into. His reply
+was insolent and defiant in the highest degree, and it was then that in
+his father's name I forbade him the house, and as his father was present
+he confirmed what I said, and told him that he would not have anything
+more to do with him. This affair may do him good, and save his neck from
+a noose. A few years at the hulks or a passage to Botany Bay will do him
+no harm; and, at any rate, his father will have rest and peace, which he
+never would have if he remained here.”
+
+A somewhat similar conversation took place at each house. John Thorndyke
+breakfasted at Sir Charles Harris', the last of the three upon whom he
+called, and then mounting rode back to Reigate.
+
+“We have found the plunder on them,” the head constable said, coming
+out of the lockup as he drew rein before it, “and, fortunately for young
+Bastow, nothing was found upon him.”
+
+“How are the two men?”
+
+“The fellow you hit first is conscious now, sir, but very weak. The
+doctor says that if he hadn't had a thick hat on, your blow would have
+killed him to a certainty. The other man's arm is set and bandaged, and
+he is all right otherwise. We shall be able to have them both in court
+at twelve o'clock.”
+
+The Squire rode up to his house. He was met at the door by his son, in a
+state of great excitement.
+
+“Is it all true, father? The news has come from the village that you
+have killed two men, and that they and Arthur Bastow have all been taken
+away in a cart, guarded by constables.”
+
+“As usual, Mark, rumor has exaggerated matters. There are no dead men;
+one certainly got a crack on the head that rendered him insensible for
+some time, and another's arm is broken.”
+
+“And are they highwaymen, father? They say that two horses were fastened
+behind the cart.”
+
+“That is what we are going to try, Mark. Until their guilt is proved, no
+one knows whether they are highwaymen or not.”
+
+“And why is Arthur Bastow taken, father?”
+
+“Simply because he was in company with the others. Now, you need not ask
+any more questions, but if you like to get your pony saddled and ride
+down with me to Reigate at eleven o'clock, I will get you into the
+courthouse, and then you will hear all about it.”
+
+At greater length the Squire went into the matter with Mrs. Cunningham,
+his lady housekeeper, and his ward's governess.
+
+“It is a bad business, Mr. Thorndyke,” she said, “and must be terrible
+for poor Mr. Bastow.”
+
+“Yes, it is a bad business altogether, except that it will rid him of
+this young rascal. If I were in his place I should be ready to suffer a
+good deal to obtain such a riddance.”
+
+“I suppose that you won't sit upon the bench today?”
+
+“No; at least I shall take no part in the deliberations. I shall, of
+course, give evidence. The affair is not likely to last very long; my
+story will take the longest to tell. Knapp's will be confirmatory of
+mine, and the Reigate constable will depose to finding the watches,
+rings, and money upon them; then, of course, the case will be adjourned
+for the attendance of the coachman and some of the passengers. I don't
+suppose they will be able to swear to their identity, for no doubt
+they were masked. But that is immaterial; the discovery of the stolen
+property upon them will be sufficient to hang them. No doubt we shall
+have some Bow Streets runners down from town tomorrow or next day, and
+they will most likely be able to say who the fellows are.”
+
+“Will Mr. Bastow have to give evidence against his son?”
+
+“Not before us, I think; but I imagine he will have to appear at the
+trial.”
+
+“It will be terrible for him.”
+
+“Yes, terrible. I sincerely hope that they will not summon him, but I am
+afraid that there is very little doubt about it; they are sure to want
+to know about his son's general conduct, though possibly the testimony
+on that point of the constable at Reigate will be sufficient. My own
+hope is that he will get a long sentence; at any rate, one long enough
+to insure his not coming back during his father's lifetime. If you had
+seen his manner when we were talking to him yesterday, you would believe
+that he is capable of anything. I have had a good many bad characters
+before me during the year and a half that I have sat upon the bench, but
+I am bound to say that I never saw one who was to my eyes so thoroughly
+evil as this young fellow. I don't think,” he added with a smile, “that
+I should feel quite comfortable myself if he were acquitted; it will
+be a long time before I shall forget the expression of his face when
+he said to me this morning, 'You will repent this night's work,
+Thorndyke.'”
+
+“You don't mean that you think he would do you any harm, Mr. Thorndyke?”
+
+“Well, I should not care to meet him in a lonely place if he was armed
+and I was not. But you need not be nervous, Mrs. Cunningham, there is
+not the smallest chance of his being out for years; and by that time his
+blood will have had time to cool down, and he will have learnt, at any
+rate, that crimes cannot be committed in this country with impunity.”
+
+“It is all very shocking,” the lady said. “What will poor Mr. Bastow do?
+I should think that he would not like to remain as clergyman here, where
+everyone knows about it.”
+
+“That must be for him to decide,” the Squire said; “but if he wishes to
+resign I certainly shall not press him to continue to hold the living.
+He is a very old friend of mine. My father presented the living to him
+when I was nine or ten years old, and I may say I saw him daily up to
+the time when I went down into Sussex. If he resigns I should urge him
+to take up his residence here and to act as Mark's tutor; and he might
+also relieve you of some of Millicent's lessons. You have plenty to do
+in looking after the management of things in general. However, that is
+for the future.”
+
+At eleven o'clock the Squire drove down to Reigate, taking Mark with
+him, as it would save all trouble about putting up the horse and pony.
+On arriving he handed Mark over to the head constable, and asked him to
+pass him into a seat in the courthouse, before the public were let in.
+
+Reigate was in a state of unusual excitement. That the coach should have
+been stopped and robbed was too common an event to excite much interest,
+but that two highwaymen should have been captured, and, as was rumored,
+a young gentleman brought in on a charge of being in connection with
+them, caused a thrill of excitement. Quite a small crowd was assembled
+before the courthouse, and the name of Squire Thorndyke passed from
+mouth to mouth.
+
+“There is some talk of his being mixed up with it in some way or other,”
+ one said. “I saw him myself ride in here, about half past five, and
+I wondered he was about so early. Some do say as he caught the two
+highwaymen single handed; but that don't stand to reason. Besides,
+what could he have been doing out at such an hour as that? He is a good
+landlord, and they say that Crowswood has been quite a different place
+since he came to be master. He is a tight hand as a magistrate, and
+cleared out half the village the first two or three months he was there;
+but he spent a mint of money on the place, and the people there say that
+they could not have a better master. Ah, here is Squire Chetwynd. He was
+sure to be here. There is Sir Charles' gig turning the corner. I expect
+most of them will be on the bench; they don't get such a case as this
+every day.”
+
+“It may be there will be nothing for us to hear when the court opens,”
+ another said. “I hear both the fellows have been shot or knocked about
+so bad that they cannot be brought up. Of course the court cannot sit if
+they aint before it.”
+
+“That is not so, Master Jones. I spoke to one of the constables half an
+hour ago--he lives next door to me--and he said that they would be well
+enough to appear. Neither of them have been shot, though they have been
+hurt pretty bad.”
+
+All this added to the desire of those around to get into the court, and
+there was quite a rush when the doors were opened two minutes before
+twelve, and it was at once crammed, the constable having some difficulty
+in getting the doors shut, and in persuading those who could not get in
+that there was not standing room for another person. There was a buzz of
+talk in court until the door opened and six magistrates came in. It was
+observed that John Thorndyke did not seat himself with the others, but
+moved his chair a little apart from them, thus confirming the report
+that he was in some way connected with the matter, and did not intend to
+take any part in the decision. Then another door opened, and the three
+prisoners were brought in. The two first were pale and evidently weak;
+one had his head wrapped in bandages, the other had the right sleeve of
+his coat cut off, and his arm bandaged and supported by a sling. Both
+made a resolute effort to preserve a careless demeanor. The third, who
+was some years younger than the others, looked round with a smile on his
+lips, bowed to the magistrates with an air of insolent bravado when
+he was placed in the dock, and then leaned easily in the corner, as
+if indifferent to the whole business. A chair was placed between his
+comrades for the use of the man whose head was bandaged. Many among
+those present knew Arthur Bastow by sight, and his name passed from
+mouth to mouth; but the usher called loudly for silence, and then the
+magistrates' clerk rose.
+
+“William Smith and John Brown--at least, these are the names given--are
+charged with stopping the South Coast coach last night, killing the
+guard, and robbing the passengers; and Arthur Bastow is charged with
+aiding and abetting the other two prisoners, and with guilty knowledge
+of their crime.”
+
+It was noticed by those who could see the prisoners' faces that, in
+spite of Bastow's air of indifference, there was an expression of
+anxiety on his face as the charge was read, and he undoubtedly felt
+relief as that against himself was mentioned. The first witness was John
+Knapp, and the constable stepped into the witness box.
+
+“What do you know of this business, Knapp?” the chairman asked. “Just
+tell it your own way.”
+
+“I am constable of Crowswood, your honor, and yesterday Squire Thorndyke
+said to me--”
+
+“No, you must not tell it like that, Knapp; you must not repeat what
+another person said to you. You can say that from information received
+you did so and so.”
+
+“Yes, your honor. From information received I went to the Rev. Mr.
+Bastow's house, at a quarter to nine last night. At nine o'clock Squire
+Thorndyke and the Parson came in together. They sent the servant up to
+bed, and then the Squire sent me round to examine the fastenings of the
+doors. I found that one back door had been left unfastened, and locked
+and bolted it. The Squire told me to lie down until one o'clock, and he
+would watch, and Mr. Bastow went up to bed.”
+
+“Do you know of your own knowledge why these precautions were taken?”
+
+“Only from what I was told, your honor. At one o'clock the Squire woke
+me, and he lay down in the parlor, telling me to call him if I heard
+any movement outside. About two o'clock I heard two horses come into the
+Parson's yard. I called Squire Thorndyke, who went upstairs to an open
+window; presently someone came and tried the back door. I heard voices
+outside, but could not hear what was said. The Squire came down and
+called me upstairs. I went up and took my place at one side of the
+window, and the Squire took his on the other. I had this cudgel in my
+hand, and the Squire his riding whip. A ladder was put up against the
+window, and then someone came up, lifted the sash up high and got in.
+There was light enough for me to see it was young Mr. Bastow. Then the
+two other prisoners came up. When the third had got into the room Mr.
+Bastow said, 'Follow me, and then you won't tumble over the furniture.'”
+
+“How was it that they did not see you and Mr. Thorndyke?” the chairman
+asked.
+
+“We were standing well back, your honor. The moon was on the other side
+of the house. There was light enough for us to see them as they got in
+at the window, but where we were standing it was quite dark, especially
+to chaps who had just come in from the moonlight. As they moved, the
+Squire hit the last of them a clout on the head with his hunting crop,
+and down he went, as if shot. The man next to him turned, but I did not
+see what took place, for, as the Squire had ordered me, I made a rush at
+Mr. Bastow and got my arms round him pretty tight, so as to prevent him
+using his pistols, if he had any. He struggled hard, but without saying
+a word, till I got my heel behind his and threw him on his back. I came
+down on the top of him; then I got the pistols out of his belt and threw
+them on the bed, slipped the handcuffs onto one wrist, lifted him up a
+bit, and then shoved him up against the bedpost, and got the handcuff
+onto his other wrist, so that he could not shift away, having the post
+in between his arms.
+
+“Then I went to see if the Squire wanted any help, but he didn't. I
+first handcuffed the man whose head he had broken, and tied the legs
+of the other, and then kept guard over them till morning. When the
+constables came up from town we searched the prisoners, and on two
+of them found the watches, money, and rings. We found nothing on Mr.
+Bastow. I went with the head constable to Mr. Bastow's room and searched
+it thoroughly, but found nothing whatever there.”
+
+The evidence created a great sensation in court. John Thorndyke had
+first intended to ask Knapp not to make any mention of the fact that
+Arthur Bastow was carrying pistols unless the question was directly put
+to him. But the more he had thought over the matter, the more convinced
+was he that the heavier the sentence the better it would be for the
+Rector; and when he had heard from the latter that there was nothing
+left in his son's room that could be brought against him, and that he
+could not be charged with the capital crime of being a receiver, he
+thought it best to let matters take their course.
+
+The head constable was the next witness. He deposed to the finding of
+the articles produced upon the two elder prisoners and the unsuccessful
+search of the younger prisoner's room.
+
+“You did not search the house further?” the chairman inquired.
+
+“No, sir; I wanted to get the prisoners down here as fast as I could,
+seeing that two of them were seriously hurt.”
+
+The chairman nodded.
+
+“You will, of course, make a careful search of the whole house,
+constable.”
+
+“Yes, sir; I left one of my men up there with instructions to allow no
+one to go upstairs until I returned.”
+
+“Quite right.”
+
+John Thorndyke was the next witness, and his evidence cleared up what
+had hitherto been a mystery to the general body of the public, as to
+how he and the constable happened to be in the house on watch when the
+highwaymen arrived. The most important part of his evidence was the
+repetition of the words young Bastow had used as he mounted the ladder,
+as they showed that it was arranged between the prisoners that the
+stolen goods should be hidden in the house. The Squire was only asked
+one or two questions.
+
+“I suppose, Mr. Thorndyke, that you had no idea whatever that the
+younger prisoner would be accompanied by anyone else when he returned
+home?”
+
+“Not the slightest,” the Squire replied. “I was there simply to prevent
+this unfortunate lad from entering the house, when perhaps he might have
+used violence towards his father. My intention was to seize him if he
+did so, and to give him the choice of enlisting, as I had urged him to
+do, or of being brought before this bench for breaking into his father's
+house. I felt that anything was better than his continuing in the evil
+courses on which he seemed bent.”
+
+“Thank you, Mr. Thorndyke. I must compliment you in the name of my
+brother magistrates, and I may say of the public, for the manner in
+which you, at considerable risk to yourself, have effected the capture
+of the two elder prisoners.”
+
+After consulting with the others the head constable was recalled.
+
+“Do you know anything about the character of the youngest prisoner?”
+
+“Yes, sir. We have had our eye upon him for some time. He was brought
+before your honors a week ago charged with being drunk and disorderly in
+this town, and was fined 5 pounds. He is constantly drinking with some
+of the worst characters in the place, and is strongly suspected of
+having been concerned in the fray between the poachers and Sir Charles
+Harris' gamekeepers. Two of the latter said that they recognized him
+amongst the poachers, but as they both declined to swear to him we did
+not arrest him.”
+
+John Knapp was then recalled, and testified to Bastow's drinking habits,
+and that the landlord of the alehouse at Crowswood had been ordered by
+the Squire not to draw any liquor for him in future on pain of having
+the renewal of his license refused.
+
+“Have you any more witnesses to call?” the chairman asked the head
+constable.
+
+“Not at present, your honor. We have sent up to town, and on the next
+occasion the coachman will be called to testify to the shooting of the
+guard, and we hope to have some of the passengers there to identify the
+articles stolen from them.”
+
+“It will be necessary that the Rev. Mr. Bastow should be here. He need
+not be called to give evidence unless we think it to be of importance,
+but he had better be in attendance. The prisoners are remanded until
+this day week.”
+
+An hour later the three prisoners, handcuffed, were driven under an
+escort of three armed constables to Croydon Jail. When again brought up
+in court the passengers on the coach identified the articles taken from
+them; the coachman gave evidence of the stopping of the coach, and of
+the shooting of the guard. The head constable testified that he had
+searched the Rectory from top to bottom, and found nothing whatever of
+a suspicious nature. None of the passengers were able to testify to the
+two elder prisoners as the men who had robbed them, as these had been
+masked, but the height and dress corresponded to those of the prisoners;
+and the two Bow Street runners then came forward, and gave evidence
+that the two elder prisoners were well known to them. They had long been
+suspected of being highwaymen, and had several times been arrested when
+riding towards London on occasions when a coach had been stopped the
+night before, but no stolen goods had ever been found upon them, and in
+no case had the passengers been able to swear to their identity. One was
+known among his associates as “Galloping Bill,” the other as the
+“Downy One.” At the conclusion of the evidence the three prisoners
+were formally committed for trial, the magistrates having retired in
+consultation for some time upon the question of whether the charge of
+receiving stolen goods ought to be made against Arthur Bastow.
+
+“I think, gentlemen,” the chairman said, after a good deal had been
+urged on both sides of the question, “in this case we can afford to take
+a merciful view. In the first place, no stolen goods were discovered
+upon him or in the house. There is strong presumptive evidence of his
+intention, but intention is not a crime, and even were the evidence
+stronger than it is, I should be inclined to take a merciful view. There
+can be no doubt that the young fellow is thoroughly bad, and the bravado
+he has exhibited throughout the hearing is at once unbecoming and
+disgraceful; but we must remember that he is not yet eighteen, and that,
+in the second place, he is the son of a much respected clergyman, who is
+our neighbor. The matter is serious enough for him as it stands, and he
+is certain to have a very heavy sentence.
+
+“Mr. Thorndyke, who takes no part in our deliberations, is most anxious
+that the prisoner's father should be spared the agony of his son being
+placed on trial on a capital charge, though I do not think that there
+would be the smallest chance of his being executed, for the judges would
+be certain to take his youth into consideration. Had there been prima
+facie evidence of concealment, we must have done our duty and sent him
+to trial on that charge; but as there is no such evidence, I think that
+it will be in all respects better to send him on a charge on which the
+evidence is as clear as noonday. Moreover, I think that Mr. Thorndyke's
+wishes should have some weight with us, seeing that it is entirely due
+to him that the important capture of these highwaymen, who have long
+been a scourge to this neighborhood, has been effected.”
+
+Mr. Bastow had not been called as a witness. John Thorndyke had brought
+him down to Reigate in a closed carriage, and he had waited in the
+justices' room while the examination went on; but the magistrates agreed
+that the evidence given was amply sufficient for them to commit upon
+without given him the pain of appearing. John Thorndyke had taken him to
+another room while the magistrates were consulting together, and when he
+heard the result drove him back again.
+
+“I have fully made up my mind to resign my living, Thorndyke. I could
+not stand up and preach to the villagers of their duties when I myself
+have failed so signally in training my own son; nor visit their houses
+and presume to lecture them on their shortcomings when my son is a
+convicted criminal.”
+
+“I quite see that, old friend,” the Squire said. “And I had no doubt but
+that you would decide on this course. I will try not to persuade you to
+change your decision, for I feel that your power of usefulness is at an
+end as far as the village is concerned. May I ask what you propose to
+do? I can hardly suppose that your savings have been large.”
+
+“Two years ago I had some hundreds laid by, but they have dwindled away
+to nothing; you can understand how. For a time it was given freely, then
+reluctantly; then I declared I would give no more, but he took it all
+the same--he knew well enough that I could never prosecute him for
+forgery.”
+
+“As bad as that, eh?” Thorndyke said sternly. “Well, we won't talk
+further of him now; what I propose is that you should take up your abode
+at the Hall. I am not satisfied with the school where Mark has been for
+the last two years, and I have been hesitating whether to get a private
+tutor for him or to send him to one of the public schools. I know that
+that would be best, but I could not bring myself to do so. I have some
+troubles of my own that but two or three people know of, and now, that
+everything is going on smoothly on the estate and in the village, I
+often feel dull, and the boy's companionship does me much good; and as
+he knows many lads of his own age in the neighborhood now, I think that
+he would do just as well at home.
+
+“He will be taking to shooting and hunting before long, and if he is
+to have a tutor, there is no one I should like to have better than
+yourself. You know all the people, and we could talk comfortably
+together of an evening when the house is quiet. Altogether, it will be
+an excellent arrangement for me. You would have your own room, and if I
+have company you need not join us unless you like. The house would not
+seem like itself without you, for you have been associated with it as
+long as I can remember. As to your going out into the world at the age
+of sixty, it would be little short of madness. There--you need not give
+me an answer now,” he went on, seeing that the Rector was too broken
+down to speak; “but I am sure that when you think it over you will come
+to the same conclusion as I do, that it will be the best plan possible
+for us both.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+
+The trial of the two highwaymen and Arthur Bastow came off in due
+course. The evidence given was similar to that offered at Reigate, the
+only addition being that Mr. Bastow was himself put into the box. The
+counsel for the prosecution said: “I am sorry to have to call you, Mr.
+Bastow. We all feel most deeply for you, and I will ask you only two or
+three questions. Was your son frequently out at night?”
+
+“He was.”
+
+“Did you often hear him return?”
+
+“Yes; I seldom went to sleep until he came back.”
+
+“Had you any reason to suppose that others returned with him?”
+
+“I never saw any others.”
+
+“But you might have heard them without seeing them. Please tell us if
+you ever heard voices.”
+
+“Yes, I have heard men's voices,” the clergyman said reluctantly, in a
+low voice.
+
+“One more question, and I have done. Have you on some occasions heard
+the sound of horses' hoofs in your yard at about the time that your son
+came in?”
+
+Mr. Bastow said in a low voice: “I have.”
+
+“Had you any suspicion whatever of the character of your son's
+visitors?”
+
+“None whatever. I supposed that those with him were companions with whom
+he had been spending the evening.”
+
+Mr. Bastow had to be assisted from the witness box, so overcome was
+he with the ordeal. He had not glanced at his son while giving his
+evidence. The latter and his two fellow prisoners maintained throughout
+the trial their expression of indifference. The two highwaymen nodded
+to acquaintances they saw in the body of the court, smiled at various
+points in the evidence, and so conducted themselves that there were
+murmured exclamations of approval of their gameness on the part of the
+lower class of the public. The jury, without a moment's hesitation,
+found them all guilty of the offenses with which they were charged.
+Bastow was first sentenced.
+
+“Young man,” the judge said, “young as you are, there can be no doubt
+whatever in the minds of anyone who has heard the evidence that you have
+been an associate with these men who have been found guilty of highway
+robbery accompanied by murder. I consider that a merciful view was taken
+of your case by the magistrates who committed you for trial, for the
+evidence of your heartbroken father, on whose gray hairs your conduct
+has brought trouble and disgrace, leaves no doubt that you have for some
+time been in league with highwaymen, although not actually participating
+in their crime. The words overheard by Mr. Thorndyke show that you were
+prepared to hide their booty for them, and it is well for you that
+you were captured before this was done, and that no proceeds of other
+robberies were found in the house. The evidence of the Bow Street
+officers show that it had for some time been suspected that these men
+had an accomplice somewhere in the neighborhood of Reigate, for although
+arrested several times under circumstances forming a strong assumption
+of their guilt, nothing was ever found upon them. There can now be
+little, doubt who their accomplice was. Had you been an older man
+I should have sentenced you to transportation for life, but in
+consideration of your youth, I shall take the milder course of
+sentencing you to fifteen years' transportation.”
+
+The capital sentence was then passed in much fewer words upon the two
+highwaymen. As they were leaving the dock Bastow turned, and in a clear
+voice said to John Thorndyke, who had been accommodated with a seat in
+the well of the court:
+
+“I have to thank you, Thorndyke, for this. I will pay off my debt some
+day, you make take your oath.”
+
+“A sad case, Mr. Thorndyke--a sad case,” the judge, who had greatly
+complimented the Squire on his conduct, said to him as he was disrobing
+afterwards. “I don't know that in all my experience I ever saw such a
+hardened young villain. With highwaymen it is a point of honor to assume
+a gayety of demeanor on such occasions; but to see a boy of eighteen,
+never before convicted, exhibiting such coolness and effrontery is quite
+beyond my experience. I suppose his record is altogether bad?”
+
+“Altogether,” the Squire said. “His father has, during the last two
+years, been quite broken by it; he owned to me that he was in bodily
+fear of the lad, who had on several occasions assaulted him, had robbed
+him of his savings by means of forgery, and was so hopelessly bad that
+he himself thought with me that the only possible hope for him was
+to get him to enlist. I myself recommended the East India Company's
+service, thinking that he would have less opportunity for crime out
+there, and that there would be a strong chance that either fever or a
+bullet would carry him off, for I own that I have not the slightest hope
+of reformation in such a character.”
+
+“I would have given him transportation for life if I had known all
+this,” the judge said. “However, it is not likely that he will ever
+come back again--very few of them do; the hulks are not the most healthy
+places in the world, and they have a pretty rough way with men who give
+them trouble, as this young fellow is likely to do.”
+
+Mr. Bastow, as soon as he had given his evidence, had taken a hackney
+coach to the inn where he and the Squire had put up on their arrival in
+town the evening before, and here, on his return, John Thorndyke found
+him. He was lying on his bed in a state of prostration.
+
+“Cheer up, Bastow,” he said, putting his hand upon the Rector's
+shoulder. “The sentence is fifteen years, which was the very amount I
+hoped that he would get. The more one sees of him the more hopeless
+it is to expect that any change will ever take place in him; and it is
+infinitely better that he should be across the sea where his conduct,
+when his term is over, can affect no one. The disgrace, such as it is,
+to his friends, is no greater in a long term than in a short one. Had
+he got off with four or five years' imprisonment, he would have been a
+perpetual trouble and a source of uneasiness, not to say alarm; and even
+had he left you alone we should always have been in a state of dread as
+to his next offense. Better that he should be out in the colonies than
+be hung at Tyburn.”
+
+“How did he take the sentence?”
+
+“With the same bravado he had shown all through, and as he went out of
+the dock addressed a threat to me, that, under the circumstances, I can
+very well afford to despise. Now, if you will take my advice, you will
+drink a couple of glasses of good port, and then go to bed. I will see
+to your being awakened at seven o'clock, which will give us time to
+breakfast comfortably, and to make a start at nine.”
+
+“I would rather not have the wine,” the Rector said feebly.
+
+“Yes, but you must take what is good for you. I have ordered up a bottle
+of the landlord's best, and must insist upon your drinking a couple of
+glasses with me. I want it almost as much as you do, for the atmosphere
+of that court was enough to poison a dog. I have got the taste of it in
+my mouth still.”
+
+With much reluctance the Rector accompanied him to the private sitting
+room that the Squire had engaged. He sat down almost mechanically in an
+easy chair. The Squire poured out the wine, and handed him a glass. Mr.
+Bastow at first put it to his lips without glancing at it, but he was a
+connoisseur in wine, and the bouquet of the port appealing to his latent
+senses, he took a sip, and then another, appreciatingly.
+
+“The landlord said it was first rate, and he is not far wrong,” John
+Thorndyke remarked, as he set down his own glass.
+
+“Yes, it is a fine vintage, and in perfect condition,” Mr. Bastow
+agreed. “I have drunk nothing better for years, though you have some
+fine bins.”
+
+“I would take a biscuit, if I were you, before I took another glass,”
+ the Squire said, helping himself from a plate on the table. “You have
+had nothing to eat today, and you want something badly. I have a dish of
+kidneys coming up in half an hour; they cook them well here.”
+
+The Rector ate a biscuit, mechanically sipped another glass of wine,
+and was even able to eat a kidney when they were brought up. Although
+September was not yet out, the Squire had a fire lighted in the room,
+and after the meal was over, and two steaming tumblers of punch were
+placed upon the table, he took a long pipe from the mantel, filled and
+lighted it, then filled another, and handed it to the Rector, at the
+same time holding out a light to him.
+
+“Life has its consolations,” he said. “You have had a lot of troubles
+one way and another, Bastow, but we may hope that they are all over now,
+and that life will go more smoothly and easily with you. We had better
+leave the past alone for the present. I call this snug: a good fire, a
+clean pipe, a comfortable chair, and a steaming bowl at one's elbow.”
+
+The Rector smiled faintly.
+
+“It seems unnatural--” he began.
+
+“Not at all, not at all,” the Squire broke in. “You have had a
+tremendous load on your mind, and now it is lifted off; the thundercloud
+has burst, and though damage has been done, one is thankful that it is
+no worse. Now I can talk to you of a matter that has been on my mind for
+the last three weeks. What steps do you think that I ought to take to
+find a successor for you? It is most important to have a man who will
+be a real help in the parish, as you have been, would pull with one
+comfortably, and be a pleasant associate. I don't want too young a
+fellow, and I don't want too old a one. I have no more idea how to set
+about it than a child. Of course, I could ask the Bishop to appoint, but
+I don't know that he would appoint at all the sort of man I want. The
+living is only worth 200 pounds a year and the house--no very great
+catch; but there is many a man that would be glad to have it.”
+
+“I have been thinking it over, too, Thorndyke, when I could bring my
+mind to consider anything but my own affairs. How would Greg do? He has
+been taking duty for me since I could not do it myself. I know that he
+is a hard working fellow, and he has a wife and a couple of children;
+his curacy is only 70 pounds a year, and it would be a perfect godsend,
+for he has no interest in the Church, and he might be years without
+preferment.”
+
+“I should think he would do very well, Bastow. Yes, he reads well, which
+I own I care for that a good deal more than for the preaching; not
+that I have anything to say against that. He gives sound and practical
+sermons, and they have the advantage of being short, which is a great
+thing. In the first place, it is good in itself, and in the second,
+specially important in a village congregation, where you know very well
+every woman present is fidgeting to get home to see that the pot is not
+boiling over, and the meat in the oven is not burnt. Yes, I will go down
+tomorrow afternoon and ask him if he would like the living. You were
+talking of selling the furniture; how much do you suppose it is worth?”
+
+“I don't suppose it will fetch above seventy or eighty pounds; it is
+solid and good, but as I have had it in use nearly forty years, it would
+not go for much.”
+
+“Well, let us say a hundred pounds,” the Squire said. “I will give you a
+check for it. I dare say Greg will find it difficult to furnish, and he
+might have to borrow the money, and the debt would be a millstone round
+his neck, perhaps, for years, so I will hand it over with the Rectory to
+him.”
+
+So they talked for an hour or two on village matters, and the Squire was
+well pleased, when his old friend went up to bed, that he had succeeded
+in diverting his thoughts for a time from the painful subject that had
+engrossed them for weeks.
+
+“You have slept well,” he said, when they met at breakfast, “I can see
+by your face.”
+
+“Yes, I have not slept so soundly for months. I went to sleep as soon
+as my head touched the pillow, and did not awake until the chambermaid
+knocked at the door.”
+
+“That second glass of punch did it, Bastow. It is a fine morning; we
+shall have a brisk drive back. I am very glad that I changed my mind and
+brought the gig instead of the close carriage.”
+
+In the afternoon the Squire drove into Reigate. He found the curate at
+home, and astonished and delighted him by asking him if he would like
+the living of Crowswood. It came altogether as a surprise to him, for
+the Rector's intentions to resign had not been made public, and it was
+supposed in the village that he was only staying at the Squire's until
+this sad affair should be over. Greg was a man of seven or eight and
+twenty, had graduated with distinction at Cambridge, but, having
+no influence, had no prospects of promotion, and the offer almost
+bewildered him.
+
+“I should be grateful indeed, Mr. Thorndyke,” he said. “It would be a
+boon to us. Will you excuse me for a moment?”
+
+And opening a door, he called for his wife, who was trying to keep the
+two children quiet there, having retired with them hastily when Mr.
+Thorndyke was announced.
+
+“What do you think, Emma?” her husband said excitedly, as she came into
+the room. “Mr. Thorndyke has been good enough to offer me the living of
+Crowswood.”
+
+Then he recovered himself. “I beg your pardon, sir, for my
+unmannerliness in not first introducing my wife to you.”
+
+“It was natural that you should think of telling her the news first of
+all,” the Squire said courteously. “Madam, I am your obedient servant,
+and I hope that soon we shall get to know each other well. I consider
+it of great importance that the Squire of a parish and the Rector should
+work well together, and see a great deal of each other. I don't know
+whether you are aware, Mr. Greg, that the living is worth 200 pounds
+a year, besides which there is a paddock of about ten acres, which is
+sufficient for the keep of a horse and cow. The Rectory is a comfortable
+one, and I have arranged with Mr. Bastow that he shall leave his
+furniture for the benefit of his successor. It will include linen, so
+that you will be put to no expense whatever in moving in. I have known
+these first expenses to seriously cripple the usefulness of a clergyman
+when appointed to a living.”
+
+“That is good of you indeed, Mr. Thorndyke,” the curate said. “We have
+been living in these lodgings since we first came here, and it will
+indeed make matters easy to have the question of furniture so kindly
+settled for us.”
+
+“Will your Rector be able to release you shortly?”
+
+“I have no doubt that he will do that at once. His son has just left
+Oxford and taken deacon's orders; and the Rector told me the other day
+that he should be glad if I would look out for another curacy, as he
+wanted to have his son here with him. He spoke very kindly, and said
+that he should make no change until I could hear of a place to suit
+me. His son has been assisting him for the last month, since I took the
+services at Crowswood, and I am sure he would release me at once.”
+
+“Then I should be glad if you will move up as soon as possible to the
+Rectory. I know nothing about the necessary forms, but I suppose that
+Mr. Bastow will send in his resignation to the Bishop, and I shall
+write and tell him that I have appointed you, and you can continue to
+officiate as you have done lately until you can be formally inducted
+as the Rector. Perhaps you would not mind going round to your Rector
+at once and telling him of the offer you have had. I have one or two
+matters to do in the town, and will call again in three quarters of
+an hour. I shall be glad to tell Mr. Bastow that you will come into
+residence at once.”
+
+On returning at the appointed time he found that the curate had
+returned.
+
+“Mr. Pilkington was very kind, and evidently very pleased; he
+congratulated me most warmly, and I can come up at once. We don't know
+how to thank you enough, Mr. Thorndyke.”
+
+“I don't want any thanks, I can assure you, Mr. Greg. Tomorrow I will
+send a couple of women in from the village to get the place in order,
+and no doubt Mr. Bastow will want to take away a few things. He is going
+to remain with me as tutor to my son. I am sure you and I will get on
+very well together, and I only hope that your sermons will be no longer
+when you are Rector than they have been while you have been assisting
+us. Long sermons may do for a town congregation, but in my opinion they
+are a very serious mistake in the case of a village one. By the way, I
+think it would be as well for you to get a servant here, and that before
+you go up. Mr. Bastow's servant was an old woman, and in a case like
+this I always think it is better not to take one's predecessor's
+servant. She generally resents any change, and is always quoting how
+her last master had things. I mention this before you go, because she
+is sure to ask to stay on, and it is much easier to say that you are
+bringing a servant with you than to have to tell her she is too old or
+too fat. Don't you think so, Mrs. Greg?”
+
+“Yes, I think it will be much better, Mr. Thorndyke. Even if I cannot
+hear of one likely to suit us permanently, I will take someone as a stop
+gap. One can easily change afterwards.”
+
+“The old woman will do very well,” the Squire said. “She has two married
+daughters in the village, and with a shilling or two from the parish she
+will manage comfortably. At any rate we shall look after her, and I have
+no doubt Mr. Bastow will make her an allowance.”
+
+Never were a pair more delighted than Parson Greg and his wife when two
+days later they took possession of their new home. Half a dozen women
+had been at work the day before, and everything was in perfect order. To
+Mrs. Greg's relief she found that the old servant had already gone, the
+Squire having himself informed her that Mrs. Greg would bring her own
+maid with her. Mr. Bastow said that he would allow her half a crown a
+week as long as she lived, and the Squire added as much more, and as the
+woman had saved a good deal during her twenty years' service with the
+Rector, she was perfectly satisfied.
+
+“It is a good thing that she should be content,” the Squire said to Mr.
+Bastow. “She has a lot of connections in the village, and if she had
+gone away with a sense of grievance she might have created a good deal
+of ill feeling against your successor, and I am very anxious that he
+should begin well. I like the young fellow, and I like his wife.”
+
+“We are fortunate, indeed, Ernest,” Mrs. Greg said the following
+morning, as with the children, two and three years old, they went out
+into the garden; where the trees were laden with apples, pears, and
+plums. “What a change from our little rooms in Reigate. I should think
+that anyone ought to be happy indeed here.”
+
+“They ought to be, Emma, but you see Mr. Bastow had trouble enough; and
+it should be a lesson to us, dear, to look very closely after the boys
+now they are young, and see that they don't make bad acquaintances.”
+
+“From what we hear of the village, there is little fear of that; the
+mischief must have begun before Mr. Thorndyke came down, when by all
+accounts things had altogether gone to the bad here, and of course young
+Bastow must have had an exceptionally evil disposition, Ernest.”
+
+“Yes, no doubt; but his father could not have looked after him properly.
+I believe, from what I hear, that Bastow was so dispirited at his
+powerlessness to put a stop to the state of things here, that, except to
+perform service, he seldom left the house, and the boy no doubt grew up
+altogether wild. You know that I was in court on the second day of the
+examination, and the young fellow's insolence and bearing astonished
+and shocked me. Happily, we have the Squire here now to back us up, the
+village has been completely cleared of all bad characters, and is by all
+accounts quite a model place, and we must do our best to keep it so.”
+
+The news of the change at the Rectory naturally occasioned a great deal
+of talk. At first there was a general feeling of regret that Mr. Bastow
+had gone, and yet it was felt that he could not have been expected to
+stay; the month's experience that they had had of the new parson had
+cleared the way for him. He and his wife soon made themselves familiar
+with the villagers, and being bright young people, speedily made
+themselves liked. The Squire and Mrs. Cunningham called the first
+afternoon after their arrival.
+
+“You must always send up if anything is wanted, Mr. Greg; whenever
+there is any illness in the village we always keep a stock of soups and
+jellies, and Mrs. Cunningham is almoner in general. Is there anything
+that we can do for you? If so, let me know without hesitation.”
+
+“Indeed, there is nothing, Mr. Thorndyke. It is marvelous to us coming
+in here and finding everything that we can possibly want.”
+
+“You will want a boy for your garden; and you cannot do better than take
+young Bill Summers. He was with me for a bit last year, when the boy I
+have now was laid up with mumps or something of that sort, and he was
+very favorably reported on as being handy in the garden, able to milk
+a cow, and so on. By the way, Mrs. Greg, I have taken the liberty of
+sending down a cow in milk. I expect she is in your meadow now. I have
+seven or eight of them, and if you will send her back when her milk
+fails I will send down another.”
+
+“You are too kind altogether, Mr. Thorndyke!” Mrs. Greg exclaimed.
+
+“Not at all. I want to see things comfortable here, and you will find it
+difficult to get on without a cow. I keep two or three for the special
+use of the village. I make them pay for it, halfpenny a pint; it is
+better to do that than to give it. It is invaluable for the children;
+and I don't think in all England you see rosier and healthier youngsters
+than those in our schools. You will sometimes find milk useful for
+puddings and that sort of thing for the sick; and they will appreciate
+it all the more than if they had to look solely to us for their supply.”
+
+“How is Mr. Bastow, sir?”
+
+“He is better than could be expected. He himself proposed this morning
+that my boy Mark should begin his studies at once; and, indeed, now
+that the worst is over and he has got rid of the load of care on his
+shoulders, I hope that we shall have him bright and cheerful again
+before long.”
+
+Such was indeed the case. For some little time Mr. Bastow avoided the
+village, but John Thorndyke got him to go down with him to call upon
+Mr. Greg, and afterwards to walk through it with him. At first he went
+timidly and shrinkingly, but the kindly greetings of the women he met,
+and the children stopping to pull a forelock or bob a courtesy as of
+old, gradually cheered him up, and he soon got accustomed to the change,
+and would of an afternoon go down to the village and chat with the
+women, after he had ascertained that his successor had no objection
+whatever, and was, indeed, pleased that he still took an interest in his
+former parishioners. Mark was at first disappointed at the arrangement,
+for he had looked forward to going to a public school. His father,
+however, had no great trouble in reconciling him to it.
+
+“Of course, Mark,” he said, “there are advantages in a public school.
+I was never at one myself, but I believe that, though the discipline is
+pretty strict, there is a great deal of fun and sport, and you may make
+desirable acquaintances. Upon the other hand, there are drawbacks. In
+the first place, the majority of the boys are sons of richer men than
+I am. I don't know that that would matter much, but it would give you
+expensive habits, and perhaps make you fonder of London life than I
+should care about. In the next place, you see, you would be at school
+when the shooting begins, and you are looking forward to carrying a gun
+next year. The same with hunting. You know I promised that this year you
+should go to the meets on your pony, and see as much of them as you can,
+and of course when you were at school you would only be able to indulge
+in these matters during your holidays; and if a hard frost set in, as
+is the case three times out of four, just as you came home, you would be
+out of it altogether.
+
+“I must say I should like you to have a real love of field sports and to
+be a good shot and a good rider. A man, however wide his acres may be,
+is thought but little of in the country if he is not a good sportsman;
+and, moreover, there is nothing better for developing health and muscles
+than riding, and tramping over the fields with a gun on your shoulder;
+and, lastly, you must not forget, Mark, that one of my objects in making
+this arrangement is to keep Mr. Bastow with us. I am sure that unless
+he thought that he was making himself useful he would not be content
+to remain here; and at his age, you know, it would be hard for him to
+obtain clerical employment.”
+
+“All right, father. I see that the present plan is the best, and that I
+should have but little sport if I went away to school. Besides, I like
+Mr. Bastow very much, and I am quite sure that I shan't get so many
+whackings from him as I used to do from old Holbrook.”
+
+“I fancy not, Mark,” his father said with a smile. “I am not against
+wholesome discipline, but I think it can be carried too far; at any
+rate, I hope you will be just as obedient to Mr. Bastow as if he always
+had a cane on the table beside him.”
+
+Mark, therefore, went to work in a cheerful spirit, and soon found that
+he made more progress in a week under Mr. Bastow's gentle tuition than
+he had done in a month under the vigorous discipline of his former
+master. Mr. and Mrs. Greg dined regularly at the Squire's once a week.
+
+“Have you had that Indian servant of yours long, Mr. Thorndyke?” Mrs.
+Greg asked one day. “He is a strange looking creature. Of course, in
+the daytime, when one sees him about in ordinary clothes, one does not
+notice him so much; but of an evening, in that Eastern costume of his,
+he looks very strange.”
+
+“He was the servant of the Colonel, my brother,” the Squire replied. “He
+brought him over from India with him. The man had been some years in his
+service, and was very attached to him, and had saved his life more than
+once, he told me. On one occasion he caught a cobra by the neck as it
+was about to strike my brother's hand as he sat at table; he carried it
+out into the compound, as George called it, but which means, he told me,
+garden, and there let it escape. Another time he caught a Thug, which
+means a sort of robber who kills his victims by strangling before
+robbing them. They are a sort of sect who regard strangling as a
+religious action, greatly favored by the bloodthirsty goddess they
+worship. He was in the act of fastening the twisted handkerchief, used
+for the purpose, round my brother's neck, when Ramoo cut him down. The
+closest shave, though, was when George, coming down the country, was
+pounced upon by a tiger and carried off. Ramoo seized a couple of
+muskets from the men, and rushed into the jungle after him, and coming
+up with the brute killed him at the first shot. George escaped with a
+broken arm and his back laid open by a scratch of the tiger's claws as
+it first seized him.
+
+“So at George's death I took Ramoo on, and have found him a most useful
+fellow. Of course, I was some little time before I became accustomed
+to his noiseless way of going about, and it used to make me jump when
+I happened to look round, and saw him standing quietly behind me when
+I thought I was quite alone. However, as soon as I became accustomed to
+him, I got over all that, and now I would not lose him for anything; he
+seems to know instinctively what I want. He is excellent as a waiter and
+valet; I should feel almost lost without him now; and the clumping about
+of an English man servant would annoy me as much as his noiseless way of
+going about did at first. He has come to speak English very fairly. Of
+course, my brother always talked to him in his own tongue; still, he had
+picked up enough English for me to get on with; now he speaks it quite
+fluently. When I have nothing whatever for him to do he devotes himself
+to my little ward. She is very fond of him, and it is quite pretty to
+see them together in the garden. Altogether, I would not part with him
+for anything.”
+
+For some years life passed uneventfully at Crowswood. It was seldom
+indeed that the Squire's authority was needed to set matters right in
+the village. The substitution of good farmers for shiftless ones in
+some of the farms, and the better cultivation generally, had given
+more employment; and as John Thorndyke preferred keeping two or three
+cottages shut up rather than have them occupied by men for whom no work
+could be found, it was rare indeed that there were any complaints
+of scarcity of work, except, indeed, on the part of the Rector, who
+declared that, what with the healthiness of the village and the absence
+of want, his occupation, save for the Sunday duty, was a sinecure. Mr.
+Bastow was more happy and much brighter than he had been for many years.
+The occupation of teaching suited him, and he was able to make the work
+pleasant to his pupil as well as to himself; indeed, it occupied but a
+small portion of the day, the amount of learning considered necessary
+at the time not being extensive. A knowledge of Greek was thought
+quite superfluous for a country gentleman. Science was in its infancy,
+mathematics a subject only to be taken up by those who wanted to obtain
+a college fellowship. Latin, however, was considered an essential, and a
+knack of apt quotation from the Latin poets an accomplishment that
+every man who was a member of society or aspired to enter Parliament
+was expected to possess. Thus Mark Thorndyke's lessons lasted but two or
+three hours a day, and the school term was a movable period, according
+to the season of the year and the engagements of the Squire and Mark. In
+winter the evening was the time, so that the boy shot with his father,
+or rode to the hounds, or, as he got older, joined in shooting parties
+at the houses of neighbors.
+
+In summer the work was done in the morning, but was not unfrequently
+broken. Mark went off at a very early hour to drive perhaps some twenty
+miles with his great chum, Dick Chetwynd, for a long day's fishing, or
+to see a main of cocks fought or a fight between the champions of two
+neighboring villages, or perhaps some more important battle.
+
+When Millicent Conyers was ten years old she came regularly into the
+study, sitting curled up in a deep chair, getting up her lessons while
+Mark did his, and then changing seats with him while he learned his
+Horace or Ovid by heart. At this time she looked up greatly to him, and
+was his companion whenever he would allow her to be, fetched and carried
+for him, and stood almost on a level with his dogs in his estimation.
+Five years later, when Mark was eighteen, these relations changed
+somewhat. He now liked to have her with him, not only when about the
+house and garden, but when he took short rides she cantered along on her
+pony by his side. She was a bright faced girl, full of life and fun, and
+rejoicing in a far greater amount of freedom than most girls of her age
+and time.
+
+“It is really time that she should learn to comport herself more
+staidly, instead of running about like a wild thing,” Mrs. Cunningham
+said, one day, as she and the Squire stood after breakfast looking out
+of the open window at Mark and Millicent.
+
+“Time enough, my dear lady, time enough. Let her enjoy life while she
+can. I am not in favor of making a young kitten behave like an old
+tabby; every creature in nature is joyful and frolicsome while it is
+young. She is as tall and as straight as any of her friends of the same
+age, and looks more healthy; she will tame down in time, and I dare say
+walk and look as prim and demure as they do. I was watching them the
+other day when there was a party of them up here, and I thought the
+difference was all to her advantage. She looked a natural, healthy girl;
+they looked like a set of overdressed dolls, afraid to move or to talk
+loud, or to stretch their mouths when they smile; very ladylike and
+nice, no doubt, but you will see Millicent will throw them into the
+shade when she is once past the tomboy age. Leave her alone, Mrs.
+Cunningham; a girl is not like a fruit tree, that wants pruning and
+training from its first year; it will be quite time to get her into
+shape when she has done growing.”
+
+John Thorndyke had occasionally made inquiries of Mr. Bastow as to
+the whereabouts of his son. At the time the sentence was passed
+transportation to the American colonies was being discontinued, and
+until other arrangements could be made hulks were established as places
+of confinement and punishment; but a few months later Arthur Bastow
+was one of the first batch of convicts sent out to the penal settlement
+formed on the east coast of Australia. This was intended to be fixed
+at Botany Bay, but it having been found that this bay was open and
+unsheltered, it was established at Sydney, although for many years the
+settlement retained in England the name of the original site. As the
+condition of the prisoners kept in the hulks was deplorable, the Squire
+had, through the influence of Sir Charles Harris, obtained the inclusion
+of Bastow's name among the first batch of those who were to sail for
+Australia. Mr. Bastow obtained permission to see his son before sailing,
+but returned home much depressed, for he had been assailed with such
+revolting and blasphemous language by him that he had been forced to
+retire in horror at the end of a few minutes.
+
+“We have done well in getting him sent off,” the Squire said, when he
+heard the result of the interview. “In the first place, the demoralizing
+effect of these hulks is quite evident, and it may be hoped that in a
+new country, where there can be no occasion for the convicts to be pent
+up together, things may be better; for although escapes from the hulks
+are not frequent, they occasionally take place, and had he gained
+his liberty we should have had an anxious time of it until he was
+re-arrested, whereas out there there is nowhere to go to, no possibility
+of committing a crime. It is not there as it was in the American colony.
+Settlements may grow up in time, but at present there are no white
+men whatever settled in the district; and the natives are, they say,
+hostile, and were a convict to escape he would almost certainly be
+killed, and possibly eaten. No doubt by the time your son has served
+his sentence colonies will be established out there, and he may then be
+disposed to settle there, either on a piece of land of which he could no
+doubt take up or in the service of one of the colonists.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V.
+
+
+The scene in the convict yard at Sydney, five years after its foundation
+as a penal settlement, was not a pleasant one to the lover of humanity.
+Warders armed to the teeth were arranging gangs that were to go out to
+labor on the roads. Many of the convicts had leg irons, but so fastened
+as to be but slight hindrance to their working powers, but the majority
+were unironed. These were the better behaved convicts; not that this
+would be judged from their faces, for the brutalizing nature of the
+system and the close association of criminals had placed its mark on
+all, and it would have been difficult for the most discriminating to
+have made any choice between the most hardened criminals and those who
+had been sent out for what would now be considered comparatively trivial
+offenses. The voyage on board ship had done much to efface distinctions,
+the convict life had done more, and the chief difference between the
+chained and unchained prisoners was that the latter were men of more
+timid disposition than many of their companions, and therefore less
+disposed to give trouble that would entail heavy punishment. But it
+was only the comparatively well conducted men who were placed upon road
+work; the rest were retained for work inside the jail, or were caged in
+solitary confinement. Each morning a number, varying from half a dozen
+to a dozen, were fastened up and flogged, in some cases with merciless
+severity, but it was seldom that a cry was uttered by these, the most
+brutal ruffians of the convict herd. This spectacle was just over: it
+was conducted in public for the edification of the rest, but, judging
+from the low laughs and brutal jests, uttered below the breath, it
+signally failed in producing the desired impression. Two of those who
+had suffered the severest punishment were now putting on their
+coarse woolen garments over their bloodstained shoulders; both were
+comparatively young men.
+
+“I shall not stand this much longer,” one muttered. “I will brain a
+warder, and get hung for it. One can but die once, while one can get
+flogged once a week.”
+
+“So would I,” the other said bitterly; “but I have some scores to settle
+in England, and I am not going to put my head in a noose until I have
+wiped them out. The sooner we make arrangements to get back there the
+better.”
+
+“Yes, we have talked of this before,” the other said, “and I quite
+agreed with you that if we all had the pluck of men we ought to be able
+to overpower the warders, in spite of their firearms. Of course some
+of us would get killed, but no one would mind that if there was but the
+remotest chance of getting away. The question is what we should do with
+ourselves when we were once outside the prison. Of course I know that
+there are two or three hundred settlers, but there would not be much
+to be got out of them, and life among those black fellows, even if they
+were civil to us, which I don't suppose they would be, would not be
+worth having.”
+
+“We might not have to stay there long; ships with stores or settlers
+arrive occasionally, and if a lot of us got away we might seize one by
+force, turn pirates for a bit, and when we are tired of that sail to
+some South American port, sell our capture, and make our way home to
+England. If we were not strong enough to take her, we could hide up on
+board her; we should be sure to find some fellow who for a pound or two
+would be willing to help us. The thing can be done if we make up our
+minds to do it, and I for one have made up my mind to try. I haven't
+chalked out a plan yet, but I am convinced that it is to be done.”
+
+“I am with you, whatever it is,” the other said; “and I think there are
+twenty or thirty we could rely on. I don't say there are more than that,
+because there are a lot of white livered cusses among them who would
+inform against us at once, so as to get their own freedom as a reward
+for doing so. Well, we will both think it over, mate, and the sooner the
+better.”
+
+The two men who were thus talking together were both by birth above the
+common herd of convicts, and had gained a considerable ascendency over
+the others because of their reckless indifference to punishment and
+their defiance of authority. Few of the men knew each other's real
+names; by the officials they were simply known by numbers, while among
+themselves each had a slang name generally gained on board ship.
+
+Separation there had, of course, been impossible, and when fastened down
+below each had told his story with such embellishments as he chose to
+give it, and being but little interfered with by their guards, save
+to insure the impossibility of a mutiny, there had been fights of a
+desperate kind. Four or five dead bodies had been found and thrown
+overboard, but as none would testify as to who had been the assailants
+none were punished for it; and so the strongest and most desperate had
+enforced their authority over the others, as wild beasts might do, and
+by the time they had reached their destination all were steeped much
+deeper in wickedness and brutalism than when they set sail.
+
+The two men who were speaking together had speedily become chums, and,
+though much younger than the majority of the prisoners, had by their
+recklessness and ferocity established an ascendency among the others.
+This ascendency had been maintained after their arrival by their
+constant acts of insubordination, and by their apparent indifference to
+the punishment awarded them. At night the convicts were lodged in wooden
+buildings, where, so long as they were not riotous, they were allowed to
+talk and converse freely, as indeed was the case when their work for the
+day was done.
+
+As to any attempt at escape, the authorities had but small anxiety, for
+until the arrival of the first settlers, three years after that of
+the convicts, there was nowhere a fugitive could go to, no food to be
+obtained, no shelter save among the blacks, who were always ready for
+a reward of tobacco and spirits to hand them over at once to the
+authorities. The case had but slightly changed since the settlement
+began to grow. It was true that by stealing sheep or driving off a few
+head of cattle a fugitive might maintain himself for a time, but even if
+not shot down by the settlers or patrols, he would be sure before long
+to be brought in by the blacks.
+
+The experiment had already been tried of farming our better conducted
+convicts to the settlers, and indeed it was the prospect of obtaining
+such cheap labor that had been the main inducement to many of the
+colonists to establish themselves so far from home, instead of going to
+America. As a whole the system worked satisfactorily; the men were
+as much prisoners as were the inmates of the jail, for they knew well
+enough that were they to leave the farmers and take to the bush they
+would remain free but a short time, being either killed or handed over
+by the blacks, and in the latter case they would be severely punished
+and set to prison work in irons, with labor very much more severe than
+that they were called upon to do on the farms.
+
+Some little time after the conversation between the two convicts the
+prison authorities were congratulating themselves upon the fact that a
+distinct change had taken or was taking place in the demeanor of many of
+the men who had hitherto been the most troublesome, and they put it down
+to the unusually severe floggings that had been inflicted on the two
+most refractory prisoners in the establishment. When in the prison
+yard or at work they were more silent than before, and did their tasks
+doggedly and sullenly; there was no open defiance to the authorities,
+and, above all, a marked cessation of drunkenness from the spirits
+smuggled into the place.
+
+Only the two originators were aware of the extent of the plot; for they
+had agreed that only by keeping every man in ignorance as to who had
+joined it could they hope to escape treachery. In the first place,
+they had taken into their confidence a dozen men on whom they could
+absolutely rely. Beyond this they had approached the others singly,
+beginning by hinting that there was a plot for escape, and that a good
+many were concerned, and telling them that these had bound themselves
+together by a solemn oath to kill any traitor, even if hanged for it.
+
+“No one is to know who is in it and who is not,” the leaders said to
+each recruit. “Every new man will be closely watched by the rest, and if
+he has any communication privately with a warder or any other official
+he will be found strangled the next morning; no one will know who did
+it. Even if he succeeded in eluding the vigilance of his comrades at the
+time, it would soon be known; for if indulgence of any kind was shown
+towards one man, or he was relieved from his ordinary work, or even
+freed altogether and suddenly, he would be a dead man in twenty-four
+hours, for we have friends outside among the ticket of leave men who
+have bound themselves to kill at once any man set free.”
+
+To the question, “What do you intend to do when we get off?” the answer
+was, “We shall go straight to the bush, so as to avoid a fight with the
+soldiers, in the first place; then we shall join that night, and drive
+off all the cattle and sheep from the settlements, take possession of
+every firearm found in the houses, then move off a couple of hundred
+miles or so into the bush, and establish a settlement of our own.
+
+“Of course, we shall take horses and clothes and any spirits and food
+we may find. If the soldiers pursue us, we will fight them; but as there
+are only three or four companies of them, and we shall be eight hundred
+strong, we shall very soon show them that they had better leave us
+alone.
+
+“Oh, yes, no doubt they will send more soldiers out from England, but
+it will be over a year before they can get here; and we propose after we
+have done with the fellows here to break up into parties of twenty and
+thirty, dividing the sheep and cattle among us, and each party going
+where it will. The place is of tremendous size, as big as a dozen
+Englands, they say, and each party will fix a place it fancies, where
+there is good water and a river with fish and so on, and we may live all
+our lives comfortably, with just enough work to raise potatoes and corn,
+and to watch our stock increasing. Anyhow, we might calculate on having
+some years of peace and freedom, and even if in the end they searched
+us all out, which would be very unlikely, they could but bring us back,
+hang a few, and set the rest to work again; but we think that they would
+most likely leave us alone altogether, quite satisfied with having got
+rid of us.”
+
+“Those who liked it could, no doubt, take wives among the blacks. The
+convict women who are out on service with the settlers would, you may
+be sure, join us at once, and an enterprising chap who preferred a white
+woman to a black could always make his way down here and persuade one to
+go off with him to his farm. That is the general plan; if many get tired
+of the life they have only to come down to Sydney, hide up near the
+place on some dark night, and go down to the port, seize a ship, and
+make off in her, compelling the officers and sailors to take them and
+land them at any port they fancy, either in Chili, Peru, or Mexico, or,
+if they like, sail west and make for Rio or Buenos Ayres or one of the
+West Indian islands. As to when it is going to be done, or how it is
+going to be done, no one will be told till it is ready to be carried
+out. We have not settled that ourselves, and thus one who was fool
+enough to risk certain death could tell the Governor no more than that
+there was a plot on hand, and that the man who had sworn him in was
+concerned in it.”
+
+So one by one every man in the prison was sworn by a terrible oath to
+secrecy, to watch his companions, and to report anything that looked
+suspicious. Many joined willingly, the prospect of relief, even should
+it only be temporary, being too fascinating to be resisted. Some joined
+against their will, fearing that a refusal to do so would be punished
+by death; and the fact that two or three men were found strangled in bed
+had a very great effect in inducing others to join in the plot.
+
+These deaths caused some uneasiness to the authorities. Their utmost
+endeavors failed to discover who were the perpetrators of these
+murders; and even when everyone in the same hut was flogged to obtain
+information, not one opened his lips.
+
+One night the word was passed round that the time had come. One only in
+each hut was familiar with the details, and he gave instructions to each
+man individually as to what he was to do. The date had been determined
+by the fact that the time which they had been sentenced to wear irons
+had terminated the day before, and their unusually subdued and quiet
+demeanor having carried them through the interval without, as usual,
+fresh punishments being awarded them before the termination of the
+former one.
+
+In the morning the whole of the convicts were drawn up to witness the
+flogging of the inmates of one of the huts, where a man had been found
+strangled the morning before. The first prisoner was taken to the
+triangle, stripped to the waist, and tied up. There was a dead silence
+in the ranks of the convicts, but as the first blow fell upon his
+shoulders there was a loud yell, and simultaneously the whole ranks
+broke up, and a number of men sprang upon each of the warders, wrested
+their muskets from them, and threw them to the ground. Then there was a
+rush towards the Governor and officers, who were assembled in front
+of the stone house that faced the open end of the square. Firing their
+pistols, these at once took refuge in the house, three or four falling
+under the scattered fire that was opened as soon as the muskets of the
+warders fell into the hands of the convicts.
+
+Directly the doors were closed the officers appeared at the windows, and
+opened a rifle fire upon the convicts, as did the guards near the gate.
+As comparatively few of the convicts had muskets, they began to waver at
+once. But, headed by the two ringleaders, the armed party rushed at the
+guard, shot them down, and threw open the gate.
+
+Then an unexpected thing occurred. The soldiers from the barracks
+happened to be marching down to do target practice on the shore, and
+were passing the convict prison when the firing broke out. They were
+at once halted, and ordered to load, and as the convicts, with exultant
+shouts, poured through the gate they saw a long line of soldiers, with
+leveled muskets, facing them.
+
+“At them!” one of the leaders shouted. “It is too late to draw back now.
+We have got to break through them.”
+
+Many of the convicts ran back into the yard; but those armed with
+muskets, the more desperate of the party, followed their leaders. A
+moment later a heavy volley rang out, and numbers of the convicts fell.
+Their two leaders, however, and some twenty of their followers, keeping
+in a close body, rushed at the line of soldiers with clubbed muskets,
+and with the suddenness and fury of the rush burst their way through
+the line, and then scattering, fled across the country, pursued by a
+dropping fire of musketry.
+
+The officers in command, seeing that but a fraction had escaped, ordered
+one company to pursue, and marched the rest into the prison yard. It was
+already deserted; the convicts had scattered to their huts, those who
+had arms throwing them away. Dotted here and there over the square were
+the bodies of eight or ten convicts and as many warders, whose skulls
+had been smashed in by their infuriated assailants as soon as they had
+obtained possession of their muskets. Close to the gate lay the six
+soldiers who had furnished the guard; these were all dead or mortally
+wounded.
+
+The Governor and the officials issued from the house as soon as the
+soldiers entered the yard. The first step to do was to turn all the
+convicts out of the huts and to iron them. No resistance was attempted,
+the sight of the soldiers completely cowing the mutineers. When the
+bodies of the convicts that had fallen were counted and the roll of the
+prisoners called over, it was found that eighteen were missing, and of
+these six were during the course of the next hour or two brought in by
+the soldiers who had gone in pursuit of them. The rest had escaped.
+
+The convicts were all questioned separately, and the tales they told
+agreed so closely that the Governor could not doubt that they were
+speaking the truth. All had been sworn in by one of two men, and knew
+nothing whatever of what was intended to be done that day, until after
+they were locked up on the evening previous. Each of those in the huts
+had received his instructions the night before from the one man.
+
+There were eighteen huts, each containing fifteen convicts. Of the men
+who had given instructions six had fallen outside the gate, together
+with sixteen others; five had been overtaken and brought in; altogether,
+twelve were still at large. Among these were the two leaders. The next
+day six of the prisoners were tried and executed. The rest were punished
+only by a reduction in their rations; sentence of death was at the same
+time passed upon the twelve still at large, so as to save the trouble of
+a succession of trials as they were caught and brought in.
+
+The two leaders had kept together after they had broken through the line
+of soldiers.
+
+“Things have gone off well,” one said as they ran through. “Those
+soldiers nearly spoilt it all.”
+
+“Yes, that was unlucky,” the other agreed; “but so far as we are
+concerned, which is all we care about, I think things have turned out
+for the best.”
+
+Nothing more was said until they had far outstripped their pursuers,
+hampered as these were by their uniforms and belts.
+
+“You mean that it is not such a bad thing that they have not all got
+away?”
+
+“Yes, that is what I mean. It is all very well to tell them about
+driving off the sheep and cattle and horses, and going to start a colony
+on our own account, but the soldiers would have been up to us before we
+had gone a day's journey. Most of the fellows would have bolted directly
+they saw them. As it is, I fancy only about a dozen have got away,
+perhaps not as many as that, and they are all men that one can rely
+upon. One can feed a dozen without difficulty--a sheep a day would do
+it--and by giving a turn to each of the settlers, the animals won't be
+missed. Besides, we shall want money if we are ever to get out of this
+cursed country. It would not be difficult to get enough for you and me,
+but when it comes to a large number the sack of the whole settlement
+would not go very far.
+
+“My own idea is that we had best join the others tonight, kill a few
+sheep, and go two or three days' march into the bush, until the heat of
+the pursuit is over. We are all armed, the blacks would not venture to
+attack us, and the soldiers would not be likely to pursue us very far.
+In a week or so, when we can assume that matters have cooled down a bit,
+we can come down again. We know all the shepherds, and even if they were
+not disposed to help us they would not dare to betray us, or report a
+sheep or two being missing. Of course, we shall have to be very careful
+to shift our quarters frequently. Those black trackers are sure to be
+sent out pretty often.”
+
+“As long as we are hanging about the settlements there won't be much
+fear of our being bothered by the blacks. Of course, we shall have to
+decide later on whether it will be best for us to try and seize a ship,
+all of us acting together, or for us to get quietly on board one and
+keep under hatches until she is well away. That is the plan I fancy
+most.”
+
+“So do I. In the first place the chances are that in the next two or
+three months at least half the fellows will be picked up. To begin with,
+several of them are sure to get hold of liquor and make attacks upon the
+settlers, in which case some of them, anyhow, are sure to get killed. In
+the next place, most of them were brought up as thieves in the slums of
+London, and will have no more idea of roughing it in a country like this
+than of behaving themselves if they were transported to a London drawing
+room. Therefore, I am pretty sure that at the end of three months we
+shall not be able to reckon on half of them. Well, six men are not
+enough to capture a ship, or, if they do capture it, to keep the crew
+under. One must sleep sometimes, and with only three or four men on deck
+we could not hope to keep a whole ship's crew at bay.”
+
+“Then there is another reason. You and I, when we have got a decent rig
+out, could pass anywhere without exciting observation; while if we had
+half a dozen of the others, whatever their good qualities, they would be
+noticed at once by their villainous faces, and if questions were to be
+asked we should be likely to find ourselves in limbo again in a very
+short time. So I am all for working on our own account, even if the
+whole of the others were ready to back us; but, of course, we must keep
+on good terms with them all, and breathe no word that we think that each
+man had better shift for himself. Some of those fellows, if they thought
+we had any idea of leaving them, would go straight into Sydney and
+denounce us, although they would know that they themselves would be
+likely to swing at the same time.”
+
+As none of the convicts were acquainted with the bush, they had been
+obliged to select as their rendezvous a hut two miles out of the town,
+where the convict gangs that worked on the road were in the habit of
+leaving their tools. On the way there the two men killed a couple of
+sheep from a flock whose position they had noticed before it became
+dark. These they skinned, cut off the heads, and left them behind,
+carrying the sheep on their shoulders to the meeting.
+
+“Is that you, Captain Wild?” a voice said as they approached.
+
+“Yes; Gentleman Dick is with me.”
+
+“That is a good job. We had begun to think that the soldiers had caught
+you.”
+
+“They would not have caught us alive, you may take your oath. How many
+are there of us here?”
+
+“Ten of us, Captain. I think that that is all there are.”
+
+“That is enough for our purpose. Has anyone got anything to eat?”
+
+There was a deep growl in the negative.
+
+“Well, we have brought a couple of sheep with us, and as we have carried
+them something like a mile, you had better handle them by turns. We will
+strike off into the bush and put another three or four miles between us
+and the jail, and then light a fire and have a meal.”
+
+Two of the men came forward and took the sheep. Then they turned off
+from the road, and taking their direction from a star, followed it for
+an hour.
+
+“I think we have got far enough now,” the man called Captain Wild said.
+“You had better cut down the bushes, and we will make a fire.”
+
+“But how are we to light it?” one of them exclaimed in a tone of
+consternation. “I don't suppose we have got flint and steel or tinder
+box among us.”
+
+“Oh, we can manage that!” the Captain said. “Get a heap of dried leaves
+here first, then some wood, and we will soon have a blaze.”
+
+His orders were obeyed. Some of the men had carried off the warders'
+swords as well as their muskets, and now used them for chopping wood.
+As soon as a small pile of dried leaves was gathered the Captain broke
+a cartridge and sprinkled half its contents among them, and then dropped
+the remainder into his musket. He flashed this off among the leaves, and
+a bright flame at once shot up, and in five minutes a fire was burning.
+
+One of the sheep was soon cut up, the meat hacked in slices from the
+bones, a ramrod was thrust through the pieces, and, supported by four
+sticks, was laid across the fire. Three other similarly laden spits
+were soon placed beside it, and in a short time the meat was ready for
+eating. Until a hearty meal had been made there was but little talking.
+
+“That is first rate,” one of the men said, as he wiped his mouth with
+the back of his hand. “Now one only wants a pipe and bacca and a glass
+of grog, to feel comfortable.”
+
+“Well, Captain, are you satisfied with the day's work?”
+
+“It would have been a grand day had it not been for the soldiers passing
+just at the time. As it is, Gentleman Dick and I have been agreeing that
+as far as we are all concerned it has not turned out so badly. There
+would have been a lot of difficulty in finding food if we had all got
+away, and some of those mealy mouthed fellows would have been sure to go
+back and peach on us at the first opportunity. A dozen is better than a
+hundred for the sort of life we are likely to lead for some time. We are
+strong enough to beat off any attack from the black fellows, and also to
+break into any of these settlers' houses.
+
+“We can, when we have a mind to, take a stray sheep now and then, or
+even a bullock would scarcely be missed, especially if our pals in the
+settlement will lend us a helping hand, which you may be sure they will
+do; in fact, they would know better than to refuse. Then a large party
+could be traced by those black trackers at a run, while a small one
+would not; especially if, as we certainly will do, we break up into twos
+and threes for a time. First of all, though, we must go well into the
+bush; at daybreak tomorrow morning we will drive off twenty sheep, and
+go right away a hundred miles, and wait there till matters have settled
+down. They will never take the troops out that distance after us. Then
+we can come back again, and hang about the settlement and take what we
+want. The wild blacks don't come near there, and we shall be safer in
+pairs than we should be if we kept together; and of course we could meet
+once a week or so to talk over our plans. We must borrow some whisky,
+flour, tea, tobacco, and a few other items from the settlers, but we had
+better do without them for this trip. I don't want to turn the settlers
+against us, for they have all got horses, and might combine with the
+troops to give chase, so it would be best to leave them alone, at any
+rate till we get back again. Another reason for treating them gently is
+that even if they did not join the troops they might get into a funk,
+and drive their sheep and horses down into Sydney, and then we should
+mighty soon get short of food. It will be quite time enough to draw upon
+them heavily when we make up our minds to get hold of a ship and sail
+away. Money would be of no use to us here, but we shall want it when we
+get to a port, wherever that port may be.”
+
+“That sounds right enough, Captain,” one of the convicts said, “and just
+at present nothing would suit me better than to get so far away from
+this place that I can lay on my back and take it easy for a spell.”
+
+There was a general chorus of assent, and there being neither tobacco
+nor spirits, the party very soon stretched themselves off to sleep round
+the fire.
+
+In the morning they were up before daylight, and half an hour later
+arrived at one of the farms farthest from Sydney. Here they found a
+flock of a hundred sheep. The shepherd came to the door of his hut on
+hearing a noise.
+
+“You had best lie down and go to sleep for the next hour,” the leader of
+the convicts said sharply. “We don't want to do an old pal any harm, and
+when you wake up in the morning and find the flock some twenty short, of
+course you won't have any idea what has come of them.”
+
+The man nodded and went back into the hut and shut the door, and the
+convicts started for the interior, driving twenty sheep before them.
+
+During the first day's journey they went fast, keeping the sheep at a
+trot before them, and continuing their journey through the heat of the
+day.
+
+“I tell you what, Captain,” one of the men said when they halted at
+sunset, “if we don't get to a water hole we shall have to give up this
+idea of going and camping in the bush. My mouth has been like an oven
+all day, and it is no use getting away from jail to die of thirst out
+here.”
+
+There had been similar remarks during the day, and the two leaders
+agreed together that it would be madness to push further, and that,
+whatever the risk, they would have to return to the settlements unless
+they could strike water. As they were sitting moodily round the fire
+they were startled by a dozen natives coming forward into the circle
+of light. These held out their hands to say that their intentions were
+peaceful.
+
+“Don't touch your muskets!” Captain Wild exclaimed sharply, as some
+of the men were on the point of jumping to their feet. “The men are
+friendly, and we may be able to get them to guide us to water.”
+
+The natives, as they came up, grinned and rubbed their stomachs, to show
+that they were hungry.
+
+“I understand,” the Captain said; “you want a sheep, we want water;” and
+he held up his hand to his mouth and lifted his elbow as if in the act
+of drinking.
+
+In two or three minutes the natives understood what he wanted, and
+beckoned to the men to follow. The tired sheep were got onto their legs
+again, and half a mile away the party arrived at a pool in what in wet
+weather was the bed of a river. A sheep was at once handed over to the
+natives, and when the men had satisfied their thirst another sheep was
+killed for their own use.
+
+After a great deal of trouble the natives were made to understand that
+the white men wanted one of their party to go with them as a guide, and
+to take them always to water holes, and a boy of fifteen was handed over
+to them in exchange for two more sheep, and at daybreak the next morning
+they started again for the interior, feeling much exhilarated by the
+piece of luck that had befallen them. They traveled for four days more,
+and then, considering that the soldiers had ceased their pursuit long
+ago, they encamped for ten days, enjoying to the utmost their recovered
+freedom and their immunity from work of any kind. Then they returned
+to the neighborhood of the settlements, and broke up, as their leader
+proposed, into pairs.
+
+They had been there but a short time before the depredations committed
+roused the settlers to band themselves together. Every horse that could
+be spared was lent to the military, who formed a mounted patrol of
+forty men, while parties of infantry, guided by native trackers, were
+constantly on the scent for the convicts.
+
+“This is just what I expected,” Captain Wild said to his lieutenant. “It
+was the choice of two evils, and I am not sure that the plan we chose
+was not the worst. We might have been quite sure that these fellows
+would not be able, even for a time, to give up their old ways. If they
+had confined themselves, as we have done, to taking a sheep when they
+wanted it, and behaving civilly when they went to one of the houses and
+begged for a few pounds of flour or tea, the settlers would have made no
+great complaint of us; they know what a hard time we have had, and you
+can see that some of the women were really sorry for us, and gave us
+more than we actually asked for. But it has not been so with the others.
+They had been breaking into houses, stealing every thing they could lay
+their hands upon, and in three or four cases shooting down men on the
+slightest provocation.
+
+“The money and watches were no good to them, but the brutes could not
+help stealing them; so here we are, and the settlement is like a swarm
+of angry bees, and this plan of handing over most of their horses to the
+military will end in all of us being hunted down if we stay here. Two
+were shot yesterday, and in another week we shall all either be killed
+or caught. There is nothing for it but to clear out. I am against
+violence, not on principle, but because in this case it sets people's
+backs up; but it cannot be helped now. We must get a couple of horses
+to ride, and a spare one to carry our swag. We must have half a sack of
+flour and a sheep--it is no use taking more than one, because the meat
+won't keep--and a good stock of tea and sugar. We must get a good supply
+of powder, if we can, some bullets and shot. We shall have to get our
+meat by shooting.
+
+“There is no time to be lost, and tonight we had better go to that
+settler's place nearest the town. He has got two of the best horses out
+here--at least so Redgrave, that shepherd I was talking to today, told
+me--and a well filled store of provisions. If he will let us have them
+without rumpus, all well and good; if not, it will be the worse for
+him. My idea is that we should ride two or three hundred miles along the
+coast until we get to a river, follow it up till we find a tidy place
+for a camp, and stop there for three or four months, then come back
+again and keep ourselves quiet until we find out that a ship is going to
+sail; then we will do a night among the farmhouses, and clean them out
+of their watches and money, manage to get on board, and hide till we
+are well out to sea. We must get a fresh fit out before we go on board;
+these clothes are neither handsome nor becoming. We must put on our best
+manners, and tell them that we are men who have served our full time,
+and want to get back, and that we were obliged to hide because we had
+not enough to pay our full passage money, but that we have enough to pay
+the cost of our grub, and are ready to pull at a rope and make ourselves
+useful in any way. If we are lucky we ought to get enough before we
+start to buy horses and set ourselves up well in business at home.”
+
+“I think that is a very good plan,” the other agreed, “and I am quite
+sure the sooner we make ourselves scarce here the better.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI.
+
+
+While arranging for young Bastow being sent out with the first batch of
+convicts John Thorndyke had been introduced to several of the officials
+of the Department, and called upon them at intervals to obtain news of
+the penal colony. Three years after its establishment a Crown colony had
+been opened for settlement in its vicinity. As the climate was said to
+be very fine and the country fertile, and land could be taken up without
+payment, the number who went out was considerable, there being the
+additional attraction that convicts of good character would be allotted
+to settlers as servants and farm hands.
+
+Six years after Arthur Bastow sailed the Squire learned that there
+had been a revolt among the convicts; several had been killed, and the
+mutiny suppressed, but about a dozen had succeeded in getting away.
+These had committed several robberies and some murders among the
+settlers, and a military force and a party of warders from the prison
+were scouring the country for them.
+
+“Of course, Mr. Thorndyke,” the official said, “the Governor in his
+report does not gives us the names of any of those concerned in the
+matter; he simply says that although the mutiny was general, it was
+wholly the work of a small number of the worse class of prisoners. By
+worse class he means the most troublesome and refractory out there.
+The prisoners are not classified according to their original crimes.
+A poacher who has killed a game keeper, or a smuggler who has killed
+a revenue officer, may in other respects be a quiet and well conducted
+man, while men sentenced for comparatively minor offenses may give an
+immense deal of trouble. I will, however, get a letter written to the
+Governor, asking him if Arthur Bastow was among those who took part in
+the revolt, and if so what has become of him.”
+
+It was more than a year before the reply came, and then the Governor
+reported that Arthur Bastow, who was believed to have been the leading
+spirit of the mutiny, was among those who had escaped, and had not yet
+been recaptured. It was generally believed that he had been killed by
+the blacks, but of this there was no actual proof.
+
+Mr. Bastow was much disturbed when he heard the news. “Suppose he comes
+back here, Mr. Thorndyke.”
+
+“I won't suppose anything of the sort,” the Squire replied. “I don't say
+that it would be altogether impossible, because now that vessels go from
+time to time to Sydney, he might, of course, be able to hide up in one
+of them, and not come on deck until she was well on her way, when, in
+all probability, he would be allowed to work his passage, and might be
+put ashore without any information being given to the authorities.
+I have no doubt that among the sailors there would be a good deal of
+sympathy felt for the convicts. No doubt they have a hard time of it,
+and we know that the gangs working on the roads are always ironed.
+Still, this is very unlikely, and the chances are all in favor of his
+being in hiding in the bush.
+
+“The shepherds and other hands on the farms are chiefly convicts, and
+would probably give him aid if he required it, and there would be no
+difficulty in getting a sheep, now and then, for, as all reports say,
+one of the chief troubles out there are the wild dogs, or dingoes, as
+they are called; any loss in that way would readily be put down to them.
+As to money, he would have no occasion for it; if he wanted it he would
+get it by robbing the settlers, he would know that if he came back here
+he would run the risk of being seized at once on landing or of being
+speedily hunted down as an escaped convict. I don't think that there is
+the slightest occasion for us to trouble ourselves about him.”
+
+But though the Squire spoke so confidently, he felt by no means sure
+that Arthur Bastow would not turn up again, for his reckless audacity
+had made a great impression upon him. The proceeds of the robberies in
+the colony, in which he had no doubt played a part, would have furnished
+him with money with which he could bribe a sailor to hide him away
+and, if necessary, pay his passage money to England, when discovered
+on board, and perhaps maintain him when he got home until he could
+replenish his purse by some unlawful means. Lastly, the Squire argued
+that the fellow's vindictive nature and longing for revenge would act as
+an incentive to bring him back to London. He talked the matter over with
+Mark, who was now a powerful young fellow of twenty, who, of course,
+remembered the incidents attending Bastow's capture and trial.
+
+“I cannot help fancying that the fellow will come back, Mark.”
+
+“Well, if he does, father, we must make it our business to lay him by
+the heels again. You managed it last time, and if he should turn up you
+may be sure I will help you to do it again.”
+
+“Yes, but we may not hear of his having returned until he strikes a
+blow. At any rate, see that your pistols are loaded and close at hand at
+night.”
+
+“They always are, father. There is no saying when a house like this,
+standing alone, and containing a good deal of plate and valuables, may
+be broken into.”
+
+“Well, you might as well carry them always when you go out after dark.
+I shall speak to Knapp, and request him to let me know if he hears of a
+suspicious looking character--any stranger, in fact--being noticed in
+or about the village, and I shall have a talk with Simeox, the head
+constable at Reigate, and ask him to do the same. He is not the same
+man who was head at the time Bastow was up before us, but he was in
+the force then, and, as one of the constables who came up to take the
+prisoners down to Reigate, he will have all the facts in his mind. He is
+a sharp fellow, and though Bastow has no doubt changed a good deal since
+then, he would hardly fail to recognize him if his eye fell upon him. Of
+course we may be alarming ourselves unnecessarily, but there are several
+reasons why I should object strongly to be shot just at the present
+time.”
+
+“Or at any other time, I should say, father,” the young man said with a
+laugh.
+
+“I shall know him, Squire, safe enough,” the head constable replied when
+John Thorndyke went down to see him on the following day; “but I should
+think that if he does come back to England he will hardly be fool enough
+to come down here. He was pretty well known in town before that affair,
+and everyone who was in the courthouse would be sure to have his face
+strongly impressed upon their minds. You may forget a man you have seen
+casually, but you don't forget one you have watched closely when he is
+in the dock with two others charged with murder. Five out of my six men
+were constables at that time, and would know him again the minute they
+saw him; but anyhow, I will tell them to keep a sharp lookout in the
+tramps' quarters, and especially over the two or three men still here
+that Bastow used to consort with. I should say that Reigate is the last
+place in the world where he would show his face.”
+
+“I hope so,” the Squire said. “He has caused trouble enough down here as
+it is; his father is getting an old man now, and is by no means strong,
+and fresh troubles of that kind would undoubtedly kill him.”
+
+A month later the Reigate coach was stopped when a short distance out
+of the town by two highwaymen, and a considerable prize obtained by the
+robbers. Soon afterwards came news of private carriages being stopped on
+various commons in the South of London, and of several burglaries taking
+place among the houses round Clapham, Wandsworth, and Putney. Such
+events were by no means uncommon, but following each other in such quick
+succession they created a strong feeling of alarm among the inhabitants
+of the neighborhood. John Thorndyke, going up to town shortly
+afterwards, went to the headquarters of the Bow Street runners, and had
+a talk with their chief in reference especially to the stoppage of the
+Reigate coach. Mr. Chetwynd had lately died, and John Thorndyke had been
+unanimously elected by his fellow magistrates as chairman of the bench.
+
+“No, Mr. Thorndyke, we have no clew whatever. Our men have been keeping
+the sharpest watch over the fellows suspected of having a hand in such
+matters, but they all seem keeping pretty quiet at present, and none of
+them seem to be particularly flush with money. It is the same with these
+burglaries in the South of London. We are at our wits' end about them.
+We are flooded with letters of complaint from residents; but though the
+patrols on the common have been doubled and every effort made, we are as
+far off as ever. As far as the burglaries are concerned, we have every
+reason to think that they are the work of two or three new hands. The
+jobs are not neatly done, and certainly not with tools usually used by
+burglars. They seem to rely upon daring rather than skill. Anyhow, we
+don't know where to look for them, and are altogether at sea.
+
+“Of course it is as annoying to us as it is to anyone else; more so,
+because the Justices of the Peace are sending complaints to the Home
+Secretary, and he in turn drops on us and wants to know what we are
+doing. I have a sort of fancy myself the fellows who are stopping the
+coaches are the same as those concerned in the burglaries. I could not
+give you my reasons for saying so, except that on no occasion has a
+coach been stopped and a house broken into on the same night. I fancy
+that at present we shan't hear much more of them. They have created such
+alarm that the coaches carry with them two men armed with blunderbusses,
+in addition to the guards, and I should fancy that every householder
+sleeps with pistols within reach, and has got arms for his servants. At
+many of the large houses I know a watchman has been engaged to sit in
+the hall all night, to ring the alarm bell and wake the inmates directly
+he hears any suspicious sounds. Perhaps the fellows may be quiet for a
+time, for they must, during the last month, have got a wonderful amount
+of spoil. Maybe they will go west--the Bath road is always a favorite
+one with these fellows--maybe they will work the northern side of the
+town. I hope we shall lay hands upon them one day, but so far I may say
+frankly we have not the slightest clew.”
+
+“But they must put their horses up somewhere?”
+
+“Yes, but unfortunately there are so many small wayside inns, that it
+is next to impossible to trace them. A number of these fellows are in
+alliance with the highwaymen. Some of them, too, have small farms in
+addition to their public house businesses, and the horses may be snugly
+put up there, while we are searching the inn stables in vain. Again,
+there are rogues even among the farmers themselves; little men, perhaps,
+who do not farm more than thirty or forty acres, either working them
+themselves, or by the aid of a hired man who lives perhaps at a village
+a mile away. To a man of this kind, the offer of a couple of guineas a
+week to keep two horses in an empty cowshed, and to ask no questions, is
+a heavy temptation.
+
+“We have got two clever fellows going about the country inquiring at
+all the villages whether two mounted men have lately been heard going
+through there late at night, or early in the morning, so as to narrow
+down the area to be searched, but nothing has come of it, although I am
+pretty sure that they must have three or four places they use in various
+directions. My men have picked up stories of horsemen being heard
+occasionally, but they come from various directions, and nowhere have
+they been noticed with any regularity. Besides, there are other knights
+of the road about, so we are no nearer than we were on that line of
+inquiry.”
+
+A month later John Thorndyke had occasion to go up again to town. This
+time Mark accompanied him. Both carried pistols, as did the groom,
+sitting behind them. The Squire himself was but a poor shot, but Mark
+had practiced a great deal.
+
+“'Tis a good thing to be able to shoot straight, Mark,” his father had
+said to him three years before. “I abhor dueling, but there is so much
+of it at present that any gentlemen might find himself in a position
+when he must either go out or submit to be considered a coward. Then,
+too, the roads are infested by highwaymen. For that reason alone it
+would be well that a man should be able to shoot straight. You should
+also practice sometimes at night, setting up some object at a distance
+so that you can just make out its outline, and taking a dozen shots at
+it. I know it is very difficult when you cannot see your own pistol, but
+you can soon learn to trust to your arm to come up to the right height
+and in the right direction. Of course you must wait until morning to
+find out where your bullet has gone.”
+
+Two days after they had reached town the Squire received a letter from
+Mrs. Cunningham.
+
+“DEAR MR. THORNDYKE:
+
+“Knapp has been up this morning to tell me that a stranger dismounted
+yesterday at the alehouse, and while his horse was being fed he asked a
+few questions. Among others, he wished to be told if you were at home,
+saying that he had known you some fifteen years ago, when you lived near
+Hastings, and should like to have a talk with you again. In fact, he had
+turned off from the main road for the purpose. He seemed disappointed
+when he heard that you had gone up to town, and hearing that you might
+not be back for three or four days, said he should be coming back
+through Reigate in a week or ten days, and he dared say he should be
+able to find time to call again. Knapp did not hear about it until this
+morning; he asked the landlord about the man, and the landlord said he
+was about thirty, dark, and sparely built. He did not notice his horse
+particularly, seeing that it was such as a small squire or farmer might
+ride. He carried a brace of pistols in his holsters. The landlord was
+not prepossessed with his appearance, and it was that that made him
+speak to Knapp about him. I have told the men to unfasten the dogs every
+night, and I have asked Knapp to send up two trustworthy men to keep
+watch.”
+
+“It may mean something, and it may not,” the Squire said, as he handed
+the letter to Mark. “It is a suspicious looking circumstance; if
+the fellow had been honest he would surely have said something about
+himself. There is no doubt these housebreakers generally find out what
+chance there is of resistance, and, hearing that we were both away,
+may have decided on making an attempt. I have pretty well finished our
+business and ordered nearly all the provisions that Mrs. Cunningham
+requires. But I have to call at my lawyer's, and that is generally a
+longish business. It is half past two o'clock now; if we start from
+here at five we shall be down soon after eight, which will be quite soon
+enough. We shall have a couple of hours' drive in the dark, but that
+won't matter, we have got the lamps.”
+
+“I am quite ready to start, father. I am engaged to sup with Reginald
+Ascot, but I will go over this afternoon and make my excuses.”
+
+At five o'clock they started. “You have got your pistols in order,
+Mark?” the Squire asked, as they drove over London Bridge.
+
+“I have them handy, father, one in each pocket.”
+
+“James, are your pistols charged?”
+
+“Yes, sir.”
+
+At six o'clock it was beginning to get dusk, and they stopped while the
+groom got down and lit the lamps; then they resumed their journey. They
+were within five miles of Reigate when suddenly two horsemen rode out
+from a side road with a shout of “Stand and deliver!”
+
+The Squire lashed the horses, and a moment later a pistol was fired, and
+the ball went through his hat. By the light of the lamps Mark saw
+the other man raise his hand, and, leveling his pistol, fired on the
+instant; then, as there was no reply to his shot, he discharged the
+second barrel at the first who had fired, and who had at once drawn
+another pistol. The two reports rang out almost at the same moment, but
+Mark's was a little the first. There was a sharp exclamation of pain
+from the highwayman, who wrenched round his horse and galloped down the
+lane from which he had issued, the groom sending two bullets after him.
+
+“Where is the other man?” Mark exclaimed, as his father reined in the
+horses.
+
+“Somewhere on the ground there, Mark; I saw him fall from his saddle as
+we passed him.”
+
+“Is it any use pursuing the other, father? I am pretty sure I hit him.”
+
+“I am quite sure you did, but it is no good our following; the side
+roads are so cut up by ruts that we should break a spring before we had
+gone a hundred yards. No, we will stop and look at this fellow who is
+unhorsed, Mark.”
+
+The groom got down, and, taking one of the carriage lamps, proceeded to
+a spot where the highwayman's horse was standing. The man was already
+dead, the bullet having hit him a few inches above the heart.
+
+“He is dead, father.”
+
+“I think you had better lift him up on the foot board behind; James can
+ride his horse. We will hand the body over to the constable at Reigate.
+He may know who he is, or find something upon him that may afford a clew
+that will lead to the capture of his companion.”
+
+“No, I don't know him, Squire,” the constable said as they stopped
+before his house and told him what had happened. “However, he certainly
+is dead, and I will get one of the men to help me carry him into the
+shed behind the courthouse. So you say that you think that the other is
+wounded?”
+
+“I am pretty sure he is. I heard him give an exclamation as my son
+fired.”
+
+“That is good shooting, Mr. Mark,” the constable said. “If every
+passenger could use his arms as you do there would soon be an end to
+stopping coaches. I will see what he has got about him, and will come up
+and let you know, Squire, the first thing in the morning.”
+
+“I will send Knapp down,” John Thorndyke said, as they drove homewards.
+“I am rather curious to know if this fellow is the same Mrs. Cunningham
+wrote about. I will tell him to take Peters along with him.”
+
+“I hardly see that there can be any connection between the two.
+Highwaymen don't go in for house breaking. I think they consider that to
+be a lower branch of the profession.”
+
+“Generally they do, no doubt, Mark; but you know I told you that the
+chief at Bow Street said that he had a suspicion that the highway
+robbers and the house breakers who have been creating so much alarm are
+the same men.”
+
+“It is curious that they should have happened to light on us, father, if
+they were intending to break into our house.”
+
+John Thorndyke made no reply, and in a few minutes drove up to the
+house. Their return, a couple of days before they were expected,
+caused great satisfaction to Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent. The former,
+however, had wisely kept from the girl the matter on which she had
+written to the Squire, and the suspicion she had herself entertained.
+
+“It is very dull without you both,” Millicent said. “I was telling Mrs.
+Cunningham that I thought it would be a good thing, when you got back,
+for us two to take a run up to town for a week, just to let you see
+how dull the place is when two of us are away. You are looking quite
+serious, uncle. Is anything the matter?”
+
+“Happily nothing is the matter with us, dear, but we have had an
+adventure, and not a very pleasant one.”
+
+“What was it?” the girl asked.
+
+“If you examine my hat closely, Millicent, it will tell you.”
+
+The girl took up the hat from a chair on which he had put it, and
+brought it to the light. “There are two holes in it,” she said. “Oh,
+Guardy, have you been shot at?”
+
+“It looks like it, dear. Two gentlemen highwaymen--at least, that is
+what I believe they call themselves--asked us pressingly to stop, and
+as we would not comply with their request, one fired at me, and, as you
+see, it was an uncommonly good shot. The other was about to fire when
+Mark's pistol put a stop to him, and his second barrel stopped the
+fellow who had fired first; he was hit, for we heard him give an
+exclamation of pain, but before any more shooting could be done he
+turned and rode off down a narrow lane where we could not follow.”
+
+“And what became of the first?” Millicent asked with open eyes.
+
+“He was dead before we could get down to examine him; he will not
+disturb the King's peace again. It happened about four miles from home,
+so we brought him in and gave him and his horse into the charge of the
+constable at Reigate.”
+
+“And you have really killed a man?” Millicent said, looking up with an
+awestruck expression to Mark.
+
+“Well, as the man would have killed us if I hadn't, I cannot say,
+Millicent, that his death weighs in any way heavily on my mind. If he
+were as good a shot as the other, my father's life would not have been
+worth much, for as we were driving fast, he was not above half as far
+away as the other had been when he fired. Just the same, I suppose, as
+it would be in a battle; a man is going to shoot you, and you shoot him
+first, and I don't suppose it ever troubles you afterwards.”
+
+“Of course I don't mean that I blame you, Mark; but it does seem
+shocking.”
+
+“I don't suppose you would think that, Millicent, if a burglar, who had
+taken one shot at you and was about to finish you with another, was cut
+short in the operation by a shot from my pistol. I believe that your
+relief and thankfulness would be so great that the idea that it was a
+shocking thing for me to do would not as much as enter your head.”
+
+“I wish you had shot the other man as well as the one you did, Mark,”
+ the Squire said, as he walked with his son down to Reigate to attend the
+inquest the next morning on the man he had brought in. Mark looked at
+his father in surprise.
+
+“There is no doubt I hit him, father,” he said; “but I should not think
+that he will be likely to trouble us again.”
+
+“I wish I felt quite sure of that. Do you know that I have a strong
+suspicion that it was Arthur Bastow?”
+
+Mark had, of course, heard of Bastow's escape, but had attached no great
+importance to it. The crime had taken place nearly eight years before,
+and although greatly impressed at the time by the ill doings of the man,
+the idea that he would ever return and endeavor to avenge himself on
+his father for the part he had taken had not occurred to him. Beyond
+mentioning his escape, the Squire had never talked to him on the
+subject.
+
+“It was he who bade us stand and deliver, and the moment he spoke the
+voice seemed familiar to me, and, thinking it over, I have an impression
+that it was his. I may be mistaken, for I have had him in my mind ever
+since I heard that he had escaped, and may therefore have connected the
+voice with him erroneously, and yet I cannot but think that I was right.
+You see, there are two or three suspicious circumstances. In the first
+place, there was this man down here making inquiries. Knapp went down
+early this morning with the innkeeper, and told me before breakfast that
+Peters at once recognized the fellow you shot as the man who had made
+the inquiries. Now, the natural result of making inquiries would have
+been that the two men would the next evening have broken into the house,
+thinking that during our absence they would meet with no resistance.
+Instead of doing this they waylaid us on the road, which looks as if it
+was me they intended to attack, and not the house.”
+
+“But how could they have known that it was us, father? It is certainly
+singular that one of the two men should have been the fellow who was up
+at the inn, but it may be only a matter of coincidence.”
+
+“I don't know, Mark; I don't say that singular coincidences don't occur,
+but I have not much faith in them. Still, if they were journeying down
+to attack the house last night they would hardly have stopped travelers
+by the way when there was a rich booty awaiting them, as they evidently
+believed there was, or that man would not have come down specially to
+make inquiries. My own impression is that when they heard that we should
+return in two or three days one of them watched us in London, and as
+soon as they learned that we were to start for home at five o'clock they
+came down here to stop us. They would hardly have done that merely to
+get our watches and what money we had in our pockets.”
+
+“No, I should think not, father; but they might be friends of men who
+have got into trouble at Reigate, and, as you are chairman of the bench,
+may have had a special grudge against you for their conviction.”
+
+“That is, of course, possible, and I hope that it is so.”
+
+“But even if Arthur Bastow had escaped, father, why should he come back
+to England, where he would know that he might be arrested again, instead
+of staying quietly out in Australia?”
+
+“There are two reasons. In the first place the life out there would not
+be a quiet one; there would be nothing for him but to attack and rob the
+settlers, and this, as they are sure to be armed, is a pretty dangerous
+business. Then there are perils from the blacks, and lastly, such a
+life would be absolutely devoid of comfort, and be that of a hunted dog;
+living always in the bush, scarcely venturing to sleep lest he should
+be pounced upon either by the armed constables of the colony or by the
+blacks. It is not as if the country were extensively populated; there
+are not a very large number of settlers there yet, and therefore very
+small scope for robbers. These people would keep very little money
+with them, and the amount of plunder to be got would be small indeed.
+Therefore, I take it that the main object of any escaped convict would
+be to get away from the place.
+
+“That is one of the reasons why the fellow might come back to England
+in spite of the risks. The other is that I believe him to be so
+diabolically vindictive that he would run almost any peril in order to
+obtain revenge upon me or his father. Twice he has threatened me, the
+first time when we captured him, the second time as he left the court
+after he had received his sentence. I am not a coward, so far as I know,
+Mark, but I am as certain as I stand here that he meant what he said,
+and that, during these years of imprisonment and toil out there, he has
+been cherishing the thought of coming home some day and getting even
+with me. You see, he is said to have been the leader of this convict
+revolt. There is no doubting his daring, and to my mind the attack upon
+us last night, when they knew that they could have managed a successful
+robbery here, points to the fact that it was the result of personal
+animosity, and strengthens my belief that it was Arthur Bastow who
+called upon us to stand and deliver.”
+
+“It is a very unpleasant idea, father.”
+
+“Very unpleasant, and it seems to me that we should at any rate spare no
+pains in hunting the man you wounded down.”
+
+“I will undertake that if you like. I have nothing particular to do, and
+it would be an excitement. You have a lot to keep you here.”
+
+“I don't fancy that you will find it an excitement, Mark, for of course
+the detectives will do the hunting, but I should certainly be glad if
+you would take a letter for me to the head of the Detective Department,
+and tell him what I think, and my reasons for thinking so, and say that
+I offer a reward of a hundred pounds for the capture of the man who
+tried to stop us, and who was, we are certain, wounded by you. Unless
+he has some marvelously out of the way hiding place, it ought not to
+be difficult. A wounded man could scarcely lie hidden in the slums of
+London without it being known to a good many people, to some of whom
+a reward of the sum of a hundred pounds would be an irresistible
+temptation.”
+
+By this time they had reached Reigate. The inquest did not last
+many minutes, and the jury without hesitation returned a verdict of
+justifiable homicide.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII.
+
+
+The next morning Mark went up to London.
+
+“Of course, Mr. Thorndyke,” the chief at Bow Street said, “your father's
+suspicions as to the man's identity may or may not be justified; that,
+however, makes no difference to us. Here is a highwayman who has been
+wounded, and would certainly be a valuable capture: I will set my men to
+work at once; if he is in London they will get news of him before many
+days. My men in any case would do their duty, but your father's offer
+will certainly stimulate their energy. Where are you stopping?”
+
+“At the Bull, in Holborn.”
+
+“Very well; I will be sure to let you know as soon as we get any clew to
+the man's identity.”
+
+Mark remained in London a week, and at the end of that time he received
+a note from Bow Street saying that the superintendent wished to see him.
+
+“I am sorry that I have no news for you, Mr. Thorndyke,” the officer
+said, when he called upon him. “Every place where such a man would be
+likely to be in hiding has been searched, and no clew whatever has been
+obtained. We shall now circulate notices of the reward throughout the
+country. If the man was at all severely hit, we may assume that he must
+be somewhere in the neighborhood of London, whereas, if the wound was
+a slight one, he might be able to go a long distance, and may be now
+in York, for aught we know. However, now that the search in London has
+terminated, I can really see no use in your staying here any longer; we
+will let you know directly we have any news.”
+
+Three months later John Thorndyke received a letter from the Detective
+Office asking him to call the next time he came up to town, as although
+no news had been obtained that would lead to the man's immediate
+arrest, news had at any rate been obtained showing that he was alive. It
+happened that Mark was intending to go up on the following day, and his
+father asked him to call for him at Bow Street.
+
+“Well, Mr. Thorndyke, we have heard about your man, and that after we
+had quite abandoned the search. I had come to the conclusion that the
+wound you gave him had been a fatal one, and that he had been quietly
+buried by some of the people with whom he was connected. The discovery
+was, as half these discoveries generally are, the result of accident.
+Last week a gentleman entered the Bank and asked for change in gold for
+a fifty pound note. The cashier, looking at the number, found that it
+was one of those that had been stolen from a passenger by one of the
+south coaches several months ago. The gentleman was at once taken into
+a private office, and questioned as to how he had obtained the note.
+The account that he gave was that he was a surgeon in practice at
+Southampton. A gentleman had arrived there on a date which we found to
+be the day after that on which you were stopped; he was well dressed,
+and had the air of a gentleman; he had come down by coach, and was
+evidently very ill. He told the surgeon that he had been engaged in a
+duel, that the pistols had been discharged simultaneously, and that he
+had killed his man, but had himself been severely wounded. He said that
+the person whom he had killed had influential connections, and that it
+would be necessary for him to remain in seclusion for a time, and he
+asked him to take charge of his case, as he had ample means of paying
+him handsomely. The surgeon examined the wound, and found it to be
+indeed a serious one, and, as he thought, probably fatal. However,
+having no doubt as to the truth of the story, he had taken the gentleman
+in, and he remained under his charge until a week before he came up to
+town.
+
+“For the first month he had been dangerously ill, but he completely
+recovered. The surgeon had no reason whatever for doubting his patient
+being a gentleman; he was fashionably dressed, and had evidently changed
+his clothes after the duel, as there were no bloodstains upon them. He
+was, however, glad when he left, as his conversation did not please him
+from its cynical tone. The Bank sent to us directly the man presented
+the note, which he stated had been given to him in part payment for his
+medical services and the board and lodging of the patient; the total
+amount had been 75 pounds, and the balance was paid in gold. As he
+was able to give several good references, and was identified by three
+gentlemen, he was, of course, released. I have no doubt whatever that
+the fellow he attended was your man. The surgeon said, whoever he was,
+he must have been a man of iron resolution to have made such a journey
+in the state he was.
+
+“No doubt he must have ridden straight to the place he used as his
+headquarters, where he had his wound roughly bandaged, changed his
+clothes, and had ridden in the morning to some point that the coach
+passed on its way to Southampton. Of course we obtained a minute
+description from the surgeon of the man's appearance. We found that
+the people at the coach office had no remembrance of there being anyone
+answering to that description among the persons who traveled by the
+coach, but of course that would not go for much, for over three months
+have elapsed.
+
+“When the coachman who had driven the down coach that day came up to
+town, we saw him, and he remembered perfectly that on or about that day
+he had picked up a passenger at Kingston--a gentleman who was in very
+weak health. There were only three inside passengers besides himself,
+and he had to be assisted into the coach. The way bill, on being turned
+up, showed that an inside passenger had been taken up at Kingston. I
+have already sent down men to make inquiries at every village in the
+district between Reigate and Kingston, and I trust that we shall lay
+hands on him, especially now we have got an accurate description of him,
+while before we were working in the dark in that respect.”
+
+“What is the description, sir? My father is much interested on that
+point, for, as I believe I told you, he has a strong suspicion that
+the fellow is the man who was transported more than eight years ago to
+Australia, and who made his escape from the prison there.”
+
+“Yes, I know. At first it appeared to me very improbable, but I am bound
+to say the description tallies very closely with that given of him. The
+surgeon took him to be nearly thirty; but after what he has gone through
+he may well look three or four years older than he is. He had light
+hair, rather small gray eyes, and a face that would have been good
+looking had it not been for its supercilious and sneering expression.”
+
+“I can remember him,” Mark said; “and that answers very closely to him.
+I should say that it is certainly Bastow, and my father made no mistake
+when he asserted that he recognized his voice.”
+
+The officer added a note to the description in his register: “Strongly
+suspected of being Arthur Bastow, transported for connivance with
+highwaymen; was leader of a mutiny in convict jail of Sydney two years
+and a half ago. Made his escape.”
+
+“There is no doubt,” he went on, “that he is a desperate character. No
+doubt he is the man who has been concerned in most of these robberies in
+the southern suburbs. We must get hold of him if we can, and once we
+do so there will be an end of his travels, for the mutiny in prison and
+escape is a hanging business, putting aside the affairs since he
+got back. Well, sir, I hope he will give you and your father no more
+trouble.”
+
+“I am sure I hope so,” Mark said. “I suppose that the fellow who was
+shot was one of the men who escaped with him from the convict prison.”
+
+“That is likely enough. Two would get home as easily as one, and the
+fact that they were both strangers here would account for the difficulty
+our men have had in their search for him. You see, we have had nothing
+whatever to go on. You must not be too sanguine about our catching the
+man in a short time: he is evidently a clever fellow, and I think it
+likely that once he got back he lost no time in getting away from this
+part of the country, and we are more likely to find him in the west or
+north than we are of laying hands on him here. We will send descriptions
+all over the country, and as soon as I hear of a series of crimes
+anywhere, I will send off two of my best men to help the local
+constables.”
+
+On his return home Mark told his father what he had done.
+
+“I thought that I could not have been mistaken, Mark; we have got that
+rascal on our hands again. I hope now that they have got a description
+of him to go by, they will not be long before they catch him; but
+the way he escaped after being badly wounded shows that he is full of
+resources, and he may give them some trouble yet, if I am not mistaken.
+At any rate, I will have a talk with the Reigate constable, and tell him
+that there is very little doubt that the man who attacked us was Arthur
+Bastow, who has, as we have heard, escaped from Botany Bay, and that he
+had best tell his men to keep a sharp lookout for him, for that, owing
+to his animosity against us for his former capture and conviction, it
+is likely enough that sooner or later he will be in this neighborhood
+again. After his determined attempt at my life when pretending to rob
+us, I shall certainly not feel comfortable until I know that he is under
+lock and key.”
+
+“I wish, Guardy, you would give up this magistrate's business,”
+ Millicent said at dinner. “I am sure that it is worrying you, and I
+can't see why you should go on with it.”
+
+“It does not worry me, as a rule, Millicent; indeed, I like the duty.
+Besides, every landowner of standing ought to take his share in public
+work. There are only two of the magistrates younger than I am, and
+whatever you may think of me, I feel myself capable of doing what work
+there is to do. When Mark gets a few years older I shall resign, and let
+him take my place on the bench. I own, though, that I should be glad if
+these highway robberies could be suppressed. Poaching and the ordinary
+offenses of drunkenness and assaults are disposed of without any
+trouble; but this stopping of the coaches, accompanied occasionally by
+the shooting of the coachman or guard, gives a great deal of trouble,
+and the worst of it is that we are practically powerless to put such
+crimes down. Nothing short of patrolling the roads in parties of three
+or four between sunset and sunrise would put a stop to them, and the
+funds at our disposal would not support such an expenditure.”
+
+“It is a pity that you cannot get up a corps like the yeomanry, and call
+it the Mounted Constabulary,” said Mark. “There are at least a dozen
+fellows I know who would, like myself, be glad to join it, and I dare
+say we could get a score of young farmers or farmers' sons.”
+
+“It is not a bad idea, Mark, and I dare say that for a time the duty
+would be zealously performed, but before very long you would tire of it.
+A few wet nights or winter's cold, and you would cease to see the fun of
+it, especially as you may be sure that the news that the roads are well
+patrolled would soon come to the ears of these scoundrels, and they
+would cease to work in the district.”
+
+“Perhaps you are right, sir; but I think that a few of us would stick to
+it.”
+
+“Perhaps so, Mark, but I should be sorry to wager that the work would
+be thoroughly done. The first county or hunt ball, or even dinner party,
+more than half of them would be away. I don't say that you personally
+might not for some considerable time persist in patrolling the roads,
+for you have a sort of personal interest in the matter; but I would
+wager that before two months have passed you would find you were the
+only one who attended at the rendezvous regularly.”
+
+A fortnight later the party were seated round the fire in the dusk.
+Mr. Bastow was sitting next to the Squire, and was in unusually good
+spirits. He had heard no word of what the Squire had discovered, nor
+dreamed that his son was again in England, still less that he was
+suspected of being one of the men who had endeavored to stop the Squire
+and his son on their drive from London. Suddenly there was the crack of
+a pistol outside, and a ball passed between him and the Squire. Without
+a word, Mark Thorndyke rushed to the door, seized a pistol from his
+riding coat, and, snatching up a heavy whip, dashed out into the garden.
+
+He was just in time to see a figure running at full speed, and he set
+off in pursuit. Good runner as he was, he gained but slightly at first,
+but after a time he drew nearer to the fugitive. The latter was but
+some sixty yards away when he leaped a hedge into a narrow lane. Mark
+followed without hesitation, but as he leaped into the road he heard a
+jeering laugh and the sharp sound of a horse's hoofs, and knew that the
+man he was pursuing had gained his horse and made off. Disgusted at his
+failure, he went slowly back to the house. The shutters had been put up.
+
+“I have lost him, father. He ran well to begin with, but I was gaining
+fast on him when he leaped into a narrow lane where he had left his
+horse, and rode off before I could get up to him. I need hardly say that
+there was no use attempting to follow on foot. He missed you all, did he
+not?”
+
+“Yes, Mark. It is not so easy to take an accurate aim when it is nearly
+dark. The bullet passed between myself and Mr. Bastow, and has buried
+itself in the mantelpiece.”
+
+“Something ought to be done, Guardy,” Millicent Conyers said
+indignantly. “It is shameful that people cannot sit in their own room
+without the risk of being shot at. What can it mean? Surely no one can
+have any enmity against you.”
+
+“I hope not, my dear,” John Thorndyke said lightly. “Some of the fellows
+we have sentenced may think that we were rather hard on them, but I
+do not think that any of them would feel it sufficiently to attempt to
+murder one; besides, Mark says that the fellow had a horse waiting
+for him, and none of our poachers would be likely to be the owner of a
+horse. It may be that the highwayman Mark shot at and wounded has come
+down to give us a fright. It is no use worrying about it now; in future
+we will have the shutters closed at sunset. It is hardly likely that
+the thing will be attempted again, and Mark's chase must have shown the
+fellow that the game is hardly worth the risk.”
+
+“He might have shot you, Mark; you had no right to risk your life in
+that sort of way,” the girl said to him, later, as they were seated
+together in front of the fire, while the Squire was reading the Gazette
+at the table, Mrs. Cunningham was working, and Mr. Bastow, who had been
+greatly shaken by the event, had retired to bed.
+
+“Do you think that he really meant to kill your father?”
+
+“I should imagine he did; a man would hardly run the risk of being hung
+merely for the pleasure of shooting. I would give a good deal if I had
+caught him, or better still, if I had shot him,” said Mark. “However, I
+will make it my business to hunt the fellow down. After this evening's
+affair, we shall never feel comfortable until he is caught. I have
+no doubt that he is the fellow we have been hunting for the last four
+months. The people at Bow Street seem no good whatever; I will try if I
+cannot succeed better.”
+
+“Don't do anything rash, Mark,” said Millicent, in a low voice; “you
+have no right to put yourself in danger.”
+
+“But our lives are in danger now, Millicent--in much greater danger
+than mine would be when looking out for him. But there seems no guarding
+against attacks like this; I mean to hunt him down, if it takes me
+a year. I have nothing special to do, and cannot employ my time more
+usefully.”
+
+When the ladies went up to bed the Squire said:
+
+“Come into the library, Mark, and we will smoke a pipe, and have a talk
+over this business.” He touched the bell. “Have you got a good fire in
+the library, Ramoo?”
+
+“Yes, sahib, very good.”
+
+“Then take a bottle of number one bin of port there--and a couple of
+glasses.”
+
+When they were quietly seated, glasses filled, and the long pipes
+alight, the Squire said: “I want to have a serious talk with you, Mark.
+What I am going to say will surprise you a good deal. I had not intended
+to tell you for another four years--that is to say, not until Millicent
+came of age--but after that affair tonight, I feel that my life is
+so uncertain that I ought not to delay letting you know the truth.
+I suppose you agree with me that it was Bastow who shot at me this
+evening?”
+
+“I have not the least doubt about that, father.”
+
+“I will not say that he shot at me,” the Squire said, “for he may have
+shot at his father; the villain is quite capable of that. It was his
+father who brought me upon him, and though I effected his capture eight
+years ago I don't suppose he cares which of us he killed. However, the
+point is not what he aimed at, but whether it was he, and that I take
+there is no doubt about. He missed me this time, but his next shot may
+be more successful, At any rate, I think that it is high time that I
+told you the story.”
+
+And, beginning with the arrival of Colonel Thorndyke at his place, he
+repeated the conversation that he had had with him. Several times in
+the early portion of his narrative he was interrupted by exclamations of
+surprise from his son.
+
+“Then Millicent is really my uncle's heiress!” exclaimed Mark, when he
+heard the request the Colonel had made of the Squire.
+
+“That is so, Mark. She does not know it herself, and it was my brother's
+urgent wish that she should not know it until she came of age or until
+she married. I fought against it to the utmost, but it was his dying
+prayer, and I could not refuse it. My solicitor knows the facts of the
+matter, and so does Mrs. Cunningham, who brought Millicent over from
+India when she was only about a year old. I may say that I especially
+urged that it would not be fair to you to be brought up to consider
+yourself to be heir to the property, but he said:
+
+“'Putting aside the estate, I have a considerable fortune. In the first
+place, there are the accumulations of rent from the Reigate place. I
+have never touched them, and they have been going on for twelve years.
+In. the next place, the shaking of the pagoda tree has gone on merrily,
+and we all made a comfortable pile. Then I always made a point of
+carrying about with me two or three hundred pounds, and after the
+sacking of some of the palaces I could pick up jewels and things from
+the troops for a trifle, being able to pay money down. Even without
+the rents here, I have some 50,000 pounds in money. I should think the
+jewels would be worth at least as much more, irrespective of a diamond
+bracelet which is, I fancy, worth more than the rest put together. It
+was stolen from the arm of some idol.' He then explained how he got it,
+and the manner in which he had placed it and the rest of his wealth in a
+secure position.
+
+“'Things stolen from a god are frightfully dangerous,' he said, 'for the
+Brahmins or priests connected with the temples have been known to follow
+them up for years, and in nine cases out of ten they get possession of
+them again. Murder in such a case is meritorious, and I would not have
+them in the house here, were they ten times the value they are. I know
+that my clothes, my drawers, and everything belonging to me have been
+gone through at night a score of times. Nothing has been stolen, but,
+being a methodical man, I could generally see some displacement in the
+things that told me they had been disturbed. They gave it up for a time,
+but I haven't a shadow of a doubt that they have been watching me ever
+since, and they may be watching me now, for anything I know. Now, half
+of that fortune I have left by my will to your son; half to the girl. I
+will tell you where the things are the last thing before I die.
+
+“'Now, mind, you must be careful when you get them. When I am dead you
+are almost certain to be watched. You don't know what these fellows are.
+The things must remain where they are until your boy comes of age. Don't
+let him keep those diamonds an hour in his possession; let him pass them
+away privately to some man in whom he has implicit confidence, for
+him to take them to a jeweler's; let him double and turn and disguise
+himself so as to throw everyone that may be spying on him off his
+track. If you can manage it, the best way would be to carry them over to
+Amsterdam, and sell them there.'
+
+“I confess it seemed absurd, but it is a matter about which he would
+know a great deal more than I do, and he was convinced that not only
+was he watched, but that he owed his life simply to the fact that the
+fellows did not know where the diamonds were hidden, and that by killing
+him they would have lost every chance of regaining them.
+
+“So convinced was he of all this, that he would not tell me where he had
+stowed them away; he seemed to think that the very walls would hear us,
+and that these fellows might be hidden under the sofa, in a cupboard, or
+up the chimney, for aught I know. He told me that he would tell me the
+secret before he died; but death came so suddenly that he never had an
+opportunity of doing so. He made a tremendous effort in his last moment,
+but failed, and I shall never forget the anguish his face expressed when
+he found himself powerless to speak; however, he pressed his snuffbox
+into my hand with such a significant look that, being certain it
+contained some clew to the mystery, and being unable to find a hidden
+spring or a receptacle, I broke it open that night.
+
+“It contained a false bottom, and here are what I found in it. I stowed
+them away in a secret drawer in that old cabinet that stands by my
+bedside. It is in the bottom pigeonhole on the right hand side. I bought
+the cabinet at a sale, and found the spring of the secret drawer quite
+accidentally. I shall put the things back tonight, and you will know
+where to look for them. You press against the bottom and up against the
+top simultaneously, and the back then falls forward. The opening behind
+is very shallow, and will hold but two or three letters. But, however,
+it sufficed for this;” and he handed Mark the coin and slip of paper.
+
+“But what are these, father?”
+
+“These are the clews by which we are to obtain the treasure.”
+
+As Mark examined them carefully the Squire stood up with his back to the
+fire, and looking round walked to the door and said: “I thought there
+was a draught somewhere; either Ramoo did not shut the door when he went
+out or it has come open again. It has done that once or twice before.
+When I go into town tomorrow I will tell Tucker to send a man up to take
+the lock off. Well, what do you make out of that?”
+
+“I can make out nothing,” Mark replied. “No doubt the coin is something
+to be given to whoever is in charge of the treasure, and Masulipatam may
+be the place where it is hidden.”
+
+“Yes, or it may be a password. It reminds one of the forty thieves
+business. You go and knock at the door of a cave, a figure armed to the
+teeth presents itself, you whisper in his ear 'Masulipatam,' he replies
+'Madras,' or 'Calcutta,' or something of that sort, you take out the
+coin and show it to him, he takes out from some hidden repository a
+similar one, compares the two, and then leads you to an inner cave piled
+up with jewels.”
+
+Mark laughed.
+
+“Well, it is no laughing matter, Mark,” the Squire went on seriously.
+“The little comedy may not be played just as I have sketched it, but I
+expect that it is something of the kind. That coin has to be shown, and
+the word 'Masulipatam' spoken to the guardian, whoever he may be, of
+your uncle's treasure. But who that guardian may be or how he is to be
+found is a mystery. I myself have never tried to solve it. There was
+nothing whatever to go upon. The things may be in England or, it may be,
+anywhere in India. To me it looked an absolutely hopeless business to
+set about. I did not see how even a first step was to be taken, and as I
+had this estate and you and Millicent to look after, and was no longer
+a young man, I put the matter aside altogether. You are young, you have
+plenty of energy, and you have your life before you, and it is a matter
+of the greatest interest to you.
+
+“Possibly--very improbably, mind, still possibly--when Millicent comes
+of age and learns who she is, Mrs. Cunningham may be able to help you.
+I have no idea whether it is so. I have never spoken to her about this
+treasure of George's, but it is just possible that while he was in
+town before he came down to me he may have given her some instructions
+concerning it. Of course he intended to give me full particulars, but he
+could hardly have avoided seeing that, in the event of my death, perhaps
+suddenly before the time came for seeking the treasure, the secret
+would be lost altogether. Whether he has told her or his lawyer or not
+I cannot say, but I have all along clung to the hope that he took some
+such natural precaution. Unless that treasure is discovered, the only
+thing that will come to you is the half of the accumulated rents of
+this estate during the ten years between my father's death and George's;
+these rents were paid to our solicitors, and by them invested.
+
+“The rentals amount to about 2500 pounds a year, and of course there is
+interest to be added, so that I suppose there is now some 25,000 pounds,
+for I had out 2000 pounds when I came here, to set matters straight. I
+had a great fight with the lawyers over it, but as I pointed out they
+had failed altogether to see that the agent did his duty, and that
+at least a couple of hundred a year ought to be expended in necessary
+repairs, I had a right to at least that sum to carry out the work that
+ought to be done from year to year. In addition to that sum I laid out
+about 1000 pounds a year for the first three years I was here; so that
+practically 5000 pounds was expended in rebuilding the village and
+doing repairs on the homesteads; that, however, is not the point now.
+Altogether, then, there is some 25,000 pounds to be divided between you
+and Millicent when she becomes mistress of this property.
+
+“According to the terms of my brother's will, I am still to remain here
+until she marries; when she does so I shall, of course, go back to my
+own little place; the income of that has been accumulating while I
+have been here, my only expenses having been for clothes. I have taken
+nothing out of this estate since I came here, and each year have paid
+to the solicitors all balances remaining after discharging the household
+expenses, these balances averaging 700 or 800 pounds a year. Of
+course the income was absolutely left to me during the time I remained
+ostensible owner, but I had no wish to make money out of a trust that
+I assumed greatly against my will. That money is Millicent's; of course
+the house had to be kept up in proper style whether I were here or not.
+Had she at once come into possession, there must have been horses, and
+carriages, and so on. I don't say that I have not had all the expenses
+of our living saved; that I had no objection to; but I was determined at
+least not to take a penny put of the estate beyond those expenses. You
+see, Mark, you will have your 12,500 pounds anyhow, as soon as Millicent
+comes of age--not a bad little sum--so that even if you never hear
+anything more of this mysterious treasure you will not be penniless, or
+in anyway dependent upon me. At my death, of course, you will come into
+the Sussex place, with what savings there may be.”
+
+“I am sure I have no reason to grumble, father,” Mark said heartily.
+“Of course it came upon me at first as a surprise that Millicent was
+the heiress here, and it flashed through my mind for the moment that the
+best thing would be to take a commission in the army, or to follow my
+uncle's example, and get a cadetship in the Company's service. I have
+no doubt that I should have enjoyed life either way quite as much or
+possibly more than if I had gone on a good many years as heir to these
+estates, and afterwards as Squire. Of course, now I shall make it my
+business to see if it is possible to obtain some sort of clew to this
+treasure, and then follow it up; but the first thing to which I shall
+give my mind will be to hunt down Bastow. We shall never feel safe here
+as long as that fellow is alive, and that will be the first thing I
+shall devote myself to. After that I shall see about the treasure.”
+
+“As to that, Mark, I cannot impress upon you too strongly what your
+uncle said. It may, of course, be a pure delusion on his part; but if
+he is right, and some of these Hindoo fellows are still on the watch to
+obtain that bracelet, you must use extraordinary precautions when you
+get it into your hands; he advised me to take it across to Amsterdam,
+and either get the stones recut or to sell them separately to different
+diamond merchants there. He said that my life would not be worth an
+hour's purchase as long as the stones were in my hands.”
+
+“That rather looks, father, as if the things were somewhere in England;
+had they been in India, you would have had them some months in your
+hands before you could get them to Amsterdam.”
+
+“I did not think of that before, Mark, and it is possible that you
+are right; but I don't know; he might have thought that it would be
+impossible for me to dispose of them at Madras or Calcutta, and may have
+assumed that I should at once deposit them in a bank to be forwarded
+with other treasure to England, or that I should get them packed away
+in the treasure safe in the ship I came back by, and that I should not
+really have them on my person till I landed in England, or until I
+took them from the Bank. Still, I see that your supposition is the most
+likely, and that they may all this time have been lying somewhere in
+London until I should present myself with a gold coin and the word
+'Masulipatam.'”
+
+Suddenly Mark sprang to his feet, and pulled back the curtains across
+a window, threw it up, and leaped into the garden, and there stood
+listening for two or three minutes, with his pistol cocked in his hand.
+He stepped for a moment into the room again.
+
+“You had better put that light out, father or we may have another shot.”
+
+“Did you hear anything, Mark?”
+
+“I thought I did, father. I may have been mistaken, but I certainly
+thought I heard a noise, and when I pulled the curtains aside the window
+was not shut by three or four inches. I will have a look through the
+shrubbery. That fellow may have come back again. Pull the curtains to
+after me.”
+
+“I will go with you, Mark.”
+
+“I would rather you didn't, father; it would only make me nervous. I
+shan't go into the shrubbery and give them a chance of getting first
+shot. I shall hide up somewhere and listen. It is a still night, and if
+there is anyone moving I am pretty sure to hear him.”
+
+The Squire turned down the lamp, drew the curtains, and seated himself
+by the fire. It was three quarters of an hour before Mark returned. He
+shut the window, and fastened it carefully.
+
+“I fancy you must have been mistaken, Mark.”
+
+“I suppose that shot through the window has made me nervous. I certainly
+did fancy I heard a noise there; it may have been a dead bough snapping,
+or something of that sort; and of course, the window being partly open,
+even though only three or four inches, any little noise would come in
+more plainly than it otherwise would do. However, everything has been
+perfectly quiet since I went out, and it is hardly likely indeed that
+the fellow would have returned so soon after the hot chase I gave him.”
+
+“It is very stupid--the window being left open,” the Squire said. “I
+shall question Martha about it in the morning; it was her duty to see
+that it was shut and fastened before drawing the curtains. Just at
+present one can scarcely be too careful. I don't mean to deny that
+whether there was a window open or not a burglar who wanted to get into
+the house could do so, still there is no use in making their work more
+easy for them. I know, as a rule, we are careless about such things;
+there has not been a burglary in this part for years, and until lately
+the front door has never been locked at night, and anyone could have
+walked in who wanted to. Of course the servants don't know that there is
+any reason for being more careful at present than usual.
+
+“I was thinking the other day of having shutters put to all these
+downstair rooms. Some of them have got them, and some have not; still,
+even with shutters, burglars can always get in if they want to do so.
+They have only to cut round the lock of a door or to make a hole in a
+panel to give them room to put an arm through and draw back a bolt, and
+the thing is done. I know that all the silver is locked up every night
+in the safe, for Ramoo sees to that, and I have never known him neglect
+anything under his charge. Well, Mark, I don't know that it is any use
+sitting up longer, we have plenty of time to talk the matter over; it is
+four years yet before Millicent comes of age, though, of course, there
+is nothing to prevent your setting out in quest of the treasure as soon
+as you like. Still, there is no hurry about it.”
+
+“None whatever, father; but I don't mean to lose a day before I try to
+get on the track of that villain Bastow.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII.
+
+
+Mark was some hours before he went to sleep. The news that he had heard
+that evening was strange and startling. Full of health and strength, the
+fact that he was not, as he had always supposed, the heir to the estate
+troubled him not at all. The fact that in four years he would come in
+for some twelve thousand pounds was sufficient to prevent his feeling
+any uneasiness as to his future; and indeed in some respects it was not
+an unpleasant idea that, instead of being tied down to the estate, he
+should be able to wander at will, visit foreign countries, and make his
+own life.
+
+In one respect he was sorry. His father had in the last year hinted more
+than once that it would be a very nice arrangement if he were to make
+up a match with his ward; he had laughed, and said that there would be
+plenty of time for that yet. But the idea had been an agreeable one. He
+was very fond of Millicent--fond, perhaps; in a cousinly way at present;
+but at any rate he liked her far better than any of the sisters of his
+friends. Of course she was only seventeen yet, and there was plenty of
+time to think of marriage in another three years. Still, the thought
+occurred to him several times that she was budding out into a young
+woman, and every month added to her attractions. It was but the day
+before he had said to himself that there was no reason to wait as long
+as three years, especially as his father seemed anxious, and would
+evidently be glad were the match to take place. Now, of course, he said
+to himself, that was at an end. He had never given her any reason to
+suppose that he cared for her, and now that she was the heiress and
+he comparatively poor, she would naturally think that it was for the
+estate, and not for herself, that she was wooed. Then there was the
+question of this curiously lost treasure, with the mysterious clew that
+led to nothing. How on earth was he to set about the quest? He puzzled
+for a long time over this, till at last he fell asleep. He was roused by
+Ramoo entering the room.
+
+“What is it, Ramoo?”
+
+“Me not know, sahib. Massa Thorndyke's door shut. Me no able to make him
+hear.”
+
+“That is curious, Ramoo,” Mark said, jumping hastily out of bed. “I will
+be with you in a minute.”
+
+He slipped on his trousers, coat, and slippers, and then accompanied
+Ramoo to his father's door. He knocked again and again, and each time
+more loudly, his face growing paler as he did so. Then he threw himself
+against the door, but it was solid and heavy.
+
+“Fetch me an ax, Ramoo,” he said. “There is something wrong here.”
+
+Ramoo returned in a short time with two men servants and with the ax in
+his hands. Mark took it, and with a few mighty blows split the woodwork,
+and then hurling himself against the door, it yielded. As he entered
+the room a cry broke from his lips. Within a pace or two of the bed the
+Squire lay on the ground, on his face, and a deep stain on the carpet
+at once showed that his death had been a violent one. Mark knelt by his
+side now, and touched him. The body was stiff and cold. The Squire must
+have been dead for some hours.
+
+“Murdered!” he said in a low voice; “my father has been murdered.”
+
+He remained in horror struck silence for a minute or two; then he slowly
+rose to his feet.
+
+“Let us lay him on the bed,” he said, and with the assistance of the
+three men he lifted and laid him there.
+
+“He has been stabbed,” he murmured, pointing to a small cut in the
+middle of the deep stain, just over the heart.
+
+Ramoo, after helping to lift the Squire onto the bed, had slid down to
+the floor, and crouched there, sobbing convulsively. The two servants
+stood helpless and aghast. Mark looked round the room: the window was
+open. He walked to it. A garden ladder stood outside, showing how the
+assassin had obtained entrance. Mark stood rigid and silent, his hands
+tightly clenched, his breath coming slowly and heavily. At last he
+roused himself.
+
+“Leave things just as they are,” he said to the men in a tone of
+unnatural calmness, “and fasten the door up again, and turn a table or
+something of that sort against it on the outside so that no one can come
+in. John, do you tell one of the grooms to saddle a horse and ride down
+into the town. Let him tell the head constable to come up at once, and
+also Dr. Holloway. Then he is to go on to Sir Charles Harris, tell him
+what has happened, and beg him to ride over at once.
+
+“Come, Ramoo,” he said in a softer voice, “you can do no good here, poor
+fellow, and the room must be closed. It is a heavy loss to you too.”
+
+The Hindoo rose slowly, the tears streaming down his face.
+
+“He was a good master,” he said, “and I loved him just as I loved the
+Colonel, sahib. Ramoo would have given his life for him.”
+
+With his hand upon Ramoo's shoulder, Mark left the room; he passed a
+group of women huddled together with blanched faces, at a short distance
+down the passage, the news that the Squire's door could not be opened
+and the sounds made by its being broken in having called them together.
+Mark could not speak. He silently shook his head and passed on. As
+he reached his room he heard shrieks and cries behind him, as the men
+informed them of what had taken place. On reaching his door, the one
+opposite opened, and Mrs. Cunningham in a dressing gown came out.
+
+“What is the matter, Mark, and what are these cries about?”
+
+“A dreadful thing has happened, Mrs. Cunningham; my father has been
+murdered in the night. Please tell Millicent.”
+
+Then he closed the door behind him, threw himself on his bed, and burst
+into a passion of tears. The Squire had been a good father to him, and
+had made him his friend and companion--a treatment rare indeed at a time
+when few sons would think of sitting down in their father's presence
+until told to do so. Since he had left school, eight years before, they
+had been very much together. For the last two or three years Mark had
+been a good deal out, but in this his father had encouraged him.
+
+“I like to see you make your own friends, Mark, and go your own way,” he
+used to say; “it is as bad for a lad to be tied to his father's coattail
+as at his mother's apron string. Get fresh ideas and form your own
+opinions. It will do for you what a public school would have done; make
+you self reliant, and independent.”
+
+Still, of course, a great portion of his time had been with his father,
+and they often would ride round the estate together and talk to the
+tenants, or walk in the gardens and forcing houses. Generally Mark would
+be driven by his father to the meet if it took place within reasonable
+distance, his horse being sent on beforehand by a groom, while of an
+evening they would sit in the library, smoke their long pipes, and talk
+over politics or the American and French wars.
+
+All this was over. There was but one thing now that he could do for his
+father, and that was to revenge his death, and at the thought he rose
+from his bed impatiently and paced up and down the room. He must wait
+for a week, wait till the funeral was over, and then he would be on
+Bastow's track. If all other plans failed he would spend his time in
+coaches until at last the villain should try to stop one; but there must
+be other ways. Could he find no other he would apply for employment as
+a Bow Street runner, serve for a year to find out their methods, and
+acquaint himself with the places where criminals were harbored. It would
+be the one object of his life, until he succeeded in laying his hand on
+Bastow's shoulder. He would not shoot him if he could help it. He should
+prefer to see him in the dock, to hear the sentence passed on him, and
+to see it carried out. As to the treasure, it was not worth a thought
+till his first duty was discharged.
+
+Presently a servant brought him a cup of tea. He drank it mechanically,
+and then proceeded to dress himself. Sir Charles Harris would be here
+soon and the others; indeed, he had scarcely finished when he was told
+that the doctor from Reigate had just arrived, and that the constable
+had come up half an hour before. He at once went down to the library,
+into which the doctor had been shown.
+
+“You have heard what has happened,” he said, as he shook hands silently.
+“I expect Sir Charles Harris here in half an hour. I suppose you will
+not go up till then?”
+
+“No, I think it will be best that no one should go in until he comes. I
+have been speaking to Simeox; he was going in, but I told him I thought
+it was better to wait. I may as well take the opportunity of going
+upstairs to see Mr. Bastow. I hear that he fainted when he heard the
+news, and that he is completely prostrate.”
+
+“Two such shocks might well prove fatal to him,” Mark said; “he has been
+weak and ailing for some time.”
+
+“Two shocks?” the doctor repeated interrogatively.
+
+“Ah, I forgot you had not heard about the affair yesterday evening: a
+man fired at us through the window when we were sitting round the fire,
+before the candles were lit. The ball passed between my father's head
+and Mr. Bastow's; both had a narrow escape; the bullet is imbedded in
+the mantelpiece. I will have it cut out; it may be a useful item of
+evidence some day.”
+
+“But what could have been the man's motive? Your father was universally
+popular.”
+
+“Except with ill doers,” Mark said. “I ran out and chased the fellow
+for half a mile, and should have caught him if he had not had a horse
+waiting for him in a lane, and he got off by the skin of his teeth. I
+hope that next time I meet him he will not be so lucky. Mr. Bastow was
+very much shaken, and went to bed soon afterwards. I am not surprised
+that this second shock should be too much for him. Will you go up and
+see him? I will speak to Simeox.”
+
+The constable was out in the garden.
+
+“This is a terrible business, Mr. Thorndyke. I suppose, after what you
+told me, you have your suspicions?”
+
+“They are not suspicions at all--they are certainties. Did you hear that
+he tried to shoot my father yesterday evening?”
+
+“No, sir, I have heard nothing about it.”
+
+Mark repeated the story of the attempt and pursuit.
+
+“Could you swear to him,' Mr. Thorndyke?”
+
+“No, there was not much light left; besides, as I have not seen him for
+the last eight years, I should certainly not be able to recognize him
+unless I had time to have a good look at him. Had it only been last
+night's affair it might have been anyone; but the shooting through the
+window was not the act of a thief, but of an assassin, who could only
+have been influenced by private enmity. I quite see that at present I
+have no legal evidence against Bastow; I am not even in a position to
+prove that he is in the country, for it cannot be said that my father's
+belief that he recognized the voice of the man who said 'Stand and
+deliver!' is proof. I doubt if anyone could swear that, when he only
+heard three words, he was absolutely sure that it was the voice of a man
+he had not seen for some years. However, fortunately, that will make no
+difference; the man is, as I told you, wanted for his heading the mutiny
+in the convict prison at Sydney, which will be quite sufficient to hang
+him without this business. But I own that I should prefer that he were
+hung for my father's murder if we could secure sufficient evidence.
+Moreover, there is the attack upon us three or four months ago, and with
+the evidence of the surgeon who attended him as to his wound, that would
+be enough to hang him. But we have first got to catch him, and that I
+mean to make my business, however long the search may take me.”
+
+“Was anything taken last night, sir?”
+
+“I don't know; I did not look. We shall see to that when we go upstairs.
+We may as well go indoors now; Sir Charles may be here in a few minutes,
+and I want to hear Dr. Holloway's report as to Mr. Bastow.”
+
+“He does not suspect, I hope, sir?”
+
+“No, thank God; my father never mentioned to him anything he heard about
+his son, or his suspicions, therefore he has no reason to believe that
+the fellow is not still in the convict prison at Sydney. We shall keep
+it from him now, whatever happens; but it would, for his sake, be best
+that this shock should prove too much for him. He has had a very hard
+time of it altogether.”
+
+“He is terribly prostrate,” the doctor reported when Mark joined him. “I
+don't think that he will get over it. He is scarcely conscious now. You
+see, he is an old man, and has no reserve of strength to fall back upon.
+Your father has been such a good friend to him that it is not surprising
+the news should have been too much for him. I examined him at the
+Squire's request some months ago as to his heart's action, which was so
+weak that I told the Squire then that he might go off at any time, and I
+rather wonder that he recovered even temporarily from the shock.”
+
+In a few minutes Sir Charles Harris drove up.
+
+“This is terrible news, my dear Mark,” he said, as he leaped from his
+gig and wrung Mark's hand--“terrible. I don't know when I have had
+such a shock; he was a noble fellow in all respects, a warm friend, an
+excellent magistrate, a kind landlord, good all round. I can scarcely
+believe it yet. A burglar, of course. I suppose he entered the house for
+the purpose of robbery, when your father awoke and jumped out of bed,
+there was a tussle, and the scoundrel killed him; at least, that is what
+I gather from the story that the groom told me.”
+
+“That is near it, Sir Charles, but I firmly believe that robbery was not
+the object, but murder; for murder was attempted yesterday evening,” and
+he informed the magistrate of the shot fired through the window.
+
+“Bless me, you don't say so!” the magistrate exclaimed. “That alters
+the case altogether, and certainly would seem to make the act one of
+premeditated murder; and yet, surely, the Squire could not have had an
+enemy. Some of the men whom we have sentenced may have felt a grudge
+against him, but surely not sufficient to lead them to a crime like
+this.”
+
+“I will talk of it with you afterwards, Sir Charles. I have the very
+strongest suspicions, although no absolute proofs. Now, will you first
+come upstairs? Doctor Holloway is here and Simeox, but no one has
+entered the room since I left it; I thought it better that it should be
+left undisturbed until you came.”
+
+“Quite so; we will go up at once.”
+
+An examination of the room showed nothing whatever that would afford the
+slightest clew. The Squire's watch was still in the watch pocket at the
+head of the bed, his purse was on a small table beside him; apparently
+nothing had been touched in the room.
+
+“If robbery was the object,” Sir Charles said gravely, “it has evidently
+not been carried out, and it is probable that Mr. Thorndyke was partly
+woke by the opening of the window, and that he was not thoroughly
+aroused until the man was close to his bed; then he leapt out and seized
+him. Probably the stab was, as Dr. Holloway assures us, instantly fatal,
+and he may have fallen so heavily that the man, fearing that the house
+would be alarmed at the sound, at once fled, without even waiting to
+snatch up the purse. The whole thing is so clear that it is scarcely
+necessary to ask any further questions. Of course, there must be an
+inquest tomorrow. I should like when I go down to ask the gardener
+where he left the ladder yesterday. Have you examined the ground for
+footmarks?”
+
+“Yes, Sir Charles, but you see it was a pretty hard frost last night,
+and I cannot find any marks at all. The ground must have been like iron
+about the time when the ladder was placed there.”
+
+The gardener, on being called in, said that the ladder was always hung
+up outside the shed at the back of the house; there was a chain round
+it, and he had found that morning that one of the links had been filed
+through.
+
+“The Squire was most particular about its being locked, as Mr. Mark
+knows, so that it could not be used by any ill disposed chaps who might
+come along at night. The key of the padlock was always hung on a nail
+round the other side of the shed. The Squire knew of it, and so did Mr.
+Mark and me; so that while it was out of the way of the eyes of a thief,
+any of us could run and get it and undo the padlock in a minute in case
+of fire or anything of that sort. I have not used the ladder, maybe,
+for a fortnight, but I know that it was hanging in its place yesterday
+afternoon.”
+
+“I expect the fellow was prowling about here for some time,” Mark said.
+“I was chatting with my father in the library when I thought I heard a
+noise, and I threw open the window, which had by some carelessness been
+left a little open, and went out, and listened for nearly an hour, but I
+could hear nothing, and put it down to the fact that I was nervous owing
+to what had happened early in the evening, and that the noise was simply
+fancy, or that the frost had caused a dry branch of one of the shrubs to
+crack.”
+
+“How was it you did not notice the window was open as you went in?”
+
+“The curtains were drawn, sir. I glanced at that when I went into the
+room with my father. After being shot at once from outside, it was
+possible that we might be again; though I own that I did not for a
+moment think that the fellow would return after the hot chase that
+I gave him. I suppose after I went in he looked about and found the
+ladder; it is likely enough that he would have had a file with him in
+case he had any bars to cut through to get into the house, but to my
+mind it is more likely that he knew where to find the ladder without any
+looking for it; it has hung there as long as I can remember.”
+
+“Yes, sir,” the gardener said, “I have worked for the Squire ever since
+he came here, and the ladder was bought a week or two after he took me
+on, and the Squire settled where it should be hung, so that it might be
+handy either in case of fire or if wanted for a painting job. This aint
+the first ladder; we got a new one four years ago.”
+
+“It is singular that the man should have known which was the window of
+your father's room.”
+
+“Very singular,” Mark said.
+
+Shortly after the doctor left, and Mark had a long talk with the
+magistrate in the library, and told him his reasons for suspecting that
+the murderer was Arthur Bastow.
+
+“It certainly looks like it,” the magistrate said thoughtfully, after
+he had heard Mark's story, “though of course it is only a case of strong
+suspicion, and not of legal proof. Your father's recognition of the
+voice could have scarcely been accepted as final when he heard but three
+words, still the whole thing hangs together. The fellow was, I should
+say, capable of anything. I don't know that I ever had a prisoner before
+me whose demeanor was so offensive and insolent, and if it can be proved
+that Bastow is in England I should certainly accept your view of the
+case. He would probably have known both where the ladder was to be found
+and which was the window of your father's bedroom.”
+
+“I should certainly think that he would know it, sir. The bedroom was
+the same that my grandfather used to sleep in, and probably during the
+years before we came here young Bastow would have often been over the
+house. The first year or two after we came he was often up here with
+his father, but I know that my father took such an objection to him, his
+manner and language were so offensive, that he would not have me, boy as
+I was--I was only about eleven when he came here--associate with him in
+the smallest degree. But during those two years he may very well have
+noticed where the ladder was.”
+
+“Do you intend to say anything about all this tomorrow at the inquest,
+Mark?”
+
+“I don't think I shall do so,” Mark said moodily. “I am certain of it
+myself, but I don't think any man would convict him without stronger
+evidence than I could give. However, that business in Australia will be
+sufficient to hang him.”
+
+“I think you are right, Mark. Of course, if you do light upon any
+evidence, we can bring this matter up in another court; if not, there
+will be no occasion for you to appear in it at all, but leave it
+altogether for the authorities to prove the Sydney case against him;
+it will only be necessary for the constables who got up the other case
+against him to prove his sentence, and for the reports of the Governor
+of the jail to be read. There will be no getting over that, and he
+will be hung as a matter of course. It will be a terrible thing for his
+unhappy father.”
+
+“I do not think that he is likely to come to know it, sir; the shock of
+the affair yesterday and that of this morning have completely prostrated
+him, and Dr. Holloway, who was up with him before you arrived, thinks
+that there is very little chance of his recovery.”
+
+When the magistrate had left, Mark sent a request to Mrs. Cunningham
+that she would come down for a few minutes. She joined him in the
+drawing room.
+
+“Thank you for coming down,” he said quietly. “I wanted to ask how you
+were, and how Millicent is.”
+
+“She is terribly upset. You see, the Squire was the only father she had
+ever known; and had he been really so he could not have been kinder. It
+is a grievous loss to me also, after ten years of happiness here; but
+I have had but little time to think of my own loss yet, I have been too
+occupied in soothing the poor girl. How are you feeling yourself, Mark?”
+
+“I don't understand myself,” he said. “I don't think that anyone could
+have loved his father better than I have done; but since I broke down
+when I first went to my room I seem to have no inclination to give way
+to sorrow. I feel frozen up; my voice does not sound to me as if it were
+my own; I am able to discuss matters as calmly as if I were speaking of
+a stranger. The one thing that I feel passionately anxious about is to
+set out on the track of the assassin.”
+
+“There is nothing unusual in your state of feeling, Mark. Such a thing
+as this is like a wound in battle; the shock is so great that for a time
+it numbs all pain. I have heard my husband say that a soldier who has
+had his arm carried off by a cannon ball will fall from the shock, and
+when he recovers consciousness will be ignorant where he has been hit.
+It is so with you; probably the sense of pain and loss will increase
+every day as you take it in more and more. As for what you say about the
+murderer, it will undoubtedly be a good thing for you to have something
+to employ your thoughts and engage all your faculties as soon as this is
+all over. Is there anything that I can do?”
+
+“No, thank you; the inquest will be held tomorrow. I have sent down to
+Chatterton to come up this afternoon to make the necessary preparations
+for the funeral. Let me see, today is Wednesday, is it not? I seem to
+have lost all account of the time.”
+
+“Yes, Wednesday.”
+
+“Then I suppose the funeral will be on Monday or Tuesday. If there is
+any message that you want sent down to the town, one of the grooms will
+carry it whenever you wish.”
+
+“Thank you; 'tis not worth sending particularly, any time will do, but
+I shall want to send a note to Mrs. Wilson presently, asking her to come
+up the first thing tomorrow morning.”
+
+“He can take it whenever, you like, Mrs. Cunningham. I have nothing
+to send down for, as far as I know. I suppose you have heard that the
+doctor thinks very badly of Mr. Bastow?”
+
+“Yes. Ramoo is sitting with him now.”
+
+“Then I think, if you will write your note at once, Mrs. Cunningham, I
+will send one down to Dr. Holloway, asking him to send an experienced
+nurse. He said he should call again this afternoon, but the sooner a
+nurse comes the better.”
+
+That afternoon Mark wrote a letter to the family solicitors, telling
+them of what had taken place, and stating that the funeral would be on
+the following Tuesday, and asking them to send down a clerk with his
+father's will, or if one of the partners could manage to come down,
+he should greatly prefer it, in view of the explanations that would be
+necessary. He had already sent off a letter to the head of the Detective
+Department, asking him to send down one of his best men as soon as
+possible. Then he went out into the garden, and walked backwards and
+forwards for about two hours, and then returned to what he thought
+would be a solitary meal. Mrs. Cunningham, however, came down. She had
+thoughtfully had the large dining table pushed on one side, and a small
+one placed near the fire.
+
+“I thought it would be more comfortable,” she said, “as there are only
+our two selves, just to sit here.”
+
+He thanked her with a look. It was a nice little dinner, and Mark, to
+his surprise, ate it with an appetite. Except the cup of tea that he
+had taken in the morning, and a glass of wine at midday, he had touched
+nothing. Mrs. Cunningham was a woman of great tact, and by making him
+talk of the steps that he intended to take to hunt down the assassin,
+kept him from thinking.
+
+“Thank you very much, Mrs. Cunningham,” he said, when the dinner was
+over. “I feel very much better.”
+
+“I have brought down my work,” she said, “and will sit here while you
+drink your wine and smoke a pipe. Millicent has gone to bed, completely
+worn out, and it will be pleasanter for us both to sit here than to be
+alone.”
+
+Mark gladly agreed to the proposal. She turned the conversation now to
+India, and talked of her life there.
+
+“I was not out there very long,” she said. “I was engaged to my husband
+when he first went out, and six years afterwards joined him there, and
+we were married. Your uncle, who was a major of his regiment, gave me
+away. My husband got his company six months afterwards, and was killed
+three years later. My pension as his widow was not a large one, and
+when your uncle offered me the charge of his daughter I was very glad to
+accept it. He gave some idea of his plans for her. I thought they were
+very foolish, but when I saw that his mind was thoroughly made up I did
+not attempt to dissuade him. He said that when he came home to England
+(and he had no idea when that would be) he should have me here, as head
+of his establishment, and it would be given out that the child was his
+ward. I hoped that he would alter his mind later on, but, as you know,
+he never did.”
+
+“Well, of course, she will have to be told now,” Mark said.
+
+“Do you think so? It seems to me that it were better that she would go
+as she is, at any rate, until she is twenty-one.”
+
+“That would be quite impossible,” Mark said decidedly. “How could I
+assume the position of master here? And even if I could, it would be a
+strange thing indeed for me to be here with a girl the age of my cousin,
+even with you as chaperon. You must see yourself that it would be quite
+impossible.”
+
+“But how could she live here by herself?”
+
+“I don't think she could live here by herself,” Mark said, “especially
+after what has happened. Of course, it has all got to be talked over,
+but my idea is that the place had better be shut up, and that you should
+take, in your own name, a house in London. I suppose she will want
+masters for the harp, and so on. For a time, at any rate, that would be
+the best plan, unless you would prefer some other place to London. We
+have done our best to carry out my uncle's wishes, but circumstances
+have been too strong for us, and it cannot be kept up any longer; but
+there is no reason, if you and she prefer it, why she should not be
+known, until you return here, by her present name. Of course the affair
+will create a great deal of talk down here, but in London no one will
+know that Millicent is an heiress, though it is hardly likely that you
+will make many acquaintances for a time.”
+
+“Have you known it long, Mark? I thought that you were kept in ignorance
+of it.”
+
+“I only heard it yesterday evening, Mrs. Cunningham; after that shot
+through the window my father thought I ought to know all about it, for
+the attempt might be repeated more successfully. He told me all about
+her, and about the treasure.”
+
+“What treasure?” Mrs. Cunningham said. “I don't know what you mean.”
+
+He then told her of the story his uncle had related, and how he had been
+prevented from giving full instructions for its discovery, the only clew
+being a gold coin and the word Masulipatam, and that this treasure had
+been left equally divided between him and Millicent by his will.
+
+“He told me that he should provide for you,” Mrs. Cunningham remarked,
+“when I said that it would be unfair that you should be brought up
+believing yourself the heir. I never heard any more about it, but I am
+glad that it is so.”
+
+“I fancy the chance of its coming to either of us is very small,” Mark
+said; “a coin and a word are not much to go upon. I have not the most
+remote idea what they mean, and whether the treasure is in England or in
+India, Heaven only knows.”
+
+“Possibly, when he made the will, he may have told the solicitors
+where it was, and instructed them to keep it secret until the time that
+Millicent came into possession of the estate.”
+
+“It is just possible he did so, Mrs. Cunningham, but the efforts he made
+to speak at the last moment would almost seem to show that he had
+not told them, for, if he had, the matter would have been of no vital
+importance one way or the other. Will Millicent be well enough to come
+down in the morning?”
+
+“I hope so.”
+
+“I hope so, too; but, at any rate, keep her up in her room till the
+afternoon. The inquest will be at eleven o'clock, and it is better that
+she should not come down until everyone has gone away.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX.
+
+
+Directly after breakfast was over the next morning the Rector came in.
+
+“I would not come in yesterday, Mark,” he said. “I knew that you would
+be best alone; and, indeed, I was myself so terribly upset by the news
+that I did not feel equal to it. I need not say how deeply I and my wife
+sympathize with you. Never did a kinder heart beat than your father's;
+never have I seen people so universally grieved as they are in the
+village. I doubt whether a man went to work yesterday, and as for
+the women, had it been a father they had lost they could not be more
+affected.”
+
+“Yes, he will be greatly missed,” Mark said unsteadily; “and, between
+ourselves--but this must go no further--I have a suspicion, amounting
+almost to a certainty, that the hand that dealt this blow is the same
+that caused the vacancy that brought you here.”
+
+“Do you mean Arthur Bastow?” Mr. Greg said in amazement. “Why, I thought
+that he was transported for fifteen years.”
+
+Then Mark told the Rector the inner history of the past six months,
+and of the report they had had from the officer at Bow Street of the
+personal appearance of the wounded man.
+
+“Other things are in favor of it,” he went on. “My father's watch and
+purse were untouched, and a stranger on a dark night would be hardly
+likely to have discovered the ladder, or to have had a file in his
+pocket with which to cut through a link, though this might have been
+part of the apparatus of any burglar. Then, again, an ordinary man would
+hardly have known which was my father's bedroom, except, indeed, that he
+saw the light there after those in the ladies' rooms were extinguished;
+but, at any rate, he could not have told which was my father's and which
+was mine. But all this is, as I said, Mr. Greg, quite between ourselves.
+I had a long talk yesterday with Sir Charles Harris, and, as he said,
+there is no legal proof whatever, strong as the suspicion is; so I am
+going to say nothing on the subject at the inquest. The scoundrel's poor
+father is dying, happily in ignorance of all this. Dr. Holloway was up
+with him all night, and told me this morning before he drove off that it
+is very unlikely that he will get through the day.”
+
+“It is all very terrible, Mark; but I cannot deny that everything points
+to the man. Surely no one else could have cut short so useful a life,
+for certainly no ordinary degree of hatred would drive a man, however
+brutal his nature, to commit such a crime, and to run the risk of
+hanging for it. Let us take a brisk walk in the garden for an hour--that
+will be the best thing for you. I will stop with you until the inquest
+is over, and then you had better come over and have lunch with us.”
+
+“Thank you; I cannot do so,” Mark said, “though I should like to. In the
+first place, Millicent will come downstairs this afternoon, and I should
+like to be in to meet her. Had it not been for that I might have come,
+as I can walk across the fields to the Rectory without passing through
+the village. There is another reason. I sent up yesterday by the coach
+a letter to be delivered at once by hand, and I expect a detective down
+here by one o'clock. I don't know that he will do any good; but at
+the same time it will give me something to do, and at present there is
+nothing I dread so much as sitting alone. Fortunately, yesterday evening
+Millicent went to bed at five o'clock, and Mrs. Cunningham sat with me
+all the evening, and her talk did me a great deal of good.”
+
+The inquest occupied a very short time, the only point on which many
+questions were asked being as to the firing through the window. Mark
+stated that it was already so dark that although he was within fifty
+yards of the man when he mounted and rode off, he could not give any
+very distinct description of his figure. It struck him as being that of
+a man of medium height.
+
+“You have made out that the bullet was intended for your father?”
+
+“I cannot say that, sir, it went between his head and that of Mr.
+Bastow, but it might have been meant for either.”
+
+“Was your father impressed with the idea that it was an attempt to
+murder him?”
+
+“He naturally thought so. Mr. Bastow can assuredly have no enemies,
+while my father, as a magistrate, may have made some. He certainly
+thought it was an attempt to murder him, and was so impressed by the
+fact that when we went to the library later on he went into certain
+family matters with me that he had never communicated before, and which,
+had it not been for this, he would not have entered into for some years
+to come.”
+
+“He had his opinion, then, as to who was his assailant?”
+
+“He had, sir, but as it was but an opinion, although there were
+several facts that seemed to justify the conviction, there was no proof
+whatever, and therefore I do not think myself justified in saying what
+that opinion was.”
+
+“Do you entertain the same opinion yourself?”
+
+“I do,” Mark said emphatically; “but until I can obtain some evidence in
+support of what is really but a matter of opinion, and because, were I
+to give the name, it would lessen my chance of obtaining such evidence,
+I decline to mention the name.”
+
+“You have no doubt that the author of the second attempt is the same as
+that of the first?”
+
+“Personally, I have no doubt whatever; it stands to reason that it is
+barely possible that two men could have, unknown to each other, made up
+their minds to murder my father on the same evening.”
+
+The constable's evidence added nothing to that given by Mark. He had
+been down to the lane where the man pursued had mounted. The reins of
+the horse had apparently been thrown over a gatepost, and he thought it
+had been standing there for some little time, for there were marks where
+it had scraped the ground repeatedly. He had followed the marks of its
+hoofs for some distance; it had gone at a gallop for about half a mile,
+and then the pace had slackened into a trot. It continued until the
+lane fell into the main road, but beyond this he had been unable to
+distinguish it from the marks of the traffic in general.
+
+“You found no footprints whatever near the foot of the ladder, or
+anywhere else round the house?”
+
+“None whatever, sir.”
+
+“There were no signs of any other window or door save that of Mr.
+Thorndyke's room being attempted?”
+
+“None at all, sir.”
+
+There was but a short consultation between the jurors, who at once
+returned a verdict of “Willful murder by some person or persons
+unknown.”
+
+Dr. Holloway had, after giving evidence, returned at once to Mr.
+Bastow's room. The only point of importance in his evidence was the
+statement that the wound must have been fatal at once, the heart itself
+having been penetrated. It had been inflicted by a dagger or a narrow
+bladed knife.
+
+“Do you mean that it was an unusually small dagger, Dr. Holloway?”
+
+“I should say it was a very fine dagger; not the sort of weapon that you
+would expect to find a highwayman carry, if he carried one at all, but
+rather a weapon of Spanish or Italian manufacture.”
+
+“Not the sort of wound that a rapier would make?”
+
+“Yes, the wound itself might have been very well made by a light rapier,
+but there was a slight bruise on the flesh on each side of the wound,
+such a mark as might be made by the handle or guard of a dagger, and
+sufficiently plain to leave no doubt in my mind that it was so made.”
+
+“Had the wound a downward course, or was it a straight thrust?”
+
+“A straight thrust,” the doctor replied. “My idea is that the two men
+were grappling together, and that as Mr. Thorndyke was a very powerful
+man, his assailant, who probably was approaching the bed with the
+dagger in his hand, plunged it into him; had he struck at him I should
+certainly have expected the course of the wound to be downward, as I
+fancy a man very seldom thrusts straight with a dagger, as he would do
+with a rapier.”
+
+When the inquest was over, Mark, going out into the hall, found the
+doctor waiting there for him.
+
+“Mr. Bastow breathed his last some ten minutes ago. I saw when I went up
+to him just before I gave my evidence that it was likely that he would
+die before I returned to the room.”
+
+“I am very sorry,” Mark said, “although I expected nothing else from
+what you told me: He was a very kind hearted man; no one could have
+had a kinder or more patient tutor than he was to me, while my father
+regarded him as a very dear and valued friend. I am expecting the
+undertaker here in a few minutes, and they can both be buried at the
+same time.”
+
+It was late in the afternoon before Millicent came down with Mrs.
+Cunningham. The news of Mr. Bastow's death had set her tears flowing
+afresh; she had been very fond of him, and that he and the Squire should
+have been taken at once seemed almost beyond belief. She had, however,
+nerved herself to some degree of composure before she went down to meet
+Mark; but although she returned the pressure of his hand, she was unable
+for some time to speak. Mrs. Cunningham thought it best to speak first
+on the minor grief.
+
+“So Mr. Bastow has gone, Mark?”
+
+“Yes, Dr. Holloway thought very badly of him yesterday, and said that he
+had but very faint hope of his rallying. I cannot help thinking that it
+was best so. Of course, he was not a very old man, but he has for some
+years been a very feeble one, and now that Millicent and I have both
+given up our studies with him, I think that he would have felt that his
+work was done, and would have gone downhill very fast.”
+
+“I think so, too,” Mrs. Cunningham agreed. “I am sure that even had the
+Squire's death come quietly, in the course of nature, it would have
+been a terrible blow to him. He was fond of you and Millicent, but his
+affection for your father was a passion; his face always lit up when he
+spoke to him. I used to think sometimes that it was like an old dog with
+his master. It was quite touching to see them together. I think, Mark,
+with you, that it is best that it should be as it is.”
+
+Gradually the conversation turned to other matters. Millicent was,
+however, unable to take any part in it, and half an hour later she held
+out her hand silently to Mark and left the room hurriedly. The next day
+she was better, and was able to walk for a time with Mark in the garden
+and talk more calmly about their mutual loss, for to her, no less than
+to Mark, the Squire had been a father.
+
+“'Tis strange to think that you are the Squire now, Mark,” she said as
+they sat together in the dining room on the evening before the funeral.
+
+“You will think it stranger still, Millicent,” he said, “when I tell you
+that I am not the Squire, and never shall be.”
+
+She looked up in his face with wonder.
+
+“What do you mean, Mark?”
+
+“Well, dear, you will know tomorrow, as Mr. Prendergast, one of the
+family solicitors, is coming down; but I think it is as well to tell you
+beforehand. It has been a curious position all along. I never knew it
+myself till my father told me when we went into the library after
+the shot was fired. The news did not affect me one way or the other,
+although it surprised me a great deal. Like yourself, I have always
+supposed that you were my father's ward, the daughter of an old comrade
+of his brother's. Well, it is a curious story, Millicent. But there is
+no occasion for you to look frightened. The fact is you are my uncle's
+daughter and my cousin.”
+
+“Oh, that is not very dreadful!” she exclaimed in a tone of relief.
+
+“Not dreadful at all,” Mark said. “But you see it involves the fact that
+you are mistress of this estate, and not I.”
+
+Millicent stood up suddenly with a little cry. “No, no, Mark, it cannot
+be! It would be dreadful, and I won't have it. Nothing could make me
+have it. What, to take the estate away from you when you have all along
+supposed it to be yours! How could I?”
+
+“But you see it never has been mine, my dear. Father might have lived
+another five-and-twenty years, and God knows I have never looked forward
+to succeeding him. Sit down and let me tell you the story. It was not my
+father's fault that he reigned here so long as master, it was the result
+of a whim of your father's. And although my father fought against it, he
+could not resist the dying prayer of my uncle.”
+
+He then related the whole circumstances under which the girl had been
+brought up as Millicent Conyers, instead of Millicent Conyers Thorndyke,
+and how the estate had been left by Colonel Thorndyke's will to his
+brother until such time as Millicent should come of age, or marry,
+and how he had ordered that when that event took place the rest of his
+property in money and jewels was to be divided equally between Mark and
+herself.
+
+“It must not be, Mark,” she said firmly. “You must take the estate, and
+we can divide the rest between us. What is the rest?”
+
+“To begin with,” Mark said cheerfully, “there are 25,000 pounds,
+the accumulations of the rents of the estate after the death of my
+grandfather up to the time when the Colonel returned from India; and
+there are, besides, a few thousands, though I don't exactly know how
+many, that my father paid over to the solicitors as the surplus of the
+rents of the estates after paying all expenses of keeping up this house.
+He very properly considered that although he had accepted the situation
+at your father's earnest wish, he ought not to make money by doing so.
+If we put it down at 30,000 pounds altogether, you see there is 15,000
+pounds for each of us. A very nice sum for a young man to start life
+with, especially as I shall have my father's estate near Hastings,
+which brings in 500 pounds a year; and as the rents of this have been
+accumulating for the last ten years, my share will be raised from 15,000
+pounds to 20,000 pounds. Besides this, there is the main bulk of the
+Colonel's fortune made in India. That seems to be worth about 100,000
+pounds but I must own that the chance of getting it seems very small.”
+
+“How is that, Mark?”
+
+Mark told her the whole story.
+
+“I mean to make it my business to follow the matter up,” he said. “I
+think that the chance of ever finding it is very small. Still, it will
+give me an object to begin life with.”
+
+“Oh, I hope that you will never find it!” she exclaimed. “From what you
+say it will be a terrible danger if you do get it.”
+
+Mark smiled.
+
+“I hardly think so, Millicent. I cannot believe that people would be
+following up this thing for over fifteen years, for it was many years
+before the Colonel came home that he got possession of these diamonds.
+Even Hindoos would, I think, have got sick of such a hopeless affair
+long before this; but as they may ever since your father's death have
+been watching us, although it hardly seems possible, I shall follow out
+the Colonel's instructions, and get rid of those particular diamonds
+at once. I shall only keep them about me long enough to take them to
+Amsterdam and sell them there. The Colonel said they were the finest
+diamonds that he ever saw, and that he really had no idea of what they
+were worth. However, that is for the future.”
+
+“Mrs. Cunningham has known this all along, Mark?”
+
+“Not about the money affairs, but of course she knew that you were my
+cousin. She brought you from India, you see, and has known all
+along that the Colonel was your father. She knows it, and the family
+solicitors know it, but I believe no one else, except, perhaps, Ramoo. I
+am not sure whether he was in uncle's service when you were sent over in
+Mrs. Cunningham's charge. He may know it or he may not, but certainly
+no one else does, except, as I say, the solicitors and myself. Possibly
+some other of the Colonel's old comrades knew that there was a child
+born; but if they were in England and happened to hear that my father
+had succeeded to the estate, they would, of course, suppose that the
+child had died.”
+
+“Then,” Millicent said, in a tone of relief, “there can be no reason why
+anyone else should know anything about it. I will see Mr. Prendergast
+when he comes down tomorrow, and beg him to say nothing about it;
+15,000 pounds is quite enough for any girl; and besides, you say that my
+father's greatest wish was that I was not to be married for money, and
+after all the pains that have been taken, his wish will not be carried
+out if I am to be made owner of the estate.”
+
+“You won't be able to persuade Mr. Prendergast to do that,” Mark said,
+smiling. “It is his duty simply to carry out the provisions of your
+father's will, and to place you in possession of the estate; and if he
+would keep silence, which he certainly won't, you don't suppose that I
+would.”
+
+“Then I shall hate you, Mark.”
+
+“I don't think you will, Millicent, and I would rather that you did that
+than that you should despise me. At the present moment you may think
+that this estate would be only a burden to you, but some day when you
+marry you might see the matter in a different light.”
+
+The girl looked at him reproachfully.
+
+“I should never think so!” she burst out. “What would you have me do?
+Live here in this great house, with only Mrs. Cunningham, while you are
+going about the world seeking for this treasure? Never!”
+
+“No, I don't think that it would be nice for you to do that, Millicent,”
+ Mark said. “Mrs. Cunningham and I have been talking it over. We thought
+that the best plan would be for her to take a house in London, and go
+there with you; you would have the advantages of good masters.
+
+“Then you were saying only a short time since that you would like to
+learn the harp and take lessons in painting. There would be time enough
+to think about what you would do with respect to this house afterward.”
+
+“It is all horrible,” Millicent said, bursting into tears, “and I shall
+always feel that I have robbed you.”
+
+“But I don't feel so in the least,” Mark urged. “I was not in the
+smallest degree put out when my father told me about it. I have always
+had a fancy for wandering about the world, as my uncle did, and doing
+something to distinguish myself, instead of settling down for life to be
+a country magistrate and a squire. Of course it came as a surprise, but
+I can assure you that it was not an altogether unpleasant one. What
+can a man want more than a nice little estate of 500 pounds a year and
+20,000 pounds in money?”
+
+“It is all very well to say that, but as you said to me just now, you
+may see it in a different light some day.”
+
+Then she sat thinking for some time. “At any rate,” she went on at last,
+“I don't see why anyone should know about it now. If the house is to be
+shut up and you are going away, why need anyone know anything about it?
+My father's wish was that I should not have people making love to me
+just because I was an heiress; after all that has been done, it would be
+wicked to go against his wishes. I suppose the interest of this 15,000
+pounds would be enough for Mrs. Cunningham and I to live comfortably on
+in London?”
+
+“Yes,” Mark said; “it will, at 5 per cent, bring in 750 pounds a year.”
+
+“Then I shall remain Millicent Conyers to the world. There is nothing to
+prevent that, is there?” she said almost defiantly.
+
+“No,” he replied thoughtfully. “The rents of this estate might
+accumulate. I suppose the solicitors would see after that; and as I
+shall be away it will, of course, make no difference to me. Were I to
+stay in the neighborhood I could not consent to live as my father did,
+in a false position; but even then I might give out that the property
+had only been left to my father during his lifetime, and that it had now
+gone elsewhere, without saying whom it had gone to. However, as I shall
+be away there will be no occasion even for that. When the will is read
+there will be no one present but ourselves, and I don't see why its
+contents should not be kept a secret for a time; at any rate, we can ask
+Mr. Prendergast's opinion upon that subject.”
+
+At this moment, Mrs. Cunningham coming into the room, Millicent ran to
+her and threw her arms round her neck.
+
+“He has made me most miserable,” she said. “I thought I could not have
+been more miserable than I was before he told me all about it.”
+
+“I knew that he was going to do so, and I was quite sure that you would
+not be pleased at the news. I have all along thought that it was a
+mistake on the part of your father; but as it was his decision, and not
+mine, I only had to carry out his wishes.”
+
+“It is cruel,” Millicent sobbed. “I don't mean it is cruel of my father;
+of course he could not have known, and he thought he was doing the best
+thing for my happiness, but it has all turned out wrong.”
+
+“For the present you may think so, dear; but you must remember that up
+to the present time it has turned out well. I know that your uncle did
+not like it at first, but I think that he passed ten happy years here.
+It gave him a great power for doing good, and he worthily availed
+himself of it. We have all spent a happy time; he was universally liked
+and respected. I think all of us have benefited by it. It would not have
+been half as pleasant if it had been known that you, my child, were the
+real owner of the estate, and he was acting merely as your guardian.
+Let us hope that everything will turn out as well in future. Colonel
+Thorndyke told me that he had left a considerable sum in addition to the
+estates, and that this was to be divided between you and Mark; so you
+see your cousin will not go out into the world a beggar.”
+
+“It is most of it lost,” Millicent said with an hysterical laugh. “It
+is all hidden away, and no one can find it; everything has gone wrong
+together.”
+
+“Well, I think, dear, that you had better go up to bed. I will go
+with you. At the present time this, of course, has come upon you as an
+additional shock. I would gladly have shielded you from it for a time if
+I could have done so, but you must have learned it tomorrow, and I quite
+agree with Mark that is was better that he should tell you this evening.
+I sent down to the town today to the doctor's and asked him to send me
+up a soothing draught, thinking that you might be upset by the news. I
+hope by the morning you will be able to look at matters more calmly.”
+
+Some time later Mrs. Cunningham came down again.
+
+“She has cried herself to sleep,” she said. “She is much grieved about
+this money being lost.”
+
+“It is annoying; still I cannot help thinking that the Colonel must have
+taken some such precaution to prevent the treasure from being lost.”
+
+“One would certainly think so,” Mrs. Cunningham agreed; “the Colonel
+seemed to me a methodical man. I know that he had the reputation of
+being one of the most particular men in the service as to all petty
+details. His instructions to me before I left him were all very minute,
+and he gave me a sealed packet which he told me contained instructions
+and a copy of the register of his marriage and of Millicent's birth, and
+he said that in case of his death I was to take it to your father. He
+said that there was a letter inclosed in it to him, and also a copy
+of his will. The letter was directed to your father, and not to me.
+I handed it over to him when he asked me to come here. He told me
+afterwards that the letter contained the request that his brother lived
+to make personally to him--that the child should be brought up as his
+ward; and that he had handed the certificates to a lawyer, who had,
+however, received copies of them from the Colonel himself before he went
+down to see your father. So, as he took these precautions to insure
+his wishes being carried out in the event of his sudden death, I should
+think that he must have done something of the sort with regard to this
+treasure.”
+
+“I should think that extremely likely, Mrs. Cunningham. I certainly had
+not thought of that before, and I hope that for Millicent's sake and my
+own it may turn out to be so. I can get on extremely well without
+it, but at the same time I don't pretend that 50,000 pounds are to be
+despised.”
+
+The next morning Mr. Prendergast, who had arrived at Reigate late the
+evening before, and had put up at an inn, came up to the house an hour
+before the time named for the funeral. He learned from Mark that he had
+already acquainted Millicent with her change of circumstances. A few
+minutes after he arrived, a servant told him that Miss Conyers would be
+glad if he would see her alone for a few minutes in the drawing room.
+Mark had already prepared him for her request.
+
+“Mark has told you that he told me about this hateful thing last night,
+I suppose, Mr. Prendergast?”
+
+“He has,” the old lawyer said kindly; “and he tells me also that you are
+not at all pleased at the news.”
+
+“Pleased! I should think not, Mr. Prendergast,” she said indignantly. “I
+am not going to rob my cousin of what he has always been taught to think
+as his inheritance. It is abominable, I call it, and most unnatural.”
+
+“But, my dear young lady, it is yours, and not his. I do not wish to
+discuss whether the arrangement was altogether a wise one, but I think
+that so far it has turned out well for all parties. Your estate has
+profited greatly by the management of your uncle, the tenants and all
+connected with it have benefited greatly, he himself has had active
+employment afforded him, of which he was fond. Your cousin has,
+I believe, enjoyed the advantages of the position, and has become
+acquainted with the best people in this part of the country, and will
+now obtain the benefit of something like 15,000 pounds--a comfortable
+little sum, especially as he inherits, I believe, his father's property
+in Sussex. You yourself will have obtained what I cannot but consider
+the advantage of having been brought up without knowing that you were an
+heiress, and therefore without being spoiled, which is, in my opinion,
+the case with many young ladies in such a condition; therefore I cannot
+but think that, if unwise in its conception, the matter has so far
+worked out well. I am bound to say that Mr. Mark Thorndyke has been
+speaking to me very handsomely on the subject, and that he appears in no
+way disappointed at finding that you are the heiress of the estate, and
+is really concerned only at your unwillingness to accept the situation.”
+
+“I wanted to know, Mr. Prendergast,” she said, but in a tone that showed
+she was convinced by his manner that her request would be refused, “if
+you could arrange so that things would not be disturbed, and he should
+come into possession as his father's heir in the natural way.”
+
+“But you see he is not his father's heir, Miss Thorndyke. His father
+only had the use, as we call it, of the property until you came of age,
+or marriage; it was not necessary for it to come to you on your coming
+of age, but only, as your father explained to me, in the event of your
+marriage; that is to say, it was not to become public that you were
+entitled to the estate until your marriage. If you married before you
+were twenty-one the property was then to come to you. If you did not
+you were to be informed of the circumstances or not, as Mr. Thorndyke
+might decide was best, but you were not to come into the property until
+you married. Your cousin was also to be informed when you came to the
+age of twenty-one, and as at that time he was to take his half share of
+the remainder of the property, he would then be able to arrange his life
+as he liked. If your uncle died, as unfortunately he has done, before
+you reached the age of twenty-one, you would then be placed in your
+proper position; but your father desired us to say to you that it was
+his wish, that if it could be arranged, your having succeeded to the
+ownership should not be publicly known until you divulged it to your
+husband after marriage. The other portions of the will must be carried
+out. This being only a request, you are at liberty to follow it or not
+as you may choose.”
+
+“Certainly I should choose,” the girl said. “After all this trouble to
+prevent my being run after as an heiress, it would be wicked to upset
+it all and to fly in the face of his wishes by setting up as mistress of
+this estate. Still you understand, Mr. Prendergast, that I don't mean to
+take it.”
+
+The lawyer smiled indulgently. “There is one way in which it might be
+managed,” he said. “Perhaps you can guess what it is?”
+
+A flush of color rose over the girl's face. “Don't say it, I beg of you,
+Mr. Prendergast. Mrs. Cunningham hinted at it this morning, and I told
+her that my own wish entirely agreed with that of my father, and that
+I was determined not to be married for money; and I am quite sure that
+Mark would be as unwilling as I am that the estate should change hands
+in that way. No, Mr. Prendergast, you must find some other way of doing
+it than that. Surely an estate cannot be forced upon anyone who is
+determined not to take it.”
+
+“Well, we must think it over,” Mr. Prendergast said quietly. “And now I
+think that it is time for me to join the others.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X.
+
+
+The funeral of Squire Thorndyke and Mr. Bastow was over, and all
+agreed they had never seen a more affecting spectacle than that at the
+churchyard when the two coffins were brought in. The distance was short,
+and the tenants had requested leave to carry the Squire's bier, while
+that of Mr. Bastow was borne by the villagers who had known and loved
+him. Behind followed all the magistrates and a great number of the
+gentry for miles round; the churchyard was crowded by every man, woman,
+and child in the village, and the women, as well as many of the men,
+wept unrestrainedly as the coffins passed by. Besides these, a large
+number of people from Reigate and the surrounding villages were present,
+attracted rather by the crime that had caused the death than by the
+loss of the Squire himself. The church was crowded, and it was with
+difficulty that Mr. Greg read the service. The Squire was laid by
+the side of his father, Mr. Bastow in the spot where many of his
+predecessors had slept before him.
+
+Mark had been greatly affected, not only by his own loss, but by the
+sight of the general grief among those for whom the Squire had done so
+much. Even Mr. Prendergast, who had taken part in many such functions
+over departed clients, was much moved by the scene.
+
+“I have been at many funerals,” he said to Mark as they walked back to
+the Hall, “but I never have been at one that so affected me. No monument
+ever raised, sir, did such credit to him who was laid beneath it as the
+tears of those simple villagers.”
+
+Mark did not reply; his heart was altogether too full to speak. As they
+entered the house he said, “The ladies will have their lunch upstairs,
+Mr. Prendergast; we may as well have ours at once, and then you can call
+them down if there is any business to be done.”
+
+“That will not take long,” the lawyer said. “I have brought down the
+wills of both your uncle the Colonel, and your father, and I think that
+it would be as well for me to read them both. That of your father is
+a very short and simple document, extending, indeed, only over a few
+lines. Your uncle's is longer and more complicated, but as you are well
+aware of the gist of it, it will take us but a short time to get through
+it.”
+
+Mark took his meal in a perfunctory manner. For himself he would have
+eaten nothing, but he made an effort to do so in order to keep his guest
+company. When it was over he said:
+
+“We may as well go into the library at once, and I will send up for the
+ladies. It is as well to lose no time, for I know that you want to catch
+the afternoon coach up to town.”
+
+Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent joined them in a minute or two, the girl
+looking very pale in her deep mourning.
+
+“I am about,” Mr. Prendergast said quietly, “to read the wills of
+Colonel Thorndyke and Mr. John Thorndyke, and I will ask you, if there
+is any phrase that you do not understand, to stop me, and I will explain
+to you its purport.”
+
+The three persons present were acquainted with the main provisions of
+the Colonel's will. It began by stating that, being determined that his
+daughter, Millicent Conyers Thorndyke, should not be married for her
+money, he hereby bequeathed to his brother, John Thorndyke, his estate
+in the parish of Crowswood, to be held by him until his daughter
+Millicent came to the age of twenty-one, or was married; if that
+marriage did not take place until she was over the age of twenty-one, so
+long was it to continue in John Thorndyke's possession, save and except
+that she was, on attaining the age of twenty-one, to receive from it an
+income of 250 pounds a year for her private use and disposal.
+
+“To Jane Cunningham, the widow of the late Captain Charles Cunningham,
+of the 10th Madras Native Infantry, should she remain with my daughter
+until the marriage of the latter, I bequeath an annuity of 150 pounds
+per annum, chargeable on the estate, and to commence at my daughter's
+marriage. All my other property in moneys, investments, jewels, and
+chattels of all sorts, is to be divided in equal portions between my
+daughter, Millicent Conyers Thorndyke, and my nephew, Mark Thorndyke.
+Should, however, my daughter die before marriage, I bequeath the said
+estate in the parish of Crowswood to my brother, John Thorndyke, for his
+life, and after him to his son Mark, and to the latter the whole of
+my other property of all kinds, this to take effect on the death of my
+daughter. Should my brother predecease the marriage or coming of age of
+my daughter, she is at once to come into possession of the said estate
+of Crowswood. In which case my nephew Mark and Mr. James Prendergast,
+of the firm of Hopwood & Prendergast, my solicitors, are to act as her
+trustees, and Mrs. Jane Cunningham and the said James Prendergast as her
+guardians.”
+
+All this was, of course, expressed in the usual legal language, but the
+purport was clear to those previously acquainted with its bearing, the
+only item that was new to them being the legacy to Mrs. Cunningham. John
+Thorndyke's testament was a short one. He left all his property to his
+son Mark, with the exception of a hundred pounds to his niece to buy a
+mourning ring or brooch or other ornament in memory of him, and fifty
+pounds to Mrs. Cunningham for a similar purpose, as a token of his
+great esteem for her character, and 200 pounds to Ramoo for his faithful
+services to his brother and himself. When the lawyer had folded up the
+wills Millicent said:
+
+“On my part, I have to say that I absolutely renounce the legacy of the
+estate in favor of my cousin Mark, who has always believed that it would
+be his.”
+
+“And I as absolutely refuse to accept the sacrifice,” Mark said.
+
+“My dear young lady,” Mr. Prendergast said quietly, “at present, at any
+rate, you have no power whatever to take any action in the matter; you
+are, in the eye of the law, an infant, and until you come of age you
+have no power to execute any legal document whatever. Therefore you
+must perforce remain mistress of the estate until you attain the age of
+twenty-one. Many things may happen before that time; for example, you
+might marry, and in that case your husband would have a voice in the
+matter; you might die, in which case Mr. Mark Thorndyke would, without
+any effort on your part, come into possession of the estate. But, at any
+rate, until you reach the age of twenty-one your trustees will collect
+the rents of the estate on your behalf, and will hold the monies in
+trust for you, making, of course, such payments for your support and
+maintenance as are fit and proper for your condition.”
+
+The tears came into Millicent's eyes as she resumed the seat from which
+she had risen, and she did not utter another word until Mr. Prendergast
+rose to leave.
+
+“I shall doubtless learn your wishes as to the future, Miss Thorndyke,
+from your cousin,” he said. “I hope that you will not cherish any
+malice against me, and that when you think it over you will come to the
+conclusion that second thoughts are sometimes the wisest, and also that
+you should have some consideration for your father's wishes in a matter
+of this kind. He worked hard and risked his life to build up the fortune
+that he has left. He evidently thought greatly of your welfare, and was,
+above all things, anxious to insure your happiness. I am sure that on
+thinking it over you will see that you should not thwart his wishes.”
+
+“My dear boy,” he said to Mark, as they stood on the doorstep waiting
+for the carriage to come round, “the best plan by far in this business
+would be for the interests of your cousin and yourself to be identical.
+She is a very charming young lady, a little headstrong in this matter,
+perhaps, but I do not think that that is altogether unnatural.”
+
+“That might have come about if it had not been for the property, Mr.
+Prendergast,” Mark said, “but it cannot be now. If she and I had been
+engaged before all this happened the case would have been different; but
+you see yourself that now my lips are sealed, for it would seem as if I
+had not cared for her until she turned out to be an heiress.”
+
+“You are a silly young couple,” the lawyer said. “I can only hope that
+as you grow older you will grow wiser. Well, you had better come up and
+have a talk with me about the assets your uncle mentions in his will.”
+
+“Then you don't know anything about them, sir?”
+
+“Nothing at all, except as to the accumulations in his absence. He
+mentioned vaguely that he was a wealthy man. I thought that, as a matter
+of course, he had told his brother all about it.”
+
+“It is a curious business, sir, and I doubt if there will ever be
+anything besides the accumulations you speak of.”
+
+“Bless me, you don't say so! Well, well, I always thought that it was
+the most foolish business that I ever heard of. However, you shall tell
+me all about it when you come up. I shall miss my coach unless I start.”
+
+So saying, he shook Mark's hand, took his place in the gig, and was
+driven away. Millicent did not come downstairs again that day.
+
+“She is thoroughly upset,” Mrs. Cunningham said, “and it would be best
+to let her have her own way for a time. I think the sooner I can get
+her away from here the better. The house is full of sad memories, and I
+myself feel shaken and in need of a change.”
+
+“I can quite understand her feeling and yours, Mrs. Cunningham. I do
+hope you will be able to disabuse her mind of the idea that I have any
+shadow of feeling of regret that she instead of I has the estate, and
+please try to work upon her on the ground of her father's wishes. I
+could see that her face changed when Mr. Prendergast put the matter
+in that light, which I do not think had occurred to her before. I am
+thinking of going up to town in a couple of days; I was thinking of
+doing so tomorrow, but a day or so will make no difference. I propose
+that you both go with me, and that I then help you look for a house.
+Even if you don't get one at once, a week in London will be a change,
+and you can then, if you like, go somewhere for a time. Of course Bath
+would be too gay at present; but you might go to Tunbridge Wells, or, if
+she would like a seaside place, as she has never been near the sea since
+she was a baby, that would be the greatest change for her. You might go
+down for a month or two to Dover or Hastings. There is no occasion for
+you to settle down in London for a time. There is Weymouth, too, if you
+would like it better. I believe that that is a cheerful place without
+being too fashionable.”
+
+“I think that will be an excellent plan,” Mrs. Cunningham said.
+
+“If you like I will drive you up to town, and the luggage can go by the
+carrier; it is more pleasant than being shut up in a coach.”
+
+“Much more cheerful, of course.”
+
+“You will, of course, leave many of your things here, and the packing
+them up will give her something to do, and prevent her from brooding.”
+
+“I think that is an excellent idea, Mark.”
+
+Late in the afternoon Ramoo came in in his usual silent manner. The man
+had said but little during the past few days, but it was evident that he
+was grieving deeply, and he looked years older than he had done before
+that fatal night.
+
+“Of course, Ramoo, you will stay with me for the present. I hardly know
+what I shall be doing for a time, but I am sure that until I settle
+down, Miss Conyers will be very glad to have you with her.”
+
+“No, sahib, Ramoo will return home to India. Ramoo is getting old; he
+was thirty when he entered the service of the Colonel, sahib; he is
+fifty now; he will go home to end his days; he has saved enough to live
+in comfort, and with what the lawyer sahib told him your father has left
+him he will be a rich man among his own people.”
+
+“But you will find things changed, Ramoo, since you left; while here,
+you know, we all regard you as a friend rather than as a servant.”
+
+“You are all very kind and good, sahib. Ramoo knows that he will meet no
+friends like those he has here, but he longs for the bright sun and blue
+sky of India, and though it will well nigh break his heart to leave the
+young missie and you, he feels that he must go.”
+
+“All right, Ramoo. We shall all be very sorry to lose you, but I
+understand your longing to go home, and I know that you always feel our
+cold winters very trying; therefore I will not oppose your wishes. I
+shall be going up to town in two or three days, and will arrange to pay
+your legacy at once, and will inquire what vessels are sailing.”
+
+Millicent was unfeignedly sorry when she heard of Ramoo's determination;
+she was very fond of him, for when as a child she first arrived at
+Crowswood he had been her companion whenever the Squire did not require
+his services, and would accompany her about the garden and grounds,
+listening to her prattle, carrying her on his shoulder, and obeying
+her behests. No doubt he knew that she was the daughter of his former
+master, and had to a certain extent transferred his allegiance from the
+sahib, whose life he had several times saved, to his little daughter.
+Still, she agreed with Mark that it was perhaps best that he should go.
+She and Mrs. Cunningham would find but little occasion for his services
+when established in London, and his swarthy complexion and semi-Eastern
+costume would attract attention, and perhaps trouble, when he went
+abroad--the population being less accustomed to Orientals then than at
+present--but still less would they know what to do with him were they
+for a time to wander about. Mark said at once that so long as he himself
+was engaged in the task that he had set himself, he could not take Ramoo
+with him, and as for his staying alone in the house when it was only in
+charge of a caretaker, it was not to be thought of.
+
+Although not inclined at the present time to agree with Mark in
+anything, Millicent could not but acknowledge that it were best that
+Ramoo should not be urged further to reconsider his determination, and
+she also fell in with his proposal that they should go up to London for
+a week, and then go down to Weymouth for a time, after which they would
+be guided by circumstances. Accordingly, two days later, Mark drove
+Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham up to London. A groom accompanied them on
+Mark's favorite horse. This was to be left in town for his use, and
+the groom was to drive the carriage back again. Comfortable rooms were
+obtained in a quiet inn for the ladies, while Mark put up at the Bull,
+saying that he would come every day to take them out.
+
+“Why did not Mark stay here, Mrs. Cunningham?” Millicent asked
+pettishly.
+
+“I suppose he thought it better that he should not do so; and I own that
+I think he was right.”
+
+“When we were, as we supposed, no relation to each other,” Millicent
+said, “we could be like brother and sister. Now that we find that we are
+cousins we are going to be stiff and ceremonious.”
+
+“Not necessarily because you are cousins, Millicent. Before, you were
+his father's ward, and under his father's care; now you are a young lady
+on your own account. You must see that the position is changed greatly,
+and that what was quite right and proper before would not be at all
+right and proper now.”
+
+Millicent shrugged her shoulders.
+
+“Oh, if Mark wishes to be distant and stiff he can certainly do so if he
+likes it. It makes no matter to me.”
+
+“That is not at all fair, Millicent, and very unlike yourself. Had not
+Mark suggested his going to another inn, I should have suggested it
+myself.”
+
+“Oh, yes; no doubt it is better,” Millicent said carelessly. “He has
+several friends in town, and of course we cannot expect him to be
+devoting himself to us.”
+
+Mrs. Cunningham raised her eyebrows slightly, but made no answer.
+Millicent was seldom wayward, but at present things had gone very hardly
+with her, and her friend felt that it would be better to leave her
+entirely to herself until her humor changed. In the morning, when Mark
+came round, Millicent announced that she felt tired with the drive of
+the previous day, and would prefer staying indoors. Mark looked a little
+surprised, more at the tone than at the substance of the words, for the
+manner in which she spoke showed that the excuse she had given was not
+her only reason for not going out.
+
+“Of course, I shall stay at home too,” Mrs. Cunningham said quietly, as
+he glanced toward her inquiringly. “Millicent is unnerved and shaken,
+and perhaps it is just as well for her to have a day's complete rest.”
+
+“Very well, Mrs. Cunningham; then I will, as I cannot be of any use to
+you, set about my own business for the day. I have already been round
+to the lawyer's, and have got a check for Ramoo's legacy. He will be up
+this afternoon, and I will go round to Leadenhall Street and find out
+what ships are sailing and when they start. I will come in this evening
+for a chat.”
+
+Millicent sat without speaking for some minutes after he had left the
+room. Mrs. Cunningham, whose hands were always busy, took some work out
+of a bag and set to work at it industriously. Presently the girl said:
+
+“What business is this that Mark is going to occupy himself in?”
+
+“I do not know much about it,” she replied. “But from a few words which
+he let drop I believe that he intends to devote himself to discovering
+and hunting down your uncle's murderer.”
+
+The listless expression faded out at once of Millicent's face.
+
+“But surely, Mrs. Cunningham, that will be very dangerous work.”
+
+“No doubt it will be dangerous work, but I don't think that that is
+likely to hinder Mark. The man, whoever he may be, is of course a
+desperate character, and not likely to be captured without making a
+fierce struggle for it.”
+
+“Then he ought to put the matter in the hands of the proper
+authorities,” Millicent said decidedly. “Of course such men are
+dangerous. Very likely, this man may have accomplices, and it is not
+against one only that Mark will have to fight. He has no right to risk
+his life in so desperate an adventure.”
+
+Mrs. Cunningham smiled quietly over her work. The Squire had often
+confided to her how glad he would be if these two should some day come
+together. In that case the disclosure after marriage of the real facts
+of the case would cause no disturbance or difficulty. The estate
+would be theirs, and it would not matter which had brought it into the
+partnership; she had thoroughly agreed with him, but so far nothing had
+occurred to give any ground for the belief that their hopes would be
+fulfilled.
+
+Till within the last year Millicent had been little more than a child;
+she had looked up to Mark as she might have done to a big brother, as
+something most admirable, as one whose dictum was law. During the last
+year there had been some slight change, but more, perhaps, on Mark's
+part than on hers. He had consulted her wishes more, had asked instead
+of ordered, and had begun to treat her as if conscious that she was fast
+growing up into womanhood.
+
+Millicent herself scarcely seemed to have noticed this change. She was
+little more inclined to assert herself than before, but was ready to
+accompany him whenever he wished her to do so, or to see him go away
+without complaint, when it so pleased him; but the last week had made a
+rapid change in their position. Millicent had sprung almost at a bound
+into a young woman. She had come to think and resolve for herself; she
+was becoming wayward and fanciful; she no longer deferred to Mark's
+opinion, but held her own, and was capable of being vexed at his
+decisions. At any rate, her relations with Mark had changed rapidly, and
+Mrs. Cunningham considered this little outburst of pettishness to be a
+good omen for her hopes, and very much better than if they had continued
+on their old footing of affectionate cousins.
+
+Mark went back again to the lawyer's, and had a long talk with Mr.
+Prendergast over the lost treasure. The old lawyer scoffed at the idea
+that there could be any danger associated with the bracelet.
+
+“Men in India, I suppose, get fanciful,” he said, “and imbibe some of
+the native superstitions. The soldier who got them from the man who
+stole them was stabbed. He might have been stabbed for a thousand
+reasons, but he had the bracelet on his mind. He was forever hiding it
+and digging it up, and fancying that someone was on his track, and he
+put down the attack as being made by someone connected with it. His
+manner impressed your uncle. He concealed the diamonds or sent them off
+somewhere, instantly. He never had any further trouble about them, but
+like many men who have a craze, fancied that he was being perpetually
+watched and followed. The unfortunate result of all this is that these
+jewels and the money that he accumulated during his service in India
+seem to be lost. A more stupid affair I never heard of.
+
+“Now, as to the clew, any reasonable man would have given full
+instructions as to how the treasure was to be found; or if he did not
+do that, would, at least, instead of carrying about an absurd coin and
+a scrap of paper with a name upon it, have written his instructions and
+put them in that ridiculous hiding place, or, more wisely still, would
+have instructed his solicitor fully on the subject. The amount of
+trouble given by men, otherwise perfectly sane, by cranks and fancies
+is astonishing. Here is something like 100,000 pounds lost owing to a
+superstitious whim. As to your chance of finding the treasure, I regard
+it as small indeed. The things are hidden in India, in some old tomb, or
+other rubbishing place. Your uncle may have committed them to the charge
+of a native; he may have sent them to a banker at one of the great
+towns; he may have shipped them to England. He may have sent them to
+the North Pole for anything I know. How can one begin to search the
+universe?”
+
+“I thought, sir, that perhaps he might have sent them to some London
+Bank or agent, with instructions to hold them until claimed by him, and
+that perhaps an inquiry among such houses would lead to the discovery
+that they hold certain property forwarded by him.”
+
+“Well; there is some sense in that suggestion,” Prendergast grumbled,
+“and I suppose the first thing to be done will be to carry that out. If
+you wish, we will do it for you. They would be more likely to give the
+information, if they possess it, to a well known firm of solicitors like
+ourselves than to any private individual. Besides, if you were to go
+yourself, they would in each case want you to be identified before they
+would answer any question, whereas I should write a note to them in the
+firm's name, with our compliments, saying that we should be glad to know
+if the late Colonel Thorndyke, of whose will we are the executors, had
+any account at their firm or has deposited any property in their hands.
+There are not above five or six banks doing business with India, and
+as many agents in a large way of business; and if he did such a
+foolish thing, he would be certain to do it with some houses of good
+standing--if, indeed, anything can be taken as certain in the case of a
+gentleman with such extraordinary fancies and plans as his.”
+
+“Thank you, Mr. Prendergast,” Mark said, with a slight smile at the
+lawyer's irritability; “that will be clearing the ground to a certain
+extent. If that does not succeed, I think I shall go to India
+myself, and shall there make similar inquiries at all the principal
+establishments at Calcutta and Madras. Should I fail there, it seems to
+me that the only remaining plan will be to find out from the military
+authorities the place where my uncle's regiment was encamped on the
+day--we have the date on which the jewels were given to him--and to
+institute a minute search of all the old ruins within such a distance as
+he might have reached within a day's ride.”
+
+“But you have no certainty that it was a ruin. He might have dug a hole
+under his tent and have buried the things there; he might have taken a
+shovel and buried them in a clump of bushes a quarter of a mile away.
+The thing is more and more ridiculous the more you look at it.”
+
+“I see it is very difficult, sir, but one might narrow it down somewhat
+if one discovered the spot. Probably there are still native officers in
+the regiment who were there at the time. If so, they might possibly know
+who was my uncle's servant at the time. The man may be a pensioner,
+and in that case I might discover his address through the military
+authorities, and I could find out from him whether my uncle often rode
+out at night, what were his habits, and possibly where the tent stood,
+and so on.”
+
+“Well,” Mr. Prendergast said, “if you like to undertake a wild goose
+chase of this sort it is your business, and not mine; but I consider
+the idea is the most Utopian that I ever heard of. As to where the tent
+stood, is it likely that a man would remember to within a hundred yards
+where a tent stood fourteen years ago? Why, you might dig up acres and
+acres of ground and not be sure then that you had hit upon the right
+place.”
+
+“There is one other circumstance, Mr. Prendergast,” Mark said quietly,
+“that has to be taken into consideration, and which renders it
+improbable that these diamonds were hidden anywhere by my uncle
+himself at that time. He certainly spoke of the whole of this treasure
+collectively. It is morally certain that he would not carry all these
+jewels that he had been collecting about with him, and certainly not his
+treasure in money. He must, therefore, have sent these diamonds to the
+person, whoever he may be, who had the keeping of his other jewels and
+of his money. This certainly points to a bank.”
+
+“There is a sensible conjecture. Yes, there is something in that. He
+certainly could not have carried about him 50,000 pounds in gold and
+as much in jewelry; it would have been the act of a madman, and Colonel
+Thorndyke, although eccentric and cranky, was not mad. But, on the
+other hand, he may have carried about a banker's passbook, or what is
+equivalent to it, for the amount that had been deposited with a native
+banker or agent, together with a receipt for the box containing the
+jewels, and this he might have hidden with the diamonds.”
+
+“I don't think that he would have done that; there could have been no
+object for his putting the power of demanding his money and valuables
+out of his possession.”
+
+“Well, well,” the lawyer said testily, “it is of no use arguing now what
+he might or might not have done. A man who would have taken the trouble
+that he did to prevent his daughter knowing that she was an heiress, and
+fancied that he was followed about by black fellows, might do anything,
+reasonable or unreasonable, under the sun. At any rate, Mr. Thorndyke,
+I will carry out your instructions as to inquiries in London, and will
+duly inform you of the result; beyond that I must really decline to give
+any advice or opinion upon the matter, which is altogether beyond me.”
+
+On leaving the lawyer's, Mark went to Bow Street, and related to the
+chief the circumstances attending his father's murder.
+
+“I have heard them from the man I sent down at your request, Mr.
+Thorndyke, and taking the attempt early in the evening and the
+subsequent murder, there can be no doubt that the affair was one of
+revenge, and not of robbery. Had the second attempt stood alone, robbery
+might have been the object; the mere fact that nothing was stolen in
+no way alters the case. Men are often seized with a certain panic after
+committing a murder, and fly at once without attempting to carry out
+their original purpose. Your father, no doubt, fell heavily, and the man
+might well have feared that the fall would be heard; but the previous
+attempt precludes the supposition that robbery was at the bottom of it.
+It points to a case of revenge, and certainly goes a very long way to
+support the theory that we talked over when I last saw you, that the
+highwayman who endeavored to stop you on the road, whom you wounded,
+and who afterwards went down to Southampton, was the escaped convict,
+Bastow. Since that time I have had a man making inquiries along the
+roads between Reigate and Kingston, but altogether without success. I
+should be glad to follow up any other line that you might suggest, and
+that might offer any reasonable possibility of success, but I must own
+that at present we are entirely off the scent.”
+
+“I am thinking of devoting myself entirely to the quest. I have no
+occupation at present. I have an income amply sufficient for my wants,
+and for all expenses that I may incur, and I intend to devote, if
+necessary, some years of my life to hunting this man down. As your men
+have searched without success in the country, I think for the present my
+best plan will be to devote myself to learning something of the ways
+and haunts of the criminal classes of London, and it is with that object
+that I have come to you now. I should like, for some time, at any rate,
+to enter the detective force as an enrolled member. I should, of course,
+require no pay, but should be prepared to obey all orders and to do any
+work required, as any other member of the corps would do. I am strong,
+active, and have, I hope, a fair share of intelligence. I should not
+mind risking my life in carrying out any duty that you might assign to
+me. I presume that I need not always be on duty, and could, when not
+required, employ my time as I liked, and keep up my acquaintances in
+town. Should it be otherwise, however, I am perfectly ready to submit
+myself in all respects to your rule. I have a first rate horse and
+should be available for country duty, wherever you might think fit to
+send me. I should not desire any distinction to be made between me and
+the paid officers.”
+
+“Your proposal is an altogether novel one, Mr. Thorndyke, but it is
+worthy of consideration. I have no doubt that you would make a very
+useful officer; the work is certainly interesting, though not without
+serious hazards. However, I will think the matter over, and if you will
+call in tomorrow you shall have my answer. We are always glad to have a
+new hand in the force, for the faces of our men are so well known among
+the criminal class that they are liable to be detected even under the
+cleverest disguises. There is work, too, upon which it is absolutely
+necessary that a gentleman should be employed, and in the event of your
+joining us, I should wish you to keep the matter strictly from all your
+acquaintances; and it would certainly be advantageous that you should,
+when disengaged, continue to mix with your friends and to mingle in
+society of all kinds as freely as possible. There is crime among the
+upper classes as well as among the lower, though of a different
+type; and as Mr. Thorndyke of Crowswood you would have far better
+opportunities of investigating some of these cases than any of my men
+would have. You would not object to take up such cases?”
+
+“Not at all, sir; that is, if it could be arranged that I should not
+do the actual work of making an arrest, or have to appear in court as a
+witness.”
+
+“That could be managed,” the chief said “When you have got to a certain
+point the matter of the final arrest could always be handed over to
+someone else, but as a rule we keep our officers in the background as
+much as possible, because at every trial the court is half full of men
+of the criminal class, and the faces of our men would soon be known to
+every one of them. Well, if you will call about ten o'clock tomorrow you
+shall have my answer; but I should advise you to think the matter
+well over before you see me again. The responsibilities as well as the
+dangers are great, and indeed in some of the work you would literally
+have to carry your life in your hand; and I can assure you that the task
+you would undertake is by no means a light one.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI.
+
+
+Mark called that evening, as he had promised, upon Mrs. Cunningham.
+
+“I hope that you feel all the better for your day's rest, Millicent,” he
+said.
+
+The girl looked quickly at him to see if there was any sarcasm in the
+question, but it was evident that the inquiry was made in earnest.
+
+“Yes, I feel better now,” she said. “I have dozed a good deal today.
+I did not feel up to anything. Mrs. Cunningham's work has progressed
+wonderfully. I should say that she has done more today than she
+ordinarily finds time to do in a week. What have you been doing with
+yourself?”
+
+“I have been having a long talk with Mr. Prendergast about the lost
+treasure.”
+
+“And of course he said that you would never find it, Mark?”
+
+“Well, yes, he distinctly expressed that opinion.”
+
+“And afterwards?”
+
+“Afterwards I went to Bow Street and had a long talk also with the chief
+officer there.”
+
+“I don't like the idea of your searching for this man, Mark. In the
+first place, I don't see why you should hope to succeed when the men
+whose business it is to do such work have failed. In the next place, I
+think that you may get into serious danger.”
+
+“That I must risk, Millicent. I have already proved a better shot than
+he is, and I am quite ready to take my chance if I can but come upon
+him; that is the difficult part of the matter. I know that I shall need
+patience, but I have plenty of time before me, and have great hopes that
+I shall run him to earth at last.”
+
+“But you would not know him if you saw him?”
+
+“I think I should,” Mark said quietly; “at least, if he is the man that
+I suspect.”
+
+“Then you do suspect someone?” Mrs. Cunningham said, laying down her
+work.
+
+“Yes, I know of no reason why you should not know it now. I
+suspect--indeed, I feel morally certain--that the man who murdered my
+father was Arthur Bastow.”
+
+An exclamation of surprise broke from both his hearers, and they
+listened with horror while he detailed the various grounds that he had
+for his suspicions. They were silent for some time after he had brought
+his narrative to a conclusion, then Mrs. Cunningham said:
+
+“What a merciful release for Mr. Bastow that he should have died before
+this terrible thing came out! For after what you have told us I can
+hardly doubt that you are right, and that it is this wicked man who is
+guilty.”
+
+“Yes, it was indeed providential,” Mark said, “though I think that,
+feeble as he has been for some months, it might have been kept from him.
+Still, a word from a chance visitor, who did not associate Bastow the
+murderer with our dear old friend, might have enlightened him, and the
+blow would have been a terrible one indeed. It is true that, as it was,
+he died from the shock, but he did not know the hand that struck the
+blow.”
+
+“Now that you have told me this,” Millicent said, “I cannot blame you,
+Mark, for determining to hunt the man down. It seems even worse than it
+did before; it is awful to think that anyone could cherish revenge like
+that. Now tell me how you are going to set about it.”
+
+“I have promised the chief officer that I will tell absolutely no
+one,” he said. “I have a plan, and I believe that in time it must be
+successful. I know well enough that I could tell you both of it without
+any fear of its going further, but he asked me to promise, and I did so
+without reservation; moreover, I think that for some reasons it is as
+well that even you should not know it. As it is, you are aware that I am
+going to try, and that is all. If I were to tell you how, you might be
+picturing all sorts of imaginary dangers and worrying yourself over
+it, so I think that it will be much the best that you should remain in
+ignorance, at any rate for a time. I can say this, that I shall for the
+present remain principally in London, and I think that I am more likely
+to come upon a clew here than elsewhere.”
+
+Millicent pouted, but Mrs. Cunningham said: “I think, perhaps, that you
+are right, Mark, and it is better that we should know nothing about it;
+we shall know that you are looking for a clew, but of course no danger
+can arise until you obtain it and attempt to arrest him. I feel sure
+that you will do nothing rash, especially as if any harm befell you he
+might escape unpunished, and therefore that when the time comes to
+seize him you will obtain such help as may be necessary, and will, if
+possible, arrest him at a moment when resistance is impossible.”
+
+“Thank you, Mrs. Cunningham; I shall certainly spare no efforts in
+taking him that way, and would far rather he met his fate on a gibbet
+than by a bullet from my pistol.”
+
+“I agree with you, Mark,” Millicent said; “even hanging is too good for
+such a wicked man. When are you going to set about it?”
+
+“I hope to be able to begin tomorrow,” he said. “I am impatient to be at
+work, even though I know perfectly well that it may be months before I
+can get on his track. I hope to get a good deal of information as to
+the habits of men of his kind from the Bow Street runners, and I have an
+appointment tomorrow morning to see their chief, who will give me every
+assistance in his power.”
+
+“Then you will not be able to take us out?” Millicent said.
+
+“I trust to do so later on, but I cannot say how long I shall be
+engaged. However, I hope to get away so as to go out with you after
+lunch, and may possibly be able to postpone my getting regularly to work
+until after you have gone, so as to be able to devote myself to your
+service.”
+
+“But what sort of work? I cannot make out how you are going to begin.”
+
+“I can tell you this much, that to begin with I shall go in company with
+a constable to various places where such a man is likely to be found.
+It will take some time to acquaint myself with all these localities; the
+next step will be to find out, if possible, if anyone at all answering
+to his description is in the habit of coming there occasionally, and
+whom he visits; another thing will be to find out the places where
+receivers of stolen goods do their business, and to watch those with
+whom highwaymen are suspected of having dealings. All this, you see,
+will entail a lot of work, and require a very large amount of patience.
+Of course, if nothing whatever comes of such inquiries, I shall have
+to try quiet places in the suburbs; you must remember that this fellow
+during his time as a convict must have had opportunities of getting
+a vast amount of information likely to be useful to him, such as the
+addresses of men holding positions of apparent respectability, and yet
+in alliance with thieves. You may be sure that when he returned he took
+every imaginable pains to obtain a safe place of concealment before
+he began his work; my own opinion is that I am more likely to find him
+living quietly in a suburban cottage than in a London slum.”
+
+Millicent was now thoroughly interested in the search. “It seems a great
+business, Mark, but going into it as thoroughly as you are doing I feel
+sure that you will succeed. I only wish that I could help you; but I
+could not do that, could I?” she asked wistfully.
+
+He saw that she was in earnest, and suppressed all semblance of a smile.
+
+“I am afraid, dear, that you would be a much greater source of
+embarrassment than of assistance to me,” he said gravely. “This is
+essentially not a woman's work. I believe that women are sometimes
+employed in the detection of what we may call domestic crimes, but this
+is a different matter altogether.”
+
+“I suppose so,” she sighed; “but it will be very hard to be taking our
+ease down at Weymouth while we know that you are, day after day, wearing
+yourself out in tramping about making inquiries.”
+
+“It will be no more fatiguing than tramping through the stubble round
+Crowswood after partridges, which I should probably be doing now if I
+were down there. By the way, before you go we shall have to talk over
+the question of shutting up the house. We had too much to think of to
+go into that before we came away, and I suppose I shall have to run down
+and arrange it all, if you have quite made up your mind that you don't
+mean to return for a year or two.”
+
+“Decidedly our present idea is to have a few weeks at Weymouth, and then
+when we feel braced up to come back here and look for a house. Where are
+you likely to be, Mark?” Mrs. Cunningham asked.
+
+“I shall consult with Dick Chetwynd; he knows the town thoroughly, and
+is more up here than he is down in the country; he will recommend me to
+some lodging in a street that, without being the height of fashion, is
+at least passable. I have not the least wish to become a regular man
+about town, but I should like to go into good society. One cannot be at
+work incessantly.”
+
+The next morning the chief of the detective department told Mark that he
+had decided to accept his offer.
+
+“As you will receive no pay,” he said, “I shall regard you as a sort of
+volunteer. For the first two or three months you will spend your time in
+going about with one or other of my men on his work. They will be able
+to put you up to disguises. When you have once learned to know all the
+thieves' quarters and the most notorious receivers of stolen goods,
+you will be able to go about your work on your own account. All that
+I require is that you shall report yourself here twice a day. Should I
+have on hand any business for which you may appear to me particularly
+well suited, I shall request you to at once undertake it, and from time
+to time, when there is a good deal of business on hand, I may get you to
+aid one of my men who may require an assistant in the job on which he is
+engaged.”
+
+“I am sure I am very much obliged to you, sir,” Mark said, “and will,
+I can assure you, do my best in every way to assist your men in any
+business in which they may be engaged.”
+
+“When will you begin?”
+
+“It is Saturday today, sir. I think I will postpone setting to until
+Monday week. My cousin and the lady in whose charge she is came up with
+me on Thursday, and will be leaving town the end of next week, and
+I should wish to escort them about while here. I will come on Monday
+morning ready for work. How had I better be dressed?”
+
+“I should say as a countryman. A convenient character for you to begin
+with will be that of a man who, having got into a poaching fray, and
+hurt a gamekeeper, has made for London as the best hiding place. You
+are quite uncertain about your future movements, but you are thinking of
+enlisting.”
+
+“Very well, sir, I will get the constable at Reigate, who knows me well,
+to send me a suit. I might find it difficult to get all the things I
+want here.”
+
+Accordingly, for the next week Mark devoted himself to the ladies.
+Millicent, in her interest in the work that he was about to undertake,
+had now quite got over her fit of ill temper, and the old cordial
+relations were renewed. On the Friday he saw them into the Weymouth
+coach, then sauntered off to his friend Chetwynd's lodgings.
+
+Ramoo had already sailed. On his arrival in town he had said that he
+should, if possible, arrange to go out as a steward.
+
+“Many men of my color who have come over here with their masters go back
+in that way,” he said, in answer to Mark's remonstrances. “It is much
+more comfortable that way than as a passenger. If you go third class,
+rough fellows laugh and mock; if you go second class, men look as much
+as to say, 'What is that colored fellow doing here? This is no place for
+him.' Much better go as steward; not very hard work; very comfortable;
+plenty to eat; no one laugh or make fun.”
+
+“Well, perhaps it would be best, when one comes to think of it, Ramoo;
+but I would gladly pay your passage in any class you like.”
+
+“Ramoo go his own way, sahib,” he said. “No pay passage money; me go to
+docks where boats are sailing, go on board and see head steward. Head
+steward glad enough to take good servant who is willing to work his
+way out, and ask for no wages. Head steward draw wages for him, and put
+wages in his own pocket. He very well satisfied.”
+
+On Wednesday he came and told Mark that he had arranged to sail in the
+Nabob, and was to go on board early the next morning. He seemed a great
+deal affected, and Mark and Millicent were equally sorry to part with
+the faithful fellow.
+
+“Well, old man,” Dick Chetwynd said, when Mark entered the room, where
+he was still at breakfast, “I was beginning to wonder whether you had
+gone to Reigate. Why, when I saw you last Friday you told me that you
+would look me up in a day or two.”
+
+“I have been busy showing London to Mrs. Cunningham and Miss Conyers,”
+ he replied--for Millicent had insisted on keeping her former name, at
+any rate for the present--and Mark was somewhat glad that there had been
+no necessity for entering into any explanations. It was agreed that
+when he went down to discharge some of the servants and called upon his
+friends he should say nothing of the change in his position, but should
+assign as a motive that he intended to travel about for a long time, and
+that he felt he could not settle down in the lonely house, at any
+rate for two or three years; and therefore intended to diminish the
+establishment.
+
+“You will have some breakfast, Mark?”
+
+“No, thank you. I breakfasted two hours ago.”
+
+“Then you still keep to your intention to stay in London for a while?”
+
+“Yes. I don't feel that I could bear the house alone,” Mark replied. “You
+see, Mrs. Cunningham and my uncle's ward could not very well remain in a
+bachelor's home, and naturally, after what has happened, they would not
+like to do so, even if they could. They have gone down to Weymouth for
+a few weeks for a complete change; and Mrs. Cunningham talks of taking
+a house in town for a time. I am going to look for lodgings, and I want
+your advice as to the quarter likely to suit me.”
+
+“Why not take up your abode here for a time? There is a vacant room, and
+I should be very glad to have you with me.”
+
+“Thank you very much, Dick, but I should prefer being alone. You will
+have friends dropping in to see you, and at present I should be poor
+company. It will be some little time before I shall feel equal to
+society.”
+
+“Of course, Mark. I always speak first and think afterwards, as you know
+pretty well by this time. Well, what sort of lodgings do you want?”
+
+“I want them to be in a good but not in a thoroughly fashionable street.
+In time, no doubt, I shall like a little society, and shall get you to
+introduce me to some of the quieter of your friends, and so gradually
+feel my way.”
+
+“I will do all that sort of thing for you, Mark. As you know, I am not
+one of those who see much fun in gambling or drinking, though one must
+play a little to be in the fashion. Still, I never go heavily into it.
+I risk a few guineas and then leave it. My own inclinations lie rather
+towards sport, and in this I can indulge without being out of the
+fashion. All the tip top people now patronize the ring, and I do so
+in my small way too. I am on good terms with all the principal prize
+fighters, and put on the gloves with one or other of them pretty nearly
+every day. I have taken courses of lessons regularly from four or five
+of them, and I can tell you that I can hold my own with most of the
+Corinthians. It is a grand sport, and I don't know how I should get
+on without it; after the hard exercise I was accustomed to down in the
+country, it keeps one's muscles in splendid order, and I can tell you
+that if one happens to get into a fight in the streets, it is no light
+thing to be able to polish off an antagonist in a round or two without
+getting a mark on your face that would keep you a prisoner in your room
+for a week or more.”
+
+“Yes, I should like very much to take lessons too, Dick; it is one of
+the things that I have always wished to do. I suppose one can do it of
+an evening, or any time you like?”
+
+“Yes, any hour suits those fellows. You ought to get either a heavy
+middleweight or a light heavyweight; you will be a heavyweight yourself
+by the time you have filled out. Let me think; what is your height--six
+feet one, if I remember rightly?”
+
+“Yes, that is about it.”
+
+“Well, with your shoulders and long reach and activity, you ought to be
+something out of the way if you take pains, Mark. You see, I am barely
+five feet ten, and am something like two stone lighter than you are. I
+suppose you are not much under twelve stone and a half.”
+
+“That is just about my weight; I weighed at the miller's only a
+fortnight ago.”
+
+“Good. I will make some inquiries, and see who would be the best man to
+take you in hand to begin with. And now about lodgings. Well, I should
+say Essex Street, or any of those streets running down from the Strand,
+would suit you. The rooms in Essex Street are bigger than those in
+Buckingham Street, and you will find anything between the two in some of
+the others. I may as well saunter round there with you. Of course money
+is no object to you?”
+
+“No,” Mark agreed, “but I don't want big rooms. I think a small one,
+when you are sitting by yourself, is more cozy and comfortable.”
+
+Finally two rooms were taken in Villiers Street; they were of moderate
+size and handsomely furnished: the last tenant had fitted them out for
+himself, but had lived to enjoy them only three months, having at the
+end of that time been killed in a duel over a quarrel at cards.
+
+“Well, I think you are in luck, Mark; you might look through a good many
+streets before you would find rooms so fashionably furnished as these. I
+see he went in for driving; that is evident from these engravings on the
+walls.”
+
+“They are common, gaudy looking things,” Mark said, “and quite out of
+character with the furniture.”
+
+“Not at all, as times go, Mark; it is quite the thing for a man to have
+prints showing his tastes, riding or driving, shooting or coaching, or
+the ring. If you don't like them you can take them down, or, what will
+be better, take them out of their frames and put some of the champions
+past and present up there instead.”
+
+“I will see about it,” Mark said with a laugh. “I may turn out a
+complete failure.”
+
+“There is no fear of that, Mark; and as the ring is all the fashion now,
+I can assure you it would be considered in good taste, though I own that
+in point of art most of these things leave a good deal to be desired.
+Now that that important thing is settled, suppose you come and lunch
+with me in Covent Garden? I don't belong to a club yet, though I have
+got my name down at a couple of them, but as far as I can see they are
+slow sort of places unless you know a lot of people. The coffee houses
+are much more amusing; you see people of all sorts there--fellows like
+myself, who have no clubs to go to; country gentlemen up for a week;
+a few writers, who, by the way, are not the best customers of these
+places; men whom nobody knows, and men whom everybody knows. Of course,
+the best time to see them is of an evening.”
+
+“Yes, I have generally been in of an evening when I have been up in
+towns Dick, and I have always been amused. However, I am quite ready to
+lunch there now, for I breakfasted early.”
+
+“I have to make some calls this afternoon, Mark. At seven this evening
+I will look in at your lodgings, and you shall go along with me to
+Ingleston's in St. Giles'. It is one of the headquarters of the fancy,
+and Jack Needham, who taught me, is safe to be there, and he will tell
+me who he thinks is best for you to begin with.”
+
+Accordingly, after taking luncheon, they separated, and Mark went to his
+inn.
+
+Ingleston's was at that time regarded as the headquarters of the fancy.
+At the back of the house was a large room, with benches rising behind
+each other to accommodate the spectators. Here, on the evenings when it
+was known that leading men would put on the gloves, peers of the realm
+would sit side by side with sporting butchers, and men of fashion back
+their opinion on a coming prize fight with ex-pugilists and publicans. A
+number of men were assembled in the bar; among these was Jack Needham.
+
+“Good evening, Mr. Chetwynd,” the man said as they came up to him. “It's
+going to be a good night. Tring and Bob Pratt are going to have a round
+or two together, and Gibbons will put on the gloves with anyone who
+likes to take him on.”
+
+“This gentleman is Mr. Thorndyke, a squire, Jack, whose place is near
+mine at Reigate. He has come up to town for a few months, and wants to
+learn how to use his mauleys. I told him that you would advise him as to
+who would be the best man for him to go to.”
+
+“I can tell you better when I have seen him strip, sir. There is no one
+in the big room at present. It won't be open for half an hour. Ingleston
+keeps it shut as long as he can so as to give everyone a fair chance of
+a good place. If the gentleman will come in there with me I will have a
+look at him.”
+
+Mark expressed his willingness to be looked at, and the man having gone
+and got the key of the room from Ingleston, went in with them and locked
+the door behind.
+
+“Now, sir, if you will strip to the waist I shall be better able to say
+who you should have as your teacher than I can now.”
+
+Mark stripped, and the man walked round and round him, examining him
+critically.
+
+“He's a big 'un,” he said to Dick when he had completed his examination.
+“He has got plenty of muscle and frame, and ought to be a tremendous
+hitter; he is about the figure of Gibbons, and if he goes in for it
+really, ought to make well nigh as good a man, if not quite. I don't
+think Bill would care about taking him up till he knows a bit about it.
+I tell you what, sir; you will be too big altogether for me by the time
+you get to be quick on your legs, and to use your strength, but if you
+like I will take you on for a month or so--say, two months; by that time
+I think you will be good enough to go to Gibbons. I will just call him
+in if you don't mind; he came in just before you.”
+
+In a couple of minutes he came in with a man of similar height and
+somewhat similar figure to Mark.
+
+“This is Gibbons, sir, ex-champion, and like enough he might be champion
+now if he chose; as fine a boxer as ever stripped, but he is ring maker
+now to the P. C. and it suits him better to do that and to teach, than
+to have a chance of getting a battle once a year or so.”
+
+“Have you a great many pupils, Gibbons?”
+
+The man shook his head.
+
+“I am too big, sir; gentlemen like to learn from someone about their
+own weight, or perhaps a bit lighter, and there are not many of them
+who would care to stand up against a man who has been champion, and so I
+have plenty of time on my hands. I am a hard hitter, too, even with the
+gloves; that is one reason why Jack had best take you on until you get
+a little handy with your fists. I do more in the dog fancier line than
+I do with boxing, but there is nothing I like better than getting the
+gloves on with an amateur who is likely to be a credit to me. That is my
+card, sir; you will find me in pretty nearly any time of the day, and
+I have got a place behind the house where I do teaching when I get
+a chance. It is handy in one way, because you can drop in and take a
+lesson any time you like.”
+
+“That would suit me exceedingly well,” Mark said; “and when I have had a
+couple of months with Needham I will come to you.”
+
+Mark now put on his clothes again, and they went out together, and
+re-entered a few minutes later, when the door was open. The benches were
+soon crowded. Mark had been to several prize fights with Dick Chetwynd,
+had often boxed with him and other lads, and had had lessons from an
+ex-prize fighter at Reigate, and was therefore able to appreciate the
+science shown by the various men who confronted each other. The event of
+the evening was the contest between Tring and Bob Pratt; both were very
+powerful men, who were about to go into strict training for matches that
+had been made for them against two west countrymen, who were thought
+very highly of by their friends, and who were regarded as possible
+candidates for the championship.
+
+Bob Pratt was a stone heavier than his opponent, but far less active,
+and owed his position more to his ability to take punishment, and to
+hard hitting powers, than to his science. In the two rounds that were
+fought, Tring had the advantage, but the general opinion was that in the
+long run the other would wear him down. Both fought with good temper,
+and were warmly applauded as they shook hands at the finish.
+
+“I think I should back Tring in a fight,” Mark said, as the meeting
+broke up, “but it is difficult to say, for he is in better condition
+than the other, and it may be that when both are thoroughly fit the
+heavy man might show more improvement than he would do.”
+
+The hat was passed round at the conclusion: Every man dropped in his
+guinea, some more, it being understood that the collection was divided
+between the two men to pay the expenses of their training.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII.
+
+
+The next morning Mark commenced work in earnest, and for two months
+visited all the worst slums of London in company with one of the Bow
+Street men. Both were generally in disguise, but Mark's companion
+sometimes went openly to some of the houses inhabited by men well known
+as criminals. On such occasions Mark remained within call, ready to go
+in if assistance should be required; but there was small fear of this,
+the men who were visited were all personally known to the officer, and
+generally greeted him with “You aint wanting me, are you?”
+
+“Not at all; what I am wanting is a little information for which I shall
+be quite willing to pay the first man who enables us to lay hands on the
+gentleman I want to find.” Then he would describe Bastow's appearance.
+
+“He has taken to the road, I fancy, and has given us a good deal of
+trouble; if it is the man I think it is, he has been away from London
+for some years, and came back eight or ten months ago.”
+
+The reply was always to the same effect:
+
+“I don't know of such a man, and never heard of him. For my part,
+I would not split on a pal, not for anything; but I should not mind
+earning five guineas to put you on a cove who is not one of us. Besides,
+it aint only the money; you know, you might do me a good turn some day.”
+
+“Quite so; well, I can tell you it is a good deal more than five guineas
+that would be earned if you could put me in the way of laying my hand on
+his shoulder. I don't think that he is living in town. I expect he is
+in some quiet neighborhood; still, if he is on the road, he must have a
+horse somewhere. You might ask among the stables, and find out whether
+anyone keeps a horse there who is in the habit of going out in the
+afternoon and not coming back until the next day. You have plenty of
+time upon your hands, and it would pay you well if you could bring me
+the information I want.”
+
+The officer said to Mark at the end of two months: “These knights of the
+road don't often mix themselves up with the London housebreakers. The
+most likely men to be able to tell you about the doings of such a
+fellow would be receivers of stolen goods, but it would be dangerous to
+question any of them--they would be sure to put him on his guard. I will
+give you a list of some of them, and I should say that your best way
+would be to watch their places of an evening, from the time it gets dark
+till ten or eleven. Of course, it is just a chance. You may watch one
+place for a month and he may happen to go there the very day you have
+gone off to watch another crib. Still, there is just the chance, and I
+don't see that there is one any other way.”
+
+During this time Mark had been taking a lesson every evening with
+Needham, and had surprised his teacher with the rapidity of his
+progress; he had said, the very evening before, when Mark had countered
+him with a blow that knocked him for two or three minutes senseless:
+
+“We have had enough of this, governor; you have got beyond me
+altogether, and I don't want another blow like that. You had better take
+on Gibbons now. You are too big altogether for me, and yet you don't
+fight like a heavyweight, for you are as quick on your pins as I am.”
+
+Well pleased at having the day to himself and of having got clear of his
+work in the thieves' rookeries, Mark went the next morning to Gibbons'
+shop. His entry was hailed by a chorus of barking from dogs of all sorts
+and sizes, from the bulldog down to the ratting terrier.
+
+“Glad to see you, Mr. Thorndyke,” Gibbons said, when he had silenced the
+barking. “I saw Jack last week, and he told me that he should hand you
+over to me pretty soon, for that you were getting beyond him altogether,
+and he thought that if you stuck to it you would give me all my work to
+do in another six months.”
+
+“I finished with him last night, Gibbons, and I shall be ready to come
+for a lesson to you every morning, somewhere about this hour. I have
+brought my bag with my togs.”
+
+“All right, sir, I am ready at once; the place is clear now behind. I
+have just been making it tidy, for we had a little ratting last night,
+one of my dogs against Sir James Collette's, fifty rats each; my dog
+beat him by three quarters of a minute.”
+
+“You will never see me here at one of those businesses. I have no
+objection to stand up to a man my own size and give and take until we
+have had enough, but to see rats slaughtered when they have not a chance
+of making a fight of it is altogether out of my line.”
+
+“Well, sir, I do not care about it myself; there are lots who do like
+it, and are ready to wager their money on it, and as it helps to sell my
+dogs, besides what I can win out of the event--it was a wager of twenty
+guineas last night--it aint for me to set myself up against it.”
+
+Calling a boy to look after the shop, Gibbons went away into a wooden
+building in the back yard; it was about twenty-five feet square, and
+there were holes in the floor for the stakes, when a regular ring was
+made. The floor was strewn with clean sawdust; a number of boxing gloves
+hung by the wall.
+
+“There is the dressing room,” Gibbons said, pointing to a door at the
+other end. When both were ready he looked Mark over. “Your muscles have
+thickened out a good bit, sir, since I saw you strip. Before another
+four years, if you keep on at it, you will be as big a man as I am. I
+am about eight years too old, and you are four years too young. You will
+improve every day, and I shan't. Now, sir, let us see what you can do.
+Jack tells me that you are wonderfully quick on your feet; there is the
+advantage you have of me. I am as strong as ever I was, I think, but I
+find that I cannot get about as I used to.”
+
+He stood somewhat carelessly at first, but as they sparred for an
+opening he became more careful, and presently hit out sharply. Mark
+leaped back, and then, springing forward, struck out with his left;
+Gibbons only just stopped it and then countered, but Mark was out of
+reach again.
+
+“That is good enough,” Gibbons said; “I can see Jack has taught you
+pretty nearly all there is to know. We will just take those hits again.
+You were right to get away from the first, but the second time you
+should have guarded with your left, and hit at my chin with your right.
+That jumping back game is first rate for avoiding punishment, but you
+have got to come in again to hit. You took me by surprise that time, and
+nearly got home, but you would not do it twice,” and so the lesson went
+on for three quarters of an hour.
+
+“That will do for today, sir; I am getting blown, if you are not. Well,
+I can tell you I have never had a more promising pupil, and I have
+brought forward two or three of the best men in the ring; no wonder that
+Jack cannot do much with you. Give me six months, every day, and you
+should have a turn occasionally with other men, and I would back you for
+a hundred pounds against any man now in the ring.”
+
+Three or four days later Mark received a message that the chief wanted
+to speak with him that afternoon, and he accordingly went down.
+
+“I've got a job for you, Mr. Thorndyke; it is just the sort of thing
+that will suit you. There is a house in Buckingham Street that we have
+had our eye on for some time; it is a gambling house, but with that we
+have nothing to do unless complaints are made, but we have had several
+complaints of late. It is a well got up place, and there are a good many
+men of title frequent it, but men of title are not always more honest
+than other people; anyhow, there are some rooks there, and several
+young fellows of means have been pigeoned and ruined. They are mighty
+particular who they let in, and there would be very little chance of
+getting my regular men in there. Now, you are a stranger in London, but
+you have friends here, and no doubt you could get introduced. We want
+to know if the play is fair; if it isn't, we would break the place up
+altogether. We know enough to do it now; but none of the poor beggars
+who have been ruined will come forward, and, indeed, haven't any idea,
+I think, that they have lost their money in anything but a run of bad
+luck.
+
+“One young fellow blew his brains out last week, and his father came
+here with a list of what are called debts of honor, which he found in
+his room. There they are, and the names of the men they are owed to; of
+course some of them have been fairly won, but I have a strong suspicion
+that those I have marked with a cross have not been. For instance, there
+is Sir James Flash, a fellow who was turned out of White's two years
+ago for sharp practice with cards; there is John Emerson, he is a man of
+good family, but all his friends have given him up long ago, and he has
+been living by his wits for the last five years. The others marked
+are all of the same sort. Now, what I want you to do is to become a
+frequenter of the place; of course you will have to play a little, and
+as you are a stranger I expect that they will let you win for a bit;
+but if not the old gentleman has placed 200 pounds in my hands for the
+expenses.”
+
+“I could play with my own money,” Mark said rather warmly.
+
+“You forget, Mr. Thorndyke,” the chief said firmly, “that at the present
+moment you are a member of my force, and that you go to this place in
+that capacity, and not as Squire of Crowswood; therefore you must, if
+you please, do as I instruct you. The gentleman will be ready to pay
+that sum. As you see, the amounts entered here total up to nearly 10,000
+pounds. He said that it will ruin him to pay that sum, but that he
+must do so rather than his son should be branded as a defaulter. I have
+advised him to write to all these people saying that it will take him
+some time to raise the money, but that he will see that nobody shall be
+a loser by his son's debts. I have told him in the meantime that I will
+endeavor to get proof that the play was not fair, and in that case he
+would, of course, refuse to pay any of the claims on that ground; and
+you may be sure that if unfair play was proved none of those concerned
+would dare to press their claims.”
+
+“Then my function would be simply to watch?”
+
+“Yes, to watch, and to bring me word of anything you may observe. You
+see, without making a public scandal, if it could be found that a man
+was discovered cheating, and the way in which he was doing it, one would
+be able to put so strong a pressure on him, that not only might he be
+forced to abstain from going to any club, but would be frightened into
+giving up any IOUs he might hold.”
+
+“I shall be glad to do the best I can, sir; but frankly I know next
+to nothing of cards, and should have but little chance of detecting
+anything that might be going on, when it must be done so cleverly that
+experienced gamblers, watching a man closely, fail to see anything
+wrong.”
+
+“I quite understand that; but one of my men has made a study of the
+various methods employed by gamblers to cheat, and although it would
+take you years to learn how to do it yourself, a few hours' instruction
+from him would at least put you up to some of their methods, and enable
+you to know where to look for cheating. The man is now waiting in the
+next room, and if you will take two or three hours daily with him, say
+for a week, you ought to be able to detect the doings of these fellows
+when to others everything seems right and above board. You may have no
+inclination for cards, but knowledge of that sort is useful to anyone
+in society, here or anywhere else, and may enable him either to save his
+own pocket or to do a service to a friend.”
+
+Mark was greatly interested in the tricks the man showed him. At first
+it seemed to him almost magical, after he himself had shuffled the cards
+and cut them the dealer invariably turned up a king. Even admitting he
+might have various places of concealment, pockets in the lining of the
+sleeve, in the inside of the coat, and in various other parts of
+the dress, in which cards could be concealed and drawn out by silken
+threads, it did not seem possible that this could be done with such
+quickness as to be unobserved. It was only when his teacher showed him,
+at first in the slowest manner, and then gradually increasing his speed,
+that he perceived that what seemed impossible was easy enough when the
+necessary practice and skill had been attained. The man was indeed an
+adept at a great variety of tricks by which the unsuspecting could be
+taken in.
+
+“I ought to know,” he said. “I was for three years in a gambling house
+in Paris, where every other man was a sharper. I have been in places of
+the same sort in Belgium, Holland, Germany, and Italy. At first I was
+only a boy waiter, and as until evening there was nothing doing at these
+places, men would sometimes amuse themselves by teaching me tricks, easy
+ones to begin with, and when they saw I was sharp and quick handed they
+went on. After a time I began to work as a confederate, and at last on
+my own account; but I got disgusted with it at last. A young fellow shot
+himself at the table of the gambling house at Rome, and at another place
+I was nearly killed by a man who had lost heavily--do you see, it has
+left a broad scar right across my forehead?--so I gave it up.
+
+“I was in the French police for a time, and used to watch some of the
+lower hells. I was nearly killed there once or twice, and at last I
+came back here. My French chief gave me a letter to the chief, and I was
+taken on at once, for, talking as I do half a dozen languages, and being
+acquainted with most of the swell mobsmen of Paris, I was just the man
+who happened to be wanted here at the time. Since I came over I have
+done a good deal in the way of breaking up hells where sailors and
+others are plundered. But, you see, I cannot be used for the higher
+class of work; my nose has been broken, and I have half a dozen scars on
+my face. I hate the sight of cards now. I have seen so much of the ruin
+they do, and have, I am sorry to say, taken a hand so often in doing it,
+that save showing someone who would use the knowledge in the right way
+how the tricks are done, nothing would persuade me to touch them again.
+However, as a protection, the knowledge is as useful as it is dangerous
+when used the other way. It would take you ten years to learn to do
+these tricks yourself so well as to defy detection; but in a very short
+time, by learning where to keep your eyes, you would get to detect
+almost any of them.
+
+“You see, there are three methods of cheating: the first by hidden
+cards, the second by marked cards, the third simply by sleight of hand,
+this being generally used in connection with marked cards. These tricks
+require great skill and extreme delicacy of touch, for the marks,
+which are generally at the edge of the cards, are so slight as to be
+altogether imperceptible save to a trained hand. There are also marks on
+the back of the cards; these are done in the printing, and are so slight
+that, unless attention were attracted to them, no one would dream of
+their existence.”
+
+In the course of a week's practice Mark learned where to look for
+cheating; he could not indeed follow the fingers of his instructor, for
+even when he knew what was going to be done, the movements were so rapid
+that his eye could not follow them, and in nine cases out of ten he
+was unable to say whether the coup had been accomplished or not; but
+he could see that there was a slight movement of the fingers that could
+only mean that something was being done.
+
+“It would be a good thing,” he said one day, “if every young fellow
+before going out into the world were to have a course of such
+instruction as you are giving me; he would learn, at least, the absolute
+folly of sitting down to play cards with strangers. He would see that
+he could be robbed in fifty different ways, and would be at the absolute
+mercy of any sharper. I never had any inclination for gambling, but if
+I had been inclined that way you would have cured me of the passion for
+life.”
+
+The week's instruction was lengthened to a fortnight, and at the end of
+that time Mark went to Dick Chetwynd.
+
+“Do you know, Dick,” he said, “a gambling place in Buckingham Street?”
+
+“I know that there is a hell there, Mark, but I have never been in it.
+Why do you ask?”
+
+“I have rather a fancy to go there,” he replied. “I hear that, although
+a good many men of fashion haunt the place, the crowd is rather a mixed
+one.”
+
+“It has a bad name, Mark; I have heard some queer reports about it.”
+
+“Yes, so have I. I should think that it is a very likely place for a man
+like Bastow to go to if he has any liking for play. Of course he would
+get up as a gentleman. At any rate, I have been making what inquiries
+I can in some of the thieves' quarters, and have come to the conclusion
+that he is not likely to have taken up his abode there, and I don't
+think I can do better than make a round of some of these doubtful
+houses. I should like to begin with this, and then work downwards.”
+
+“Well, I dare say I could manage it, Mark; I know half a dozen men who
+play there; they say there is more fun and excitement to be got than
+at White's or Crockford's, or any of those places. Some men, of course,
+play high, but a good many who go there only risk a few guineas; some go
+because it is the proper thing at present for a man about town either to
+play or to bet on horses or cock fights, or to patronize the ring; and,
+after all, it is easier to stroll for an hour or two of an evening into
+comfortable rooms, where you meet a lively set and there is champagne
+always going, than it is to attend races or prize fights.”
+
+Very few days passed that Mark did not go in for half an hour's chat
+with his friend, and two days after this conversation Dick said:
+
+“By the way, Mark, I have arranged for us to go to that hell tonight;
+young Boldero, who is a member of my club, told me some time ago that he
+played there sometimes. I met him yesterday evening, and said that I had
+a fancy to go and have a look at it, and that a friend of mine from the
+country also wanted to go; he said at once that he would take us there.
+
+“'I should advise you not to play much, Chetwynd,' he said; 'sometimes
+they play uncommonly high, and there are some fellows who have wonderful
+luck. Of course, on ordinary occasions, when the play is low, you could
+stake a few guineas there as well as elsewhere, but when really high
+play is on we small fish always stand out. All I can say is that I have
+never seen anything that savors of foul play in the smallest degree; but
+you understand how it is, if one man happens to have a big run of luck,
+there are always fellows who go about hinting that there is something
+wrong in it. However, it is a jolly place to drop into, and, of course
+there is no occasion to play always, and if one loses one is likely to
+win on the next race or on the next fight.'”
+
+Accordingly that evening Mark met Boldero, whom he had once or twice
+before seen in Dick's company, and the three went together to the house
+in Buckingham Street. Boldero nodded to the doorkeeper as he went in,
+and they then proceeded upstairs and entered a handsome room, with
+comfortable sofas and chairs, on which a dozen men were seated, for the
+most part smoking. Several champagne bottles stood on the tables, and
+all who liked helped themselves. Boldero was known to several of those
+present, while two or three were also known to Dick. Boldero introduced
+them both to his friends. One of these was the Hon. John Emerson, a man
+of some five and thirty, with a languid air and a slight drawl.
+
+“Glad to make your acquaintance, sir,” he said to Mark. “Have you been
+long in town?”
+
+“Two or three months only,” Mark replied.
+
+“Is this your first visit here?”
+
+“Yes, this is my first visit to any place of the sort, but I thought
+that I should like to go the rounds before I went home again.”
+
+“Quite so. Going to punt a few guineas, I suppose?”
+
+“Yes, I suppose that is the right thing to do.”
+
+“Well, everyone who comes is expected to do a little that way; there is
+no occasion to play high.”
+
+“Oh, I should not like to do that,” Mark said innocently; “indeed, I
+know very little about cards.”
+
+“Oh, that is quite immaterial so long as you only play games of chance;
+in fact, you don't want to know anything about them. You see others
+staking their money, some on one side of the table, and some on the
+other; you place your money whichever side you like, and take your
+chance. There is no skill in it. Some people play on what they call a
+system, but there is nothing in it; you have just as much chance if you
+put your money down blindfolded. If luck is with you, you win; if luck
+is against you, you lose.”
+
+After chatting for a few minutes Mark went with his two companions
+upstairs. The room they now entered was furnished as a drawing room,
+except that in the middle was a table, round which some fifteen people
+were seated, while as many more looked on; round the room were several
+small tables, on which were packs of cards. These were for those who
+preferred to play piquet or ecarte, two or three couples being so
+engaged. Mark knew enough of cards to know that hazard was being played
+at the large table. There was an inner room, and Mark strolled across
+and looked in. It was at present untenanted; it contained a center table
+capable of holding four, and two or three small ones, with two chairs
+set in readiness to each.
+
+“That is where the heavy play goes on,” Boldero said. “None of your four
+or five guineas wagers there, fifties and hundreds are nearer the mark,
+and I have seen a thousand wagered many a time. It is exciting work even
+looking on, I can tell you; what it must be for the players I cannot
+say, but I should think it must be frightful.”
+
+Mark took up his stand at the hazard table, and after looking on for
+some little time began to play. Beginning with guineas, he gradually, as
+luck favored him, played five guineas, and after half an hour's play won
+fifty. Then luck turned, and in a few minutes he had lost all he won.
+
+“You ought to have stopped, Mark,” Dick said reproachfully, as he
+stepped back from his place, which was at once filled by one who had
+been standing behind him.
+
+The play in the inner room had now begun, and Mark went in and joined
+those who were looking on. In half an hour one of the players had had
+enough, and a young man said to Emerson, who was standing on the other
+side of the table:
+
+“Now, Mr. Emerson, will you give me my revenge?”
+
+“I would really rather not, Mr. Cotter. The luck has been so one sided
+lately that I would rather leave it alone.”
+
+“But it may turn tonight,” the other said. “At any rate, I will try it,
+if you have no objection.”
+
+There was a certain eagerness in the young man's voice that caused Mark
+to watch him closely. He was a good looking young fellow, but his face
+was not a strong one; and although he evidently tried to assume an
+appearance of indifference as he sat down, there was a nervous movement
+of his fingers. Mark took his place behind him as play began. The game
+was ecarte, and for a time Emerson lost.
+
+“I think the luck has changed, Mr. Cotter, but as we generally raise the
+stakes after playing for a bit, I am ready to do so. Shall we make it
+fifty pounds again?”
+
+“With pleasure,” the young man said.
+
+He won the next two games, then for some time they won alternately.
+
+“Shall we say a hundred again?” he said.
+
+“As you like,” Emerson replied. “We don't seem to get much forwarder
+either way at present.”
+
+A considerable number of lookers on had now gathered round. So far Mark,
+although watching the fingers of the opposite player intently, had seen
+no sign whatever of unfair play. He now redoubled his attention. Cotter
+won the first game, his adversary the three next. Mark noticed now that
+after looking at his hand Emerson looked abstractedly, as if meditating
+before taking the next step; there was no expression in his face, but
+Mark fancied that his eyes rested for a moment on the man standing next
+to himself. He looked at his watch and then, as if finding the hour
+later than he had expected, moved away from his place, and presently
+joined Dick, who was standing with Boldero on the other side of the
+table.
+
+“Who is that man playing with Emerson?” he asked in a whisper.
+
+“He is the son of Cotter, the head of Cotter's Bank, in Lombard Street.”
+
+As the men were standing two or three deep round the table, Mark could
+not see the table itself, but this mattered little, for his attention
+was entirely directed towards the man standing behind Cotter's chair. He
+saw that after glancing down at the young man's hand he looked across as
+if seeing what Emerson was going to do; sometimes his eyes dropped
+for an instant, at other times there was no such movement, and after
+noticing this four or five times, and noticing the course Emerson took,
+he had no doubt whatever in his own mind that the movement of the man's
+eyes was an intimation to Emerson of the nature of Cotter's hand. The
+young man had lost four games in succession; he had grown very pale, but
+showed no other signs of agitation. Presently he said:
+
+“You have your usual luck again; I will only play one more game tonight,
+but we may as well make it worth playing. Shall we say five hundred?”
+
+“At your service,” Emerson replied.
+
+This time the face of the man standing behind Cotter's chair was
+immovable, and Mark, placing himself behind a short man and straining
+his head forward, saw that Cotter scored four. The next time there was
+still no sign. Emerson showed a king and scored it, and then won every
+trick and the game.
+
+“That makes nine hundred pounds,” the young man said quietly, writing
+an IOU for that amount and handing it to Emerson. There was a general
+movement of the spectators, and two fresh players took the seats vacated
+by the late antagonists.
+
+“Who was the man standing behind Cotter's chair?” Mark asked Boldero.
+
+“That is Sir James Flash. He is just going to play, you see; it is sure
+to be another hot game, and an interesting one.”
+
+“Well, I think I will go,” Mark said; “the heat of the room has given me
+a bit of a headache. I will see you tomorrow, Dick.”
+
+“Good night, old man,” Chetwynd said; and, shaking hands with Boldero,
+Mark went downstairs immediately after Cotter. The latter went into the
+room below, drank off a tumbler of champagne, and then went down, took
+his hat, and went out. Mark followed him for a short distance, and
+joined him as soon as he got up into the Strand.
+
+“Mr. Cotter,” he said, “I have not the pleasure of knowing you
+personally, and I must introduce myself. My name is Mark Thorndyke,
+and I am the owner of an estate close to Reigate. Would you mind my
+exchanging a few words with you?”
+
+Cotter looked up, and was about to give a flat refusal, but the
+expression of Mark's face was so friendly and pleasant that he changed
+his mind and said in a hard voice:
+
+“I really do not know what you can have to say to me, Mr. Thorndyke, but
+of course I can hardly refuse to hear you.”
+
+They walked across the road and turned up a quiet street.
+
+“For certain reasons it is not necessary for me to explain,” Mark said,
+“I went to that place for the first time tonight, and I watched the play
+between you and Mr. Emerson.”
+
+“It does not matter, sir; I lost, and I am not going there again.”
+
+“I hope, on the contrary, that you will go there again, Mr. Cotter. If I
+mistake not, from what I heard, you have lost considerable sums to that
+man.”
+
+“I imagine, sir, that that is no business of a stranger.”
+
+“In no way personally,” Mark replied, not heeding the angry ring in
+the voice, “but as an honest man it does concern me. I am absolutely
+convinced, sir, that that money has not been won from you fairly.”
+
+The young man gave a start.
+
+“Impossible!” he said shortly. “Mr. Emerson is a man of good family and
+a gentleman.”
+
+“He is a man of good family, I admit, but certainly not a gentleman; his
+antecedents are notorious.”
+
+“I have never heard a word against him; he is intimate with Sir James
+Flash and other gentlemen of position.”
+
+“I am not surprised, that you have not heard of it; it was probably
+to the interest of several persons that you should not do so. Nor do
+I suppose that you are aware that Sir James Flash was himself expelled
+from White's for cheating at cards.”
+
+“Impossible!” Mr. Cotter replied.
+
+“I can assure you of the fact,” Mark said quietly. “Probably you have
+among your acquaintances some members of White's. I am sure if you ask
+them they will confirm the fact. Now, sir, I can assure you that I
+have no interest in this matter, save to prevent a gentleman from being
+ruined by blacklegs. May I ask how much you owe to Mr. Emerson and Sir
+James Flash?”
+
+The young man hesitated. “I believe you, sir,” he said at last. “They
+hold my IOUs for 29,000 pounds. I need hardly say it is absolute ruin.
+My intention is to make a clean breast to my father about it tomorrow
+morning. My father will give me the money, in the first place because he
+loves me and would save my name from disgrace, and in the second because
+were I posted as a defaulter it would strike a severe blow at the credit
+of the bank. So he will give me the money, but he will bid me leave his
+house forever. That will matter little, for I shall pay the money, and
+tomorrow night I shall blow out my brains.”
+
+“Well, sir, if you will follow my advice you will neither pay the
+money nor blow out your brains. I saw enough tonight to feel absolutely
+certain that you have been cheated. Sir James Flash stood behind you,
+and was, I am sure, signaling your hand to Emerson. I believe that
+Emerson played fair otherwise, until the last game, but I am convinced
+that he then cheated. You had good hands, but he had better; and
+although I did not see him cheat--for I was on the other side of the
+table--I am convinced that he did so. Now, sir, I advise you to go in
+as usual tomorrow evening, and to play, raising your stakes as you did
+tonight. When the times comes I will expose him. Should I not be able to
+detect him we must try another night. I am so much convinced that this
+is the case, and that I shall succeed, that whether you play one night
+or three I will guarantee that you shall be no loser, but will, on the
+honor of a gentleman, place in your hands the amount of your losses; so
+that you will not have to ask your father for a check larger than you
+would do if you confessed to him tomorrow morning. I only ask in return
+that you, on your part, will give me your word of honor that you will
+never touch a card again after you rise from the table.”
+
+“I cannot accept so generous an offer from a stranger,” Cotter said in a
+low tone.
+
+“I do not think that it is generous,” Mark replied quietly, “because I
+am perfectly convinced that I shall not have to pay at all. Have you any
+other IOUs out?”
+
+“I have given them for about 5000 pounds, but that is not in addition
+to the 29,000 pounds. Emerson told me that as he knew that I should have
+difficulty in paying them at the present moment, he had taken them up,
+and held them with his own.”
+
+“Will you give me the names of the persons to whom you gave them in the
+first place?”
+
+“Certainly;” and he mentioned three names, all of which stood with a
+black cross against them on Mark's list.
+
+“Thank you. Then you will go tomorrow night again?”
+
+“Yes; and I swear to you that I will never touch a card afterwards.”
+
+“I don't think that you need fear,” Mark said. “I have not been long in
+London, but I happen to have been shown a good many of the tricks that
+these blacklegs play on greenhorns, which will account for my having
+noticed what has never been observed by the honest portion of the men
+who frequent the place. Now I will say good night, sir. I shall be
+behind your chair or his tomorrow night.”
+
+“I don't know what to say,” Cotter said hesitatingly.
+
+“There is no occasion to say anything; it is the duty of every honest
+man to interfere if he sees another honest man being robbed, and that is
+my sole object in this matter. Good night;” and turning round, he walked
+rapidly away.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII.
+
+
+The next morning, before going round to Gibbons', Mark saw his chief and
+told him of what had taken place on the previous evening.
+
+“I certainly did not think that you would succeed so soon; you believe
+that you will be able fairly to expose these fellows?”
+
+“I have no doubt whatever that I shall be able to expose one of them;
+and I have equally no doubt that if the others are arrested, either
+false cards or pockets for cards will be found upon them. What do you
+wish me to do, sir? I can, of course, expose any fellow I catch at it,
+but can do nothing about the others.”
+
+“I must have more than one captured,” the chief said. “At even the most
+irreproachable club there may be one blackleg, but if it is clear that
+this place is the haunt of blacklegs we can break it. There are half a
+dozen Acts that apply; there is the 11th Act of Henry VIII, statute 33,
+cap. 9, which prohibits the keeping of any common house for dice, cards,
+or any unlawful game. That has never been repealed, except that gaming
+houses were licensed in 1620. What is more to the point is that
+five Acts of George II, the 9th, 12th, 13th, 18th, and 30th, impose
+penalties upon the keepers of public houses for permitting gambling, and
+lay heavy penalties upon hazard, roulette, and other gambling games, on
+the keepers of gambling houses and those who play there. Having received
+complaints of several young men being rooked in the place, we can, if
+we prove that some of its frequenters are blacklegs, shut the place up
+altogether. We should do it quietly, and without fuss, if possible;
+but if we shut it up several others of the same sort will be certain to
+close their doors. But mind, there will probably be a desperate row, and
+you had better take pistols with you. I will have four men close at
+hand from ten o'clock till the time the place closes, and if they hear a
+scrimmage, or you fire a pistol out of the window, they will rush in and
+seize all engaged in the row, and march them to the lock up. Of course
+you will have to be included.”
+
+Mark then went to Chetwynd.
+
+“Well, what did you think of it last night?”
+
+“Well, I own that it went against my grain to see that young fellow
+being victimized by a sharper.”
+
+“My dear Mark, you must not use such language as that. I fancy from
+what I have heard that the Honorable John is not altogether an estimable
+character, but to call him a sharper is going too far altogether.”
+
+“I don't think that it is, for from what I saw last night I am pretty
+well convinced that he did not play fair. I mean to go again tonight.”
+
+“But why on earth should you mix yourself up in such an affair, Mark? It
+is no business of yours; you are not an habitue of the place. Above
+all, it is extremely unlikely that you are right. There were some
+shady people there, no doubt, but there were also a good many gentlemen
+present, and as you know nothing of cards, as far as I know, it is the
+most unlikely thing in the world that you should find out that Emerson
+cheated when no one else noticed it.”
+
+“It is my business; it is the duty of every honest man to see that a
+poor lad like that should not be eaten up by a shark like Emerson. I
+don't care if there is a shindy over it. I shall not interfere unless I
+can prove that the man is cheating, in which case no man of honor would
+go out with him. I shall be glad if you and Boldero would go with me
+again this evening. I am not known there, and you are to a good many
+men, and Boldero to many more. I only want that, if I get into a row,
+you should testify to the fact that I am a gentleman, and ordinarily
+sane. If there is a row you will have an opportunity of seeing how much
+I have benefited by my lessons.”
+
+“Yes, I heard you were making tremendous progress. Jack Needham told
+me a month ago that you had knocked him out of time, and I went into
+Gibbons' yesterday morning with a man who wanted to buy a dog, and he
+told me that he considered that it was a great misfortune that you were
+an amateur, for that you only required another six months' practice, and
+he would then be ready to back you for a hundred pounds against any man
+in the ring. But about this affair, Mark. Are you really in earnest?”
+
+“I am, Dick, thoroughly in earnest; so would you be if you had spoken
+to Cotter last night, as I did. I tell you that if I had not given him a
+little hope that the thing might come out right, he would have blown out
+his brains today.”
+
+“Well, Mark, if you have set your mind on it, of course I will stick to
+you, though I have some doubts whether Cotter has any brains to speak
+of to blow out, else he would not be mad enough to back himself against
+Emerson and other men whom Boldero tells me he has been playing with.”
+
+“He has made an ass of himself, no doubt, Dick; but I fancy a good
+many fellows do that at one time or other of their lives, though not, I
+grant, always in the same way.”
+
+“Well, I will go, Mark. I need not ask Boldero, for he told me that he
+should look in again at ten o'clock this evening, for he thought that
+another night's play would probably bring Cotter to the end of his
+tether.”
+
+Accordingly a little before ten they walked into the gambling house
+together.
+
+“Now, Dick, I want you, as soon as you sit down, to take your place in
+the front line within a yard or two of Emerson. I don't want you to be
+just behind him, but a short distance away; and I want you to keep your
+eye upon Sir James Flash, who, if I am not mistaken, will take up the
+same position that he did last night, near enough to Cotter to see
+his hand. You will remark, I have no doubt, as I did last night, that
+whenever Cotter has a bad hand, Flash will either close his eyes, or put
+his hand up to his mouth and stroke his mustache, or make some sign of
+that sort. When Cotter has a good hand he will stand perfectly still or
+look about the room. At any rate, he will make no sign--that, of course,
+is a guide to Emerson whether to propose or to refuse to allow Cotter
+to do so. I need not point out to you what a tremendous advantage
+the knowledge whether an opponent's hand is good or not gives him. Of
+course, while watching an hour's play I can only know that Flash was
+making signs, and that when he did so Cotter's hand was a bad one. It is
+possible that the manner in which the sign was made, either by closing
+his eye or twisting his mustache, or so on, may have been an intimation
+as to the suit in which Cotter was strongest or weakest.”
+
+“By Jove, this is a serious thing, Mark.”
+
+“It is a serious thing. I don't want you to get into a row with the
+fellow. I should like you to give me a nod when you have satisfied
+yourself that I was not mistaken. I will take upon myself to denounce
+the fellow, and to say what I noticed yesterday and you can back me up
+by saying that you saw the same thing. I have no doubt that I shall be
+able to convince every decent man there that my charge is well founded.
+I am going to watch Emerson. With the help he gets from Flash, he won't
+risk anything by cheating until it comes to a big stake like the last
+game yesterday, in which case, if Cotter's hand happens to be a strong
+one, he is likely to do so, and I fancy if he does I shall be able to
+catch him at it. You had better keep Boldero near you. You can whisper
+to him what you are watching Flash for, and get him to do so too; as,
+if I catch Emerson cheating, there is likely to be a row; he can lend
+a hand if necessary, and, at any rate, his joining in with you will
+suffice to show his friends that the thing is genuine.”
+
+“All right, Mark. I am interested in the matter now, and am ready for
+anything.”
+
+Soon after ten Cotter and Emerson again sat down, and, as usual, a lot
+of spectators gathered round the table. The game resembled the one on
+the previous evening. Mark placed himself' by the side of Cotter, a
+stranger stood immediately behind his chair, another member of the club
+was on the other side, and Sir James Flash stood partly behind him, so
+that although somewhat in the background he could obtain a view between
+their heads of Cotter's cards. Mark saw to his satisfaction that Dick
+and Boldero had secured the exact position that he wished them to take.
+For the first few games the play was even, and Dick began to think that
+Mark had been mistaken, for Flash appeared to take little interest in
+the game, and made no sign how Emerson should proceed.
+
+As soon as the stake rose to a hundred again he distinctly saw Flash
+close his eyes and play with his mustache; he called Boldero's attention
+to the fact, and found the latter, who had also been watching, had
+noticed it. By the time a few games had been played he verified Mark's
+assertion that these signs were signals that Cotter's hand was a bad
+one, and in each case Emerson played without giving his opponent the
+opportunity of discarding and taking in fresh cards. He and Dick nodded
+quietly to Mark, who had satisfied himself that so far Emerson had not
+cheated in any other way. As on the previous evening, Cotter, after
+losing five or six hundred pounds, proposed a final game of five
+hundred. Mark bent down his head, so that the intentness of his gaze
+should not be noticed, but from under his eyebrows he watched Emerson's
+every movement; suddenly he placed a foot on the edge of the chair of
+the man sitting in front of him, and with a sudden spring leaped upon
+the table, seized Emerson's hand, and held it up to the full length of
+his arm.
+
+“Gentlemen,” he shouted, “this fellow is cheating; there is a card in
+his hand which he has just brought from under the table.”
+
+In a moment there was a dead silence of surprise; then Mark forced the
+hand open and took Emerson's card, which he held up.
+
+“There, you see, gentleman; it is a king.”
+
+Then a Babel of sounds arose, a dozen hands were laid upon Emerson, who
+was pulled back from his chair and thrown down on a sofa, while hands
+were run over his coat, waistcoat, and breeches.
+
+“Here they are!” a man shouted, and held a dozen cards over his head.
+
+The place of concealment had been cleverly chosen; the breeches
+apparently buttoned closely at the knee, but in reality they were loose
+enough to enable a finger and thumb to be passed between them and the
+stocking, and in the lining of the breeches was a pocket in which the
+cards had been placed, being held there by two pieces of whalebone, that
+closed the pocket. The searchers, among whom were Dick and Boldero, did
+not have it all their own way; four or five men rushed upon them, and
+endeavored to pull them off Emerson. The din of voices was prodigious,
+but Mark, still standing on the table, stilled it for a moment by
+shouting:
+
+“The scoundrel has an accomplice, who this evening and yesterday has
+been signaling the strength of the cards in Mr. Cotter's hands.”
+
+“Who is he?” was shouted over the room.
+
+“It is Sir James Flash,” Mark said. “I denounce him as a cheat and a
+sharper.”
+
+As pale as death, Flash rushed to the table.
+
+“I don't know who you are, sir,” he said, in a tone of concentrated
+rage, “but you are a liar, and you shall answer for this in the
+morning.”
+
+“I will answer to any gentleman that calls me to account,” Mark said,
+in a ringing voice, “but I don't meet a man who has been expelled from
+White's for cheating, and who I have no doubt is well stocked with cards
+at the present moment, in readiness for the victim that he is next going
+to meet after the plucking of Mr. Cotter has been done. Now, gentlemen,
+search him and see if I am wrong; if I am I will apologize for that part
+of my accusation.”
+
+Flash drew a pistol from his pocket, but in an instant his arm was
+seized by those standing round him, and it exploded harmlessly. Among
+those who seized Flash was the man who had played with him the previous
+evening. In spite of his struggles and curses, and the efforts of his
+friends to rescue him, he too was thrown down and eight court cards were
+found concealed in his sleeve. The uproar while this was going on had
+been tremendous, but it was suddenly stilled as four men in dark clothes
+entered the room. Each held in his hand the well known symbol of his
+office, the little ebony staff surmounted by a silver crown.
+
+“I arrest all present in the name of the king,” one said, “for breaking
+the laws against gambling, and for brawling and the use of firearms.
+Now, gentlemen, resistance is useless; I must request that you each give
+me your card, and your word of honor that you will appear at Bow Street
+tomorrow morning.”
+
+“What is all this about, sir?” he asked Mark, who was still standing on
+the table.
+
+“Two fellows here have been caught cheating.”
+
+“What is your name and address, sir?”
+
+“My name is Mark Thorndyke, and I am a landed gentleman at Reigate; my
+friends Mr. Chetwynd and Mr. Boldero will bear this out.”
+
+“Who are the two men?” the constable asked.
+
+“The two fellows with torn clothes,” Mark said. “They are Mr. Emerson
+and Sir James Flash.”
+
+“You are certain of the charge that you are making?”
+
+“Quite certain; the cards have been found hidden upon them.”
+
+“Yes, yes!” a score of voices shouted; “they have been caught in the act
+of cheating.”
+
+“Take those two men into custody,” the constable said to two of his
+companions.
+
+“Who fired that pistol?” he went on.
+
+A number of voices shouted:
+
+“Sir James Flash; he attempted to murder Mr. Thorndyke.”
+
+The constable nodded to the man who had laid his hands on Sir James
+Flash, and in a moment a pair of handcuffs closed on his wrists.
+
+“You shall repent this!” Flash exclaimed furiously.
+
+“Calm yourself, Sir James,” the constable said calmly. “We know our
+duty, and do it whether a man is a peer or a peasant; you are accused of
+card sharping and an attempted murder.”
+
+“What is your address in town, Mr. Thorndyke?” he asked.
+
+“18 Villiers Street.”
+
+“Is there any charge against anyone else here? A good many of you seem
+to have your clothes torn and disarranged.”
+
+“Some fellows attempted to rescue Emerson and Flash while we were
+searching them; for what reason we can all pretty well imagine.”
+
+“I shall require the names in the morning of your assailants,” the
+constable said; “it looks very much as if they were confederates of the
+two prisoners. Now, gentlemen, you can all leave. This house is
+closed, and will not be opened again until this affair is thoroughly
+investigated.”
+
+In five minutes the house was deserted.
+
+“How can I thank you, Mr. Thorndyke?” Cotter, who was one of those who
+had seized Flash's arm, diverted his aim and searched him, said, when
+they got outside the house. “You have saved my life. It did not seem
+possible to me that you could succeed in showing that I was being
+cheated, and I had firmly resolved that, instead of allowing you to
+suffer loss, I would tomorrow morning make a clean breast of the whole
+affair to my father, as I had intended to have done this morning.”
+
+“If I might advise you, Mr. Cotter, I should say, carry out your
+intention as far as making a clean breast of it is concerned. Happily,
+you are free from debt, as those IOUs are worthless, for they were
+obtained from you by cheating, therefore you have no demand to make upon
+his purse. The police will, I have no doubt, endeavor to keep this thing
+quiet, but your name may come out, and it would be far better that
+your father should hear this story from you than elsewhere; and your
+assurance that you will never touch a card again, and the heavy lesson
+that you have had, will doubtless induce him to look at the matter
+leniently. It will, no doubt, be a painful story to tell, but it will be
+far better told by you.”
+
+“I will do it, sir; as you say, the lesson has been a heavy one, and
+henceforth my father shall have no reason to complain of me. May I call
+and see you tomorrow evening?”
+
+“Certainly. I shall be at home from seven to eight, after which hour I
+have an engagement. Good night.”
+
+Cotter walked on, and Mark fell back, and joined Dick and Boldero, who
+had fallen behind when they saw him speaking to Cotter.
+
+“Well, Mark, I congratulate you,” Dick Chetwynd said. “You did it
+wonderfully, though how on earth you knew that fellow had a card in his
+hand is more than I can guess.”
+
+“I felt sure he was going to cheat,” Mark said quietly; “I saw that
+Cotter's hand was a very strong one, and knew that Emerson would be
+aware that it was so, because he would receive no signal from Flash,
+therefore this was the time, if any, that he would cheat. He had been
+playing with both hands upon the table. I saw him withdraw one, there
+was a little pause, and then it came up again, and I had not a doubt
+in the world that there was a card in it, and that it had been
+hidden somewhere in his breeches, which is one of the best places of
+concealment, for his hand being under the table while getting at the
+card, no one present who was not behind the scenes, as I was, could
+detect him doing it.”
+
+“The wonder to me is,” Boldero said, “that while there were a number
+of men looking on closely, for Emerson has long been suspected of not
+playing fair, you, just fresh from the country, if I may say so, should
+have spotted him.”
+
+“That is easily explained,” Mark said. “Not wishing to fall a victim, I
+have of late been put up to a great many of these sharpers' tricks by a
+man who at one time had been in the trade himself.”
+
+“That was a capital idea, Mark,” Dick said. “I wish you would introduce
+me to him.”
+
+“I won't do that, Dick, but I shall be very glad to teach you all I know
+myself about it; but I fancy that after this you will be in no great
+hurry to enter a gambling hell again.”
+
+“That is so, Mark. I have never had any great inclination for play;
+but after this you may be quite sure that I will light shy of cards
+altogether. Still, I shall be glad if you will put me up to some of
+these tricks, for I may be able to some day save a victim of card
+sharpers, as you have done this evening.”
+
+The next morning, when those who had been present at the scene of the
+previous evening arrived at the office of the detectives in Bow Street,
+they were shown into some private rooms, and asked to wait. Cotter,
+Mark, and his two friends first had an interview with the chief.
+
+“You will understand,” the latter said, “that this is an altogether
+informal affair. I propose you first tell me your story as briefly as
+possible.”
+
+This was done.
+
+“Now, Mr. Cotter. I take it that you do not wish to prosecute?”
+
+“Certainly not. I would, in fact, give anything rather than appear in
+it.”
+
+“You have said that, in addition to the IOUs that you have given to the
+two men caught cheating, they hold others to the amount of some five
+or six thousand pounds, given by you to three other frequenters of the
+club. In fact, these papers have been found in Emerson's pocketbook; he
+told you, I believe, that he had taken them up, so that you should not
+be inconvenienced by them. I understand, then, that you will be quite
+content if you get these IOUs back again; those given to Emerson and
+Flash are, of course, worthless. After what has happened, they could not
+be presented, but probably you might have trouble about the others,
+for, though I have no doubt that the whole of the men were in league
+together, we have no means of absolutely proving it.”
+
+“I shall be more than content, sir; I have no wish to prosecute.”
+
+“We are glad,” the chief said, “to be able to close a dangerous place;
+and as the exposure will put a stop to the career of these two men, and
+no doubt alarm a good many others, we don't care about taking the matter
+into court. Such gross scandals as this are best kept quiet, when there
+is no object in ventilating them. Therefore, gentlemen, as Mr. Cotter
+is willing to do so, we shall let the matter drop. I shall be obliged if
+you will step into the next room, however, until I have seen these three
+men.”
+
+When they had left, the three were brought in.
+
+“You have been concerned, sirs,” the chief said sternly, “in winning
+large sums of money from the Hon. William Denton, from Mr. James Carew,
+from Mr. William Hobson, and others; in all of these cases the two men
+caught cheating last night were also concerned. You all hold notes of
+hand of Mr. Hobson. I shall advise that gentleman's father to refuse to
+pay those notes, and promise him that if any further request for payment
+is made I will furnish him with such particulars for publication as
+will more than justify him in the eyes of the world in refusing to honor
+them. You, as well as Mr. Emerson and Sir James Flash, have won large
+sums from Mr. Cotter, and the fact that the IOUs he gave you were found
+on Mr. Emerson points very strongly to their being in confederacy with
+you in the matter; at any rate, they point so strongly that, whether a
+jury would convict or not on the evidence that we shall be able to lay
+before them, there can be no question whatever as to what the opinion of
+men of honor will be. These IOUs are in our hands. Mr. Cotter does not
+desire to pursue the case; he will, however, refuse absolutely to pay
+those IOUs, and in doing so he will have the approval of all honorable
+men. That being so, the IOUs are absolutely useless to you, and if you
+will agree to my tearing them up now, he has most kindly consented to
+let the matter drop in your cases.”
+
+The three men, who had all turned very white when he was speaking, now
+protested angrily against imputations being made on their honor.
+
+“Well, sirs,” the officer said, “in that case the matter can, of course,
+go on. You know best what the feeling will be as to these IOUs. They
+will form an important item of evidence against you, you will see. As
+the matter stands, either you gave them to Emerson to collect for you,
+without any money passing between you--a very strange procedure, which
+you will find it difficult to explain--or else he gave you the coin for
+them, and you passed them over to him, and have, therefore, parted with
+all claim on Mr. Cotter on your own account. Of course I impound them
+with the other IOUs as proof of a conspiracy between you. Now, sirs, am
+I to tear them up or not?”
+
+The three men looked at each other, and then one of them said:
+
+“We protest altogether against the assertion, sir, but at the same
+time, as there can be little doubt that Emerson and Sir James Flash have
+played unfairly, and we do not wish any association of our names
+with theirs, we are perfectly willing that the IOUs, which, under the
+circumstances, we should never have dreamt of presenting, should be
+destroyed.”
+
+“I think that you have chosen wisely,” the chief said dryly. “It is a
+pity that you did not do so at first. These are the IOUs he gave to one
+or other of you. Perhaps it would be pleasanter for you to destroy them
+yourselves.”
+
+The three men took the papers with their names on them and tore them up.
+
+“Thank you,” he went on sarcastically. “That will place you in a
+better position. You will be able to tell your friends that you felt so
+indignant at the manner in which Mr. Cotter had been swindled by Emerson
+and Flash that you at once destroyed his IOUs for the sums that you had
+won of him. But, gentlemen,”--he spoke sternly now,--“remember that we
+have a long list against you, and that the next victim, or let us say
+his father, might be more disposed to push matters to their full length
+than is Mr. Cotter. Remember, also, that we keep ourselves acquainted
+with what is going on, and that should trouble arise we shall produce
+all the complaints that have been made against you, and shall also
+mention your connection with this affair, in which, as I understand, you
+all did your best to prevent those two fellows from being searched.”
+
+Without saying another word the three men went out of the room,
+too crestfallen to make even an attempt at keeping up their air of
+indignation. The others were then called in.
+
+“I am sorry, gentlemen,” he said, “that you have had the trouble of
+coming here, for the gentleman swindled has declined to prosecute the
+swindlers, and you will understand that he is somewhat anxious that his
+name should not appear in the matter. Fortunately, as instead of paying
+in cash he gave IOUs for his losses, he will not be a loser to any large
+amount by these transactions. I may say that the proprietor of the hell
+has been there this morning, and to avoid trouble he has consented to
+close his place for good. I have only to remark that I should advise
+you, gentlemen, in future, only to indulge in gambling in places where
+you may be fairly assured of the character of the men you play with. I
+think, in conclusion, that you may all feel grateful to Mr. Cotter for
+refusing to prosecute. It has saved you from having to appear in court
+as witnesses in so utterly disreputable an affair.”
+
+There was a general murmur of assent, and in a minute or two the room
+was clear. Flash and Emerson were then brought in, with a constable on
+each side of them.
+
+“Mr. Cotter has, I regret to say, declined to prosecute, and Mr.
+Thorndyke has done the same with regard to Sir James Flash's use of his
+pistol. You have, therefore, escaped the punishment due to swindlers
+at cards. It is the less matter, as you are not likely to have an
+opportunity of making fresh victims, for the story will be known by
+this afternoon in every club in London. These IOUs will be of no use to
+you--they are not worth the paper on which they are written. However,
+I shall take it upon myself to hand them back to Mr. Cotter, to prevent
+the possibility of their getting into other hands and giving him
+trouble.
+
+“You can unlock those handcuffs, constable; these men are at liberty to
+go, and if they will take my advice they will lose no time in crossing
+the water and establishing themselves somewhere where their talents are
+likely to be better appreciated than they are here. They can go; one
+of you can call a hackney coach for them if they wish it. They will
+scarcely care to walk with their garments in their present condition.”
+
+Then the chief went into the next room.
+
+“There is an end of that affair, Mr. Cotter. Here are the IOUs you gave
+to those two swindlers. Those you gave to the other three men, who were
+no doubt their confederates, have been torn up by them in my presence.
+They declare that after seeing how shamefully you had been victimized
+they had not the slightest idea of ever presenting them.”
+
+“I am sure that I am extremely grateful to you,” Cotter said. “I know
+that I have behaved like a madman, and that I don't deserve to have got
+off as I have done. It will be a lesson to me for life, I can assure
+you.”
+
+On leaving, Dick Chetwynd walked for some distance with Mark--as far as
+Gibbons' place in St. Giles.
+
+“There is one thing which I cannot understand,” he said, “and that is
+how it was that the constables happened to be so close at hand, just at
+the time they were wanted.”
+
+“Well, you see, Dick, my relations with Bow Street are just at present
+of a somewhat close nature, for they are aiding me in the search that I
+told you that I was making for my father's murderer. The consequence was
+that I had only to mention to the chief that I fancied I had detected
+cheating at that place, and that there was a likelihood of a row there
+last night, and he at once said he would send four men, to come in if
+they heard a rumpus; and he was, indeed, rather glad of an opportunity
+for breaking up the place, concerning which he had had several
+complaints of young men being plucked to the last feather. Well, it was
+lucky they came. I don't say that it would have made any difference,
+because I think our side was a great deal stronger than they were, still
+it would have led to a nasty row, and perhaps to half a dozen duels
+afterwards. Well, I will say goodby now. I am very glad that the affair
+has been dropped; it would not have mattered so much to me, as I am
+single and my own master, but there were a good many men there who would
+have been ready to have paid up handsomely rather than that their names
+should appear in connection with a row at a gambling house.”
+
+At seven o'clock in the evening Philip Cotter called at Mark's lodgings,
+accompanied by his father, who, as he came in with him, advanced at once
+to Mark and shook him warmly by the hand.
+
+“My son has told me everything, Mr. Thorndyke,” he said, “and I cannot
+thank you sufficiently for the noble part you took in rescuing him from
+the terrible effects of his folly. I have been down here twice this
+afternoon, for I felt that I could not rest until I had shaken you by
+the hand. It is not the question of money so much, though that would
+have been a serious loss to me, but it is the saving of my son's life,
+and the saving of the honor of our name.”
+
+“I am glad indeed to have been of service, Mr. Cotter, and I trust that
+you have consented to forgive the folly that he has committed, and which
+I feel sure will never be repeated.”
+
+“Yes. It was a heavy blow to me, Mr. Thorndyke, when Philip told me; but
+as he has sworn most solemnly never to touch a card again, and as I feel
+sure that the lesson cannot but be a useful one to him all his life, I
+have agreed to say no more about it, and let the matter drop altogether.
+He has been fortunate to have escaped so easily. He has told me of the
+noble offer you made to pay his losses if you should not be able to
+prove that he was being cheated.”
+
+“I was not committing myself heavily,” Mark said with a smile. “I had
+seen enough to be absolutely certain, and was sure that I should be able
+to bring it home to them.”
+
+“But it was at a considerable risk to yourself, Mr. Thorndyke. As it
+was, you had a narrow escape of being shot.”
+
+“Not a very narrow escape,” Mark replied. “With so many men standing
+round him and their attention called to him, it was certain that he
+would be seized before he could take aim at me. I had pistols in my
+pocket, and was prepared to fire in an instant, but I saw at once that
+there was no occasion for that.”
+
+“But I cannot imagine how you should have detected the cheating,” the
+banker said. “You are younger than my son, and he said that you told
+him that you had only recently come up to London. It is astonishing that
+while experienced players should never have noticed that anything was
+wrong you should have discovered it.”
+
+“The explanation is simple, Mr. Cotter. I have no inclination for play
+myself, but I happened a short time since to fall in with a man who was
+well acquainted with all the various methods of card sharping. I thought
+that a knowledge of that might some day be useful, and I got him to
+put me up to a number of the tricks of card sharpers both at home and
+abroad. Having these fresh in my mind, and seeing that your son was
+playing with a man whose reputation I knew to be bad, I naturally
+concentrated my attention upon him, and was not long in discovering that
+he had a confederate standing behind your son's chair. Being a stranger
+in the place, I could not denounce him, but the next night I set two
+friends to watch that method of cheating, while I kept my eyes fixed on
+Emerson's hands. As I anticipated, there was nothing suspicious about
+his movements so long as play was comparatively low, for the advantage
+that he gained from his confederate enabled him to be sure of winning in
+the long run; it was only in the last game, which was a high one, that,
+as he knew that your son had a strong hand, he was tempted to stock
+his hand with false cards; and watching closely, I had no difficulty in
+detecting his method.”
+
+“Well, sir, you have, at any rate, laid us both under the deepest
+obligation. Is there any possible way in which we can show our
+gratitude?”
+
+Mark thought for a moment.
+
+“In one way you might do me a favor, Mr. Cotter. A ward of my father's,
+who will inherit some property when she comes of age, is at present
+finishing her education in town, and is living with a lady who has
+been her friend and companion since childhood. I have a good many
+acquaintances, but they are all bachelors; and having been living down
+at my father's place, near Reigate, for so many years, the ladies have
+no acquaintances in London. They live at Islington, and their life is
+a very dull one. I am anxious, for several reasons, that the young lady
+should have the advantage of going somewhat into society. Hitherto I
+have had no means of introducing her. If it is not too much to ask, Mr.
+Cotter, I should be extremely glad and obliged if Mrs. Cotter would call
+on them and give them an introduction into society. The lady with my
+father's ward is the widow of a captain in the Indian Army, and is in
+all ways a very charming person, and has been at the head of my father's
+establishment for the last twelve years.”
+
+“With the greatest pleasure in the world, Mr. Thorndyke. I am only sorry
+that it is so slight a thing that you ask of me. I have thought it
+but right to tell my wife what has passed, and I had difficulty in
+persuading her not to come with me this evening to also express her
+gratitude to you. She will be pleased indeed to call upon your friends
+at once, and I am sure she will do so tomorrow. I was going to ask you
+to dine with us, and I hope that you will do so. We shall have no one
+else, and I hope that you will be able to arrange to meet your friends
+at our house a few days later.”
+
+The next morning Mark called on Mrs. Cunningham.
+
+“I think you will have a visitor today,” he said. “It has happened that
+I have been able to do a service to the son of Mr. Cotter, a wealthy
+banker. I am going to dine there this evening. He asked me about my
+friends in London, and I mentioned that my only lady friends were you
+and Millicent. He asked a few questions as to where you were living, and
+so on, and said that his wife would have much pleasure in calling and
+introducing Millicent into society. As your life is very dull here, and
+it is clearly very desirable that Millicent should go into society, I
+gladly accepted the offer, and I believe that she will call today.”
+
+“That will be very nice indeed, Mark. Millicent is not complaining, but
+she must have felt it very dull. I have even felt it so myself after the
+cheerful society we had at home.”
+
+“I don't know that I shall like it,” Millicent said doubtfully.
+
+“Oh, yes, you will, Millicent; and besides, it will be good for you. It
+is not natural for a girl of your age to be here without friends, and I
+shall be very glad to know that you are going to mix a little with other
+people.”
+
+Mrs. Cotter called that afternoon, and three days later Mark met Mrs.
+Cunningham and Millicent at a dinner party at the banker's, and Mrs.
+Cotter introduced them very warmly to several of her friends, with the
+result that in a very short time they were frequently invited out, while
+they became very intimate with the banker and his wife, and often spent
+the day there.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV.
+
+
+Some little time after this Mark was intrusted by his chief with the
+work of discovering a man who had committed a very atrocious murder, and
+was, it was tolerably certain, hiding in the slums of Westminster. It
+was the first business of the kind that had been confided to him, and he
+was exceedingly anxious to carry it out successfully. He dressed himself
+as a street hawker, and took a small lodging in one of the lanes, being
+away the greater portion of the day ostensibly on his business, and
+of an evening dropped into some of the worst public houses in the
+neighborhood. He was at first viewed with some suspicion, but it was not
+long before he became popular. He let it be understood that he had got
+into trouble down in the country, and that he was quite ready to take
+part in any job that promised to be profitable. But he principally
+owed his popularity to the fact that the bully of the locality picked
+a quarrel with him, and, to the astonishment of those present, Mark
+invited him to go outside.
+
+“You had better make it up with him, mate,” a man sitting by his side
+whispered. “He was in the prize ring at one time, and thrashed big Mike
+Hartley at Kennington. He had to give it up owing to having fought a
+cross. He would kill you in five minutes.”
+
+“I will chance that,” Mark said quietly, as he moved towards the door.
+“I don't think that he is stronger than I am, and I can use my fists a
+bit, too.”
+
+By the time they had taken off their upper garments a crowd had
+assembled. The news that a hawker was going to stand up against
+Black Jim circulated rapidly, and caused intense excitement. To the
+astonishment of the spectators, the bully from the first had not a
+shadow of a chance, and at the end of the third round was carried away
+senseless, while the hawker had not received a scratch. A few days later
+Mark, who, on the strength of his prowess, had had two or three hints
+that he could be put up to a good thing if he was inclined to join, was
+going down to Westminster when two men stopped and looked after him.
+
+“I tell you, Emerson, that is the fellow. I could swear to him anywhere.
+What he is got up like that for I cannot tell you, but I should not be
+surprised if he is one of that Bow Street gang. He called himself Mark
+Thorndyke, and Chetwynd said that he was a gentleman of property; but
+that might have been part of the plant to catch us. I have never been
+able to understand how a raw countryman could have caught you palming
+that card. I believe that fellow is a Bow Street runner; if so, it is
+rum if we cannot manage to get even with him before we go. It seemed
+to me that luck had deserted us altogether; but this looks as if it was
+going to turn again. Let's go after him.”
+
+Keeping some fifty yards behind him, they watched Mark to his lodgings,
+waited until he came out again, and followed him to a public house.
+
+“He is acting as a detective, sure enough,” Emerson said. “The question
+is, what are we to do next?”
+
+In half an hour Mark came out again. Several people nodded to him as he
+passed them, but they saw a big man, who happened to be standing under
+a lamp, turn his back suddenly as Mark approached him, and, after he had
+passed, stand scowling after him, and muttering deep curses. Flash
+at once went up to him. “Do you know who that fellow is, my man?” The
+fellow turned savagely upon him.
+
+“I don't know who he is; but what is that to you?”
+
+“He is not a friend of ours,” Flash said quietly; “quite the contrary.
+We have known him when he was not got up like this, and we are rather
+curious to know what he is doing here.”
+
+“Do you mean that?”
+
+“I do; I owe the fellow a grudge.”
+
+“So do I,” the man growled. “Just step up this next turning; there won't
+be anyone about there. Now, then, what do yer want to know?”
+
+“I want to know who he is.”
+
+“Well, he calls himself a hawker; but my idea of him is he is one of the
+fancy, perhaps a west countryman, who is keeping dark here till he can
+get a match on. I have been a prize fighter myself, but he knocked me
+out in three rounds the other day.”
+
+“Well, the last time I saw him,” Flash said, “he was dressed as a swell.
+My idea of him is, he is a Bow Street runner, and he is got up like this
+to lay his hands on some of the fellows down here.”
+
+“You don't mean it!” the man said with a deep oath. “Then I can tell you
+he has come to the wrong shop. I have only got to whisper it about, and
+his life would not be worth an hour's purchase. I had meant to stick
+a knife in him on the first opportunity, but this will save me the
+trouble.”
+
+“Well, you can have your revenge and five guineas besides,” Flash said.
+“But we must be there at the time. I should like him to know that I was
+at the bottom of his being caught.”
+
+They stood talking together for a few minutes, and then separated, Flash
+and his companion going back to a quiet lodging they had taken until
+they could finish their arrangements for disposing of their furniture
+and belongings before going abroad, while at the same time they finished
+plucking a country greenhorn they had met at a coffee house. Two days
+later, wrapped up in great coats, and with rough caps pulled down over
+their eyes, they entered the thieves' resort half an hour before Mark's
+usual time of getting there. A larger number of men than usual were
+assembled, and among them was Black Jim. The men were all talking
+excitedly, and were evidently furious at the news that the pugilist had
+just told them.
+
+“Those are the gents that have given me the office,” he said, as Flash
+and his companion entered. “They can tell yer he is one of that cursed
+Bow Street lot.”
+
+“That is right enough, my men,” Flash said. “He and four of his mates
+broke into a place where we were having a bit of play, three weeks
+since, marched us all away to Bow Street, and shut the place up. I don't
+know what he is down here for, but you may be sure that it's for no good
+to some of you. We owe him a heavy one ourselves. He came spying on us
+dressed up as a swell and spoilt our game, and got the darbies put on
+us, and we have sworn to get even with him.”
+
+“You will get even, don't you fear,” one of the men growled, “and more
+than even, strike me blind if you don't.”
+
+“Look here, lads,” Flash said. “There is one thing I say--don't use your
+knives on him; remember he is a runner, and no doubt his chief knows all
+that he is doing, and no doubt ordered him to come here. There will be
+a big search, you may be sure, when he don't turn up to make his report.
+So don't let's have any bloodshed. Let the thing be done quietly.”
+
+“We can chuck his body into the river,” one said.
+
+“Yes, but if it is picked up with half a dozen holes in it, you may be
+sure that they will be down here, and like enough every man who has used
+this place will be arrested; you know that when there are twenty men in
+a job the chances are that one will slip his neck out of the halter by
+turning King's evidence.”
+
+An angry growl went round the room.
+
+“Well, you know well enough it is so, it is always the case; besides, we
+ought to give him a little time to prepare himself. My idea is that the
+best plan will be to bind and gag him first, then we can hold a little
+court over him, and let him know what is coming. An hour later, when the
+place gets a bit quiet, we can carry him down to the river--it is not
+above fifty yards away--tie a heavy weight round his neck, cut his cords
+the last thing, and chuck him over; if his body is found, it will be
+thought it is that of some chap tired of life who took pains to drown
+himself pretty quickly, and there won't be any fuss over him, and there
+will be nothing to come upon any of you fellows for.”
+
+There was a general murmur of assent. Several of those present had
+already committed themselves to some extent with the supposed hawker,
+and were as eager as Flash himself that he should be killed; still,
+all felt that it was as well that it should be managed with the least
+possible risk of discovery, for while an ordinary man could be put
+out of the way without any trouble arising, the fact that he was a Bow
+Street runner added enormously to the risk of the discovery of his fate.
+
+There was a little talk, and then two of the men went out and brought
+back a couple of strong ropes. A few minutes after their return Mark
+Thorndyke came in. He paused as he entered the room, in surprise at the
+silence that reigned, for he was accustomed to be greeted with friendly
+exclamations. However, as he walked in the door closed, and then
+suddenly, with shouts of “Down with the spy!” the men sprang from their
+seats and made a sudden rush at him. For a minute the struggle was
+tremendous; man after man went down under Mark's blows, others clung
+onto him from behind, a rope was passed round his legs and pulled, and
+he fell down with a crash, bringing down five or six of his assailants;
+a minute later he was gagged and bound.
+
+While the struggle was going on no one noticed that a Lascar's face was
+pressed against the window; it disappeared as soon as Mark fell, and
+ten minutes later a dark faced sailor ran into Gibbons'; it was a quiet
+evening at Ingleston's, and Gibbons, after smoking a pipe with half a
+dozen of the pugilists, had just returned.
+
+“Hallo,” he said, as he opened the door, “what the deuce do you want?”
+
+The man was for a moment too breathless to answer.
+
+“You know Mr. Thorndyke,” he said at last, in very fair English.
+
+“Yes, I know him. Well, what of him?”
+
+“He has been attacked by a number of thieves in a public house near the
+river, at Westminster, and he will be murdered unless you go with others
+to help him.”
+
+“What the deuce was he doing there?” Gibbons muttered, and then, seizing
+his cap, said to the Lascar,
+
+“Come along with me; it aint likely that we shall be in time, but we
+will try, anyhow.”
+
+He ran to Ingleston's.
+
+“Come along, Ingleston,” he exclaimed, “and all of you. You all know
+Mr. Thorndyke. This man says he has been attacked by a gang down at
+Westminster, and will be murdered. I am afraid we shan't be in time, but
+it is worth trying.”
+
+The prize fighters all leaped to their feet. Mark had sparred with
+several of them, and, being open handed and friendly, was generally
+liked. In a moment, headed by Ingleston and Gibbons, they started at the
+top of their speed, and in less than a quarter of an hour were at bank
+side.
+
+“That is the house,” the sailor said, pointing to the public, where a
+red blind had been lowered at the window, and two men lounged outside
+the door to tell any chance customer that might come along he was not
+wanted there at present.
+
+Inside a mock trial had been going on, and Mark had been sentenced to
+death as a spy, not a voice being raised in his defense. As soon as he
+had been lifted up and seated so that he could see the faces of those
+present, he recognized the two gamblers, and saw at once that his fate
+was sealed; even had they not been there the chance of escape would have
+been small. The fact that one of the detectives had been caught under
+circumstances when there was but slight chance of its ever being known
+how he came to his end, was in itself sufficient to doom him. Several
+of the men present had taken him into their confidence, and he had
+encouraged them to do so, not that he wanted to entrap them, or that he
+intended to do so, but in order to obtain a clew through them as to the
+hiding place of the man he was in search of.
+
+The savage exultation on the faces of the two gamblers, however, was
+sufficient to extinguish any ray of hope. He felt sure at once that they
+had been the authors of his seizure, and that no thought of mercy would
+enter the minds of these two scoundrels whose plans he had frustrated,
+whose position he had demolished, and to whom he had caused the loss of
+a large sum of money. Neither Flash nor Emerson would have taken share
+in a crime known to so many had they not been on the point of leaving
+England. Their names were known to no one there, and even should some of
+these afterwards peach they would at least be safe. Mark had been asked
+whether he could deny that he was a member of the detective force, and
+had shaken his head. Even if he had told a lie, which he would not do,
+the lie would have been a useless one. No one would have believed it,
+for the two gamblers would have been witnesses that he was so.
+
+He had been placed in one corner of the room, so that what light there
+was would not fall on his face, and had anyone entered they would not
+have noticed that he was gagged. One, indeed, had suggested that it
+would be better to lay him under one of the benches, but Black Jim said,
+with a brutal laugh:
+
+“No, no; it is better that we should keep sight of him, and if anyone
+asks a question of course we can say that the gentleman has the
+toothache.”
+
+Presently Flash spoke to the ruffian in a low voice.
+
+“Yes, I think you are right,” he replied. “Look here,” he went on,
+raising his voice. “There is no occasion to have such a lot in this
+business; Jake Watson, Bill the Tinker, and me are quite enough to carry
+him to his bed. I reckon the rest had better make themselves scarce when
+the times comes, go home, and keep their mouths shut. I need not say
+that anyone who lets his tongue wag about it is likely to come to a
+worse end than this bloodhound. We will have another glass of grog
+before you turn out; the streets won't be quiet for another hour
+yet, and there is another guinea of this worthy hawker's to be spent.
+Summers, make another big bowl of punch. Don't put so much water in it
+as you did in the last.”
+
+The landlord, a notorious ruffian, was just coming into the room with a
+huge bowl when there was the sound of a scuffle outside.
+
+“You had better see what is up,” Black Jim said, and two of the men
+nearest the door unbarred and opened it. As they did so there was a
+rush, and eight powerful men ran in, knocking to the floor those who had
+opened the door. The rest sprang to their feet; Gibbons looked round,
+and as his eye fell upon Mark, who had, the moment the men inside rose,
+got into a standing position, Gibbons launched himself towards him,
+striking four of the ruffians who endeavored to stop him to the ground
+with his crushing blows.
+
+“This way,” he shouted to his friends. “Ingleston and Tring, do you keep
+the door.”
+
+The moment the six men had closed round Mark, one of them, taking
+out his knife, cut the cords, removed the bandage from his mouth, and
+extricated the gag. The name of the two prize fighters had created
+something like a panic among the crowd, which had increased when one of
+them shouted, “It is Charley Gibbons.”
+
+Flash and Emerson sprang to their feet with the rest, and the latter
+shouted, “Go at them, men; there are only eight of them, and we are
+twenty. Knife them, or you will all hang for this job.”
+
+The knowledge of their danger was evident to all the men, and, nerved by
+desperation, they rushed at the prize fighters; but the eight were now
+nine, and each of them in a fray of this kind was equal to half a dozen
+ordinary men. Scarce a word was spoken, but the sound of crushing blows
+and scuffling, and an occasional, oath, made a confused din in the half
+lighted room. Mark burst his way through his assailants to the spot
+where Flash and Emerson were standing, somewhat in the rear of the
+crowd, for they had been sitting at the other end of the room. Flash had
+a pistol in his hand, but the man who was standing in front of him was
+struck with such violence that he fell backwards, knocking Emerson
+to the ground and almost upsetting Flash, and before the latter could
+steady himself Mark struck him with all his force under the chin. A
+moment later the landlord blew out the two candles, and in the darkness
+the ruffians made a dash for the door, carried Tring and Ingleston off
+their feet, and rushed out into the lane.
+
+“If the man who blew those candles out don't light them again at once,”
+ Gibbons shouted, “I, Charley Gibbons, tell him that I will smash him and
+burn this place over his head; he had best be quick about it.”
+
+The landlord, cowed with the threat, soon returned with a candle from
+the kitchen, and lit those that he had extinguished.
+
+“Well, Mr. Thorndyke, we just arrived in time, I fancy,” Gibbons said.
+
+“You have saved my life, Gibbons--you and the others. How you got to
+know that I was here I cannot imagine. I would have been a dead man
+in another half hour if you had not arrived. I thank you all from the
+bottom of my heart.”
+
+“That is all right, sir,” Gibbons said. “It is a pleasure to give such
+scoundrels as these a lesson. Is anyone hurt? I fancy I have got a
+scratch or two.”
+
+Several of the men had been cut with knives, but the blows had been
+given so hurriedly that no one was seriously injured. Twelve men lay on
+the ground.
+
+“Now sir, what shall we do with these fellows?”
+
+“I should say we had better leave them alone, Gibbons. I don't want any
+row over the affair. It is the work of these two fellows here. I think I
+pretty well settled one of them.”
+
+Gibbons stooped over Flash.
+
+“You have broken his jaw, sir; but he will come round in time. I believe
+this other fellow is only shamming. I don't see any of our handiwork
+upon his face. The others have all got as much as they want, I think,”
+ and taking a candle he looked at their faces. “There is not one of them
+who will want to show up for a week or so,” he said, “and there are two
+or three who will carry the marks to their graves. Well, sir, if you
+don't want anything done to them, the sooner we are off the better.
+Those fellows who got away may bring a lot of others down upon us. As
+long as it is only fists, we could march through Westminster; but as
+they would have knives, it is just as well to get out of it before there
+is any trouble. You are got up in a rum way, Mr. Thorndyke.”
+
+“Yes; I will tell you about it afterwards. I agree with you that we had
+best be moving at once.”
+
+But the men who had fled were too glad to have made their escape to
+think of anything but to make for their dens as quick as possible,
+and the party passed through the lanes into the open space in front of
+Parliament House without interruption.
+
+“We will go up to your place, Ingleston, and talk it over there,” Mark
+said. “You can get those cuts bound up, and I shall be very glad to
+get a drink. That thing they shoved into my mouth hurt my tongue a good
+deal, and I have not gone through a pleasant half hour, I can tell you.”
+
+He walked up past Whitehall with Gibbons and Ingleston, the others
+going in pairs, so as not to attract attention. As soon as they reached
+Ingleston's place, the latter told the man in the bar to put the
+shutters up, led the way into the bar parlor, and mixed a large bowl of
+punch.
+
+“Now, Gibbons, in the first place,” Mark said, after quenching his
+thirst, “how did you know of my being in danger?”
+
+“Well, sir, a black sailor chap ran into my place suddenly and told me.”
+
+“Do you mean a colored man, Gibbons?”
+
+“Yes, sir, one of those Lascar chaps you see about the docks. I did not
+ask any questions, but ran as hard as I could. I had only left here five
+minutes before, and knew that Tring and some of the others would still
+be here. They did not lose a moment, and off we went. The sailor chap he
+kept ahead. I tried to come up to him two or three times to get to know
+something about it, but he always seemed to quicken his pace when I was
+coming up, and I soon got too blown to want to do much talking. He led
+us to the door, and after that I saw nothing more of him. What became
+of him I don't know. I expect he was better at running than he was at
+fighting.”
+
+“It is curious,” Mark said thoughtfully. “He might have been in the
+place when I went in, and slipped out while I was making a fight for it.
+I have seen a Lascar several times while I have been down there. I dare
+say it was the same man, though why he should take such trouble for the
+sake of a stranger I don't know. There seems to be a good many of them
+about, for now I think of it, I have run against them several times
+wherever I have been in town.”
+
+“Now, sir, what did they want to kill you for?”
+
+“Well, Gibbons, it happened in this way. My father, you know, was
+murdered by a man who had a grudge against him, and who is both a
+highwayman and a house breaker.”
+
+“They don't often go together,” Ingleston said. “The highwaymen
+generally look down upon the burglars and keep themselves to
+themselves.”
+
+“I hew they do, Ingleston; but this fellow has been a convict, and is
+not particular what he turns his hand to. The detectives have been
+after him for a long time, but have failed, and I determined to take the
+matter up myself, and ever since I have been up here I have been hunting
+about in the worst quarters of the town. The people of Bow Street have
+aided me in every way they could, and I suppose some of these men have
+seen me go in or out of the place. Of course, when I am going into these
+bad quarters, I put on a disguise and manage to get in with some of
+these thieves, and so to try to get news of him through them. Three
+weeks ago I decided to try Westminster. I was getting on uncommonly well
+there, principally because I gave a tremendous thrashing to a fellow
+they call Black Jim. He has been a prize fighter.”
+
+“I know him,” Tring said; “it was the fellow that was kicked out for
+selling a fight. He was not a bad man with his fists, either; but I
+expect you astonished him, Mr. Thorndyke.”
+
+“Yes, I knocked him out of time in three rounds. Well, he has been a
+bully down there, and everyone was very glad he was taken down. After
+that I got to know several of the worst lot down there. They fancied
+that I was one of themselves, and several of them made proposals to me
+to join them, and, of course, I encouraged the idea in hopes of coming
+upon the man that I was after. Then some fellow in the street recognized
+me, I suppose, and denounced me to the rest as being one of the runners.
+I suppose he told them this evening, before I went in.
+
+“The place was a regular thieves' den, which, of course, was why I
+went there. Naturally they were furious, especially those who had been
+proposing to me to join them. Anyhow, they had evidently settled among
+themselves that I was to be put out of the way, and directly I went in I
+was attacked. I knocked down a few of them, but they jumped on my back,
+and one of them managed to get a rope round my legs, and down I went
+with three or four of them, and before I could get up again they had
+tied and gagged me. Then they held a sort of court. Man after man got up
+and said that I had been drawing them on to find out what they were up
+to, and had agreed to join them, of course with the intention of getting
+them caught in the act, and two got up and said that they knew me as one
+of the runners. They all agreed that I must be put out of the way.
+
+“I suppose, as the landlord did not want blood spilt in his house, they
+did not knife me at once; however, they told me that they had decided
+that as soon as the coast was clear I should be carried down to the
+river, and chucked in, with an old anchor tied to my neck. I had just
+a gleam of hope a short time before you came in, for then it had been
+settled that it was just as well no more should be engaged in the affair
+than was necessary, and that Black Jim, with two others, whom I had
+been talking to, and the two men who had told them that I was a runner,
+should manage it, and the rest were to go off to their homes.
+
+“I had been all the time trying to loosen my ropes, and had got one of
+my hands nearly free, and I thought that if they waited another half
+hour I might have got them both free, and been able to make a bit of a
+fight of it, though I had very little hope of getting my legs free.
+
+“However, I had my eye on the knife of the man who was sitting next to
+me, and who was one of those who was to stay. I thought that if I had my
+hands free, I could snatch his knife, settle him, and then cut the ropes
+from my legs; that done, I could, I think, have managed Black Jim and
+the others. As for the men who denounced me, they were small men, and I
+had no fear of them in a fight, unless; as I thought likely enough, they
+might have pistols. One of them is the fellow whose jaw I broke; I hit
+him hard, for he had a pistol in his hand.”
+
+“There is no doubt you hit him hard,” Gibbons said dryly. “He looked a
+better sort than the rest.”
+
+“Yes, the fellow was a card sharper whom I once detected at cheating;
+and so was the one who was lying next to him, the man whom you said you
+thought was shamming.”
+
+By this time the men's wounds were all bandaged up. Mark told them that
+he would be round there again in the morning, and hoped that they would
+all be there.
+
+“I shall go home at once, and turn in,” he said. “Straining at those
+cords has taken the skin off my wrists, and I feel stiff all over; it
+will be a day or two, Gibbons, before I am able to put the gloves on
+again. I wish I could find that Lascar; I owe him a heavy debt.”
+
+As Mark made his way home he thought a good deal about the colored
+sailor. If the man had been in the den the ruffians would hardly have
+ventured to have attacked him in the presence of a stranger. Of course,
+he might have been passing, and have seen the fray through the window,
+but in that case he would run to the nearest constable. How could he
+know anything about his habits, and why should he have gone to Gibbons
+for assistance? That, and the fact that he had so often observed
+Lascars in the places he had gone to, certainly looked as if he had been
+watched, and if so, it could only be connected with those diamonds. It
+was a curious thing altogether.
+
+The next morning he went early to Bow Street. As soon as the chief came
+he related the events of the previous evening, and told him that it was
+Flash and Emerson who had denounced him.
+
+“I know the place,” the officer said. “It is one of the worst thieves'
+dens in London. However, it is just as well you decided not to take any
+steps. Of course, all the fellows would have sworn that they did not
+intend to do any harm, but that Flash had put them up to frightening
+you, and I doubt whether any jury would have convicted. As to the other
+men, we know that they are all thieves, and some of them worse; but the
+mere fact that they proposed to you to join in their crimes won't do,
+as no actual crime was committed. However, I shall have the gang closely
+watched, and, at any rate, you had better leave Westminster alone;
+someone else must take up the work of looking for that man you were
+on the watch for. Anyhow, you had best take a week's rest; there is
+no doubt you have had a very narrow escape. It is strange about that
+Lascar; he might not have cared for going in to take part in the fray,
+but you would have thought that he would have waited outside to get a
+reward for bringing those men to your rescue.”
+
+As Mark did not care to tell about the diamonds till the time came for
+getting them, he made no reply, beyond expressing an agreement with the
+chief's surprise at the man not having remained to the end of the fray.
+On leaving Bow Street he went up to Ingleston's. The men who had rescued
+him the night before were gathered there; and he presented each of them
+with a check for twenty-five guineas.
+
+“I know very well,” he said, “that you had no thought of reward when you
+hurried down to save me, but that is no reason why I should not show my
+gratitude to you for the service you have rendered me; some of you might
+very well have been seriously hurt, if not killed, by their knives. At
+any rate, I insist upon you taking it; money is always useful, you know,
+and it is not often so well earned as this.”
+
+The men were greatly pleased, and Tring said:
+
+“Well, sir, if you get into another scrape you may be sure that you can
+count upon us.”
+
+“I shall try and not get into any more,” Mark laughed. “This has been
+a good deal more serious than I had bargained for, and I shall be very
+careful in the future.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV.
+
+
+“The burglary season seems to have recommenced in earnest,” Mark's chief
+said some nine months after he had been at work. “For a time there had
+been a lull, as you know, but I have had three reports this week, and it
+strikes me that they are by the same hand as before; of course I may be
+mistaken, but they are done in a similar way, the only difference being
+that there is ground for believing that only one man is engaged in them.
+I fancy the fellow that you are after has either been away from London
+for some time, or has been keeping very quiet. At any rate, we have
+every ground for believing that he keeps himself aloof from London
+thieves, which is what I should expect from such a man. If one has nerve
+enough to do it, there is nothing like working singly; when two or
+three men are engaged, there is always the risk of one being caught
+and turning Queen's evidence, or of there being a quarrel, and of his
+peaching from revenge.
+
+“If your man has been away from town, he has certainly not been working
+any one district; of course, one gets the usual number of reports from
+different quarters; but although burglaries are frequent enough, there
+has been no complaint of a sudden increase of such crimes as there would
+have been judging from the numerous daring attempts here, had Bastow
+been concerned; therefore I feel sure that he has been living quietly.
+He would have his mate's share--that man you shot, you know--of the
+plunder they made together; he would know that after that affair at your
+place there would be a vigilant hunt for him, and it is likely enough
+that he has retired altogether from business for a time.
+
+“However, men of that sort can never stand a quiet life long, and are
+sure sooner or later to take to their trade again, if only for the sake
+of its excitement. Now that the burglaries have begun again, I shall
+be glad if you will devote yourself entirely to this business. You have
+served a good apprenticeship, and for our sake as well as yours I should
+be glad for you to have it in hand.”
+
+“I shall be very pleased to do so, sir. Although we do not know where he
+is to be found, I think I can say that it is not in the slums of
+London; it seems to me that he may be quietly settled as an eminently
+respectable man almost under our noses; he may show himself occasionally
+at fashionable resorts, and may be a regular attendant at horse races.
+
+“He would not run any appreciable risk in doing so, for his face is
+quite unknown to anyone except the constables who were present at his
+trial, and even these would scarcely be likely to recognize him, for he
+was then but eighteen, while he is now six or seven and twenty, and no
+doubt the life he has led must have changed him greatly.”
+
+“I quite agree with you,” the chief said. “After the first hunt for him
+was over, he might do almost anything without running much risk. Well,
+I put the matter in your hands, and leave it to you to work out in your
+own way; you have given ample proof of your shrewdness and pluck, and
+in this case especially I know that you will do everything that is
+possible. Of course you will be relieved of all other duties, and if it
+takes you months before you can lay hands upon him, we shall consider it
+time well spent, if you succeed at last. From time to time change your
+quarters, but let me know your address, so that, should I learn anything
+that may be useful, I can communicate with you at once. You had better
+take another name than that by which you are known in the force. I shall
+be glad if, after thinking the matter over, you will write me a few
+lines stating what you propose to do in the first place.”
+
+Mark went back to his lodgings, and sat there for some time, thinking
+matters over. His first thought was to attend the races for a time, but
+seeing the number of people there, and his own ignorance of Bastow's
+appearance, he abandoned the idea, and determined to try a slower but
+more methodical plan. After coming to that conclusion he put on his hat
+and made his way to Mrs. Cunningham's.
+
+“Well, Mr. Constable,” Millicent said saucily, as he entered, “any fresh
+captures?”
+
+“No, I think that I have for the present done with that sort of thing; I
+have served my apprenticeship, and am now setting up on my own account.”
+
+“How is that, Mark?”
+
+“There is reason to believe that Bastow has begun his work again near
+London. As I have told you, it is absolutely certain that he is not
+hiding in any of the places frequented by criminals here, and there
+is every reason for supposing that he has been leading a quiet life
+somewhere, or that he has been away in the country. As long as that was
+the case, there was nothing to be done; but now that he seems to have
+set to work again, it is time for me to be on the move. I have seen the
+chief this morning, and he has released me from all other' duty, and
+given me carte blanche to work in my own way.”
+
+“Then why don't you leave the force altogether, Mark? You know that I
+have always thought it hateful that you should be working under orders,
+like any other constable.”
+
+“Of course, women don't like to be under orders, Millicent; but men are
+not so independent, and are quite content to obey those who are well
+qualified to give orders. I have had a very interesting time of it.”
+
+“Very interesting!” she said scornfully. “You have nearly been killed
+or shot half a dozen times; you have been obliged to wear all sorts of
+dirty clothes, to sleep in places where one would not put a dog, and
+generally to do all sorts of things altogether unbecoming in your
+position.”
+
+“My dear, I have no particular position,” he laughed, and then went on
+more seriously: “My one position at present is that of avenger of
+my father's murder, and nothing that can assist me in the task is
+unbecoming to me; but, as I said, it has been interesting, I may almost
+say fascinating, work. I used to be fond of hunting, but I can tell you
+that it is infinitely more exciting to hunt a man than it is to hunt a
+fox. You are your own hound, you have to pick up the scent, to follow
+it up, however much the quarry may wind and double, and when at last you
+lay your hand upon his shoulder and say, 'In the King's name,' there is
+an infinitely keener pleasure than there is when the hounds run down
+the fox. One sport is perhaps as dangerous as the other: in the one case
+your horse may fail at a leap and you may break your neck, in the other
+you may get a bullet in your head; so in that respect there is not much
+to choose between man and fox hunting. There is the advantage, though,
+that in the one you have to depend upon your horse's strength, and in
+the other on your own courage.”
+
+“I know that you are an enthusiast over it, Mark, and I can fancy that
+if I were a big strong man, as you are, I might do the same; but if you
+are going now to try by yourself, why should you not leave the force
+altogether?”
+
+“Because, in the first place, I shall get all the information they
+obtain, and can send for any assistance that I may require. In the next
+place, by showing this little staff with its silver crown, I show that
+I am a Bow Street runner, and can obtain information at once from all
+sorts of people which I could not get without its aid.”
+
+“Well, I won't say anything more against it, Mark. How are you going to
+begin?”
+
+“I mean to go the round of all the places near London--say, within ten
+miles. I shall stay from a week to a fortnight in each, take a quiet
+lodging, give out that I am on the lookout for a small house with a
+garden, and get to talk with people of all kinds.”
+
+“But I cannot see what you have to inquire for.”
+
+“I imagine that Bastow will have taken just the sort of house that I am
+inquiring for, and in the course of my questions I may hear of someone
+living in just that sort of way--a retired life, not making many
+friends, going up to London sometimes, and keeping, perhaps, a deaf old
+woman as a servant, or perhaps a deaf old man--someone, you see, who
+would not be likely to hear him if he came home in the middle of the
+night, or in the early morning. Once I hear of such a man, I should
+ascertain his age, and whether generally he agreed in appearance with
+what Bastow is likely to be by this time, then get down one of the
+constables who was at the trial, and take his opinion on the subject,
+after which we should only have to watch the house at night and pounce
+upon him as he came back from one of his excursions. That is the broad
+outline of my plan. I cannot help thinking that in the long run I shall
+be able to trace him, and of course it will make it all the easier if he
+takes to stopping coaches or committing murderous burglaries.”
+
+“Then I suppose we are not going to see you often, Mark?”
+
+“Well, not so often as you have done, Millicent, for some time, at any
+rate. I shall not be more than five or six miles away, and I shall often
+ride into town for the evening, and return late with some sort of hope
+that I may be stopped on the road again; it would save me a world of
+trouble, you see, if he would come to me instead of my having to find
+him.”
+
+“Which side of London are you going to try first?”
+
+“The south side, certainly; there are a score of places that would be
+convenient to him--Dulwich, Clapham, Tooting, Wimbledon, Stockwell; the
+list is a long one. I should say Wimbledon was about the most distant,
+and I should think that he would not go so far as that; if he only acted
+as a highwayman he might be as far off as Epsom; but if he is really the
+man concerned in these burglaries he must be but a short distance away.
+He would hardly risk having to ride very far with the chance of coming
+upon the patrols. I think that I shall begin at Peckham; that is a
+central sort of position, and from there I shall work gradually west;
+before I do so perhaps I shall try Lewisham. He is likely, in any case,
+to be quite on the outskirts of any village he may have settled in, in
+order that he may ride in and out at any hour without his coming and
+going being noticed.”
+
+“You certainly seem to have thought it over in all ways, Mark; you
+almost infect me with your ardor, and make me wish that I was a man and
+could help you.”
+
+“You are much nicer as you are, Millicent.”
+
+The girl tossed her head in disdain at the compliment.
+
+“It is all very well, Mark,” she went on, ignoring his speech, “but it
+seems to me that in finding out things a woman would be able to do
+just as much as a man; she can gossip with her neighbors and ask about
+everyone in a place quite as well, if not better, than a man.”
+
+“Yes I don't doubt that,” Mark laughed, “and if I want your aid I shall
+have no hesitation in asking for it. Until then I hope you will go on
+with your painting and harping steadily, like a good little girl.”
+
+“I am nearly eighteen, sir, and I object to be called a good little
+girl.”
+
+“Well, if I were to say a good young woman you would not like it.”
+
+“No, I don't think I should. I don't know why, but when anyone says a
+girl is a good young woman or a nice young woman, there always seems
+something derogatory about it; it is almost as bad as saying she is a
+very respectable young person, which is odious.”
+
+“Then, you see,” he went on, “you are quite getting on in society; since
+Mr. Cotter's introduction to Mrs. Cunningham and his mother's subsequent
+call you have got to know a good many people and go about a good deal.”
+
+“Yes, it has been more lively of late,” she admitted. “At first it was
+certainly monstrously dull here, and I began to think that we should
+have to change our plans and go down again to Weymouth, and settle there
+for a time. Now I am getting contented; but I admit, even at the risk of
+making you conceited, that we shall certainly miss you very much, as
+you have been very good, considering how busy you have been, to come in
+three or four evenings every week for a chat.”
+
+“There has been nothing very good about it, Millicent; it has been very
+pleasant to me; it is like a bit of old times again when I am here with
+you two, and seem to leave all the excitement of one's work behind as I
+come in at the door.”
+
+“I wonder whether the old time will ever come back again, Mark?” she
+said sadly.
+
+“It never can be quite the old time again, but when you are back at the
+old place it may be very near it.”
+
+She looked at him reproachfully.
+
+“You think that I shall change my mind, Mark, but at heart you know
+better. The day I am one and twenty I hope to carry out my intentions.”
+
+“Well, as I have told you before, Millicent, I cannot control your
+actions, but I am at least master of my own. You can give away Crowswood
+to whom you like, but at least you cannot compel me to take it. Make it
+over to one of the hospitals if you like--that is within your power; but
+it is not in your power to force me into the mean action of enriching
+myself because you have romantic notions in your mind. I should scorn
+myself were I capable of doing such an action. I wonder you think so
+meanly of me as to suppose for a moment that I would do so.”
+
+“It is a great pity my father did not leave the property outright to
+your father, then all this bother would have been avoided,” she said
+quietly. “I should still have had plenty to live upon without there
+being any fear of being loved merely for my money.”
+
+“It would have been the same thing if he had,” Mark said stubbornly.
+“My father would not have taken it, and I am sure that I should not have
+taken it after him; you are his proper heiress. I don't say if he had
+left a son, and that son had been a second Bastow, that one would have
+hesitated, for he would probably have gambled it away in a year, the
+tenants might have been ruined, and the village gone to the dogs.
+Every man has a right to disinherit an unworthy son, but that is a very
+different thing from disinheriting a daughter simply from a whim. Well,
+don't let us talk about it any more, Millicent. It is the only thing
+that we don't agree about, and therefore it is best left alone.”
+
+The next day Mark established himself at an inn in Peckham, and for six
+weeks made diligent inquiries, but without success. There were at least
+a dozen men who lived quietly and rode or drove to their business in
+town. Many of them were put aside as needing no investigation, having
+been residents there for years. Some of the others he saw start or
+return, but none of them corresponded in any way with the probable
+appearance of the man for whom he was in search. During this time he
+heard of several private coaches being held up on the road between Epsom
+and London, and three burglaries took place at Streatham.
+
+He then moved to Stockwell. Before proceeding there he had his horse
+up again from Crowswood, and rode into Stockwell from the west. He was
+dressed now as a small country squire, and had a valise strapped behind
+his saddle. The inn there was a busy one.
+
+“I want a room,” he said, as he alighted. “I shall probably stay here a
+few days.”
+
+Presently he had a talk with the landlord.
+
+“I am on the lookout,” he said, “for a little place near town. I have
+come in for a small estate in the country, but I have no taste for
+farming, and want to be within easy reach of town, and at the same
+time to have a place with a paddock where I can keep my horse and live
+quietly. I don't much care whether it is here or anywhere else within
+a few miles of town, and I intend to ride about and see if I can find a
+place that will suit me. I do not want to be nearer the town than this,
+for I have not money enough to go the pace; still, I should like to be
+near enough to ride or walk in whenever I have a fancy for it.”
+
+“I understand, sir. Of course there are plenty of places round here,
+at Clapham and Tooting, and I may say Streatham, but most of them are
+a deal too large for a bachelor, still I have no doubt you would find a
+place to suit you without much difficulty. These sort of places are most
+in request by London tradesmen who have given up business and want to
+get a little way out of town and keep a gig. I should say there must be
+a score of such people living round here. I am often asked about such
+places, but I don't know of one to let just at the present moment.
+
+“Still, there ought to be, for of late people have not cared so much
+to come out here; there has been such a scare owing to highwaymen and
+burglars, that men with wives and families don't fancy settling out of
+town, though there aint much work about it, for to every one house that
+is broken into there are thousands that are not, and besides, the houses
+that these fellows try are large places, where there is plenty of silver
+plate and a few gold watches, and perhaps some money to be had.”
+
+Mark soon made the acquaintance of the stablemen, and a few pints of
+beer put them on good terms with him. Every day he took rides round the
+neighborhood, going out early, stabling his horse, and after having a
+chat with the ostlers, strolling round the place. Clapham, Ewell, and
+Streatham were also visited.
+
+“I know of a place that would just suit you,” the ostler at the
+Greyhound at Streatham said to him, on the occasion of his third visit
+there; “but it is let; my old mother is the gentleman's housekeeper.
+He took the place through me, for he rode up just as you have done, one
+afternoon, nigh a year ago. He was from town, he was; he told me that
+he had been going the pace too hard, and had to pull in, and wanted a
+little place where he could keep his horse and live quiet for a time. I
+told him of a place that I thought would suit him just outside the town,
+and he called in the next day and told me he had taken it. 'Now,' he
+said, 'I want a woman as house keeper; an old woman, you know. I cannot
+be bothered with a young one. If you speak a civil word to a wench she
+soon fancies you are in love with her. I want one who can cook a chop or
+a steak, fry me a bit of bacon, and boil an egg and keep the place tidy.
+I intend to look after my horse myself.'
+
+“'Well, sir,' I said, 'there is my old mother. She is a widow, and it
+is as much as she can do to keep off the parish. She is reckoned a tidy
+cook and a good cleaner, and she could keep herself well enough if it
+wasn't that she is so hard of hearing that many people don't care to
+employ her.'
+
+“'I don't care a rap about that,' he said. 'I shall not need to talk to
+her except to tell her what I will have for dinner, and if she is deaf
+she won't want to be away gossiping. Does she live near here?'
+
+“'She lives in the town,' I said. 'I can fetch her down in half an
+hour.'
+
+“'That will do,' says he. 'I am going to have lunch. When I have, done I
+will come out and speak with her.'
+
+“Well, sir, he engaged her right off, and he tipped me a guinea for
+finding the place for him, and there he has been ever since. It was a
+lucky job for mother, for she says there never was a gentleman that gave
+less trouble. He is a wonderful quiet man, and in general stops at home
+all the day smoking and reading. He has a boy comes in two or three
+times a week to work in the garden. Sometimes of an evening he rides up
+to town. I expect he cannot keep away from the cards altogether.”
+
+“Is he an elderly man?” Mark asked.
+
+“Lor', no, sir; under thirty, I should say. He is a free handed sort of
+chap, and though he aint particular about his eating, he likes a bottle
+of good wine, the old woman says, even if it is only with a chop. He
+never rides past here and I happen to be outside without tossing me a
+shilling to drink his health.”
+
+Mark went into the house and ordered lunch. It would not have done to
+have asked any more questions or to have shown any special interest in
+the matter, but he felt so excited that he could not have avoided doing
+so had he waited longer with the ostler. After he had finished his meal
+he strolled out again into the stable yard.
+
+“Well,” he said to the ostler, “can't you put me up to another good
+thing, just as you told that gentleman you were speaking to me about?”
+
+“There are two or three places that I know of that might suit you, sir.
+There is a house on the hill. I know that it has got a paddock, but I
+don't know how big it is; it is in general known as Hawleys--that is the
+name of the last people who lived there. Anyone will tell you which is
+the house. Then there is another place. You turn to the right the third
+turning on the hill; it stands by itself two or three hundred yards
+down; it has got a goodish bit of ground. There is only one house beyond
+it; that is the one where my mother lives. That was an old farm once,
+but this was built later. I believe the ground belonged to the farm. You
+will know it by a big tree in front of it; it stands back forty feet or
+so from the road.”
+
+“Where does the road lead to?”
+
+“Well, sir, it aint much of a road beyond the next house; it is only
+a lane, but you can get through that way into the main road, through
+Tooting down into Balham, and on to Wimbledon.”
+
+“'I think I will go and have a look at both those places,” Mark said.
+
+“Will you take your horse, sir?”
+
+“No; I suppose it is not much above half a mile?”
+
+“About that, sir.”
+
+“Then I will walk; I shall not be likely to find anyone to hold my horse
+there.”
+
+Mark had no difficulty in finding the house. It looked as if it had been
+untenanted for some time, and in the window was a notice that for keys
+and information applications were to be made at a shop in the High
+Street. Well pleased to find that there was no one in the house, Mark
+entered the gate and passed round into what at one time had been a
+kitchen garden behind it; at the bottom of this was a field of three or
+four acres.
+
+The ground was separated by a hedge from that of the house beyond. This
+was fully a hundred yards away. A well bred horse was grazing in the
+field, a man smoking a pipe was watching a boy doing gardening work
+behind the house. Mark remained for nearly an hour concealed behind
+the hedge in hopes that he would come nearer. At the end of that time,
+however, he went into the house, and after waiting another ten minutes
+Mark also left, resisting the temptation to walk along the road and take
+a closer look at it, for he felt that such a step would be dangerous,
+for should the man notice anyone looking at the place his suspicions
+might be aroused.
+
+It was evident that the lane was very little used; in many cases the
+grass grew across it. There were marks of horses' feet, but none of
+wheels, and he concluded that when going up to town the man came that
+way and rode quietly through Streatham, for the hoof prints all pointed
+in that direction, and that on his return at night he came up the lane
+from the other road.
+
+“Well, master, what do you think of the houses?” the ostler asked on his
+return to the inn.
+
+“I have only been to the one in the lane that you spoke of, for I want
+to get back to town. I had a good look at it, but it is rather a dreary
+looking place, and evidently wants a lot of repairs before it can
+be made comfortable. The next time that I am down I will look at the
+other.”
+
+Mounting his horse, he rode at a rapid pace into London, and dismounted
+at Bow Street.
+
+“You have news, I see, Mr. Thorndyke,” the chief said when he entered.
+
+“I have, sir; I believe that I have marked the man down; at any rate, if
+it is not he, it is a criminal of some sort--of that I have no doubt.”
+
+“That is good news indeed,” the chief said. “Now tell me all about it.”
+
+Mark repeated the story the ostler had told him, and the result of his
+own observations.
+
+“You see,” he said, “the man, whether Bastow or not, has clearly taken
+the place for the purpose of concealment, for he can approach it by
+the lane, which is a very unfrequented one, on his return from his
+expeditions. He has taken on a deaf old woman who will not hear him ride
+in at night, and will have no idea at what hours he comes home. Riding
+out through the main street in the afternoon he would excite no notice,
+and the story to the ostler would very well account for his taking the
+house and for his habit of coming up here of an afternoon and returning
+late. I thought it best to come back and tell you, and I will adopt any
+plan that you suggest for his capture.”
+
+“You say that he has been there for nearly a year?”
+
+“About a year, the ostler said.”
+
+“Then one of my men, at least, must have been very careless not to
+have found him out long ago. Let me see;” and he took down a volume of
+reports. “Streatham. Tomlinson has been here a fortnight making every
+inquiry. 'No man of suspicious appearance or of unknown antecedents
+here.'
+
+“Humph! That is not the first time that Tomlinson has failed altogether
+in his duty. However, that does not matter for the moment. What is your
+own idea, Mr. Thorndyke?”
+
+“My idea is that a couple of good men should go down with me to
+Streatham, and that we should be always on the watch in High Street
+until we see him ride past. Directly it is dark we will go to his house,
+fasten the old woman up, and search it thoroughly. If we find stolen
+property so much the better; but in any case we shall wait inside the
+house until he returns, and as he comes in throw ourselves upon him
+before he has time to draw a pistol. I should say it would be as well
+the men should go down in a trap. There is an empty house next door, and
+when we go to search the place we can leave the horse and trap inside
+the gate. Directly we have him secure we can fetch up the trap, put him
+in, and one of the men and myself can drive him back here, leaving the
+other in charge of the house, which can then be searched again next
+day.”
+
+“I think that will be a very good plan, and will avoid all unnecessary
+fuss. I will send Malcolm and Chester down with you tomorrow. Where will
+you meet them?”
+
+“I should say that they had better put up at the Greyhound. I don't
+suppose he will go out until six or seven o'clock, but they had better
+be there earlier. One should station himself in the main street, the
+other concealing himself somewhere beyond the fellow's house, for it is
+likely enough that sometimes he may take the other way. I will go down
+to the Greyhound at six, and will wait there until one of them brings me
+news that he has left.”
+
+“I think you had better come in in the morning, and give your
+instructions to the men; there will be less fear of any mistake being
+made. I should say you had better put your horse up and come here on
+foot; one can never be too careful when one is dealing with so crafty
+a rogue as this; he certainly does not work with an accomplice, but for
+all that he may have two or three sharp boys in his pay, and they may
+watch this place by turns and carry him news of any stir about the
+office.”
+
+“I will walk in,” Mark replied. “It is no distance from Stockwell.”
+
+Mark slept but little that night. He had believed all along that he
+should be finally successful, but the discovery had come so suddenly
+that it had taken him completely by surprise. It might not be the man,
+and he tried hard to persuade himself that the chances were against his
+being so, so that he should not feel disappointed should it turn out
+that it was some other criminal, for that the man was a criminal he had
+not a shadow of doubt.
+
+The next morning he was at the office early. The chief arrived half an
+hour later, and the two officers were at once called in.
+
+“You will go with Mr. Thorndyke,” the chief said, “and he will give you
+instructions. The capture is a very important one, and there must be no
+mistake made. We believe the man to be Bastow. I think you were present
+at his trial, Chester; he escaped from Sydney Convict Prison some
+three years ago, and is, I believe, the author of many of the highway
+robberies and burglaries that have puzzled us so. Of course, you will
+take firearms, but if he is alone you will certainly have no occasion
+to use them, especially as you will take him completely by surprise.
+You will order a gig from Morden, and leave here about three o'clock. I
+should say you had better get up as two countrymen who have been up
+to market. However, Mr. Thorndyke will explain the whole matter to you
+fully.”
+
+Mark then went off with the two officers to a private room, and went
+into the whole matter with them.
+
+“I think, Chester,” he said, “that you had better watch in the High
+Street, because you know the man. At least, you have seen him, and may
+recognize him again.”
+
+“I think I should know him, however much he has changed. I took
+particular notice of him at the trial, and thought what a hardened
+looking young scamp he was. It is very seldom I forget a face when once
+I have a thorough look at it, and I don't think I am likely to forget
+his.”
+
+“Malcolm, I think you cannot do better than take your place in the
+garden of the house next to his; it is a place that has stood empty for
+many months, and there is no chance of anyone seeing you. His paddock
+comes up to the garden, and you can, by placing yourself in the corner,
+see him as he comes out into the lane. As soon as you see that he has
+gone, come back to the Greyhound with the news. I shall be there, and
+you will pick up Chester in the High Street as you come along; of course
+you won't pretend to know me, but the mere fact of your coming back will
+be enough to tell me that he has gone. As soon as it gets dark we will
+pay our reckoning, and drive off in the gig, leaving it in the drive in
+front of the house this side of his. I shall have strolled off before,
+and shall be waiting for you there. If he does not come out by ten
+o'clock we can give it up for tonight. You had better say that you have
+changed your mind, and will take beds at the Greyhound; and the next
+morning drive off in your gig and put up again at the inn at the other
+end of the town, the White Horse. I will come over again at two o'clock
+in the afternoon. You will bring handcuffs, and you had better also
+bring a stout rope to tie him with.”
+
+When every detail had been arranged, Mark strolled to Dick Chetwynd's
+lodgings.
+
+“Well, Mark what has become of you? I have not seen you for the last two
+months, and I hear that you have not been near Ingleston's crib since I
+saw you.”
+
+“No, I have been away on business. You know I told you that I was
+spending much of my time in endeavoring to hunt down my father's
+murderer. I can tell you now that I have been working all the time with
+the Bow Street people, and I think I know every thieves' slum in London
+as well as any constable in the town.”
+
+“You don't say so, Mark! Well, I should not like such work as that. The
+prize fighters are a pretty rough lot, but to go to such dens as those
+is enough to make one shudder. But that does not explain where you have
+been now.”
+
+“No. Well, having persuaded myself at last that his headquarters were
+not in town, I have been trying the villages round, and I believe that I
+have laid my hands on him at last.”
+
+“You don't say so, Mark! Well, I congratulate you heartily, both on your
+having caught the fellow and for having got rid of such horrid work.
+Where is he? Have you got him lodged in jail?”
+
+“No, we are going to capture him tonight; or if not tonight, tomorrow
+night. Two of the Bow Street officers are going down with me, and we
+shall have him as he comes home from one of his expeditions either on
+the highway or as a house breaker. If he does not go this evening we
+shall wait until tomorrow, but at any rate, the first time that he goes
+out we shall have him.”
+
+“I have got a special engagement for this evening, Mark, or I would
+offer to go with you and lend you a hand, if necessary.”
+
+“There is no occasion for that, Dick. We shall take the fellow by
+surprise as he goes into his own house, and have him handcuffed before
+he can draw a pistol. Then, when we have got him fairly tied up, we
+shall put him into a light cart that we shall have handy, and bring him
+straight to Bow Street. To tell you the truth, I am so excited over the
+thought that I do not know how I should have got through the day if I
+had not come in to have a chat with you.”
+
+“I can quite understand that, old fellow. Well, the best thing we can do
+is to take a stroll out and look at the fashions. It is early yet, but
+just at present it is all the rage to turn out early. It will do me
+good too, for I was at Ingleston's last night, and the smoke and row has
+given me a headache. I shall really have to give up going there, except
+when there is an important fight on. It is too much to stand, and the
+tobacco is so bad that I am obliged to keep a suit of clothes for the
+purpose. Let us be off at once.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI.
+
+
+At four o'clock Mark put up his horse at the Greyhound, and chatted for
+a quarter of an hour with the ostler, who had been making inquiries,
+and had heard of one or two other houses in the neighborhood which were
+untenanted. Mark then strolled up the town, exchanging a passing
+glance with Chester, who, in a velveteen coat, low hat and gaiters, was
+chatting with a wagoner going with a load of hay for the next morning's
+market in London. He turned into an inn, called for a pint of the best
+port, and sat down in the parlor at a table close to the window, so that
+he could see all who went up or down. He entered into conversation with
+two or three people who came in, and so passed the time till seven, when
+he felt too restless to sit still longer, and went out into the street.
+
+When he was halfway to the Greyhound he heard the sound of a horse's
+hoofs behind him, and saw a quietly dressed man coming along at an easy
+trot. Had it not been that he recognized the horse, he could not have
+felt sure that its rider was the man whose coming he had been waiting
+for, there being nothing in his appearance that would excite the
+slightest suspicion that he was other than a gentleman of moderate means
+and quiet taste, either returning from a ride or passing through on his
+way to town. He had a well built and active figure, carried himself with
+the ease of a thorough horseman, and nodded to one or two persons of his
+acquaintance, and checking his horse at the principal butcher's, ordered
+some meat to be sent in that evening.
+
+Mark could trace no resemblance in the face to that of the young fellow
+he remembered. It was a quiet and resolute one. If this were Bastow,
+he had lost the sneering and insolent expression that was so strongly
+impressed on his memory. It might be the man, but if so, he was greatly
+changed. Mark's first impression was that it could not be Bastow; but
+when he thought over the years of toil and confinement in the convict
+prison, the life he had led in the bush, and the two years he had passed
+since he returned home, he imagined that the insolence of youth might
+well have disappeared, and been succeeded by the resolute daring and
+dogged determination that seemed to be impressed on this fellow's face.
+
+Mark paused fifty yards before he reached the inn. In a few minutes he
+saw Chester coming along. There was no one else in sight.
+
+“Is it Bastow?” he asked, as the officer came up.
+
+“It's Bastow sure enough, sir. But he is so changed that if I had not
+had him in my mind I should not have recognized him. I calculate that a
+man who has gone through what he has would have lost the expression he
+had as a boy. He must have learnt a lot in the convict prison, and
+the fact that he headed the mutiny and escaped from the searchers and
+managed to get home showed that he must have become a resolute and
+desperate man. All those burglaries, and the way in which he has several
+times stopped coaches single handed, show his nerve and coolness. I had
+all that in my mind as he came along, and his face was pretty much as I
+expected to see it. He is a cool hand, and I can understand how he has
+given us the slip so long. There is none of the shifty look about his
+eyes that one generally sees in criminals, no glancing from side to
+side; he rode with the air of a man who had a right to be where he was,
+and feared no one. He will be an awkward customer to tackle if we do not
+take him by surprise.”
+
+“Yes, I agree with you there. However, he won't have much chance of
+using either his pistols or his strength. Here is Malcolm coming, so I
+will walk away for a few minutes, and let you go in first. You can tell
+the ostler now that you will have your horse put in at nine o'clock. I
+have been thinking, by the way, that we had better take the trap round
+behind the house instead of leaving it in the drive. The man may come
+back this way, and if so, he might hear the horse stamp or make some
+movement, and that would at once put him on his guard.”
+
+As the officers entered the inn Mark went into the yard and told the
+ostler that he had met some friends, and should let his horse remain
+there for the night.
+
+“It is possible that they may drive me into the town in the morning,” he
+said; “and I shall very likely send a man down for the horse.”
+
+At a quarter to nine he went out again, and walked to the house he had
+before visited; in ten minutes he heard the sound of wheels, threw open
+the gate, and the men, jumping down, led the horse in.
+
+“You may as well take him out of the trap,” he said. “We cannot very
+well get that round the house, but there is no difficulty about taking
+the horse.”
+
+The officers had brought a halter and a nosebag full of corn. The horse
+was fastened to a tree with soft ground round it, the nosebag put on,
+and a horse cloth thrown over its back; then Mark and his two companions
+went out into the lane, and in a couple of minutes entered the next
+gate, treading lightly, and going round to the back of the house.
+
+A light burned in the kitchen, and an old woman could be seen knitting.
+They lifted the latch and walked in. Dropping her knitting, she rose
+with an exclamation of terror.
+
+Mark advanced alone.
+
+“Do not be frightened,” he said; “we are not going to do you any harm.”
+ He took out his little ebony staff. “We are constables,” he went on,
+“and have orders to search this house. We must secure you, but you will
+be released in the morning. Now, which is your room?”
+
+In spite of Mark's assurance, the old woman was almost paralyzed with
+terror. However, the two constables assisted her up to her room, and
+there secured her with a rope, taking care that it was not so tightly
+bound as to hurt her. Then they placed a gag in her mouth, and left her.
+
+“Now let us search his room in the first place,” Mark said, when they
+came downstairs again. “I hardly expect we shall find anything. You may
+be sure that he will have taken great pains to hide away any booty that
+he may have here, and that it will need daylight and a closer search
+than we can give the place now, before we find anything.”
+
+The search of the house was indeed fruitless. They cut open the bed,
+prized up every loose board in the bedroom and the parlor, lifted the
+hearth stone, tapped the walls, and searched every drawer; then, taking
+a lantern, went out into the stable. The officers were both accustomed
+to look for hiding places, and ran their hands along on the top of the
+walls, examining the stone flooring and manger.
+
+“That is a very large corn bin,” Mark said, as he looked round, when
+they desisted from the search.
+
+“You are right, sir. We will empty it.”
+
+There were two or three empty sacks on the ground near it, and they
+emptied the corn into these, so that there should be no litter about.
+Chester gave an exclamation of disappointment as they reached the
+bottom. Mark put his hand on the bin and gave it a pull.
+
+“It is just as I thought,” he said. “It is fastened down. I saw an ax in
+the woodshed, Malcolm; just fetch it here.”
+
+While the man was away Mark took the lantern and examined the bottom
+closely. “We shan't want the ax,” he said, as he pointed out to Chester
+a piece of string that was apparently jammed in the form of a loop
+between the bottom and side. “Just get in and clear those few handfuls
+of corn out. I think you will see that it will pull up then.”
+
+There was, however, no movement in the bottom when Mark pulled at the
+loop.
+
+“Look closely round outside,” he said, handing Malcolm, who had
+now returned, the lantern. “I have no doubt that there is a catch
+somewhere.”
+
+In a minute or two the constable found a small ring between two of the
+cobblestones close to the foot of the wall. He pulled at it, and as
+he did so Mark felt the resistance to his pull cease suddenly, and the
+bottom of the bin came up like a trapdoor.
+
+“That is a clever hiding place,” he said. “If I had not happened to
+notice that the bin was fixed we might have had a long search before we
+found it here.”
+
+Below was a square hole, the size of the bin; a ladder led down into it.
+Mark, with a lantern, descended. Four or five sacks piled on each other
+lay at the bottom, leaving just room enough for a man to stand beside
+them.
+
+“The top one is silver by the feel,” he said, “not yet broken up; these
+smaller sacks are solid. I suppose it is silver that has been melted
+down. This--” and he lifted a bag some eighteen inches deep, opened it,
+and looked in “--contains watches and jewels. Now I think we will leave
+things here for the present, and put everything straight. He may be back
+before long.”
+
+Mark ascended, the bottom of the trap was shut down again, the corn
+poured in, and the bags thrown down on the spot from which they had been
+taken. They returned to the house, shut the door, and extinguished the
+light.
+
+“That has been a grand find,” he said; “even if this is not Bastow, it
+will be a valuable capture.”
+
+“That it will, Mr. Thorndyke. I have no doubt that this fellow is
+the man we have been in search of for the last eighteen months; that
+accounts for our difficulty in laying hold of him. He has been too
+crafty to try to sell any of his plunder, so that none of the fences
+have known anything about him. No doubt he has taken sufficient cash to
+enable him to live here quietly. He intended some time or other to melt
+down all the rest of the plate and to sell the silver, which he could do
+easily enough. As for the watches and jewels, he could get rid of them
+abroad.”
+
+“No doubt that is what he intended,” Mark agreed. “It is not often these
+fellows are as prudent as he has been; if they were, your work would be
+a good deal more difficult than it is.”
+
+“You are right, sir; I don't know that I ever heard of such a case
+before. The fellow almost deserves to get away.”
+
+“That would be rewarding him too highly for his caution,” Mark laughed.
+“He is a desperate villain, and all the more dangerous for being a
+prudent one. Now, I think one of us had better keep watch at the gate by
+turns. We shall hear him coming in plenty of time to get back here and
+be in readiness for him. We must each understand our part thoroughly.
+I will stand facing the door. It is possible that he may light that
+lantern we saw hanging in the stable, but I don't think it likely he
+will do so; he will take off the saddle, and either take the horse in
+there--there is plenty of food in the manger--or else turn it out into
+the paddock. As he comes in I will throw my arms round him and you will
+at once close in, one on each side, each catch an arm tightly, handcuff
+him, and take the pistols from his belt. Don't leave go of his arms
+until I have lit the candle; he may have another pistol inside his coat,
+and might draw it.”
+
+It was now one o'clock, and half an hour later Malcolm, who was at the
+gate, came in quietly and said he could hear a horse coming along the
+lane.
+
+“Which way, Malcolm?”
+
+“Tooting way.”
+
+“That is all right. I have been a little nervous lest if he came
+the other way our horse might make some slight noise and attract his
+attention; that was our only weak point.”
+
+They had already ascertained that the front door was locked and bolted,
+and that he must therefore enter through the kitchen. They heard the
+horse stop in front, a moment later the gate was opened, and through
+the window they could just make out the figure of a man leading a horse;
+then the stable door opened, and they heard a movement, and knew that
+the horse was being unsaddled; they heard it walk into the stable, the
+door was shut behind it, and a step approached the back door. It was
+opened, and a voice said with an oath, “The old fool has forgotten to
+leave a candle burning;” then he stepped into the kitchen.
+
+In an instant there was a sound of a violent struggle, deep oaths and
+curses, two sharp clicks, then all was quiet except heavy breathing and
+the striking of flint on a tinderbox; there was the blue glare of the
+sulphur match, and a candle was lighted. Mark then turned to the man who
+was standing still grasped in the hands of his two captors.
+
+“Arthur Bastow,” he said, producing his staff, “I arrest you in the
+King's name, as an escaped convict, as a notorious highwayman and house
+breaker.”
+
+As his name was spoken the man started, then he said quietly:
+
+“You have made a mistake this time, my men; my name is William Johnson;
+I am well known here, and have been a quiet resident in this house for
+upwards of a year.”
+
+“A resident, but not a quiet resident, Bastow. I don't think we are
+mistaken; but even if you can prove that you are not Bastow, but William
+Johnson, a man of means and family, we have evidence enough upon the
+other charges. We have been in search of you for a long time, and have
+got you at last. You don't remember me, though it is but eighteen months
+since we met; but I fancy that I then left a mark upon you that still
+remains on your shoulder. I am Mark Thorndyke, and you will understand
+now why I have hunted you down.”
+
+“The game is not finished yet,” the man said recklessly. “The hunting
+down will be the other way next time, Mark Thorndyke.”
+
+“I don't think so. Now, Chester, you may as well tie his feet together,
+and then search him. When that is done I will look after him while you
+fetch the trap round.”
+
+In his pockets were found two gold watches, forty-eight pounds in gold,
+and a hundred pounds in bank notes.
+
+“We shall hear where this comes from tomorrow,” Malcolm said, as he laid
+them on the table; “it will save us the trouble of getting evidence from
+Australia.”
+
+The prisoner was placed in a chair, and then the two officers went out
+to fetch the trap round.
+
+“So you have turned thief catcher, have you?” he said in a sneering
+tone, that recalled him to Mark's memory far more than his face had
+done, “and you carry a Bow Street staff about with you, and pretend to
+belong to the force: that is a punishable offense, you know.”
+
+“Yes, it would be if I had no right to use it,” Mark said quietly; “but
+it happens that I have a right, having been for a year and a half in the
+force. I joined it solely to hunt you down, and now that I have done so
+my resignation will be sent in tomorrow.”
+
+“And how is the worthy squire?”
+
+Mark started to his feet, and seized one of the pistols lying before
+him.
+
+“You villain!” he exclaimed, “I wonder you dare mention his name--you,
+his murderer.”
+
+“It was but tit for tat,” the man said coolly; “he murdered me, body and
+soul, when he sent me to the hulks. I told him I would be even with him.
+I did not think I had hit him at the time, for I thought that if I had
+you would have stopped with him, and would not have chased me across the
+fields.”
+
+“You scoundrel!” Mark said. “You know well enough that you came back,
+stole into his room, and stabbed him.”
+
+Bastow looked at him with a puzzled expression.
+
+“I don't know what you are talking about,” he said. “I fired at him
+through the window--I don't mind saying so to you, because there are no
+witnesses--and saw him jump up, but I fancied I had missed him. I
+saw you bolt out of the room, and thought it better to be off at once
+instead of taking another shot. You gave me a hard chase. It was lucky
+for you that you did not come up with me, for if you had done so I
+should have shot you; I owed you one for having killed as good a comrade
+as man ever had, and for that bullet you put in my shoulder before. If
+I had not been so out of breath that I could not feel sure of my aim I
+should have stopped for you, but I rode straight to town.”
+
+“A likely story,” Mark said shortly. “What, you will pretend that there
+were two murderers hanging round the house that night?--a likely tale
+indeed.”
+
+“I tell you that if your father was killed by a knife or dagger, I had
+nothing to do with it,” the man said. “I am obliged to the man, whoever
+he was. I had intended to go down again to Reigate to finish the job
+myself; I should scarcely have missed a second time. So it is for that
+you hunted me down? Well, I don't blame you; I never forgive an injury,
+and I see your sentiments are mine. Whether I killed your father or not
+makes no difference; he was killed, that is the principal point; if I
+was going to be put on my trial for that I could prove that at eight
+o'clock I was in a coffee house in Covent Garden. I purposely kicked
+up a row there, and was turned out, so that if I were charged with that
+shooting affair I could prove that I was in London that evening.”
+
+“I can't quite believe that,” Mark said; “a fast horse would have
+brought you up to town in an hour and a half, and another fast horse
+would have taken you back again as quickly; so you might have been in
+London at eight and back again at Crowswood by half past twelve or one,
+even if you stopped a couple of hours at a coffee house. However, you
+won't be tried for that. Those things on the table and the contents of
+that corn bin are enough to hang you a dozen times.”
+
+“Curse you! have you found that out?” Bastow exclaimed furiously.
+
+“We have,” Mark replied. “It would have been wiser if you had got rid
+of your things sooner. It was a clever hiding place, but it is always
+dangerous to keep such things by you, Bastow.”
+
+The man said no more, but sat quietly in his chair until they heard
+the vehicle stop outside the gate. Then the two constables came in,
+and lifting Bastow, carried him out and placed him in the bottom of the
+cart.
+
+“You can loose the old woman now, Malcolm,” Mark said as he took his
+seat and gathered the reins in his hand. “By eleven o'clock, no doubt,
+one of the others will be down with the gig again, and you can empty
+out the contents of that hole, and bring them up with you. I don't think
+that it will be of any use searching further. You might have a good look
+all round before you come away. There may be some notes stowed away,
+though it is likely enough that they have been sent away by post to some
+receiver abroad.”
+
+For some time after starting they could hear the prisoner moving about
+uneasily in the straw.
+
+“I suppose there is no fear of his slipping out of those handcuffs,
+Chester?”
+
+“Not a bit; they are full tight for him. I expect that that is what is
+making him uncomfortable.”
+
+Presently the movement ceased.
+
+“He is still enough now, Mr. Thorndyke. I should not be at all surprised
+if he has dropped off to sleep. He is hardened enough to sleep while the
+gibbet was waiting for him.”
+
+It was four o'clock in the morning when they drove up at Bow Street. Two
+constables on duty came out to the cart.
+
+“We have got a prisoner, Inspector,” Chester said. “He is the man we
+have been looking for so long. I fancy we have got all the swag that has
+been stolen for the last eighteen months--bags of jewels and watches,
+and sacks of silver. He is handcuffed, and his legs are tied, so we must
+carry him in.”
+
+The officer fetched out a lantern. The other constable helped him to let
+down the backboard of the cart.
+
+“Now, Bastow, wake up,” Chester said. “Here we are.”
+
+But there was no movement!
+
+“He is mighty sound asleep,” the constable said.
+
+“Well, haul him out;” and, taking the man by the shoulders, they pulled
+him out from the cart.
+
+“There is something rum about him,” the constable said; and as they
+lowered his feet to the pavement his head fell forward, and he would
+have sunk down if they had not supported him.
+
+The Inspector raised the lantern to his face.
+
+“Why, the man is dead,” he said.
+
+“Dead!” Chester repeated incredulously.
+
+“Aye, that he is. Look here;” and he pointed to a slim steel handle some
+three inches long, projecting over the region of the heart. “You must
+have searched him very carelessly, Chester. Well, bring him in now.”
+
+They carried him into the room, where two candles were burning. Mark
+followed them. The inspector pulled out the dagger. It was but four
+inches long, with a very thin blade. The handle was little thicker than
+the blade itself. Mark took it and examined it.
+
+“I have not a shadow of doubt that this is the dagger with which he
+murdered my father. The wound was very narrow, about this width, and the
+doctor said that the weapon that had been used was certainly a foreign
+dagger.”
+
+“I don't think this is a foreign dagger,” the Inspector said on
+examining it, “although it may be the one that was used, as you say,
+Mr. Thorndyke. It has evidently been made to carry about without being
+observed.”
+
+He threw back the dead man's coat.
+
+“Ah, here is where it was kept. You see, the lining has been sewn to the
+cloth, so as to make a sheath down by the seam under the arm. I expect
+that, knowing what would happen if he were caught, he had made up his
+mind to do it all along. Well, I don't know that you are to be so much
+blamed, Chester, for, passing your hand over his clothes, you might very
+well miss this, which is no thicker than a piece of whalebone. Well,
+well, he has saved us a good deal of trouble. You say you have got most
+of the booty he has collected?”
+
+“I don't know that we have got all of it, sir, but we have made a very
+big haul, anyhow; it was a cunningly contrived place. There was a big
+corn bin in the stable, and when we had emptied out the corn it seemed
+empty. However, Mr. Thorndyke discovered that the bin was fixed. Then we
+found that the bottom was really a trap door, and under it was a sort of
+well in which were sacks and bags. One of the sacks was full of unbroken
+silver, two others contained silver ingots, things that he had melted
+down, and there was a large bag full of watches and jewels. In his
+pocket we found a hundred pounds in bank notes, about fifty guineas, and
+a couple of gold watches.”
+
+“That he must have got tonight from the Portsmouth coach; we heard half
+an hour ago that it had been stopped near Kingston, the coachman shot,
+and the passengers robbed. It will be good news to some of them that
+we have got hold of their valuables. Well, Mr. Thorndyke, I have to
+congratulate you most heartily on the skill with which you have ferreted
+out a man who had baffled us for so long, and had become a perfect
+terror to the south of London. No doubt we shall be able to trace
+a great portion of the property in that sack. The capture has been
+splendidly effected.”
+
+“You will understand,” Mark said, “that I do not wish my name to appear
+in the matter at all. I have, as you know, been actuated by private
+reasons only in my search, and I see no occasion why my name should
+be mentioned; the evidence of Chester and Malcolm will be ample. From
+information received, they went down to this place, searched it in
+his absence, discovered the stolen goods, and captured them. Having
+handcuffed and bound him, one drove him up to town, the other remaining
+to guard the treasure. On his way he got at this hidden dagger and
+stabbed himself. My evidence would not strengthen the case at all.”
+
+“No, I don't see that it will be necessary to call you, Mr. Thorndyke.
+The discovery of this hidden booty and the proceeds of the coach robbery
+would be quite sufficient. Beyond the coroner's inquest there will be no
+inquiry. Had it been otherwise it might probably have been necessary to
+call you at the trial. However, as it is, it will save a lot of trouble;
+now we shall only need to find the owners of these bank notes. I will
+send off a cart for the things as early as I can get one, and will send
+a couple of constables round to the houses where burglaries have
+been committed to request the owners to come over and see if they can
+identify any of their property; and those who do so can attend the
+inquest tomorrow, though I don't suppose they will be called. The chief
+will be mightily pleased when he hears what has taken place, for he has
+been sadly worried by these constant complaints, and I fancy that
+the authorities have been rather down upon him on the subject. The
+announcement that the career of this famous robber has been brought to
+an end will cause quite a sensation, and people round the commons on the
+south side will sleep more quietly than they have done lately. I expect
+that if he had not put an end to himself we should have had to send him
+across to Newington today, for of course it is a Surrey business, though
+we have had the luck to take him. I suppose we shall not see much of you
+in the future, Mr. Thorndyke?”
+
+“No indeed,” Mark said. “My business is done, and I shall send in my
+resignation this morning. I don't regret the time that I have spent over
+it; I have learned a great deal, and have seen a lot of the shady side
+of life, and have picked up experience in a good many ways.”
+
+Mark, after requesting the Inspector to find a man to go over to
+Streatham and bring back his horse, and writing an order to the ostler
+to deliver it, walked across to his lodgings. Upon the whole, he was
+not sorry that Bastow had taken the matter into his own hands; he had,
+certainly, while engaged in the search, looked forward to seeing him in
+the dock and witnessing his execution, but he now felt that enough had
+been done for vengeance, and that it was as well that the matter had
+ended as it had. He was wearied out with the excitement of the last
+forty-eight hours. It was one o'clock when he awoke, and after dressing
+and going into Covent Garden to lunch at one of the coffee houses, he
+made his way up to Islington.
+
+“Taking a day's holiday?” Millicent asked as he came in.
+
+“Well, not exactly, Millicent; I have left school altogether.”
+
+“Left school, Mark? Do you mean that you have decided that it is of no
+use going on any longer?”
+
+“I have given it up because I have finished it. Arthur Bastow was
+captured last night, and committed suicide as he was being taken to the
+station.”
+
+An exclamation of surprise broke from Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent.
+
+“It seems horrid to be glad that anyone has taken his own life,” the
+latter said; “but I cannot help feeling so, for as long as he lived I
+should never have considered that you were safe, and besides, I suppose
+there is no doubt that if he had not killed himself he would have been
+hung.”
+
+“There is not a shadow of doubt about that,” Mark replied. “We found
+the proceeds of a vast number of robberies at his place, and also in
+his pockets the money he had taken from the passengers of the Portsmouth
+coach an hour before we captured him. So that putting aside that
+Australian business altogether, his doom was sealed.”
+
+“Now, please, tell us all about it,” Mrs. Cunningham said. “But first
+let us congratulate you most warmly not only on the success of your
+search, but that the work is at an end.”
+
+“Yes, I am glad it is over. At first I was very much interested; in
+fact, I was intensely interested all along, and should have been for
+however long it had continued. But, at the same time, I could do nothing
+else, and one does not want to spend one's whole life as a detective.
+At last it came about almost by chance, and the only thing I have to
+congratulate myself upon is that my idea of the sort of place he would
+have taken was exactly borne out by fact.”
+
+And Mark then gave them a full account of the manner in which the
+discovery had been made and the capture effected.
+
+“You see, Millicent, I followed your injunction, and was very careful.
+Taking him by surprise as I did, I might have managed it single handed,
+but with the aid of two good men it made a certainty of it, and the
+whole thing was comfortably arranged.”
+
+“I think you have done splendidly, Mark,” Mrs. Cunningham said. “It was
+certainly wonderful that you should have found him doing exactly what
+you had guessed, even down to the deaf servant. Well, now that is done
+and over, what do you think of doing next?”
+
+“I have hardly thought about that,” he replied; “but, at any rate, I
+shall take a few weeks' holiday, and I suppose after that I shall settle
+down to the search for my uncle's treasure. I am afraid that will be
+a much longer and a vastly more difficult business than this has been.
+Here there were all sorts of clews to work upon. Bastow ought to have
+been captured months ago, but in this other affair, so far, there is
+next to nothing to follow up. We don't even know whether the things are
+in India or in England. I believe they will be found, but that it will
+be by an accident. Besides, I fancy that we shall hear about them when
+you come of age, Millicent. There was to have been no change till that
+time, and I cannot help thinking that Uncle George must have made some
+provisions by which we should get to know about them in the event of
+his death without his having an opportunity of telling anyone where they
+are.
+
+“He might have been killed in battle; he might have been drowned on his
+way home. He had thought the whole matter over so thoroughly, I do think
+the possibilities of this could not have escaped him. As I told you,
+Mr. Prendergast made inquiries of all the principal bankers and Indian
+agents here, and altogether without success. After he had done that, I
+got a list of all the leading firms in Calcutta and Madras, and wrote to
+them, and all the replies were in the negative. It is true that does
+not prove anything absolutely. Eighteen years is a long time, and the
+chances are that during those years almost every head of a firm would
+have retired and come home. Such a matter would only be likely to be
+known to the heads; and if, as we thought likely, the box or chest was
+merely forwarded by a firm there to England, the transaction would
+not have attracted any special attention. If, upon the other hand, it
+remained out there it might have been put down in a cellar or store, and
+have been lying there ever since, altogether forgotten.”
+
+“I don't see myself why you should bother any more about it; perhaps,
+as you say, it will turn up of itself when I come of age. At any rate, I
+should say it is certainly as well to wait till then and see if it does,
+especially as you acknowledge that you have no clew whatever to work
+on. It is only three more years, for I am eighteen next week, and it
+certainly seems to me that it will be very foolish to spend the next
+three years in searching about for a thing that may come to you without
+any searching at all.”
+
+“Well, I will think it over.”
+
+“You see, you really don't want the money, Mark,” she went on.
+
+“No, I don't want it particularly, Millicent; but when one knows that
+there is something like 50,000 pounds waiting for one somewhere, one
+would like to get it. Your father worked for twenty years of his life
+accumulating it for us, and it seems to me a sort of sacred duty to see
+that his labor has not all been thrown away.”
+
+Millicent was silent.
+
+“It is very tiresome,” she said presently. “Of course my father
+intended, as you say, that his savings should come to us, but I am sure
+he never meant that they should be a bother and a trouble to us.”
+
+“I don't see why they should ever be that, Millicent. As it is we have
+both sufficient for anything any man or woman could reasonably want, and
+neither of us need fret over it if the treasure is never found. Still,
+he wished us to have it, and it is properly ours, and I don't want it to
+go to enrich someone who has not a shadow of a right to it.”
+
+On the following morning Mark went to attend the inquest on Bastow. He
+did not go into the court, however, but remained close at hand in the
+event of the coroner insisting upon his being called. However, the two
+men only spoke casually in their evidence of their comrade Roberts, who
+had been also engaged in the capture. One of the jurymen suggested that
+he should also be called, but the coroner said:
+
+“I really cannot see any occasion for it; we are here to consider how
+the deceased came by his death, and I think it must be perfectly clear
+that he came by it by his own act. You have heard how he was captured,
+that the spoils of the coach that he had just rifled were found upon
+him, and that the booty he had been acquiring from his deeds for months
+past also was seized; therefore, as the man was desperate, and knew
+well enough that his life was forfeited, there was ample motive for
+his putting an end to his wretched existence. I really do not think,
+gentlemen, that it is worth while to waste your time and mine by going
+into further evidence.”
+
+Finally, a verdict of felo de se was returned, with a strong expression
+of the jury's admiration of the conduct of constables Malcolm, Chester,
+and Roberts, who had so cleverly effected the capture of the man who had
+so long set the law at defiance.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII.
+
+
+Four days later Mark, on his return from dinner, found Philip Cotter
+sitting in his room waiting for him. They had met on the previous
+evening, and Cotter had expressed his intention of calling upon him the
+next day.
+
+“I am here on a matter of business, Thorndyke,” the latter said as they
+shook hands.
+
+“Of business!” Mark repeated.
+
+“Yes. You might guess for a year, and I don't suppose that you would hit
+it. It is rather a curious thing. Nearly twenty years ago--”
+
+“I can guess it before you go any further,” Mark exclaimed, leaping up
+from the seat that he had just taken. “Your people received a box from
+India.”
+
+“That is so Mark; although how you guessed it I don't know.”
+
+“We have been searching for it for years,” Mark replied. “Our lawyer,
+Prendergast, wrote to you about that box; at least, he wrote to you
+asking if you had any property belonging to Colonel Thorndyke, and your
+people wrote to say they hadn't.”
+
+“Yes, I remember I wrote to him myself. Of course that was before you
+did me that great service, and I did not know your name, and we had not
+the name on our books. What is in the box?”
+
+“Jewels worth something like fifty thousand pounds.”
+
+“By Jove, I congratulate you, old fellow; that is to say, if you have
+the handling of it. Well, this is what happened. The box was sent to
+us by a firm in Calcutta, together with bills for 50,000 pounds. The
+instructions were that the money was to be invested in stock, and that
+we were to manage it and to take 100 pounds a year for so doing. The
+rest of the interest of the money was to be invested. The box was a very
+massive one, and was marked with the letters XYZ. It was very carefully
+sealed. Our instructions were that the owner of the box and the money
+might present himself at any time.”
+
+“And that the proof of his ownership was to be that he was to use the
+word 'Masulipatam,'” Mark broke in, “and produce a gold coin that would,
+probably--though of this I am not certain--correspond with the seals.”
+
+He got up and went to the cabinet which he had brought up with him from
+Crowswood, unlocked it, and produced the piece of paper and the coin.
+
+“Yes, that looks like the seal, Thorndyke. At any rate, it is the same
+sort of thing. Why on earth didn't you come with it before, and take the
+things away?”
+
+“Simply because I did not know where to go to. My uncle was dying
+when he came home, and told my father about the treasure, but he died
+suddenly, and my father did not know whether it was sent to England or
+committed to someone's charge in India, or buried there. We did the only
+thing we could, namely, inquired at all the banks and agents here and
+at all the principal firms in Madras and Calcutta to ask if they had in
+their possession any property belonging to the late Colonel Thorndyke.”
+
+“You see, we did not know,” Cotter went on, “any more than Adam, to whom
+the box belonged. Fortunately, the agent sent in his communication a
+sealed letter, on the outside of which was written, 'This is to remain
+unopened, but if no one before that date presents himself with the token
+and password, it is to be read on the 18th of August, 1789.' That was
+yesterday, you know.”
+
+“Yes, that was my cousin's eighteenth birthday. We thought if my uncle
+had left the box in anyone's charge he would probably have given him
+some such instructions, for at that time there was hard fighting in
+India, and he might have been killed any day, and would therefore
+naturally have made some provisions for preventing the secret dying with
+him.”
+
+“We did not think of it until this morning early, though we have been
+rather curious over it ourselves. When we opened it, inside was another
+letter addressed 'To be delivered to John Thorndyke, Esquire, at
+Crawley, near Hastings, or at Crowswood, Reigate, or in the event of his
+death to his executors.'”
+
+“I am one of his executors,” Mark said; “Mr. Prendergast, the lawyer,
+is the other. I think I had better go round to him tomorrow and open the
+letter there.”
+
+“Oh, I should think you might open it at once, Thorndyke. It will
+probably only contain instructions, and, at any rate, as you have the
+coin and the word, you could come round tomorrow morning and get the
+chest out if you want it.”
+
+“I won't do that,” Mark said; “the coffer contains gems worth over
+50,000 pounds, and I would very much rather it remained in your keeping
+until I decide what to do with it. How large is it?”
+
+“It is a square box, about a foot each way; and it is pretty heavy,
+probably from the setting of the jewels. Well, anyhow, I am heartily
+glad, Thorndyke. I know, of course, that you are well off, still 100,000
+pounds--for the money has doubled itself since we had it--to say nothing
+of the jewels, is a nice plum to drop into anyone's mouth.”
+
+“Very nice indeed, although only half of it comes to me under my uncle's
+will. To tell you the truth, I am more glad that the mystery has been
+solved than at getting the money; the affair was a great worry to my
+father, and has been so to me. I felt that I ought to search for the
+treasure, and yet the probability of finding it seemed so small that I
+felt the thing was hopeless, and that really the only chance was that my
+uncle would have taken just the course he did, and have fixed some date
+when the treasure should be handed over, if not asked for. I rather
+fancied that it would not have been for another three years, for that is
+when my cousin comes of age.”
+
+“What cousin do you mean?” Philip Cotter asked. “I did not know you had
+one.”
+
+“Well, that is at present a secret, Cotter--one of the mysteries
+connected with my uncle's will. For myself, I would tell it in the
+market place tomorrow, but she wishes it to be preserved at present; you
+shall certainly know as soon as anyone. By the way, I have not seen
+you at Mrs. Cunningham's for the last week, and you used to be a pretty
+regular visitor.”
+
+“No,” the young man said gloomily; “I don't mind telling you that Miss
+Conyers refused me a fortnight ago. I never thought that I had much
+chance, but I had just a shadow of hope, and that is at an end now.”
+
+“Perhaps in the future--” Mark suggested for the sake of saying
+something.
+
+“No; I said as much as that to her, and she replied that it would
+always be the same, and I gathered from her manner, although she did not
+exactly say so, that there was someone else in the case, and yet I have
+never met anyone often there.”
+
+“Perhaps you are mistaken,” Mark said.
+
+“Well, whether or not, there is clearly no hope for me. I am very sorry,
+but it is no use moping over it. My father and mother like her so much,
+and they are anxious for me to marry and settle down; altogether, it
+would have been just the thing. I do not know whether she has any money,
+and did not care, for of course I shall have plenty. I shall be a junior
+partner in another six months; my father told me so the other day. He
+said that at one time he was afraid that I should never come into the
+house, for that it would not have been fair to the others to take such
+a reckless fellow in, but that I seemed to have reformed so thoroughly
+since that affair that if I continued so for another six months they
+should have no hesitation in giving me a share.”
+
+It was too late to go up to Islington that evening. In the morning Mark
+went with the still unopened letter to the solicitor's. The old lawyer
+congratulated him most heartily when he told him of the discovery that
+he had made.
+
+“I am glad indeed, Mark; not so much for the sake of the money, but
+because I was afraid that that confounded treasure was going to unsettle
+your life. When a man once begins treasure hunting it becomes a sort of
+craze, and he can no more give it up than an opium smoker can the use
+of the drug. Thank goodness, that is over; so the capital amount is
+doubled, and you are accordingly worth 70,000 pounds more than you were
+this time yesterday--a fine windfall! Now let us see what your uncle
+says.”
+
+He broke the seal. The letter was a short one, and began:
+
+“My DEAR JOHN:
+
+“If you have not, before you receive this, got my treasure, you will get
+it on the 18th or 19th of August, 17??89. I have made a will which will
+give you full instructions what to do with it. I may say, though, that I
+have left it between a little daughter who was born six months ago, and
+your son Mark. My own intentions are to stop out here until I get the
+rank of general, and I have taken the measures that I have done in case
+a bullet or a sharp attack of fever carries me off suddenly. I hope that
+you will have carried out the provisions of my will, and I hope also
+that I shall have come home and talked the whole matter over with you
+before I go under.
+
+“Your affectionate brother.”
+
+“A singular man,” Mr. Prendergast said, as he laid the letter down on
+the table beside him. “What trouble these crotchety people do give!
+I suppose you have altogether put aside that folly of his about the
+jewels?”
+
+“Well, no, I can't say that I have, Mr. Prendergast. Do you know that
+I have a fancy--it may only be a fancy, but if so, I cannot shake it
+off--that I am watched by Lascars. There was one standing at the corner
+of the street as I came up this morning, and again and again I have
+run across one. It is not always the same man, nor have I any absolute
+reasons for believing that they are watching me; still, somehow or
+other, I do come across them more frequently than seems natural.”
+
+“Pooh, nonsense, Mark! I should have thought that you were too sensible
+a fellow to have such ridiculous fancies in your head.”
+
+“Of course, I should never have thought of such a thing, Mr.
+Prendergast, if it had not been for what my father told me, that my
+uncle was desperately in earnest about it, and had an intense conviction
+that someone watched his every movement.”
+
+“Don't let us talk of such folly any longer,” the lawyer said irritably.
+“Now that you have got the money, the best thing you can do is to go at
+once and carry out what was the wish both of your father and your uncle,
+and ask your cousin to marry you; that will put an end to the whole
+business, and I can tell you that I am positively convinced that the
+day she gets twenty-one she will renounce the property, and that if you
+refuse to take it she will pass it over to some hospital or other. You
+cannot do better than prevent her from carrying out such an act of folly
+as that, and the only way that I can see is by your marrying her. I
+gathered from what you said when I gave you the same advice at Reigate
+that you liked her and should have done it had it not been for her
+coming into the estate instead of you. Well, you are now in a position
+to ask her to marry you without the possibility of its being supposed
+that you are a fortune hunter.”
+
+“I will think about it, Mr. Prendergast. Of course this money does make
+a considerable difference in my position; however, I shall do nothing
+until I have got the jewels off my hands.”
+
+“Well, a couple of days will manage that,” the lawyer said; “you have
+only got to take the box to a first class jeweler, and get him to value
+the things and make you an offer for the whole of them.”
+
+Mark did not care to press the subject, and on leaving went to Cotter's
+Bank. He was at once shown into his friend's room, and the latter took
+him to his father.
+
+“It is curious, Mr. Thorndyke,” the latter said heartily, “that we
+should have been keeping your money all this time without having the
+slightest idea that it belonged to you. We are ready at once to pay it
+over to your order, for if you pronounce the word you know of, and I
+find that the coin you have corresponds with the seal on the box, the
+necessary proof will be given us that you have authority to take it
+away. I have had the box brought up this morning, so that we can compare
+the seal.”
+
+The box was taken out of the strong safe, and it was at once seen that
+the coin corresponded with the seals.
+
+“I will leave it with you for the present, Mr. Cotter; it contains a
+large amount of jewels, and until I have decided what to do with them I
+would rather leave them; it would be madness to have 50,000 pounds worth
+of gems in a London lodging, even for a single night. As to the money,
+that also had better remain as it is at present invested. As I told your
+son--that and the jewels are the joint property of myself and another. I
+dare say that in a few days half of the money will be transferred to
+the name of the other legatee; that can be easily done. I shall get
+my lawyer, Mr. Prendergast, to call upon you, Mr. Cotter. I suppose it
+would be better that some legal proof that we are entitled to the money
+should be given.”
+
+“I shall be glad to see him and to take his instructions,” the banker
+said; “but in point of fact I regard the property as yours; I have
+nothing to do with wills or other arrangements. I simply received
+the box and the cash with an order that they should be delivered to
+whomsoever should come with the word 'Masulipatam' and a coin to match
+the seals. That you have done, and with subsequent dispositions I have
+no concern. I shall be happy to keep this box for you as long as you
+should think proper; and I have also written out an acknowledgement
+that I hold securities of the value, at the closing prices yesterday, of
+103,000 pounds 16 shillings,” and he handed the paper to Mark.
+
+As the latter left the bank he looked up and down the street, and
+muttered an angry exclamation as he caught sight of a rough looking
+fellow just turning a corner into a side street. The glance was so
+momentary a one that he could not say whether the man was a colored
+seaman; but he certainly thought that he was a Lascar.
+
+“I am going to have trouble about that bracelet,” he said to himself,
+as he hailed a hackney coach and told him to drive to Islington. “I am
+convinced that the Colonel was right, and that there are some men over
+in this country with the fixed purpose of seeing what is done with those
+jewels, and obtaining them if possible. How they could tell that they
+were deposited at Cotter's beats me altogether. It may be indeed that
+they really knew nothing about it, and have simply been watching me.
+They can hardly have been watching me for the last nine months, and yet,
+curiously enough, though I have never given the matter a thought since,
+Charley Gibbons said that it was a dark colored man who brought the news
+that took them to my rescue and saved my life. I have often run against
+Lascars, and if they have taken this trouble all along, now that they
+have seen me come out of the bank, I shall be watched night and day.
+
+“It is a creepy sort of idea. I should not be afraid of any number of
+them if they attacked me openly; but there is no saying what they might
+do. I wish Ramoo had been here. I would have consulted him about it; but
+as I got a letter from him only last week saying that he had, on the day
+of writing it, arrived in Calcutta, it is of no use wishing that. At any
+rate, I cannot do better than stick to the plan that my uncle sketched
+out, and take them across to Amsterdam. It would be very unfair to take
+them to any jeweler here. He might have them in his possession for a
+week or ten days before he made me any definite offer for them, and
+during that time I would not give a fig for his life. If I distribute
+the stones at Amsterdam they would hardly set about attacking twelve
+diamond merchants one after another. Well, at any rate, I must say
+nothing about the affair to Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham. It was bad
+enough my running risks in the pursuit of Bastow; but this would be ten
+times worse, and I know Millicent would be for letting the things remain
+for good at the banker's. But I have no idea of allowing myself to be
+frightened by two or three black scoundrels into throwing away 50,000
+pounds.”
+
+Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent were sitting in their bonnets in the
+parlor.
+
+“Here you are at last, sir,” the girl said. “Another five minutes, and
+we should have gone out. You told us that you would come early, and
+now it is twelve o'clock; and you are generally so punctual in your
+appointments. What have you got to say for yourself?”
+
+“A good many things have happened since then, Millicent. Last night your
+friend Mr. Cotter called upon me.”
+
+“Why do you say my friend? He was your friend, and it was entirely
+through you that we knew him at all.”
+
+“Well, we will say 'our friend,' Millicent; and he made a communication
+to me that this morning I had to go to Mr. Prendergast and make a
+communication to him.”
+
+“What do you mean by your communications?” Millicent asked, laughing.
+“You are quite mysterious, Mark.”
+
+“And then I had to go,” he went on, without heeding her interruption,
+“to Cotter's Bank, where I saw both our friend and his father, and there
+is the result of these communications and that interview;” and he threw
+the paper to her.
+
+“What does it mean?” she asked in astonishment, after glancing through
+it.
+
+“It means, dear, that your father took exactly the precautions I thought
+he would take, and after sending his money and jewels home, he sent a
+sealed letter to the firm with whom he deposited them, which happened to
+be Cotter's, with instructions that should no one present himself with
+the word and coin by the 18th of August, 1789--that is to say, on your
+eighteenth birthday--the envelope should be opened; it was so opened,
+and it contained a letter that was to be sent to my father, or, in the
+case of his death before that date, to his executors.”
+
+“How wonderful!” the girl said. “I had quite given up all idea of it.
+But how is it that it came to be so much? Have they sold the jewels?”
+
+“No, you see it is the compound interest going on for seventeen years,
+and perhaps some rise in the value of the securities, that has doubled
+the original sum invested. As for the jewels, I have left them at the
+bank; I should not care about having 50,000 pounds worth of such things
+in my rooms and I should not think that you would like to have them
+here, either.”
+
+“Certainly not,” Mrs. Cunningham said emphatically; “you did quite
+right, Mark. I don't think I could sleep, even if you had half a dozen
+of your detective friends posted round the house.”
+
+“Still I suppose we shall have a chance of seeing them?” Millicent said.
+
+“Certainly. I can make an appointment with Philip Cotter for you to see
+them at the bank; or if I take them to a jeweler to value, you could
+see them there. But I should think that the bank would be the best. I am
+sure that Cotter would put his room at your disposal, and, of course,
+if you would like to have some of them for yourself you could select
+any you liked, but I expect that they won't look much in their present
+settings; the Indian jewelers have not the knack of setting off gems.
+However, there is no hurry about them one way or another. The money,
+I have told Cotter's father, shall, for the present, remain as it
+is invested; it is all in the Funds, Cotter said, for although the
+instructions were that it was to be put into good securities, he did
+not feel justified under the peculiar circumstances in going outside
+Government stock. Mr. Prendergast is quite of opinion that it would be
+better to make no change until you come of age. I did not know whether
+you would wait till then, for some purpose or other you might want to
+use some of it.”
+
+Millicent shrugged her shoulders.
+
+“I think I would much rather have had just the money I had before, Mark;
+all this will be a great nuisance, I am sure. I think there ought to be
+a law against women having more than 20,000 pounds, whether in money or
+in land.”
+
+Mark laughed.
+
+“It would be a bad thing for spendthrift young noblemen, Millicent. How
+are they to pay off their debts and mortgages if there were no heiresses
+ready to do so in exchange for a title?”
+
+“It would be a good thing for them, I consider,” the girl said
+indignantly. “In the first place, they would not impoverish themselves
+if they knew that there was no way of building up their fortune again,
+and in the next place, if they did ruin themselves they would have to
+either set to work to earn an honest living or blow out their brains,
+if they have any to blow out. I can assure you that I don't feel at all
+exultant at getting all this money, and I think that my father was quite
+right in wishing that I should know nothing about it until I married;
+but, on the other hand, I am heartily glad, more glad than I can say,
+Mark, that you have come into your share.”
+
+“I am glad for one reason, Millicent; that is, that this must put an end
+to the ridiculous idea you have of giving up Crowswood. Your father has
+made me rich beyond anything I could possibly have expected from him.
+I suddenly find myself a wealthy man, and I can buy another estate for
+myself worth more than Crowswood if inclined to settle down as a squire;
+therefore your theory that I have been disappointed in not inheriting
+what I thought was my father's estate falls to the ground altogether. In
+no case would I ever have accepted your sacrifice. If you had liked to
+hand it over to St. Bartholomew's or Guy's Hospital, or to give it away
+to any other charity, I would not have prevented you, but I would never
+have accepted it for myself. Now, thank goodness, the question cannot
+arise; for you must see that, even looking at the matter from a purely
+business point of view, I have benefited to an enormous and altogether
+unexpected extent by your father's will, and if any contest between us
+could arise it should be on the ground that he has acted unfairly to you
+by giving me so large a proportion of the money that, in the course of
+nature, you should have inherited. It was not even as if he had known
+and liked me, for I was but four years old at the time he wrote the
+letter saying that I was to share the money and jewels with you.”
+
+“You are very obstinate and very disagreeable, Mark,” she said, with
+tears in her eyes.
+
+“I think the obstinacy has been principally on your side, Millicent;
+though certainly I should not think of saying that you have been
+disagreeable. It has been an excess of kindheartedness on your part,
+and you have resolutely closed your eyes to the fact that, had I been
+willing to take advantage of your generosity, I should have lacked the
+courage to do so, for I should have been pointed at wherever I went,
+as a mean fellow who took advantage of his little cousin's romantic
+generosity. Pray, dear, let us say no more about it. We are two rich
+young people; we have both an estate; yours, I grant, is the larger,
+but if I choose I can increase mine, until it is quite as large as
+Crowswood. We can be better friends than we have been for the last year,
+because this point of dispute has always stood between us and made us
+uncomfortable. Now you will have to think over what you would like done,
+and whether you wish any change made in your manner of living.”
+
+“Did you tell Mr. Cotter,” Millicent laughed, after a pause, “that I had
+a half share in the money?”
+
+“No, that was a matter for you to decide, not for me. I told him that
+I was only a half shareholder, but there was no necessity to say who
+it was who had the other half. When I was talking to Philip Cotter, the
+words 'my cousin' slipped out, but he did not associate it in any way
+with you. It might have been the son of another brother or of a sister
+of my father's.”
+
+“In that case, then, we will certainly make no change, will we, Mrs.
+Cunningham?”
+
+“I think, Millicent, that Mr. Prendergast and Mark will probably be of
+opinion that you ought now to be introduced regularly into society. The
+fact that you are a rich heiress might, as your father so much wished,
+remain a secret. But it is one thing having this blazoned about and
+quite another for you to be living quietly here, where, with the
+exception of Mr. Cotter and a few other friends, you have no society
+whatever. Certainly it was not the wish of your father that you should
+remain unmarried. You are quite pretty and nice enough to be sought for
+yourself alone, and I must say that I think, now that you have finished
+with your various masters, it would be well that you should go out a
+good deal more, and that as a first step we should go down to Bath this
+year instead of paying another visit to Weymouth, as we had arranged.”
+
+“I don't want any change at all, Mrs. Cunningham. If I am to get married
+I shall be married; if I am not I shall not fret about it.”
+
+“But for all that, Millicent,” Mark said, “Mrs. Cunningham is right.
+We quite agree that there is no occasion whatever for you to go about
+labeled 'A good estate and over 70,000 pounds in cash,' but I do think
+that it is right that you should go into society. With the exception of
+Philip Cotter, Dick Chetwynd, and two or three other of my friends, you
+really know very few people. You have now gone out of mourning, and I
+think that Mrs. Cunningham's proposal that you should go down to Bath
+is a very good one. I shall not be sorry for a change myself, for I have
+been engrossed in my work for a long time now. I can go down a day or
+two before you, and get you comfortable lodgings, and will myself
+stay at a hotel. Although I have no intimate friends beyond those from
+Reigate, I know a large number of men of fashion from meeting them at
+the boxing schools and other places, and could introduce you both, and
+get you into society.”
+
+“I am altogether opposed to the idea,” Millicent said decidedly. “You
+want to trot me out like a horse for sale.”
+
+“No, Millicent,” Mark said calmly. “I only want you to have the same
+advantages that other girls have, neither more nor less, and for you
+to enjoy yourself as others do. There is nothing undignified or
+objectionable about that, especially as we are agreed that nothing shall
+be said about your fortune. Well, we will think it over. Mr. Prendergast
+and I certainly do not wish to act as tyrants, and there is no occasion
+to come to a decision in a hurry. We have only discovered our good
+fortune today, and can scarcely appreciate the difference that it will
+make to us. We can think over what will be for the best at our leisure,
+and see if we cannot hit upon some plan that will be agreeable to you.”
+
+“Thank you, Mark,” she said gratefully. “I am afraid that you must think
+me very disagreeable and cross; but though you, as a man, have not the
+same sort of feelings, I can assure you that I feel all this money and
+so on to be a heavy burden; and were it not for your sake I could wish
+heartily that this treasure had never been discovered at all.”
+
+“I can quite understand that,” he said quietly. “At the present moment,
+even, I do not see that it will be of much advantage to me; but it may
+be that some day I shall see it in a different light. It has come upon
+me almost as suddenly as it has upon you. I thought that after I had
+finished with the Bastow affair I should set to work to find out this
+treasure, and that it would probably take me out to India, occupy me
+there for some time, and that afterwards I might travel through other
+places, and be away from England three or four years. Now the matter
+is altogether altered, and I shall be some time before I form any fresh
+plans. In fact, these must depend upon circumstances.”
+
+Mrs. Cunningham had left the room two or three minutes before, thinking
+that Mark might be able to talk her charge into a more reasonable state
+of mind were he alone with her, and he added:
+
+“Of one circumstance in particular.”
+
+She looked up inquiringly.
+
+“Well, Millicent, it depends a great deal upon you. I know you think
+that all that has happened during the past year has been a little hard
+upon you, and I thoroughly agree with you; you were fond of Crowswood,
+and were very happy there, and the change to this somewhat dull house,
+just at a time when you are of an age to enjoy pleasure, has been a
+trial. Then, too, there has been this question of the estate upon your
+mind. But you must remember it has been somewhat of a trial to me also.
+I grant that I have had plenty of occupation which has been in every way
+beneficial to me, and have not at all lamented leaving the country, but
+in one respect it has been a trial. I don't know whether it ever entered
+your mind, before that sad time at home, that I was getting to care for
+you in a very different way to that in which I had done before.
+
+“My father, I think, observed it, for he threw out a very plain hint
+once that he would very gladly see us coming together. However, I never
+spoke of it to you. I was young and you were young. It seemed to me that
+there was plenty of time, and that, moreover, it would not be fair for
+me to speak to you until you had had the opportunity of going out and of
+seeing other men. Then came the evening before his death, when my father
+told me how matters really stood, and he again said that there was a way
+by which all trouble could be obviated. But I saw that it was not so,
+and that the hope I had entertained must be put aside. I had never told
+you I loved you when I seemed to be the heir of the property and you
+only the daughter of an old comrade of his, and I saw that were I to
+speak now, when you were the heiress, it could not but appear to you
+that it was the estate and not you that I wanted, and I felt my lips
+were sealed forever. Mr. Prendergast said that day when he came down to
+the funeral, and you told him that you would not take the property, that
+it might be managed in another way, and you said that you did not want
+to be married for your money; so you see you saw it in exactly the same
+light as I did.
+
+“My first thought this morning, when Mr. Cotter told me that the money
+had mounted up to over 100,000 pounds, was that it would unseal my
+lips. You were still better off than I was, but the difference was now
+immaterial. I was a rich man, and had not the smallest occasion to marry
+for money. Whether I married a girl without a penny, or an heiress,
+could make but little difference to me, as I have certainly no ambition
+to become a great landowner. I still think that it would have been more
+fair to you to give you the opportunity of seeing more of the society of
+the world before speaking to you, but you see you are opposed to that,
+and therefore it would be the same did I wait patiently another year,
+which I don't think I should be able to do. I love you, Millicent. It
+is only during the past eighteen months, when I have thought that I
+had lost you, that I have known how much I love you, and how much my
+happiness depends upon you. I can truly say that were you penniless, it
+would make no shadow of difference to me. It is no longer a question of
+arranging matters comfortably: it is a question of love. The estate is
+nothing to me. It never has been anything, and it does not count at all
+in the scale. I hope that you will put it altogether out of your mind in
+giving me an answer; and that if you cannot say as truly and wholly as I
+do, 'I love you,' that you will say as frankly as you have always spoken
+to me, 'I love you very much as a cousin, Mark, but not in that way.'”
+
+The girl had sat perfectly quiet while he was speaking.
+
+He was standing before her now, and he took one of her hands.
+
+“I love you, dear; I love you with all my heart. Do you love me?”
+
+Then she looked up and rose to her feet, and placed both hands upon his
+shoulders.
+
+“As you love me, so I love you, Mark.”
+
+After that, conversation languished till Mrs. Cunningham came into the
+room, five minutes later.
+
+“We have come to the conclusion, Mrs. Cunningham,” he said, “that there
+will be no necessity for the visit to Bath. Millicent is otherwise
+provided for; she has promised to be my wife.”
+
+“I am glad, Mark, glad indeed!” and she took Millicent in her arms and
+kissed her tenderly. “I have all along hoped for it, but I began to
+be afraid that you were both such obstinate young people that it would
+never come about. I know that your father wished it, Mark, and he told
+me that his brother had said that it would be a good arrangement if
+some day you should come to like each other. I have guessed for the last
+year, and, indeed, before then, that Millicent would not say 'No' if you
+ever asked her; but this stupid estate seemed to stand in the way. Of
+late, I have even come to hope that the obstinate girl would keep to her
+intention, and that if, as I knew would be the case, you refused to take
+the estate, she would give it away to some charity. In that case, there
+could be nothing to prevent your speaking; and even then you would have
+been between you very fairly equipped with this world's goods. However,
+the present is a far better solution, and the discovery of the treasure
+has saved you from three years' waiting before things were straightened
+out. I feel as if I were her mother, Mark, having had her in my charge
+since she was a baby; and as she grew up it became my fondest hope to
+see you united some day, and I think that I am almost as pleased that my
+hope has been fulfilled as you are yourselves.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII.
+
+
+After thinking over the best way in which to set about the work of
+carrying the diamonds to Amsterdam, Mark decided upon asking the advice
+of his late chief. The latter said, as Mark entered his room:
+
+“I did not expect to see you here again, Mr. Thorndyke.”
+
+“Well, sir, I have come to ask your' advice about another matter
+altogether.”
+
+“What is it now?”
+
+“I have to convey a diamond bracelet of very great value across to
+Amsterdam. I have reasons to believe that there is a plot to seize it
+on the way, and that the men engaged will hesitate at nothing to achieve
+their object. Under these circumstances I should be very much obliged
+if you will tell me what would be the best course to pursue. I must say
+that the bracelet is, with many other jewels, in a strong teak box of
+about a foot square, at present in the possession of our bankers; they
+were brought from India by my uncle. I imagine that the rest of the
+jewels are of comparatively little importance in the eyes of these men,
+though doubtless they would take them also if they lay their hands on
+them. The bracelet, however, is of special interest to them, not so
+much for its intrinsic value, as because it was stolen from one of their
+sacred idols.
+
+“This was about twenty years ago; but I have reason to believe that the
+search for it on the part of some Hindoos connected with the temple has
+never ceased. The soldier who took it was murdered; his comrade, into
+whose hands they next passed, was also murdered. They next came to my
+uncle, who forwarded it at once to England. His bungalows were searched
+again and again, until probably the fellows came to the conclusion that
+he must have either buried it or sent it away. Nevertheless, to the day
+of his death he was firmly convinced that he was closely followed, and
+every movement watched. He warned my father solemnly that he too would
+be watched, but as far as we know it was not so; at any rate, we had no
+reason to suppose that the house was ever entered. On the other hand, I
+am convinced I have been watched more or less closely ever since I came
+up to town, and as I came out from the bank yesterday I saw a man--a
+colored fellow, I believe--on the watch.
+
+“My uncle said that my life would not be worth an hour's purchase so
+long as I had the bracelet in my possession, and advised that it should
+be taken straight over to Amsterdam, broken up, and the diamonds sold
+singly to the merchants there.”
+
+“It is a curious story, Mr. Thorndyke. I own to ignorance of these
+Indian thieves and their ways, but it certainly seems extraordinary that
+so hopeless a quest should be kept up for so long a time. You are sure
+that it is not fancy on your part that you have been watched? I know you
+are not the sort of man to take fancies in your head, but as you have
+had the matter so strongly impressed upon you, you might naturally have
+been inclined to think this would be the case when it was not so.”
+
+“No, I don't think there is any chance of my being mistaken. It is only
+of late that I have thought about it, but when I did so and thought over
+what had passed since I came to London, I recalled the fact that I had
+very often come across foreign seamen; sometimes they were Lascars, at
+others they might have been Italian or Spanish seamen; and you see,
+sir, it was, as I told you at the time, some foreign sailor who came
+and informed Gibbons that I had fallen into the hands of a gang of
+criminals, and that I should certainly be killed if I was not rescued
+immediately. Gibbons at once got together half a dozen fighting men,
+and, as you know, rescued me just in time. It was extraordinary that the
+man never came forward to obtain any reward.”
+
+“That was a friendly act, Mr. Thorndyke.”
+
+“Yes, I have no reason to suppose that these men would be hostile to me
+personally. I was not the thief, I was simply the person who happened to
+be in possession, or rather, might come into possession of the bracelet.
+From the close watch they had kept, they were, I imagine, well aware
+that I had not got it, but may have thought, and doubtless did think,
+that I had some clew to its hiding place, and should sooner or later
+get it. With my death the clew might be finally lost, and my life was
+consequently of extreme importance to them, and therefore they took
+steps to have me rescued, and the fact that they learned this and knew
+how friendly I was with Gibbons shows how close was the watch kept over
+me. No doubt, had Gibbons refused to help them, they would have come
+here at once.”
+
+“Certainly, after what you say it would seem that your conjecture is
+right, and in this case, if I were you, I should take the bracelet out
+of the case and conceal it about me. I would not fetch it myself from
+the bank.”
+
+“I don't think I should be much safer so,” Mark said thoughtfully.
+“In the first place, I must go to the bank to get them, and I might be
+murdered merely on the supposition that I had brought the bracelet away.
+In the next place, even if I got to Amsterdam safely and got rid of the
+bracelet and returned unnoticed by them, a fresh danger would arise when
+I got the other gems into my possession, for they could not be certain
+whether the diamonds were still among them or not.”
+
+“I should hardly think that would be the case if they watch you as
+strictly as you believe. Even if none of them accompanied you, they
+would soon find out what diamond merchants you went to, and the leader
+might call upon these men, stating that he was commissioned to purchase
+some diamonds of exceptional value for an Eastern Prince, in which case
+he would be sure to obtain sight of them.
+
+“If I had your business to perform, I would not go near the bank again,
+but would send some friend I could trust to go and open the box, and
+take out the bracelet, and make it into a small parcel. He should hand
+it to you privately, as you are on your way to embark for Amsterdam.
+Then I would take with me one or two of my men, and, say, a couple of
+your prize fighters, and with such a guard you ought to be fairly safe.”
+
+“I think that is a capital plan,” Mark said, “and if I don't go to the
+bank there will be nothing to lead them to suppose that I have taken
+them out, or that I am just going across to Holland.”
+
+Mark then went straight to Dick Chetwynd's lodgings.
+
+“I want you to do me a service, Dick,” he said.
+
+“With pleasure, Mark. What sort of service is it? If it is anything in
+my power, you know that you can absolutely rely upon me. You are not
+going to fight a duel, are you, and want a second?”
+
+“No; quite another sort of business. I will tell you shortly what it is.
+I have to convey an extremely valuable diamond bracelet to Amsterdam,
+and I have reason to believe that there will be an attempt to murder me,
+and to carry off the jewels before I can dispose of them. It happened in
+this way;” and he then related the history of the diamonds, the reason
+he was followed, and the suggestions that the Chief of the Bow Street
+detectives had given him.
+
+“That is all right,” Dick said, when he concluded. “It is a rum
+business, but certainly I will do what you ask me; and, what is more, I
+will go over with you to Amsterdam, and see the thing through. It is an
+interesting business, if it is a queer one.”
+
+“You know Philip Cotter?”
+
+“Of course, Mark; why, I have met him with you several times.”
+
+“I will give you a note to ask him to allow you to open the case, and
+to take from it the bracelet; I don't know whether it is a regular
+gold mounted bracelet, or simply some diamonds that have been fastened
+together as a necklace; however, I suppose you are sure to recognize
+them; they are altogether exceptional stones, and will certainly be done
+up in a packet by themselves, whatever the others may be. Say that you
+will call in and take them away some other time, of which I will give
+him notice by letter. I will write the note now, and if you can spare
+time to go there today, all the better, for I shall be glad to get the
+business over; then I will come again tomorrow morning, and we will
+arrange the details of the plan. I will look in the shipping list, and
+see what vessels are sailing for Amsterdam. When we have fixed on one,
+it will be best for you to take our passages under any names you like,
+so that they are not our own. The detectives will take their passages
+separately, and so will Gibbons and whoever else goes with us.”
+
+“I will go at once, Mark.”
+
+“Don't go straight there, Dick; if these fellows are dogging my
+footsteps everywhere, and saw me coming here, they might take it into
+their heads to follow you.”
+
+“Oh, they can never be doing all that sort of thing; that's too much to
+believe. However, to please you, I will go into my club for a quarter of
+an hour. Shall I come round to your rooms this evening, or will you come
+here?”
+
+“I think I will put off our meeting altogether until tomorrow morning. I
+have an engagement this evening that I cannot very well get out of.”
+
+“All right, Mark, just as you please. What time will you come round in
+the morning?”
+
+“About the time you have finished breakfast. I will go now, and have a
+look at the shipping list.”
+
+They parted at the door, and Mark went to the coffee house where
+shipping matters were specially attended to, and where master mariners
+might often be met, conversing together, or with ship owners or
+merchants. On going through the list, he found that the fast sailing
+brig, Essex, of 204 tons, and mounting eight guns, would sail for
+Amsterdam in three days' time, and would take in goods for that place,
+and, should sufficient freight be obtained, for any other Dutch port.
+It was also announced that she had good accommodation for passengers.
+Information as to cargo could be obtained from her owners, on Tower
+Hill, or from the captain on board, between the hours of ten and twelve.
+Then, in small type, it was stated that the Essex was at present lying
+in the outside tier nearly opposite Anderson's wharf.
+
+Mark made a note of all these particulars in his pocketbook, and then
+went to Ingleston's public house.
+
+“Morning, Mr. Thorndyke,” the man said; “haven't seen yer for the last
+month or so.”
+
+“No; I have been out of town. Do you expect Gibbons in here this
+morning?”
+
+“It is about his time, sir, when he has nothing in particular to see
+about. Like a turn with the mauleys this morning?”
+
+“Not this morning, Ingleston. I have got some engagements for the next
+day or two where I could not very well show myself with a black eye or a
+swelled nose; you have given me a good many of both.”
+
+“Well, Mr. Thorndyke, when one stands up against a man who is as strong
+as one's self, and a mighty quick and hard hitter, you have got to hit
+sharp and quick too. You know my opinion, that there aint half a dozen
+men in the country could lick you if you had a proper training.”
+
+“I suppose you couldn't get away for a week, or maybe two?” he said.
+
+“Lor' bless you, no, sir. Who would there be to keep order here at
+night? When I first came here I had not given up the ring, and I fought
+once or twice afterwards. But, Lor' bless you, I soon found that I had
+got either to give up the pub or the ring, and as I was doing a tidy
+business here, I thought it best to retire; since then business has
+grown. You see, boxing is more fashionable than it used to be, and
+there are very few nights when one don't have a dozen Corinthians in
+here--sometimes there are twice as many--either to see some of the new
+hands put on the mauleys, and judge for themselves how they are going to
+turn out, or maybe to arrange for a bout between some novice they fancy
+and one of the west countrymen. No, sir, I could not do it anyhow; I
+should not like to be away even for one night, though I know Gibbons
+would look after things for me; as for being away for a week, I could
+not do it for any money. No, sir, my fight with Jackson last year was
+the last time I shall ever go into the ring. I was a fool to go in for
+that, but I got taunted into it. I never thought that I should lick him,
+though, as you know, sir, I have licked a good many good men in my time,
+but Jackson is an out and out man, and he has got a lot more science
+than I ever had; my only chance was that I could knock him out of time
+or wear him down; but he was too quick on his pins for me to do the
+former. Ah, Gibbons, here is Mr. Thorndyke. He wants to see you; you had
+best go into my room behind the bar.”
+
+“Want to get hold of a fresh hand, Mr. Thorndyke?” Gibbons asked when
+they had sat down by the fire.
+
+“No, Gibbons, it is another business altogether. Have you got anything
+particular to keep you in town for the next fortnight? It may not be
+over a week, but it may be over a fortnight.”
+
+“No, sir,” the man said, after taking three or four draws at his long
+pipe. “No, sir; they won't want the ropes and stakes for another three
+weeks, so I am your man if you want me. What, is it for, sir?”
+
+“Well, it is rather a curious affair, Gibbons. I have to take a very
+valuable bracelet over to Amsterdam, to sell there, and I have very
+strong reasons for believing that if some fellows get an inkling of it
+they will try to put me out of the way, and get hold of the diamonds. I
+want a couple of good men to go with me.”
+
+“Well sir, I should say you and me could lick a dozen ordinary chaps,
+without thinking anything of it.”
+
+“I dare say we could, Gibbons, in a stand up fight without weapons, but
+I fancy these fellows will not try that. They are foreigners, and the
+first thing they would try would be to put a dagger between my shoulders
+as I walked up and down on deck at night, or, more likely still, creep
+into my cabin and stab me while I was asleep. If the voyage were only to
+last one night I might sit up, pistol in hand, but if the wind is foul
+we might be a week. We are a pretty strong party. Mr. Chetwynd--you know
+him--is going with me; there will also be two runners from Bow Street,
+and I want you to take another good man with you. Of course, on board
+we shall separate. The Bow Street men will watch the passengers, and you
+and your mate will smoke your pipes and keep yourselves ready to join
+in if you see there is going to be a row. But I rather think that the
+passage will be a quiet one. At Amsterdam, until I have got rid of the
+diamonds I certainly should not care about going out into the street
+after nightfall without having you close behind me.”
+
+“All right, sir. I should say Tom Tring would be as good a man as one
+could get at the job. What is the money to be, Mr. Thorndyke?”
+
+“Well, what do you think yourself, Gibbons?”
+
+“I take it you pay all expenses, sir?”
+
+“Yes, everything.”
+
+“Would five and twenty guineas a head be too much?”
+
+“No; I will do better than that. I will give you five and twenty guineas
+each when we get to Amsterdam, and I will give you another twenty-five
+each if I come back here safe and sound.”
+
+“Well, I call that handsome. One could not want more, and you can rely
+on it that Tring will jump at the offer. He has not been able to get a
+fight on lately, and he is rather in low water.”
+
+“Well, you will both get up as quiet traders. I don't know what other
+passengers there may be, but I don't want them to know that you belong
+to the fancy.”
+
+“I twig, sir. We will get up quiet like.”
+
+“Then I want you tomorrow morning, Gibbons, to go down to Holmes
+& Moore, No. 67 Tower Street, and take two first class tickets to
+Amsterdam on board the Essex, which sails on Saturday. I don't know what
+the passage money will be, but this is sure to be enough; and we can
+settle accounts afterwards. You will find out what time of day she will
+start.”
+
+“All right, governor. I suppose you will be here again before that?”
+
+“No, I don't suppose I shall, unless there is some change in the
+arrangements. If for any reasons Tring cannot go with you, you will
+get somebody else instead. You are sure that you quite understand
+your instructions? Here is the name and address of the people in Tower
+Street.”
+
+“All right, sir. You may make sure that when you go down to the ship you
+will see the two of us on board.”
+
+It needed but a few minutes at Bow Street to inform the chief of the
+arrangements that had been made.
+
+“I have told off Chester and Malcolm; one of them shall go down and
+take their tickets. Of course, they will take their passages in the fore
+cabin, as the danger, if there is danger, may come from there, and you
+will have your other two men with you aft. I fancy myself that there is
+hardly any chance of your being in any way troubled while on board.
+It will be considered that there will be a vastly greater chance of
+carrying out any plan they may have formed at Amsterdam than there would
+be on board a ship; you see, if there were any struggle whatever on
+board there would be no escape for them.
+
+“For myself, of course I cannot give any opinion worth having in a
+matter so different from anything we have to do with here, and I should
+have unhesitatingly scoffed at the idea of anyone watching the movements
+of people for a long number of years in order to obtain the possession
+of jewels, however valuable. However, your uncle was well acquainted
+with the habits of Hindoos, and was not a man to be lightly alarmed;
+you yourself, after your year with us, should not be deceived in such
+a matter as being yourself followed; under these circumstances you
+are quite right to take every precaution, and as you pay well for
+the services of our two men, even if I had no belief whatever in the
+existence of danger to you, I should not feel justified in refusing to
+let you have them.”
+
+Having arranged these matters, Mark spent the rest of his time that day
+and the next at Islington.
+
+“I am going across to Amsterdam on Saturday with a diamond bracelet to
+sell there.”
+
+Millicent looked at him in reproachful surprise.
+
+“Why, surely, Mark, there can be no hurry about that. I think you might
+have stayed a little longer before running away.”
+
+“I should do so, you may be quite sure, Millicent, if I consulted my own
+inclinations, but I am bearing out your father's wishes. This bracelet
+is the most valuable of all the things he had, and I believe that it has
+some sort of history attached to it. He told my father that he had
+sent all the gems home principally to get these diamonds out of his
+possession; he said that as soon as my father got hold of the things, he
+was to take the diamonds straight over to Amsterdam and sell them there,
+for he considered that they were much too valuable to be kept in the
+house, and that it was possible that some of the Hindoos might endeavor
+to get possession of them. At the time he spoke he believed that my
+father would, at his death, go to the bank and get the jewels, as of
+course he would have done if he had known where to find them. My
+father promised him that they should be taken to Amsterdam at once; and
+although so many years have passed since his death, I think I am bound
+to carry out that promise.”
+
+“I have never been able to understand, Mark, how it was that my father,
+when he gave all these instructions about me and these jewels and so on,
+did not at the same time tell uncle where to find them.”
+
+“It was a fancy of his; he was in very bad health, and he thought so
+much over these diamonds that it had become almost a sort of mania with
+him that not only was there danger in their possession, but that he
+was watched night and day wherever he went. He thought, even, if he
+whispered where the hiding place was to be discovered it might be heard;
+therefore he deferred telling it until too late. Of course all this
+was but a fancy on his part, although it is probable enough that the
+possession of the diamonds was a source of danger in India, and might
+have been a source of danger here had any thieves known that such
+valuable gems were kept in a private house or carried about. At any
+rate, I shall be glad to be free of the responsibility; and although,
+naturally, I don't like leaving you at the present time, I think it best
+to carry out your father's instructions at once, and to get them off
+my mind altogether. Dick Chetwynd is going with me, so it will be a
+pleasant little trip.”
+
+“Well, I am glad he is going with you, Mark; for although I know well
+enough that they could never be watching for those diamonds to turn
+up all these years, I feel sure I should fidget and worry if you were
+alone. You are not going to take the others with you?”
+
+“No, only this particular bracelet. None of the others are exceptionally
+valuable, so far as I know. At any rate, your father did not specially
+allude to them. I have no doubt that there are some really valuable
+jewels among them, for my uncle prided himself on being a judge of
+precious stones, and as he invested a large amount of money in them,
+they are, no doubt, worth a great deal. Still, I don't suppose there
+will be any difficulty in selling them here, and, at any rate, I don't
+want to be delayed at Amsterdam by having to sell perhaps fifty or a
+hundred pieces of jewelry; any time will do for that. I fancy that I
+ought to be able to dispose of the bracelet in three or four days at the
+outside. I have got from Bow Street a list of all the principal diamond
+merchants in Amsterdam. That is a matter of great interest to the force,
+as almost all precious stones stolen in this country are sent across
+there, and if there is any special jewel robbery we send over a list of
+all the articles taken to the merchants there. As a rule, that would
+not prevent their dealing in them, but there are some who will not touch
+things that have been dishonestly come by, and we occasionally get hints
+that enable us to lay hands upon thieves over there.”
+
+“I hate to hear you say 'the force,' Mark, just as if you were still a
+detective; it is bad enough that you should have belonged to it, even
+for the purpose you did; but you have done with it now.”
+
+“Yes; but, you see, it is rather difficult to get out of the habit when
+one has been for over a year constantly at work at a thing. This will be
+my last absence on business, Millicent; henceforward I shall be able to
+be always with you.”
+
+“Well, now that I know what you have been doing all this time, Mark, I
+must admit that you have been very good to have been with us as much as
+you have. I often used to wonder how you passed your time. Of course I
+knew that you were trying to find that man out, but it did not seem to
+me that you could be always at that, and I never dreamt that you had
+become a regular detective. I am very glad I did not know it till a
+short time before you gave it up. In the first place, I should have
+been horrified, and, in the second place, I should have been constantly
+uneasy about you. However, as this is to be the last time, I will let
+you go without grumbling.”
+
+“By the way, Millicent, what do you wish me to say about our engagement?
+I don't see that there is the slightest occasion for us to keep up the
+farce of your being Miss Conyers any longer. You cannot be married under
+a false name, you know, and now that you have escaped what your father
+was so afraid of, and are going to be married for love and not for
+money, I don't see why there should be any more mystery about it.”
+
+“But how would you account for my having been called Conyers all this
+time?”
+
+“I should simply tell the truth; that your father, having a great fear
+that you might be married for money, left the estate to my father, to
+be held by him until you came of age, and that it was at his particular
+request that you were brought up simply as his ward, and dropped the
+family name and passed by your two Christian names. I should say that
+we have all been aware for a long time of the facts of the case, and
+I should also say that your father had left a very large fortune in
+addition to the estate between us, and had expressed a hope that we
+should, when the time came, marry each other.”
+
+“Then people will think that we have only married to keep the fortune
+together, Mark.”
+
+“Well, my dear, I don't suppose there are a great many people who will
+be interested in the matter, and those who get to know you will see at
+once that as far as I am concerned, there was no great difficulty in
+falling in with your father's ideas, while, on the other hand, they may
+consider that you made a noble sacrifice of yourself in agreeing to the
+plan.”
+
+“Nonsense, sir. I am not going to flatter you, as no doubt you expect;
+but, at any rate, I am perfectly content with my share of the bargain.”
+
+“Well, there is one thing, Millicent; all who knew us down at Reigate
+will say that it is a very sensible arrangement, and will be glad to
+know that I shall retain the estate they have hitherto considered to be
+mine. Well, then, you agree to my mentioning to my intimate friends that
+you are my cousin, and that we are engaged?”
+
+“Yes, I suppose it is the best thing, Mark, and, as you say, I must
+marry under my proper name, and it is just as well to get the talk
+over down at Reigate now, as for it all to come as a wonder when we are
+married.”
+
+“When is that going to be, Millicent?”
+
+“Oh, I don't know; of course it will be a long time before we even think
+of that.”
+
+“I beg your pardon, I am thinking of it now, and I can see no reason
+whatever why it should be delayed. We know each other well enough, I
+should think, and there is no probability of our changing our minds on
+discovering all sorts of faults, that we never dreamt, in each other.
+I may be away for a fortnight, and I would suggest that you had better
+make your preparations at once, so that we can be married a fortnight
+after I come back.”
+
+“You say that there is no fear of our discovering faults in each other.
+I can assure you that I have just discovered a very serious fault,
+namely, that you are altogether too masterful, too bent upon having your
+own way. I know you always were so when you were a boy, but I hoped
+you had grown out of it; now I see that I was altogether mistaken.
+Seriously, Mark, your proposal is absurd.”
+
+“Where does the absurdity come in, Millicent?”
+
+“Well, everywhere,” she said gravely.
+
+“Which in the present case means nowhere,” he said. “Do you mean to tell
+me, Millicent, that in this town there are not a hundred dressmakers,
+each of whom could turn you out a wedding dress and as many other
+garments as you can possibly require in the course of a month, or even
+if that effort were too stupendous, that you could not divide the work
+among a dozen of them?”
+
+“Well, I don't say that could not be done,” Millicent admitted
+reluctantly.
+
+“Well, what other objection is there?”
+
+“Well, you see, one does not, like to be bustled in such a matter as
+this, Mark. One likes to think it all over and to realize it to one's
+self.”
+
+“Well, dear, you will have a fortnight while I am away to think and to
+realize as much as you like. I can see no advantage myself in waiting
+a single day longer than there is a necessity for; I have been for the
+last year coming here merely as a visitor, and I want to take possession
+of you and have you all to myself. I suppose Mrs. Cunningham will be
+coming in presently, and I will put the matter to her. If she says you
+cannot be ready in a month I must give you another week, but I don't
+think that she will say so. By the way, how about her?”
+
+“I was thinking of that last night, Mark. It would be very lonely for
+her to live by herself now, and you see she has always been as a mother
+to me.”
+
+“Quite so, dear; and I am sure that I should have no objection to her
+coming back to Crowswood, and living there as a friend, and helping you
+in the housekeeping.”
+
+“Thank you very much, Mark; I should like that in every way. You see, I
+know nothing whatever about housekeeping; and besides, when you are
+out, it would be a great thing to have her with me, for it would be very
+lonely by myself in that big house.”
+
+“Well, we will have her there, by all means, dear, if she likes to come;
+you had better talk it over with her. Ah! here she is.
+
+“We were just talking over the time it will take Millicent to get
+ready,” he said, “and I shall be glad of your opinion. I have been
+telling her that I am going away for a fortnight, and have proposed that
+the marriage should come off a fortnight later. I cannot see any use in
+delay, and she does not either; at least, I suppose not, for the only
+objection she has advanced is that there will be but a short time in
+which to get her things ready. That strikes me as being all nonsense.
+I could get things ready for ten weddings in that time. What do you
+think?”
+
+“I see no reason for delay,” Mrs. Cunningham said; “and assuredly a
+month ought to be sufficient to get everything made.”
+
+“Thank you, Mrs. Cunningham; then we can consider that settled,
+Millicent!”
+
+“I call this tyranny, Mrs. Cunningham,” Millicent protested. “He says
+he proposes that we shall be married in a month; it is not a proposal at
+all, it is an order. If he had wanted me in such a hurry he might have
+said so a year ago, and now that he has made up his mind at last, he
+wants everything done in a hurry.”
+
+“It is the nature of men, my dear; they are all alike in that respect.
+I think you had better make up your mind to it, especially as I have no
+doubt in this case the order is not a very unpleasant one.”
+
+“You are too bad, Mrs. Cunningham,” Millicent said. “I made sure that I
+should find you on my side, and it seems you have gone over altogether
+to the enemy.”
+
+“Where are you going to?” asked Mrs. Cunningham of Mark.
+
+“I am going across to Amsterdam to sell that bracelet. My uncle
+expressed a particular wish to my father that he should do so
+immediately it came into his possession. Dick Chetwynd is going over
+with me, and if the weather is fair it will be a pleasant trip.”
+
+“Where are you thinking of going after the marriage?”
+
+“We have not talked it over yet. My own idea is that, as neither of
+us has been abroad, we might as well take this opportunity for seeing
+something of the Continent. Of course we cannot go to France, things are
+in too disturbed a state there; but we might go to Brussels, and then
+into Germany, and perhaps as far as Vienna, and then down into Italy;
+but of course, if Millicent prefers it, we will simply take a tour
+through England and Scotland.”
+
+“Oh, I am glad that I am to have some voice in the matter,” Millicent
+said. “However, I should like the tour you propose very much, Mark. I
+have often thought that I should like to see Italy above all places.”
+
+“Well, then, we will consider that settled. And now, what are you going
+to do for today?”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX.
+
+
+The Essex was to sail at eleven o'clock. Half an hour before that
+time Mark's hackney coach drew up at the wharf. Ten minutes later Dick
+Chetwynd, who had, like Mark, driven by a circuitous route, and had made
+several stoppages, joined him, and as they shook hands slipped a parcel
+into his hand, and this Mark at once pocketed, and buttoned his coat up
+tightly; then hailing a boat, they went on board together; they had sent
+their luggage on the previous evening. On getting on board Mark saw the
+two prize fighters walking up and down the deck aft. They were quietly
+dressed, and save for their size would have attracted no attention,
+and would have been taken for two countrymen on their way to Holland on
+business.
+
+The two detectives were seated forward, their appearance being that of
+two quiet business men, commercial travelers or small traders. The two
+friends first went below, and saw to the cabin which they were to share,
+and found their luggage was all there. Then they returned on deck. Four
+or five other passengers were standing watching the last bales of goods
+coming on board. The tide was just on the turn, and a quarter of an hour
+later the warps were thrown off, and some of the sails hoisted, and the
+Essex began to move through the water.
+
+“Look there, Dick!” Mark exclaimed. “Do you see that boat lying on its
+oars in the middle of the stream? That man sitting in the stern is a
+foreigner, either from Southern Europe or from India.”
+
+“He is certainly a dark man, Mark. Still, that may be only a
+coincidence.”
+
+“It is rather a curious one,” Mark said. “We are too far off to see
+his features, but he is apparently watching us off. There, the oars are
+dipping into the water, now he sees that we are fairly under way.”
+
+“Well, Mark, I shall begin to think that you are right. I am bound to
+say that hitherto I thought that it was ridiculous to suppose that
+you could have been watched as you thought, and that you had got these
+diamonds on your brain till you had really become fanciful. However, it
+certainly looks as if you were right; but even if you were, how on earth
+could they have found out that we were going by this ship?”
+
+“That is more than I can tell; if they have been watching me they must
+have known that I was intimate with you; they have seen me come out of
+Cotter's Bank, and afterwards enter your lodgings; they would feel sure
+that I had heard that there would be danger connected with the diamonds,
+and might suppose that I should get some friend to take them from the
+bank, and may have followed your movements as well as mine. In that case
+they would have found out that you also went to Cotter's Bank; may have
+followed you to Tower Street, and found out that you had taken a passage
+for two to Amsterdam. They may again have seen you go to the bank this
+morning and have guessed that you had the diamonds about you, and then
+seeing us together on the wharf would feel pretty certain that it was
+so. One of them may have hired that boat and watched the Essex to see
+that neither of us went on shore again.”
+
+“Now they see that we are off they will know that their game is up,”
+ Chetwynd said.
+
+“I am not so sure of that, Dick; there are craft going every day to
+Antwerp and Flushing, and for anything we know some of them may be on
+board a craft already dropping down like ourselves by this tide. But
+even if we had twelve hours' start, by landing, say at Flushing, they
+would have time to cross by land to Amsterdam and get there before us.”
+
+“Yes, I suppose they would; anyhow, it is pretty certain that we shall
+not be troubled on the voyage.”
+
+“Yes, I never thought there was much danger of that, because even if
+they were on board they would see that you and I, being always together,
+could not be got rid of without an alarm being given.”
+
+Not until they were passing Greenwich did either of the detectives come
+near Mark, then as he and Dick were standing by the bulwarks, looking
+at the hospital, Chester strolled across the deck and, pointing to the
+building as if asking him some question about it, said:
+
+“There is a colored man forward, dressed as a sailor.”
+
+“Is that so?” Mark said. “I see no one aft here who looks suspicious,
+and I don't think they will try anything till we get to Amsterdam. There
+was a colored man in a boat watching us as we set sail.”
+
+“I saw him, sir. Can he get to Amsterdam before us?”
+
+“Yes, I have no doubt he can; if he lands at Flushing or Antwerp, and
+takes a post chaise or a diligence, I should say he could get there
+twenty-four hours before us. Certainly he could do so if he landed at
+The Hague, as we have to go a long way round to get into the Zuyder Zee.
+That is where the real danger will be; still you had better keep a sharp
+lookout on the man forward.”
+
+No more was said. Mark was not long in getting into conversation with
+the other passengers aft, and later on strolled forward with Dick,
+asking the sailors some questions as to what sort of passage they were
+likely to have, and how the wind suited. The men agreed that unless the
+wind shifted they would not be likely to make a quick passage.
+
+“The wind is northeasterly,” one of them said. “We can only just lay
+our course now, and it will be dead against us in some of the reaches.
+Still, I think we shall manage to make down to sea with only a tack or
+two, but when we are once fairly out of the river it will be a long leg
+and a short one, and going up round the Texel it will be dead against
+us. Except that it would be a bit worse if it had a little more east
+in it, it is about as foul a wind as we could have, and I don't see any
+sign of a change, worse luck.”
+
+Presently, moving about among them, he got next to Gibbons.
+
+“I don't think we shall have any trouble on board,” he said; “if there
+is any, it will be after we have landed. But you can keep an eye on that
+foreign sailor standing alone there up in the bows.”
+
+“All right, sir; if you like, I can manage to get into a quarrel with
+him, and can warrant that he won't get out of his berth before it is
+time to go ashore.”
+
+“No, I would leave him alone, Gibbons; as long as he is forward he can
+do no harm; but if you see him working his way aft, after it gets dark,
+it will do him no harm if you manage to stumble against him and give him
+a clout on the head.”
+
+“All right, sir; if I hit him once he won't want another. The fellow
+seems quiet enough, and as far as strength goes he don't look stronger
+than a girl.”
+
+After chatting for some time longer Mark and Dick Chetwynd went aft
+again. The Essex did not put into any intermediate port, and it was only
+on the sixth day after sailing that she approached Amsterdam. The voyage
+had passed off without any incident except that at nine o'clock one
+evening there had been a slight noise on deck and the sound of a fall.
+The friends went up at once. Several of the sailors had run aft, and
+Gibbons was explaining matters to them.
+
+“I was walking up and down the deck,” he said, “when I saw this chap
+staring down through the skylight, and I said to him, 'I don't call it
+good manners to be prying down into your betters' cabin.' He did not
+answer or move, so I gave him a push, when he turned upon me like a wild
+cat, and drew his knife from his girdle. There it is, on the other side
+of the deck. As I did not want daylight put into me, I just knocked him
+down.”
+
+“Served him right,” one of the sailors said. “He had no right to come
+aft at all, and if he drew his knife on you, you were quite right in
+laying him out. But you must have hit him mighty hard, for you have
+knocked the life pretty near out of him. Well, we may as well carry him
+forward and throw a bucket of water over him. That is the worst of these
+foreign chaps; they are always so ready with their knives. However, I
+don't think he will be likely to try his hand on an Englishman again.”
+
+Mark and his friend went below again. In the morning Mark asked one of
+the sailors if the foreigner was much hurt.
+
+“Well, he is a good bit hurt, sir. That big chap looks as strong as a
+bullock, and his blow has flattened the foreign chap's nose. He cannot
+see out of his eyes this morning, and is keeping his bunk. They cannot
+stand a blow, those foreign chaps; but I don't suppose that any of us
+would have stood such a blow as that, without feeling it pretty heavy.
+The man who hit him is quite sorry this morning that he hit him quite so
+hot, but, as he says, when a fellow draws a knife on you, you have not
+got much time for thinking it over, and you have got to hit quick and
+hard. I told him he needn't be sorry about it. I consider when a fellow
+draws a knife that hanging aint too bad for him, whether he gets it into
+a man or not.”
+
+There was a growl of assent from two or three sailors standing round,
+for in those days the use of the knife was almost unknown in England,
+and was abhorrent to Englishmen, both as being cowardly and unfair, and
+as being a purely foreign crime.
+
+“It will be dark before we get alongside,” Mark said to the two
+detectives. “Do you two walk first; we will keep just behind you, and
+the others shall follow as close as they can keep to us. If anyone is
+looking out for us they will see that we are a strong party, and that it
+would be no good to attack us, for even if they were to stab me it would
+not be possible to search me for the diamonds when I am with a party
+like this.”
+
+It was indeed quite dark when the brig brought up outside a tier of
+vessels lying by the wharf. A few oil lamps burning by the quay showed
+that there were a good many people still sauntering about. The party
+waited until the rest of the passengers had landed. They learned from
+one of those who knew the place that the hotel to which they were going
+was but three or four hundred yards away, and obtained directions how to
+find it.
+
+“Now we will go,” Mark said. “Gibbons, you had better keep a sharp
+lookout on your own account. That fellow you knocked down may try to put
+a knife into you.”
+
+“I will keep a sharp lookout, sir, never you fear.”
+
+“I think, Tring, you had better watch Gibbons; he is more in danger than
+I am. Have you seen the man go on shore?”
+
+“Yes, he was the very first to cross onto the next vessel,” Tring said.
+
+The loungers on the quay had gathered together to watch the passengers
+as they left the ship, and by the dim light from one of the oil lamps it
+could be seen that the majority of them were of the roughest class.
+As they were passing through them a man with a cry of rage sprang at
+Gibbons with an uplifted knife. Tring's fist struck him under the ear as
+he was in the act of striking, and he fell like a log. There was a cry
+of “Down with them!” and a rush of a score of men, most of whom were
+armed with heavy bludgeons.
+
+The party was at once broken up, heavy blows were exchanged, the two
+pugilists rolling their assailants over like ninepins, but receiving
+several heavy blows from their assailants' clubs. A rush of five or
+six men separated Mark from the others. Those in front of him he struck
+down, but a moment later received a tremendous blow on the back of the
+head which struck him to the ground unconscious. His companions were all
+too busy defending themselves against their assailants to notice what
+had been done, and as the attack had taken place in the center of the
+roadway behind the quay, there was no lamp, and the fight was taking
+place in almost total darkness.
+
+By this time many people had run up at the sound of the fray. A minute
+later there was a cry that the watch were coming, and four or five men
+with lanterns emerged from one of the streets leading down to the quays,
+and hurried towards the spot. The fight at once ceased, the men who had
+attacked mingled with the crowd, and when the watch came up they found
+the five Englishmen clustered together and ten or twelve men lying on
+the ground.
+
+The instant that the fight had ceased Dick Chetwynd asked, “Where is Mr.
+Thorndyke?”
+
+No answer was given. The other four men simultaneously uttered
+exclamations of alarm. The crowd was thinning fast as the watch came up.
+
+“What is all this about?” one of them asked in Dutch.
+
+“Do any of you speak English?” Dick asked.
+
+“I do,” one of them said.
+
+“We landed five minutes ago from that craft,” continued Dick, “and as we
+came across we were attacked by a band of ruffians. An Englishman, one
+of our party, is missing.”
+
+“Whose bodies are these?” the watchman asked, raising his lantern and
+pointing to them.
+
+“Perhaps Mr. Thorndyke is among them,” Dick Chetwynd said.
+
+The fallen figures were examined by the light of the lanterns. Mark was
+not among them. The watchmen uttered an exclamation of astonishment as
+they looked at the men's faces.
+
+“What did you strike them with?” the one who spoke first asked.
+
+“Struck them with our fists, of course,” Gibbons replied. “They will do
+well enough; you need not bother about them, they will come round again
+presently. The question is, Where is Mr. Thorndyke?”
+
+The whole of the lookers on had dispersed, each fearing that he might be
+charged with taking part in the outrage.
+
+“This is a very serious matter,” Chetwynd said. “We have every reason
+to believe that the attack was premeditated, for the gentleman who is
+missing was known to have some valuables on him; all these fellows ought
+to be taken and locked up and made to give an account of themselves. We
+are going to the Hotel d'Hollande where you can find us at any time. I
+dare say some of these scoundrels are known to you, and that may give
+you a clew as to where Mr. Thorndyke is.
+
+“I have but little hope that he will be found alive; no doubt he has
+been stabbed and his body carried off so that they can search his
+clothes at their leisure. We came in a strong party to prevent the risk
+of an attack upon Mr. Thorndyke. Here is my card. It is of no use our
+attempting to search by ourselves, but if you will get these fellows
+taken to the watch house, and will call at the hotel, we will join your
+party and help you to search the places you think he has most likely
+been taken to.”
+
+“I think, sir, you had better come with me to the watch house, and see
+the Lieutenant, and tell him what has happened.”
+
+“I will just take my friends to the hotel, and shall be back from there
+before you have got men to take these fellows away. If you go to one of
+those ships and borrow a bucket, empty it over each of them; you will
+find that will bring them to!”
+
+As soon as they arrived at the hotel Dick ordered a private sitting room
+and five bedrooms.
+
+“We have made a terrible mess of this, lads,” he said gloomily. “I don't
+say that it is any of our faults, but it is a horrible affair. I have
+not the least doubt that Mr. Thorndyke has been killed, and it is no
+satisfaction to us that we have pretty nearly done for a dozen of those
+scoundrels.”
+
+“I would not have had it happen for a hundred pounds, nor a thousand,
+sir. If there had been daylight we could have licked a score of them in
+spite of their bludgeons, but they came with such a rush at us that we
+got separated before we knew where we were. I don't think that it was
+our fault. I feel as much ashamed as if I had thrown up the sponge in
+the ring at the end of the first round. To think that we came over here,
+four of us, and yourself, sir, on purpose to take care of Mr. Thorndyke,
+all well save a few knocks with those sticks, and Mr. Thorndyke killed
+and carried off before we have been on shore five minutes. A better
+young fellow I never put on the gloves with;” and Gibbons passed the
+back of his hand across his eyes.
+
+“Well, I must be off now,” Chetwynd said. “I feel heartbroken over it.
+I have known him since we were boys together; and what makes it worse
+is that only three days ago he became engaged to be married. How we are
+going to take the news back God only knows!”
+
+As he hurried down the street towards the wharf he saw a number of
+lanterns coming towards him, and ten or twelve watchmen came along
+escorting the prisoners, many of whose faces were covered with blood;
+then came four other watchmen carrying a body on a stretcher.
+
+“One of them is dead,” the watchman who had before spoken said to Dick.
+“A foreign seaman, a Lascar I should say, from his color; we found an
+open knife by his side.”
+
+“That is the man who began the fray,” Chetwynd said. “He was on the
+point of stabbing one of my companions when another hit him under the
+ear.”
+
+“What!” the watchman said. “He must have been hit like the kick of a
+horse. All these prisoners seem to have been struck but once; two of
+them cannot speak. I think their jaws are broken; four of them have
+broken noses, and another has had all his front teeth knocked out, while
+the others are nearly as bad.”
+
+“I see you have brought with you some of their bludgeons,” Dick said,
+pointing to one of the watchmen carrying a great bundle of sticks over
+his shoulder.
+
+“Yes, sir, twenty-three of them; it certainly seems to show that it
+was a planned thing. Most of these fellows' faces are so bruised that
+I cannot say who they are at present, but two or three are known as the
+worst ruffians in the city, and I have no doubt we shall find that they
+all belong to the same gang.”
+
+By this time they had arrived at the watch house, a building of
+considerable size; the prisoners were first lodged in a strong room with
+barred windows and very heavy doors, and then the watchman went with
+Chetwynd to the Lieutenant's room. The officer had just returned, having
+hurried down with a reinforcement to the wharf as soon as he had heard
+of the fray, and tried to obtain some information from the people who
+had gathered round, attracted by the lanterns of the watch. He had
+already learned from the watchmen all they knew about the affair. As he
+spoke English well, he at once addressed Dick:
+
+“This is a serious affair, sir.”
+
+“A very serious affair, for, indeed, I am afraid that my dearest friend
+has been murdered.”
+
+“Will you kindly give me the particulars?” the officer said, sitting
+down to the table with a pen in his hand.
+
+Dick Chetwynd told him the story of how Mr. Thorndyke, having some very
+valuable jewels that he wished to dispose of, and believing that he
+would be attacked by a band of robbers, had asked him to accompany him,
+and had brought four detective officers and pugilists to protect him
+against any sudden attack.
+
+“Ah, that accounts for the terrible blows that these fellows received,”
+ the officer said. “And your friend; was he a strong man?”
+
+“He was a man exceptionally strong, and a match for either of the
+pugilists that he brought over. I have no doubt that he was stabbed,
+though of course he might have been brought down by a blow from one of
+the bludgeons. He must have been completely insensible when carried off.
+
+“The watchman here tells me that three or four of these ruffians are
+known, and perhaps if you will give orders for the blood to be washed
+off the others' faces some more may be recognized and prove an aid in
+enabling you to form an idea where Mr. Thorndyke has been carried. I
+trust that you will send out a party to search for him. I and the four
+men with me will gladly join them, and may be of use if any resistance
+is offered.”
+
+The Lieutenant at once gave orders to the watchman to go down and see
+that the prisoners all washed their faces. As soon as he returned with
+the report that this was done the officer went down with Dick Chetwynd
+to examine them. Three or four of the men with lanterns also went in.
+Eight out of eleven men were recognized; the other three, whose features
+were so swollen that they could not see out of their eyes, could not be
+made out, but their companions, on being questioned, gave their names.
+
+“They all belong to a gang of wharf thieves and plunderers. They live
+in a slum near the water. I will have men posted in the lanes leading
+to it, and will myself go with you to see that a search is made of every
+house; but first I will try to find out from these fellows where he was
+to be taken.
+
+“Now, my men,” he said, “anyone of you who will tell me where one of the
+party you attacked was to be taken to will find things made easy for him
+at his trial.”
+
+None of the men spoke for a minute, and then one said:
+
+“We know nothing about it; how should we, when we were all knocked
+stupid?”
+
+“No, but you might know where he was to be taken.”
+
+“I know nothing about that. We all got word to mind we were on the wharf
+when a brig, that was seen coming up, came alongside, and that we were
+to have a hundred francs each for attacking some passengers as they
+landed. Six of them came along together, and one said, 'These are the
+men.' A black sailor came up first and spoke to two or three men in some
+foreign language. I don't know who the men were; it was too dark to see
+their faces. It was one of them who gave the order. It seemed an easy
+job enough when there were twenty-five of us with heavy sticks, but it
+didn't turn out so. I only know that I hit one big fellow a blow that
+ought to have knocked him down, and the next moment there was a crash,
+and I don't know anything more about it until a lot of water was thrown
+over me and one of the watch helped me to my feet. I don't know whether
+the others know more than I do, but I don't think they do.”
+
+All the others protested at once that they were equally ignorant. They
+had gone to earn a hundred francs. They had been told that the money was
+all right, but who found it or who were the men to be attacked they had
+not the least idea.
+
+“How was it that you all had these bludgeons--there were no knives found
+on any of you?”
+
+The man who spoke before said:
+
+“The order was 'No knives,' and before we went down to the wharf each
+of us was searched and a stick given to us. I suppose from that, that
+whoever paid for the job didn't want blood to be shed; it suited us well
+enough, for it was a job there was sure to be a row over, and I don't
+suppose any of us wanted to put his head in a noose. I know that we all
+said to each other as we went out that it did not want such sticks as we
+had to give a man a thrashing, but the man who hired us, whoever he was,
+knew his customers better than we did.”
+
+The officer translated the man's words as they were spoken to Dick, and
+on hearing the last speech, the latter said:
+
+“Then there is still hope that Thorndyke may only have been stunned;
+that is a greater reason for our losing no time in looking for him, for
+I am afraid that they won't hesitate to kill him when they have got him
+hidden away.”
+
+“I expect,” the Lieutenant said, “they thought that if any of the watch
+came upon them as they were carrying him off, they might be at once
+arrested if it was found that they were carrying a dead man, whilst if
+he were only stunned they would say that it was a drunken comrade who
+had fallen and knocked his head against something. I agree with you,
+sir; we had better start on our search at once.”
+
+“Will you pass the Hotel d'Hollande? If not, I will run and bring my
+men.”
+
+“Yes, I will go that way; it will be no further.”
+
+Dick walked on fast.
+
+“We have no news of him,” he said, as he entered the room where the four
+men were anxiously awaiting him, “but we and the watch are now going to
+search the slums where the men who were taken prisoners all live; come
+down now, and I will tell you what I have learned, before the others
+come up.
+
+“There is reason for believing that he was not stabbed,” he went on, as
+they reached the street, “for the men all say that they were armed only
+with clubs, and that the strictest orders were given that none were to
+carry knives, therefore there is little doubt that he was at the time
+only stunned. But I am bound to say that this gives me very small ground
+for hoping that we may find him alive. I fear they only stunned him, so
+that they might carry him safely to their haunts, for if stopped
+they could say that it was a drunken comrade, who had fallen and hurt
+himself. I fear that when they get him into one of their dens they will
+make short work of him, therefore it is clear that there is not a moment
+to be lost. Ah, here comes the watch.”
+
+There were eight men with the Lieutenant.
+
+“I have already sent off ten others,” he said as he joined Chetwynd, “to
+watch the lanes, and let no one go in or out. I thought it best not to
+lose a moment about that, for when the men see that we have learned
+from the others where the gang came from, and have closed the avenues
+of escape, they will hesitate about murdering their prisoner if he was
+still alive when my men got there.”
+
+In a quarter of an hour they arrived at the end of a narrow lane, where
+two watchmen were standing with lanterns.
+
+“You have seen nor heard nothing?” the Lieutenant asked him.
+
+“No, sir, we have not seen a man moving in the lane.”
+
+“There is just one hope that we might be in time,” the Lieutenant said,
+as he went on down the lane, “and that is, that the fellows when they
+gather will be so dismayed at finding that nearly half their number are
+missing, and knowing that some of them are pretty sure to make a clean
+breast of it, they will hesitate to complete their crime. It is one
+thing to rob a man in the streets, quite another to murder him in cold
+blood. There is likely to be a good deal of difference of opinion among
+them, some of the more desperate being in favor of carrying the thing
+through, but others are sure to be against it, and nothing may have been
+done. You may be sure that the sight of my men at the end of the lanes
+will still further alarm them. I have no doubt the news that we have
+surrounded the district has already been circulated, and that if alive
+now he is safe, for they will think it is better to suffer a year or
+two's imprisonment than to be tried for murder. We are sure to make some
+captures, for it is probable that several of the others will bear marks
+of the fight. Each man we take we will question separately; one or other
+of them is pretty safe to be ready to say where your friend was taken to
+if I promise him that he shan't be prosecuted.”
+
+Every house in the district was searched from top to bottom. Six
+men; with cut and bruised faces, were found shamming sleep, and were
+separately questioned closely; all declared that they knew nothing
+whatever of anyone being carried there.
+
+“It is of no use your denying your share in the affair,” the Lieutenant
+said. “Your comrades have confessed that there were twenty-five of you
+hired to carry out this, and that you received a hundred francs each.
+Now, if this gentleman is not found, it will be a hanging matter for
+some of you, and you had better tell all you know. If you will tell us
+where he is, I will promise that you shan't be included in the list of
+those who will be prosecuted.”
+
+The reply, although put in different words, was identical with that of
+the prisoners.
+
+“We had nothing to do with carrying him off; we were hired only to
+knock the men down who were pointed out to us; not a word was said about
+carrying them off. He may have been carried off, that we cannot say, but
+he has certainly not been brought here, and none of us had anything to
+do with it.”
+
+Morning was breaking before the search was concluded. The detectives,
+accustomed as they were to visit the worst slums of London, were
+horrified at the crowding, the squalor, and the misery of the places
+they entered.
+
+“My opinion. Mr. Chetwynd,” Gibbons growled, “is that the best thing to
+do would be to put a score of soldiers at the end of all these lanes,
+and then to burn the whole place down, and make a clean sweep of it. I
+never saw such a villainous looking crew in all my life. I have been
+in hopes all along that some of them would resist; it would have been a
+real pleasure to have let fly at them.”
+
+“They are a villainous set of wretches, Gibbons, but they may not be all
+criminals.”
+
+“Well; I don't know, sir; but I know that if I were on a jury, and any
+of the lot were in the dock, I should not want to hear any evidence
+against them; their faces are enough to hang them.”
+
+At last the search was over, and they were glad indeed when they emerged
+from the lanes and breathed the pure air outside, for all the Englishmen
+felt sick at the poisonous air of the dens they had entered. The
+prisoners, as they were taken, had been sent off to the watch house.
+
+“I begin to think that the story these fellows tell is a true one, Mr.
+Chetwynd,” the Lieutenant said, “and that they had nothing to do with
+carrying your friend off. In the first place, they all tell the same
+story: that in itself would not be much, as that might have been settled
+beforehand; but it is hardly likely that one of the lot would not have
+been ready to purchase his life by turning on the others. There is very
+little honor among thieves; and as they know that we have taken their
+mates--for no doubt we were watched as we marched them up the town--they
+would make sure that someone would turn traitor, and would think they
+might as well be beforehand. I fancy that the men, whoever they are,
+who hired this gang to attack you, carried out that part of the business
+themselves.”
+
+“I am afraid that is so,” Dick agreed; “and I fear in that case that he
+is in even worse hands than if these ruffians here had taken him.”
+
+“Well, sir, can you furnish us with any clew?”
+
+“The only clew is that they were most probably dark men. That man who
+was killed was undoubtedly one of them. I should say that they would
+probably be got up as foreign sailors.”
+
+“Well, that is something to go upon, at any rate. I will send round men
+at once to all the places by the quays where sailors board, and if three
+or four of them have been together at any place we are sure to hear of
+it, and the moment I have news I will send to your hotel.”
+
+“Thank you; I don't see that we can be of any use at present, but you
+will find us ready to turn out again the moment we hear that you have
+news.”
+
+When the party returned to the hotel they sat talking the matter over
+for upwards of an hour. All were greatly discouraged, for they had
+little hope indeed of ever learning what had become of Mark. As they had
+started out Dick had told the night porter that he could not say what
+time they might return, but that before the house closed he must have a
+couple of bottles of spirits and some tumblers sent up to their sitting
+room, together with some bread and cold meat, for that they might not
+return until morning, and would need something before they went to bed,
+as they had had nothing since their dinner, at one o'clock.
+
+“It wants something to take the taste of that place out of one's mouth,”
+ Tring said to Dick, as, directly they entered, he poured some spirits
+into the glasses. “I feel as queer as if I had been hocussed.”
+
+All, indeed, were feeling the same, and it was not until they had eaten
+their supper and considerably lowered the spirits in the two bottles
+that they began to talk. The two detectives were the principal speakers,
+and both of these were of opinion that the only shadow of hope remaining
+rested upon Mark himself.
+
+“Unless they finished him before he came round,” Malcolm said, “they
+would find him an awkward customer to deal with. Mr. Thorndyke has got
+his head screwed on right, and if, as you say, they are Indians, Mr.
+Chetwynd, I should think that if he once comes fairly round, unless he
+is tied up, he will be a match for them, even with their knives. That is
+the only chance I see. Even if the watch do find out that three or four
+foreign sailors have been at one of the boarding houses and did not turn
+up last night, I don't think we shall be much nearer. They will probably
+only have carried him some distance along the wharf, got to some quiet
+place where there is a big pile of wood, or something of that sort, then
+put a knife into him, searched for the diamonds, which you may be sure
+they would find easily enough wherever he had hidden them, and then make
+off, most likely for Rotterdam or The Hague; they could be at either of
+these places by this time, and will mostly likely divide the diamonds
+and get on board different craft, bound for London or Hull, or indeed
+any other port, and then ship for India. From what Mr. Thorndyke said
+they did not want the diamonds to sell, but only to carry back to some
+temple from which they were stolen twenty years ago.”
+
+Chester was of precisely the same opinion.
+
+“I am afraid, Mr. Chetwynd,” he added, as they rose to go to their rooms
+for two or three hours' sleep, “the only news that we shall get in the
+morning is that Mr. Thorndyke's body has been found.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX.
+
+
+At ten o'clock a constable came with a message from the Lieutenant to
+Mr. Chetwynd that he would be glad if he would come down to the watch
+house. Dick did not wake the others, but freshening himself up by
+pouring a jug of water over his head, went at once with the constable.
+
+“Have you news?” he asked eagerly as he entered.
+
+“Yes, the men returned an hour ago. At four of the houses they went to
+a foreign sailor had been lodging there for the last day or so, but
+yesterday afternoon all had paid their reckoning and left. Then the idea
+struck me that it would be as well to ask if they had been seen on the
+quays, and I sent off a fresh batch of men to make inquiries. A quarter
+of an hour ago one of them came back with the news that he had learned
+from a sailor that he had noticed a dark colored foreigner, whom he took
+to be a Lascar sailor, talking to a boatman, and that they had rowed off
+together to a barge anchored a short way out; he did not notice anything
+more about him.
+
+“Now, I should not be at all surprised if the fellow went off to arrange
+with the bargeman for a passage for himself and four or five comrades to
+some port or other, it might be anywhere. It would make no difference to
+them where the barge was bound for. No doubt he saw the man again after
+the brig was sighted, and told him that they should come on board soon
+after it got dark, and told him to have the boat at the stairs. You
+see, in that case they might not have carried Mr. Thorndyke above fifty
+yards. They would probably get him on board as one of their party who
+had been drunk. The barge, no doubt, got under way about nine o'clock,
+which is the hour when the tide was high last night, and during the
+night the Indians could easily drop your friend overboard--and may
+even have done so before they got under way, which would have been the
+easiest thing to do. There would have been no one at the helm, and they
+could have chosen a moment when the crew, probably only three, were
+below. I am afraid that this is not a cheering lookout, but I have
+little doubt that it is the correct one.
+
+“I have told my men to find out what barge was lying at the spot the
+sailor pointed out, and if we discover her name, which we are likely to
+be able to do, there will be no difficulty in finding out to whom she
+belongs and where she was bound for. Then we can follow it up; though
+there is little likelihood of our finding the murderers still on board.”
+
+“Thank you very much for the pains that you are taking, sir,” Dick said.
+“I am afraid that there is no shadow of hope of finding my poor friend
+alive. I have no doubt that the thing has happened exactly as you
+suggest; the whole course of the affair shows how carefully it was
+planned, and I have no hope that any scruple about taking life would be
+felt by them for a moment. I will go back to the hotel, and I shall be
+obliged if you will let me know as soon as you obtain any clew as to the
+barge.”
+
+An hour and a half later the officer himself came round to the room
+where Dick Chetwynd and the two pugilists were sitting. The detectives
+had started out to make inquiries on their own account, taking with them
+a hanger on at the hotel who spoke English.
+
+“The barge's name was the Julie,” he said; “she has a cargo on board for
+Rotterdam.”
+
+“I think the best thing would be to take a carriage, and drive there at
+once,” Dick said.
+
+“You can do that, sir, but I don't think you will be there before the
+barge; they have something like eighteen hours' start for you, and the
+wind has been all the time in the east. I should say that they would be
+there by eight o'clock this morning.”
+
+“No, I don't know that it would be of any use, but at least it would be
+doing something. I suppose we could be there in four hours?”
+
+“From that to five; but even if the barge were delayed, and you got
+there first, which is very unlikely, I do not think that there would be
+the remotest chance of finding those villains on board. I reckon they
+would, as we agreed, launch the body overboard even before they got
+under way here, and they may either have landed again before the craft
+got under way, pretending that they had changed their minds, and then
+walked across to The Hague or to Haarlem, or have gone on with the barge
+for two hours, or even until daybreak. If by that time they were near
+Rotterdam, they may have stayed on board till they got there; if not,
+they may have landed, and finished the journey on foot, but they would
+certainly not have stopped on board after six or seven o'clock this
+morning. They would calculate that possibly we might get on their track
+at an early hour this morning, and set out in pursuit at once.
+
+“However, it will doubtless be a satisfaction to you to be moving,
+and at least you will be able to overhaul the barge when you get to
+Rotterdam, and to hear what the boatmen say. The chances are they will
+not even have noticed that one of the men who came on board was missing.
+The men may very well have made up a long bundle, carried it on shore
+with them, or three of them may have carried a fourth ashore; and in the
+dark the bargemen were unlikely to have noticed that the number was less
+than when they came on board. However, it will be something for you to
+find out when and where the fellows landed.”
+
+“Yes; I should certainly like to lay hands on them, though I am afraid
+we should find it very hard to prove that they had anything to do with
+this affair.”
+
+“I think that also, Mr. Chetwynd. Morally, we may feel absolutely
+certain; but, unless the boatmen noticed that one of their number was
+missing when they landed, we have at present no evidence to connect them
+with it.”
+
+“We will set out as soon as my other two men return. I told them to be
+back soon after twelve. I will write to you this evening from Rotterdam.
+Ah! here are the men.”
+
+The door opened, and, to the stupefaction of the party, Mark Thorndyke
+entered the room.
+
+“Good Heavens, Mark!” Dick exclaimed, springing forward and seizing
+his hand, “is it really you alive in the flesh? We had given you up for
+dead. We have been searching the town for you all night, and were just
+going to set out for Rotterdam in search of a barge on which we believed
+you were carried. Why, it seems almost a miracle!”
+
+The two prize fighters also came forward, and shook hands with a
+pressure that would have made most men shrink.
+
+“I am as glad, Mr. Thorndyke,” Gibbons said, “as if anyone had given me
+a thousand pounds. I have never quite given up hope, for, as I said to
+Mr. Chetwynd, if you got but a shadow of a chance, you would polish off
+those nigger fellows in no time; but I was afraid that they never would
+give you a chance. Well, I am glad, sir.”
+
+“Mark, this is the Lieutenant of the watch here,” Dick said. “He has
+been most kind, and has himself headed the search that has been made for
+you all night. Now tell us all about it.”
+
+“First of all give me something to drink, for, except some water, I have
+had nothing since dinner yesterday. You are right, Dick; it is almost a
+miracle, even to me, that I am here. I would not have given a penny for
+my chance of life, and I can no more account for the fact that I am here
+than you can.”
+
+Mark drank off a tumbler of weak spirits and water that Gibbons poured
+out for him. Chetwynd rang the bell, and ordered lunch to be brought
+up at once. Just at this moment the two detectives came in, and were
+astonished and delighted at finding Mark there.
+
+“Now,” he said, “I will tell you as much as I know, which is little
+enough. When I came to my senses I found myself lying on the deck of a
+craft of some sort; it was a long time before I could at all understand
+how I got there. I think it was the pain from the back of my head that
+brought it to my mind that I must have been knocked down and stunned in
+that fight; for some time I was very vague in my brain as to that, but
+it all came back suddenly, and I recalled that we had all got separated.
+I was hitting out, and then there was a crash. Yes, I must have been
+knocked down and stunned, and I could only suppose that in the darkness
+and confusion I had been carried off and taken on board without any of
+you missing me; my hands and feet were tied, and there was something
+shoved into my mouth that prevented me from speaking.
+
+“I should think that it must have been an hour before I quite recovered
+my senses, and got the thing fairly into my mind. Then a man with a
+knife leant over me, and made signs that if I spoke he would stab me,
+and another took the gag out of my mouth and poured some water down my
+throat, and then put it in again. I saw that he was a dark colored man,
+and I then understood it all; it was those Hindoos who had got up the
+attack upon us and had carried me off. I had no doubt they had got the
+diamonds I had sewn up in the waistband of my trousers.
+
+“I wondered why they were keeping me, but was sure they would stab
+me presently and throw me overboard. I knew that they had killed two
+soldiers for the sake of the diamonds, and if it hadn't been that they
+had given me the water, I should not have had a shadow of doubt about my
+fate.”
+
+“I puzzled over why they should have done so, and came to the conclusion
+that they dared not do it on board, because of the crew, and that they
+intended to take me on shore somewhere, and there dispose of me. I made
+many attempts to loosen my ropes, but they would not give the slightest.
+At last I think I dozed off for a time. After I had had the water they
+drew a blanket or something of that sort over me. It had been there
+before, but it had only been pulled up as high as my nose, and I felt
+sure that it was only done to prevent the Dutchmen on the boat seeing
+that I was bound and gagged; this time they pulled it right over my
+face. When they took it off again I could see it was nearly morning, for
+there was a faint light in the sky. They were moving about on the deck,
+and presently I saw one of the sailors get into the boat and pull it
+along, hand over hand, by the rail, until he was close to me. Then four
+Lascar sort of chaps--I could scarcely make out their features--lifted
+me and lowered me into the boat and got in themselves.
+
+“I did not attempt to struggle. No doubt they had made up some tale
+that I was mad or something of that sort, and I thought that I had best
+pretend to be quiet and peaceable till I could see some sort of chance
+of making a fight for it. It was but a few yards from the shore. The man
+lifted me out onto the bank, and the sailor then started to row back
+to the barge; they carried me a few yards away, and then laid me face
+downwards on some grass. Now, I thought to myself, it is all over; they
+are going to stab me and make off. To my surprise I felt they were
+doing something--I could not make out what--to the ropes; then there
+was quiet. I lay there I should think for half an hour, wondering why
+on earth they did not finish me. At last I made up my mind to move,
+and turned round onto my back. As I lay there I could see no one, and,
+raising my head, looked round. To my amazement I found that I was alone.
+It was now almost light, and as I craned my head in all directions I
+assured myself that they had gone; then I began to try again at the
+ropes.
+
+“To my surprise I found that they were much looser than they were
+before, although still tight enough to give me nearly an hour's work
+before I got my hands free. Then it took me almost as long to get
+the ropes off my legs, for they had knotted them in such a fearfully
+intricate way that it was a long time before I could even discover where
+the ends were. At last I finished the job, stood up, and looked round. A
+quarter of a mile off there was a good sized town, but not a soul could
+I see.
+
+“Till now I had hardly thought of the diamonds; I put my hands to my
+waistband and found, as I expected, that they were gone. I think I felt
+nothing but pleasure: the confounded things had given trouble enough,
+and I was well rid of them. Why they should have spared my life I could
+not imagine. If they had finished me, which they could have done without
+any risk to themselves when they got me ashore, they could have gone off
+with the diamonds without the slightest fear of pursuit, while now there
+was, of course, a chance that I might follow and recognize them.”
+
+“Would you know them again?” the Lieutenant interrupted.
+
+“Not in the slightest; it was light enough to see that they were dark,
+but from the time the boat came along the blanket was over my head,
+and except when they gave me the water I had no chance of seeing any
+of their features. Still, if I had gone straight to the town I saw and
+reported the matter to the authorities and sent mounted men to all the
+ports to warn them not to let any colored men embark, I might have given
+them a lot of trouble, but I don't suppose any of them would ever have
+been caught. After the craft they had shown in the whole matter, it is
+certain that they would have laid their plans for escape so well
+that the law would never have laid hands upon them. I put my hand
+mechanically to my watch to see the time, and to my astonishment
+discovered that I still had it in my pocket, and was equally surprised
+to find that the money in my trousers' pockets was also untouched. The
+watch had, of course, stopped. I first of all went down to the water and
+had a good wash; then I proceeded to the town, and, going to a hotel,
+ordered breakfast.”
+
+“Why, I thought you said that you had had nothing to eat, Mark.”
+
+“Yes? Well, I had forgotten all about that breakfast. The people looked
+a good deal surprised at an Englishman walking in in that way. While
+I was eating my breakfast two men--who were, I suppose, authorities of
+some kind--who spoke English, came and questioned me. As I had made up
+my mind to say nothing more about the affair, I merely told them that I
+had come for a sail from Amsterdam, and that I wanted a carriage to take
+me back. They were evidently astonished at my choosing a dark night for
+such a trip, but I said that I had some curiosity to see how the boatmen
+navigated their vessel when there were no lighthouses or anything to
+steer by. They asked a few more questions, and then went away, evidently
+thinking that I was a little mad. However, they must have spoken to the
+landlord, who in a short time made signs that the carriage was at the
+door.
+
+“I had avoided asking the men either the name of the place or how far
+it was from any big town, because that would have made the whole affair
+more singular. It was a quarter past eight when I started, and beyond
+the fact that I know by the sun we came pretty nearly due east, I have
+not the slightest idea of the road. The coachman could not speak a word
+of English. I should say we came about seven miles an hour and stopped
+once to bait the horses, so I suppose that it must have been between
+four and five miles from Rotterdam when I landed.”
+
+Lunch had by this time been laid on the table, and at Dick's invitation
+the Lieutenant joined them.
+
+“It is an extraordinary story!” he said. “That your life should have
+been spared is altogether beyond my comprehension, still more so why
+they should have left you your money and watch.”
+
+“The whole story is extraordinary,” Dick Chetwynd said; “for we have
+every reason to believe that those fellows, or at least one or two of
+them, have been patiently watching for a chance of carrying off those
+diamonds for twenty years. When my friend told me of it ten days ago I
+did not believe that it could be possible; but he has certainly shown
+that he was correct in his opinion.”
+
+Mark then related the history of the jewels, surprising the pugilists
+and detectives as much as the Lieutenant.
+
+“It is extraordinary indeed,” the latter said. “I should not have
+believed it possible that men would devote so many years to such a
+purpose, nor that they could have succeeded in tracing the diamonds in
+spite of the precaution taken by your uncle, and afterwards by yourself.
+It would seem that from the time he landed in England he, and after him
+your father and yourself, must have been watched almost night and day.
+I can understand now why they did not take your watch and money.
+They evidently acted from a sort of religious enthusiasm, and were no
+ordinary thieves, but as evidently they did not hesitate to kill, I
+cannot understand why they should have added to their risks by sparing
+you.”
+
+“No, that is what puzzles me,” Mark agreed. “I was thinking it over
+while we were driving here. Now let me hear about the fight, Dick. How
+did you all come out of it?”
+
+“As well as could be expected. Gibbons and Tring both got some heavy
+blows with the cudgels, as indeed we all did more or less, but they did
+great execution. Eleven fellows were left senseless on the ground, and
+one of them, that black fellow who came over with us, was killed. The
+other ten are all in prison. All of us did our best, and managed to
+leave our mark on eight others, who were in consequence picked out, and
+are also in jail.”
+
+Dick went on to relate the particulars of the search.
+
+“You see, our friend here had traced you to the barge and found out her
+destination, and if you had come ten minutes later you would have found
+that we had all just started for Rotterdam. I was only waiting for
+Chester and Malcolm to return to set out. I am sorry, Mark, that you
+have lost your diamonds; not so much because they are gone, for I can
+well understand you to be thoroughly glad to be rid of such dangerous
+articles, but because they have carried them off in our teeth, after we
+have been specially retained to protect you. I certainly thought that
+with such a bodyguard you were absolutely safe from any number of
+Hindoos.”
+
+“Yes, we made a regular mess of it, Mr. Thorndyke,” Gibbons said. “I
+never felt so certain of winning a battle as I did that you would not
+be touched as long as we were looking after you. Tring and I, if we had
+been asked, would have said that we could each have taken on a dozen
+foreigners easily. Mr. Chetwynd is handy with his fists too, though he
+hasn't your weight and reach, and your two other friends are both pretty
+well accustomed to deal with rough customers. As for Tring and me, it
+makes one feel small to know that we have been bested by a handful of
+niggers, or Hindoos, or whatever the chaps are, whom a good sized boy of
+twelve ought to be able to polish off.”
+
+“Now, Mark, what is to be done next?” Dick Chetwynd asked.
+
+“The next thing will be to get back as soon as we can, Dick. I, for one,
+have had enough of Holland to last me for a lifetime.”
+
+“I am afraid, gentlemen,” the Lieutenant said, “you will have to wait
+a day or two before you can leave. I have nineteen men in prison, and
+there will be a meeting of magistrates this afternoon. Now you have come
+back, Mr. Thorndyke, the charge against them won't be as serious as
+it would have been before, but they are guilty of a desperate and
+premeditated assault upon six passengers on their arrival here; they
+have already admitted that they were paid for their work; and as among
+them are some of the worst characters in the city, you may be sure that
+now we have got them fairly in our hands we shall not let them go. It is
+so simple an affair that the investigation ought not to take long, but
+we shall want to find out, if we can, who acted as the intermediary
+between the Hindoos and the prisoners. I should think that two meetings
+ought to be sufficient for the present, but I am afraid that there may
+then be a long remand, and that you will either have to remain here or
+to come over again.”
+
+“It would be a horrible nuisance,” Dick said; “still it would be better
+to come back again than to wait here indefinitely, and anyhow I don't
+suppose it would be necessary for all of us to come back again.”
+
+“I should not mind if it could be arranged for me to be here again in a
+month's time,” Mark agreed, “for, to tell you the truth, I am going to
+be married in less than three weeks, and as I had intended to come to
+Brussels, and afterwards to travel for a while, I could make a visit
+here without greatly putting myself out.”
+
+“I will try and arrange that, Mr. Thorndyke.”
+
+“I shall be glad,” Mark said, “if you can manage to get the men
+sentenced without going into the question of the diamonds at all, and
+treat the matter as a mere attempt at robbery. It surely would not be
+necessary to bring the question of my being carried away into the matter
+at all; I can give evidence that I was knocked down and stunned, and
+that I was robbed of some jewels that I had about me, which were the
+object of the attack.”
+
+“I think we should have to admit that,” the Lieutenant said; “it must
+come out that the attack was an organized one.”
+
+“Well, if it must, it must,” Mark said reluctantly; “but then, you see,
+no end of questions would be asked, and the thing might be delayed while
+a search is being made for the men who stole the bracelet.”
+
+“Well, we will keep it out of the inquiry if we can,” the Lieutenant
+said. “The meeting will be at three o'clock. I will send a man to take
+you to the Town Hall.”
+
+At the appointed hour the party proceeded to the court, and the eighteen
+prisoners, under a strong guard, having been brought in, six magistrates
+took their places on the bench; the rest of the court was crowded, the
+fray on the wharf and the number of captures having created quite a
+stir in the city. They had arranged that Tring should first give
+his evidence, which he did, the Lieutenant of the watch acting as
+interpreter, though most of the magistrates understood English. The
+appearance of the prisoners created quite a sensation in the court, for
+the injuries that they had received were now even more conspicuous than
+they had been when they were first captured; some of them had to be led
+into court, their eyes being completely closed, others had their heads
+bandaged, and all showed signs of tremendous punishment. Tring related
+that he, with five others, had come ashore together; one of his
+companions had a row on board a ship they had crossed in, with a
+Lascar sailor, who was a passenger, and they kept together as they were
+crossing the wharf, thinking that possibly the man might attempt to stab
+his companion.
+
+“I was walking behind him,” Tring went on, “when the Lascar jumped
+suddenly out from among the men standing about, and was about to stab my
+companion, when I hit him just in time, and he went down; then there was
+a rush, and we all got separated, and did as well as we could until the
+watch came up; that is all that I know about it.”
+
+“Is the Lascar among the prisoners?” one of the magistrates asked the
+Lieutenant of the watch.
+
+“No, sir, when picked up by one of my men he was found to be dead; the
+blow had apparently killed him instantly.”
+
+The other five then gave their evidence; it was similar to that of
+Tring, save that being in front of him they knew nothing of the attack
+by the Lascar. All they knew about it was that there was a sudden
+rush upon them by a number of men armed with bludgeons, that they were
+separated, and that each defended himself until the guard came up.
+
+Some of the watch then gave evidence, and told how on arriving at
+the spot eleven of the prisoners were found lying senseless; how, on
+recovering, they were all taken to the watch house, where several of
+them were recognized as notoriously bad characters; they had admitted
+that they were paid to make the attack, which was apparently the result
+of the private enmity of some person or persons unknown to one or more
+of those attacked.
+
+The Lieutenant then related the steps that he had taken to capture
+others connected with the attack, and that he found eight men bearing
+marks of the fray, and that all these were also notorious characters,
+and associates of the prisoners first taken. The first witnesses were
+again questioned; five of them said that, so far as they knew, they had
+no personal enemies. Mark, who was the last to get into the witness box,
+said that he himself had no enemies, but that an uncle of his, who was
+in the British Indian service, had a sort of feud with some members of
+a sect there on account of some jewels that he had purchased, and which
+had, they declared, been stolen from a temple. Two soldiers through
+whose hands these things had passed, had been successively killed by
+them, and his uncle had to the day of his death believed that their
+vengeance would one day fall upon him.
+
+“I can only suppose,” continued Mark, “that I have inherited the enmity
+they bore him, as I inherited the jewels, and that the attack was really
+designed solely against me, and the consequences might have been
+fatal to me had it not been for the strength and courage of my fellow
+passengers.”
+
+“Did they come with you for your protection, Mr. Thorndyke?”
+
+“To some extent, yes. The fact is, that I have for some time been
+convinced that I was followed about by natives of India, and remembering
+what my uncle had said on the subject, I became to some degree
+apprehensive, and thought it as well to leave London for a short time.
+That this attack was really instigated by the men I have no doubt
+whatever, since, as you have heard, it was begun by a Lascar, who tried
+to stab one of my companions and who received a knockdown blow that
+caused his death from one of the others. It is a well known fact that
+these people will cherish for many years a determination to avenge any
+injury. However, I hope that after the failure of this attempt upon my
+life I shall hear no more of them.”
+
+“Were any knives found on the prisoners?” the magistrates asked the
+Lieutenant of the watch.
+
+“No, sir; all carried clubs. And they told me that they had been
+especially ordered not to take knives, and had indeed been searched
+before they came out.”
+
+“What impression do you gather from that, Mr. Thorndyke?”
+
+“My impression is, sir, that they desired to overpower those with me and
+to beat them down, in order to carry out their revenge upon me.”
+
+After some consultation the magistrate who had before spoken said:
+
+“The prisoners will be remanded. It is necessary that we should find out
+who was the chief culprit who bribed this gang.”
+
+As soon as the prisoners were taken out of court Mark slipped across to
+the magistrates, accompanied by the Lieutenant as interpreter.
+
+“I hope, gentlemen, that our presence here will not be necessary, for it
+would be a matter of extreme inconvenience. I may say that my marriage
+is fixed for today three weeks, hence you can well imagine that I want
+to return as soon as possible. Two of the men are, as you have heard,
+Bow Street officers, whose presence could not well be spared.”
+
+The magistrates again consulted together.
+
+“Your evidence has all been taken down by the clerk of the court.
+Certainly we should not require your presence at the remand; but whether
+we should do so at the trial would, of course, depend upon whether these
+men all own their guilt, which, having been taken red handed, it is
+likely enough they will do. We will consent, therefore, to your leaving,
+if you will give us an undertaking to return for the trial if your
+presence is necessary, and that you will bring with you the man who
+struck down the Lascar who commenced the fray, and one of the others.”
+
+“That I will do willingly,” Mark replied. “We are much obliged to
+you for your consideration. I shall be traveling for a time after my
+marriage; but I will as I pass through Belgium after my marriage give
+you the route I intend to take and the address at which letters will
+find me, and if you send me a sufficiently long notice I will at once
+return for the trial.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXI.
+
+
+“You managed that very well, Mark,” Dick said. “You kept well within the
+limits of truth without bringing the real facts of the attack upon us
+into the case.”
+
+“Well, you see, Dick, after working as a detective, one gets into the
+way of telling stories with the smallest amount of deviation possible
+from the truth. What will these fellows get done to them, Lieutenant?”
+
+“I should say that they will get two or three years imprisonment; the
+only charge now is rioting and assault. It is lucky for them that they
+had clubs instead of knives, for that would have brought the matter
+under the head of attempted murder. The matter of the gems was not
+important in the case, but there is sure to be a great fuss and search
+for the missing Indians. I suppose you will soon be off home now?”
+
+“Yes, I shall find out tonight what vessel leaves for England tomorrow,
+and take a berth in the first that sails for London. It is too late to
+think of starting this evening, and indeed I feel that I want a long
+night's rest, for I did not sleep much last night, and have not quite
+recovered from that crack on my head.”
+
+On his return to the hotel Mark sent out a man to inquire at the
+shipping offices, and finding that a bark would sail at nine o'clock
+the next morning, they went down and took berths, and sailed in her next
+day. The voyage home was a rapid one, for the wind blew steadily from
+the east, and the vessel made the passage to the mouth of the river in
+two days, and the next took them up to London.
+
+“I will call round tomorrow or next day, Gibbons, with the checks for
+you both,” Mark said as he prepared to go ashore.
+
+“No, sir. We are both of one mind that we could not take them. We went
+over to prevent you being robbed of those sparklers, and to see that you
+came to no harm. Well, the things are lost, and you got knocked down
+and carried away. It is no thanks to us that you are alive now. It is a
+mortifying job, that with two detectives to watch over things and with
+us to fight we should have been fairly beat by a few black niggers.”
+
+“If there had been any bungling on your part, Gibbons, there might be
+something in what you say, but no one could have foreseen that before we
+had been on shore two minutes we should have been attacked in that way.
+You both did all that men could do, as was shown by the condition of
+the fellows who were taken. I was just as much separated from you as you
+were from me, and the fact that we were surprised as we were is really
+due to my not determining to stay on board until the morning, which I
+could no doubt have done with the captain's permission. It never struck
+me for a moment that we should be attacked in force. I thought it
+probable that an attempt at assassination would be made, but it
+certainly did not seem probable that it would be attempted while you
+were all with me. You are not in the slightest degree to blame, for
+your part of the agreement was carried out to my satisfaction. I shall
+certainly carry out mine, as I have arrived home safe and sound.”
+
+“Well, governor, it is very good of you; but I tell you it will go
+against the grain for us to take your money.”
+
+On landing, Mark parted with Dick Chetwynd, who had arranged to drop
+Mark's bag at his lodgings on his way home, and at once took a hackney
+coach to Islington. Millicent gave a cry of delight as he entered the
+room.
+
+“You are back earlier than I expected, Mark. You told me before you
+started that the wind was in the east, and that you might be a long time
+getting to Amsterdam unless it changed. I have been watching the vane on
+the church, and it has been pointing east ever since.
+
+“Well, you have sold the diamonds, I hope?” she said, after the first
+greeting was over.
+
+“No; I have bad news for you, Millicent; the jewels have been stolen.”
+
+“Well it does not make much difference, Mark. We have much more than
+enough without them, so don't bother yourself in the least. How did it
+happen?”
+
+“Well, it is rather a long story. I will tell it you when Mrs.
+Cunningham is here, so as not to have to go over it twice. How are the
+dresses getting on?”
+
+“I suppose they are getting on all right,” she said. “I have done
+nothing for the last two days but try them on. You see, we put them
+out to three milliners, and they all three seem to reach the same point
+together, and I start after breakfast, and it takes about two hours at
+each place. You don't know what trouble you have given me by hurrying
+things on so unreasonably.”
+
+“Well, it is better to have it all done and over,” he said, “than to
+have the thing hanging over you for a couple of months.”
+
+“That is what Mrs. Cunningham says. Now I want to hear about your
+adventures, and I will call her down.”
+
+
+“Only think, Mrs. Cunningham,” Millicent said presently, with a laugh,
+after she had returned with her, “this silly boy has actually let the
+diamonds be stolen from him.”
+
+
+“No, really, Millicent!”
+
+“Yes, indeed. Fancy his not being fit to be trusted to look after them!
+However, I tell him it is of no consequence. I don't know how they went.
+He would not tell me the story until you came down.”
+
+“I am sorry to say it is true, Mrs. Cunningham, although I can assure
+you that I really cannot blame myself for either carelessness or
+stupidity. I knew when I started that there was a very great risk, and
+took what seemed to me every possible precaution, for in addition to
+Dick Chetwynd going with me, I took two detectives from Bow Street and
+two prize fighters.”
+
+Exclamations of surprise broke from both ladies.
+
+“And yet, in spite of all that, these things were stolen,” Millicent
+said. “How on earth did they do it? I should have sewn them up in my
+pockets inside my dress.”
+
+“I sewed them up in the waistband of my trousers, Millicent, and yet
+they managed, in spite of us, to steal them. And now I must begin by
+telling you the whole history of those diamonds, and you will understand
+why I thought it necessary to take a strong party with me.”
+
+He then told them, repeating the history the Colonel had given his
+father of the diamonds, and the conviction that he had, that he had been
+followed by Hindoos, and the instructions he had given for the disposal
+of the bracelet.
+
+“As you know,” he said, “nothing happened to confirm my uncle's belief
+that there were men over here in search of the diamonds during my
+father's life, but since then I have come to the same conclusion that he
+had, and felt positive that I was being constantly followed wherever I
+went. As soon as I heard where the treasure was I began to take every
+precaution in my power. I avoided going to the bank after my first visit
+there, and, as you know, would not bring the things for you to look
+at. I got Dick Chetwynd to go there, open the case, and take out these
+diamonds. He did not bring them away with him, but fetched them from
+there the morning we started. He went down and took the passage for us
+both at the shipping office, and the pugilists and the detectives each
+took passages for themselves, so that I hoped, however closely I was
+followed, they would not learn that I was taking them to Amsterdam.”
+
+“It was very wrong, Mark; very wrong indeed,” Millicent broke in. “You
+had no right to run such a terrible risk; it would have been better for
+you to have taken the diamonds and thrown them into the Thames.”
+
+“That would not have improved matters,” he said; “the Indians would not
+have known that I had got rid of them, and would have continued their
+efforts to find them, and I should always have been in danger instead
+of getting it over once for all. However, I did not think that there was
+any danger, going over as I did, with two of the best prize fighters
+in England, to say nothing of the detectives, who were the men who
+were with me when I caught Bastow. The only danger was that I might be
+stabbed; but, as they would know, it was no use their stabbing me unless
+they could search me quietly, and that they could not do unless I was
+alone and in some lonely neighborhood, and I had made up my mind not to
+stir out unless the whole party were with me. I found out, when we got
+on board that in spite of all the precautions I had taken, they had
+discovered that I was going to sail for Amsterdam, which they could only
+have done by following Dick as well as myself. There was a dark faced
+foreign sailor, who, I had no doubt, was a Hindoo, already on board, and
+I saw another in a boat watching us start; this was unpleasant, but as
+I felt sure that they could not have known that I had with me detectives
+and pugilists, I still felt that they would be able to do nothing when I
+got to Amsterdam.”
+
+Then he told them the whole story of the attack, of his being carried
+away, and of his unexpected release; of the search that had been made
+for him and the arrest of eighteen of his assailants. Millicent grew
+pale as he continued, and burst into tears when she heard of his being a
+prisoner in the hands of the Hindoos.
+
+“I shall never let you go out of my sight again, Mark!” she exclaimed
+when he had finished. “It was bad enough before when you were searching
+for that man here, and I used to be terribly anxious; but that was
+nothing to this.”
+
+“Well, there is an end of it now, Millicent; the men have got the
+diamonds, and will soon be on their way to India, if they have not
+started already.”
+
+“Nasty things!” she said; “I shall never like diamonds again: they will
+always remind me of the terrible danger that you have run. Isn't it
+extraordinary that for twenty years four or five men should be spending
+their lives waiting for a chance of getting them back!”
+
+“I do not expect there were so many as that; probably there was only
+one. He would have no difficulty in learning that my father had not
+received any extraordinary gems from my uncle, and probably supposed
+that they would not be taken out from wherever they might be until you
+came of age. After the death of my father he might suppose that I should
+take them out, or that, at any rate, I should go to whoever had them,
+and see that they were all right, and he then, perhaps, engaged half a
+dozen Lascars--there are plenty of them at the docks--and had me watched
+wherever I went; and, do you know, that I believe I once owed my life to
+them.”
+
+“How was that, Mark?”
+
+“Well, I was captured by some fellows who suspected me to be a Bow
+Street runner, and I think that it would have gone very hard with me
+if a party of five or six prize fighters had not broken into the house,
+pretty nearly killed the men in whose hands I was, and rescued me. They
+said that they had heard of my danger from a foreign sailor who called
+at Gibbons', with whom I was in the habit of boxing, and told him about
+it. You see, until they learned where the jewels were, my life was
+valuable to them, for possibly I was the only person who knew where they
+were hidden; so really I don't think I have any reason for bearing a
+grudge against them. They saved my life in the first place, and spared
+it at what was a distinct risk to themselves. On the other hand, they
+were content with regaining the bracelet, not even, as I told you,
+taking my watch or purse. You see, with them it was a matter of
+religion. They had no animosity against me personally, but I have no
+doubt they would have stabbed me without the slightest compunction had
+there been no other way of getting the things. Still, I think that I owe
+a debt of gratitude to them rather than the reverse, and, after all, the
+loss of the bracelet is not a serious one to us.”
+
+“I am glad it is gone,” Millicent said. “You say it had already caused
+the death of two men, and if you had succeeded in selling it I can't
+help thinking that the money would have brought ill fortune to us. I am
+heartily glad that the diamonds are gone, Mark. I suppose they were very
+handsome?”
+
+“They were magnificent,” he said. “Dick and Cotter both agreed that they
+had never seen their equal, and I fancy that they must have been worth a
+great deal more than your father valued them at.”
+
+“Well, it does not matter at all. There is no history attached to the
+others, I hope, Mark?”
+
+“Not in any way, dear. They were bought, as the Colonel told my father,
+in the ordinary course of things, and some, no doubt, were obtained at
+the capture of some of the native princes' treasuries; but it was solely
+on account of this bracelet that he had any anxiety. You can wear all
+the others, if you have a fancy for keeping them, without a shadow of
+risk.”
+
+“No, Mark, we will sell them every one. I don't think that I shall ever
+care to wear any jewels again; and if I am ever presented at court and
+have to do so, I would rather that you should buy some new ones fresh
+from a jeweler's shop than wear anything that has come from India.”
+
+“To-morrow you shall both go to the bank with me to see them, and then I
+will take them to some first-class jeweler's and get him to value them.”
+
+The visit was paid next day. Both Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham were
+somewhat disappointed at the jewels.
+
+“It is hardly fair to see them like this,” Philip Cotter said. “They
+would look very different if reset. No Indian jewels I have ever seen
+show to advantage in their native settings; but many of the stones are
+very large, and without knowing anything about them I should say that
+they are worth the 50,000 pounds at which you say Colonel Thorndyke
+valued them. He was not likely to be mistaken. He was evidently a judge
+of these matters, and would hardly be likely to be far wrong.”
+
+“We will go with you to the jeweler's, Mark,” Millicent said. “In the
+first place, I shall not feel quite comfortable until I know that they
+are out of your hands, and in the next place I should like to hear what
+he thinks of them.”
+
+“I have a number of Indian jewels that I wish you to value for me,” Mark
+said, as, carrying the case, he entered the jeweler's shop. “They were
+collected by Colonel Thorndyke, an uncle of mine, during service in
+India.”
+
+The jeweler took them with him into a room behind the shop. The case was
+opened, and the man took out sixty-eight small parcels it contained, and
+opened them one after the other.
+
+“I shall need a very careful examination of these before I can form any
+estimate of their value,” he said, after inspecting some of the more
+important pieces of jewelry carefully. “They are a most magnificent
+collection, and had they been properly cut in the first place they would
+have been worth a very large sum. Unfortunately, the Indian princes
+think more of size than of lustre, and have their stones cut very much
+too flat to show off their full brilliancy. Some of these large ones I
+should certainly advise to be recut, for what they will lose in weight
+they will gain in beauty and value. However, sir, I will go through them
+and give you an estimate of the selling value of each piece. I need not
+say that they ought all to be reset in the prevailing fashion; but
+the gold, which is in some cases unnecessarily massive, will go some
+distance towards defraying the expense.”
+
+“When shall I call again?” Mark asked.
+
+“I should be glad if you can give me a week,” the jeweler said. “Some
+of the things, for instance that great pearl necklace, I could appraise
+without much difficulty, but all the gems must be taken out of their
+settings before I could form a fair idea of their value.”
+
+“Then I will call in a week's time,” Mark said. “I am in no particular
+hurry about them, but I would rather that they were in your care than
+mine.”
+
+“Yes, if the cracksmen got word that there was such a collection as this
+in any private house it would need a couple of men with pistols to keep
+guard over them.”
+
+A week later Mark again called.
+
+“I have the list ready for you, sir; you will see that they are not
+marked according to their setting, but according to their size and
+value. Thus, you see, the largest stones are priced separately; the
+smaller ones are in groups according to their weight. The total comes
+to 42,000 pounds. I do not know whether that at all equals your
+expectations. I may say that I have shown the stones to two or three of
+our principal diamond merchants, and that the prices I have put down are
+those at which they would be willing to buy them; possibly some would be
+worth more. I had the merchants here together, and they spent some hours
+going through them, and the sums put down are those at which one or
+other were willing to purchase.”
+
+“It quite answers my expectations,” Mark said. “My uncle's estimate,
+indeed, was somewhat higher, but doubtless he judged them at the price
+which they would fetch in India. Well, sir, I authorize you to close
+with the offers, and to dispose of them for me. I will give you a
+written authority to do so. In the meantime, I wish to buy a suite of
+jewels as a wedding present, a tiara, necklace, and bracelets; but I do
+not want any diamonds to be among them.”
+
+“I am afraid I have nothing in stock without diamonds; of course, I have
+both necklaces and bracelets of almost any stones that you might select,
+but I have no complete set without diamonds; the effect would be somber,
+and few ladies would like them.”
+
+“We have some unpleasant associations with diamonds,” Mark said, “and
+on that point I am quite determined; but if you used pearls instead of
+diamonds the effect might be as good. I don't care whether the stones
+are emeralds or rubies; at any rate, I should like to see some, and then
+perhaps you might be able to make me a set on the same model.”
+
+Several superb sets were brought in; Mark selected one of emeralds and
+diamonds.
+
+“What would be the price of this set?” he asked.
+
+“That set is 6000 pounds, sir; the stones are exceptionally fine ones;
+but if you substituted pearls of equal size for the diamonds, it would
+cost considerably less; I could not give you the exact price until it is
+made, but I should say that it would be about 4500 pounds.”
+
+“Very well, then, I will take that. How long will it be making?”
+
+“I should not like to say less than three months at the earliest; it
+will require some time to collect as fine a set of emeralds as these.
+Indeed, I think that most probably I shall use these emeralds, or the
+greater part of them, and collect others to take their places at my
+leisure. I do not know whether the best plan would not be to take the
+diamonds out and substitute pearls; there would be no difficulty in
+getting them, and in that case I might have it ready for you in a
+month.”
+
+“I think that will be the best plan; but you need not be in any
+particular hurry about them. My marriage will take place in less than
+a fortnight, and after that I shall probably be three or four months
+before I return to London. I will get you to keep the things until I
+come back.”
+
+“I have sold the jewels, Millicent,” he said, when he returned to
+Islington; “the jeweler has found purchasers for them all, and the total
+comes to 42,000 pounds.”
+
+“Whatever shall we do with all our money, Mark?”
+
+“I rather wonder myself, dear. However, there is one thing, there are
+always plenty of people who will be glad to relieve us of anything that
+we don't want. I can tell you that in the course of my search for Bastow
+I have seen an amount of poverty and misery such as I never dreamt of,
+and I certainly should like to do something to relieve it. The best
+thing that I know of would be to give a handsome sum to three or four
+of the great hospitals. I don't know of any better means of helping the
+very poor.”
+
+“Suppose, Mark,” the girl said, putting her hand on his arm, “we give
+this 42,000 pounds as a thank offering. We never expected to get it,
+and my father's jewels have nearly cost you your life. We have such an
+abundance without that, I should like, above all things, to give this
+money away.”
+
+“I think that is an excellent plan, Millicent, and a very happy thought
+on your part. We cannot do it now, as we have not yet got the money, but
+as soon as we do we will send off checks for 10,000 guineas each to St.
+Bartholomew's, Guy's, and St. Thomas'--those are the three principal
+ones; the others we can settle afterwards. But I should say that the
+Foundling would be as good as any, and I believe that they are rather
+short of funds at present; then there is the London Mendicity Society,
+and many other good charities. Perhaps it would be better to divide the
+whole among eight of them instead of four; but we need not settle that
+until we return.”
+
+“Do you think we shall have to go to this horrid Amsterdam, Mark?”
+
+“I hope not, dear; but I shall no doubt hear from the Lieutenant of the
+watch during the next week or ten days.”
+
+When the letter came it was satisfactory. The prisoners, seeing the
+hopelessness of any defense, had all admitted their guilt, and the name
+of the man who had dealt with them had also been given up. Except in his
+case there would be no trial. The others would have sentences passed
+on them at once, and three, who had been promised comparatively slight
+punishment, would go into the box to give evidence against the man
+who had engaged them. Before starting for Holland Mark had consulted
+Millicent as to whether she would prefer being married in London or at
+Crowswood. She had replied:
+
+“I should greatly prefer Crowswood, Mark. Here we know no one, there we
+should be among all our friends; certainly if we don't go we must get
+Mr. Greg to come up and marry us here. I am sure he would feel very
+disappointed if anyone else were asked. At the same time I should not
+like to go home. When we come back from our trip it will be different;
+but it would be a great trial now, and however happy we might be, I
+should feel there was a gloom over the house.”
+
+“I quite agree with you, Millicent. When we come back we can see about
+entirely refurnishing it, and, perhaps, adding some rooms to it, and we
+need not go down until a complete change has been made. We shall be able
+to manage it somehow or other, and I quite agree with you that anything
+will be better than going back to the house for a day or two before the
+wedding.”
+
+On the voyage back from Holland Mark had talked the matter over with
+Dick Chetwynd, and said that he thought of taking rooms for Mrs.
+Cunningham and Millicent at Reigate, and stopping at the hotel himself,
+and having the wedding breakfast there.
+
+“Of course, Dick, you will be my best man.”
+
+“I should think so,” Dick laughed. “Why, if you had asked anyone else
+I should have made a personal matter of it with him, and have given
+him the option of resigning the position or going out with me. But your
+other plans are foolish, and I shall take the matter into my own hands;
+I shall insist upon the two ladies coming down to the Park, and I will
+get my aunt to come and preside generally over things. I shall fill up
+the house with bridesmaids, and shall have a dance the evening before.
+You can put up at the hotel if you like, but you know very well that
+there are a dozen houses where they will be delighted to have you; there
+is no doubt that when they know what is coming off you will get a dozen
+invitations, and then after church all those invited will drive off to
+the Park to the wedding breakfast. After that is over you can start in a
+post chaise to Canterbury or Dover, wherever you may decide to make your
+first halt.”
+
+“But, my dear Dick, I could not put you to all this trouble!”
+
+“Nonsense, man. I should enjoy it immensely; besides, I shall be really
+glad of a good reason to try and open the doors of the Park again. I
+have been there very little since my father's death, and I think I shall
+make it my headquarters in future. I am getting rather tired of bachelor
+life in London, and must look out for a wife; so nothing could be more
+appropriate than this idea. Don't bother yourself any further about
+it. I shall ride down and establish myself there tomorrow, and spend
+a couple of days in driving round to our friends and in sending out
+invitations. I shall still have nearly a fortnight for making
+all preparations. Why, it will cause quite an excitement in the
+neighborhood! I shall be hailed as a benefactor, and I shall let
+everyone know that your father's ward was really your cousin, but that
+by the will of her father she was to drop her surname until she came of
+age; and that until that time your father was to have the entire control
+of the property. I shall add that although the estate, of course, is
+hers, your uncle has left you a very big fortune, and that nothing could
+be more suitable in all respects than the marriage.”
+
+“That will do excellently, Dick; that will be quite enough, without
+going into details at all. You can mention that we intend to have the
+house entirely refurnished, and on the return from our wedding trip
+abroad to settle there. I am sure I am extremely obliged to you for your
+offer, which will certainly clear away all sorts of small difficulties.”
+
+A day or two after his return Mark wrote to Mr. Greg telling him the
+relations in which Millicent and he stood to each other, and of the near
+approach of their marriage. He said that Millicent would be married from
+Dick Chetwynd's, but that it would be at Crowswood church. In return he
+received a warm letter of congratulation from the Rector, telling him
+that the news was in every respect delightful, and that his wife and
+the children were in a state of the highest excitement, not only at the
+marriage, but at their coming down to reside again at Crowswood.
+
+“The village,” he said, “will be scarcely less pleased than I am, for
+though everything goes on as you ordered, and the people get their milk,
+broths, and jellies as before, they don't look at it as the same thing
+as it was in the old days. I cannot say that the news of your engagement
+to Miss Conyers--I ought to say Miss Thorndyke--is surprising, for I had
+thought that it would be quite the natural thing for you to fall in love
+with each other, and, indeed, my wife declares that she saw it coming
+on distinctly during the last few months before you left here. Your
+postscript saying that Bastow had been captured and had committed
+suicide gave me a distinct feeling of relief, for no one could tell
+whether the deadly enmity that he felt for your father might not extend
+to you. I have cut this note rather short, but I have just heard the
+door shut, and I am quite sure that my wife has gone down to tell the
+good news in the village, and I really cannot deny myself the pleasure
+of telling some of the people myself, and seeing their faces brighten up
+at the news.”
+
+As Dick had foretold would be the case, Mark received a very warm
+letter from Sir Charles Harris, congratulating him upon his approaching
+marriage, and insisting upon his taking up his quarters with him.
+
+“I am sending a man down with this to hand it to the guard as the up
+coach goes through the town. Chetwynd told me that his call on me was
+the first he had paid, so I feel fairly confident that I shall forestall
+the rest of your friends, and that you will give me the pleasure of your
+company.”
+
+Mark wrote back accepting the invitation at once, which enabled him to
+decline half a dozen others without the necessity of making a choice.
+Everything turned out as arranged. Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham went
+down in a post chaise, two days before the wedding, and Mark drove down
+in his gig with them. Dick Chetwynd met them on horseback just outside
+Reigate, and escorted the ladies to his house, Mark driving on to that
+of Sir Charles Harris. Millicent found the house full of her special
+friends, whom she had asked to be her bridesmaids. She was almost
+bewildered by the warmth of their welcome, and overpowered by the
+questions poured upon her.
+
+“The news quite took all our breath away, Millicent,” one of them said.
+“It seems extraordinary that you should have been Miss Thorndyke all the
+time, though I don't think that any of us were at all surprised that you
+should take the name now; you must have been surprised when you heard
+that you were the heiress of Crowswood.”
+
+“I was a great deal more disgusted than surprised,” she said rather
+indignantly. “I did not think that it was fair at all that I should step
+into Mark's shoes.”
+
+“Well, it has all come right now, Millicent, and I dare say you thought
+that it would, even then.”
+
+“I can assure you that I did not; quite the contrary, I thought that it
+never would come right. I was very unhappy about it for a time.”
+
+“Now, young ladies,” Dick Chetwynd laughed, “will you please take Mrs.
+Cunningham and Miss Thorndyke up to their rooms? I don't suppose I shall
+see any more of you before dinner time; there are those trunks to be
+opened and examined, talked over, and admired. Mind, I have fifteen
+more, for the most part men, coming to dinner, so those of you who
+aspire to follow Miss Thorndyke's example had best prepare yourselves
+for conquest.”
+
+The ball on the following evening was a great success. Dick had
+determined that it should be a memorable one, and there was a consensus
+of opinion that it was the most brilliant that had taken place in that
+part of the country for many years.
+
+Crowswood church and village presented a most festive appearance on
+the following day; there was not a cottage that had not great posies of
+flowers in its windows, and that had not made some sort of attempt
+at decoration with flags or flowers. A huge arch of evergreens, with
+sheaves of wheat and flowers, had been erected on the top of the hill,
+and every man, woman, and child turned out in their best, and cheered
+lustily, first, when Mark drove up in his gig, and equally lustily when
+the Chetwynd carriage, drawn by four gray horses, dashed up, preceded
+by a large number of others with the bridesmaids and friends. The church
+was already crowded, and Mr. Greg was visibly moved at seeing the son
+and niece of the man to whom he owed his living made man and wife.
+When the wedding breakfast, at which more than fifty sat down, and
+the necessary toasts were over, Mr. and Mrs. Thorndyke started for
+Canterbury.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXII.
+
+
+It was not until Easter that Mark Thorndyke and his wife returned to
+England. They had spent the greater portion of that time in Italy,
+lingering for a month at Venice, and had then journeyed quietly
+homewards through Bavaria and Saxony; They were in no hurry, as before
+starting on their honeymoon Mark had consulted an architect, had told
+him exactly what he wanted, and had left the matter in his hands. Mrs.
+Cunningham had from time to time kept them informed how things were
+going on. The part of the house in which the Squire's room had been
+situated was entirely pulled down, and a new wing built in its stead.
+Millicent had been specially wishful that this should be done.
+
+“I don't know that I am superstitious, Mark,” she had said, “but I do
+think that when a murder has taken place in a house it is better to make
+a complete change. The servants always think they see or hear something.
+That part of the house is avoided, and it is difficult to get anyone to
+stay there. I think it is very much more important to do that than it
+is to get the house refurnished; we can do anything in that way you
+like when we get back, but I should certainly like very much to have the
+great alteration made before we return.”
+
+The architect was a clever one, and the house, which was some two
+hundred years old, was greatly improved in appearance by the new wing,
+which was made to harmonize well with the rest, but was specially
+designed to give as much variety as possible to the general outline.
+Millicent uttered an exclamation of pleasure when they first caught a
+glimpse of the house. As they rode through the village they were again
+welcomed as heartily as they were on their wedding day. Mrs. Cunningham
+received them; she had been established there for a month, and had
+placed the house entirely on its old footing. They first examined the
+new portion of the house, and Millicent was greatly pleased with the
+rooms that had been prepared for them, Mark having requested Mrs.
+Cunningham to put the furnishing into the hands of the best known firm
+of the day.
+
+“I have asked,” Mrs. Cunningham said, “the Rector and his wife and
+Mr. Chetwynd to dine with us this evening; they can scarcely be termed
+company, and I thought that you might find it pleasant to have these old
+friends here the first evening. There is a letter for you on the library
+table, Mark; it may almost be called a packet; it has been here nearly a
+month.”
+
+In our days a newly married couple would find on their return from
+foreign travel basketfuls of letters, circulars, and catalogues from
+tradesmen of all kinds; happily, our forefathers were saved from these
+inflictions, and Mark at once went to the library with almost a feeling
+of surprise as to who could have written to him. He saw at once that
+it was a ship's letter, for on the top was written, “Favored by the
+Surinam.”
+
+“Why, it is Ramoo's writing. I suppose he gave it to someone he knew,
+and that instead of its being put in the mail bag in India, he brought
+it on with him. What a tremendously long epistle!” he exclaimed,
+glancing his eye down the first page, and then a puzzled expression came
+across his face; he sat down and began to read from the first slowly and
+carefully.
+
+“HONORED SAHIB:
+
+“I do not know why I should write to tell you the true history of all
+these matters. I have thought it over many times, but I feel that it
+is right that you should know clearly what has happened, and how it has
+come about, and more especially that you should know that you need never
+fear any troubles such as those that have taken place. I am beginning
+to write this while we are yet sailing, and shall send it to you by
+ship from the Cape, or if it chances that we meet any ship on her way to
+England, our letters may be put on board her.”
+
+“Why, this letter must be more than a year old,” Mark said to himself.
+There was no date to the letter, but, turning to the last sheet, he saw
+as a postscript after the signature the words, “January 26th.--A ship,
+the Surinam, is lying a short distance from us, and will take our
+letters to England.”
+
+“Yes, it must be a year old; but what he means by the way he begins is
+more than I can imagine;” and he turned back to the point at which he
+had broken off.
+
+“I would tell it you in order as it happened. I, Ramoo, am a Brahmin.
+Twenty years ago I was the head priest of a great temple. I shall not
+say where the temple was; it matters not in any way. There was fighting,
+as there is always fighting in India. There were Company's Sepoys and
+white troops, and one night the most sacred bracelet of the great god of
+our temple was stolen.”
+
+“Good Heavens!” Mark exclaimed, laying down the letter. “Then it has
+been Ramoo who has all this time been in pursuit of the diamonds; and to
+think that my uncle never even suspected him!”
+
+Then suddenly he continued, “now I understand why it was my life was
+spared by those fellows. By Jove, this is astounding!” Then he took up
+the letter again.
+
+“Two of the Brahmins under me had observed, at a festival the day before
+the bracelet was lost, a white soldier staring at it with covetous eyes.
+One of them was in charge of the temple on the night when it was stolen,
+and on the day following he came to me, and said, 'I desire to devote my
+life to the recovery of the jewels of the god. Bondah will go with me;
+we will return no more until we bring them back.' 'It is good,' I said;
+'the god must be appeased, or terrible misfortunes may happen.' Then we
+held a solemn service in the temple. The two men removed the caste marks
+from their foreheads, prostrated themselves before the god, and went
+out from amongst us as outcasts until the day of their death. Two months
+later a messenger came from the one who had spoken to me, saying that
+they had found the man, but had for a long time had no opportunity of
+finding the bracelet. Then Bondah had met him in a lonely place, and
+had attacked him. Bondah had lost his life, but the soldier was, though
+sorely wounded, able to get back to his regiment. He had died, but he
+had, the writer was convinced, passed the jewels on to a comrade, whom
+he would watch. Then I saw that one man was not sufficient for such a
+task. Then I, too, the Chief Brahmin of the temple, saw that it was my
+duty to go forth also.
+
+“I laid the matter before the others, and they said, 'You are right; it
+is you who, as the chief in the service of the god, should bring back
+his jewels.' So again there was a service, and I went forth as an
+outcast and a wanderer, knowing that I must do many things that were
+forbidden to my caste; that I must touch unclean things, must eat
+forbidden food, and must take life if needs be. You, sahib, cannot
+understand how terrible was the degradation to me, who was of the purest
+blood of the Brahmins. I had taken the most solemn vows to devote my
+life to this. I knew that, whether successful or not, although I might
+be forgiven my offense by the god, yet that never again could I recover
+my caste, even though the heaviest penances were performed. Henceforth,
+I must stand alone in the world, without kindred, without friends,
+without help, save such as the god might give me in the search.
+
+“I was rich. The greater part of my goods I gave to the temple, and yet
+retained a considerable sum, for I should need money to carry out my
+quest, and after I had accomplished it I should hand over what remained
+for the benefit of the poor. I should myself become a fakir. I want you
+to understand, sahib, that henceforth I had but one object in life, a
+supreme one, to accomplish, in which nothing must stand in my way, and
+that what would be in others a crime was but a sacrifice on my part,
+most acceptable to the god. I journeyed down to the place where my
+comrade was, dressed as one of the lowest class, even as a sweeper, and
+he and I strove by all the means in our power to discover what this man
+had done with the jewels. Night after night we crawled into his tent. We
+searched his bed and his clothes. With sharp rods we tried every inch of
+the soil, believing that he had hidden the diamonds underground, but we
+failed.
+
+“There my comrade said, 'I must give my life to find out where he hides
+these things. I will watch night after night by the door of his tent,
+and if he comes out I will stab him; it shall be a mortal wound, but
+I will not kill him outright. Before he dies he will doubtless, as the
+other did, pass the jewels on to some comrade, and then it will be for
+you to follow him up.' 'It is good,' I said. 'This man may have hidden
+them away somewhere during the time they have marched through the
+country. In spite of the watch you have kept he may have said to
+himself, “I will return, though it be years hence.” Your plan is good,'
+I said. 'I envy you. 'Tis better to die thus than to live in sin as we
+are doing.'
+
+“That evening the man was stabbed, but an officer running up killed my
+comrade. The soldier was taken to the hospital, and I lay down beside
+the tent with my eye to a slit that I had cut, and watched till morning.
+
+“Then I took my broom and swept the ground. I had not been hired as one
+of the camp sweepers, and so could move about and sweep where I chose.
+No one ever asked me any questions. The soldiers heeded me no more than
+if I had been a dog, and, of course, supposed that I was acting by the
+order of the head of the sweepers. Presently I saw one of the servants
+of the hospital go across to the tent of the officer who had killed my
+comrade. He came over and went into the hospital tent. I felt sure that
+it was the wounded man who had sent for him. He was in there some time.
+Presently a soldier came out and went to the tent of the wounded man,
+and returned bringing a musket. Then I said to myself, 'The god has
+blinded us. He wills that we shall go through many more toils before we
+regain the bracelet.' Doubtless the man had carried the bracelet in his
+musket all the time, and we, blind that we were, had never thought of
+it.
+
+“Presently the officer came out again. I noticed that as he did so he
+looked round on all sides as if to see if he were watched. Then I knew
+that it was as I had thought: the soldier had given the bracelet to him.
+At this I was pleased; it would be far more easy to search the tent of
+an officer than of a soldier, who sleeps surrounded by his comrades. I
+thought that there was no hurry now; it would need but patience, and
+I should be sure to find them. I had not calculated that he would
+have better opportunities than the soldier for going about, and that,
+doubtless, the soldier had warned him of his danger. Two hours later the
+officer mounted his horse and rode towards the camp of another regiment,
+a mile and a quarter away. There was nothing in that; but I watched for
+his return all that day and all that night, and when he did not come
+back, I felt that he was doing something to get rid of the diamonds.
+
+“He was away three days, and when he returned I was almost sure that he
+had not the diamonds about him. As he had ridden off he had looked about
+just as he had when he left the hospital: he was uneasy, just as if he
+was watched; now he was uneasy no longer. Then I knew that my search
+would be a long one, and might fail altogether. I went away, and for
+three months I prayed and fasted; then I returned. I bought different
+clothes, I painted my forehead with another caste mark, then I bought
+from the servant of an officer in another regiment his papers of
+service: recommendations from former masters. Then I went to the
+officer--you will guess, sahib, that it was the Major, your uncle--and I
+paid his servant to leave his service, and to present me as a brother
+of his who had been accustomed to serve white sahibs, and was, like
+himself, a good servant; so I took his place.
+
+“He was a good master, and I came to love him, though I knew that I
+might yet have to kill him. You have heard that I saved his life three
+times; I did so partly because I loved him, but chiefly because his life
+was most precious to me, for if he had died I should have lost all clew
+to the bracelet. I had, of course, made sure that he had not got
+them with him; over and over again I searched every article in his
+possession. I ripped open his saddle lest they might be sewn up in its
+stuffing. All that could be done I did, until I was quite sure that he
+had not got them. He, on his part, came to like me. He thought that I
+was the most faithful of servants, and after the last time I saved his
+life he took me with him everywhere. He went down to Madras, and was
+married there. I watched his every movement. After that he went down
+frequently. Then a child was born, and six months afterwards his wife
+died.
+
+“The regiment was stationed at the fort. At that time he was at many
+places--the governor's, the other officer sahibs', the merchants', and
+others'. I could not follow him, but I was sure by his manner that he
+had not taken back the bracelet from whoever he had sent it to. I knew
+him so well by this time that I should have noticed any change in his
+manner in a moment. At last the child went away in the charge of
+Mrs. Cunningham. I bribed the child's ayah, and she searched Mrs.
+Cunningham's boxes and every garment she had, and found no small sealed
+parcel or box amongst them. Three years more passed. By this time the
+Colonel treated me more as a friend than as a servant. He said one day,
+laughing, 'It is a long time since my things have been turned topsy
+turvy, Ramoo. I think the thieves have come to the conclusion that I
+have not got what they are looking for.' 'What is that, sahib?' I asked.
+'Some special jewels,' he said. 'They are extremely valuable. But I have
+got them and a lot of other things so safely stowed that no one will
+ever find them unless I give them the clew.' 'But suppose you are
+killed, sahib,' I said; 'your little daughter will never get the
+things.' 'I have provided for that,' he answered. 'If I am killed I have
+arranged that she shall know all about it either when she comes to the
+age of eighteen or twenty-one.'
+
+“A few weeks after that he was wounded very badly. I nursed him night
+and day for weeks, and when he came to England he brought me with him.
+As you know, sahib, he died. When he was in London he went to see Mrs.
+Cunningham and the child, and several times to the office of the lawyer
+who attended your father's funeral. Then he came down to your father,
+and I know he had long and earnest conversations with him. I did all I
+could to listen, but the Colonel always had the windows and doors shut
+before he began to speak. I could see that your father was troubled.
+Then the Colonel died. After his death I could never find his snuff box;
+he had carried it about with him for some years; once or twice I had
+examined it, but it was too small for the diamonds to be hidden in. I
+suppose that he had given it to the sahib, your father, but as I could
+never find it I guessed that there was some mystery attached to it,
+though what I could not tell.
+
+“Then your father took me down to Crowswood with him, and Mrs.
+Cunningham and the little girl came down. I was surprised to find that
+your father seemed to be master of the estate, and that no one thought
+anything of the child, whose name had been changed. I spoke one day to
+Mrs. Cunningham about it; your father seemed to me a just and good man,
+and I could not believe that he was robbing his brother's daughter. Mrs.
+Cunningham told me that the Colonel did not wish her to be known as an
+heiress, and that he had left the estate to his brother until she came
+of age. Your father was as good a master as the Colonel had been.
+I watched and watched, and once or twice I overheard him talking to
+himself in the library, and discovered that your father himself was
+altogether ignorant of the hiding place of the property that the Colonel
+had mentioned in his will. I knew then that I should have to wait until
+the child was either eighteen or twenty-one.
+
+“It was a long time, but I had learnt to be patient. I was not unhappy;
+I loved your father, I loved the Colonel's little daughter; and I was
+very fond of you. All these things were small to me in comparison to my
+vow and the finding the jewels of the god, but they shortened the years
+of waiting. Then a year before the young mistress was eighteen came the
+shot through the window. I did not know who had fired it, but I saw that
+your father's life was in danger, and I said to myself, 'He will tell
+the young sahib what he knows about the bracelet.' After you had gone
+into the library I opened the door quietly, and listened. I could hear
+much that was said, but not all. I heard him say something about a snuff
+box, and some means of finding the lost things being hidden in it, and
+that he had kept them all these years in a secret hiding place, which he
+described. You were to search for the diamonds, and I guessed from that
+that he did not know what he was to be told when the young memsahib came
+of age, or perhaps when she was eighteen. It was not until I had thought
+over what I heard that I came to the conclusion that if I could find the
+things he spoke of I might be able to find the jewels. By that time your
+father had gone to bed. I was foolish not to have been patient, but
+my blood boiled after waiting for eighteen or nineteen years. The god
+seemed to have sent me the chance, and it seemed to me that I should
+take it at once. I knew that he generally slept with his window open,
+and it seemed to me that it would be easy to slip in there and to get
+those things from the cabinet. I knew where the ladder was kept. I took
+a file from the tool chest and cut the chain.”
+
+Here Mark dropped the letter in horror.
+
+“Good Heavens!” he exclaimed. “Then Bastow spoke truly, and he was not
+my father's murderer! Never did a single suspicion of Ramoo enter my
+head. This is appalling; but I cannot read any more now. It is time for
+me to go and dress for dinner.”
+
+“Is anything the matter with you, Mark?” Millicent asked anxiously, as
+she met him in the drawing room; “you look as white as a sheet.”
+
+“I have been reading Ramoo's letter, and he has told me some things that
+have surprised and shocked me. I will tell you about them after dinner,
+dear. It is a long story, but you won't have to wait until Dick and the
+Gregs are gone. They are interested in all that interests us, and shall
+hear the letter read. No; I think I will ask them and Dick to come in
+the morning. I should not like anything to sadden the first evening of
+our coming home.”
+
+“Then it is something sad.”
+
+“Yes, but it does not affect us, though it does affect Ramoo. Now clear
+your brow, dear, and dismiss the subject from your mind, else our guests
+will fancy that our marriage has not been altogether so satisfactory as
+they had hoped.”
+
+“As if they could think such a thing as that, Mark,” she said
+indignantly. “But there is the sound of wheels; it is Mr. Chetwynd's
+gig.”
+
+The three visitors all came in together, having met at the door. Mark,
+with a great effort, put aside the letter from his mind, and a cheerful
+evening was spent. They had much to tell of their travels, many
+questions to ask about the parish and their mutual friends and the
+neighborhood generally, and when they rose to go Mark said:
+
+“Would you mind riding over again tomorrow morning, Dick? I have a
+letter to read to you that will interest you greatly.”
+
+“Certainly. What time shall I be here?”
+
+“Say at eleven o'clock. It is a long epistle, and will take us an hour
+to get through; after that we can stroll round, and, of course, you will
+stop to lunch.
+
+“I should be glad if you and Mrs. Greg can come over too,” he added,
+turning to the Rector; “you will be much interested also in the matter.”
+
+
+The next day the party met in the library at the hour named. “I may tell
+you, Mr. Greg, that I specially asked you and your wife here because
+this letter throws some light on Arthur Bastow's connection with my
+father's murder; you were friends with his father, and I think you ought
+to know. As to you, Dick, the letter will interest you from beginning to
+end, and will surprise as much as it will interest you.”
+
+“Even I don't know what it is, Mrs. Greg,” Millicent said. “I know it
+quite upset Mark yesterday, but he said he would sooner I did not know
+anything about it until today, as he did not want me to be saddened on
+the first evening of our return home. Now, please go on, Mark; you have
+said quite enough to excite us all.”
+
+Mark had read but a short distance when Dick Chetwynd exclaimed:
+
+“Then Ramoo was at the bottom of that Indian business, after all. I
+almost wonder you never suspected it, Mark.”
+
+“Well, I hardly could do so,” Mark said, “when my uncle was so fond of
+him, and he had served him so faithfully.”
+
+As he approached the point at which he had laid down the letter on the
+previous evening, Millicent's color faded.
+
+Suddenly an exclamation of horror broke from her when he read the last
+line.
+
+“Oh, Mark,” she said, with quivering lips, “don't say it was Ramoo. He
+always seemed so kind and good.”
+
+“It was here I stopped last night,” he said, “but I fear there can be no
+doubt about it. I must say that it is evident from this letter, that
+no thought of doing my father harm was in his mind when he placed that
+ladder against the window. Now I will go on.”
+
+The letter continued as follows:
+
+“Having placed the ladder, I clambered to the window and quietly entered
+the room. It was quite dark, but I knew the place of every piece of
+furniture so well that I was able to go without hesitation to the
+cabinet. Your father was speaking very slowly and distinctly when he
+told you how it was to be opened, and I was able to do it easily, but
+I did not know that the back opened with a sharp click, and the noise
+startled me and woke your father. In an instant he was out of bed and
+seized me by the throat. Now, he was a much stronger man than I was. I
+struggled in vain. I felt that in a moment I should become insensible;
+my vow and my duty to the god flashed across me, and scarce knowing what
+I did, I drew a little dagger I always carried, and struck blindly.
+He fell, and I fell beside him. For a time I was insensible. When I
+recovered I was seized with the bitterest remorse that I had killed one
+I loved, but I seemed to hear the voice of the god saying, 'You have
+done well, Ramoo. I am your great master, and you are bound to my
+service.'
+
+“I got up almost blindly, felt in the cabinet, and found a coin and a
+piece of paper, and a feeling of exultation came over me that, after
+nearly twenty years, I should succeed in carrying out my vow and taking
+his bracelet back to the god. I descended the ladder, crept in the back
+door by which I had come out, went up to my room, where I had kept a
+light burning, and examined my treasures. Then I saw that all had been
+in vain. They were doubtless a key to the mystery, but until a clew was
+given they were absolutely useless. I sat for hours staring at them. I
+would have gone back and replaced them in the cabinet and left all as
+it had been before, but I dared not enter the room again. The next day I
+heard you say that you suspected that the talk with your father had been
+overheard, and that the man who had earlier in the evening before shot
+at him had returned, and while listening had heard something said about
+the hiding place, and thought that he would find some sort of treasure
+there. I thought that in the talk your father might have told you how
+to use these things, though I had not caught it, and it was therefore
+important that you should have them back again, so I went into the room
+after the inquest was over, and placed the things in their hiding place
+again.
+
+“Then, thinking it over, I determined to leave your service. You would
+be trying to find the treasure, and I must watch you, and this I could
+not do as long as I was a house servant; so I came up to London, and you
+thought I had sailed for India, but I did not go. I hired four Lascars,
+men of my own religion, and paid them to watch every movement that you
+made, to see where you visited and where you went. I paid them well,
+and they served me well; it was so that I was able to bring those men
+to your help when but for that you would have lost your life. It was for
+this to some extent that I had you followed; for I soon found out that
+you were on the search for the man who had fired through the window, and
+who you believed had killed your father, rather than for the jewels. I
+knew that you might run into danger, and partly because I loved you, and
+partly because it was possible that it would be essential for that coin
+and piece of paper to be produced in order that the treasure might be
+obtained, I kept guard over you.
+
+“When the 18th of August approached we were all on the watch. I felt
+sure that you would take every possible precaution while you had the
+bracelet in your possession. We knew who were your principal friends,
+the banker's son and Mr. Chetwynd. On the 18th of August everything went
+on as usual. On the following day the banker's son came to you, and as
+soon as he left you, you went to the lawyer's, and afterwards to the
+banker's. I felt sure now that it was at that bank that the jewels had
+been placed, and that you had been waiting till the young memsahib's
+birthday for the news that they might be taken out; then you went to Mr.
+Chetwynd's, and he went to the bank. I had no doubt that he was to take
+them out for you, and after that one of the men never took his eyes off
+him when he was outside of his house. Afterwards you went to the place
+where the men used to fight, and the man who was watching you went in,
+and had beer, and saw you talking with the big man you used to fight
+with, in the parlor behind the bar. The watcher went out to follow you,
+but left another to watch this man. We found that both Mr. Chetwynd and
+he went to a shipping office in Tower Street, and we then guessed that
+you intended to take the bracelet at once across the sea.
+
+“I went myself and found out that a vessel was sailing in two days to
+Amsterdam. I took a passage for a man in the cheap cabin, and asked to
+look at the list of passengers, as I believed that some friend would
+be sailing by her; there were two men's names down together in one
+handwriting among the first class passengers, and I guessed that these
+were you and Mr. Chetwynd. I also saw the name of the big man, which I
+had heard long before, down in the list of passengers, and another
+name next to his in the same handwriting. I did not know his name, but
+guessed that it was another of the fighting men, and that they were
+going to look after you until you had got rid of the diamonds. On the
+morning that she was to sail one of the Lascars was on board; I thought
+it possible that in order to throw anyone who might be following you off
+your scent you might at the last moment go ashore, and that Mr. Chetwynd
+might take the diamonds over, so I watched, and saw you on the deck with
+your friend.
+
+“I and the other three Lascars then took passage that evening in a craft
+for Rotterdam, and got to Amsterdam two days before your ship arrived;
+we went to different houses, and going separately into the worst parts
+of the town, soon found a man who kept a gambling den, and who was a
+man who could be trusted. I offered him a thousand francs to collect
+twenty-five men, who were to be paid a hundred francs each, and to be
+ready, if your ship arrived after dark, to attack two passengers I would
+point out to them. I did not want you to be hurt, so bargained that all
+knives were to be left behind, and that he was to supply the men only
+with clubs. If the ship came in in daylight you were to be attacked the
+first time you went out after dark. You know how that was carried out.
+You had two more men with you than I had expected; but I thought that
+with a sudden rush you might all be separated. You know the rest. The
+moment you were knocked down I and three others carried you to a boat.
+It had been lying near the stairs, and we took you off to the barge in
+which I had arranged you should be taken to Rotterdam.
+
+“We told them that you were a drunken man who had been stunned in a
+fight in a public house. As soon as we were off, I searched you and
+found the diamonds. Then, as you know, we put you ashore. We all
+crossed to England that night. Two days later I sailed in this ship, the
+Brahmapootra. I am not afraid of telling you this, because I know that
+the diamonds will not shine on the god's arm until all fear of search
+and inquiry are over. My task will be done when I hand them over to the
+man who holds the office I once held; then I shall bear the penances
+imposed on me for having broken my caste in every way, and for having
+taken life, and for the rest of my days I shall wander as a fakir
+through India. I shall be supported by the knowledge that I have done my
+duty to my god, and have sacrificed all in his service, but it will ever
+be a grief to me that in so doing it was necessary to sacrifice the life
+of one who had ever shown me kindness. You may wonder why I have written
+this, but I felt that I must own the truth to you, and that you should
+know that if in the course of my duty to the god it was my misfortune
+to slay your father, I have twice saved your life, just as three times I
+saved that of the Colonel Sahib, your uncle.”
+
+There was silence for some little time after Mark had finished reading.
+
+“It is a strange story indeed,” Mr. Greg said, “but it is not for us
+to judge the man. He has acted according to his lights, and none can do
+more. He sacrificed himself and his life solely to the service of his
+god, well knowing that even were he successful, his reward would be
+penance and suffering, and a life of what cannot but be misery to a
+man brought up, as he has been, to consider himself of the highest and
+holiest rank of the people. I think, Mark, we need neither say nor think
+anything harshly of him.”
+
+“Certainly not,” Mark agreed. “I can understand that according to his
+view of the matter anything that stood between him and his goal was but
+an obstacle to be swept aside; assuredly there was no premeditation in
+the killing of my father. I have no doubt that the man was attached to
+him, and that he killed him not to save his own life, but in order that
+his mission might be carried out.”
+
+“Quite so, Mark; it was done in the same spirit, if I may say so, that
+Abraham would have sacrificed his son at the order of his God. What
+years of devotion that man has passed through! Accustomed, as you see,
+to a lofty position, to the respect and veneration of those around him,
+he became a servant, and performed duties that were in his opinion not
+only humiliating, but polluting and destructive to his caste, and which
+rendered him an outcast even among the lowest of his people. Do you not
+think so, Mrs. Thorndyke?”
+
+Millicent, who was crying quietly, looked up.
+
+“I can only think of him as the man who twice saved Mark's life,” she
+said.
+
+“I understand why you have wished to tell me this story,” the Rector
+went on to Mark. “You wish me to know that Arthur Bastow did not add
+this to his other crimes; that he was spared from being the murderer of
+your father, but from no want of will on his part; and, as we know, he
+killed many others, the last but an hour or two before he put an end to
+his own life; still I am glad that this terrible crime is not his. It
+seemed to be so revolting and unnatural. It was the Squire's father who
+had given the living to his father, and the Squire himself had been his
+friend in the greatest of his trials, and had given him a shelter and a
+home in his old age. I am glad, at least, that the man, evil as he was,
+was spared this last crime of the grossest ingratitude.”
+
+“Well, Mark,” Dick Chetwynd said cheerfully, in order to turn the
+subject, “I am heartily glad that we have got to the bottom of this
+jewel mystery. I have been puzzling over it all the time that you have
+been away, and I have never been able to understand how, in spite of
+the precautions that we took, they should have found out that the jewels
+were at Cotter's, and that you had them on board with you, and, above
+all, why they spared your life when they could so easily and safely
+have put you out of the way. It is certainly strange that while you were
+thinking over everything connected with the jewels, the idea that Ramoo
+was the leading spirit in the whole business should never once have
+occurred to you.”
+
+A month later, when Mark went up to town, he called at Leadenhall
+Street.
+
+“Of course, you have not heard of the arrival of the Brahmapootra at
+Madras yet. May I ask when she left the Cape?”
+
+“She never left the Cape, sir,” the clerk replied, “and there are very
+grave fears for her safety. She spoke the Surinam and gave her mails
+for England when the latter was eight days out from the Cape, and the
+Surinam reported that a day later she encountered a terrible gale, lost
+several spars, and narrowly escaped being blown onto the African coast.
+Since then we have had no news of the Brahmapootra. A number of Indiamen
+have arrived since; the latest came in only yesterday, and up to the
+time when she left no news had been received of the ship. Three small
+craft had been sent up the coast weeks before to make inquiries for her,
+but had returned without being able to obtain any intelligence, and had
+seen no wreckage on the coast, although they had gone several hundred
+miles beyond where she had spoken the Surinam, therefore there can be
+little doubt that she foundered with all hands during the gale. You had
+no near relatives on board, I hope, sir?”
+
+“No near relatives, but there was one on board in whom I was greatly
+interested. Here is my card; I should feel greatly obliged if you would
+write me a line should you hear anything of her.”
+
+“I will do so, sir. We have had innumerable inquiries from friends and
+relatives of those on board, and although of late we have been obliged
+to say that there can no longer be any hope that she will ever be heard
+of, not a day passes but many persons still come in to inquire.”
+
+No letter ever came to Mark; no news was ever heard of the Brahmapootra.
+Ramoo's sacrifice was in vain, and never again did the diamond bracelet
+glisten on the arm of the idol in the unknown temple.
+
+
+
+THE END.
+
+
+
+
+
+End of Project Gutenberg's Colonel Thorndyke's Secret, by G. A. Henty
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET ***
+
+***** This file should be named 8155-0.txt or 8155-0.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/8/1/5/8155/
+
+Produced by Martin Robb
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase “Project
+Gutenberg”), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. “Project Gutenberg” is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (“the Foundation”
+ or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase “Project Gutenberg” appears, or with which the phrase “Project
+Gutenberg” is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase “Project Gutenberg” associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+“Plain Vanilla ASCII” or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original “Plain Vanilla ASCII” or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, “Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation.”
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+“Defects,” such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the “Right
+of Replacement or Refund” described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/8155-0.zip b/8155-0.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d728ed7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/8155-0.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/8155-h.zip b/8155-h.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7f703cc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/8155-h.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/8155-h/8155-h.htm b/8155-h/8155-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..266e441
--- /dev/null
+++ b/8155-h/8155-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,15423 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+
+<!DOCTYPE html
+ PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
+ "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd" >
+
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" lang="en">
+ <head>
+ <title>
+ Colonel Thorndyke's Secret, by G. A. Henty.
+ </title>
+
+<style type="text/css">
+ <!--
+ body { margin:5%; background:#faebd0; text-align:justify}
+ P { text-indent: 1em; margin-top: .25em; margin-bottom: .25em; }
+ H1,H2,H3,H4,H5,H6 { text-align: center; margin-left: 15%; margin-right: 15%; }
+ hr { width: 50%; text-align: center;}
+ .foot { margin-left: 5%; margin-right: 5%; text-align: justify; font-size: 80%; font-style: italic;}
+ blockquote {font-size: 97%; font-style: italic; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%;}
+ .mynote {background-color: #DDE; color: #000; padding: .5em; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-family: sans-serif; font-size: 95%;}
+ .toc { margin-left: 10%; margin-bottom: .75em;}
+ .toc2 { margin-left: 20%;}
+ .xx-small {font-size: 60%;}
+ .x-small {font-size: 75%;}
+ .small {font-size: 85%;}
+ .large {font-size: 115%;}
+ .x-large {font-size: 130%;}
+ .indent5 { margin-left: 5%;}
+ .indent10 { margin-left: 10%;}
+ .indent15 { margin-left: 15%;}
+ .indent20 { margin-left: 20%;}
+ .indent30 { margin-left: 30%;}
+ .indent40 { margin-left: 40%;}
+ div.fig { display:block; margin:0 auto; text-align:center; }
+ div.middle { margin-left: 20%; margin-right: 20%; text-align: justify; }
+ .figleft {float: left; margin-left: 0%; margin-right: 1%;}
+ .figright {float: right; margin-right: 0%; margin-left: 1%;}
+ .pagenum {position: absolute; right: 1%; font-size: 0.6em;
+ font-variant: normal; font-style: normal;
+ text-align: right; background-color: #FFFACD;
+ border: 1px solid; padding: 0.3em;text-indent: 0em;}
+ .side { float: left; font-size: 75%; width: 15%; padding-left: 0.8em;
+ border-left: dashed thin; text-align: left;
+ text-indent: 0; font-weight: bold; font-style: italic;
+ font-weight: bold; color: black; background: #eeeeee; border: solid 1px;}
+ .head { float: left; font-size: 90%; width: 98%; padding-left: 0.8em;
+ border-left: dashed thin; text-align: center;
+ text-indent: 0; font-weight: bold; font-style: italic;
+ font-weight: bold; color: black; background: #eeeeee; border: solid 1px;}
+ p.pfirst, p.noindent {text-indent: 0}
+ span.dropcap { float: left; margin: 0 0.1em 0 0; line-height: 0.8 }
+ pre { font-style: italic; font-size: 90%; margin-left: 10%;}
+ -->
+</style>
+ </head>
+ <body>
+<pre xml:space="preserve">
+
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of Colonel Thorndyke's Secret, by G. A. Henty
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: Colonel Thorndyke's Secret
+
+Author: G. A. Henty
+
+Release Date: July 23, 2009 [EBook #8155]
+Last Updated: March 11, 2018
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: UTF-8
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Martin Robb, and David Widger
+
+
+
+
+
+
+</pre>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <h1>
+ COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET
+ </h1>
+ <p>
+ <br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <h2>
+ By G. A. Henty.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ <br /> <br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <br /> <br />
+ </p>
+ <blockquote>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <big><b>CONTENTS</b></big>
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /> <a href="#link2H_4_0001"> PUBLISHER'S INTRODUCTION. </a><br /><br /><br />
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0001"> CHAPTER I. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0002"> CHAPTER II </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0003"> CHAPTER III. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0004"> CHAPTER IV. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0005"> CHAPTER V. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0006"> CHAPTER VI. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0007"> CHAPTER VII. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0008"> CHAPTER VIII. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0009"> CHAPTER IX. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0010"> CHAPTER X. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0011"> CHAPTER XI. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0012"> CHAPTER XII. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0013"> CHAPTER XIII. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0014"> CHAPTER XIV. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0015"> CHAPTER XV. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0016"> CHAPTER XVI. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0017"> CHAPTER XVII. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0018"> CHAPTER XVIII. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0019"> CHAPTER XIX. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0020"> CHAPTER XX. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0021"> CHAPTER XXI. </a>
+ </p>
+ <p class="toc">
+ <a href="#link2HCH0022"> CHAPTER XXII. </a>
+ </p>
+ </blockquote>
+ <p>
+ <br /> <br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <br /> <br /> <a name="link2H_4_0001" id="link2H_4_0001">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <h2>
+ PUBLISHER'S INTRODUCTION.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Colonel Thorndyke's Secret&rdquo; is a story so far out of the ordinary that it
+ will not be inappropriate to speak a few words regarding the tale and its
+ unusually successful author, Mr. George Alfred Henty.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The plot of the story hinges upon the possession of a valuable bracelet,
+ of diamonds, stolen from a Hindoo idol by a British soldier in India. This
+ bracelet falls into the possession of Colonel Thorndyke, who, shortly
+ afterward, is sent home to England because of his wounds. The secret
+ concerning the bracelet is told to the Colonel's brother, a country
+ squire, and the treasure is left to younger members of the Thorndyke
+ family.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As is well known today, the theft of anything from a Hindoo temple is
+ considered an extraordinary crime in India, and when this occurs it
+ becomes a religious duty for one or more persons to hunt down the thief
+ and bring back the property taken from the heathen god.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The members of the Thorndyke family soon learn that they are being
+ watched. But this is at a time when highwaymen are numerous in this part
+ of England, and they cannot determine whether the work is that of the
+ &ldquo;knights of the roads&rdquo; or that of the Lascars after the famous bracelet. A
+ mysterious death follows, and the younger members of the family are almost
+ stunned, not knowing what will happen next. They would give the bracelet
+ up, but do not know where it is hidden, the secret having been in the sole
+ possession of the member now dead. In this quandary the young hero of the
+ tale rises to the occasion and determines to join the London police force
+ and become a detective, with the hope of ultimately clearing up the
+ mystery. Thrilling adventures of a most unusual kind follow, and at last
+ something of the mystery is explained. The bracelet and other jewelry are
+ unearthed, and it is decided to take the bracelet to Amsterdam and offer
+ it to the diamond cutters at that place. But the carrying of the bracelet
+ is both difficult and dangerous. How the mission is brought to a
+ conclusion, and what part the Lascars played in the final adventure, will
+ be found in the pages that follow.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It can truthfully be said that Mr. Henty is easily the most popular of all
+ English story tellers, his books for boys enjoying a circulation of from a
+ hundred and fifty thousand to two hundred and fifty thousand per year. His
+ tales are all clean, and although some are full of exciting situations and
+ thrilling to the last degree, they are of a high moral tone, while the
+ English employed is of the best.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The present story is of peculiar value as giving a good insight into
+ country and town life in England over a hundred years ago, when railways
+ and telegraph lines were unknown and when the &ldquo;knights of the road&rdquo; were
+ apt to hold up any stagecoach that happened to come along. It also gives a
+ truthful picture of the dark and underhanded work accomplished at times by
+ those of East Indian blood, especially when on what they consider a
+ religious mission.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <br /> <br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <br /> <br /> <a name="link2HCH0001" id="link2HCH0001">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER I.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ Squire Thorndyke, of the Manor House of Crawley, was, on the 1st of
+ September; 1782, walking up and down the little terrace in front of the
+ quaint old house in an unusually disturbed mood. He was a man of forty
+ three or four, stoutly and strongly built, and inclined to be portly. Save
+ the loss of his wife four years before, there had been but little to
+ ruffle the easy tenor of his life. A younger son, he had, at his mother's
+ death, when he was three and twenty, come in for the small estate at
+ Crawley, which had been her jointure.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For ten years he had led a life resembling that of most of his neighbors;
+ he had hunted and shot, been a regular attendant at any main of cocks that
+ was fought within fifteen miles of Crawley, had occasionally been up to
+ London for a week or two to see the gay doings there. Of an evening he had
+ generally gone down to the inn, where he talked over, with two or three of
+ his own condition and a few of the better class of farmers, the news of
+ the day, the war with the French, the troubles in Scotland, the alarming
+ march of the Young Pretender, and his defeat at Culloden&mdash;with no
+ very keen interest in the result, for the Southern gentry and yeomen,
+ unlike those in the North, had no strong leanings either way. They had a
+ dull dislike for Hanoverian George, but no great love for the exiled
+ Stuarts, whose patron, the King of France, was an enemy of England.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ More often, however, their thoughts turned upon local topics&mdash;the
+ holding up of the coach of Sir James Harris or Squire Hamilton by
+ highwaymen; the affray between the French smugglers and the Revenue men
+ near Selsea Bill or Shoreham; the delinquencies of the poaching gangs; the
+ heaviness of the taxes, and the price of corn.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At the age of thirty-three Squire Thorndyke married the daughter of a
+ neighboring landowner; a son was born and three years later Mrs. Thorndyke
+ died. Since then the Squire had led a more retired life; he still went
+ down to smoke his pipe at the inn parlor, but he gave up his visits to
+ town; and cock fights, and even bull baiting, were no longer attractions
+ to him. He was known as a good landlord to the three or four farmers who
+ held land under him; was respected and liked in the village, where he was
+ always ready to assist in cases of real distress; was of an easygoing
+ disposition and on good terms with all his neighbors.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ But today he was unusually disturbed in his mind. A messenger had ridden
+ up two hours before with a letter from London. It was as follows:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;MY DEAR BROTHER JOHN:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will be surprised indeed at this letter from me, who, doubtless, you
+ suppose to be fighting in India. I have done with fighting, and am nearly
+ done with life. I was shot in the battle of Buxar, eighteen months ago.
+ For a time the surgeons thought that it was going to be fatal; then I
+ rallied, and for some months it seemed that, in spite of the ball that
+ they were never able to find, I was going to get over it, and should be
+ fit for service again. Then I got worse; first it was a cough, then the
+ blood used to come up, and they said that the only chance for me was to
+ come home. I did not believe it would be of any use, but I thought that I
+ would rather die at home than in India, so home I came, and have now been
+ a week in London.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I thought at first of going down to my place at Reigate, and having you
+ and your boy there with me; but as I have certainly not many weeks,
+ perhaps not many days, to live, I thought I would come down to you; so the
+ day after you receive this letter I shall be with you. I shall not bring
+ my little girl down; I have left her in good hands, and I shall only bring
+ with me my Hindoo servant. He will give you no trouble&mdash;a mat to
+ sleep on, and a little rice to eat, will satisfy his wants; and he will
+ take the trouble of me a good deal off your hands. He was a Sepoy in my
+ regiment, and has always evinced the greatest devotion for me. More than
+ once in battle he has saved my life, and has, for the last three years,
+ been my servant, and has nursed me since I have been ill as tenderly as a
+ woman could have done. As I shall have time to tell you everything when I
+ arrive, I will say no more now.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The news had much affected John Thorndyke. His brother George was five
+ years his senior, and had gone out as a cadet in the company's service
+ when John was but thirteen, and this was his first home coming. Had it not
+ been for a portrait that had been taken of him in his uniform just before
+ he sailed, John would have had but little remembrance of him. In that he
+ was represented as a thin, spare youth, with an expression of quiet
+ determination in his face. From his father John had, of course, heard much
+ about him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Nothing would satisfy him but to go out to India, John. There was, of
+ course, no occasion for it, as he would have this place after me&mdash;a
+ fine estate and a good position: what could he want more? But he was a
+ curious fellow. Once he formed an opinion there was no persuading him to
+ change it. He was always getting ideas such as no one else would think of;
+ he did not care for anything that other people cared for; never hunted nor
+ shot. He used to puzzle me altogether with his ways, and, 'pon my word, I
+ was not sorry when he said he would go to India, for there was no saying
+ how he might have turned out if he had stopped here. He never could do
+ anything like anybody else: nothing that he could have done would have
+ surprised me.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If he had told me that he intended to be a play actor, or a Jockey, or a
+ private, or a book writer, I should not have been surprised. Upon my word,
+ it was rather a relief to me when he said, 'I have made up my mind to go
+ into the East India Service, father. I suppose you can get me a
+ cadetship?' At least that was an honorable profession; and I knew, anyhow,
+ that when he once said 'I have made up my mind, father,' no arguments
+ would move him, and that if I did not get him a cadetship he was perfectly
+ capable of running away, going up to London, and enlisting in one of their
+ white regiments.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke's own remembrances were that his brother had always been
+ good natured to him, that he had often told him long stories about Indian
+ adventures, and that a short time before he went away, having heard that
+ he had been unmercifully beaten by the schoolmaster at Reigate for some
+ trifling fault, he had gone down to the town, and had so battered the man
+ that the school had to be closed for a fortnight. They had always kept up
+ a correspondence. When he received the news of his father's death George
+ had written to him, begging him to go down to Reigate, and to manage the
+ estate for him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;you will draw its income as long as you are there.
+ I mayn't be back for another twenty years; one gets rich out here fast,
+ what with plunder and presents and one thing and another, and it is no use
+ to have money accumulating at home, so just live on the place as if it
+ were your own, until I come home to turn you out.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John had declined the offer.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am very well where I am,&rdquo; he wrote, &ldquo;and the care of the estate would
+ be a horrible worry to me; besides, I have just married, and if I ever
+ have any children they would be brought up beyond their station. I have
+ done what I can for you. I have seen the family lawyers, who have engaged
+ a man who has been steward to Sir John Hieover, and looked after the
+ estate during his son's minority. But the young blade, on coming of age,
+ set to work to make ducks and drakes of the property, and Newman could not
+ bear to see the estate going to the Jews, so, as luck would have it, he
+ resigned a month ago, and has been appointed steward at Reigate. Of
+ course, if you don't like the arrangement you must write and say so. It
+ will be a year before I get your answer, and he has only been engaged for
+ certain for that time; it must lie with you as to permanent arrangement.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ So Newman had taken charge of the Reigate estate, and had continued to
+ manage it ever since, although George had written home in great
+ displeasure at his offer being refused.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Inside the Manor the bustle of preparations was going on; the spare room,
+ which had not been used for many years, was being turned out, and a great
+ fire lighted to air it. John Thorndyke had sent a letter by the returning
+ messenger to a friend in town, begging him to go at once to Leadenhall
+ Street and send down a supply of Indian condiments for his brother's use,
+ and had then betaken himself to the garden to think the matter over. The
+ next day a post chaise arrived, bringing the invalid and his colored
+ servant, whose complexion and Indian garb struck the maids with an awe not
+ unmingled with alarm. John Thorndyke could hardly believe that the bent
+ and emaciated figure was that of his brother, but he remembered the voice
+ when the latter said, holding out his hand to him:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, brother John, here I am, what is left of me. Gracious, man, who
+ would have thought that you were going to grow up such a fine tall fellow?
+ You are more fitted to be a soldier than I am. No, don't try to help me
+ out; Ramoo will do that&mdash;he is accustomed to my ways, and I would as
+ soon trust myself to a rogue elephant as to you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am sorry to see you looking so bad, brother George.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What must be must. I have had my fling; and after thirty years of
+ marching and fighting, I have no right to grumble if I am laid upon my
+ back at last.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Leaning on Ramoo's arm, Colonel Thorndyke made his way into the house, and
+ when the Hindoo had arranged the cushions of the sofa, took his place
+ there in a half reclining position.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am not always as bad as this, John,&rdquo; he said; &ldquo;the jolting of your
+ confounded roads has been too much for me. If I were the King I would hang
+ every fellow who had anything to do with them&mdash;contractors, boards of
+ county magistrates, and the whole lot. If I had known what it was going to
+ be like I would have hired a sedan chair, and had myself carried down.
+ That is what I have been doing in London; but I would rather have had an
+ Indian palkee, that one could have lain down comfortably in.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What shall I get you first, George? I have got some lemons.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I want something better than lemons, John. Have you any Burgundy handy?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, plenty.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If you give a bottle to Ramoo he will know how much water I want.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Here the servants entered with a tray with a chicken and a dish of
+ kidneys.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I sent up yesterday for some of the Indian things that you are accustomed
+ to, George, but they have not come down yet.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I brought a store down with me. This will do capitally for the present.
+ Ramoo will do the cooking for me in future. He need not go into the
+ kitchen to scare the maids. I could see they looked at him as if he had
+ been his infernal majesty, as he came in. He can do it anywhere; all he
+ wants is an iron pot with some holes in it, and some charcoal. He can
+ squat out there on the veranda, or, if it is bad weather, any shed will do
+ for him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, it is nice to be home again, John,&rdquo; he went on, after he had eaten
+ a few mouthfuls of chicken and drunk a tumbler of Burgundy and water. &ldquo;I
+ am glad to be back, now I am here, though I dare say I should not have
+ come home for another ten years if it had not been for this rascally
+ bullet. Where is your boy?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is away at school.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I think I will go up to bed at once, if you don't mind, John. I
+ shall be fitter to talk in the morning.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next day, indeed, Colonel Thorndyke was materially better. His voice
+ was stronger and more cheery, and when he came down after breakfast he
+ took his seat in an easy chair instead of on the sofa.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, brother,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;we will have a cozy chat. There are several
+ things I want done, but the chief of these is that when I am gone you
+ should go down to Reigate, as I wanted you to do ten years ago. I want you
+ to seem to be its master, as well as be its master, until Millicent comes
+ of age, if not longer. Her name is Millicent Conyers Thorndyke. I wish her
+ to be called Millicent Conyers, and to appear as your ward, and not as
+ your niece and heiress of the property. If there is one thing in the world
+ I have a greater horror of than another, it is of a girl being married for
+ her money. I don't suppose that anyone knows that I have a daughter&mdash;at
+ any rate, none beyond a few Indian chums. She was sent home with an ayah
+ under the charge of the widow of a comrade of mine. I had been away for
+ months, and only went back to Calcutta in time to see her mother die. So
+ that is all right.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I could not do such a thing as that, George. I should be living under
+ false colors. It is not that I mind so much leaving here and looking after
+ the child's interest at Reigate, but I could not possibly take possession
+ of the place as its owner when I should not be so. Besides, there are
+ other objections. Mark would grow up supposing himself to be the heir.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Mark will be all right. I have, since I have been in London, signed a
+ will, leaving the rest of my fortune between them. I had it drawn up by
+ our father's solicitors, relying upon your consent to do what I asked you.
+ I have explained the matter to them, and given them the assignment, or
+ whatever they call it, of the Reigate estate to you, until my daughter
+ comes of age, appointing them her guardians should you die before that.
+ Thus, you will be placed in a proper position; and should it be known by
+ any means that the child is my daughter, that deed will still be a proof
+ that you are carrying out my wishes, and are absolute master of the estate
+ until she comes of age.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I must think it all over, George. It is a singular proposal, and I own I
+ would rather things went on in their regular course.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, yes, I understand that, John; but you see I have altogether set my
+ mind on this matter. I want to know that my girl is not going to be
+ married for her money; and, at any rate, that deed makes you master of the
+ Reigate estates for the next thirteen years; so the only thing that I
+ really want of you is to let the girl be called your ward instead of your
+ niece, and that she and everyone else shall be in ignorance that she is an
+ heiress. So far from doing the girl a wrong, you will be doing her a
+ benefit; and as I have explained the whole matter to our lawyers, no one
+ can possibly think that the thing has been done from any motive whatever
+ except that of affording me satisfaction.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will think the matter over,&rdquo; John repeated. &ldquo;Of course, brother, it has
+ been in your mind for some time, but it comes altogether fresh to me, and
+ I must look at it in every light. For myself, I have no wish at all to
+ become master of our father's estate. I have been going in one groove for
+ the last twenty years, and don't care about changing it. You wished me to
+ do so ten years ago, and I declined then, and the ten years have not made
+ me more desirous of change than I was before.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right; think it over. Please send Ramoo in to me; I have tired myself
+ in talking.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke smoked many churchwarden pipes in the little arbor in his
+ garden that day. In the afternoon his brother was so weak and tired that
+ the subject of the conversation was not reverted to. At eight o'clock the
+ Colonel went off to bed. The next morning, after breakfast, he was
+ brighter again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, John, what has come of your thinking?&rdquo; he asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't like it, George.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You mayn't like it, John, but you will do it. I am not going to have my
+ girl run after by ruined spendthrifts who want her money to repair their
+ fortunes; and I tell you frankly, if you refuse I shall go up to town
+ tomorrow, and I shall make a new will, leaving all my property to your
+ son, subject to a life annuity of 200 pounds a year to the child, and
+ ordering that, in the event of his dying before he comes of age, or of
+ refusing to accept the provisions of the will, or handing any of the
+ property or money over to my daughter, the whole estate, money, jewels,
+ and all, shall go to the London hospitals, subject, as before, to the
+ annuity.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Don't be an ass, brother John. Do you think that I don't know what I am
+ doing? I have seen enough of the evils of marrying for money out in India.
+ Every ship that comes out brings so many girls sent out to some relation
+ to be put on the marriage market, and marrying men old enough to be pretty
+ nearly their grandfathers, with the natural consequence that there is the
+ devil to pay before they have been married a year or two. Come, you know
+ you will do it; why not give in at once, and have done with it? It is not
+ a bad thing for you, it will be a good thing for your boy, it will save my
+ girl from fortune hunters, and enable me to die quietly and comfortably.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, George, I will do it. Mind, I don't do it willingly, but I do
+ it for your sake.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is right,&rdquo; Colonel Thorndyke said, holding out his thin bronzed hand
+ to his brother; &ldquo;that is off my mind. Now, there is only one other thing&mdash;those
+ confounded jewels. But I won't talk about them now.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was not indeed till three or four days later that the Colonel again
+ spoke to his brother on any than ordinary matters. He had indeed been very
+ weak and ailing. After breakfast, when, as usual, he was a little stronger
+ and brighter than later in the day, he said to his brother suddenly:&mdash;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I suppose there are no hiding places in this room?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Hiding places! What do you mean, George?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Places where a fellow could hide up and hear what we are talking about.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I don't think so,&rdquo; the Squire replied, looking round vaguely. &ldquo;Such
+ an idea never occurred to me. Why do you ask?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Because, John, if there is such a thing as a hiding place, someone will
+ be sure to be hiding there. Where does that door lead to?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It doesn't lead anywhere; it used to lead into the next room, but it was
+ closed up before my time, and turned into a cupboard, and this door is
+ permanently closed.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you mind stepping round into the next room and seeing if anyone is in
+ the cupboard?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Thinking that his brother was a little light headed, John Thorndyke went
+ into the next room, and returned, saying gravely that no one was there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Will you look behind the curtains, John, and under this sofa, and
+ everywhere else where even a cat could be hidden? That seems all right,&rdquo;
+ the Colonel went on, as his brother continued the search. &ldquo;You know there
+ is a saying that walls have ears, and I am not sure that it is not so. I
+ have been haunted with the feeling that everything I did was watched, and
+ that everything I said was listened to for years; and I can tell you it is
+ a devilishly unpleasant thought. Draw your chair quite close to me. It is
+ about my jewels, John. I always had a fancy for jewels&mdash;not to wear
+ them, but to own them. In my time I have had good opportunities in that
+ way, both in the Madras Presidency and in the Carnatic. In the first
+ place, I have never cared for taking presents in money, but I have never
+ refused jewels; and what with Rajahs and Nabobs and Ministers that one had
+ helped or done a good turn to somehow, a good deal came to me that way.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I always made a point of carrying money with me, and after a defeat
+ of the enemy or a successful siege, there was always lots of loot, and the
+ soldiers were glad enough to sell anything in the way of jewels for a
+ tithe of their value in gold. I should say if I put the value of the
+ jewels at 50,000 pounds I am not much wide of the mark. That is all right,
+ there is no bother about them; the trouble came from a diamond bracelet
+ that I got from a soldier. We were in camp near Tanjore. I was officer of
+ the day. I had made my rounds, and was coming back to my quarters, when I
+ saw a soldier coming out of a tent thirty or forty yards away. It was a
+ moonlight night, and the tent was one belonging to a white Madras
+ regiment. Suddenly, I saw another figure, that had been lying down outside
+ the tent, rise. I saw the flash of the moonlight on steel; then there was
+ a blow, and the soldier fell. I drew my sword and rushed forward.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The native&mdash;for I could see that it was a native&mdash;was bending
+ over the man he had stabbed. His back was towards me, and on the sandy
+ soil he did not hear my footsteps until I was close to him; then he sprang
+ up with a cry of fury, and leaped on me like a tiger. I was so taken by
+ surprise that before I could use my sword the fellow had given me a nasty
+ stab on the shoulder; but before he could strike again I had run him
+ through. By this time several other, men ran out of the tent, uttering
+ exclamations of rage at seeing their fallen comrade.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'What is it, sir?' they asked me.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'This scoundrel, here, has stabbed your comrade,' I said. 'He did not see
+ me coming, and I ran up just as he was, I think, rifling him for booty. He
+ came at me like a wild cat, and has given me a nasty stab. However, I have
+ put an end to his game. Is your comrade dead?'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'No, sir, he is breathing still; but I fancy there is little chance for
+ him.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'You had better carry him to the hospital tent at once; I will send a
+ surgeon there.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I called the regimental surgeon up, and went with him to the hospital
+ tent, telling him what had happened. He shook his head after examining the
+ man's wound, which was fairly between the shoulders.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'He may live a few hours, but there is no chance of his getting better.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'Now,' I said, 'you may as well have a look at my wound, for the villain
+ stabbed me too.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'You have had a pretty narrow escape of it,' he said, as he examined it.
+ 'If he had struck an inch or two nearer the shoulder the knife would have
+ gone right into you; but you see I expect he was springing as he struck,
+ and the blow fell nearly perpendicularly, and it glanced down over your
+ ribs, and made a gash six inches long. There is no danger. I will bandage
+ it now, and tomorrow morning I will sew the edges together, and make a
+ proper job of it.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;In the morning one of the hospital attendants came to me and said the
+ soldier who had been wounded wanted to speak to me. The doctor said he
+ would not live long. I went across to him. He was on a bed some little
+ distance from any of the others, for it was the healthy season, and there
+ were only three or four others in the tent.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'I hear, Major Thorndyke,' he said in a low voice, 'that you killed that
+ fellow who gave me this wound, and that you yourself were stabbed.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'Mine is not a serious business, my man,' I said. 'I wish you had got off
+ as easily.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'I have been expecting it, sir,' he said; 'and how I came to be fool
+ enough to go outside the tent by myself I cannot think. I was uneasy, and
+ could not sleep; I felt hot and feverish, and came out for a breath of
+ fresh air. I will tell you what caused it, sir. About two years ago a
+ cousin of mine, in one of the King's regiments, who was dying, they said,
+ of fever (but I know the doctors thought he had been poisoned), said to
+ me, &ldquo;Here are some things that will make your fortune if ever you get to
+ England; but I tell you beforehand, they are dangerous things to keep
+ about you. I fancy that they have something to do with my being like this
+ now. A year ago I went with some others into one of their great temples on
+ a feast day. Well, the god had got on all his trinkets, and among them was
+ a bracelet with the biggest diamonds I ever saw. I did not think so much
+ of it at the time, but I kept on thinking of them afterwards, and it
+ happened that some months after our visit we took the place by storm. I
+ made straight for the temple, and I got the jewels. It don't matter how I
+ got them&mdash;I got them. Well, since that I have never had any peace;
+ pretty near every night one or other of our tents was turned topsy turvy,
+ all the kits turned out, and even the ground dug up with knives. You know
+ how silently Indian thieves can work. However, nothing was ever stolen,
+ and as for the diamonds, at the end of every day's march I always went out
+ as soon as it was quite dark, and buried the bracelet between the tent
+ pegs; it did not take a minute to do. When we moved, of course, I took it
+ up again. At last I gave that up, for however early I turned out in the
+ morning there was sure to be a native about. I took then to dropping it
+ down the barrel of my gun; that way I beat them. Still, I have always
+ somehow felt myself watched, and my tent has been disturbed a great deal
+ oftener than any of the others. I have had half a mind to throw the things
+ away many a time, but I could not bring myself to do it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'Well, sir, I have carried the bracelet ever since. I have done as he
+ did, and always had it in my musket barrel&mdash;When we had fighting to
+ do I would drop it out into my hand and slip it into my ammunition pouch;
+ but I know that I have always been followed, just as Bill was. I suppose
+ they found out that I went to see him before he died. Anyhow, my tent has
+ been rummaged again and again. I have no doubt that fellow whom you killed
+ last night had been watching me all the time, and thought that I had come
+ out to hide the things. However, there they are, sir. One of my mates
+ brought my musket here a quarter of an hour ago, and emptied the barrel
+ out for me. Now, sir, you did your best to save my life last night, and
+ you killed that fellow who did for me, and you pretty nearly got killed
+ yourself. I have got no one else I could give the things to, and if I were
+ to give them to one of my mates in the regiment they would probably cost
+ him his life, as they have cost me mine. But you will know what to do with
+ the things; they are worth a lot of money if you can get them home. Mind,
+ sir, you have got to be careful. I have heard tales of how those priests
+ will follow up a temple jewel that has been lost for years, and never give
+ it up until they get it back again.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'I ought to give it up,' I said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'You don't know where it came from, sir,' he replied. 'I was one of a
+ party of convalescents who were sent up just before that fight, and my own
+ regiment was not there: it might have been here, and it might have been in
+ the Carnatic. Bill never told me, and I have no more idea than a babe
+ unborn.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The gems were certainly magnificent; and though I knew well enough that
+ these untiring Brahmins would not be long in guessing that the things had
+ come into my possession, I took the bracelet. I thought, anyhow, that I
+ might have a few hours' start; the fellow I had killed might, of course,
+ have one or two others with him, but I had to risk that. I got leave an
+ hour later, and went down to Madras, and got them put into a place of
+ safety. That I was watched all the time I was in India afterwards I have
+ no doubt, but no attempts were made to assassinate me. They would have
+ known that I went straight away, but whether I had buried them somewhere
+ on the road, or had given them to someone's care at Madras they could not
+ know, and there was, therefore, nothing for them to do but to wait till I
+ made a move.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have no doubt whatever that they came over in the same ship with me.
+ Two or three times during the week I was in London I saw colored men in
+ the street outside the hotel. Once it was a Lascar seaman, another time a
+ dark looking sailor in European clothes: he might pass for a Spaniard.
+ Several times as I was going about in a sedan chair I looked out suddenly,
+ and each time there was a dark face somewhere in the street behind. I had
+ a letter this morning from the lawyer, and he mentioned that two days ago
+ his offices had been broken into, and every strong box and drawer forced
+ open, but that, curiously enough, they could not find that anything had
+ been stolen, though in the cashier's box there were 30 pounds in gold. Of
+ course it was my friends. I have no doubt that one or two of them have
+ followed me down here; and for anything I know they may be lurking
+ somewhere in your garden at the present moment&mdash;that is, if they are
+ not standing beside us in this room.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke looked round with an uncomfortable feeling.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How do you mean, George?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I mean some of those Indian fellows can do all sorts of wonderful
+ conjuring tricks. I have seen them go up into the air on a rope and never
+ come down again, and for aught I know they may be able to render
+ themselves invisible. Seriously, I think that it is likely as not.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, and where are the things to be found now, George?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That I won't tell you, John. Before I go I will whisper it in your ear,
+ and give you the means of finding them, but not till then. No, I will
+ write it down on a piece of paper, and slip it into your hand. As soon as
+ you get out of the room you glance at it, and then put the piece of paper
+ into your mouth, chew it up and swallow it. I tell you I dare not even
+ whisper it; but whatever you do, take no steps in the matter until your
+ son comes of age.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There can surely be no danger in another twelve years, George; they will
+ have given up the search long before that.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not they,&rdquo; the Colonel said emphatically. &ldquo;If they die others will take
+ their places: it is a sacred business with them. My advice to you is,
+ either sell them directly you get them into your hands, or go straight to
+ Amsterdam and sell them there to one of the diamond cutters, who will turn
+ them out so that they will be altered beyond all recognition. Don't sell
+ more than two stones at most to any one man; then they will never come out
+ as a bracelet again, and the hunt will be over.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I would almost rather leave them alone altogether, George.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, they are worth 50,000 pounds if they are worth a penny, and a great
+ deal more I should say; but you cannot leave them alone without leaving
+ everything alone, for all my gems are with them, and 52,000 pounds in
+ gold. Of course, if you like you can, when you get the box, pick those
+ diamonds out and chuck them away, but if you do you must do it openly, so
+ that anyone watching you may see you do it, otherwise the search will go
+ on.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Two days later, as Ramoo was helping the Colonel to the sofa, the latter
+ was seized with a violent fit of coughing, then a rush of blood poured
+ from his lips. His brother and Ramoo laid him on the sofa almost
+ insensible.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Run and get some water, Ramoo,&rdquo; John Thorndyke said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As Ramoo left the room the Colonel feebly placed his snuffbox in his
+ brother's hand with a significant glance; then he made several desperate
+ efforts to speak, and tried to struggle up into a sitting position;
+ another gush of blood poured from him, and as it ceased he fell back dead.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke was bitterly grieved at the death of his brother, and it
+ was not until he went up to his room that night that he thought of the
+ snuffbox that he had dropped into his pocket as his brother handed it to
+ him. He had no doubt that it contained the instructions as to the
+ treasure. It was of Indian manufacture. He emptied the snuff from it, but
+ it contained nothing else. He was convinced that the secret must be hidden
+ there, and after in vain endeavoring to find a spring, he took a poker and
+ hammered it, and as it bent a spring gave way, and showed a very shallow
+ false bottom.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In this was a thin gold coin, evidently of considerable antiquity, and a
+ small piece of paper, on which was written the word &ldquo;Masulipatam.&rdquo; John
+ Thorndyke looked at it in bewilderment; that it was connected with the
+ secret he felt certain, but alone it was absolutely useless. Doubtless his
+ brother had intended to give him the key of the riddle, when he had so
+ desperately striven to speak. After in vain thinking the matter over he
+ said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, thank goodness; there is nothing to be done about the matter for
+ another thirteen or fourteen years; it is of no use worrying about it
+ now.&rdquo; He went to an old fashioned cabinet, and placed the coin and piece
+ of paper in a very cunningly devised secret drawer. The next morning he
+ went out into the garden and dropped the battered snuffbox into the well,
+ and then dismissed the subject from his mind.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0002" id="link2HCH0002">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER II
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ Standing some two miles out of Reigate is the village of Crowswood, a
+ quiet place and fairly well to do, thanks in no small degree to Squire
+ Thorndyke, who owned the whole of the parish, and by whom and his tenants
+ the greater portion of the village were employed. Greatly had the closing
+ of the Manor House, after the death of old Squire Thorndyke, been felt.
+ There were no more jellies, soups, and other comforts to be looked for in
+ time of sickness, no abatement of rent when the breadwinner was sick or
+ disabled, no check to the drunkards, whom the knowledge that they would be
+ turned out of their cottage at a week's notice kept in some sort of order.
+ When, therefore, after ten years of absence of all government, John
+ Thorndyke, after the death of his brother, the Colonel, came down and took
+ possession, he found the place sadly changed from what it had been when he
+ had left it twenty years before. His first act was to dismiss Newman; who,
+ completely unchecked, had, he found, been sadly mismanaging affairs. It
+ was not long, however, before his hand made itself felt. Two out of the
+ three public houses were shut up in six months, a score of their habitual
+ frequenters had, weeks before, been turned out of their houses, an order
+ had been issued that unless a cottage was kept in good order and the
+ garden bright and blooming with flowers in the summer a fresh tenant would
+ be found for it. Every child must be sent to the village school; the
+ Squire was ready to do what there was to be done in the way of thatching
+ and whitewashing, repairing palings and painting doors and windows, but,
+ as he told the people, the village had to be kept clean and decent, and
+ anyone who would not conform to the rules was at liberty to leave without
+ a day's notice.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Many of the villagers grumbled under their breath, but public opinion was,
+ on the whole, favorable. There was someone to look after them now, someone
+ who would see that the greater portion of the wages was not spent at the
+ alehouse, who would take an interest in the people, and would lend a
+ helping hand in bad times. There was a feeling of regret that the Squire
+ was a widower, but the post of visitor and almoner was well supplied by
+ the lady who acted as companion and governess to the Squire's little ward
+ and regulated the affairs of his household.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke had never had much occasion for the display of energy
+ before, but he had an abundance of it, although hitherto latent. He had
+ come into this business against his will, but he took it up with a
+ determination to do well in it. The income was legally his until his niece
+ came of age, but he was determined he would take nothing out of the estate
+ beyond the necessary expenses of the position, and that all surplus should
+ be expended in improving it in every way possible, so that he could hand
+ it over to her in the most perfect condition. Therefore, when he came into
+ possession he made a close inspection of the farms, with their houses,
+ barns, and other tenements. Where he saw that the men were doing their
+ best, that the hedges and fields were in good order, he did everything
+ that was necessary without a word; but where there were slovenly farming
+ and signs of neglect and carelessness, he spoke out his mind sharply.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;This has all got to be amended,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;What must be done I will do,
+ but unless I see things well kept up, the fences in good order, the hedges
+ cut, the cattle in good condition, and everything going on as it ought to
+ be, out you go next Christmas. The estate at present is a disgrace to the
+ county, but it shall not be so any longer if I can help it. I shall do my
+ share, and anyone who is not prepared to do the same had better look out
+ for another holding at once.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ No one rejoiced more at the coming home of the Squire than Mr. Bastow, the
+ Rector. He had had a pleasant time of it during the life of the old
+ Squire. He was always a welcome guest at the house; Mr. Thorndyke had been
+ ever ready to put his hand into his pocket for any repairs needed for the
+ church, and bore on his shoulders almost the entire expense of the village
+ school. In the latter respect there had been no falling off, he having
+ given explicit instructions to his solicitors to pay his usual annual
+ subscriptions to the school until his son's return from India. But with
+ the death of the Squire the Rector had gradually lost all authority in the
+ village.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For a time force of habit had had its effect, but as this wore out and the
+ people recognized that he had no real authority things went from bad to
+ worse. Drunken men would shout jeeringly as they passed the Rectory on
+ their way home from the alehouse; women no longer feared reproof for the
+ untidiness of their houses and children; the school was half emptied and
+ the church almost wholly so.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For seven or eight years Mr. Bastow had a hard time of it. It was, then,
+ both with pleasure as an old friend, and with renewed hopefulness for the
+ village, that he visited John Thorndyke on his return. The change in the
+ state of affairs was almost instantaneous. As soon as it became known that
+ the Rector was backed, heart and soul, by the Squire's authority, and that
+ a complaint from him was followed the next day by a notice to quit at the
+ end of a week, his own authority was established as firmly as it had been
+ in the old Squire's time, and in a couple of years Crowswood became quite
+ a model village. Every garden blossomed with flowers; roses and eglantine
+ clustered over the cottages, neatness and order prevailed everywhere.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The children were tidily dressed and respectful in manner, the women
+ bright and cheerful, and the solitary alehouse remaining had but few
+ customers, and those few were never allowed to transgress the bounds of
+ moderation. The Squire had a talk with the landlord a fortnight after his
+ arrival.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am not going to turn you out, Peters,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I hear that you make
+ some efforts to keep your house decently; the other two I shall send
+ packing directly their terms are up. Whether you remain permanently must
+ depend upon yourself. I will do up your house for you, and build a bar
+ parlor alongside, where quiet men can sit and smoke their pipes and talk
+ and take their beer in comfort, and have liberty to enjoy themselves as
+ long as their enjoyment does not cause annoyance to other people or keep
+ their wives and children in rags. I will do anything for you if I find the
+ place well conducted; but I warn you that I will have no drunkenness. A
+ man who, to my knowledge, gets drunk twice, will not get drunk a third
+ time in this parish, and if you let men get drunk here it is your fault as
+ much as theirs. Now we understand each other.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Things once placed on a satisfactory footing, the Squire had but little
+ more trouble, and it soon came to be understood that he was not to be
+ trifled with, and that Crowswood was no longer a place for the idle or
+ shiftless. Two or three of the farmers left at the termination of their
+ year, but better men took their places, and John Thorndyke, having settled
+ matters to his satisfaction, now began to attend more to other affairs. He
+ had been, when he first came back, welcomed with great heartiness by all
+ the gentry of the neighborhood; his father had been a popular man, and
+ young Thorndyke had been regarded as a pleasant young fellow, and would in
+ any case have been welcomed, if only because Crowswood had become a
+ nuisance to the whole district. It was, indeed, a sort of rendezvous for
+ poachers and bad characters, it was more than suspected that gangs of
+ thieves and burglars made it their headquarters, and that even highwaymen
+ found it a convenient and quiet resort.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Thus, then, the transformation effected within a few months of Mr.
+ Thorndyke's return caused general and lively satisfaction, and a year
+ later he was put on the Commission of the Peace, and became one of the
+ most regular attendants at the Bench of Magistrates. Reluctantly as he had
+ taken up his present position, he found it, as time went on, a pleasant
+ one. He had not been conscious before that time hung somewhat heavily on
+ his hands, but here he had duties to perform and ample employment. His
+ nature was naturally somewhat a masterful one, and both as a magistrate
+ and a landlord he had scope and power of action. Occasionally he went up
+ to London, always driving his gig, with a pair of fast trotting horses,
+ and was known to the frequenters of the coffee houses chiefly patronized
+ by country gentlemen. Altogether, John Thorndyke became quite a notable
+ person in the district, and men were inclined to congratulate themselves
+ upon the fact that he, and not the Indian officer, his brother, had come
+ into the estate.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The idea of an old Indian officer in those days was that he was almost of
+ necessity an invalid, and an irritable one, with a liver hopelessly
+ deranged, a yellow complexion, and a hatred of the English climate. The
+ fact that, instead of leaving the army and coming home at his father's
+ death, George Thorndyke had chosen to remain abroad and leave the estate
+ to the management of agents, had specially prejudiced him in the eyes of
+ the people of that part, and had heightened the warmth with which they had
+ received his brother. John Thorndyke had upon the occasion, of his first
+ visit to the family solicitors spoken his mind with much freedom as to the
+ manner in which Newman had been allowed a free hand.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Another ten years,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;and there would not have been a cottage
+ habitable on the estate, nor a farm worth cultivating. He did absolutely
+ nothing beyond collecting the rents. He let the whole place go to rack and
+ ruin. The first day I arrived I sent him out of the house, with a talking
+ to that he won't forget as long as he lives.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We never heard any complaints about him, Mr. Thorndyke, except that I
+ think we did once hear from the Rector of the place that his conduct was
+ not satisfactory. I remember that we wrote to him about it, and he said
+ that the Rector was a malignant fellow, on bad terms with all his
+ parishioners.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If I had the scoundrel here,&rdquo; John Thorndyke said with indignation, &ldquo;I
+ would let him have a taste of the lash of my dog whip. You should not have
+ taken the fellow's word; you should have sent down someone to find out the
+ true state of things. Why, the place has been an eyesore to the whole
+ neighborhood, the resort of poaching, thieving rascals; by gad, if my
+ brother George had gone down there I don't know what would have happened!
+ It will cost a couple of years' rent to get things put straight.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When the Squire was at home there was scarce an evening when the Rector
+ did not come up to smoke a pipe and take his glass of old Jamaica or
+ Hollands with him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Look here, Bastow,&rdquo; the latter said, some three years after his return,
+ &ldquo;what are you going to do with that boy of yours? I hear bad reports of
+ him from everyone; he gets into broils at the alehouse, and I hear that he
+ consorts with a bad lot of fellows down at Reigate. One of my tenants&mdash;I
+ won't mention names&mdash;complained to me that he had persecuted his
+ daughter with his attentions. They say, he was recognized among that
+ poaching gang that had an affray with Sir James Hartrop's keepers. The
+ thing is becoming a gross scandal.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know what to do about him, Squire; the boy has always been a
+ trouble to me. You see, before you came home, he got into bad hands in the
+ village here. Of course they have all gone, but several of them only moved
+ as far as Reigate, and he kept up their acquaintance. I thrashed him again
+ and again, but he has got beyond that now, you see; he is nearly eighteen,
+ and openly scoffs at my authority. Upon my word, I don't know what to do
+ in the matter.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is growing up a thorough young ruffian,&rdquo; the Squire said indignantly,
+ &ldquo;and one of these mornings I expect to see him brought up before us
+ charged with some serious offense. We had to fine him last week for being
+ drunk and making a disturbance down at Reigate. Why do you let him have
+ money? You may have no authority over him; but at least you should refuse
+ to open your purse to him. Don't you see that this sort of thing is not
+ only a disgrace to him, but very prejudicial to the village? What
+ authority can you have for speaking against vice and drunkenness, when
+ your son is constantly intoxicated?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I see that, Squire&mdash;none better; and I have thought of resigning my
+ cure.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Stuff and nonsense, Parson! If the young fellow persists in his present
+ course he must leave the village, that is clear enough; but that is no
+ reason why you should. The question is what is to be done with him? The
+ best thing he could do would be to enlist. He might be of some service to
+ his country, in India or the American Colonies, but so far as I can see he
+ is only qualifying himself for a jail here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have told him as much, Squire,&rdquo; Mr. Bastow said, in a depressed voice,
+ &ldquo;and he has simply laughed in my face, and said that he was very
+ comfortable where he was, and had no idea whatever of moving.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What time does he go out in the morning?&rdquo; John Thorndyke asked abruptly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He never gets up till twelve o'clock, and has his breakfast when I take
+ my dinner.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I will come in tomorrow morning and have a talk with him myself.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next day the Squire rode up to the door of the Rectory soon after one
+ o'clock. Mr. Bastow had just finished his meal; his son, a young fellow of
+ between seventeen and eighteen, was lolling in an easy chair.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have come in principally to speak to you, young sir,&rdquo; John Thorndyke
+ said quietly. &ldquo;I have been asking your father what you intend to do with
+ yourself. He says he does not know.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The young fellow looked up with an air of insolent effrontery.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know that it is any business of yours, Mr. Thorndyke, what I do
+ with myself.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, yes, it is,&rdquo; the Squire replied. &ldquo;This village and the people in it
+ are mine. You are disturbing the village with your blackguard conduct; you
+ are annoying some of the girls on the estate, and altogether you are
+ making yourself a nuisance. I stopped at the alehouse as I came here, and
+ have ordered the landlord to draw no more liquor for you, and unless you
+ amend your conduct, and that quickly, I will have you out of the village
+ altogether.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I fancy, Mr. Thorndyke, that, even as a justice of the peace, you have
+ not the power to dictate to my father who shall be the occupant of this
+ house.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What you say is perfectly true; but as you make your father's life a
+ burden to him, and he is desirous of your absence, I can and will order
+ the village constable to remove you from his house by force, if
+ necessary.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The young fellow cast an evil glance at his father. &ldquo;He has not been
+ complaining, has he?&rdquo; he said, with a sneer.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He has not, sir,&rdquo; John Thorndyke said indignantly. &ldquo;It is I who have been
+ complaining to him, and he admits that you are altogether beyond his
+ authority. I have pointed out to him that he is in no way obliged to
+ support you at your age in idleness and dissipation, and that it were best
+ for him and all concerned that he should close his doors to you. I don't
+ want to have to send the son of my old friend to prison, but I can see
+ well enough that that is what it will come to if you don't give up your
+ evil courses. I should think you know by this time that I am a man of my
+ word. I have taken some pains to purge this village of all bad characters,
+ and I do not intend to have an exception made of the son of the clergyman,
+ who, in his family as well as in his own person, is bound to set an
+ example.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Mr. Thorndyke, I utterly decline to obey your orders or to be
+ guided by your advice.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very well, sir,&rdquo; the magistrate said sternly. &ldquo;Mr. Bastow, do I
+ understand that you desire that your son shall no longer remain an inmate
+ of your house?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I do,&rdquo; the clergyman said firmly; &ldquo;and if he does so I have no other
+ course before me but to resign my living; my position here has become
+ absolutely unbearable.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very well, sir, then you will please lock your doors tonight, and if he
+ attempts to enter, I, as a magistrate, should know how to deal with him.
+ Now, young sir, you understand your position; you may not take my advice,
+ nevertheless, I shall give it you. The best thing you can do is to take
+ your place for town on the outside of the coach that comes through Reigate
+ this afternoon, and tomorrow morning proceed either to the recruiting
+ officer for His Majesty's service, or to that for the East India
+ Company's. You have health and strength, you will get rid at once of your
+ bad associates, and will start afresh in a life in which you may redeem
+ your past and be useful to your king and country.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Young Bastow smiled.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thanks,&rdquo; he said sarcastically. &ldquo;I have my own plans, and shall follow
+ them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I would think, Mr. Bastow,&rdquo; the Squire said quietly, &ldquo;it would just be as
+ well for you to come home with me. I don't think that the leave taking is
+ likely to be an affectionate one.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Rector rose at once.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will come with you, Squire. I may tell you now, what I have not told
+ you before, that my son has more than once raised his hand against me, and
+ that I do not care to be left alone with him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I judged him capable even of that, Mr. Bastow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Goodby, Arthur,&rdquo; his father said. &ldquo;My heart is ready to break that it has
+ come to this; but for both our sakes it is better so. Goodby, my son, and
+ may Heaven lead you to better ways! If ever you come to me and say,
+ 'Father, I have turned over a new leaf, and heartily repent the trouble I
+ have caused you,' you will receive a hearty welcome from me, and no words
+ of reproach for the past.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The young man paid no attention to the offered hand, but laughed
+ scornfully.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have not got rid of me yet,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;As for you, Squire Thorndyke,
+ I shall not forget your meddlesome interference, and some day, maybe, you
+ will be sorry for it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think not,&rdquo; John Thorndyke said gravely. &ldquo;I am doing my duty to the
+ village, and still more I am doing my duty to an old friend, and I am not
+ likely ever to feel any regret that I have so acted. Now, Parson, let's be
+ off.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After leaving the house with the clergyman, the Squire stopped at the
+ house of Knapp, the village constable; and said a few words to him, then,
+ leading his horse, walked home with Mr. Bastow.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Don't be cast down, old friend,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;It is a terrible trial to you;
+ but it is one sharp wrench, and then it will be over. Anything is better
+ than what you must have been suffering for some time.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I quite feel that, Squire; my life has indeed been intolerable of late. I
+ had a painful time before, but always looked forward with hope to your
+ brother coming home. Since you returned, and matters in the parish have
+ been put straight, this trouble has come in to take the place of the
+ other, and I have felt that I would rather resign and beg for charity than
+ see my son going from bad to worse, a scandal to the parish, and a
+ hindrance to all good work.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a bad business, Bastow, and it seems to me that two or three years
+ in prison would be the best thing for him, as he will not take up the only
+ trade open to him. At any rate, it would separate him from his evil
+ associates, and give you peace while he is behind the bars. Where does he
+ get his money?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That I know not, Squire. He takes some from me&mdash;it used to be done
+ secretly, now it is done with threats, and, as I told you, with violence&mdash;but
+ that would not account for his always having money. He must get it
+ somewhere else, for when I have paid my bills, as I always do the hour
+ that I receive money, there is but little over for him to take. He is
+ often away all night, sometimes for two or three days together, and I dare
+ not think what he does with himself; but certainly he gets money somehow,
+ and I am afraid that I cannot hope it is honestly obtained.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I do not well see how it can be,&rdquo; the Squire agreed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If I had before known as much as you tell me now, I would have taken some
+ steps to have him watched, and to nip the matter before it went too far.
+ Do you think that he will take your notice, and come no more to the
+ house?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mr. Bastow shook his head.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I fear that the only effect will be to make him worse, even when he was
+ quite a small boy punishment only had that effect with him. He will come
+ back tonight probably half drunk, and certainly furious at my having
+ ventured to lay the case before you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You must lock the doors and bar the windows.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I did that when he first took to being out at night, but he always
+ managed to get in somehow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, it must be all put a stop to, Bastow; and I will come back with you
+ this evening, and if this young rascal breaks into the house I will have
+ him down at Reigate tomorrow on the charge of house breaking; or, at any
+ rate, I will threaten to do so if he does not give a promise that he will
+ in future keep away from you altogether.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall be glad, at any rate, if you will come down, Squire, for, to say
+ the truth, I feel uneasy as to the steps he may take in his fury at our
+ conversation just now.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke took down from a wall a heavy hunting whip, as he went out
+ with the parson at nine o'clock. He had in vain endeavored to cheer his
+ old friend as they sat over their steaming glasses of Jamaica. The parson
+ had never been a strong man; he was of a kindly disposition, and an
+ unwearied worker when there was an opportunity for work, but he had always
+ shrunk from unpleasantness, and was ready to yield rather than bring about
+ trouble. He had for a long time suffered in silence, and had not the
+ Squire himself approached the subject of his son's delinquencies, he would
+ have never opened his mouth about it. Now, however, that he had done so,
+ and the Squire had taken the matter in hand, and had laid down what was to
+ be done, though he trembled at the prospect, he did not even think of
+ opposing his plan, and indeed could think of no alternative for it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have told John Knapp to be here,&rdquo; the Squire said, as they reached the
+ house. &ldquo;It is just as well that he should be present if your son comes
+ back again. He is a quiet, trustworthy fellow, and will keep his mouth
+ shut if I tell him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mr. Bastow made no reply. It was terrible to him that there should be
+ another witness to his son's conduct, but he saw that the Squire was
+ right. An old woman opened the door.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Are all the shutters closed and barred?&rdquo; John Thorndyke asked her.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, sir; I always sees to that as soon as it gets dark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very well; you can go to bed now, Elisa,&rdquo; her master said. &ldquo;Is John Knapp
+ here?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, he came an hour ago, and is sitting in the kitchen.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will call him in myself when I want to speak to him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as the old servant had gone upstairs the Squire went into the
+ kitchen, Mr. Bastow having gone to the cellar to fetch up a bottle of old
+ brandy that was part of a two dozen case given to him by the old Squire
+ fifteen years before.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you go round the house, John, and see that everything is properly
+ fastened up. I see that you have got a jug of beer there. You had better
+ get a couple of hours' sleep on that settle. I shall keep watch, till I am
+ sleepy, and then I will call you. Let me know if you find any of the doors
+ or windows unbarred.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Five minutes later the constable knocked at the door of the parlor. &ldquo;The
+ door opening into the stable yard was unbarred, Squire.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I thought it likely that it would be so, Knapp. You have made it fast
+ now, I suppose? That is right. Now lie down and get an hour or two of
+ sleep; it is scarce likely that he will be back until late.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That was the old woman, of course,&rdquo; he went on to his companion, when the
+ door closed behind the constable. &ldquo;I thought it likely enough that he
+ might tell her to leave a way for him to come in. You told me that she had
+ been with you a good many years. I dare say she has left that door
+ unbarred for him many a time. I should advise you to get a man to sleep in
+ the house regularly; there are plenty of fellows who will be glad to do it
+ for a shilling or two a week, and I do not think that it is safe for you
+ to be here alone.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ An hour later he said to the Rector: &ldquo;Now, Bastow, you had best go to bed.
+ I have taken the matter into my own hands, and will carry it through.
+ However, I won't have him taken away without your being present, and will
+ call you when we want you. Of course, if he will give a solemn promise not
+ to molest you, and, even if he won't enlist, to leave this part of the
+ country altogether, I shall let him off.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is one thing, Mr. Thorndyke, that I have not told you,&rdquo; the Rector
+ said hesitatingly. &ldquo;Sometimes, when he comes home late, he brings someone
+ with him; I have heard voices downstairs. I have never seen who it was&mdash;for
+ what could I have done if I went down?&mdash;but I have heard horses
+ brought round to the stable yard, and heard them ride away:&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is just as well you told me,&rdquo; the Squire said dryly. &ldquo;If you had told
+ me this evening at the house, I would have dropped a brace of pistols into
+ my pocket. However, this hunting crop is a good weapon; but I don't
+ suppose they will show fight, even if anyone is with him. Besides, Knapp
+ has a stout oaken cudgel with him&mdash;I noticed it standing against his
+ chair as I went in&mdash;and as he is a strong active fellow, and we shall
+ have the advantage of a surprise, I fancy we should be a match even for
+ three or four of them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At one o'clock the Squire roused John Knapp. &ldquo;It is one o'clock, John; now
+ take off your boots. I don't want him to know that there is anyone in the
+ house till we get hold of him. I am going to lie down on the sofa in the
+ parlor. The moment you hear footsteps you come and wake me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The clock in the kitchen had just struck two when the constable shook John
+ Thorndyke. &ldquo;There are two horses just coming into the yard.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right. I opened a window in the room looking down into the yard
+ before I lay down. I will go up and see what they are going to do. If they
+ try to break in anywhere down here, do you come at once quietly up to me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Squire had taken off his boots before he lay down, and, holding his
+ heavy hunting crop in his hand, he went quietly upstairs. As he went to
+ the window he heard Arthur Bastow say angrily:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Confound the old woman! she has locked the door; she has never played me
+ that trick before. There is a ladder in the stable, and I will get in at
+ that window up there and open it for you. Or you may as well come up that
+ way, too, and then you can stow the things away in my room at once, and
+ have done with it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Squire went hastily down.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Come upstairs, Knapp,&rdquo; he whispered to the constable. &ldquo;There are three of
+ them, and I fancy the two mounted men are highwaymen. Let them all get in,
+ keeping yourself well back from the window. The moon is round on the other
+ side of the house, but it will be light enough for us to see them as they
+ get in. I will take the last fellow, and I will warrant that he will give
+ no trouble; then I will fall upon the second, and do you spring on young
+ Bastow. The two highwaymen are sure to have pistols, and he may have some
+ also. Give him a clip with that cudgel of yours first, then spring on him,
+ and hold his arms tightly by his side. If I call you give him a back heel
+ and throw him smartly, and then come to my aid. I don't think I shall want
+ it, but it is as well to prepare for everything.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They went upstairs and took their places, one on each side of the window,
+ standing three or four feet back. Just as they took up their positions the
+ top of the stable ladder appeared above the sill of the window. Half a
+ minute later young Bastow's head appeared, and he threw up the sash still
+ higher, and stepped into the room; then he turned and helped two men in,
+ one after the other.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Follow me,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;then you won't tumble over the furniture.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As they turned, the heavy handle of John's Thorndyke's whip fell with
+ tremendous force on the head of the last man.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What the devil is that?&rdquo; the other exclaimed, snatching out a pistol and
+ turning round, as the falling body struck him, but he got no further.
+ Again the heavy whip descended, this time on his right arm; it dropped
+ useless by his side, and the pistol fell from his hand. Then John
+ Thorndyke fell upon him and bore him to the ground, snatched the other
+ pistol from his belt, and held it to his head.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, my man,&rdquo; he said quietly, &ldquo;if you don't surrender I will blow out
+ your brains.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I surrender,&rdquo; the man moaned. &ldquo;I believe that you have broken my arm.
+ Curse you, whoever you are.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The struggle between John Knapp and young Bastow was soon over. The young
+ fellow was lithe and sinewy, but he was no match for the constable, who,
+ indeed, had almost overpowered him before he was aware what had happened.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Has he got pistols, Knapp?&rdquo; the Squire asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, sir, a brace of them; I have got them both safely in my pocket.
+ There,&rdquo; he went on, as a sharp click was heard, &ldquo;I have got the darbys on
+ him. Now shall I help you, sir?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You had better run downstairs first and light a couple of candles at the
+ kitchen fire: you will find a pair standing on the parlor table. Don't be
+ long about it; the first fellow I hit was stunned, and he may come round
+ any moment.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will make sure of him before I go, Squire. I have got another pair of
+ darbys in my pocket.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as he had fastened these upon the wrists of the insensible man he
+ ran downstairs, and in a minute returned with the candles.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am glad that you are back,&rdquo; the Squire said. &ldquo;I was afraid that young
+ rascal would try to escape.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I took good care of that, Squire; you see I put one of his arms round the
+ bedpost before I slipped the darbys on, and he cannot get away unless he
+ takes the whole bed with him; and as I don't think he would get it out
+ either by the window or the door, he is as safe here as he would be in
+ Newgate. What is the next thing to do, Squire?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You had better tie this fellow's legs. I will leave you a candle here,
+ and you can keep guard over them while I go and wake Mr. Bastow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Rector needed no waking; he was walking up and down his room in great
+ distress. He had not undressed, but had thrown himself upon his bed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What has happened, Thorndyke?&rdquo; he asked as the Squire entered. &ldquo;I heard
+ two heavy falls, and I felt that something terrible had taken place.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, it has been a serious matter&mdash;very serious. That unfortunate
+ son of yours is not hurt, but I don't know but that the best thing that
+ could have happened would have been for him to have got a bullet through
+ his head. He brought home with him two men who are, I have little doubt,
+ highwaymen; anyhow, they each had a brace of pistols in their belt, and
+ from what he said I think they have been stopping a coach. At any rate,
+ they have something with them that they were going to hide here, and I
+ fancy it is not the first time that it has been done. I don't expect your
+ son had anything to do with the robbery, though he was carrying a brace of
+ pistols, too; however, we have got them all three.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, you see, Bastow, this takes the affair altogether out of our hands.
+ I had hoped that when we caught your son in the act of breaking into your
+ house after you had ordered him from it, we should be able to frighten him
+ into enlisting, or, at any rate, into promising to disturb you no more,
+ for even if we had taken him before the bench, nothing could have been
+ done to him, for under such circumstances his re-entering the house could
+ not be looked upon as an act of burglary. As it is, the affair is
+ altogether changed. Even if I wished to do so, as a magistrate I could not
+ release those two highwaymen; they must appear as prisoners in court. I
+ shall hear down in the town tomorrow morning what coach has been stopped,
+ and I have no doubt that they have on them the proceeds of the robbery.
+ Your son was consorting with and aiding them, and acting as a receiver of
+ stolen goods, and as you have heard horses here before it is probable that
+ when his room is thoroughly searched we shall come upon a number of
+ articles of the same sort. I am sorry that I ever meddled in the matter;
+ but it is too late for that now. You had better come downstairs with me,
+ and we will take a turn in the garden, and try to see what had best be
+ done.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0003" id="link2HCH0003">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER III.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke opened the shutters of the parlor window, and stepped out
+ into the garden alone, for the Rector was too unnerved and shattered to go
+ out with him, but threw himself on the sofa, completely prostrated. Half
+ an hour later the Squire re-entered the room. The morning was just
+ beginning to break. Mr. Bastow raised his head and looked sadly at him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can see no way out of it, old friend. Were it not that he is in charge
+ of the constable, I should have said that your only course was to aid your
+ son to escape; but Knapp is a shrewd fellow as well as an honest one. You
+ cannot possibly get your son away without his assistance, for he is
+ handcuffed to the bed, and Knapp, in so serious a matter as this, would
+ not, I am sure, lend himself to an escape. I have no doubt that with my
+ influence with the other magistrates, and, indeed, on the circumstances of
+ the case, they will commit him on a minor charge only, as the passengers
+ of the coach will, I hope, give evidence that it was stopped by mounted
+ men alone. I think, therefore, that he would only be charged with
+ consorting with and aiding the highwaymen after the event, and of aiding
+ them to conceal stolen goods&mdash;that is, if any are found in his room.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That much stolen property has been hidden there, there is little reason
+ to doubt, but it may have been removed shortly afterwards. It was, of
+ course, very convenient for them to have some place where they could take
+ things at once, and then ride on quietly to London the next day, for, if
+ arrested; nothing would be found upon them, and it would be impossible to
+ connect them with the robbery. Later on they might come back again and get
+ them from him. Of course, if nothing is found in his room, we get rid of
+ the charge of receiving altogether, and there would be nothing but
+ harboring, aiding, and abetting&mdash;a much less serious business. Look
+ here, old friend, I will strain a point. I will go out into the garden
+ again and walk about for an hour, and while I am out, if you should take
+ advantage of my absence to creep up to your son's room and to search it
+ thoroughly, examining every board of the floor to see if it is loose, and
+ should you find anything concealed, to take it and hide it, of course I
+ cannot help it. The things, if there are any, might secretly be packed up
+ by you in a box and sent up to Bow Street, with a line inside, saying that
+ they are proceeds of robbery, and that you hope the owners will be traced
+ and their property restored to them. Not, of course, in your own hand, and
+ without a signature. There might be some little trouble in managing it,
+ but it could, no doubt, be done.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke went out into the garden without another word. The hour was
+ nearly up when Mr. Bastow came out; he looked ten years older than he had
+ done on the previous day. He wrung his friend's hand.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank God I have been up there,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I do not think they will find
+ anything.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Say nothing about it, Bastow; I don't want to know whether you found
+ anything. Now I am going to fetch two or three of the men from the
+ village, to get them to aid the constable in keeping guard, and another to
+ go up to the house at once and order a groom to saddle one of my horses
+ and bring it here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As it was now past five o'clock, and the Squire found most of the men
+ getting up, he sent one off to the house with the message, and returned
+ with two others to the Rectory. He told them briefly that two highwaymen
+ had been arrested during the night, and that as young Mr. Bastow was in
+ their company at the time, it had been necessary as a matter of form to
+ arrest him also. He went upstairs with them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have brought up two men to sit with you, Knapp, until the Reigate
+ constables come up. You can take those handcuffs off Mr. Bastow, but see
+ that he does not leave the room, and do you yourself sit in a chair
+ against the door, and place one of these men at the window. How about
+ others?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The man you hit first, Squire, did not move until a quarter of an hour
+ ago; he has been muttering to himself since, but I don't think he is
+ sensible. The other one has been quiet enough, but there is no doubt that
+ his arm is broken.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am going to ride down to Reigate at once, and will bring back a surgeon
+ with me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will repent this night's business, Thorndyke!&rdquo; Arthur Bastow said
+ threateningly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I fancy that you will repent it more than I shall, Bastow; it is likely
+ that you will have plenty of time to do so.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was not long before the groom with the horse arrived. John Thorndyke
+ rode at a gallop down to Reigate, and first called on the head constable.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Dawney,&rdquo; he said, as the man came down, partially dressed, at his
+ summons, &ldquo;has anything taken place during the night?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, Squire, the up coach was stopped a mile before it got here, and the
+ passengers robbed. It was due here at one, and did not come in till half
+ an hour later. Of course I was sent for. The guard was shot. There were
+ two of the fellows. He let fly with his blunderbuss, but he does not seem
+ to have hit either of them, and one rode up and shot him dead; then they
+ robbed all the passengers. They got six gold watches, some rings, and,
+ adding up the amounts taken from all the passengers, about a hundred and
+ fifty pounds in money.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I fancy I have got your two highwaymen safe, <i>Dawney</i>.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have, sir?&rdquo; the constable said in astonishment.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes. I happened to be at the Rectory. Mr. Bastow had had a quarrel with
+ his son, and had forbidden him the house.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The constable shook his head. &ldquo;I am afraid he is a very bad one, that
+ young chap.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am afraid he is, Dawney. However, his father was afraid that he might
+ come in during the night and make a scene, so I said I would stop with
+ him, and I took our village constable with me. At two o'clock this morning
+ the young fellow came with two mounted men, who, I have no doubt, were
+ highwaymen. We had locked up down below. Bastow took a ladder, and the
+ three got in at a bedroom window on the first floor. Knapp and I were
+ waiting for them there, and, taking them by surprise, succeeded in
+ capturing them before the highwaymen could use their pistols. The
+ constable and two men are looking after them, but as one has not got over
+ a knock I gave him on the head, and the other has a broken arm, there is
+ little fear of their making their escape. You had better go up with two of
+ your men, and take a light cart with you with some straw in the bottom,
+ and bring them all down here. I will ride round myself to Mr. Chetwynde,
+ Sir Charles Harris, and Mr. Merchison, and we will sit at twelve o'clock.
+ You can send round a constable with the usual letters to the others, but
+ those three will be quite enough for the preliminary examination.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Squire, that is good news indeed. We have had the coach held up so
+ often within five miles of this place during the past three months, that
+ we have been getting quite a bad name. And to think that young Bastow was
+ in it! I have heard some queer stories about him, and fancied before long
+ I should have to put my hand upon his shoulder; but I didn't expect this.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is not a shadow of proof that he had anything to do with the
+ robbery, Dawney, but he will have difficulty in proving that he did not
+ afterwards abet them. It is serious enough as it is, and I am terribly
+ grieved for his father's sake.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, sir; I have always heard him spoken of as a kind gentleman, and one
+ who took a lot of trouble whenever anyone was sick. Well, sir, I will be
+ off in twenty minutes. I will run round at once and send Dr. Hewett up to
+ the Rectory, and a man shall start on horseback at seven o'clock with the
+ summons to the other magistrates.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke rode round to his three fellow magistrates, who, living
+ nearest to the town, were most regular in their attendance at the
+ meetings. They all listened in surprise to his narrative, and expressed
+ great pleasure at hearing that the men who had been such a pest to the
+ neighborhood, and had caused them all personally a great deal of trouble,
+ had been captured. All had heard tales, too, to Arthur Bastow's
+ disadvantage, and expressed great commiseration for his father. They
+ agreed to meet at the court half an hour before business began, to talk
+ the matter over together.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is out of the question that we can release him on bail,&rdquo; the gentleman
+ who was chairman of the bench said. &ldquo;Quite so,&rdquo; John Thorndyke agreed. &ldquo;In
+ the first place, the matter is too serious; and in the next, he certainly
+ would not be able to find bail; and lastly, for his father's sake, it is
+ unadvisable that he should be let out. At the same time, it appears to me
+ that there is a broad distinction between his case and the others. I fear
+ that there can be no question that he had prior acquaintance with these
+ men, and that he was cognizant of the whole business; something I heard
+ him say, and which, to my regret, I shall have to repeat in court, almost
+ proves that he was so. Still, let us hope none of the stolen property will
+ be found upon him; whether they had intended to pass it over to his care
+ or not is immaterial. If they had not done so, I doubt whether he could be
+ charged with receiving stolen goods, and we might make the charge simply
+ one of aiding these two criminals, and of being so far an accessory after
+ the crime.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If we could soften it down still further I should, for his father's sake,
+ be glad; but as far as he himself is concerned, I would do nothing to
+ lighten his punishment. He is about as bad a specimen of human nature as I
+ ever came across. His father is in bodily fear of him. I saw the young
+ fellow yesterday, and urged him to enlist, in order to break himself loose
+ from the bad companionship he had fallen into. His reply was insolent and
+ defiant in the highest degree, and it was then that in his father's name I
+ forbade him the house, and as his father was present he confirmed what I
+ said, and told him that he would not have anything more to do with him.
+ This affair may do him good, and save his neck from a noose. A few years
+ at the hulks or a passage to Botany Bay will do him no harm; and, at any
+ rate, his father will have rest and peace, which he never would have if he
+ remained here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A somewhat similar conversation took place at each house. John Thorndyke
+ breakfasted at Sir Charles Harris', the last of the three upon whom he
+ called, and then mounting rode back to Reigate.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have found the plunder on them,&rdquo; the head constable said, coming out
+ of the lockup as he drew rein before it, &ldquo;and, fortunately for young
+ Bastow, nothing was found upon him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How are the two men?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The fellow you hit first is conscious now, sir, but very weak. The doctor
+ says that if he hadn't had a thick hat on, your blow would have killed him
+ to a certainty. The other man's arm is set and bandaged, and he is all
+ right otherwise. We shall be able to have them both in court at twelve
+ o'clock.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Squire rode up to his house. He was met at the door by his son, in a
+ state of great excitement.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Is it all true, father? The news has come from the village that you have
+ killed two men, and that they and Arthur Bastow have all been taken away
+ in a cart, guarded by constables.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;As usual, Mark, rumor has exaggerated matters. There are no dead men; one
+ certainly got a crack on the head that rendered him insensible for some
+ time, and another's arm is broken.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And are they highwaymen, father? They say that two horses were fastened
+ behind the cart.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is what we are going to try, Mark. Until their guilt is proved, no
+ one knows whether they are highwaymen or not.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And why is Arthur Bastow taken, father?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Simply because he was in company with the others. Now, you need not ask
+ any more questions, but if you like to get your pony saddled and ride down
+ with me to Reigate at eleven o'clock, I will get you into the courthouse,
+ and then you will hear all about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At greater length the Squire went into the matter with Mrs. Cunningham,
+ his lady housekeeper, and his ward's governess.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a bad business, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; she said, &ldquo;and must be terrible for
+ poor Mr. Bastow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, it is a bad business altogether, except that it will rid him of this
+ young rascal. If I were in his place I should be ready to suffer a good
+ deal to obtain such a riddance.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I suppose that you won't sit upon the bench today?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No; at least I shall take no part in the deliberations. I shall, of
+ course, give evidence. The affair is not likely to last very long; my
+ story will take the longest to tell. Knapp's will be confirmatory of mine,
+ and the Reigate constable will depose to finding the watches, rings, and
+ money upon them; then, of course, the case will be adjourned for the
+ attendance of the coachman and some of the passengers. I don't suppose
+ they will be able to swear to their identity, for no doubt they were
+ masked. But that is immaterial; the discovery of the stolen property upon
+ them will be sufficient to hang them. No doubt we shall have some Bow
+ Streets runners down from town tomorrow or next day, and they will most
+ likely be able to say who the fellows are.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Will Mr. Bastow have to give evidence against his son?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not before us, I think; but I imagine he will have to appear at the
+ trial.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It will be terrible for him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, terrible. I sincerely hope that they will not summon him, but I am
+ afraid that there is very little doubt about it; they are sure to want to
+ know about his son's general conduct, though possibly the testimony on
+ that point of the constable at Reigate will be sufficient. My own hope is
+ that he will get a long sentence; at any rate, one long enough to insure
+ his not coming back during his father's lifetime. If you had seen his
+ manner when we were talking to him yesterday, you would believe that he is
+ capable of anything. I have had a good many bad characters before me
+ during the year and a half that I have sat upon the bench, but I am bound
+ to say that I never saw one who was to my eyes so thoroughly evil as this
+ young fellow. I don't think,&rdquo; he added with a smile, &ldquo;that I should feel
+ quite comfortable myself if he were acquitted; it will be a long time
+ before I shall forget the expression of his face when he said to me this
+ morning, 'You will repent this night's work, Thorndyke.'&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You don't mean that you think he would do you any harm, Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I should not care to meet him in a lonely place if he was armed and
+ I was not. But you need not be nervous, Mrs. Cunningham, there is not the
+ smallest chance of his being out for years; and by that time his blood
+ will have had time to cool down, and he will have learnt, at any rate,
+ that crimes cannot be committed in this country with impunity.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is all very shocking,&rdquo; the lady said. &ldquo;What will poor Mr. Bastow do? I
+ should think that he would not like to remain as clergyman here, where
+ everyone knows about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That must be for him to decide,&rdquo; the Squire said; &ldquo;but if he wishes to
+ resign I certainly shall not press him to continue to hold the living. He
+ is a very old friend of mine. My father presented the living to him when I
+ was nine or ten years old, and I may say I saw him daily up to the time
+ when I went down into Sussex. If he resigns I should urge him to take up
+ his residence here and to act as Mark's tutor; and he might also relieve
+ you of some of Millicent's lessons. You have plenty to do in looking after
+ the management of things in general. However, that is for the future.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At eleven o'clock the Squire drove down to Reigate, taking Mark with him,
+ as it would save all trouble about putting up the horse and pony. On
+ arriving he handed Mark over to the head constable, and asked him to pass
+ him into a seat in the courthouse, before the public were let in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Reigate was in a state of unusual excitement. That the coach should have
+ been stopped and robbed was too common an event to excite much interest,
+ but that two highwaymen should have been captured, and, as was rumored, a
+ young gentleman brought in on a charge of being in connection with them,
+ caused a thrill of excitement. Quite a small crowd was assembled before
+ the courthouse, and the name of Squire Thorndyke passed from mouth to
+ mouth.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is some talk of his being mixed up with it in some way or other,&rdquo;
+ one said. &ldquo;I saw him myself ride in here, about half past five, and I
+ wondered he was about so early. Some do say as he caught the two
+ highwaymen single handed; but that don't stand to reason. Besides, what
+ could he have been doing out at such an hour as that? He is a good
+ landlord, and they say that Crowswood has been quite a different place
+ since he came to be master. He is a tight hand as a magistrate, and
+ cleared out half the village the first two or three months he was there;
+ but he spent a mint of money on the place, and the people there say that
+ they could not have a better master. Ah, here is Squire Chetwynd. He was
+ sure to be here. There is Sir Charles' gig turning the corner. I expect
+ most of them will be on the bench; they don't get such a case as this
+ every day.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It may be there will be nothing for us to hear when the court opens,&rdquo;
+ another said. &ldquo;I hear both the fellows have been shot or knocked about so
+ bad that they cannot be brought up. Of course the court cannot sit if they
+ aint before it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is not so, Master Jones. I spoke to one of the constables half an
+ hour ago&mdash;he lives next door to me&mdash;and he said that they would
+ be well enough to appear. Neither of them have been shot, though they have
+ been hurt pretty bad.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All this added to the desire of those around to get into the court, and
+ there was quite a rush when the doors were opened two minutes before
+ twelve, and it was at once crammed, the constable having some difficulty
+ in getting the doors shut, and in persuading those who could not get in
+ that there was not standing room for another person. There was a buzz of
+ talk in court until the door opened and six magistrates came in. It was
+ observed that John Thorndyke did not seat himself with the others, but
+ moved his chair a little apart from them, thus confirming the report that
+ he was in some way connected with the matter, and did not intend to take
+ any part in the decision. Then another door opened, and the three
+ prisoners were brought in. The two first were pale and evidently weak; one
+ had his head wrapped in bandages, the other had the right sleeve of his
+ coat cut off, and his arm bandaged and supported by a sling. Both made a
+ resolute effort to preserve a careless demeanor. The third, who was some
+ years younger than the others, looked round with a smile on his lips,
+ bowed to the magistrates with an air of insolent bravado when he was
+ placed in the dock, and then leaned easily in the corner, as if
+ indifferent to the whole business. A chair was placed between his comrades
+ for the use of the man whose head was bandaged. Many among those present
+ knew Arthur Bastow by sight, and his name passed from mouth to mouth; but
+ the usher called loudly for silence, and then the magistrates' clerk rose.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;William Smith and John Brown&mdash;at least, these are the names given&mdash;are
+ charged with stopping the South Coast coach last night, killing the guard,
+ and robbing the passengers; and Arthur Bastow is charged with aiding and
+ abetting the other two prisoners, and with guilty knowledge of their
+ crime.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was noticed by those who could see the prisoners' faces that, in spite
+ of Bastow's air of indifference, there was an expression of anxiety on his
+ face as the charge was read, and he undoubtedly felt relief as that
+ against himself was mentioned. The first witness was John Knapp, and the
+ constable stepped into the witness box.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What do you know of this business, Knapp?&rdquo; the chairman asked. &ldquo;Just tell
+ it your own way.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am constable of Crowswood, your honor, and yesterday Squire Thorndyke
+ said to me&mdash;&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, you must not tell it like that, Knapp; you must not repeat what
+ another person said to you. You can say that from information received you
+ did so and so.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, your honor. From information received I went to the Rev. Mr.
+ Bastow's house, at a quarter to nine last night. At nine o'clock Squire
+ Thorndyke and the Parson came in together. They sent the servant up to
+ bed, and then the Squire sent me round to examine the fastenings of the
+ doors. I found that one back door had been left unfastened, and locked and
+ bolted it. The Squire told me to lie down until one o'clock, and he would
+ watch, and Mr. Bastow went up to bed.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you know of your own knowledge why these precautions were taken?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Only from what I was told, your honor. At one o'clock the Squire woke me,
+ and he lay down in the parlor, telling me to call him if I heard any
+ movement outside. About two o'clock I heard two horses come into the
+ Parson's yard. I called Squire Thorndyke, who went upstairs to an open
+ window; presently someone came and tried the back door. I heard voices
+ outside, but could not hear what was said. The Squire came down and called
+ me upstairs. I went up and took my place at one side of the window, and
+ the Squire took his on the other. I had this cudgel in my hand, and the
+ Squire his riding whip. A ladder was put up against the window, and then
+ someone came up, lifted the sash up high and got in. There was light
+ enough for me to see it was young Mr. Bastow. Then the two other prisoners
+ came up. When the third had got into the room Mr. Bastow said, 'Follow me,
+ and then you won't tumble over the furniture.'&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How was it that they did not see you and Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo; the chairman
+ asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We were standing well back, your honor. The moon was on the other side of
+ the house. There was light enough for us to see them as they got in at the
+ window, but where we were standing it was quite dark, especially to chaps
+ who had just come in from the moonlight. As they moved, the Squire hit the
+ last of them a clout on the head with his hunting crop, and down he went,
+ as if shot. The man next to him turned, but I did not see what took place,
+ for, as the Squire had ordered me, I made a rush at Mr. Bastow and got my
+ arms round him pretty tight, so as to prevent him using his pistols, if he
+ had any. He struggled hard, but without saying a word, till I got my heel
+ behind his and threw him on his back. I came down on the top of him; then
+ I got the pistols out of his belt and threw them on the bed, slipped the
+ handcuffs onto one wrist, lifted him up a bit, and then shoved him up
+ against the bedpost, and got the handcuff onto his other wrist, so that he
+ could not shift away, having the post in between his arms.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I went to see if the Squire wanted any help, but he didn't. I first
+ handcuffed the man whose head he had broken, and tied the legs of the
+ other, and then kept guard over them till morning. When the constables
+ came up from town we searched the prisoners, and on two of them found the
+ watches, money, and rings. We found nothing on Mr. Bastow. I went with the
+ head constable to Mr. Bastow's room and searched it thoroughly, but found
+ nothing whatever there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The evidence created a great sensation in court. John Thorndyke had first
+ intended to ask Knapp not to make any mention of the fact that Arthur
+ Bastow was carrying pistols unless the question was directly put to him.
+ But the more he had thought over the matter, the more convinced was he
+ that the heavier the sentence the better it would be for the Rector; and
+ when he had heard from the latter that there was nothing left in his son's
+ room that could be brought against him, and that he could not be charged
+ with the capital crime of being a receiver, he thought it best to let
+ matters take their course.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The head constable was the next witness. He deposed to the finding of the
+ articles produced upon the two elder prisoners and the unsuccessful search
+ of the younger prisoner's room.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You did not search the house further?&rdquo; the chairman inquired.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, sir; I wanted to get the prisoners down here as fast as I could,
+ seeing that two of them were seriously hurt.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The chairman nodded.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will, of course, make a careful search of the whole house,
+ constable.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, sir; I left one of my men up there with instructions to allow no one
+ to go upstairs until I returned.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Quite right.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke was the next witness, and his evidence cleared up what had
+ hitherto been a mystery to the general body of the public, as to how he
+ and the constable happened to be in the house on watch when the highwaymen
+ arrived. The most important part of his evidence was the repetition of the
+ words young Bastow had used as he mounted the ladder, as they showed that
+ it was arranged between the prisoners that the stolen goods should be
+ hidden in the house. The Squire was only asked one or two questions.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I suppose, Mr. Thorndyke, that you had no idea whatever that the younger
+ prisoner would be accompanied by anyone else when he returned home?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not the slightest,&rdquo; the Squire replied. &ldquo;I was there simply to prevent
+ this unfortunate lad from entering the house, when perhaps he might have
+ used violence towards his father. My intention was to seize him if he did
+ so, and to give him the choice of enlisting, as I had urged him to do, or
+ of being brought before this bench for breaking into his father's house. I
+ felt that anything was better than his continuing in the evil courses on
+ which he seemed bent.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you, Mr. Thorndyke. I must compliment you in the name of my brother
+ magistrates, and I may say of the public, for the manner in which you, at
+ considerable risk to yourself, have effected the capture of the two elder
+ prisoners.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After consulting with the others the head constable was recalled.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you know anything about the character of the youngest prisoner?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, sir. We have had our eye upon him for some time. He was brought
+ before your honors a week ago charged with being drunk and disorderly in
+ this town, and was fined 5 pounds. He is constantly drinking with some of
+ the worst characters in the place, and is strongly suspected of having
+ been concerned in the fray between the poachers and Sir Charles Harris'
+ gamekeepers. Two of the latter said that they recognized him amongst the
+ poachers, but as they both declined to swear to him we did not arrest
+ him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Knapp was then recalled, and testified to Bastow's drinking habits,
+ and that the landlord of the alehouse at Crowswood had been ordered by the
+ Squire not to draw any liquor for him in future on pain of having the
+ renewal of his license refused.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Have you any more witnesses to call?&rdquo; the chairman asked the head
+ constable.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not at present, your honor. We have sent up to town, and on the next
+ occasion the coachman will be called to testify to the shooting of the
+ guard, and we hope to have some of the passengers there to identify the
+ articles stolen from them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It will be necessary that the Rev. Mr. Bastow should be here. He need not
+ be called to give evidence unless we think it to be of importance, but he
+ had better be in attendance. The prisoners are remanded until this day
+ week.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ An hour later the three prisoners, handcuffed, were driven under an escort
+ of three armed constables to Croydon Jail. When again brought up in court
+ the passengers on the coach identified the articles taken from them; the
+ coachman gave evidence of the stopping of the coach, and of the shooting
+ of the guard. The head constable testified that he had searched the
+ Rectory from top to bottom, and found nothing whatever of a suspicious
+ nature. None of the passengers were able to testify to the two elder
+ prisoners as the men who had robbed them, as these had been masked, but
+ the height and dress corresponded to those of the prisoners; and the two
+ Bow Street runners then came forward, and gave evidence that the two elder
+ prisoners were well known to them. They had long been suspected of being
+ highwaymen, and had several times been arrested when riding towards London
+ on occasions when a coach had been stopped the night before, but no stolen
+ goods had ever been found upon them, and in no case had the passengers
+ been able to swear to their identity. One was known among his associates
+ as &ldquo;Galloping Bill,&rdquo; the other as the &ldquo;Downy One.&rdquo; At the conclusion of
+ the evidence the three prisoners were formally committed for trial, the
+ magistrates having retired in consultation for some time upon the question
+ of whether the charge of receiving stolen goods ought to be made against
+ Arthur Bastow.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think, gentlemen,&rdquo; the chairman said, after a good deal had been urged
+ on both sides of the question, &ldquo;in this case we can afford to take a
+ merciful view. In the first place, no stolen goods were discovered upon
+ him or in the house. There is strong presumptive evidence of his
+ intention, but intention is not a crime, and even were the evidence
+ stronger than it is, I should be inclined to take a merciful view. There
+ can be no doubt that the young fellow is thoroughly bad, and the bravado
+ he has exhibited throughout the hearing is at once unbecoming and
+ disgraceful; but we must remember that he is not yet eighteen, and that,
+ in the second place, he is the son of a much respected clergyman, who is
+ our neighbor. The matter is serious enough for him as it stands, and he is
+ certain to have a very heavy sentence.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Mr. Thorndyke, who takes no part in our deliberations, is most anxious
+ that the prisoner's father should be spared the agony of his son being
+ placed on trial on a capital charge, though I do not think that there
+ would be the smallest chance of his being executed, for the judges would
+ be certain to take his youth into consideration. Had there been prima
+ facie evidence of concealment, we must have done our duty and sent him to
+ trial on that charge; but as there is no such evidence, I think that it
+ will be in all respects better to send him on a charge on which the
+ evidence is as clear as noonday. Moreover, I think that Mr. Thorndyke's
+ wishes should have some weight with us, seeing that it is entirely due to
+ him that the important capture of these highwaymen, who have long been a
+ scourge to this neighborhood, has been effected.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mr. Bastow had not been called as a witness. John Thorndyke had brought
+ him down to Reigate in a closed carriage, and he had waited in the
+ justices' room while the examination went on; but the magistrates agreed
+ that the evidence given was amply sufficient for them to commit upon
+ without given him the pain of appearing. John Thorndyke had taken him to
+ another room while the magistrates were consulting together, and when he
+ heard the result drove him back again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have fully made up my mind to resign my living, Thorndyke. I could not
+ stand up and preach to the villagers of their duties when I myself have
+ failed so signally in training my own son; nor visit their houses and
+ presume to lecture them on their shortcomings when my son is a convicted
+ criminal.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I quite see that, old friend,&rdquo; the Squire said. &ldquo;And I had no doubt but
+ that you would decide on this course. I will try not to persuade you to
+ change your decision, for I feel that your power of usefulness is at an
+ end as far as the village is concerned. May I ask what you propose to do?
+ I can hardly suppose that your savings have been large.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Two years ago I had some hundreds laid by, but they have dwindled away to
+ nothing; you can understand how. For a time it was given freely, then
+ reluctantly; then I declared I would give no more, but he took it all the
+ same&mdash;he knew well enough that I could never prosecute him for
+ forgery.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;As bad as that, eh?&rdquo; Thorndyke said sternly. &ldquo;Well, we won't talk further
+ of him now; what I propose is that you should take up your abode at the
+ Hall. I am not satisfied with the school where Mark has been for the last
+ two years, and I have been hesitating whether to get a private tutor for
+ him or to send him to one of the public schools. I know that that would be
+ best, but I could not bring myself to do so. I have some troubles of my
+ own that but two or three people know of, and now, that everything is
+ going on smoothly on the estate and in the village, I often feel dull, and
+ the boy's companionship does me much good; and as he knows many lads of
+ his own age in the neighborhood now, I think that he would do just as well
+ at home.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He will be taking to shooting and hunting before long, and if he is to
+ have a tutor, there is no one I should like to have better than yourself.
+ You know all the people, and we could talk comfortably together of an
+ evening when the house is quiet. Altogether, it will be an excellent
+ arrangement for me. You would have your own room, and if I have company
+ you need not join us unless you like. The house would not seem like itself
+ without you, for you have been associated with it as long as I can
+ remember. As to your going out into the world at the age of sixty, it
+ would be little short of madness. There&mdash;you need not give me an
+ answer now,&rdquo; he went on, seeing that the Rector was too broken down to
+ speak; &ldquo;but I am sure that when you think it over you will come to the
+ same conclusion as I do, that it will be the best plan possible for us
+ both.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0004" id="link2HCH0004">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER IV.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The trial of the two highwaymen and Arthur Bastow came off in due course.
+ The evidence given was similar to that offered at Reigate, the only
+ addition being that Mr. Bastow was himself put into the box. The counsel
+ for the prosecution said: &ldquo;I am sorry to have to call you, Mr. Bastow. We
+ all feel most deeply for you, and I will ask you only two or three
+ questions. Was your son frequently out at night?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He was.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Did you often hear him return?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes; I seldom went to sleep until he came back.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Had you any reason to suppose that others returned with him?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I never saw any others.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But you might have heard them without seeing them. Please tell us if you
+ ever heard voices.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I have heard men's voices,&rdquo; the clergyman said reluctantly, in a low
+ voice.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;One more question, and I have done. Have you on some occasions heard the
+ sound of horses' hoofs in your yard at about the time that your son came
+ in?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mr. Bastow said in a low voice: &ldquo;I have.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Had you any suspicion whatever of the character of your son's visitors?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;None whatever. I supposed that those with him were companions with whom
+ he had been spending the evening.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mr. Bastow had to be assisted from the witness box, so overcome was he
+ with the ordeal. He had not glanced at his son while giving his evidence.
+ The latter and his two fellow prisoners maintained throughout the trial
+ their expression of indifference. The two highwaymen nodded to
+ acquaintances they saw in the body of the court, smiled at various points
+ in the evidence, and so conducted themselves that there were murmured
+ exclamations of approval of their gameness on the part of the lower class
+ of the public. The jury, without a moment's hesitation, found them all
+ guilty of the offenses with which they were charged. Bastow was first
+ sentenced.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Young man,&rdquo; the judge said, &ldquo;young as you are, there can be no doubt
+ whatever in the minds of anyone who has heard the evidence that you have
+ been an associate with these men who have been found guilty of highway
+ robbery accompanied by murder. I consider that a merciful view was taken
+ of your case by the magistrates who committed you for trial, for the
+ evidence of your heartbroken father, on whose gray hairs your conduct has
+ brought trouble and disgrace, leaves no doubt that you have for some time
+ been in league with highwaymen, although not actually participating in
+ their crime. The words overheard by Mr. Thorndyke show that you were
+ prepared to hide their booty for them, and it is well for you that you
+ were captured before this was done, and that no proceeds of other
+ robberies were found in the house. The evidence of the Bow Street officers
+ show that it had for some time been suspected that these men had an
+ accomplice somewhere in the neighborhood of Reigate, for although arrested
+ several times under circumstances forming a strong assumption of their
+ guilt, nothing was ever found upon them. There can now be little, doubt
+ who their accomplice was. Had you been an older man I should have
+ sentenced you to transportation for life, but in consideration of your
+ youth, I shall take the milder course of sentencing you to fifteen years'
+ transportation.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The capital sentence was then passed in much fewer words upon the two
+ highwaymen. As they were leaving the dock Bastow turned, and in a clear
+ voice said to John Thorndyke, who had been accommodated with a seat in the
+ well of the court:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have to thank you, Thorndyke, for this. I will pay off my debt some
+ day, you make take your oath.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;A sad case, Mr. Thorndyke&mdash;a sad case,&rdquo; the judge, who had greatly
+ complimented the Squire on his conduct, said to him as he was disrobing
+ afterwards. &ldquo;I don't know that in all my experience I ever saw such a
+ hardened young villain. With highwaymen it is a point of honor to assume a
+ gayety of demeanor on such occasions; but to see a boy of eighteen, never
+ before convicted, exhibiting such coolness and effrontery is quite beyond
+ my experience. I suppose his record is altogether bad?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Altogether,&rdquo; the Squire said. &ldquo;His father has, during the last two years,
+ been quite broken by it; he owned to me that he was in bodily fear of the
+ lad, who had on several occasions assaulted him, had robbed him of his
+ savings by means of forgery, and was so hopelessly bad that he himself
+ thought with me that the only possible hope for him was to get him to
+ enlist. I myself recommended the East India Company's service, thinking
+ that he would have less opportunity for crime out there, and that there
+ would be a strong chance that either fever or a bullet would carry him
+ off, for I own that I have not the slightest hope of reformation in such a
+ character.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I would have given him transportation for life if I had known all this,&rdquo;
+ the judge said. &ldquo;However, it is not likely that he will ever come back
+ again&mdash;very few of them do; the hulks are not the most healthy places
+ in the world, and they have a pretty rough way with men who give them
+ trouble, as this young fellow is likely to do.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mr. Bastow, as soon as he had given his evidence, had taken a hackney
+ coach to the inn where he and the Squire had put up on their arrival in
+ town the evening before, and here, on his return, John Thorndyke found
+ him. He was lying on his bed in a state of prostration.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Cheer up, Bastow,&rdquo; he said, putting his hand upon the Rector's shoulder.
+ &ldquo;The sentence is fifteen years, which was the very amount I hoped that he
+ would get. The more one sees of him the more hopeless it is to expect that
+ any change will ever take place in him; and it is infinitely better that
+ he should be across the sea where his conduct, when his term is over, can
+ affect no one. The disgrace, such as it is, to his friends, is no greater
+ in a long term than in a short one. Had he got off with four or five
+ years' imprisonment, he would have been a perpetual trouble and a source
+ of uneasiness, not to say alarm; and even had he left you alone we should
+ always have been in a state of dread as to his next offense. Better that
+ he should be out in the colonies than be hung at Tyburn.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How did he take the sentence?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;With the same bravado he had shown all through, and as he went out of the
+ dock addressed a threat to me, that, under the circumstances, I can very
+ well afford to despise. Now, if you will take my advice, you will drink a
+ couple of glasses of good port, and then go to bed. I will see to your
+ being awakened at seven o'clock, which will give us time to breakfast
+ comfortably, and to make a start at nine.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I would rather not have the wine,&rdquo; the Rector said feebly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, but you must take what is good for you. I have ordered up a bottle
+ of the landlord's best, and must insist upon your drinking a couple of
+ glasses with me. I want it almost as much as you do, for the atmosphere of
+ that court was enough to poison a dog. I have got the taste of it in my
+ mouth still.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ With much reluctance the Rector accompanied him to the private sitting
+ room that the Squire had engaged. He sat down almost mechanically in an
+ easy chair. The Squire poured out the wine, and handed him a glass. Mr.
+ Bastow at first put it to his lips without glancing at it, but he was a
+ connoisseur in wine, and the bouquet of the port appealing to his latent
+ senses, he took a sip, and then another, appreciatingly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The landlord said it was first rate, and he is not far wrong,&rdquo; John
+ Thorndyke remarked, as he set down his own glass.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, it is a fine vintage, and in perfect condition,&rdquo; Mr. Bastow agreed.
+ &ldquo;I have drunk nothing better for years, though you have some fine bins.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I would take a biscuit, if I were you, before I took another glass,&rdquo; the
+ Squire said, helping himself from a plate on the table. &ldquo;You have had
+ nothing to eat today, and you want something badly. I have a dish of
+ kidneys coming up in half an hour; they cook them well here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Rector ate a biscuit, mechanically sipped another glass of wine, and
+ was even able to eat a kidney when they were brought up. Although
+ September was not yet out, the Squire had a fire lighted in the room, and
+ after the meal was over, and two steaming tumblers of punch were placed
+ upon the table, he took a long pipe from the mantel, filled and lighted
+ it, then filled another, and handed it to the Rector, at the same time
+ holding out a light to him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Life has its consolations,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;You have had a lot of troubles one
+ way and another, Bastow, but we may hope that they are all over now, and
+ that life will go more smoothly and easily with you. We had better leave
+ the past alone for the present. I call this snug: a good fire, a clean
+ pipe, a comfortable chair, and a steaming bowl at one's elbow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Rector smiled faintly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It seems unnatural&mdash;&rdquo; he began.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not at all, not at all,&rdquo; the Squire broke in. &ldquo;You have had a tremendous
+ load on your mind, and now it is lifted off; the thundercloud has burst,
+ and though damage has been done, one is thankful that it is no worse. Now
+ I can talk to you of a matter that has been on my mind for the last three
+ weeks. What steps do you think that I ought to take to find a successor
+ for you? It is most important to have a man who will be a real help in the
+ parish, as you have been, would pull with one comfortably, and be a
+ pleasant associate. I don't want too young a fellow, and I don't want too
+ old a one. I have no more idea how to set about it than a child. Of
+ course, I could ask the Bishop to appoint, but I don't know that he would
+ appoint at all the sort of man I want. The living is only worth 200 pounds
+ a year and the house&mdash;no very great catch; but there is many a man
+ that would be glad to have it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have been thinking it over, too, Thorndyke, when I could bring my mind
+ to consider anything but my own affairs. How would Greg do? He has been
+ taking duty for me since I could not do it myself. I know that he is a
+ hard working fellow, and he has a wife and a couple of children; his
+ curacy is only 70 pounds a year, and it would be a perfect godsend, for he
+ has no interest in the Church, and he might be years without preferment.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should think he would do very well, Bastow. Yes, he reads well, which I
+ own I care for that a good deal more than for the preaching; not that I
+ have anything to say against that. He gives sound and practical sermons,
+ and they have the advantage of being short, which is a great thing. In the
+ first place, it is good in itself, and in the second, specially important
+ in a village congregation, where you know very well every woman present is
+ fidgeting to get home to see that the pot is not boiling over, and the
+ meat in the oven is not burnt. Yes, I will go down tomorrow afternoon and
+ ask him if he would like the living. You were talking of selling the
+ furniture; how much do you suppose it is worth?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't suppose it will fetch above seventy or eighty pounds; it is solid
+ and good, but as I have had it in use nearly forty years, it would not go
+ for much.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, let us say a hundred pounds,&rdquo; the Squire said. &ldquo;I will give you a
+ check for it. I dare say Greg will find it difficult to furnish, and he
+ might have to borrow the money, and the debt would be a millstone round
+ his neck, perhaps, for years, so I will hand it over with the Rectory to
+ him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ So they talked for an hour or two on village matters, and the Squire was
+ well pleased, when his old friend went up to bed, that he had succeeded in
+ diverting his thoughts for a time from the painful subject that had
+ engrossed them for weeks.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have slept well,&rdquo; he said, when they met at breakfast, &ldquo;I can see by
+ your face.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I have not slept so soundly for months. I went to sleep as soon as
+ my head touched the pillow, and did not awake until the chambermaid
+ knocked at the door.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That second glass of punch did it, Bastow. It is a fine morning; we shall
+ have a brisk drive back. I am very glad that I changed my mind and brought
+ the gig instead of the close carriage.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In the afternoon the Squire drove into Reigate. He found the curate at
+ home, and astonished and delighted him by asking him if he would like the
+ living of Crowswood. It came altogether as a surprise to him, for the
+ Rector's intentions to resign had not been made public, and it was
+ supposed in the village that he was only staying at the Squire's until
+ this sad affair should be over. Greg was a man of seven or eight and
+ twenty, had graduated with distinction at Cambridge, but, having no
+ influence, had no prospects of promotion, and the offer almost bewildered
+ him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should be grateful indeed, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;It would be a boon
+ to us. Will you excuse me for a moment?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ And opening a door, he called for his wife, who was trying to keep the two
+ children quiet there, having retired with them hastily when Mr. Thorndyke
+ was announced.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What do you think, Emma?&rdquo; her husband said excitedly, as she came into
+ the room. &ldquo;Mr. Thorndyke has been good enough to offer me the living of
+ Crowswood.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then he recovered himself. &ldquo;I beg your pardon, sir, for my unmannerliness
+ in not first introducing my wife to you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It was natural that you should think of telling her the news first of
+ all,&rdquo; the Squire said courteously. &ldquo;Madam, I am your obedient servant, and
+ I hope that soon we shall get to know each other well. I consider it of
+ great importance that the Squire of a parish and the Rector should work
+ well together, and see a great deal of each other. I don't know whether
+ you are aware, Mr. Greg, that the living is worth 200 pounds a year,
+ besides which there is a paddock of about ten acres, which is sufficient
+ for the keep of a horse and cow. The Rectory is a comfortable one, and I
+ have arranged with Mr. Bastow that he shall leave his furniture for the
+ benefit of his successor. It will include linen, so that you will be put
+ to no expense whatever in moving in. I have known these first expenses to
+ seriously cripple the usefulness of a clergyman when appointed to a
+ living.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is good of you indeed, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; the curate said. &ldquo;We have
+ been living in these lodgings since we first came here, and it will indeed
+ make matters easy to have the question of furniture so kindly settled for
+ us.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Will your Rector be able to release you shortly?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have no doubt that he will do that at once. His son has just left
+ Oxford and taken deacon's orders; and the Rector told me the other day
+ that he should be glad if I would look out for another curacy, as he
+ wanted to have his son here with him. He spoke very kindly, and said that
+ he should make no change until I could hear of a place to suit me. His son
+ has been assisting him for the last month, since I took the services at
+ Crowswood, and I am sure he would release me at once.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I should be glad if you will move up as soon as possible to the
+ Rectory. I know nothing about the necessary forms, but I suppose that Mr.
+ Bastow will send in his resignation to the Bishop, and I shall write and
+ tell him that I have appointed you, and you can continue to officiate as
+ you have done lately until you can be formally inducted as the Rector.
+ Perhaps you would not mind going round to your Rector at once and telling
+ him of the offer you have had. I have one or two matters to do in the
+ town, and will call again in three quarters of an hour. I shall be glad to
+ tell Mr. Bastow that you will come into residence at once.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On returning at the appointed time he found that the curate had returned.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Mr. Pilkington was very kind, and evidently very pleased; he
+ congratulated me most warmly, and I can come up at once. We don't know how
+ to thank you enough, Mr. Thorndyke.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't want any thanks, I can assure you, Mr. Greg. Tomorrow I will send
+ a couple of women in from the village to get the place in order, and no
+ doubt Mr. Bastow will want to take away a few things. He is going to
+ remain with me as tutor to my son. I am sure you and I will get on very
+ well together, and I only hope that your sermons will be no longer when
+ you are Rector than they have been while you have been assisting us. Long
+ sermons may do for a town congregation, but in my opinion they are a very
+ serious mistake in the case of a village one. By the way, I think it would
+ be as well for you to get a servant here, and that before you go up. Mr.
+ Bastow's servant was an old woman, and in a case like this I always think
+ it is better not to take one's predecessor's servant. She generally
+ resents any change, and is always quoting how her last master had things.
+ I mention this before you go, because she is sure to ask to stay on, and
+ it is much easier to say that you are bringing a servant with you than to
+ have to tell her she is too old or too fat. Don't you think so, Mrs.
+ Greg?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I think it will be much better, Mr. Thorndyke. Even if I cannot hear
+ of one likely to suit us permanently, I will take someone as a stop gap.
+ One can easily change afterwards.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The old woman will do very well,&rdquo; the Squire said. &ldquo;She has two married
+ daughters in the village, and with a shilling or two from the parish she
+ will manage comfortably. At any rate we shall look after her, and I have
+ no doubt Mr. Bastow will make her an allowance.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Never were a pair more delighted than Parson Greg and his wife when two
+ days later they took possession of their new home. Half a dozen women had
+ been at work the day before, and everything was in perfect order. To Mrs.
+ Greg's relief she found that the old servant had already gone, the Squire
+ having himself informed her that Mrs. Greg would bring her own maid with
+ her. Mr. Bastow said that he would allow her half a crown a week as long
+ as she lived, and the Squire added as much more, and as the woman had
+ saved a good deal during her twenty years' service with the Rector, she
+ was perfectly satisfied.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a good thing that she should be content,&rdquo; the Squire said to Mr.
+ Bastow. &ldquo;She has a lot of connections in the village, and if she had gone
+ away with a sense of grievance she might have created a good deal of ill
+ feeling against your successor, and I am very anxious that he should begin
+ well. I like the young fellow, and I like his wife.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We are fortunate, indeed, Ernest,&rdquo; Mrs. Greg said the following morning,
+ as with the children, two and three years old, they went out into the
+ garden; where the trees were laden with apples, pears, and plums. &ldquo;What a
+ change from our little rooms in Reigate. I should think that anyone ought
+ to be happy indeed here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;They ought to be, Emma, but you see Mr. Bastow had trouble enough; and it
+ should be a lesson to us, dear, to look very closely after the boys now
+ they are young, and see that they don't make bad acquaintances.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;From what we hear of the village, there is little fear of that; the
+ mischief must have begun before Mr. Thorndyke came down, when by all
+ accounts things had altogether gone to the bad here, and of course young
+ Bastow must have had an exceptionally evil disposition, Ernest.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, no doubt; but his father could not have looked after him properly. I
+ believe, from what I hear, that Bastow was so dispirited at his
+ powerlessness to put a stop to the state of things here, that, except to
+ perform service, he seldom left the house, and the boy no doubt grew up
+ altogether wild. You know that I was in court on the second day of the
+ examination, and the young fellow's insolence and bearing astonished and
+ shocked me. Happily, we have the Squire here now to back us up, the
+ village has been completely cleared of all bad characters, and is by all
+ accounts quite a model place, and we must do our best to keep it so.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The news of the change at the Rectory naturally occasioned a great deal of
+ talk. At first there was a general feeling of regret that Mr. Bastow had
+ gone, and yet it was felt that he could not have been expected to stay;
+ the month's experience that they had had of the new parson had cleared the
+ way for him. He and his wife soon made themselves familiar with the
+ villagers, and being bright young people, speedily made themselves liked.
+ The Squire and Mrs. Cunningham called the first afternoon after their
+ arrival.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You must always send up if anything is wanted, Mr. Greg; whenever there
+ is any illness in the village we always keep a stock of soups and jellies,
+ and Mrs. Cunningham is almoner in general. Is there anything that we can
+ do for you? If so, let me know without hesitation.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Indeed, there is nothing, Mr. Thorndyke. It is marvelous to us coming in
+ here and finding everything that we can possibly want.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will want a boy for your garden; and you cannot do better than take
+ young Bill Summers. He was with me for a bit last year, when the boy I
+ have now was laid up with mumps or something of that sort, and he was very
+ favorably reported on as being handy in the garden, able to milk a cow,
+ and so on. By the way, Mrs. Greg, I have taken the liberty of sending down
+ a cow in milk. I expect she is in your meadow now. I have seven or eight
+ of them, and if you will send her back when her milk fails I will send
+ down another.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You are too kind altogether, Mr. Thorndyke!&rdquo; Mrs. Greg exclaimed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not at all. I want to see things comfortable here, and you will find it
+ difficult to get on without a cow. I keep two or three for the special use
+ of the village. I make them pay for it, halfpenny a pint; it is better to
+ do that than to give it. It is invaluable for the children; and I don't
+ think in all England you see rosier and healthier youngsters than those in
+ our schools. You will sometimes find milk useful for puddings and that
+ sort of thing for the sick; and they will appreciate it all the more than
+ if they had to look solely to us for their supply.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How is Mr. Bastow, sir?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is better than could be expected. He himself proposed this morning
+ that my boy Mark should begin his studies at once; and, indeed, now that
+ the worst is over and he has got rid of the load of care on his shoulders,
+ I hope that we shall have him bright and cheerful again before long.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Such was indeed the case. For some little time Mr. Bastow avoided the
+ village, but John Thorndyke got him to go down with him to call upon Mr.
+ Greg, and afterwards to walk through it with him. At first he went timidly
+ and shrinkingly, but the kindly greetings of the women he met, and the
+ children stopping to pull a forelock or bob a courtesy as of old,
+ gradually cheered him up, and he soon got accustomed to the change, and
+ would of an afternoon go down to the village and chat with the women,
+ after he had ascertained that his successor had no objection whatever, and
+ was, indeed, pleased that he still took an interest in his former
+ parishioners. Mark was at first disappointed at the arrangement, for he
+ had looked forward to going to a public school. His father, however, had
+ no great trouble in reconciling him to it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, Mark,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;there are advantages in a public school. I
+ was never at one myself, but I believe that, though the discipline is
+ pretty strict, there is a great deal of fun and sport, and you may make
+ desirable acquaintances. Upon the other hand, there are drawbacks. In the
+ first place, the majority of the boys are sons of richer men than I am. I
+ don't know that that would matter much, but it would give you expensive
+ habits, and perhaps make you fonder of London life than I should care
+ about. In the next place, you see, you would be at school when the
+ shooting begins, and you are looking forward to carrying a gun next year.
+ The same with hunting. You know I promised that this year you should go to
+ the meets on your pony, and see as much of them as you can, and of course
+ when you were at school you would only be able to indulge in these matters
+ during your holidays; and if a hard frost set in, as is the case three
+ times out of four, just as you came home, you would be out of it
+ altogether.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I must say I should like you to have a real love of field sports and to
+ be a good shot and a good rider. A man, however wide his acres may be, is
+ thought but little of in the country if he is not a good sportsman; and,
+ moreover, there is nothing better for developing health and muscles than
+ riding, and tramping over the fields with a gun on your shoulder; and,
+ lastly, you must not forget, Mark, that one of my objects in making this
+ arrangement is to keep Mr. Bastow with us. I am sure that unless he
+ thought that he was making himself useful he would not be content to
+ remain here; and at his age, you know, it would be hard for him to obtain
+ clerical employment.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, father. I see that the present plan is the best, and that I
+ should have but little sport if I went away to school. Besides, I like Mr.
+ Bastow very much, and I am quite sure that I shan't get so many whackings
+ from him as I used to do from old Holbrook.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I fancy not, Mark,&rdquo; his father said with a smile. &ldquo;I am not against
+ wholesome discipline, but I think it can be carried too far; at any rate,
+ I hope you will be just as obedient to Mr. Bastow as if he always had a
+ cane on the table beside him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark, therefore, went to work in a cheerful spirit, and soon found that he
+ made more progress in a week under Mr. Bastow's gentle tuition than he had
+ done in a month under the vigorous discipline of his former master. Mr.
+ and Mrs. Greg dined regularly at the Squire's once a week.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Have you had that Indian servant of yours long, Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo; Mrs. Greg
+ asked one day. &ldquo;He is a strange looking creature. Of course, in the
+ daytime, when one sees him about in ordinary clothes, one does not notice
+ him so much; but of an evening, in that Eastern costume of his, he looks
+ very strange.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He was the servant of the Colonel, my brother,&rdquo; the Squire replied. &ldquo;He
+ brought him over from India with him. The man had been some years in his
+ service, and was very attached to him, and had saved his life more than
+ once, he told me. On one occasion he caught a cobra by the neck as it was
+ about to strike my brother's hand as he sat at table; he carried it out
+ into the compound, as George called it, but which means, he told me,
+ garden, and there let it escape. Another time he caught a Thug, which
+ means a sort of robber who kills his victims by strangling before robbing
+ them. They are a sort of sect who regard strangling as a religious action,
+ greatly favored by the bloodthirsty goddess they worship. He was in the
+ act of fastening the twisted handkerchief, used for the purpose, round my
+ brother's neck, when Ramoo cut him down. The closest shave, though, was
+ when George, coming down the country, was pounced upon by a tiger and
+ carried off. Ramoo seized a couple of muskets from the men, and rushed
+ into the jungle after him, and coming up with the brute killed him at the
+ first shot. George escaped with a broken arm and his back laid open by a
+ scratch of the tiger's claws as it first seized him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;So at George's death I took Ramoo on, and have found him a most useful
+ fellow. Of course, I was some little time before I became accustomed to
+ his noiseless way of going about, and it used to make me jump when I
+ happened to look round, and saw him standing quietly behind me when I
+ thought I was quite alone. However, as soon as I became accustomed to him,
+ I got over all that, and now I would not lose him for anything; he seems
+ to know instinctively what I want. He is excellent as a waiter and valet;
+ I should feel almost lost without him now; and the clumping about of an
+ English man servant would annoy me as much as his noiseless way of going
+ about did at first. He has come to speak English very fairly. Of course,
+ my brother always talked to him in his own tongue; still, he had picked up
+ enough English for me to get on with; now he speaks it quite fluently.
+ When I have nothing whatever for him to do he devotes himself to my little
+ ward. She is very fond of him, and it is quite pretty to see them together
+ in the garden. Altogether, I would not part with him for anything.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For some years life passed uneventfully at Crowswood. It was seldom indeed
+ that the Squire's authority was needed to set matters right in the
+ village. The substitution of good farmers for shiftless ones in some of
+ the farms, and the better cultivation generally, had given more
+ employment; and as John Thorndyke preferred keeping two or three cottages
+ shut up rather than have them occupied by men for whom no work could be
+ found, it was rare indeed that there were any complaints of scarcity of
+ work, except, indeed, on the part of the Rector, who declared that, what
+ with the healthiness of the village and the absence of want, his
+ occupation, save for the Sunday duty, was a sinecure. Mr. Bastow was more
+ happy and much brighter than he had been for many years. The occupation of
+ teaching suited him, and he was able to make the work pleasant to his
+ pupil as well as to himself; indeed, it occupied but a small portion of
+ the day, the amount of learning considered necessary at the time not being
+ extensive. A knowledge of Greek was thought quite superfluous for a
+ country gentleman. Science was in its infancy, mathematics a subject only
+ to be taken up by those who wanted to obtain a college fellowship. Latin,
+ however, was considered an essential, and a knack of apt quotation from
+ the Latin poets an accomplishment that every man who was a member of
+ society or aspired to enter Parliament was expected to possess. Thus Mark
+ Thorndyke's lessons lasted but two or three hours a day, and the school
+ term was a movable period, according to the season of the year and the
+ engagements of the Squire and Mark. In winter the evening was the time, so
+ that the boy shot with his father, or rode to the hounds, or, as he got
+ older, joined in shooting parties at the houses of neighbors.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In summer the work was done in the morning, but was not unfrequently
+ broken. Mark went off at a very early hour to drive perhaps some twenty
+ miles with his great chum, Dick Chetwynd, for a long day's fishing, or to
+ see a main of cocks fought or a fight between the champions of two
+ neighboring villages, or perhaps some more important battle.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When Millicent Conyers was ten years old she came regularly into the
+ study, sitting curled up in a deep chair, getting up her lessons while
+ Mark did his, and then changing seats with him while he learned his Horace
+ or Ovid by heart. At this time she looked up greatly to him, and was his
+ companion whenever he would allow her to be, fetched and carried for him,
+ and stood almost on a level with his dogs in his estimation. Five years
+ later, when Mark was eighteen, these relations changed somewhat. He now
+ liked to have her with him, not only when about the house and garden, but
+ when he took short rides she cantered along on her pony by his side. She
+ was a bright faced girl, full of life and fun, and rejoicing in a far
+ greater amount of freedom than most girls of her age and time.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is really time that she should learn to comport herself more staidly,
+ instead of running about like a wild thing,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said, one
+ day, as she and the Squire stood after breakfast looking out of the open
+ window at Mark and Millicent.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Time enough, my dear lady, time enough. Let her enjoy life while she can.
+ I am not in favor of making a young kitten behave like an old tabby; every
+ creature in nature is joyful and frolicsome while it is young. She is as
+ tall and as straight as any of her friends of the same age, and looks more
+ healthy; she will tame down in time, and I dare say walk and look as prim
+ and demure as they do. I was watching them the other day when there was a
+ party of them up here, and I thought the difference was all to her
+ advantage. She looked a natural, healthy girl; they looked like a set of
+ overdressed dolls, afraid to move or to talk loud, or to stretch their
+ mouths when they smile; very ladylike and nice, no doubt, but you will see
+ Millicent will throw them into the shade when she is once past the tomboy
+ age. Leave her alone, Mrs. Cunningham; a girl is not like a fruit tree,
+ that wants pruning and training from its first year; it will be quite time
+ to get her into shape when she has done growing.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke had occasionally made inquiries of Mr. Bastow as to the
+ whereabouts of his son. At the time the sentence was passed transportation
+ to the American colonies was being discontinued, and until other
+ arrangements could be made hulks were established as places of confinement
+ and punishment; but a few months later Arthur Bastow was one of the first
+ batch of convicts sent out to the penal settlement formed on the east
+ coast of Australia. This was intended to be fixed at Botany Bay, but it
+ having been found that this bay was open and unsheltered, it was
+ established at Sydney, although for many years the settlement retained in
+ England the name of the original site. As the condition of the prisoners
+ kept in the hulks was deplorable, the Squire had, through the influence of
+ Sir Charles Harris, obtained the inclusion of Bastow's name among the
+ first batch of those who were to sail for Australia. Mr. Bastow obtained
+ permission to see his son before sailing, but returned home much
+ depressed, for he had been assailed with such revolting and blasphemous
+ language by him that he had been forced to retire in horror at the end of
+ a few minutes.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have done well in getting him sent off,&rdquo; the Squire said, when he
+ heard the result of the interview. &ldquo;In the first place, the demoralizing
+ effect of these hulks is quite evident, and it may be hoped that in a new
+ country, where there can be no occasion for the convicts to be pent up
+ together, things may be better; for although escapes from the hulks are
+ not frequent, they occasionally take place, and had he gained his liberty
+ we should have had an anxious time of it until he was re-arrested, whereas
+ out there there is nowhere to go to, no possibility of committing a crime.
+ It is not there as it was in the American colony. Settlements may grow up
+ in time, but at present there are no white men whatever settled in the
+ district; and the natives are, they say, hostile, and were a convict to
+ escape he would almost certainly be killed, and possibly eaten. No doubt
+ by the time your son has served his sentence colonies will be established
+ out there, and he may then be disposed to settle there, either on a piece
+ of land of which he could no doubt take up or in the service of one of the
+ colonists.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0005" id="link2HCH0005">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER V.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The scene in the convict yard at Sydney, five years after its foundation
+ as a penal settlement, was not a pleasant one to the lover of humanity.
+ Warders armed to the teeth were arranging gangs that were to go out to
+ labor on the roads. Many of the convicts had leg irons, but so fastened as
+ to be but slight hindrance to their working powers, but the majority were
+ unironed. These were the better behaved convicts; not that this would be
+ judged from their faces, for the brutalizing nature of the system and the
+ close association of criminals had placed its mark on all, and it would
+ have been difficult for the most discriminating to have made any choice
+ between the most hardened criminals and those who had been sent out for
+ what would now be considered comparatively trivial offenses. The voyage on
+ board ship had done much to efface distinctions, the convict life had done
+ more, and the chief difference between the chained and unchained prisoners
+ was that the latter were men of more timid disposition than many of their
+ companions, and therefore less disposed to give trouble that would entail
+ heavy punishment. But it was only the comparatively well conducted men who
+ were placed upon road work; the rest were retained for work inside the
+ jail, or were caged in solitary confinement. Each morning a number,
+ varying from half a dozen to a dozen, were fastened up and flogged, in
+ some cases with merciless severity, but it was seldom that a cry was
+ uttered by these, the most brutal ruffians of the convict herd. This
+ spectacle was just over: it was conducted in public for the edification of
+ the rest, but, judging from the low laughs and brutal jests, uttered below
+ the breath, it signally failed in producing the desired impression. Two of
+ those who had suffered the severest punishment were now putting on their
+ coarse woolen garments over their bloodstained shoulders; both were
+ comparatively young men.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall not stand this much longer,&rdquo; one muttered. &ldquo;I will brain a
+ warder, and get hung for it. One can but die once, while one can get
+ flogged once a week.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;So would I,&rdquo; the other said bitterly; &ldquo;but I have some scores to settle
+ in England, and I am not going to put my head in a noose until I have
+ wiped them out. The sooner we make arrangements to get back there the
+ better.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, we have talked of this before,&rdquo; the other said, &ldquo;and I quite agreed
+ with you that if we all had the pluck of men we ought to be able to
+ overpower the warders, in spite of their firearms. Of course some of us
+ would get killed, but no one would mind that if there was but the remotest
+ chance of getting away. The question is what we should do with ourselves
+ when we were once outside the prison. Of course I know that there are two
+ or three hundred settlers, but there would not be much to be got out of
+ them, and life among those black fellows, even if they were civil to us,
+ which I don't suppose they would be, would not be worth having.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We might not have to stay there long; ships with stores or settlers
+ arrive occasionally, and if a lot of us got away we might seize one by
+ force, turn pirates for a bit, and when we are tired of that sail to some
+ South American port, sell our capture, and make our way home to England.
+ If we were not strong enough to take her, we could hide up on board her;
+ we should be sure to find some fellow who for a pound or two would be
+ willing to help us. The thing can be done if we make up our minds to do
+ it, and I for one have made up my mind to try. I haven't chalked out a
+ plan yet, but I am convinced that it is to be done.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am with you, whatever it is,&rdquo; the other said; &ldquo;and I think there are
+ twenty or thirty we could rely on. I don't say there are more than that,
+ because there are a lot of white livered cusses among them who would
+ inform against us at once, so as to get their own freedom as a reward for
+ doing so. Well, we will both think it over, mate, and the sooner the
+ better.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The two men who were thus talking together were both by birth above the
+ common herd of convicts, and had gained a considerable ascendency over the
+ others because of their reckless indifference to punishment and their
+ defiance of authority. Few of the men knew each other's real names; by the
+ officials they were simply known by numbers, while among themselves each
+ had a slang name generally gained on board ship.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Separation there had, of course, been impossible, and when fastened down
+ below each had told his story with such embellishments as he chose to give
+ it, and being but little interfered with by their guards, save to insure
+ the impossibility of a mutiny, there had been fights of a desperate kind.
+ Four or five dead bodies had been found and thrown overboard, but as none
+ would testify as to who had been the assailants none were punished for it;
+ and so the strongest and most desperate had enforced their authority over
+ the others, as wild beasts might do, and by the time they had reached
+ their destination all were steeped much deeper in wickedness and brutalism
+ than when they set sail.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The two men who were speaking together had speedily become chums, and,
+ though much younger than the majority of the prisoners, had by their
+ recklessness and ferocity established an ascendency among the others. This
+ ascendency had been maintained after their arrival by their constant acts
+ of insubordination, and by their apparent indifference to the punishment
+ awarded them. At night the convicts were lodged in wooden buildings,
+ where, so long as they were not riotous, they were allowed to talk and
+ converse freely, as indeed was the case when their work for the day was
+ done.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As to any attempt at escape, the authorities had but small anxiety, for
+ until the arrival of the first settlers, three years after that of the
+ convicts, there was nowhere a fugitive could go to, no food to be
+ obtained, no shelter save among the blacks, who were always ready for a
+ reward of tobacco and spirits to hand them over at once to the
+ authorities. The case had but slightly changed since the settlement began
+ to grow. It was true that by stealing sheep or driving off a few head of
+ cattle a fugitive might maintain himself for a time, but even if not shot
+ down by the settlers or patrols, he would be sure before long to be
+ brought in by the blacks.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The experiment had already been tried of farming our better conducted
+ convicts to the settlers, and indeed it was the prospect of obtaining such
+ cheap labor that had been the main inducement to many of the colonists to
+ establish themselves so far from home, instead of going to America. As a
+ whole the system worked satisfactorily; the men were as much prisoners as
+ were the inmates of the jail, for they knew well enough that were they to
+ leave the farmers and take to the bush they would remain free but a short
+ time, being either killed or handed over by the blacks, and in the latter
+ case they would be severely punished and set to prison work in irons, with
+ labor very much more severe than that they were called upon to do on the
+ farms.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Some little time after the conversation between the two convicts the
+ prison authorities were congratulating themselves upon the fact that a
+ distinct change had taken or was taking place in the demeanor of many of
+ the men who had hitherto been the most troublesome, and they put it down
+ to the unusually severe floggings that had been inflicted on the two most
+ refractory prisoners in the establishment. When in the prison yard or at
+ work they were more silent than before, and did their tasks doggedly and
+ sullenly; there was no open defiance to the authorities, and, above all, a
+ marked cessation of drunkenness from the spirits smuggled into the place.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Only the two originators were aware of the extent of the plot; for they
+ had agreed that only by keeping every man in ignorance as to who had
+ joined it could they hope to escape treachery. In the first place, they
+ had taken into their confidence a dozen men on whom they could absolutely
+ rely. Beyond this they had approached the others singly, beginning by
+ hinting that there was a plot for escape, and that a good many were
+ concerned, and telling them that these had bound themselves together by a
+ solemn oath to kill any traitor, even if hanged for it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No one is to know who is in it and who is not,&rdquo; the leaders said to each
+ recruit. &ldquo;Every new man will be closely watched by the rest, and if he has
+ any communication privately with a warder or any other official he will be
+ found strangled the next morning; no one will know who did it. Even if he
+ succeeded in eluding the vigilance of his comrades at the time, it would
+ soon be known; for if indulgence of any kind was shown towards one man, or
+ he was relieved from his ordinary work, or even freed altogether and
+ suddenly, he would be a dead man in twenty-four hours, for we have friends
+ outside among the ticket of leave men who have bound themselves to kill at
+ once any man set free.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ To the question, &ldquo;What do you intend to do when we get off?&rdquo; the answer
+ was, &ldquo;We shall go straight to the bush, so as to avoid a fight with the
+ soldiers, in the first place; then we shall join that night, and drive off
+ all the cattle and sheep from the settlements, take possession of every
+ firearm found in the houses, then move off a couple of hundred miles or so
+ into the bush, and establish a settlement of our own.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, we shall take horses and clothes and any spirits and food we
+ may find. If the soldiers pursue us, we will fight them; but as there are
+ only three or four companies of them, and we shall be eight hundred
+ strong, we shall very soon show them that they had better leave us alone.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, yes, no doubt they will send more soldiers out from England, but it
+ will be over a year before they can get here; and we propose after we have
+ done with the fellows here to break up into parties of twenty and thirty,
+ dividing the sheep and cattle among us, and each party going where it
+ will. The place is of tremendous size, as big as a dozen Englands, they
+ say, and each party will fix a place it fancies, where there is good water
+ and a river with fish and so on, and we may live all our lives
+ comfortably, with just enough work to raise potatoes and corn, and to
+ watch our stock increasing. Anyhow, we might calculate on having some
+ years of peace and freedom, and even if in the end they searched us all
+ out, which would be very unlikely, they could but bring us back, hang a
+ few, and set the rest to work again; but we think that they would most
+ likely leave us alone altogether, quite satisfied with having got rid of
+ us.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Those who liked it could, no doubt, take wives among the blacks. The
+ convict women who are out on service with the settlers would, you may be
+ sure, join us at once, and an enterprising chap who preferred a white
+ woman to a black could always make his way down here and persuade one to
+ go off with him to his farm. That is the general plan; if many get tired
+ of the life they have only to come down to Sydney, hide up near the place
+ on some dark night, and go down to the port, seize a ship, and make off in
+ her, compelling the officers and sailors to take them and land them at any
+ port they fancy, either in Chili, Peru, or Mexico, or, if they like, sail
+ west and make for Rio or Buenos Ayres or one of the West Indian islands.
+ As to when it is going to be done, or how it is going to be done, no one
+ will be told till it is ready to be carried out. We have not settled that
+ ourselves, and thus one who was fool enough to risk certain death could
+ tell the Governor no more than that there was a plot on hand, and that the
+ man who had sworn him in was concerned in it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ So one by one every man in the prison was sworn by a terrible oath to
+ secrecy, to watch his companions, and to report anything that looked
+ suspicious. Many joined willingly, the prospect of relief, even should it
+ only be temporary, being too fascinating to be resisted. Some joined
+ against their will, fearing that a refusal to do so would be punished by
+ death; and the fact that two or three men were found strangled in bed had
+ a very great effect in inducing others to join in the plot.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ These deaths caused some uneasiness to the authorities. Their utmost
+ endeavors failed to discover who were the perpetrators of these murders;
+ and even when everyone in the same hut was flogged to obtain information,
+ not one opened his lips.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ One night the word was passed round that the time had come. One only in
+ each hut was familiar with the details, and he gave instructions to each
+ man individually as to what he was to do. The date had been determined by
+ the fact that the time which they had been sentenced to wear irons had
+ terminated the day before, and their unusually subdued and quiet demeanor
+ having carried them through the interval without, as usual, fresh
+ punishments being awarded them before the termination of the former one.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In the morning the whole of the convicts were drawn up to witness the
+ flogging of the inmates of one of the huts, where a man had been found
+ strangled the morning before. The first prisoner was taken to the
+ triangle, stripped to the waist, and tied up. There was a dead silence in
+ the ranks of the convicts, but as the first blow fell upon his shoulders
+ there was a loud yell, and simultaneously the whole ranks broke up, and a
+ number of men sprang upon each of the warders, wrested their muskets from
+ them, and threw them to the ground. Then there was a rush towards the
+ Governor and officers, who were assembled in front of the stone house that
+ faced the open end of the square. Firing their pistols, these at once took
+ refuge in the house, three or four falling under the scattered fire that
+ was opened as soon as the muskets of the warders fell into the hands of
+ the convicts.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Directly the doors were closed the officers appeared at the windows, and
+ opened a rifle fire upon the convicts, as did the guards near the gate. As
+ comparatively few of the convicts had muskets, they began to waver at
+ once. But, headed by the two ringleaders, the armed party rushed at the
+ guard, shot them down, and threw open the gate.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then an unexpected thing occurred. The soldiers from the barracks happened
+ to be marching down to do target practice on the shore, and were passing
+ the convict prison when the firing broke out. They were at once halted,
+ and ordered to load, and as the convicts, with exultant shouts, poured
+ through the gate they saw a long line of soldiers, with leveled muskets,
+ facing them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;At them!&rdquo; one of the leaders shouted. &ldquo;It is too late to draw back now.
+ We have got to break through them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Many of the convicts ran back into the yard; but those armed with muskets,
+ the more desperate of the party, followed their leaders. A moment later a
+ heavy volley rang out, and numbers of the convicts fell. Their two
+ leaders, however, and some twenty of their followers, keeping in a close
+ body, rushed at the line of soldiers with clubbed muskets, and with the
+ suddenness and fury of the rush burst their way through the line, and then
+ scattering, fled across the country, pursued by a dropping fire of
+ musketry.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The officers in command, seeing that but a fraction had escaped, ordered
+ one company to pursue, and marched the rest into the prison yard. It was
+ already deserted; the convicts had scattered to their huts, those who had
+ arms throwing them away. Dotted here and there over the square were the
+ bodies of eight or ten convicts and as many warders, whose skulls had been
+ smashed in by their infuriated assailants as soon as they had obtained
+ possession of their muskets. Close to the gate lay the six soldiers who
+ had furnished the guard; these were all dead or mortally wounded.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Governor and the officials issued from the house as soon as the
+ soldiers entered the yard. The first step to do was to turn all the
+ convicts out of the huts and to iron them. No resistance was attempted,
+ the sight of the soldiers completely cowing the mutineers. When the bodies
+ of the convicts that had fallen were counted and the roll of the prisoners
+ called over, it was found that eighteen were missing, and of these six
+ were during the course of the next hour or two brought in by the soldiers
+ who had gone in pursuit of them. The rest had escaped.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The convicts were all questioned separately, and the tales they told
+ agreed so closely that the Governor could not doubt that they were
+ speaking the truth. All had been sworn in by one of two men, and knew
+ nothing whatever of what was intended to be done that day, until after
+ they were locked up on the evening previous. Each of those in the huts had
+ received his instructions the night before from the one man.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There were eighteen huts, each containing fifteen convicts. Of the men who
+ had given instructions six had fallen outside the gate, together with
+ sixteen others; five had been overtaken and brought in; altogether, twelve
+ were still at large. Among these were the two leaders. The next day six of
+ the prisoners were tried and executed. The rest were punished only by a
+ reduction in their rations; sentence of death was at the same time passed
+ upon the twelve still at large, so as to save the trouble of a succession
+ of trials as they were caught and brought in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The two leaders had kept together after they had broken through the line
+ of soldiers.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Things have gone off well,&rdquo; one said as they ran through. &ldquo;Those soldiers
+ nearly spoilt it all.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, that was unlucky,&rdquo; the other agreed; &ldquo;but so far as we are
+ concerned, which is all we care about, I think things have turned out for
+ the best.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Nothing more was said until they had far outstripped their pursuers,
+ hampered as these were by their uniforms and belts.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You mean that it is not such a bad thing that they have not all got
+ away?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, that is what I mean. It is all very well to tell them about driving
+ off the sheep and cattle and horses, and going to start a colony on our
+ own account, but the soldiers would have been up to us before we had gone
+ a day's journey. Most of the fellows would have bolted directly they saw
+ them. As it is, I fancy only about a dozen have got away, perhaps not as
+ many as that, and they are all men that one can rely upon. One can feed a
+ dozen without difficulty&mdash;a sheep a day would do it&mdash;and by
+ giving a turn to each of the settlers, the animals won't be missed.
+ Besides, we shall want money if we are ever to get out of this cursed
+ country. It would not be difficult to get enough for you and me, but when
+ it comes to a large number the sack of the whole settlement would not go
+ very far.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My own idea is that we had best join the others tonight, kill a few
+ sheep, and go two or three days' march into the bush, until the heat of
+ the pursuit is over. We are all armed, the blacks would not venture to
+ attack us, and the soldiers would not be likely to pursue us very far. In
+ a week or so, when we can assume that matters have cooled down a bit, we
+ can come down again. We know all the shepherds, and even if they were not
+ disposed to help us they would not dare to betray us, or report a sheep or
+ two being missing. Of course, we shall have to be very careful to shift
+ our quarters frequently. Those black trackers are sure to be sent out
+ pretty often.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;As long as we are hanging about the settlements there won't be much fear
+ of our being bothered by the blacks. Of course, we shall have to decide
+ later on whether it will be best for us to try and seize a ship, all of us
+ acting together, or for us to get quietly on board one and keep under
+ hatches until she is well away. That is the plan I fancy most.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;So do I. In the first place the chances are that in the next two or three
+ months at least half the fellows will be picked up. To begin with, several
+ of them are sure to get hold of liquor and make attacks upon the settlers,
+ in which case some of them, anyhow, are sure to get killed. In the next
+ place, most of them were brought up as thieves in the slums of London, and
+ will have no more idea of roughing it in a country like this than of
+ behaving themselves if they were transported to a London drawing room.
+ Therefore, I am pretty sure that at the end of three months we shall not
+ be able to reckon on half of them. Well, six men are not enough to capture
+ a ship, or, if they do capture it, to keep the crew under. One must sleep
+ sometimes, and with only three or four men on deck we could not hope to
+ keep a whole ship's crew at bay.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then there is another reason. You and I, when we have got a decent rig
+ out, could pass anywhere without exciting observation; while if we had
+ half a dozen of the others, whatever their good qualities, they would be
+ noticed at once by their villainous faces, and if questions were to be
+ asked we should be likely to find ourselves in limbo again in a very short
+ time. So I am all for working on our own account, even if the whole of the
+ others were ready to back us; but, of course, we must keep on good terms
+ with them all, and breathe no word that we think that each man had better
+ shift for himself. Some of those fellows, if they thought we had any idea
+ of leaving them, would go straight into Sydney and denounce us, although
+ they would know that they themselves would be likely to swing at the same
+ time.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As none of the convicts were acquainted with the bush, they had been
+ obliged to select as their rendezvous a hut two miles out of the town,
+ where the convict gangs that worked on the road were in the habit of
+ leaving their tools. On the way there the two men killed a couple of sheep
+ from a flock whose position they had noticed before it became dark. These
+ they skinned, cut off the heads, and left them behind, carrying the sheep
+ on their shoulders to the meeting.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Is that you, Captain Wild?&rdquo; a voice said as they approached.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes; Gentleman Dick is with me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is a good job. We had begun to think that the soldiers had caught
+ you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;They would not have caught us alive, you may take your oath. How many are
+ there of us here?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Ten of us, Captain. I think that that is all there are.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is enough for our purpose. Has anyone got anything to eat?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a deep growl in the negative.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, we have brought a couple of sheep with us, and as we have carried
+ them something like a mile, you had better handle them by turns. We will
+ strike off into the bush and put another three or four miles between us
+ and the jail, and then light a fire and have a meal.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Two of the men came forward and took the sheep. Then they turned off from
+ the road, and taking their direction from a star, followed it for an hour.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think we have got far enough now,&rdquo; the man called Captain Wild said.
+ &ldquo;You had better cut down the bushes, and we will make a fire.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But how are we to light it?&rdquo; one of them exclaimed in a tone of
+ consternation. &ldquo;I don't suppose we have got flint and steel or tinder box
+ among us.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, we can manage that!&rdquo; the Captain said. &ldquo;Get a heap of dried leaves
+ here first, then some wood, and we will soon have a blaze.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ His orders were obeyed. Some of the men had carried off the warders'
+ swords as well as their muskets, and now used them for chopping wood. As
+ soon as a small pile of dried leaves was gathered the Captain broke a
+ cartridge and sprinkled half its contents among them, and then dropped the
+ remainder into his musket. He flashed this off among the leaves, and a
+ bright flame at once shot up, and in five minutes a fire was burning.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ One of the sheep was soon cut up, the meat hacked in slices from the
+ bones, a ramrod was thrust through the pieces, and, supported by four
+ sticks, was laid across the fire. Three other similarly laden spits were
+ soon placed beside it, and in a short time the meat was ready for eating.
+ Until a hearty meal had been made there was but little talking.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is first rate,&rdquo; one of the men said, as he wiped his mouth with the
+ back of his hand. &ldquo;Now one only wants a pipe and bacca and a glass of
+ grog, to feel comfortable.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Captain, are you satisfied with the day's work?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It would have been a grand day had it not been for the soldiers passing
+ just at the time. As it is, Gentleman Dick and I have been agreeing that
+ as far as we are all concerned it has not turned out so badly. There would
+ have been a lot of difficulty in finding food if we had all got away, and
+ some of those mealy mouthed fellows would have been sure to go back and
+ peach on us at the first opportunity. A dozen is better than a hundred for
+ the sort of life we are likely to lead for some time. We are strong enough
+ to beat off any attack from the black fellows, and also to break into any
+ of these settlers' houses.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We can, when we have a mind to, take a stray sheep now and then, or even
+ a bullock would scarcely be missed, especially if our pals in the
+ settlement will lend us a helping hand, which you may be sure they will
+ do; in fact, they would know better than to refuse. Then a large party
+ could be traced by those black trackers at a run, while a small one would
+ not; especially if, as we certainly will do, we break up into twos and
+ threes for a time. First of all, though, we must go well into the bush; at
+ daybreak tomorrow morning we will drive off twenty sheep, and go right
+ away a hundred miles, and wait there till matters have settled down. They
+ will never take the troops out that distance after us. Then we can come
+ back again, and hang about the settlement and take what we want. The wild
+ blacks don't come near there, and we shall be safer in pairs than we
+ should be if we kept together; and of course we could meet once a week or
+ so to talk over our plans. We must borrow some whisky, flour, tea,
+ tobacco, and a few other items from the settlers, but we had better do
+ without them for this trip. I don't want to turn the settlers against us,
+ for they have all got horses, and might combine with the troops to give
+ chase, so it would be best to leave them alone, at any rate till we get
+ back again. Another reason for treating them gently is that even if they
+ did not join the troops they might get into a funk, and drive their sheep
+ and horses down into Sydney, and then we should mighty soon get short of
+ food. It will be quite time enough to draw upon them heavily when we make
+ up our minds to get hold of a ship and sail away. Money would be of no use
+ to us here, but we shall want it when we get to a port, wherever that port
+ may be.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That sounds right enough, Captain,&rdquo; one of the convicts said, &ldquo;and just
+ at present nothing would suit me better than to get so far away from this
+ place that I can lay on my back and take it easy for a spell.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a general chorus of assent, and there being neither tobacco nor
+ spirits, the party very soon stretched themselves off to sleep round the
+ fire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In the morning they were up before daylight, and half an hour later
+ arrived at one of the farms farthest from Sydney. Here they found a flock
+ of a hundred sheep. The shepherd came to the door of his hut on hearing a
+ noise.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You had best lie down and go to sleep for the next hour,&rdquo; the leader of
+ the convicts said sharply. &ldquo;We don't want to do an old pal any harm, and
+ when you wake up in the morning and find the flock some twenty short, of
+ course you won't have any idea what has come of them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The man nodded and went back into the hut and shut the door, and the
+ convicts started for the interior, driving twenty sheep before them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ During the first day's journey they went fast, keeping the sheep at a trot
+ before them, and continuing their journey through the heat of the day.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I tell you what, Captain,&rdquo; one of the men said when they halted at
+ sunset, &ldquo;if we don't get to a water hole we shall have to give up this
+ idea of going and camping in the bush. My mouth has been like an oven all
+ day, and it is no use getting away from jail to die of thirst out here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There had been similar remarks during the day, and the two leaders agreed
+ together that it would be madness to push further, and that, whatever the
+ risk, they would have to return to the settlements unless they could
+ strike water. As they were sitting moodily round the fire they were
+ startled by a dozen natives coming forward into the circle of light. These
+ held out their hands to say that their intentions were peaceful.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Don't touch your muskets!&rdquo; Captain Wild exclaimed sharply, as some of the
+ men were on the point of jumping to their feet. &ldquo;The men are friendly, and
+ we may be able to get them to guide us to water.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The natives, as they came up, grinned and rubbed their stomachs, to show
+ that they were hungry.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I understand,&rdquo; the Captain said; &ldquo;you want a sheep, we want water;&rdquo; and
+ he held up his hand to his mouth and lifted his elbow as if in the act of
+ drinking.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In two or three minutes the natives understood what he wanted, and
+ beckoned to the men to follow. The tired sheep were got onto their legs
+ again, and half a mile away the party arrived at a pool in what in wet
+ weather was the bed of a river. A sheep was at once handed over to the
+ natives, and when the men had satisfied their thirst another sheep was
+ killed for their own use.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After a great deal of trouble the natives were made to understand that the
+ white men wanted one of their party to go with them as a guide, and to
+ take them always to water holes, and a boy of fifteen was handed over to
+ them in exchange for two more sheep, and at daybreak the next morning they
+ started again for the interior, feeling much exhilarated by the piece of
+ luck that had befallen them. They traveled for four days more, and then,
+ considering that the soldiers had ceased their pursuit long ago, they
+ encamped for ten days, enjoying to the utmost their recovered freedom and
+ their immunity from work of any kind. Then they returned to the
+ neighborhood of the settlements, and broke up, as their leader proposed,
+ into pairs.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They had been there but a short time before the depredations committed
+ roused the settlers to band themselves together. Every horse that could be
+ spared was lent to the military, who formed a mounted patrol of forty men,
+ while parties of infantry, guided by native trackers, were constantly on
+ the scent for the convicts.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;This is just what I expected,&rdquo; Captain Wild said to his lieutenant. &ldquo;It
+ was the choice of two evils, and I am not sure that the plan we chose was
+ not the worst. We might have been quite sure that these fellows would not
+ be able, even for a time, to give up their old ways. If they had confined
+ themselves, as we have done, to taking a sheep when they wanted it, and
+ behaving civilly when they went to one of the houses and begged for a few
+ pounds of flour or tea, the settlers would have made no great complaint of
+ us; they know what a hard time we have had, and you can see that some of
+ the women were really sorry for us, and gave us more than we actually
+ asked for. But it has not been so with the others. They had been breaking
+ into houses, stealing every thing they could lay their hands upon, and in
+ three or four cases shooting down men on the slightest provocation.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The money and watches were no good to them, but the brutes could not help
+ stealing them; so here we are, and the settlement is like a swarm of angry
+ bees, and this plan of handing over most of their horses to the military
+ will end in all of us being hunted down if we stay here. Two were shot
+ yesterday, and in another week we shall all either be killed or caught.
+ There is nothing for it but to clear out. I am against violence, not on
+ principle, but because in this case it sets people's backs up; but it
+ cannot be helped now. We must get a couple of horses to ride, and a spare
+ one to carry our swag. We must have half a sack of flour and a sheep&mdash;it
+ is no use taking more than one, because the meat won't keep&mdash;and a
+ good stock of tea and sugar. We must get a good supply of powder, if we
+ can, some bullets and shot. We shall have to get our meat by shooting.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is no time to be lost, and tonight we had better go to that
+ settler's place nearest the town. He has got two of the best horses out
+ here&mdash;at least so Redgrave, that shepherd I was talking to today,
+ told me&mdash;and a well filled store of provisions. If he will let us
+ have them without rumpus, all well and good; if not, it will be the worse
+ for him. My idea is that we should ride two or three hundred miles along
+ the coast until we get to a river, follow it up till we find a tidy place
+ for a camp, and stop there for three or four months, then come back again
+ and keep ourselves quiet until we find out that a ship is going to sail;
+ then we will do a night among the farmhouses, and clean them out of their
+ watches and money, manage to get on board, and hide till we are well out
+ to sea. We must get a fresh fit out before we go on board; these clothes
+ are neither handsome nor becoming. We must put on our best manners, and
+ tell them that we are men who have served our full time, and want to get
+ back, and that we were obliged to hide because we had not enough to pay
+ our full passage money, but that we have enough to pay the cost of our
+ grub, and are ready to pull at a rope and make ourselves useful in any
+ way. If we are lucky we ought to get enough before we start to buy horses
+ and set ourselves up well in business at home.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think that is a very good plan,&rdquo; the other agreed, &ldquo;and I am quite sure
+ the sooner we make ourselves scarce here the better.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0006" id="link2HCH0006">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER VI.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ While arranging for young Bastow being sent out with the first batch of
+ convicts John Thorndyke had been introduced to several of the officials of
+ the Department, and called upon them at intervals to obtain news of the
+ penal colony. Three years after its establishment a Crown colony had been
+ opened for settlement in its vicinity. As the climate was said to be very
+ fine and the country fertile, and land could be taken up without payment,
+ the number who went out was considerable, there being the additional
+ attraction that convicts of good character would be allotted to settlers
+ as servants and farm hands.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Six years after Arthur Bastow sailed the Squire learned that there had
+ been a revolt among the convicts; several had been killed, and the mutiny
+ suppressed, but about a dozen had succeeded in getting away. These had
+ committed several robberies and some murders among the settlers, and a
+ military force and a party of warders from the prison were scouring the
+ country for them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; the official said, &ldquo;the Governor in his report
+ does not gives us the names of any of those concerned in the matter; he
+ simply says that although the mutiny was general, it was wholly the work
+ of a small number of the worse class of prisoners. By worse class he means
+ the most troublesome and refractory out there. The prisoners are not
+ classified according to their original crimes. A poacher who has killed a
+ game keeper, or a smuggler who has killed a revenue officer, may in other
+ respects be a quiet and well conducted man, while men sentenced for
+ comparatively minor offenses may give an immense deal of trouble. I will,
+ however, get a letter written to the Governor, asking him if Arthur Bastow
+ was among those who took part in the revolt, and if so what has become of
+ him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was more than a year before the reply came, and then the Governor
+ reported that Arthur Bastow, who was believed to have been the leading
+ spirit of the mutiny, was among those who had escaped, and had not yet
+ been recaptured. It was generally believed that he had been killed by the
+ blacks, but of this there was no actual proof.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mr. Bastow was much disturbed when he heard the news. &ldquo;Suppose he comes
+ back here, Mr. Thorndyke.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I won't suppose anything of the sort,&rdquo; the Squire replied. &ldquo;I don't say
+ that it would be altogether impossible, because now that vessels go from
+ time to time to Sydney, he might, of course, be able to hide up in one of
+ them, and not come on deck until she was well on her way, when, in all
+ probability, he would be allowed to work his passage, and might be put
+ ashore without any information being given to the authorities. I have no
+ doubt that among the sailors there would be a good deal of sympathy felt
+ for the convicts. No doubt they have a hard time of it, and we know that
+ the gangs working on the roads are always ironed. Still, this is very
+ unlikely, and the chances are all in favor of his being in hiding in the
+ bush.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The shepherds and other hands on the farms are chiefly convicts, and
+ would probably give him aid if he required it, and there would be no
+ difficulty in getting a sheep, now and then, for, as all reports say, one
+ of the chief troubles out there are the wild dogs, or dingoes, as they are
+ called; any loss in that way would readily be put down to them. As to
+ money, he would have no occasion for it; if he wanted it he would get it
+ by robbing the settlers, he would know that if he came back here he would
+ run the risk of being seized at once on landing or of being speedily
+ hunted down as an escaped convict. I don't think that there is the
+ slightest occasion for us to trouble ourselves about him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ But though the Squire spoke so confidently, he felt by no means sure that
+ Arthur Bastow would not turn up again, for his reckless audacity had made
+ a great impression upon him. The proceeds of the robberies in the colony,
+ in which he had no doubt played a part, would have furnished him with
+ money with which he could bribe a sailor to hide him away and, if
+ necessary, pay his passage money to England, when discovered on board, and
+ perhaps maintain him when he got home until he could replenish his purse
+ by some unlawful means. Lastly, the Squire argued that the fellow's
+ vindictive nature and longing for revenge would act as an incentive to
+ bring him back to London. He talked the matter over with Mark, who was now
+ a powerful young fellow of twenty, who, of course, remembered the
+ incidents attending Bastow's capture and trial.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I cannot help fancying that the fellow will come back, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, if he does, father, we must make it our business to lay him by the
+ heels again. You managed it last time, and if he should turn up you may be
+ sure I will help you to do it again.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, but we may not hear of his having returned until he strikes a blow.
+ At any rate, see that your pistols are loaded and close at hand at night.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;They always are, father. There is no saying when a house like this,
+ standing alone, and containing a good deal of plate and valuables, may be
+ broken into.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, you might as well carry them always when you go out after dark. I
+ shall speak to Knapp, and request him to let me know if he hears of a
+ suspicious looking character&mdash;any stranger, in fact&mdash;being
+ noticed in or about the village, and I shall have a talk with Simeox, the
+ head constable at Reigate, and ask him to do the same. He is not the same
+ man who was head at the time Bastow was up before us, but he was in the
+ force then, and, as one of the constables who came up to take the
+ prisoners down to Reigate, he will have all the facts in his mind. He is a
+ sharp fellow, and though Bastow has no doubt changed a good deal since
+ then, he would hardly fail to recognize him if his eye fell upon him. Of
+ course we may be alarming ourselves unnecessarily, but there are several
+ reasons why I should object strongly to be shot just at the present time.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Or at any other time, I should say, father,&rdquo; the young man said with a
+ laugh.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall know him, Squire, safe enough,&rdquo; the head constable replied when
+ John Thorndyke went down to see him on the following day; &ldquo;but I should
+ think that if he does come back to England he will hardly be fool enough
+ to come down here. He was pretty well known in town before that affair,
+ and everyone who was in the courthouse would be sure to have his face
+ strongly impressed upon their minds. You may forget a man you have seen
+ casually, but you don't forget one you have watched closely when he is in
+ the dock with two others charged with murder. Five out of my six men were
+ constables at that time, and would know him again the minute they saw him;
+ but anyhow, I will tell them to keep a sharp lookout in the tramps'
+ quarters, and especially over the two or three men still here that Bastow
+ used to consort with. I should say that Reigate is the last place in the
+ world where he would show his face.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hope so,&rdquo; the Squire said. &ldquo;He has caused trouble enough down here as
+ it is; his father is getting an old man now, and is by no means strong,
+ and fresh troubles of that kind would undoubtedly kill him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A month later the Reigate coach was stopped when a short distance out of
+ the town by two highwaymen, and a considerable prize obtained by the
+ robbers. Soon afterwards came news of private carriages being stopped on
+ various commons in the South of London, and of several burglaries taking
+ place among the houses round Clapham, Wandsworth, and Putney. Such events
+ were by no means uncommon, but following each other in such quick
+ succession they created a strong feeling of alarm among the inhabitants of
+ the neighborhood. John Thorndyke, going up to town shortly afterwards,
+ went to the headquarters of the Bow Street runners, and had a talk with
+ their chief in reference especially to the stoppage of the Reigate coach.
+ Mr. Chetwynd had lately died, and John Thorndyke had been unanimously
+ elected by his fellow magistrates as chairman of the bench.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, Mr. Thorndyke, we have no clew whatever. Our men have been keeping
+ the sharpest watch over the fellows suspected of having a hand in such
+ matters, but they all seem keeping pretty quiet at present, and none of
+ them seem to be particularly flush with money. It is the same with these
+ burglaries in the South of London. We are at our wits' end about them. We
+ are flooded with letters of complaint from residents; but though the
+ patrols on the common have been doubled and every effort made, we are as
+ far off as ever. As far as the burglaries are concerned, we have every
+ reason to think that they are the work of two or three new hands. The jobs
+ are not neatly done, and certainly not with tools usually used by
+ burglars. They seem to rely upon daring rather than skill. Anyhow, we
+ don't know where to look for them, and are altogether at sea.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course it is as annoying to us as it is to anyone else; more so,
+ because the Justices of the Peace are sending complaints to the Home
+ Secretary, and he in turn drops on us and wants to know what we are doing.
+ I have a sort of fancy myself the fellows who are stopping the coaches are
+ the same as those concerned in the burglaries. I could not give you my
+ reasons for saying so, except that on no occasion has a coach been stopped
+ and a house broken into on the same night. I fancy that at present we
+ shan't hear much more of them. They have created such alarm that the
+ coaches carry with them two men armed with blunderbusses, in addition to
+ the guards, and I should fancy that every householder sleeps with pistols
+ within reach, and has got arms for his servants. At many of the large
+ houses I know a watchman has been engaged to sit in the hall all night, to
+ ring the alarm bell and wake the inmates directly he hears any suspicious
+ sounds. Perhaps the fellows may be quiet for a time, for they must, during
+ the last month, have got a wonderful amount of spoil. Maybe they will go
+ west&mdash;the Bath road is always a favorite one with these fellows&mdash;maybe
+ they will work the northern side of the town. I hope we shall lay hands
+ upon them one day, but so far I may say frankly we have not the slightest
+ clew.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But they must put their horses up somewhere?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, but unfortunately there are so many small wayside inns, that it is
+ next to impossible to trace them. A number of these fellows are in
+ alliance with the highwaymen. Some of them, too, have small farms in
+ addition to their public house businesses, and the horses may be snugly
+ put up there, while we are searching the inn stables in vain. Again, there
+ are rogues even among the farmers themselves; little men, perhaps, who do
+ not farm more than thirty or forty acres, either working them themselves,
+ or by the aid of a hired man who lives perhaps at a village a mile away.
+ To a man of this kind, the offer of a couple of guineas a week to keep two
+ horses in an empty cowshed, and to ask no questions, is a heavy
+ temptation.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have got two clever fellows going about the country inquiring at all
+ the villages whether two mounted men have lately been heard going through
+ there late at night, or early in the morning, so as to narrow down the
+ area to be searched, but nothing has come of it, although I am pretty sure
+ that they must have three or four places they use in various directions.
+ My men have picked up stories of horsemen being heard occasionally, but
+ they come from various directions, and nowhere have they been noticed with
+ any regularity. Besides, there are other knights of the road about, so we
+ are no nearer than we were on that line of inquiry.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A month later John Thorndyke had occasion to go up again to town. This
+ time Mark accompanied him. Both carried pistols, as did the groom, sitting
+ behind them. The Squire himself was but a poor shot, but Mark had
+ practiced a great deal.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'Tis a good thing to be able to shoot straight, Mark,&rdquo; his father had
+ said to him three years before. &ldquo;I abhor dueling, but there is so much of
+ it at present that any gentlemen might find himself in a position when he
+ must either go out or submit to be considered a coward. Then, too, the
+ roads are infested by highwaymen. For that reason alone it would be well
+ that a man should be able to shoot straight. You should also practice
+ sometimes at night, setting up some object at a distance so that you can
+ just make out its outline, and taking a dozen shots at it. I know it is
+ very difficult when you cannot see your own pistol, but you can soon learn
+ to trust to your arm to come up to the right height and in the right
+ direction. Of course you must wait until morning to find out where your
+ bullet has gone.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Two days after they had reached town the Squire received a letter from
+ Mrs. Cunningham.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;DEAR MR. THORNDYKE:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Knapp has been up this morning to tell me that a stranger dismounted
+ yesterday at the alehouse, and while his horse was being fed he asked a
+ few questions. Among others, he wished to be told if you were at home,
+ saying that he had known you some fifteen years ago, when you lived near
+ Hastings, and should like to have a talk with you again. In fact, he had
+ turned off from the main road for the purpose. He seemed disappointed when
+ he heard that you had gone up to town, and hearing that you might not be
+ back for three or four days, said he should be coming back through Reigate
+ in a week or ten days, and he dared say he should be able to find time to
+ call again. Knapp did not hear about it until this morning; he asked the
+ landlord about the man, and the landlord said he was about thirty, dark,
+ and sparely built. He did not notice his horse particularly, seeing that
+ it was such as a small squire or farmer might ride. He carried a brace of
+ pistols in his holsters. The landlord was not prepossessed with his
+ appearance, and it was that that made him speak to Knapp about him. I have
+ told the men to unfasten the dogs every night, and I have asked Knapp to
+ send up two trustworthy men to keep watch.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It may mean something, and it may not,&rdquo; the Squire said, as he handed the
+ letter to Mark. &ldquo;It is a suspicious looking circumstance; if the fellow
+ had been honest he would surely have said something about himself. There
+ is no doubt these housebreakers generally find out what chance there is of
+ resistance, and, hearing that we were both away, may have decided on
+ making an attempt. I have pretty well finished our business and ordered
+ nearly all the provisions that Mrs. Cunningham requires. But I have to
+ call at my lawyer's, and that is generally a longish business. It is half
+ past two o'clock now; if we start from here at five we shall be down soon
+ after eight, which will be quite soon enough. We shall have a couple of
+ hours' drive in the dark, but that won't matter, we have got the lamps.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am quite ready to start, father. I am engaged to sup with Reginald
+ Ascot, but I will go over this afternoon and make my excuses.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At five o'clock they started. &ldquo;You have got your pistols in order, Mark?&rdquo;
+ the Squire asked, as they drove over London Bridge.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have them handy, father, one in each pocket.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;James, are your pistols charged?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, sir.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At six o'clock it was beginning to get dusk, and they stopped while the
+ groom got down and lit the lamps; then they resumed their journey. They
+ were within five miles of Reigate when suddenly two horsemen rode out from
+ a side road with a shout of &ldquo;Stand and deliver!&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Squire lashed the horses, and a moment later a pistol was fired, and
+ the ball went through his hat. By the light of the lamps Mark saw the
+ other man raise his hand, and, leveling his pistol, fired on the instant;
+ then, as there was no reply to his shot, he discharged the second barrel
+ at the first who had fired, and who had at once drawn another pistol. The
+ two reports rang out almost at the same moment, but Mark's was a little
+ the first. There was a sharp exclamation of pain from the highwayman, who
+ wrenched round his horse and galloped down the lane from which he had
+ issued, the groom sending two bullets after him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Where is the other man?&rdquo; Mark exclaimed, as his father reined in the
+ horses.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Somewhere on the ground there, Mark; I saw him fall from his saddle as we
+ passed him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Is it any use pursuing the other, father? I am pretty sure I hit him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am quite sure you did, but it is no good our following; the side roads
+ are so cut up by ruts that we should break a spring before we had gone a
+ hundred yards. No, we will stop and look at this fellow who is unhorsed,
+ Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The groom got down, and, taking one of the carriage lamps, proceeded to a
+ spot where the highwayman's horse was standing. The man was already dead,
+ the bullet having hit him a few inches above the heart.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is dead, father.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think you had better lift him up on the foot board behind; James can
+ ride his horse. We will hand the body over to the constable at Reigate. He
+ may know who he is, or find something upon him that may afford a clew that
+ will lead to the capture of his companion.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I don't know him, Squire,&rdquo; the constable said as they stopped before
+ his house and told him what had happened. &ldquo;However, he certainly is dead,
+ and I will get one of the men to help me carry him into the shed behind
+ the courthouse. So you say that you think that the other is wounded?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am pretty sure he is. I heard him give an exclamation as my son fired.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is good shooting, Mr. Mark,&rdquo; the constable said. &ldquo;If every passenger
+ could use his arms as you do there would soon be an end to stopping
+ coaches. I will see what he has got about him, and will come up and let
+ you know, Squire, the first thing in the morning.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will send Knapp down,&rdquo; John Thorndyke said, as they drove homewards. &ldquo;I
+ am rather curious to know if this fellow is the same Mrs. Cunningham wrote
+ about. I will tell him to take Peters along with him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hardly see that there can be any connection between the two. Highwaymen
+ don't go in for house breaking. I think they consider that to be a lower
+ branch of the profession.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Generally they do, no doubt, Mark; but you know I told you that the chief
+ at Bow Street said that he had a suspicion that the highway robbers and
+ the house breakers who have been creating so much alarm are the same men.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is curious that they should have happened to light on us, father, if
+ they were intending to break into our house.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ John Thorndyke made no reply, and in a few minutes drove up to the house.
+ Their return, a couple of days before they were expected, caused great
+ satisfaction to Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent. The former, however, had
+ wisely kept from the girl the matter on which she had written to the
+ Squire, and the suspicion she had herself entertained.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is very dull without you both,&rdquo; Millicent said. &ldquo;I was telling Mrs.
+ Cunningham that I thought it would be a good thing, when you got back, for
+ us two to take a run up to town for a week, just to let you see how dull
+ the place is when two of us are away. You are looking quite serious,
+ uncle. Is anything the matter?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Happily nothing is the matter with us, dear, but we have had an
+ adventure, and not a very pleasant one.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What was it?&rdquo; the girl asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If you examine my hat closely, Millicent, it will tell you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The girl took up the hat from a chair on which he had put it, and brought
+ it to the light. &ldquo;There are two holes in it,&rdquo; she said. &ldquo;Oh, Guardy, have
+ you been shot at?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It looks like it, dear. Two gentlemen highwaymen&mdash;at least, that is
+ what I believe they call themselves&mdash;asked us pressingly to stop, and
+ as we would not comply with their request, one fired at me, and, as you
+ see, it was an uncommonly good shot. The other was about to fire when
+ Mark's pistol put a stop to him, and his second barrel stopped the fellow
+ who had fired first; he was hit, for we heard him give an exclamation of
+ pain, but before any more shooting could be done he turned and rode off
+ down a narrow lane where we could not follow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And what became of the first?&rdquo; Millicent asked with open eyes.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He was dead before we could get down to examine him; he will not disturb
+ the King's peace again. It happened about four miles from home, so we
+ brought him in and gave him and his horse into the charge of the constable
+ at Reigate.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And you have really killed a man?&rdquo; Millicent said, looking up with an
+ awestruck expression to Mark.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, as the man would have killed us if I hadn't, I cannot say,
+ Millicent, that his death weighs in any way heavily on my mind. If he were
+ as good a shot as the other, my father's life would not have been worth
+ much, for as we were driving fast, he was not above half as far away as
+ the other had been when he fired. Just the same, I suppose, as it would be
+ in a battle; a man is going to shoot you, and you shoot him first, and I
+ don't suppose it ever troubles you afterwards.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course I don't mean that I blame you, Mark; but it does seem
+ shocking.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't suppose you would think that, Millicent, if a burglar, who had
+ taken one shot at you and was about to finish you with another, was cut
+ short in the operation by a shot from my pistol. I believe that your
+ relief and thankfulness would be so great that the idea that it was a
+ shocking thing for me to do would not as much as enter your head.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I wish you had shot the other man as well as the one you did, Mark,&rdquo; the
+ Squire said, as he walked with his son down to Reigate to attend the
+ inquest the next morning on the man he had brought in. Mark looked at his
+ father in surprise.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is no doubt I hit him, father,&rdquo; he said; &ldquo;but I should not think
+ that he will be likely to trouble us again.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I wish I felt quite sure of that. Do you know that I have a strong
+ suspicion that it was Arthur Bastow?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark had, of course, heard of Bastow's escape, but had attached no great
+ importance to it. The crime had taken place nearly eight years before, and
+ although greatly impressed at the time by the ill doings of the man, the
+ idea that he would ever return and endeavor to avenge himself on his
+ father for the part he had taken had not occurred to him. Beyond
+ mentioning his escape, the Squire had never talked to him on the subject.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It was he who bade us stand and deliver, and the moment he spoke the
+ voice seemed familiar to me, and, thinking it over, I have an impression
+ that it was his. I may be mistaken, for I have had him in my mind ever
+ since I heard that he had escaped, and may therefore have connected the
+ voice with him erroneously, and yet I cannot but think that I was right.
+ You see, there are two or three suspicious circumstances. In the first
+ place, there was this man down here making inquiries. Knapp went down
+ early this morning with the innkeeper, and told me before breakfast that
+ Peters at once recognized the fellow you shot as the man who had made the
+ inquiries. Now, the natural result of making inquiries would have been
+ that the two men would the next evening have broken into the house,
+ thinking that during our absence they would meet with no resistance.
+ Instead of doing this they waylaid us on the road, which looks as if it
+ was me they intended to attack, and not the house.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But how could they have known that it was us, father? It is certainly
+ singular that one of the two men should have been the fellow who was up at
+ the inn, but it may be only a matter of coincidence.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know, Mark; I don't say that singular coincidences don't occur,
+ but I have not much faith in them. Still, if they were journeying down to
+ attack the house last night they would hardly have stopped travelers by
+ the way when there was a rich booty awaiting them, as they evidently
+ believed there was, or that man would not have come down specially to make
+ inquiries. My own impression is that when they heard that we should return
+ in two or three days one of them watched us in London, and as soon as they
+ learned that we were to start for home at five o'clock they came down here
+ to stop us. They would hardly have done that merely to get our watches and
+ what money we had in our pockets.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I should think not, father; but they might be friends of men who have
+ got into trouble at Reigate, and, as you are chairman of the bench, may
+ have had a special grudge against you for their conviction.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is, of course, possible, and I hope that it is so.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But even if Arthur Bastow had escaped, father, why should he come back to
+ England, where he would know that he might be arrested again, instead of
+ staying quietly out in Australia?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There are two reasons. In the first place the life out there would not be
+ a quiet one; there would be nothing for him but to attack and rob the
+ settlers, and this, as they are sure to be armed, is a pretty dangerous
+ business. Then there are perils from the blacks, and lastly, such a life
+ would be absolutely devoid of comfort, and be that of a hunted dog; living
+ always in the bush, scarcely venturing to sleep lest he should be pounced
+ upon either by the armed constables of the colony or by the blacks. It is
+ not as if the country were extensively populated; there are not a very
+ large number of settlers there yet, and therefore very small scope for
+ robbers. These people would keep very little money with them, and the
+ amount of plunder to be got would be small indeed. Therefore, I take it
+ that the main object of any escaped convict would be to get away from the
+ place.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is one of the reasons why the fellow might come back to England in
+ spite of the risks. The other is that I believe him to be so diabolically
+ vindictive that he would run almost any peril in order to obtain revenge
+ upon me or his father. Twice he has threatened me, the first time when we
+ captured him, the second time as he left the court after he had received
+ his sentence. I am not a coward, so far as I know, Mark, but I am as
+ certain as I stand here that he meant what he said, and that, during these
+ years of imprisonment and toil out there, he has been cherishing the
+ thought of coming home some day and getting even with me. You see, he is
+ said to have been the leader of this convict revolt. There is no doubting
+ his daring, and to my mind the attack upon us last night, when they knew
+ that they could have managed a successful robbery here, points to the fact
+ that it was the result of personal animosity, and strengthens my belief
+ that it was Arthur Bastow who called upon us to stand and deliver.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a very unpleasant idea, father.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very unpleasant, and it seems to me that we should at any rate spare no
+ pains in hunting the man you wounded down.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will undertake that if you like. I have nothing particular to do, and
+ it would be an excitement. You have a lot to keep you here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't fancy that you will find it an excitement, Mark, for of course
+ the detectives will do the hunting, but I should certainly be glad if you
+ would take a letter for me to the head of the Detective Department, and
+ tell him what I think, and my reasons for thinking so, and say that I
+ offer a reward of a hundred pounds for the capture of the man who tried to
+ stop us, and who was, we are certain, wounded by you. Unless he has some
+ marvelously out of the way hiding place, it ought not to be difficult. A
+ wounded man could scarcely lie hidden in the slums of London without it
+ being known to a good many people, to some of whom a reward of the sum of
+ a hundred pounds would be an irresistible temptation.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ By this time they had reached Reigate. The inquest did not last many
+ minutes, and the jury without hesitation returned a verdict of justifiable
+ homicide.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0007" id="link2HCH0007">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER VII.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The next morning Mark went up to London.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; the chief at Bow Street said, &ldquo;your father's
+ suspicions as to the man's identity may or may not be justified; that,
+ however, makes no difference to us. Here is a highwayman who has been
+ wounded, and would certainly be a valuable capture: I will set my men to
+ work at once; if he is in London they will get news of him before many
+ days. My men in any case would do their duty, but your father's offer will
+ certainly stimulate their energy. Where are you stopping?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;At the Bull, in Holborn.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very well; I will be sure to let you know as soon as we get any clew to
+ the man's identity.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark remained in London a week, and at the end of that time he received a
+ note from Bow Street saying that the superintendent wished to see him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am sorry that I have no news for you, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; the officer said,
+ when he called upon him. &ldquo;Every place where such a man would be likely to
+ be in hiding has been searched, and no clew whatever has been obtained. We
+ shall now circulate notices of the reward throughout the country. If the
+ man was at all severely hit, we may assume that he must be somewhere in
+ the neighborhood of London, whereas, if the wound was a slight one, he
+ might be able to go a long distance, and may be now in York, for aught we
+ know. However, now that the search in London has terminated, I can really
+ see no use in your staying here any longer; we will let you know directly
+ we have any news.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Three months later John Thorndyke received a letter from the Detective
+ Office asking him to call the next time he came up to town, as although no
+ news had been obtained that would lead to the man's immediate arrest, news
+ had at any rate been obtained showing that he was alive. It happened that
+ Mark was intending to go up on the following day, and his father asked him
+ to call for him at Bow Street.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Mr. Thorndyke, we have heard about your man, and that after we had
+ quite abandoned the search. I had come to the conclusion that the wound
+ you gave him had been a fatal one, and that he had been quietly buried by
+ some of the people with whom he was connected. The discovery was, as half
+ these discoveries generally are, the result of accident. Last week a
+ gentleman entered the Bank and asked for change in gold for a fifty pound
+ note. The cashier, looking at the number, found that it was one of those
+ that had been stolen from a passenger by one of the south coaches several
+ months ago. The gentleman was at once taken into a private office, and
+ questioned as to how he had obtained the note. The account that he gave
+ was that he was a surgeon in practice at Southampton. A gentleman had
+ arrived there on a date which we found to be the day after that on which
+ you were stopped; he was well dressed, and had the air of a gentleman; he
+ had come down by coach, and was evidently very ill. He told the surgeon
+ that he had been engaged in a duel, that the pistols had been discharged
+ simultaneously, and that he had killed his man, but had himself been
+ severely wounded. He said that the person whom he had killed had
+ influential connections, and that it would be necessary for him to remain
+ in seclusion for a time, and he asked him to take charge of his case, as
+ he had ample means of paying him handsomely. The surgeon examined the
+ wound, and found it to be indeed a serious one, and, as he thought,
+ probably fatal. However, having no doubt as to the truth of the story, he
+ had taken the gentleman in, and he remained under his charge until a week
+ before he came up to town.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;For the first month he had been dangerously ill, but he completely
+ recovered. The surgeon had no reason whatever for doubting his patient
+ being a gentleman; he was fashionably dressed, and had evidently changed
+ his clothes after the duel, as there were no bloodstains upon them. He
+ was, however, glad when he left, as his conversation did not please him
+ from its cynical tone. The Bank sent to us directly the man presented the
+ note, which he stated had been given to him in part payment for his
+ medical services and the board and lodging of the patient; the total
+ amount had been 75 pounds, and the balance was paid in gold. As he was
+ able to give several good references, and was identified by three
+ gentlemen, he was, of course, released. I have no doubt whatever that the
+ fellow he attended was your man. The surgeon said, whoever he was, he must
+ have been a man of iron resolution to have made such a journey in the
+ state he was.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No doubt he must have ridden straight to the place he used as his
+ headquarters, where he had his wound roughly bandaged, changed his
+ clothes, and had ridden in the morning to some point that the coach passed
+ on its way to Southampton. Of course we obtained a minute description from
+ the surgeon of the man's appearance. We found that the people at the coach
+ office had no remembrance of there being anyone answering to that
+ description among the persons who traveled by the coach, but of course
+ that would not go for much, for over three months have elapsed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;When the coachman who had driven the down coach that day came up to town,
+ we saw him, and he remembered perfectly that on or about that day he had
+ picked up a passenger at Kingston&mdash;a gentleman who was in very weak
+ health. There were only three inside passengers besides himself, and he
+ had to be assisted into the coach. The way bill, on being turned up,
+ showed that an inside passenger had been taken up at Kingston. I have
+ already sent down men to make inquiries at every village in the district
+ between Reigate and Kingston, and I trust that we shall lay hands on him,
+ especially now we have got an accurate description of him, while before we
+ were working in the dark in that respect.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What is the description, sir? My father is much interested on that point,
+ for, as I believe I told you, he has a strong suspicion that the fellow is
+ the man who was transported more than eight years ago to Australia, and
+ who made his escape from the prison there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I know. At first it appeared to me very improbable, but I am bound
+ to say the description tallies very closely with that given of him. The
+ surgeon took him to be nearly thirty; but after what he has gone through
+ he may well look three or four years older than he is. He had light hair,
+ rather small gray eyes, and a face that would have been good looking had
+ it not been for its supercilious and sneering expression.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can remember him,&rdquo; Mark said; &ldquo;and that answers very closely to him. I
+ should say that it is certainly Bastow, and my father made no mistake when
+ he asserted that he recognized his voice.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The officer added a note to the description in his register: &ldquo;Strongly
+ suspected of being Arthur Bastow, transported for connivance with
+ highwaymen; was leader of a mutiny in convict jail of Sydney two years and
+ a half ago. Made his escape.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is no doubt,&rdquo; he went on, &ldquo;that he is a desperate character. No
+ doubt he is the man who has been concerned in most of these robberies in
+ the southern suburbs. We must get hold of him if we can, and once we do so
+ there will be an end of his travels, for the mutiny in prison and escape
+ is a hanging business, putting aside the affairs since he got back. Well,
+ sir, I hope he will give you and your father no more trouble.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am sure I hope so,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;I suppose that the fellow who was shot
+ was one of the men who escaped with him from the convict prison.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is likely enough. Two would get home as easily as one, and the fact
+ that they were both strangers here would account for the difficulty our
+ men have had in their search for him. You see, we have had nothing
+ whatever to go on. You must not be too sanguine about our catching the man
+ in a short time: he is evidently a clever fellow, and I think it likely
+ that once he got back he lost no time in getting away from this part of
+ the country, and we are more likely to find him in the west or north than
+ we are of laying hands on him here. We will send descriptions all over the
+ country, and as soon as I hear of a series of crimes anywhere, I will send
+ off two of my best men to help the local constables.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On his return home Mark told his father what he had done.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I thought that I could not have been mistaken, Mark; we have got that
+ rascal on our hands again. I hope now that they have got a description of
+ him to go by, they will not be long before they catch him; but the way he
+ escaped after being badly wounded shows that he is full of resources, and
+ he may give them some trouble yet, if I am not mistaken. At any rate, I
+ will have a talk with the Reigate constable, and tell him that there is
+ very little doubt that the man who attacked us was Arthur Bastow, who has,
+ as we have heard, escaped from Botany Bay, and that he had best tell his
+ men to keep a sharp lookout for him, for that, owing to his animosity
+ against us for his former capture and conviction, it is likely enough that
+ sooner or later he will be in this neighborhood again. After his
+ determined attempt at my life when pretending to rob us, I shall certainly
+ not feel comfortable until I know that he is under lock and key.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I wish, Guardy, you would give up this magistrate's business,&rdquo; Millicent
+ said at dinner. &ldquo;I am sure that it is worrying you, and I can't see why
+ you should go on with it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It does not worry me, as a rule, Millicent; indeed, I like the duty.
+ Besides, every landowner of standing ought to take his share in public
+ work. There are only two of the magistrates younger than I am, and
+ whatever you may think of me, I feel myself capable of doing what work
+ there is to do. When Mark gets a few years older I shall resign, and let
+ him take my place on the bench. I own, though, that I should be glad if
+ these highway robberies could be suppressed. Poaching and the ordinary
+ offenses of drunkenness and assaults are disposed of without any trouble;
+ but this stopping of the coaches, accompanied occasionally by the shooting
+ of the coachman or guard, gives a great deal of trouble, and the worst of
+ it is that we are practically powerless to put such crimes down. Nothing
+ short of patrolling the roads in parties of three or four between sunset
+ and sunrise would put a stop to them, and the funds at our disposal would
+ not support such an expenditure.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a pity that you cannot get up a corps like the yeomanry, and call
+ it the Mounted Constabulary,&rdquo; said Mark. &ldquo;There are at least a dozen
+ fellows I know who would, like myself, be glad to join it, and I dare say
+ we could get a score of young farmers or farmers' sons.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is not a bad idea, Mark, and I dare say that for a time the duty would
+ be zealously performed, but before very long you would tire of it. A few
+ wet nights or winter's cold, and you would cease to see the fun of it,
+ especially as you may be sure that the news that the roads are well
+ patrolled would soon come to the ears of these scoundrels, and they would
+ cease to work in the district.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Perhaps you are right, sir; but I think that a few of us would stick to
+ it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Perhaps so, Mark, but I should be sorry to wager that the work would be
+ thoroughly done. The first county or hunt ball, or even dinner party, more
+ than half of them would be away. I don't say that you personally might not
+ for some considerable time persist in patrolling the roads, for you have a
+ sort of personal interest in the matter; but I would wager that before two
+ months have passed you would find you were the only one who attended at
+ the rendezvous regularly.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A fortnight later the party were seated round the fire in the dusk. Mr.
+ Bastow was sitting next to the Squire, and was in unusually good spirits.
+ He had heard no word of what the Squire had discovered, nor dreamed that
+ his son was again in England, still less that he was suspected of being
+ one of the men who had endeavored to stop the Squire and his son on their
+ drive from London. Suddenly there was the crack of a pistol outside, and a
+ ball passed between him and the Squire. Without a word, Mark Thorndyke
+ rushed to the door, seized a pistol from his riding coat, and, snatching
+ up a heavy whip, dashed out into the garden.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He was just in time to see a figure running at full speed, and he set off
+ in pursuit. Good runner as he was, he gained but slightly at first, but
+ after a time he drew nearer to the fugitive. The latter was but some sixty
+ yards away when he leaped a hedge into a narrow lane. Mark followed
+ without hesitation, but as he leaped into the road he heard a jeering
+ laugh and the sharp sound of a horse's hoofs, and knew that the man he was
+ pursuing had gained his horse and made off. Disgusted at his failure, he
+ went slowly back to the house. The shutters had been put up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have lost him, father. He ran well to begin with, but I was gaining
+ fast on him when he leaped into a narrow lane where he had left his horse,
+ and rode off before I could get up to him. I need hardly say that there
+ was no use attempting to follow on foot. He missed you all, did he not?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, Mark. It is not so easy to take an accurate aim when it is nearly
+ dark. The bullet passed between myself and Mr. Bastow, and has buried
+ itself in the mantelpiece.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Something ought to be done, Guardy,&rdquo; Millicent Conyers said indignantly.
+ &ldquo;It is shameful that people cannot sit in their own room without the risk
+ of being shot at. What can it mean? Surely no one can have any enmity
+ against you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hope not, my dear,&rdquo; John Thorndyke said lightly. &ldquo;Some of the fellows
+ we have sentenced may think that we were rather hard on them, but I do not
+ think that any of them would feel it sufficiently to attempt to murder
+ one; besides, Mark says that the fellow had a horse waiting for him, and
+ none of our poachers would be likely to be the owner of a horse. It may be
+ that the highwayman Mark shot at and wounded has come down to give us a
+ fright. It is no use worrying about it now; in future we will have the
+ shutters closed at sunset. It is hardly likely that the thing will be
+ attempted again, and Mark's chase must have shown the fellow that the game
+ is hardly worth the risk.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He might have shot you, Mark; you had no right to risk your life in that
+ sort of way,&rdquo; the girl said to him, later, as they were seated together in
+ front of the fire, while the Squire was reading the Gazette at the table,
+ Mrs. Cunningham was working, and Mr. Bastow, who had been greatly shaken
+ by the event, had retired to bed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you think that he really meant to kill your father?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should imagine he did; a man would hardly run the risk of being hung
+ merely for the pleasure of shooting. I would give a good deal if I had
+ caught him, or better still, if I had shot him,&rdquo; said Mark. &ldquo;However, I
+ will make it my business to hunt the fellow down. After this evening's
+ affair, we shall never feel comfortable until he is caught. I have no
+ doubt that he is the fellow we have been hunting for the last four months.
+ The people at Bow Street seem no good whatever; I will try if I cannot
+ succeed better.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Don't do anything rash, Mark,&rdquo; said Millicent, in a low voice; &ldquo;you have
+ no right to put yourself in danger.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But our lives are in danger now, Millicent&mdash;in much greater danger
+ than mine would be when looking out for him. But there seems no guarding
+ against attacks like this; I mean to hunt him down, if it takes me a year.
+ I have nothing special to do, and cannot employ my time more usefully.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When the ladies went up to bed the Squire said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Come into the library, Mark, and we will smoke a pipe, and have a talk
+ over this business.&rdquo; He touched the bell. &ldquo;Have you got a good fire in the
+ library, Ramoo?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, sahib, very good.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then take a bottle of number one bin of port there&mdash;and a couple of
+ glasses.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When they were quietly seated, glasses filled, and the long pipes alight,
+ the Squire said: &ldquo;I want to have a serious talk with you, Mark. What I am
+ going to say will surprise you a good deal. I had not intended to tell you
+ for another four years&mdash;that is to say, not until Millicent came of
+ age&mdash;but after that affair tonight, I feel that my life is so
+ uncertain that I ought not to delay letting you know the truth. I suppose
+ you agree with me that it was Bastow who shot at me this evening?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have not the least doubt about that, father.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will not say that he shot at me,&rdquo; the Squire said, &ldquo;for he may have
+ shot at his father; the villain is quite capable of that. It was his
+ father who brought me upon him, and though I effected his capture eight
+ years ago I don't suppose he cares which of us he killed. However, the
+ point is not what he aimed at, but whether it was he, and that I take
+ there is no doubt about. He missed me this time, but his next shot may be
+ more successful, At any rate, I think that it is high time that I told you
+ the story.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ And, beginning with the arrival of Colonel Thorndyke at his place, he
+ repeated the conversation that he had had with him. Several times in the
+ early portion of his narrative he was interrupted by exclamations of
+ surprise from his son.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then Millicent is really my uncle's heiress!&rdquo; exclaimed Mark, when he
+ heard the request the Colonel had made of the Squire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is so, Mark. She does not know it herself, and it was my brother's
+ urgent wish that she should not know it until she came of age or until she
+ married. I fought against it to the utmost, but it was his dying prayer,
+ and I could not refuse it. My solicitor knows the facts of the matter, and
+ so does Mrs. Cunningham, who brought Millicent over from India when she
+ was only about a year old. I may say that I especially urged that it would
+ not be fair to you to be brought up to consider yourself to be heir to the
+ property, but he said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'Putting aside the estate, I have a considerable fortune. In the first
+ place, there are the accumulations of rent from the Reigate place. I have
+ never touched them, and they have been going on for twelve years. In. the
+ next place, the shaking of the pagoda tree has gone on merrily, and we all
+ made a comfortable pile. Then I always made a point of carrying about with
+ me two or three hundred pounds, and after the sacking of some of the
+ palaces I could pick up jewels and things from the troops for a trifle,
+ being able to pay money down. Even without the rents here, I have some
+ 50,000 pounds in money. I should think the jewels would be worth at least
+ as much more, irrespective of a diamond bracelet which is, I fancy, worth
+ more than the rest put together. It was stolen from the arm of some idol.'
+ He then explained how he got it, and the manner in which he had placed it
+ and the rest of his wealth in a secure position.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'Things stolen from a god are frightfully dangerous,' he said, 'for the
+ Brahmins or priests connected with the temples have been known to follow
+ them up for years, and in nine cases out of ten they get possession of
+ them again. Murder in such a case is meritorious, and I would not have
+ them in the house here, were they ten times the value they are. I know
+ that my clothes, my drawers, and everything belonging to me have been gone
+ through at night a score of times. Nothing has been stolen, but, being a
+ methodical man, I could generally see some displacement in the things that
+ told me they had been disturbed. They gave it up for a time, but I haven't
+ a shadow of a doubt that they have been watching me ever since, and they
+ may be watching me now, for anything I know. Now, half of that fortune I
+ have left by my will to your son; half to the girl. I will tell you where
+ the things are the last thing before I die.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'Now, mind, you must be careful when you get them. When I am dead you are
+ almost certain to be watched. You don't know what these fellows are. The
+ things must remain where they are until your boy comes of age. Don't let
+ him keep those diamonds an hour in his possession; let him pass them away
+ privately to some man in whom he has implicit confidence, for him to take
+ them to a jeweler's; let him double and turn and disguise himself so as to
+ throw everyone that may be spying on him off his track. If you can manage
+ it, the best way would be to carry them over to Amsterdam, and sell them
+ there.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I confess it seemed absurd, but it is a matter about which he would know
+ a great deal more than I do, and he was convinced that not only was he
+ watched, but that he owed his life simply to the fact that the fellows did
+ not know where the diamonds were hidden, and that by killing him they
+ would have lost every chance of regaining them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;So convinced was he of all this, that he would not tell me where he had
+ stowed them away; he seemed to think that the very walls would hear us,
+ and that these fellows might be hidden under the sofa, in a cupboard, or
+ up the chimney, for aught I know. He told me that he would tell me the
+ secret before he died; but death came so suddenly that he never had an
+ opportunity of doing so. He made a tremendous effort in his last moment,
+ but failed, and I shall never forget the anguish his face expressed when
+ he found himself powerless to speak; however, he pressed his snuffbox into
+ my hand with such a significant look that, being certain it contained some
+ clew to the mystery, and being unable to find a hidden spring or a
+ receptacle, I broke it open that night.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It contained a false bottom, and here are what I found in it. I stowed
+ them away in a secret drawer in that old cabinet that stands by my
+ bedside. It is in the bottom pigeonhole on the right hand side. I bought
+ the cabinet at a sale, and found the spring of the secret drawer quite
+ accidentally. I shall put the things back tonight, and you will know where
+ to look for them. You press against the bottom and up against the top
+ simultaneously, and the back then falls forward. The opening behind is
+ very shallow, and will hold but two or three letters. But, however, it
+ sufficed for this;&rdquo; and he handed Mark the coin and slip of paper.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But what are these, father?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;These are the clews by which we are to obtain the treasure.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As Mark examined them carefully the Squire stood up with his back to the
+ fire, and looking round walked to the door and said: &ldquo;I thought there was
+ a draught somewhere; either Ramoo did not shut the door when he went out
+ or it has come open again. It has done that once or twice before. When I
+ go into town tomorrow I will tell Tucker to send a man up to take the lock
+ off. Well, what do you make out of that?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can make out nothing,&rdquo; Mark replied. &ldquo;No doubt the coin is something to
+ be given to whoever is in charge of the treasure, and Masulipatam may be
+ the place where it is hidden.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, or it may be a password. It reminds one of the forty thieves
+ business. You go and knock at the door of a cave, a figure armed to the
+ teeth presents itself, you whisper in his ear 'Masulipatam,' he replies
+ 'Madras,' or 'Calcutta,' or something of that sort, you take out the coin
+ and show it to him, he takes out from some hidden repository a similar
+ one, compares the two, and then leads you to an inner cave piled up with
+ jewels.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark laughed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, it is no laughing matter, Mark,&rdquo; the Squire went on seriously. &ldquo;The
+ little comedy may not be played just as I have sketched it, but I expect
+ that it is something of the kind. That coin has to be shown, and the word
+ 'Masulipatam' spoken to the guardian, whoever he may be, of your uncle's
+ treasure. But who that guardian may be or how he is to be found is a
+ mystery. I myself have never tried to solve it. There was nothing whatever
+ to go upon. The things may be in England or, it may be, anywhere in India.
+ To me it looked an absolutely hopeless business to set about. I did not
+ see how even a first step was to be taken, and as I had this estate and
+ you and Millicent to look after, and was no longer a young man, I put the
+ matter aside altogether. You are young, you have plenty of energy, and you
+ have your life before you, and it is a matter of the greatest interest to
+ you.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Possibly&mdash;very improbably, mind, still possibly&mdash;when Millicent
+ comes of age and learns who she is, Mrs. Cunningham may be able to help
+ you. I have no idea whether it is so. I have never spoken to her about
+ this treasure of George's, but it is just possible that while he was in
+ town before he came down to me he may have given her some instructions
+ concerning it. Of course he intended to give me full particulars, but he
+ could hardly have avoided seeing that, in the event of my death, perhaps
+ suddenly before the time came for seeking the treasure, the secret would
+ be lost altogether. Whether he has told her or his lawyer or not I cannot
+ say, but I have all along clung to the hope that he took some such natural
+ precaution. Unless that treasure is discovered, the only thing that will
+ come to you is the half of the accumulated rents of this estate during the
+ ten years between my father's death and George's; these rents were paid to
+ our solicitors, and by them invested.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The rentals amount to about 2500 pounds a year, and of course there is
+ interest to be added, so that I suppose there is now some 25,000 pounds,
+ for I had out 2000 pounds when I came here, to set matters straight. I had
+ a great fight with the lawyers over it, but as I pointed out they had
+ failed altogether to see that the agent did his duty, and that at least a
+ couple of hundred a year ought to be expended in necessary repairs, I had
+ a right to at least that sum to carry out the work that ought to be done
+ from year to year. In addition to that sum I laid out about 1000 pounds a
+ year for the first three years I was here; so that practically 5000 pounds
+ was expended in rebuilding the village and doing repairs on the
+ homesteads; that, however, is not the point now. Altogether, then, there
+ is some 25,000 pounds to be divided between you and Millicent when she
+ becomes mistress of this property.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;According to the terms of my brother's will, I am still to remain here
+ until she marries; when she does so I shall, of course, go back to my own
+ little place; the income of that has been accumulating while I have been
+ here, my only expenses having been for clothes. I have taken nothing out
+ of this estate since I came here, and each year have paid to the
+ solicitors all balances remaining after discharging the household
+ expenses, these balances averaging 700 or 800 pounds a year. Of course the
+ income was absolutely left to me during the time I remained ostensible
+ owner, but I had no wish to make money out of a trust that I assumed
+ greatly against my will. That money is Millicent's; of course the house
+ had to be kept up in proper style whether I were here or not. Had she at
+ once come into possession, there must have been horses, and carriages, and
+ so on. I don't say that I have not had all the expenses of our living
+ saved; that I had no objection to; but I was determined at least not to
+ take a penny put of the estate beyond those expenses. You see, Mark, you
+ will have your 12,500 pounds anyhow, as soon as Millicent comes of age&mdash;not
+ a bad little sum&mdash;so that even if you never hear anything more of
+ this mysterious treasure you will not be penniless, or in anyway dependent
+ upon me. At my death, of course, you will come into the Sussex place, with
+ what savings there may be.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am sure I have no reason to grumble, father,&rdquo; Mark said heartily. &ldquo;Of
+ course it came upon me at first as a surprise that Millicent was the
+ heiress here, and it flashed through my mind for the moment that the best
+ thing would be to take a commission in the army, or to follow my uncle's
+ example, and get a cadetship in the Company's service. I have no doubt
+ that I should have enjoyed life either way quite as much or possibly more
+ than if I had gone on a good many years as heir to these estates, and
+ afterwards as Squire. Of course, now I shall make it my business to see if
+ it is possible to obtain some sort of clew to this treasure, and then
+ follow it up; but the first thing to which I shall give my mind will be to
+ hunt down Bastow. We shall never feel safe here as long as that fellow is
+ alive, and that will be the first thing I shall devote myself to. After
+ that I shall see about the treasure.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;As to that, Mark, I cannot impress upon you too strongly what your uncle
+ said. It may, of course, be a pure delusion on his part; but if he is
+ right, and some of these Hindoo fellows are still on the watch to obtain
+ that bracelet, you must use extraordinary precautions when you get it into
+ your hands; he advised me to take it across to Amsterdam, and either get
+ the stones recut or to sell them separately to different diamond merchants
+ there. He said that my life would not be worth an hour's purchase as long
+ as the stones were in my hands.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That rather looks, father, as if the things were somewhere in England;
+ had they been in India, you would have had them some months in your hands
+ before you could get them to Amsterdam.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I did not think of that before, Mark, and it is possible that you are
+ right; but I don't know; he might have thought that it would be impossible
+ for me to dispose of them at Madras or Calcutta, and may have assumed that
+ I should at once deposit them in a bank to be forwarded with other
+ treasure to England, or that I should get them packed away in the treasure
+ safe in the ship I came back by, and that I should not really have them on
+ my person till I landed in England, or until I took them from the Bank.
+ Still, I see that your supposition is the most likely, and that they may
+ all this time have been lying somewhere in London until I should present
+ myself with a gold coin and the word 'Masulipatam.'&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Suddenly Mark sprang to his feet, and pulled back the curtains across a
+ window, threw it up, and leaped into the garden, and there stood listening
+ for two or three minutes, with his pistol cocked in his hand. He stepped
+ for a moment into the room again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You had better put that light out, father or we may have another shot.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Did you hear anything, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I thought I did, father. I may have been mistaken, but I certainly
+ thought I heard a noise, and when I pulled the curtains aside the window
+ was not shut by three or four inches. I will have a look through the
+ shrubbery. That fellow may have come back again. Pull the curtains to
+ after me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will go with you, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I would rather you didn't, father; it would only make me nervous. I
+ shan't go into the shrubbery and give them a chance of getting first shot.
+ I shall hide up somewhere and listen. It is a still night, and if there is
+ anyone moving I am pretty sure to hear him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Squire turned down the lamp, drew the curtains, and seated himself by
+ the fire. It was three quarters of an hour before Mark returned. He shut
+ the window, and fastened it carefully.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I fancy you must have been mistaken, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I suppose that shot through the window has made me nervous. I certainly
+ did fancy I heard a noise there; it may have been a dead bough snapping,
+ or something of that sort; and of course, the window being partly open,
+ even though only three or four inches, any little noise would come in more
+ plainly than it otherwise would do. However, everything has been perfectly
+ quiet since I went out, and it is hardly likely indeed that the fellow
+ would have returned so soon after the hot chase I gave him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is very stupid&mdash;the window being left open,&rdquo; the Squire said. &ldquo;I
+ shall question Martha about it in the morning; it was her duty to see that
+ it was shut and fastened before drawing the curtains. Just at present one
+ can scarcely be too careful. I don't mean to deny that whether there was a
+ window open or not a burglar who wanted to get into the house could do so,
+ still there is no use in making their work more easy for them. I know, as
+ a rule, we are careless about such things; there has not been a burglary
+ in this part for years, and until lately the front door has never been
+ locked at night, and anyone could have walked in who wanted to. Of course
+ the servants don't know that there is any reason for being more careful at
+ present than usual.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I was thinking the other day of having shutters put to all these
+ downstair rooms. Some of them have got them, and some have not; still,
+ even with shutters, burglars can always get in if they want to do so. They
+ have only to cut round the lock of a door or to make a hole in a panel to
+ give them room to put an arm through and draw back a bolt, and the thing
+ is done. I know that all the silver is locked up every night in the safe,
+ for Ramoo sees to that, and I have never known him neglect anything under
+ his charge. Well, Mark, I don't know that it is any use sitting up longer,
+ we have plenty of time to talk the matter over; it is four years yet
+ before Millicent comes of age, though, of course, there is nothing to
+ prevent your setting out in quest of the treasure as soon as you like.
+ Still, there is no hurry about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;None whatever, father; but I don't mean to lose a day before I try to get
+ on the track of that villain Bastow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0008" id="link2HCH0008">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER VIII.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ Mark was some hours before he went to sleep. The news that he had heard
+ that evening was strange and startling. Full of health and strength, the
+ fact that he was not, as he had always supposed, the heir to the estate
+ troubled him not at all. The fact that in four years he would come in for
+ some twelve thousand pounds was sufficient to prevent his feeling any
+ uneasiness as to his future; and indeed in some respects it was not an
+ unpleasant idea that, instead of being tied down to the estate, he should
+ be able to wander at will, visit foreign countries, and make his own life.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In one respect he was sorry. His father had in the last year hinted more
+ than once that it would be a very nice arrangement if he were to make up a
+ match with his ward; he had laughed, and said that there would be plenty
+ of time for that yet. But the idea had been an agreeable one. He was very
+ fond of Millicent&mdash;fond, perhaps; in a cousinly way at present; but
+ at any rate he liked her far better than any of the sisters of his
+ friends. Of course she was only seventeen yet, and there was plenty of
+ time to think of marriage in another three years. Still, the thought
+ occurred to him several times that she was budding out into a young woman,
+ and every month added to her attractions. It was but the day before he had
+ said to himself that there was no reason to wait as long as three years,
+ especially as his father seemed anxious, and would evidently be glad were
+ the match to take place. Now, of course, he said to himself, that was at
+ an end. He had never given her any reason to suppose that he cared for
+ her, and now that she was the heiress and he comparatively poor, she would
+ naturally think that it was for the estate, and not for herself, that she
+ was wooed. Then there was the question of this curiously lost treasure,
+ with the mysterious clew that led to nothing. How on earth was he to set
+ about the quest? He puzzled for a long time over this, till at last he
+ fell asleep. He was roused by Ramoo entering the room.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What is it, Ramoo?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Me not know, sahib. Massa Thorndyke's door shut. Me no able to make him
+ hear.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is curious, Ramoo,&rdquo; Mark said, jumping hastily out of bed. &ldquo;I will
+ be with you in a minute.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He slipped on his trousers, coat, and slippers, and then accompanied Ramoo
+ to his father's door. He knocked again and again, and each time more
+ loudly, his face growing paler as he did so. Then he threw himself against
+ the door, but it was solid and heavy.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Fetch me an ax, Ramoo,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;There is something wrong here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Ramoo returned in a short time with two men servants and with the ax in
+ his hands. Mark took it, and with a few mighty blows split the woodwork,
+ and then hurling himself against the door, it yielded. As he entered the
+ room a cry broke from his lips. Within a pace or two of the bed the Squire
+ lay on the ground, on his face, and a deep stain on the carpet at once
+ showed that his death had been a violent one. Mark knelt by his side now,
+ and touched him. The body was stiff and cold. The Squire must have been
+ dead for some hours.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Murdered!&rdquo; he said in a low voice; &ldquo;my father has been murdered.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He remained in horror struck silence for a minute or two; then he slowly
+ rose to his feet.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Let us lay him on the bed,&rdquo; he said, and with the assistance of the three
+ men he lifted and laid him there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He has been stabbed,&rdquo; he murmured, pointing to a small cut in the middle
+ of the deep stain, just over the heart.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Ramoo, after helping to lift the Squire onto the bed, had slid down to the
+ floor, and crouched there, sobbing convulsively. The two servants stood
+ helpless and aghast. Mark looked round the room: the window was open. He
+ walked to it. A garden ladder stood outside, showing how the assassin had
+ obtained entrance. Mark stood rigid and silent, his hands tightly
+ clenched, his breath coming slowly and heavily. At last he roused himself.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Leave things just as they are,&rdquo; he said to the men in a tone of unnatural
+ calmness, &ldquo;and fasten the door up again, and turn a table or something of
+ that sort against it on the outside so that no one can come in. John, do
+ you tell one of the grooms to saddle a horse and ride down into the town.
+ Let him tell the head constable to come up at once, and also Dr. Holloway.
+ Then he is to go on to Sir Charles Harris, tell him what has happened, and
+ beg him to ride over at once.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Come, Ramoo,&rdquo; he said in a softer voice, &ldquo;you can do no good here, poor
+ fellow, and the room must be closed. It is a heavy loss to you too.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Hindoo rose slowly, the tears streaming down his face.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He was a good master,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;and I loved him just as I loved the
+ Colonel, sahib. Ramoo would have given his life for him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ With his hand upon Ramoo's shoulder, Mark left the room; he passed a group
+ of women huddled together with blanched faces, at a short distance down
+ the passage, the news that the Squire's door could not be opened and the
+ sounds made by its being broken in having called them together. Mark could
+ not speak. He silently shook his head and passed on. As he reached his
+ room he heard shrieks and cries behind him, as the men informed them of
+ what had taken place. On reaching his door, the one opposite opened, and
+ Mrs. Cunningham in a dressing gown came out.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What is the matter, Mark, and what are these cries about?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;A dreadful thing has happened, Mrs. Cunningham; my father has been
+ murdered in the night. Please tell Millicent.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then he closed the door behind him, threw himself on his bed, and burst
+ into a passion of tears. The Squire had been a good father to him, and had
+ made him his friend and companion&mdash;a treatment rare indeed at a time
+ when few sons would think of sitting down in their father's presence until
+ told to do so. Since he had left school, eight years before, they had been
+ very much together. For the last two or three years Mark had been a good
+ deal out, but in this his father had encouraged him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I like to see you make your own friends, Mark, and go your own way,&rdquo; he
+ used to say; &ldquo;it is as bad for a lad to be tied to his father's coattail
+ as at his mother's apron string. Get fresh ideas and form your own
+ opinions. It will do for you what a public school would have done; make
+ you self reliant, and independent.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Still, of course, a great portion of his time had been with his father,
+ and they often would ride round the estate together and talk to the
+ tenants, or walk in the gardens and forcing houses. Generally Mark would
+ be driven by his father to the meet if it took place within reasonable
+ distance, his horse being sent on beforehand by a groom, while of an
+ evening they would sit in the library, smoke their long pipes, and talk
+ over politics or the American and French wars.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All this was over. There was but one thing now that he could do for his
+ father, and that was to revenge his death, and at the thought he rose from
+ his bed impatiently and paced up and down the room. He must wait for a
+ week, wait till the funeral was over, and then he would be on Bastow's
+ track. If all other plans failed he would spend his time in coaches until
+ at last the villain should try to stop one; but there must be other ways.
+ Could he find no other he would apply for employment as a Bow Street
+ runner, serve for a year to find out their methods, and acquaint himself
+ with the places where criminals were harbored. It would be the one object
+ of his life, until he succeeded in laying his hand on Bastow's shoulder.
+ He would not shoot him if he could help it. He should prefer to see him in
+ the dock, to hear the sentence passed on him, and to see it carried out.
+ As to the treasure, it was not worth a thought till his first duty was
+ discharged.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Presently a servant brought him a cup of tea. He drank it mechanically,
+ and then proceeded to dress himself. Sir Charles Harris would be here soon
+ and the others; indeed, he had scarcely finished when he was told that the
+ doctor from Reigate had just arrived, and that the constable had come up
+ half an hour before. He at once went down to the library, into which the
+ doctor had been shown.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have heard what has happened,&rdquo; he said, as he shook hands silently.
+ &ldquo;I expect Sir Charles Harris here in half an hour. I suppose you will not
+ go up till then?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I think it will be best that no one should go in until he comes. I
+ have been speaking to Simeox; he was going in, but I told him I thought it
+ was better to wait. I may as well take the opportunity of going upstairs
+ to see Mr. Bastow. I hear that he fainted when he heard the news, and that
+ he is completely prostrate.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Two such shocks might well prove fatal to him,&rdquo; Mark said; &ldquo;he has been
+ weak and ailing for some time.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Two shocks?&rdquo; the doctor repeated interrogatively.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Ah, I forgot you had not heard about the affair yesterday evening: a man
+ fired at us through the window when we were sitting round the fire, before
+ the candles were lit. The ball passed between my father's head and Mr.
+ Bastow's; both had a narrow escape; the bullet is imbedded in the
+ mantelpiece. I will have it cut out; it may be a useful item of evidence
+ some day.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But what could have been the man's motive? Your father was universally
+ popular.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Except with ill doers,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;I ran out and chased the fellow for
+ half a mile, and should have caught him if he had not had a horse waiting
+ for him in a lane, and he got off by the skin of his teeth. I hope that
+ next time I meet him he will not be so lucky. Mr. Bastow was very much
+ shaken, and went to bed soon afterwards. I am not surprised that this
+ second shock should be too much for him. Will you go up and see him? I
+ will speak to Simeox.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The constable was out in the garden.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;This is a terrible business, Mr. Thorndyke. I suppose, after what you
+ told me, you have your suspicions?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;They are not suspicions at all&mdash;they are certainties. Did you hear
+ that he tried to shoot my father yesterday evening?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, sir, I have heard nothing about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark repeated the story of the attempt and pursuit.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Could you swear to him,' Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, there was not much light left; besides, as I have not seen him for
+ the last eight years, I should certainly not be able to recognize him
+ unless I had time to have a good look at him. Had it only been last
+ night's affair it might have been anyone; but the shooting through the
+ window was not the act of a thief, but of an assassin, who could only have
+ been influenced by private enmity. I quite see that at present I have no
+ legal evidence against Bastow; I am not even in a position to prove that
+ he is in the country, for it cannot be said that my father's belief that
+ he recognized the voice of the man who said 'Stand and deliver!' is proof.
+ I doubt if anyone could swear that, when he only heard three words, he was
+ absolutely sure that it was the voice of a man he had not seen for some
+ years. However, fortunately, that will make no difference; the man is, as
+ I told you, wanted for his heading the mutiny in the convict prison at
+ Sydney, which will be quite sufficient to hang him without this business.
+ But I own that I should prefer that he were hung for my father's murder if
+ we could secure sufficient evidence. Moreover, there is the attack upon us
+ three or four months ago, and with the evidence of the surgeon who
+ attended him as to his wound, that would be enough to hang him. But we
+ have first got to catch him, and that I mean to make my business, however
+ long the search may take me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Was anything taken last night, sir?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know; I did not look. We shall see to that when we go upstairs.
+ We may as well go indoors now; Sir Charles may be here in a few minutes,
+ and I want to hear Dr. Holloway's report as to Mr. Bastow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He does not suspect, I hope, sir?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, thank God; my father never mentioned to him anything he heard about
+ his son, or his suspicions, therefore he has no reason to believe that the
+ fellow is not still in the convict prison at Sydney. We shall keep it from
+ him now, whatever happens; but it would, for his sake, be best that this
+ shock should prove too much for him. He has had a very hard time of it
+ altogether.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is terribly prostrate,&rdquo; the doctor reported when Mark joined him. &ldquo;I
+ don't think that he will get over it. He is scarcely conscious now. You
+ see, he is an old man, and has no reserve of strength to fall back upon.
+ Your father has been such a good friend to him that it is not surprising
+ the news should have been too much for him. I examined him at the Squire's
+ request some months ago as to his heart's action, which was so weak that I
+ told the Squire then that he might go off at any time, and I rather wonder
+ that he recovered even temporarily from the shock.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In a few minutes Sir Charles Harris drove up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;This is terrible news, my dear Mark,&rdquo; he said, as he leaped from his gig
+ and wrung Mark's hand&mdash;&ldquo;terrible. I don't know when I have had such a
+ shock; he was a noble fellow in all respects, a warm friend, an excellent
+ magistrate, a kind landlord, good all round. I can scarcely believe it
+ yet. A burglar, of course. I suppose he entered the house for the purpose
+ of robbery, when your father awoke and jumped out of bed, there was a
+ tussle, and the scoundrel killed him; at least, that is what I gather from
+ the story that the groom told me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is near it, Sir Charles, but I firmly believe that robbery was not
+ the object, but murder; for murder was attempted yesterday evening,&rdquo; and
+ he informed the magistrate of the shot fired through the window.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Bless me, you don't say so!&rdquo; the magistrate exclaimed. &ldquo;That alters the
+ case altogether, and certainly would seem to make the act one of
+ premeditated murder; and yet, surely, the Squire could not have had an
+ enemy. Some of the men whom we have sentenced may have felt a grudge
+ against him, but surely not sufficient to lead them to a crime like this.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will talk of it with you afterwards, Sir Charles. I have the very
+ strongest suspicions, although no absolute proofs. Now, will you first
+ come upstairs? Doctor Holloway is here and Simeox, but no one has entered
+ the room since I left it; I thought it better that it should be left
+ undisturbed until you came.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Quite so; we will go up at once.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ An examination of the room showed nothing whatever that would afford the
+ slightest clew. The Squire's watch was still in the watch pocket at the
+ head of the bed, his purse was on a small table beside him; apparently
+ nothing had been touched in the room.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If robbery was the object,&rdquo; Sir Charles said gravely, &ldquo;it has evidently
+ not been carried out, and it is probable that Mr. Thorndyke was partly
+ woke by the opening of the window, and that he was not thoroughly aroused
+ until the man was close to his bed; then he leapt out and seized him.
+ Probably the stab was, as Dr. Holloway assures us, instantly fatal, and he
+ may have fallen so heavily that the man, fearing that the house would be
+ alarmed at the sound, at once fled, without even waiting to snatch up the
+ purse. The whole thing is so clear that it is scarcely necessary to ask
+ any further questions. Of course, there must be an inquest tomorrow. I
+ should like when I go down to ask the gardener where he left the ladder
+ yesterday. Have you examined the ground for footmarks?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, Sir Charles, but you see it was a pretty hard frost last night, and
+ I cannot find any marks at all. The ground must have been like iron about
+ the time when the ladder was placed there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The gardener, on being called in, said that the ladder was always hung up
+ outside the shed at the back of the house; there was a chain round it, and
+ he had found that morning that one of the links had been filed through.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The Squire was most particular about its being locked, as Mr. Mark knows,
+ so that it could not be used by any ill disposed chaps who might come
+ along at night. The key of the padlock was always hung on a nail round the
+ other side of the shed. The Squire knew of it, and so did Mr. Mark and me;
+ so that while it was out of the way of the eyes of a thief, any of us
+ could run and get it and undo the padlock in a minute in case of fire or
+ anything of that sort. I have not used the ladder, maybe, for a fortnight,
+ but I know that it was hanging in its place yesterday afternoon.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I expect the fellow was prowling about here for some time,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;I
+ was chatting with my father in the library when I thought I heard a noise,
+ and I threw open the window, which had by some carelessness been left a
+ little open, and went out, and listened for nearly an hour, but I could
+ hear nothing, and put it down to the fact that I was nervous owing to what
+ had happened early in the evening, and that the noise was simply fancy, or
+ that the frost had caused a dry branch of one of the shrubs to crack.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How was it you did not notice the window was open as you went in?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The curtains were drawn, sir. I glanced at that when I went into the room
+ with my father. After being shot at once from outside, it was possible
+ that we might be again; though I own that I did not for a moment think
+ that the fellow would return after the hot chase that I gave him. I
+ suppose after I went in he looked about and found the ladder; it is likely
+ enough that he would have had a file with him in case he had any bars to
+ cut through to get into the house, but to my mind it is more likely that
+ he knew where to find the ladder without any looking for it; it has hung
+ there as long as I can remember.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, sir,&rdquo; the gardener said, &ldquo;I have worked for the Squire ever since he
+ came here, and the ladder was bought a week or two after he took me on,
+ and the Squire settled where it should be hung, so that it might be handy
+ either in case of fire or if wanted for a painting job. This aint the
+ first ladder; we got a new one four years ago.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is singular that the man should have known which was the window of
+ your father's room.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very singular,&rdquo; Mark said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Shortly after the doctor left, and Mark had a long talk with the
+ magistrate in the library, and told him his reasons for suspecting that
+ the murderer was Arthur Bastow.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It certainly looks like it,&rdquo; the magistrate said thoughtfully, after he
+ had heard Mark's story, &ldquo;though of course it is only a case of strong
+ suspicion, and not of legal proof. Your father's recognition of the voice
+ could have scarcely been accepted as final when he heard but three words,
+ still the whole thing hangs together. The fellow was, I should say,
+ capable of anything. I don't know that I ever had a prisoner before me
+ whose demeanor was so offensive and insolent, and if it can be proved that
+ Bastow is in England I should certainly accept your view of the case. He
+ would probably have known both where the ladder was to be found and which
+ was the window of your father's bedroom.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should certainly think that he would know it, sir. The bedroom was the
+ same that my grandfather used to sleep in, and probably during the years
+ before we came here young Bastow would have often been over the house. The
+ first year or two after we came he was often up here with his father, but
+ I know that my father took such an objection to him, his manner and
+ language were so offensive, that he would not have me, boy as I was&mdash;I
+ was only about eleven when he came here&mdash;associate with him in the
+ smallest degree. But during those two years he may very well have noticed
+ where the ladder was.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you intend to say anything about all this tomorrow at the inquest,
+ Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't think I shall do so,&rdquo; Mark said moodily. &ldquo;I am certain of it
+ myself, but I don't think any man would convict him without stronger
+ evidence than I could give. However, that business in Australia will be
+ sufficient to hang him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think you are right, Mark. Of course, if you do light upon any
+ evidence, we can bring this matter up in another court; if not, there will
+ be no occasion for you to appear in it at all, but leave it altogether for
+ the authorities to prove the Sydney case against him; it will only be
+ necessary for the constables who got up the other case against him to
+ prove his sentence, and for the reports of the Governor of the jail to be
+ read. There will be no getting over that, and he will be hung as a matter
+ of course. It will be a terrible thing for his unhappy father.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I do not think that he is likely to come to know it, sir; the shock of
+ the affair yesterday and that of this morning have completely prostrated
+ him, and Dr. Holloway, who was up with him before you arrived, thinks that
+ there is very little chance of his recovery.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When the magistrate had left, Mark sent a request to Mrs. Cunningham that
+ she would come down for a few minutes. She joined him in the drawing room.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you for coming down,&rdquo; he said quietly. &ldquo;I wanted to ask how you
+ were, and how Millicent is.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;She is terribly upset. You see, the Squire was the only father she had
+ ever known; and had he been really so he could not have been kinder. It is
+ a grievous loss to me also, after ten years of happiness here; but I have
+ had but little time to think of my own loss yet, I have been too occupied
+ in soothing the poor girl. How are you feeling yourself, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't understand myself,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I don't think that anyone could
+ have loved his father better than I have done; but since I broke down when
+ I first went to my room I seem to have no inclination to give way to
+ sorrow. I feel frozen up; my voice does not sound to me as if it were my
+ own; I am able to discuss matters as calmly as if I were speaking of a
+ stranger. The one thing that I feel passionately anxious about is to set
+ out on the track of the assassin.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is nothing unusual in your state of feeling, Mark. Such a thing as
+ this is like a wound in battle; the shock is so great that for a time it
+ numbs all pain. I have heard my husband say that a soldier who has had his
+ arm carried off by a cannon ball will fall from the shock, and when he
+ recovers consciousness will be ignorant where he has been hit. It is so
+ with you; probably the sense of pain and loss will increase every day as
+ you take it in more and more. As for what you say about the murderer, it
+ will undoubtedly be a good thing for you to have something to employ your
+ thoughts and engage all your faculties as soon as this is all over. Is
+ there anything that I can do?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, thank you; the inquest will be held tomorrow. I have sent down to
+ Chatterton to come up this afternoon to make the necessary preparations
+ for the funeral. Let me see, today is Wednesday, is it not? I seem to have
+ lost all account of the time.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, Wednesday.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I suppose the funeral will be on Monday or Tuesday. If there is any
+ message that you want sent down to the town, one of the grooms will carry
+ it whenever you wish.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you; 'tis not worth sending particularly, any time will do, but I
+ shall want to send a note to Mrs. Wilson presently, asking her to come up
+ the first thing tomorrow morning.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He can take it whenever, you like, Mrs. Cunningham. I have nothing to
+ send down for, as far as I know. I suppose you have heard that the doctor
+ thinks very badly of Mr. Bastow?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes. Ramoo is sitting with him now.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I think, if you will write your note at once, Mrs. Cunningham, I
+ will send one down to Dr. Holloway, asking him to send an experienced
+ nurse. He said he should call again this afternoon, but the sooner a nurse
+ comes the better.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ That afternoon Mark wrote a letter to the family solicitors, telling them
+ of what had taken place, and stating that the funeral would be on the
+ following Tuesday, and asking them to send down a clerk with his father's
+ will, or if one of the partners could manage to come down, he should
+ greatly prefer it, in view of the explanations that would be necessary. He
+ had already sent off a letter to the head of the Detective Department,
+ asking him to send down one of his best men as soon as possible. Then he
+ went out into the garden, and walked backwards and forwards for about two
+ hours, and then returned to what he thought would be a solitary meal. Mrs.
+ Cunningham, however, came down. She had thoughtfully had the large dining
+ table pushed on one side, and a small one placed near the fire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I thought it would be more comfortable,&rdquo; she said, &ldquo;as there are only our
+ two selves, just to sit here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He thanked her with a look. It was a nice little dinner, and Mark, to his
+ surprise, ate it with an appetite. Except the cup of tea that he had taken
+ in the morning, and a glass of wine at midday, he had touched nothing.
+ Mrs. Cunningham was a woman of great tact, and by making him talk of the
+ steps that he intended to take to hunt down the assassin, kept him from
+ thinking.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you very much, Mrs. Cunningham,&rdquo; he said, when the dinner was over.
+ &ldquo;I feel very much better.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have brought down my work,&rdquo; she said, &ldquo;and will sit here while you
+ drink your wine and smoke a pipe. Millicent has gone to bed, completely
+ worn out, and it will be pleasanter for us both to sit here than to be
+ alone.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark gladly agreed to the proposal. She turned the conversation now to
+ India, and talked of her life there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I was not out there very long,&rdquo; she said. &ldquo;I was engaged to my husband
+ when he first went out, and six years afterwards joined him there, and we
+ were married. Your uncle, who was a major of his regiment, gave me away.
+ My husband got his company six months afterwards, and was killed three
+ years later. My pension as his widow was not a large one, and when your
+ uncle offered me the charge of his daughter I was very glad to accept it.
+ He gave some idea of his plans for her. I thought they were very foolish,
+ but when I saw that his mind was thoroughly made up I did not attempt to
+ dissuade him. He said that when he came home to England (and he had no
+ idea when that would be) he should have me here, as head of his
+ establishment, and it would be given out that the child was his ward. I
+ hoped that he would alter his mind later on, but, as you know, he never
+ did.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, of course, she will have to be told now,&rdquo; Mark said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you think so? It seems to me that it were better that she would go as
+ she is, at any rate, until she is twenty-one.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That would be quite impossible,&rdquo; Mark said decidedly. &ldquo;How could I assume
+ the position of master here? And even if I could, it would be a strange
+ thing indeed for me to be here with a girl the age of my cousin, even with
+ you as chaperon. You must see yourself that it would be quite impossible.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But how could she live here by herself?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't think she could live here by herself,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;especially
+ after what has happened. Of course, it has all got to be talked over, but
+ my idea is that the place had better be shut up, and that you should take,
+ in your own name, a house in London. I suppose she will want masters for
+ the harp, and so on. For a time, at any rate, that would be the best plan,
+ unless you would prefer some other place to London. We have done our best
+ to carry out my uncle's wishes, but circumstances have been too strong for
+ us, and it cannot be kept up any longer; but there is no reason, if you
+ and she prefer it, why she should not be known, until you return here, by
+ her present name. Of course the affair will create a great deal of talk
+ down here, but in London no one will know that Millicent is an heiress,
+ though it is hardly likely that you will make many acquaintances for a
+ time.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Have you known it long, Mark? I thought that you were kept in ignorance
+ of it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I only heard it yesterday evening, Mrs. Cunningham; after that shot
+ through the window my father thought I ought to know all about it, for the
+ attempt might be repeated more successfully. He told me all about her, and
+ about the treasure.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What treasure?&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said. &ldquo;I don't know what you mean.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He then told her of the story his uncle had related, and how he had been
+ prevented from giving full instructions for its discovery, the only clew
+ being a gold coin and the word Masulipatam, and that this treasure had
+ been left equally divided between him and Millicent by his will.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He told me that he should provide for you,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham remarked,
+ &ldquo;when I said that it would be unfair that you should be brought up
+ believing yourself the heir. I never heard any more about it, but I am
+ glad that it is so.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I fancy the chance of its coming to either of us is very small,&rdquo; Mark
+ said; &ldquo;a coin and a word are not much to go upon. I have not the most
+ remote idea what they mean, and whether the treasure is in England or in
+ India, Heaven only knows.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Possibly, when he made the will, he may have told the solicitors where it
+ was, and instructed them to keep it secret until the time that Millicent
+ came into possession of the estate.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is just possible he did so, Mrs. Cunningham, but the efforts he made
+ to speak at the last moment would almost seem to show that he had not told
+ them, for, if he had, the matter would have been of no vital importance
+ one way or the other. Will Millicent be well enough to come down in the
+ morning?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hope so.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hope so, too; but, at any rate, keep her up in her room till the
+ afternoon. The inquest will be at eleven o'clock, and it is better that
+ she should not come down until everyone has gone away.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0009" id="link2HCH0009">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER IX.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ Directly after breakfast was over the next morning the Rector came in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I would not come in yesterday, Mark,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I knew that you would be
+ best alone; and, indeed, I was myself so terribly upset by the news that I
+ did not feel equal to it. I need not say how deeply I and my wife
+ sympathize with you. Never did a kinder heart beat than your father's;
+ never have I seen people so universally grieved as they are in the
+ village. I doubt whether a man went to work yesterday, and as for the
+ women, had it been a father they had lost they could not be more
+ affected.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, he will be greatly missed,&rdquo; Mark said unsteadily; &ldquo;and, between
+ ourselves&mdash;but this must go no further&mdash;I have a suspicion,
+ amounting almost to a certainty, that the hand that dealt this blow is the
+ same that caused the vacancy that brought you here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you mean Arthur Bastow?&rdquo; Mr. Greg said in amazement. &ldquo;Why, I thought
+ that he was transported for fifteen years.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then Mark told the Rector the inner history of the past six months, and of
+ the report they had had from the officer at Bow Street of the personal
+ appearance of the wounded man.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Other things are in favor of it,&rdquo; he went on. &ldquo;My father's watch and
+ purse were untouched, and a stranger on a dark night would be hardly
+ likely to have discovered the ladder, or to have had a file in his pocket
+ with which to cut through a link, though this might have been part of the
+ apparatus of any burglar. Then, again, an ordinary man would hardly have
+ known which was my father's bedroom, except, indeed, that he saw the light
+ there after those in the ladies' rooms were extinguished; but, at any
+ rate, he could not have told which was my father's and which was mine. But
+ all this is, as I said, Mr. Greg, quite between ourselves. I had a long
+ talk yesterday with Sir Charles Harris, and, as he said, there is no legal
+ proof whatever, strong as the suspicion is; so I am going to say nothing
+ on the subject at the inquest. The scoundrel's poor father is dying,
+ happily in ignorance of all this. Dr. Holloway was up with him all night,
+ and told me this morning before he drove off that it is very unlikely that
+ he will get through the day.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is all very terrible, Mark; but I cannot deny that everything points
+ to the man. Surely no one else could have cut short so useful a life, for
+ certainly no ordinary degree of hatred would drive a man, however brutal
+ his nature, to commit such a crime, and to run the risk of hanging for it.
+ Let us take a brisk walk in the garden for an hour&mdash;that will be the
+ best thing for you. I will stop with you until the inquest is over, and
+ then you had better come over and have lunch with us.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you; I cannot do so,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;though I should like to. In the
+ first place, Millicent will come downstairs this afternoon, and I should
+ like to be in to meet her. Had it not been for that I might have come, as
+ I can walk across the fields to the Rectory without passing through the
+ village. There is another reason. I sent up yesterday by the coach a
+ letter to be delivered at once by hand, and I expect a detective down here
+ by one o'clock. I don't know that he will do any good; but at the same
+ time it will give me something to do, and at present there is nothing I
+ dread so much as sitting alone. Fortunately, yesterday evening Millicent
+ went to bed at five o'clock, and Mrs. Cunningham sat with me all the
+ evening, and her talk did me a great deal of good.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The inquest occupied a very short time, the only point on which many
+ questions were asked being as to the firing through the window. Mark
+ stated that it was already so dark that although he was within fifty yards
+ of the man when he mounted and rode off, he could not give any very
+ distinct description of his figure. It struck him as being that of a man
+ of medium height.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have made out that the bullet was intended for your father?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I cannot say that, sir, it went between his head and that of Mr. Bastow,
+ but it might have been meant for either.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Was your father impressed with the idea that it was an attempt to murder
+ him?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He naturally thought so. Mr. Bastow can assuredly have no enemies, while
+ my father, as a magistrate, may have made some. He certainly thought it
+ was an attempt to murder him, and was so impressed by the fact that when
+ we went to the library later on he went into certain family matters with
+ me that he had never communicated before, and which, had it not been for
+ this, he would not have entered into for some years to come.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He had his opinion, then, as to who was his assailant?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He had, sir, but as it was but an opinion, although there were several
+ facts that seemed to justify the conviction, there was no proof whatever,
+ and therefore I do not think myself justified in saying what that opinion
+ was.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you entertain the same opinion yourself?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I do,&rdquo; Mark said emphatically; &ldquo;but until I can obtain some evidence in
+ support of what is really but a matter of opinion, and because, were I to
+ give the name, it would lessen my chance of obtaining such evidence, I
+ decline to mention the name.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have no doubt that the author of the second attempt is the same as
+ that of the first?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Personally, I have no doubt whatever; it stands to reason that it is
+ barely possible that two men could have, unknown to each other, made up
+ their minds to murder my father on the same evening.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The constable's evidence added nothing to that given by Mark. He had been
+ down to the lane where the man pursued had mounted. The reins of the horse
+ had apparently been thrown over a gatepost, and he thought it had been
+ standing there for some little time, for there were marks where it had
+ scraped the ground repeatedly. He had followed the marks of its hoofs for
+ some distance; it had gone at a gallop for about half a mile, and then the
+ pace had slackened into a trot. It continued until the lane fell into the
+ main road, but beyond this he had been unable to distinguish it from the
+ marks of the traffic in general.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You found no footprints whatever near the foot of the ladder, or anywhere
+ else round the house?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;None whatever, sir.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There were no signs of any other window or door save that of Mr.
+ Thorndyke's room being attempted?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;None at all, sir.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was but a short consultation between the jurors, who at once
+ returned a verdict of &ldquo;Willful murder by some person or persons unknown.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Dr. Holloway had, after giving evidence, returned at once to Mr. Bastow's
+ room. The only point of importance in his evidence was the statement that
+ the wound must have been fatal at once, the heart itself having been
+ penetrated. It had been inflicted by a dagger or a narrow bladed knife.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you mean that it was an unusually small dagger, Dr. Holloway?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should say it was a very fine dagger; not the sort of weapon that you
+ would expect to find a highwayman carry, if he carried one at all, but
+ rather a weapon of Spanish or Italian manufacture.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not the sort of wound that a rapier would make?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, the wound itself might have been very well made by a light rapier,
+ but there was a slight bruise on the flesh on each side of the wound, such
+ a mark as might be made by the handle or guard of a dagger, and
+ sufficiently plain to leave no doubt in my mind that it was so made.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Had the wound a downward course, or was it a straight thrust?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;A straight thrust,&rdquo; the doctor replied. &ldquo;My idea is that the two men were
+ grappling together, and that as Mr. Thorndyke was a very powerful man, his
+ assailant, who probably was approaching the bed with the dagger in his
+ hand, plunged it into him; had he struck at him I should certainly have
+ expected the course of the wound to be downward, as I fancy a man very
+ seldom thrusts straight with a dagger, as he would do with a rapier.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When the inquest was over, Mark, going out into the hall, found the doctor
+ waiting there for him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Mr. Bastow breathed his last some ten minutes ago. I saw when I went up
+ to him just before I gave my evidence that it was likely that he would die
+ before I returned to the room.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am very sorry,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;although I expected nothing else from what
+ you told me: He was a very kind hearted man; no one could have had a
+ kinder or more patient tutor than he was to me, while my father regarded
+ him as a very dear and valued friend. I am expecting the undertaker here
+ in a few minutes, and they can both be buried at the same time.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was late in the afternoon before Millicent came down with Mrs.
+ Cunningham. The news of Mr. Bastow's death had set her tears flowing
+ afresh; she had been very fond of him, and that he and the Squire should
+ have been taken at once seemed almost beyond belief. She had, however,
+ nerved herself to some degree of composure before she went down to meet
+ Mark; but although she returned the pressure of his hand, she was unable
+ for some time to speak. Mrs. Cunningham thought it best to speak first on
+ the minor grief.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;So Mr. Bastow has gone, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, Dr. Holloway thought very badly of him yesterday, and said that he
+ had but very faint hope of his rallying. I cannot help thinking that it
+ was best so. Of course, he was not a very old man, but he has for some
+ years been a very feeble one, and now that Millicent and I have both given
+ up our studies with him, I think that he would have felt that his work was
+ done, and would have gone downhill very fast.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think so, too,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham agreed. &ldquo;I am sure that even had the
+ Squire's death come quietly, in the course of nature, it would have been a
+ terrible blow to him. He was fond of you and Millicent, but his affection
+ for your father was a passion; his face always lit up when he spoke to
+ him. I used to think sometimes that it was like an old dog with his
+ master. It was quite touching to see them together. I think, Mark, with
+ you, that it is best that it should be as it is.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Gradually the conversation turned to other matters. Millicent was,
+ however, unable to take any part in it, and half an hour later she held
+ out her hand silently to Mark and left the room hurriedly. The next day
+ she was better, and was able to walk for a time with Mark in the garden
+ and talk more calmly about their mutual loss, for to her, no less than to
+ Mark, the Squire had been a father.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'Tis strange to think that you are the Squire now, Mark,&rdquo; she said as
+ they sat together in the dining room on the evening before the funeral.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will think it stranger still, Millicent,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;when I tell you
+ that I am not the Squire, and never shall be.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ She looked up in his face with wonder.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What do you mean, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, dear, you will know tomorrow, as Mr. Prendergast, one of the family
+ solicitors, is coming down; but I think it is as well to tell you
+ beforehand. It has been a curious position all along. I never knew it
+ myself till my father told me when we went into the library after the shot
+ was fired. The news did not affect me one way or the other, although it
+ surprised me a great deal. Like yourself, I have always supposed that you
+ were my father's ward, the daughter of an old comrade of his brother's.
+ Well, it is a curious story, Millicent. But there is no occasion for you
+ to look frightened. The fact is you are my uncle's daughter and my
+ cousin.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, that is not very dreadful!&rdquo; she exclaimed in a tone of relief.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not dreadful at all,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;But you see it involves the fact that
+ you are mistress of this estate, and not I.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent stood up suddenly with a little cry. &ldquo;No, no, Mark, it cannot
+ be! It would be dreadful, and I won't have it. Nothing could make me have
+ it. What, to take the estate away from you when you have all along
+ supposed it to be yours! How could I?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But you see it never has been mine, my dear. Father might have lived
+ another five-and-twenty years, and God knows I have never looked forward
+ to succeeding him. Sit down and let me tell you the story. It was not my
+ father's fault that he reigned here so long as master, it was the result
+ of a whim of your father's. And although my father fought against it, he
+ could not resist the dying prayer of my uncle.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He then related the whole circumstances under which the girl had been
+ brought up as Millicent Conyers, instead of Millicent Conyers Thorndyke,
+ and how the estate had been left by Colonel Thorndyke's will to his
+ brother until such time as Millicent should come of age, or marry, and how
+ he had ordered that when that event took place the rest of his property in
+ money and jewels was to be divided equally between Mark and herself.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It must not be, Mark,&rdquo; she said firmly. &ldquo;You must take the estate, and we
+ can divide the rest between us. What is the rest?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;To begin with,&rdquo; Mark said cheerfully, &ldquo;there are 25,000 pounds, the
+ accumulations of the rents of the estate after the death of my grandfather
+ up to the time when the Colonel returned from India; and there are,
+ besides, a few thousands, though I don't exactly know how many, that my
+ father paid over to the solicitors as the surplus of the rents of the
+ estates after paying all expenses of keeping up this house. He very
+ properly considered that although he had accepted the situation at your
+ father's earnest wish, he ought not to make money by doing so. If we put
+ it down at 30,000 pounds altogether, you see there is 15,000 pounds for
+ each of us. A very nice sum for a young man to start life with, especially
+ as I shall have my father's estate near Hastings, which brings in 500
+ pounds a year; and as the rents of this have been accumulating for the
+ last ten years, my share will be raised from 15,000 pounds to 20,000
+ pounds. Besides this, there is the main bulk of the Colonel's fortune made
+ in India. That seems to be worth about 100,000 pounds but I must own that
+ the chance of getting it seems very small.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How is that, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark told her the whole story.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I mean to make it my business to follow the matter up,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I think
+ that the chance of ever finding it is very small. Still, it will give me
+ an object to begin life with.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, I hope that you will never find it!&rdquo; she exclaimed. &ldquo;From what you
+ say it will be a terrible danger if you do get it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark smiled.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hardly think so, Millicent. I cannot believe that people would be
+ following up this thing for over fifteen years, for it was many years
+ before the Colonel came home that he got possession of these diamonds.
+ Even Hindoos would, I think, have got sick of such a hopeless affair long
+ before this; but as they may ever since your father's death have been
+ watching us, although it hardly seems possible, I shall follow out the
+ Colonel's instructions, and get rid of those particular diamonds at once.
+ I shall only keep them about me long enough to take them to Amsterdam and
+ sell them there. The Colonel said they were the finest diamonds that he
+ ever saw, and that he really had no idea of what they were worth. However,
+ that is for the future.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Mrs. Cunningham has known this all along, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not about the money affairs, but of course she knew that you were my
+ cousin. She brought you from India, you see, and has known all along that
+ the Colonel was your father. She knows it, and the family solicitors know
+ it, but I believe no one else, except, perhaps, Ramoo. I am not sure
+ whether he was in uncle's service when you were sent over in Mrs.
+ Cunningham's charge. He may know it or he may not, but certainly no one
+ else does, except, as I say, the solicitors and myself. Possibly some
+ other of the Colonel's old comrades knew that there was a child born; but
+ if they were in England and happened to hear that my father had succeeded
+ to the estate, they would, of course, suppose that the child had died.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then,&rdquo; Millicent said, in a tone of relief, &ldquo;there can be no reason why
+ anyone else should know anything about it. I will see Mr. Prendergast when
+ he comes down tomorrow, and beg him to say nothing about it; 15,000 pounds
+ is quite enough for any girl; and besides, you say that my father's
+ greatest wish was that I was not to be married for money, and after all
+ the pains that have been taken, his wish will not be carried out if I am
+ to be made owner of the estate.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You won't be able to persuade Mr. Prendergast to do that,&rdquo; Mark said,
+ smiling. &ldquo;It is his duty simply to carry out the provisions of your
+ father's will, and to place you in possession of the estate; and if he
+ would keep silence, which he certainly won't, you don't suppose that I
+ would.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I shall hate you, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't think you will, Millicent, and I would rather that you did that
+ than that you should despise me. At the present moment you may think that
+ this estate would be only a burden to you, but some day when you marry you
+ might see the matter in a different light.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The girl looked at him reproachfully.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should never think so!&rdquo; she burst out. &ldquo;What would you have me do? Live
+ here in this great house, with only Mrs. Cunningham, while you are going
+ about the world seeking for this treasure? Never!&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I don't think that it would be nice for you to do that, Millicent,&rdquo;
+ Mark said. &ldquo;Mrs. Cunningham and I have been talking it over. We thought
+ that the best plan would be for her to take a house in London, and go
+ there with you; you would have the advantages of good masters.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then you were saying only a short time since that you would like to learn
+ the harp and take lessons in painting. There would be time enough to think
+ about what you would do with respect to this house afterward.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is all horrible,&rdquo; Millicent said, bursting into tears, &ldquo;and I shall
+ always feel that I have robbed you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But I don't feel so in the least,&rdquo; Mark urged. &ldquo;I was not in the smallest
+ degree put out when my father told me about it. I have always had a fancy
+ for wandering about the world, as my uncle did, and doing something to
+ distinguish myself, instead of settling down for life to be a country
+ magistrate and a squire. Of course it came as a surprise, but I can assure
+ you that it was not an altogether unpleasant one. What can a man want more
+ than a nice little estate of 500 pounds a year and 20,000 pounds in
+ money?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is all very well to say that, but as you said to me just now, you may
+ see it in a different light some day.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then she sat thinking for some time. &ldquo;At any rate,&rdquo; she went on at last,
+ &ldquo;I don't see why anyone should know about it now. If the house is to be
+ shut up and you are going away, why need anyone know anything about it? My
+ father's wish was that I should not have people making love to me just
+ because I was an heiress; after all that has been done, it would be wicked
+ to go against his wishes. I suppose the interest of this 15,000 pounds
+ would be enough for Mrs. Cunningham and I to live comfortably on in
+ London?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes,&rdquo; Mark said; &ldquo;it will, at 5 per cent, bring in 750 pounds a year.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I shall remain Millicent Conyers to the world. There is nothing to
+ prevent that, is there?&rdquo; she said almost defiantly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No,&rdquo; he replied thoughtfully. &ldquo;The rents of this estate might accumulate.
+ I suppose the solicitors would see after that; and as I shall be away it
+ will, of course, make no difference to me. Were I to stay in the
+ neighborhood I could not consent to live as my father did, in a false
+ position; but even then I might give out that the property had only been
+ left to my father during his lifetime, and that it had now gone elsewhere,
+ without saying whom it had gone to. However, as I shall be away there will
+ be no occasion even for that. When the will is read there will be no one
+ present but ourselves, and I don't see why its contents should not be kept
+ a secret for a time; at any rate, we can ask Mr. Prendergast's opinion
+ upon that subject.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At this moment, Mrs. Cunningham coming into the room, Millicent ran to her
+ and threw her arms round her neck.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He has made me most miserable,&rdquo; she said. &ldquo;I thought I could not have
+ been more miserable than I was before he told me all about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I knew that he was going to do so, and I was quite sure that you would
+ not be pleased at the news. I have all along thought that it was a mistake
+ on the part of your father; but as it was his decision, and not mine, I
+ only had to carry out his wishes.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is cruel,&rdquo; Millicent sobbed. &ldquo;I don't mean it is cruel of my father;
+ of course he could not have known, and he thought he was doing the best
+ thing for my happiness, but it has all turned out wrong.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;For the present you may think so, dear; but you must remember that up to
+ the present time it has turned out well. I know that your uncle did not
+ like it at first, but I think that he passed ten happy years here. It gave
+ him a great power for doing good, and he worthily availed himself of it.
+ We have all spent a happy time; he was universally liked and respected. I
+ think all of us have benefited by it. It would not have been half as
+ pleasant if it had been known that you, my child, were the real owner of
+ the estate, and he was acting merely as your guardian. Let us hope that
+ everything will turn out as well in future. Colonel Thorndyke told me that
+ he had left a considerable sum in addition to the estates, and that this
+ was to be divided between you and Mark; so you see your cousin will not go
+ out into the world a beggar.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is most of it lost,&rdquo; Millicent said with an hysterical laugh. &ldquo;It is
+ all hidden away, and no one can find it; everything has gone wrong
+ together.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I think, dear, that you had better go up to bed. I will go with
+ you. At the present time this, of course, has come upon you as an
+ additional shock. I would gladly have shielded you from it for a time if I
+ could have done so, but you must have learned it tomorrow, and I quite
+ agree with Mark that is was better that he should tell you this evening. I
+ sent down to the town today to the doctor's and asked him to send me up a
+ soothing draught, thinking that you might be upset by the news. I hope by
+ the morning you will be able to look at matters more calmly.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Some time later Mrs. Cunningham came down again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;She has cried herself to sleep,&rdquo; she said. &ldquo;She is much grieved about
+ this money being lost.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is annoying; still I cannot help thinking that the Colonel must have
+ taken some such precaution to prevent the treasure from being lost.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;One would certainly think so,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham agreed; &ldquo;the Colonel
+ seemed to me a methodical man. I know that he had the reputation of being
+ one of the most particular men in the service as to all petty details. His
+ instructions to me before I left him were all very minute, and he gave me
+ a sealed packet which he told me contained instructions and a copy of the
+ register of his marriage and of Millicent's birth, and he said that in
+ case of his death I was to take it to your father. He said that there was
+ a letter inclosed in it to him, and also a copy of his will. The letter
+ was directed to your father, and not to me. I handed it over to him when
+ he asked me to come here. He told me afterwards that the letter contained
+ the request that his brother lived to make personally to him&mdash;that
+ the child should be brought up as his ward; and that he had handed the
+ certificates to a lawyer, who had, however, received copies of them from
+ the Colonel himself before he went down to see your father. So, as he took
+ these precautions to insure his wishes being carried out in the event of
+ his sudden death, I should think that he must have done something of the
+ sort with regard to this treasure.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should think that extremely likely, Mrs. Cunningham. I certainly had
+ not thought of that before, and I hope that for Millicent's sake and my
+ own it may turn out to be so. I can get on extremely well without it, but
+ at the same time I don't pretend that 50,000 pounds are to be despised.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next morning Mr. Prendergast, who had arrived at Reigate late the
+ evening before, and had put up at an inn, came up to the house an hour
+ before the time named for the funeral. He learned from Mark that he had
+ already acquainted Millicent with her change of circumstances. A few
+ minutes after he arrived, a servant told him that Miss Conyers would be
+ glad if he would see her alone for a few minutes in the drawing room. Mark
+ had already prepared him for her request.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Mark has told you that he told me about this hateful thing last night, I
+ suppose, Mr. Prendergast?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He has,&rdquo; the old lawyer said kindly; &ldquo;and he tells me also that you are
+ not at all pleased at the news.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Pleased! I should think not, Mr. Prendergast,&rdquo; she said indignantly. &ldquo;I
+ am not going to rob my cousin of what he has always been taught to think
+ as his inheritance. It is abominable, I call it, and most unnatural.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But, my dear young lady, it is yours, and not his. I do not wish to
+ discuss whether the arrangement was altogether a wise one, but I think
+ that so far it has turned out well for all parties. Your estate has
+ profited greatly by the management of your uncle, the tenants and all
+ connected with it have benefited greatly, he himself has had active
+ employment afforded him, of which he was fond. Your cousin has, I believe,
+ enjoyed the advantages of the position, and has become acquainted with the
+ best people in this part of the country, and will now obtain the benefit
+ of something like 15,000 pounds&mdash;a comfortable little sum, especially
+ as he inherits, I believe, his father's property in Sussex. You yourself
+ will have obtained what I cannot but consider the advantage of having been
+ brought up without knowing that you were an heiress, and therefore without
+ being spoiled, which is, in my opinion, the case with many young ladies in
+ such a condition; therefore I cannot but think that, if unwise in its
+ conception, the matter has so far worked out well. I am bound to say that
+ Mr. Mark Thorndyke has been speaking to me very handsomely on the subject,
+ and that he appears in no way disappointed at finding that you are the
+ heiress of the estate, and is really concerned only at your unwillingness
+ to accept the situation.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I wanted to know, Mr. Prendergast,&rdquo; she said, but in a tone that showed
+ she was convinced by his manner that her request would be refused, &ldquo;if you
+ could arrange so that things would not be disturbed, and he should come
+ into possession as his father's heir in the natural way.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But you see he is not his father's heir, Miss Thorndyke. His father only
+ had the use, as we call it, of the property until you came of age, or
+ marriage; it was not necessary for it to come to you on your coming of
+ age, but only, as your father explained to me, in the event of your
+ marriage; that is to say, it was not to become public that you were
+ entitled to the estate until your marriage. If you married before you were
+ twenty-one the property was then to come to you. If you did not you were
+ to be informed of the circumstances or not, as Mr. Thorndyke might decide
+ was best, but you were not to come into the property until you married.
+ Your cousin was also to be informed when you came to the age of
+ twenty-one, and as at that time he was to take his half share of the
+ remainder of the property, he would then be able to arrange his life as he
+ liked. If your uncle died, as unfortunately he has done, before you
+ reached the age of twenty-one, you would then be placed in your proper
+ position; but your father desired us to say to you that it was his wish,
+ that if it could be arranged, your having succeeded to the ownership
+ should not be publicly known until you divulged it to your husband after
+ marriage. The other portions of the will must be carried out. This being
+ only a request, you are at liberty to follow it or not as you may choose.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Certainly I should choose,&rdquo; the girl said. &ldquo;After all this trouble to
+ prevent my being run after as an heiress, it would be wicked to upset it
+ all and to fly in the face of his wishes by setting up as mistress of this
+ estate. Still you understand, Mr. Prendergast, that I don't mean to take
+ it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The lawyer smiled indulgently. &ldquo;There is one way in which it might be
+ managed,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;Perhaps you can guess what it is?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A flush of color rose over the girl's face. &ldquo;Don't say it, I beg of you,
+ Mr. Prendergast. Mrs. Cunningham hinted at it this morning, and I told her
+ that my own wish entirely agreed with that of my father, and that I was
+ determined not to be married for money; and I am quite sure that Mark
+ would be as unwilling as I am that the estate should change hands in that
+ way. No, Mr. Prendergast, you must find some other way of doing it than
+ that. Surely an estate cannot be forced upon anyone who is determined not
+ to take it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, we must think it over,&rdquo; Mr. Prendergast said quietly. &ldquo;And now I
+ think that it is time for me to join the others.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0010" id="link2HCH0010">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER X.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The funeral of Squire Thorndyke and Mr. Bastow was over, and all agreed
+ they had never seen a more affecting spectacle than that at the churchyard
+ when the two coffins were brought in. The distance was short, and the
+ tenants had requested leave to carry the Squire's bier, while that of Mr.
+ Bastow was borne by the villagers who had known and loved him. Behind
+ followed all the magistrates and a great number of the gentry for miles
+ round; the churchyard was crowded by every man, woman, and child in the
+ village, and the women, as well as many of the men, wept unrestrainedly as
+ the coffins passed by. Besides these, a large number of people from
+ Reigate and the surrounding villages were present, attracted rather by the
+ crime that had caused the death than by the loss of the Squire himself.
+ The church was crowded, and it was with difficulty that Mr. Greg read the
+ service. The Squire was laid by the side of his father, Mr. Bastow in the
+ spot where many of his predecessors had slept before him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark had been greatly affected, not only by his own loss, but by the sight
+ of the general grief among those for whom the Squire had done so much.
+ Even Mr. Prendergast, who had taken part in many such functions over
+ departed clients, was much moved by the scene.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have been at many funerals,&rdquo; he said to Mark as they walked back to the
+ Hall, &ldquo;but I never have been at one that so affected me. No monument ever
+ raised, sir, did such credit to him who was laid beneath it as the tears
+ of those simple villagers.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark did not reply; his heart was altogether too full to speak. As they
+ entered the house he said, &ldquo;The ladies will have their lunch upstairs, Mr.
+ Prendergast; we may as well have ours at once, and then you can call them
+ down if there is any business to be done.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That will not take long,&rdquo; the lawyer said. &ldquo;I have brought down the wills
+ of both your uncle the Colonel, and your father, and I think that it would
+ be as well for me to read them both. That of your father is a very short
+ and simple document, extending, indeed, only over a few lines. Your
+ uncle's is longer and more complicated, but as you are well aware of the
+ gist of it, it will take us but a short time to get through it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark took his meal in a perfunctory manner. For himself he would have
+ eaten nothing, but he made an effort to do so in order to keep his guest
+ company. When it was over he said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We may as well go into the library at once, and I will send up for the
+ ladies. It is as well to lose no time, for I know that you want to catch
+ the afternoon coach up to town.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent joined them in a minute or two, the girl
+ looking very pale in her deep mourning.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am about,&rdquo; Mr. Prendergast said quietly, &ldquo;to read the wills of Colonel
+ Thorndyke and Mr. John Thorndyke, and I will ask you, if there is any
+ phrase that you do not understand, to stop me, and I will explain to you
+ its purport.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The three persons present were acquainted with the main provisions of the
+ Colonel's will. It began by stating that, being determined that his
+ daughter, Millicent Conyers Thorndyke, should not be married for her
+ money, he hereby bequeathed to his brother, John Thorndyke, his estate in
+ the parish of Crowswood, to be held by him until his daughter Millicent
+ came to the age of twenty-one, or was married; if that marriage did not
+ take place until she was over the age of twenty-one, so long was it to
+ continue in John Thorndyke's possession, save and except that she was, on
+ attaining the age of twenty-one, to receive from it an income of 250
+ pounds a year for her private use and disposal.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;To Jane Cunningham, the widow of the late Captain Charles Cunningham, of
+ the 10th Madras Native Infantry, should she remain with my daughter until
+ the marriage of the latter, I bequeath an annuity of 150 pounds per annum,
+ chargeable on the estate, and to commence at my daughter's marriage. All
+ my other property in moneys, investments, jewels, and chattels of all
+ sorts, is to be divided in equal portions between my daughter, Millicent
+ Conyers Thorndyke, and my nephew, Mark Thorndyke. Should, however, my
+ daughter die before marriage, I bequeath the said estate in the parish of
+ Crowswood to my brother, John Thorndyke, for his life, and after him to
+ his son Mark, and to the latter the whole of my other property of all
+ kinds, this to take effect on the death of my daughter. Should my brother
+ predecease the marriage or coming of age of my daughter, she is at once to
+ come into possession of the said estate of Crowswood. In which case my
+ nephew Mark and Mr. James Prendergast, of the firm of Hopwood &amp;
+ Prendergast, my solicitors, are to act as her trustees, and Mrs. Jane
+ Cunningham and the said James Prendergast as her guardians.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All this was, of course, expressed in the usual legal language, but the
+ purport was clear to those previously acquainted with its bearing, the
+ only item that was new to them being the legacy to Mrs. Cunningham. John
+ Thorndyke's testament was a short one. He left all his property to his son
+ Mark, with the exception of a hundred pounds to his niece to buy a
+ mourning ring or brooch or other ornament in memory of him, and fifty
+ pounds to Mrs. Cunningham for a similar purpose, as a token of his great
+ esteem for her character, and 200 pounds to Ramoo for his faithful
+ services to his brother and himself. When the lawyer had folded up the
+ wills Millicent said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;On my part, I have to say that I absolutely renounce the legacy of the
+ estate in favor of my cousin Mark, who has always believed that it would
+ be his.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And I as absolutely refuse to accept the sacrifice,&rdquo; Mark said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My dear young lady,&rdquo; Mr. Prendergast said quietly, &ldquo;at present, at any
+ rate, you have no power whatever to take any action in the matter; you
+ are, in the eye of the law, an infant, and until you come of age you have
+ no power to execute any legal document whatever. Therefore you must
+ perforce remain mistress of the estate until you attain the age of
+ twenty-one. Many things may happen before that time; for example, you
+ might marry, and in that case your husband would have a voice in the
+ matter; you might die, in which case Mr. Mark Thorndyke would, without any
+ effort on your part, come into possession of the estate. But, at any rate,
+ until you reach the age of twenty-one your trustees will collect the rents
+ of the estate on your behalf, and will hold the monies in trust for you,
+ making, of course, such payments for your support and maintenance as are
+ fit and proper for your condition.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The tears came into Millicent's eyes as she resumed the seat from which
+ she had risen, and she did not utter another word until Mr. Prendergast
+ rose to leave.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall doubtless learn your wishes as to the future, Miss Thorndyke,
+ from your cousin,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I hope that you will not cherish any malice
+ against me, and that when you think it over you will come to the
+ conclusion that second thoughts are sometimes the wisest, and also that
+ you should have some consideration for your father's wishes in a matter of
+ this kind. He worked hard and risked his life to build up the fortune that
+ he has left. He evidently thought greatly of your welfare, and was, above
+ all things, anxious to insure your happiness. I am sure that on thinking
+ it over you will see that you should not thwart his wishes.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My dear boy,&rdquo; he said to Mark, as they stood on the doorstep waiting for
+ the carriage to come round, &ldquo;the best plan by far in this business would
+ be for the interests of your cousin and yourself to be identical. She is a
+ very charming young lady, a little headstrong in this matter, perhaps, but
+ I do not think that that is altogether unnatural.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That might have come about if it had not been for the property, Mr.
+ Prendergast,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;but it cannot be now. If she and I had been
+ engaged before all this happened the case would have been different; but
+ you see yourself that now my lips are sealed, for it would seem as if I
+ had not cared for her until she turned out to be an heiress.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You are a silly young couple,&rdquo; the lawyer said. &ldquo;I can only hope that as
+ you grow older you will grow wiser. Well, you had better come up and have
+ a talk with me about the assets your uncle mentions in his will.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then you don't know anything about them, sir?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Nothing at all, except as to the accumulations in his absence. He
+ mentioned vaguely that he was a wealthy man. I thought that, as a matter
+ of course, he had told his brother all about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a curious business, sir, and I doubt if there will ever be anything
+ besides the accumulations you speak of.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Bless me, you don't say so! Well, well, I always thought that it was the
+ most foolish business that I ever heard of. However, you shall tell me all
+ about it when you come up. I shall miss my coach unless I start.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ So saying, he shook Mark's hand, took his place in the gig, and was driven
+ away. Millicent did not come downstairs again that day.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;She is thoroughly upset,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said, &ldquo;and it would be best to
+ let her have her own way for a time. I think the sooner I can get her away
+ from here the better. The house is full of sad memories, and I myself feel
+ shaken and in need of a change.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can quite understand her feeling and yours, Mrs. Cunningham. I do hope
+ you will be able to disabuse her mind of the idea that I have any shadow
+ of feeling of regret that she instead of I has the estate, and please try
+ to work upon her on the ground of her father's wishes. I could see that
+ her face changed when Mr. Prendergast put the matter in that light, which
+ I do not think had occurred to her before. I am thinking of going up to
+ town in a couple of days; I was thinking of doing so tomorrow, but a day
+ or so will make no difference. I propose that you both go with me, and
+ that I then help you look for a house. Even if you don't get one at once,
+ a week in London will be a change, and you can then, if you like, go
+ somewhere for a time. Of course Bath would be too gay at present; but you
+ might go to Tunbridge Wells, or, if she would like a seaside place, as she
+ has never been near the sea since she was a baby, that would be the
+ greatest change for her. You might go down for a month or two to Dover or
+ Hastings. There is no occasion for you to settle down in London for a
+ time. There is Weymouth, too, if you would like it better. I believe that
+ that is a cheerful place without being too fashionable.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think that will be an excellent plan,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If you like I will drive you up to town, and the luggage can go by the
+ carrier; it is more pleasant than being shut up in a coach.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Much more cheerful, of course.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will, of course, leave many of your things here, and the packing them
+ up will give her something to do, and prevent her from brooding.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think that is an excellent idea, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Late in the afternoon Ramoo came in in his usual silent manner. The man
+ had said but little during the past few days, but it was evident that he
+ was grieving deeply, and he looked years older than he had done before
+ that fatal night.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, Ramoo, you will stay with me for the present. I hardly know
+ what I shall be doing for a time, but I am sure that until I settle down,
+ Miss Conyers will be very glad to have you with her.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, sahib, Ramoo will return home to India. Ramoo is getting old; he was
+ thirty when he entered the service of the Colonel, sahib; he is fifty now;
+ he will go home to end his days; he has saved enough to live in comfort,
+ and with what the lawyer sahib told him your father has left him he will
+ be a rich man among his own people.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But you will find things changed, Ramoo, since you left; while here, you
+ know, we all regard you as a friend rather than as a servant.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You are all very kind and good, sahib. Ramoo knows that he will meet no
+ friends like those he has here, but he longs for the bright sun and blue
+ sky of India, and though it will well nigh break his heart to leave the
+ young missie and you, he feels that he must go.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, Ramoo. We shall all be very sorry to lose you, but I
+ understand your longing to go home, and I know that you always feel our
+ cold winters very trying; therefore I will not oppose your wishes. I shall
+ be going up to town in two or three days, and will arrange to pay your
+ legacy at once, and will inquire what vessels are sailing.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent was unfeignedly sorry when she heard of Ramoo's determination;
+ she was very fond of him, for when as a child she first arrived at
+ Crowswood he had been her companion whenever the Squire did not require
+ his services, and would accompany her about the garden and grounds,
+ listening to her prattle, carrying her on his shoulder, and obeying her
+ behests. No doubt he knew that she was the daughter of his former master,
+ and had to a certain extent transferred his allegiance from the sahib,
+ whose life he had several times saved, to his little daughter. Still, she
+ agreed with Mark that it was perhaps best that he should go. She and Mrs.
+ Cunningham would find but little occasion for his services when
+ established in London, and his swarthy complexion and semi-Eastern costume
+ would attract attention, and perhaps trouble, when he went abroad&mdash;the
+ population being less accustomed to Orientals then than at present&mdash;but
+ still less would they know what to do with him were they for a time to
+ wander about. Mark said at once that so long as he himself was engaged in
+ the task that he had set himself, he could not take Ramoo with him, and as
+ for his staying alone in the house when it was only in charge of a
+ caretaker, it was not to be thought of.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Although not inclined at the present time to agree with Mark in anything,
+ Millicent could not but acknowledge that it were best that Ramoo should
+ not be urged further to reconsider his determination, and she also fell in
+ with his proposal that they should go up to London for a week, and then go
+ down to Weymouth for a time, after which they would be guided by
+ circumstances. Accordingly, two days later, Mark drove Millicent and Mrs.
+ Cunningham up to London. A groom accompanied them on Mark's favorite
+ horse. This was to be left in town for his use, and the groom was to drive
+ the carriage back again. Comfortable rooms were obtained in a quiet inn
+ for the ladies, while Mark put up at the Bull, saying that he would come
+ every day to take them out.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Why did not Mark stay here, Mrs. Cunningham?&rdquo; Millicent asked pettishly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I suppose he thought it better that he should not do so; and I own that I
+ think he was right.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;When we were, as we supposed, no relation to each other,&rdquo; Millicent said,
+ &ldquo;we could be like brother and sister. Now that we find that we are cousins
+ we are going to be stiff and ceremonious.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not necessarily because you are cousins, Millicent. Before, you were his
+ father's ward, and under his father's care; now you are a young lady on
+ your own account. You must see that the position is changed greatly, and
+ that what was quite right and proper before would not be at all right and
+ proper now.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent shrugged her shoulders.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, if Mark wishes to be distant and stiff he can certainly do so if he
+ likes it. It makes no matter to me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is not at all fair, Millicent, and very unlike yourself. Had not
+ Mark suggested his going to another inn, I should have suggested it
+ myself.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, yes; no doubt it is better,&rdquo; Millicent said carelessly. &ldquo;He has
+ several friends in town, and of course we cannot expect him to be devoting
+ himself to us.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mrs. Cunningham raised her eyebrows slightly, but made no answer.
+ Millicent was seldom wayward, but at present things had gone very hardly
+ with her, and her friend felt that it would be better to leave her
+ entirely to herself until her humor changed. In the morning, when Mark
+ came round, Millicent announced that she felt tired with the drive of the
+ previous day, and would prefer staying indoors. Mark looked a little
+ surprised, more at the tone than at the substance of the words, for the
+ manner in which she spoke showed that the excuse she had given was not her
+ only reason for not going out.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, I shall stay at home too,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said quietly, as he
+ glanced toward her inquiringly. &ldquo;Millicent is unnerved and shaken, and
+ perhaps it is just as well for her to have a day's complete rest.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very well, Mrs. Cunningham; then I will, as I cannot be of any use to
+ you, set about my own business for the day. I have already been round to
+ the lawyer's, and have got a check for Ramoo's legacy. He will be up this
+ afternoon, and I will go round to Leadenhall Street and find out what
+ ships are sailing and when they start. I will come in this evening for a
+ chat.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent sat without speaking for some minutes after he had left the
+ room. Mrs. Cunningham, whose hands were always busy, took some work out of
+ a bag and set to work at it industriously. Presently the girl said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What business is this that Mark is going to occupy himself in?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I do not know much about it,&rdquo; she replied. &ldquo;But from a few words which he
+ let drop I believe that he intends to devote himself to discovering and
+ hunting down your uncle's murderer.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The listless expression faded out at once of Millicent's face.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But surely, Mrs. Cunningham, that will be very dangerous work.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No doubt it will be dangerous work, but I don't think that that is likely
+ to hinder Mark. The man, whoever he may be, is of course a desperate
+ character, and not likely to be captured without making a fierce struggle
+ for it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then he ought to put the matter in the hands of the proper authorities,&rdquo;
+ Millicent said decidedly. &ldquo;Of course such men are dangerous. Very likely,
+ this man may have accomplices, and it is not against one only that Mark
+ will have to fight. He has no right to risk his life in so desperate an
+ adventure.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mrs. Cunningham smiled quietly over her work. The Squire had often
+ confided to her how glad he would be if these two should some day come
+ together. In that case the disclosure after marriage of the real facts of
+ the case would cause no disturbance or difficulty. The estate would be
+ theirs, and it would not matter which had brought it into the partnership;
+ she had thoroughly agreed with him, but so far nothing had occurred to
+ give any ground for the belief that their hopes would be fulfilled.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Till within the last year Millicent had been little more than a child; she
+ had looked up to Mark as she might have done to a big brother, as
+ something most admirable, as one whose dictum was law. During the last
+ year there had been some slight change, but more, perhaps, on Mark's part
+ than on hers. He had consulted her wishes more, had asked instead of
+ ordered, and had begun to treat her as if conscious that she was fast
+ growing up into womanhood.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent herself scarcely seemed to have noticed this change. She was
+ little more inclined to assert herself than before, but was ready to
+ accompany him whenever he wished her to do so, or to see him go away
+ without complaint, when it so pleased him; but the last week had made a
+ rapid change in their position. Millicent had sprung almost at a bound
+ into a young woman. She had come to think and resolve for herself; she was
+ becoming wayward and fanciful; she no longer deferred to Mark's opinion,
+ but held her own, and was capable of being vexed at his decisions. At any
+ rate, her relations with Mark had changed rapidly, and Mrs. Cunningham
+ considered this little outburst of pettishness to be a good omen for her
+ hopes, and very much better than if they had continued on their old
+ footing of affectionate cousins.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark went back again to the lawyer's, and had a long talk with Mr.
+ Prendergast over the lost treasure. The old lawyer scoffed at the idea
+ that there could be any danger associated with the bracelet.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Men in India, I suppose, get fanciful,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;and imbibe some of the
+ native superstitions. The soldier who got them from the man who stole them
+ was stabbed. He might have been stabbed for a thousand reasons, but he had
+ the bracelet on his mind. He was forever hiding it and digging it up, and
+ fancying that someone was on his track, and he put down the attack as
+ being made by someone connected with it. His manner impressed your uncle.
+ He concealed the diamonds or sent them off somewhere, instantly. He never
+ had any further trouble about them, but like many men who have a craze,
+ fancied that he was being perpetually watched and followed. The
+ unfortunate result of all this is that these jewels and the money that he
+ accumulated during his service in India seem to be lost. A more stupid
+ affair I never heard of.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, as to the clew, any reasonable man would have given full
+ instructions as to how the treasure was to be found; or if he did not do
+ that, would, at least, instead of carrying about an absurd coin and a
+ scrap of paper with a name upon it, have written his instructions and put
+ them in that ridiculous hiding place, or, more wisely still, would have
+ instructed his solicitor fully on the subject. The amount of trouble given
+ by men, otherwise perfectly sane, by cranks and fancies is astonishing.
+ Here is something like 100,000 pounds lost owing to a superstitious whim.
+ As to your chance of finding the treasure, I regard it as small indeed.
+ The things are hidden in India, in some old tomb, or other rubbishing
+ place. Your uncle may have committed them to the charge of a native; he
+ may have sent them to a banker at one of the great towns; he may have
+ shipped them to England. He may have sent them to the North Pole for
+ anything I know. How can one begin to search the universe?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I thought, sir, that perhaps he might have sent them to some London Bank
+ or agent, with instructions to hold them until claimed by him, and that
+ perhaps an inquiry among such houses would lead to the discovery that they
+ hold certain property forwarded by him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well; there is some sense in that suggestion,&rdquo; Prendergast grumbled, &ldquo;and
+ I suppose the first thing to be done will be to carry that out. If you
+ wish, we will do it for you. They would be more likely to give the
+ information, if they possess it, to a well known firm of solicitors like
+ ourselves than to any private individual. Besides, if you were to go
+ yourself, they would in each case want you to be identified before they
+ would answer any question, whereas I should write a note to them in the
+ firm's name, with our compliments, saying that we should be glad to know
+ if the late Colonel Thorndyke, of whose will we are the executors, had any
+ account at their firm or has deposited any property in their hands. There
+ are not above five or six banks doing business with India, and as many
+ agents in a large way of business; and if he did such a foolish thing, he
+ would be certain to do it with some houses of good standing&mdash;if,
+ indeed, anything can be taken as certain in the case of a gentleman with
+ such extraordinary fancies and plans as his.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you, Mr. Prendergast,&rdquo; Mark said, with a slight smile at the
+ lawyer's irritability; &ldquo;that will be clearing the ground to a certain
+ extent. If that does not succeed, I think I shall go to India myself, and
+ shall there make similar inquiries at all the principal establishments at
+ Calcutta and Madras. Should I fail there, it seems to me that the only
+ remaining plan will be to find out from the military authorities the place
+ where my uncle's regiment was encamped on the day&mdash;we have the date
+ on which the jewels were given to him&mdash;and to institute a minute
+ search of all the old ruins within such a distance as he might have
+ reached within a day's ride.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But you have no certainty that it was a ruin. He might have dug a hole
+ under his tent and have buried the things there; he might have taken a
+ shovel and buried them in a clump of bushes a quarter of a mile away. The
+ thing is more and more ridiculous the more you look at it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I see it is very difficult, sir, but one might narrow it down somewhat if
+ one discovered the spot. Probably there are still native officers in the
+ regiment who were there at the time. If so, they might possibly know who
+ was my uncle's servant at the time. The man may be a pensioner, and in
+ that case I might discover his address through the military authorities,
+ and I could find out from him whether my uncle often rode out at night,
+ what were his habits, and possibly where the tent stood, and so on.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well,&rdquo; Mr. Prendergast said, &ldquo;if you like to undertake a wild goose chase
+ of this sort it is your business, and not mine; but I consider the idea is
+ the most Utopian that I ever heard of. As to where the tent stood, is it
+ likely that a man would remember to within a hundred yards where a tent
+ stood fourteen years ago? Why, you might dig up acres and acres of ground
+ and not be sure then that you had hit upon the right place.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is one other circumstance, Mr. Prendergast,&rdquo; Mark said quietly,
+ &ldquo;that has to be taken into consideration, and which renders it improbable
+ that these diamonds were hidden anywhere by my uncle himself at that time.
+ He certainly spoke of the whole of this treasure collectively. It is
+ morally certain that he would not carry all these jewels that he had been
+ collecting about with him, and certainly not his treasure in money. He
+ must, therefore, have sent these diamonds to the person, whoever he may
+ be, who had the keeping of his other jewels and of his money. This
+ certainly points to a bank.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is a sensible conjecture. Yes, there is something in that. He
+ certainly could not have carried about him 50,000 pounds in gold and as
+ much in jewelry; it would have been the act of a madman, and Colonel
+ Thorndyke, although eccentric and cranky, was not mad. But, on the other
+ hand, he may have carried about a banker's passbook, or what is equivalent
+ to it, for the amount that had been deposited with a native banker or
+ agent, together with a receipt for the box containing the jewels, and this
+ he might have hidden with the diamonds.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't think that he would have done that; there could have been no
+ object for his putting the power of demanding his money and valuables out
+ of his possession.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, well,&rdquo; the lawyer said testily, &ldquo;it is of no use arguing now what
+ he might or might not have done. A man who would have taken the trouble
+ that he did to prevent his daughter knowing that she was an heiress, and
+ fancied that he was followed about by black fellows, might do anything,
+ reasonable or unreasonable, under the sun. At any rate, Mr. Thorndyke, I
+ will carry out your instructions as to inquiries in London, and will duly
+ inform you of the result; beyond that I must really decline to give any
+ advice or opinion upon the matter, which is altogether beyond me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On leaving the lawyer's, Mark went to Bow Street, and related to the chief
+ the circumstances attending his father's murder.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have heard them from the man I sent down at your request, Mr.
+ Thorndyke, and taking the attempt early in the evening and the subsequent
+ murder, there can be no doubt that the affair was one of revenge, and not
+ of robbery. Had the second attempt stood alone, robbery might have been
+ the object; the mere fact that nothing was stolen in no way alters the
+ case. Men are often seized with a certain panic after committing a murder,
+ and fly at once without attempting to carry out their original purpose.
+ Your father, no doubt, fell heavily, and the man might well have feared
+ that the fall would be heard; but the previous attempt precludes the
+ supposition that robbery was at the bottom of it. It points to a case of
+ revenge, and certainly goes a very long way to support the theory that we
+ talked over when I last saw you, that the highwayman who endeavored to
+ stop you on the road, whom you wounded, and who afterwards went down to
+ Southampton, was the escaped convict, Bastow. Since that time I have had a
+ man making inquiries along the roads between Reigate and Kingston, but
+ altogether without success. I should be glad to follow up any other line
+ that you might suggest, and that might offer any reasonable possibility of
+ success, but I must own that at present we are entirely off the scent.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am thinking of devoting myself entirely to the quest. I have no
+ occupation at present. I have an income amply sufficient for my wants, and
+ for all expenses that I may incur, and I intend to devote, if necessary,
+ some years of my life to hunting this man down. As your men have searched
+ without success in the country, I think for the present my best plan will
+ be to devote myself to learning something of the ways and haunts of the
+ criminal classes of London, and it is with that object that I have come to
+ you now. I should like, for some time, at any rate, to enter the detective
+ force as an enrolled member. I should, of course, require no pay, but
+ should be prepared to obey all orders and to do any work required, as any
+ other member of the corps would do. I am strong, active, and have, I hope,
+ a fair share of intelligence. I should not mind risking my life in
+ carrying out any duty that you might assign to me. I presume that I need
+ not always be on duty, and could, when not required, employ my time as I
+ liked, and keep up my acquaintances in town. Should it be otherwise,
+ however, I am perfectly ready to submit myself in all respects to your
+ rule. I have a first rate horse and should be available for country duty,
+ wherever you might think fit to send me. I should not desire any
+ distinction to be made between me and the paid officers.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Your proposal is an altogether novel one, Mr. Thorndyke, but it is worthy
+ of consideration. I have no doubt that you would make a very useful
+ officer; the work is certainly interesting, though not without serious
+ hazards. However, I will think the matter over, and if you will call in
+ tomorrow you shall have my answer. We are always glad to have a new hand
+ in the force, for the faces of our men are so well known among the
+ criminal class that they are liable to be detected even under the
+ cleverest disguises. There is work, too, upon which it is absolutely
+ necessary that a gentleman should be employed, and in the event of your
+ joining us, I should wish you to keep the matter strictly from all your
+ acquaintances; and it would certainly be advantageous that you should,
+ when disengaged, continue to mix with your friends and to mingle in
+ society of all kinds as freely as possible. There is crime among the upper
+ classes as well as among the lower, though of a different type; and as Mr.
+ Thorndyke of Crowswood you would have far better opportunities of
+ investigating some of these cases than any of my men would have. You would
+ not object to take up such cases?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not at all, sir; that is, if it could be arranged that I should not do
+ the actual work of making an arrest, or have to appear in court as a
+ witness.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That could be managed,&rdquo; the chief said &ldquo;When you have got to a certain
+ point the matter of the final arrest could always be handed over to
+ someone else, but as a rule we keep our officers in the background as much
+ as possible, because at every trial the court is half full of men of the
+ criminal class, and the faces of our men would soon be known to every one
+ of them. Well, if you will call about ten o'clock tomorrow you shall have
+ my answer; but I should advise you to think the matter well over before
+ you see me again. The responsibilities as well as the dangers are great,
+ and indeed in some of the work you would literally have to carry your life
+ in your hand; and I can assure you that the task you would undertake is by
+ no means a light one.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0011" id="link2HCH0011">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XI.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ Mark called that evening, as he had promised, upon Mrs. Cunningham.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hope that you feel all the better for your day's rest, Millicent,&rdquo; he
+ said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The girl looked quickly at him to see if there was any sarcasm in the
+ question, but it was evident that the inquiry was made in earnest.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I feel better now,&rdquo; she said. &ldquo;I have dozed a good deal today. I did
+ not feel up to anything. Mrs. Cunningham's work has progressed
+ wonderfully. I should say that she has done more today than she ordinarily
+ finds time to do in a week. What have you been doing with yourself?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have been having a long talk with Mr. Prendergast about the lost
+ treasure.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And of course he said that you would never find it, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, yes, he distinctly expressed that opinion.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And afterwards?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Afterwards I went to Bow Street and had a long talk also with the chief
+ officer there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't like the idea of your searching for this man, Mark. In the first
+ place, I don't see why you should hope to succeed when the men whose
+ business it is to do such work have failed. In the next place, I think
+ that you may get into serious danger.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That I must risk, Millicent. I have already proved a better shot than he
+ is, and I am quite ready to take my chance if I can but come upon him;
+ that is the difficult part of the matter. I know that I shall need
+ patience, but I have plenty of time before me, and have great hopes that I
+ shall run him to earth at last.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But you would not know him if you saw him?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think I should,&rdquo; Mark said quietly; &ldquo;at least, if he is the man that I
+ suspect.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then you do suspect someone?&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said, laying down her work.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I know of no reason why you should not know it now. I suspect&mdash;indeed,
+ I feel morally certain&mdash;that the man who murdered my father was
+ Arthur Bastow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ An exclamation of surprise broke from both his hearers, and they listened
+ with horror while he detailed the various grounds that he had for his
+ suspicions. They were silent for some time after he had brought his
+ narrative to a conclusion, then Mrs. Cunningham said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What a merciful release for Mr. Bastow that he should have died before
+ this terrible thing came out! For after what you have told us I can hardly
+ doubt that you are right, and that it is this wicked man who is guilty.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, it was indeed providential,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;though I think that, feeble
+ as he has been for some months, it might have been kept from him. Still, a
+ word from a chance visitor, who did not associate Bastow the murderer with
+ our dear old friend, might have enlightened him, and the blow would have
+ been a terrible one indeed. It is true that, as it was, he died from the
+ shock, but he did not know the hand that struck the blow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now that you have told me this,&rdquo; Millicent said, &ldquo;I cannot blame you,
+ Mark, for determining to hunt the man down. It seems even worse than it
+ did before; it is awful to think that anyone could cherish revenge like
+ that. Now tell me how you are going to set about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have promised the chief officer that I will tell absolutely no one,&rdquo; he
+ said. &ldquo;I have a plan, and I believe that in time it must be successful. I
+ know well enough that I could tell you both of it without any fear of its
+ going further, but he asked me to promise, and I did so without
+ reservation; moreover, I think that for some reasons it is as well that
+ even you should not know it. As it is, you are aware that I am going to
+ try, and that is all. If I were to tell you how, you might be picturing
+ all sorts of imaginary dangers and worrying yourself over it, so I think
+ that it will be much the best that you should remain in ignorance, at any
+ rate for a time. I can say this, that I shall for the present remain
+ principally in London, and I think that I am more likely to come upon a
+ clew here than elsewhere.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent pouted, but Mrs. Cunningham said: &ldquo;I think, perhaps, that you
+ are right, Mark, and it is better that we should know nothing about it; we
+ shall know that you are looking for a clew, but of course no danger can
+ arise until you obtain it and attempt to arrest him. I feel sure that you
+ will do nothing rash, especially as if any harm befell you he might escape
+ unpunished, and therefore that when the time comes to seize him you will
+ obtain such help as may be necessary, and will, if possible, arrest him at
+ a moment when resistance is impossible.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you, Mrs. Cunningham; I shall certainly spare no efforts in taking
+ him that way, and would far rather he met his fate on a gibbet than by a
+ bullet from my pistol.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I agree with you, Mark,&rdquo; Millicent said; &ldquo;even hanging is too good for
+ such a wicked man. When are you going to set about it?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hope to be able to begin tomorrow,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I am impatient to be at
+ work, even though I know perfectly well that it may be months before I can
+ get on his track. I hope to get a good deal of information as to the
+ habits of men of his kind from the Bow Street runners, and I have an
+ appointment tomorrow morning to see their chief, who will give me every
+ assistance in his power.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then you will not be able to take us out?&rdquo; Millicent said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I trust to do so later on, but I cannot say how long I shall be engaged.
+ However, I hope to get away so as to go out with you after lunch, and may
+ possibly be able to postpone my getting regularly to work until after you
+ have gone, so as to be able to devote myself to your service.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But what sort of work? I cannot make out how you are going to begin.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can tell you this much, that to begin with I shall go in company with a
+ constable to various places where such a man is likely to be found. It
+ will take some time to acquaint myself with all these localities; the next
+ step will be to find out, if possible, if anyone at all answering to his
+ description is in the habit of coming there occasionally, and whom he
+ visits; another thing will be to find out the places where receivers of
+ stolen goods do their business, and to watch those with whom highwaymen
+ are suspected of having dealings. All this, you see, will entail a lot of
+ work, and require a very large amount of patience. Of course, if nothing
+ whatever comes of such inquiries, I shall have to try quiet places in the
+ suburbs; you must remember that this fellow during his time as a convict
+ must have had opportunities of getting a vast amount of information likely
+ to be useful to him, such as the addresses of men holding positions of
+ apparent respectability, and yet in alliance with thieves. You may be sure
+ that when he returned he took every imaginable pains to obtain a safe
+ place of concealment before he began his work; my own opinion is that I am
+ more likely to find him living quietly in a suburban cottage than in a
+ London slum.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent was now thoroughly interested in the search. &ldquo;It seems a great
+ business, Mark, but going into it as thoroughly as you are doing I feel
+ sure that you will succeed. I only wish that I could help you; but I could
+ not do that, could I?&rdquo; she asked wistfully.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He saw that she was in earnest, and suppressed all semblance of a smile.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am afraid, dear, that you would be a much greater source of
+ embarrassment than of assistance to me,&rdquo; he said gravely. &ldquo;This is
+ essentially not a woman's work. I believe that women are sometimes
+ employed in the detection of what we may call domestic crimes, but this is
+ a different matter altogether.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I suppose so,&rdquo; she sighed; &ldquo;but it will be very hard to be taking our
+ ease down at Weymouth while we know that you are, day after day, wearing
+ yourself out in tramping about making inquiries.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It will be no more fatiguing than tramping through the stubble round
+ Crowswood after partridges, which I should probably be doing now if I were
+ down there. By the way, before you go we shall have to talk over the
+ question of shutting up the house. We had too much to think of to go into
+ that before we came away, and I suppose I shall have to run down and
+ arrange it all, if you have quite made up your mind that you don't mean to
+ return for a year or two.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Decidedly our present idea is to have a few weeks at Weymouth, and then
+ when we feel braced up to come back here and look for a house. Where are
+ you likely to be, Mark?&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall consult with Dick Chetwynd; he knows the town thoroughly, and is
+ more up here than he is down in the country; he will recommend me to some
+ lodging in a street that, without being the height of fashion, is at least
+ passable. I have not the least wish to become a regular man about town,
+ but I should like to go into good society. One cannot be at work
+ incessantly.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next morning the chief of the detective department told Mark that he
+ had decided to accept his offer.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;As you will receive no pay,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;I shall regard you as a sort of
+ volunteer. For the first two or three months you will spend your time in
+ going about with one or other of my men on his work. They will be able to
+ put you up to disguises. When you have once learned to know all the
+ thieves' quarters and the most notorious receivers of stolen goods, you
+ will be able to go about your work on your own account. All that I require
+ is that you shall report yourself here twice a day. Should I have on hand
+ any business for which you may appear to me particularly well suited, I
+ shall request you to at once undertake it, and from time to time, when
+ there is a good deal of business on hand, I may get you to aid one of my
+ men who may require an assistant in the job on which he is engaged.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am sure I am very much obliged to you, sir,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;and will, I
+ can assure you, do my best in every way to assist your men in any business
+ in which they may be engaged.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;When will you begin?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is Saturday today, sir. I think I will postpone setting to until
+ Monday week. My cousin and the lady in whose charge she is came up with me
+ on Thursday, and will be leaving town the end of next week, and I should
+ wish to escort them about while here. I will come on Monday morning ready
+ for work. How had I better be dressed?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should say as a countryman. A convenient character for you to begin
+ with will be that of a man who, having got into a poaching fray, and hurt
+ a gamekeeper, has made for London as the best hiding place. You are quite
+ uncertain about your future movements, but you are thinking of enlisting.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very well, sir, I will get the constable at Reigate, who knows me well,
+ to send me a suit. I might find it difficult to get all the things I want
+ here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Accordingly, for the next week Mark devoted himself to the ladies.
+ Millicent, in her interest in the work that he was about to undertake, had
+ now quite got over her fit of ill temper, and the old cordial relations
+ were renewed. On the Friday he saw them into the Weymouth coach, then
+ sauntered off to his friend Chetwynd's lodgings.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Ramoo had already sailed. On his arrival in town he had said that he
+ should, if possible, arrange to go out as a steward.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Many men of my color who have come over here with their masters go back
+ in that way,&rdquo; he said, in answer to Mark's remonstrances. &ldquo;It is much more
+ comfortable that way than as a passenger. If you go third class, rough
+ fellows laugh and mock; if you go second class, men look as much as to
+ say, 'What is that colored fellow doing here? This is no place for him.'
+ Much better go as steward; not very hard work; very comfortable; plenty to
+ eat; no one laugh or make fun.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, perhaps it would be best, when one comes to think of it, Ramoo; but
+ I would gladly pay your passage in any class you like.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Ramoo go his own way, sahib,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;No pay passage money; me go to
+ docks where boats are sailing, go on board and see head steward. Head
+ steward glad enough to take good servant who is willing to work his way
+ out, and ask for no wages. Head steward draw wages for him, and put wages
+ in his own pocket. He very well satisfied.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On Wednesday he came and told Mark that he had arranged to sail in the
+ Nabob, and was to go on board early the next morning. He seemed a great
+ deal affected, and Mark and Millicent were equally sorry to part with the
+ faithful fellow.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, old man,&rdquo; Dick Chetwynd said, when Mark entered the room, where he
+ was still at breakfast, &ldquo;I was beginning to wonder whether you had gone to
+ Reigate. Why, when I saw you last Friday you told me that you would look
+ me up in a day or two.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have been busy showing London to Mrs. Cunningham and Miss Conyers,&rdquo; he
+ replied&mdash;for Millicent had insisted on keeping her former name, at
+ any rate for the present&mdash;and Mark was somewhat glad that there had
+ been no necessity for entering into any explanations. It was agreed that
+ when he went down to discharge some of the servants and called upon his
+ friends he should say nothing of the change in his position, but should
+ assign as a motive that he intended to travel about for a long time, and
+ that he felt he could not settle down in the lonely house, at any rate for
+ two or three years; and therefore intended to diminish the establishment.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will have some breakfast, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, thank you. I breakfasted two hours ago.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then you still keep to your intention to stay in London for a while?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes. I don't feel that I could bear the house alone,&rdquo; Mark replied. &ldquo;You
+ see, Mrs. Cunningham and my uncle's ward could not very well remain in a
+ bachelor's home, and naturally, after what has happened, they would not
+ like to do so, even if they could. They have gone down to Weymouth for a
+ few weeks for a complete change; and Mrs. Cunningham talks of taking a
+ house in town for a time. I am going to look for lodgings, and I want your
+ advice as to the quarter likely to suit me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Why not take up your abode here for a time? There is a vacant room, and I
+ should be very glad to have you with me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you very much, Dick, but I should prefer being alone. You will have
+ friends dropping in to see you, and at present I should be poor company.
+ It will be some little time before I shall feel equal to society.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, Mark. I always speak first and think afterwards, as you know
+ pretty well by this time. Well, what sort of lodgings do you want?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I want them to be in a good but not in a thoroughly fashionable street.
+ In time, no doubt, I shall like a little society, and shall get you to
+ introduce me to some of the quieter of your friends, and so gradually feel
+ my way.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will do all that sort of thing for you, Mark. As you know, I am not one
+ of those who see much fun in gambling or drinking, though one must play a
+ little to be in the fashion. Still, I never go heavily into it. I risk a
+ few guineas and then leave it. My own inclinations lie rather towards
+ sport, and in this I can indulge without being out of the fashion. All the
+ tip top people now patronize the ring, and I do so in my small way too. I
+ am on good terms with all the principal prize fighters, and put on the
+ gloves with one or other of them pretty nearly every day. I have taken
+ courses of lessons regularly from four or five of them, and I can tell you
+ that I can hold my own with most of the Corinthians. It is a grand sport,
+ and I don't know how I should get on without it; after the hard exercise I
+ was accustomed to down in the country, it keeps one's muscles in splendid
+ order, and I can tell you that if one happens to get into a fight in the
+ streets, it is no light thing to be able to polish off an antagonist in a
+ round or two without getting a mark on your face that would keep you a
+ prisoner in your room for a week or more.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I should like very much to take lessons too, Dick; it is one of the
+ things that I have always wished to do. I suppose one can do it of an
+ evening, or any time you like?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, any hour suits those fellows. You ought to get either a heavy
+ middleweight or a light heavyweight; you will be a heavyweight yourself by
+ the time you have filled out. Let me think; what is your height&mdash;six
+ feet one, if I remember rightly?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, that is about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, with your shoulders and long reach and activity, you ought to be
+ something out of the way if you take pains, Mark. You see, I am barely
+ five feet ten, and am something like two stone lighter than you are. I
+ suppose you are not much under twelve stone and a half.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is just about my weight; I weighed at the miller's only a fortnight
+ ago.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Good. I will make some inquiries, and see who would be the best man to
+ take you in hand to begin with. And now about lodgings. Well, I should say
+ Essex Street, or any of those streets running down from the Strand, would
+ suit you. The rooms in Essex Street are bigger than those in Buckingham
+ Street, and you will find anything between the two in some of the others.
+ I may as well saunter round there with you. Of course money is no object
+ to you?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No,&rdquo; Mark agreed, &ldquo;but I don't want big rooms. I think a small one, when
+ you are sitting by yourself, is more cozy and comfortable.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Finally two rooms were taken in Villiers Street; they were of moderate
+ size and handsomely furnished: the last tenant had fitted them out for
+ himself, but had lived to enjoy them only three months, having at the end
+ of that time been killed in a duel over a quarrel at cards.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I think you are in luck, Mark; you might look through a good many
+ streets before you would find rooms so fashionably furnished as these. I
+ see he went in for driving; that is evident from these engravings on the
+ walls.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;They are common, gaudy looking things,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;and quite out of
+ character with the furniture.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not at all, as times go, Mark; it is quite the thing for a man to have
+ prints showing his tastes, riding or driving, shooting or coaching, or the
+ ring. If you don't like them you can take them down, or, what will be
+ better, take them out of their frames and put some of the champions past
+ and present up there instead.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will see about it,&rdquo; Mark said with a laugh. &ldquo;I may turn out a complete
+ failure.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is no fear of that, Mark; and as the ring is all the fashion now, I
+ can assure you it would be considered in good taste, though I own that in
+ point of art most of these things leave a good deal to be desired. Now
+ that that important thing is settled, suppose you come and lunch with me
+ in Covent Garden? I don't belong to a club yet, though I have got my name
+ down at a couple of them, but as far as I can see they are slow sort of
+ places unless you know a lot of people. The coffee houses are much more
+ amusing; you see people of all sorts there&mdash;fellows like myself, who
+ have no clubs to go to; country gentlemen up for a week; a few writers,
+ who, by the way, are not the best customers of these places; men whom
+ nobody knows, and men whom everybody knows. Of course, the best time to
+ see them is of an evening.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I have generally been in of an evening when I have been up in towns
+ Dick, and I have always been amused. However, I am quite ready to lunch
+ there now, for I breakfasted early.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have to make some calls this afternoon, Mark. At seven this evening I
+ will look in at your lodgings, and you shall go along with me to
+ Ingleston's in St. Giles'. It is one of the headquarters of the fancy, and
+ Jack Needham, who taught me, is safe to be there, and he will tell me who
+ he thinks is best for you to begin with.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Accordingly, after taking luncheon, they separated, and Mark went to his
+ inn.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Ingleston's was at that time regarded as the headquarters of the fancy. At
+ the back of the house was a large room, with benches rising behind each
+ other to accommodate the spectators. Here, on the evenings when it was
+ known that leading men would put on the gloves, peers of the realm would
+ sit side by side with sporting butchers, and men of fashion back their
+ opinion on a coming prize fight with ex-pugilists and publicans. A number
+ of men were assembled in the bar; among these was Jack Needham.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Good evening, Mr. Chetwynd,&rdquo; the man said as they came up to him. &ldquo;It's
+ going to be a good night. Tring and Bob Pratt are going to have a round or
+ two together, and Gibbons will put on the gloves with anyone who likes to
+ take him on.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;This gentleman is Mr. Thorndyke, a squire, Jack, whose place is near mine
+ at Reigate. He has come up to town for a few months, and wants to learn
+ how to use his mauleys. I told him that you would advise him as to who
+ would be the best man for him to go to.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can tell you better when I have seen him strip, sir. There is no one in
+ the big room at present. It won't be open for half an hour. Ingleston
+ keeps it shut as long as he can so as to give everyone a fair chance of a
+ good place. If the gentleman will come in there with me I will have a look
+ at him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark expressed his willingness to be looked at, and the man having gone
+ and got the key of the room from Ingleston, went in with them and locked
+ the door behind.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, sir, if you will strip to the waist I shall be better able to say
+ who you should have as your teacher than I can now.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark stripped, and the man walked round and round him, examining him
+ critically.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He's a big 'un,&rdquo; he said to Dick when he had completed his examination.
+ &ldquo;He has got plenty of muscle and frame, and ought to be a tremendous
+ hitter; he is about the figure of Gibbons, and if he goes in for it
+ really, ought to make well nigh as good a man, if not quite. I don't think
+ Bill would care about taking him up till he knows a bit about it. I tell
+ you what, sir; you will be too big altogether for me by the time you get
+ to be quick on your legs, and to use your strength, but if you like I will
+ take you on for a month or so&mdash;say, two months; by that time I think
+ you will be good enough to go to Gibbons. I will just call him in if you
+ don't mind; he came in just before you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In a couple of minutes he came in with a man of similar height and
+ somewhat similar figure to Mark.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;This is Gibbons, sir, ex-champion, and like enough he might be champion
+ now if he chose; as fine a boxer as ever stripped, but he is ring maker
+ now to the P. C. and it suits him better to do that and to teach, than to
+ have a chance of getting a battle once a year or so.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Have you a great many pupils, Gibbons?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The man shook his head.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am too big, sir; gentlemen like to learn from someone about their own
+ weight, or perhaps a bit lighter, and there are not many of them who would
+ care to stand up against a man who has been champion, and so I have plenty
+ of time on my hands. I am a hard hitter, too, even with the gloves; that
+ is one reason why Jack had best take you on until you get a little handy
+ with your fists. I do more in the dog fancier line than I do with boxing,
+ but there is nothing I like better than getting the gloves on with an
+ amateur who is likely to be a credit to me. That is my card, sir; you will
+ find me in pretty nearly any time of the day, and I have got a place
+ behind the house where I do teaching when I get a chance. It is handy in
+ one way, because you can drop in and take a lesson any time you like.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That would suit me exceedingly well,&rdquo; Mark said; &ldquo;and when I have had a
+ couple of months with Needham I will come to you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark now put on his clothes again, and they went out together, and
+ re-entered a few minutes later, when the door was open. The benches were
+ soon crowded. Mark had been to several prize fights with Dick Chetwynd,
+ had often boxed with him and other lads, and had had lessons from an
+ ex-prize fighter at Reigate, and was therefore able to appreciate the
+ science shown by the various men who confronted each other. The event of
+ the evening was the contest between Tring and Bob Pratt; both were very
+ powerful men, who were about to go into strict training for matches that
+ had been made for them against two west countrymen, who were thought very
+ highly of by their friends, and who were regarded as possible candidates
+ for the championship.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Bob Pratt was a stone heavier than his opponent, but far less active, and
+ owed his position more to his ability to take punishment, and to hard
+ hitting powers, than to his science. In the two rounds that were fought,
+ Tring had the advantage, but the general opinion was that in the long run
+ the other would wear him down. Both fought with good temper, and were
+ warmly applauded as they shook hands at the finish.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think I should back Tring in a fight,&rdquo; Mark said, as the meeting broke
+ up, &ldquo;but it is difficult to say, for he is in better condition than the
+ other, and it may be that when both are thoroughly fit the heavy man might
+ show more improvement than he would do.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The hat was passed round at the conclusion: Every man dropped in his
+ guinea, some more, it being understood that the collection was divided
+ between the two men to pay the expenses of their training.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0012" id="link2HCH0012">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XII.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The next morning Mark commenced work in earnest, and for two months
+ visited all the worst slums of London in company with one of the Bow
+ Street men. Both were generally in disguise, but Mark's companion
+ sometimes went openly to some of the houses inhabited by men well known as
+ criminals. On such occasions Mark remained within call, ready to go in if
+ assistance should be required; but there was small fear of this, the men
+ who were visited were all personally known to the officer, and generally
+ greeted him with &ldquo;You aint wanting me, are you?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not at all; what I am wanting is a little information for which I shall
+ be quite willing to pay the first man who enables us to lay hands on the
+ gentleman I want to find.&rdquo; Then he would describe Bastow's appearance.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He has taken to the road, I fancy, and has given us a good deal of
+ trouble; if it is the man I think it is, he has been away from London for
+ some years, and came back eight or ten months ago.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The reply was always to the same effect:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know of such a man, and never heard of him. For my part, I would
+ not split on a pal, not for anything; but I should not mind earning five
+ guineas to put you on a cove who is not one of us. Besides, it aint only
+ the money; you know, you might do me a good turn some day.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Quite so; well, I can tell you it is a good deal more than five guineas
+ that would be earned if you could put me in the way of laying my hand on
+ his shoulder. I don't think that he is living in town. I expect he is in
+ some quiet neighborhood; still, if he is on the road, he must have a horse
+ somewhere. You might ask among the stables, and find out whether anyone
+ keeps a horse there who is in the habit of going out in the afternoon and
+ not coming back until the next day. You have plenty of time upon your
+ hands, and it would pay you well if you could bring me the information I
+ want.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The officer said to Mark at the end of two months: &ldquo;These knights of the
+ road don't often mix themselves up with the London housebreakers. The most
+ likely men to be able to tell you about the doings of such a fellow would
+ be receivers of stolen goods, but it would be dangerous to question any of
+ them&mdash;they would be sure to put him on his guard. I will give you a
+ list of some of them, and I should say that your best way would be to
+ watch their places of an evening, from the time it gets dark till ten or
+ eleven. Of course, it is just a chance. You may watch one place for a
+ month and he may happen to go there the very day you have gone off to
+ watch another crib. Still, there is just the chance, and I don't see that
+ there is one any other way.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ During this time Mark had been taking a lesson every evening with Needham,
+ and had surprised his teacher with the rapidity of his progress; he had
+ said, the very evening before, when Mark had countered him with a blow
+ that knocked him for two or three minutes senseless:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have had enough of this, governor; you have got beyond me altogether,
+ and I don't want another blow like that. You had better take on Gibbons
+ now. You are too big altogether for me, and yet you don't fight like a
+ heavyweight, for you are as quick on your pins as I am.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Well pleased at having the day to himself and of having got clear of his
+ work in the thieves' rookeries, Mark went the next morning to Gibbons'
+ shop. His entry was hailed by a chorus of barking from dogs of all sorts
+ and sizes, from the bulldog down to the ratting terrier.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Glad to see you, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; Gibbons said, when he had silenced the
+ barking. &ldquo;I saw Jack last week, and he told me that he should hand you
+ over to me pretty soon, for that you were getting beyond him altogether,
+ and he thought that if you stuck to it you would give me all my work to do
+ in another six months.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I finished with him last night, Gibbons, and I shall be ready to come for
+ a lesson to you every morning, somewhere about this hour. I have brought
+ my bag with my togs.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, sir, I am ready at once; the place is clear now behind. I have
+ just been making it tidy, for we had a little ratting last night, one of
+ my dogs against Sir James Collette's, fifty rats each; my dog beat him by
+ three quarters of a minute.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will never see me here at one of those businesses. I have no
+ objection to stand up to a man my own size and give and take until we have
+ had enough, but to see rats slaughtered when they have not a chance of
+ making a fight of it is altogether out of my line.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, sir, I do not care about it myself; there are lots who do like it,
+ and are ready to wager their money on it, and as it helps to sell my dogs,
+ besides what I can win out of the event&mdash;it was a wager of twenty
+ guineas last night&mdash;it aint for me to set myself up against it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Calling a boy to look after the shop, Gibbons went away into a wooden
+ building in the back yard; it was about twenty-five feet square, and there
+ were holes in the floor for the stakes, when a regular ring was made. The
+ floor was strewn with clean sawdust; a number of boxing gloves hung by the
+ wall.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is the dressing room,&rdquo; Gibbons said, pointing to a door at the
+ other end. When both were ready he looked Mark over. &ldquo;Your muscles have
+ thickened out a good bit, sir, since I saw you strip. Before another four
+ years, if you keep on at it, you will be as big a man as I am. I am about
+ eight years too old, and you are four years too young. You will improve
+ every day, and I shan't. Now, sir, let us see what you can do. Jack tells
+ me that you are wonderfully quick on your feet; there is the advantage you
+ have of me. I am as strong as ever I was, I think, but I find that I
+ cannot get about as I used to.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He stood somewhat carelessly at first, but as they sparred for an opening
+ he became more careful, and presently hit out sharply. Mark leaped back,
+ and then, springing forward, struck out with his left; Gibbons only just
+ stopped it and then countered, but Mark was out of reach again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is good enough,&rdquo; Gibbons said; &ldquo;I can see Jack has taught you pretty
+ nearly all there is to know. We will just take those hits again. You were
+ right to get away from the first, but the second time you should have
+ guarded with your left, and hit at my chin with your right. That jumping
+ back game is first rate for avoiding punishment, but you have got to come
+ in again to hit. You took me by surprise that time, and nearly got home,
+ but you would not do it twice,&rdquo; and so the lesson went on for three
+ quarters of an hour.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That will do for today, sir; I am getting blown, if you are not. Well, I
+ can tell you I have never had a more promising pupil, and I have brought
+ forward two or three of the best men in the ring; no wonder that Jack
+ cannot do much with you. Give me six months, every day, and you should
+ have a turn occasionally with other men, and I would back you for a
+ hundred pounds against any man now in the ring.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Three or four days later Mark received a message that the chief wanted to
+ speak with him that afternoon, and he accordingly went down.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I've got a job for you, Mr. Thorndyke; it is just the sort of thing that
+ will suit you. There is a house in Buckingham Street that we have had our
+ eye on for some time; it is a gambling house, but with that we have
+ nothing to do unless complaints are made, but we have had several
+ complaints of late. It is a well got up place, and there are a good many
+ men of title frequent it, but men of title are not always more honest than
+ other people; anyhow, there are some rooks there, and several young
+ fellows of means have been pigeoned and ruined. They are mighty particular
+ who they let in, and there would be very little chance of getting my
+ regular men in there. Now, you are a stranger in London, but you have
+ friends here, and no doubt you could get introduced. We want to know if
+ the play is fair; if it isn't, we would break the place up altogether. We
+ know enough to do it now; but none of the poor beggars who have been
+ ruined will come forward, and, indeed, haven't any idea, I think, that
+ they have lost their money in anything but a run of bad luck.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;One young fellow blew his brains out last week, and his father came here
+ with a list of what are called debts of honor, which he found in his room.
+ There they are, and the names of the men they are owed to; of course some
+ of them have been fairly won, but I have a strong suspicion that those I
+ have marked with a cross have not been. For instance, there is Sir James
+ Flash, a fellow who was turned out of White's two years ago for sharp
+ practice with cards; there is John Emerson, he is a man of good family,
+ but all his friends have given him up long ago, and he has been living by
+ his wits for the last five years. The others marked are all of the same
+ sort. Now, what I want you to do is to become a frequenter of the place;
+ of course you will have to play a little, and as you are a stranger I
+ expect that they will let you win for a bit; but if not the old gentleman
+ has placed 200 pounds in my hands for the expenses.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I could play with my own money,&rdquo; Mark said rather warmly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You forget, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; the chief said firmly, &ldquo;that at the present
+ moment you are a member of my force, and that you go to this place in that
+ capacity, and not as Squire of Crowswood; therefore you must, if you
+ please, do as I instruct you. The gentleman will be ready to pay that sum.
+ As you see, the amounts entered here total up to nearly 10,000 pounds. He
+ said that it will ruin him to pay that sum, but that he must do so rather
+ than his son should be branded as a defaulter. I have advised him to write
+ to all these people saying that it will take him some time to raise the
+ money, but that he will see that nobody shall be a loser by his son's
+ debts. I have told him in the meantime that I will endeavor to get proof
+ that the play was not fair, and in that case he would, of course, refuse
+ to pay any of the claims on that ground; and you may be sure that if
+ unfair play was proved none of those concerned would dare to press their
+ claims.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then my function would be simply to watch?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, to watch, and to bring me word of anything you may observe. You see,
+ without making a public scandal, if it could be found that a man was
+ discovered cheating, and the way in which he was doing it, one would be
+ able to put so strong a pressure on him, that not only might he be forced
+ to abstain from going to any club, but would be frightened into giving up
+ any IOUs he might hold.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall be glad to do the best I can, sir; but frankly I know next to
+ nothing of cards, and should have but little chance of detecting anything
+ that might be going on, when it must be done so cleverly that experienced
+ gamblers, watching a man closely, fail to see anything wrong.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I quite understand that; but one of my men has made a study of the
+ various methods employed by gamblers to cheat, and although it would take
+ you years to learn how to do it yourself, a few hours' instruction from
+ him would at least put you up to some of their methods, and enable you to
+ know where to look for cheating. The man is now waiting in the next room,
+ and if you will take two or three hours daily with him, say for a week,
+ you ought to be able to detect the doings of these fellows when to others
+ everything seems right and above board. You may have no inclination for
+ cards, but knowledge of that sort is useful to anyone in society, here or
+ anywhere else, and may enable him either to save his own pocket or to do a
+ service to a friend.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark was greatly interested in the tricks the man showed him. At first it
+ seemed to him almost magical, after he himself had shuffled the cards and
+ cut them the dealer invariably turned up a king. Even admitting he might
+ have various places of concealment, pockets in the lining of the sleeve,
+ in the inside of the coat, and in various other parts of the dress, in
+ which cards could be concealed and drawn out by silken threads, it did not
+ seem possible that this could be done with such quickness as to be
+ unobserved. It was only when his teacher showed him, at first in the
+ slowest manner, and then gradually increasing his speed, that he perceived
+ that what seemed impossible was easy enough when the necessary practice
+ and skill had been attained. The man was indeed an adept at a great
+ variety of tricks by which the unsuspecting could be taken in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I ought to know,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I was for three years in a gambling house in
+ Paris, where every other man was a sharper. I have been in places of the
+ same sort in Belgium, Holland, Germany, and Italy. At first I was only a
+ boy waiter, and as until evening there was nothing doing at these places,
+ men would sometimes amuse themselves by teaching me tricks, easy ones to
+ begin with, and when they saw I was sharp and quick handed they went on.
+ After a time I began to work as a confederate, and at last on my own
+ account; but I got disgusted with it at last. A young fellow shot himself
+ at the table of the gambling house at Rome, and at another place I was
+ nearly killed by a man who had lost heavily&mdash;do you see, it has left
+ a broad scar right across my forehead?&mdash;so I gave it up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I was in the French police for a time, and used to watch some of the
+ lower hells. I was nearly killed there once or twice, and at last I came
+ back here. My French chief gave me a letter to the chief, and I was taken
+ on at once, for, talking as I do half a dozen languages, and being
+ acquainted with most of the swell mobsmen of Paris, I was just the man who
+ happened to be wanted here at the time. Since I came over I have done a
+ good deal in the way of breaking up hells where sailors and others are
+ plundered. But, you see, I cannot be used for the higher class of work; my
+ nose has been broken, and I have half a dozen scars on my face. I hate the
+ sight of cards now. I have seen so much of the ruin they do, and have, I
+ am sorry to say, taken a hand so often in doing it, that save showing
+ someone who would use the knowledge in the right way how the tricks are
+ done, nothing would persuade me to touch them again. However, as a
+ protection, the knowledge is as useful as it is dangerous when used the
+ other way. It would take you ten years to learn to do these tricks
+ yourself so well as to defy detection; but in a very short time, by
+ learning where to keep your eyes, you would get to detect almost any of
+ them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You see, there are three methods of cheating: the first by hidden cards,
+ the second by marked cards, the third simply by sleight of hand, this
+ being generally used in connection with marked cards. These tricks require
+ great skill and extreme delicacy of touch, for the marks, which are
+ generally at the edge of the cards, are so slight as to be altogether
+ imperceptible save to a trained hand. There are also marks on the back of
+ the cards; these are done in the printing, and are so slight that, unless
+ attention were attracted to them, no one would dream of their existence.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In the course of a week's practice Mark learned where to look for
+ cheating; he could not indeed follow the fingers of his instructor, for
+ even when he knew what was going to be done, the movements were so rapid
+ that his eye could not follow them, and in nine cases out of ten he was
+ unable to say whether the coup had been accomplished or not; but he could
+ see that there was a slight movement of the fingers that could only mean
+ that something was being done.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It would be a good thing,&rdquo; he said one day, &ldquo;if every young fellow before
+ going out into the world were to have a course of such instruction as you
+ are giving me; he would learn, at least, the absolute folly of sitting
+ down to play cards with strangers. He would see that he could be robbed in
+ fifty different ways, and would be at the absolute mercy of any sharper. I
+ never had any inclination for gambling, but if I had been inclined that
+ way you would have cured me of the passion for life.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The week's instruction was lengthened to a fortnight, and at the end of
+ that time Mark went to Dick Chetwynd.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you know, Dick,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;a gambling place in Buckingham Street?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I know that there is a hell there, Mark, but I have never been in it. Why
+ do you ask?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have rather a fancy to go there,&rdquo; he replied. &ldquo;I hear that, although a
+ good many men of fashion haunt the place, the crowd is rather a mixed
+ one.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It has a bad name, Mark; I have heard some queer reports about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, so have I. I should think that it is a very likely place for a man
+ like Bastow to go to if he has any liking for play. Of course he would get
+ up as a gentleman. At any rate, I have been making what inquiries I can in
+ some of the thieves' quarters, and have come to the conclusion that he is
+ not likely to have taken up his abode there, and I don't think I can do
+ better than make a round of some of these doubtful houses. I should like
+ to begin with this, and then work downwards.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I dare say I could manage it, Mark; I know half a dozen men who
+ play there; they say there is more fun and excitement to be got than at
+ White's or Crockford's, or any of those places. Some men, of course, play
+ high, but a good many who go there only risk a few guineas; some go
+ because it is the proper thing at present for a man about town either to
+ play or to bet on horses or cock fights, or to patronize the ring; and,
+ after all, it is easier to stroll for an hour or two of an evening into
+ comfortable rooms, where you meet a lively set and there is champagne
+ always going, than it is to attend races or prize fights.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Very few days passed that Mark did not go in for half an hour's chat with
+ his friend, and two days after this conversation Dick said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;By the way, Mark, I have arranged for us to go to that hell tonight;
+ young Boldero, who is a member of my club, told me some time ago that he
+ played there sometimes. I met him yesterday evening, and said that I had a
+ fancy to go and have a look at it, and that a friend of mine from the
+ country also wanted to go; he said at once that he would take us there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'I should advise you not to play much, Chetwynd,' he said; 'sometimes
+ they play uncommonly high, and there are some fellows who have wonderful
+ luck. Of course, on ordinary occasions, when the play is low, you could
+ stake a few guineas there as well as elsewhere, but when really high play
+ is on we small fish always stand out. All I can say is that I have never
+ seen anything that savors of foul play in the smallest degree; but you
+ understand how it is, if one man happens to have a big run of luck, there
+ are always fellows who go about hinting that there is something wrong in
+ it. However, it is a jolly place to drop into, and, of course there is no
+ occasion to play always, and if one loses one is likely to win on the next
+ race or on the next fight.'&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Accordingly that evening Mark met Boldero, whom he had once or twice
+ before seen in Dick's company, and the three went together to the house in
+ Buckingham Street. Boldero nodded to the doorkeeper as he went in, and
+ they then proceeded upstairs and entered a handsome room, with comfortable
+ sofas and chairs, on which a dozen men were seated, for the most part
+ smoking. Several champagne bottles stood on the tables, and all who liked
+ helped themselves. Boldero was known to several of those present, while
+ two or three were also known to Dick. Boldero introduced them both to his
+ friends. One of these was the Hon. John Emerson, a man of some five and
+ thirty, with a languid air and a slight drawl.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Glad to make your acquaintance, sir,&rdquo; he said to Mark. &ldquo;Have you been
+ long in town?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Two or three months only,&rdquo; Mark replied.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Is this your first visit here?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, this is my first visit to any place of the sort, but I thought that
+ I should like to go the rounds before I went home again.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Quite so. Going to punt a few guineas, I suppose?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I suppose that is the right thing to do.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, everyone who comes is expected to do a little that way; there is no
+ occasion to play high.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, I should not like to do that,&rdquo; Mark said innocently; &ldquo;indeed, I know
+ very little about cards.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, that is quite immaterial so long as you only play games of chance; in
+ fact, you don't want to know anything about them. You see others staking
+ their money, some on one side of the table, and some on the other; you
+ place your money whichever side you like, and take your chance. There is
+ no skill in it. Some people play on what they call a system, but there is
+ nothing in it; you have just as much chance if you put your money down
+ blindfolded. If luck is with you, you win; if luck is against you, you
+ lose.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After chatting for a few minutes Mark went with his two companions
+ upstairs. The room they now entered was furnished as a drawing room,
+ except that in the middle was a table, round which some fifteen people
+ were seated, while as many more looked on; round the room were several
+ small tables, on which were packs of cards. These were for those who
+ preferred to play piquet or ecarte, two or three couples being so engaged.
+ Mark knew enough of cards to know that hazard was being played at the
+ large table. There was an inner room, and Mark strolled across and looked
+ in. It was at present untenanted; it contained a center table capable of
+ holding four, and two or three small ones, with two chairs set in
+ readiness to each.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is where the heavy play goes on,&rdquo; Boldero said. &ldquo;None of your four
+ or five guineas wagers there, fifties and hundreds are nearer the mark,
+ and I have seen a thousand wagered many a time. It is exciting work even
+ looking on, I can tell you; what it must be for the players I cannot say,
+ but I should think it must be frightful.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark took up his stand at the hazard table, and after looking on for some
+ little time began to play. Beginning with guineas, he gradually, as luck
+ favored him, played five guineas, and after half an hour's play won fifty.
+ Then luck turned, and in a few minutes he had lost all he won.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You ought to have stopped, Mark,&rdquo; Dick said reproachfully, as he stepped
+ back from his place, which was at once filled by one who had been standing
+ behind him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The play in the inner room had now begun, and Mark went in and joined
+ those who were looking on. In half an hour one of the players had had
+ enough, and a young man said to Emerson, who was standing on the other
+ side of the table:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, Mr. Emerson, will you give me my revenge?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I would really rather not, Mr. Cotter. The luck has been so one sided
+ lately that I would rather leave it alone.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But it may turn tonight,&rdquo; the other said. &ldquo;At any rate, I will try it, if
+ you have no objection.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a certain eagerness in the young man's voice that caused Mark to
+ watch him closely. He was a good looking young fellow, but his face was
+ not a strong one; and although he evidently tried to assume an appearance
+ of indifference as he sat down, there was a nervous movement of his
+ fingers. Mark took his place behind him as play began. The game was
+ ecarte, and for a time Emerson lost.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think the luck has changed, Mr. Cotter, but as we generally raise the
+ stakes after playing for a bit, I am ready to do so. Shall we make it
+ fifty pounds again?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;With pleasure,&rdquo; the young man said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He won the next two games, then for some time they won alternately.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Shall we say a hundred again?&rdquo; he said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;As you like,&rdquo; Emerson replied. &ldquo;We don't seem to get much forwarder
+ either way at present.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A considerable number of lookers on had now gathered round. So far Mark,
+ although watching the fingers of the opposite player intently, had seen no
+ sign whatever of unfair play. He now redoubled his attention. Cotter won
+ the first game, his adversary the three next. Mark noticed now that after
+ looking at his hand Emerson looked abstractedly, as if meditating before
+ taking the next step; there was no expression in his face, but Mark
+ fancied that his eyes rested for a moment on the man standing next to
+ himself. He looked at his watch and then, as if finding the hour later
+ than he had expected, moved away from his place, and presently joined
+ Dick, who was standing with Boldero on the other side of the table.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Who is that man playing with Emerson?&rdquo; he asked in a whisper.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is the son of Cotter, the head of Cotter's Bank, in Lombard Street.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As the men were standing two or three deep round the table, Mark could not
+ see the table itself, but this mattered little, for his attention was
+ entirely directed towards the man standing behind Cotter's chair. He saw
+ that after glancing down at the young man's hand he looked across as if
+ seeing what Emerson was going to do; sometimes his eyes dropped for an
+ instant, at other times there was no such movement, and after noticing
+ this four or five times, and noticing the course Emerson took, he had no
+ doubt whatever in his own mind that the movement of the man's eyes was an
+ intimation to Emerson of the nature of Cotter's hand. The young man had
+ lost four games in succession; he had grown very pale, but showed no other
+ signs of agitation. Presently he said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have your usual luck again; I will only play one more game tonight,
+ but we may as well make it worth playing. Shall we say five hundred?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;At your service,&rdquo; Emerson replied.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ This time the face of the man standing behind Cotter's chair was
+ immovable, and Mark, placing himself behind a short man and straining his
+ head forward, saw that Cotter scored four. The next time there was still
+ no sign. Emerson showed a king and scored it, and then won every trick and
+ the game.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That makes nine hundred pounds,&rdquo; the young man said quietly, writing an
+ IOU for that amount and handing it to Emerson. There was a general
+ movement of the spectators, and two fresh players took the seats vacated
+ by the late antagonists.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Who was the man standing behind Cotter's chair?&rdquo; Mark asked Boldero.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is Sir James Flash. He is just going to play, you see; it is sure to
+ be another hot game, and an interesting one.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I think I will go,&rdquo; Mark said; &ldquo;the heat of the room has given me a
+ bit of a headache. I will see you tomorrow, Dick.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Good night, old man,&rdquo; Chetwynd said; and, shaking hands with Boldero,
+ Mark went downstairs immediately after Cotter. The latter went into the
+ room below, drank off a tumbler of champagne, and then went down, took his
+ hat, and went out. Mark followed him for a short distance, and joined him
+ as soon as he got up into the Strand.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Mr. Cotter,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;I have not the pleasure of knowing you personally,
+ and I must introduce myself. My name is Mark Thorndyke, and I am the owner
+ of an estate close to Reigate. Would you mind my exchanging a few words
+ with you?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Cotter looked up, and was about to give a flat refusal, but the expression
+ of Mark's face was so friendly and pleasant that he changed his mind and
+ said in a hard voice:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I really do not know what you can have to say to me, Mr. Thorndyke, but
+ of course I can hardly refuse to hear you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They walked across the road and turned up a quiet street.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;For certain reasons it is not necessary for me to explain,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;I
+ went to that place for the first time tonight, and I watched the play
+ between you and Mr. Emerson.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It does not matter, sir; I lost, and I am not going there again.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hope, on the contrary, that you will go there again, Mr. Cotter. If I
+ mistake not, from what I heard, you have lost considerable sums to that
+ man.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I imagine, sir, that that is no business of a stranger.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;In no way personally,&rdquo; Mark replied, not heeding the angry ring in the
+ voice, &ldquo;but as an honest man it does concern me. I am absolutely
+ convinced, sir, that that money has not been won from you fairly.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The young man gave a start.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Impossible!&rdquo; he said shortly. &ldquo;Mr. Emerson is a man of good family and a
+ gentleman.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is a man of good family, I admit, but certainly not a gentleman; his
+ antecedents are notorious.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have never heard a word against him; he is intimate with Sir James
+ Flash and other gentlemen of position.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am not surprised, that you have not heard of it; it was probably to the
+ interest of several persons that you should not do so. Nor do I suppose
+ that you are aware that Sir James Flash was himself expelled from White's
+ for cheating at cards.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Impossible!&rdquo; Mr. Cotter replied.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can assure you of the fact,&rdquo; Mark said quietly. &ldquo;Probably you have
+ among your acquaintances some members of White's. I am sure if you ask
+ them they will confirm the fact. Now, sir, I can assure you that I have no
+ interest in this matter, save to prevent a gentleman from being ruined by
+ blacklegs. May I ask how much you owe to Mr. Emerson and Sir James Flash?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The young man hesitated. &ldquo;I believe you, sir,&rdquo; he said at last. &ldquo;They hold
+ my IOUs for 29,000 pounds. I need hardly say it is absolute ruin. My
+ intention is to make a clean breast to my father about it tomorrow
+ morning. My father will give me the money, in the first place because he
+ loves me and would save my name from disgrace, and in the second because
+ were I posted as a defaulter it would strike a severe blow at the credit
+ of the bank. So he will give me the money, but he will bid me leave his
+ house forever. That will matter little, for I shall pay the money, and
+ tomorrow night I shall blow out my brains.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, sir, if you will follow my advice you will neither pay the money
+ nor blow out your brains. I saw enough tonight to feel absolutely certain
+ that you have been cheated. Sir James Flash stood behind you, and was, I
+ am sure, signaling your hand to Emerson. I believe that Emerson played
+ fair otherwise, until the last game, but I am convinced that he then
+ cheated. You had good hands, but he had better; and although I did not see
+ him cheat&mdash;for I was on the other side of the table&mdash;I am
+ convinced that he did so. Now, sir, I advise you to go in as usual
+ tomorrow evening, and to play, raising your stakes as you did tonight.
+ When the times comes I will expose him. Should I not be able to detect him
+ we must try another night. I am so much convinced that this is the case,
+ and that I shall succeed, that whether you play one night or three I will
+ guarantee that you shall be no loser, but will, on the honor of a
+ gentleman, place in your hands the amount of your losses; so that you will
+ not have to ask your father for a check larger than you would do if you
+ confessed to him tomorrow morning. I only ask in return that you, on your
+ part, will give me your word of honor that you will never touch a card
+ again after you rise from the table.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I cannot accept so generous an offer from a stranger,&rdquo; Cotter said in a
+ low tone.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I do not think that it is generous,&rdquo; Mark replied quietly, &ldquo;because I am
+ perfectly convinced that I shall not have to pay at all. Have you any
+ other IOUs out?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have given them for about 5000 pounds, but that is not in addition to
+ the 29,000 pounds. Emerson told me that as he knew that I should have
+ difficulty in paying them at the present moment, he had taken them up, and
+ held them with his own.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Will you give me the names of the persons to whom you gave them in the
+ first place?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Certainly;&rdquo; and he mentioned three names, all of which stood with a black
+ cross against them on Mark's list.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you. Then you will go tomorrow night again?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes; and I swear to you that I will never touch a card afterwards.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't think that you need fear,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;I have not been long in
+ London, but I happen to have been shown a good many of the tricks that
+ these blacklegs play on greenhorns, which will account for my having
+ noticed what has never been observed by the honest portion of the men who
+ frequent the place. Now I will say good night, sir. I shall be behind your
+ chair or his tomorrow night.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know what to say,&rdquo; Cotter said hesitatingly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is no occasion to say anything; it is the duty of every honest man
+ to interfere if he sees another honest man being robbed, and that is my
+ sole object in this matter. Good night;&rdquo; and turning round, he walked
+ rapidly away.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0013" id="link2HCH0013">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XIII.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The next morning, before going round to Gibbons', Mark saw his chief and
+ told him of what had taken place on the previous evening.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I certainly did not think that you would succeed so soon; you believe
+ that you will be able fairly to expose these fellows?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have no doubt whatever that I shall be able to expose one of them; and
+ I have equally no doubt that if the others are arrested, either false
+ cards or pockets for cards will be found upon them. What do you wish me to
+ do, sir? I can, of course, expose any fellow I catch at it, but can do
+ nothing about the others.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I must have more than one captured,&rdquo; the chief said. &ldquo;At even the most
+ irreproachable club there may be one blackleg, but if it is clear that
+ this place is the haunt of blacklegs we can break it. There are half a
+ dozen Acts that apply; there is the 11th Act of Henry VIII, statute 33,
+ cap. 9, which prohibits the keeping of any common house for dice, cards,
+ or any unlawful game. That has never been repealed, except that gaming
+ houses were licensed in 1620. What is more to the point is that five Acts
+ of George II, the 9th, 12th, 13th, 18th, and 30th, impose penalties upon
+ the keepers of public houses for permitting gambling, and lay heavy
+ penalties upon hazard, roulette, and other gambling games, on the keepers
+ of gambling houses and those who play there. Having received complaints of
+ several young men being rooked in the place, we can, if we prove that some
+ of its frequenters are blacklegs, shut the place up altogether. We should
+ do it quietly, and without fuss, if possible; but if we shut it up several
+ others of the same sort will be certain to close their doors. But mind,
+ there will probably be a desperate row, and you had better take pistols
+ with you. I will have four men close at hand from ten o'clock till the
+ time the place closes, and if they hear a scrimmage, or you fire a pistol
+ out of the window, they will rush in and seize all engaged in the row, and
+ march them to the lock up. Of course you will have to be included.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark then went to Chetwynd.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, what did you think of it last night?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I own that it went against my grain to see that young fellow being
+ victimized by a sharper.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My dear Mark, you must not use such language as that. I fancy from what I
+ have heard that the Honorable John is not altogether an estimable
+ character, but to call him a sharper is going too far altogether.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't think that it is, for from what I saw last night I am pretty well
+ convinced that he did not play fair. I mean to go again tonight.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But why on earth should you mix yourself up in such an affair, Mark? It
+ is no business of yours; you are not an habitue of the place. Above all,
+ it is extremely unlikely that you are right. There were some shady people
+ there, no doubt, but there were also a good many gentlemen present, and as
+ you know nothing of cards, as far as I know, it is the most unlikely thing
+ in the world that you should find out that Emerson cheated when no one
+ else noticed it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is my business; it is the duty of every honest man to see that a poor
+ lad like that should not be eaten up by a shark like Emerson. I don't care
+ if there is a shindy over it. I shall not interfere unless I can prove
+ that the man is cheating, in which case no man of honor would go out with
+ him. I shall be glad if you and Boldero would go with me again this
+ evening. I am not known there, and you are to a good many men, and Boldero
+ to many more. I only want that, if I get into a row, you should testify to
+ the fact that I am a gentleman, and ordinarily sane. If there is a row you
+ will have an opportunity of seeing how much I have benefited by my
+ lessons.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I heard you were making tremendous progress. Jack Needham told me a
+ month ago that you had knocked him out of time, and I went into Gibbons'
+ yesterday morning with a man who wanted to buy a dog, and he told me that
+ he considered that it was a great misfortune that you were an amateur, for
+ that you only required another six months' practice, and he would then be
+ ready to back you for a hundred pounds against any man in the ring. But
+ about this affair, Mark. Are you really in earnest?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am, Dick, thoroughly in earnest; so would you be if you had spoken to
+ Cotter last night, as I did. I tell you that if I had not given him a
+ little hope that the thing might come out right, he would have blown out
+ his brains today.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Mark, if you have set your mind on it, of course I will stick to
+ you, though I have some doubts whether Cotter has any brains to speak of
+ to blow out, else he would not be mad enough to back himself against
+ Emerson and other men whom Boldero tells me he has been playing with.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He has made an ass of himself, no doubt, Dick; but I fancy a good many
+ fellows do that at one time or other of their lives, though not, I grant,
+ always in the same way.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I will go, Mark. I need not ask Boldero, for he told me that he
+ should look in again at ten o'clock this evening, for he thought that
+ another night's play would probably bring Cotter to the end of his
+ tether.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Accordingly a little before ten they walked into the gambling house
+ together.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, Dick, I want you, as soon as you sit down, to take your place in the
+ front line within a yard or two of Emerson. I don't want you to be just
+ behind him, but a short distance away; and I want you to keep your eye
+ upon Sir James Flash, who, if I am not mistaken, will take up the same
+ position that he did last night, near enough to Cotter to see his hand.
+ You will remark, I have no doubt, as I did last night, that whenever
+ Cotter has a bad hand, Flash will either close his eyes, or put his hand
+ up to his mouth and stroke his mustache, or make some sign of that sort.
+ When Cotter has a good hand he will stand perfectly still or look about
+ the room. At any rate, he will make no sign&mdash;that, of course, is a
+ guide to Emerson whether to propose or to refuse to allow Cotter to do so.
+ I need not point out to you what a tremendous advantage the knowledge
+ whether an opponent's hand is good or not gives him. Of course, while
+ watching an hour's play I can only know that Flash was making signs, and
+ that when he did so Cotter's hand was a bad one. It is possible that the
+ manner in which the sign was made, either by closing his eye or twisting
+ his mustache, or so on, may have been an intimation as to the suit in
+ which Cotter was strongest or weakest.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;By Jove, this is a serious thing, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a serious thing. I don't want you to get into a row with the
+ fellow. I should like you to give me a nod when you have satisfied
+ yourself that I was not mistaken. I will take upon myself to denounce the
+ fellow, and to say what I noticed yesterday and you can back me up by
+ saying that you saw the same thing. I have no doubt that I shall be able
+ to convince every decent man there that my charge is well founded. I am
+ going to watch Emerson. With the help he gets from Flash, he won't risk
+ anything by cheating until it comes to a big stake like the last game
+ yesterday, in which case, if Cotter's hand happens to be a strong one, he
+ is likely to do so, and I fancy if he does I shall be able to catch him at
+ it. You had better keep Boldero near you. You can whisper to him what you
+ are watching Flash for, and get him to do so too; as, if I catch Emerson
+ cheating, there is likely to be a row; he can lend a hand if necessary,
+ and, at any rate, his joining in with you will suffice to show his friends
+ that the thing is genuine.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, Mark. I am interested in the matter now, and am ready for
+ anything.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Soon after ten Cotter and Emerson again sat down, and, as usual, a lot of
+ spectators gathered round the table. The game resembled the one on the
+ previous evening. Mark placed himself' by the side of Cotter, a stranger
+ stood immediately behind his chair, another member of the club was on the
+ other side, and Sir James Flash stood partly behind him, so that although
+ somewhat in the background he could obtain a view between their heads of
+ Cotter's cards. Mark saw to his satisfaction that Dick and Boldero had
+ secured the exact position that he wished them to take. For the first few
+ games the play was even, and Dick began to think that Mark had been
+ mistaken, for Flash appeared to take little interest in the game, and made
+ no sign how Emerson should proceed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as the stake rose to a hundred again he distinctly saw Flash close
+ his eyes and play with his mustache; he called Boldero's attention to the
+ fact, and found the latter, who had also been watching, had noticed it. By
+ the time a few games had been played he verified Mark's assertion that
+ these signs were signals that Cotter's hand was a bad one, and in each
+ case Emerson played without giving his opponent the opportunity of
+ discarding and taking in fresh cards. He and Dick nodded quietly to Mark,
+ who had satisfied himself that so far Emerson had not cheated in any other
+ way. As on the previous evening, Cotter, after losing five or six hundred
+ pounds, proposed a final game of five hundred. Mark bent down his head, so
+ that the intentness of his gaze should not be noticed, but from under his
+ eyebrows he watched Emerson's every movement; suddenly he placed a foot on
+ the edge of the chair of the man sitting in front of him, and with a
+ sudden spring leaped upon the table, seized Emerson's hand, and held it up
+ to the full length of his arm.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Gentlemen,&rdquo; he shouted, &ldquo;this fellow is cheating; there is a card in his
+ hand which he has just brought from under the table.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In a moment there was a dead silence of surprise; then Mark forced the
+ hand open and took Emerson's card, which he held up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There, you see, gentleman; it is a king.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then a Babel of sounds arose, a dozen hands were laid upon Emerson, who
+ was pulled back from his chair and thrown down on a sofa, while hands were
+ run over his coat, waistcoat, and breeches.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Here they are!&rdquo; a man shouted, and held a dozen cards over his head.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The place of concealment had been cleverly chosen; the breeches apparently
+ buttoned closely at the knee, but in reality they were loose enough to
+ enable a finger and thumb to be passed between them and the stocking, and
+ in the lining of the breeches was a pocket in which the cards had been
+ placed, being held there by two pieces of whalebone, that closed the
+ pocket. The searchers, among whom were Dick and Boldero, did not have it
+ all their own way; four or five men rushed upon them, and endeavored to
+ pull them off Emerson. The din of voices was prodigious, but Mark, still
+ standing on the table, stilled it for a moment by shouting:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The scoundrel has an accomplice, who this evening and yesterday has been
+ signaling the strength of the cards in Mr. Cotter's hands.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Who is he?&rdquo; was shouted over the room.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is Sir James Flash,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;I denounce him as a cheat and a
+ sharper.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As pale as death, Flash rushed to the table.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know who you are, sir,&rdquo; he said, in a tone of concentrated rage,
+ &ldquo;but you are a liar, and you shall answer for this in the morning.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will answer to any gentleman that calls me to account,&rdquo; Mark said, in a
+ ringing voice, &ldquo;but I don't meet a man who has been expelled from White's
+ for cheating, and who I have no doubt is well stocked with cards at the
+ present moment, in readiness for the victim that he is next going to meet
+ after the plucking of Mr. Cotter has been done. Now, gentlemen, search him
+ and see if I am wrong; if I am I will apologize for that part of my
+ accusation.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Flash drew a pistol from his pocket, but in an instant his arm was seized
+ by those standing round him, and it exploded harmlessly. Among those who
+ seized Flash was the man who had played with him the previous evening. In
+ spite of his struggles and curses, and the efforts of his friends to
+ rescue him, he too was thrown down and eight court cards were found
+ concealed in his sleeve. The uproar while this was going on had been
+ tremendous, but it was suddenly stilled as four men in dark clothes
+ entered the room. Each held in his hand the well known symbol of his
+ office, the little ebony staff surmounted by a silver crown.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I arrest all present in the name of the king,&rdquo; one said, &ldquo;for breaking
+ the laws against gambling, and for brawling and the use of firearms. Now,
+ gentlemen, resistance is useless; I must request that you each give me
+ your card, and your word of honor that you will appear at Bow Street
+ tomorrow morning.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What is all this about, sir?&rdquo; he asked Mark, who was still standing on
+ the table.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Two fellows here have been caught cheating.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What is your name and address, sir?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My name is Mark Thorndyke, and I am a landed gentleman at Reigate; my
+ friends Mr. Chetwynd and Mr. Boldero will bear this out.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Who are the two men?&rdquo; the constable asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The two fellows with torn clothes,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;They are Mr. Emerson and
+ Sir James Flash.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You are certain of the charge that you are making?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Quite certain; the cards have been found hidden upon them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, yes!&rdquo; a score of voices shouted; &ldquo;they have been caught in the act
+ of cheating.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Take those two men into custody,&rdquo; the constable said to two of his
+ companions.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Who fired that pistol?&rdquo; he went on.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A number of voices shouted:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Sir James Flash; he attempted to murder Mr. Thorndyke.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The constable nodded to the man who had laid his hands on Sir James Flash,
+ and in a moment a pair of handcuffs closed on his wrists.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You shall repent this!&rdquo; Flash exclaimed furiously.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Calm yourself, Sir James,&rdquo; the constable said calmly. &ldquo;We know our duty,
+ and do it whether a man is a peer or a peasant; you are accused of card
+ sharping and an attempted murder.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What is your address in town, Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo; he asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;18 Villiers Street.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Is there any charge against anyone else here? A good many of you seem to
+ have your clothes torn and disarranged.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Some fellows attempted to rescue Emerson and Flash while we were
+ searching them; for what reason we can all pretty well imagine.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall require the names in the morning of your assailants,&rdquo; the
+ constable said; &ldquo;it looks very much as if they were confederates of the
+ two prisoners. Now, gentlemen, you can all leave. This house is closed,
+ and will not be opened again until this affair is thoroughly
+ investigated.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In five minutes the house was deserted.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How can I thank you, Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo; Cotter, who was one of those who had
+ seized Flash's arm, diverted his aim and searched him, said, when they got
+ outside the house. &ldquo;You have saved my life. It did not seem possible to me
+ that you could succeed in showing that I was being cheated, and I had
+ firmly resolved that, instead of allowing you to suffer loss, I would
+ tomorrow morning make a clean breast of the whole affair to my father, as
+ I had intended to have done this morning.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If I might advise you, Mr. Cotter, I should say, carry out your intention
+ as far as making a clean breast of it is concerned. Happily, you are free
+ from debt, as those IOUs are worthless, for they were obtained from you by
+ cheating, therefore you have no demand to make upon his purse. The police
+ will, I have no doubt, endeavor to keep this thing quiet, but your name
+ may come out, and it would be far better that your father should hear this
+ story from you than elsewhere; and your assurance that you will never
+ touch a card again, and the heavy lesson that you have had, will doubtless
+ induce him to look at the matter leniently. It will, no doubt, be a
+ painful story to tell, but it will be far better told by you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will do it, sir; as you say, the lesson has been a heavy one, and
+ henceforth my father shall have no reason to complain of me. May I call
+ and see you tomorrow evening?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Certainly. I shall be at home from seven to eight, after which hour I
+ have an engagement. Good night.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Cotter walked on, and Mark fell back, and joined Dick and Boldero, who had
+ fallen behind when they saw him speaking to Cotter.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Mark, I congratulate you,&rdquo; Dick Chetwynd said. &ldquo;You did it
+ wonderfully, though how on earth you knew that fellow had a card in his
+ hand is more than I can guess.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I felt sure he was going to cheat,&rdquo; Mark said quietly; &ldquo;I saw that
+ Cotter's hand was a very strong one, and knew that Emerson would be aware
+ that it was so, because he would receive no signal from Flash, therefore
+ this was the time, if any, that he would cheat. He had been playing with
+ both hands upon the table. I saw him withdraw one, there was a little
+ pause, and then it came up again, and I had not a doubt in the world that
+ there was a card in it, and that it had been hidden somewhere in his
+ breeches, which is one of the best places of concealment, for his hand
+ being under the table while getting at the card, no one present who was
+ not behind the scenes, as I was, could detect him doing it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The wonder to me is,&rdquo; Boldero said, &ldquo;that while there were a number of
+ men looking on closely, for Emerson has long been suspected of not playing
+ fair, you, just fresh from the country, if I may say so, should have
+ spotted him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is easily explained,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;Not wishing to fall a victim, I
+ have of late been put up to a great many of these sharpers' tricks by a
+ man who at one time had been in the trade himself.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That was a capital idea, Mark,&rdquo; Dick said. &ldquo;I wish you would introduce me
+ to him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I won't do that, Dick, but I shall be very glad to teach you all I know
+ myself about it; but I fancy that after this you will be in no great hurry
+ to enter a gambling hell again.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is so, Mark. I have never had any great inclination for play; but
+ after this you may be quite sure that I will light shy of cards
+ altogether. Still, I shall be glad if you will put me up to some of these
+ tricks, for I may be able to some day save a victim of card sharpers, as
+ you have done this evening.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next morning, when those who had been present at the scene of the
+ previous evening arrived at the office of the detectives in Bow Street,
+ they were shown into some private rooms, and asked to wait. Cotter, Mark,
+ and his two friends first had an interview with the chief.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will understand,&rdquo; the latter said, &ldquo;that this is an altogether
+ informal affair. I propose you first tell me your story as briefly as
+ possible.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ This was done.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, Mr. Cotter. I take it that you do not wish to prosecute?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Certainly not. I would, in fact, give anything rather than appear in it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have said that, in addition to the IOUs that you have given to the
+ two men caught cheating, they hold others to the amount of some five or
+ six thousand pounds, given by you to three other frequenters of the club.
+ In fact, these papers have been found in Emerson's pocketbook; he told
+ you, I believe, that he had taken them up, so that you should not be
+ inconvenienced by them. I understand, then, that you will be quite content
+ if you get these IOUs back again; those given to Emerson and Flash are, of
+ course, worthless. After what has happened, they could not be presented,
+ but probably you might have trouble about the others, for, though I have
+ no doubt that the whole of the men were in league together, we have no
+ means of absolutely proving it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall be more than content, sir; I have no wish to prosecute.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We are glad,&rdquo; the chief said, &ldquo;to be able to close a dangerous place; and
+ as the exposure will put a stop to the career of these two men, and no
+ doubt alarm a good many others, we don't care about taking the matter into
+ court. Such gross scandals as this are best kept quiet, when there is no
+ object in ventilating them. Therefore, gentlemen, as Mr. Cotter is willing
+ to do so, we shall let the matter drop. I shall be obliged if you will
+ step into the next room, however, until I have seen these three men.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When they had left, the three were brought in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have been concerned, sirs,&rdquo; the chief said sternly, &ldquo;in winning large
+ sums of money from the Hon. William Denton, from Mr. James Carew, from Mr.
+ William Hobson, and others; in all of these cases the two men caught
+ cheating last night were also concerned. You all hold notes of hand of Mr.
+ Hobson. I shall advise that gentleman's father to refuse to pay those
+ notes, and promise him that if any further request for payment is made I
+ will furnish him with such particulars for publication as will more than
+ justify him in the eyes of the world in refusing to honor them. You, as
+ well as Mr. Emerson and Sir James Flash, have won large sums from Mr.
+ Cotter, and the fact that the IOUs he gave you were found on Mr. Emerson
+ points very strongly to their being in confederacy with you in the matter;
+ at any rate, they point so strongly that, whether a jury would convict or
+ not on the evidence that we shall be able to lay before them, there can be
+ no question whatever as to what the opinion of men of honor will be. These
+ IOUs are in our hands. Mr. Cotter does not desire to pursue the case; he
+ will, however, refuse absolutely to pay those IOUs, and in doing so he
+ will have the approval of all honorable men. That being so, the IOUs are
+ absolutely useless to you, and if you will agree to my tearing them up
+ now, he has most kindly consented to let the matter drop in your cases.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The three men, who had all turned very white when he was speaking, now
+ protested angrily against imputations being made on their honor.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, sirs,&rdquo; the officer said, &ldquo;in that case the matter can, of course,
+ go on. You know best what the feeling will be as to these IOUs. They will
+ form an important item of evidence against you, you will see. As the
+ matter stands, either you gave them to Emerson to collect for you, without
+ any money passing between you&mdash;a very strange procedure, which you
+ will find it difficult to explain&mdash;or else he gave you the coin for
+ them, and you passed them over to him, and have, therefore, parted with
+ all claim on Mr. Cotter on your own account. Of course I impound them with
+ the other IOUs as proof of a conspiracy between you. Now, sirs, am I to
+ tear them up or not?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The three men looked at each other, and then one of them said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We protest altogether against the assertion, sir, but at the same time,
+ as there can be little doubt that Emerson and Sir James Flash have played
+ unfairly, and we do not wish any association of our names with theirs, we
+ are perfectly willing that the IOUs, which, under the circumstances, we
+ should never have dreamt of presenting, should be destroyed.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think that you have chosen wisely,&rdquo; the chief said dryly. &ldquo;It is a pity
+ that you did not do so at first. These are the IOUs he gave to one or
+ other of you. Perhaps it would be pleasanter for you to destroy them
+ yourselves.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The three men took the papers with their names on them and tore them up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you,&rdquo; he went on sarcastically. &ldquo;That will place you in a better
+ position. You will be able to tell your friends that you felt so indignant
+ at the manner in which Mr. Cotter had been swindled by Emerson and Flash
+ that you at once destroyed his IOUs for the sums that you had won of him.
+ But, gentlemen,&rdquo;&mdash;he spoke sternly now,&mdash;&ldquo;remember that we have
+ a long list against you, and that the next victim, or let us say his
+ father, might be more disposed to push matters to their full length than
+ is Mr. Cotter. Remember, also, that we keep ourselves acquainted with what
+ is going on, and that should trouble arise we shall produce all the
+ complaints that have been made against you, and shall also mention your
+ connection with this affair, in which, as I understand, you all did your
+ best to prevent those two fellows from being searched.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Without saying another word the three men went out of the room, too
+ crestfallen to make even an attempt at keeping up their air of
+ indignation. The others were then called in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am sorry, gentlemen,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;that you have had the trouble of coming
+ here, for the gentleman swindled has declined to prosecute the swindlers,
+ and you will understand that he is somewhat anxious that his name should
+ not appear in the matter. Fortunately, as instead of paying in cash he
+ gave IOUs for his losses, he will not be a loser to any large amount by
+ these transactions. I may say that the proprietor of the hell has been
+ there this morning, and to avoid trouble he has consented to close his
+ place for good. I have only to remark that I should advise you, gentlemen,
+ in future, only to indulge in gambling in places where you may be fairly
+ assured of the character of the men you play with. I think, in conclusion,
+ that you may all feel grateful to Mr. Cotter for refusing to prosecute. It
+ has saved you from having to appear in court as witnesses in so utterly
+ disreputable an affair.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a general murmur of assent, and in a minute or two the room was
+ clear. Flash and Emerson were then brought in, with a constable on each
+ side of them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Mr. Cotter has, I regret to say, declined to prosecute, and Mr. Thorndyke
+ has done the same with regard to Sir James Flash's use of his pistol. You
+ have, therefore, escaped the punishment due to swindlers at cards. It is
+ the less matter, as you are not likely to have an opportunity of making
+ fresh victims, for the story will be known by this afternoon in every club
+ in London. These IOUs will be of no use to you&mdash;they are not worth
+ the paper on which they are written. However, I shall take it upon myself
+ to hand them back to Mr. Cotter, to prevent the possibility of their
+ getting into other hands and giving him trouble.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You can unlock those handcuffs, constable; these men are at liberty to
+ go, and if they will take my advice they will lose no time in crossing the
+ water and establishing themselves somewhere where their talents are likely
+ to be better appreciated than they are here. They can go; one of you can
+ call a hackney coach for them if they wish it. They will scarcely care to
+ walk with their garments in their present condition.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then the chief went into the next room.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is an end of that affair, Mr. Cotter. Here are the IOUs you gave to
+ those two swindlers. Those you gave to the other three men, who were no
+ doubt their confederates, have been torn up by them in my presence. They
+ declare that after seeing how shamefully you had been victimized they had
+ not the slightest idea of ever presenting them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am sure that I am extremely grateful to you,&rdquo; Cotter said. &ldquo;I know that
+ I have behaved like a madman, and that I don't deserve to have got off as
+ I have done. It will be a lesson to me for life, I can assure you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On leaving, Dick Chetwynd walked for some distance with Mark&mdash;as far
+ as Gibbons' place in St. Giles.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is one thing which I cannot understand,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;and that is how
+ it was that the constables happened to be so close at hand, just at the
+ time they were wanted.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, you see, Dick, my relations with Bow Street are just at present of
+ a somewhat close nature, for they are aiding me in the search that I told
+ you that I was making for my father's murderer. The consequence was that I
+ had only to mention to the chief that I fancied I had detected cheating at
+ that place, and that there was a likelihood of a row there last night, and
+ he at once said he would send four men, to come in if they heard a rumpus;
+ and he was, indeed, rather glad of an opportunity for breaking up the
+ place, concerning which he had had several complaints of young men being
+ plucked to the last feather. Well, it was lucky they came. I don't say
+ that it would have made any difference, because I think our side was a
+ great deal stronger than they were, still it would have led to a nasty
+ row, and perhaps to half a dozen duels afterwards. Well, I will say goodby
+ now. I am very glad that the affair has been dropped; it would not have
+ mattered so much to me, as I am single and my own master, but there were a
+ good many men there who would have been ready to have paid up handsomely
+ rather than that their names should appear in connection with a row at a
+ gambling house.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At seven o'clock in the evening Philip Cotter called at Mark's lodgings,
+ accompanied by his father, who, as he came in with him, advanced at once
+ to Mark and shook him warmly by the hand.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My son has told me everything, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;and I cannot
+ thank you sufficiently for the noble part you took in rescuing him from
+ the terrible effects of his folly. I have been down here twice this
+ afternoon, for I felt that I could not rest until I had shaken you by the
+ hand. It is not the question of money so much, though that would have been
+ a serious loss to me, but it is the saving of my son's life, and the
+ saving of the honor of our name.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am glad indeed to have been of service, Mr. Cotter, and I trust that
+ you have consented to forgive the folly that he has committed, and which I
+ feel sure will never be repeated.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes. It was a heavy blow to me, Mr. Thorndyke, when Philip told me; but
+ as he has sworn most solemnly never to touch a card again, and as I feel
+ sure that the lesson cannot but be a useful one to him all his life, I
+ have agreed to say no more about it, and let the matter drop altogether.
+ He has been fortunate to have escaped so easily. He has told me of the
+ noble offer you made to pay his losses if you should not be able to prove
+ that he was being cheated.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I was not committing myself heavily,&rdquo; Mark said with a smile. &ldquo;I had seen
+ enough to be absolutely certain, and was sure that I should be able to
+ bring it home to them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But it was at a considerable risk to yourself, Mr. Thorndyke. As it was,
+ you had a narrow escape of being shot.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not a very narrow escape,&rdquo; Mark replied. &ldquo;With so many men standing round
+ him and their attention called to him, it was certain that he would be
+ seized before he could take aim at me. I had pistols in my pocket, and was
+ prepared to fire in an instant, but I saw at once that there was no
+ occasion for that.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But I cannot imagine how you should have detected the cheating,&rdquo; the
+ banker said. &ldquo;You are younger than my son, and he said that you told him
+ that you had only recently come up to London. It is astonishing that while
+ experienced players should never have noticed that anything was wrong you
+ should have discovered it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The explanation is simple, Mr. Cotter. I have no inclination for play
+ myself, but I happened a short time since to fall in with a man who was
+ well acquainted with all the various methods of card sharping. I thought
+ that a knowledge of that might some day be useful, and I got him to put me
+ up to a number of the tricks of card sharpers both at home and abroad.
+ Having these fresh in my mind, and seeing that your son was playing with a
+ man whose reputation I knew to be bad, I naturally concentrated my
+ attention upon him, and was not long in discovering that he had a
+ confederate standing behind your son's chair. Being a stranger in the
+ place, I could not denounce him, but the next night I set two friends to
+ watch that method of cheating, while I kept my eyes fixed on Emerson's
+ hands. As I anticipated, there was nothing suspicious about his movements
+ so long as play was comparatively low, for the advantage that he gained
+ from his confederate enabled him to be sure of winning in the long run; it
+ was only in the last game, which was a high one, that, as he knew that
+ your son had a strong hand, he was tempted to stock his hand with false
+ cards; and watching closely, I had no difficulty in detecting his method.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, sir, you have, at any rate, laid us both under the deepest
+ obligation. Is there any possible way in which we can show our gratitude?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark thought for a moment.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;In one way you might do me a favor, Mr. Cotter. A ward of my father's,
+ who will inherit some property when she comes of age, is at present
+ finishing her education in town, and is living with a lady who has been
+ her friend and companion since childhood. I have a good many
+ acquaintances, but they are all bachelors; and having been living down at
+ my father's place, near Reigate, for so many years, the ladies have no
+ acquaintances in London. They live at Islington, and their life is a very
+ dull one. I am anxious, for several reasons, that the young lady should
+ have the advantage of going somewhat into society. Hitherto I have had no
+ means of introducing her. If it is not too much to ask, Mr. Cotter, I
+ should be extremely glad and obliged if Mrs. Cotter would call on them and
+ give them an introduction into society. The lady with my father's ward is
+ the widow of a captain in the Indian Army, and is in all ways a very
+ charming person, and has been at the head of my father's establishment for
+ the last twelve years.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;With the greatest pleasure in the world, Mr. Thorndyke. I am only sorry
+ that it is so slight a thing that you ask of me. I have thought it but
+ right to tell my wife what has passed, and I had difficulty in persuading
+ her not to come with me this evening to also express her gratitude to you.
+ She will be pleased indeed to call upon your friends at once, and I am
+ sure she will do so tomorrow. I was going to ask you to dine with us, and
+ I hope that you will do so. We shall have no one else, and I hope that you
+ will be able to arrange to meet your friends at our house a few days
+ later.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next morning Mark called on Mrs. Cunningham.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think you will have a visitor today,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;It has happened that I
+ have been able to do a service to the son of Mr. Cotter, a wealthy banker.
+ I am going to dine there this evening. He asked me about my friends in
+ London, and I mentioned that my only lady friends were you and Millicent.
+ He asked a few questions as to where you were living, and so on, and said
+ that his wife would have much pleasure in calling and introducing
+ Millicent into society. As your life is very dull here, and it is clearly
+ very desirable that Millicent should go into society, I gladly accepted
+ the offer, and I believe that she will call today.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That will be very nice indeed, Mark. Millicent is not complaining, but
+ she must have felt it very dull. I have even felt it so myself after the
+ cheerful society we had at home.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know that I shall like it,&rdquo; Millicent said doubtfully.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, yes, you will, Millicent; and besides, it will be good for you. It is
+ not natural for a girl of your age to be here without friends, and I shall
+ be very glad to know that you are going to mix a little with other
+ people.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mrs. Cotter called that afternoon, and three days later Mark met Mrs.
+ Cunningham and Millicent at a dinner party at the banker's, and Mrs.
+ Cotter introduced them very warmly to several of her friends, with the
+ result that in a very short time they were frequently invited out, while
+ they became very intimate with the banker and his wife, and often spent
+ the day there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0014" id="link2HCH0014">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XIV.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ Some little time after this Mark was intrusted by his chief with the work
+ of discovering a man who had committed a very atrocious murder, and was,
+ it was tolerably certain, hiding in the slums of Westminster. It was the
+ first business of the kind that had been confided to him, and he was
+ exceedingly anxious to carry it out successfully. He dressed himself as a
+ street hawker, and took a small lodging in one of the lanes, being away
+ the greater portion of the day ostensibly on his business, and of an
+ evening dropped into some of the worst public houses in the neighborhood.
+ He was at first viewed with some suspicion, but it was not long before he
+ became popular. He let it be understood that he had got into trouble down
+ in the country, and that he was quite ready to take part in any job that
+ promised to be profitable. But he principally owed his popularity to the
+ fact that the bully of the locality picked a quarrel with him, and, to the
+ astonishment of those present, Mark invited him to go outside.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You had better make it up with him, mate,&rdquo; a man sitting by his side
+ whispered. &ldquo;He was in the prize ring at one time, and thrashed big Mike
+ Hartley at Kennington. He had to give it up owing to having fought a
+ cross. He would kill you in five minutes.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will chance that,&rdquo; Mark said quietly, as he moved towards the door. &ldquo;I
+ don't think that he is stronger than I am, and I can use my fists a bit,
+ too.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ By the time they had taken off their upper garments a crowd had assembled.
+ The news that a hawker was going to stand up against Black Jim circulated
+ rapidly, and caused intense excitement. To the astonishment of the
+ spectators, the bully from the first had not a shadow of a chance, and at
+ the end of the third round was carried away senseless, while the hawker
+ had not received a scratch. A few days later Mark, who, on the strength of
+ his prowess, had had two or three hints that he could be put up to a good
+ thing if he was inclined to join, was going down to Westminster when two
+ men stopped and looked after him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I tell you, Emerson, that is the fellow. I could swear to him anywhere.
+ What he is got up like that for I cannot tell you, but I should not be
+ surprised if he is one of that Bow Street gang. He called himself Mark
+ Thorndyke, and Chetwynd said that he was a gentleman of property; but that
+ might have been part of the plant to catch us. I have never been able to
+ understand how a raw countryman could have caught you palming that card. I
+ believe that fellow is a Bow Street runner; if so, it is rum if we cannot
+ manage to get even with him before we go. It seemed to me that luck had
+ deserted us altogether; but this looks as if it was going to turn again.
+ Let's go after him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Keeping some fifty yards behind him, they watched Mark to his lodgings,
+ waited until he came out again, and followed him to a public house.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is acting as a detective, sure enough,&rdquo; Emerson said. &ldquo;The question
+ is, what are we to do next?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In half an hour Mark came out again. Several people nodded to him as he
+ passed them, but they saw a big man, who happened to be standing under a
+ lamp, turn his back suddenly as Mark approached him, and, after he had
+ passed, stand scowling after him, and muttering deep curses. Flash at once
+ went up to him. &ldquo;Do you know who that fellow is, my man?&rdquo; The fellow
+ turned savagely upon him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know who he is; but what is that to you?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is not a friend of ours,&rdquo; Flash said quietly; &ldquo;quite the contrary. We
+ have known him when he was not got up like this, and we are rather curious
+ to know what he is doing here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you mean that?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I do; I owe the fellow a grudge.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;So do I,&rdquo; the man growled. &ldquo;Just step up this next turning; there won't
+ be anyone about there. Now, then, what do yer want to know?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I want to know who he is.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, he calls himself a hawker; but my idea of him is he is one of the
+ fancy, perhaps a west countryman, who is keeping dark here till he can get
+ a match on. I have been a prize fighter myself, but he knocked me out in
+ three rounds the other day.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, the last time I saw him,&rdquo; Flash said, &ldquo;he was dressed as a swell.
+ My idea of him is, he is a Bow Street runner, and he is got up like this
+ to lay his hands on some of the fellows down here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You don't mean it!&rdquo; the man said with a deep oath. &ldquo;Then I can tell you
+ he has come to the wrong shop. I have only got to whisper it about, and
+ his life would not be worth an hour's purchase. I had meant to stick a
+ knife in him on the first opportunity, but this will save me the trouble.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, you can have your revenge and five guineas besides,&rdquo; Flash said.
+ &ldquo;But we must be there at the time. I should like him to know that I was at
+ the bottom of his being caught.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They stood talking together for a few minutes, and then separated, Flash
+ and his companion going back to a quiet lodging they had taken until they
+ could finish their arrangements for disposing of their furniture and
+ belongings before going abroad, while at the same time they finished
+ plucking a country greenhorn they had met at a coffee house. Two days
+ later, wrapped up in great coats, and with rough caps pulled down over
+ their eyes, they entered the thieves' resort half an hour before Mark's
+ usual time of getting there. A larger number of men than usual were
+ assembled, and among them was Black Jim. The men were all talking
+ excitedly, and were evidently furious at the news that the pugilist had
+ just told them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Those are the gents that have given me the office,&rdquo; he said, as Flash and
+ his companion entered. &ldquo;They can tell yer he is one of that cursed Bow
+ Street lot.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is right enough, my men,&rdquo; Flash said. &ldquo;He and four of his mates
+ broke into a place where we were having a bit of play, three weeks since,
+ marched us all away to Bow Street, and shut the place up. I don't know
+ what he is down here for, but you may be sure that it's for no good to
+ some of you. We owe him a heavy one ourselves. He came spying on us
+ dressed up as a swell and spoilt our game, and got the darbies put on us,
+ and we have sworn to get even with him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will get even, don't you fear,&rdquo; one of the men growled, &ldquo;and more
+ than even, strike me blind if you don't.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Look here, lads,&rdquo; Flash said. &ldquo;There is one thing I say&mdash;don't use
+ your knives on him; remember he is a runner, and no doubt his chief knows
+ all that he is doing, and no doubt ordered him to come here. There will be
+ a big search, you may be sure, when he don't turn up to make his report.
+ So don't let's have any bloodshed. Let the thing be done quietly.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We can chuck his body into the river,&rdquo; one said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, but if it is picked up with half a dozen holes in it, you may be
+ sure that they will be down here, and like enough every man who has used
+ this place will be arrested; you know that when there are twenty men in a
+ job the chances are that one will slip his neck out of the halter by
+ turning King's evidence.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ An angry growl went round the room.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, you know well enough it is so, it is always the case; besides, we
+ ought to give him a little time to prepare himself. My idea is that the
+ best plan will be to bind and gag him first, then we can hold a little
+ court over him, and let him know what is coming. An hour later, when the
+ place gets a bit quiet, we can carry him down to the river&mdash;it is not
+ above fifty yards away&mdash;tie a heavy weight round his neck, cut his
+ cords the last thing, and chuck him over; if his body is found, it will be
+ thought it is that of some chap tired of life who took pains to drown
+ himself pretty quickly, and there won't be any fuss over him, and there
+ will be nothing to come upon any of you fellows for.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a general murmur of assent. Several of those present had already
+ committed themselves to some extent with the supposed hawker, and were as
+ eager as Flash himself that he should be killed; still, all felt that it
+ was as well that it should be managed with the least possible risk of
+ discovery, for while an ordinary man could be put out of the way without
+ any trouble arising, the fact that he was a Bow Street runner added
+ enormously to the risk of the discovery of his fate.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a little talk, and then two of the men went out and brought back
+ a couple of strong ropes. A few minutes after their return Mark Thorndyke
+ came in. He paused as he entered the room, in surprise at the silence that
+ reigned, for he was accustomed to be greeted with friendly exclamations.
+ However, as he walked in the door closed, and then suddenly, with shouts
+ of &ldquo;Down with the spy!&rdquo; the men sprang from their seats and made a sudden
+ rush at him. For a minute the struggle was tremendous; man after man went
+ down under Mark's blows, others clung onto him from behind, a rope was
+ passed round his legs and pulled, and he fell down with a crash, bringing
+ down five or six of his assailants; a minute later he was gagged and
+ bound.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ While the struggle was going on no one noticed that a Lascar's face was
+ pressed against the window; it disappeared as soon as Mark fell, and ten
+ minutes later a dark faced sailor ran into Gibbons'; it was a quiet
+ evening at Ingleston's, and Gibbons, after smoking a pipe with half a
+ dozen of the pugilists, had just returned.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Hallo,&rdquo; he said, as he opened the door, &ldquo;what the deuce do you want?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The man was for a moment too breathless to answer.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You know Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; he said at last, in very fair English.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I know him. Well, what of him?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He has been attacked by a number of thieves in a public house near the
+ river, at Westminster, and he will be murdered unless you go with others
+ to help him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What the deuce was he doing there?&rdquo; Gibbons muttered, and then, seizing
+ his cap, said to the Lascar,
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Come along with me; it aint likely that we shall be in time, but we will
+ try, anyhow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He ran to Ingleston's.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Come along, Ingleston,&rdquo; he exclaimed, &ldquo;and all of you. You all know Mr.
+ Thorndyke. This man says he has been attacked by a gang down at
+ Westminster, and will be murdered. I am afraid we shan't be in time, but
+ it is worth trying.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The prize fighters all leaped to their feet. Mark had sparred with several
+ of them, and, being open handed and friendly, was generally liked. In a
+ moment, headed by Ingleston and Gibbons, they started at the top of their
+ speed, and in less than a quarter of an hour were at bank side.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is the house,&rdquo; the sailor said, pointing to the public, where a red
+ blind had been lowered at the window, and two men lounged outside the door
+ to tell any chance customer that might come along he was not wanted there
+ at present.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Inside a mock trial had been going on, and Mark had been sentenced to
+ death as a spy, not a voice being raised in his defense. As soon as he had
+ been lifted up and seated so that he could see the faces of those present,
+ he recognized the two gamblers, and saw at once that his fate was sealed;
+ even had they not been there the chance of escape would have been small.
+ The fact that one of the detectives had been caught under circumstances
+ when there was but slight chance of its ever being known how he came to
+ his end, was in itself sufficient to doom him. Several of the men present
+ had taken him into their confidence, and he had encouraged them to do so,
+ not that he wanted to entrap them, or that he intended to do so, but in
+ order to obtain a clew through them as to the hiding place of the man he
+ was in search of.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The savage exultation on the faces of the two gamblers, however, was
+ sufficient to extinguish any ray of hope. He felt sure at once that they
+ had been the authors of his seizure, and that no thought of mercy would
+ enter the minds of these two scoundrels whose plans he had frustrated,
+ whose position he had demolished, and to whom he had caused the loss of a
+ large sum of money. Neither Flash nor Emerson would have taken share in a
+ crime known to so many had they not been on the point of leaving England.
+ Their names were known to no one there, and even should some of these
+ afterwards peach they would at least be safe. Mark had been asked whether
+ he could deny that he was a member of the detective force, and had shaken
+ his head. Even if he had told a lie, which he would not do, the lie would
+ have been a useless one. No one would have believed it, for the two
+ gamblers would have been witnesses that he was so.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He had been placed in one corner of the room, so that what light there was
+ would not fall on his face, and had anyone entered they would not have
+ noticed that he was gagged. One, indeed, had suggested that it would be
+ better to lay him under one of the benches, but Black Jim said, with a
+ brutal laugh:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, no; it is better that we should keep sight of him, and if anyone asks
+ a question of course we can say that the gentleman has the toothache.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Presently Flash spoke to the ruffian in a low voice.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I think you are right,&rdquo; he replied. &ldquo;Look here,&rdquo; he went on, raising
+ his voice. &ldquo;There is no occasion to have such a lot in this business; Jake
+ Watson, Bill the Tinker, and me are quite enough to carry him to his bed.
+ I reckon the rest had better make themselves scarce when the times comes,
+ go home, and keep their mouths shut. I need not say that anyone who lets
+ his tongue wag about it is likely to come to a worse end than this
+ bloodhound. We will have another glass of grog before you turn out; the
+ streets won't be quiet for another hour yet, and there is another guinea
+ of this worthy hawker's to be spent. Summers, make another big bowl of
+ punch. Don't put so much water in it as you did in the last.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The landlord, a notorious ruffian, was just coming into the room with a
+ huge bowl when there was the sound of a scuffle outside.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You had better see what is up,&rdquo; Black Jim said, and two of the men
+ nearest the door unbarred and opened it. As they did so there was a rush,
+ and eight powerful men ran in, knocking to the floor those who had opened
+ the door. The rest sprang to their feet; Gibbons looked round, and as his
+ eye fell upon Mark, who had, the moment the men inside rose, got into a
+ standing position, Gibbons launched himself towards him, striking four of
+ the ruffians who endeavored to stop him to the ground with his crushing
+ blows.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;This way,&rdquo; he shouted to his friends. &ldquo;Ingleston and Tring, do you keep
+ the door.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The moment the six men had closed round Mark, one of them, taking out his
+ knife, cut the cords, removed the bandage from his mouth, and extricated
+ the gag. The name of the two prize fighters had created something like a
+ panic among the crowd, which had increased when one of them shouted, &ldquo;It
+ is Charley Gibbons.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Flash and Emerson sprang to their feet with the rest, and the latter
+ shouted, &ldquo;Go at them, men; there are only eight of them, and we are
+ twenty. Knife them, or you will all hang for this job.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The knowledge of their danger was evident to all the men, and, nerved by
+ desperation, they rushed at the prize fighters; but the eight were now
+ nine, and each of them in a fray of this kind was equal to half a dozen
+ ordinary men. Scarce a word was spoken, but the sound of crushing blows
+ and scuffling, and an occasional, oath, made a confused din in the half
+ lighted room. Mark burst his way through his assailants to the spot where
+ Flash and Emerson were standing, somewhat in the rear of the crowd, for
+ they had been sitting at the other end of the room. Flash had a pistol in
+ his hand, but the man who was standing in front of him was struck with
+ such violence that he fell backwards, knocking Emerson to the ground and
+ almost upsetting Flash, and before the latter could steady himself Mark
+ struck him with all his force under the chin. A moment later the landlord
+ blew out the two candles, and in the darkness the ruffians made a dash for
+ the door, carried Tring and Ingleston off their feet, and rushed out into
+ the lane.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If the man who blew those candles out don't light them again at once,&rdquo;
+ Gibbons shouted, &ldquo;I, Charley Gibbons, tell him that I will smash him and
+ burn this place over his head; he had best be quick about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The landlord, cowed with the threat, soon returned with a candle from the
+ kitchen, and lit those that he had extinguished.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Mr. Thorndyke, we just arrived in time, I fancy,&rdquo; Gibbons said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have saved my life, Gibbons&mdash;you and the others. How you got to
+ know that I was here I cannot imagine. I would have been a dead man in
+ another half hour if you had not arrived. I thank you all from the bottom
+ of my heart.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is all right, sir,&rdquo; Gibbons said. &ldquo;It is a pleasure to give such
+ scoundrels as these a lesson. Is anyone hurt? I fancy I have got a scratch
+ or two.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Several of the men had been cut with knives, but the blows had been given
+ so hurriedly that no one was seriously injured. Twelve men lay on the
+ ground.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now sir, what shall we do with these fellows?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should say we had better leave them alone, Gibbons. I don't want any
+ row over the affair. It is the work of these two fellows here. I think I
+ pretty well settled one of them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Gibbons stooped over Flash.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have broken his jaw, sir; but he will come round in time. I believe
+ this other fellow is only shamming. I don't see any of our handiwork upon
+ his face. The others have all got as much as they want, I think,&rdquo; and
+ taking a candle he looked at their faces. &ldquo;There is not one of them who
+ will want to show up for a week or so,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;and there are two or
+ three who will carry the marks to their graves. Well, sir, if you don't
+ want anything done to them, the sooner we are off the better. Those
+ fellows who got away may bring a lot of others down upon us. As long as it
+ is only fists, we could march through Westminster; but as they would have
+ knives, it is just as well to get out of it before there is any trouble.
+ You are got up in a rum way, Mr. Thorndyke.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes; I will tell you about it afterwards. I agree with you that we had
+ best be moving at once.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ But the men who had fled were too glad to have made their escape to think
+ of anything but to make for their dens as quick as possible, and the party
+ passed through the lanes into the open space in front of Parliament House
+ without interruption.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We will go up to your place, Ingleston, and talk it over there,&rdquo; Mark
+ said. &ldquo;You can get those cuts bound up, and I shall be very glad to get a
+ drink. That thing they shoved into my mouth hurt my tongue a good deal,
+ and I have not gone through a pleasant half hour, I can tell you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He walked up past Whitehall with Gibbons and Ingleston, the others going
+ in pairs, so as not to attract attention. As soon as they reached
+ Ingleston's place, the latter told the man in the bar to put the shutters
+ up, led the way into the bar parlor, and mixed a large bowl of punch.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, Gibbons, in the first place,&rdquo; Mark said, after quenching his thirst,
+ &ldquo;how did you know of my being in danger?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, sir, a black sailor chap ran into my place suddenly and told me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you mean a colored man, Gibbons?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, sir, one of those Lascar chaps you see about the docks. I did not
+ ask any questions, but ran as hard as I could. I had only left here five
+ minutes before, and knew that Tring and some of the others would still be
+ here. They did not lose a moment, and off we went. The sailor chap he kept
+ ahead. I tried to come up to him two or three times to get to know
+ something about it, but he always seemed to quicken his pace when I was
+ coming up, and I soon got too blown to want to do much talking. He led us
+ to the door, and after that I saw nothing more of him. What became of him
+ I don't know. I expect he was better at running than he was at fighting.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is curious,&rdquo; Mark said thoughtfully. &ldquo;He might have been in the place
+ when I went in, and slipped out while I was making a fight for it. I have
+ seen a Lascar several times while I have been down there. I dare say it
+ was the same man, though why he should take such trouble for the sake of a
+ stranger I don't know. There seems to be a good many of them about, for
+ now I think of it, I have run against them several times wherever I have
+ been in town.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, sir, what did they want to kill you for?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Gibbons, it happened in this way. My father, you know, was murdered
+ by a man who had a grudge against him, and who is both a highwayman and a
+ house breaker.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;They don't often go together,&rdquo; Ingleston said. &ldquo;The highwaymen generally
+ look down upon the burglars and keep themselves to themselves.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hew they do, Ingleston; but this fellow has been a convict, and is not
+ particular what he turns his hand to. The detectives have been after him
+ for a long time, but have failed, and I determined to take the matter up
+ myself, and ever since I have been up here I have been hunting about in
+ the worst quarters of the town. The people of Bow Street have aided me in
+ every way they could, and I suppose some of these men have seen me go in
+ or out of the place. Of course, when I am going into these bad quarters, I
+ put on a disguise and manage to get in with some of these thieves, and so
+ to try to get news of him through them. Three weeks ago I decided to try
+ Westminster. I was getting on uncommonly well there, principally because I
+ gave a tremendous thrashing to a fellow they call Black Jim. He has been a
+ prize fighter.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I know him,&rdquo; Tring said; &ldquo;it was the fellow that was kicked out for
+ selling a fight. He was not a bad man with his fists, either; but I expect
+ you astonished him, Mr. Thorndyke.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I knocked him out of time in three rounds. Well, he has been a bully
+ down there, and everyone was very glad he was taken down. After that I got
+ to know several of the worst lot down there. They fancied that I was one
+ of themselves, and several of them made proposals to me to join them, and,
+ of course, I encouraged the idea in hopes of coming upon the man that I
+ was after. Then some fellow in the street recognized me, I suppose, and
+ denounced me to the rest as being one of the runners. I suppose he told
+ them this evening, before I went in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The place was a regular thieves' den, which, of course, was why I went
+ there. Naturally they were furious, especially those who had been
+ proposing to me to join them. Anyhow, they had evidently settled among
+ themselves that I was to be put out of the way, and directly I went in I
+ was attacked. I knocked down a few of them, but they jumped on my back,
+ and one of them managed to get a rope round my legs, and down I went with
+ three or four of them, and before I could get up again they had tied and
+ gagged me. Then they held a sort of court. Man after man got up and said
+ that I had been drawing them on to find out what they were up to, and had
+ agreed to join them, of course with the intention of getting them caught
+ in the act, and two got up and said that they knew me as one of the
+ runners. They all agreed that I must be put out of the way.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I suppose, as the landlord did not want blood spilt in his house, they
+ did not knife me at once; however, they told me that they had decided that
+ as soon as the coast was clear I should be carried down to the river, and
+ chucked in, with an old anchor tied to my neck. I had just a gleam of hope
+ a short time before you came in, for then it had been settled that it was
+ just as well no more should be engaged in the affair than was necessary,
+ and that Black Jim, with two others, whom I had been talking to, and the
+ two men who had told them that I was a runner, should manage it, and the
+ rest were to go off to their homes.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I had been all the time trying to loosen my ropes, and had got one of my
+ hands nearly free, and I thought that if they waited another half hour I
+ might have got them both free, and been able to make a bit of a fight of
+ it, though I had very little hope of getting my legs free.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;However, I had my eye on the knife of the man who was sitting next to me,
+ and who was one of those who was to stay. I thought that if I had my hands
+ free, I could snatch his knife, settle him, and then cut the ropes from my
+ legs; that done, I could, I think, have managed Black Jim and the others.
+ As for the men who denounced me, they were small men, and I had no fear of
+ them in a fight, unless; as I thought likely enough, they might have
+ pistols. One of them is the fellow whose jaw I broke; I hit him hard, for
+ he had a pistol in his hand.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is no doubt you hit him hard,&rdquo; Gibbons said dryly. &ldquo;He looked a
+ better sort than the rest.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, the fellow was a card sharper whom I once detected at cheating; and
+ so was the one who was lying next to him, the man whom you said you
+ thought was shamming.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ By this time the men's wounds were all bandaged up. Mark told them that he
+ would be round there again in the morning, and hoped that they would all
+ be there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall go home at once, and turn in,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;Straining at those cords
+ has taken the skin off my wrists, and I feel stiff all over; it will be a
+ day or two, Gibbons, before I am able to put the gloves on again. I wish I
+ could find that Lascar; I owe him a heavy debt.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As Mark made his way home he thought a good deal about the colored sailor.
+ If the man had been in the den the ruffians would hardly have ventured to
+ have attacked him in the presence of a stranger. Of course, he might have
+ been passing, and have seen the fray through the window, but in that case
+ he would run to the nearest constable. How could he know anything about
+ his habits, and why should he have gone to Gibbons for assistance? That,
+ and the fact that he had so often observed Lascars in the places he had
+ gone to, certainly looked as if he had been watched, and if so, it could
+ only be connected with those diamonds. It was a curious thing altogether.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next morning he went early to Bow Street. As soon as the chief came he
+ related the events of the previous evening, and told him that it was Flash
+ and Emerson who had denounced him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I know the place,&rdquo; the officer said. &ldquo;It is one of the worst thieves'
+ dens in London. However, it is just as well you decided not to take any
+ steps. Of course, all the fellows would have sworn that they did not
+ intend to do any harm, but that Flash had put them up to frightening you,
+ and I doubt whether any jury would have convicted. As to the other men, we
+ know that they are all thieves, and some of them worse; but the mere fact
+ that they proposed to you to join in their crimes won't do, as no actual
+ crime was committed. However, I shall have the gang closely watched, and,
+ at any rate, you had better leave Westminster alone; someone else must
+ take up the work of looking for that man you were on the watch for.
+ Anyhow, you had best take a week's rest; there is no doubt you have had a
+ very narrow escape. It is strange about that Lascar; he might not have
+ cared for going in to take part in the fray, but you would have thought
+ that he would have waited outside to get a reward for bringing those men
+ to your rescue.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As Mark did not care to tell about the diamonds till the time came for
+ getting them, he made no reply, beyond expressing an agreement with the
+ chief's surprise at the man not having remained to the end of the fray. On
+ leaving Bow Street he went up to Ingleston's. The men who had rescued him
+ the night before were gathered there; and he presented each of them with a
+ check for twenty-five guineas.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I know very well,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;that you had no thought of reward when you
+ hurried down to save me, but that is no reason why I should not show my
+ gratitude to you for the service you have rendered me; some of you might
+ very well have been seriously hurt, if not killed, by their knives. At any
+ rate, I insist upon you taking it; money is always useful, you know, and
+ it is not often so well earned as this.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The men were greatly pleased, and Tring said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, sir, if you get into another scrape you may be sure that you can
+ count upon us.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall try and not get into any more,&rdquo; Mark laughed. &ldquo;This has been a
+ good deal more serious than I had bargained for, and I shall be very
+ careful in the future.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0015" id="link2HCH0015">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XV.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The burglary season seems to have recommenced in earnest,&rdquo; Mark's chief
+ said some nine months after he had been at work. &ldquo;For a time there had
+ been a lull, as you know, but I have had three reports this week, and it
+ strikes me that they are by the same hand as before; of course I may be
+ mistaken, but they are done in a similar way, the only difference being
+ that there is ground for believing that only one man is engaged in them. I
+ fancy the fellow that you are after has either been away from London for
+ some time, or has been keeping very quiet. At any rate, we have every
+ ground for believing that he keeps himself aloof from London thieves,
+ which is what I should expect from such a man. If one has nerve enough to
+ do it, there is nothing like working singly; when two or three men are
+ engaged, there is always the risk of one being caught and turning Queen's
+ evidence, or of there being a quarrel, and of his peaching from revenge.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If your man has been away from town, he has certainly not been working
+ any one district; of course, one gets the usual number of reports from
+ different quarters; but although burglaries are frequent enough, there has
+ been no complaint of a sudden increase of such crimes as there would have
+ been judging from the numerous daring attempts here, had Bastow been
+ concerned; therefore I feel sure that he has been living quietly. He would
+ have his mate's share&mdash;that man you shot, you know&mdash;of the
+ plunder they made together; he would know that after that affair at your
+ place there would be a vigilant hunt for him, and it is likely enough that
+ he has retired altogether from business for a time.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;However, men of that sort can never stand a quiet life long, and are sure
+ sooner or later to take to their trade again, if only for the sake of its
+ excitement. Now that the burglaries have begun again, I shall be glad if
+ you will devote yourself entirely to this business. You have served a good
+ apprenticeship, and for our sake as well as yours I should be glad for you
+ to have it in hand.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall be very pleased to do so, sir. Although we do not know where he
+ is to be found, I think I can say that it is not in the slums of London;
+ it seems to me that he may be quietly settled as an eminently respectable
+ man almost under our noses; he may show himself occasionally at
+ fashionable resorts, and may be a regular attendant at horse races.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He would not run any appreciable risk in doing so, for his face is quite
+ unknown to anyone except the constables who were present at his trial, and
+ even these would scarcely be likely to recognize him, for he was then but
+ eighteen, while he is now six or seven and twenty, and no doubt the life
+ he has led must have changed him greatly.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I quite agree with you,&rdquo; the chief said. &ldquo;After the first hunt for him
+ was over, he might do almost anything without running much risk. Well, I
+ put the matter in your hands, and leave it to you to work out in your own
+ way; you have given ample proof of your shrewdness and pluck, and in this
+ case especially I know that you will do everything that is possible. Of
+ course you will be relieved of all other duties, and if it takes you
+ months before you can lay hands upon him, we shall consider it time well
+ spent, if you succeed at last. From time to time change your quarters, but
+ let me know your address, so that, should I learn anything that may be
+ useful, I can communicate with you at once. You had better take another
+ name than that by which you are known in the force. I shall be glad if,
+ after thinking the matter over, you will write me a few lines stating what
+ you propose to do in the first place.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark went back to his lodgings, and sat there for some time, thinking
+ matters over. His first thought was to attend the races for a time, but
+ seeing the number of people there, and his own ignorance of Bastow's
+ appearance, he abandoned the idea, and determined to try a slower but more
+ methodical plan. After coming to that conclusion he put on his hat and
+ made his way to Mrs. Cunningham's.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Mr. Constable,&rdquo; Millicent said saucily, as he entered, &ldquo;any fresh
+ captures?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I think that I have for the present done with that sort of thing; I
+ have served my apprenticeship, and am now setting up on my own account.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How is that, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is reason to believe that Bastow has begun his work again near
+ London. As I have told you, it is absolutely certain that he is not hiding
+ in any of the places frequented by criminals here, and there is every
+ reason for supposing that he has been leading a quiet life somewhere, or
+ that he has been away in the country. As long as that was the case, there
+ was nothing to be done; but now that he seems to have set to work again,
+ it is time for me to be on the move. I have seen the chief this morning,
+ and he has released me from all other' duty, and given me carte blanche to
+ work in my own way.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then why don't you leave the force altogether, Mark? You know that I have
+ always thought it hateful that you should be working under orders, like
+ any other constable.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, women don't like to be under orders, Millicent; but men are
+ not so independent, and are quite content to obey those who are well
+ qualified to give orders. I have had a very interesting time of it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very interesting!&rdquo; she said scornfully. &ldquo;You have nearly been killed or
+ shot half a dozen times; you have been obliged to wear all sorts of dirty
+ clothes, to sleep in places where one would not put a dog, and generally
+ to do all sorts of things altogether unbecoming in your position.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My dear, I have no particular position,&rdquo; he laughed, and then went on
+ more seriously: &ldquo;My one position at present is that of avenger of my
+ father's murder, and nothing that can assist me in the task is unbecoming
+ to me; but, as I said, it has been interesting, I may almost say
+ fascinating, work. I used to be fond of hunting, but I can tell you that
+ it is infinitely more exciting to hunt a man than it is to hunt a fox. You
+ are your own hound, you have to pick up the scent, to follow it up,
+ however much the quarry may wind and double, and when at last you lay your
+ hand upon his shoulder and say, 'In the King's name,' there is an
+ infinitely keener pleasure than there is when the hounds run down the fox.
+ One sport is perhaps as dangerous as the other: in the one case your horse
+ may fail at a leap and you may break your neck, in the other you may get a
+ bullet in your head; so in that respect there is not much to choose
+ between man and fox hunting. There is the advantage, though, that in the
+ one you have to depend upon your horse's strength, and in the other on
+ your own courage.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I know that you are an enthusiast over it, Mark, and I can fancy that if
+ I were a big strong man, as you are, I might do the same; but if you are
+ going now to try by yourself, why should you not leave the force
+ altogether?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Because, in the first place, I shall get all the information they obtain,
+ and can send for any assistance that I may require. In the next place, by
+ showing this little staff with its silver crown, I show that I am a Bow
+ Street runner, and can obtain information at once from all sorts of people
+ which I could not get without its aid.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I won't say anything more against it, Mark. How are you going to
+ begin?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I mean to go the round of all the places near London&mdash;say, within
+ ten miles. I shall stay from a week to a fortnight in each, take a quiet
+ lodging, give out that I am on the lookout for a small house with a
+ garden, and get to talk with people of all kinds.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But I cannot see what you have to inquire for.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I imagine that Bastow will have taken just the sort of house that I am
+ inquiring for, and in the course of my questions I may hear of someone
+ living in just that sort of way&mdash;a retired life, not making many
+ friends, going up to London sometimes, and keeping, perhaps, a deaf old
+ woman as a servant, or perhaps a deaf old man&mdash;someone, you see, who
+ would not be likely to hear him if he came home in the middle of the
+ night, or in the early morning. Once I hear of such a man, I should
+ ascertain his age, and whether generally he agreed in appearance with what
+ Bastow is likely to be by this time, then get down one of the constables
+ who was at the trial, and take his opinion on the subject, after which we
+ should only have to watch the house at night and pounce upon him as he
+ came back from one of his excursions. That is the broad outline of my
+ plan. I cannot help thinking that in the long run I shall be able to trace
+ him, and of course it will make it all the easier if he takes to stopping
+ coaches or committing murderous burglaries.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I suppose we are not going to see you often, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, not so often as you have done, Millicent, for some time, at any
+ rate. I shall not be more than five or six miles away, and I shall often
+ ride into town for the evening, and return late with some sort of hope
+ that I may be stopped on the road again; it would save me a world of
+ trouble, you see, if he would come to me instead of my having to find
+ him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Which side of London are you going to try first?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The south side, certainly; there are a score of places that would be
+ convenient to him&mdash;Dulwich, Clapham, Tooting, Wimbledon, Stockwell;
+ the list is a long one. I should say Wimbledon was about the most distant,
+ and I should think that he would not go so far as that; if he only acted
+ as a highwayman he might be as far off as Epsom; but if he is really the
+ man concerned in these burglaries he must be but a short distance away. He
+ would hardly risk having to ride very far with the chance of coming upon
+ the patrols. I think that I shall begin at Peckham; that is a central sort
+ of position, and from there I shall work gradually west; before I do so
+ perhaps I shall try Lewisham. He is likely, in any case, to be quite on
+ the outskirts of any village he may have settled in, in order that he may
+ ride in and out at any hour without his coming and going being noticed.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You certainly seem to have thought it over in all ways, Mark; you almost
+ infect me with your ardor, and make me wish that I was a man and could
+ help you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You are much nicer as you are, Millicent.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The girl tossed her head in disdain at the compliment.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is all very well, Mark,&rdquo; she went on, ignoring his speech, &ldquo;but it
+ seems to me that in finding out things a woman would be able to do just as
+ much as a man; she can gossip with her neighbors and ask about everyone in
+ a place quite as well, if not better, than a man.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes I don't doubt that,&rdquo; Mark laughed, &ldquo;and if I want your aid I shall
+ have no hesitation in asking for it. Until then I hope you will go on with
+ your painting and harping steadily, like a good little girl.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am nearly eighteen, sir, and I object to be called a good little girl.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, if I were to say a good young woman you would not like it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I don't think I should. I don't know why, but when anyone says a girl
+ is a good young woman or a nice young woman, there always seems something
+ derogatory about it; it is almost as bad as saying she is a very
+ respectable young person, which is odious.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then, you see,&rdquo; he went on, &ldquo;you are quite getting on in society; since
+ Mr. Cotter's introduction to Mrs. Cunningham and his mother's subsequent
+ call you have got to know a good many people and go about a good deal.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, it has been more lively of late,&rdquo; she admitted. &ldquo;At first it was
+ certainly monstrously dull here, and I began to think that we should have
+ to change our plans and go down again to Weymouth, and settle there for a
+ time. Now I am getting contented; but I admit, even at the risk of making
+ you conceited, that we shall certainly miss you very much, as you have
+ been very good, considering how busy you have been, to come in three or
+ four evenings every week for a chat.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There has been nothing very good about it, Millicent; it has been very
+ pleasant to me; it is like a bit of old times again when I am here with
+ you two, and seem to leave all the excitement of one's work behind as I
+ come in at the door.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I wonder whether the old time will ever come back again, Mark?&rdquo; she said
+ sadly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It never can be quite the old time again, but when you are back at the
+ old place it may be very near it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ She looked at him reproachfully.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You think that I shall change my mind, Mark, but at heart you know
+ better. The day I am one and twenty I hope to carry out my intentions.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, as I have told you before, Millicent, I cannot control your
+ actions, but I am at least master of my own. You can give away Crowswood
+ to whom you like, but at least you cannot compel me to take it. Make it
+ over to one of the hospitals if you like&mdash;that is within your power;
+ but it is not in your power to force me into the mean action of enriching
+ myself because you have romantic notions in your mind. I should scorn
+ myself were I capable of doing such an action. I wonder you think so
+ meanly of me as to suppose for a moment that I would do so.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a great pity my father did not leave the property outright to your
+ father, then all this bother would have been avoided,&rdquo; she said quietly.
+ &ldquo;I should still have had plenty to live upon without there being any fear
+ of being loved merely for my money.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It would have been the same thing if he had,&rdquo; Mark said stubbornly. &ldquo;My
+ father would not have taken it, and I am sure that I should not have taken
+ it after him; you are his proper heiress. I don't say if he had left a
+ son, and that son had been a second Bastow, that one would have hesitated,
+ for he would probably have gambled it away in a year, the tenants might
+ have been ruined, and the village gone to the dogs. Every man has a right
+ to disinherit an unworthy son, but that is a very different thing from
+ disinheriting a daughter simply from a whim. Well, don't let us talk about
+ it any more, Millicent. It is the only thing that we don't agree about,
+ and therefore it is best left alone.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next day Mark established himself at an inn in Peckham, and for six
+ weeks made diligent inquiries, but without success. There were at least a
+ dozen men who lived quietly and rode or drove to their business in town.
+ Many of them were put aside as needing no investigation, having been
+ residents there for years. Some of the others he saw start or return, but
+ none of them corresponded in any way with the probable appearance of the
+ man for whom he was in search. During this time he heard of several
+ private coaches being held up on the road between Epsom and London, and
+ three burglaries took place at Streatham.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He then moved to Stockwell. Before proceeding there he had his horse up
+ again from Crowswood, and rode into Stockwell from the west. He was
+ dressed now as a small country squire, and had a valise strapped behind
+ his saddle. The inn there was a busy one.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I want a room,&rdquo; he said, as he alighted. &ldquo;I shall probably stay here a
+ few days.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Presently he had a talk with the landlord.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am on the lookout,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;for a little place near town. I have come
+ in for a small estate in the country, but I have no taste for farming, and
+ want to be within easy reach of town, and at the same time to have a place
+ with a paddock where I can keep my horse and live quietly. I don't much
+ care whether it is here or anywhere else within a few miles of town, and I
+ intend to ride about and see if I can find a place that will suit me. I do
+ not want to be nearer the town than this, for I have not money enough to
+ go the pace; still, I should like to be near enough to ride or walk in
+ whenever I have a fancy for it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I understand, sir. Of course there are plenty of places round here, at
+ Clapham and Tooting, and I may say Streatham, but most of them are a deal
+ too large for a bachelor, still I have no doubt you would find a place to
+ suit you without much difficulty. These sort of places are most in request
+ by London tradesmen who have given up business and want to get a little
+ way out of town and keep a gig. I should say there must be a score of such
+ people living round here. I am often asked about such places, but I don't
+ know of one to let just at the present moment.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Still, there ought to be, for of late people have not cared so much to
+ come out here; there has been such a scare owing to highwaymen and
+ burglars, that men with wives and families don't fancy settling out of
+ town, though there aint much work about it, for to every one house that is
+ broken into there are thousands that are not, and besides, the houses that
+ these fellows try are large places, where there is plenty of silver plate
+ and a few gold watches, and perhaps some money to be had.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark soon made the acquaintance of the stablemen, and a few pints of beer
+ put them on good terms with him. Every day he took rides round the
+ neighborhood, going out early, stabling his horse, and after having a chat
+ with the ostlers, strolling round the place. Clapham, Ewell, and Streatham
+ were also visited.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I know of a place that would just suit you,&rdquo; the ostler at the Greyhound
+ at Streatham said to him, on the occasion of his third visit there; &ldquo;but
+ it is let; my old mother is the gentleman's housekeeper. He took the place
+ through me, for he rode up just as you have done, one afternoon, nigh a
+ year ago. He was from town, he was; he told me that he had been going the
+ pace too hard, and had to pull in, and wanted a little place where he
+ could keep his horse and live quiet for a time. I told him of a place that
+ I thought would suit him just outside the town, and he called in the next
+ day and told me he had taken it. 'Now,' he said, 'I want a woman as house
+ keeper; an old woman, you know. I cannot be bothered with a young one. If
+ you speak a civil word to a wench she soon fancies you are in love with
+ her. I want one who can cook a chop or a steak, fry me a bit of bacon, and
+ boil an egg and keep the place tidy. I intend to look after my horse
+ myself.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'Well, sir,' I said, 'there is my old mother. She is a widow, and it is
+ as much as she can do to keep off the parish. She is reckoned a tidy cook
+ and a good cleaner, and she could keep herself well enough if it wasn't
+ that she is so hard of hearing that many people don't care to employ her.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'I don't care a rap about that,' he said. 'I shall not need to talk to
+ her except to tell her what I will have for dinner, and if she is deaf she
+ won't want to be away gossiping. Does she live near here?'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'She lives in the town,' I said. 'I can fetch her down in half an hour.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'That will do,' says he. 'I am going to have lunch. When I have, done I
+ will come out and speak with her.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, sir, he engaged her right off, and he tipped me a guinea for
+ finding the place for him, and there he has been ever since. It was a
+ lucky job for mother, for she says there never was a gentleman that gave
+ less trouble. He is a wonderful quiet man, and in general stops at home
+ all the day smoking and reading. He has a boy comes in two or three times
+ a week to work in the garden. Sometimes of an evening he rides up to town.
+ I expect he cannot keep away from the cards altogether.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Is he an elderly man?&rdquo; Mark asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Lor', no, sir; under thirty, I should say. He is a free handed sort of
+ chap, and though he aint particular about his eating, he likes a bottle of
+ good wine, the old woman says, even if it is only with a chop. He never
+ rides past here and I happen to be outside without tossing me a shilling
+ to drink his health.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark went into the house and ordered lunch. It would not have done to have
+ asked any more questions or to have shown any special interest in the
+ matter, but he felt so excited that he could not have avoided doing so had
+ he waited longer with the ostler. After he had finished his meal he
+ strolled out again into the stable yard.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well,&rdquo; he said to the ostler, &ldquo;can't you put me up to another good thing,
+ just as you told that gentleman you were speaking to me about?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There are two or three places that I know of that might suit you, sir.
+ There is a house on the hill. I know that it has got a paddock, but I
+ don't know how big it is; it is in general known as Hawleys&mdash;that is
+ the name of the last people who lived there. Anyone will tell you which is
+ the house. Then there is another place. You turn to the right the third
+ turning on the hill; it stands by itself two or three hundred yards down;
+ it has got a goodish bit of ground. There is only one house beyond it;
+ that is the one where my mother lives. That was an old farm once, but this
+ was built later. I believe the ground belonged to the farm. You will know
+ it by a big tree in front of it; it stands back forty feet or so from the
+ road.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Where does the road lead to?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, sir, it aint much of a road beyond the next house; it is only a
+ lane, but you can get through that way into the main road, through Tooting
+ down into Balham, and on to Wimbledon.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;'I think I will go and have a look at both those places,&rdquo; Mark said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Will you take your horse, sir?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No; I suppose it is not much above half a mile?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;About that, sir.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I will walk; I shall not be likely to find anyone to hold my horse
+ there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark had no difficulty in finding the house. It looked as if it had been
+ untenanted for some time, and in the window was a notice that for keys and
+ information applications were to be made at a shop in the High Street.
+ Well pleased to find that there was no one in the house, Mark entered the
+ gate and passed round into what at one time had been a kitchen garden
+ behind it; at the bottom of this was a field of three or four acres.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The ground was separated by a hedge from that of the house beyond. This
+ was fully a hundred yards away. A well bred horse was grazing in the
+ field, a man smoking a pipe was watching a boy doing gardening work behind
+ the house. Mark remained for nearly an hour concealed behind the hedge in
+ hopes that he would come nearer. At the end of that time, however, he went
+ into the house, and after waiting another ten minutes Mark also left,
+ resisting the temptation to walk along the road and take a closer look at
+ it, for he felt that such a step would be dangerous, for should the man
+ notice anyone looking at the place his suspicions might be aroused.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was evident that the lane was very little used; in many cases the grass
+ grew across it. There were marks of horses' feet, but none of wheels, and
+ he concluded that when going up to town the man came that way and rode
+ quietly through Streatham, for the hoof prints all pointed in that
+ direction, and that on his return at night he came up the lane from the
+ other road.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, master, what do you think of the houses?&rdquo; the ostler asked on his
+ return to the inn.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have only been to the one in the lane that you spoke of, for I want to
+ get back to town. I had a good look at it, but it is rather a dreary
+ looking place, and evidently wants a lot of repairs before it can be made
+ comfortable. The next time that I am down I will look at the other.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mounting his horse, he rode at a rapid pace into London, and dismounted at
+ Bow Street.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have news, I see, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; the chief said when he entered.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have, sir; I believe that I have marked the man down; at any rate, if
+ it is not he, it is a criminal of some sort&mdash;of that I have no
+ doubt.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is good news indeed,&rdquo; the chief said. &ldquo;Now tell me all about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark repeated the story the ostler had told him, and the result of his own
+ observations.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You see,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;the man, whether Bastow or not, has clearly taken the
+ place for the purpose of concealment, for he can approach it by the lane,
+ which is a very unfrequented one, on his return from his expeditions. He
+ has taken on a deaf old woman who will not hear him ride in at night, and
+ will have no idea at what hours he comes home. Riding out through the main
+ street in the afternoon he would excite no notice, and the story to the
+ ostler would very well account for his taking the house and for his habit
+ of coming up here of an afternoon and returning late. I thought it best to
+ come back and tell you, and I will adopt any plan that you suggest for his
+ capture.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You say that he has been there for nearly a year?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;About a year, the ostler said.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then one of my men, at least, must have been very careless not to have
+ found him out long ago. Let me see;&rdquo; and he took down a volume of reports.
+ &ldquo;Streatham. Tomlinson has been here a fortnight making every inquiry. 'No
+ man of suspicious appearance or of unknown antecedents here.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Humph! That is not the first time that Tomlinson has failed altogether in
+ his duty. However, that does not matter for the moment. What is your own
+ idea, Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My idea is that a couple of good men should go down with me to Streatham,
+ and that we should be always on the watch in High Street until we see him
+ ride past. Directly it is dark we will go to his house, fasten the old
+ woman up, and search it thoroughly. If we find stolen property so much the
+ better; but in any case we shall wait inside the house until he returns,
+ and as he comes in throw ourselves upon him before he has time to draw a
+ pistol. I should say it would be as well the men should go down in a trap.
+ There is an empty house next door, and when we go to search the place we
+ can leave the horse and trap inside the gate. Directly we have him secure
+ we can fetch up the trap, put him in, and one of the men and myself can
+ drive him back here, leaving the other in charge of the house, which can
+ then be searched again next day.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think that will be a very good plan, and will avoid all unnecessary
+ fuss. I will send Malcolm and Chester down with you tomorrow. Where will
+ you meet them?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should say that they had better put up at the Greyhound. I don't
+ suppose he will go out until six or seven o'clock, but they had better be
+ there earlier. One should station himself in the main street, the other
+ concealing himself somewhere beyond the fellow's house, for it is likely
+ enough that sometimes he may take the other way. I will go down to the
+ Greyhound at six, and will wait there until one of them brings me news
+ that he has left.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think you had better come in in the morning, and give your instructions
+ to the men; there will be less fear of any mistake being made. I should
+ say you had better put your horse up and come here on foot; one can never
+ be too careful when one is dealing with so crafty a rogue as this; he
+ certainly does not work with an accomplice, but for all that he may have
+ two or three sharp boys in his pay, and they may watch this place by turns
+ and carry him news of any stir about the office.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will walk in,&rdquo; Mark replied. &ldquo;It is no distance from Stockwell.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark slept but little that night. He had believed all along that he should
+ be finally successful, but the discovery had come so suddenly that it had
+ taken him completely by surprise. It might not be the man, and he tried
+ hard to persuade himself that the chances were against his being so, so
+ that he should not feel disappointed should it turn out that it was some
+ other criminal, for that the man was a criminal he had not a shadow of
+ doubt.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next morning he was at the office early. The chief arrived half an
+ hour later, and the two officers were at once called in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will go with Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; the chief said, &ldquo;and he will give you
+ instructions. The capture is a very important one, and there must be no
+ mistake made. We believe the man to be Bastow. I think you were present at
+ his trial, Chester; he escaped from Sydney Convict Prison some three years
+ ago, and is, I believe, the author of many of the highway robberies and
+ burglaries that have puzzled us so. Of course, you will take firearms, but
+ if he is alone you will certainly have no occasion to use them, especially
+ as you will take him completely by surprise. You will order a gig from
+ Morden, and leave here about three o'clock. I should say you had better
+ get up as two countrymen who have been up to market. However, Mr.
+ Thorndyke will explain the whole matter to you fully.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark then went off with the two officers to a private room, and went into
+ the whole matter with them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think, Chester,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;that you had better watch in the High
+ Street, because you know the man. At least, you have seen him, and may
+ recognize him again.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think I should know him, however much he has changed. I took particular
+ notice of him at the trial, and thought what a hardened looking young
+ scamp he was. It is very seldom I forget a face when once I have a
+ thorough look at it, and I don't think I am likely to forget his.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Malcolm, I think you cannot do better than take your place in the garden
+ of the house next to his; it is a place that has stood empty for many
+ months, and there is no chance of anyone seeing you. His paddock comes up
+ to the garden, and you can, by placing yourself in the corner, see him as
+ he comes out into the lane. As soon as you see that he has gone, come back
+ to the Greyhound with the news. I shall be there, and you will pick up
+ Chester in the High Street as you come along; of course you won't pretend
+ to know me, but the mere fact of your coming back will be enough to tell
+ me that he has gone. As soon as it gets dark we will pay our reckoning,
+ and drive off in the gig, leaving it in the drive in front of the house
+ this side of his. I shall have strolled off before, and shall be waiting
+ for you there. If he does not come out by ten o'clock we can give it up
+ for tonight. You had better say that you have changed your mind, and will
+ take beds at the Greyhound; and the next morning drive off in your gig and
+ put up again at the inn at the other end of the town, the White Horse. I
+ will come over again at two o'clock in the afternoon. You will bring
+ handcuffs, and you had better also bring a stout rope to tie him with.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When every detail had been arranged, Mark strolled to Dick Chetwynd's
+ lodgings.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Mark what has become of you? I have not seen you for the last two
+ months, and I hear that you have not been near Ingleston's crib since I
+ saw you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I have been away on business. You know I told you that I was spending
+ much of my time in endeavoring to hunt down my father's murderer. I can
+ tell you now that I have been working all the time with the Bow Street
+ people, and I think I know every thieves' slum in London as well as any
+ constable in the town.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You don't say so, Mark! Well, I should not like such work as that. The
+ prize fighters are a pretty rough lot, but to go to such dens as those is
+ enough to make one shudder. But that does not explain where you have been
+ now.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No. Well, having persuaded myself at last that his headquarters were not
+ in town, I have been trying the villages round, and I believe that I have
+ laid my hands on him at last.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You don't say so, Mark! Well, I congratulate you heartily, both on your
+ having caught the fellow and for having got rid of such horrid work. Where
+ is he? Have you got him lodged in jail?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, we are going to capture him tonight; or if not tonight, tomorrow
+ night. Two of the Bow Street officers are going down with me, and we shall
+ have him as he comes home from one of his expeditions either on the
+ highway or as a house breaker. If he does not go this evening we shall
+ wait until tomorrow, but at any rate, the first time that he goes out we
+ shall have him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have got a special engagement for this evening, Mark, or I would offer
+ to go with you and lend you a hand, if necessary.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is no occasion for that, Dick. We shall take the fellow by surprise
+ as he goes into his own house, and have him handcuffed before he can draw
+ a pistol. Then, when we have got him fairly tied up, we shall put him into
+ a light cart that we shall have handy, and bring him straight to Bow
+ Street. To tell you the truth, I am so excited over the thought that I do
+ not know how I should have got through the day if I had not come in to
+ have a chat with you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can quite understand that, old fellow. Well, the best thing we can do
+ is to take a stroll out and look at the fashions. It is early yet, but
+ just at present it is all the rage to turn out early. It will do me good
+ too, for I was at Ingleston's last night, and the smoke and row has given
+ me a headache. I shall really have to give up going there, except when
+ there is an important fight on. It is too much to stand, and the tobacco
+ is so bad that I am obliged to keep a suit of clothes for the purpose. Let
+ us be off at once.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0016" id="link2HCH0016">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XVI.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ At four o'clock Mark put up his horse at the Greyhound, and chatted for a
+ quarter of an hour with the ostler, who had been making inquiries, and had
+ heard of one or two other houses in the neighborhood which were
+ untenanted. Mark then strolled up the town, exchanging a passing glance
+ with Chester, who, in a velveteen coat, low hat and gaiters, was chatting
+ with a wagoner going with a load of hay for the next morning's market in
+ London. He turned into an inn, called for a pint of the best port, and sat
+ down in the parlor at a table close to the window, so that he could see
+ all who went up or down. He entered into conversation with two or three
+ people who came in, and so passed the time till seven, when he felt too
+ restless to sit still longer, and went out into the street.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When he was halfway to the Greyhound he heard the sound of a horse's hoofs
+ behind him, and saw a quietly dressed man coming along at an easy trot.
+ Had it not been that he recognized the horse, he could not have felt sure
+ that its rider was the man whose coming he had been waiting for, there
+ being nothing in his appearance that would excite the slightest suspicion
+ that he was other than a gentleman of moderate means and quiet taste,
+ either returning from a ride or passing through on his way to town. He had
+ a well built and active figure, carried himself with the ease of a
+ thorough horseman, and nodded to one or two persons of his acquaintance,
+ and checking his horse at the principal butcher's, ordered some meat to be
+ sent in that evening.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark could trace no resemblance in the face to that of the young fellow he
+ remembered. It was a quiet and resolute one. If this were Bastow, he had
+ lost the sneering and insolent expression that was so strongly impressed
+ on his memory. It might be the man, but if so, he was greatly changed.
+ Mark's first impression was that it could not be Bastow; but when he
+ thought over the years of toil and confinement in the convict prison, the
+ life he had led in the bush, and the two years he had passed since he
+ returned home, he imagined that the insolence of youth might well have
+ disappeared, and been succeeded by the resolute daring and dogged
+ determination that seemed to be impressed on this fellow's face.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark paused fifty yards before he reached the inn. In a few minutes he saw
+ Chester coming along. There was no one else in sight.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Is it Bastow?&rdquo; he asked, as the officer came up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It's Bastow sure enough, sir. But he is so changed that if I had not had
+ him in my mind I should not have recognized him. I calculate that a man
+ who has gone through what he has would have lost the expression he had as
+ a boy. He must have learnt a lot in the convict prison, and the fact that
+ he headed the mutiny and escaped from the searchers and managed to get
+ home showed that he must have become a resolute and desperate man. All
+ those burglaries, and the way in which he has several times stopped
+ coaches single handed, show his nerve and coolness. I had all that in my
+ mind as he came along, and his face was pretty much as I expected to see
+ it. He is a cool hand, and I can understand how he has given us the slip
+ so long. There is none of the shifty look about his eyes that one
+ generally sees in criminals, no glancing from side to side; he rode with
+ the air of a man who had a right to be where he was, and feared no one. He
+ will be an awkward customer to tackle if we do not take him by surprise.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I agree with you there. However, he won't have much chance of using
+ either his pistols or his strength. Here is Malcolm coming, so I will walk
+ away for a few minutes, and let you go in first. You can tell the ostler
+ now that you will have your horse put in at nine o'clock. I have been
+ thinking, by the way, that we had better take the trap round behind the
+ house instead of leaving it in the drive. The man may come back this way,
+ and if so, he might hear the horse stamp or make some movement, and that
+ would at once put him on his guard.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As the officers entered the inn Mark went into the yard and told the
+ ostler that he had met some friends, and should let his horse remain there
+ for the night.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is possible that they may drive me into the town in the morning,&rdquo; he
+ said; &ldquo;and I shall very likely send a man down for the horse.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At a quarter to nine he went out again, and walked to the house he had
+ before visited; in ten minutes he heard the sound of wheels, threw open
+ the gate, and the men, jumping down, led the horse in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You may as well take him out of the trap,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;We cannot very well
+ get that round the house, but there is no difficulty about taking the
+ horse.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The officers had brought a halter and a nosebag full of corn. The horse
+ was fastened to a tree with soft ground round it, the nosebag put on, and
+ a horse cloth thrown over its back; then Mark and his two companions went
+ out into the lane, and in a couple of minutes entered the next gate,
+ treading lightly, and going round to the back of the house.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A light burned in the kitchen, and an old woman could be seen knitting.
+ They lifted the latch and walked in. Dropping her knitting, she rose with
+ an exclamation of terror.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark advanced alone.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do not be frightened,&rdquo; he said; &ldquo;we are not going to do you any harm.&rdquo; He
+ took out his little ebony staff. &ldquo;We are constables,&rdquo; he went on, &ldquo;and
+ have orders to search this house. We must secure you, but you will be
+ released in the morning. Now, which is your room?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In spite of Mark's assurance, the old woman was almost paralyzed with
+ terror. However, the two constables assisted her up to her room, and there
+ secured her with a rope, taking care that it was not so tightly bound as
+ to hurt her. Then they placed a gag in her mouth, and left her.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now let us search his room in the first place,&rdquo; Mark said, when they came
+ downstairs again. &ldquo;I hardly expect we shall find anything. You may be sure
+ that he will have taken great pains to hide away any booty that he may
+ have here, and that it will need daylight and a closer search than we can
+ give the place now, before we find anything.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The search of the house was indeed fruitless. They cut open the bed,
+ prized up every loose board in the bedroom and the parlor, lifted the
+ hearth stone, tapped the walls, and searched every drawer; then, taking a
+ lantern, went out into the stable. The officers were both accustomed to
+ look for hiding places, and ran their hands along on the top of the walls,
+ examining the stone flooring and manger.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is a very large corn bin,&rdquo; Mark said, as he looked round, when they
+ desisted from the search.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You are right, sir. We will empty it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There were two or three empty sacks on the ground near it, and they
+ emptied the corn into these, so that there should be no litter about.
+ Chester gave an exclamation of disappointment as they reached the bottom.
+ Mark put his hand on the bin and gave it a pull.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is just as I thought,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;It is fastened down. I saw an ax in
+ the woodshed, Malcolm; just fetch it here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ While the man was away Mark took the lantern and examined the bottom
+ closely. &ldquo;We shan't want the ax,&rdquo; he said, as he pointed out to Chester a
+ piece of string that was apparently jammed in the form of a loop between
+ the bottom and side. &ldquo;Just get in and clear those few handfuls of corn
+ out. I think you will see that it will pull up then.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was, however, no movement in the bottom when Mark pulled at the
+ loop.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Look closely round outside,&rdquo; he said, handing Malcolm, who had now
+ returned, the lantern. &ldquo;I have no doubt that there is a catch somewhere.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In a minute or two the constable found a small ring between two of the
+ cobblestones close to the foot of the wall. He pulled at it, and as he did
+ so Mark felt the resistance to his pull cease suddenly, and the bottom of
+ the bin came up like a trapdoor.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is a clever hiding place,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;If I had not happened to notice
+ that the bin was fixed we might have had a long search before we found it
+ here.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Below was a square hole, the size of the bin; a ladder led down into it.
+ Mark, with a lantern, descended. Four or five sacks piled on each other
+ lay at the bottom, leaving just room enough for a man to stand beside
+ them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The top one is silver by the feel,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;not yet broken up; these
+ smaller sacks are solid. I suppose it is silver that has been melted down.
+ This&mdash;&rdquo; and he lifted a bag some eighteen inches deep, opened it, and
+ looked in &ldquo;&mdash;contains watches and jewels. Now I think we will leave
+ things here for the present, and put everything straight. He may be back
+ before long.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark ascended, the bottom of the trap was shut down again, the corn poured
+ in, and the bags thrown down on the spot from which they had been taken.
+ They returned to the house, shut the door, and extinguished the light.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That has been a grand find,&rdquo; he said; &ldquo;even if this is not Bastow, it
+ will be a valuable capture.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That it will, Mr. Thorndyke. I have no doubt that this fellow is the man
+ we have been in search of for the last eighteen months; that accounts for
+ our difficulty in laying hold of him. He has been too crafty to try to
+ sell any of his plunder, so that none of the fences have known anything
+ about him. No doubt he has taken sufficient cash to enable him to live
+ here quietly. He intended some time or other to melt down all the rest of
+ the plate and to sell the silver, which he could do easily enough. As for
+ the watches and jewels, he could get rid of them abroad.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No doubt that is what he intended,&rdquo; Mark agreed. &ldquo;It is not often these
+ fellows are as prudent as he has been; if they were, your work would be a
+ good deal more difficult than it is.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You are right, sir; I don't know that I ever heard of such a case before.
+ The fellow almost deserves to get away.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That would be rewarding him too highly for his caution,&rdquo; Mark laughed.
+ &ldquo;He is a desperate villain, and all the more dangerous for being a prudent
+ one. Now, I think one of us had better keep watch at the gate by turns. We
+ shall hear him coming in plenty of time to get back here and be in
+ readiness for him. We must each understand our part thoroughly. I will
+ stand facing the door. It is possible that he may light that lantern we
+ saw hanging in the stable, but I don't think it likely he will do so; he
+ will take off the saddle, and either take the horse in there&mdash;there
+ is plenty of food in the manger&mdash;or else turn it out into the
+ paddock. As he comes in I will throw my arms round him and you will at
+ once close in, one on each side, each catch an arm tightly, handcuff him,
+ and take the pistols from his belt. Don't leave go of his arms until I
+ have lit the candle; he may have another pistol inside his coat, and might
+ draw it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was now one o'clock, and half an hour later Malcolm, who was at the
+ gate, came in quietly and said he could hear a horse coming along the
+ lane.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Which way, Malcolm?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Tooting way.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is all right. I have been a little nervous lest if he came the other
+ way our horse might make some slight noise and attract his attention; that
+ was our only weak point.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They had already ascertained that the front door was locked and bolted,
+ and that he must therefore enter through the kitchen. They heard the horse
+ stop in front, a moment later the gate was opened, and through the window
+ they could just make out the figure of a man leading a horse; then the
+ stable door opened, and they heard a movement, and knew that the horse was
+ being unsaddled; they heard it walk into the stable, the door was shut
+ behind it, and a step approached the back door. It was opened, and a voice
+ said with an oath, &ldquo;The old fool has forgotten to leave a candle burning;&rdquo;
+ then he stepped into the kitchen.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In an instant there was a sound of a violent struggle, deep oaths and
+ curses, two sharp clicks, then all was quiet except heavy breathing and
+ the striking of flint on a tinderbox; there was the blue glare of the
+ sulphur match, and a candle was lighted. Mark then turned to the man who
+ was standing still grasped in the hands of his two captors.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Arthur Bastow,&rdquo; he said, producing his staff, &ldquo;I arrest you in the King's
+ name, as an escaped convict, as a notorious highwayman and house breaker.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As his name was spoken the man started, then he said quietly:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have made a mistake this time, my men; my name is William Johnson; I
+ am well known here, and have been a quiet resident in this house for
+ upwards of a year.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;A resident, but not a quiet resident, Bastow. I don't think we are
+ mistaken; but even if you can prove that you are not Bastow, but William
+ Johnson, a man of means and family, we have evidence enough upon the other
+ charges. We have been in search of you for a long time, and have got you
+ at last. You don't remember me, though it is but eighteen months since we
+ met; but I fancy that I then left a mark upon you that still remains on
+ your shoulder. I am Mark Thorndyke, and you will understand now why I have
+ hunted you down.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The game is not finished yet,&rdquo; the man said recklessly. &ldquo;The hunting down
+ will be the other way next time, Mark Thorndyke.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't think so. Now, Chester, you may as well tie his feet together,
+ and then search him. When that is done I will look after him while you
+ fetch the trap round.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In his pockets were found two gold watches, forty-eight pounds in gold,
+ and a hundred pounds in bank notes.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We shall hear where this comes from tomorrow,&rdquo; Malcolm said, as he laid
+ them on the table; &ldquo;it will save us the trouble of getting evidence from
+ Australia.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The prisoner was placed in a chair, and then the two officers went out to
+ fetch the trap round.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;So you have turned thief catcher, have you?&rdquo; he said in a sneering tone,
+ that recalled him to Mark's memory far more than his face had done, &ldquo;and
+ you carry a Bow Street staff about with you, and pretend to belong to the
+ force: that is a punishable offense, you know.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, it would be if I had no right to use it,&rdquo; Mark said quietly; &ldquo;but it
+ happens that I have a right, having been for a year and a half in the
+ force. I joined it solely to hunt you down, and now that I have done so my
+ resignation will be sent in tomorrow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And how is the worthy squire?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark started to his feet, and seized one of the pistols lying before him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You villain!&rdquo; he exclaimed, &ldquo;I wonder you dare mention his name&mdash;you,
+ his murderer.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It was but tit for tat,&rdquo; the man said coolly; &ldquo;he murdered me, body and
+ soul, when he sent me to the hulks. I told him I would be even with him. I
+ did not think I had hit him at the time, for I thought that if I had you
+ would have stopped with him, and would not have chased me across the
+ fields.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You scoundrel!&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;You know well enough that you came back,
+ stole into his room, and stabbed him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Bastow looked at him with a puzzled expression.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know what you are talking about,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;I fired at him
+ through the window&mdash;I don't mind saying so to you, because there are
+ no witnesses&mdash;and saw him jump up, but I fancied I had missed him. I
+ saw you bolt out of the room, and thought it better to be off at once
+ instead of taking another shot. You gave me a hard chase. It was lucky for
+ you that you did not come up with me, for if you had done so I should have
+ shot you; I owed you one for having killed as good a comrade as man ever
+ had, and for that bullet you put in my shoulder before. If I had not been
+ so out of breath that I could not feel sure of my aim I should have
+ stopped for you, but I rode straight to town.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;A likely story,&rdquo; Mark said shortly. &ldquo;What, you will pretend that there
+ were two murderers hanging round the house that night?&mdash;a likely tale
+ indeed.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I tell you that if your father was killed by a knife or dagger, I had
+ nothing to do with it,&rdquo; the man said. &ldquo;I am obliged to the man, whoever he
+ was. I had intended to go down again to Reigate to finish the job myself;
+ I should scarcely have missed a second time. So it is for that you hunted
+ me down? Well, I don't blame you; I never forgive an injury, and I see
+ your sentiments are mine. Whether I killed your father or not makes no
+ difference; he was killed, that is the principal point; if I was going to
+ be put on my trial for that I could prove that at eight o'clock I was in a
+ coffee house in Covent Garden. I purposely kicked up a row there, and was
+ turned out, so that if I were charged with that shooting affair I could
+ prove that I was in London that evening.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can't quite believe that,&rdquo; Mark said; &ldquo;a fast horse would have brought
+ you up to town in an hour and a half, and another fast horse would have
+ taken you back again as quickly; so you might have been in London at eight
+ and back again at Crowswood by half past twelve or one, even if you
+ stopped a couple of hours at a coffee house. However, you won't be tried
+ for that. Those things on the table and the contents of that corn bin are
+ enough to hang you a dozen times.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Curse you! have you found that out?&rdquo; Bastow exclaimed furiously.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have,&rdquo; Mark replied. &ldquo;It would have been wiser if you had got rid of
+ your things sooner. It was a clever hiding place, but it is always
+ dangerous to keep such things by you, Bastow.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The man said no more, but sat quietly in his chair until they heard the
+ vehicle stop outside the gate. Then the two constables came in, and
+ lifting Bastow, carried him out and placed him in the bottom of the cart.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You can loose the old woman now, Malcolm,&rdquo; Mark said as he took his seat
+ and gathered the reins in his hand. &ldquo;By eleven o'clock, no doubt, one of
+ the others will be down with the gig again, and you can empty out the
+ contents of that hole, and bring them up with you. I don't think that it
+ will be of any use searching further. You might have a good look all round
+ before you come away. There may be some notes stowed away, though it is
+ likely enough that they have been sent away by post to some receiver
+ abroad.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ For some time after starting they could hear the prisoner moving about
+ uneasily in the straw.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I suppose there is no fear of his slipping out of those handcuffs,
+ Chester?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not a bit; they are full tight for him. I expect that that is what is
+ making him uncomfortable.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Presently the movement ceased.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is still enough now, Mr. Thorndyke. I should not be at all surprised
+ if he has dropped off to sleep. He is hardened enough to sleep while the
+ gibbet was waiting for him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was four o'clock in the morning when they drove up at Bow Street. Two
+ constables on duty came out to the cart.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have got a prisoner, Inspector,&rdquo; Chester said. &ldquo;He is the man we have
+ been looking for so long. I fancy we have got all the swag that has been
+ stolen for the last eighteen months&mdash;bags of jewels and watches, and
+ sacks of silver. He is handcuffed, and his legs are tied, so we must carry
+ him in.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The officer fetched out a lantern. The other constable helped him to let
+ down the backboard of the cart.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, Bastow, wake up,&rdquo; Chester said. &ldquo;Here we are.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ But there was no movement!
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is mighty sound asleep,&rdquo; the constable said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, haul him out;&rdquo; and, taking the man by the shoulders, they pulled
+ him out from the cart.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is something rum about him,&rdquo; the constable said; and as they
+ lowered his feet to the pavement his head fell forward, and he would have
+ sunk down if they had not supported him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Inspector raised the lantern to his face.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Why, the man is dead,&rdquo; he said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Dead!&rdquo; Chester repeated incredulously.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Aye, that he is. Look here;&rdquo; and he pointed to a slim steel handle some
+ three inches long, projecting over the region of the heart. &ldquo;You must have
+ searched him very carelessly, Chester. Well, bring him in now.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They carried him into the room, where two candles were burning. Mark
+ followed them. The inspector pulled out the dagger. It was but four inches
+ long, with a very thin blade. The handle was little thicker than the blade
+ itself. Mark took it and examined it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have not a shadow of doubt that this is the dagger with which he
+ murdered my father. The wound was very narrow, about this width, and the
+ doctor said that the weapon that had been used was certainly a foreign
+ dagger.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't think this is a foreign dagger,&rdquo; the Inspector said on examining
+ it, &ldquo;although it may be the one that was used, as you say, Mr. Thorndyke.
+ It has evidently been made to carry about without being observed.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He threw back the dead man's coat.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Ah, here is where it was kept. You see, the lining has been sewn to the
+ cloth, so as to make a sheath down by the seam under the arm. I expect
+ that, knowing what would happen if he were caught, he had made up his mind
+ to do it all along. Well, I don't know that you are to be so much blamed,
+ Chester, for, passing your hand over his clothes, you might very well miss
+ this, which is no thicker than a piece of whalebone. Well, well, he has
+ saved us a good deal of trouble. You say you have got most of the booty he
+ has collected?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know that we have got all of it, sir, but we have made a very big
+ haul, anyhow; it was a cunningly contrived place. There was a big corn bin
+ in the stable, and when we had emptied out the corn it seemed empty.
+ However, Mr. Thorndyke discovered that the bin was fixed. Then we found
+ that the bottom was really a trap door, and under it was a sort of well in
+ which were sacks and bags. One of the sacks was full of unbroken silver,
+ two others contained silver ingots, things that he had melted down, and
+ there was a large bag full of watches and jewels. In his pocket we found a
+ hundred pounds in bank notes, about fifty guineas, and a couple of gold
+ watches.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That he must have got tonight from the Portsmouth coach; we heard half an
+ hour ago that it had been stopped near Kingston, the coachman shot, and
+ the passengers robbed. It will be good news to some of them that we have
+ got hold of their valuables. Well, Mr. Thorndyke, I have to congratulate
+ you most heartily on the skill with which you have ferreted out a man who
+ had baffled us for so long, and had become a perfect terror to the south
+ of London. No doubt we shall be able to trace a great portion of the
+ property in that sack. The capture has been splendidly effected.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You will understand,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;that I do not wish my name to appear in
+ the matter at all. I have, as you know, been actuated by private reasons
+ only in my search, and I see no occasion why my name should be mentioned;
+ the evidence of Chester and Malcolm will be ample. From information
+ received, they went down to this place, searched it in his absence,
+ discovered the stolen goods, and captured them. Having handcuffed and
+ bound him, one drove him up to town, the other remaining to guard the
+ treasure. On his way he got at this hidden dagger and stabbed himself. My
+ evidence would not strengthen the case at all.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I don't see that it will be necessary to call you, Mr. Thorndyke. The
+ discovery of this hidden booty and the proceeds of the coach robbery would
+ be quite sufficient. Beyond the coroner's inquest there will be no
+ inquiry. Had it been otherwise it might probably have been necessary to
+ call you at the trial. However, as it is, it will save a lot of trouble;
+ now we shall only need to find the owners of these bank notes. I will send
+ off a cart for the things as early as I can get one, and will send a
+ couple of constables round to the houses where burglaries have been
+ committed to request the owners to come over and see if they can identify
+ any of their property; and those who do so can attend the inquest
+ tomorrow, though I don't suppose they will be called. The chief will be
+ mightily pleased when he hears what has taken place, for he has been sadly
+ worried by these constant complaints, and I fancy that the authorities
+ have been rather down upon him on the subject. The announcement that the
+ career of this famous robber has been brought to an end will cause quite a
+ sensation, and people round the commons on the south side will sleep more
+ quietly than they have done lately. I expect that if he had not put an end
+ to himself we should have had to send him across to Newington today, for
+ of course it is a Surrey business, though we have had the luck to take
+ him. I suppose we shall not see much of you in the future, Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No indeed,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;My business is done, and I shall send in my
+ resignation this morning. I don't regret the time that I have spent over
+ it; I have learned a great deal, and have seen a lot of the shady side of
+ life, and have picked up experience in a good many ways.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark, after requesting the Inspector to find a man to go over to Streatham
+ and bring back his horse, and writing an order to the ostler to deliver
+ it, walked across to his lodgings. Upon the whole, he was not sorry that
+ Bastow had taken the matter into his own hands; he had, certainly, while
+ engaged in the search, looked forward to seeing him in the dock and
+ witnessing his execution, but he now felt that enough had been done for
+ vengeance, and that it was as well that the matter had ended as it had. He
+ was wearied out with the excitement of the last forty-eight hours. It was
+ one o'clock when he awoke, and after dressing and going into Covent Garden
+ to lunch at one of the coffee houses, he made his way up to Islington.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Taking a day's holiday?&rdquo; Millicent asked as he came in.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, not exactly, Millicent; I have left school altogether.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Left school, Mark? Do you mean that you have decided that it is of no use
+ going on any longer?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have given it up because I have finished it. Arthur Bastow was captured
+ last night, and committed suicide as he was being taken to the station.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ An exclamation of surprise broke from Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It seems horrid to be glad that anyone has taken his own life,&rdquo; the
+ latter said; &ldquo;but I cannot help feeling so, for as long as he lived I
+ should never have considered that you were safe, and besides, I suppose
+ there is no doubt that if he had not killed himself he would have been
+ hung.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is not a shadow of doubt about that,&rdquo; Mark replied. &ldquo;We found the
+ proceeds of a vast number of robberies at his place, and also in his
+ pockets the money he had taken from the passengers of the Portsmouth coach
+ an hour before we captured him. So that putting aside that Australian
+ business altogether, his doom was sealed.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, please, tell us all about it,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said. &ldquo;But first let
+ us congratulate you most warmly not only on the success of your search,
+ but that the work is at an end.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I am glad it is over. At first I was very much interested; in fact,
+ I was intensely interested all along, and should have been for however
+ long it had continued. But, at the same time, I could do nothing else, and
+ one does not want to spend one's whole life as a detective. At last it
+ came about almost by chance, and the only thing I have to congratulate
+ myself upon is that my idea of the sort of place he would have taken was
+ exactly borne out by fact.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ And Mark then gave them a full account of the manner in which the
+ discovery had been made and the capture effected.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You see, Millicent, I followed your injunction, and was very careful.
+ Taking him by surprise as I did, I might have managed it single handed,
+ but with the aid of two good men it made a certainty of it, and the whole
+ thing was comfortably arranged.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think you have done splendidly, Mark,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said. &ldquo;It was
+ certainly wonderful that you should have found him doing exactly what you
+ had guessed, even down to the deaf servant. Well, now that is done and
+ over, what do you think of doing next?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have hardly thought about that,&rdquo; he replied; &ldquo;but, at any rate, I shall
+ take a few weeks' holiday, and I suppose after that I shall settle down to
+ the search for my uncle's treasure. I am afraid that will be a much longer
+ and a vastly more difficult business than this has been. Here there were
+ all sorts of clews to work upon. Bastow ought to have been captured months
+ ago, but in this other affair, so far, there is next to nothing to follow
+ up. We don't even know whether the things are in India or in England. I
+ believe they will be found, but that it will be by an accident. Besides, I
+ fancy that we shall hear about them when you come of age, Millicent. There
+ was to have been no change till that time, and I cannot help thinking that
+ Uncle George must have made some provisions by which we should get to know
+ about them in the event of his death without his having an opportunity of
+ telling anyone where they are.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He might have been killed in battle; he might have been drowned on his
+ way home. He had thought the whole matter over so thoroughly, I do think
+ the possibilities of this could not have escaped him. As I told you, Mr.
+ Prendergast made inquiries of all the principal bankers and Indian agents
+ here, and altogether without success. After he had done that, I got a list
+ of all the leading firms in Calcutta and Madras, and wrote to them, and
+ all the replies were in the negative. It is true that does not prove
+ anything absolutely. Eighteen years is a long time, and the chances are
+ that during those years almost every head of a firm would have retired and
+ come home. Such a matter would only be likely to be known to the heads;
+ and if, as we thought likely, the box or chest was merely forwarded by a
+ firm there to England, the transaction would not have attracted any
+ special attention. If, upon the other hand, it remained out there it might
+ have been put down in a cellar or store, and have been lying there ever
+ since, altogether forgotten.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't see myself why you should bother any more about it; perhaps, as
+ you say, it will turn up of itself when I come of age. At any rate, I
+ should say it is certainly as well to wait till then and see if it does,
+ especially as you acknowledge that you have no clew whatever to work on.
+ It is only three more years, for I am eighteen next week, and it certainly
+ seems to me that it will be very foolish to spend the next three years in
+ searching about for a thing that may come to you without any searching at
+ all.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I will think it over.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You see, you really don't want the money, Mark,&rdquo; she went on.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I don't want it particularly, Millicent; but when one knows that
+ there is something like 50,000 pounds waiting for one somewhere, one would
+ like to get it. Your father worked for twenty years of his life
+ accumulating it for us, and it seems to me a sort of sacred duty to see
+ that his labor has not all been thrown away.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent was silent.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is very tiresome,&rdquo; she said presently. &ldquo;Of course my father intended,
+ as you say, that his savings should come to us, but I am sure he never
+ meant that they should be a bother and a trouble to us.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't see why they should ever be that, Millicent. As it is we have
+ both sufficient for anything any man or woman could reasonably want, and
+ neither of us need fret over it if the treasure is never found. Still, he
+ wished us to have it, and it is properly ours, and I don't want it to go
+ to enrich someone who has not a shadow of a right to it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On the following morning Mark went to attend the inquest on Bastow. He did
+ not go into the court, however, but remained close at hand in the event of
+ the coroner insisting upon his being called. However, the two men only
+ spoke casually in their evidence of their comrade Roberts, who had been
+ also engaged in the capture. One of the jurymen suggested that he should
+ also be called, but the coroner said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I really cannot see any occasion for it; we are here to consider how the
+ deceased came by his death, and I think it must be perfectly clear that he
+ came by it by his own act. You have heard how he was captured, that the
+ spoils of the coach that he had just rifled were found upon him, and that
+ the booty he had been acquiring from his deeds for months past also was
+ seized; therefore, as the man was desperate, and knew well enough that his
+ life was forfeited, there was ample motive for his putting an end to his
+ wretched existence. I really do not think, gentlemen, that it is worth
+ while to waste your time and mine by going into further evidence.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Finally, a verdict of felo de se was returned, with a strong expression of
+ the jury's admiration of the conduct of constables Malcolm, Chester, and
+ Roberts, who had so cleverly effected the capture of the man who had so
+ long set the law at defiance.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0017" id="link2HCH0017">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XVII.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ Four days later Mark, on his return from dinner, found Philip Cotter
+ sitting in his room waiting for him. They had met on the previous evening,
+ and Cotter had expressed his intention of calling upon him the next day.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am here on a matter of business, Thorndyke,&rdquo; the latter said as they
+ shook hands.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of business!&rdquo; Mark repeated.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes. You might guess for a year, and I don't suppose that you would hit
+ it. It is rather a curious thing. Nearly twenty years ago&mdash;&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can guess it before you go any further,&rdquo; Mark exclaimed, leaping up
+ from the seat that he had just taken. &ldquo;Your people received a box from
+ India.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is so Mark; although how you guessed it I don't know.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have been searching for it for years,&rdquo; Mark replied. &ldquo;Our lawyer,
+ Prendergast, wrote to you about that box; at least, he wrote to you asking
+ if you had any property belonging to Colonel Thorndyke, and your people
+ wrote to say they hadn't.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I remember I wrote to him myself. Of course that was before you did
+ me that great service, and I did not know your name, and we had not the
+ name on our books. What is in the box?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Jewels worth something like fifty thousand pounds.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;By Jove, I congratulate you, old fellow; that is to say, if you have the
+ handling of it. Well, this is what happened. The box was sent to us by a
+ firm in Calcutta, together with bills for 50,000 pounds. The instructions
+ were that the money was to be invested in stock, and that we were to
+ manage it and to take 100 pounds a year for so doing. The rest of the
+ interest of the money was to be invested. The box was a very massive one,
+ and was marked with the letters XYZ. It was very carefully sealed. Our
+ instructions were that the owner of the box and the money might present
+ himself at any time.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And that the proof of his ownership was to be that he was to use the word
+ 'Masulipatam,'&rdquo; Mark broke in, &ldquo;and produce a gold coin that would,
+ probably&mdash;though of this I am not certain&mdash;correspond with the
+ seals.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He got up and went to the cabinet which he had brought up with him from
+ Crowswood, unlocked it, and produced the piece of paper and the coin.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, that looks like the seal, Thorndyke. At any rate, it is the same
+ sort of thing. Why on earth didn't you come with it before, and take the
+ things away?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Simply because I did not know where to go to. My uncle was dying when he
+ came home, and told my father about the treasure, but he died suddenly,
+ and my father did not know whether it was sent to England or committed to
+ someone's charge in India, or buried there. We did the only thing we
+ could, namely, inquired at all the banks and agents here and at all the
+ principal firms in Madras and Calcutta to ask if they had in their
+ possession any property belonging to the late Colonel Thorndyke.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You see, we did not know,&rdquo; Cotter went on, &ldquo;any more than Adam, to whom
+ the box belonged. Fortunately, the agent sent in his communication a
+ sealed letter, on the outside of which was written, 'This is to remain
+ unopened, but if no one before that date presents himself with the token
+ and password, it is to be read on the 18th of August, 1789.' That was
+ yesterday, you know.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, that was my cousin's eighteenth birthday. We thought if my uncle had
+ left the box in anyone's charge he would probably have given him some such
+ instructions, for at that time there was hard fighting in India, and he
+ might have been killed any day, and would therefore naturally have made
+ some provisions for preventing the secret dying with him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We did not think of it until this morning early, though we have been
+ rather curious over it ourselves. When we opened it, inside was another
+ letter addressed 'To be delivered to John Thorndyke, Esquire, at Crawley,
+ near Hastings, or at Crowswood, Reigate, or in the event of his death to
+ his executors.'&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am one of his executors,&rdquo; Mark said; &ldquo;Mr. Prendergast, the lawyer, is
+ the other. I think I had better go round to him tomorrow and open the
+ letter there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, I should think you might open it at once, Thorndyke. It will probably
+ only contain instructions, and, at any rate, as you have the coin and the
+ word, you could come round tomorrow morning and get the chest out if you
+ want it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I won't do that,&rdquo; Mark said; &ldquo;the coffer contains gems worth over 50,000
+ pounds, and I would very much rather it remained in your keeping until I
+ decide what to do with it. How large is it?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a square box, about a foot each way; and it is pretty heavy,
+ probably from the setting of the jewels. Well, anyhow, I am heartily glad,
+ Thorndyke. I know, of course, that you are well off, still 100,000 pounds&mdash;for
+ the money has doubled itself since we had it&mdash;to say nothing of the
+ jewels, is a nice plum to drop into anyone's mouth.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very nice indeed, although only half of it comes to me under my uncle's
+ will. To tell you the truth, I am more glad that the mystery has been
+ solved than at getting the money; the affair was a great worry to my
+ father, and has been so to me. I felt that I ought to search for the
+ treasure, and yet the probability of finding it seemed so small that I
+ felt the thing was hopeless, and that really the only chance was that my
+ uncle would have taken just the course he did, and have fixed some date
+ when the treasure should be handed over, if not asked for. I rather
+ fancied that it would not have been for another three years, for that is
+ when my cousin comes of age.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What cousin do you mean?&rdquo; Philip Cotter asked. &ldquo;I did not know you had
+ one.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, that is at present a secret, Cotter&mdash;one of the mysteries
+ connected with my uncle's will. For myself, I would tell it in the market
+ place tomorrow, but she wishes it to be preserved at present; you shall
+ certainly know as soon as anyone. By the way, I have not seen you at Mrs.
+ Cunningham's for the last week, and you used to be a pretty regular
+ visitor.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No,&rdquo; the young man said gloomily; &ldquo;I don't mind telling you that Miss
+ Conyers refused me a fortnight ago. I never thought that I had much
+ chance, but I had just a shadow of hope, and that is at an end now.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Perhaps in the future&mdash;&rdquo; Mark suggested for the sake of saying
+ something.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No; I said as much as that to her, and she replied that it would always
+ be the same, and I gathered from her manner, although she did not exactly
+ say so, that there was someone else in the case, and yet I have never met
+ anyone often there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Perhaps you are mistaken,&rdquo; Mark said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, whether or not, there is clearly no hope for me. I am very sorry,
+ but it is no use moping over it. My father and mother like her so much,
+ and they are anxious for me to marry and settle down; altogether, it would
+ have been just the thing. I do not know whether she has any money, and did
+ not care, for of course I shall have plenty. I shall be a junior partner
+ in another six months; my father told me so the other day. He said that at
+ one time he was afraid that I should never come into the house, for that
+ it would not have been fair to the others to take such a reckless fellow
+ in, but that I seemed to have reformed so thoroughly since that affair
+ that if I continued so for another six months they should have no
+ hesitation in giving me a share.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was too late to go up to Islington that evening. In the morning Mark
+ went with the still unopened letter to the solicitor's. The old lawyer
+ congratulated him most heartily when he told him of the discovery that he
+ had made.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am glad indeed, Mark; not so much for the sake of the money, but
+ because I was afraid that that confounded treasure was going to unsettle
+ your life. When a man once begins treasure hunting it becomes a sort of
+ craze, and he can no more give it up than an opium smoker can the use of
+ the drug. Thank goodness, that is over; so the capital amount is doubled,
+ and you are accordingly worth 70,000 pounds more than you were this time
+ yesterday&mdash;a fine windfall! Now let us see what your uncle says.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He broke the seal. The letter was a short one, and began:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My DEAR JOHN:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If you have not, before you receive this, got my treasure, you will get
+ it on the 18th or 19th of August, 17??89. I have made a will which will
+ give you full instructions what to do with it. I may say, though, that I
+ have left it between a little daughter who was born six months ago, and
+ your son Mark. My own intentions are to stop out here until I get the rank
+ of general, and I have taken the measures that I have done in case a
+ bullet or a sharp attack of fever carries me off suddenly. I hope that you
+ will have carried out the provisions of my will, and I hope also that I
+ shall have come home and talked the whole matter over with you before I go
+ under.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Your affectionate brother.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;A singular man,&rdquo; Mr. Prendergast said, as he laid the letter down on the
+ table beside him. &ldquo;What trouble these crotchety people do give! I suppose
+ you have altogether put aside that folly of his about the jewels?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, no, I can't say that I have, Mr. Prendergast. Do you know that I
+ have a fancy&mdash;it may only be a fancy, but if so, I cannot shake it
+ off&mdash;that I am watched by Lascars. There was one standing at the
+ corner of the street as I came up this morning, and again and again I have
+ run across one. It is not always the same man, nor have I any absolute
+ reasons for believing that they are watching me; still, somehow or other,
+ I do come across them more frequently than seems natural.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Pooh, nonsense, Mark! I should have thought that you were too sensible a
+ fellow to have such ridiculous fancies in your head.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, I should never have thought of such a thing, Mr. Prendergast,
+ if it had not been for what my father told me, that my uncle was
+ desperately in earnest about it, and had an intense conviction that
+ someone watched his every movement.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Don't let us talk of such folly any longer,&rdquo; the lawyer said irritably.
+ &ldquo;Now that you have got the money, the best thing you can do is to go at
+ once and carry out what was the wish both of your father and your uncle,
+ and ask your cousin to marry you; that will put an end to the whole
+ business, and I can tell you that I am positively convinced that the day
+ she gets twenty-one she will renounce the property, and that if you refuse
+ to take it she will pass it over to some hospital or other. You cannot do
+ better than prevent her from carrying out such an act of folly as that,
+ and the only way that I can see is by your marrying her. I gathered from
+ what you said when I gave you the same advice at Reigate that you liked
+ her and should have done it had it not been for her coming into the estate
+ instead of you. Well, you are now in a position to ask her to marry you
+ without the possibility of its being supposed that you are a fortune
+ hunter.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will think about it, Mr. Prendergast. Of course this money does make a
+ considerable difference in my position; however, I shall do nothing until
+ I have got the jewels off my hands.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, a couple of days will manage that,&rdquo; the lawyer said; &ldquo;you have only
+ got to take the box to a first class jeweler, and get him to value the
+ things and make you an offer for the whole of them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark did not care to press the subject, and on leaving went to Cotter's
+ Bank. He was at once shown into his friend's room, and the latter took him
+ to his father.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is curious, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; the latter said heartily, &ldquo;that we should
+ have been keeping your money all this time without having the slightest
+ idea that it belonged to you. We are ready at once to pay it over to your
+ order, for if you pronounce the word you know of, and I find that the coin
+ you have corresponds with the seal on the box, the necessary proof will be
+ given us that you have authority to take it away. I have had the box
+ brought up this morning, so that we can compare the seal.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The box was taken out of the strong safe, and it was at once seen that the
+ coin corresponded with the seals.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will leave it with you for the present, Mr. Cotter; it contains a large
+ amount of jewels, and until I have decided what to do with them I would
+ rather leave them; it would be madness to have 50,000 pounds worth of gems
+ in a London lodging, even for a single night. As to the money, that also
+ had better remain as it is at present invested. As I told your son&mdash;that
+ and the jewels are the joint property of myself and another. I dare say
+ that in a few days half of the money will be transferred to the name of
+ the other legatee; that can be easily done. I shall get my lawyer, Mr.
+ Prendergast, to call upon you, Mr. Cotter. I suppose it would be better
+ that some legal proof that we are entitled to the money should be given.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall be glad to see him and to take his instructions,&rdquo; the banker
+ said; &ldquo;but in point of fact I regard the property as yours; I have nothing
+ to do with wills or other arrangements. I simply received the box and the
+ cash with an order that they should be delivered to whomsoever should come
+ with the word 'Masulipatam' and a coin to match the seals. That you have
+ done, and with subsequent dispositions I have no concern. I shall be happy
+ to keep this box for you as long as you should think proper; and I have
+ also written out an acknowledgement that I hold securities of the value,
+ at the closing prices yesterday, of 103,000 pounds 16 shillings,&rdquo; and he
+ handed the paper to Mark.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As the latter left the bank he looked up and down the street, and muttered
+ an angry exclamation as he caught sight of a rough looking fellow just
+ turning a corner into a side street. The glance was so momentary a one
+ that he could not say whether the man was a colored seaman; but he
+ certainly thought that he was a Lascar.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am going to have trouble about that bracelet,&rdquo; he said to himself, as
+ he hailed a hackney coach and told him to drive to Islington. &ldquo;I am
+ convinced that the Colonel was right, and that there are some men over in
+ this country with the fixed purpose of seeing what is done with those
+ jewels, and obtaining them if possible. How they could tell that they were
+ deposited at Cotter's beats me altogether. It may be indeed that they
+ really knew nothing about it, and have simply been watching me. They can
+ hardly have been watching me for the last nine months, and yet, curiously
+ enough, though I have never given the matter a thought since, Charley
+ Gibbons said that it was a dark colored man who brought the news that took
+ them to my rescue and saved my life. I have often run against Lascars, and
+ if they have taken this trouble all along, now that they have seen me come
+ out of the bank, I shall be watched night and day.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a creepy sort of idea. I should not be afraid of any number of them
+ if they attacked me openly; but there is no saying what they might do. I
+ wish Ramoo had been here. I would have consulted him about it; but as I
+ got a letter from him only last week saying that he had, on the day of
+ writing it, arrived in Calcutta, it is of no use wishing that. At any
+ rate, I cannot do better than stick to the plan that my uncle sketched
+ out, and take them across to Amsterdam. It would be very unfair to take
+ them to any jeweler here. He might have them in his possession for a week
+ or ten days before he made me any definite offer for them, and during that
+ time I would not give a fig for his life. If I distribute the stones at
+ Amsterdam they would hardly set about attacking twelve diamond merchants
+ one after another. Well, at any rate, I must say nothing about the affair
+ to Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham. It was bad enough my running risks in
+ the pursuit of Bastow; but this would be ten times worse, and I know
+ Millicent would be for letting the things remain for good at the banker's.
+ But I have no idea of allowing myself to be frightened by two or three
+ black scoundrels into throwing away 50,000 pounds.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent were sitting in their bonnets in the parlor.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Here you are at last, sir,&rdquo; the girl said. &ldquo;Another five minutes, and we
+ should have gone out. You told us that you would come early, and now it is
+ twelve o'clock; and you are generally so punctual in your appointments.
+ What have you got to say for yourself?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;A good many things have happened since then, Millicent. Last night your
+ friend Mr. Cotter called upon me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Why do you say my friend? He was your friend, and it was entirely through
+ you that we knew him at all.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, we will say 'our friend,' Millicent; and he made a communication to
+ me that this morning I had to go to Mr. Prendergast and make a
+ communication to him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What do you mean by your communications?&rdquo; Millicent asked, laughing. &ldquo;You
+ are quite mysterious, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And then I had to go,&rdquo; he went on, without heeding her interruption, &ldquo;to
+ Cotter's Bank, where I saw both our friend and his father, and there is
+ the result of these communications and that interview;&rdquo; and he threw the
+ paper to her.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What does it mean?&rdquo; she asked in astonishment, after glancing through it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It means, dear, that your father took exactly the precautions I thought
+ he would take, and after sending his money and jewels home, he sent a
+ sealed letter to the firm with whom he deposited them, which happened to
+ be Cotter's, with instructions that should no one present himself with the
+ word and coin by the 18th of August, 1789&mdash;that is to say, on your
+ eighteenth birthday&mdash;the envelope should be opened; it was so opened,
+ and it contained a letter that was to be sent to my father, or, in the
+ case of his death before that date, to his executors.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How wonderful!&rdquo; the girl said. &ldquo;I had quite given up all idea of it. But
+ how is it that it came to be so much? Have they sold the jewels?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, you see it is the compound interest going on for seventeen years, and
+ perhaps some rise in the value of the securities, that has doubled the
+ original sum invested. As for the jewels, I have left them at the bank; I
+ should not care about having 50,000 pounds worth of such things in my
+ rooms and I should not think that you would like to have them here,
+ either.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Certainly not,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said emphatically; &ldquo;you did quite right,
+ Mark. I don't think I could sleep, even if you had half a dozen of your
+ detective friends posted round the house.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Still I suppose we shall have a chance of seeing them?&rdquo; Millicent said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Certainly. I can make an appointment with Philip Cotter for you to see
+ them at the bank; or if I take them to a jeweler to value, you could see
+ them there. But I should think that the bank would be the best. I am sure
+ that Cotter would put his room at your disposal, and, of course, if you
+ would like to have some of them for yourself you could select any you
+ liked, but I expect that they won't look much in their present settings;
+ the Indian jewelers have not the knack of setting off gems. However, there
+ is no hurry about them one way or another. The money, I have told Cotter's
+ father, shall, for the present, remain as it is invested; it is all in the
+ Funds, Cotter said, for although the instructions were that it was to be
+ put into good securities, he did not feel justified under the peculiar
+ circumstances in going outside Government stock. Mr. Prendergast is quite
+ of opinion that it would be better to make no change until you come of
+ age. I did not know whether you would wait till then, for some purpose or
+ other you might want to use some of it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent shrugged her shoulders.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think I would much rather have had just the money I had before, Mark;
+ all this will be a great nuisance, I am sure. I think there ought to be a
+ law against women having more than 20,000 pounds, whether in money or in
+ land.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark laughed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It would be a bad thing for spendthrift young noblemen, Millicent. How
+ are they to pay off their debts and mortgages if there were no heiresses
+ ready to do so in exchange for a title?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It would be a good thing for them, I consider,&rdquo; the girl said
+ indignantly. &ldquo;In the first place, they would not impoverish themselves if
+ they knew that there was no way of building up their fortune again, and in
+ the next place, if they did ruin themselves they would have to either set
+ to work to earn an honest living or blow out their brains, if they have
+ any to blow out. I can assure you that I don't feel at all exultant at
+ getting all this money, and I think that my father was quite right in
+ wishing that I should know nothing about it until I married; but, on the
+ other hand, I am heartily glad, more glad than I can say, Mark, that you
+ have come into your share.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am glad for one reason, Millicent; that is, that this must put an end
+ to the ridiculous idea you have of giving up Crowswood. Your father has
+ made me rich beyond anything I could possibly have expected from him. I
+ suddenly find myself a wealthy man, and I can buy another estate for
+ myself worth more than Crowswood if inclined to settle down as a squire;
+ therefore your theory that I have been disappointed in not inheriting what
+ I thought was my father's estate falls to the ground altogether. In no
+ case would I ever have accepted your sacrifice. If you had liked to hand
+ it over to St. Bartholomew's or Guy's Hospital, or to give it away to any
+ other charity, I would not have prevented you, but I would never have
+ accepted it for myself. Now, thank goodness, the question cannot arise;
+ for you must see that, even looking at the matter from a purely business
+ point of view, I have benefited to an enormous and altogether unexpected
+ extent by your father's will, and if any contest between us could arise it
+ should be on the ground that he has acted unfairly to you by giving me so
+ large a proportion of the money that, in the course of nature, you should
+ have inherited. It was not even as if he had known and liked me, for I was
+ but four years old at the time he wrote the letter saying that I was to
+ share the money and jewels with you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You are very obstinate and very disagreeable, Mark,&rdquo; she said, with tears
+ in her eyes.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think the obstinacy has been principally on your side, Millicent;
+ though certainly I should not think of saying that you have been
+ disagreeable. It has been an excess of kindheartedness on your part, and
+ you have resolutely closed your eyes to the fact that, had I been willing
+ to take advantage of your generosity, I should have lacked the courage to
+ do so, for I should have been pointed at wherever I went, as a mean fellow
+ who took advantage of his little cousin's romantic generosity. Pray, dear,
+ let us say no more about it. We are two rich young people; we have both an
+ estate; yours, I grant, is the larger, but if I choose I can increase
+ mine, until it is quite as large as Crowswood. We can be better friends
+ than we have been for the last year, because this point of dispute has
+ always stood between us and made us uncomfortable. Now you will have to
+ think over what you would like done, and whether you wish any change made
+ in your manner of living.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Did you tell Mr. Cotter,&rdquo; Millicent laughed, after a pause, &ldquo;that I had a
+ half share in the money?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, that was a matter for you to decide, not for me. I told him that I
+ was only a half shareholder, but there was no necessity to say who it was
+ who had the other half. When I was talking to Philip Cotter, the words 'my
+ cousin' slipped out, but he did not associate it in any way with you. It
+ might have been the son of another brother or of a sister of my father's.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;In that case, then, we will certainly make no change, will we, Mrs.
+ Cunningham?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think, Millicent, that Mr. Prendergast and Mark will probably be of
+ opinion that you ought now to be introduced regularly into society. The
+ fact that you are a rich heiress might, as your father so much wished,
+ remain a secret. But it is one thing having this blazoned about and quite
+ another for you to be living quietly here, where, with the exception of
+ Mr. Cotter and a few other friends, you have no society whatever.
+ Certainly it was not the wish of your father that you should remain
+ unmarried. You are quite pretty and nice enough to be sought for yourself
+ alone, and I must say that I think, now that you have finished with your
+ various masters, it would be well that you should go out a good deal more,
+ and that as a first step we should go down to Bath this year instead of
+ paying another visit to Weymouth, as we had arranged.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't want any change at all, Mrs. Cunningham. If I am to get married I
+ shall be married; if I am not I shall not fret about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But for all that, Millicent,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;Mrs. Cunningham is right. We
+ quite agree that there is no occasion whatever for you to go about labeled
+ 'A good estate and over 70,000 pounds in cash,' but I do think that it is
+ right that you should go into society. With the exception of Philip
+ Cotter, Dick Chetwynd, and two or three other of my friends, you really
+ know very few people. You have now gone out of mourning, and I think that
+ Mrs. Cunningham's proposal that you should go down to Bath is a very good
+ one. I shall not be sorry for a change myself, for I have been engrossed
+ in my work for a long time now. I can go down a day or two before you, and
+ get you comfortable lodgings, and will myself stay at a hotel. Although I
+ have no intimate friends beyond those from Reigate, I know a large number
+ of men of fashion from meeting them at the boxing schools and other
+ places, and could introduce you both, and get you into society.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am altogether opposed to the idea,&rdquo; Millicent said decidedly. &ldquo;You want
+ to trot me out like a horse for sale.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, Millicent,&rdquo; Mark said calmly. &ldquo;I only want you to have the same
+ advantages that other girls have, neither more nor less, and for you to
+ enjoy yourself as others do. There is nothing undignified or objectionable
+ about that, especially as we are agreed that nothing shall be said about
+ your fortune. Well, we will think it over. Mr. Prendergast and I certainly
+ do not wish to act as tyrants, and there is no occasion to come to a
+ decision in a hurry. We have only discovered our good fortune today, and
+ can scarcely appreciate the difference that it will make to us. We can
+ think over what will be for the best at our leisure, and see if we cannot
+ hit upon some plan that will be agreeable to you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you, Mark,&rdquo; she said gratefully. &ldquo;I am afraid that you must think
+ me very disagreeable and cross; but though you, as a man, have not the
+ same sort of feelings, I can assure you that I feel all this money and so
+ on to be a heavy burden; and were it not for your sake I could wish
+ heartily that this treasure had never been discovered at all.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can quite understand that,&rdquo; he said quietly. &ldquo;At the present moment,
+ even, I do not see that it will be of much advantage to me; but it may be
+ that some day I shall see it in a different light. It has come upon me
+ almost as suddenly as it has upon you. I thought that after I had finished
+ with the Bastow affair I should set to work to find out this treasure, and
+ that it would probably take me out to India, occupy me there for some
+ time, and that afterwards I might travel through other places, and be away
+ from England three or four years. Now the matter is altogether altered,
+ and I shall be some time before I form any fresh plans. In fact, these
+ must depend upon circumstances.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mrs. Cunningham had left the room two or three minutes before, thinking
+ that Mark might be able to talk her charge into a more reasonable state of
+ mind were he alone with her, and he added:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of one circumstance in particular.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ She looked up inquiringly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Millicent, it depends a great deal upon you. I know you think that
+ all that has happened during the past year has been a little hard upon
+ you, and I thoroughly agree with you; you were fond of Crowswood, and were
+ very happy there, and the change to this somewhat dull house, just at a
+ time when you are of an age to enjoy pleasure, has been a trial. Then,
+ too, there has been this question of the estate upon your mind. But you
+ must remember it has been somewhat of a trial to me also. I grant that I
+ have had plenty of occupation which has been in every way beneficial to
+ me, and have not at all lamented leaving the country, but in one respect
+ it has been a trial. I don't know whether it ever entered your mind,
+ before that sad time at home, that I was getting to care for you in a very
+ different way to that in which I had done before.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My father, I think, observed it, for he threw out a very plain hint once
+ that he would very gladly see us coming together. However, I never spoke
+ of it to you. I was young and you were young. It seemed to me that there
+ was plenty of time, and that, moreover, it would not be fair for me to
+ speak to you until you had had the opportunity of going out and of seeing
+ other men. Then came the evening before his death, when my father told me
+ how matters really stood, and he again said that there was a way by which
+ all trouble could be obviated. But I saw that it was not so, and that the
+ hope I had entertained must be put aside. I had never told you I loved you
+ when I seemed to be the heir of the property and you only the daughter of
+ an old comrade of his, and I saw that were I to speak now, when you were
+ the heiress, it could not but appear to you that it was the estate and not
+ you that I wanted, and I felt my lips were sealed forever. Mr. Prendergast
+ said that day when he came down to the funeral, and you told him that you
+ would not take the property, that it might be managed in another way, and
+ you said that you did not want to be married for your money; so you see
+ you saw it in exactly the same light as I did.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My first thought this morning, when Mr. Cotter told me that the money had
+ mounted up to over 100,000 pounds, was that it would unseal my lips. You
+ were still better off than I was, but the difference was now immaterial. I
+ was a rich man, and had not the smallest occasion to marry for money.
+ Whether I married a girl without a penny, or an heiress, could make but
+ little difference to me, as I have certainly no ambition to become a great
+ landowner. I still think that it would have been more fair to you to give
+ you the opportunity of seeing more of the society of the world before
+ speaking to you, but you see you are opposed to that, and therefore it
+ would be the same did I wait patiently another year, which I don't think I
+ should be able to do. I love you, Millicent. It is only during the past
+ eighteen months, when I have thought that I had lost you, that I have
+ known how much I love you, and how much my happiness depends upon you. I
+ can truly say that were you penniless, it would make no shadow of
+ difference to me. It is no longer a question of arranging matters
+ comfortably: it is a question of love. The estate is nothing to me. It
+ never has been anything, and it does not count at all in the scale. I hope
+ that you will put it altogether out of your mind in giving me an answer;
+ and that if you cannot say as truly and wholly as I do, 'I love you,' that
+ you will say as frankly as you have always spoken to me, 'I love you very
+ much as a cousin, Mark, but not in that way.'&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The girl had sat perfectly quiet while he was speaking.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He was standing before her now, and he took one of her hands.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I love you, dear; I love you with all my heart. Do you love me?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then she looked up and rose to her feet, and placed both hands upon his
+ shoulders.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;As you love me, so I love you, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After that, conversation languished till Mrs. Cunningham came into the
+ room, five minutes later.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have come to the conclusion, Mrs. Cunningham,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;that there
+ will be no necessity for the visit to Bath. Millicent is otherwise
+ provided for; she has promised to be my wife.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am glad, Mark, glad indeed!&rdquo; and she took Millicent in her arms and
+ kissed her tenderly. &ldquo;I have all along hoped for it, but I began to be
+ afraid that you were both such obstinate young people that it would never
+ come about. I know that your father wished it, Mark, and he told me that
+ his brother had said that it would be a good arrangement if some day you
+ should come to like each other. I have guessed for the last year, and,
+ indeed, before then, that Millicent would not say 'No' if you ever asked
+ her; but this stupid estate seemed to stand in the way. Of late, I have
+ even come to hope that the obstinate girl would keep to her intention, and
+ that if, as I knew would be the case, you refused to take the estate, she
+ would give it away to some charity. In that case, there could be nothing
+ to prevent your speaking; and even then you would have been between you
+ very fairly equipped with this world's goods. However, the present is a
+ far better solution, and the discovery of the treasure has saved you from
+ three years' waiting before things were straightened out. I feel as if I
+ were her mother, Mark, having had her in my charge since she was a baby;
+ and as she grew up it became my fondest hope to see you united some day,
+ and I think that I am almost as pleased that my hope has been fulfilled as
+ you are yourselves.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0018" id="link2HCH0018">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XVIII.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ After thinking over the best way in which to set about the work of
+ carrying the diamonds to Amsterdam, Mark decided upon asking the advice of
+ his late chief. The latter said, as Mark entered his room:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I did not expect to see you here again, Mr. Thorndyke.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, sir, I have come to ask your' advice about another matter
+ altogether.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What is it now?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have to convey a diamond bracelet of very great value across to
+ Amsterdam. I have reasons to believe that there is a plot to seize it on
+ the way, and that the men engaged will hesitate at nothing to achieve
+ their object. Under these circumstances I should be very much obliged if
+ you will tell me what would be the best course to pursue. I must say that
+ the bracelet is, with many other jewels, in a strong teak box of about a
+ foot square, at present in the possession of our bankers; they were
+ brought from India by my uncle. I imagine that the rest of the jewels are
+ of comparatively little importance in the eyes of these men, though
+ doubtless they would take them also if they lay their hands on them. The
+ bracelet, however, is of special interest to them, not so much for its
+ intrinsic value, as because it was stolen from one of their sacred idols.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;This was about twenty years ago; but I have reason to believe that the
+ search for it on the part of some Hindoos connected with the temple has
+ never ceased. The soldier who took it was murdered; his comrade, into
+ whose hands they next passed, was also murdered. They next came to my
+ uncle, who forwarded it at once to England. His bungalows were searched
+ again and again, until probably the fellows came to the conclusion that he
+ must have either buried it or sent it away. Nevertheless, to the day of
+ his death he was firmly convinced that he was closely followed, and every
+ movement watched. He warned my father solemnly that he too would be
+ watched, but as far as we know it was not so; at any rate, we had no
+ reason to suppose that the house was ever entered. On the other hand, I am
+ convinced I have been watched more or less closely ever since I came up to
+ town, and as I came out from the bank yesterday I saw a man&mdash;a
+ colored fellow, I believe&mdash;on the watch.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My uncle said that my life would not be worth an hour's purchase so long
+ as I had the bracelet in my possession, and advised that it should be
+ taken straight over to Amsterdam, broken up, and the diamonds sold singly
+ to the merchants there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a curious story, Mr. Thorndyke. I own to ignorance of these Indian
+ thieves and their ways, but it certainly seems extraordinary that so
+ hopeless a quest should be kept up for so long a time. You are sure that
+ it is not fancy on your part that you have been watched? I know you are
+ not the sort of man to take fancies in your head, but as you have had the
+ matter so strongly impressed upon you, you might naturally have been
+ inclined to think this would be the case when it was not so.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I don't think there is any chance of my being mistaken. It is only of
+ late that I have thought about it, but when I did so and thought over what
+ had passed since I came to London, I recalled the fact that I had very
+ often come across foreign seamen; sometimes they were Lascars, at others
+ they might have been Italian or Spanish seamen; and you see, sir, it was,
+ as I told you at the time, some foreign sailor who came and informed
+ Gibbons that I had fallen into the hands of a gang of criminals, and that
+ I should certainly be killed if I was not rescued immediately. Gibbons at
+ once got together half a dozen fighting men, and, as you know, rescued me
+ just in time. It was extraordinary that the man never came forward to
+ obtain any reward.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That was a friendly act, Mr. Thorndyke.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I have no reason to suppose that these men would be hostile to me
+ personally. I was not the thief, I was simply the person who happened to
+ be in possession, or rather, might come into possession of the bracelet.
+ From the close watch they had kept, they were, I imagine, well aware that
+ I had not got it, but may have thought, and doubtless did think, that I
+ had some clew to its hiding place, and should sooner or later get it. With
+ my death the clew might be finally lost, and my life was consequently of
+ extreme importance to them, and therefore they took steps to have me
+ rescued, and the fact that they learned this and knew how friendly I was
+ with Gibbons shows how close was the watch kept over me. No doubt, had
+ Gibbons refused to help them, they would have come here at once.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Certainly, after what you say it would seem that your conjecture is
+ right, and in this case, if I were you, I should take the bracelet out of
+ the case and conceal it about me. I would not fetch it myself from the
+ bank.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't think I should be much safer so,&rdquo; Mark said thoughtfully. &ldquo;In the
+ first place, I must go to the bank to get them, and I might be murdered
+ merely on the supposition that I had brought the bracelet away. In the
+ next place, even if I got to Amsterdam safely and got rid of the bracelet
+ and returned unnoticed by them, a fresh danger would arise when I got the
+ other gems into my possession, for they could not be certain whether the
+ diamonds were still among them or not.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should hardly think that would be the case if they watch you as
+ strictly as you believe. Even if none of them accompanied you, they would
+ soon find out what diamond merchants you went to, and the leader might
+ call upon these men, stating that he was commissioned to purchase some
+ diamonds of exceptional value for an Eastern Prince, in which case he
+ would be sure to obtain sight of them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If I had your business to perform, I would not go near the bank again,
+ but would send some friend I could trust to go and open the box, and take
+ out the bracelet, and make it into a small parcel. He should hand it to
+ you privately, as you are on your way to embark for Amsterdam. Then I
+ would take with me one or two of my men, and, say, a couple of your prize
+ fighters, and with such a guard you ought to be fairly safe.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think that is a capital plan,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;and if I don't go to the
+ bank there will be nothing to lead them to suppose that I have taken them
+ out, or that I am just going across to Holland.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark then went straight to Dick Chetwynd's lodgings.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I want you to do me a service, Dick,&rdquo; he said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;With pleasure, Mark. What sort of service is it? If it is anything in my
+ power, you know that you can absolutely rely upon me. You are not going to
+ fight a duel, are you, and want a second?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No; quite another sort of business. I will tell you shortly what it is. I
+ have to convey an extremely valuable diamond bracelet to Amsterdam, and I
+ have reason to believe that there will be an attempt to murder me, and to
+ carry off the jewels before I can dispose of them. It happened in this
+ way;&rdquo; and he then related the history of the diamonds, the reason he was
+ followed, and the suggestions that the Chief of the Bow Street detectives
+ had given him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is all right,&rdquo; Dick said, when he concluded. &ldquo;It is a rum business,
+ but certainly I will do what you ask me; and, what is more, I will go over
+ with you to Amsterdam, and see the thing through. It is an interesting
+ business, if it is a queer one.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You know Philip Cotter?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, Mark; why, I have met him with you several times.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will give you a note to ask him to allow you to open the case, and to
+ take from it the bracelet; I don't know whether it is a regular gold
+ mounted bracelet, or simply some diamonds that have been fastened together
+ as a necklace; however, I suppose you are sure to recognize them; they are
+ altogether exceptional stones, and will certainly be done up in a packet
+ by themselves, whatever the others may be. Say that you will call in and
+ take them away some other time, of which I will give him notice by letter.
+ I will write the note now, and if you can spare time to go there today,
+ all the better, for I shall be glad to get the business over; then I will
+ come again tomorrow morning, and we will arrange the details of the plan.
+ I will look in the shipping list, and see what vessels are sailing for
+ Amsterdam. When we have fixed on one, it will be best for you to take our
+ passages under any names you like, so that they are not our own. The
+ detectives will take their passages separately, and so will Gibbons and
+ whoever else goes with us.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will go at once, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Don't go straight there, Dick; if these fellows are dogging my footsteps
+ everywhere, and saw me coming here, they might take it into their heads to
+ follow you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, they can never be doing all that sort of thing; that's too much to
+ believe. However, to please you, I will go into my club for a quarter of
+ an hour. Shall I come round to your rooms this evening, or will you come
+ here?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think I will put off our meeting altogether until tomorrow morning. I
+ have an engagement this evening that I cannot very well get out of.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, Mark, just as you please. What time will you come round in the
+ morning?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;About the time you have finished breakfast. I will go now, and have a
+ look at the shipping list.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ They parted at the door, and Mark went to the coffee house where shipping
+ matters were specially attended to, and where master mariners might often
+ be met, conversing together, or with ship owners or merchants. On going
+ through the list, he found that the fast sailing brig, Essex, of 204 tons,
+ and mounting eight guns, would sail for Amsterdam in three days' time, and
+ would take in goods for that place, and, should sufficient freight be
+ obtained, for any other Dutch port. It was also announced that she had
+ good accommodation for passengers. Information as to cargo could be
+ obtained from her owners, on Tower Hill, or from the captain on board,
+ between the hours of ten and twelve. Then, in small type, it was stated
+ that the Essex was at present lying in the outside tier nearly opposite
+ Anderson's wharf.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark made a note of all these particulars in his pocketbook, and then went
+ to Ingleston's public house.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Morning, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; the man said; &ldquo;haven't seen yer for the last
+ month or so.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No; I have been out of town. Do you expect Gibbons in here this morning?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is about his time, sir, when he has nothing in particular to see
+ about. Like a turn with the mauleys this morning?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not this morning, Ingleston. I have got some engagements for the next day
+ or two where I could not very well show myself with a black eye or a
+ swelled nose; you have given me a good many of both.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Mr. Thorndyke, when one stands up against a man who is as strong as
+ one's self, and a mighty quick and hard hitter, you have got to hit sharp
+ and quick too. You know my opinion, that there aint half a dozen men in
+ the country could lick you if you had a proper training.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I suppose you couldn't get away for a week, or maybe two?&rdquo; he said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Lor' bless you, no, sir. Who would there be to keep order here at night?
+ When I first came here I had not given up the ring, and I fought once or
+ twice afterwards. But, Lor' bless you, I soon found that I had got either
+ to give up the pub or the ring, and as I was doing a tidy business here, I
+ thought it best to retire; since then business has grown. You see, boxing
+ is more fashionable than it used to be, and there are very few nights when
+ one don't have a dozen Corinthians in here&mdash;sometimes there are twice
+ as many&mdash;either to see some of the new hands put on the mauleys, and
+ judge for themselves how they are going to turn out, or maybe to arrange
+ for a bout between some novice they fancy and one of the west countrymen.
+ No, sir, I could not do it anyhow; I should not like to be away even for
+ one night, though I know Gibbons would look after things for me; as for
+ being away for a week, I could not do it for any money. No, sir, my fight
+ with Jackson last year was the last time I shall ever go into the ring. I
+ was a fool to go in for that, but I got taunted into it. I never thought
+ that I should lick him, though, as you know, sir, I have licked a good
+ many good men in my time, but Jackson is an out and out man, and he has
+ got a lot more science than I ever had; my only chance was that I could
+ knock him out of time or wear him down; but he was too quick on his pins
+ for me to do the former. Ah, Gibbons, here is Mr. Thorndyke. He wants to
+ see you; you had best go into my room behind the bar.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Want to get hold of a fresh hand, Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo; Gibbons asked when they
+ had sat down by the fire.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, Gibbons, it is another business altogether. Have you got anything
+ particular to keep you in town for the next fortnight? It may not be over
+ a week, but it may be over a fortnight.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, sir,&rdquo; the man said, after taking three or four draws at his long
+ pipe. &ldquo;No, sir; they won't want the ropes and stakes for another three
+ weeks, so I am your man if you want me. What, is it for, sir?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, it is rather a curious affair, Gibbons. I have to take a very
+ valuable bracelet over to Amsterdam, to sell there, and I have very strong
+ reasons for believing that if some fellows get an inkling of it they will
+ try to put me out of the way, and get hold of the diamonds. I want a
+ couple of good men to go with me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well sir, I should say you and me could lick a dozen ordinary chaps,
+ without thinking anything of it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I dare say we could, Gibbons, in a stand up fight without weapons, but I
+ fancy these fellows will not try that. They are foreigners, and the first
+ thing they would try would be to put a dagger between my shoulders as I
+ walked up and down on deck at night, or, more likely still, creep into my
+ cabin and stab me while I was asleep. If the voyage were only to last one
+ night I might sit up, pistol in hand, but if the wind is foul we might be
+ a week. We are a pretty strong party. Mr. Chetwynd&mdash;you know him&mdash;is
+ going with me; there will also be two runners from Bow Street, and I want
+ you to take another good man with you. Of course, on board we shall
+ separate. The Bow Street men will watch the passengers, and you and your
+ mate will smoke your pipes and keep yourselves ready to join in if you see
+ there is going to be a row. But I rather think that the passage will be a
+ quiet one. At Amsterdam, until I have got rid of the diamonds I certainly
+ should not care about going out into the street after nightfall without
+ having you close behind me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, sir. I should say Tom Tring would be as good a man as one
+ could get at the job. What is the money to be, Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, what do you think yourself, Gibbons?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I take it you pay all expenses, sir?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, everything.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Would five and twenty guineas a head be too much?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No; I will do better than that. I will give you five and twenty guineas
+ each when we get to Amsterdam, and I will give you another twenty-five
+ each if I come back here safe and sound.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I call that handsome. One could not want more, and you can rely on
+ it that Tring will jump at the offer. He has not been able to get a fight
+ on lately, and he is rather in low water.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, you will both get up as quiet traders. I don't know what other
+ passengers there may be, but I don't want them to know that you belong to
+ the fancy.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I twig, sir. We will get up quiet like.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I want you tomorrow morning, Gibbons, to go down to Holmes &amp;
+ Moore, No. 67 Tower Street, and take two first class tickets to Amsterdam
+ on board the Essex, which sails on Saturday. I don't know what the passage
+ money will be, but this is sure to be enough; and we can settle accounts
+ afterwards. You will find out what time of day she will start.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, governor. I suppose you will be here again before that?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I don't suppose I shall, unless there is some change in the
+ arrangements. If for any reasons Tring cannot go with you, you will get
+ somebody else instead. You are sure that you quite understand your
+ instructions? Here is the name and address of the people in Tower Street.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, sir. You may make sure that when you go down to the ship you
+ will see the two of us on board.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It needed but a few minutes at Bow Street to inform the chief of the
+ arrangements that had been made.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have told off Chester and Malcolm; one of them shall go down and take
+ their tickets. Of course, they will take their passages in the fore cabin,
+ as the danger, if there is danger, may come from there, and you will have
+ your other two men with you aft. I fancy myself that there is hardly any
+ chance of your being in any way troubled while on board. It will be
+ considered that there will be a vastly greater chance of carrying out any
+ plan they may have formed at Amsterdam than there would be on board a
+ ship; you see, if there were any struggle whatever on board there would be
+ no escape for them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;For myself, of course I cannot give any opinion worth having in a matter
+ so different from anything we have to do with here, and I should have
+ unhesitatingly scoffed at the idea of anyone watching the movements of
+ people for a long number of years in order to obtain the possession of
+ jewels, however valuable. However, your uncle was well acquainted with the
+ habits of Hindoos, and was not a man to be lightly alarmed; you yourself,
+ after your year with us, should not be deceived in such a matter as being
+ yourself followed; under these circumstances you are quite right to take
+ every precaution, and as you pay well for the services of our two men,
+ even if I had no belief whatever in the existence of danger to you, I
+ should not feel justified in refusing to let you have them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Having arranged these matters, Mark spent the rest of his time that day
+ and the next at Islington.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am going across to Amsterdam on Saturday with a diamond bracelet to
+ sell there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent looked at him in reproachful surprise.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Why, surely, Mark, there can be no hurry about that. I think you might
+ have stayed a little longer before running away.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should do so, you may be quite sure, Millicent, if I consulted my own
+ inclinations, but I am bearing out your father's wishes. This bracelet is
+ the most valuable of all the things he had, and I believe that it has some
+ sort of history attached to it. He told my father that he had sent all the
+ gems home principally to get these diamonds out of his possession; he said
+ that as soon as my father got hold of the things, he was to take the
+ diamonds straight over to Amsterdam and sell them there, for he considered
+ that they were much too valuable to be kept in the house, and that it was
+ possible that some of the Hindoos might endeavor to get possession of
+ them. At the time he spoke he believed that my father would, at his death,
+ go to the bank and get the jewels, as of course he would have done if he
+ had known where to find them. My father promised him that they should be
+ taken to Amsterdam at once; and although so many years have passed since
+ his death, I think I am bound to carry out that promise.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have never been able to understand, Mark, how it was that my father,
+ when he gave all these instructions about me and these jewels and so on,
+ did not at the same time tell uncle where to find them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It was a fancy of his; he was in very bad health, and he thought so much
+ over these diamonds that it had become almost a sort of mania with him
+ that not only was there danger in their possession, but that he was
+ watched night and day wherever he went. He thought, even, if he whispered
+ where the hiding place was to be discovered it might be heard; therefore
+ he deferred telling it until too late. Of course all this was but a fancy
+ on his part, although it is probable enough that the possession of the
+ diamonds was a source of danger in India, and might have been a source of
+ danger here had any thieves known that such valuable gems were kept in a
+ private house or carried about. At any rate, I shall be glad to be free of
+ the responsibility; and although, naturally, I don't like leaving you at
+ the present time, I think it best to carry out your father's instructions
+ at once, and to get them off my mind altogether. Dick Chetwynd is going
+ with me, so it will be a pleasant little trip.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I am glad he is going with you, Mark; for although I know well
+ enough that they could never be watching for those diamonds to turn up all
+ these years, I feel sure I should fidget and worry if you were alone. You
+ are not going to take the others with you?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, only this particular bracelet. None of the others are exceptionally
+ valuable, so far as I know. At any rate, your father did not specially
+ allude to them. I have no doubt that there are some really valuable jewels
+ among them, for my uncle prided himself on being a judge of precious
+ stones, and as he invested a large amount of money in them, they are, no
+ doubt, worth a great deal. Still, I don't suppose there will be any
+ difficulty in selling them here, and, at any rate, I don't want to be
+ delayed at Amsterdam by having to sell perhaps fifty or a hundred pieces
+ of jewelry; any time will do for that. I fancy that I ought to be able to
+ dispose of the bracelet in three or four days at the outside. I have got
+ from Bow Street a list of all the principal diamond merchants in
+ Amsterdam. That is a matter of great interest to the force, as almost all
+ precious stones stolen in this country are sent across there, and if there
+ is any special jewel robbery we send over a list of all the articles taken
+ to the merchants there. As a rule, that would not prevent their dealing in
+ them, but there are some who will not touch things that have been
+ dishonestly come by, and we occasionally get hints that enable us to lay
+ hands upon thieves over there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hate to hear you say 'the force,' Mark, just as if you were still a
+ detective; it is bad enough that you should have belonged to it, even for
+ the purpose you did; but you have done with it now.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes; but, you see, it is rather difficult to get out of the habit when
+ one has been for over a year constantly at work at a thing. This will be
+ my last absence on business, Millicent; henceforward I shall be able to be
+ always with you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, now that I know what you have been doing all this time, Mark, I
+ must admit that you have been very good to have been with us as much as
+ you have. I often used to wonder how you passed your time. Of course I
+ knew that you were trying to find that man out, but it did not seem to me
+ that you could be always at that, and I never dreamt that you had become a
+ regular detective. I am very glad I did not know it till a short time
+ before you gave it up. In the first place, I should have been horrified,
+ and, in the second place, I should have been constantly uneasy about you.
+ However, as this is to be the last time, I will let you go without
+ grumbling.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;By the way, Millicent, what do you wish me to say about our engagement? I
+ don't see that there is the slightest occasion for us to keep up the farce
+ of your being Miss Conyers any longer. You cannot be married under a false
+ name, you know, and now that you have escaped what your father was so
+ afraid of, and are going to be married for love and not for money, I don't
+ see why there should be any more mystery about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But how would you account for my having been called Conyers all this
+ time?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should simply tell the truth; that your father, having a great fear
+ that you might be married for money, left the estate to my father, to be
+ held by him until you came of age, and that it was at his particular
+ request that you were brought up simply as his ward, and dropped the
+ family name and passed by your two Christian names. I should say that we
+ have all been aware for a long time of the facts of the case, and I should
+ also say that your father had left a very large fortune in addition to the
+ estate between us, and had expressed a hope that we should, when the time
+ came, marry each other.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then people will think that we have only married to keep the fortune
+ together, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, my dear, I don't suppose there are a great many people who will be
+ interested in the matter, and those who get to know you will see at once
+ that as far as I am concerned, there was no great difficulty in falling in
+ with your father's ideas, while, on the other hand, they may consider that
+ you made a noble sacrifice of yourself in agreeing to the plan.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Nonsense, sir. I am not going to flatter you, as no doubt you expect;
+ but, at any rate, I am perfectly content with my share of the bargain.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, there is one thing, Millicent; all who knew us down at Reigate will
+ say that it is a very sensible arrangement, and will be glad to know that
+ I shall retain the estate they have hitherto considered to be mine. Well,
+ then, you agree to my mentioning to my intimate friends that you are my
+ cousin, and that we are engaged?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I suppose it is the best thing, Mark, and, as you say, I must marry
+ under my proper name, and it is just as well to get the talk over down at
+ Reigate now, as for it all to come as a wonder when we are married.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;When is that going to be, Millicent?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, I don't know; of course it will be a long time before we even think
+ of that.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I beg your pardon, I am thinking of it now, and I can see no reason
+ whatever why it should be delayed. We know each other well enough, I
+ should think, and there is no probability of our changing our minds on
+ discovering all sorts of faults, that we never dreamt, in each other. I
+ may be away for a fortnight, and I would suggest that you had better make
+ your preparations at once, so that we can be married a fortnight after I
+ come back.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You say that there is no fear of our discovering faults in each other. I
+ can assure you that I have just discovered a very serious fault, namely,
+ that you are altogether too masterful, too bent upon having your own way.
+ I know you always were so when you were a boy, but I hoped you had grown
+ out of it; now I see that I was altogether mistaken. Seriously, Mark, your
+ proposal is absurd.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Where does the absurdity come in, Millicent?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, everywhere,&rdquo; she said gravely.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Which in the present case means nowhere,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;Do you mean to tell
+ me, Millicent, that in this town there are not a hundred dressmakers, each
+ of whom could turn you out a wedding dress and as many other garments as
+ you can possibly require in the course of a month, or even if that effort
+ were too stupendous, that you could not divide the work among a dozen of
+ them?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I don't say that could not be done,&rdquo; Millicent admitted
+ reluctantly.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, what other objection is there?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, you see, one does not, like to be bustled in such a matter as this,
+ Mark. One likes to think it all over and to realize it to one's self.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, dear, you will have a fortnight while I am away to think and to
+ realize as much as you like. I can see no advantage myself in waiting a
+ single day longer than there is a necessity for; I have been for the last
+ year coming here merely as a visitor, and I want to take possession of you
+ and have you all to myself. I suppose Mrs. Cunningham will be coming in
+ presently, and I will put the matter to her. If she says you cannot be
+ ready in a month I must give you another week, but I don't think that she
+ will say so. By the way, how about her?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I was thinking of that last night, Mark. It would be very lonely for her
+ to live by herself now, and you see she has always been as a mother to
+ me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Quite so, dear; and I am sure that I should have no objection to her
+ coming back to Crowswood, and living there as a friend, and helping you in
+ the housekeeping.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you very much, Mark; I should like that in every way. You see, I
+ know nothing whatever about housekeeping; and besides, when you are out,
+ it would be a great thing to have her with me, for it would be very lonely
+ by myself in that big house.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, we will have her there, by all means, dear, if she likes to come;
+ you had better talk it over with her. Ah! here she is.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We were just talking over the time it will take Millicent to get ready,&rdquo;
+ he said, &ldquo;and I shall be glad of your opinion. I have been telling her
+ that I am going away for a fortnight, and have proposed that the marriage
+ should come off a fortnight later. I cannot see any use in delay, and she
+ does not either; at least, I suppose not, for the only objection she has
+ advanced is that there will be but a short time in which to get her things
+ ready. That strikes me as being all nonsense. I could get things ready for
+ ten weddings in that time. What do you think?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I see no reason for delay,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said; &ldquo;and assuredly a month
+ ought to be sufficient to get everything made.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you, Mrs. Cunningham; then we can consider that settled,
+ Millicent!&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I call this tyranny, Mrs. Cunningham,&rdquo; Millicent protested. &ldquo;He says he
+ proposes that we shall be married in a month; it is not a proposal at all,
+ it is an order. If he had wanted me in such a hurry he might have said so
+ a year ago, and now that he has made up his mind at last, he wants
+ everything done in a hurry.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is the nature of men, my dear; they are all alike in that respect. I
+ think you had better make up your mind to it, especially as I have no
+ doubt in this case the order is not a very unpleasant one.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You are too bad, Mrs. Cunningham,&rdquo; Millicent said. &ldquo;I made sure that I
+ should find you on my side, and it seems you have gone over altogether to
+ the enemy.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Where are you going to?&rdquo; asked Mrs. Cunningham of Mark.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am going across to Amsterdam to sell that bracelet. My uncle expressed
+ a particular wish to my father that he should do so immediately it came
+ into his possession. Dick Chetwynd is going over with me, and if the
+ weather is fair it will be a pleasant trip.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Where are you thinking of going after the marriage?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have not talked it over yet. My own idea is that, as neither of us has
+ been abroad, we might as well take this opportunity for seeing something
+ of the Continent. Of course we cannot go to France, things are in too
+ disturbed a state there; but we might go to Brussels, and then into
+ Germany, and perhaps as far as Vienna, and then down into Italy; but of
+ course, if Millicent prefers it, we will simply take a tour through
+ England and Scotland.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, I am glad that I am to have some voice in the matter,&rdquo; Millicent
+ said. &ldquo;However, I should like the tour you propose very much, Mark. I have
+ often thought that I should like to see Italy above all places.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, then, we will consider that settled. And now, what are you going to
+ do for today?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0019" id="link2HCH0019">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XIX.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ The Essex was to sail at eleven o'clock. Half an hour before that time
+ Mark's hackney coach drew up at the wharf. Ten minutes later Dick
+ Chetwynd, who had, like Mark, driven by a circuitous route, and had made
+ several stoppages, joined him, and as they shook hands slipped a parcel
+ into his hand, and this Mark at once pocketed, and buttoned his coat up
+ tightly; then hailing a boat, they went on board together; they had sent
+ their luggage on the previous evening. On getting on board Mark saw the
+ two prize fighters walking up and down the deck aft. They were quietly
+ dressed, and save for their size would have attracted no attention, and
+ would have been taken for two countrymen on their way to Holland on
+ business.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The two detectives were seated forward, their appearance being that of two
+ quiet business men, commercial travelers or small traders. The two friends
+ first went below, and saw to the cabin which they were to share, and found
+ their luggage was all there. Then they returned on deck. Four or five
+ other passengers were standing watching the last bales of goods coming on
+ board. The tide was just on the turn, and a quarter of an hour later the
+ warps were thrown off, and some of the sails hoisted, and the Essex began
+ to move through the water.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Look there, Dick!&rdquo; Mark exclaimed. &ldquo;Do you see that boat lying on its
+ oars in the middle of the stream? That man sitting in the stern is a
+ foreigner, either from Southern Europe or from India.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He is certainly a dark man, Mark. Still, that may be only a coincidence.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is rather a curious one,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;We are too far off to see his
+ features, but he is apparently watching us off. There, the oars are
+ dipping into the water, now he sees that we are fairly under way.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Mark, I shall begin to think that you are right. I am bound to say
+ that hitherto I thought that it was ridiculous to suppose that you could
+ have been watched as you thought, and that you had got these diamonds on
+ your brain till you had really become fanciful. However, it certainly
+ looks as if you were right; but even if you were, how on earth could they
+ have found out that we were going by this ship?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is more than I can tell; if they have been watching me they must
+ have known that I was intimate with you; they have seen me come out of
+ Cotter's Bank, and afterwards enter your lodgings; they would feel sure
+ that I had heard that there would be danger connected with the diamonds,
+ and might suppose that I should get some friend to take them from the
+ bank, and may have followed your movements as well as mine. In that case
+ they would have found out that you also went to Cotter's Bank; may have
+ followed you to Tower Street, and found out that you had taken a passage
+ for two to Amsterdam. They may again have seen you go to the bank this
+ morning and have guessed that you had the diamonds about you, and then
+ seeing us together on the wharf would feel pretty certain that it was so.
+ One of them may have hired that boat and watched the Essex to see that
+ neither of us went on shore again.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now they see that we are off they will know that their game is up,&rdquo;
+ Chetwynd said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am not so sure of that, Dick; there are craft going every day to
+ Antwerp and Flushing, and for anything we know some of them may be on
+ board a craft already dropping down like ourselves by this tide. But even
+ if we had twelve hours' start, by landing, say at Flushing, they would
+ have time to cross by land to Amsterdam and get there before us.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I suppose they would; anyhow, it is pretty certain that we shall not
+ be troubled on the voyage.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I never thought there was much danger of that, because even if they
+ were on board they would see that you and I, being always together, could
+ not be got rid of without an alarm being given.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Not until they were passing Greenwich did either of the detectives come
+ near Mark, then as he and Dick were standing by the bulwarks, looking at
+ the hospital, Chester strolled across the deck and, pointing to the
+ building as if asking him some question about it, said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is a colored man forward, dressed as a sailor.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Is that so?&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;I see no one aft here who looks suspicious, and
+ I don't think they will try anything till we get to Amsterdam. There was a
+ colored man in a boat watching us as we set sail.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I saw him, sir. Can he get to Amsterdam before us?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I have no doubt he can; if he lands at Flushing or Antwerp, and
+ takes a post chaise or a diligence, I should say he could get there
+ twenty-four hours before us. Certainly he could do so if he landed at The
+ Hague, as we have to go a long way round to get into the Zuyder Zee. That
+ is where the real danger will be; still you had better keep a sharp
+ lookout on the man forward.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ No more was said. Mark was not long in getting into conversation with the
+ other passengers aft, and later on strolled forward with Dick, asking the
+ sailors some questions as to what sort of passage they were likely to
+ have, and how the wind suited. The men agreed that unless the wind shifted
+ they would not be likely to make a quick passage.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The wind is northeasterly,&rdquo; one of them said. &ldquo;We can only just lay our
+ course now, and it will be dead against us in some of the reaches. Still,
+ I think we shall manage to make down to sea with only a tack or two, but
+ when we are once fairly out of the river it will be a long leg and a short
+ one, and going up round the Texel it will be dead against us. Except that
+ it would be a bit worse if it had a little more east in it, it is about as
+ foul a wind as we could have, and I don't see any sign of a change, worse
+ luck.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Presently, moving about among them, he got next to Gibbons.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't think we shall have any trouble on board,&rdquo; he said; &ldquo;if there is
+ any, it will be after we have landed. But you can keep an eye on that
+ foreign sailor standing alone there up in the bows.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, sir; if you like, I can manage to get into a quarrel with him,
+ and can warrant that he won't get out of his berth before it is time to go
+ ashore.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I would leave him alone, Gibbons; as long as he is forward he can do
+ no harm; but if you see him working his way aft, after it gets dark, it
+ will do him no harm if you manage to stumble against him and give him a
+ clout on the head.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;All right, sir; if I hit him once he won't want another. The fellow seems
+ quiet enough, and as far as strength goes he don't look stronger than a
+ girl.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After chatting for some time longer Mark and Dick Chetwynd went aft again.
+ The Essex did not put into any intermediate port, and it was only on the
+ sixth day after sailing that she approached Amsterdam. The voyage had
+ passed off without any incident except that at nine o'clock one evening
+ there had been a slight noise on deck and the sound of a fall. The friends
+ went up at once. Several of the sailors had run aft, and Gibbons was
+ explaining matters to them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I was walking up and down the deck,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;when I saw this chap
+ staring down through the skylight, and I said to him, 'I don't call it
+ good manners to be prying down into your betters' cabin.' He did not
+ answer or move, so I gave him a push, when he turned upon me like a wild
+ cat, and drew his knife from his girdle. There it is, on the other side of
+ the deck. As I did not want daylight put into me, I just knocked him
+ down.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Served him right,&rdquo; one of the sailors said. &ldquo;He had no right to come aft
+ at all, and if he drew his knife on you, you were quite right in laying
+ him out. But you must have hit him mighty hard, for you have knocked the
+ life pretty near out of him. Well, we may as well carry him forward and
+ throw a bucket of water over him. That is the worst of these foreign
+ chaps; they are always so ready with their knives. However, I don't think
+ he will be likely to try his hand on an Englishman again.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark and his friend went below again. In the morning Mark asked one of the
+ sailors if the foreigner was much hurt.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, he is a good bit hurt, sir. That big chap looks as strong as a
+ bullock, and his blow has flattened the foreign chap's nose. He cannot see
+ out of his eyes this morning, and is keeping his bunk. They cannot stand a
+ blow, those foreign chaps; but I don't suppose that any of us would have
+ stood such a blow as that, without feeling it pretty heavy. The man who
+ hit him is quite sorry this morning that he hit him quite so hot, but, as
+ he says, when a fellow draws a knife on you, you have not got much time
+ for thinking it over, and you have got to hit quick and hard. I told him
+ he needn't be sorry about it. I consider when a fellow draws a knife that
+ hanging aint too bad for him, whether he gets it into a man or not.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was a growl of assent from two or three sailors standing round, for
+ in those days the use of the knife was almost unknown in England, and was
+ abhorrent to Englishmen, both as being cowardly and unfair, and as being a
+ purely foreign crime.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It will be dark before we get alongside,&rdquo; Mark said to the two
+ detectives. &ldquo;Do you two walk first; we will keep just behind you, and the
+ others shall follow as close as they can keep to us. If anyone is looking
+ out for us they will see that we are a strong party, and that it would be
+ no good to attack us, for even if they were to stab me it would not be
+ possible to search me for the diamonds when I am with a party like this.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ It was indeed quite dark when the brig brought up outside a tier of
+ vessels lying by the wharf. A few oil lamps burning by the quay showed
+ that there were a good many people still sauntering about. The party
+ waited until the rest of the passengers had landed. They learned from one
+ of those who knew the place that the hotel to which they were going was
+ but three or four hundred yards away, and obtained directions how to find
+ it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now we will go,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;Gibbons, you had better keep a sharp lookout
+ on your own account. That fellow you knocked down may try to put a knife
+ into you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will keep a sharp lookout, sir, never you fear.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think, Tring, you had better watch Gibbons; he is more in danger than I
+ am. Have you seen the man go on shore?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, he was the very first to cross onto the next vessel,&rdquo; Tring said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The loungers on the quay had gathered together to watch the passengers as
+ they left the ship, and by the dim light from one of the oil lamps it
+ could be seen that the majority of them were of the roughest class. As
+ they were passing through them a man with a cry of rage sprang at Gibbons
+ with an uplifted knife. Tring's fist struck him under the ear as he was in
+ the act of striking, and he fell like a log. There was a cry of &ldquo;Down with
+ them!&rdquo; and a rush of a score of men, most of whom were armed with heavy
+ bludgeons.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The party was at once broken up, heavy blows were exchanged, the two
+ pugilists rolling their assailants over like ninepins, but receiving
+ several heavy blows from their assailants' clubs. A rush of five or six
+ men separated Mark from the others. Those in front of him he struck down,
+ but a moment later received a tremendous blow on the back of the head
+ which struck him to the ground unconscious. His companions were all too
+ busy defending themselves against their assailants to notice what had been
+ done, and as the attack had taken place in the center of the roadway
+ behind the quay, there was no lamp, and the fight was taking place in
+ almost total darkness.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ By this time many people had run up at the sound of the fray. A minute
+ later there was a cry that the watch were coming, and four or five men
+ with lanterns emerged from one of the streets leading down to the quays,
+ and hurried towards the spot. The fight at once ceased, the men who had
+ attacked mingled with the crowd, and when the watch came up they found the
+ five Englishmen clustered together and ten or twelve men lying on the
+ ground.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The instant that the fight had ceased Dick Chetwynd asked, &ldquo;Where is Mr.
+ Thorndyke?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ No answer was given. The other four men simultaneously uttered
+ exclamations of alarm. The crowd was thinning fast as the watch came up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What is all this about?&rdquo; one of them asked in Dutch.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do any of you speak English?&rdquo; Dick asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I do,&rdquo; one of them said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We landed five minutes ago from that craft,&rdquo; continued Dick, &ldquo;and as we
+ came across we were attacked by a band of ruffians. An Englishman, one of
+ our party, is missing.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Whose bodies are these?&rdquo; the watchman asked, raising his lantern and
+ pointing to them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Perhaps Mr. Thorndyke is among them,&rdquo; Dick Chetwynd said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The fallen figures were examined by the light of the lanterns. Mark was
+ not among them. The watchmen uttered an exclamation of astonishment as
+ they looked at the men's faces.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What did you strike them with?&rdquo; the one who spoke first asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Struck them with our fists, of course,&rdquo; Gibbons replied. &ldquo;They will do
+ well enough; you need not bother about them, they will come round again
+ presently. The question is, Where is Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The whole of the lookers on had dispersed, each fearing that he might be
+ charged with taking part in the outrage.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;This is a very serious matter,&rdquo; Chetwynd said. &ldquo;We have every reason to
+ believe that the attack was premeditated, for the gentleman who is missing
+ was known to have some valuables on him; all these fellows ought to be
+ taken and locked up and made to give an account of themselves. We are
+ going to the Hotel d'Hollande where you can find us at any time. I dare
+ say some of these scoundrels are known to you, and that may give you a
+ clew as to where Mr. Thorndyke is.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have but little hope that he will be found alive; no doubt he has been
+ stabbed and his body carried off so that they can search his clothes at
+ their leisure. We came in a strong party to prevent the risk of an attack
+ upon Mr. Thorndyke. Here is my card. It is of no use our attempting to
+ search by ourselves, but if you will get these fellows taken to the watch
+ house, and will call at the hotel, we will join your party and help you to
+ search the places you think he has most likely been taken to.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think, sir, you had better come with me to the watch house, and see the
+ Lieutenant, and tell him what has happened.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will just take my friends to the hotel, and shall be back from there
+ before you have got men to take these fellows away. If you go to one of
+ those ships and borrow a bucket, empty it over each of them; you will find
+ that will bring them to!&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as they arrived at the hotel Dick ordered a private sitting room
+ and five bedrooms.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have made a terrible mess of this, lads,&rdquo; he said gloomily. &ldquo;I don't
+ say that it is any of our faults, but it is a horrible affair. I have not
+ the least doubt that Mr. Thorndyke has been killed, and it is no
+ satisfaction to us that we have pretty nearly done for a dozen of those
+ scoundrels.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I would not have had it happen for a hundred pounds, nor a thousand, sir.
+ If there had been daylight we could have licked a score of them in spite
+ of their bludgeons, but they came with such a rush at us that we got
+ separated before we knew where we were. I don't think that it was our
+ fault. I feel as much ashamed as if I had thrown up the sponge in the ring
+ at the end of the first round. To think that we came over here, four of
+ us, and yourself, sir, on purpose to take care of Mr. Thorndyke, all well
+ save a few knocks with those sticks, and Mr. Thorndyke killed and carried
+ off before we have been on shore five minutes. A better young fellow I
+ never put on the gloves with;&rdquo; and Gibbons passed the back of his hand
+ across his eyes.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I must be off now,&rdquo; Chetwynd said. &ldquo;I feel heartbroken over it. I
+ have known him since we were boys together; and what makes it worse is
+ that only three days ago he became engaged to be married. How we are going
+ to take the news back God only knows!&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As he hurried down the street towards the wharf he saw a number of
+ lanterns coming towards him, and ten or twelve watchmen came along
+ escorting the prisoners, many of whose faces were covered with blood; then
+ came four other watchmen carrying a body on a stretcher.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;One of them is dead,&rdquo; the watchman who had before spoken said to Dick. &ldquo;A
+ foreign seaman, a Lascar I should say, from his color; we found an open
+ knife by his side.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is the man who began the fray,&rdquo; Chetwynd said. &ldquo;He was on the point
+ of stabbing one of my companions when another hit him under the ear.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What!&rdquo; the watchman said. &ldquo;He must have been hit like the kick of a
+ horse. All these prisoners seem to have been struck but once; two of them
+ cannot speak. I think their jaws are broken; four of them have broken
+ noses, and another has had all his front teeth knocked out, while the
+ others are nearly as bad.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I see you have brought with you some of their bludgeons,&rdquo; Dick said,
+ pointing to one of the watchmen carrying a great bundle of sticks over his
+ shoulder.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, sir, twenty-three of them; it certainly seems to show that it was a
+ planned thing. Most of these fellows' faces are so bruised that I cannot
+ say who they are at present, but two or three are known as the worst
+ ruffians in the city, and I have no doubt we shall find that they all
+ belong to the same gang.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ By this time they had arrived at the watch house, a building of
+ considerable size; the prisoners were first lodged in a strong room with
+ barred windows and very heavy doors, and then the watchman went with
+ Chetwynd to the Lieutenant's room. The officer had just returned, having
+ hurried down with a reinforcement to the wharf as soon as he had heard of
+ the fray, and tried to obtain some information from the people who had
+ gathered round, attracted by the lanterns of the watch. He had already
+ learned from the watchmen all they knew about the affair. As he spoke
+ English well, he at once addressed Dick:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;This is a serious affair, sir.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;A very serious affair, for, indeed, I am afraid that my dearest friend
+ has been murdered.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Will you kindly give me the particulars?&rdquo; the officer said, sitting down
+ to the table with a pen in his hand.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Dick Chetwynd told him the story of how Mr. Thorndyke, having some very
+ valuable jewels that he wished to dispose of, and believing that he would
+ be attacked by a band of robbers, had asked him to accompany him, and had
+ brought four detective officers and pugilists to protect him against any
+ sudden attack.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Ah, that accounts for the terrible blows that these fellows received,&rdquo;
+ the officer said. &ldquo;And your friend; was he a strong man?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He was a man exceptionally strong, and a match for either of the
+ pugilists that he brought over. I have no doubt that he was stabbed,
+ though of course he might have been brought down by a blow from one of the
+ bludgeons. He must have been completely insensible when carried off.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The watchman here tells me that three or four of these ruffians are
+ known, and perhaps if you will give orders for the blood to be washed off
+ the others' faces some more may be recognized and prove an aid in enabling
+ you to form an idea where Mr. Thorndyke has been carried. I trust that you
+ will send out a party to search for him. I and the four men with me will
+ gladly join them, and may be of use if any resistance is offered.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Lieutenant at once gave orders to the watchman to go down and see that
+ the prisoners all washed their faces. As soon as he returned with the
+ report that this was done the officer went down with Dick Chetwynd to
+ examine them. Three or four of the men with lanterns also went in. Eight
+ out of eleven men were recognized; the other three, whose features were so
+ swollen that they could not see out of their eyes, could not be made out,
+ but their companions, on being questioned, gave their names.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;They all belong to a gang of wharf thieves and plunderers. They live in a
+ slum near the water. I will have men posted in the lanes leading to it,
+ and will myself go with you to see that a search is made of every house;
+ but first I will try to find out from these fellows where he was to be
+ taken.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, my men,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;anyone of you who will tell me where one of the
+ party you attacked was to be taken to will find things made easy for him
+ at his trial.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ None of the men spoke for a minute, and then one said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We know nothing about it; how should we, when we were all knocked
+ stupid?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, but you might know where he was to be taken.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I know nothing about that. We all got word to mind we were on the wharf
+ when a brig, that was seen coming up, came alongside, and that we were to
+ have a hundred francs each for attacking some passengers as they landed.
+ Six of them came along together, and one said, 'These are the men.' A
+ black sailor came up first and spoke to two or three men in some foreign
+ language. I don't know who the men were; it was too dark to see their
+ faces. It was one of them who gave the order. It seemed an easy job enough
+ when there were twenty-five of us with heavy sticks, but it didn't turn
+ out so. I only know that I hit one big fellow a blow that ought to have
+ knocked him down, and the next moment there was a crash, and I don't know
+ anything more about it until a lot of water was thrown over me and one of
+ the watch helped me to my feet. I don't know whether the others know more
+ than I do, but I don't think they do.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All the others protested at once that they were equally ignorant. They had
+ gone to earn a hundred francs. They had been told that the money was all
+ right, but who found it or who were the men to be attacked they had not
+ the least idea.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How was it that you all had these bludgeons&mdash;there were no knives
+ found on any of you?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The man who spoke before said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The order was 'No knives,' and before we went down to the wharf each of
+ us was searched and a stick given to us. I suppose from that, that whoever
+ paid for the job didn't want blood to be shed; it suited us well enough,
+ for it was a job there was sure to be a row over, and I don't suppose any
+ of us wanted to put his head in a noose. I know that we all said to each
+ other as we went out that it did not want such sticks as we had to give a
+ man a thrashing, but the man who hired us, whoever he was, knew his
+ customers better than we did.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The officer translated the man's words as they were spoken to Dick, and on
+ hearing the last speech, the latter said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then there is still hope that Thorndyke may only have been stunned; that
+ is a greater reason for our losing no time in looking for him, for I am
+ afraid that they won't hesitate to kill him when they have got him hidden
+ away.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I expect,&rdquo; the Lieutenant said, &ldquo;they thought that if any of the watch
+ came upon them as they were carrying him off, they might be at once
+ arrested if it was found that they were carrying a dead man, whilst if he
+ were only stunned they would say that it was a drunken comrade who had
+ fallen and knocked his head against something. I agree with you, sir; we
+ had better start on our search at once.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Will you pass the Hotel d'Hollande? If not, I will run and bring my men.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I will go that way; it will be no further.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Dick walked on fast.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have no news of him,&rdquo; he said, as he entered the room where the four
+ men were anxiously awaiting him, &ldquo;but we and the watch are now going to
+ search the slums where the men who were taken prisoners all live; come
+ down now, and I will tell you what I have learned, before the others come
+ up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is reason for believing that he was not stabbed,&rdquo; he went on, as
+ they reached the street, &ldquo;for the men all say that they were armed only
+ with clubs, and that the strictest orders were given that none were to
+ carry knives, therefore there is little doubt that he was at the time only
+ stunned. But I am bound to say that this gives me very small ground for
+ hoping that we may find him alive. I fear they only stunned him, so that
+ they might carry him safely to their haunts, for if stopped they could say
+ that it was a drunken comrade, who had fallen and hurt himself. I fear
+ that when they get him into one of their dens they will make short work of
+ him, therefore it is clear that there is not a moment to be lost. Ah, here
+ comes the watch.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There were eight men with the Lieutenant.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have already sent off ten others,&rdquo; he said as he joined Chetwynd, &ldquo;to
+ watch the lanes, and let no one go in or out. I thought it best not to
+ lose a moment about that, for when the men see that we have learned from
+ the others where the gang came from, and have closed the avenues of
+ escape, they will hesitate about murdering their prisoner if he was still
+ alive when my men got there.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In a quarter of an hour they arrived at the end of a narrow lane, where
+ two watchmen were standing with lanterns.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You have seen nor heard nothing?&rdquo; the Lieutenant asked him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, sir, we have not seen a man moving in the lane.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There is just one hope that we might be in time,&rdquo; the Lieutenant said, as
+ he went on down the lane, &ldquo;and that is, that the fellows when they gather
+ will be so dismayed at finding that nearly half their number are missing,
+ and knowing that some of them are pretty sure to make a clean breast of
+ it, they will hesitate to complete their crime. It is one thing to rob a
+ man in the streets, quite another to murder him in cold blood. There is
+ likely to be a good deal of difference of opinion among them, some of the
+ more desperate being in favor of carrying the thing through, but others
+ are sure to be against it, and nothing may have been done. You may be sure
+ that the sight of my men at the end of the lanes will still further alarm
+ them. I have no doubt the news that we have surrounded the district has
+ already been circulated, and that if alive now he is safe, for they will
+ think it is better to suffer a year or two's imprisonment than to be tried
+ for murder. We are sure to make some captures, for it is probable that
+ several of the others will bear marks of the fight. Each man we take we
+ will question separately; one or other of them is pretty safe to be ready
+ to say where your friend was taken to if I promise him that he shan't be
+ prosecuted.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Every house in the district was searched from top to bottom. Six men; with
+ cut and bruised faces, were found shamming sleep, and were separately
+ questioned closely; all declared that they knew nothing whatever of anyone
+ being carried there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is of no use your denying your share in the affair,&rdquo; the Lieutenant
+ said. &ldquo;Your comrades have confessed that there were twenty-five of you
+ hired to carry out this, and that you received a hundred francs each. Now,
+ if this gentleman is not found, it will be a hanging matter for some of
+ you, and you had better tell all you know. If you will tell us where he
+ is, I will promise that you shan't be included in the list of those who
+ will be prosecuted.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The reply, although put in different words, was identical with that of the
+ prisoners.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We had nothing to do with carrying him off; we were hired only to knock
+ the men down who were pointed out to us; not a word was said about
+ carrying them off. He may have been carried off, that we cannot say, but
+ he has certainly not been brought here, and none of us had anything to do
+ with it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Morning was breaking before the search was concluded. The detectives,
+ accustomed as they were to visit the worst slums of London, were horrified
+ at the crowding, the squalor, and the misery of the places they entered.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My opinion. Mr. Chetwynd,&rdquo; Gibbons growled, &ldquo;is that the best thing to do
+ would be to put a score of soldiers at the end of all these lanes, and
+ then to burn the whole place down, and make a clean sweep of it. I never
+ saw such a villainous looking crew in all my life. I have been in hopes
+ all along that some of them would resist; it would have been a real
+ pleasure to have let fly at them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;They are a villainous set of wretches, Gibbons, but they may not be all
+ criminals.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well; I don't know, sir; but I know that if I were on a jury, and any of
+ the lot were in the dock, I should not want to hear any evidence against
+ them; their faces are enough to hang them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At last the search was over, and they were glad indeed when they emerged
+ from the lanes and breathed the pure air outside, for all the Englishmen
+ felt sick at the poisonous air of the dens they had entered. The
+ prisoners, as they were taken, had been sent off to the watch house.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I begin to think that the story these fellows tell is a true one, Mr.
+ Chetwynd,&rdquo; the Lieutenant said, &ldquo;and that they had nothing to do with
+ carrying your friend off. In the first place, they all tell the same
+ story: that in itself would not be much, as that might have been settled
+ beforehand; but it is hardly likely that one of the lot would not have
+ been ready to purchase his life by turning on the others. There is very
+ little honor among thieves; and as they know that we have taken their
+ mates&mdash;for no doubt we were watched as we marched them up the town&mdash;they
+ would make sure that someone would turn traitor, and would think they
+ might as well be beforehand. I fancy that the men, whoever they are, who
+ hired this gang to attack you, carried out that part of the business
+ themselves.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am afraid that is so,&rdquo; Dick agreed; &ldquo;and I fear in that case that he is
+ in even worse hands than if these ruffians here had taken him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, sir, can you furnish us with any clew?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The only clew is that they were most probably dark men. That man who was
+ killed was undoubtedly one of them. I should say that they would probably
+ be got up as foreign sailors.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, that is something to go upon, at any rate. I will send round men at
+ once to all the places by the quays where sailors board, and if three or
+ four of them have been together at any place we are sure to hear of it,
+ and the moment I have news I will send to your hotel.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you; I don't see that we can be of any use at present, but you will
+ find us ready to turn out again the moment we hear that you have news.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When the party returned to the hotel they sat talking the matter over for
+ upwards of an hour. All were greatly discouraged, for they had little hope
+ indeed of ever learning what had become of Mark. As they had started out
+ Dick had told the night porter that he could not say what time they might
+ return, but that before the house closed he must have a couple of bottles
+ of spirits and some tumblers sent up to their sitting room, together with
+ some bread and cold meat, for that they might not return until morning,
+ and would need something before they went to bed, as they had had nothing
+ since their dinner, at one o'clock.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It wants something to take the taste of that place out of one's mouth,&rdquo;
+ Tring said to Dick, as, directly they entered, he poured some spirits into
+ the glasses. &ldquo;I feel as queer as if I had been hocussed.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ All, indeed, were feeling the same, and it was not until they had eaten
+ their supper and considerably lowered the spirits in the two bottles that
+ they began to talk. The two detectives were the principal speakers, and
+ both of these were of opinion that the only shadow of hope remaining
+ rested upon Mark himself.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Unless they finished him before he came round,&rdquo; Malcolm said, &ldquo;they would
+ find him an awkward customer to deal with. Mr. Thorndyke has got his head
+ screwed on right, and if, as you say, they are Indians, Mr. Chetwynd, I
+ should think that if he once comes fairly round, unless he is tied up, he
+ will be a match for them, even with their knives. That is the only chance
+ I see. Even if the watch do find out that three or four foreign sailors
+ have been at one of the boarding houses and did not turn up last night, I
+ don't think we shall be much nearer. They will probably only have carried
+ him some distance along the wharf, got to some quiet place where there is
+ a big pile of wood, or something of that sort, then put a knife into him,
+ searched for the diamonds, which you may be sure they would find easily
+ enough wherever he had hidden them, and then make off, most likely for
+ Rotterdam or The Hague; they could be at either of these places by this
+ time, and will mostly likely divide the diamonds and get on board
+ different craft, bound for London or Hull, or indeed any other port, and
+ then ship for India. From what Mr. Thorndyke said they did not want the
+ diamonds to sell, but only to carry back to some temple from which they
+ were stolen twenty years ago.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Chester was of precisely the same opinion.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am afraid, Mr. Chetwynd,&rdquo; he added, as they rose to go to their rooms
+ for two or three hours' sleep, &ldquo;the only news that we shall get in the
+ morning is that Mr. Thorndyke's body has been found.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0020" id="link2HCH0020">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XX.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ At ten o'clock a constable came with a message from the Lieutenant to Mr.
+ Chetwynd that he would be glad if he would come down to the watch house.
+ Dick did not wake the others, but freshening himself up by pouring a jug
+ of water over his head, went at once with the constable.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Have you news?&rdquo; he asked eagerly as he entered.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, the men returned an hour ago. At four of the houses they went to a
+ foreign sailor had been lodging there for the last day or so, but
+ yesterday afternoon all had paid their reckoning and left. Then the idea
+ struck me that it would be as well to ask if they had been seen on the
+ quays, and I sent off a fresh batch of men to make inquiries. A quarter of
+ an hour ago one of them came back with the news that he had learned from a
+ sailor that he had noticed a dark colored foreigner, whom he took to be a
+ Lascar sailor, talking to a boatman, and that they had rowed off together
+ to a barge anchored a short way out; he did not notice anything more about
+ him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, I should not be at all surprised if the fellow went off to arrange
+ with the bargeman for a passage for himself and four or five comrades to
+ some port or other, it might be anywhere. It would make no difference to
+ them where the barge was bound for. No doubt he saw the man again after
+ the brig was sighted, and told him that they should come on board soon
+ after it got dark, and told him to have the boat at the stairs. You see,
+ in that case they might not have carried Mr. Thorndyke above fifty yards.
+ They would probably get him on board as one of their party who had been
+ drunk. The barge, no doubt, got under way about nine o'clock, which is the
+ hour when the tide was high last night, and during the night the Indians
+ could easily drop your friend overboard&mdash;and may even have done so
+ before they got under way, which would have been the easiest thing to do.
+ There would have been no one at the helm, and they could have chosen a
+ moment when the crew, probably only three, were below. I am afraid that
+ this is not a cheering lookout, but I have little doubt that it is the
+ correct one.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have told my men to find out what barge was lying at the spot the
+ sailor pointed out, and if we discover her name, which we are likely to be
+ able to do, there will be no difficulty in finding out to whom she belongs
+ and where she was bound for. Then we can follow it up; though there is
+ little likelihood of our finding the murderers still on board.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Thank you very much for the pains that you are taking, sir,&rdquo; Dick said.
+ &ldquo;I am afraid that there is no shadow of hope of finding my poor friend
+ alive. I have no doubt that the thing has happened exactly as you suggest;
+ the whole course of the affair shows how carefully it was planned, and I
+ have no hope that any scruple about taking life would be felt by them for
+ a moment. I will go back to the hotel, and I shall be obliged if you will
+ let me know as soon as you obtain any clew as to the barge.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ An hour and a half later the officer himself came round to the room where
+ Dick Chetwynd and the two pugilists were sitting. The detectives had
+ started out to make inquiries on their own account, taking with them a
+ hanger on at the hotel who spoke English.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The barge's name was the Julie,&rdquo; he said; &ldquo;she has a cargo on board for
+ Rotterdam.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think the best thing would be to take a carriage, and drive there at
+ once,&rdquo; Dick said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You can do that, sir, but I don't think you will be there before the
+ barge; they have something like eighteen hours' start for you, and the
+ wind has been all the time in the east. I should say that they would be
+ there by eight o'clock this morning.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, I don't know that it would be of any use, but at least it would be
+ doing something. I suppose we could be there in four hours?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;From that to five; but even if the barge were delayed, and you got there
+ first, which is very unlikely, I do not think that there would be the
+ remotest chance of finding those villains on board. I reckon they would,
+ as we agreed, launch the body overboard even before they got under way
+ here, and they may either have landed again before the craft got under
+ way, pretending that they had changed their minds, and then walked across
+ to The Hague or to Haarlem, or have gone on with the barge for two hours,
+ or even until daybreak. If by that time they were near Rotterdam, they may
+ have stayed on board till they got there; if not, they may have landed,
+ and finished the journey on foot, but they would certainly not have
+ stopped on board after six or seven o'clock this morning. They would
+ calculate that possibly we might get on their track at an early hour this
+ morning, and set out in pursuit at once.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;However, it will doubtless be a satisfaction to you to be moving, and at
+ least you will be able to overhaul the barge when you get to Rotterdam,
+ and to hear what the boatmen say. The chances are they will not even have
+ noticed that one of the men who came on board was missing. The men may
+ very well have made up a long bundle, carried it on shore with them, or
+ three of them may have carried a fourth ashore; and in the dark the
+ bargemen were unlikely to have noticed that the number was less than when
+ they came on board. However, it will be something for you to find out when
+ and where the fellows landed.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes; I should certainly like to lay hands on them, though I am afraid we
+ should find it very hard to prove that they had anything to do with this
+ affair.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think that also, Mr. Chetwynd. Morally, we may feel absolutely certain;
+ but, unless the boatmen noticed that one of their number was missing when
+ they landed, we have at present no evidence to connect them with it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We will set out as soon as my other two men return. I told them to be
+ back soon after twelve. I will write to you this evening from Rotterdam.
+ Ah! here are the men.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The door opened, and, to the stupefaction of the party, Mark Thorndyke
+ entered the room.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Good Heavens, Mark!&rdquo; Dick exclaimed, springing forward and seizing his
+ hand, &ldquo;is it really you alive in the flesh? We had given you up for dead.
+ We have been searching the town for you all night, and were just going to
+ set out for Rotterdam in search of a barge on which we believed you were
+ carried. Why, it seems almost a miracle!&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The two prize fighters also came forward, and shook hands with a pressure
+ that would have made most men shrink.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am as glad, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; Gibbons said, &ldquo;as if anyone had given me a
+ thousand pounds. I have never quite given up hope, for, as I said to Mr.
+ Chetwynd, if you got but a shadow of a chance, you would polish off those
+ nigger fellows in no time; but I was afraid that they never would give you
+ a chance. Well, I am glad, sir.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Mark, this is the Lieutenant of the watch here,&rdquo; Dick said. &ldquo;He has been
+ most kind, and has himself headed the search that has been made for you
+ all night. Now tell us all about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;First of all give me something to drink, for, except some water, I have
+ had nothing since dinner yesterday. You are right, Dick; it is almost a
+ miracle, even to me, that I am here. I would not have given a penny for my
+ chance of life, and I can no more account for the fact that I am here than
+ you can.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark drank off a tumbler of weak spirits and water that Gibbons poured out
+ for him. Chetwynd rang the bell, and ordered lunch to be brought up at
+ once. Just at this moment the two detectives came in, and were astonished
+ and delighted at finding Mark there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;I will tell you as much as I know, which is little
+ enough. When I came to my senses I found myself lying on the deck of a
+ craft of some sort; it was a long time before I could at all understand
+ how I got there. I think it was the pain from the back of my head that
+ brought it to my mind that I must have been knocked down and stunned in
+ that fight; for some time I was very vague in my brain as to that, but it
+ all came back suddenly, and I recalled that we had all got separated. I
+ was hitting out, and then there was a crash. Yes, I must have been knocked
+ down and stunned, and I could only suppose that in the darkness and
+ confusion I had been carried off and taken on board without any of you
+ missing me; my hands and feet were tied, and there was something shoved
+ into my mouth that prevented me from speaking.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should think that it must have been an hour before I quite recovered my
+ senses, and got the thing fairly into my mind. Then a man with a knife
+ leant over me, and made signs that if I spoke he would stab me, and
+ another took the gag out of my mouth and poured some water down my throat,
+ and then put it in again. I saw that he was a dark colored man, and I then
+ understood it all; it was those Hindoos who had got up the attack upon us
+ and had carried me off. I had no doubt they had got the diamonds I had
+ sewn up in the waistband of my trousers.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I wondered why they were keeping me, but was sure they would stab me
+ presently and throw me overboard. I knew that they had killed two soldiers
+ for the sake of the diamonds, and if it hadn't been that they had given me
+ the water, I should not have had a shadow of doubt about my fate.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I puzzled over why they should have done so, and came to the conclusion
+ that they dared not do it on board, because of the crew, and that they
+ intended to take me on shore somewhere, and there dispose of me. I made
+ many attempts to loosen my ropes, but they would not give the slightest.
+ At last I think I dozed off for a time. After I had had the water they
+ drew a blanket or something of that sort over me. It had been there
+ before, but it had only been pulled up as high as my nose, and I felt sure
+ that it was only done to prevent the Dutchmen on the boat seeing that I
+ was bound and gagged; this time they pulled it right over my face. When
+ they took it off again I could see it was nearly morning, for there was a
+ faint light in the sky. They were moving about on the deck, and presently
+ I saw one of the sailors get into the boat and pull it along, hand over
+ hand, by the rail, until he was close to me. Then four Lascar sort of
+ chaps&mdash;I could scarcely make out their features&mdash;lifted me and
+ lowered me into the boat and got in themselves.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I did not attempt to struggle. No doubt they had made up some tale that I
+ was mad or something of that sort, and I thought that I had best pretend
+ to be quiet and peaceable till I could see some sort of chance of making a
+ fight for it. It was but a few yards from the shore. The man lifted me out
+ onto the bank, and the sailor then started to row back to the barge; they
+ carried me a few yards away, and then laid me face downwards on some
+ grass. Now, I thought to myself, it is all over; they are going to stab me
+ and make off. To my surprise I felt they were doing something&mdash;I
+ could not make out what&mdash;to the ropes; then there was quiet. I lay
+ there I should think for half an hour, wondering why on earth they did not
+ finish me. At last I made up my mind to move, and turned round onto my
+ back. As I lay there I could see no one, and, raising my head, looked
+ round. To my amazement I found that I was alone. It was now almost light,
+ and as I craned my head in all directions I assured myself that they had
+ gone; then I began to try again at the ropes.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;To my surprise I found that they were much looser than they were before,
+ although still tight enough to give me nearly an hour's work before I got
+ my hands free. Then it took me almost as long to get the ropes off my
+ legs, for they had knotted them in such a fearfully intricate way that it
+ was a long time before I could even discover where the ends were. At last
+ I finished the job, stood up, and looked round. A quarter of a mile off
+ there was a good sized town, but not a soul could I see.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Till now I had hardly thought of the diamonds; I put my hands to my
+ waistband and found, as I expected, that they were gone. I think I felt
+ nothing but pleasure: the confounded things had given trouble enough, and
+ I was well rid of them. Why they should have spared my life I could not
+ imagine. If they had finished me, which they could have done without any
+ risk to themselves when they got me ashore, they could have gone off with
+ the diamonds without the slightest fear of pursuit, while now there was,
+ of course, a chance that I might follow and recognize them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Would you know them again?&rdquo; the Lieutenant interrupted.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not in the slightest; it was light enough to see that they were dark, but
+ from the time the boat came along the blanket was over my head, and except
+ when they gave me the water I had no chance of seeing any of their
+ features. Still, if I had gone straight to the town I saw and reported the
+ matter to the authorities and sent mounted men to all the ports to warn
+ them not to let any colored men embark, I might have given them a lot of
+ trouble, but I don't suppose any of them would ever have been caught.
+ After the craft they had shown in the whole matter, it is certain that
+ they would have laid their plans for escape so well that the law would
+ never have laid hands upon them. I put my hand mechanically to my watch to
+ see the time, and to my astonishment discovered that I still had it in my
+ pocket, and was equally surprised to find that the money in my trousers'
+ pockets was also untouched. The watch had, of course, stopped. I first of
+ all went down to the water and had a good wash; then I proceeded to the
+ town, and, going to a hotel, ordered breakfast.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Why, I thought you said that you had had nothing to eat, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes? Well, I had forgotten all about that breakfast. The people looked a
+ good deal surprised at an Englishman walking in in that way. While I was
+ eating my breakfast two men&mdash;who were, I suppose, authorities of some
+ kind&mdash;who spoke English, came and questioned me. As I had made up my
+ mind to say nothing more about the affair, I merely told them that I had
+ come for a sail from Amsterdam, and that I wanted a carriage to take me
+ back. They were evidently astonished at my choosing a dark night for such
+ a trip, but I said that I had some curiosity to see how the boatmen
+ navigated their vessel when there were no lighthouses or anything to steer
+ by. They asked a few more questions, and then went away, evidently
+ thinking that I was a little mad. However, they must have spoken to the
+ landlord, who in a short time made signs that the carriage was at the
+ door.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I had avoided asking the men either the name of the place or how far it
+ was from any big town, because that would have made the whole affair more
+ singular. It was a quarter past eight when I started, and beyond the fact
+ that I know by the sun we came pretty nearly due east, I have not the
+ slightest idea of the road. The coachman could not speak a word of
+ English. I should say we came about seven miles an hour and stopped once
+ to bait the horses, so I suppose that it must have been between four and
+ five miles from Rotterdam when I landed.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Lunch had by this time been laid on the table, and at Dick's invitation
+ the Lieutenant joined them.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is an extraordinary story!&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;That your life should have been
+ spared is altogether beyond my comprehension, still more so why they
+ should have left you your money and watch.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The whole story is extraordinary,&rdquo; Dick Chetwynd said; &ldquo;for we have every
+ reason to believe that those fellows, or at least one or two of them, have
+ been patiently watching for a chance of carrying off those diamonds for
+ twenty years. When my friend told me of it ten days ago I did not believe
+ that it could be possible; but he has certainly shown that he was correct
+ in his opinion.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark then related the history of the jewels, surprising the pugilists and
+ detectives as much as the Lieutenant.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is extraordinary indeed,&rdquo; the latter said. &ldquo;I should not have believed
+ it possible that men would devote so many years to such a purpose, nor
+ that they could have succeeded in tracing the diamonds in spite of the
+ precaution taken by your uncle, and afterwards by yourself. It would seem
+ that from the time he landed in England he, and after him your father and
+ yourself, must have been watched almost night and day. I can understand
+ now why they did not take your watch and money. They evidently acted from
+ a sort of religious enthusiasm, and were no ordinary thieves, but as
+ evidently they did not hesitate to kill, I cannot understand why they
+ should have added to their risks by sparing you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, that is what puzzles me,&rdquo; Mark agreed. &ldquo;I was thinking it over while
+ we were driving here. Now let me hear about the fight, Dick. How did you
+ all come out of it?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;As well as could be expected. Gibbons and Tring both got some heavy blows
+ with the cudgels, as indeed we all did more or less, but they did great
+ execution. Eleven fellows were left senseless on the ground, and one of
+ them, that black fellow who came over with us, was killed. The other ten
+ are all in prison. All of us did our best, and managed to leave our mark
+ on eight others, who were in consequence picked out, and are also in
+ jail.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Dick went on to relate the particulars of the search.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You see, our friend here had traced you to the barge and found out her
+ destination, and if you had come ten minutes later you would have found
+ that we had all just started for Rotterdam. I was only waiting for Chester
+ and Malcolm to return to set out. I am sorry, Mark, that you have lost
+ your diamonds; not so much because they are gone, for I can well
+ understand you to be thoroughly glad to be rid of such dangerous articles,
+ but because they have carried them off in our teeth, after we have been
+ specially retained to protect you. I certainly thought that with such a
+ bodyguard you were absolutely safe from any number of Hindoos.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, we made a regular mess of it, Mr. Thorndyke,&rdquo; Gibbons said. &ldquo;I never
+ felt so certain of winning a battle as I did that you would not be touched
+ as long as we were looking after you. Tring and I, if we had been asked,
+ would have said that we could each have taken on a dozen foreigners
+ easily. Mr. Chetwynd is handy with his fists too, though he hasn't your
+ weight and reach, and your two other friends are both pretty well
+ accustomed to deal with rough customers. As for Tring and me, it makes one
+ feel small to know that we have been bested by a handful of niggers, or
+ Hindoos, or whatever the chaps are, whom a good sized boy of twelve ought
+ to be able to polish off.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, Mark, what is to be done next?&rdquo; Dick Chetwynd asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The next thing will be to get back as soon as we can, Dick. I, for one,
+ have had enough of Holland to last me for a lifetime.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am afraid, gentlemen,&rdquo; the Lieutenant said, &ldquo;you will have to wait a
+ day or two before you can leave. I have nineteen men in prison, and there
+ will be a meeting of magistrates this afternoon. Now you have come back,
+ Mr. Thorndyke, the charge against them won't be as serious as it would
+ have been before, but they are guilty of a desperate and premeditated
+ assault upon six passengers on their arrival here; they have already
+ admitted that they were paid for their work; and as among them are some of
+ the worst characters in the city, you may be sure that now we have got
+ them fairly in our hands we shall not let them go. It is so simple an
+ affair that the investigation ought not to take long, but we shall want to
+ find out, if we can, who acted as the intermediary between the Hindoos and
+ the prisoners. I should think that two meetings ought to be sufficient for
+ the present, but I am afraid that there may then be a long remand, and
+ that you will either have to remain here or to come over again.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It would be a horrible nuisance,&rdquo; Dick said; &ldquo;still it would be better to
+ come back again than to wait here indefinitely, and anyhow I don't suppose
+ it would be necessary for all of us to come back again.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should not mind if it could be arranged for me to be here again in a
+ month's time,&rdquo; Mark agreed, &ldquo;for, to tell you the truth, I am going to be
+ married in less than three weeks, and as I had intended to come to
+ Brussels, and afterwards to travel for a while, I could make a visit here
+ without greatly putting myself out.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will try and arrange that, Mr. Thorndyke.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall be glad,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;if you can manage to get the men sentenced
+ without going into the question of the diamonds at all, and treat the
+ matter as a mere attempt at robbery. It surely would not be necessary to
+ bring the question of my being carried away into the matter at all; I can
+ give evidence that I was knocked down and stunned, and that I was robbed
+ of some jewels that I had about me, which were the object of the attack.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think we should have to admit that,&rdquo; the Lieutenant said; &ldquo;it must come
+ out that the attack was an organized one.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, if it must, it must,&rdquo; Mark said reluctantly; &ldquo;but then, you see, no
+ end of questions would be asked, and the thing might be delayed while a
+ search is being made for the men who stole the bracelet.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, we will keep it out of the inquiry if we can,&rdquo; the Lieutenant said.
+ &ldquo;The meeting will be at three o'clock. I will send a man to take you to
+ the Town Hall.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ At the appointed hour the party proceeded to the court, and the eighteen
+ prisoners, under a strong guard, having been brought in, six magistrates
+ took their places on the bench; the rest of the court was crowded, the
+ fray on the wharf and the number of captures having created quite a stir
+ in the city. They had arranged that Tring should first give his evidence,
+ which he did, the Lieutenant of the watch acting as interpreter, though
+ most of the magistrates understood English. The appearance of the
+ prisoners created quite a sensation in the court, for the injuries that
+ they had received were now even more conspicuous than they had been when
+ they were first captured; some of them had to be led into court, their
+ eyes being completely closed, others had their heads bandaged, and all
+ showed signs of tremendous punishment. Tring related that he, with five
+ others, had come ashore together; one of his companions had a row on board
+ a ship they had crossed in, with a Lascar sailor, who was a passenger, and
+ they kept together as they were crossing the wharf, thinking that possibly
+ the man might attempt to stab his companion.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I was walking behind him,&rdquo; Tring went on, &ldquo;when the Lascar jumped
+ suddenly out from among the men standing about, and was about to stab my
+ companion, when I hit him just in time, and he went down; then there was a
+ rush, and we all got separated, and did as well as we could until the
+ watch came up; that is all that I know about it.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Is the Lascar among the prisoners?&rdquo; one of the magistrates asked the
+ Lieutenant of the watch.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, sir, when picked up by one of my men he was found to be dead; the
+ blow had apparently killed him instantly.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The other five then gave their evidence; it was similar to that of Tring,
+ save that being in front of him they knew nothing of the attack by the
+ Lascar. All they knew about it was that there was a sudden rush upon them
+ by a number of men armed with bludgeons, that they were separated, and
+ that each defended himself until the guard came up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Some of the watch then gave evidence, and told how on arriving at the spot
+ eleven of the prisoners were found lying senseless; how, on recovering,
+ they were all taken to the watch house, where several of them were
+ recognized as notoriously bad characters; they had admitted that they were
+ paid to make the attack, which was apparently the result of the private
+ enmity of some person or persons unknown to one or more of those attacked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The Lieutenant then related the steps that he had taken to capture others
+ connected with the attack, and that he found eight men bearing marks of
+ the fray, and that all these were also notorious characters, and
+ associates of the prisoners first taken. The first witnesses were again
+ questioned; five of them said that, so far as they knew, they had no
+ personal enemies. Mark, who was the last to get into the witness box, said
+ that he himself had no enemies, but that an uncle of his, who was in the
+ British Indian service, had a sort of feud with some members of a sect
+ there on account of some jewels that he had purchased, and which had, they
+ declared, been stolen from a temple. Two soldiers through whose hands
+ these things had passed, had been successively killed by them, and his
+ uncle had to the day of his death believed that their vengeance would one
+ day fall upon him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can only suppose,&rdquo; continued Mark, &ldquo;that I have inherited the enmity
+ they bore him, as I inherited the jewels, and that the attack was really
+ designed solely against me, and the consequences might have been fatal to
+ me had it not been for the strength and courage of my fellow passengers.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Did they come with you for your protection, Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;To some extent, yes. The fact is, that I have for some time been
+ convinced that I was followed about by natives of India, and remembering
+ what my uncle had said on the subject, I became to some degree
+ apprehensive, and thought it as well to leave London for a short time.
+ That this attack was really instigated by the men I have no doubt
+ whatever, since, as you have heard, it was begun by a Lascar, who tried to
+ stab one of my companions and who received a knockdown blow that caused
+ his death from one of the others. It is a well known fact that these
+ people will cherish for many years a determination to avenge any injury.
+ However, I hope that after the failure of this attempt upon my life I
+ shall hear no more of them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Were any knives found on the prisoners?&rdquo; the magistrates asked the
+ Lieutenant of the watch.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, sir; all carried clubs. And they told me that they had been
+ especially ordered not to take knives, and had indeed been searched before
+ they came out.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What impression do you gather from that, Mr. Thorndyke?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;My impression is, sir, that they desired to overpower those with me and
+ to beat them down, in order to carry out their revenge upon me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ After some consultation the magistrate who had before spoken said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The prisoners will be remanded. It is necessary that we should find out
+ who was the chief culprit who bribed this gang.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As soon as the prisoners were taken out of court Mark slipped across to
+ the magistrates, accompanied by the Lieutenant as interpreter.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hope, gentlemen, that our presence here will not be necessary, for it
+ would be a matter of extreme inconvenience. I may say that my marriage is
+ fixed for today three weeks, hence you can well imagine that I want to
+ return as soon as possible. Two of the men are, as you have heard, Bow
+ Street officers, whose presence could not well be spared.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The magistrates again consulted together.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Your evidence has all been taken down by the clerk of the court.
+ Certainly we should not require your presence at the remand; but whether
+ we should do so at the trial would, of course, depend upon whether these
+ men all own their guilt, which, having been taken red handed, it is likely
+ enough they will do. We will consent, therefore, to your leaving, if you
+ will give us an undertaking to return for the trial if your presence is
+ necessary, and that you will bring with you the man who struck down the
+ Lascar who commenced the fray, and one of the others.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That I will do willingly,&rdquo; Mark replied. &ldquo;We are much obliged to you for
+ your consideration. I shall be traveling for a time after my marriage; but
+ I will as I pass through Belgium after my marriage give you the route I
+ intend to take and the address at which letters will find me, and if you
+ send me a sufficiently long notice I will at once return for the trial.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0021" id="link2HCH0021">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XXI.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You managed that very well, Mark,&rdquo; Dick said. &ldquo;You kept well within the
+ limits of truth without bringing the real facts of the attack upon us into
+ the case.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, you see, Dick, after working as a detective, one gets into the way
+ of telling stories with the smallest amount of deviation possible from the
+ truth. What will these fellows get done to them, Lieutenant?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should say that they will get two or three years imprisonment; the only
+ charge now is rioting and assault. It is lucky for them that they had
+ clubs instead of knives, for that would have brought the matter under the
+ head of attempted murder. The matter of the gems was not important in the
+ case, but there is sure to be a great fuss and search for the missing
+ Indians. I suppose you will soon be off home now?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, I shall find out tonight what vessel leaves for England tomorrow,
+ and take a berth in the first that sails for London. It is too late to
+ think of starting this evening, and indeed I feel that I want a long
+ night's rest, for I did not sleep much last night, and have not quite
+ recovered from that crack on my head.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On his return to the hotel Mark sent out a man to inquire at the shipping
+ offices, and finding that a bark would sail at nine o'clock the next
+ morning, they went down and took berths, and sailed in her next day. The
+ voyage home was a rapid one, for the wind blew steadily from the east, and
+ the vessel made the passage to the mouth of the river in two days, and the
+ next took them up to London.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will call round tomorrow or next day, Gibbons, with the checks for you
+ both,&rdquo; Mark said as he prepared to go ashore.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, sir. We are both of one mind that we could not take them. We went
+ over to prevent you being robbed of those sparklers, and to see that you
+ came to no harm. Well, the things are lost, and you got knocked down and
+ carried away. It is no thanks to us that you are alive now. It is a
+ mortifying job, that with two detectives to watch over things and with us
+ to fight we should have been fairly beat by a few black niggers.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;If there had been any bungling on your part, Gibbons, there might be
+ something in what you say, but no one could have foreseen that before we
+ had been on shore two minutes we should have been attacked in that way.
+ You both did all that men could do, as was shown by the condition of the
+ fellows who were taken. I was just as much separated from you as you were
+ from me, and the fact that we were surprised as we were is really due to
+ my not determining to stay on board until the morning, which I could no
+ doubt have done with the captain's permission. It never struck me for a
+ moment that we should be attacked in force. I thought it probable that an
+ attempt at assassination would be made, but it certainly did not seem
+ probable that it would be attempted while you were all with me. You are
+ not in the slightest degree to blame, for your part of the agreement was
+ carried out to my satisfaction. I shall certainly carry out mine, as I
+ have arrived home safe and sound.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, governor, it is very good of you; but I tell you it will go against
+ the grain for us to take your money.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On landing, Mark parted with Dick Chetwynd, who had arranged to drop
+ Mark's bag at his lodgings on his way home, and at once took a hackney
+ coach to Islington. Millicent gave a cry of delight as he entered the
+ room.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;You are back earlier than I expected, Mark. You told me before you
+ started that the wind was in the east, and that you might be a long time
+ getting to Amsterdam unless it changed. I have been watching the vane on
+ the church, and it has been pointing east ever since.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, you have sold the diamonds, I hope?&rdquo; she said, after the first
+ greeting was over.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No; I have bad news for you, Millicent; the jewels have been stolen.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well it does not make much difference, Mark. We have much more than
+ enough without them, so don't bother yourself in the least. How did it
+ happen?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, it is rather a long story. I will tell it you when Mrs. Cunningham
+ is here, so as not to have to go over it twice. How are the dresses
+ getting on?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I suppose they are getting on all right,&rdquo; she said. &ldquo;I have done nothing
+ for the last two days but try them on. You see, we put them out to three
+ milliners, and they all three seem to reach the same point together, and I
+ start after breakfast, and it takes about two hours at each place. You
+ don't know what trouble you have given me by hurrying things on so
+ unreasonably.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, it is better to have it all done and over,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;than to have
+ the thing hanging over you for a couple of months.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That is what Mrs. Cunningham says. Now I want to hear about your
+ adventures, and I will call her down.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Only think, Mrs. Cunningham,&rdquo; Millicent said presently, with a laugh,
+ after she had returned with her, &ldquo;this silly boy has actually let the
+ diamonds be stolen from him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, really, Millicent!&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, indeed. Fancy his not being fit to be trusted to look after them!
+ However, I tell him it is of no consequence. I don't know how they went.
+ He would not tell me the story until you came down.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am sorry to say it is true, Mrs. Cunningham, although I can assure you
+ that I really cannot blame myself for either carelessness or stupidity. I
+ knew when I started that there was a very great risk, and took what seemed
+ to me every possible precaution, for in addition to Dick Chetwynd going
+ with me, I took two detectives from Bow Street and two prize fighters.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Exclamations of surprise broke from both ladies.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;And yet, in spite of all that, these things were stolen,&rdquo; Millicent said.
+ &ldquo;How on earth did they do it? I should have sewn them up in my pockets
+ inside my dress.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I sewed them up in the waistband of my trousers, Millicent, and yet they
+ managed, in spite of us, to steal them. And now I must begin by telling
+ you the whole history of those diamonds, and you will understand why I
+ thought it necessary to take a strong party with me.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ He then told them, repeating the history the Colonel had given his father
+ of the diamonds, and the conviction that he had, that he had been followed
+ by Hindoos, and the instructions he had given for the disposal of the
+ bracelet.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;As you know,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;nothing happened to confirm my uncle's belief
+ that there were men over here in search of the diamonds during my father's
+ life, but since then I have come to the same conclusion that he had, and
+ felt positive that I was being constantly followed wherever I went. As
+ soon as I heard where the treasure was I began to take every precaution in
+ my power. I avoided going to the bank after my first visit there, and, as
+ you know, would not bring the things for you to look at. I got Dick
+ Chetwynd to go there, open the case, and take out these diamonds. He did
+ not bring them away with him, but fetched them from there the morning we
+ started. He went down and took the passage for us both at the shipping
+ office, and the pugilists and the detectives each took passages for
+ themselves, so that I hoped, however closely I was followed, they would
+ not learn that I was taking them to Amsterdam.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It was very wrong, Mark; very wrong indeed,&rdquo; Millicent broke in. &ldquo;You had
+ no right to run such a terrible risk; it would have been better for you to
+ have taken the diamonds and thrown them into the Thames.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That would not have improved matters,&rdquo; he said; &ldquo;the Indians would not
+ have known that I had got rid of them, and would have continued their
+ efforts to find them, and I should always have been in danger instead of
+ getting it over once for all. However, I did not think that there was any
+ danger, going over as I did, with two of the best prize fighters in
+ England, to say nothing of the detectives, who were the men who were with
+ me when I caught Bastow. The only danger was that I might be stabbed; but,
+ as they would know, it was no use their stabbing me unless they could
+ search me quietly, and that they could not do unless I was alone and in
+ some lonely neighborhood, and I had made up my mind not to stir out unless
+ the whole party were with me. I found out, when we got on board that in
+ spite of all the precautions I had taken, they had discovered that I was
+ going to sail for Amsterdam, which they could only have done by following
+ Dick as well as myself. There was a dark faced foreign sailor, who, I had
+ no doubt, was a Hindoo, already on board, and I saw another in a boat
+ watching us start; this was unpleasant, but as I felt sure that they could
+ not have known that I had with me detectives and pugilists, I still felt
+ that they would be able to do nothing when I got to Amsterdam.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then he told them the whole story of the attack, of his being carried
+ away, and of his unexpected release; of the search that had been made for
+ him and the arrest of eighteen of his assailants. Millicent grew pale as
+ he continued, and burst into tears when she heard of his being a prisoner
+ in the hands of the Hindoos.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall never let you go out of my sight again, Mark!&rdquo; she exclaimed when
+ he had finished. &ldquo;It was bad enough before when you were searching for
+ that man here, and I used to be terribly anxious; but that was nothing to
+ this.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, there is an end of it now, Millicent; the men have got the
+ diamonds, and will soon be on their way to India, if they have not started
+ already.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Nasty things!&rdquo; she said; &ldquo;I shall never like diamonds again: they will
+ always remind me of the terrible danger that you have run. Isn't it
+ extraordinary that for twenty years four or five men should be spending
+ their lives waiting for a chance of getting them back!&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I do not expect there were so many as that; probably there was only one.
+ He would have no difficulty in learning that my father had not received
+ any extraordinary gems from my uncle, and probably supposed that they
+ would not be taken out from wherever they might be until you came of age.
+ After the death of my father he might suppose that I should take them out,
+ or that, at any rate, I should go to whoever had them, and see that they
+ were all right, and he then, perhaps, engaged half a dozen Lascars&mdash;there
+ are plenty of them at the docks&mdash;and had me watched wherever I went;
+ and, do you know, that I believe I once owed my life to them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;How was that, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I was captured by some fellows who suspected me to be a Bow Street
+ runner, and I think that it would have gone very hard with me if a party
+ of five or six prize fighters had not broken into the house, pretty nearly
+ killed the men in whose hands I was, and rescued me. They said that they
+ had heard of my danger from a foreign sailor who called at Gibbons', with
+ whom I was in the habit of boxing, and told him about it. You see, until
+ they learned where the jewels were, my life was valuable to them, for
+ possibly I was the only person who knew where they were hidden; so really
+ I don't think I have any reason for bearing a grudge against them. They
+ saved my life in the first place, and spared it at what was a distinct
+ risk to themselves. On the other hand, they were content with regaining
+ the bracelet, not even, as I told you, taking my watch or purse. You see,
+ with them it was a matter of religion. They had no animosity against me
+ personally, but I have no doubt they would have stabbed me without the
+ slightest compunction had there been no other way of getting the things.
+ Still, I think that I owe a debt of gratitude to them rather than the
+ reverse, and, after all, the loss of the bracelet is not a serious one to
+ us.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am glad it is gone,&rdquo; Millicent said. &ldquo;You say it had already caused the
+ death of two men, and if you had succeeded in selling it I can't help
+ thinking that the money would have brought ill fortune to us. I am
+ heartily glad that the diamonds are gone, Mark. I suppose they were very
+ handsome?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;They were magnificent,&rdquo; he said. &ldquo;Dick and Cotter both agreed that they
+ had never seen their equal, and I fancy that they must have been worth a
+ great deal more than your father valued them at.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, it does not matter at all. There is no history attached to the
+ others, I hope, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Not in any way, dear. They were bought, as the Colonel told my father, in
+ the ordinary course of things, and some, no doubt, were obtained at the
+ capture of some of the native princes' treasuries; but it was solely on
+ account of this bracelet that he had any anxiety. You can wear all the
+ others, if you have a fancy for keeping them, without a shadow of risk.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No, Mark, we will sell them every one. I don't think that I shall ever
+ care to wear any jewels again; and if I am ever presented at court and
+ have to do so, I would rather that you should buy some new ones fresh from
+ a jeweler's shop than wear anything that has come from India.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;To-morrow you shall both go to the bank with me to see them, and then I
+ will take them to some first-class jeweler's and get him to value them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The visit was paid next day. Both Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham were
+ somewhat disappointed at the jewels.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is hardly fair to see them like this,&rdquo; Philip Cotter said. &ldquo;They would
+ look very different if reset. No Indian jewels I have ever seen show to
+ advantage in their native settings; but many of the stones are very large,
+ and without knowing anything about them I should say that they are worth
+ the 50,000 pounds at which you say Colonel Thorndyke valued them. He was
+ not likely to be mistaken. He was evidently a judge of these matters, and
+ would hardly be likely to be far wrong.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We will go with you to the jeweler's, Mark,&rdquo; Millicent said. &ldquo;In the
+ first place, I shall not feel quite comfortable until I know that they are
+ out of your hands, and in the next place I should like to hear what he
+ thinks of them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have a number of Indian jewels that I wish you to value for me,&rdquo; Mark
+ said, as, carrying the case, he entered the jeweler's shop. &ldquo;They were
+ collected by Colonel Thorndyke, an uncle of mine, during service in
+ India.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The jeweler took them with him into a room behind the shop. The case was
+ opened, and the man took out sixty-eight small parcels it contained, and
+ opened them one after the other.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I shall need a very careful examination of these before I can form any
+ estimate of their value,&rdquo; he said, after inspecting some of the more
+ important pieces of jewelry carefully. &ldquo;They are a most magnificent
+ collection, and had they been properly cut in the first place they would
+ have been worth a very large sum. Unfortunately, the Indian princes think
+ more of size than of lustre, and have their stones cut very much too flat
+ to show off their full brilliancy. Some of these large ones I should
+ certainly advise to be recut, for what they will lose in weight they will
+ gain in beauty and value. However, sir, I will go through them and give
+ you an estimate of the selling value of each piece. I need not say that
+ they ought all to be reset in the prevailing fashion; but the gold, which
+ is in some cases unnecessarily massive, will go some distance towards
+ defraying the expense.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;When shall I call again?&rdquo; Mark asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should be glad if you can give me a week,&rdquo; the jeweler said. &ldquo;Some of
+ the things, for instance that great pearl necklace, I could appraise
+ without much difficulty, but all the gems must be taken out of their
+ settings before I could form a fair idea of their value.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I will call in a week's time,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;I am in no particular
+ hurry about them, but I would rather that they were in your care than
+ mine.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, if the cracksmen got word that there was such a collection as this
+ in any private house it would need a couple of men with pistols to keep
+ guard over them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A week later Mark again called.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have the list ready for you, sir; you will see that they are not marked
+ according to their setting, but according to their size and value. Thus,
+ you see, the largest stones are priced separately; the smaller ones are in
+ groups according to their weight. The total comes to 42,000 pounds. I do
+ not know whether that at all equals your expectations. I may say that I
+ have shown the stones to two or three of our principal diamond merchants,
+ and that the prices I have put down are those at which they would be
+ willing to buy them; possibly some would be worth more. I had the
+ merchants here together, and they spent some hours going through them, and
+ the sums put down are those at which one or other were willing to
+ purchase.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It quite answers my expectations,&rdquo; Mark said. &ldquo;My uncle's estimate,
+ indeed, was somewhat higher, but doubtless he judged them at the price
+ which they would fetch in India. Well, sir, I authorize you to close with
+ the offers, and to dispose of them for me. I will give you a written
+ authority to do so. In the meantime, I wish to buy a suite of jewels as a
+ wedding present, a tiara, necklace, and bracelets; but I do not want any
+ diamonds to be among them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am afraid I have nothing in stock without diamonds; of course, I have
+ both necklaces and bracelets of almost any stones that you might select,
+ but I have no complete set without diamonds; the effect would be somber,
+ and few ladies would like them.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We have some unpleasant associations with diamonds,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;and on
+ that point I am quite determined; but if you used pearls instead of
+ diamonds the effect might be as good. I don't care whether the stones are
+ emeralds or rubies; at any rate, I should like to see some, and then
+ perhaps you might be able to make me a set on the same model.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Several superb sets were brought in; Mark selected one of emeralds and
+ diamonds.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;What would be the price of this set?&rdquo; he asked.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That set is 6000 pounds, sir; the stones are exceptionally fine ones; but
+ if you substituted pearls of equal size for the diamonds, it would cost
+ considerably less; I could not give you the exact price until it is made,
+ but I should say that it would be about 4500 pounds.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Very well, then, I will take that. How long will it be making?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should not like to say less than three months at the earliest; it will
+ require some time to collect as fine a set of emeralds as these. Indeed, I
+ think that most probably I shall use these emeralds, or the greater part
+ of them, and collect others to take their places at my leisure. I do not
+ know whether the best plan would not be to take the diamonds out and
+ substitute pearls; there would be no difficulty in getting them, and in
+ that case I might have it ready for you in a month.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think that will be the best plan; but you need not be in any particular
+ hurry about them. My marriage will take place in less than a fortnight,
+ and after that I shall probably be three or four months before I return to
+ London. I will get you to keep the things until I come back.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have sold the jewels, Millicent,&rdquo; he said, when he returned to
+ Islington; &ldquo;the jeweler has found purchasers for them all, and the total
+ comes to 42,000 pounds.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Whatever shall we do with all our money, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I rather wonder myself, dear. However, there is one thing, there are
+ always plenty of people who will be glad to relieve us of anything that we
+ don't want. I can tell you that in the course of my search for Bastow I
+ have seen an amount of poverty and misery such as I never dreamt of, and I
+ certainly should like to do something to relieve it. The best thing that I
+ know of would be to give a handsome sum to three or four of the great
+ hospitals. I don't know of any better means of helping the very poor.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Suppose, Mark,&rdquo; the girl said, putting her hand on his arm, &ldquo;we give this
+ 42,000 pounds as a thank offering. We never expected to get it, and my
+ father's jewels have nearly cost you your life. We have such an abundance
+ without that, I should like, above all things, to give this money away.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I think that is an excellent plan, Millicent, and a very happy thought on
+ your part. We cannot do it now, as we have not yet got the money, but as
+ soon as we do we will send off checks for 10,000 guineas each to St.
+ Bartholomew's, Guy's, and St. Thomas'&mdash;those are the three principal
+ ones; the others we can settle afterwards. But I should say that the
+ Foundling would be as good as any, and I believe that they are rather
+ short of funds at present; then there is the London Mendicity Society, and
+ many other good charities. Perhaps it would be better to divide the whole
+ among eight of them instead of four; but we need not settle that until we
+ return.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Do you think we shall have to go to this horrid Amsterdam, Mark?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I hope not, dear; but I shall no doubt hear from the Lieutenant of the
+ watch during the next week or ten days.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ When the letter came it was satisfactory. The prisoners, seeing the
+ hopelessness of any defense, had all admitted their guilt, and the name of
+ the man who had dealt with them had also been given up. Except in his case
+ there would be no trial. The others would have sentences passed on them at
+ once, and three, who had been promised comparatively slight punishment,
+ would go into the box to give evidence against the man who had engaged
+ them. Before starting for Holland Mark had consulted Millicent as to
+ whether she would prefer being married in London or at Crowswood. She had
+ replied:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should greatly prefer Crowswood, Mark. Here we know no one, there we
+ should be among all our friends; certainly if we don't go we must get Mr.
+ Greg to come up and marry us here. I am sure he would feel very
+ disappointed if anyone else were asked. At the same time I should not like
+ to go home. When we come back from our trip it will be different; but it
+ would be a great trial now, and however happy we might be, I should feel
+ there was a gloom over the house.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I quite agree with you, Millicent. When we come back we can see about
+ entirely refurnishing it, and, perhaps, adding some rooms to it, and we
+ need not go down until a complete change has been made. We shall be able
+ to manage it somehow or other, and I quite agree with you that anything
+ will be better than going back to the house for a day or two before the
+ wedding.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ On the voyage back from Holland Mark had talked the matter over with Dick
+ Chetwynd, and said that he thought of taking rooms for Mrs. Cunningham and
+ Millicent at Reigate, and stopping at the hotel himself, and having the
+ wedding breakfast there.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, Dick, you will be my best man.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should think so,&rdquo; Dick laughed. &ldquo;Why, if you had asked anyone else I
+ should have made a personal matter of it with him, and have given him the
+ option of resigning the position or going out with me. But your other
+ plans are foolish, and I shall take the matter into my own hands; I shall
+ insist upon the two ladies coming down to the Park, and I will get my aunt
+ to come and preside generally over things. I shall fill up the house with
+ bridesmaids, and shall have a dance the evening before. You can put up at
+ the hotel if you like, but you know very well that there are a dozen
+ houses where they will be delighted to have you; there is no doubt that
+ when they know what is coming off you will get a dozen invitations, and
+ then after church all those invited will drive off to the Park to the
+ wedding breakfast. After that is over you can start in a post chaise to
+ Canterbury or Dover, wherever you may decide to make your first halt.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;But, my dear Dick, I could not put you to all this trouble!&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Nonsense, man. I should enjoy it immensely; besides, I shall be really
+ glad of a good reason to try and open the doors of the Park again. I have
+ been there very little since my father's death, and I think I shall make
+ it my headquarters in future. I am getting rather tired of bachelor life
+ in London, and must look out for a wife; so nothing could be more
+ appropriate than this idea. Don't bother yourself any further about it. I
+ shall ride down and establish myself there tomorrow, and spend a couple of
+ days in driving round to our friends and in sending out invitations. I
+ shall still have nearly a fortnight for making all preparations. Why, it
+ will cause quite an excitement in the neighborhood! I shall be hailed as a
+ benefactor, and I shall let everyone know that your father's ward was
+ really your cousin, but that by the will of her father she was to drop her
+ surname until she came of age; and that until that time your father was to
+ have the entire control of the property. I shall add that although the
+ estate, of course, is hers, your uncle has left you a very big fortune,
+ and that nothing could be more suitable in all respects than the
+ marriage.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That will do excellently, Dick; that will be quite enough, without going
+ into details at all. You can mention that we intend to have the house
+ entirely refurnished, and on the return from our wedding trip abroad to
+ settle there. I am sure I am extremely obliged to you for your offer,
+ which will certainly clear away all sorts of small difficulties.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A day or two after his return Mark wrote to Mr. Greg telling him the
+ relations in which Millicent and he stood to each other, and of the near
+ approach of their marriage. He said that Millicent would be married from
+ Dick Chetwynd's, but that it would be at Crowswood church. In return he
+ received a warm letter of congratulation from the Rector, telling him that
+ the news was in every respect delightful, and that his wife and the
+ children were in a state of the highest excitement, not only at the
+ marriage, but at their coming down to reside again at Crowswood.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The village,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;will be scarcely less pleased than I am, for
+ though everything goes on as you ordered, and the people get their milk,
+ broths, and jellies as before, they don't look at it as the same thing as
+ it was in the old days. I cannot say that the news of your engagement to
+ Miss Conyers&mdash;I ought to say Miss Thorndyke&mdash;is surprising, for
+ I had thought that it would be quite the natural thing for you to fall in
+ love with each other, and, indeed, my wife declares that she saw it coming
+ on distinctly during the last few months before you left here. Your
+ postscript saying that Bastow had been captured and had committed suicide
+ gave me a distinct feeling of relief, for no one could tell whether the
+ deadly enmity that he felt for your father might not extend to you. I have
+ cut this note rather short, but I have just heard the door shut, and I am
+ quite sure that my wife has gone down to tell the good news in the
+ village, and I really cannot deny myself the pleasure of telling some of
+ the people myself, and seeing their faces brighten up at the news.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As Dick had foretold would be the case, Mark received a very warm letter
+ from Sir Charles Harris, congratulating him upon his approaching marriage,
+ and insisting upon his taking up his quarters with him.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I am sending a man down with this to hand it to the guard as the up coach
+ goes through the town. Chetwynd told me that his call on me was the first
+ he had paid, so I feel fairly confident that I shall forestall the rest of
+ your friends, and that you will give me the pleasure of your company.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark wrote back accepting the invitation at once, which enabled him to
+ decline half a dozen others without the necessity of making a choice.
+ Everything turned out as arranged. Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham went down
+ in a post chaise, two days before the wedding, and Mark drove down in his
+ gig with them. Dick Chetwynd met them on horseback just outside Reigate,
+ and escorted the ladies to his house, Mark driving on to that of Sir
+ Charles Harris. Millicent found the house full of her special friends,
+ whom she had asked to be her bridesmaids. She was almost bewildered by the
+ warmth of their welcome, and overpowered by the questions poured upon her.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The news quite took all our breath away, Millicent,&rdquo; one of them said.
+ &ldquo;It seems extraordinary that you should have been Miss Thorndyke all the
+ time, though I don't think that any of us were at all surprised that you
+ should take the name now; you must have been surprised when you heard that
+ you were the heiress of Crowswood.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I was a great deal more disgusted than surprised,&rdquo; she said rather
+ indignantly. &ldquo;I did not think that it was fair at all that I should step
+ into Mark's shoes.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, it has all come right now, Millicent, and I dare say you thought
+ that it would, even then.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can assure you that I did not; quite the contrary, I thought that it
+ never would come right. I was very unhappy about it for a time.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Now, young ladies,&rdquo; Dick Chetwynd laughed, &ldquo;will you please take Mrs.
+ Cunningham and Miss Thorndyke up to their rooms? I don't suppose I shall
+ see any more of you before dinner time; there are those trunks to be
+ opened and examined, talked over, and admired. Mind, I have fifteen more,
+ for the most part men, coming to dinner, so those of you who aspire to
+ follow Miss Thorndyke's example had best prepare yourselves for conquest.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The ball on the following evening was a great success. Dick had determined
+ that it should be a memorable one, and there was a consensus of opinion
+ that it was the most brilliant that had taken place in that part of the
+ country for many years.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Crowswood church and village presented a most festive appearance on the
+ following day; there was not a cottage that had not great posies of
+ flowers in its windows, and that had not made some sort of attempt at
+ decoration with flags or flowers. A huge arch of evergreens, with sheaves
+ of wheat and flowers, had been erected on the top of the hill, and every
+ man, woman, and child turned out in their best, and cheered lustily,
+ first, when Mark drove up in his gig, and equally lustily when the
+ Chetwynd carriage, drawn by four gray horses, dashed up, preceded by a
+ large number of others with the bridesmaids and friends. The church was
+ already crowded, and Mr. Greg was visibly moved at seeing the son and
+ niece of the man to whom he owed his living made man and wife. When the
+ wedding breakfast, at which more than fifty sat down, and the necessary
+ toasts were over, Mr. and Mrs. Thorndyke started for Canterbury.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ <a name="link2HCH0022" id="link2HCH0022">
+ <!-- H2 anchor --> </a>
+ </p>
+ <div style="height: 4em;">
+ <br /><br /><br /><br />
+ </div>
+ <h2>
+ CHAPTER XXII.
+ </h2>
+ <p>
+ It was not until Easter that Mark Thorndyke and his wife returned to
+ England. They had spent the greater portion of that time in Italy,
+ lingering for a month at Venice, and had then journeyed quietly homewards
+ through Bavaria and Saxony; They were in no hurry, as before starting on
+ their honeymoon Mark had consulted an architect, had told him exactly what
+ he wanted, and had left the matter in his hands. Mrs. Cunningham had from
+ time to time kept them informed how things were going on. The part of the
+ house in which the Squire's room had been situated was entirely pulled
+ down, and a new wing built in its stead. Millicent had been specially
+ wishful that this should be done.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I don't know that I am superstitious, Mark,&rdquo; she had said, &ldquo;but I do
+ think that when a murder has taken place in a house it is better to make a
+ complete change. The servants always think they see or hear something.
+ That part of the house is avoided, and it is difficult to get anyone to
+ stay there. I think it is very much more important to do that than it is
+ to get the house refurnished; we can do anything in that way you like when
+ we get back, but I should certainly like very much to have the great
+ alteration made before we return.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The architect was a clever one, and the house, which was some two hundred
+ years old, was greatly improved in appearance by the new wing, which was
+ made to harmonize well with the rest, but was specially designed to give
+ as much variety as possible to the general outline. Millicent uttered an
+ exclamation of pleasure when they first caught a glimpse of the house. As
+ they rode through the village they were again welcomed as heartily as they
+ were on their wedding day. Mrs. Cunningham received them; she had been
+ established there for a month, and had placed the house entirely on its
+ old footing. They first examined the new portion of the house, and
+ Millicent was greatly pleased with the rooms that had been prepared for
+ them, Mark having requested Mrs. Cunningham to put the furnishing into the
+ hands of the best known firm of the day.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have asked,&rdquo; Mrs. Cunningham said, &ldquo;the Rector and his wife and Mr.
+ Chetwynd to dine with us this evening; they can scarcely be termed
+ company, and I thought that you might find it pleasant to have these old
+ friends here the first evening. There is a letter for you on the library
+ table, Mark; it may almost be called a packet; it has been here nearly a
+ month.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ In our days a newly married couple would find on their return from foreign
+ travel basketfuls of letters, circulars, and catalogues from tradesmen of
+ all kinds; happily, our forefathers were saved from these inflictions, and
+ Mark at once went to the library with almost a feeling of surprise as to
+ who could have written to him. He saw at once that it was a ship's letter,
+ for on the top was written, &ldquo;Favored by the Surinam.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Why, it is Ramoo's writing. I suppose he gave it to someone he knew, and
+ that instead of its being put in the mail bag in India, he brought it on
+ with him. What a tremendously long epistle!&rdquo; he exclaimed, glancing his
+ eye down the first page, and then a puzzled expression came across his
+ face; he sat down and began to read from the first slowly and carefully.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;HONORED SAHIB:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I do not know why I should write to tell you the true history of all
+ these matters. I have thought it over many times, but I feel that it is
+ right that you should know clearly what has happened, and how it has come
+ about, and more especially that you should know that you need never fear
+ any troubles such as those that have taken place. I am beginning to write
+ this while we are yet sailing, and shall send it to you by ship from the
+ Cape, or if it chances that we meet any ship on her way to England, our
+ letters may be put on board her.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Why, this letter must be more than a year old,&rdquo; Mark said to himself.
+ There was no date to the letter, but, turning to the last sheet, he saw as
+ a postscript after the signature the words, &ldquo;January 26th.&mdash;A ship,
+ the Surinam, is lying a short distance from us, and will take our letters
+ to England.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, it must be a year old; but what he means by the way he begins is
+ more than I can imagine;&rdquo; and he turned back to the point at which he had
+ broken off.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I would tell it you in order as it happened. I, Ramoo, am a Brahmin.
+ Twenty years ago I was the head priest of a great temple. I shall not say
+ where the temple was; it matters not in any way. There was fighting, as
+ there is always fighting in India. There were Company's Sepoys and white
+ troops, and one night the most sacred bracelet of the great god of our
+ temple was stolen.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Good Heavens!&rdquo; Mark exclaimed, laying down the letter. &ldquo;Then it has been
+ Ramoo who has all this time been in pursuit of the diamonds; and to think
+ that my uncle never even suspected him!&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Then suddenly he continued, &ldquo;now I understand why it was my life was
+ spared by those fellows. By Jove, this is astounding!&rdquo; Then he took up the
+ letter again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Two of the Brahmins under me had observed, at a festival the day before
+ the bracelet was lost, a white soldier staring at it with covetous eyes.
+ One of them was in charge of the temple on the night when it was stolen,
+ and on the day following he came to me, and said, 'I desire to devote my
+ life to the recovery of the jewels of the god. Bondah will go with me; we
+ will return no more until we bring them back.' 'It is good,' I said; 'the
+ god must be appeased, or terrible misfortunes may happen.' Then we held a
+ solemn service in the temple. The two men removed the caste marks from
+ their foreheads, prostrated themselves before the god, and went out from
+ amongst us as outcasts until the day of their death. Two months later a
+ messenger came from the one who had spoken to me, saying that they had
+ found the man, but had for a long time had no opportunity of finding the
+ bracelet. Then Bondah had met him in a lonely place, and had attacked him.
+ Bondah had lost his life, but the soldier was, though sorely wounded, able
+ to get back to his regiment. He had died, but he had, the writer was
+ convinced, passed the jewels on to a comrade, whom he would watch. Then I
+ saw that one man was not sufficient for such a task. Then I, too, the
+ Chief Brahmin of the temple, saw that it was my duty to go forth also.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I laid the matter before the others, and they said, 'You are right; it is
+ you who, as the chief in the service of the god, should bring back his
+ jewels.' So again there was a service, and I went forth as an outcast and
+ a wanderer, knowing that I must do many things that were forbidden to my
+ caste; that I must touch unclean things, must eat forbidden food, and must
+ take life if needs be. You, sahib, cannot understand how terrible was the
+ degradation to me, who was of the purest blood of the Brahmins. I had
+ taken the most solemn vows to devote my life to this. I knew that, whether
+ successful or not, although I might be forgiven my offense by the god, yet
+ that never again could I recover my caste, even though the heaviest
+ penances were performed. Henceforth, I must stand alone in the world,
+ without kindred, without friends, without help, save such as the god might
+ give me in the search.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I was rich. The greater part of my goods I gave to the temple, and yet
+ retained a considerable sum, for I should need money to carry out my
+ quest, and after I had accomplished it I should hand over what remained
+ for the benefit of the poor. I should myself become a fakir. I want you to
+ understand, sahib, that henceforth I had but one object in life, a supreme
+ one, to accomplish, in which nothing must stand in my way, and that what
+ would be in others a crime was but a sacrifice on my part, most acceptable
+ to the god. I journeyed down to the place where my comrade was, dressed as
+ one of the lowest class, even as a sweeper, and he and I strove by all the
+ means in our power to discover what this man had done with the jewels.
+ Night after night we crawled into his tent. We searched his bed and his
+ clothes. With sharp rods we tried every inch of the soil, believing that
+ he had hidden the diamonds underground, but we failed.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;There my comrade said, 'I must give my life to find out where he hides
+ these things. I will watch night after night by the door of his tent, and
+ if he comes out I will stab him; it shall be a mortal wound, but I will
+ not kill him outright. Before he dies he will doubtless, as the other did,
+ pass the jewels on to some comrade, and then it will be for you to follow
+ him up.' 'It is good,' I said. 'This man may have hidden them away
+ somewhere during the time they have marched through the country. In spite
+ of the watch you have kept he may have said to himself, &ldquo;I will return,
+ though it be years hence.&rdquo; Your plan is good,' I said. 'I envy you. 'Tis
+ better to die thus than to live in sin as we are doing.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;That evening the man was stabbed, but an officer running up killed my
+ comrade. The soldier was taken to the hospital, and I lay down beside the
+ tent with my eye to a slit that I had cut, and watched till morning.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then I took my broom and swept the ground. I had not been hired as one of
+ the camp sweepers, and so could move about and sweep where I chose. No one
+ ever asked me any questions. The soldiers heeded me no more than if I had
+ been a dog, and, of course, supposed that I was acting by the order of the
+ head of the sweepers. Presently I saw one of the servants of the hospital
+ go across to the tent of the officer who had killed my comrade. He came
+ over and went into the hospital tent. I felt sure that it was the wounded
+ man who had sent for him. He was in there some time. Presently a soldier
+ came out and went to the tent of the wounded man, and returned bringing a
+ musket. Then I said to myself, 'The god has blinded us. He wills that we
+ shall go through many more toils before we regain the bracelet.' Doubtless
+ the man had carried the bracelet in his musket all the time, and we, blind
+ that we were, had never thought of it.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Presently the officer came out again. I noticed that as he did so he
+ looked round on all sides as if to see if he were watched. Then I knew
+ that it was as I had thought: the soldier had given the bracelet to him.
+ At this I was pleased; it would be far more easy to search the tent of an
+ officer than of a soldier, who sleeps surrounded by his comrades. I
+ thought that there was no hurry now; it would need but patience, and I
+ should be sure to find them. I had not calculated that he would have
+ better opportunities than the soldier for going about, and that,
+ doubtless, the soldier had warned him of his danger. Two hours later the
+ officer mounted his horse and rode towards the camp of another regiment, a
+ mile and a quarter away. There was nothing in that; but I watched for his
+ return all that day and all that night, and when he did not come back, I
+ felt that he was doing something to get rid of the diamonds.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He was away three days, and when he returned I was almost sure that he
+ had not the diamonds about him. As he had ridden off he had looked about
+ just as he had when he left the hospital: he was uneasy, just as if he was
+ watched; now he was uneasy no longer. Then I knew that my search would be
+ a long one, and might fail altogether. I went away, and for three months I
+ prayed and fasted; then I returned. I bought different clothes, I painted
+ my forehead with another caste mark, then I bought from the servant of an
+ officer in another regiment his papers of service: recommendations from
+ former masters. Then I went to the officer&mdash;you will guess, sahib,
+ that it was the Major, your uncle&mdash;and I paid his servant to leave
+ his service, and to present me as a brother of his who had been accustomed
+ to serve white sahibs, and was, like himself, a good servant; so I took
+ his place.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;He was a good master, and I came to love him, though I knew that I might
+ yet have to kill him. You have heard that I saved his life three times; I
+ did so partly because I loved him, but chiefly because his life was most
+ precious to me, for if he had died I should have lost all clew to the
+ bracelet. I had, of course, made sure that he had not got them with him;
+ over and over again I searched every article in his possession. I ripped
+ open his saddle lest they might be sewn up in its stuffing. All that could
+ be done I did, until I was quite sure that he had not got them. He, on his
+ part, came to like me. He thought that I was the most faithful of
+ servants, and after the last time I saved his life he took me with him
+ everywhere. He went down to Madras, and was married there. I watched his
+ every movement. After that he went down frequently. Then a child was born,
+ and six months afterwards his wife died.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;The regiment was stationed at the fort. At that time he was at many
+ places&mdash;the governor's, the other officer sahibs', the merchants',
+ and others'. I could not follow him, but I was sure by his manner that he
+ had not taken back the bracelet from whoever he had sent it to. I knew him
+ so well by this time that I should have noticed any change in his manner
+ in a moment. At last the child went away in the charge of Mrs. Cunningham.
+ I bribed the child's ayah, and she searched Mrs. Cunningham's boxes and
+ every garment she had, and found no small sealed parcel or box amongst
+ them. Three years more passed. By this time the Colonel treated me more as
+ a friend than as a servant. He said one day, laughing, 'It is a long time
+ since my things have been turned topsy turvy, Ramoo. I think the thieves
+ have come to the conclusion that I have not got what they are looking
+ for.' 'What is that, sahib?' I asked. 'Some special jewels,' he said.
+ 'They are extremely valuable. But I have got them and a lot of other
+ things so safely stowed that no one will ever find them unless I give them
+ the clew.' 'But suppose you are killed, sahib,' I said; 'your little
+ daughter will never get the things.' 'I have provided for that,' he
+ answered. 'If I am killed I have arranged that she shall know all about it
+ either when she comes to the age of eighteen or twenty-one.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;A few weeks after that he was wounded very badly. I nursed him night and
+ day for weeks, and when he came to England he brought me with him. As you
+ know, sahib, he died. When he was in London he went to see Mrs. Cunningham
+ and the child, and several times to the office of the lawyer who attended
+ your father's funeral. Then he came down to your father, and I know he had
+ long and earnest conversations with him. I did all I could to listen, but
+ the Colonel always had the windows and doors shut before he began to
+ speak. I could see that your father was troubled. Then the Colonel died.
+ After his death I could never find his snuff box; he had carried it about
+ with him for some years; once or twice I had examined it, but it was too
+ small for the diamonds to be hidden in. I suppose that he had given it to
+ the sahib, your father, but as I could never find it I guessed that there
+ was some mystery attached to it, though what I could not tell.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then your father took me down to Crowswood with him, and Mrs. Cunningham
+ and the little girl came down. I was surprised to find that your father
+ seemed to be master of the estate, and that no one thought anything of the
+ child, whose name had been changed. I spoke one day to Mrs. Cunningham
+ about it; your father seemed to me a just and good man, and I could not
+ believe that he was robbing his brother's daughter. Mrs. Cunningham told
+ me that the Colonel did not wish her to be known as an heiress, and that
+ he had left the estate to his brother until she came of age. Your father
+ was as good a master as the Colonel had been. I watched and watched, and
+ once or twice I overheard him talking to himself in the library, and
+ discovered that your father himself was altogether ignorant of the hiding
+ place of the property that the Colonel had mentioned in his will. I knew
+ then that I should have to wait until the child was either eighteen or
+ twenty-one.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It was a long time, but I had learnt to be patient. I was not unhappy; I
+ loved your father, I loved the Colonel's little daughter; and I was very
+ fond of you. All these things were small to me in comparison to my vow and
+ the finding the jewels of the god, but they shortened the years of
+ waiting. Then a year before the young mistress was eighteen came the shot
+ through the window. I did not know who had fired it, but I saw that your
+ father's life was in danger, and I said to myself, 'He will tell the young
+ sahib what he knows about the bracelet.' After you had gone into the
+ library I opened the door quietly, and listened. I could hear much that
+ was said, but not all. I heard him say something about a snuff box, and
+ some means of finding the lost things being hidden in it, and that he had
+ kept them all these years in a secret hiding place, which he described.
+ You were to search for the diamonds, and I guessed from that that he did
+ not know what he was to be told when the young memsahib came of age, or
+ perhaps when she was eighteen. It was not until I had thought over what I
+ heard that I came to the conclusion that if I could find the things he
+ spoke of I might be able to find the jewels. By that time your father had
+ gone to bed. I was foolish not to have been patient, but my blood boiled
+ after waiting for eighteen or nineteen years. The god seemed to have sent
+ me the chance, and it seemed to me that I should take it at once. I knew
+ that he generally slept with his window open, and it seemed to me that it
+ would be easy to slip in there and to get those things from the cabinet. I
+ knew where the ladder was kept. I took a file from the tool chest and cut
+ the chain.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Here Mark dropped the letter in horror.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Good Heavens!&rdquo; he exclaimed. &ldquo;Then Bastow spoke truly, and he was not my
+ father's murderer! Never did a single suspicion of Ramoo enter my head.
+ This is appalling; but I cannot read any more now. It is time for me to go
+ and dress for dinner.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Is anything the matter with you, Mark?&rdquo; Millicent asked anxiously, as she
+ met him in the drawing room; &ldquo;you look as white as a sheet.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I have been reading Ramoo's letter, and he has told me some things that
+ have surprised and shocked me. I will tell you about them after dinner,
+ dear. It is a long story, but you won't have to wait until Dick and the
+ Gregs are gone. They are interested in all that interests us, and shall
+ hear the letter read. No; I think I will ask them and Dick to come in the
+ morning. I should not like anything to sadden the first evening of our
+ coming home.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then it is something sad.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Yes, but it does not affect us, though it does affect Ramoo. Now clear
+ your brow, dear, and dismiss the subject from your mind, else our guests
+ will fancy that our marriage has not been altogether so satisfactory as
+ they had hoped.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;As if they could think such a thing as that, Mark,&rdquo; she said indignantly.
+ &ldquo;But there is the sound of wheels; it is Mr. Chetwynd's gig.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The three visitors all came in together, having met at the door. Mark,
+ with a great effort, put aside the letter from his mind, and a cheerful
+ evening was spent. They had much to tell of their travels, many questions
+ to ask about the parish and their mutual friends and the neighborhood
+ generally, and when they rose to go Mark said:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Would you mind riding over again tomorrow morning, Dick? I have a letter
+ to read to you that will interest you greatly.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Certainly. What time shall I be here?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Say at eleven o'clock. It is a long epistle, and will take us an hour to
+ get through; after that we can stroll round, and, of course, you will stop
+ to lunch.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I should be glad if you and Mrs. Greg can come over too,&rdquo; he added,
+ turning to the Rector; &ldquo;you will be much interested also in the matter.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The next day the party met in the library at the hour named. &ldquo;I may tell
+ you, Mr. Greg, that I specially asked you and your wife here because this
+ letter throws some light on Arthur Bastow's connection with my father's
+ murder; you were friends with his father, and I think you ought to know.
+ As to you, Dick, the letter will interest you from beginning to end, and
+ will surprise as much as it will interest you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Even I don't know what it is, Mrs. Greg,&rdquo; Millicent said. &ldquo;I know it
+ quite upset Mark yesterday, but he said he would sooner I did not know
+ anything about it until today, as he did not want me to be saddened on the
+ first evening of our return home. Now, please go on, Mark; you have said
+ quite enough to excite us all.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Mark had read but a short distance when Dick Chetwynd exclaimed:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then Ramoo was at the bottom of that Indian business, after all. I almost
+ wonder you never suspected it, Mark.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, I hardly could do so,&rdquo; Mark said, &ldquo;when my uncle was so fond of
+ him, and he had served him so faithfully.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ As he approached the point at which he had laid down the letter on the
+ previous evening, Millicent's color faded.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Suddenly an exclamation of horror broke from her when he read the last
+ line.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Oh, Mark,&rdquo; she said, with quivering lips, &ldquo;don't say it was Ramoo. He
+ always seemed so kind and good.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It was here I stopped last night,&rdquo; he said, &ldquo;but I fear there can be no
+ doubt about it. I must say that it is evident from this letter, that no
+ thought of doing my father harm was in his mind when he placed that ladder
+ against the window. Now I will go on.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ The letter continued as follows:
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Having placed the ladder, I clambered to the window and quietly entered
+ the room. It was quite dark, but I knew the place of every piece of
+ furniture so well that I was able to go without hesitation to the cabinet.
+ Your father was speaking very slowly and distinctly when he told you how
+ it was to be opened, and I was able to do it easily, but I did not know
+ that the back opened with a sharp click, and the noise startled me and
+ woke your father. In an instant he was out of bed and seized me by the
+ throat. Now, he was a much stronger man than I was. I struggled in vain. I
+ felt that in a moment I should become insensible; my vow and my duty to
+ the god flashed across me, and scarce knowing what I did, I drew a little
+ dagger I always carried, and struck blindly. He fell, and I fell beside
+ him. For a time I was insensible. When I recovered I was seized with the
+ bitterest remorse that I had killed one I loved, but I seemed to hear the
+ voice of the god saying, 'You have done well, Ramoo. I am your great
+ master, and you are bound to my service.'
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I got up almost blindly, felt in the cabinet, and found a coin and a
+ piece of paper, and a feeling of exultation came over me that, after
+ nearly twenty years, I should succeed in carrying out my vow and taking
+ his bracelet back to the god. I descended the ladder, crept in the back
+ door by which I had come out, went up to my room, where I had kept a light
+ burning, and examined my treasures. Then I saw that all had been in vain.
+ They were doubtless a key to the mystery, but until a clew was given they
+ were absolutely useless. I sat for hours staring at them. I would have
+ gone back and replaced them in the cabinet and left all as it had been
+ before, but I dared not enter the room again. The next day I heard you say
+ that you suspected that the talk with your father had been overheard, and
+ that the man who had earlier in the evening before shot at him had
+ returned, and while listening had heard something said about the hiding
+ place, and thought that he would find some sort of treasure there. I
+ thought that in the talk your father might have told you how to use these
+ things, though I had not caught it, and it was therefore important that
+ you should have them back again, so I went into the room after the inquest
+ was over, and placed the things in their hiding place again.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Then, thinking it over, I determined to leave your service. You would be
+ trying to find the treasure, and I must watch you, and this I could not do
+ as long as I was a house servant; so I came up to London, and you thought
+ I had sailed for India, but I did not go. I hired four Lascars, men of my
+ own religion, and paid them to watch every movement that you made, to see
+ where you visited and where you went. I paid them well, and they served me
+ well; it was so that I was able to bring those men to your help when but
+ for that you would have lost your life. It was for this to some extent
+ that I had you followed; for I soon found out that you were on the search
+ for the man who had fired through the window, and who you believed had
+ killed your father, rather than for the jewels. I knew that you might run
+ into danger, and partly because I loved you, and partly because it was
+ possible that it would be essential for that coin and piece of paper to be
+ produced in order that the treasure might be obtained, I kept guard over
+ you.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;When the 18th of August approached we were all on the watch. I felt sure
+ that you would take every possible precaution while you had the bracelet
+ in your possession. We knew who were your principal friends, the banker's
+ son and Mr. Chetwynd. On the 18th of August everything went on as usual.
+ On the following day the banker's son came to you, and as soon as he left
+ you, you went to the lawyer's, and afterwards to the banker's. I felt sure
+ now that it was at that bank that the jewels had been placed, and that you
+ had been waiting till the young memsahib's birthday for the news that they
+ might be taken out; then you went to Mr. Chetwynd's, and he went to the
+ bank. I had no doubt that he was to take them out for you, and after that
+ one of the men never took his eyes off him when he was outside of his
+ house. Afterwards you went to the place where the men used to fight, and
+ the man who was watching you went in, and had beer, and saw you talking
+ with the big man you used to fight with, in the parlor behind the bar. The
+ watcher went out to follow you, but left another to watch this man. We
+ found that both Mr. Chetwynd and he went to a shipping office in Tower
+ Street, and we then guessed that you intended to take the bracelet at once
+ across the sea.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I went myself and found out that a vessel was sailing in two days to
+ Amsterdam. I took a passage for a man in the cheap cabin, and asked to
+ look at the list of passengers, as I believed that some friend would be
+ sailing by her; there were two men's names down together in one
+ handwriting among the first class passengers, and I guessed that these
+ were you and Mr. Chetwynd. I also saw the name of the big man, which I had
+ heard long before, down in the list of passengers, and another name next
+ to his in the same handwriting. I did not know his name, but guessed that
+ it was another of the fighting men, and that they were going to look after
+ you until you had got rid of the diamonds. On the morning that she was to
+ sail one of the Lascars was on board; I thought it possible that in order
+ to throw anyone who might be following you off your scent you might at the
+ last moment go ashore, and that Mr. Chetwynd might take the diamonds over,
+ so I watched, and saw you on the deck with your friend.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I and the other three Lascars then took passage that evening in a craft
+ for Rotterdam, and got to Amsterdam two days before your ship arrived; we
+ went to different houses, and going separately into the worst parts of the
+ town, soon found a man who kept a gambling den, and who was a man who
+ could be trusted. I offered him a thousand francs to collect twenty-five
+ men, who were to be paid a hundred francs each, and to be ready, if your
+ ship arrived after dark, to attack two passengers I would point out to
+ them. I did not want you to be hurt, so bargained that all knives were to
+ be left behind, and that he was to supply the men only with clubs. If the
+ ship came in in daylight you were to be attacked the first time you went
+ out after dark. You know how that was carried out. You had two more men
+ with you than I had expected; but I thought that with a sudden rush you
+ might all be separated. You know the rest. The moment you were knocked
+ down I and three others carried you to a boat. It had been lying near the
+ stairs, and we took you off to the barge in which I had arranged you
+ should be taken to Rotterdam.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;We told them that you were a drunken man who had been stunned in a fight
+ in a public house. As soon as we were off, I searched you and found the
+ diamonds. Then, as you know, we put you ashore. We all crossed to England
+ that night. Two days later I sailed in this ship, the Brahmapootra. I am
+ not afraid of telling you this, because I know that the diamonds will not
+ shine on the god's arm until all fear of search and inquiry are over. My
+ task will be done when I hand them over to the man who holds the office I
+ once held; then I shall bear the penances imposed on me for having broken
+ my caste in every way, and for having taken life, and for the rest of my
+ days I shall wander as a fakir through India. I shall be supported by the
+ knowledge that I have done my duty to my god, and have sacrificed all in
+ his service, but it will ever be a grief to me that in so doing it was
+ necessary to sacrifice the life of one who had ever shown me kindness. You
+ may wonder why I have written this, but I felt that I must own the truth
+ to you, and that you should know that if in the course of my duty to the
+ god it was my misfortune to slay your father, I have twice saved your
+ life, just as three times I saved that of the Colonel Sahib, your uncle.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ There was silence for some little time after Mark had finished reading.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;It is a strange story indeed,&rdquo; Mr. Greg said, &ldquo;but it is not for us to
+ judge the man. He has acted according to his lights, and none can do more.
+ He sacrificed himself and his life solely to the service of his god, well
+ knowing that even were he successful, his reward would be penance and
+ suffering, and a life of what cannot but be misery to a man brought up, as
+ he has been, to consider himself of the highest and holiest rank of the
+ people. I think, Mark, we need neither say nor think anything harshly of
+ him.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Certainly not,&rdquo; Mark agreed. &ldquo;I can understand that according to his view
+ of the matter anything that stood between him and his goal was but an
+ obstacle to be swept aside; assuredly there was no premeditation in the
+ killing of my father. I have no doubt that the man was attached to him,
+ and that he killed him not to save his own life, but in order that his
+ mission might be carried out.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Quite so, Mark; it was done in the same spirit, if I may say so, that
+ Abraham would have sacrificed his son at the order of his God. What years
+ of devotion that man has passed through! Accustomed, as you see, to a
+ lofty position, to the respect and veneration of those around him, he
+ became a servant, and performed duties that were in his opinion not only
+ humiliating, but polluting and destructive to his caste, and which
+ rendered him an outcast even among the lowest of his people. Do you not
+ think so, Mrs. Thorndyke?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ Millicent, who was crying quietly, looked up.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I can only think of him as the man who twice saved Mark's life,&rdquo; she
+ said.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I understand why you have wished to tell me this story,&rdquo; the Rector went
+ on to Mark. &ldquo;You wish me to know that Arthur Bastow did not add this to
+ his other crimes; that he was spared from being the murderer of your
+ father, but from no want of will on his part; and, as we know, he killed
+ many others, the last but an hour or two before he put an end to his own
+ life; still I am glad that this terrible crime is not his. It seemed to be
+ so revolting and unnatural. It was the Squire's father who had given the
+ living to his father, and the Squire himself had been his friend in the
+ greatest of his trials, and had given him a shelter and a home in his old
+ age. I am glad, at least, that the man, evil as he was, was spared this
+ last crime of the grossest ingratitude.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Well, Mark,&rdquo; Dick Chetwynd said cheerfully, in order to turn the subject,
+ &ldquo;I am heartily glad that we have got to the bottom of this jewel mystery.
+ I have been puzzling over it all the time that you have been away, and I
+ have never been able to understand how, in spite of the precautions that
+ we took, they should have found out that the jewels were at Cotter's, and
+ that you had them on board with you, and, above all, why they spared your
+ life when they could so easily and safely have put you out of the way. It
+ is certainly strange that while you were thinking over everything
+ connected with the jewels, the idea that Ramoo was the leading spirit in
+ the whole business should never once have occurred to you.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ A month later, when Mark went up to town, he called at Leadenhall Street.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;Of course, you have not heard of the arrival of the Brahmapootra at
+ Madras yet. May I ask when she left the Cape?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;She never left the Cape, sir,&rdquo; the clerk replied, &ldquo;and there are very
+ grave fears for her safety. She spoke the Surinam and gave her mails for
+ England when the latter was eight days out from the Cape, and the Surinam
+ reported that a day later she encountered a terrible gale, lost several
+ spars, and narrowly escaped being blown onto the African coast. Since then
+ we have had no news of the Brahmapootra. A number of Indiamen have arrived
+ since; the latest came in only yesterday, and up to the time when she left
+ no news had been received of the ship. Three small craft had been sent up
+ the coast weeks before to make inquiries for her, but had returned without
+ being able to obtain any intelligence, and had seen no wreckage on the
+ coast, although they had gone several hundred miles beyond where she had
+ spoken the Surinam, therefore there can be little doubt that she foundered
+ with all hands during the gale. You had no near relatives on board, I
+ hope, sir?&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;No near relatives, but there was one on board in whom I was greatly
+ interested. Here is my card; I should feel greatly obliged if you would
+ write me a line should you hear anything of her.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ &ldquo;I will do so, sir. We have had innumerable inquiries from friends and
+ relatives of those on board, and although of late we have been obliged to
+ say that there can no longer be any hope that she will ever be heard of,
+ not a day passes but many persons still come in to inquire.&rdquo;
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ No letter ever came to Mark; no news was ever heard of the Brahmapootra.
+ Ramoo's sacrifice was in vain, and never again did the diamond bracelet
+ glisten on the arm of the idol in the unknown temple.
+ </p>
+ <p>
+ THE END. <br /> <br />
+ </p>
+ <hr />
+ <p>
+ <br /> <br />
+ </p>
+<pre xml:space="preserve">
+
+
+
+
+
+End of Project Gutenberg's Colonel Thorndyke's Secret, by G. A. Henty
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET ***
+
+***** This file should be named 8155-h.htm or 8155-h.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/8/1/5/8155/
+
+Produced by Martin Robb, and David Widger
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase &ldquo;Project
+Gutenberg&rdquo;), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. &ldquo;Project Gutenberg&rdquo; is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (&ldquo;the Foundation&rdquo;
+ or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase &ldquo;Project Gutenberg&rdquo; appears, or with which the phrase &ldquo;Project
+Gutenberg&rdquo; is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase &ldquo;Project Gutenberg&rdquo; associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+&ldquo;Plain Vanilla ASCII&rdquo; or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original &ldquo;Plain Vanilla ASCII&rdquo; or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, &ldquo;Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation.&rdquo;
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+&ldquo;Defects,&rdquo; such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the &ldquo;Right
+of Replacement or Refund&rdquo; described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+
+</pre>
+ </body>
+</html>
diff --git a/8155.txt b/8155.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2360137
--- /dev/null
+++ b/8155.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,13346 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of Colonel Thorndyke's Secret, by G. A. Henty
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: Colonel Thorndyke's Secret
+
+Author: G. A. Henty
+
+Release Date: May, 2005 [EBook #8155]
+Posting Date: July 23, 2009
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ASCII
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Martin Robb
+
+
+
+
+
+COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET
+
+
+By G. A. Henty.
+
+
+
+
+PUBLISHER'S INTRODUCTION.
+
+
+"Colonel Thorndyke's Secret" is a story so far out of the ordinary that
+it will not be inappropriate to speak a few words regarding the tale and
+its unusually successful author, Mr. George Alfred Henty.
+
+The plot of the story hinges upon the possession of a valuable bracelet,
+of diamonds, stolen from a Hindoo idol by a British soldier in India.
+This bracelet falls into the possession of Colonel Thorndyke, who,
+shortly afterward, is sent home to England because of his wounds. The
+secret concerning the bracelet is told to the Colonel's brother, a
+country squire, and the treasure is left to younger members of the
+Thorndyke family.
+
+As is well known today, the theft of anything from a Hindoo temple is
+considered an extraordinary crime in India, and when this occurs it
+becomes a religious duty for one or more persons to hunt down the thief
+and bring back the property taken from the heathen god.
+
+The members of the Thorndyke family soon learn that they are being
+watched. But this is at a time when highwaymen are numerous in this part
+of England, and they cannot determine whether the work is that of the
+"knights of the roads" or that of the Lascars after the famous bracelet.
+A mysterious death follows, and the younger members of the family are
+almost stunned, not knowing what will happen next. They would give the
+bracelet up, but do not know where it is hidden, the secret having been
+in the sole possession of the member now dead. In this quandary the
+young hero of the tale rises to the occasion and determines to join the
+London police force and become a detective, with the hope of ultimately
+clearing up the mystery. Thrilling adventures of a most unusual kind
+follow, and at last something of the mystery is explained. The bracelet
+and other jewelry are unearthed, and it is decided to take the bracelet
+to Amsterdam and offer it to the diamond cutters at that place. But
+the carrying of the bracelet is both difficult and dangerous. How the
+mission is brought to a conclusion, and what part the Lascars played in
+the final adventure, will be found in the pages that follow.
+
+It can truthfully be said that Mr. Henty is easily the most popular of
+all English story tellers, his books for boys enjoying a circulation of
+from a hundred and fifty thousand to two hundred and fifty thousand per
+year. His tales are all clean, and although some are full of exciting
+situations and thrilling to the last degree, they are of a high moral
+tone, while the English employed is of the best.
+
+The present story is of peculiar value as giving a good insight into
+country and town life in England over a hundred years ago, when railways
+and telegraph lines were unknown and when the "knights of the road" were
+apt to hold up any stagecoach that happened to come along. It also gives
+a truthful picture of the dark and underhanded work accomplished at
+times by those of East Indian blood, especially when on what they
+consider a religious mission.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I.
+
+
+Squire Thorndyke, of the Manor House of Crawley, was, on the 1st of
+September; 1782, walking up and down the little terrace in front of the
+quaint old house in an unusually disturbed mood. He was a man of forty
+three or four, stoutly and strongly built, and inclined to be portly.
+Save the loss of his wife four years before, there had been but little
+to ruffle the easy tenor of his life. A younger son, he had, at his
+mother's death, when he was three and twenty, come in for the small
+estate at Crawley, which had been her jointure.
+
+For ten years he had led a life resembling that of most of his
+neighbors; he had hunted and shot, been a regular attendant at any
+main of cocks that was fought within fifteen miles of Crawley, had
+occasionally been up to London for a week or two to see the gay doings
+there. Of an evening he had generally gone down to the inn, where he
+talked over, with two or three of his own condition and a few of the
+better class of farmers, the news of the day, the war with the French,
+the troubles in Scotland, the alarming march of the Young Pretender, and
+his defeat at Culloden--with no very keen interest in the result, for
+the Southern gentry and yeomen, unlike those in the North, had no strong
+leanings either way. They had a dull dislike for Hanoverian George, but
+no great love for the exiled Stuarts, whose patron, the King of France,
+was an enemy of England.
+
+More often, however, their thoughts turned upon local topics--the
+holding up of the coach of Sir James Harris or Squire Hamilton by
+highwaymen; the affray between the French smugglers and the Revenue men
+near Selsea Bill or Shoreham; the delinquencies of the poaching gangs;
+the heaviness of the taxes, and the price of corn.
+
+At the age of thirty-three Squire Thorndyke married the daughter of
+a neighboring landowner; a son was born and three years later Mrs.
+Thorndyke died. Since then the Squire had led a more retired life; he
+still went down to smoke his pipe at the inn parlor, but he gave up his
+visits to town; and cock fights, and even bull baiting, were no longer
+attractions to him. He was known as a good landlord to the three or four
+farmers who held land under him; was respected and liked in the village,
+where he was always ready to assist in cases of real distress; was of an
+easygoing disposition and on good terms with all his neighbors.
+
+But today he was unusually disturbed in his mind. A messenger had ridden
+up two hours before with a letter from London. It was as follows:
+
+"MY DEAR BROTHER JOHN:
+
+"You will be surprised indeed at this letter from me, who, doubtless,
+you suppose to be fighting in India. I have done with fighting, and
+am nearly done with life. I was shot in the battle of Buxar, eighteen
+months ago. For a time the surgeons thought that it was going to be
+fatal; then I rallied, and for some months it seemed that, in spite of
+the ball that they were never able to find, I was going to get over it,
+and should be fit for service again. Then I got worse; first it was
+a cough, then the blood used to come up, and they said that the only
+chance for me was to come home. I did not believe it would be of any
+use, but I thought that I would rather die at home than in India, so
+home I came, and have now been a week in London.
+
+"I thought at first of going down to my place at Reigate, and having
+you and your boy there with me; but as I have certainly not many weeks,
+perhaps not many days, to live, I thought I would come down to you; so
+the day after you receive this letter I shall be with you. I shall not
+bring my little girl down; I have left her in good hands, and I shall
+only bring with me my Hindoo servant. He will give you no trouble--a mat
+to sleep on, and a little rice to eat, will satisfy his wants; and he
+will take the trouble of me a good deal off your hands. He was a Sepoy
+in my regiment, and has always evinced the greatest devotion for me.
+More than once in battle he has saved my life, and has, for the last
+three years, been my servant, and has nursed me since I have been ill
+as tenderly as a woman could have done. As I shall have time to tell you
+everything when I arrive, I will say no more now."
+
+The news had much affected John Thorndyke. His brother George was five
+years his senior, and had gone out as a cadet in the company's service
+when John was but thirteen, and this was his first home coming. Had it
+not been for a portrait that had been taken of him in his uniform just
+before he sailed, John would have had but little remembrance of him. In
+that he was represented as a thin, spare youth, with an expression of
+quiet determination in his face. From his father John had, of course,
+heard much about him.
+
+"Nothing would satisfy him but to go out to India, John. There was, of
+course, no occasion for it, as he would have this place after me--a
+fine estate and a good position: what could he want more? But he was a
+curious fellow. Once he formed an opinion there was no persuading him to
+change it. He was always getting ideas such as no one else would think
+of; he did not care for anything that other people cared for; never
+hunted nor shot. He used to puzzle me altogether with his ways, and,
+'pon my word, I was not sorry when he said he would go to India, for
+there was no saying how he might have turned out if he had stopped here.
+He never could do anything like anybody else: nothing that he could have
+done would have surprised me.
+
+"If he had told me that he intended to be a play actor, or a Jockey, or
+a private, or a book writer, I should not have been surprised. Upon my
+word, it was rather a relief to me when he said, 'I have made up my mind
+to go into the East India Service, father. I suppose you can get me
+a cadetship?' At least that was an honorable profession; and I knew,
+anyhow, that when he once said 'I have made up my mind, father,' no
+arguments would move him, and that if I did not get him a cadetship he
+was perfectly capable of running away, going up to London, and enlisting
+in one of their white regiments."
+
+John Thorndyke's own remembrances were that his brother had always
+been good natured to him, that he had often told him long stories about
+Indian adventures, and that a short time before he went away, having
+heard that he had been unmercifully beaten by the schoolmaster at
+Reigate for some trifling fault, he had gone down to the town, and had
+so battered the man that the school had to be closed for a fortnight.
+They had always kept up a correspondence. When he received the news of
+his father's death George had written to him, begging him to go down to
+Reigate, and to manage the estate for him.
+
+"Of course," he said, "you will draw its income as long as you are
+there. I mayn't be back for another twenty years; one gets rich out here
+fast, what with plunder and presents and one thing and another, and it
+is no use to have money accumulating at home, so just live on the place
+as if it were your own, until I come home to turn you out."
+
+John had declined the offer.
+
+"I am very well where I am," he wrote, "and the care of the estate would
+be a horrible worry to me; besides, I have just married, and if I ever
+have any children they would be brought up beyond their station. I
+have done what I can for you. I have seen the family lawyers, who have
+engaged a man who has been steward to Sir John Hieover, and looked after
+the estate during his son's minority. But the young blade, on coming of
+age, set to work to make ducks and drakes of the property, and Newman
+could not bear to see the estate going to the Jews, so, as luck would
+have it, he resigned a month ago, and has been appointed steward at
+Reigate. Of course, if you don't like the arrangement you must write and
+say so. It will be a year before I get your answer, and he has only been
+engaged for certain for that time; it must lie with you as to permanent
+arrangement."
+
+So Newman had taken charge of the Reigate estate, and had continued
+to manage it ever since, although George had written home in great
+displeasure at his offer being refused.
+
+Inside the Manor the bustle of preparations was going on; the spare
+room, which had not been used for many years, was being turned out, and
+a great fire lighted to air it. John Thorndyke had sent a letter by the
+returning messenger to a friend in town, begging him to go at once to
+Leadenhall Street and send down a supply of Indian condiments for his
+brother's use, and had then betaken himself to the garden to think the
+matter over. The next day a post chaise arrived, bringing the invalid
+and his colored servant, whose complexion and Indian garb struck the
+maids with an awe not unmingled with alarm. John Thorndyke could hardly
+believe that the bent and emaciated figure was that of his brother, but
+he remembered the voice when the latter said, holding out his hand to
+him:
+
+"Well, brother John, here I am, what is left of me. Gracious, man,
+who would have thought that you were going to grow up such a fine tall
+fellow? You are more fitted to be a soldier than I am. No, don't try
+to help me out; Ramoo will do that--he is accustomed to my ways, and I
+would as soon trust myself to a rogue elephant as to you."
+
+"I am sorry to see you looking so bad, brother George."
+
+"What must be must. I have had my fling; and after thirty years of
+marching and fighting, I have no right to grumble if I am laid upon my
+back at last."
+
+Leaning on Ramoo's arm, Colonel Thorndyke made his way into the house,
+and when the Hindoo had arranged the cushions of the sofa, took his
+place there in a half reclining position.
+
+"I am not always as bad as this, John," he said; "the jolting of your
+confounded roads has been too much for me. If I were the King I would
+hang every fellow who had anything to do with them--contractors, boards
+of county magistrates, and the whole lot. If I had known what it was
+going to be like I would have hired a sedan chair, and had myself
+carried down. That is what I have been doing in London; but I would
+rather have had an Indian palkee, that one could have lain down
+comfortably in."
+
+"What shall I get you first, George? I have got some lemons."
+
+"I want something better than lemons, John. Have you any Burgundy
+handy?"
+
+"Yes, plenty."
+
+"If you give a bottle to Ramoo he will know how much water I want."
+
+Here the servants entered with a tray with a chicken and a dish of
+kidneys.
+
+"I sent up yesterday for some of the Indian things that you are
+accustomed to, George, but they have not come down yet."
+
+"I brought a store down with me. This will do capitally for the present.
+Ramoo will do the cooking for me in future. He need not go into the
+kitchen to scare the maids. I could see they looked at him as if he had
+been his infernal majesty, as he came in. He can do it anywhere; all he
+wants is an iron pot with some holes in it, and some charcoal. He can
+squat out there on the veranda, or, if it is bad weather, any shed will
+do for him.
+
+"Well, it is nice to be home again, John," he went on, after he had
+eaten a few mouthfuls of chicken and drunk a tumbler of Burgundy and
+water. "I am glad to be back, now I am here, though I dare say I should
+not have come home for another ten years if it had not been for this
+rascally bullet. Where is your boy?"
+
+"He is away at school."
+
+"Well, I think I will go up to bed at once, if you don't mind, John. I
+shall be fitter to talk in the morning."
+
+The next day, indeed, Colonel Thorndyke was materially better. His voice
+was stronger and more cheery, and when he came down after breakfast he
+took his seat in an easy chair instead of on the sofa.
+
+"Now, brother," he said, "we will have a cozy chat. There are several
+things I want done, but the chief of these is that when I am gone you
+should go down to Reigate, as I wanted you to do ten years ago. I want
+you to seem to be its master, as well as be its master, until Millicent
+comes of age, if not longer. Her name is Millicent Conyers Thorndyke. I
+wish her to be called Millicent Conyers, and to appear as your ward, and
+not as your niece and heiress of the property. If there is one thing in
+the world I have a greater horror of than another, it is of a girl being
+married for her money. I don't suppose that anyone knows that I have a
+daughter--at any rate, none beyond a few Indian chums. She was sent home
+with an ayah under the charge of the widow of a comrade of mine. I had
+been away for months, and only went back to Calcutta in time to see her
+mother die. So that is all right."
+
+"I could not do such a thing as that, George. I should be living under
+false colors. It is not that I mind so much leaving here and looking
+after the child's interest at Reigate, but I could not possibly take
+possession of the place as its owner when I should not be so. Besides,
+there are other objections. Mark would grow up supposing himself to be
+the heir."
+
+"Mark will be all right. I have, since I have been in London, signed a
+will, leaving the rest of my fortune between them. I had it drawn up by
+our father's solicitors, relying upon your consent to do what I asked
+you. I have explained the matter to them, and given them the assignment,
+or whatever they call it, of the Reigate estate to you, until my
+daughter comes of age, appointing them her guardians should you die
+before that. Thus, you will be placed in a proper position; and should
+it be known by any means that the child is my daughter, that deed will
+still be a proof that you are carrying out my wishes, and are absolute
+master of the estate until she comes of age."
+
+"I must think it all over, George. It is a singular proposal, and I own
+I would rather things went on in their regular course."
+
+"Yes, yes, I understand that, John; but you see I have altogether set
+my mind on this matter. I want to know that my girl is not going to be
+married for her money; and, at any rate, that deed makes you master of
+the Reigate estates for the next thirteen years; so the only thing that
+I really want of you is to let the girl be called your ward instead of
+your niece, and that she and everyone else shall be in ignorance that
+she is an heiress. So far from doing the girl a wrong, you will be doing
+her a benefit; and as I have explained the whole matter to our lawyers,
+no one can possibly think that the thing has been done from any motive
+whatever except that of affording me satisfaction."
+
+"I will think the matter over," John repeated. "Of course, brother, it
+has been in your mind for some time, but it comes altogether fresh to
+me, and I must look at it in every light. For myself, I have no wish at
+all to become master of our father's estate. I have been going in one
+groove for the last twenty years, and don't care about changing it. You
+wished me to do so ten years ago, and I declined then, and the ten years
+have not made me more desirous of change than I was before."
+
+"All right; think it over. Please send Ramoo in to me; I have tired
+myself in talking."
+
+John Thorndyke smoked many churchwarden pipes in the little arbor in his
+garden that day. In the afternoon his brother was so weak and tired that
+the subject of the conversation was not reverted to. At eight o'clock
+the Colonel went off to bed. The next morning, after breakfast, he was
+brighter again.
+
+"Well, John, what has come of your thinking?" he asked.
+
+"I don't like it, George."
+
+"You mayn't like it, John, but you will do it. I am not going to have my
+girl run after by ruined spendthrifts who want her money to repair their
+fortunes; and I tell you frankly, if you refuse I shall go up to town
+tomorrow, and I shall make a new will, leaving all my property to your
+son, subject to a life annuity of 200 pounds a year to the child, and
+ordering that, in the event of his dying before he comes of age, or of
+refusing to accept the provisions of the will, or handing any of the
+property or money over to my daughter, the whole estate, money, jewels,
+and all, shall go to the London hospitals, subject, as before, to the
+annuity.
+
+"Don't be an ass, brother John. Do you think that I don't know what I
+am doing? I have seen enough of the evils of marrying for money out in
+India. Every ship that comes out brings so many girls sent out to some
+relation to be put on the marriage market, and marrying men old enough
+to be pretty nearly their grandfathers, with the natural consequence
+that there is the devil to pay before they have been married a year or
+two. Come, you know you will do it; why not give in at once, and have
+done with it? It is not a bad thing for you, it will be a good thing for
+your boy, it will save my girl from fortune hunters, and enable me to
+die quietly and comfortably."
+
+"All right, George, I will do it. Mind, I don't do it willingly, but I
+do it for your sake."
+
+"That is right," Colonel Thorndyke said, holding out his thin bronzed
+hand to his brother; "that is off my mind. Now, there is only one other
+thing--those confounded jewels. But I won't talk about them now."
+
+It was not indeed till three or four days later that the Colonel again
+spoke to his brother on any than ordinary matters. He had indeed been
+very weak and ailing. After breakfast, when, as usual, he was a little
+stronger and brighter than later in the day, he said to his brother
+suddenly:--
+
+"I suppose there are no hiding places in this room?"
+
+"Hiding places! What do you mean, George?"
+
+"Places where a fellow could hide up and hear what we are talking
+about."
+
+"No, I don't think so," the Squire replied, looking round vaguely. "Such
+an idea never occurred to me. Why do you ask?"
+
+"Because, John, if there is such a thing as a hiding place, someone will
+be sure to be hiding there. Where does that door lead to?"
+
+"It doesn't lead anywhere; it used to lead into the next room, but it
+was closed up before my time, and turned into a cupboard, and this door
+is permanently closed."
+
+"Do you mind stepping round into the next room and seeing if anyone is
+in the cupboard?"
+
+Thinking that his brother was a little light headed, John Thorndyke went
+into the next room, and returned, saying gravely that no one was there.
+
+"Will you look behind the curtains, John, and under this sofa, and
+everywhere else where even a cat could be hidden? That seems all right,"
+the Colonel went on, as his brother continued the search. "You know
+there is a saying that walls have ears, and I am not sure that it is
+not so. I have been haunted with the feeling that everything I did was
+watched, and that everything I said was listened to for years; and I can
+tell you it is a devilishly unpleasant thought. Draw your chair quite
+close to me. It is about my jewels, John. I always had a fancy for
+jewels--not to wear them, but to own them. In my time I have had good
+opportunities in that way, both in the Madras Presidency and in the
+Carnatic. In the first place, I have never cared for taking presents in
+money, but I have never refused jewels; and what with Rajahs and Nabobs
+and Ministers that one had helped or done a good turn to somehow, a good
+deal came to me that way.
+
+"Then I always made a point of carrying money with me, and after a
+defeat of the enemy or a successful siege, there was always lots of
+loot, and the soldiers were glad enough to sell anything in the way of
+jewels for a tithe of their value in gold. I should say if I put the
+value of the jewels at 50,000 pounds I am not much wide of the mark.
+That is all right, there is no bother about them; the trouble came
+from a diamond bracelet that I got from a soldier. We were in camp near
+Tanjore. I was officer of the day. I had made my rounds, and was coming
+back to my quarters, when I saw a soldier coming out of a tent thirty
+or forty yards away. It was a moonlight night, and the tent was one
+belonging to a white Madras regiment. Suddenly, I saw another figure,
+that had been lying down outside the tent, rise. I saw the flash of the
+moonlight on steel; then there was a blow, and the soldier fell. I drew
+my sword and rushed forward.
+
+"The native--for I could see that it was a native--was bending over the
+man he had stabbed. His back was towards me, and on the sandy soil he
+did not hear my footsteps until I was close to him; then he sprang up
+with a cry of fury, and leaped on me like a tiger. I was so taken by
+surprise that before I could use my sword the fellow had given me a
+nasty stab on the shoulder; but before he could strike again I had
+run him through. By this time several other, men ran out of the tent,
+uttering exclamations of rage at seeing their fallen comrade.
+
+"'What is it, sir?' they asked me.
+
+"'This scoundrel, here, has stabbed your comrade,' I said. 'He did not
+see me coming, and I ran up just as he was, I think, rifling him for
+booty. He came at me like a wild cat, and has given me a nasty stab.
+However, I have put an end to his game. Is your comrade dead?'
+
+"'No, sir, he is breathing still; but I fancy there is little chance for
+him.'
+
+"'You had better carry him to the hospital tent at once; I will send a
+surgeon there.'
+
+"I called the regimental surgeon up, and went with him to the hospital
+tent, telling him what had happened. He shook his head after examining
+the man's wound, which was fairly between the shoulders.
+
+"'He may live a few hours, but there is no chance of his getting
+better.'
+
+"'Now,' I said, 'you may as well have a look at my wound, for the
+villain stabbed me too.'
+
+"'You have had a pretty narrow escape of it,' he said, as he examined
+it. 'If he had struck an inch or two nearer the shoulder the knife would
+have gone right into you; but you see I expect he was springing as he
+struck, and the blow fell nearly perpendicularly, and it glanced down
+over your ribs, and made a gash six inches long. There is no danger. I
+will bandage it now, and tomorrow morning I will sew the edges together,
+and make a proper job of it.'
+
+"In the morning one of the hospital attendants came to me and said the
+soldier who had been wounded wanted to speak to me. The doctor said he
+would not live long. I went across to him. He was on a bed some little
+distance from any of the others, for it was the healthy season, and
+there were only three or four others in the tent.
+
+"'I hear, Major Thorndyke,' he said in a low voice, 'that you killed
+that fellow who gave me this wound, and that you yourself were stabbed.'
+
+"'Mine is not a serious business, my man,' I said. 'I wish you had got
+off as easily.'
+
+"'I have been expecting it, sir,' he said; 'and how I came to be fool
+enough to go outside the tent by myself I cannot think. I was uneasy,
+and could not sleep; I felt hot and feverish, and came out for a breath
+of fresh air. I will tell you what caused it, sir. About two years ago
+a cousin of mine, in one of the King's regiments, who was dying, they
+said, of fever (but I know the doctors thought he had been poisoned),
+said to me, "Here are some things that will make your fortune if ever
+you get to England; but I tell you beforehand, they are dangerous things
+to keep about you. I fancy that they have something to do with my being
+like this now. A year ago I went with some others into one of their
+great temples on a feast day. Well, the god had got on all his trinkets,
+and among them was a bracelet with the biggest diamonds I ever saw. I
+did not think so much of it at the time, but I kept on thinking of them
+afterwards, and it happened that some months after our visit we took the
+place by storm. I made straight for the temple, and I got the jewels. It
+don't matter how I got them--I got them. Well, since that I have never
+had any peace; pretty near every night one or other of our tents was
+turned topsy turvy, all the kits turned out, and even the ground dug
+up with knives. You know how silently Indian thieves can work. However,
+nothing was ever stolen, and as for the diamonds, at the end of every
+day's march I always went out as soon as it was quite dark, and buried
+the bracelet between the tent pegs; it did not take a minute to do. When
+we moved, of course, I took it up again. At last I gave that up, for
+however early I turned out in the morning there was sure to be a native
+about. I took then to dropping it down the barrel of my gun; that way I
+beat them. Still, I have always somehow felt myself watched, and my tent
+has been disturbed a great deal oftener than any of the others. I have
+had half a mind to throw the things away many a time, but I could not
+bring myself to do it."
+
+"'Well, sir, I have carried the bracelet ever since. I have done as he
+did, and always had it in my musket barrel--When we had fighting to do I
+would drop it out into my hand and slip it into my ammunition pouch;
+but I know that I have always been followed, just as Bill was. I suppose
+they found out that I went to see him before he died. Anyhow, my tent
+has been rummaged again and again. I have no doubt that fellow whom you
+killed last night had been watching me all the time, and thought that I
+had come out to hide the things. However, there they are, sir. One of my
+mates brought my musket here a quarter of an hour ago, and emptied the
+barrel out for me. Now, sir, you did your best to save my life last
+night, and you killed that fellow who did for me, and you pretty nearly
+got killed yourself. I have got no one else I could give the things to,
+and if I were to give them to one of my mates in the regiment they would
+probably cost him his life, as they have cost me mine. But you will know
+what to do with the things; they are worth a lot of money if you can get
+them home. Mind, sir, you have got to be careful. I have heard tales of
+how those priests will follow up a temple jewel that has been lost for
+years, and never give it up until they get it back again.'
+
+"'I ought to give it up,' I said.
+
+"'You don't know where it came from, sir,' he replied. 'I was one of a
+party of convalescents who were sent up just before that fight, and my
+own regiment was not there: it might have been here, and it might have
+been in the Carnatic. Bill never told me, and I have no more idea than a
+babe unborn.'
+
+"The gems were certainly magnificent; and though I knew well enough that
+these untiring Brahmins would not be long in guessing that the things
+had come into my possession, I took the bracelet. I thought, anyhow,
+that I might have a few hours' start; the fellow I had killed might, of
+course, have one or two others with him, but I had to risk that. I got
+leave an hour later, and went down to Madras, and got them put into
+a place of safety. That I was watched all the time I was in India
+afterwards I have no doubt, but no attempts were made to assassinate
+me. They would have known that I went straight away, but whether I had
+buried them somewhere on the road, or had given them to someone's care
+at Madras they could not know, and there was, therefore, nothing for
+them to do but to wait till I made a move.
+
+"I have no doubt whatever that they came over in the same ship with me.
+Two or three times during the week I was in London I saw colored men in
+the street outside the hotel. Once it was a Lascar seaman, another time
+a dark looking sailor in European clothes: he might pass for a Spaniard.
+Several times as I was going about in a sedan chair I looked out
+suddenly, and each time there was a dark face somewhere in the street
+behind. I had a letter this morning from the lawyer, and he mentioned
+that two days ago his offices had been broken into, and every strong box
+and drawer forced open, but that, curiously enough, they could not find
+that anything had been stolen, though in the cashier's box there were 30
+pounds in gold. Of course it was my friends. I have no doubt that one or
+two of them have followed me down here; and for anything I know they may
+be lurking somewhere in your garden at the present moment--that is, if
+they are not standing beside us in this room."
+
+John Thorndyke looked round with an uncomfortable feeling.
+
+"How do you mean, George?"
+
+"I mean some of those Indian fellows can do all sorts of wonderful
+conjuring tricks. I have seen them go up into the air on a rope and
+never come down again, and for aught I know they may be able to render
+themselves invisible. Seriously, I think that it is likely as not."
+
+"Well, and where are the things to be found now, George?"
+
+"That I won't tell you, John. Before I go I will whisper it in your ear,
+and give you the means of finding them, but not till then. No, I will
+write it down on a piece of paper, and slip it into your hand. As soon
+as you get out of the room you glance at it, and then put the piece of
+paper into your mouth, chew it up and swallow it. I tell you I dare not
+even whisper it; but whatever you do, take no steps in the matter until
+your son comes of age."
+
+"There can surely be no danger in another twelve years, George; they
+will have given up the search long before that."
+
+
+"Not they," the Colonel said emphatically. "If they die others will take
+their places: it is a sacred business with them. My advice to you is,
+either sell them directly you get them into your hands, or go straight
+to Amsterdam and sell them there to one of the diamond cutters, who will
+turn them out so that they will be altered beyond all recognition. Don't
+sell more than two stones at most to any one man; then they will never
+come out as a bracelet again, and the hunt will be over."
+
+
+"I would almost rather leave them alone altogether, George."
+
+"Well, they are worth 50,000 pounds if they are worth a penny, and a
+great deal more I should say; but you cannot leave them alone without
+leaving everything alone, for all my gems are with them, and 52,000
+pounds in gold. Of course, if you like you can, when you get the box,
+pick those diamonds out and chuck them away, but if you do you must do
+it openly, so that anyone watching you may see you do it, otherwise the
+search will go on."
+
+Two days later, as Ramoo was helping the Colonel to the sofa, the latter
+was seized with a violent fit of coughing, then a rush of blood poured
+from his lips. His brother and Ramoo laid him on the sofa almost
+insensible.
+
+"Run and get some water, Ramoo," John Thorndyke said.
+
+As Ramoo left the room the Colonel feebly placed his snuffbox in his
+brother's hand with a significant glance; then he made several desperate
+efforts to speak, and tried to struggle up into a sitting position;
+another gush of blood poured from him, and as it ceased he fell back
+dead.
+
+John Thorndyke was bitterly grieved at the death of his brother, and it
+was not until he went up to his room that night that he thought of the
+snuffbox that he had dropped into his pocket as his brother handed it
+to him. He had no doubt that it contained the instructions as to the
+treasure. It was of Indian manufacture. He emptied the snuff from it,
+but it contained nothing else. He was convinced that the secret must be
+hidden there, and after in vain endeavoring to find a spring, he took
+a poker and hammered it, and as it bent a spring gave way, and showed a
+very shallow false bottom.
+
+In this was a thin gold coin, evidently of considerable antiquity, and a
+small piece of paper, on which was written the word "Masulipatam." John
+Thorndyke looked at it in bewilderment; that it was connected with the
+secret he felt certain, but alone it was absolutely useless. Doubtless
+his brother had intended to give him the key of the riddle, when he had
+so desperately striven to speak. After in vain thinking the matter over
+he said:
+
+"Well, thank goodness; there is nothing to be done about the matter for
+another thirteen or fourteen years; it is of no use worrying about it
+now." He went to an old fashioned cabinet, and placed the coin and piece
+of paper in a very cunningly devised secret drawer. The next morning
+he went out into the garden and dropped the battered snuffbox into the
+well, and then dismissed the subject from his mind.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+
+Standing some two miles out of Reigate is the village of Crowswood, a
+quiet place and fairly well to do, thanks in no small degree to Squire
+Thorndyke, who owned the whole of the parish, and by whom and his
+tenants the greater portion of the village were employed. Greatly had
+the closing of the Manor House, after the death of old Squire Thorndyke,
+been felt. There were no more jellies, soups, and other comforts to
+be looked for in time of sickness, no abatement of rent when the
+breadwinner was sick or disabled, no check to the drunkards, whom the
+knowledge that they would be turned out of their cottage at a week's
+notice kept in some sort of order. When, therefore, after ten years
+of absence of all government, John Thorndyke, after the death of his
+brother, the Colonel, came down and took possession, he found the place
+sadly changed from what it had been when he had left it twenty years
+before. His first act was to dismiss Newman; who, completely unchecked,
+had, he found, been sadly mismanaging affairs. It was not long, however,
+before his hand made itself felt. Two out of the three public houses
+were shut up in six months, a score of their habitual frequenters had,
+weeks before, been turned out of their houses, an order had been issued
+that unless a cottage was kept in good order and the garden bright and
+blooming with flowers in the summer a fresh tenant would be found for
+it. Every child must be sent to the village school; the Squire was
+ready to do what there was to be done in the way of thatching and
+whitewashing, repairing palings and painting doors and windows, but,
+as he told the people, the village had to be kept clean and decent,
+and anyone who would not conform to the rules was at liberty to leave
+without a day's notice.
+
+Many of the villagers grumbled under their breath, but public opinion
+was, on the whole, favorable. There was someone to look after them now,
+someone who would see that the greater portion of the wages was not
+spent at the alehouse, who would take an interest in the people, and
+would lend a helping hand in bad times. There was a feeling of regret
+that the Squire was a widower, but the post of visitor and almoner was
+well supplied by the lady who acted as companion and governess to the
+Squire's little ward and regulated the affairs of his household.
+
+John Thorndyke had never had much occasion for the display of energy
+before, but he had an abundance of it, although hitherto latent. He
+had come into this business against his will, but he took it up with
+a determination to do well in it. The income was legally his until his
+niece came of age, but he was determined he would take nothing out of
+the estate beyond the necessary expenses of the position, and that all
+surplus should be expended in improving it in every way possible,
+so that he could hand it over to her in the most perfect condition.
+Therefore, when he came into possession he made a close inspection of
+the farms, with their houses, barns, and other tenements. Where he saw
+that the men were doing their best, that the hedges and fields were in
+good order, he did everything that was necessary without a word; but
+where there were slovenly farming and signs of neglect and carelessness,
+he spoke out his mind sharply.
+
+"This has all got to be amended," he said. "What must be done I will
+do, but unless I see things well kept up, the fences in good order, the
+hedges cut, the cattle in good condition, and everything going on as
+it ought to be, out you go next Christmas. The estate at present is a
+disgrace to the county, but it shall not be so any longer if I can help
+it. I shall do my share, and anyone who is not prepared to do the same
+had better look out for another holding at once."
+
+No one rejoiced more at the coming home of the Squire than Mr. Bastow,
+the Rector. He had had a pleasant time of it during the life of the old
+Squire. He was always a welcome guest at the house; Mr. Thorndyke had
+been ever ready to put his hand into his pocket for any repairs needed
+for the church, and bore on his shoulders almost the entire expense of
+the village school. In the latter respect there had been no falling off,
+he having given explicit instructions to his solicitors to pay his usual
+annual subscriptions to the school until his son's return from India.
+But with the death of the Squire the Rector had gradually lost all
+authority in the village.
+
+For a time force of habit had had its effect, but as this wore out and
+the people recognized that he had no real authority things went from bad
+to worse. Drunken men would shout jeeringly as they passed the Rectory
+on their way home from the alehouse; women no longer feared reproof for
+the untidiness of their houses and children; the school was half emptied
+and the church almost wholly so.
+
+For seven or eight years Mr. Bastow had a hard time of it. It was, then,
+both with pleasure as an old friend, and with renewed hopefulness for
+the village, that he visited John Thorndyke on his return. The change
+in the state of affairs was almost instantaneous. As soon as it became
+known that the Rector was backed, heart and soul, by the Squire's
+authority, and that a complaint from him was followed the next day by a
+notice to quit at the end of a week, his own authority was established
+as firmly as it had been in the old Squire's time, and in a couple of
+years Crowswood became quite a model village. Every garden blossomed
+with flowers; roses and eglantine clustered over the cottages, neatness
+and order prevailed everywhere.
+
+The children were tidily dressed and respectful in manner, the women
+bright and cheerful, and the solitary alehouse remaining had but few
+customers, and those few were never allowed to transgress the bounds of
+moderation. The Squire had a talk with the landlord a fortnight after
+his arrival.
+
+"I am not going to turn you out, Peters," he said. "I hear that you make
+some efforts to keep your house decently; the other two I shall send
+packing directly their terms are up. Whether you remain permanently must
+depend upon yourself. I will do up your house for you, and build a bar
+parlor alongside, where quiet men can sit and smoke their pipes and talk
+and take their beer in comfort, and have liberty to enjoy themselves as
+long as their enjoyment does not cause annoyance to other people or keep
+their wives and children in rags. I will do anything for you if I
+find the place well conducted; but I warn you that I will have no
+drunkenness. A man who, to my knowledge, gets drunk twice, will not get
+drunk a third time in this parish, and if you let men get drunk here it
+is your fault as much as theirs. Now we understand each other."
+
+Things once placed on a satisfactory footing, the Squire had but little
+more trouble, and it soon came to be understood that he was not to be
+trifled with, and that Crowswood was no longer a place for the idle or
+shiftless. Two or three of the farmers left at the termination of their
+year, but better men took their places, and John Thorndyke, having
+settled matters to his satisfaction, now began to attend more to other
+affairs. He had been, when he first came back, welcomed with great
+heartiness by all the gentry of the neighborhood; his father had been a
+popular man, and young Thorndyke had been regarded as a pleasant young
+fellow, and would in any case have been welcomed, if only because
+Crowswood had become a nuisance to the whole district. It was, indeed,
+a sort of rendezvous for poachers and bad characters, it was more than
+suspected that gangs of thieves and burglars made it their headquarters,
+and that even highwaymen found it a convenient and quiet resort.
+
+Thus, then, the transformation effected within a few months of Mr.
+Thorndyke's return caused general and lively satisfaction, and a year
+later he was put on the Commission of the Peace, and became one of the
+most regular attendants at the Bench of Magistrates. Reluctantly as
+he had taken up his present position, he found it, as time went on, a
+pleasant one. He had not been conscious before that time hung somewhat
+heavily on his hands, but here he had duties to perform and ample
+employment. His nature was naturally somewhat a masterful one, and
+both as a magistrate and a landlord he had scope and power of action.
+Occasionally he went up to London, always driving his gig, with a pair
+of fast trotting horses, and was known to the frequenters of the
+coffee houses chiefly patronized by country gentlemen. Altogether, John
+Thorndyke became quite a notable person in the district, and men were
+inclined to congratulate themselves upon the fact that he, and not the
+Indian officer, his brother, had come into the estate.
+
+The idea of an old Indian officer in those days was that he was almost
+of necessity an invalid, and an irritable one, with a liver hopelessly
+deranged, a yellow complexion, and a hatred of the English climate. The
+fact that, instead of leaving the army and coming home at his father's
+death, George Thorndyke had chosen to remain abroad and leave the estate
+to the management of agents, had specially prejudiced him in the eyes of
+the people of that part, and had heightened the warmth with which they
+had received his brother. John Thorndyke had upon the occasion, of his
+first visit to the family solicitors spoken his mind with much freedom
+as to the manner in which Newman had been allowed a free hand.
+
+"Another ten years," he said, "and there would not have been a cottage
+habitable on the estate, nor a farm worth cultivating. He did absolutely
+nothing beyond collecting the rents. He let the whole place go to rack
+and ruin. The first day I arrived I sent him out of the house, with a
+talking to that he won't forget as long as he lives."
+
+"We never heard any complaints about him, Mr. Thorndyke, except that I
+think we did once hear from the Rector of the place that his conduct was
+not satisfactory. I remember that we wrote to him about it, and he
+said that the Rector was a malignant fellow, on bad terms with all his
+parishioners."
+
+"If I had the scoundrel here," John Thorndyke said with indignation, "I
+would let him have a taste of the lash of my dog whip. You should not
+have taken the fellow's word; you should have sent down someone to find
+out the true state of things. Why, the place has been an eyesore to the
+whole neighborhood, the resort of poaching, thieving rascals; by gad,
+if my brother George had gone down there I don't know what would
+have happened! It will cost a couple of years' rent to get things put
+straight."
+
+When the Squire was at home there was scarce an evening when the Rector
+did not come up to smoke a pipe and take his glass of old Jamaica or
+Hollands with him.
+
+"Look here, Bastow," the latter said, some three years after his return,
+"what are you going to do with that boy of yours? I hear bad reports of
+him from everyone; he gets into broils at the alehouse, and I hear
+that he consorts with a bad lot of fellows down at Reigate. One of my
+tenants--I won't mention names--complained to me that he had persecuted
+his daughter with his attentions. They say, he was recognized among that
+poaching gang that had an affray with Sir James Hartrop's keepers. The
+thing is becoming a gross scandal."
+
+"I don't know what to do about him, Squire; the boy has always been a
+trouble to me. You see, before you came home, he got into bad hands in
+the village here. Of course they have all gone, but several of them only
+moved as far as Reigate, and he kept up their acquaintance. I thrashed
+him again and again, but he has got beyond that now, you see; he is
+nearly eighteen, and openly scoffs at my authority. Upon my word, I
+don't know what to do in the matter."
+
+"He is growing up a thorough young ruffian," the Squire said
+indignantly, "and one of these mornings I expect to see him brought up
+before us charged with some serious offense. We had to fine him last
+week for being drunk and making a disturbance down at Reigate. Why do
+you let him have money? You may have no authority over him; but at least
+you should refuse to open your purse to him. Don't you see that this
+sort of thing is not only a disgrace to him, but very prejudicial to
+the village? What authority can you have for speaking against vice and
+drunkenness, when your son is constantly intoxicated?"
+
+"I see that, Squire--none better; and I have thought of resigning my
+cure."
+
+"Stuff and nonsense, Parson! If the young fellow persists in his present
+course he must leave the village, that is clear enough; but that is no
+reason why you should. The question is what is to be done with him? The
+best thing he could do would be to enlist. He might be of some service
+to his country, in India or the American Colonies, but so far as I can
+see he is only qualifying himself for a jail here."
+
+"I have told him as much, Squire," Mr. Bastow said, in a depressed
+voice, "and he has simply laughed in my face, and said that he was very
+comfortable where he was, and had no idea whatever of moving."
+
+"What time does he go out in the morning?" John Thorndyke asked
+abruptly.
+
+"He never gets up till twelve o'clock, and has his breakfast when I take
+my dinner."
+
+"Well, I will come in tomorrow morning and have a talk with him myself."
+
+The next day the Squire rode up to the door of the Rectory soon after
+one o'clock. Mr. Bastow had just finished his meal; his son, a young
+fellow of between seventeen and eighteen, was lolling in an easy chair.
+
+"I have come in principally to speak to you, young sir," John Thorndyke
+said quietly. "I have been asking your father what you intend to do with
+yourself. He says he does not know."
+
+The young fellow looked up with an air of insolent effrontery.
+
+"I don't know that it is any business of yours, Mr. Thorndyke, what I do
+with myself."
+
+"Oh, yes, it is," the Squire replied. "This village and the people in it
+are mine. You are disturbing the village with your blackguard conduct;
+you are annoying some of the girls on the estate, and altogether you are
+making yourself a nuisance. I stopped at the alehouse as I came here,
+and have ordered the landlord to draw no more liquor for you, and unless
+you amend your conduct, and that quickly, I will have you out of the
+village altogether."
+
+"I fancy, Mr. Thorndyke, that, even as a justice of the peace, you have
+not the power to dictate to my father who shall be the occupant of this
+house."
+
+"What you say is perfectly true; but as you make your father's life a
+burden to him, and he is desirous of your absence, I can and will
+order the village constable to remove you from his house by force, if
+necessary."
+
+The young fellow cast an evil glance at his father. "He has not been
+complaining, has he?" he said, with a sneer.
+
+"He has not, sir," John Thorndyke said indignantly. "It is I who have
+been complaining to him, and he admits that you are altogether beyond
+his authority. I have pointed out to him that he is in no way obliged
+to support you at your age in idleness and dissipation, and that it were
+best for him and all concerned that he should close his doors to you. I
+don't want to have to send the son of my old friend to prison, but I can
+see well enough that that is what it will come to if you don't give up
+your evil courses. I should think you know by this time that I am a man
+of my word. I have taken some pains to purge this village of all bad
+characters, and I do not intend to have an exception made of the son of
+the clergyman, who, in his family as well as in his own person, is bound
+to set an example."
+
+"Well, Mr. Thorndyke, I utterly decline to obey your orders or to be
+guided by your advice."
+
+"Very well, sir," the magistrate said sternly. "Mr. Bastow, do I
+understand that you desire that your son shall no longer remain an
+inmate of your house?"
+
+"I do," the clergyman said firmly; "and if he does so I have no other
+course before me but to resign my living; my position here has become
+absolutely unbearable."
+
+"Very well, sir, then you will please lock your doors tonight, and if he
+attempts to enter, I, as a magistrate, should know how to deal with
+him. Now, young sir, you understand your position; you may not take my
+advice, nevertheless, I shall give it you. The best thing you can do
+is to take your place for town on the outside of the coach that comes
+through Reigate this afternoon, and tomorrow morning proceed either to
+the recruiting officer for His Majesty's service, or to that for the
+East India Company's. You have health and strength, you will get rid at
+once of your bad associates, and will start afresh in a life in which
+you may redeem your past and be useful to your king and country."
+
+Young Bastow smiled.
+
+"Thanks," he said sarcastically. "I have my own plans, and shall follow
+them."
+
+"I would think, Mr. Bastow," the Squire said quietly, "it would just
+be as well for you to come home with me. I don't think that the leave
+taking is likely to be an affectionate one."
+
+The Rector rose at once.
+
+"I will come with you, Squire. I may tell you now, what I have not told
+you before, that my son has more than once raised his hand against me,
+and that I do not care to be left alone with him."
+
+"I judged him capable even of that, Mr. Bastow."
+
+"Goodby, Arthur," his father said. "My heart is ready to break that it
+has come to this; but for both our sakes it is better so. Goodby, my
+son, and may Heaven lead you to better ways! If ever you come to me and
+say, 'Father, I have turned over a new leaf, and heartily repent the
+trouble I have caused you,' you will receive a hearty welcome from me,
+and no words of reproach for the past."
+
+The young man paid no attention to the offered hand, but laughed
+scornfully.
+
+"You have not got rid of me yet," he said. "As for you, Squire
+Thorndyke, I shall not forget your meddlesome interference, and some
+day, maybe, you will be sorry for it."
+
+"I think not," John Thorndyke said gravely. "I am doing my duty to the
+village, and still more I am doing my duty to an old friend, and I am
+not likely ever to feel any regret that I have so acted. Now, Parson,
+let's be off."
+
+After leaving the house with the clergyman, the Squire stopped at the
+house of Knapp, the village constable; and said a few words to him,
+then, leading his horse, walked home with Mr. Bastow.
+
+"Don't be cast down, old friend," he said. "It is a terrible trial to
+you; but it is one sharp wrench, and then it will be over. Anything is
+better than what you must have been suffering for some time."
+
+"I quite feel that, Squire; my life has indeed been intolerable of late.
+I had a painful time before, but always looked forward with hope to your
+brother coming home. Since you returned, and matters in the parish have
+been put straight, this trouble has come in to take the place of the
+other, and I have felt that I would rather resign and beg for charity
+than see my son going from bad to worse, a scandal to the parish, and a
+hindrance to all good work."
+
+"It is a bad business, Bastow, and it seems to me that two or three
+years in prison would be the best thing for him, as he will not take up
+the only trade open to him. At any rate, it would separate him from his
+evil associates, and give you peace while he is behind the bars. Where
+does he get his money?"
+
+"That I know not, Squire. He takes some from me--it used to be done
+secretly, now it is done with threats, and, as I told you, with
+violence--but that would not account for his always having money. He
+must get it somewhere else, for when I have paid my bills, as I always
+do the hour that I receive money, there is but little over for him
+to take. He is often away all night, sometimes for two or three days
+together, and I dare not think what he does with himself; but certainly
+he gets money somehow, and I am afraid that I cannot hope it is honestly
+obtained."
+
+"I do not well see how it can be," the Squire agreed.
+
+"If I had before known as much as you tell me now, I would have taken
+some steps to have him watched, and to nip the matter before it went too
+far. Do you think that he will take your notice, and come no more to the
+house?"
+
+Mr. Bastow shook his head.
+
+"I fear that the only effect will be to make him worse, even when he was
+quite a small boy punishment only had that effect with him. He will come
+back tonight probably half drunk, and certainly furious at my having
+ventured to lay the case before you."
+
+"You must lock the doors and bar the windows."
+
+"I did that when he first took to being out at night, but he always
+managed to get in somehow."
+
+"Well, it must be all put a stop to, Bastow; and I will come back with
+you this evening, and if this young rascal breaks into the house I will
+have him down at Reigate tomorrow on the charge of house breaking; or,
+at any rate, I will threaten to do so if he does not give a promise that
+he will in future keep away from you altogether."
+
+"I shall be glad, at any rate, if you will come down, Squire, for, to
+say the truth, I feel uneasy as to the steps he may take in his fury at
+our conversation just now."
+
+John Thorndyke took down from a wall a heavy hunting whip, as he went
+out with the parson at nine o'clock. He had in vain endeavored to cheer
+his old friend as they sat over their steaming glasses of Jamaica. The
+parson had never been a strong man; he was of a kindly disposition, and
+an unwearied worker when there was an opportunity for work, but he had
+always shrunk from unpleasantness, and was ready to yield rather than
+bring about trouble. He had for a long time suffered in silence, and
+had not the Squire himself approached the subject of his son's
+delinquencies, he would have never opened his mouth about it. Now,
+however, that he had done so, and the Squire had taken the matter in
+hand, and had laid down what was to be done, though he trembled at the
+prospect, he did not even think of opposing his plan, and indeed could
+think of no alternative for it.
+
+"I have told John Knapp to be here," the Squire said, as they reached
+the house. "It is just as well that he should be present if your son
+comes back again. He is a quiet, trustworthy fellow, and will keep his
+mouth shut if I tell him."
+
+Mr. Bastow made no reply. It was terrible to him that there should be
+another witness to his son's conduct, but he saw that the Squire was
+right. An old woman opened the door.
+
+"Are all the shutters closed and barred?" John Thorndyke asked her.
+
+"Yes, sir; I always sees to that as soon as it gets dark."
+
+"Very well; you can go to bed now, Elisa," her master said. "Is John
+Knapp here?"
+
+"Yes, he came an hour ago, and is sitting in the kitchen."
+
+"I will call him in myself when I want to speak to him."
+
+As soon as the old servant had gone upstairs the Squire went into the
+kitchen, Mr. Bastow having gone to the cellar to fetch up a bottle of
+old brandy that was part of a two dozen case given to him by the old
+Squire fifteen years before.
+
+"Do you go round the house, John, and see that everything is properly
+fastened up. I see that you have got a jug of beer there. You had better
+get a couple of hours' sleep on that settle. I shall keep watch, till I
+am sleepy, and then I will call you. Let me know if you find any of the
+doors or windows unbarred."
+
+Five minutes later the constable knocked at the door of the parlor. "The
+door opening into the stable yard was unbarred, Squire."
+
+"I thought it likely that it would be so, Knapp. You have made it fast
+now, I suppose? That is right. Now lie down and get an hour or two of
+sleep; it is scarce likely that he will be back until late.
+
+"That was the old woman, of course," he went on to his companion, when
+the door closed behind the constable. "I thought it likely enough that
+he might tell her to leave a way for him to come in. You told me that
+she had been with you a good many years. I dare say she has left that
+door unbarred for him many a time. I should advise you to get a man to
+sleep in the house regularly; there are plenty of fellows who will be
+glad to do it for a shilling or two a week, and I do not think that it
+is safe for you to be here alone."
+
+An hour later he said to the Rector: "Now, Bastow, you had best go
+to bed. I have taken the matter into my own hands, and will carry
+it through. However, I won't have him taken away without your being
+present, and will call you when we want you. Of course, if he will give
+a solemn promise not to molest you, and, even if he won't enlist, to
+leave this part of the country altogether, I shall let him off."
+
+"There is one thing, Mr. Thorndyke, that I have not told you," the
+Rector said hesitatingly. "Sometimes, when he comes home late, he brings
+someone with him; I have heard voices downstairs. I have never seen who
+it was--for what could I have done if I went down?--but I have heard
+horses brought round to the stable yard, and heard them ride away:"
+
+"It is just as well you told me," the Squire said dryly. "If you had
+told me this evening at the house, I would have dropped a brace of
+pistols into my pocket. However, this hunting crop is a good weapon;
+but I don't suppose they will show fight, even if anyone is with him.
+Besides, Knapp has a stout oaken cudgel with him--I noticed it standing
+against his chair as I went in--and as he is a strong active fellow, and
+we shall have the advantage of a surprise, I fancy we should be a match
+even for three or four of them."
+
+At one o'clock the Squire roused John Knapp. "It is one o'clock, John;
+now take off your boots. I don't want him to know that there is anyone
+in the house till we get hold of him. I am going to lie down on the sofa
+in the parlor. The moment you hear footsteps you come and wake me."
+
+The clock in the kitchen had just struck two when the constable shook
+John Thorndyke. "There are two horses just coming into the yard."
+
+"All right. I opened a window in the room looking down into the yard
+before I lay down. I will go up and see what they are going to do. If
+they try to break in anywhere down here, do you come at once quietly up
+to me."
+
+The Squire had taken off his boots before he lay down, and, holding his
+heavy hunting crop in his hand, he went quietly upstairs. As he went to
+the window he heard Arthur Bastow say angrily:
+
+"Confound the old woman! she has locked the door; she has never played
+me that trick before. There is a ladder in the stable, and I will get in
+at that window up there and open it for you. Or you may as well come up
+that way, too, and then you can stow the things away in my room at once,
+and have done with it."
+
+The Squire went hastily down.
+
+"Come upstairs, Knapp," he whispered to the constable. "There are three
+of them, and I fancy the two mounted men are highwaymen. Let them all
+get in, keeping yourself well back from the window. The moon is round on
+the other side of the house, but it will be light enough for us to see
+them as they get in. I will take the last fellow, and I will warrant
+that he will give no trouble; then I will fall upon the second, and do
+you spring on young Bastow. The two highwaymen are sure to have pistols,
+and he may have some also. Give him a clip with that cudgel of yours
+first, then spring on him, and hold his arms tightly by his side. If I
+call you give him a back heel and throw him smartly, and then come to
+my aid. I don't think I shall want it, but it is as well to prepare for
+everything."
+
+They went upstairs and took their places, one on each side of the
+window, standing three or four feet back. Just as they took up their
+positions the top of the stable ladder appeared above the sill of the
+window. Half a minute later young Bastow's head appeared, and he threw
+up the sash still higher, and stepped into the room; then he turned and
+helped two men in, one after the other.
+
+"Follow me," he said, "then you won't tumble over the furniture."
+
+As they turned, the heavy handle of John's Thorndyke's whip fell with
+tremendous force on the head of the last man.
+
+"What the devil is that?" the other exclaimed, snatching out a pistol
+and turning round, as the falling body struck him, but he got no
+further. Again the heavy whip descended, this time on his right arm;
+it dropped useless by his side, and the pistol fell from his hand. Then
+John Thorndyke fell upon him and bore him to the ground, snatched the
+other pistol from his belt, and held it to his head.
+
+"Now, my man," he said quietly, "if you don't surrender I will blow out
+your brains."
+
+"I surrender," the man moaned. "I believe that you have broken my arm.
+Curse you, whoever you are."
+
+The struggle between John Knapp and young Bastow was soon over.
+The young fellow was lithe and sinewy, but he was no match for the
+constable, who, indeed, had almost overpowered him before he was aware
+what had happened.
+
+"Has he got pistols, Knapp?" the Squire asked.
+
+"Yes, sir, a brace of them; I have got them both safely in my pocket.
+There," he went on, as a sharp click was heard, "I have got the darbys
+on him. Now shall I help you, sir?"
+
+"You had better run downstairs first and light a couple of candles at
+the kitchen fire: you will find a pair standing on the parlor table.
+Don't be long about it; the first fellow I hit was stunned, and he may
+come round any moment."
+
+"I will make sure of him before I go, Squire. I have got another pair of
+darbys in my pocket."
+
+As soon as he had fastened these upon the wrists of the insensible man
+he ran downstairs, and in a minute returned with the candles.
+
+"I am glad that you are back," the Squire said. "I was afraid that young
+rascal would try to escape."
+
+"I took good care of that, Squire; you see I put one of his arms round
+the bedpost before I slipped the darbys on, and he cannot get away
+unless he takes the whole bed with him; and as I don't think he would
+get it out either by the window or the door, he is as safe here as he
+would be in Newgate. What is the next thing to do, Squire?"
+
+"You had better tie this fellow's legs. I will leave you a candle here,
+and you can keep guard over them while I go and wake Mr. Bastow."
+
+The Rector needed no waking; he was walking up and down his room in
+great distress. He had not undressed, but had thrown himself upon his
+bed.
+
+"What has happened, Thorndyke?" he asked as the Squire entered. "I heard
+two heavy falls, and I felt that something terrible had taken place."
+
+"Well, it has been a serious matter--very serious. That unfortunate
+son of yours is not hurt, but I don't know but that the best thing that
+could have happened would have been for him to have got a bullet through
+his head. He brought home with him two men who are, I have little doubt,
+highwaymen; anyhow, they each had a brace of pistols in their belt, and
+from what he said I think they have been stopping a coach. At any rate,
+they have something with them that they were going to hide here, and
+I fancy it is not the first time that it has been done. I don't expect
+your son had anything to do with the robbery, though he was carrying a
+brace of pistols, too; however, we have got them all three.
+
+"Now, you see, Bastow, this takes the affair altogether out of our
+hands. I had hoped that when we caught your son in the act of breaking
+into your house after you had ordered him from it, we should be able to
+frighten him into enlisting, or, at any rate, into promising to disturb
+you no more, for even if we had taken him before the bench, nothing
+could have been done to him, for under such circumstances his
+re-entering the house could not be looked upon as an act of burglary. As
+it is, the affair is altogether changed. Even if I wished to do so, as a
+magistrate I could not release those two highwaymen; they must appear as
+prisoners in court. I shall hear down in the town tomorrow morning what
+coach has been stopped, and I have no doubt that they have on them the
+proceeds of the robbery. Your son was consorting with and aiding them,
+and acting as a receiver of stolen goods, and as you have heard horses
+here before it is probable that when his room is thoroughly searched we
+shall come upon a number of articles of the same sort. I am sorry that
+I ever meddled in the matter; but it is too late for that now. You had
+better come downstairs with me, and we will take a turn in the garden,
+and try to see what had best be done."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+
+John Thorndyke opened the shutters of the parlor window, and stepped out
+into the garden alone, for the Rector was too unnerved and shattered to
+go out with him, but threw himself on the sofa, completely prostrated.
+Half an hour later the Squire re-entered the room. The morning was just
+beginning to break. Mr. Bastow raised his head and looked sadly at him.
+
+"I can see no way out of it, old friend. Were it not that he is in
+charge of the constable, I should have said that your only course was
+to aid your son to escape; but Knapp is a shrewd fellow as well as
+an honest one. You cannot possibly get your son away without his
+assistance, for he is handcuffed to the bed, and Knapp, in so serious a
+matter as this, would not, I am sure, lend himself to an escape. I have
+no doubt that with my influence with the other magistrates, and, indeed,
+on the circumstances of the case, they will commit him on a minor charge
+only, as the passengers of the coach will, I hope, give evidence that it
+was stopped by mounted men alone. I think, therefore, that he would
+only be charged with consorting with and aiding the highwaymen after the
+event, and of aiding them to conceal stolen goods--that is, if any are
+found in his room.
+
+"That much stolen property has been hidden there, there is little reason
+to doubt, but it may have been removed shortly afterwards. It was, of
+course, very convenient for them to have some place where they could
+take things at once, and then ride on quietly to London the next day,
+for, if arrested; nothing would be found upon them, and it would be
+impossible to connect them with the robbery. Later on they might come
+back again and get them from him. Of course, if nothing is found in his
+room, we get rid of the charge of receiving altogether, and there would
+be nothing but harboring, aiding, and abetting--a much less serious
+business. Look here, old friend, I will strain a point. I will go out
+into the garden again and walk about for an hour, and while I am out, if
+you should take advantage of my absence to creep up to your son's room
+and to search it thoroughly, examining every board of the floor to see
+if it is loose, and should you find anything concealed, to take it and
+hide it, of course I cannot help it. The things, if there are any, might
+secretly be packed up by you in a box and sent up to Bow Street, with a
+line inside, saying that they are proceeds of robbery, and that you hope
+the owners will be traced and their property restored to them. Not, of
+course, in your own hand, and without a signature. There might be some
+little trouble in managing it, but it could, no doubt, be done."
+
+John Thorndyke went out into the garden without another word. The hour
+was nearly up when Mr. Bastow came out; he looked ten years older than
+he had done on the previous day. He wrung his friend's hand.
+
+"Thank God I have been up there," he said. "I do not think they will
+find anything."
+
+"Say nothing about it, Bastow; I don't want to know whether you found
+anything. Now I am going to fetch two or three of the men from the
+village, to get them to aid the constable in keeping guard, and another
+to go up to the house at once and order a groom to saddle one of my
+horses and bring it here."
+
+As it was now past five o'clock, and the Squire found most of the men
+getting up, he sent one off to the house with the message, and returned
+with two others to the Rectory. He told them briefly that two highwaymen
+had been arrested during the night, and that as young Mr. Bastow was in
+their company at the time, it had been necessary as a matter of form to
+arrest him also. He went upstairs with them.
+
+"I have brought up two men to sit with you, Knapp, until the Reigate
+constables come up. You can take those handcuffs off Mr. Bastow, but
+see that he does not leave the room, and do you yourself sit in a chair
+against the door, and place one of these men at the window. How about
+others?"
+
+"The man you hit first, Squire, did not move until a quarter of an hour
+ago; he has been muttering to himself since, but I don't think he is
+sensible. The other one has been quiet enough, but there is no doubt
+that his arm is broken."
+
+"I am going to ride down to Reigate at once, and will bring back a
+surgeon with me."
+
+"You will repent this night's business, Thorndyke!" Arthur Bastow said
+threateningly.
+
+"I fancy that you will repent it more than I shall, Bastow; it is likely
+that you will have plenty of time to do so."
+
+It was not long before the groom with the horse arrived. John Thorndyke
+rode at a gallop down to Reigate, and first called on the head
+constable.
+
+"Dawney," he said, as the man came down, partially dressed, at his
+summons, "has anything taken place during the night?"
+
+"Yes, Squire, the up coach was stopped a mile before it got here, and
+the passengers robbed. It was due here at one, and did not come in till
+half an hour later. Of course I was sent for. The guard was shot. There
+were two of the fellows. He let fly with his blunderbuss, but he does
+not seem to have hit either of them, and one rode up and shot him dead;
+then they robbed all the passengers. They got six gold watches, some
+rings, and, adding up the amounts taken from all the passengers, about a
+hundred and fifty pounds in money."
+
+"Well, I fancy I have got your two highwaymen safe, _Dawney_."
+
+"You have, sir?" the constable said in astonishment.
+
+"Yes. I happened to be at the Rectory. Mr. Bastow had had a quarrel with
+his son, and had forbidden him the house."
+
+The constable shook his head. "I am afraid he is a very bad one, that
+young chap."
+
+"I am afraid he is, Dawney. However, his father was afraid that he might
+come in during the night and make a scene, so I said I would stop with
+him, and I took our village constable with me. At two o'clock this
+morning the young fellow came with two mounted men, who, I have no
+doubt, were highwaymen. We had locked up down below. Bastow took a
+ladder, and the three got in at a bedroom window on the first floor.
+Knapp and I were waiting for them there, and, taking them by surprise,
+succeeded in capturing them before the highwaymen could use their
+pistols. The constable and two men are looking after them, but as one
+has not got over a knock I gave him on the head, and the other has a
+broken arm, there is little fear of their making their escape. You had
+better go up with two of your men, and take a light cart with you with
+some straw in the bottom, and bring them all down here. I will ride
+round myself to Mr. Chetwynde, Sir Charles Harris, and Mr. Merchison,
+and we will sit at twelve o'clock. You can send round a constable with
+the usual letters to the others, but those three will be quite enough
+for the preliminary examination."
+
+"Well, Squire, that is good news indeed. We have had the coach held up
+so often within five miles of this place during the past three months,
+that we have been getting quite a bad name. And to think that young
+Bastow was in it! I have heard some queer stories about him, and fancied
+before long I should have to put my hand upon his shoulder; but I didn't
+expect this."
+
+"There is not a shadow of proof that he had anything to do with the
+robbery, Dawney, but he will have difficulty in proving that he did not
+afterwards abet them. It is serious enough as it is, and I am terribly
+grieved for his father's sake."
+
+"Yes, sir; I have always heard him spoken of as a kind gentleman, and
+one who took a lot of trouble whenever anyone was sick. Well, sir, I
+will be off in twenty minutes. I will run round at once and send Dr.
+Hewett up to the Rectory, and a man shall start on horseback at seven
+o'clock with the summons to the other magistrates."
+
+John Thorndyke rode round to his three fellow magistrates, who, living
+nearest to the town, were most regular in their attendance at the
+meetings. They all listened in surprise to his narrative, and expressed
+great pleasure at hearing that the men who had been such a pest to
+the neighborhood, and had caused them all personally a great deal of
+trouble, had been captured. All had heard tales, too, to Arthur Bastow's
+disadvantage, and expressed great commiseration for his father. They
+agreed to meet at the court half an hour before business began, to talk
+the matter over together.
+
+"It is out of the question that we can release him on bail," the
+gentleman who was chairman of the bench said. "Quite so," John Thorndyke
+agreed. "In the first place, the matter is too serious; and in the
+next, he certainly would not be able to find bail; and lastly, for his
+father's sake, it is unadvisable that he should be let out. At the same
+time, it appears to me that there is a broad distinction between his
+case and the others. I fear that there can be no question that he had
+prior acquaintance with these men, and that he was cognizant of the
+whole business; something I heard him say, and which, to my regret, I
+shall have to repeat in court, almost proves that he was so. Still, let
+us hope none of the stolen property will be found upon him; whether they
+had intended to pass it over to his care or not is immaterial. If they
+had not done so, I doubt whether he could be charged with receiving
+stolen goods, and we might make the charge simply one of aiding these
+two criminals, and of being so far an accessory after the crime.
+
+"If we could soften it down still further I should, for his father's
+sake, be glad; but as far as he himself is concerned, I would do nothing
+to lighten his punishment. He is about as bad a specimen of human nature
+as I ever came across. His father is in bodily fear of him. I saw the
+young fellow yesterday, and urged him to enlist, in order to break
+himself loose from the bad companionship he had fallen into. His reply
+was insolent and defiant in the highest degree, and it was then that in
+his father's name I forbade him the house, and as his father was present
+he confirmed what I said, and told him that he would not have anything
+more to do with him. This affair may do him good, and save his neck from
+a noose. A few years at the hulks or a passage to Botany Bay will do him
+no harm; and, at any rate, his father will have rest and peace, which he
+never would have if he remained here."
+
+A somewhat similar conversation took place at each house. John Thorndyke
+breakfasted at Sir Charles Harris', the last of the three upon whom he
+called, and then mounting rode back to Reigate.
+
+"We have found the plunder on them," the head constable said, coming
+out of the lockup as he drew rein before it, "and, fortunately for young
+Bastow, nothing was found upon him."
+
+"How are the two men?"
+
+"The fellow you hit first is conscious now, sir, but very weak. The
+doctor says that if he hadn't had a thick hat on, your blow would have
+killed him to a certainty. The other man's arm is set and bandaged, and
+he is all right otherwise. We shall be able to have them both in court
+at twelve o'clock."
+
+The Squire rode up to his house. He was met at the door by his son, in a
+state of great excitement.
+
+"Is it all true, father? The news has come from the village that you
+have killed two men, and that they and Arthur Bastow have all been taken
+away in a cart, guarded by constables."
+
+"As usual, Mark, rumor has exaggerated matters. There are no dead men;
+one certainly got a crack on the head that rendered him insensible for
+some time, and another's arm is broken."
+
+"And are they highwaymen, father? They say that two horses were fastened
+behind the cart."
+
+"That is what we are going to try, Mark. Until their guilt is proved, no
+one knows whether they are highwaymen or not."
+
+"And why is Arthur Bastow taken, father?"
+
+"Simply because he was in company with the others. Now, you need not ask
+any more questions, but if you like to get your pony saddled and ride
+down with me to Reigate at eleven o'clock, I will get you into the
+courthouse, and then you will hear all about it."
+
+At greater length the Squire went into the matter with Mrs. Cunningham,
+his lady housekeeper, and his ward's governess.
+
+"It is a bad business, Mr. Thorndyke," she said, "and must be terrible
+for poor Mr. Bastow."
+
+"Yes, it is a bad business altogether, except that it will rid him of
+this young rascal. If I were in his place I should be ready to suffer a
+good deal to obtain such a riddance."
+
+"I suppose that you won't sit upon the bench today?"
+
+"No; at least I shall take no part in the deliberations. I shall, of
+course, give evidence. The affair is not likely to last very long; my
+story will take the longest to tell. Knapp's will be confirmatory of
+mine, and the Reigate constable will depose to finding the watches,
+rings, and money upon them; then, of course, the case will be adjourned
+for the attendance of the coachman and some of the passengers. I don't
+suppose they will be able to swear to their identity, for no doubt
+they were masked. But that is immaterial; the discovery of the stolen
+property upon them will be sufficient to hang them. No doubt we shall
+have some Bow Streets runners down from town tomorrow or next day, and
+they will most likely be able to say who the fellows are."
+
+"Will Mr. Bastow have to give evidence against his son?"
+
+"Not before us, I think; but I imagine he will have to appear at the
+trial."
+
+"It will be terrible for him."
+
+"Yes, terrible. I sincerely hope that they will not summon him, but I am
+afraid that there is very little doubt about it; they are sure to want
+to know about his son's general conduct, though possibly the testimony
+on that point of the constable at Reigate will be sufficient. My own
+hope is that he will get a long sentence; at any rate, one long enough
+to insure his not coming back during his father's lifetime. If you had
+seen his manner when we were talking to him yesterday, you would believe
+that he is capable of anything. I have had a good many bad characters
+before me during the year and a half that I have sat upon the bench, but
+I am bound to say that I never saw one who was to my eyes so thoroughly
+evil as this young fellow. I don't think," he added with a smile, "that
+I should feel quite comfortable myself if he were acquitted; it will
+be a long time before I shall forget the expression of his face when
+he said to me this morning, 'You will repent this night's work,
+Thorndyke.'"
+
+"You don't mean that you think he would do you any harm, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"Well, I should not care to meet him in a lonely place if he was armed
+and I was not. But you need not be nervous, Mrs. Cunningham, there is
+not the smallest chance of his being out for years; and by that time his
+blood will have had time to cool down, and he will have learnt, at any
+rate, that crimes cannot be committed in this country with impunity."
+
+"It is all very shocking," the lady said. "What will poor Mr. Bastow do?
+I should think that he would not like to remain as clergyman here, where
+everyone knows about it."
+
+"That must be for him to decide," the Squire said; "but if he wishes to
+resign I certainly shall not press him to continue to hold the living.
+He is a very old friend of mine. My father presented the living to him
+when I was nine or ten years old, and I may say I saw him daily up to
+the time when I went down into Sussex. If he resigns I should urge him
+to take up his residence here and to act as Mark's tutor; and he might
+also relieve you of some of Millicent's lessons. You have plenty to do
+in looking after the management of things in general. However, that is
+for the future."
+
+At eleven o'clock the Squire drove down to Reigate, taking Mark with
+him, as it would save all trouble about putting up the horse and pony.
+On arriving he handed Mark over to the head constable, and asked him to
+pass him into a seat in the courthouse, before the public were let in.
+
+Reigate was in a state of unusual excitement. That the coach should have
+been stopped and robbed was too common an event to excite much interest,
+but that two highwaymen should have been captured, and, as was rumored,
+a young gentleman brought in on a charge of being in connection with
+them, caused a thrill of excitement. Quite a small crowd was assembled
+before the courthouse, and the name of Squire Thorndyke passed from
+mouth to mouth.
+
+"There is some talk of his being mixed up with it in some way or other,"
+one said. "I saw him myself ride in here, about half past five, and
+I wondered he was about so early. Some do say as he caught the two
+highwaymen single handed; but that don't stand to reason. Besides,
+what could he have been doing out at such an hour as that? He is a good
+landlord, and they say that Crowswood has been quite a different place
+since he came to be master. He is a tight hand as a magistrate, and
+cleared out half the village the first two or three months he was there;
+but he spent a mint of money on the place, and the people there say that
+they could not have a better master. Ah, here is Squire Chetwynd. He was
+sure to be here. There is Sir Charles' gig turning the corner. I expect
+most of them will be on the bench; they don't get such a case as this
+every day."
+
+"It may be there will be nothing for us to hear when the court opens,"
+another said. "I hear both the fellows have been shot or knocked about
+so bad that they cannot be brought up. Of course the court cannot sit if
+they aint before it."
+
+"That is not so, Master Jones. I spoke to one of the constables half an
+hour ago--he lives next door to me--and he said that they would be well
+enough to appear. Neither of them have been shot, though they have been
+hurt pretty bad."
+
+All this added to the desire of those around to get into the court, and
+there was quite a rush when the doors were opened two minutes before
+twelve, and it was at once crammed, the constable having some difficulty
+in getting the doors shut, and in persuading those who could not get in
+that there was not standing room for another person. There was a buzz of
+talk in court until the door opened and six magistrates came in. It was
+observed that John Thorndyke did not seat himself with the others, but
+moved his chair a little apart from them, thus confirming the report
+that he was in some way connected with the matter, and did not intend to
+take any part in the decision. Then another door opened, and the three
+prisoners were brought in. The two first were pale and evidently weak;
+one had his head wrapped in bandages, the other had the right sleeve of
+his coat cut off, and his arm bandaged and supported by a sling. Both
+made a resolute effort to preserve a careless demeanor. The third, who
+was some years younger than the others, looked round with a smile on his
+lips, bowed to the magistrates with an air of insolent bravado when
+he was placed in the dock, and then leaned easily in the corner, as
+if indifferent to the whole business. A chair was placed between his
+comrades for the use of the man whose head was bandaged. Many among
+those present knew Arthur Bastow by sight, and his name passed from
+mouth to mouth; but the usher called loudly for silence, and then the
+magistrates' clerk rose.
+
+"William Smith and John Brown--at least, these are the names given--are
+charged with stopping the South Coast coach last night, killing the
+guard, and robbing the passengers; and Arthur Bastow is charged with
+aiding and abetting the other two prisoners, and with guilty knowledge
+of their crime."
+
+It was noticed by those who could see the prisoners' faces that, in
+spite of Bastow's air of indifference, there was an expression of
+anxiety on his face as the charge was read, and he undoubtedly felt
+relief as that against himself was mentioned. The first witness was John
+Knapp, and the constable stepped into the witness box.
+
+"What do you know of this business, Knapp?" the chairman asked. "Just
+tell it your own way."
+
+"I am constable of Crowswood, your honor, and yesterday Squire Thorndyke
+said to me--"
+
+"No, you must not tell it like that, Knapp; you must not repeat what
+another person said to you. You can say that from information received
+you did so and so."
+
+"Yes, your honor. From information received I went to the Rev. Mr.
+Bastow's house, at a quarter to nine last night. At nine o'clock Squire
+Thorndyke and the Parson came in together. They sent the servant up to
+bed, and then the Squire sent me round to examine the fastenings of the
+doors. I found that one back door had been left unfastened, and locked
+and bolted it. The Squire told me to lie down until one o'clock, and he
+would watch, and Mr. Bastow went up to bed."
+
+"Do you know of your own knowledge why these precautions were taken?"
+
+"Only from what I was told, your honor. At one o'clock the Squire woke
+me, and he lay down in the parlor, telling me to call him if I heard
+any movement outside. About two o'clock I heard two horses come into the
+Parson's yard. I called Squire Thorndyke, who went upstairs to an open
+window; presently someone came and tried the back door. I heard voices
+outside, but could not hear what was said. The Squire came down and
+called me upstairs. I went up and took my place at one side of the
+window, and the Squire took his on the other. I had this cudgel in my
+hand, and the Squire his riding whip. A ladder was put up against the
+window, and then someone came up, lifted the sash up high and got in.
+There was light enough for me to see it was young Mr. Bastow. Then the
+two other prisoners came up. When the third had got into the room Mr.
+Bastow said, 'Follow me, and then you won't tumble over the furniture.'"
+
+"How was it that they did not see you and Mr. Thorndyke?" the chairman
+asked.
+
+"We were standing well back, your honor. The moon was on the other side
+of the house. There was light enough for us to see them as they got in
+at the window, but where we were standing it was quite dark, especially
+to chaps who had just come in from the moonlight. As they moved, the
+Squire hit the last of them a clout on the head with his hunting crop,
+and down he went, as if shot. The man next to him turned, but I did not
+see what took place, for, as the Squire had ordered me, I made a rush at
+Mr. Bastow and got my arms round him pretty tight, so as to prevent him
+using his pistols, if he had any. He struggled hard, but without saying
+a word, till I got my heel behind his and threw him on his back. I came
+down on the top of him; then I got the pistols out of his belt and threw
+them on the bed, slipped the handcuffs onto one wrist, lifted him up a
+bit, and then shoved him up against the bedpost, and got the handcuff
+onto his other wrist, so that he could not shift away, having the post
+in between his arms.
+
+"Then I went to see if the Squire wanted any help, but he didn't. I
+first handcuffed the man whose head he had broken, and tied the legs
+of the other, and then kept guard over them till morning. When the
+constables came up from town we searched the prisoners, and on two
+of them found the watches, money, and rings. We found nothing on Mr.
+Bastow. I went with the head constable to Mr. Bastow's room and searched
+it thoroughly, but found nothing whatever there."
+
+The evidence created a great sensation in court. John Thorndyke had
+first intended to ask Knapp not to make any mention of the fact that
+Arthur Bastow was carrying pistols unless the question was directly put
+to him. But the more he had thought over the matter, the more convinced
+was he that the heavier the sentence the better it would be for the
+Rector; and when he had heard from the latter that there was nothing
+left in his son's room that could be brought against him, and that he
+could not be charged with the capital crime of being a receiver, he
+thought it best to let matters take their course.
+
+The head constable was the next witness. He deposed to the finding of
+the articles produced upon the two elder prisoners and the unsuccessful
+search of the younger prisoner's room.
+
+"You did not search the house further?" the chairman inquired.
+
+"No, sir; I wanted to get the prisoners down here as fast as I could,
+seeing that two of them were seriously hurt."
+
+The chairman nodded.
+
+"You will, of course, make a careful search of the whole house,
+constable."
+
+"Yes, sir; I left one of my men up there with instructions to allow no
+one to go upstairs until I returned."
+
+"Quite right."
+
+John Thorndyke was the next witness, and his evidence cleared up what
+had hitherto been a mystery to the general body of the public, as to
+how he and the constable happened to be in the house on watch when the
+highwaymen arrived. The most important part of his evidence was the
+repetition of the words young Bastow had used as he mounted the ladder,
+as they showed that it was arranged between the prisoners that the
+stolen goods should be hidden in the house. The Squire was only asked
+one or two questions.
+
+"I suppose, Mr. Thorndyke, that you had no idea whatever that the
+younger prisoner would be accompanied by anyone else when he returned
+home?"
+
+"Not the slightest," the Squire replied. "I was there simply to prevent
+this unfortunate lad from entering the house, when perhaps he might have
+used violence towards his father. My intention was to seize him if he
+did so, and to give him the choice of enlisting, as I had urged him to
+do, or of being brought before this bench for breaking into his father's
+house. I felt that anything was better than his continuing in the evil
+courses on which he seemed bent."
+
+"Thank you, Mr. Thorndyke. I must compliment you in the name of my
+brother magistrates, and I may say of the public, for the manner in
+which you, at considerable risk to yourself, have effected the capture
+of the two elder prisoners."
+
+After consulting with the others the head constable was recalled.
+
+"Do you know anything about the character of the youngest prisoner?"
+
+"Yes, sir. We have had our eye upon him for some time. He was brought
+before your honors a week ago charged with being drunk and disorderly in
+this town, and was fined 5 pounds. He is constantly drinking with some
+of the worst characters in the place, and is strongly suspected of
+having been concerned in the fray between the poachers and Sir Charles
+Harris' gamekeepers. Two of the latter said that they recognized him
+amongst the poachers, but as they both declined to swear to him we did
+not arrest him."
+
+John Knapp was then recalled, and testified to Bastow's drinking habits,
+and that the landlord of the alehouse at Crowswood had been ordered by
+the Squire not to draw any liquor for him in future on pain of having
+the renewal of his license refused.
+
+"Have you any more witnesses to call?" the chairman asked the head
+constable.
+
+"Not at present, your honor. We have sent up to town, and on the next
+occasion the coachman will be called to testify to the shooting of the
+guard, and we hope to have some of the passengers there to identify the
+articles stolen from them."
+
+"It will be necessary that the Rev. Mr. Bastow should be here. He need
+not be called to give evidence unless we think it to be of importance,
+but he had better be in attendance. The prisoners are remanded until
+this day week."
+
+An hour later the three prisoners, handcuffed, were driven under an
+escort of three armed constables to Croydon Jail. When again brought up
+in court the passengers on the coach identified the articles taken from
+them; the coachman gave evidence of the stopping of the coach, and of
+the shooting of the guard. The head constable testified that he had
+searched the Rectory from top to bottom, and found nothing whatever of
+a suspicious nature. None of the passengers were able to testify to the
+two elder prisoners as the men who had robbed them, as these had been
+masked, but the height and dress corresponded to those of the prisoners;
+and the two Bow Street runners then came forward, and gave evidence
+that the two elder prisoners were well known to them. They had long been
+suspected of being highwaymen, and had several times been arrested when
+riding towards London on occasions when a coach had been stopped the
+night before, but no stolen goods had ever been found upon them, and in
+no case had the passengers been able to swear to their identity. One was
+known among his associates as "Galloping Bill," the other as the
+"Downy One." At the conclusion of the evidence the three prisoners
+were formally committed for trial, the magistrates having retired in
+consultation for some time upon the question of whether the charge of
+receiving stolen goods ought to be made against Arthur Bastow.
+
+"I think, gentlemen," the chairman said, after a good deal had been
+urged on both sides of the question, "in this case we can afford to take
+a merciful view. In the first place, no stolen goods were discovered
+upon him or in the house. There is strong presumptive evidence of his
+intention, but intention is not a crime, and even were the evidence
+stronger than it is, I should be inclined to take a merciful view. There
+can be no doubt that the young fellow is thoroughly bad, and the bravado
+he has exhibited throughout the hearing is at once unbecoming and
+disgraceful; but we must remember that he is not yet eighteen, and that,
+in the second place, he is the son of a much respected clergyman, who is
+our neighbor. The matter is serious enough for him as it stands, and he
+is certain to have a very heavy sentence.
+
+"Mr. Thorndyke, who takes no part in our deliberations, is most anxious
+that the prisoner's father should be spared the agony of his son being
+placed on trial on a capital charge, though I do not think that there
+would be the smallest chance of his being executed, for the judges would
+be certain to take his youth into consideration. Had there been prima
+facie evidence of concealment, we must have done our duty and sent him
+to trial on that charge; but as there is no such evidence, I think that
+it will be in all respects better to send him on a charge on which the
+evidence is as clear as noonday. Moreover, I think that Mr. Thorndyke's
+wishes should have some weight with us, seeing that it is entirely due
+to him that the important capture of these highwaymen, who have long
+been a scourge to this neighborhood, has been effected."
+
+Mr. Bastow had not been called as a witness. John Thorndyke had brought
+him down to Reigate in a closed carriage, and he had waited in the
+justices' room while the examination went on; but the magistrates agreed
+that the evidence given was amply sufficient for them to commit upon
+without given him the pain of appearing. John Thorndyke had taken him to
+another room while the magistrates were consulting together, and when he
+heard the result drove him back again.
+
+"I have fully made up my mind to resign my living, Thorndyke. I could
+not stand up and preach to the villagers of their duties when I myself
+have failed so signally in training my own son; nor visit their houses
+and presume to lecture them on their shortcomings when my son is a
+convicted criminal."
+
+"I quite see that, old friend," the Squire said. "And I had no doubt but
+that you would decide on this course. I will try not to persuade you to
+change your decision, for I feel that your power of usefulness is at an
+end as far as the village is concerned. May I ask what you propose to
+do? I can hardly suppose that your savings have been large."
+
+"Two years ago I had some hundreds laid by, but they have dwindled away
+to nothing; you can understand how. For a time it was given freely, then
+reluctantly; then I declared I would give no more, but he took it all
+the same--he knew well enough that I could never prosecute him for
+forgery."
+
+"As bad as that, eh?" Thorndyke said sternly. "Well, we won't talk
+further of him now; what I propose is that you should take up your abode
+at the Hall. I am not satisfied with the school where Mark has been for
+the last two years, and I have been hesitating whether to get a private
+tutor for him or to send him to one of the public schools. I know that
+that would be best, but I could not bring myself to do so. I have some
+troubles of my own that but two or three people know of, and now, that
+everything is going on smoothly on the estate and in the village, I
+often feel dull, and the boy's companionship does me much good; and as
+he knows many lads of his own age in the neighborhood now, I think that
+he would do just as well at home.
+
+"He will be taking to shooting and hunting before long, and if he is
+to have a tutor, there is no one I should like to have better than
+yourself. You know all the people, and we could talk comfortably
+together of an evening when the house is quiet. Altogether, it will be
+an excellent arrangement for me. You would have your own room, and if I
+have company you need not join us unless you like. The house would not
+seem like itself without you, for you have been associated with it as
+long as I can remember. As to your going out into the world at the age
+of sixty, it would be little short of madness. There--you need not give
+me an answer now," he went on, seeing that the Rector was too broken
+down to speak; "but I am sure that when you think it over you will come
+to the same conclusion as I do, that it will be the best plan possible
+for us both."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+
+The trial of the two highwaymen and Arthur Bastow came off in due
+course. The evidence given was similar to that offered at Reigate, the
+only addition being that Mr. Bastow was himself put into the box. The
+counsel for the prosecution said: "I am sorry to have to call you, Mr.
+Bastow. We all feel most deeply for you, and I will ask you only two or
+three questions. Was your son frequently out at night?"
+
+"He was."
+
+"Did you often hear him return?"
+
+"Yes; I seldom went to sleep until he came back."
+
+"Had you any reason to suppose that others returned with him?"
+
+"I never saw any others."
+
+"But you might have heard them without seeing them. Please tell us if
+you ever heard voices."
+
+"Yes, I have heard men's voices," the clergyman said reluctantly, in a
+low voice.
+
+"One more question, and I have done. Have you on some occasions heard
+the sound of horses' hoofs in your yard at about the time that your son
+came in?"
+
+Mr. Bastow said in a low voice: "I have."
+
+"Had you any suspicion whatever of the character of your son's
+visitors?"
+
+"None whatever. I supposed that those with him were companions with whom
+he had been spending the evening."
+
+Mr. Bastow had to be assisted from the witness box, so overcome was
+he with the ordeal. He had not glanced at his son while giving his
+evidence. The latter and his two fellow prisoners maintained throughout
+the trial their expression of indifference. The two highwaymen nodded
+to acquaintances they saw in the body of the court, smiled at various
+points in the evidence, and so conducted themselves that there were
+murmured exclamations of approval of their gameness on the part of the
+lower class of the public. The jury, without a moment's hesitation,
+found them all guilty of the offenses with which they were charged.
+Bastow was first sentenced.
+
+"Young man," the judge said, "young as you are, there can be no doubt
+whatever in the minds of anyone who has heard the evidence that you have
+been an associate with these men who have been found guilty of highway
+robbery accompanied by murder. I consider that a merciful view was taken
+of your case by the magistrates who committed you for trial, for the
+evidence of your heartbroken father, on whose gray hairs your conduct
+has brought trouble and disgrace, leaves no doubt that you have for some
+time been in league with highwaymen, although not actually participating
+in their crime. The words overheard by Mr. Thorndyke show that you were
+prepared to hide their booty for them, and it is well for you that
+you were captured before this was done, and that no proceeds of other
+robberies were found in the house. The evidence of the Bow Street
+officers show that it had for some time been suspected that these men
+had an accomplice somewhere in the neighborhood of Reigate, for although
+arrested several times under circumstances forming a strong assumption
+of their guilt, nothing was ever found upon them. There can now be
+little, doubt who their accomplice was. Had you been an older man
+I should have sentenced you to transportation for life, but in
+consideration of your youth, I shall take the milder course of
+sentencing you to fifteen years' transportation."
+
+The capital sentence was then passed in much fewer words upon the two
+highwaymen. As they were leaving the dock Bastow turned, and in a clear
+voice said to John Thorndyke, who had been accommodated with a seat in
+the well of the court:
+
+"I have to thank you, Thorndyke, for this. I will pay off my debt some
+day, you make take your oath."
+
+"A sad case, Mr. Thorndyke--a sad case," the judge, who had greatly
+complimented the Squire on his conduct, said to him as he was disrobing
+afterwards. "I don't know that in all my experience I ever saw such a
+hardened young villain. With highwaymen it is a point of honor to assume
+a gayety of demeanor on such occasions; but to see a boy of eighteen,
+never before convicted, exhibiting such coolness and effrontery is quite
+beyond my experience. I suppose his record is altogether bad?"
+
+"Altogether," the Squire said. "His father has, during the last two
+years, been quite broken by it; he owned to me that he was in bodily
+fear of the lad, who had on several occasions assaulted him, had robbed
+him of his savings by means of forgery, and was so hopelessly bad that
+he himself thought with me that the only possible hope for him was
+to get him to enlist. I myself recommended the East India Company's
+service, thinking that he would have less opportunity for crime out
+there, and that there would be a strong chance that either fever or a
+bullet would carry him off, for I own that I have not the slightest hope
+of reformation in such a character."
+
+"I would have given him transportation for life if I had known all
+this," the judge said. "However, it is not likely that he will ever
+come back again--very few of them do; the hulks are not the most healthy
+places in the world, and they have a pretty rough way with men who give
+them trouble, as this young fellow is likely to do."
+
+Mr. Bastow, as soon as he had given his evidence, had taken a hackney
+coach to the inn where he and the Squire had put up on their arrival in
+town the evening before, and here, on his return, John Thorndyke found
+him. He was lying on his bed in a state of prostration.
+
+"Cheer up, Bastow," he said, putting his hand upon the Rector's
+shoulder. "The sentence is fifteen years, which was the very amount I
+hoped that he would get. The more one sees of him the more hopeless
+it is to expect that any change will ever take place in him; and it is
+infinitely better that he should be across the sea where his conduct,
+when his term is over, can affect no one. The disgrace, such as it is,
+to his friends, is no greater in a long term than in a short one. Had
+he got off with four or five years' imprisonment, he would have been a
+perpetual trouble and a source of uneasiness, not to say alarm; and even
+had he left you alone we should always have been in a state of dread as
+to his next offense. Better that he should be out in the colonies than
+be hung at Tyburn."
+
+"How did he take the sentence?"
+
+"With the same bravado he had shown all through, and as he went out of
+the dock addressed a threat to me, that, under the circumstances, I can
+very well afford to despise. Now, if you will take my advice, you will
+drink a couple of glasses of good port, and then go to bed. I will see
+to your being awakened at seven o'clock, which will give us time to
+breakfast comfortably, and to make a start at nine."
+
+"I would rather not have the wine," the Rector said feebly.
+
+"Yes, but you must take what is good for you. I have ordered up a bottle
+of the landlord's best, and must insist upon your drinking a couple of
+glasses with me. I want it almost as much as you do, for the atmosphere
+of that court was enough to poison a dog. I have got the taste of it in
+my mouth still."
+
+With much reluctance the Rector accompanied him to the private sitting
+room that the Squire had engaged. He sat down almost mechanically in an
+easy chair. The Squire poured out the wine, and handed him a glass. Mr.
+Bastow at first put it to his lips without glancing at it, but he was a
+connoisseur in wine, and the bouquet of the port appealing to his latent
+senses, he took a sip, and then another, appreciatingly.
+
+"The landlord said it was first rate, and he is not far wrong," John
+Thorndyke remarked, as he set down his own glass.
+
+"Yes, it is a fine vintage, and in perfect condition," Mr. Bastow
+agreed. "I have drunk nothing better for years, though you have some
+fine bins."
+
+"I would take a biscuit, if I were you, before I took another glass,"
+the Squire said, helping himself from a plate on the table. "You have
+had nothing to eat today, and you want something badly. I have a dish of
+kidneys coming up in half an hour; they cook them well here."
+
+The Rector ate a biscuit, mechanically sipped another glass of wine,
+and was even able to eat a kidney when they were brought up. Although
+September was not yet out, the Squire had a fire lighted in the room,
+and after the meal was over, and two steaming tumblers of punch were
+placed upon the table, he took a long pipe from the mantel, filled and
+lighted it, then filled another, and handed it to the Rector, at the
+same time holding out a light to him.
+
+"Life has its consolations," he said. "You have had a lot of troubles
+one way and another, Bastow, but we may hope that they are all over now,
+and that life will go more smoothly and easily with you. We had better
+leave the past alone for the present. I call this snug: a good fire, a
+clean pipe, a comfortable chair, and a steaming bowl at one's elbow."
+
+The Rector smiled faintly.
+
+"It seems unnatural--" he began.
+
+"Not at all, not at all," the Squire broke in. "You have had a
+tremendous load on your mind, and now it is lifted off; the thundercloud
+has burst, and though damage has been done, one is thankful that it is
+no worse. Now I can talk to you of a matter that has been on my mind for
+the last three weeks. What steps do you think that I ought to take to
+find a successor for you? It is most important to have a man who will
+be a real help in the parish, as you have been, would pull with one
+comfortably, and be a pleasant associate. I don't want too young a
+fellow, and I don't want too old a one. I have no more idea how to set
+about it than a child. Of course, I could ask the Bishop to appoint, but
+I don't know that he would appoint at all the sort of man I want. The
+living is only worth 200 pounds a year and the house--no very great
+catch; but there is many a man that would be glad to have it."
+
+"I have been thinking it over, too, Thorndyke, when I could bring my
+mind to consider anything but my own affairs. How would Greg do? He has
+been taking duty for me since I could not do it myself. I know that he
+is a hard working fellow, and he has a wife and a couple of children;
+his curacy is only 70 pounds a year, and it would be a perfect godsend,
+for he has no interest in the Church, and he might be years without
+preferment."
+
+"I should think he would do very well, Bastow. Yes, he reads well, which
+I own I care for that a good deal more than for the preaching; not
+that I have anything to say against that. He gives sound and practical
+sermons, and they have the advantage of being short, which is a great
+thing. In the first place, it is good in itself, and in the second,
+specially important in a village congregation, where you know very well
+every woman present is fidgeting to get home to see that the pot is not
+boiling over, and the meat in the oven is not burnt. Yes, I will go down
+tomorrow afternoon and ask him if he would like the living. You were
+talking of selling the furniture; how much do you suppose it is worth?"
+
+"I don't suppose it will fetch above seventy or eighty pounds; it is
+solid and good, but as I have had it in use nearly forty years, it would
+not go for much."
+
+"Well, let us say a hundred pounds," the Squire said. "I will give you a
+check for it. I dare say Greg will find it difficult to furnish, and he
+might have to borrow the money, and the debt would be a millstone round
+his neck, perhaps, for years, so I will hand it over with the Rectory to
+him."
+
+So they talked for an hour or two on village matters, and the Squire was
+well pleased, when his old friend went up to bed, that he had succeeded
+in diverting his thoughts for a time from the painful subject that had
+engrossed them for weeks.
+
+"You have slept well," he said, when they met at breakfast, "I can see
+by your face."
+
+"Yes, I have not slept so soundly for months. I went to sleep as soon
+as my head touched the pillow, and did not awake until the chambermaid
+knocked at the door."
+
+"That second glass of punch did it, Bastow. It is a fine morning; we
+shall have a brisk drive back. I am very glad that I changed my mind and
+brought the gig instead of the close carriage."
+
+In the afternoon the Squire drove into Reigate. He found the curate at
+home, and astonished and delighted him by asking him if he would like
+the living of Crowswood. It came altogether as a surprise to him, for
+the Rector's intentions to resign had not been made public, and it was
+supposed in the village that he was only staying at the Squire's until
+this sad affair should be over. Greg was a man of seven or eight and
+twenty, had graduated with distinction at Cambridge, but, having
+no influence, had no prospects of promotion, and the offer almost
+bewildered him.
+
+"I should be grateful indeed, Mr. Thorndyke," he said. "It would be a
+boon to us. Will you excuse me for a moment?"
+
+And opening a door, he called for his wife, who was trying to keep the
+two children quiet there, having retired with them hastily when Mr.
+Thorndyke was announced.
+
+"What do you think, Emma?" her husband said excitedly, as she came into
+the room. "Mr. Thorndyke has been good enough to offer me the living of
+Crowswood."
+
+Then he recovered himself. "I beg your pardon, sir, for my
+unmannerliness in not first introducing my wife to you."
+
+"It was natural that you should think of telling her the news first of
+all," the Squire said courteously. "Madam, I am your obedient servant,
+and I hope that soon we shall get to know each other well. I consider
+it of great importance that the Squire of a parish and the Rector should
+work well together, and see a great deal of each other. I don't know
+whether you are aware, Mr. Greg, that the living is worth 200 pounds
+a year, besides which there is a paddock of about ten acres, which is
+sufficient for the keep of a horse and cow. The Rectory is a comfortable
+one, and I have arranged with Mr. Bastow that he shall leave his
+furniture for the benefit of his successor. It will include linen, so
+that you will be put to no expense whatever in moving in. I have known
+these first expenses to seriously cripple the usefulness of a clergyman
+when appointed to a living."
+
+"That is good of you indeed, Mr. Thorndyke," the curate said. "We have
+been living in these lodgings since we first came here, and it will
+indeed make matters easy to have the question of furniture so kindly
+settled for us."
+
+"Will your Rector be able to release you shortly?"
+
+"I have no doubt that he will do that at once. His son has just left
+Oxford and taken deacon's orders; and the Rector told me the other day
+that he should be glad if I would look out for another curacy, as he
+wanted to have his son here with him. He spoke very kindly, and said
+that he should make no change until I could hear of a place to suit
+me. His son has been assisting him for the last month, since I took the
+services at Crowswood, and I am sure he would release me at once."
+
+"Then I should be glad if you will move up as soon as possible to the
+Rectory. I know nothing about the necessary forms, but I suppose that
+Mr. Bastow will send in his resignation to the Bishop, and I shall
+write and tell him that I have appointed you, and you can continue to
+officiate as you have done lately until you can be formally inducted
+as the Rector. Perhaps you would not mind going round to your Rector
+at once and telling him of the offer you have had. I have one or two
+matters to do in the town, and will call again in three quarters of
+an hour. I shall be glad to tell Mr. Bastow that you will come into
+residence at once."
+
+On returning at the appointed time he found that the curate had
+returned.
+
+"Mr. Pilkington was very kind, and evidently very pleased; he
+congratulated me most warmly, and I can come up at once. We don't know
+how to thank you enough, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"I don't want any thanks, I can assure you, Mr. Greg. Tomorrow I will
+send a couple of women in from the village to get the place in order,
+and no doubt Mr. Bastow will want to take away a few things. He is going
+to remain with me as tutor to my son. I am sure you and I will get on
+very well together, and I only hope that your sermons will be no longer
+when you are Rector than they have been while you have been assisting
+us. Long sermons may do for a town congregation, but in my opinion they
+are a very serious mistake in the case of a village one. By the way, I
+think it would be as well for you to get a servant here, and that before
+you go up. Mr. Bastow's servant was an old woman, and in a case like
+this I always think it is better not to take one's predecessor's
+servant. She generally resents any change, and is always quoting how
+her last master had things. I mention this before you go, because she
+is sure to ask to stay on, and it is much easier to say that you are
+bringing a servant with you than to have to tell her she is too old or
+too fat. Don't you think so, Mrs. Greg?"
+
+"Yes, I think it will be much better, Mr. Thorndyke. Even if I cannot
+hear of one likely to suit us permanently, I will take someone as a stop
+gap. One can easily change afterwards."
+
+"The old woman will do very well," the Squire said. "She has two married
+daughters in the village, and with a shilling or two from the parish she
+will manage comfortably. At any rate we shall look after her, and I have
+no doubt Mr. Bastow will make her an allowance."
+
+Never were a pair more delighted than Parson Greg and his wife when two
+days later they took possession of their new home. Half a dozen women
+had been at work the day before, and everything was in perfect order. To
+Mrs. Greg's relief she found that the old servant had already gone, the
+Squire having himself informed her that Mrs. Greg would bring her own
+maid with her. Mr. Bastow said that he would allow her half a crown a
+week as long as she lived, and the Squire added as much more, and as the
+woman had saved a good deal during her twenty years' service with the
+Rector, she was perfectly satisfied.
+
+"It is a good thing that she should be content," the Squire said to Mr.
+Bastow. "She has a lot of connections in the village, and if she had
+gone away with a sense of grievance she might have created a good deal
+of ill feeling against your successor, and I am very anxious that he
+should begin well. I like the young fellow, and I like his wife."
+
+"We are fortunate, indeed, Ernest," Mrs. Greg said the following
+morning, as with the children, two and three years old, they went out
+into the garden; where the trees were laden with apples, pears, and
+plums. "What a change from our little rooms in Reigate. I should think
+that anyone ought to be happy indeed here."
+
+"They ought to be, Emma, but you see Mr. Bastow had trouble enough; and
+it should be a lesson to us, dear, to look very closely after the boys
+now they are young, and see that they don't make bad acquaintances."
+
+"From what we hear of the village, there is little fear of that; the
+mischief must have begun before Mr. Thorndyke came down, when by all
+accounts things had altogether gone to the bad here, and of course young
+Bastow must have had an exceptionally evil disposition, Ernest."
+
+"Yes, no doubt; but his father could not have looked after him properly.
+I believe, from what I hear, that Bastow was so dispirited at his
+powerlessness to put a stop to the state of things here, that, except to
+perform service, he seldom left the house, and the boy no doubt grew up
+altogether wild. You know that I was in court on the second day of the
+examination, and the young fellow's insolence and bearing astonished
+and shocked me. Happily, we have the Squire here now to back us up, the
+village has been completely cleared of all bad characters, and is by all
+accounts quite a model place, and we must do our best to keep it so."
+
+The news of the change at the Rectory naturally occasioned a great deal
+of talk. At first there was a general feeling of regret that Mr. Bastow
+had gone, and yet it was felt that he could not have been expected to
+stay; the month's experience that they had had of the new parson had
+cleared the way for him. He and his wife soon made themselves familiar
+with the villagers, and being bright young people, speedily made
+themselves liked. The Squire and Mrs. Cunningham called the first
+afternoon after their arrival.
+
+"You must always send up if anything is wanted, Mr. Greg; whenever
+there is any illness in the village we always keep a stock of soups and
+jellies, and Mrs. Cunningham is almoner in general. Is there anything
+that we can do for you? If so, let me know without hesitation."
+
+"Indeed, there is nothing, Mr. Thorndyke. It is marvelous to us coming
+in here and finding everything that we can possibly want."
+
+"You will want a boy for your garden; and you cannot do better than take
+young Bill Summers. He was with me for a bit last year, when the boy I
+have now was laid up with mumps or something of that sort, and he was
+very favorably reported on as being handy in the garden, able to milk
+a cow, and so on. By the way, Mrs. Greg, I have taken the liberty of
+sending down a cow in milk. I expect she is in your meadow now. I have
+seven or eight of them, and if you will send her back when her milk
+fails I will send down another."
+
+"You are too kind altogether, Mr. Thorndyke!" Mrs. Greg exclaimed.
+
+"Not at all. I want to see things comfortable here, and you will find it
+difficult to get on without a cow. I keep two or three for the special
+use of the village. I make them pay for it, halfpenny a pint; it is
+better to do that than to give it. It is invaluable for the children;
+and I don't think in all England you see rosier and healthier youngsters
+than those in our schools. You will sometimes find milk useful for
+puddings and that sort of thing for the sick; and they will appreciate
+it all the more than if they had to look solely to us for their supply."
+
+"How is Mr. Bastow, sir?"
+
+"He is better than could be expected. He himself proposed this morning
+that my boy Mark should begin his studies at once; and, indeed, now
+that the worst is over and he has got rid of the load of care on his
+shoulders, I hope that we shall have him bright and cheerful again
+before long."
+
+Such was indeed the case. For some little time Mr. Bastow avoided the
+village, but John Thorndyke got him to go down with him to call upon
+Mr. Greg, and afterwards to walk through it with him. At first he went
+timidly and shrinkingly, but the kindly greetings of the women he met,
+and the children stopping to pull a forelock or bob a courtesy as of
+old, gradually cheered him up, and he soon got accustomed to the change,
+and would of an afternoon go down to the village and chat with the
+women, after he had ascertained that his successor had no objection
+whatever, and was, indeed, pleased that he still took an interest in his
+former parishioners. Mark was at first disappointed at the arrangement,
+for he had looked forward to going to a public school. His father,
+however, had no great trouble in reconciling him to it.
+
+"Of course, Mark," he said, "there are advantages in a public school.
+I was never at one myself, but I believe that, though the discipline is
+pretty strict, there is a great deal of fun and sport, and you may make
+desirable acquaintances. Upon the other hand, there are drawbacks. In
+the first place, the majority of the boys are sons of richer men than
+I am. I don't know that that would matter much, but it would give you
+expensive habits, and perhaps make you fonder of London life than I
+should care about. In the next place, you see, you would be at school
+when the shooting begins, and you are looking forward to carrying a gun
+next year. The same with hunting. You know I promised that this year you
+should go to the meets on your pony, and see as much of them as you can,
+and of course when you were at school you would only be able to indulge
+in these matters during your holidays; and if a hard frost set in, as
+is the case three times out of four, just as you came home, you would be
+out of it altogether.
+
+"I must say I should like you to have a real love of field sports and to
+be a good shot and a good rider. A man, however wide his acres may be,
+is thought but little of in the country if he is not a good sportsman;
+and, moreover, there is nothing better for developing health and muscles
+than riding, and tramping over the fields with a gun on your shoulder;
+and, lastly, you must not forget, Mark, that one of my objects in making
+this arrangement is to keep Mr. Bastow with us. I am sure that unless
+he thought that he was making himself useful he would not be content
+to remain here; and at his age, you know, it would be hard for him to
+obtain clerical employment."
+
+"All right, father. I see that the present plan is the best, and that I
+should have but little sport if I went away to school. Besides, I like
+Mr. Bastow very much, and I am quite sure that I shan't get so many
+whackings from him as I used to do from old Holbrook."
+
+"I fancy not, Mark," his father said with a smile. "I am not against
+wholesome discipline, but I think it can be carried too far; at any
+rate, I hope you will be just as obedient to Mr. Bastow as if he always
+had a cane on the table beside him."
+
+Mark, therefore, went to work in a cheerful spirit, and soon found that
+he made more progress in a week under Mr. Bastow's gentle tuition than
+he had done in a month under the vigorous discipline of his former
+master. Mr. and Mrs. Greg dined regularly at the Squire's once a week.
+
+"Have you had that Indian servant of yours long, Mr. Thorndyke?" Mrs.
+Greg asked one day. "He is a strange looking creature. Of course, in
+the daytime, when one sees him about in ordinary clothes, one does not
+notice him so much; but of an evening, in that Eastern costume of his,
+he looks very strange."
+
+"He was the servant of the Colonel, my brother," the Squire replied. "He
+brought him over from India with him. The man had been some years in his
+service, and was very attached to him, and had saved his life more than
+once, he told me. On one occasion he caught a cobra by the neck as it
+was about to strike my brother's hand as he sat at table; he carried it
+out into the compound, as George called it, but which means, he told me,
+garden, and there let it escape. Another time he caught a Thug, which
+means a sort of robber who kills his victims by strangling before
+robbing them. They are a sort of sect who regard strangling as a
+religious action, greatly favored by the bloodthirsty goddess they
+worship. He was in the act of fastening the twisted handkerchief, used
+for the purpose, round my brother's neck, when Ramoo cut him down. The
+closest shave, though, was when George, coming down the country, was
+pounced upon by a tiger and carried off. Ramoo seized a couple of
+muskets from the men, and rushed into the jungle after him, and coming
+up with the brute killed him at the first shot. George escaped with a
+broken arm and his back laid open by a scratch of the tiger's claws as
+it first seized him.
+
+"So at George's death I took Ramoo on, and have found him a most useful
+fellow. Of course, I was some little time before I became accustomed
+to his noiseless way of going about, and it used to make me jump when
+I happened to look round, and saw him standing quietly behind me when
+I thought I was quite alone. However, as soon as I became accustomed to
+him, I got over all that, and now I would not lose him for anything; he
+seems to know instinctively what I want. He is excellent as a waiter and
+valet; I should feel almost lost without him now; and the clumping about
+of an English man servant would annoy me as much as his noiseless way of
+going about did at first. He has come to speak English very fairly. Of
+course, my brother always talked to him in his own tongue; still, he had
+picked up enough English for me to get on with; now he speaks it quite
+fluently. When I have nothing whatever for him to do he devotes himself
+to my little ward. She is very fond of him, and it is quite pretty to
+see them together in the garden. Altogether, I would not part with him
+for anything."
+
+For some years life passed uneventfully at Crowswood. It was seldom
+indeed that the Squire's authority was needed to set matters right in
+the village. The substitution of good farmers for shiftless ones in
+some of the farms, and the better cultivation generally, had given
+more employment; and as John Thorndyke preferred keeping two or three
+cottages shut up rather than have them occupied by men for whom no work
+could be found, it was rare indeed that there were any complaints
+of scarcity of work, except, indeed, on the part of the Rector, who
+declared that, what with the healthiness of the village and the absence
+of want, his occupation, save for the Sunday duty, was a sinecure. Mr.
+Bastow was more happy and much brighter than he had been for many years.
+The occupation of teaching suited him, and he was able to make the work
+pleasant to his pupil as well as to himself; indeed, it occupied but a
+small portion of the day, the amount of learning considered necessary
+at the time not being extensive. A knowledge of Greek was thought
+quite superfluous for a country gentleman. Science was in its infancy,
+mathematics a subject only to be taken up by those who wanted to obtain
+a college fellowship. Latin, however, was considered an essential, and a
+knack of apt quotation from the Latin poets an accomplishment that
+every man who was a member of society or aspired to enter Parliament
+was expected to possess. Thus Mark Thorndyke's lessons lasted but two or
+three hours a day, and the school term was a movable period, according
+to the season of the year and the engagements of the Squire and Mark. In
+winter the evening was the time, so that the boy shot with his father,
+or rode to the hounds, or, as he got older, joined in shooting parties
+at the houses of neighbors.
+
+In summer the work was done in the morning, but was not unfrequently
+broken. Mark went off at a very early hour to drive perhaps some twenty
+miles with his great chum, Dick Chetwynd, for a long day's fishing, or
+to see a main of cocks fought or a fight between the champions of two
+neighboring villages, or perhaps some more important battle.
+
+When Millicent Conyers was ten years old she came regularly into the
+study, sitting curled up in a deep chair, getting up her lessons while
+Mark did his, and then changing seats with him while he learned his
+Horace or Ovid by heart. At this time she looked up greatly to him, and
+was his companion whenever he would allow her to be, fetched and carried
+for him, and stood almost on a level with his dogs in his estimation.
+Five years later, when Mark was eighteen, these relations changed
+somewhat. He now liked to have her with him, not only when about the
+house and garden, but when he took short rides she cantered along on her
+pony by his side. She was a bright faced girl, full of life and fun, and
+rejoicing in a far greater amount of freedom than most girls of her age
+and time.
+
+"It is really time that she should learn to comport herself more
+staidly, instead of running about like a wild thing," Mrs. Cunningham
+said, one day, as she and the Squire stood after breakfast looking out
+of the open window at Mark and Millicent.
+
+"Time enough, my dear lady, time enough. Let her enjoy life while she
+can. I am not in favor of making a young kitten behave like an old
+tabby; every creature in nature is joyful and frolicsome while it is
+young. She is as tall and as straight as any of her friends of the same
+age, and looks more healthy; she will tame down in time, and I dare say
+walk and look as prim and demure as they do. I was watching them the
+other day when there was a party of them up here, and I thought the
+difference was all to her advantage. She looked a natural, healthy girl;
+they looked like a set of overdressed dolls, afraid to move or to talk
+loud, or to stretch their mouths when they smile; very ladylike and
+nice, no doubt, but you will see Millicent will throw them into the
+shade when she is once past the tomboy age. Leave her alone, Mrs.
+Cunningham; a girl is not like a fruit tree, that wants pruning and
+training from its first year; it will be quite time to get her into
+shape when she has done growing."
+
+John Thorndyke had occasionally made inquiries of Mr. Bastow as to
+the whereabouts of his son. At the time the sentence was passed
+transportation to the American colonies was being discontinued, and
+until other arrangements could be made hulks were established as places
+of confinement and punishment; but a few months later Arthur Bastow
+was one of the first batch of convicts sent out to the penal settlement
+formed on the east coast of Australia. This was intended to be fixed
+at Botany Bay, but it having been found that this bay was open and
+unsheltered, it was established at Sydney, although for many years the
+settlement retained in England the name of the original site. As the
+condition of the prisoners kept in the hulks was deplorable, the Squire
+had, through the influence of Sir Charles Harris, obtained the inclusion
+of Bastow's name among the first batch of those who were to sail for
+Australia. Mr. Bastow obtained permission to see his son before sailing,
+but returned home much depressed, for he had been assailed with such
+revolting and blasphemous language by him that he had been forced to
+retire in horror at the end of a few minutes.
+
+"We have done well in getting him sent off," the Squire said, when he
+heard the result of the interview. "In the first place, the demoralizing
+effect of these hulks is quite evident, and it may be hoped that in a
+new country, where there can be no occasion for the convicts to be pent
+up together, things may be better; for although escapes from the hulks
+are not frequent, they occasionally take place, and had he gained
+his liberty we should have had an anxious time of it until he was
+re-arrested, whereas out there there is nowhere to go to, no possibility
+of committing a crime. It is not there as it was in the American colony.
+Settlements may grow up in time, but at present there are no white
+men whatever settled in the district; and the natives are, they say,
+hostile, and were a convict to escape he would almost certainly be
+killed, and possibly eaten. No doubt by the time your son has served
+his sentence colonies will be established out there, and he may then be
+disposed to settle there, either on a piece of land of which he could no
+doubt take up or in the service of one of the colonists."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V.
+
+
+The scene in the convict yard at Sydney, five years after its foundation
+as a penal settlement, was not a pleasant one to the lover of humanity.
+Warders armed to the teeth were arranging gangs that were to go out to
+labor on the roads. Many of the convicts had leg irons, but so fastened
+as to be but slight hindrance to their working powers, but the majority
+were unironed. These were the better behaved convicts; not that this
+would be judged from their faces, for the brutalizing nature of the
+system and the close association of criminals had placed its mark on
+all, and it would have been difficult for the most discriminating to
+have made any choice between the most hardened criminals and those who
+had been sent out for what would now be considered comparatively trivial
+offenses. The voyage on board ship had done much to efface distinctions,
+the convict life had done more, and the chief difference between the
+chained and unchained prisoners was that the latter were men of more
+timid disposition than many of their companions, and therefore less
+disposed to give trouble that would entail heavy punishment. But it
+was only the comparatively well conducted men who were placed upon road
+work; the rest were retained for work inside the jail, or were caged in
+solitary confinement. Each morning a number, varying from half a dozen
+to a dozen, were fastened up and flogged, in some cases with merciless
+severity, but it was seldom that a cry was uttered by these, the most
+brutal ruffians of the convict herd. This spectacle was just over: it
+was conducted in public for the edification of the rest, but, judging
+from the low laughs and brutal jests, uttered below the breath, it
+signally failed in producing the desired impression. Two of those who
+had suffered the severest punishment were now putting on their
+coarse woolen garments over their bloodstained shoulders; both were
+comparatively young men.
+
+"I shall not stand this much longer," one muttered. "I will brain a
+warder, and get hung for it. One can but die once, while one can get
+flogged once a week."
+
+"So would I," the other said bitterly; "but I have some scores to settle
+in England, and I am not going to put my head in a noose until I have
+wiped them out. The sooner we make arrangements to get back there the
+better."
+
+"Yes, we have talked of this before," the other said, "and I quite
+agreed with you that if we all had the pluck of men we ought to be able
+to overpower the warders, in spite of their firearms. Of course some
+of us would get killed, but no one would mind that if there was but the
+remotest chance of getting away. The question is what we should do with
+ourselves when we were once outside the prison. Of course I know that
+there are two or three hundred settlers, but there would not be much
+to be got out of them, and life among those black fellows, even if they
+were civil to us, which I don't suppose they would be, would not be
+worth having."
+
+"We might not have to stay there long; ships with stores or settlers
+arrive occasionally, and if a lot of us got away we might seize one by
+force, turn pirates for a bit, and when we are tired of that sail to
+some South American port, sell our capture, and make our way home to
+England. If we were not strong enough to take her, we could hide up on
+board her; we should be sure to find some fellow who for a pound or two
+would be willing to help us. The thing can be done if we make up our
+minds to do it, and I for one have made up my mind to try. I haven't
+chalked out a plan yet, but I am convinced that it is to be done."
+
+"I am with you, whatever it is," the other said; "and I think there are
+twenty or thirty we could rely on. I don't say there are more than that,
+because there are a lot of white livered cusses among them who would
+inform against us at once, so as to get their own freedom as a reward
+for doing so. Well, we will both think it over, mate, and the sooner the
+better."
+
+The two men who were thus talking together were both by birth above the
+common herd of convicts, and had gained a considerable ascendency over
+the others because of their reckless indifference to punishment and
+their defiance of authority. Few of the men knew each other's real
+names; by the officials they were simply known by numbers, while among
+themselves each had a slang name generally gained on board ship.
+
+Separation there had, of course, been impossible, and when fastened down
+below each had told his story with such embellishments as he chose to
+give it, and being but little interfered with by their guards, save
+to insure the impossibility of a mutiny, there had been fights of a
+desperate kind. Four or five dead bodies had been found and thrown
+overboard, but as none would testify as to who had been the assailants
+none were punished for it; and so the strongest and most desperate had
+enforced their authority over the others, as wild beasts might do, and
+by the time they had reached their destination all were steeped much
+deeper in wickedness and brutalism than when they set sail.
+
+The two men who were speaking together had speedily become chums, and,
+though much younger than the majority of the prisoners, had by their
+recklessness and ferocity established an ascendency among the others.
+This ascendency had been maintained after their arrival by their
+constant acts of insubordination, and by their apparent indifference to
+the punishment awarded them. At night the convicts were lodged in wooden
+buildings, where, so long as they were not riotous, they were allowed to
+talk and converse freely, as indeed was the case when their work for the
+day was done.
+
+As to any attempt at escape, the authorities had but small anxiety, for
+until the arrival of the first settlers, three years after that of
+the convicts, there was nowhere a fugitive could go to, no food to be
+obtained, no shelter save among the blacks, who were always ready for
+a reward of tobacco and spirits to hand them over at once to the
+authorities. The case had but slightly changed since the settlement
+began to grow. It was true that by stealing sheep or driving off a few
+head of cattle a fugitive might maintain himself for a time, but even if
+not shot down by the settlers or patrols, he would be sure before long
+to be brought in by the blacks.
+
+The experiment had already been tried of farming our better conducted
+convicts to the settlers, and indeed it was the prospect of obtaining
+such cheap labor that had been the main inducement to many of the
+colonists to establish themselves so far from home, instead of going to
+America. As a whole the system worked satisfactorily; the men were
+as much prisoners as were the inmates of the jail, for they knew well
+enough that were they to leave the farmers and take to the bush they
+would remain free but a short time, being either killed or handed over
+by the blacks, and in the latter case they would be severely punished
+and set to prison work in irons, with labor very much more severe than
+that they were called upon to do on the farms.
+
+Some little time after the conversation between the two convicts the
+prison authorities were congratulating themselves upon the fact that a
+distinct change had taken or was taking place in the demeanor of many of
+the men who had hitherto been the most troublesome, and they put it down
+to the unusually severe floggings that had been inflicted on the two
+most refractory prisoners in the establishment. When in the prison
+yard or at work they were more silent than before, and did their tasks
+doggedly and sullenly; there was no open defiance to the authorities,
+and, above all, a marked cessation of drunkenness from the spirits
+smuggled into the place.
+
+Only the two originators were aware of the extent of the plot; for they
+had agreed that only by keeping every man in ignorance as to who had
+joined it could they hope to escape treachery. In the first place,
+they had taken into their confidence a dozen men on whom they could
+absolutely rely. Beyond this they had approached the others singly,
+beginning by hinting that there was a plot for escape, and that a good
+many were concerned, and telling them that these had bound themselves
+together by a solemn oath to kill any traitor, even if hanged for it.
+
+"No one is to know who is in it and who is not," the leaders said to
+each recruit. "Every new man will be closely watched by the rest, and if
+he has any communication privately with a warder or any other official
+he will be found strangled the next morning; no one will know who did
+it. Even if he succeeded in eluding the vigilance of his comrades at the
+time, it would soon be known; for if indulgence of any kind was shown
+towards one man, or he was relieved from his ordinary work, or even
+freed altogether and suddenly, he would be a dead man in twenty-four
+hours, for we have friends outside among the ticket of leave men who
+have bound themselves to kill at once any man set free."
+
+To the question, "What do you intend to do when we get off?" the answer
+was, "We shall go straight to the bush, so as to avoid a fight with the
+soldiers, in the first place; then we shall join that night, and drive
+off all the cattle and sheep from the settlements, take possession of
+every firearm found in the houses, then move off a couple of hundred
+miles or so into the bush, and establish a settlement of our own.
+
+"Of course, we shall take horses and clothes and any spirits and food
+we may find. If the soldiers pursue us, we will fight them; but as there
+are only three or four companies of them, and we shall be eight hundred
+strong, we shall very soon show them that they had better leave us
+alone.
+
+"Oh, yes, no doubt they will send more soldiers out from England, but
+it will be over a year before they can get here; and we propose after we
+have done with the fellows here to break up into parties of twenty and
+thirty, dividing the sheep and cattle among us, and each party going
+where it will. The place is of tremendous size, as big as a dozen
+Englands, they say, and each party will fix a place it fancies, where
+there is good water and a river with fish and so on, and we may live all
+our lives comfortably, with just enough work to raise potatoes and corn,
+and to watch our stock increasing. Anyhow, we might calculate on having
+some years of peace and freedom, and even if in the end they searched
+us all out, which would be very unlikely, they could but bring us back,
+hang a few, and set the rest to work again; but we think that they would
+most likely leave us alone altogether, quite satisfied with having got
+rid of us."
+
+"Those who liked it could, no doubt, take wives among the blacks. The
+convict women who are out on service with the settlers would, you may
+be sure, join us at once, and an enterprising chap who preferred a white
+woman to a black could always make his way down here and persuade one to
+go off with him to his farm. That is the general plan; if many get tired
+of the life they have only to come down to Sydney, hide up near the
+place on some dark night, and go down to the port, seize a ship, and
+make off in her, compelling the officers and sailors to take them and
+land them at any port they fancy, either in Chili, Peru, or Mexico, or,
+if they like, sail west and make for Rio or Buenos Ayres or one of the
+West Indian islands. As to when it is going to be done, or how it is
+going to be done, no one will be told till it is ready to be carried
+out. We have not settled that ourselves, and thus one who was fool
+enough to risk certain death could tell the Governor no more than that
+there was a plot on hand, and that the man who had sworn him in was
+concerned in it."
+
+So one by one every man in the prison was sworn by a terrible oath to
+secrecy, to watch his companions, and to report anything that looked
+suspicious. Many joined willingly, the prospect of relief, even should
+it only be temporary, being too fascinating to be resisted. Some joined
+against their will, fearing that a refusal to do so would be punished
+by death; and the fact that two or three men were found strangled in bed
+had a very great effect in inducing others to join in the plot.
+
+These deaths caused some uneasiness to the authorities. Their utmost
+endeavors failed to discover who were the perpetrators of these
+murders; and even when everyone in the same hut was flogged to obtain
+information, not one opened his lips.
+
+One night the word was passed round that the time had come. One only in
+each hut was familiar with the details, and he gave instructions to each
+man individually as to what he was to do. The date had been determined
+by the fact that the time which they had been sentenced to wear irons
+had terminated the day before, and their unusually subdued and quiet
+demeanor having carried them through the interval without, as usual,
+fresh punishments being awarded them before the termination of the
+former one.
+
+In the morning the whole of the convicts were drawn up to witness the
+flogging of the inmates of one of the huts, where a man had been found
+strangled the morning before. The first prisoner was taken to the
+triangle, stripped to the waist, and tied up. There was a dead silence
+in the ranks of the convicts, but as the first blow fell upon his
+shoulders there was a loud yell, and simultaneously the whole ranks
+broke up, and a number of men sprang upon each of the warders, wrested
+their muskets from them, and threw them to the ground. Then there was a
+rush towards the Governor and officers, who were assembled in front
+of the stone house that faced the open end of the square. Firing their
+pistols, these at once took refuge in the house, three or four falling
+under the scattered fire that was opened as soon as the muskets of the
+warders fell into the hands of the convicts.
+
+Directly the doors were closed the officers appeared at the windows, and
+opened a rifle fire upon the convicts, as did the guards near the gate.
+As comparatively few of the convicts had muskets, they began to waver at
+once. But, headed by the two ringleaders, the armed party rushed at the
+guard, shot them down, and threw open the gate.
+
+Then an unexpected thing occurred. The soldiers from the barracks
+happened to be marching down to do target practice on the shore, and
+were passing the convict prison when the firing broke out. They were
+at once halted, and ordered to load, and as the convicts, with exultant
+shouts, poured through the gate they saw a long line of soldiers, with
+leveled muskets, facing them.
+
+"At them!" one of the leaders shouted. "It is too late to draw back now.
+We have got to break through them."
+
+Many of the convicts ran back into the yard; but those armed with
+muskets, the more desperate of the party, followed their leaders. A
+moment later a heavy volley rang out, and numbers of the convicts fell.
+Their two leaders, however, and some twenty of their followers, keeping
+in a close body, rushed at the line of soldiers with clubbed muskets,
+and with the suddenness and fury of the rush burst their way through
+the line, and then scattering, fled across the country, pursued by a
+dropping fire of musketry.
+
+The officers in command, seeing that but a fraction had escaped, ordered
+one company to pursue, and marched the rest into the prison yard. It was
+already deserted; the convicts had scattered to their huts, those who
+had arms throwing them away. Dotted here and there over the square were
+the bodies of eight or ten convicts and as many warders, whose skulls
+had been smashed in by their infuriated assailants as soon as they had
+obtained possession of their muskets. Close to the gate lay the six
+soldiers who had furnished the guard; these were all dead or mortally
+wounded.
+
+The Governor and the officials issued from the house as soon as the
+soldiers entered the yard. The first step to do was to turn all the
+convicts out of the huts and to iron them. No resistance was attempted,
+the sight of the soldiers completely cowing the mutineers. When the
+bodies of the convicts that had fallen were counted and the roll of the
+prisoners called over, it was found that eighteen were missing, and of
+these six were during the course of the next hour or two brought in by
+the soldiers who had gone in pursuit of them. The rest had escaped.
+
+The convicts were all questioned separately, and the tales they told
+agreed so closely that the Governor could not doubt that they were
+speaking the truth. All had been sworn in by one of two men, and knew
+nothing whatever of what was intended to be done that day, until after
+they were locked up on the evening previous. Each of those in the huts
+had received his instructions the night before from the one man.
+
+There were eighteen huts, each containing fifteen convicts. Of the men
+who had given instructions six had fallen outside the gate, together
+with sixteen others; five had been overtaken and brought in; altogether,
+twelve were still at large. Among these were the two leaders. The next
+day six of the prisoners were tried and executed. The rest were punished
+only by a reduction in their rations; sentence of death was at the same
+time passed upon the twelve still at large, so as to save the trouble of
+a succession of trials as they were caught and brought in.
+
+The two leaders had kept together after they had broken through the line
+of soldiers.
+
+"Things have gone off well," one said as they ran through. "Those
+soldiers nearly spoilt it all."
+
+"Yes, that was unlucky," the other agreed; "but so far as we are
+concerned, which is all we care about, I think things have turned out
+for the best."
+
+Nothing more was said until they had far outstripped their pursuers,
+hampered as these were by their uniforms and belts.
+
+"You mean that it is not such a bad thing that they have not all got
+away?"
+
+"Yes, that is what I mean. It is all very well to tell them about
+driving off the sheep and cattle and horses, and going to start a colony
+on our own account, but the soldiers would have been up to us before we
+had gone a day's journey. Most of the fellows would have bolted directly
+they saw them. As it is, I fancy only about a dozen have got away,
+perhaps not as many as that, and they are all men that one can rely
+upon. One can feed a dozen without difficulty--a sheep a day would do
+it--and by giving a turn to each of the settlers, the animals won't be
+missed. Besides, we shall want money if we are ever to get out of this
+cursed country. It would not be difficult to get enough for you and me,
+but when it comes to a large number the sack of the whole settlement
+would not go very far.
+
+"My own idea is that we had best join the others tonight, kill a few
+sheep, and go two or three days' march into the bush, until the heat of
+the pursuit is over. We are all armed, the blacks would not venture to
+attack us, and the soldiers would not be likely to pursue us very far.
+In a week or so, when we can assume that matters have cooled down a bit,
+we can come down again. We know all the shepherds, and even if they were
+not disposed to help us they would not dare to betray us, or report a
+sheep or two being missing. Of course, we shall have to be very careful
+to shift our quarters frequently. Those black trackers are sure to be
+sent out pretty often."
+
+"As long as we are hanging about the settlements there won't be much
+fear of our being bothered by the blacks. Of course, we shall have to
+decide later on whether it will be best for us to try and seize a ship,
+all of us acting together, or for us to get quietly on board one and
+keep under hatches until she is well away. That is the plan I fancy
+most."
+
+"So do I. In the first place the chances are that in the next two or
+three months at least half the fellows will be picked up. To begin with,
+several of them are sure to get hold of liquor and make attacks upon the
+settlers, in which case some of them, anyhow, are sure to get killed. In
+the next place, most of them were brought up as thieves in the slums of
+London, and will have no more idea of roughing it in a country like this
+than of behaving themselves if they were transported to a London drawing
+room. Therefore, I am pretty sure that at the end of three months we
+shall not be able to reckon on half of them. Well, six men are not
+enough to capture a ship, or, if they do capture it, to keep the crew
+under. One must sleep sometimes, and with only three or four men on deck
+we could not hope to keep a whole ship's crew at bay."
+
+"Then there is another reason. You and I, when we have got a decent rig
+out, could pass anywhere without exciting observation; while if we had
+half a dozen of the others, whatever their good qualities, they would be
+noticed at once by their villainous faces, and if questions were to be
+asked we should be likely to find ourselves in limbo again in a very
+short time. So I am all for working on our own account, even if the
+whole of the others were ready to back us; but, of course, we must keep
+on good terms with them all, and breathe no word that we think that each
+man had better shift for himself. Some of those fellows, if they thought
+we had any idea of leaving them, would go straight into Sydney and
+denounce us, although they would know that they themselves would be
+likely to swing at the same time."
+
+As none of the convicts were acquainted with the bush, they had been
+obliged to select as their rendezvous a hut two miles out of the town,
+where the convict gangs that worked on the road were in the habit of
+leaving their tools. On the way there the two men killed a couple of
+sheep from a flock whose position they had noticed before it became
+dark. These they skinned, cut off the heads, and left them behind,
+carrying the sheep on their shoulders to the meeting.
+
+"Is that you, Captain Wild?" a voice said as they approached.
+
+"Yes; Gentleman Dick is with me."
+
+"That is a good job. We had begun to think that the soldiers had caught
+you."
+
+"They would not have caught us alive, you may take your oath. How many
+are there of us here?"
+
+"Ten of us, Captain. I think that that is all there are."
+
+"That is enough for our purpose. Has anyone got anything to eat?"
+
+There was a deep growl in the negative.
+
+"Well, we have brought a couple of sheep with us, and as we have carried
+them something like a mile, you had better handle them by turns. We will
+strike off into the bush and put another three or four miles between us
+and the jail, and then light a fire and have a meal."
+
+Two of the men came forward and took the sheep. Then they turned off
+from the road, and taking their direction from a star, followed it for
+an hour.
+
+"I think we have got far enough now," the man called Captain Wild said.
+"You had better cut down the bushes, and we will make a fire."
+
+"But how are we to light it?" one of them exclaimed in a tone of
+consternation. "I don't suppose we have got flint and steel or tinder
+box among us."
+
+"Oh, we can manage that!" the Captain said. "Get a heap of dried leaves
+here first, then some wood, and we will soon have a blaze."
+
+His orders were obeyed. Some of the men had carried off the warders'
+swords as well as their muskets, and now used them for chopping wood.
+As soon as a small pile of dried leaves was gathered the Captain broke
+a cartridge and sprinkled half its contents among them, and then dropped
+the remainder into his musket. He flashed this off among the leaves, and
+a bright flame at once shot up, and in five minutes a fire was burning.
+
+One of the sheep was soon cut up, the meat hacked in slices from the
+bones, a ramrod was thrust through the pieces, and, supported by four
+sticks, was laid across the fire. Three other similarly laden spits
+were soon placed beside it, and in a short time the meat was ready for
+eating. Until a hearty meal had been made there was but little talking.
+
+"That is first rate," one of the men said, as he wiped his mouth with
+the back of his hand. "Now one only wants a pipe and bacca and a glass
+of grog, to feel comfortable."
+
+"Well, Captain, are you satisfied with the day's work?"
+
+"It would have been a grand day had it not been for the soldiers passing
+just at the time. As it is, Gentleman Dick and I have been agreeing that
+as far as we are all concerned it has not turned out so badly. There
+would have been a lot of difficulty in finding food if we had all got
+away, and some of those mealy mouthed fellows would have been sure to go
+back and peach on us at the first opportunity. A dozen is better than a
+hundred for the sort of life we are likely to lead for some time. We are
+strong enough to beat off any attack from the black fellows, and also to
+break into any of these settlers' houses.
+
+"We can, when we have a mind to, take a stray sheep now and then, or
+even a bullock would scarcely be missed, especially if our pals in the
+settlement will lend us a helping hand, which you may be sure they will
+do; in fact, they would know better than to refuse. Then a large party
+could be traced by those black trackers at a run, while a small one
+would not; especially if, as we certainly will do, we break up into twos
+and threes for a time. First of all, though, we must go well into the
+bush; at daybreak tomorrow morning we will drive off twenty sheep, and
+go right away a hundred miles, and wait there till matters have settled
+down. They will never take the troops out that distance after us. Then
+we can come back again, and hang about the settlement and take what we
+want. The wild blacks don't come near there, and we shall be safer in
+pairs than we should be if we kept together; and of course we could meet
+once a week or so to talk over our plans. We must borrow some whisky,
+flour, tea, tobacco, and a few other items from the settlers, but we had
+better do without them for this trip. I don't want to turn the settlers
+against us, for they have all got horses, and might combine with the
+troops to give chase, so it would be best to leave them alone, at any
+rate till we get back again. Another reason for treating them gently is
+that even if they did not join the troops they might get into a funk,
+and drive their sheep and horses down into Sydney, and then we should
+mighty soon get short of food. It will be quite time enough to draw upon
+them heavily when we make up our minds to get hold of a ship and sail
+away. Money would be of no use to us here, but we shall want it when we
+get to a port, wherever that port may be."
+
+"That sounds right enough, Captain," one of the convicts said, "and just
+at present nothing would suit me better than to get so far away from
+this place that I can lay on my back and take it easy for a spell."
+
+There was a general chorus of assent, and there being neither tobacco
+nor spirits, the party very soon stretched themselves off to sleep round
+the fire.
+
+In the morning they were up before daylight, and half an hour later
+arrived at one of the farms farthest from Sydney. Here they found a
+flock of a hundred sheep. The shepherd came to the door of his hut on
+hearing a noise.
+
+"You had best lie down and go to sleep for the next hour," the leader of
+the convicts said sharply. "We don't want to do an old pal any harm, and
+when you wake up in the morning and find the flock some twenty short, of
+course you won't have any idea what has come of them."
+
+The man nodded and went back into the hut and shut the door, and the
+convicts started for the interior, driving twenty sheep before them.
+
+During the first day's journey they went fast, keeping the sheep at a
+trot before them, and continuing their journey through the heat of the
+day.
+
+"I tell you what, Captain," one of the men said when they halted at
+sunset, "if we don't get to a water hole we shall have to give up this
+idea of going and camping in the bush. My mouth has been like an oven
+all day, and it is no use getting away from jail to die of thirst out
+here."
+
+There had been similar remarks during the day, and the two leaders
+agreed together that it would be madness to push further, and that,
+whatever the risk, they would have to return to the settlements unless
+they could strike water. As they were sitting moodily round the fire
+they were startled by a dozen natives coming forward into the circle
+of light. These held out their hands to say that their intentions were
+peaceful.
+
+"Don't touch your muskets!" Captain Wild exclaimed sharply, as some
+of the men were on the point of jumping to their feet. "The men are
+friendly, and we may be able to get them to guide us to water."
+
+The natives, as they came up, grinned and rubbed their stomachs, to show
+that they were hungry.
+
+"I understand," the Captain said; "you want a sheep, we want water;" and
+he held up his hand to his mouth and lifted his elbow as if in the act
+of drinking.
+
+In two or three minutes the natives understood what he wanted, and
+beckoned to the men to follow. The tired sheep were got onto their legs
+again, and half a mile away the party arrived at a pool in what in wet
+weather was the bed of a river. A sheep was at once handed over to the
+natives, and when the men had satisfied their thirst another sheep was
+killed for their own use.
+
+After a great deal of trouble the natives were made to understand that
+the white men wanted one of their party to go with them as a guide, and
+to take them always to water holes, and a boy of fifteen was handed over
+to them in exchange for two more sheep, and at daybreak the next morning
+they started again for the interior, feeling much exhilarated by the
+piece of luck that had befallen them. They traveled for four days more,
+and then, considering that the soldiers had ceased their pursuit long
+ago, they encamped for ten days, enjoying to the utmost their recovered
+freedom and their immunity from work of any kind. Then they returned
+to the neighborhood of the settlements, and broke up, as their leader
+proposed, into pairs.
+
+They had been there but a short time before the depredations committed
+roused the settlers to band themselves together. Every horse that could
+be spared was lent to the military, who formed a mounted patrol of
+forty men, while parties of infantry, guided by native trackers, were
+constantly on the scent for the convicts.
+
+"This is just what I expected," Captain Wild said to his lieutenant. "It
+was the choice of two evils, and I am not sure that the plan we chose
+was not the worst. We might have been quite sure that these fellows
+would not be able, even for a time, to give up their old ways. If they
+had confined themselves, as we have done, to taking a sheep when they
+wanted it, and behaving civilly when they went to one of the houses and
+begged for a few pounds of flour or tea, the settlers would have made no
+great complaint of us; they know what a hard time we have had, and you
+can see that some of the women were really sorry for us, and gave us
+more than we actually asked for. But it has not been so with the others.
+They had been breaking into houses, stealing every thing they could lay
+their hands upon, and in three or four cases shooting down men on the
+slightest provocation.
+
+"The money and watches were no good to them, but the brutes could not
+help stealing them; so here we are, and the settlement is like a swarm
+of angry bees, and this plan of handing over most of their horses to the
+military will end in all of us being hunted down if we stay here. Two
+were shot yesterday, and in another week we shall all either be killed
+or caught. There is nothing for it but to clear out. I am against
+violence, not on principle, but because in this case it sets people's
+backs up; but it cannot be helped now. We must get a couple of horses
+to ride, and a spare one to carry our swag. We must have half a sack of
+flour and a sheep--it is no use taking more than one, because the meat
+won't keep--and a good stock of tea and sugar. We must get a good supply
+of powder, if we can, some bullets and shot. We shall have to get our
+meat by shooting.
+
+"There is no time to be lost, and tonight we had better go to that
+settler's place nearest the town. He has got two of the best horses out
+here--at least so Redgrave, that shepherd I was talking to today, told
+me--and a well filled store of provisions. If he will let us have them
+without rumpus, all well and good; if not, it will be the worse for
+him. My idea is that we should ride two or three hundred miles along the
+coast until we get to a river, follow it up till we find a tidy place
+for a camp, and stop there for three or four months, then come back
+again and keep ourselves quiet until we find out that a ship is going to
+sail; then we will do a night among the farmhouses, and clean them out
+of their watches and money, manage to get on board, and hide till we
+are well out to sea. We must get a fresh fit out before we go on board;
+these clothes are neither handsome nor becoming. We must put on our best
+manners, and tell them that we are men who have served our full time,
+and want to get back, and that we were obliged to hide because we had
+not enough to pay our full passage money, but that we have enough to pay
+the cost of our grub, and are ready to pull at a rope and make ourselves
+useful in any way. If we are lucky we ought to get enough before we
+start to buy horses and set ourselves up well in business at home."
+
+"I think that is a very good plan," the other agreed, "and I am quite
+sure the sooner we make ourselves scarce here the better."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI.
+
+
+While arranging for young Bastow being sent out with the first batch of
+convicts John Thorndyke had been introduced to several of the officials
+of the Department, and called upon them at intervals to obtain news of
+the penal colony. Three years after its establishment a Crown colony had
+been opened for settlement in its vicinity. As the climate was said to
+be very fine and the country fertile, and land could be taken up without
+payment, the number who went out was considerable, there being the
+additional attraction that convicts of good character would be allotted
+to settlers as servants and farm hands.
+
+Six years after Arthur Bastow sailed the Squire learned that there
+had been a revolt among the convicts; several had been killed, and the
+mutiny suppressed, but about a dozen had succeeded in getting away.
+These had committed several robberies and some murders among the
+settlers, and a military force and a party of warders from the prison
+were scouring the country for them.
+
+"Of course, Mr. Thorndyke," the official said, "the Governor in his
+report does not gives us the names of any of those concerned in the
+matter; he simply says that although the mutiny was general, it was
+wholly the work of a small number of the worse class of prisoners. By
+worse class he means the most troublesome and refractory out there.
+The prisoners are not classified according to their original crimes.
+A poacher who has killed a game keeper, or a smuggler who has killed
+a revenue officer, may in other respects be a quiet and well conducted
+man, while men sentenced for comparatively minor offenses may give an
+immense deal of trouble. I will, however, get a letter written to the
+Governor, asking him if Arthur Bastow was among those who took part in
+the revolt, and if so what has become of him."
+
+It was more than a year before the reply came, and then the Governor
+reported that Arthur Bastow, who was believed to have been the leading
+spirit of the mutiny, was among those who had escaped, and had not yet
+been recaptured. It was generally believed that he had been killed by
+the blacks, but of this there was no actual proof.
+
+Mr. Bastow was much disturbed when he heard the news. "Suppose he comes
+back here, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"I won't suppose anything of the sort," the Squire replied. "I don't say
+that it would be altogether impossible, because now that vessels go from
+time to time to Sydney, he might, of course, be able to hide up in one
+of them, and not come on deck until she was well on her way, when, in
+all probability, he would be allowed to work his passage, and might be
+put ashore without any information being given to the authorities.
+I have no doubt that among the sailors there would be a good deal of
+sympathy felt for the convicts. No doubt they have a hard time of it,
+and we know that the gangs working on the roads are always ironed.
+Still, this is very unlikely, and the chances are all in favor of his
+being in hiding in the bush.
+
+"The shepherds and other hands on the farms are chiefly convicts, and
+would probably give him aid if he required it, and there would be no
+difficulty in getting a sheep, now and then, for, as all reports say,
+one of the chief troubles out there are the wild dogs, or dingoes, as
+they are called; any loss in that way would readily be put down to them.
+As to money, he would have no occasion for it; if he wanted it he would
+get it by robbing the settlers, he would know that if he came back here
+he would run the risk of being seized at once on landing or of being
+speedily hunted down as an escaped convict. I don't think that there is
+the slightest occasion for us to trouble ourselves about him."
+
+But though the Squire spoke so confidently, he felt by no means sure
+that Arthur Bastow would not turn up again, for his reckless audacity
+had made a great impression upon him. The proceeds of the robberies in
+the colony, in which he had no doubt played a part, would have furnished
+him with money with which he could bribe a sailor to hide him away
+and, if necessary, pay his passage money to England, when discovered
+on board, and perhaps maintain him when he got home until he could
+replenish his purse by some unlawful means. Lastly, the Squire argued
+that the fellow's vindictive nature and longing for revenge would act as
+an incentive to bring him back to London. He talked the matter over with
+Mark, who was now a powerful young fellow of twenty, who, of course,
+remembered the incidents attending Bastow's capture and trial.
+
+"I cannot help fancying that the fellow will come back, Mark."
+
+"Well, if he does, father, we must make it our business to lay him by
+the heels again. You managed it last time, and if he should turn up you
+may be sure I will help you to do it again."
+
+"Yes, but we may not hear of his having returned until he strikes a
+blow. At any rate, see that your pistols are loaded and close at hand at
+night."
+
+"They always are, father. There is no saying when a house like this,
+standing alone, and containing a good deal of plate and valuables, may
+be broken into."
+
+"Well, you might as well carry them always when you go out after dark.
+I shall speak to Knapp, and request him to let me know if he hears of a
+suspicious looking character--any stranger, in fact--being noticed in
+or about the village, and I shall have a talk with Simeox, the head
+constable at Reigate, and ask him to do the same. He is not the same
+man who was head at the time Bastow was up before us, but he was in
+the force then, and, as one of the constables who came up to take the
+prisoners down to Reigate, he will have all the facts in his mind. He is
+a sharp fellow, and though Bastow has no doubt changed a good deal since
+then, he would hardly fail to recognize him if his eye fell upon him. Of
+course we may be alarming ourselves unnecessarily, but there are several
+reasons why I should object strongly to be shot just at the present
+time."
+
+"Or at any other time, I should say, father," the young man said with a
+laugh.
+
+"I shall know him, Squire, safe enough," the head constable replied when
+John Thorndyke went down to see him on the following day; "but I should
+think that if he does come back to England he will hardly be fool enough
+to come down here. He was pretty well known in town before that affair,
+and everyone who was in the courthouse would be sure to have his face
+strongly impressed upon their minds. You may forget a man you have seen
+casually, but you don't forget one you have watched closely when he is
+in the dock with two others charged with murder. Five out of my six men
+were constables at that time, and would know him again the minute they
+saw him; but anyhow, I will tell them to keep a sharp lookout in the
+tramps' quarters, and especially over the two or three men still here
+that Bastow used to consort with. I should say that Reigate is the last
+place in the world where he would show his face."
+
+"I hope so," the Squire said. "He has caused trouble enough down here as
+it is; his father is getting an old man now, and is by no means strong,
+and fresh troubles of that kind would undoubtedly kill him."
+
+A month later the Reigate coach was stopped when a short distance out
+of the town by two highwaymen, and a considerable prize obtained by the
+robbers. Soon afterwards came news of private carriages being stopped on
+various commons in the South of London, and of several burglaries taking
+place among the houses round Clapham, Wandsworth, and Putney. Such
+events were by no means uncommon, but following each other in such quick
+succession they created a strong feeling of alarm among the inhabitants
+of the neighborhood. John Thorndyke, going up to town shortly
+afterwards, went to the headquarters of the Bow Street runners, and had
+a talk with their chief in reference especially to the stoppage of the
+Reigate coach. Mr. Chetwynd had lately died, and John Thorndyke had been
+unanimously elected by his fellow magistrates as chairman of the bench.
+
+"No, Mr. Thorndyke, we have no clew whatever. Our men have been keeping
+the sharpest watch over the fellows suspected of having a hand in such
+matters, but they all seem keeping pretty quiet at present, and none of
+them seem to be particularly flush with money. It is the same with these
+burglaries in the South of London. We are at our wits' end about them.
+We are flooded with letters of complaint from residents; but though the
+patrols on the common have been doubled and every effort made, we are as
+far off as ever. As far as the burglaries are concerned, we have every
+reason to think that they are the work of two or three new hands. The
+jobs are not neatly done, and certainly not with tools usually used by
+burglars. They seem to rely upon daring rather than skill. Anyhow, we
+don't know where to look for them, and are altogether at sea.
+
+"Of course it is as annoying to us as it is to anyone else; more so,
+because the Justices of the Peace are sending complaints to the Home
+Secretary, and he in turn drops on us and wants to know what we are
+doing. I have a sort of fancy myself the fellows who are stopping the
+coaches are the same as those concerned in the burglaries. I could not
+give you my reasons for saying so, except that on no occasion has a
+coach been stopped and a house broken into on the same night. I fancy
+that at present we shan't hear much more of them. They have created such
+alarm that the coaches carry with them two men armed with blunderbusses,
+in addition to the guards, and I should fancy that every householder
+sleeps with pistols within reach, and has got arms for his servants. At
+many of the large houses I know a watchman has been engaged to sit in
+the hall all night, to ring the alarm bell and wake the inmates directly
+he hears any suspicious sounds. Perhaps the fellows may be quiet for a
+time, for they must, during the last month, have got a wonderful amount
+of spoil. Maybe they will go west--the Bath road is always a favorite
+one with these fellows--maybe they will work the northern side of the
+town. I hope we shall lay hands upon them one day, but so far I may say
+frankly we have not the slightest clew."
+
+"But they must put their horses up somewhere?"
+
+"Yes, but unfortunately there are so many small wayside inns, that it
+is next to impossible to trace them. A number of these fellows are in
+alliance with the highwaymen. Some of them, too, have small farms in
+addition to their public house businesses, and the horses may be snugly
+put up there, while we are searching the inn stables in vain. Again,
+there are rogues even among the farmers themselves; little men, perhaps,
+who do not farm more than thirty or forty acres, either working them
+themselves, or by the aid of a hired man who lives perhaps at a village
+a mile away. To a man of this kind, the offer of a couple of guineas a
+week to keep two horses in an empty cowshed, and to ask no questions, is
+a heavy temptation.
+
+"We have got two clever fellows going about the country inquiring at
+all the villages whether two mounted men have lately been heard going
+through there late at night, or early in the morning, so as to narrow
+down the area to be searched, but nothing has come of it, although I am
+pretty sure that they must have three or four places they use in various
+directions. My men have picked up stories of horsemen being heard
+occasionally, but they come from various directions, and nowhere have
+they been noticed with any regularity. Besides, there are other knights
+of the road about, so we are no nearer than we were on that line of
+inquiry."
+
+A month later John Thorndyke had occasion to go up again to town. This
+time Mark accompanied him. Both carried pistols, as did the groom,
+sitting behind them. The Squire himself was but a poor shot, but Mark
+had practiced a great deal.
+
+"'Tis a good thing to be able to shoot straight, Mark," his father had
+said to him three years before. "I abhor dueling, but there is so much
+of it at present that any gentlemen might find himself in a position
+when he must either go out or submit to be considered a coward. Then,
+too, the roads are infested by highwaymen. For that reason alone it
+would be well that a man should be able to shoot straight. You should
+also practice sometimes at night, setting up some object at a distance
+so that you can just make out its outline, and taking a dozen shots at
+it. I know it is very difficult when you cannot see your own pistol, but
+you can soon learn to trust to your arm to come up to the right height
+and in the right direction. Of course you must wait until morning to
+find out where your bullet has gone."
+
+Two days after they had reached town the Squire received a letter from
+Mrs. Cunningham.
+
+"DEAR MR. THORNDYKE:
+
+"Knapp has been up this morning to tell me that a stranger dismounted
+yesterday at the alehouse, and while his horse was being fed he asked a
+few questions. Among others, he wished to be told if you were at home,
+saying that he had known you some fifteen years ago, when you lived near
+Hastings, and should like to have a talk with you again. In fact, he had
+turned off from the main road for the purpose. He seemed disappointed
+when he heard that you had gone up to town, and hearing that you might
+not be back for three or four days, said he should be coming back
+through Reigate in a week or ten days, and he dared say he should be
+able to find time to call again. Knapp did not hear about it until this
+morning; he asked the landlord about the man, and the landlord said he
+was about thirty, dark, and sparely built. He did not notice his horse
+particularly, seeing that it was such as a small squire or farmer might
+ride. He carried a brace of pistols in his holsters. The landlord was
+not prepossessed with his appearance, and it was that that made him
+speak to Knapp about him. I have told the men to unfasten the dogs every
+night, and I have asked Knapp to send up two trustworthy men to keep
+watch."
+
+"It may mean something, and it may not," the Squire said, as he handed
+the letter to Mark. "It is a suspicious looking circumstance; if
+the fellow had been honest he would surely have said something about
+himself. There is no doubt these housebreakers generally find out what
+chance there is of resistance, and, hearing that we were both away,
+may have decided on making an attempt. I have pretty well finished our
+business and ordered nearly all the provisions that Mrs. Cunningham
+requires. But I have to call at my lawyer's, and that is generally a
+longish business. It is half past two o'clock now; if we start from
+here at five we shall be down soon after eight, which will be quite soon
+enough. We shall have a couple of hours' drive in the dark, but that
+won't matter, we have got the lamps."
+
+"I am quite ready to start, father. I am engaged to sup with Reginald
+Ascot, but I will go over this afternoon and make my excuses."
+
+At five o'clock they started. "You have got your pistols in order,
+Mark?" the Squire asked, as they drove over London Bridge.
+
+"I have them handy, father, one in each pocket."
+
+"James, are your pistols charged?"
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+At six o'clock it was beginning to get dusk, and they stopped while the
+groom got down and lit the lamps; then they resumed their journey. They
+were within five miles of Reigate when suddenly two horsemen rode out
+from a side road with a shout of "Stand and deliver!"
+
+The Squire lashed the horses, and a moment later a pistol was fired, and
+the ball went through his hat. By the light of the lamps Mark saw
+the other man raise his hand, and, leveling his pistol, fired on the
+instant; then, as there was no reply to his shot, he discharged the
+second barrel at the first who had fired, and who had at once drawn
+another pistol. The two reports rang out almost at the same moment, but
+Mark's was a little the first. There was a sharp exclamation of pain
+from the highwayman, who wrenched round his horse and galloped down the
+lane from which he had issued, the groom sending two bullets after him.
+
+"Where is the other man?" Mark exclaimed, as his father reined in the
+horses.
+
+"Somewhere on the ground there, Mark; I saw him fall from his saddle as
+we passed him."
+
+"Is it any use pursuing the other, father? I am pretty sure I hit him."
+
+"I am quite sure you did, but it is no good our following; the side
+roads are so cut up by ruts that we should break a spring before we had
+gone a hundred yards. No, we will stop and look at this fellow who is
+unhorsed, Mark."
+
+The groom got down, and, taking one of the carriage lamps, proceeded to
+a spot where the highwayman's horse was standing. The man was already
+dead, the bullet having hit him a few inches above the heart.
+
+"He is dead, father."
+
+"I think you had better lift him up on the foot board behind; James can
+ride his horse. We will hand the body over to the constable at Reigate.
+He may know who he is, or find something upon him that may afford a clew
+that will lead to the capture of his companion."
+
+"No, I don't know him, Squire," the constable said as they stopped
+before his house and told him what had happened. "However, he certainly
+is dead, and I will get one of the men to help me carry him into the
+shed behind the courthouse. So you say that you think that the other is
+wounded?"
+
+"I am pretty sure he is. I heard him give an exclamation as my son
+fired."
+
+"That is good shooting, Mr. Mark," the constable said. "If every
+passenger could use his arms as you do there would soon be an end to
+stopping coaches. I will see what he has got about him, and will come up
+and let you know, Squire, the first thing in the morning."
+
+"I will send Knapp down," John Thorndyke said, as they drove homewards.
+"I am rather curious to know if this fellow is the same Mrs. Cunningham
+wrote about. I will tell him to take Peters along with him."
+
+"I hardly see that there can be any connection between the two.
+Highwaymen don't go in for house breaking. I think they consider that to
+be a lower branch of the profession."
+
+"Generally they do, no doubt, Mark; but you know I told you that the
+chief at Bow Street said that he had a suspicion that the highway
+robbers and the house breakers who have been creating so much alarm are
+the same men."
+
+"It is curious that they should have happened to light on us, father, if
+they were intending to break into our house."
+
+John Thorndyke made no reply, and in a few minutes drove up to the
+house. Their return, a couple of days before they were expected,
+caused great satisfaction to Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent. The former,
+however, had wisely kept from the girl the matter on which she had
+written to the Squire, and the suspicion she had herself entertained.
+
+"It is very dull without you both," Millicent said. "I was telling Mrs.
+Cunningham that I thought it would be a good thing, when you got back,
+for us two to take a run up to town for a week, just to let you see
+how dull the place is when two of us are away. You are looking quite
+serious, uncle. Is anything the matter?"
+
+"Happily nothing is the matter with us, dear, but we have had an
+adventure, and not a very pleasant one."
+
+"What was it?" the girl asked.
+
+"If you examine my hat closely, Millicent, it will tell you."
+
+The girl took up the hat from a chair on which he had put it, and
+brought it to the light. "There are two holes in it," she said. "Oh,
+Guardy, have you been shot at?"
+
+"It looks like it, dear. Two gentlemen highwaymen--at least, that is
+what I believe they call themselves--asked us pressingly to stop, and
+as we would not comply with their request, one fired at me, and, as you
+see, it was an uncommonly good shot. The other was about to fire when
+Mark's pistol put a stop to him, and his second barrel stopped the
+fellow who had fired first; he was hit, for we heard him give an
+exclamation of pain, but before any more shooting could be done he
+turned and rode off down a narrow lane where we could not follow."
+
+"And what became of the first?" Millicent asked with open eyes.
+
+"He was dead before we could get down to examine him; he will not
+disturb the King's peace again. It happened about four miles from home,
+so we brought him in and gave him and his horse into the charge of the
+constable at Reigate."
+
+"And you have really killed a man?" Millicent said, looking up with an
+awestruck expression to Mark.
+
+"Well, as the man would have killed us if I hadn't, I cannot say,
+Millicent, that his death weighs in any way heavily on my mind. If he
+were as good a shot as the other, my father's life would not have been
+worth much, for as we were driving fast, he was not above half as far
+away as the other had been when he fired. Just the same, I suppose, as
+it would be in a battle; a man is going to shoot you, and you shoot him
+first, and I don't suppose it ever troubles you afterwards."
+
+"Of course I don't mean that I blame you, Mark; but it does seem
+shocking."
+
+"I don't suppose you would think that, Millicent, if a burglar, who had
+taken one shot at you and was about to finish you with another, was cut
+short in the operation by a shot from my pistol. I believe that your
+relief and thankfulness would be so great that the idea that it was a
+shocking thing for me to do would not as much as enter your head."
+
+"I wish you had shot the other man as well as the one you did, Mark,"
+the Squire said, as he walked with his son down to Reigate to attend the
+inquest the next morning on the man he had brought in. Mark looked at
+his father in surprise.
+
+"There is no doubt I hit him, father," he said; "but I should not think
+that he will be likely to trouble us again."
+
+"I wish I felt quite sure of that. Do you know that I have a strong
+suspicion that it was Arthur Bastow?"
+
+Mark had, of course, heard of Bastow's escape, but had attached no great
+importance to it. The crime had taken place nearly eight years before,
+and although greatly impressed at the time by the ill doings of the man,
+the idea that he would ever return and endeavor to avenge himself on
+his father for the part he had taken had not occurred to him. Beyond
+mentioning his escape, the Squire had never talked to him on the
+subject.
+
+"It was he who bade us stand and deliver, and the moment he spoke the
+voice seemed familiar to me, and, thinking it over, I have an impression
+that it was his. I may be mistaken, for I have had him in my mind ever
+since I heard that he had escaped, and may therefore have connected the
+voice with him erroneously, and yet I cannot but think that I was right.
+You see, there are two or three suspicious circumstances. In the first
+place, there was this man down here making inquiries. Knapp went down
+early this morning with the innkeeper, and told me before breakfast that
+Peters at once recognized the fellow you shot as the man who had made
+the inquiries. Now, the natural result of making inquiries would have
+been that the two men would the next evening have broken into the house,
+thinking that during our absence they would meet with no resistance.
+Instead of doing this they waylaid us on the road, which looks as if it
+was me they intended to attack, and not the house."
+
+"But how could they have known that it was us, father? It is certainly
+singular that one of the two men should have been the fellow who was up
+at the inn, but it may be only a matter of coincidence."
+
+"I don't know, Mark; I don't say that singular coincidences don't occur,
+but I have not much faith in them. Still, if they were journeying down
+to attack the house last night they would hardly have stopped travelers
+by the way when there was a rich booty awaiting them, as they evidently
+believed there was, or that man would not have come down specially to
+make inquiries. My own impression is that when they heard that we should
+return in two or three days one of them watched us in London, and as
+soon as they learned that we were to start for home at five o'clock they
+came down here to stop us. They would hardly have done that merely to
+get our watches and what money we had in our pockets."
+
+"No, I should think not, father; but they might be friends of men who
+have got into trouble at Reigate, and, as you are chairman of the bench,
+may have had a special grudge against you for their conviction."
+
+"That is, of course, possible, and I hope that it is so."
+
+"But even if Arthur Bastow had escaped, father, why should he come back
+to England, where he would know that he might be arrested again, instead
+of staying quietly out in Australia?"
+
+"There are two reasons. In the first place the life out there would not
+be a quiet one; there would be nothing for him but to attack and rob the
+settlers, and this, as they are sure to be armed, is a pretty dangerous
+business. Then there are perils from the blacks, and lastly, such a
+life would be absolutely devoid of comfort, and be that of a hunted dog;
+living always in the bush, scarcely venturing to sleep lest he should
+be pounced upon either by the armed constables of the colony or by the
+blacks. It is not as if the country were extensively populated; there
+are not a very large number of settlers there yet, and therefore very
+small scope for robbers. These people would keep very little money
+with them, and the amount of plunder to be got would be small indeed.
+Therefore, I take it that the main object of any escaped convict would
+be to get away from the place.
+
+"That is one of the reasons why the fellow might come back to England
+in spite of the risks. The other is that I believe him to be so
+diabolically vindictive that he would run almost any peril in order to
+obtain revenge upon me or his father. Twice he has threatened me, the
+first time when we captured him, the second time as he left the court
+after he had received his sentence. I am not a coward, so far as I know,
+Mark, but I am as certain as I stand here that he meant what he said,
+and that, during these years of imprisonment and toil out there, he has
+been cherishing the thought of coming home some day and getting even
+with me. You see, he is said to have been the leader of this convict
+revolt. There is no doubting his daring, and to my mind the attack upon
+us last night, when they knew that they could have managed a successful
+robbery here, points to the fact that it was the result of personal
+animosity, and strengthens my belief that it was Arthur Bastow who
+called upon us to stand and deliver."
+
+"It is a very unpleasant idea, father."
+
+"Very unpleasant, and it seems to me that we should at any rate spare no
+pains in hunting the man you wounded down."
+
+"I will undertake that if you like. I have nothing particular to do, and
+it would be an excitement. You have a lot to keep you here."
+
+"I don't fancy that you will find it an excitement, Mark, for of course
+the detectives will do the hunting, but I should certainly be glad if
+you would take a letter for me to the head of the Detective Department,
+and tell him what I think, and my reasons for thinking so, and say that
+I offer a reward of a hundred pounds for the capture of the man who
+tried to stop us, and who was, we are certain, wounded by you. Unless
+he has some marvelously out of the way hiding place, it ought not to
+be difficult. A wounded man could scarcely lie hidden in the slums of
+London without it being known to a good many people, to some of whom
+a reward of the sum of a hundred pounds would be an irresistible
+temptation."
+
+By this time they had reached Reigate. The inquest did not last
+many minutes, and the jury without hesitation returned a verdict of
+justifiable homicide.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII.
+
+
+The next morning Mark went up to London.
+
+"Of course, Mr. Thorndyke," the chief at Bow Street said, "your father's
+suspicions as to the man's identity may or may not be justified; that,
+however, makes no difference to us. Here is a highwayman who has been
+wounded, and would certainly be a valuable capture: I will set my men to
+work at once; if he is in London they will get news of him before many
+days. My men in any case would do their duty, but your father's offer
+will certainly stimulate their energy. Where are you stopping?"
+
+"At the Bull, in Holborn."
+
+"Very well; I will be sure to let you know as soon as we get any clew to
+the man's identity."
+
+Mark remained in London a week, and at the end of that time he received
+a note from Bow Street saying that the superintendent wished to see him.
+
+"I am sorry that I have no news for you, Mr. Thorndyke," the officer
+said, when he called upon him. "Every place where such a man would be
+likely to be in hiding has been searched, and no clew whatever has been
+obtained. We shall now circulate notices of the reward throughout the
+country. If the man was at all severely hit, we may assume that he must
+be somewhere in the neighborhood of London, whereas, if the wound was
+a slight one, he might be able to go a long distance, and may be now
+in York, for aught we know. However, now that the search in London has
+terminated, I can really see no use in your staying here any longer; we
+will let you know directly we have any news."
+
+Three months later John Thorndyke received a letter from the Detective
+Office asking him to call the next time he came up to town, as although
+no news had been obtained that would lead to the man's immediate
+arrest, news had at any rate been obtained showing that he was alive. It
+happened that Mark was intending to go up on the following day, and his
+father asked him to call for him at Bow Street.
+
+"Well, Mr. Thorndyke, we have heard about your man, and that after we
+had quite abandoned the search. I had come to the conclusion that the
+wound you gave him had been a fatal one, and that he had been quietly
+buried by some of the people with whom he was connected. The discovery
+was, as half these discoveries generally are, the result of accident.
+Last week a gentleman entered the Bank and asked for change in gold for
+a fifty pound note. The cashier, looking at the number, found that it
+was one of those that had been stolen from a passenger by one of the
+south coaches several months ago. The gentleman was at once taken into
+a private office, and questioned as to how he had obtained the note.
+The account that he gave was that he was a surgeon in practice at
+Southampton. A gentleman had arrived there on a date which we found to
+be the day after that on which you were stopped; he was well dressed,
+and had the air of a gentleman; he had come down by coach, and was
+evidently very ill. He told the surgeon that he had been engaged in a
+duel, that the pistols had been discharged simultaneously, and that he
+had killed his man, but had himself been severely wounded. He said that
+the person whom he had killed had influential connections, and that it
+would be necessary for him to remain in seclusion for a time, and he
+asked him to take charge of his case, as he had ample means of paying
+him handsomely. The surgeon examined the wound, and found it to be
+indeed a serious one, and, as he thought, probably fatal. However,
+having no doubt as to the truth of the story, he had taken the gentleman
+in, and he remained under his charge until a week before he came up to
+town.
+
+"For the first month he had been dangerously ill, but he completely
+recovered. The surgeon had no reason whatever for doubting his patient
+being a gentleman; he was fashionably dressed, and had evidently changed
+his clothes after the duel, as there were no bloodstains upon them. He
+was, however, glad when he left, as his conversation did not please him
+from its cynical tone. The Bank sent to us directly the man presented
+the note, which he stated had been given to him in part payment for his
+medical services and the board and lodging of the patient; the total
+amount had been 75 pounds, and the balance was paid in gold. As he
+was able to give several good references, and was identified by three
+gentlemen, he was, of course, released. I have no doubt whatever that
+the fellow he attended was your man. The surgeon said, whoever he was,
+he must have been a man of iron resolution to have made such a journey
+in the state he was.
+
+"No doubt he must have ridden straight to the place he used as his
+headquarters, where he had his wound roughly bandaged, changed his
+clothes, and had ridden in the morning to some point that the coach
+passed on its way to Southampton. Of course we obtained a minute
+description from the surgeon of the man's appearance. We found that
+the people at the coach office had no remembrance of there being anyone
+answering to that description among the persons who traveled by the
+coach, but of course that would not go for much, for over three months
+have elapsed.
+
+"When the coachman who had driven the down coach that day came up to
+town, we saw him, and he remembered perfectly that on or about that day
+he had picked up a passenger at Kingston--a gentleman who was in very
+weak health. There were only three inside passengers besides himself,
+and he had to be assisted into the coach. The way bill, on being turned
+up, showed that an inside passenger had been taken up at Kingston. I
+have already sent down men to make inquiries at every village in the
+district between Reigate and Kingston, and I trust that we shall lay
+hands on him, especially now we have got an accurate description of him,
+while before we were working in the dark in that respect."
+
+"What is the description, sir? My father is much interested on that
+point, for, as I believe I told you, he has a strong suspicion that
+the fellow is the man who was transported more than eight years ago to
+Australia, and who made his escape from the prison there."
+
+"Yes, I know. At first it appeared to me very improbable, but I am bound
+to say the description tallies very closely with that given of him. The
+surgeon took him to be nearly thirty; but after what he has gone through
+he may well look three or four years older than he is. He had light
+hair, rather small gray eyes, and a face that would have been good
+looking had it not been for its supercilious and sneering expression."
+
+"I can remember him," Mark said; "and that answers very closely to him.
+I should say that it is certainly Bastow, and my father made no mistake
+when he asserted that he recognized his voice."
+
+The officer added a note to the description in his register: "Strongly
+suspected of being Arthur Bastow, transported for connivance with
+highwaymen; was leader of a mutiny in convict jail of Sydney two years
+and a half ago. Made his escape."
+
+"There is no doubt," he went on, "that he is a desperate character. No
+doubt he is the man who has been concerned in most of these robberies in
+the southern suburbs. We must get hold of him if we can, and once we
+do so there will be an end of his travels, for the mutiny in prison and
+escape is a hanging business, putting aside the affairs since he
+got back. Well, sir, I hope he will give you and your father no more
+trouble."
+
+"I am sure I hope so," Mark said. "I suppose that the fellow who was
+shot was one of the men who escaped with him from the convict prison."
+
+"That is likely enough. Two would get home as easily as one, and the
+fact that they were both strangers here would account for the difficulty
+our men have had in their search for him. You see, we have had nothing
+whatever to go on. You must not be too sanguine about our catching the
+man in a short time: he is evidently a clever fellow, and I think it
+likely that once he got back he lost no time in getting away from this
+part of the country, and we are more likely to find him in the west or
+north than we are of laying hands on him here. We will send descriptions
+all over the country, and as soon as I hear of a series of crimes
+anywhere, I will send off two of my best men to help the local
+constables."
+
+On his return home Mark told his father what he had done.
+
+"I thought that I could not have been mistaken, Mark; we have got that
+rascal on our hands again. I hope now that they have got a description
+of him to go by, they will not be long before they catch him; but
+the way he escaped after being badly wounded shows that he is full of
+resources, and he may give them some trouble yet, if I am not mistaken.
+At any rate, I will have a talk with the Reigate constable, and tell him
+that there is very little doubt that the man who attacked us was Arthur
+Bastow, who has, as we have heard, escaped from Botany Bay, and that he
+had best tell his men to keep a sharp lookout for him, for that, owing
+to his animosity against us for his former capture and conviction, it
+is likely enough that sooner or later he will be in this neighborhood
+again. After his determined attempt at my life when pretending to rob
+us, I shall certainly not feel comfortable until I know that he is under
+lock and key."
+
+"I wish, Guardy, you would give up this magistrate's business,"
+Millicent said at dinner. "I am sure that it is worrying you, and I
+can't see why you should go on with it."
+
+"It does not worry me, as a rule, Millicent; indeed, I like the duty.
+Besides, every landowner of standing ought to take his share in public
+work. There are only two of the magistrates younger than I am, and
+whatever you may think of me, I feel myself capable of doing what work
+there is to do. When Mark gets a few years older I shall resign, and let
+him take my place on the bench. I own, though, that I should be glad if
+these highway robberies could be suppressed. Poaching and the ordinary
+offenses of drunkenness and assaults are disposed of without any
+trouble; but this stopping of the coaches, accompanied occasionally by
+the shooting of the coachman or guard, gives a great deal of trouble,
+and the worst of it is that we are practically powerless to put such
+crimes down. Nothing short of patrolling the roads in parties of three
+or four between sunset and sunrise would put a stop to them, and the
+funds at our disposal would not support such an expenditure."
+
+"It is a pity that you cannot get up a corps like the yeomanry, and call
+it the Mounted Constabulary," said Mark. "There are at least a dozen
+fellows I know who would, like myself, be glad to join it, and I dare
+say we could get a score of young farmers or farmers' sons."
+
+"It is not a bad idea, Mark, and I dare say that for a time the duty
+would be zealously performed, but before very long you would tire of it.
+A few wet nights or winter's cold, and you would cease to see the fun of
+it, especially as you may be sure that the news that the roads are well
+patrolled would soon come to the ears of these scoundrels, and they
+would cease to work in the district."
+
+"Perhaps you are right, sir; but I think that a few of us would stick to
+it."
+
+"Perhaps so, Mark, but I should be sorry to wager that the work would
+be thoroughly done. The first county or hunt ball, or even dinner party,
+more than half of them would be away. I don't say that you personally
+might not for some considerable time persist in patrolling the roads,
+for you have a sort of personal interest in the matter; but I would
+wager that before two months have passed you would find you were the
+only one who attended at the rendezvous regularly."
+
+A fortnight later the party were seated round the fire in the dusk.
+Mr. Bastow was sitting next to the Squire, and was in unusually good
+spirits. He had heard no word of what the Squire had discovered, nor
+dreamed that his son was again in England, still less that he was
+suspected of being one of the men who had endeavored to stop the Squire
+and his son on their drive from London. Suddenly there was the crack of
+a pistol outside, and a ball passed between him and the Squire. Without
+a word, Mark Thorndyke rushed to the door, seized a pistol from his
+riding coat, and, snatching up a heavy whip, dashed out into the garden.
+
+He was just in time to see a figure running at full speed, and he set
+off in pursuit. Good runner as he was, he gained but slightly at first,
+but after a time he drew nearer to the fugitive. The latter was but
+some sixty yards away when he leaped a hedge into a narrow lane. Mark
+followed without hesitation, but as he leaped into the road he heard a
+jeering laugh and the sharp sound of a horse's hoofs, and knew that the
+man he was pursuing had gained his horse and made off. Disgusted at his
+failure, he went slowly back to the house. The shutters had been put up.
+
+"I have lost him, father. He ran well to begin with, but I was gaining
+fast on him when he leaped into a narrow lane where he had left his
+horse, and rode off before I could get up to him. I need hardly say that
+there was no use attempting to follow on foot. He missed you all, did he
+not?"
+
+"Yes, Mark. It is not so easy to take an accurate aim when it is nearly
+dark. The bullet passed between myself and Mr. Bastow, and has buried
+itself in the mantelpiece."
+
+"Something ought to be done, Guardy," Millicent Conyers said
+indignantly. "It is shameful that people cannot sit in their own room
+without the risk of being shot at. What can it mean? Surely no one can
+have any enmity against you."
+
+"I hope not, my dear," John Thorndyke said lightly. "Some of the fellows
+we have sentenced may think that we were rather hard on them, but I
+do not think that any of them would feel it sufficiently to attempt to
+murder one; besides, Mark says that the fellow had a horse waiting
+for him, and none of our poachers would be likely to be the owner of a
+horse. It may be that the highwayman Mark shot at and wounded has come
+down to give us a fright. It is no use worrying about it now; in future
+we will have the shutters closed at sunset. It is hardly likely that
+the thing will be attempted again, and Mark's chase must have shown the
+fellow that the game is hardly worth the risk."
+
+"He might have shot you, Mark; you had no right to risk your life in
+that sort of way," the girl said to him, later, as they were seated
+together in front of the fire, while the Squire was reading the Gazette
+at the table, Mrs. Cunningham was working, and Mr. Bastow, who had been
+greatly shaken by the event, had retired to bed.
+
+"Do you think that he really meant to kill your father?"
+
+"I should imagine he did; a man would hardly run the risk of being hung
+merely for the pleasure of shooting. I would give a good deal if I had
+caught him, or better still, if I had shot him," said Mark. "However, I
+will make it my business to hunt the fellow down. After this evening's
+affair, we shall never feel comfortable until he is caught. I have
+no doubt that he is the fellow we have been hunting for the last four
+months. The people at Bow Street seem no good whatever; I will try if I
+cannot succeed better."
+
+"Don't do anything rash, Mark," said Millicent, in a low voice; "you
+have no right to put yourself in danger."
+
+"But our lives are in danger now, Millicent--in much greater danger
+than mine would be when looking out for him. But there seems no guarding
+against attacks like this; I mean to hunt him down, if it takes me
+a year. I have nothing special to do, and cannot employ my time more
+usefully."
+
+When the ladies went up to bed the Squire said:
+
+"Come into the library, Mark, and we will smoke a pipe, and have a talk
+over this business." He touched the bell. "Have you got a good fire in
+the library, Ramoo?"
+
+"Yes, sahib, very good."
+
+"Then take a bottle of number one bin of port there--and a couple of
+glasses."
+
+When they were quietly seated, glasses filled, and the long pipes
+alight, the Squire said: "I want to have a serious talk with you, Mark.
+What I am going to say will surprise you a good deal. I had not intended
+to tell you for another four years--that is to say, not until Millicent
+came of age--but after that affair tonight, I feel that my life is
+so uncertain that I ought not to delay letting you know the truth.
+I suppose you agree with me that it was Bastow who shot at me this
+evening?"
+
+"I have not the least doubt about that, father."
+
+"I will not say that he shot at me," the Squire said, "for he may have
+shot at his father; the villain is quite capable of that. It was his
+father who brought me upon him, and though I effected his capture eight
+years ago I don't suppose he cares which of us he killed. However, the
+point is not what he aimed at, but whether it was he, and that I take
+there is no doubt about. He missed me this time, but his next shot may
+be more successful, At any rate, I think that it is high time that I
+told you the story."
+
+And, beginning with the arrival of Colonel Thorndyke at his place, he
+repeated the conversation that he had had with him. Several times in
+the early portion of his narrative he was interrupted by exclamations of
+surprise from his son.
+
+"Then Millicent is really my uncle's heiress!" exclaimed Mark, when he
+heard the request the Colonel had made of the Squire.
+
+"That is so, Mark. She does not know it herself, and it was my brother's
+urgent wish that she should not know it until she came of age or until
+she married. I fought against it to the utmost, but it was his dying
+prayer, and I could not refuse it. My solicitor knows the facts of the
+matter, and so does Mrs. Cunningham, who brought Millicent over from
+India when she was only about a year old. I may say that I especially
+urged that it would not be fair to you to be brought up to consider
+yourself to be heir to the property, but he said:
+
+"'Putting aside the estate, I have a considerable fortune. In the first
+place, there are the accumulations of rent from the Reigate place. I
+have never touched them, and they have been going on for twelve years.
+In. the next place, the shaking of the pagoda tree has gone on merrily,
+and we all made a comfortable pile. Then I always made a point of
+carrying about with me two or three hundred pounds, and after the
+sacking of some of the palaces I could pick up jewels and things from
+the troops for a trifle, being able to pay money down. Even without
+the rents here, I have some 50,000 pounds in money. I should think the
+jewels would be worth at least as much more, irrespective of a diamond
+bracelet which is, I fancy, worth more than the rest put together. It
+was stolen from the arm of some idol.' He then explained how he got it,
+and the manner in which he had placed it and the rest of his wealth in a
+secure position.
+
+"'Things stolen from a god are frightfully dangerous,' he said, 'for the
+Brahmins or priests connected with the temples have been known to follow
+them up for years, and in nine cases out of ten they get possession of
+them again. Murder in such a case is meritorious, and I would not have
+them in the house here, were they ten times the value they are. I know
+that my clothes, my drawers, and everything belonging to me have been
+gone through at night a score of times. Nothing has been stolen, but,
+being a methodical man, I could generally see some displacement in the
+things that told me they had been disturbed. They gave it up for a time,
+but I haven't a shadow of a doubt that they have been watching me ever
+since, and they may be watching me now, for anything I know. Now, half
+of that fortune I have left by my will to your son; half to the girl. I
+will tell you where the things are the last thing before I die.
+
+"'Now, mind, you must be careful when you get them. When I am dead you
+are almost certain to be watched. You don't know what these fellows are.
+The things must remain where they are until your boy comes of age. Don't
+let him keep those diamonds an hour in his possession; let him pass them
+away privately to some man in whom he has implicit confidence, for
+him to take them to a jeweler's; let him double and turn and disguise
+himself so as to throw everyone that may be spying on him off his
+track. If you can manage it, the best way would be to carry them over to
+Amsterdam, and sell them there.'
+
+"I confess it seemed absurd, but it is a matter about which he would
+know a great deal more than I do, and he was convinced that not only
+was he watched, but that he owed his life simply to the fact that the
+fellows did not know where the diamonds were hidden, and that by killing
+him they would have lost every chance of regaining them.
+
+"So convinced was he of all this, that he would not tell me where he had
+stowed them away; he seemed to think that the very walls would hear us,
+and that these fellows might be hidden under the sofa, in a cupboard, or
+up the chimney, for aught I know. He told me that he would tell me the
+secret before he died; but death came so suddenly that he never had an
+opportunity of doing so. He made a tremendous effort in his last moment,
+but failed, and I shall never forget the anguish his face expressed when
+he found himself powerless to speak; however, he pressed his snuffbox
+into my hand with such a significant look that, being certain it
+contained some clew to the mystery, and being unable to find a hidden
+spring or a receptacle, I broke it open that night.
+
+"It contained a false bottom, and here are what I found in it. I stowed
+them away in a secret drawer in that old cabinet that stands by my
+bedside. It is in the bottom pigeonhole on the right hand side. I bought
+the cabinet at a sale, and found the spring of the secret drawer quite
+accidentally. I shall put the things back tonight, and you will know
+where to look for them. You press against the bottom and up against the
+top simultaneously, and the back then falls forward. The opening behind
+is very shallow, and will hold but two or three letters. But, however,
+it sufficed for this;" and he handed Mark the coin and slip of paper.
+
+"But what are these, father?"
+
+"These are the clews by which we are to obtain the treasure."
+
+As Mark examined them carefully the Squire stood up with his back to the
+fire, and looking round walked to the door and said: "I thought there
+was a draught somewhere; either Ramoo did not shut the door when he went
+out or it has come open again. It has done that once or twice before.
+When I go into town tomorrow I will tell Tucker to send a man up to take
+the lock off. Well, what do you make out of that?"
+
+"I can make out nothing," Mark replied. "No doubt the coin is something
+to be given to whoever is in charge of the treasure, and Masulipatam may
+be the place where it is hidden."
+
+"Yes, or it may be a password. It reminds one of the forty thieves
+business. You go and knock at the door of a cave, a figure armed to the
+teeth presents itself, you whisper in his ear 'Masulipatam,' he replies
+'Madras,' or 'Calcutta,' or something of that sort, you take out the
+coin and show it to him, he takes out from some hidden repository a
+similar one, compares the two, and then leads you to an inner cave piled
+up with jewels."
+
+Mark laughed.
+
+"Well, it is no laughing matter, Mark," the Squire went on seriously.
+"The little comedy may not be played just as I have sketched it, but I
+expect that it is something of the kind. That coin has to be shown, and
+the word 'Masulipatam' spoken to the guardian, whoever he may be, of
+your uncle's treasure. But who that guardian may be or how he is to be
+found is a mystery. I myself have never tried to solve it. There was
+nothing whatever to go upon. The things may be in England or, it may be,
+anywhere in India. To me it looked an absolutely hopeless business to
+set about. I did not see how even a first step was to be taken, and as I
+had this estate and you and Millicent to look after, and was no longer
+a young man, I put the matter aside altogether. You are young, you have
+plenty of energy, and you have your life before you, and it is a matter
+of the greatest interest to you.
+
+"Possibly--very improbably, mind, still possibly--when Millicent comes
+of age and learns who she is, Mrs. Cunningham may be able to help you.
+I have no idea whether it is so. I have never spoken to her about this
+treasure of George's, but it is just possible that while he was in
+town before he came down to me he may have given her some instructions
+concerning it. Of course he intended to give me full particulars, but he
+could hardly have avoided seeing that, in the event of my death, perhaps
+suddenly before the time came for seeking the treasure, the secret
+would be lost altogether. Whether he has told her or his lawyer or not
+I cannot say, but I have all along clung to the hope that he took some
+such natural precaution. Unless that treasure is discovered, the only
+thing that will come to you is the half of the accumulated rents of
+this estate during the ten years between my father's death and George's;
+these rents were paid to our solicitors, and by them invested.
+
+"The rentals amount to about 2500 pounds a year, and of course there is
+interest to be added, so that I suppose there is now some 25,000 pounds,
+for I had out 2000 pounds when I came here, to set matters straight. I
+had a great fight with the lawyers over it, but as I pointed out they
+had failed altogether to see that the agent did his duty, and that
+at least a couple of hundred a year ought to be expended in necessary
+repairs, I had a right to at least that sum to carry out the work that
+ought to be done from year to year. In addition to that sum I laid out
+about 1000 pounds a year for the first three years I was here; so that
+practically 5000 pounds was expended in rebuilding the village and
+doing repairs on the homesteads; that, however, is not the point now.
+Altogether, then, there is some 25,000 pounds to be divided between you
+and Millicent when she becomes mistress of this property.
+
+"According to the terms of my brother's will, I am still to remain here
+until she marries; when she does so I shall, of course, go back to my
+own little place; the income of that has been accumulating while I
+have been here, my only expenses having been for clothes. I have taken
+nothing out of this estate since I came here, and each year have paid
+to the solicitors all balances remaining after discharging the household
+expenses, these balances averaging 700 or 800 pounds a year. Of
+course the income was absolutely left to me during the time I remained
+ostensible owner, but I had no wish to make money out of a trust that
+I assumed greatly against my will. That money is Millicent's; of course
+the house had to be kept up in proper style whether I were here or not.
+Had she at once come into possession, there must have been horses, and
+carriages, and so on. I don't say that I have not had all the expenses
+of our living saved; that I had no objection to; but I was determined at
+least not to take a penny put of the estate beyond those expenses. You
+see, Mark, you will have your 12,500 pounds anyhow, as soon as Millicent
+comes of age--not a bad little sum--so that even if you never hear
+anything more of this mysterious treasure you will not be penniless, or
+in anyway dependent upon me. At my death, of course, you will come into
+the Sussex place, with what savings there may be."
+
+"I am sure I have no reason to grumble, father," Mark said heartily.
+"Of course it came upon me at first as a surprise that Millicent was
+the heiress here, and it flashed through my mind for the moment that the
+best thing would be to take a commission in the army, or to follow my
+uncle's example, and get a cadetship in the Company's service. I have
+no doubt that I should have enjoyed life either way quite as much or
+possibly more than if I had gone on a good many years as heir to these
+estates, and afterwards as Squire. Of course, now I shall make it my
+business to see if it is possible to obtain some sort of clew to this
+treasure, and then follow it up; but the first thing to which I shall
+give my mind will be to hunt down Bastow. We shall never feel safe here
+as long as that fellow is alive, and that will be the first thing I
+shall devote myself to. After that I shall see about the treasure."
+
+"As to that, Mark, I cannot impress upon you too strongly what your
+uncle said. It may, of course, be a pure delusion on his part; but if
+he is right, and some of these Hindoo fellows are still on the watch to
+obtain that bracelet, you must use extraordinary precautions when you
+get it into your hands; he advised me to take it across to Amsterdam,
+and either get the stones recut or to sell them separately to different
+diamond merchants there. He said that my life would not be worth an
+hour's purchase as long as the stones were in my hands."
+
+"That rather looks, father, as if the things were somewhere in England;
+had they been in India, you would have had them some months in your
+hands before you could get them to Amsterdam."
+
+"I did not think of that before, Mark, and it is possible that you
+are right; but I don't know; he might have thought that it would be
+impossible for me to dispose of them at Madras or Calcutta, and may have
+assumed that I should at once deposit them in a bank to be forwarded
+with other treasure to England, or that I should get them packed away
+in the treasure safe in the ship I came back by, and that I should not
+really have them on my person till I landed in England, or until I
+took them from the Bank. Still, I see that your supposition is the most
+likely, and that they may all this time have been lying somewhere in
+London until I should present myself with a gold coin and the word
+'Masulipatam.'"
+
+Suddenly Mark sprang to his feet, and pulled back the curtains across
+a window, threw it up, and leaped into the garden, and there stood
+listening for two or three minutes, with his pistol cocked in his hand.
+He stepped for a moment into the room again.
+
+"You had better put that light out, father or we may have another shot."
+
+"Did you hear anything, Mark?"
+
+"I thought I did, father. I may have been mistaken, but I certainly
+thought I heard a noise, and when I pulled the curtains aside the window
+was not shut by three or four inches. I will have a look through the
+shrubbery. That fellow may have come back again. Pull the curtains to
+after me."
+
+"I will go with you, Mark."
+
+"I would rather you didn't, father; it would only make me nervous. I
+shan't go into the shrubbery and give them a chance of getting first
+shot. I shall hide up somewhere and listen. It is a still night, and if
+there is anyone moving I am pretty sure to hear him."
+
+The Squire turned down the lamp, drew the curtains, and seated himself
+by the fire. It was three quarters of an hour before Mark returned. He
+shut the window, and fastened it carefully.
+
+"I fancy you must have been mistaken, Mark."
+
+"I suppose that shot through the window has made me nervous. I certainly
+did fancy I heard a noise there; it may have been a dead bough snapping,
+or something of that sort; and of course, the window being partly open,
+even though only three or four inches, any little noise would come in
+more plainly than it otherwise would do. However, everything has been
+perfectly quiet since I went out, and it is hardly likely indeed that
+the fellow would have returned so soon after the hot chase I gave him."
+
+"It is very stupid--the window being left open," the Squire said. "I
+shall question Martha about it in the morning; it was her duty to see
+that it was shut and fastened before drawing the curtains. Just at
+present one can scarcely be too careful. I don't mean to deny that
+whether there was a window open or not a burglar who wanted to get into
+the house could do so, still there is no use in making their work more
+easy for them. I know, as a rule, we are careless about such things;
+there has not been a burglary in this part for years, and until lately
+the front door has never been locked at night, and anyone could have
+walked in who wanted to. Of course the servants don't know that there is
+any reason for being more careful at present than usual.
+
+"I was thinking the other day of having shutters put to all these
+downstair rooms. Some of them have got them, and some have not; still,
+even with shutters, burglars can always get in if they want to do so.
+They have only to cut round the lock of a door or to make a hole in a
+panel to give them room to put an arm through and draw back a bolt, and
+the thing is done. I know that all the silver is locked up every night
+in the safe, for Ramoo sees to that, and I have never known him neglect
+anything under his charge. Well, Mark, I don't know that it is any use
+sitting up longer, we have plenty of time to talk the matter over; it is
+four years yet before Millicent comes of age, though, of course, there
+is nothing to prevent your setting out in quest of the treasure as soon
+as you like. Still, there is no hurry about it."
+
+"None whatever, father; but I don't mean to lose a day before I try to
+get on the track of that villain Bastow."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII.
+
+
+Mark was some hours before he went to sleep. The news that he had heard
+that evening was strange and startling. Full of health and strength, the
+fact that he was not, as he had always supposed, the heir to the estate
+troubled him not at all. The fact that in four years he would come in
+for some twelve thousand pounds was sufficient to prevent his feeling
+any uneasiness as to his future; and indeed in some respects it was not
+an unpleasant idea that, instead of being tied down to the estate, he
+should be able to wander at will, visit foreign countries, and make his
+own life.
+
+In one respect he was sorry. His father had in the last year hinted more
+than once that it would be a very nice arrangement if he were to make
+up a match with his ward; he had laughed, and said that there would be
+plenty of time for that yet. But the idea had been an agreeable one. He
+was very fond of Millicent--fond, perhaps; in a cousinly way at present;
+but at any rate he liked her far better than any of the sisters of his
+friends. Of course she was only seventeen yet, and there was plenty of
+time to think of marriage in another three years. Still, the thought
+occurred to him several times that she was budding out into a young
+woman, and every month added to her attractions. It was but the day
+before he had said to himself that there was no reason to wait as long
+as three years, especially as his father seemed anxious, and would
+evidently be glad were the match to take place. Now, of course, he said
+to himself, that was at an end. He had never given her any reason to
+suppose that he cared for her, and now that she was the heiress and
+he comparatively poor, she would naturally think that it was for the
+estate, and not for herself, that she was wooed. Then there was the
+question of this curiously lost treasure, with the mysterious clew that
+led to nothing. How on earth was he to set about the quest? He puzzled
+for a long time over this, till at last he fell asleep. He was roused by
+Ramoo entering the room.
+
+"What is it, Ramoo?"
+
+"Me not know, sahib. Massa Thorndyke's door shut. Me no able to make him
+hear."
+
+"That is curious, Ramoo," Mark said, jumping hastily out of bed. "I will
+be with you in a minute."
+
+He slipped on his trousers, coat, and slippers, and then accompanied
+Ramoo to his father's door. He knocked again and again, and each time
+more loudly, his face growing paler as he did so. Then he threw himself
+against the door, but it was solid and heavy.
+
+"Fetch me an ax, Ramoo," he said. "There is something wrong here."
+
+Ramoo returned in a short time with two men servants and with the ax in
+his hands. Mark took it, and with a few mighty blows split the woodwork,
+and then hurling himself against the door, it yielded. As he entered
+the room a cry broke from his lips. Within a pace or two of the bed the
+Squire lay on the ground, on his face, and a deep stain on the carpet
+at once showed that his death had been a violent one. Mark knelt by his
+side now, and touched him. The body was stiff and cold. The Squire must
+have been dead for some hours.
+
+"Murdered!" he said in a low voice; "my father has been murdered."
+
+He remained in horror struck silence for a minute or two; then he slowly
+rose to his feet.
+
+"Let us lay him on the bed," he said, and with the assistance of the
+three men he lifted and laid him there.
+
+"He has been stabbed," he murmured, pointing to a small cut in the
+middle of the deep stain, just over the heart.
+
+Ramoo, after helping to lift the Squire onto the bed, had slid down to
+the floor, and crouched there, sobbing convulsively. The two servants
+stood helpless and aghast. Mark looked round the room: the window was
+open. He walked to it. A garden ladder stood outside, showing how the
+assassin had obtained entrance. Mark stood rigid and silent, his hands
+tightly clenched, his breath coming slowly and heavily. At last he
+roused himself.
+
+"Leave things just as they are," he said to the men in a tone of
+unnatural calmness, "and fasten the door up again, and turn a table or
+something of that sort against it on the outside so that no one can come
+in. John, do you tell one of the grooms to saddle a horse and ride down
+into the town. Let him tell the head constable to come up at once, and
+also Dr. Holloway. Then he is to go on to Sir Charles Harris, tell him
+what has happened, and beg him to ride over at once.
+
+"Come, Ramoo," he said in a softer voice, "you can do no good here, poor
+fellow, and the room must be closed. It is a heavy loss to you too."
+
+The Hindoo rose slowly, the tears streaming down his face.
+
+"He was a good master," he said, "and I loved him just as I loved the
+Colonel, sahib. Ramoo would have given his life for him."
+
+With his hand upon Ramoo's shoulder, Mark left the room; he passed a
+group of women huddled together with blanched faces, at a short distance
+down the passage, the news that the Squire's door could not be opened
+and the sounds made by its being broken in having called them together.
+Mark could not speak. He silently shook his head and passed on. As
+he reached his room he heard shrieks and cries behind him, as the men
+informed them of what had taken place. On reaching his door, the one
+opposite opened, and Mrs. Cunningham in a dressing gown came out.
+
+"What is the matter, Mark, and what are these cries about?"
+
+"A dreadful thing has happened, Mrs. Cunningham; my father has been
+murdered in the night. Please tell Millicent."
+
+Then he closed the door behind him, threw himself on his bed, and burst
+into a passion of tears. The Squire had been a good father to him, and
+had made him his friend and companion--a treatment rare indeed at a time
+when few sons would think of sitting down in their father's presence
+until told to do so. Since he had left school, eight years before, they
+had been very much together. For the last two or three years Mark had
+been a good deal out, but in this his father had encouraged him.
+
+"I like to see you make your own friends, Mark, and go your own way," he
+used to say; "it is as bad for a lad to be tied to his father's coattail
+as at his mother's apron string. Get fresh ideas and form your own
+opinions. It will do for you what a public school would have done; make
+you self reliant, and independent."
+
+Still, of course, a great portion of his time had been with his father,
+and they often would ride round the estate together and talk to the
+tenants, or walk in the gardens and forcing houses. Generally Mark would
+be driven by his father to the meet if it took place within reasonable
+distance, his horse being sent on beforehand by a groom, while of an
+evening they would sit in the library, smoke their long pipes, and talk
+over politics or the American and French wars.
+
+All this was over. There was but one thing now that he could do for his
+father, and that was to revenge his death, and at the thought he rose
+from his bed impatiently and paced up and down the room. He must wait
+for a week, wait till the funeral was over, and then he would be on
+Bastow's track. If all other plans failed he would spend his time in
+coaches until at last the villain should try to stop one; but there must
+be other ways. Could he find no other he would apply for employment as
+a Bow Street runner, serve for a year to find out their methods, and
+acquaint himself with the places where criminals were harbored. It would
+be the one object of his life, until he succeeded in laying his hand on
+Bastow's shoulder. He would not shoot him if he could help it. He should
+prefer to see him in the dock, to hear the sentence passed on him, and
+to see it carried out. As to the treasure, it was not worth a thought
+till his first duty was discharged.
+
+Presently a servant brought him a cup of tea. He drank it mechanically,
+and then proceeded to dress himself. Sir Charles Harris would be here
+soon and the others; indeed, he had scarcely finished when he was told
+that the doctor from Reigate had just arrived, and that the constable
+had come up half an hour before. He at once went down to the library,
+into which the doctor had been shown.
+
+"You have heard what has happened," he said, as he shook hands silently.
+"I expect Sir Charles Harris here in half an hour. I suppose you will
+not go up till then?"
+
+"No, I think it will be best that no one should go in until he comes. I
+have been speaking to Simeox; he was going in, but I told him I thought
+it was better to wait. I may as well take the opportunity of going
+upstairs to see Mr. Bastow. I hear that he fainted when he heard the
+news, and that he is completely prostrate."
+
+"Two such shocks might well prove fatal to him," Mark said; "he has been
+weak and ailing for some time."
+
+"Two shocks?" the doctor repeated interrogatively.
+
+"Ah, I forgot you had not heard about the affair yesterday evening: a
+man fired at us through the window when we were sitting round the fire,
+before the candles were lit. The ball passed between my father's head
+and Mr. Bastow's; both had a narrow escape; the bullet is imbedded in
+the mantelpiece. I will have it cut out; it may be a useful item of
+evidence some day."
+
+"But what could have been the man's motive? Your father was universally
+popular."
+
+"Except with ill doers," Mark said. "I ran out and chased the fellow
+for half a mile, and should have caught him if he had not had a horse
+waiting for him in a lane, and he got off by the skin of his teeth. I
+hope that next time I meet him he will not be so lucky. Mr. Bastow was
+very much shaken, and went to bed soon afterwards. I am not surprised
+that this second shock should be too much for him. Will you go up and
+see him? I will speak to Simeox."
+
+The constable was out in the garden.
+
+"This is a terrible business, Mr. Thorndyke. I suppose, after what you
+told me, you have your suspicions?"
+
+"They are not suspicions at all--they are certainties. Did you hear that
+he tried to shoot my father yesterday evening?"
+
+"No, sir, I have heard nothing about it."
+
+Mark repeated the story of the attempt and pursuit.
+
+"Could you swear to him,' Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"No, there was not much light left; besides, as I have not seen him for
+the last eight years, I should certainly not be able to recognize him
+unless I had time to have a good look at him. Had it only been last
+night's affair it might have been anyone; but the shooting through the
+window was not the act of a thief, but of an assassin, who could only
+have been influenced by private enmity. I quite see that at present I
+have no legal evidence against Bastow; I am not even in a position to
+prove that he is in the country, for it cannot be said that my father's
+belief that he recognized the voice of the man who said 'Stand and
+deliver!' is proof. I doubt if anyone could swear that, when he only
+heard three words, he was absolutely sure that it was the voice of a man
+he had not seen for some years. However, fortunately, that will make no
+difference; the man is, as I told you, wanted for his heading the mutiny
+in the convict prison at Sydney, which will be quite sufficient to hang
+him without this business. But I own that I should prefer that he were
+hung for my father's murder if we could secure sufficient evidence.
+Moreover, there is the attack upon us three or four months ago, and with
+the evidence of the surgeon who attended him as to his wound, that would
+be enough to hang him. But we have first got to catch him, and that I
+mean to make my business, however long the search may take me."
+
+"Was anything taken last night, sir?"
+
+"I don't know; I did not look. We shall see to that when we go upstairs.
+We may as well go indoors now; Sir Charles may be here in a few minutes,
+and I want to hear Dr. Holloway's report as to Mr. Bastow."
+
+"He does not suspect, I hope, sir?"
+
+"No, thank God; my father never mentioned to him anything he heard about
+his son, or his suspicions, therefore he has no reason to believe that
+the fellow is not still in the convict prison at Sydney. We shall keep
+it from him now, whatever happens; but it would, for his sake, be best
+that this shock should prove too much for him. He has had a very hard
+time of it altogether."
+
+"He is terribly prostrate," the doctor reported when Mark joined him. "I
+don't think that he will get over it. He is scarcely conscious now. You
+see, he is an old man, and has no reserve of strength to fall back upon.
+Your father has been such a good friend to him that it is not surprising
+the news should have been too much for him. I examined him at the
+Squire's request some months ago as to his heart's action, which was so
+weak that I told the Squire then that he might go off at any time, and I
+rather wonder that he recovered even temporarily from the shock."
+
+In a few minutes Sir Charles Harris drove up.
+
+"This is terrible news, my dear Mark," he said, as he leaped from his
+gig and wrung Mark's hand--"terrible. I don't know when I have had
+such a shock; he was a noble fellow in all respects, a warm friend, an
+excellent magistrate, a kind landlord, good all round. I can scarcely
+believe it yet. A burglar, of course. I suppose he entered the house for
+the purpose of robbery, when your father awoke and jumped out of bed,
+there was a tussle, and the scoundrel killed him; at least, that is what
+I gather from the story that the groom told me."
+
+"That is near it, Sir Charles, but I firmly believe that robbery was not
+the object, but murder; for murder was attempted yesterday evening," and
+he informed the magistrate of the shot fired through the window.
+
+"Bless me, you don't say so!" the magistrate exclaimed. "That alters
+the case altogether, and certainly would seem to make the act one of
+premeditated murder; and yet, surely, the Squire could not have had an
+enemy. Some of the men whom we have sentenced may have felt a grudge
+against him, but surely not sufficient to lead them to a crime like
+this."
+
+"I will talk of it with you afterwards, Sir Charles. I have the very
+strongest suspicions, although no absolute proofs. Now, will you first
+come upstairs? Doctor Holloway is here and Simeox, but no one has
+entered the room since I left it; I thought it better that it should be
+left undisturbed until you came."
+
+"Quite so; we will go up at once."
+
+An examination of the room showed nothing whatever that would afford the
+slightest clew. The Squire's watch was still in the watch pocket at the
+head of the bed, his purse was on a small table beside him; apparently
+nothing had been touched in the room.
+
+"If robbery was the object," Sir Charles said gravely, "it has evidently
+not been carried out, and it is probable that Mr. Thorndyke was partly
+woke by the opening of the window, and that he was not thoroughly
+aroused until the man was close to his bed; then he leapt out and seized
+him. Probably the stab was, as Dr. Holloway assures us, instantly fatal,
+and he may have fallen so heavily that the man, fearing that the house
+would be alarmed at the sound, at once fled, without even waiting to
+snatch up the purse. The whole thing is so clear that it is scarcely
+necessary to ask any further questions. Of course, there must be an
+inquest tomorrow. I should like when I go down to ask the gardener
+where he left the ladder yesterday. Have you examined the ground for
+footmarks?"
+
+"Yes, Sir Charles, but you see it was a pretty hard frost last night,
+and I cannot find any marks at all. The ground must have been like iron
+about the time when the ladder was placed there."
+
+The gardener, on being called in, said that the ladder was always hung
+up outside the shed at the back of the house; there was a chain round
+it, and he had found that morning that one of the links had been filed
+through.
+
+"The Squire was most particular about its being locked, as Mr. Mark
+knows, so that it could not be used by any ill disposed chaps who might
+come along at night. The key of the padlock was always hung on a nail
+round the other side of the shed. The Squire knew of it, and so did Mr.
+Mark and me; so that while it was out of the way of the eyes of a thief,
+any of us could run and get it and undo the padlock in a minute in case
+of fire or anything of that sort. I have not used the ladder, maybe,
+for a fortnight, but I know that it was hanging in its place yesterday
+afternoon."
+
+"I expect the fellow was prowling about here for some time," Mark said.
+"I was chatting with my father in the library when I thought I heard a
+noise, and I threw open the window, which had by some carelessness been
+left a little open, and went out, and listened for nearly an hour, but I
+could hear nothing, and put it down to the fact that I was nervous owing
+to what had happened early in the evening, and that the noise was simply
+fancy, or that the frost had caused a dry branch of one of the shrubs to
+crack."
+
+"How was it you did not notice the window was open as you went in?"
+
+"The curtains were drawn, sir. I glanced at that when I went into the
+room with my father. After being shot at once from outside, it was
+possible that we might be again; though I own that I did not for a
+moment think that the fellow would return after the hot chase that
+I gave him. I suppose after I went in he looked about and found the
+ladder; it is likely enough that he would have had a file with him in
+case he had any bars to cut through to get into the house, but to my
+mind it is more likely that he knew where to find the ladder without any
+looking for it; it has hung there as long as I can remember."
+
+"Yes, sir," the gardener said, "I have worked for the Squire ever since
+he came here, and the ladder was bought a week or two after he took me
+on, and the Squire settled where it should be hung, so that it might be
+handy either in case of fire or if wanted for a painting job. This aint
+the first ladder; we got a new one four years ago."
+
+"It is singular that the man should have known which was the window of
+your father's room."
+
+"Very singular," Mark said.
+
+Shortly after the doctor left, and Mark had a long talk with the
+magistrate in the library, and told him his reasons for suspecting that
+the murderer was Arthur Bastow.
+
+"It certainly looks like it," the magistrate said thoughtfully, after
+he had heard Mark's story, "though of course it is only a case of strong
+suspicion, and not of legal proof. Your father's recognition of the
+voice could have scarcely been accepted as final when he heard but three
+words, still the whole thing hangs together. The fellow was, I should
+say, capable of anything. I don't know that I ever had a prisoner before
+me whose demeanor was so offensive and insolent, and if it can be proved
+that Bastow is in England I should certainly accept your view of the
+case. He would probably have known both where the ladder was to be found
+and which was the window of your father's bedroom."
+
+"I should certainly think that he would know it, sir. The bedroom was
+the same that my grandfather used to sleep in, and probably during the
+years before we came here young Bastow would have often been over the
+house. The first year or two after we came he was often up here with
+his father, but I know that my father took such an objection to him, his
+manner and language were so offensive, that he would not have me, boy as
+I was--I was only about eleven when he came here--associate with him in
+the smallest degree. But during those two years he may very well have
+noticed where the ladder was."
+
+"Do you intend to say anything about all this tomorrow at the inquest,
+Mark?"
+
+"I don't think I shall do so," Mark said moodily. "I am certain of it
+myself, but I don't think any man would convict him without stronger
+evidence than I could give. However, that business in Australia will be
+sufficient to hang him."
+
+"I think you are right, Mark. Of course, if you do light upon any
+evidence, we can bring this matter up in another court; if not, there
+will be no occasion for you to appear in it at all, but leave it
+altogether for the authorities to prove the Sydney case against him;
+it will only be necessary for the constables who got up the other case
+against him to prove his sentence, and for the reports of the Governor
+of the jail to be read. There will be no getting over that, and he
+will be hung as a matter of course. It will be a terrible thing for his
+unhappy father."
+
+"I do not think that he is likely to come to know it, sir; the shock of
+the affair yesterday and that of this morning have completely prostrated
+him, and Dr. Holloway, who was up with him before you arrived, thinks
+that there is very little chance of his recovery."
+
+When the magistrate had left, Mark sent a request to Mrs. Cunningham
+that she would come down for a few minutes. She joined him in the
+drawing room.
+
+"Thank you for coming down," he said quietly. "I wanted to ask how you
+were, and how Millicent is."
+
+"She is terribly upset. You see, the Squire was the only father she had
+ever known; and had he been really so he could not have been kinder. It
+is a grievous loss to me also, after ten years of happiness here; but
+I have had but little time to think of my own loss yet, I have been too
+occupied in soothing the poor girl. How are you feeling yourself, Mark?"
+
+"I don't understand myself," he said. "I don't think that anyone could
+have loved his father better than I have done; but since I broke down
+when I first went to my room I seem to have no inclination to give way
+to sorrow. I feel frozen up; my voice does not sound to me as if it were
+my own; I am able to discuss matters as calmly as if I were speaking of
+a stranger. The one thing that I feel passionately anxious about is to
+set out on the track of the assassin."
+
+"There is nothing unusual in your state of feeling, Mark. Such a thing
+as this is like a wound in battle; the shock is so great that for a time
+it numbs all pain. I have heard my husband say that a soldier who has
+had his arm carried off by a cannon ball will fall from the shock, and
+when he recovers consciousness will be ignorant where he has been hit.
+It is so with you; probably the sense of pain and loss will increase
+every day as you take it in more and more. As for what you say about the
+murderer, it will undoubtedly be a good thing for you to have something
+to employ your thoughts and engage all your faculties as soon as this is
+all over. Is there anything that I can do?"
+
+"No, thank you; the inquest will be held tomorrow. I have sent down to
+Chatterton to come up this afternoon to make the necessary preparations
+for the funeral. Let me see, today is Wednesday, is it not? I seem to
+have lost all account of the time."
+
+"Yes, Wednesday."
+
+"Then I suppose the funeral will be on Monday or Tuesday. If there is
+any message that you want sent down to the town, one of the grooms will
+carry it whenever you wish."
+
+"Thank you; 'tis not worth sending particularly, any time will do, but
+I shall want to send a note to Mrs. Wilson presently, asking her to come
+up the first thing tomorrow morning."
+
+"He can take it whenever, you like, Mrs. Cunningham. I have nothing
+to send down for, as far as I know. I suppose you have heard that the
+doctor thinks very badly of Mr. Bastow?"
+
+"Yes. Ramoo is sitting with him now."
+
+"Then I think, if you will write your note at once, Mrs. Cunningham, I
+will send one down to Dr. Holloway, asking him to send an experienced
+nurse. He said he should call again this afternoon, but the sooner a
+nurse comes the better."
+
+That afternoon Mark wrote a letter to the family solicitors, telling
+them of what had taken place, and stating that the funeral would be on
+the following Tuesday, and asking them to send down a clerk with his
+father's will, or if one of the partners could manage to come down,
+he should greatly prefer it, in view of the explanations that would be
+necessary. He had already sent off a letter to the head of the Detective
+Department, asking him to send down one of his best men as soon as
+possible. Then he went out into the garden, and walked backwards and
+forwards for about two hours, and then returned to what he thought
+would be a solitary meal. Mrs. Cunningham, however, came down. She had
+thoughtfully had the large dining table pushed on one side, and a small
+one placed near the fire.
+
+"I thought it would be more comfortable," she said, "as there are only
+our two selves, just to sit here."
+
+He thanked her with a look. It was a nice little dinner, and Mark, to
+his surprise, ate it with an appetite. Except the cup of tea that he
+had taken in the morning, and a glass of wine at midday, he had touched
+nothing. Mrs. Cunningham was a woman of great tact, and by making him
+talk of the steps that he intended to take to hunt down the assassin,
+kept him from thinking.
+
+"Thank you very much, Mrs. Cunningham," he said, when the dinner was
+over. "I feel very much better."
+
+"I have brought down my work," she said, "and will sit here while you
+drink your wine and smoke a pipe. Millicent has gone to bed, completely
+worn out, and it will be pleasanter for us both to sit here than to be
+alone."
+
+Mark gladly agreed to the proposal. She turned the conversation now to
+India, and talked of her life there.
+
+"I was not out there very long," she said. "I was engaged to my husband
+when he first went out, and six years afterwards joined him there, and
+we were married. Your uncle, who was a major of his regiment, gave me
+away. My husband got his company six months afterwards, and was killed
+three years later. My pension as his widow was not a large one, and
+when your uncle offered me the charge of his daughter I was very glad to
+accept it. He gave some idea of his plans for her. I thought they were
+very foolish, but when I saw that his mind was thoroughly made up I did
+not attempt to dissuade him. He said that when he came home to England
+(and he had no idea when that would be) he should have me here, as head
+of his establishment, and it would be given out that the child was his
+ward. I hoped that he would alter his mind later on, but, as you know,
+he never did."
+
+"Well, of course, she will have to be told now," Mark said.
+
+"Do you think so? It seems to me that it were better that she would go
+as she is, at any rate, until she is twenty-one."
+
+"That would be quite impossible," Mark said decidedly. "How could I
+assume the position of master here? And even if I could, it would be a
+strange thing indeed for me to be here with a girl the age of my cousin,
+even with you as chaperon. You must see yourself that it would be quite
+impossible."
+
+"But how could she live here by herself?"
+
+"I don't think she could live here by herself," Mark said, "especially
+after what has happened. Of course, it has all got to be talked over,
+but my idea is that the place had better be shut up, and that you should
+take, in your own name, a house in London. I suppose she will want
+masters for the harp, and so on. For a time, at any rate, that would be
+the best plan, unless you would prefer some other place to London. We
+have done our best to carry out my uncle's wishes, but circumstances
+have been too strong for us, and it cannot be kept up any longer; but
+there is no reason, if you and she prefer it, why she should not be
+known, until you return here, by her present name. Of course the affair
+will create a great deal of talk down here, but in London no one will
+know that Millicent is an heiress, though it is hardly likely that you
+will make many acquaintances for a time."
+
+"Have you known it long, Mark? I thought that you were kept in ignorance
+of it."
+
+"I only heard it yesterday evening, Mrs. Cunningham; after that shot
+through the window my father thought I ought to know all about it, for
+the attempt might be repeated more successfully. He told me all about
+her, and about the treasure."
+
+"What treasure?" Mrs. Cunningham said. "I don't know what you mean."
+
+He then told her of the story his uncle had related, and how he had been
+prevented from giving full instructions for its discovery, the only clew
+being a gold coin and the word Masulipatam, and that this treasure had
+been left equally divided between him and Millicent by his will.
+
+"He told me that he should provide for you," Mrs. Cunningham remarked,
+"when I said that it would be unfair that you should be brought up
+believing yourself the heir. I never heard any more about it, but I am
+glad that it is so."
+
+"I fancy the chance of its coming to either of us is very small," Mark
+said; "a coin and a word are not much to go upon. I have not the most
+remote idea what they mean, and whether the treasure is in England or in
+India, Heaven only knows."
+
+"Possibly, when he made the will, he may have told the solicitors
+where it was, and instructed them to keep it secret until the time that
+Millicent came into possession of the estate."
+
+"It is just possible he did so, Mrs. Cunningham, but the efforts he made
+to speak at the last moment would almost seem to show that he had
+not told them, for, if he had, the matter would have been of no vital
+importance one way or the other. Will Millicent be well enough to come
+down in the morning?"
+
+"I hope so."
+
+"I hope so, too; but, at any rate, keep her up in her room till the
+afternoon. The inquest will be at eleven o'clock, and it is better that
+she should not come down until everyone has gone away."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX.
+
+
+Directly after breakfast was over the next morning the Rector came in.
+
+"I would not come in yesterday, Mark," he said. "I knew that you would
+be best alone; and, indeed, I was myself so terribly upset by the news
+that I did not feel equal to it. I need not say how deeply I and my wife
+sympathize with you. Never did a kinder heart beat than your father's;
+never have I seen people so universally grieved as they are in the
+village. I doubt whether a man went to work yesterday, and as for
+the women, had it been a father they had lost they could not be more
+affected."
+
+"Yes, he will be greatly missed," Mark said unsteadily; "and, between
+ourselves--but this must go no further--I have a suspicion, amounting
+almost to a certainty, that the hand that dealt this blow is the same
+that caused the vacancy that brought you here."
+
+"Do you mean Arthur Bastow?" Mr. Greg said in amazement. "Why, I thought
+that he was transported for fifteen years."
+
+Then Mark told the Rector the inner history of the past six months,
+and of the report they had had from the officer at Bow Street of the
+personal appearance of the wounded man.
+
+"Other things are in favor of it," he went on. "My father's watch and
+purse were untouched, and a stranger on a dark night would be hardly
+likely to have discovered the ladder, or to have had a file in his
+pocket with which to cut through a link, though this might have been
+part of the apparatus of any burglar. Then, again, an ordinary man would
+hardly have known which was my father's bedroom, except, indeed, that he
+saw the light there after those in the ladies' rooms were extinguished;
+but, at any rate, he could not have told which was my father's and which
+was mine. But all this is, as I said, Mr. Greg, quite between ourselves.
+I had a long talk yesterday with Sir Charles Harris, and, as he said,
+there is no legal proof whatever, strong as the suspicion is; so I am
+going to say nothing on the subject at the inquest. The scoundrel's poor
+father is dying, happily in ignorance of all this. Dr. Holloway was up
+with him all night, and told me this morning before he drove off that it
+is very unlikely that he will get through the day."
+
+"It is all very terrible, Mark; but I cannot deny that everything points
+to the man. Surely no one else could have cut short so useful a life,
+for certainly no ordinary degree of hatred would drive a man, however
+brutal his nature, to commit such a crime, and to run the risk of
+hanging for it. Let us take a brisk walk in the garden for an hour--that
+will be the best thing for you. I will stop with you until the inquest
+is over, and then you had better come over and have lunch with us."
+
+"Thank you; I cannot do so," Mark said, "though I should like to. In the
+first place, Millicent will come downstairs this afternoon, and I should
+like to be in to meet her. Had it not been for that I might have come,
+as I can walk across the fields to the Rectory without passing through
+the village. There is another reason. I sent up yesterday by the coach
+a letter to be delivered at once by hand, and I expect a detective down
+here by one o'clock. I don't know that he will do any good; but at
+the same time it will give me something to do, and at present there is
+nothing I dread so much as sitting alone. Fortunately, yesterday evening
+Millicent went to bed at five o'clock, and Mrs. Cunningham sat with me
+all the evening, and her talk did me a great deal of good."
+
+The inquest occupied a very short time, the only point on which many
+questions were asked being as to the firing through the window. Mark
+stated that it was already so dark that although he was within fifty
+yards of the man when he mounted and rode off, he could not give any
+very distinct description of his figure. It struck him as being that of
+a man of medium height.
+
+"You have made out that the bullet was intended for your father?"
+
+"I cannot say that, sir, it went between his head and that of Mr.
+Bastow, but it might have been meant for either."
+
+"Was your father impressed with the idea that it was an attempt to
+murder him?"
+
+"He naturally thought so. Mr. Bastow can assuredly have no enemies,
+while my father, as a magistrate, may have made some. He certainly
+thought it was an attempt to murder him, and was so impressed by the
+fact that when we went to the library later on he went into certain
+family matters with me that he had never communicated before, and which,
+had it not been for this, he would not have entered into for some years
+to come."
+
+"He had his opinion, then, as to who was his assailant?"
+
+"He had, sir, but as it was but an opinion, although there were
+several facts that seemed to justify the conviction, there was no proof
+whatever, and therefore I do not think myself justified in saying what
+that opinion was."
+
+"Do you entertain the same opinion yourself?"
+
+"I do," Mark said emphatically; "but until I can obtain some evidence in
+support of what is really but a matter of opinion, and because, were I
+to give the name, it would lessen my chance of obtaining such evidence,
+I decline to mention the name."
+
+"You have no doubt that the author of the second attempt is the same as
+that of the first?"
+
+"Personally, I have no doubt whatever; it stands to reason that it is
+barely possible that two men could have, unknown to each other, made up
+their minds to murder my father on the same evening."
+
+The constable's evidence added nothing to that given by Mark. He had
+been down to the lane where the man pursued had mounted. The reins of
+the horse had apparently been thrown over a gatepost, and he thought it
+had been standing there for some little time, for there were marks where
+it had scraped the ground repeatedly. He had followed the marks of its
+hoofs for some distance; it had gone at a gallop for about half a mile,
+and then the pace had slackened into a trot. It continued until the
+lane fell into the main road, but beyond this he had been unable to
+distinguish it from the marks of the traffic in general.
+
+"You found no footprints whatever near the foot of the ladder, or
+anywhere else round the house?"
+
+"None whatever, sir."
+
+"There were no signs of any other window or door save that of Mr.
+Thorndyke's room being attempted?"
+
+"None at all, sir."
+
+There was but a short consultation between the jurors, who at once
+returned a verdict of "Willful murder by some person or persons
+unknown."
+
+Dr. Holloway had, after giving evidence, returned at once to Mr.
+Bastow's room. The only point of importance in his evidence was the
+statement that the wound must have been fatal at once, the heart itself
+having been penetrated. It had been inflicted by a dagger or a narrow
+bladed knife.
+
+"Do you mean that it was an unusually small dagger, Dr. Holloway?"
+
+"I should say it was a very fine dagger; not the sort of weapon that you
+would expect to find a highwayman carry, if he carried one at all, but
+rather a weapon of Spanish or Italian manufacture."
+
+"Not the sort of wound that a rapier would make?"
+
+"Yes, the wound itself might have been very well made by a light rapier,
+but there was a slight bruise on the flesh on each side of the wound,
+such a mark as might be made by the handle or guard of a dagger, and
+sufficiently plain to leave no doubt in my mind that it was so made."
+
+"Had the wound a downward course, or was it a straight thrust?"
+
+"A straight thrust," the doctor replied. "My idea is that the two men
+were grappling together, and that as Mr. Thorndyke was a very powerful
+man, his assailant, who probably was approaching the bed with the
+dagger in his hand, plunged it into him; had he struck at him I should
+certainly have expected the course of the wound to be downward, as I
+fancy a man very seldom thrusts straight with a dagger, as he would do
+with a rapier."
+
+When the inquest was over, Mark, going out into the hall, found the
+doctor waiting there for him.
+
+"Mr. Bastow breathed his last some ten minutes ago. I saw when I went up
+to him just before I gave my evidence that it was likely that he would
+die before I returned to the room."
+
+"I am very sorry," Mark said, "although I expected nothing else from
+what you told me: He was a very kind hearted man; no one could have
+had a kinder or more patient tutor than he was to me, while my father
+regarded him as a very dear and valued friend. I am expecting the
+undertaker here in a few minutes, and they can both be buried at the
+same time."
+
+It was late in the afternoon before Millicent came down with Mrs.
+Cunningham. The news of Mr. Bastow's death had set her tears flowing
+afresh; she had been very fond of him, and that he and the Squire should
+have been taken at once seemed almost beyond belief. She had, however,
+nerved herself to some degree of composure before she went down to meet
+Mark; but although she returned the pressure of his hand, she was unable
+for some time to speak. Mrs. Cunningham thought it best to speak first
+on the minor grief.
+
+"So Mr. Bastow has gone, Mark?"
+
+"Yes, Dr. Holloway thought very badly of him yesterday, and said that he
+had but very faint hope of his rallying. I cannot help thinking that it
+was best so. Of course, he was not a very old man, but he has for some
+years been a very feeble one, and now that Millicent and I have both
+given up our studies with him, I think that he would have felt that his
+work was done, and would have gone downhill very fast."
+
+"I think so, too," Mrs. Cunningham agreed. "I am sure that even had the
+Squire's death come quietly, in the course of nature, it would have
+been a terrible blow to him. He was fond of you and Millicent, but his
+affection for your father was a passion; his face always lit up when he
+spoke to him. I used to think sometimes that it was like an old dog with
+his master. It was quite touching to see them together. I think, Mark,
+with you, that it is best that it should be as it is."
+
+Gradually the conversation turned to other matters. Millicent was,
+however, unable to take any part in it, and half an hour later she held
+out her hand silently to Mark and left the room hurriedly. The next day
+she was better, and was able to walk for a time with Mark in the garden
+and talk more calmly about their mutual loss, for to her, no less than
+to Mark, the Squire had been a father.
+
+"'Tis strange to think that you are the Squire now, Mark," she said as
+they sat together in the dining room on the evening before the funeral.
+
+"You will think it stranger still, Millicent," he said, "when I tell you
+that I am not the Squire, and never shall be."
+
+She looked up in his face with wonder.
+
+"What do you mean, Mark?"
+
+"Well, dear, you will know tomorrow, as Mr. Prendergast, one of the
+family solicitors, is coming down; but I think it is as well to tell you
+beforehand. It has been a curious position all along. I never knew it
+myself till my father told me when we went into the library after
+the shot was fired. The news did not affect me one way or the other,
+although it surprised me a great deal. Like yourself, I have always
+supposed that you were my father's ward, the daughter of an old comrade
+of his brother's. Well, it is a curious story, Millicent. But there is
+no occasion for you to look frightened. The fact is you are my uncle's
+daughter and my cousin."
+
+"Oh, that is not very dreadful!" she exclaimed in a tone of relief.
+
+"Not dreadful at all," Mark said. "But you see it involves the fact that
+you are mistress of this estate, and not I."
+
+Millicent stood up suddenly with a little cry. "No, no, Mark, it cannot
+be! It would be dreadful, and I won't have it. Nothing could make me
+have it. What, to take the estate away from you when you have all along
+supposed it to be yours! How could I?"
+
+"But you see it never has been mine, my dear. Father might have lived
+another five-and-twenty years, and God knows I have never looked forward
+to succeeding him. Sit down and let me tell you the story. It was not my
+father's fault that he reigned here so long as master, it was the result
+of a whim of your father's. And although my father fought against it, he
+could not resist the dying prayer of my uncle."
+
+He then related the whole circumstances under which the girl had been
+brought up as Millicent Conyers, instead of Millicent Conyers Thorndyke,
+and how the estate had been left by Colonel Thorndyke's will to his
+brother until such time as Millicent should come of age, or marry,
+and how he had ordered that when that event took place the rest of his
+property in money and jewels was to be divided equally between Mark and
+herself.
+
+"It must not be, Mark," she said firmly. "You must take the estate, and
+we can divide the rest between us. What is the rest?"
+
+"To begin with," Mark said cheerfully, "there are 25,000 pounds,
+the accumulations of the rents of the estate after the death of my
+grandfather up to the time when the Colonel returned from India; and
+there are, besides, a few thousands, though I don't exactly know how
+many, that my father paid over to the solicitors as the surplus of the
+rents of the estates after paying all expenses of keeping up this house.
+He very properly considered that although he had accepted the situation
+at your father's earnest wish, he ought not to make money by doing so.
+If we put it down at 30,000 pounds altogether, you see there is 15,000
+pounds for each of us. A very nice sum for a young man to start life
+with, especially as I shall have my father's estate near Hastings,
+which brings in 500 pounds a year; and as the rents of this have been
+accumulating for the last ten years, my share will be raised from 15,000
+pounds to 20,000 pounds. Besides this, there is the main bulk of the
+Colonel's fortune made in India. That seems to be worth about 100,000
+pounds but I must own that the chance of getting it seems very small."
+
+"How is that, Mark?"
+
+Mark told her the whole story.
+
+"I mean to make it my business to follow the matter up," he said. "I
+think that the chance of ever finding it is very small. Still, it will
+give me an object to begin life with."
+
+"Oh, I hope that you will never find it!" she exclaimed. "From what you
+say it will be a terrible danger if you do get it."
+
+Mark smiled.
+
+"I hardly think so, Millicent. I cannot believe that people would be
+following up this thing for over fifteen years, for it was many years
+before the Colonel came home that he got possession of these diamonds.
+Even Hindoos would, I think, have got sick of such a hopeless affair
+long before this; but as they may ever since your father's death have
+been watching us, although it hardly seems possible, I shall follow out
+the Colonel's instructions, and get rid of those particular diamonds
+at once. I shall only keep them about me long enough to take them to
+Amsterdam and sell them there. The Colonel said they were the finest
+diamonds that he ever saw, and that he really had no idea of what they
+were worth. However, that is for the future."
+
+"Mrs. Cunningham has known this all along, Mark?"
+
+"Not about the money affairs, but of course she knew that you were my
+cousin. She brought you from India, you see, and has known all
+along that the Colonel was your father. She knows it, and the family
+solicitors know it, but I believe no one else, except, perhaps, Ramoo. I
+am not sure whether he was in uncle's service when you were sent over in
+Mrs. Cunningham's charge. He may know it or he may not, but certainly
+no one else does, except, as I say, the solicitors and myself. Possibly
+some other of the Colonel's old comrades knew that there was a child
+born; but if they were in England and happened to hear that my father
+had succeeded to the estate, they would, of course, suppose that the
+child had died."
+
+"Then," Millicent said, in a tone of relief, "there can be no reason why
+anyone else should know anything about it. I will see Mr. Prendergast
+when he comes down tomorrow, and beg him to say nothing about it;
+15,000 pounds is quite enough for any girl; and besides, you say that my
+father's greatest wish was that I was not to be married for money, and
+after all the pains that have been taken, his wish will not be carried
+out if I am to be made owner of the estate."
+
+"You won't be able to persuade Mr. Prendergast to do that," Mark said,
+smiling. "It is his duty simply to carry out the provisions of your
+father's will, and to place you in possession of the estate; and if he
+would keep silence, which he certainly won't, you don't suppose that I
+would."
+
+"Then I shall hate you, Mark."
+
+"I don't think you will, Millicent, and I would rather that you did that
+than that you should despise me. At the present moment you may think
+that this estate would be only a burden to you, but some day when you
+marry you might see the matter in a different light."
+
+The girl looked at him reproachfully.
+
+"I should never think so!" she burst out. "What would you have me do?
+Live here in this great house, with only Mrs. Cunningham, while you are
+going about the world seeking for this treasure? Never!"
+
+"No, I don't think that it would be nice for you to do that, Millicent,"
+Mark said. "Mrs. Cunningham and I have been talking it over. We thought
+that the best plan would be for her to take a house in London, and go
+there with you; you would have the advantages of good masters.
+
+"Then you were saying only a short time since that you would like to
+learn the harp and take lessons in painting. There would be time enough
+to think about what you would do with respect to this house afterward."
+
+"It is all horrible," Millicent said, bursting into tears, "and I shall
+always feel that I have robbed you."
+
+"But I don't feel so in the least," Mark urged. "I was not in the
+smallest degree put out when my father told me about it. I have always
+had a fancy for wandering about the world, as my uncle did, and doing
+something to distinguish myself, instead of settling down for life to be
+a country magistrate and a squire. Of course it came as a surprise, but
+I can assure you that it was not an altogether unpleasant one. What
+can a man want more than a nice little estate of 500 pounds a year and
+20,000 pounds in money?"
+
+"It is all very well to say that, but as you said to me just now, you
+may see it in a different light some day."
+
+Then she sat thinking for some time. "At any rate," she went on at last,
+"I don't see why anyone should know about it now. If the house is to be
+shut up and you are going away, why need anyone know anything about it?
+My father's wish was that I should not have people making love to me
+just because I was an heiress; after all that has been done, it would be
+wicked to go against his wishes. I suppose the interest of this 15,000
+pounds would be enough for Mrs. Cunningham and I to live comfortably on
+in London?"
+
+"Yes," Mark said; "it will, at 5 per cent, bring in 750 pounds a year."
+
+"Then I shall remain Millicent Conyers to the world. There is nothing to
+prevent that, is there?" she said almost defiantly.
+
+"No," he replied thoughtfully. "The rents of this estate might
+accumulate. I suppose the solicitors would see after that; and as I
+shall be away it will, of course, make no difference to me. Were I to
+stay in the neighborhood I could not consent to live as my father did,
+in a false position; but even then I might give out that the property
+had only been left to my father during his lifetime, and that it had now
+gone elsewhere, without saying whom it had gone to. However, as I shall
+be away there will be no occasion even for that. When the will is read
+there will be no one present but ourselves, and I don't see why its
+contents should not be kept a secret for a time; at any rate, we can ask
+Mr. Prendergast's opinion upon that subject."
+
+At this moment, Mrs. Cunningham coming into the room, Millicent ran to
+her and threw her arms round her neck.
+
+"He has made me most miserable," she said. "I thought I could not have
+been more miserable than I was before he told me all about it."
+
+"I knew that he was going to do so, and I was quite sure that you would
+not be pleased at the news. I have all along thought that it was a
+mistake on the part of your father; but as it was his decision, and not
+mine, I only had to carry out his wishes."
+
+"It is cruel," Millicent sobbed. "I don't mean it is cruel of my father;
+of course he could not have known, and he thought he was doing the best
+thing for my happiness, but it has all turned out wrong."
+
+"For the present you may think so, dear; but you must remember that up
+to the present time it has turned out well. I know that your uncle did
+not like it at first, but I think that he passed ten happy years here.
+It gave him a great power for doing good, and he worthily availed
+himself of it. We have all spent a happy time; he was universally liked
+and respected. I think all of us have benefited by it. It would not have
+been half as pleasant if it had been known that you, my child, were the
+real owner of the estate, and he was acting merely as your guardian.
+Let us hope that everything will turn out as well in future. Colonel
+Thorndyke told me that he had left a considerable sum in addition to the
+estates, and that this was to be divided between you and Mark; so you
+see your cousin will not go out into the world a beggar."
+
+"It is most of it lost," Millicent said with an hysterical laugh. "It
+is all hidden away, and no one can find it; everything has gone wrong
+together."
+
+"Well, I think, dear, that you had better go up to bed. I will go
+with you. At the present time this, of course, has come upon you as an
+additional shock. I would gladly have shielded you from it for a time if
+I could have done so, but you must have learned it tomorrow, and I quite
+agree with Mark that is was better that he should tell you this evening.
+I sent down to the town today to the doctor's and asked him to send me
+up a soothing draught, thinking that you might be upset by the news. I
+hope by the morning you will be able to look at matters more calmly."
+
+Some time later Mrs. Cunningham came down again.
+
+"She has cried herself to sleep," she said. "She is much grieved about
+this money being lost."
+
+"It is annoying; still I cannot help thinking that the Colonel must have
+taken some such precaution to prevent the treasure from being lost."
+
+"One would certainly think so," Mrs. Cunningham agreed; "the Colonel
+seemed to me a methodical man. I know that he had the reputation of
+being one of the most particular men in the service as to all petty
+details. His instructions to me before I left him were all very minute,
+and he gave me a sealed packet which he told me contained instructions
+and a copy of the register of his marriage and of Millicent's birth, and
+he said that in case of his death I was to take it to your father. He
+said that there was a letter inclosed in it to him, and also a copy
+of his will. The letter was directed to your father, and not to me.
+I handed it over to him when he asked me to come here. He told me
+afterwards that the letter contained the request that his brother lived
+to make personally to him--that the child should be brought up as his
+ward; and that he had handed the certificates to a lawyer, who had,
+however, received copies of them from the Colonel himself before he went
+down to see your father. So, as he took these precautions to insure
+his wishes being carried out in the event of his sudden death, I should
+think that he must have done something of the sort with regard to this
+treasure."
+
+"I should think that extremely likely, Mrs. Cunningham. I certainly had
+not thought of that before, and I hope that for Millicent's sake and my
+own it may turn out to be so. I can get on extremely well without
+it, but at the same time I don't pretend that 50,000 pounds are to be
+despised."
+
+The next morning Mr. Prendergast, who had arrived at Reigate late the
+evening before, and had put up at an inn, came up to the house an hour
+before the time named for the funeral. He learned from Mark that he had
+already acquainted Millicent with her change of circumstances. A few
+minutes after he arrived, a servant told him that Miss Conyers would be
+glad if he would see her alone for a few minutes in the drawing room.
+Mark had already prepared him for her request.
+
+"Mark has told you that he told me about this hateful thing last night,
+I suppose, Mr. Prendergast?"
+
+"He has," the old lawyer said kindly; "and he tells me also that you are
+not at all pleased at the news."
+
+"Pleased! I should think not, Mr. Prendergast," she said indignantly. "I
+am not going to rob my cousin of what he has always been taught to think
+as his inheritance. It is abominable, I call it, and most unnatural."
+
+"But, my dear young lady, it is yours, and not his. I do not wish to
+discuss whether the arrangement was altogether a wise one, but I think
+that so far it has turned out well for all parties. Your estate has
+profited greatly by the management of your uncle, the tenants and all
+connected with it have benefited greatly, he himself has had active
+employment afforded him, of which he was fond. Your cousin has,
+I believe, enjoyed the advantages of the position, and has become
+acquainted with the best people in this part of the country, and will
+now obtain the benefit of something like 15,000 pounds--a comfortable
+little sum, especially as he inherits, I believe, his father's property
+in Sussex. You yourself will have obtained what I cannot but consider
+the advantage of having been brought up without knowing that you were an
+heiress, and therefore without being spoiled, which is, in my opinion,
+the case with many young ladies in such a condition; therefore I cannot
+but think that, if unwise in its conception, the matter has so far
+worked out well. I am bound to say that Mr. Mark Thorndyke has been
+speaking to me very handsomely on the subject, and that he appears in no
+way disappointed at finding that you are the heiress of the estate, and
+is really concerned only at your unwillingness to accept the situation."
+
+"I wanted to know, Mr. Prendergast," she said, but in a tone that showed
+she was convinced by his manner that her request would be refused, "if
+you could arrange so that things would not be disturbed, and he should
+come into possession as his father's heir in the natural way."
+
+"But you see he is not his father's heir, Miss Thorndyke. His father
+only had the use, as we call it, of the property until you came of age,
+or marriage; it was not necessary for it to come to you on your coming
+of age, but only, as your father explained to me, in the event of your
+marriage; that is to say, it was not to become public that you were
+entitled to the estate until your marriage. If you married before you
+were twenty-one the property was then to come to you. If you did not
+you were to be informed of the circumstances or not, as Mr. Thorndyke
+might decide was best, but you were not to come into the property until
+you married. Your cousin was also to be informed when you came to the
+age of twenty-one, and as at that time he was to take his half share of
+the remainder of the property, he would then be able to arrange his life
+as he liked. If your uncle died, as unfortunately he has done, before
+you reached the age of twenty-one, you would then be placed in your
+proper position; but your father desired us to say to you that it was
+his wish, that if it could be arranged, your having succeeded to the
+ownership should not be publicly known until you divulged it to your
+husband after marriage. The other portions of the will must be carried
+out. This being only a request, you are at liberty to follow it or not
+as you may choose."
+
+"Certainly I should choose," the girl said. "After all this trouble to
+prevent my being run after as an heiress, it would be wicked to upset
+it all and to fly in the face of his wishes by setting up as mistress of
+this estate. Still you understand, Mr. Prendergast, that I don't mean to
+take it."
+
+The lawyer smiled indulgently. "There is one way in which it might be
+managed," he said. "Perhaps you can guess what it is?"
+
+A flush of color rose over the girl's face. "Don't say it, I beg of you,
+Mr. Prendergast. Mrs. Cunningham hinted at it this morning, and I told
+her that my own wish entirely agreed with that of my father, and that
+I was determined not to be married for money; and I am quite sure that
+Mark would be as unwilling as I am that the estate should change hands
+in that way. No, Mr. Prendergast, you must find some other way of doing
+it than that. Surely an estate cannot be forced upon anyone who is
+determined not to take it."
+
+"Well, we must think it over," Mr. Prendergast said quietly. "And now I
+think that it is time for me to join the others."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X.
+
+
+The funeral of Squire Thorndyke and Mr. Bastow was over, and all
+agreed they had never seen a more affecting spectacle than that at the
+churchyard when the two coffins were brought in. The distance was short,
+and the tenants had requested leave to carry the Squire's bier, while
+that of Mr. Bastow was borne by the villagers who had known and loved
+him. Behind followed all the magistrates and a great number of the
+gentry for miles round; the churchyard was crowded by every man, woman,
+and child in the village, and the women, as well as many of the men,
+wept unrestrainedly as the coffins passed by. Besides these, a large
+number of people from Reigate and the surrounding villages were present,
+attracted rather by the crime that had caused the death than by the
+loss of the Squire himself. The church was crowded, and it was with
+difficulty that Mr. Greg read the service. The Squire was laid by
+the side of his father, Mr. Bastow in the spot where many of his
+predecessors had slept before him.
+
+Mark had been greatly affected, not only by his own loss, but by the
+sight of the general grief among those for whom the Squire had done so
+much. Even Mr. Prendergast, who had taken part in many such functions
+over departed clients, was much moved by the scene.
+
+"I have been at many funerals," he said to Mark as they walked back to
+the Hall, "but I never have been at one that so affected me. No monument
+ever raised, sir, did such credit to him who was laid beneath it as the
+tears of those simple villagers."
+
+Mark did not reply; his heart was altogether too full to speak. As they
+entered the house he said, "The ladies will have their lunch upstairs,
+Mr. Prendergast; we may as well have ours at once, and then you can call
+them down if there is any business to be done."
+
+"That will not take long," the lawyer said. "I have brought down the
+wills of both your uncle the Colonel, and your father, and I think that
+it would be as well for me to read them both. That of your father is
+a very short and simple document, extending, indeed, only over a few
+lines. Your uncle's is longer and more complicated, but as you are well
+aware of the gist of it, it will take us but a short time to get through
+it."
+
+Mark took his meal in a perfunctory manner. For himself he would have
+eaten nothing, but he made an effort to do so in order to keep his guest
+company. When it was over he said:
+
+"We may as well go into the library at once, and I will send up for the
+ladies. It is as well to lose no time, for I know that you want to catch
+the afternoon coach up to town."
+
+Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent joined them in a minute or two, the girl
+looking very pale in her deep mourning.
+
+"I am about," Mr. Prendergast said quietly, "to read the wills of
+Colonel Thorndyke and Mr. John Thorndyke, and I will ask you, if there
+is any phrase that you do not understand, to stop me, and I will explain
+to you its purport."
+
+The three persons present were acquainted with the main provisions of
+the Colonel's will. It began by stating that, being determined that his
+daughter, Millicent Conyers Thorndyke, should not be married for her
+money, he hereby bequeathed to his brother, John Thorndyke, his estate
+in the parish of Crowswood, to be held by him until his daughter
+Millicent came to the age of twenty-one, or was married; if that
+marriage did not take place until she was over the age of twenty-one, so
+long was it to continue in John Thorndyke's possession, save and except
+that she was, on attaining the age of twenty-one, to receive from it an
+income of 250 pounds a year for her private use and disposal.
+
+"To Jane Cunningham, the widow of the late Captain Charles Cunningham,
+of the 10th Madras Native Infantry, should she remain with my daughter
+until the marriage of the latter, I bequeath an annuity of 150 pounds
+per annum, chargeable on the estate, and to commence at my daughter's
+marriage. All my other property in moneys, investments, jewels, and
+chattels of all sorts, is to be divided in equal portions between my
+daughter, Millicent Conyers Thorndyke, and my nephew, Mark Thorndyke.
+Should, however, my daughter die before marriage, I bequeath the said
+estate in the parish of Crowswood to my brother, John Thorndyke, for his
+life, and after him to his son Mark, and to the latter the whole of
+my other property of all kinds, this to take effect on the death of my
+daughter. Should my brother predecease the marriage or coming of age of
+my daughter, she is at once to come into possession of the said estate
+of Crowswood. In which case my nephew Mark and Mr. James Prendergast,
+of the firm of Hopwood & Prendergast, my solicitors, are to act as her
+trustees, and Mrs. Jane Cunningham and the said James Prendergast as her
+guardians."
+
+All this was, of course, expressed in the usual legal language, but the
+purport was clear to those previously acquainted with its bearing, the
+only item that was new to them being the legacy to Mrs. Cunningham. John
+Thorndyke's testament was a short one. He left all his property to his
+son Mark, with the exception of a hundred pounds to his niece to buy a
+mourning ring or brooch or other ornament in memory of him, and fifty
+pounds to Mrs. Cunningham for a similar purpose, as a token of his
+great esteem for her character, and 200 pounds to Ramoo for his faithful
+services to his brother and himself. When the lawyer had folded up the
+wills Millicent said:
+
+"On my part, I have to say that I absolutely renounce the legacy of the
+estate in favor of my cousin Mark, who has always believed that it would
+be his."
+
+"And I as absolutely refuse to accept the sacrifice," Mark said.
+
+"My dear young lady," Mr. Prendergast said quietly, "at present, at any
+rate, you have no power whatever to take any action in the matter; you
+are, in the eye of the law, an infant, and until you come of age you
+have no power to execute any legal document whatever. Therefore you
+must perforce remain mistress of the estate until you attain the age of
+twenty-one. Many things may happen before that time; for example, you
+might marry, and in that case your husband would have a voice in the
+matter; you might die, in which case Mr. Mark Thorndyke would, without
+any effort on your part, come into possession of the estate. But, at any
+rate, until you reach the age of twenty-one your trustees will collect
+the rents of the estate on your behalf, and will hold the monies in
+trust for you, making, of course, such payments for your support and
+maintenance as are fit and proper for your condition."
+
+The tears came into Millicent's eyes as she resumed the seat from which
+she had risen, and she did not utter another word until Mr. Prendergast
+rose to leave.
+
+"I shall doubtless learn your wishes as to the future, Miss Thorndyke,
+from your cousin," he said. "I hope that you will not cherish any
+malice against me, and that when you think it over you will come to the
+conclusion that second thoughts are sometimes the wisest, and also that
+you should have some consideration for your father's wishes in a matter
+of this kind. He worked hard and risked his life to build up the fortune
+that he has left. He evidently thought greatly of your welfare, and was,
+above all things, anxious to insure your happiness. I am sure that on
+thinking it over you will see that you should not thwart his wishes."
+
+"My dear boy," he said to Mark, as they stood on the doorstep waiting
+for the carriage to come round, "the best plan by far in this business
+would be for the interests of your cousin and yourself to be identical.
+She is a very charming young lady, a little headstrong in this matter,
+perhaps, but I do not think that that is altogether unnatural."
+
+"That might have come about if it had not been for the property, Mr.
+Prendergast," Mark said, "but it cannot be now. If she and I had been
+engaged before all this happened the case would have been different; but
+you see yourself that now my lips are sealed, for it would seem as if I
+had not cared for her until she turned out to be an heiress."
+
+"You are a silly young couple," the lawyer said. "I can only hope that
+as you grow older you will grow wiser. Well, you had better come up and
+have a talk with me about the assets your uncle mentions in his will."
+
+"Then you don't know anything about them, sir?"
+
+"Nothing at all, except as to the accumulations in his absence. He
+mentioned vaguely that he was a wealthy man. I thought that, as a matter
+of course, he had told his brother all about it."
+
+"It is a curious business, sir, and I doubt if there will ever be
+anything besides the accumulations you speak of."
+
+"Bless me, you don't say so! Well, well, I always thought that it was
+the most foolish business that I ever heard of. However, you shall tell
+me all about it when you come up. I shall miss my coach unless I start."
+
+So saying, he shook Mark's hand, took his place in the gig, and was
+driven away. Millicent did not come downstairs again that day.
+
+"She is thoroughly upset," Mrs. Cunningham said, "and it would be best
+to let her have her own way for a time. I think the sooner I can get
+her away from here the better. The house is full of sad memories, and I
+myself feel shaken and in need of a change."
+
+"I can quite understand her feeling and yours, Mrs. Cunningham. I do
+hope you will be able to disabuse her mind of the idea that I have any
+shadow of feeling of regret that she instead of I has the estate, and
+please try to work upon her on the ground of her father's wishes. I
+could see that her face changed when Mr. Prendergast put the matter
+in that light, which I do not think had occurred to her before. I am
+thinking of going up to town in a couple of days; I was thinking of
+doing so tomorrow, but a day or so will make no difference. I propose
+that you both go with me, and that I then help you look for a house.
+Even if you don't get one at once, a week in London will be a change,
+and you can then, if you like, go somewhere for a time. Of course Bath
+would be too gay at present; but you might go to Tunbridge Wells, or, if
+she would like a seaside place, as she has never been near the sea since
+she was a baby, that would be the greatest change for her. You might go
+down for a month or two to Dover or Hastings. There is no occasion for
+you to settle down in London for a time. There is Weymouth, too, if you
+would like it better. I believe that that is a cheerful place without
+being too fashionable."
+
+"I think that will be an excellent plan," Mrs. Cunningham said.
+
+"If you like I will drive you up to town, and the luggage can go by the
+carrier; it is more pleasant than being shut up in a coach."
+
+"Much more cheerful, of course."
+
+"You will, of course, leave many of your things here, and the packing
+them up will give her something to do, and prevent her from brooding."
+
+"I think that is an excellent idea, Mark."
+
+Late in the afternoon Ramoo came in in his usual silent manner. The man
+had said but little during the past few days, but it was evident that he
+was grieving deeply, and he looked years older than he had done before
+that fatal night.
+
+"Of course, Ramoo, you will stay with me for the present. I hardly know
+what I shall be doing for a time, but I am sure that until I settle
+down, Miss Conyers will be very glad to have you with her."
+
+"No, sahib, Ramoo will return home to India. Ramoo is getting old; he
+was thirty when he entered the service of the Colonel, sahib; he is
+fifty now; he will go home to end his days; he has saved enough to live
+in comfort, and with what the lawyer sahib told him your father has left
+him he will be a rich man among his own people."
+
+"But you will find things changed, Ramoo, since you left; while here,
+you know, we all regard you as a friend rather than as a servant."
+
+"You are all very kind and good, sahib. Ramoo knows that he will meet no
+friends like those he has here, but he longs for the bright sun and blue
+sky of India, and though it will well nigh break his heart to leave the
+young missie and you, he feels that he must go."
+
+"All right, Ramoo. We shall all be very sorry to lose you, but I
+understand your longing to go home, and I know that you always feel our
+cold winters very trying; therefore I will not oppose your wishes. I
+shall be going up to town in two or three days, and will arrange to pay
+your legacy at once, and will inquire what vessels are sailing."
+
+Millicent was unfeignedly sorry when she heard of Ramoo's determination;
+she was very fond of him, for when as a child she first arrived at
+Crowswood he had been her companion whenever the Squire did not require
+his services, and would accompany her about the garden and grounds,
+listening to her prattle, carrying her on his shoulder, and obeying
+her behests. No doubt he knew that she was the daughter of his former
+master, and had to a certain extent transferred his allegiance from the
+sahib, whose life he had several times saved, to his little daughter.
+Still, she agreed with Mark that it was perhaps best that he should go.
+She and Mrs. Cunningham would find but little occasion for his services
+when established in London, and his swarthy complexion and semi-Eastern
+costume would attract attention, and perhaps trouble, when he went
+abroad--the population being less accustomed to Orientals then than at
+present--but still less would they know what to do with him were they
+for a time to wander about. Mark said at once that so long as he himself
+was engaged in the task that he had set himself, he could not take Ramoo
+with him, and as for his staying alone in the house when it was only in
+charge of a caretaker, it was not to be thought of.
+
+Although not inclined at the present time to agree with Mark in
+anything, Millicent could not but acknowledge that it were best that
+Ramoo should not be urged further to reconsider his determination, and
+she also fell in with his proposal that they should go up to London for
+a week, and then go down to Weymouth for a time, after which they would
+be guided by circumstances. Accordingly, two days later, Mark drove
+Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham up to London. A groom accompanied them on
+Mark's favorite horse. This was to be left in town for his use, and
+the groom was to drive the carriage back again. Comfortable rooms were
+obtained in a quiet inn for the ladies, while Mark put up at the Bull,
+saying that he would come every day to take them out.
+
+"Why did not Mark stay here, Mrs. Cunningham?" Millicent asked
+pettishly.
+
+"I suppose he thought it better that he should not do so; and I own that
+I think he was right."
+
+"When we were, as we supposed, no relation to each other," Millicent
+said, "we could be like brother and sister. Now that we find that we are
+cousins we are going to be stiff and ceremonious."
+
+"Not necessarily because you are cousins, Millicent. Before, you were
+his father's ward, and under his father's care; now you are a young lady
+on your own account. You must see that the position is changed greatly,
+and that what was quite right and proper before would not be at all
+right and proper now."
+
+Millicent shrugged her shoulders.
+
+"Oh, if Mark wishes to be distant and stiff he can certainly do so if he
+likes it. It makes no matter to me."
+
+"That is not at all fair, Millicent, and very unlike yourself. Had not
+Mark suggested his going to another inn, I should have suggested it
+myself."
+
+"Oh, yes; no doubt it is better," Millicent said carelessly. "He has
+several friends in town, and of course we cannot expect him to be
+devoting himself to us."
+
+Mrs. Cunningham raised her eyebrows slightly, but made no answer.
+Millicent was seldom wayward, but at present things had gone very hardly
+with her, and her friend felt that it would be better to leave her
+entirely to herself until her humor changed. In the morning, when Mark
+came round, Millicent announced that she felt tired with the drive of
+the previous day, and would prefer staying indoors. Mark looked a little
+surprised, more at the tone than at the substance of the words, for the
+manner in which she spoke showed that the excuse she had given was not
+her only reason for not going out.
+
+"Of course, I shall stay at home too," Mrs. Cunningham said quietly, as
+he glanced toward her inquiringly. "Millicent is unnerved and shaken,
+and perhaps it is just as well for her to have a day's complete rest."
+
+"Very well, Mrs. Cunningham; then I will, as I cannot be of any use to
+you, set about my own business for the day. I have already been round
+to the lawyer's, and have got a check for Ramoo's legacy. He will be up
+this afternoon, and I will go round to Leadenhall Street and find out
+what ships are sailing and when they start. I will come in this evening
+for a chat."
+
+Millicent sat without speaking for some minutes after he had left the
+room. Mrs. Cunningham, whose hands were always busy, took some work out
+of a bag and set to work at it industriously. Presently the girl said:
+
+"What business is this that Mark is going to occupy himself in?"
+
+"I do not know much about it," she replied. "But from a few words which
+he let drop I believe that he intends to devote himself to discovering
+and hunting down your uncle's murderer."
+
+The listless expression faded out at once of Millicent's face.
+
+"But surely, Mrs. Cunningham, that will be very dangerous work."
+
+"No doubt it will be dangerous work, but I don't think that that is
+likely to hinder Mark. The man, whoever he may be, is of course a
+desperate character, and not likely to be captured without making a
+fierce struggle for it."
+
+"Then he ought to put the matter in the hands of the proper
+authorities," Millicent said decidedly. "Of course such men are
+dangerous. Very likely, this man may have accomplices, and it is not
+against one only that Mark will have to fight. He has no right to risk
+his life in so desperate an adventure."
+
+Mrs. Cunningham smiled quietly over her work. The Squire had often
+confided to her how glad he would be if these two should some day come
+together. In that case the disclosure after marriage of the real facts
+of the case would cause no disturbance or difficulty. The estate
+would be theirs, and it would not matter which had brought it into the
+partnership; she had thoroughly agreed with him, but so far nothing had
+occurred to give any ground for the belief that their hopes would be
+fulfilled.
+
+Till within the last year Millicent had been little more than a child;
+she had looked up to Mark as she might have done to a big brother, as
+something most admirable, as one whose dictum was law. During the last
+year there had been some slight change, but more, perhaps, on Mark's
+part than on hers. He had consulted her wishes more, had asked instead
+of ordered, and had begun to treat her as if conscious that she was fast
+growing up into womanhood.
+
+Millicent herself scarcely seemed to have noticed this change. She was
+little more inclined to assert herself than before, but was ready to
+accompany him whenever he wished her to do so, or to see him go away
+without complaint, when it so pleased him; but the last week had made a
+rapid change in their position. Millicent had sprung almost at a bound
+into a young woman. She had come to think and resolve for herself; she
+was becoming wayward and fanciful; she no longer deferred to Mark's
+opinion, but held her own, and was capable of being vexed at his
+decisions. At any rate, her relations with Mark had changed rapidly, and
+Mrs. Cunningham considered this little outburst of pettishness to be a
+good omen for her hopes, and very much better than if they had continued
+on their old footing of affectionate cousins.
+
+Mark went back again to the lawyer's, and had a long talk with Mr.
+Prendergast over the lost treasure. The old lawyer scoffed at the idea
+that there could be any danger associated with the bracelet.
+
+"Men in India, I suppose, get fanciful," he said, "and imbibe some of
+the native superstitions. The soldier who got them from the man who
+stole them was stabbed. He might have been stabbed for a thousand
+reasons, but he had the bracelet on his mind. He was forever hiding it
+and digging it up, and fancying that someone was on his track, and he
+put down the attack as being made by someone connected with it. His
+manner impressed your uncle. He concealed the diamonds or sent them off
+somewhere, instantly. He never had any further trouble about them, but
+like many men who have a craze, fancied that he was being perpetually
+watched and followed. The unfortunate result of all this is that these
+jewels and the money that he accumulated during his service in India
+seem to be lost. A more stupid affair I never heard of.
+
+"Now, as to the clew, any reasonable man would have given full
+instructions as to how the treasure was to be found; or if he did not
+do that, would, at least, instead of carrying about an absurd coin and
+a scrap of paper with a name upon it, have written his instructions and
+put them in that ridiculous hiding place, or, more wisely still, would
+have instructed his solicitor fully on the subject. The amount of
+trouble given by men, otherwise perfectly sane, by cranks and fancies
+is astonishing. Here is something like 100,000 pounds lost owing to a
+superstitious whim. As to your chance of finding the treasure, I regard
+it as small indeed. The things are hidden in India, in some old tomb, or
+other rubbishing place. Your uncle may have committed them to the charge
+of a native; he may have sent them to a banker at one of the great
+towns; he may have shipped them to England. He may have sent them to
+the North Pole for anything I know. How can one begin to search the
+universe?"
+
+"I thought, sir, that perhaps he might have sent them to some London
+Bank or agent, with instructions to hold them until claimed by him, and
+that perhaps an inquiry among such houses would lead to the discovery
+that they hold certain property forwarded by him."
+
+"Well; there is some sense in that suggestion," Prendergast grumbled,
+"and I suppose the first thing to be done will be to carry that out. If
+you wish, we will do it for you. They would be more likely to give the
+information, if they possess it, to a well known firm of solicitors like
+ourselves than to any private individual. Besides, if you were to go
+yourself, they would in each case want you to be identified before they
+would answer any question, whereas I should write a note to them in the
+firm's name, with our compliments, saying that we should be glad to know
+if the late Colonel Thorndyke, of whose will we are the executors, had
+any account at their firm or has deposited any property in their hands.
+There are not above five or six banks doing business with India, and
+as many agents in a large way of business; and if he did such a
+foolish thing, he would be certain to do it with some houses of good
+standing--if, indeed, anything can be taken as certain in the case of a
+gentleman with such extraordinary fancies and plans as his."
+
+"Thank you, Mr. Prendergast," Mark said, with a slight smile at the
+lawyer's irritability; "that will be clearing the ground to a certain
+extent. If that does not succeed, I think I shall go to India
+myself, and shall there make similar inquiries at all the principal
+establishments at Calcutta and Madras. Should I fail there, it seems to
+me that the only remaining plan will be to find out from the military
+authorities the place where my uncle's regiment was encamped on the
+day--we have the date on which the jewels were given to him--and to
+institute a minute search of all the old ruins within such a distance as
+he might have reached within a day's ride."
+
+"But you have no certainty that it was a ruin. He might have dug a hole
+under his tent and have buried the things there; he might have taken a
+shovel and buried them in a clump of bushes a quarter of a mile away.
+The thing is more and more ridiculous the more you look at it."
+
+"I see it is very difficult, sir, but one might narrow it down somewhat
+if one discovered the spot. Probably there are still native officers in
+the regiment who were there at the time. If so, they might possibly know
+who was my uncle's servant at the time. The man may be a pensioner,
+and in that case I might discover his address through the military
+authorities, and I could find out from him whether my uncle often rode
+out at night, what were his habits, and possibly where the tent stood,
+and so on."
+
+"Well," Mr. Prendergast said, "if you like to undertake a wild goose
+chase of this sort it is your business, and not mine; but I consider
+the idea is the most Utopian that I ever heard of. As to where the tent
+stood, is it likely that a man would remember to within a hundred yards
+where a tent stood fourteen years ago? Why, you might dig up acres and
+acres of ground and not be sure then that you had hit upon the right
+place."
+
+"There is one other circumstance, Mr. Prendergast," Mark said quietly,
+"that has to be taken into consideration, and which renders it
+improbable that these diamonds were hidden anywhere by my uncle
+himself at that time. He certainly spoke of the whole of this treasure
+collectively. It is morally certain that he would not carry all these
+jewels that he had been collecting about with him, and certainly not his
+treasure in money. He must, therefore, have sent these diamonds to the
+person, whoever he may be, who had the keeping of his other jewels and
+of his money. This certainly points to a bank."
+
+"There is a sensible conjecture. Yes, there is something in that. He
+certainly could not have carried about him 50,000 pounds in gold and
+as much in jewelry; it would have been the act of a madman, and Colonel
+Thorndyke, although eccentric and cranky, was not mad. But, on the
+other hand, he may have carried about a banker's passbook, or what is
+equivalent to it, for the amount that had been deposited with a native
+banker or agent, together with a receipt for the box containing the
+jewels, and this he might have hidden with the diamonds."
+
+"I don't think that he would have done that; there could have been no
+object for his putting the power of demanding his money and valuables
+out of his possession."
+
+"Well, well," the lawyer said testily, "it is of no use arguing now what
+he might or might not have done. A man who would have taken the trouble
+that he did to prevent his daughter knowing that she was an heiress, and
+fancied that he was followed about by black fellows, might do anything,
+reasonable or unreasonable, under the sun. At any rate, Mr. Thorndyke,
+I will carry out your instructions as to inquiries in London, and will
+duly inform you of the result; beyond that I must really decline to give
+any advice or opinion upon the matter, which is altogether beyond me."
+
+On leaving the lawyer's, Mark went to Bow Street, and related to the
+chief the circumstances attending his father's murder.
+
+"I have heard them from the man I sent down at your request, Mr.
+Thorndyke, and taking the attempt early in the evening and the
+subsequent murder, there can be no doubt that the affair was one of
+revenge, and not of robbery. Had the second attempt stood alone, robbery
+might have been the object; the mere fact that nothing was stolen in
+no way alters the case. Men are often seized with a certain panic after
+committing a murder, and fly at once without attempting to carry out
+their original purpose. Your father, no doubt, fell heavily, and the man
+might well have feared that the fall would be heard; but the previous
+attempt precludes the supposition that robbery was at the bottom of it.
+It points to a case of revenge, and certainly goes a very long way to
+support the theory that we talked over when I last saw you, that the
+highwayman who endeavored to stop you on the road, whom you wounded,
+and who afterwards went down to Southampton, was the escaped convict,
+Bastow. Since that time I have had a man making inquiries along the
+roads between Reigate and Kingston, but altogether without success. I
+should be glad to follow up any other line that you might suggest, and
+that might offer any reasonable possibility of success, but I must own
+that at present we are entirely off the scent."
+
+"I am thinking of devoting myself entirely to the quest. I have no
+occupation at present. I have an income amply sufficient for my wants,
+and for all expenses that I may incur, and I intend to devote, if
+necessary, some years of my life to hunting this man down. As your men
+have searched without success in the country, I think for the present my
+best plan will be to devote myself to learning something of the ways
+and haunts of the criminal classes of London, and it is with that object
+that I have come to you now. I should like, for some time, at any rate,
+to enter the detective force as an enrolled member. I should, of course,
+require no pay, but should be prepared to obey all orders and to do any
+work required, as any other member of the corps would do. I am strong,
+active, and have, I hope, a fair share of intelligence. I should not
+mind risking my life in carrying out any duty that you might assign to
+me. I presume that I need not always be on duty, and could, when not
+required, employ my time as I liked, and keep up my acquaintances in
+town. Should it be otherwise, however, I am perfectly ready to submit
+myself in all respects to your rule. I have a first rate horse and
+should be available for country duty, wherever you might think fit to
+send me. I should not desire any distinction to be made between me and
+the paid officers."
+
+"Your proposal is an altogether novel one, Mr. Thorndyke, but it is
+worthy of consideration. I have no doubt that you would make a very
+useful officer; the work is certainly interesting, though not without
+serious hazards. However, I will think the matter over, and if you will
+call in tomorrow you shall have my answer. We are always glad to have a
+new hand in the force, for the faces of our men are so well known among
+the criminal class that they are liable to be detected even under the
+cleverest disguises. There is work, too, upon which it is absolutely
+necessary that a gentleman should be employed, and in the event of your
+joining us, I should wish you to keep the matter strictly from all your
+acquaintances; and it would certainly be advantageous that you should,
+when disengaged, continue to mix with your friends and to mingle in
+society of all kinds as freely as possible. There is crime among the
+upper classes as well as among the lower, though of a different
+type; and as Mr. Thorndyke of Crowswood you would have far better
+opportunities of investigating some of these cases than any of my men
+would have. You would not object to take up such cases?"
+
+"Not at all, sir; that is, if it could be arranged that I should not
+do the actual work of making an arrest, or have to appear in court as a
+witness."
+
+"That could be managed," the chief said "When you have got to a certain
+point the matter of the final arrest could always be handed over to
+someone else, but as a rule we keep our officers in the background as
+much as possible, because at every trial the court is half full of men
+of the criminal class, and the faces of our men would soon be known to
+every one of them. Well, if you will call about ten o'clock tomorrow you
+shall have my answer; but I should advise you to think the matter
+well over before you see me again. The responsibilities as well as the
+dangers are great, and indeed in some of the work you would literally
+have to carry your life in your hand; and I can assure you that the task
+you would undertake is by no means a light one."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI.
+
+
+Mark called that evening, as he had promised, upon Mrs. Cunningham.
+
+"I hope that you feel all the better for your day's rest, Millicent," he
+said.
+
+The girl looked quickly at him to see if there was any sarcasm in the
+question, but it was evident that the inquiry was made in earnest.
+
+"Yes, I feel better now," she said. "I have dozed a good deal today.
+I did not feel up to anything. Mrs. Cunningham's work has progressed
+wonderfully. I should say that she has done more today than she
+ordinarily finds time to do in a week. What have you been doing with
+yourself?"
+
+"I have been having a long talk with Mr. Prendergast about the lost
+treasure."
+
+"And of course he said that you would never find it, Mark?"
+
+"Well, yes, he distinctly expressed that opinion."
+
+"And afterwards?"
+
+"Afterwards I went to Bow Street and had a long talk also with the chief
+officer there."
+
+"I don't like the idea of your searching for this man, Mark. In the
+first place, I don't see why you should hope to succeed when the men
+whose business it is to do such work have failed. In the next place, I
+think that you may get into serious danger."
+
+"That I must risk, Millicent. I have already proved a better shot than
+he is, and I am quite ready to take my chance if I can but come upon
+him; that is the difficult part of the matter. I know that I shall need
+patience, but I have plenty of time before me, and have great hopes that
+I shall run him to earth at last."
+
+"But you would not know him if you saw him?"
+
+"I think I should," Mark said quietly; "at least, if he is the man that
+I suspect."
+
+"Then you do suspect someone?" Mrs. Cunningham said, laying down her
+work.
+
+"Yes, I know of no reason why you should not know it now. I
+suspect--indeed, I feel morally certain--that the man who murdered my
+father was Arthur Bastow."
+
+An exclamation of surprise broke from both his hearers, and they
+listened with horror while he detailed the various grounds that he had
+for his suspicions. They were silent for some time after he had brought
+his narrative to a conclusion, then Mrs. Cunningham said:
+
+"What a merciful release for Mr. Bastow that he should have died before
+this terrible thing came out! For after what you have told us I can
+hardly doubt that you are right, and that it is this wicked man who is
+guilty."
+
+"Yes, it was indeed providential," Mark said, "though I think that,
+feeble as he has been for some months, it might have been kept from him.
+Still, a word from a chance visitor, who did not associate Bastow the
+murderer with our dear old friend, might have enlightened him, and the
+blow would have been a terrible one indeed. It is true that, as it was,
+he died from the shock, but he did not know the hand that struck the
+blow."
+
+"Now that you have told me this," Millicent said, "I cannot blame you,
+Mark, for determining to hunt the man down. It seems even worse than it
+did before; it is awful to think that anyone could cherish revenge like
+that. Now tell me how you are going to set about it."
+
+"I have promised the chief officer that I will tell absolutely no
+one," he said. "I have a plan, and I believe that in time it must be
+successful. I know well enough that I could tell you both of it without
+any fear of its going further, but he asked me to promise, and I did so
+without reservation; moreover, I think that for some reasons it is as
+well that even you should not know it. As it is, you are aware that I am
+going to try, and that is all. If I were to tell you how, you might be
+picturing all sorts of imaginary dangers and worrying yourself over
+it, so I think that it will be much the best that you should remain in
+ignorance, at any rate for a time. I can say this, that I shall for the
+present remain principally in London, and I think that I am more likely
+to come upon a clew here than elsewhere."
+
+Millicent pouted, but Mrs. Cunningham said: "I think, perhaps, that you
+are right, Mark, and it is better that we should know nothing about it;
+we shall know that you are looking for a clew, but of course no danger
+can arise until you obtain it and attempt to arrest him. I feel sure
+that you will do nothing rash, especially as if any harm befell you he
+might escape unpunished, and therefore that when the time comes to
+seize him you will obtain such help as may be necessary, and will, if
+possible, arrest him at a moment when resistance is impossible."
+
+"Thank you, Mrs. Cunningham; I shall certainly spare no efforts in
+taking him that way, and would far rather he met his fate on a gibbet
+than by a bullet from my pistol."
+
+"I agree with you, Mark," Millicent said; "even hanging is too good for
+such a wicked man. When are you going to set about it?"
+
+"I hope to be able to begin tomorrow," he said. "I am impatient to be at
+work, even though I know perfectly well that it may be months before I
+can get on his track. I hope to get a good deal of information as to
+the habits of men of his kind from the Bow Street runners, and I have an
+appointment tomorrow morning to see their chief, who will give me every
+assistance in his power."
+
+"Then you will not be able to take us out?" Millicent said.
+
+"I trust to do so later on, but I cannot say how long I shall be
+engaged. However, I hope to get away so as to go out with you after
+lunch, and may possibly be able to postpone my getting regularly to work
+until after you have gone, so as to be able to devote myself to your
+service."
+
+"But what sort of work? I cannot make out how you are going to begin."
+
+"I can tell you this much, that to begin with I shall go in company with
+a constable to various places where such a man is likely to be found.
+It will take some time to acquaint myself with all these localities; the
+next step will be to find out, if possible, if anyone at all answering
+to his description is in the habit of coming there occasionally, and
+whom he visits; another thing will be to find out the places where
+receivers of stolen goods do their business, and to watch those with
+whom highwaymen are suspected of having dealings. All this, you see,
+will entail a lot of work, and require a very large amount of patience.
+Of course, if nothing whatever comes of such inquiries, I shall have
+to try quiet places in the suburbs; you must remember that this fellow
+during his time as a convict must have had opportunities of getting
+a vast amount of information likely to be useful to him, such as the
+addresses of men holding positions of apparent respectability, and yet
+in alliance with thieves. You may be sure that when he returned he took
+every imaginable pains to obtain a safe place of concealment before
+he began his work; my own opinion is that I am more likely to find him
+living quietly in a suburban cottage than in a London slum."
+
+Millicent was now thoroughly interested in the search. "It seems a great
+business, Mark, but going into it as thoroughly as you are doing I feel
+sure that you will succeed. I only wish that I could help you; but I
+could not do that, could I?" she asked wistfully.
+
+He saw that she was in earnest, and suppressed all semblance of a smile.
+
+"I am afraid, dear, that you would be a much greater source of
+embarrassment than of assistance to me," he said gravely. "This is
+essentially not a woman's work. I believe that women are sometimes
+employed in the detection of what we may call domestic crimes, but this
+is a different matter altogether."
+
+"I suppose so," she sighed; "but it will be very hard to be taking our
+ease down at Weymouth while we know that you are, day after day, wearing
+yourself out in tramping about making inquiries."
+
+"It will be no more fatiguing than tramping through the stubble round
+Crowswood after partridges, which I should probably be doing now if I
+were down there. By the way, before you go we shall have to talk over
+the question of shutting up the house. We had too much to think of to
+go into that before we came away, and I suppose I shall have to run down
+and arrange it all, if you have quite made up your mind that you don't
+mean to return for a year or two."
+
+"Decidedly our present idea is to have a few weeks at Weymouth, and then
+when we feel braced up to come back here and look for a house. Where are
+you likely to be, Mark?" Mrs. Cunningham asked.
+
+"I shall consult with Dick Chetwynd; he knows the town thoroughly, and
+is more up here than he is down in the country; he will recommend me to
+some lodging in a street that, without being the height of fashion, is
+at least passable. I have not the least wish to become a regular man
+about town, but I should like to go into good society. One cannot be at
+work incessantly."
+
+The next morning the chief of the detective department told Mark that he
+had decided to accept his offer.
+
+"As you will receive no pay," he said, "I shall regard you as a sort of
+volunteer. For the first two or three months you will spend your time in
+going about with one or other of my men on his work. They will be able
+to put you up to disguises. When you have once learned to know all the
+thieves' quarters and the most notorious receivers of stolen goods,
+you will be able to go about your work on your own account. All that
+I require is that you shall report yourself here twice a day. Should I
+have on hand any business for which you may appear to me particularly
+well suited, I shall request you to at once undertake it, and from time
+to time, when there is a good deal of business on hand, I may get you to
+aid one of my men who may require an assistant in the job on which he is
+engaged."
+
+"I am sure I am very much obliged to you, sir," Mark said, "and will,
+I can assure you, do my best in every way to assist your men in any
+business in which they may be engaged."
+
+"When will you begin?"
+
+"It is Saturday today, sir. I think I will postpone setting to until
+Monday week. My cousin and the lady in whose charge she is came up with
+me on Thursday, and will be leaving town the end of next week, and
+I should wish to escort them about while here. I will come on Monday
+morning ready for work. How had I better be dressed?"
+
+"I should say as a countryman. A convenient character for you to begin
+with will be that of a man who, having got into a poaching fray, and
+hurt a gamekeeper, has made for London as the best hiding place. You
+are quite uncertain about your future movements, but you are thinking of
+enlisting."
+
+"Very well, sir, I will get the constable at Reigate, who knows me well,
+to send me a suit. I might find it difficult to get all the things I
+want here."
+
+Accordingly, for the next week Mark devoted himself to the ladies.
+Millicent, in her interest in the work that he was about to undertake,
+had now quite got over her fit of ill temper, and the old cordial
+relations were renewed. On the Friday he saw them into the Weymouth
+coach, then sauntered off to his friend Chetwynd's lodgings.
+
+Ramoo had already sailed. On his arrival in town he had said that he
+should, if possible, arrange to go out as a steward.
+
+"Many men of my color who have come over here with their masters go back
+in that way," he said, in answer to Mark's remonstrances. "It is much
+more comfortable that way than as a passenger. If you go third class,
+rough fellows laugh and mock; if you go second class, men look as much
+as to say, 'What is that colored fellow doing here? This is no place for
+him.' Much better go as steward; not very hard work; very comfortable;
+plenty to eat; no one laugh or make fun."
+
+"Well, perhaps it would be best, when one comes to think of it, Ramoo;
+but I would gladly pay your passage in any class you like."
+
+"Ramoo go his own way, sahib," he said. "No pay passage money; me go to
+docks where boats are sailing, go on board and see head steward. Head
+steward glad enough to take good servant who is willing to work his
+way out, and ask for no wages. Head steward draw wages for him, and put
+wages in his own pocket. He very well satisfied."
+
+On Wednesday he came and told Mark that he had arranged to sail in the
+Nabob, and was to go on board early the next morning. He seemed a great
+deal affected, and Mark and Millicent were equally sorry to part with
+the faithful fellow.
+
+"Well, old man," Dick Chetwynd said, when Mark entered the room, where
+he was still at breakfast, "I was beginning to wonder whether you had
+gone to Reigate. Why, when I saw you last Friday you told me that you
+would look me up in a day or two."
+
+"I have been busy showing London to Mrs. Cunningham and Miss Conyers,"
+he replied--for Millicent had insisted on keeping her former name, at
+any rate for the present--and Mark was somewhat glad that there had been
+no necessity for entering into any explanations. It was agreed that
+when he went down to discharge some of the servants and called upon his
+friends he should say nothing of the change in his position, but should
+assign as a motive that he intended to travel about for a long time, and
+that he felt he could not settle down in the lonely house, at any
+rate for two or three years; and therefore intended to diminish the
+establishment.
+
+"You will have some breakfast, Mark?"
+
+"No, thank you. I breakfasted two hours ago."
+
+"Then you still keep to your intention to stay in London for a while?"
+
+"Yes. I don't feel that I could bear the house alone," Mark replied. "You
+see, Mrs. Cunningham and my uncle's ward could not very well remain in a
+bachelor's home, and naturally, after what has happened, they would not
+like to do so, even if they could. They have gone down to Weymouth for
+a few weeks for a complete change; and Mrs. Cunningham talks of taking
+a house in town for a time. I am going to look for lodgings, and I want
+your advice as to the quarter likely to suit me."
+
+"Why not take up your abode here for a time? There is a vacant room, and
+I should be very glad to have you with me."
+
+"Thank you very much, Dick, but I should prefer being alone. You will
+have friends dropping in to see you, and at present I should be poor
+company. It will be some little time before I shall feel equal to
+society."
+
+"Of course, Mark. I always speak first and think afterwards, as you know
+pretty well by this time. Well, what sort of lodgings do you want?"
+
+"I want them to be in a good but not in a thoroughly fashionable street.
+In time, no doubt, I shall like a little society, and shall get you to
+introduce me to some of the quieter of your friends, and so gradually
+feel my way."
+
+"I will do all that sort of thing for you, Mark. As you know, I am not
+one of those who see much fun in gambling or drinking, though one must
+play a little to be in the fashion. Still, I never go heavily into it.
+I risk a few guineas and then leave it. My own inclinations lie rather
+towards sport, and in this I can indulge without being out of the
+fashion. All the tip top people now patronize the ring, and I do so
+in my small way too. I am on good terms with all the principal prize
+fighters, and put on the gloves with one or other of them pretty nearly
+every day. I have taken courses of lessons regularly from four or five
+of them, and I can tell you that I can hold my own with most of the
+Corinthians. It is a grand sport, and I don't know how I should get
+on without it; after the hard exercise I was accustomed to down in the
+country, it keeps one's muscles in splendid order, and I can tell you
+that if one happens to get into a fight in the streets, it is no light
+thing to be able to polish off an antagonist in a round or two without
+getting a mark on your face that would keep you a prisoner in your room
+for a week or more."
+
+"Yes, I should like very much to take lessons too, Dick; it is one of
+the things that I have always wished to do. I suppose one can do it of
+an evening, or any time you like?"
+
+"Yes, any hour suits those fellows. You ought to get either a heavy
+middleweight or a light heavyweight; you will be a heavyweight yourself
+by the time you have filled out. Let me think; what is your height--six
+feet one, if I remember rightly?"
+
+"Yes, that is about it."
+
+"Well, with your shoulders and long reach and activity, you ought to be
+something out of the way if you take pains, Mark. You see, I am barely
+five feet ten, and am something like two stone lighter than you are. I
+suppose you are not much under twelve stone and a half."
+
+"That is just about my weight; I weighed at the miller's only a
+fortnight ago."
+
+"Good. I will make some inquiries, and see who would be the best man to
+take you in hand to begin with. And now about lodgings. Well, I should
+say Essex Street, or any of those streets running down from the Strand,
+would suit you. The rooms in Essex Street are bigger than those in
+Buckingham Street, and you will find anything between the two in some of
+the others. I may as well saunter round there with you. Of course money
+is no object to you?"
+
+"No," Mark agreed, "but I don't want big rooms. I think a small one,
+when you are sitting by yourself, is more cozy and comfortable."
+
+Finally two rooms were taken in Villiers Street; they were of moderate
+size and handsomely furnished: the last tenant had fitted them out for
+himself, but had lived to enjoy them only three months, having at the
+end of that time been killed in a duel over a quarrel at cards.
+
+"Well, I think you are in luck, Mark; you might look through a good many
+streets before you would find rooms so fashionably furnished as these. I
+see he went in for driving; that is evident from these engravings on the
+walls."
+
+"They are common, gaudy looking things," Mark said, "and quite out of
+character with the furniture."
+
+"Not at all, as times go, Mark; it is quite the thing for a man to have
+prints showing his tastes, riding or driving, shooting or coaching, or
+the ring. If you don't like them you can take them down, or, what will
+be better, take them out of their frames and put some of the champions
+past and present up there instead."
+
+"I will see about it," Mark said with a laugh. "I may turn out a
+complete failure."
+
+"There is no fear of that, Mark; and as the ring is all the fashion now,
+I can assure you it would be considered in good taste, though I own that
+in point of art most of these things leave a good deal to be desired.
+Now that that important thing is settled, suppose you come and lunch
+with me in Covent Garden? I don't belong to a club yet, though I have
+got my name down at a couple of them, but as far as I can see they are
+slow sort of places unless you know a lot of people. The coffee houses
+are much more amusing; you see people of all sorts there--fellows like
+myself, who have no clubs to go to; country gentlemen up for a week;
+a few writers, who, by the way, are not the best customers of these
+places; men whom nobody knows, and men whom everybody knows. Of course,
+the best time to see them is of an evening."
+
+"Yes, I have generally been in of an evening when I have been up in
+towns Dick, and I have always been amused. However, I am quite ready to
+lunch there now, for I breakfasted early."
+
+"I have to make some calls this afternoon, Mark. At seven this evening
+I will look in at your lodgings, and you shall go along with me to
+Ingleston's in St. Giles'. It is one of the headquarters of the fancy,
+and Jack Needham, who taught me, is safe to be there, and he will tell
+me who he thinks is best for you to begin with."
+
+Accordingly, after taking luncheon, they separated, and Mark went to his
+inn.
+
+Ingleston's was at that time regarded as the headquarters of the fancy.
+At the back of the house was a large room, with benches rising behind
+each other to accommodate the spectators. Here, on the evenings when it
+was known that leading men would put on the gloves, peers of the realm
+would sit side by side with sporting butchers, and men of fashion back
+their opinion on a coming prize fight with ex-pugilists and publicans. A
+number of men were assembled in the bar; among these was Jack Needham.
+
+"Good evening, Mr. Chetwynd," the man said as they came up to him. "It's
+going to be a good night. Tring and Bob Pratt are going to have a round
+or two together, and Gibbons will put on the gloves with anyone who
+likes to take him on."
+
+"This gentleman is Mr. Thorndyke, a squire, Jack, whose place is near
+mine at Reigate. He has come up to town for a few months, and wants to
+learn how to use his mauleys. I told him that you would advise him as to
+who would be the best man for him to go to."
+
+"I can tell you better when I have seen him strip, sir. There is no one
+in the big room at present. It won't be open for half an hour. Ingleston
+keeps it shut as long as he can so as to give everyone a fair chance of
+a good place. If the gentleman will come in there with me I will have a
+look at him."
+
+Mark expressed his willingness to be looked at, and the man having gone
+and got the key of the room from Ingleston, went in with them and locked
+the door behind.
+
+"Now, sir, if you will strip to the waist I shall be better able to say
+who you should have as your teacher than I can now."
+
+Mark stripped, and the man walked round and round him, examining him
+critically.
+
+"He's a big 'un," he said to Dick when he had completed his examination.
+"He has got plenty of muscle and frame, and ought to be a tremendous
+hitter; he is about the figure of Gibbons, and if he goes in for it
+really, ought to make well nigh as good a man, if not quite. I don't
+think Bill would care about taking him up till he knows a bit about it.
+I tell you what, sir; you will be too big altogether for me by the time
+you get to be quick on your legs, and to use your strength, but if you
+like I will take you on for a month or so--say, two months; by that time
+I think you will be good enough to go to Gibbons. I will just call him
+in if you don't mind; he came in just before you."
+
+In a couple of minutes he came in with a man of similar height and
+somewhat similar figure to Mark.
+
+"This is Gibbons, sir, ex-champion, and like enough he might be champion
+now if he chose; as fine a boxer as ever stripped, but he is ring maker
+now to the P. C. and it suits him better to do that and to teach, than
+to have a chance of getting a battle once a year or so."
+
+"Have you a great many pupils, Gibbons?"
+
+The man shook his head.
+
+"I am too big, sir; gentlemen like to learn from someone about their
+own weight, or perhaps a bit lighter, and there are not many of them
+who would care to stand up against a man who has been champion, and so I
+have plenty of time on my hands. I am a hard hitter, too, even with the
+gloves; that is one reason why Jack had best take you on until you get
+a little handy with your fists. I do more in the dog fancier line than
+I do with boxing, but there is nothing I like better than getting the
+gloves on with an amateur who is likely to be a credit to me. That is my
+card, sir; you will find me in pretty nearly any time of the day, and
+I have got a place behind the house where I do teaching when I get
+a chance. It is handy in one way, because you can drop in and take a
+lesson any time you like."
+
+"That would suit me exceedingly well," Mark said; "and when I have had a
+couple of months with Needham I will come to you."
+
+Mark now put on his clothes again, and they went out together, and
+re-entered a few minutes later, when the door was open. The benches were
+soon crowded. Mark had been to several prize fights with Dick Chetwynd,
+had often boxed with him and other lads, and had had lessons from an
+ex-prize fighter at Reigate, and was therefore able to appreciate the
+science shown by the various men who confronted each other. The event of
+the evening was the contest between Tring and Bob Pratt; both were very
+powerful men, who were about to go into strict training for matches that
+had been made for them against two west countrymen, who were thought
+very highly of by their friends, and who were regarded as possible
+candidates for the championship.
+
+Bob Pratt was a stone heavier than his opponent, but far less active,
+and owed his position more to his ability to take punishment, and to
+hard hitting powers, than to his science. In the two rounds that were
+fought, Tring had the advantage, but the general opinion was that in the
+long run the other would wear him down. Both fought with good temper,
+and were warmly applauded as they shook hands at the finish.
+
+"I think I should back Tring in a fight," Mark said, as the meeting
+broke up, "but it is difficult to say, for he is in better condition
+than the other, and it may be that when both are thoroughly fit the
+heavy man might show more improvement than he would do."
+
+The hat was passed round at the conclusion: Every man dropped in his
+guinea, some more, it being understood that the collection was divided
+between the two men to pay the expenses of their training.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII.
+
+
+The next morning Mark commenced work in earnest, and for two months
+visited all the worst slums of London in company with one of the Bow
+Street men. Both were generally in disguise, but Mark's companion
+sometimes went openly to some of the houses inhabited by men well known
+as criminals. On such occasions Mark remained within call, ready to go
+in if assistance should be required; but there was small fear of this,
+the men who were visited were all personally known to the officer, and
+generally greeted him with "You aint wanting me, are you?"
+
+"Not at all; what I am wanting is a little information for which I shall
+be quite willing to pay the first man who enables us to lay hands on the
+gentleman I want to find." Then he would describe Bastow's appearance.
+
+"He has taken to the road, I fancy, and has given us a good deal of
+trouble; if it is the man I think it is, he has been away from London
+for some years, and came back eight or ten months ago."
+
+The reply was always to the same effect:
+
+"I don't know of such a man, and never heard of him. For my part,
+I would not split on a pal, not for anything; but I should not mind
+earning five guineas to put you on a cove who is not one of us. Besides,
+it aint only the money; you know, you might do me a good turn some day."
+
+"Quite so; well, I can tell you it is a good deal more than five guineas
+that would be earned if you could put me in the way of laying my hand on
+his shoulder. I don't think that he is living in town. I expect he is
+in some quiet neighborhood; still, if he is on the road, he must have a
+horse somewhere. You might ask among the stables, and find out whether
+anyone keeps a horse there who is in the habit of going out in the
+afternoon and not coming back until the next day. You have plenty of
+time upon your hands, and it would pay you well if you could bring me
+the information I want."
+
+The officer said to Mark at the end of two months: "These knights of the
+road don't often mix themselves up with the London housebreakers. The
+most likely men to be able to tell you about the doings of such a
+fellow would be receivers of stolen goods, but it would be dangerous to
+question any of them--they would be sure to put him on his guard. I will
+give you a list of some of them, and I should say that your best way
+would be to watch their places of an evening, from the time it gets dark
+till ten or eleven. Of course, it is just a chance. You may watch one
+place for a month and he may happen to go there the very day you have
+gone off to watch another crib. Still, there is just the chance, and I
+don't see that there is one any other way."
+
+During this time Mark had been taking a lesson every evening with
+Needham, and had surprised his teacher with the rapidity of his
+progress; he had said, the very evening before, when Mark had countered
+him with a blow that knocked him for two or three minutes senseless:
+
+"We have had enough of this, governor; you have got beyond me
+altogether, and I don't want another blow like that. You had better take
+on Gibbons now. You are too big altogether for me, and yet you don't
+fight like a heavyweight, for you are as quick on your pins as I am."
+
+Well pleased at having the day to himself and of having got clear of his
+work in the thieves' rookeries, Mark went the next morning to Gibbons'
+shop. His entry was hailed by a chorus of barking from dogs of all sorts
+and sizes, from the bulldog down to the ratting terrier.
+
+"Glad to see you, Mr. Thorndyke," Gibbons said, when he had silenced the
+barking. "I saw Jack last week, and he told me that he should hand you
+over to me pretty soon, for that you were getting beyond him altogether,
+and he thought that if you stuck to it you would give me all my work to
+do in another six months."
+
+"I finished with him last night, Gibbons, and I shall be ready to come
+for a lesson to you every morning, somewhere about this hour. I have
+brought my bag with my togs."
+
+"All right, sir, I am ready at once; the place is clear now behind. I
+have just been making it tidy, for we had a little ratting last night,
+one of my dogs against Sir James Collette's, fifty rats each; my dog
+beat him by three quarters of a minute."
+
+"You will never see me here at one of those businesses. I have no
+objection to stand up to a man my own size and give and take until we
+have had enough, but to see rats slaughtered when they have not a chance
+of making a fight of it is altogether out of my line."
+
+"Well, sir, I do not care about it myself; there are lots who do like
+it, and are ready to wager their money on it, and as it helps to sell my
+dogs, besides what I can win out of the event--it was a wager of twenty
+guineas last night--it aint for me to set myself up against it."
+
+Calling a boy to look after the shop, Gibbons went away into a wooden
+building in the back yard; it was about twenty-five feet square, and
+there were holes in the floor for the stakes, when a regular ring was
+made. The floor was strewn with clean sawdust; a number of boxing gloves
+hung by the wall.
+
+"There is the dressing room," Gibbons said, pointing to a door at the
+other end. When both were ready he looked Mark over. "Your muscles have
+thickened out a good bit, sir, since I saw you strip. Before another
+four years, if you keep on at it, you will be as big a man as I am. I
+am about eight years too old, and you are four years too young. You will
+improve every day, and I shan't. Now, sir, let us see what you can do.
+Jack tells me that you are wonderfully quick on your feet; there is the
+advantage you have of me. I am as strong as ever I was, I think, but I
+find that I cannot get about as I used to."
+
+He stood somewhat carelessly at first, but as they sparred for an
+opening he became more careful, and presently hit out sharply. Mark
+leaped back, and then, springing forward, struck out with his left;
+Gibbons only just stopped it and then countered, but Mark was out of
+reach again.
+
+"That is good enough," Gibbons said; "I can see Jack has taught you
+pretty nearly all there is to know. We will just take those hits again.
+You were right to get away from the first, but the second time you
+should have guarded with your left, and hit at my chin with your right.
+That jumping back game is first rate for avoiding punishment, but you
+have got to come in again to hit. You took me by surprise that time, and
+nearly got home, but you would not do it twice," and so the lesson went
+on for three quarters of an hour.
+
+"That will do for today, sir; I am getting blown, if you are not. Well,
+I can tell you I have never had a more promising pupil, and I have
+brought forward two or three of the best men in the ring; no wonder that
+Jack cannot do much with you. Give me six months, every day, and you
+should have a turn occasionally with other men, and I would back you for
+a hundred pounds against any man now in the ring."
+
+Three or four days later Mark received a message that the chief wanted
+to speak with him that afternoon, and he accordingly went down.
+
+"I've got a job for you, Mr. Thorndyke; it is just the sort of thing
+that will suit you. There is a house in Buckingham Street that we have
+had our eye on for some time; it is a gambling house, but with that we
+have nothing to do unless complaints are made, but we have had several
+complaints of late. It is a well got up place, and there are a good many
+men of title frequent it, but men of title are not always more honest
+than other people; anyhow, there are some rooks there, and several
+young fellows of means have been pigeoned and ruined. They are mighty
+particular who they let in, and there would be very little chance of
+getting my regular men in there. Now, you are a stranger in London, but
+you have friends here, and no doubt you could get introduced. We want
+to know if the play is fair; if it isn't, we would break the place up
+altogether. We know enough to do it now; but none of the poor beggars
+who have been ruined will come forward, and, indeed, haven't any idea,
+I think, that they have lost their money in anything but a run of bad
+luck.
+
+"One young fellow blew his brains out last week, and his father came
+here with a list of what are called debts of honor, which he found in
+his room. There they are, and the names of the men they are owed to; of
+course some of them have been fairly won, but I have a strong suspicion
+that those I have marked with a cross have not been. For instance, there
+is Sir James Flash, a fellow who was turned out of White's two years
+ago for sharp practice with cards; there is John Emerson, he is a man of
+good family, but all his friends have given him up long ago, and he has
+been living by his wits for the last five years. The others marked
+are all of the same sort. Now, what I want you to do is to become a
+frequenter of the place; of course you will have to play a little, and
+as you are a stranger I expect that they will let you win for a bit;
+but if not the old gentleman has placed 200 pounds in my hands for the
+expenses."
+
+"I could play with my own money," Mark said rather warmly.
+
+"You forget, Mr. Thorndyke," the chief said firmly, "that at the present
+moment you are a member of my force, and that you go to this place in
+that capacity, and not as Squire of Crowswood; therefore you must, if
+you please, do as I instruct you. The gentleman will be ready to pay
+that sum. As you see, the amounts entered here total up to nearly 10,000
+pounds. He said that it will ruin him to pay that sum, but that he
+must do so rather than his son should be branded as a defaulter. I have
+advised him to write to all these people saying that it will take him
+some time to raise the money, but that he will see that nobody shall be
+a loser by his son's debts. I have told him in the meantime that I will
+endeavor to get proof that the play was not fair, and in that case he
+would, of course, refuse to pay any of the claims on that ground; and
+you may be sure that if unfair play was proved none of those concerned
+would dare to press their claims."
+
+"Then my function would be simply to watch?"
+
+"Yes, to watch, and to bring me word of anything you may observe. You
+see, without making a public scandal, if it could be found that a man
+was discovered cheating, and the way in which he was doing it, one would
+be able to put so strong a pressure on him, that not only might he be
+forced to abstain from going to any club, but would be frightened into
+giving up any IOUs he might hold."
+
+"I shall be glad to do the best I can, sir; but frankly I know next
+to nothing of cards, and should have but little chance of detecting
+anything that might be going on, when it must be done so cleverly that
+experienced gamblers, watching a man closely, fail to see anything
+wrong."
+
+"I quite understand that; but one of my men has made a study of the
+various methods employed by gamblers to cheat, and although it would
+take you years to learn how to do it yourself, a few hours' instruction
+from him would at least put you up to some of their methods, and enable
+you to know where to look for cheating. The man is now waiting in the
+next room, and if you will take two or three hours daily with him, say
+for a week, you ought to be able to detect the doings of these fellows
+when to others everything seems right and above board. You may have no
+inclination for cards, but knowledge of that sort is useful to anyone
+in society, here or anywhere else, and may enable him either to save his
+own pocket or to do a service to a friend."
+
+Mark was greatly interested in the tricks the man showed him. At first
+it seemed to him almost magical, after he himself had shuffled the cards
+and cut them the dealer invariably turned up a king. Even admitting he
+might have various places of concealment, pockets in the lining of the
+sleeve, in the inside of the coat, and in various other parts of
+the dress, in which cards could be concealed and drawn out by silken
+threads, it did not seem possible that this could be done with such
+quickness as to be unobserved. It was only when his teacher showed him,
+at first in the slowest manner, and then gradually increasing his speed,
+that he perceived that what seemed impossible was easy enough when the
+necessary practice and skill had been attained. The man was indeed an
+adept at a great variety of tricks by which the unsuspecting could be
+taken in.
+
+"I ought to know," he said. "I was for three years in a gambling house
+in Paris, where every other man was a sharper. I have been in places of
+the same sort in Belgium, Holland, Germany, and Italy. At first I was
+only a boy waiter, and as until evening there was nothing doing at these
+places, men would sometimes amuse themselves by teaching me tricks, easy
+ones to begin with, and when they saw I was sharp and quick handed they
+went on. After a time I began to work as a confederate, and at last on
+my own account; but I got disgusted with it at last. A young fellow shot
+himself at the table of the gambling house at Rome, and at another place
+I was nearly killed by a man who had lost heavily--do you see, it has
+left a broad scar right across my forehead?--so I gave it up.
+
+"I was in the French police for a time, and used to watch some of the
+lower hells. I was nearly killed there once or twice, and at last I
+came back here. My French chief gave me a letter to the chief, and I was
+taken on at once, for, talking as I do half a dozen languages, and being
+acquainted with most of the swell mobsmen of Paris, I was just the man
+who happened to be wanted here at the time. Since I came over I have
+done a good deal in the way of breaking up hells where sailors and
+others are plundered. But, you see, I cannot be used for the higher
+class of work; my nose has been broken, and I have half a dozen scars on
+my face. I hate the sight of cards now. I have seen so much of the ruin
+they do, and have, I am sorry to say, taken a hand so often in doing it,
+that save showing someone who would use the knowledge in the right way
+how the tricks are done, nothing would persuade me to touch them again.
+However, as a protection, the knowledge is as useful as it is dangerous
+when used the other way. It would take you ten years to learn to do
+these tricks yourself so well as to defy detection; but in a very short
+time, by learning where to keep your eyes, you would get to detect
+almost any of them.
+
+"You see, there are three methods of cheating: the first by hidden
+cards, the second by marked cards, the third simply by sleight of hand,
+this being generally used in connection with marked cards. These tricks
+require great skill and extreme delicacy of touch, for the marks,
+which are generally at the edge of the cards, are so slight as to be
+altogether imperceptible save to a trained hand. There are also marks on
+the back of the cards; these are done in the printing, and are so slight
+that, unless attention were attracted to them, no one would dream of
+their existence."
+
+In the course of a week's practice Mark learned where to look for
+cheating; he could not indeed follow the fingers of his instructor, for
+even when he knew what was going to be done, the movements were so rapid
+that his eye could not follow them, and in nine cases out of ten he
+was unable to say whether the coup had been accomplished or not; but
+he could see that there was a slight movement of the fingers that could
+only mean that something was being done.
+
+"It would be a good thing," he said one day, "if every young fellow
+before going out into the world were to have a course of such
+instruction as you are giving me; he would learn, at least, the absolute
+folly of sitting down to play cards with strangers. He would see that
+he could be robbed in fifty different ways, and would be at the absolute
+mercy of any sharper. I never had any inclination for gambling, but if
+I had been inclined that way you would have cured me of the passion for
+life."
+
+The week's instruction was lengthened to a fortnight, and at the end of
+that time Mark went to Dick Chetwynd.
+
+"Do you know, Dick," he said, "a gambling place in Buckingham Street?"
+
+"I know that there is a hell there, Mark, but I have never been in it.
+Why do you ask?"
+
+"I have rather a fancy to go there," he replied. "I hear that, although
+a good many men of fashion haunt the place, the crowd is rather a mixed
+one."
+
+"It has a bad name, Mark; I have heard some queer reports about it."
+
+"Yes, so have I. I should think that it is a very likely place for a man
+like Bastow to go to if he has any liking for play. Of course he would
+get up as a gentleman. At any rate, I have been making what inquiries
+I can in some of the thieves' quarters, and have come to the conclusion
+that he is not likely to have taken up his abode there, and I don't
+think I can do better than make a round of some of these doubtful
+houses. I should like to begin with this, and then work downwards."
+
+"Well, I dare say I could manage it, Mark; I know half a dozen men who
+play there; they say there is more fun and excitement to be got than
+at White's or Crockford's, or any of those places. Some men, of course,
+play high, but a good many who go there only risk a few guineas; some go
+because it is the proper thing at present for a man about town either to
+play or to bet on horses or cock fights, or to patronize the ring; and,
+after all, it is easier to stroll for an hour or two of an evening into
+comfortable rooms, where you meet a lively set and there is champagne
+always going, than it is to attend races or prize fights."
+
+Very few days passed that Mark did not go in for half an hour's chat
+with his friend, and two days after this conversation Dick said:
+
+"By the way, Mark, I have arranged for us to go to that hell tonight;
+young Boldero, who is a member of my club, told me some time ago that he
+played there sometimes. I met him yesterday evening, and said that I had
+a fancy to go and have a look at it, and that a friend of mine from the
+country also wanted to go; he said at once that he would take us there.
+
+"'I should advise you not to play much, Chetwynd,' he said; 'sometimes
+they play uncommonly high, and there are some fellows who have wonderful
+luck. Of course, on ordinary occasions, when the play is low, you could
+stake a few guineas there as well as elsewhere, but when really high
+play is on we small fish always stand out. All I can say is that I have
+never seen anything that savors of foul play in the smallest degree; but
+you understand how it is, if one man happens to have a big run of luck,
+there are always fellows who go about hinting that there is something
+wrong in it. However, it is a jolly place to drop into, and, of course
+there is no occasion to play always, and if one loses one is likely to
+win on the next race or on the next fight.'"
+
+Accordingly that evening Mark met Boldero, whom he had once or twice
+before seen in Dick's company, and the three went together to the house
+in Buckingham Street. Boldero nodded to the doorkeeper as he went in,
+and they then proceeded upstairs and entered a handsome room, with
+comfortable sofas and chairs, on which a dozen men were seated, for the
+most part smoking. Several champagne bottles stood on the tables, and
+all who liked helped themselves. Boldero was known to several of those
+present, while two or three were also known to Dick. Boldero introduced
+them both to his friends. One of these was the Hon. John Emerson, a man
+of some five and thirty, with a languid air and a slight drawl.
+
+"Glad to make your acquaintance, sir," he said to Mark. "Have you been
+long in town?"
+
+"Two or three months only," Mark replied.
+
+"Is this your first visit here?"
+
+"Yes, this is my first visit to any place of the sort, but I thought
+that I should like to go the rounds before I went home again."
+
+"Quite so. Going to punt a few guineas, I suppose?"
+
+"Yes, I suppose that is the right thing to do."
+
+"Well, everyone who comes is expected to do a little that way; there is
+no occasion to play high."
+
+"Oh, I should not like to do that," Mark said innocently; "indeed, I
+know very little about cards."
+
+"Oh, that is quite immaterial so long as you only play games of chance;
+in fact, you don't want to know anything about them. You see others
+staking their money, some on one side of the table, and some on the
+other; you place your money whichever side you like, and take your
+chance. There is no skill in it. Some people play on what they call a
+system, but there is nothing in it; you have just as much chance if you
+put your money down blindfolded. If luck is with you, you win; if luck
+is against you, you lose."
+
+After chatting for a few minutes Mark went with his two companions
+upstairs. The room they now entered was furnished as a drawing room,
+except that in the middle was a table, round which some fifteen people
+were seated, while as many more looked on; round the room were several
+small tables, on which were packs of cards. These were for those who
+preferred to play piquet or ecarte, two or three couples being so
+engaged. Mark knew enough of cards to know that hazard was being played
+at the large table. There was an inner room, and Mark strolled across
+and looked in. It was at present untenanted; it contained a center table
+capable of holding four, and two or three small ones, with two chairs
+set in readiness to each.
+
+"That is where the heavy play goes on," Boldero said. "None of your four
+or five guineas wagers there, fifties and hundreds are nearer the mark,
+and I have seen a thousand wagered many a time. It is exciting work even
+looking on, I can tell you; what it must be for the players I cannot
+say, but I should think it must be frightful."
+
+Mark took up his stand at the hazard table, and after looking on for
+some little time began to play. Beginning with guineas, he gradually, as
+luck favored him, played five guineas, and after half an hour's play won
+fifty. Then luck turned, and in a few minutes he had lost all he won.
+
+"You ought to have stopped, Mark," Dick said reproachfully, as he
+stepped back from his place, which was at once filled by one who had
+been standing behind him.
+
+The play in the inner room had now begun, and Mark went in and joined
+those who were looking on. In half an hour one of the players had had
+enough, and a young man said to Emerson, who was standing on the other
+side of the table:
+
+"Now, Mr. Emerson, will you give me my revenge?"
+
+"I would really rather not, Mr. Cotter. The luck has been so one sided
+lately that I would rather leave it alone."
+
+"But it may turn tonight," the other said. "At any rate, I will try it,
+if you have no objection."
+
+There was a certain eagerness in the young man's voice that caused Mark
+to watch him closely. He was a good looking young fellow, but his face
+was not a strong one; and although he evidently tried to assume an
+appearance of indifference as he sat down, there was a nervous movement
+of his fingers. Mark took his place behind him as play began. The game
+was ecarte, and for a time Emerson lost.
+
+"I think the luck has changed, Mr. Cotter, but as we generally raise the
+stakes after playing for a bit, I am ready to do so. Shall we make it
+fifty pounds again?"
+
+"With pleasure," the young man said.
+
+He won the next two games, then for some time they won alternately.
+
+"Shall we say a hundred again?" he said.
+
+"As you like," Emerson replied. "We don't seem to get much forwarder
+either way at present."
+
+A considerable number of lookers on had now gathered round. So far Mark,
+although watching the fingers of the opposite player intently, had seen
+no sign whatever of unfair play. He now redoubled his attention. Cotter
+won the first game, his adversary the three next. Mark noticed now that
+after looking at his hand Emerson looked abstractedly, as if meditating
+before taking the next step; there was no expression in his face, but
+Mark fancied that his eyes rested for a moment on the man standing next
+to himself. He looked at his watch and then, as if finding the hour
+later than he had expected, moved away from his place, and presently
+joined Dick, who was standing with Boldero on the other side of the
+table.
+
+"Who is that man playing with Emerson?" he asked in a whisper.
+
+"He is the son of Cotter, the head of Cotter's Bank, in Lombard Street."
+
+As the men were standing two or three deep round the table, Mark could
+not see the table itself, but this mattered little, for his attention
+was entirely directed towards the man standing behind Cotter's chair. He
+saw that after glancing down at the young man's hand he looked across as
+if seeing what Emerson was going to do; sometimes his eyes dropped
+for an instant, at other times there was no such movement, and after
+noticing this four or five times, and noticing the course Emerson took,
+he had no doubt whatever in his own mind that the movement of the man's
+eyes was an intimation to Emerson of the nature of Cotter's hand. The
+young man had lost four games in succession; he had grown very pale, but
+showed no other signs of agitation. Presently he said:
+
+"You have your usual luck again; I will only play one more game tonight,
+but we may as well make it worth playing. Shall we say five hundred?"
+
+"At your service," Emerson replied.
+
+This time the face of the man standing behind Cotter's chair was
+immovable, and Mark, placing himself behind a short man and straining
+his head forward, saw that Cotter scored four. The next time there was
+still no sign. Emerson showed a king and scored it, and then won every
+trick and the game.
+
+"That makes nine hundred pounds," the young man said quietly, writing
+an IOU for that amount and handing it to Emerson. There was a general
+movement of the spectators, and two fresh players took the seats vacated
+by the late antagonists.
+
+"Who was the man standing behind Cotter's chair?" Mark asked Boldero.
+
+"That is Sir James Flash. He is just going to play, you see; it is sure
+to be another hot game, and an interesting one."
+
+"Well, I think I will go," Mark said; "the heat of the room has given me
+a bit of a headache. I will see you tomorrow, Dick."
+
+"Good night, old man," Chetwynd said; and, shaking hands with Boldero,
+Mark went downstairs immediately after Cotter. The latter went into the
+room below, drank off a tumbler of champagne, and then went down, took
+his hat, and went out. Mark followed him for a short distance, and
+joined him as soon as he got up into the Strand.
+
+"Mr. Cotter," he said, "I have not the pleasure of knowing you
+personally, and I must introduce myself. My name is Mark Thorndyke,
+and I am the owner of an estate close to Reigate. Would you mind my
+exchanging a few words with you?"
+
+Cotter looked up, and was about to give a flat refusal, but the
+expression of Mark's face was so friendly and pleasant that he changed
+his mind and said in a hard voice:
+
+"I really do not know what you can have to say to me, Mr. Thorndyke, but
+of course I can hardly refuse to hear you."
+
+They walked across the road and turned up a quiet street.
+
+"For certain reasons it is not necessary for me to explain," Mark said,
+"I went to that place for the first time tonight, and I watched the play
+between you and Mr. Emerson."
+
+"It does not matter, sir; I lost, and I am not going there again."
+
+"I hope, on the contrary, that you will go there again, Mr. Cotter. If I
+mistake not, from what I heard, you have lost considerable sums to that
+man."
+
+"I imagine, sir, that that is no business of a stranger."
+
+"In no way personally," Mark replied, not heeding the angry ring in
+the voice, "but as an honest man it does concern me. I am absolutely
+convinced, sir, that that money has not been won from you fairly."
+
+The young man gave a start.
+
+"Impossible!" he said shortly. "Mr. Emerson is a man of good family and
+a gentleman."
+
+"He is a man of good family, I admit, but certainly not a gentleman; his
+antecedents are notorious."
+
+"I have never heard a word against him; he is intimate with Sir James
+Flash and other gentlemen of position."
+
+"I am not surprised, that you have not heard of it; it was probably
+to the interest of several persons that you should not do so. Nor do
+I suppose that you are aware that Sir James Flash was himself expelled
+from White's for cheating at cards."
+
+"Impossible!" Mr. Cotter replied.
+
+"I can assure you of the fact," Mark said quietly. "Probably you have
+among your acquaintances some members of White's. I am sure if you ask
+them they will confirm the fact. Now, sir, I can assure you that I
+have no interest in this matter, save to prevent a gentleman from being
+ruined by blacklegs. May I ask how much you owe to Mr. Emerson and Sir
+James Flash?"
+
+The young man hesitated. "I believe you, sir," he said at last. "They
+hold my IOUs for 29,000 pounds. I need hardly say it is absolute ruin.
+My intention is to make a clean breast to my father about it tomorrow
+morning. My father will give me the money, in the first place because he
+loves me and would save my name from disgrace, and in the second because
+were I posted as a defaulter it would strike a severe blow at the credit
+of the bank. So he will give me the money, but he will bid me leave his
+house forever. That will matter little, for I shall pay the money, and
+tomorrow night I shall blow out my brains."
+
+"Well, sir, if you will follow my advice you will neither pay the
+money nor blow out your brains. I saw enough tonight to feel absolutely
+certain that you have been cheated. Sir James Flash stood behind you,
+and was, I am sure, signaling your hand to Emerson. I believe that
+Emerson played fair otherwise, until the last game, but I am convinced
+that he then cheated. You had good hands, but he had better; and
+although I did not see him cheat--for I was on the other side of the
+table--I am convinced that he did so. Now, sir, I advise you to go in
+as usual tomorrow evening, and to play, raising your stakes as you did
+tonight. When the times comes I will expose him. Should I not be able to
+detect him we must try another night. I am so much convinced that this
+is the case, and that I shall succeed, that whether you play one night
+or three I will guarantee that you shall be no loser, but will, on the
+honor of a gentleman, place in your hands the amount of your losses; so
+that you will not have to ask your father for a check larger than you
+would do if you confessed to him tomorrow morning. I only ask in return
+that you, on your part, will give me your word of honor that you will
+never touch a card again after you rise from the table."
+
+"I cannot accept so generous an offer from a stranger," Cotter said in a
+low tone.
+
+"I do not think that it is generous," Mark replied quietly, "because I
+am perfectly convinced that I shall not have to pay at all. Have you any
+other IOUs out?"
+
+"I have given them for about 5000 pounds, but that is not in addition
+to the 29,000 pounds. Emerson told me that as he knew that I should have
+difficulty in paying them at the present moment, he had taken them up,
+and held them with his own."
+
+"Will you give me the names of the persons to whom you gave them in the
+first place?"
+
+"Certainly;" and he mentioned three names, all of which stood with a
+black cross against them on Mark's list.
+
+"Thank you. Then you will go tomorrow night again?"
+
+"Yes; and I swear to you that I will never touch a card afterwards."
+
+"I don't think that you need fear," Mark said. "I have not been long in
+London, but I happen to have been shown a good many of the tricks that
+these blacklegs play on greenhorns, which will account for my having
+noticed what has never been observed by the honest portion of the men
+who frequent the place. Now I will say good night, sir. I shall be
+behind your chair or his tomorrow night."
+
+"I don't know what to say," Cotter said hesitatingly.
+
+"There is no occasion to say anything; it is the duty of every honest
+man to interfere if he sees another honest man being robbed, and that is
+my sole object in this matter. Good night;" and turning round, he walked
+rapidly away.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII.
+
+
+The next morning, before going round to Gibbons', Mark saw his chief and
+told him of what had taken place on the previous evening.
+
+"I certainly did not think that you would succeed so soon; you believe
+that you will be able fairly to expose these fellows?"
+
+"I have no doubt whatever that I shall be able to expose one of them;
+and I have equally no doubt that if the others are arrested, either
+false cards or pockets for cards will be found upon them. What do you
+wish me to do, sir? I can, of course, expose any fellow I catch at it,
+but can do nothing about the others."
+
+"I must have more than one captured," the chief said. "At even the most
+irreproachable club there may be one blackleg, but if it is clear that
+this place is the haunt of blacklegs we can break it. There are half a
+dozen Acts that apply; there is the 11th Act of Henry VIII, statute 33,
+cap. 9, which prohibits the keeping of any common house for dice, cards,
+or any unlawful game. That has never been repealed, except that gaming
+houses were licensed in 1620. What is more to the point is that
+five Acts of George II, the 9th, 12th, 13th, 18th, and 30th, impose
+penalties upon the keepers of public houses for permitting gambling, and
+lay heavy penalties upon hazard, roulette, and other gambling games, on
+the keepers of gambling houses and those who play there. Having received
+complaints of several young men being rooked in the place, we can, if
+we prove that some of its frequenters are blacklegs, shut the place up
+altogether. We should do it quietly, and without fuss, if possible;
+but if we shut it up several others of the same sort will be certain to
+close their doors. But mind, there will probably be a desperate row, and
+you had better take pistols with you. I will have four men close at
+hand from ten o'clock till the time the place closes, and if they hear a
+scrimmage, or you fire a pistol out of the window, they will rush in and
+seize all engaged in the row, and march them to the lock up. Of course
+you will have to be included."
+
+Mark then went to Chetwynd.
+
+"Well, what did you think of it last night?"
+
+"Well, I own that it went against my grain to see that young fellow
+being victimized by a sharper."
+
+"My dear Mark, you must not use such language as that. I fancy from
+what I have heard that the Honorable John is not altogether an estimable
+character, but to call him a sharper is going too far altogether."
+
+"I don't think that it is, for from what I saw last night I am pretty
+well convinced that he did not play fair. I mean to go again tonight."
+
+"But why on earth should you mix yourself up in such an affair, Mark? It
+is no business of yours; you are not an habitue of the place. Above
+all, it is extremely unlikely that you are right. There were some
+shady people there, no doubt, but there were also a good many gentlemen
+present, and as you know nothing of cards, as far as I know, it is the
+most unlikely thing in the world that you should find out that Emerson
+cheated when no one else noticed it."
+
+"It is my business; it is the duty of every honest man to see that a
+poor lad like that should not be eaten up by a shark like Emerson. I
+don't care if there is a shindy over it. I shall not interfere unless I
+can prove that the man is cheating, in which case no man of honor would
+go out with him. I shall be glad if you and Boldero would go with me
+again this evening. I am not known there, and you are to a good many
+men, and Boldero to many more. I only want that, if I get into a row,
+you should testify to the fact that I am a gentleman, and ordinarily
+sane. If there is a row you will have an opportunity of seeing how much
+I have benefited by my lessons."
+
+"Yes, I heard you were making tremendous progress. Jack Needham told
+me a month ago that you had knocked him out of time, and I went into
+Gibbons' yesterday morning with a man who wanted to buy a dog, and he
+told me that he considered that it was a great misfortune that you were
+an amateur, for that you only required another six months' practice, and
+he would then be ready to back you for a hundred pounds against any man
+in the ring. But about this affair, Mark. Are you really in earnest?"
+
+"I am, Dick, thoroughly in earnest; so would you be if you had spoken
+to Cotter last night, as I did. I tell you that if I had not given him a
+little hope that the thing might come out right, he would have blown out
+his brains today."
+
+"Well, Mark, if you have set your mind on it, of course I will stick to
+you, though I have some doubts whether Cotter has any brains to speak
+of to blow out, else he would not be mad enough to back himself against
+Emerson and other men whom Boldero tells me he has been playing with."
+
+"He has made an ass of himself, no doubt, Dick; but I fancy a good
+many fellows do that at one time or other of their lives, though not, I
+grant, always in the same way."
+
+"Well, I will go, Mark. I need not ask Boldero, for he told me that he
+should look in again at ten o'clock this evening, for he thought that
+another night's play would probably bring Cotter to the end of his
+tether."
+
+Accordingly a little before ten they walked into the gambling house
+together.
+
+"Now, Dick, I want you, as soon as you sit down, to take your place in
+the front line within a yard or two of Emerson. I don't want you to be
+just behind him, but a short distance away; and I want you to keep your
+eye upon Sir James Flash, who, if I am not mistaken, will take up the
+same position that he did last night, near enough to Cotter to see
+his hand. You will remark, I have no doubt, as I did last night, that
+whenever Cotter has a bad hand, Flash will either close his eyes, or put
+his hand up to his mouth and stroke his mustache, or make some sign of
+that sort. When Cotter has a good hand he will stand perfectly still or
+look about the room. At any rate, he will make no sign--that, of course,
+is a guide to Emerson whether to propose or to refuse to allow Cotter
+to do so. I need not point out to you what a tremendous advantage
+the knowledge whether an opponent's hand is good or not gives him. Of
+course, while watching an hour's play I can only know that Flash was
+making signs, and that when he did so Cotter's hand was a bad one. It is
+possible that the manner in which the sign was made, either by closing
+his eye or twisting his mustache, or so on, may have been an intimation
+as to the suit in which Cotter was strongest or weakest."
+
+"By Jove, this is a serious thing, Mark."
+
+"It is a serious thing. I don't want you to get into a row with the
+fellow. I should like you to give me a nod when you have satisfied
+yourself that I was not mistaken. I will take upon myself to denounce
+the fellow, and to say what I noticed yesterday and you can back me up
+by saying that you saw the same thing. I have no doubt that I shall be
+able to convince every decent man there that my charge is well founded.
+I am going to watch Emerson. With the help he gets from Flash, he won't
+risk anything by cheating until it comes to a big stake like the last
+game yesterday, in which case, if Cotter's hand happens to be a strong
+one, he is likely to do so, and I fancy if he does I shall be able to
+catch him at it. You had better keep Boldero near you. You can whisper
+to him what you are watching Flash for, and get him to do so too; as,
+if I catch Emerson cheating, there is likely to be a row; he can lend
+a hand if necessary, and, at any rate, his joining in with you will
+suffice to show his friends that the thing is genuine."
+
+"All right, Mark. I am interested in the matter now, and am ready for
+anything."
+
+Soon after ten Cotter and Emerson again sat down, and, as usual, a lot
+of spectators gathered round the table. The game resembled the one on
+the previous evening. Mark placed himself' by the side of Cotter, a
+stranger stood immediately behind his chair, another member of the club
+was on the other side, and Sir James Flash stood partly behind him, so
+that although somewhat in the background he could obtain a view between
+their heads of Cotter's cards. Mark saw to his satisfaction that Dick
+and Boldero had secured the exact position that he wished them to take.
+For the first few games the play was even, and Dick began to think that
+Mark had been mistaken, for Flash appeared to take little interest in
+the game, and made no sign how Emerson should proceed.
+
+As soon as the stake rose to a hundred again he distinctly saw Flash
+close his eyes and play with his mustache; he called Boldero's attention
+to the fact, and found the latter, who had also been watching, had
+noticed it. By the time a few games had been played he verified Mark's
+assertion that these signs were signals that Cotter's hand was a bad
+one, and in each case Emerson played without giving his opponent the
+opportunity of discarding and taking in fresh cards. He and Dick nodded
+quietly to Mark, who had satisfied himself that so far Emerson had not
+cheated in any other way. As on the previous evening, Cotter, after
+losing five or six hundred pounds, proposed a final game of five
+hundred. Mark bent down his head, so that the intentness of his gaze
+should not be noticed, but from under his eyebrows he watched Emerson's
+every movement; suddenly he placed a foot on the edge of the chair of
+the man sitting in front of him, and with a sudden spring leaped upon
+the table, seized Emerson's hand, and held it up to the full length of
+his arm.
+
+"Gentlemen," he shouted, "this fellow is cheating; there is a card in
+his hand which he has just brought from under the table."
+
+In a moment there was a dead silence of surprise; then Mark forced the
+hand open and took Emerson's card, which he held up.
+
+"There, you see, gentleman; it is a king."
+
+Then a Babel of sounds arose, a dozen hands were laid upon Emerson, who
+was pulled back from his chair and thrown down on a sofa, while hands
+were run over his coat, waistcoat, and breeches.
+
+"Here they are!" a man shouted, and held a dozen cards over his head.
+
+The place of concealment had been cleverly chosen; the breeches
+apparently buttoned closely at the knee, but in reality they were loose
+enough to enable a finger and thumb to be passed between them and the
+stocking, and in the lining of the breeches was a pocket in which the
+cards had been placed, being held there by two pieces of whalebone, that
+closed the pocket. The searchers, among whom were Dick and Boldero, did
+not have it all their own way; four or five men rushed upon them, and
+endeavored to pull them off Emerson. The din of voices was prodigious,
+but Mark, still standing on the table, stilled it for a moment by
+shouting:
+
+"The scoundrel has an accomplice, who this evening and yesterday has
+been signaling the strength of the cards in Mr. Cotter's hands."
+
+"Who is he?" was shouted over the room.
+
+"It is Sir James Flash," Mark said. "I denounce him as a cheat and a
+sharper."
+
+As pale as death, Flash rushed to the table.
+
+"I don't know who you are, sir," he said, in a tone of concentrated
+rage, "but you are a liar, and you shall answer for this in the
+morning."
+
+"I will answer to any gentleman that calls me to account," Mark said,
+in a ringing voice, "but I don't meet a man who has been expelled from
+White's for cheating, and who I have no doubt is well stocked with cards
+at the present moment, in readiness for the victim that he is next going
+to meet after the plucking of Mr. Cotter has been done. Now, gentlemen,
+search him and see if I am wrong; if I am I will apologize for that part
+of my accusation."
+
+Flash drew a pistol from his pocket, but in an instant his arm was
+seized by those standing round him, and it exploded harmlessly. Among
+those who seized Flash was the man who had played with him the previous
+evening. In spite of his struggles and curses, and the efforts of his
+friends to rescue him, he too was thrown down and eight court cards were
+found concealed in his sleeve. The uproar while this was going on had
+been tremendous, but it was suddenly stilled as four men in dark clothes
+entered the room. Each held in his hand the well known symbol of his
+office, the little ebony staff surmounted by a silver crown.
+
+"I arrest all present in the name of the king," one said, "for breaking
+the laws against gambling, and for brawling and the use of firearms.
+Now, gentlemen, resistance is useless; I must request that you each give
+me your card, and your word of honor that you will appear at Bow Street
+tomorrow morning."
+
+"What is all this about, sir?" he asked Mark, who was still standing on
+the table.
+
+"Two fellows here have been caught cheating."
+
+"What is your name and address, sir?"
+
+"My name is Mark Thorndyke, and I am a landed gentleman at Reigate; my
+friends Mr. Chetwynd and Mr. Boldero will bear this out."
+
+"Who are the two men?" the constable asked.
+
+"The two fellows with torn clothes," Mark said. "They are Mr. Emerson
+and Sir James Flash."
+
+"You are certain of the charge that you are making?"
+
+"Quite certain; the cards have been found hidden upon them."
+
+"Yes, yes!" a score of voices shouted; "they have been caught in the act
+of cheating."
+
+"Take those two men into custody," the constable said to two of his
+companions.
+
+"Who fired that pistol?" he went on.
+
+A number of voices shouted:
+
+"Sir James Flash; he attempted to murder Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+The constable nodded to the man who had laid his hands on Sir James
+Flash, and in a moment a pair of handcuffs closed on his wrists.
+
+"You shall repent this!" Flash exclaimed furiously.
+
+"Calm yourself, Sir James," the constable said calmly. "We know our
+duty, and do it whether a man is a peer or a peasant; you are accused of
+card sharping and an attempted murder."
+
+"What is your address in town, Mr. Thorndyke?" he asked.
+
+"18 Villiers Street."
+
+"Is there any charge against anyone else here? A good many of you seem
+to have your clothes torn and disarranged."
+
+"Some fellows attempted to rescue Emerson and Flash while we were
+searching them; for what reason we can all pretty well imagine."
+
+"I shall require the names in the morning of your assailants," the
+constable said; "it looks very much as if they were confederates of the
+two prisoners. Now, gentlemen, you can all leave. This house is
+closed, and will not be opened again until this affair is thoroughly
+investigated."
+
+In five minutes the house was deserted.
+
+"How can I thank you, Mr. Thorndyke?" Cotter, who was one of those who
+had seized Flash's arm, diverted his aim and searched him, said, when
+they got outside the house. "You have saved my life. It did not seem
+possible to me that you could succeed in showing that I was being
+cheated, and I had firmly resolved that, instead of allowing you to
+suffer loss, I would tomorrow morning make a clean breast of the whole
+affair to my father, as I had intended to have done this morning."
+
+"If I might advise you, Mr. Cotter, I should say, carry out your
+intention as far as making a clean breast of it is concerned. Happily,
+you are free from debt, as those IOUs are worthless, for they were
+obtained from you by cheating, therefore you have no demand to make upon
+his purse. The police will, I have no doubt, endeavor to keep this thing
+quiet, but your name may come out, and it would be far better that
+your father should hear this story from you than elsewhere; and your
+assurance that you will never touch a card again, and the heavy lesson
+that you have had, will doubtless induce him to look at the matter
+leniently. It will, no doubt, be a painful story to tell, but it will be
+far better told by you."
+
+"I will do it, sir; as you say, the lesson has been a heavy one, and
+henceforth my father shall have no reason to complain of me. May I call
+and see you tomorrow evening?"
+
+"Certainly. I shall be at home from seven to eight, after which hour I
+have an engagement. Good night."
+
+Cotter walked on, and Mark fell back, and joined Dick and Boldero, who
+had fallen behind when they saw him speaking to Cotter.
+
+"Well, Mark, I congratulate you," Dick Chetwynd said. "You did it
+wonderfully, though how on earth you knew that fellow had a card in his
+hand is more than I can guess."
+
+"I felt sure he was going to cheat," Mark said quietly; "I saw that
+Cotter's hand was a very strong one, and knew that Emerson would be
+aware that it was so, because he would receive no signal from Flash,
+therefore this was the time, if any, that he would cheat. He had been
+playing with both hands upon the table. I saw him withdraw one, there
+was a little pause, and then it came up again, and I had not a doubt
+in the world that there was a card in it, and that it had been
+hidden somewhere in his breeches, which is one of the best places of
+concealment, for his hand being under the table while getting at the
+card, no one present who was not behind the scenes, as I was, could
+detect him doing it."
+
+"The wonder to me is," Boldero said, "that while there were a number
+of men looking on closely, for Emerson has long been suspected of not
+playing fair, you, just fresh from the country, if I may say so, should
+have spotted him."
+
+"That is easily explained," Mark said. "Not wishing to fall a victim, I
+have of late been put up to a great many of these sharpers' tricks by a
+man who at one time had been in the trade himself."
+
+"That was a capital idea, Mark," Dick said. "I wish you would introduce
+me to him."
+
+"I won't do that, Dick, but I shall be very glad to teach you all I know
+myself about it; but I fancy that after this you will be in no great
+hurry to enter a gambling hell again."
+
+"That is so, Mark. I have never had any great inclination for play;
+but after this you may be quite sure that I will light shy of cards
+altogether. Still, I shall be glad if you will put me up to some of
+these tricks, for I may be able to some day save a victim of card
+sharpers, as you have done this evening."
+
+The next morning, when those who had been present at the scene of the
+previous evening arrived at the office of the detectives in Bow Street,
+they were shown into some private rooms, and asked to wait. Cotter,
+Mark, and his two friends first had an interview with the chief.
+
+"You will understand," the latter said, "that this is an altogether
+informal affair. I propose you first tell me your story as briefly as
+possible."
+
+This was done.
+
+"Now, Mr. Cotter. I take it that you do not wish to prosecute?"
+
+"Certainly not. I would, in fact, give anything rather than appear in
+it."
+
+"You have said that, in addition to the IOUs that you have given to the
+two men caught cheating, they hold others to the amount of some five
+or six thousand pounds, given by you to three other frequenters of the
+club. In fact, these papers have been found in Emerson's pocketbook; he
+told you, I believe, that he had taken them up, so that you should not
+be inconvenienced by them. I understand, then, that you will be quite
+content if you get these IOUs back again; those given to Emerson and
+Flash are, of course, worthless. After what has happened, they could not
+be presented, but probably you might have trouble about the others,
+for, though I have no doubt that the whole of the men were in league
+together, we have no means of absolutely proving it."
+
+"I shall be more than content, sir; I have no wish to prosecute."
+
+"We are glad," the chief said, "to be able to close a dangerous place;
+and as the exposure will put a stop to the career of these two men, and
+no doubt alarm a good many others, we don't care about taking the matter
+into court. Such gross scandals as this are best kept quiet, when there
+is no object in ventilating them. Therefore, gentlemen, as Mr. Cotter
+is willing to do so, we shall let the matter drop. I shall be obliged if
+you will step into the next room, however, until I have seen these three
+men."
+
+When they had left, the three were brought in.
+
+"You have been concerned, sirs," the chief said sternly, "in winning
+large sums of money from the Hon. William Denton, from Mr. James Carew,
+from Mr. William Hobson, and others; in all of these cases the two men
+caught cheating last night were also concerned. You all hold notes of
+hand of Mr. Hobson. I shall advise that gentleman's father to refuse to
+pay those notes, and promise him that if any further request for payment
+is made I will furnish him with such particulars for publication as
+will more than justify him in the eyes of the world in refusing to honor
+them. You, as well as Mr. Emerson and Sir James Flash, have won large
+sums from Mr. Cotter, and the fact that the IOUs he gave you were found
+on Mr. Emerson points very strongly to their being in confederacy with
+you in the matter; at any rate, they point so strongly that, whether a
+jury would convict or not on the evidence that we shall be able to lay
+before them, there can be no question whatever as to what the opinion of
+men of honor will be. These IOUs are in our hands. Mr. Cotter does not
+desire to pursue the case; he will, however, refuse absolutely to pay
+those IOUs, and in doing so he will have the approval of all honorable
+men. That being so, the IOUs are absolutely useless to you, and if you
+will agree to my tearing them up now, he has most kindly consented to
+let the matter drop in your cases."
+
+The three men, who had all turned very white when he was speaking, now
+protested angrily against imputations being made on their honor.
+
+"Well, sirs," the officer said, "in that case the matter can, of course,
+go on. You know best what the feeling will be as to these IOUs. They
+will form an important item of evidence against you, you will see. As
+the matter stands, either you gave them to Emerson to collect for you,
+without any money passing between you--a very strange procedure, which
+you will find it difficult to explain--or else he gave you the coin for
+them, and you passed them over to him, and have, therefore, parted with
+all claim on Mr. Cotter on your own account. Of course I impound them
+with the other IOUs as proof of a conspiracy between you. Now, sirs, am
+I to tear them up or not?"
+
+The three men looked at each other, and then one of them said:
+
+"We protest altogether against the assertion, sir, but at the same
+time, as there can be little doubt that Emerson and Sir James Flash have
+played unfairly, and we do not wish any association of our names
+with theirs, we are perfectly willing that the IOUs, which, under the
+circumstances, we should never have dreamt of presenting, should be
+destroyed."
+
+"I think that you have chosen wisely," the chief said dryly. "It is a
+pity that you did not do so at first. These are the IOUs he gave to one
+or other of you. Perhaps it would be pleasanter for you to destroy them
+yourselves."
+
+The three men took the papers with their names on them and tore them up.
+
+"Thank you," he went on sarcastically. "That will place you in a
+better position. You will be able to tell your friends that you felt so
+indignant at the manner in which Mr. Cotter had been swindled by Emerson
+and Flash that you at once destroyed his IOUs for the sums that you had
+won of him. But, gentlemen,"--he spoke sternly now,--"remember that we
+have a long list against you, and that the next victim, or let us say
+his father, might be more disposed to push matters to their full length
+than is Mr. Cotter. Remember, also, that we keep ourselves acquainted
+with what is going on, and that should trouble arise we shall produce
+all the complaints that have been made against you, and shall also
+mention your connection with this affair, in which, as I understand, you
+all did your best to prevent those two fellows from being searched."
+
+Without saying another word the three men went out of the room,
+too crestfallen to make even an attempt at keeping up their air of
+indignation. The others were then called in.
+
+"I am sorry, gentlemen," he said, "that you have had the trouble of
+coming here, for the gentleman swindled has declined to prosecute the
+swindlers, and you will understand that he is somewhat anxious that his
+name should not appear in the matter. Fortunately, as instead of paying
+in cash he gave IOUs for his losses, he will not be a loser to any large
+amount by these transactions. I may say that the proprietor of the hell
+has been there this morning, and to avoid trouble he has consented to
+close his place for good. I have only to remark that I should advise
+you, gentlemen, in future, only to indulge in gambling in places where
+you may be fairly assured of the character of the men you play with. I
+think, in conclusion, that you may all feel grateful to Mr. Cotter for
+refusing to prosecute. It has saved you from having to appear in court
+as witnesses in so utterly disreputable an affair."
+
+There was a general murmur of assent, and in a minute or two the room
+was clear. Flash and Emerson were then brought in, with a constable on
+each side of them.
+
+"Mr. Cotter has, I regret to say, declined to prosecute, and Mr.
+Thorndyke has done the same with regard to Sir James Flash's use of his
+pistol. You have, therefore, escaped the punishment due to swindlers
+at cards. It is the less matter, as you are not likely to have an
+opportunity of making fresh victims, for the story will be known by
+this afternoon in every club in London. These IOUs will be of no use to
+you--they are not worth the paper on which they are written. However,
+I shall take it upon myself to hand them back to Mr. Cotter, to prevent
+the possibility of their getting into other hands and giving him
+trouble.
+
+"You can unlock those handcuffs, constable; these men are at liberty to
+go, and if they will take my advice they will lose no time in crossing
+the water and establishing themselves somewhere where their talents are
+likely to be better appreciated than they are here. They can go; one
+of you can call a hackney coach for them if they wish it. They will
+scarcely care to walk with their garments in their present condition."
+
+Then the chief went into the next room.
+
+"There is an end of that affair, Mr. Cotter. Here are the IOUs you gave
+to those two swindlers. Those you gave to the other three men, who were
+no doubt their confederates, have been torn up by them in my presence.
+They declare that after seeing how shamefully you had been victimized
+they had not the slightest idea of ever presenting them."
+
+"I am sure that I am extremely grateful to you," Cotter said. "I know
+that I have behaved like a madman, and that I don't deserve to have got
+off as I have done. It will be a lesson to me for life, I can assure
+you."
+
+On leaving, Dick Chetwynd walked for some distance with Mark--as far as
+Gibbons' place in St. Giles.
+
+"There is one thing which I cannot understand," he said, "and that is
+how it was that the constables happened to be so close at hand, just at
+the time they were wanted."
+
+"Well, you see, Dick, my relations with Bow Street are just at present
+of a somewhat close nature, for they are aiding me in the search that I
+told you that I was making for my father's murderer. The consequence was
+that I had only to mention to the chief that I fancied I had detected
+cheating at that place, and that there was a likelihood of a row there
+last night, and he at once said he would send four men, to come in if
+they heard a rumpus; and he was, indeed, rather glad of an opportunity
+for breaking up the place, concerning which he had had several
+complaints of young men being plucked to the last feather. Well, it was
+lucky they came. I don't say that it would have made any difference,
+because I think our side was a great deal stronger than they were, still
+it would have led to a nasty row, and perhaps to half a dozen duels
+afterwards. Well, I will say goodby now. I am very glad that the affair
+has been dropped; it would not have mattered so much to me, as I am
+single and my own master, but there were a good many men there who would
+have been ready to have paid up handsomely rather than that their names
+should appear in connection with a row at a gambling house."
+
+At seven o'clock in the evening Philip Cotter called at Mark's lodgings,
+accompanied by his father, who, as he came in with him, advanced at once
+to Mark and shook him warmly by the hand.
+
+"My son has told me everything, Mr. Thorndyke," he said, "and I cannot
+thank you sufficiently for the noble part you took in rescuing him from
+the terrible effects of his folly. I have been down here twice this
+afternoon, for I felt that I could not rest until I had shaken you by
+the hand. It is not the question of money so much, though that would
+have been a serious loss to me, but it is the saving of my son's life,
+and the saving of the honor of our name."
+
+"I am glad indeed to have been of service, Mr. Cotter, and I trust that
+you have consented to forgive the folly that he has committed, and which
+I feel sure will never be repeated."
+
+"Yes. It was a heavy blow to me, Mr. Thorndyke, when Philip told me; but
+as he has sworn most solemnly never to touch a card again, and as I feel
+sure that the lesson cannot but be a useful one to him all his life, I
+have agreed to say no more about it, and let the matter drop altogether.
+He has been fortunate to have escaped so easily. He has told me of the
+noble offer you made to pay his losses if you should not be able to
+prove that he was being cheated."
+
+"I was not committing myself heavily," Mark said with a smile. "I had
+seen enough to be absolutely certain, and was sure that I should be able
+to bring it home to them."
+
+"But it was at a considerable risk to yourself, Mr. Thorndyke. As it
+was, you had a narrow escape of being shot."
+
+"Not a very narrow escape," Mark replied. "With so many men standing
+round him and their attention called to him, it was certain that he
+would be seized before he could take aim at me. I had pistols in my
+pocket, and was prepared to fire in an instant, but I saw at once that
+there was no occasion for that."
+
+"But I cannot imagine how you should have detected the cheating," the
+banker said. "You are younger than my son, and he said that you told
+him that you had only recently come up to London. It is astonishing that
+while experienced players should never have noticed that anything was
+wrong you should have discovered it."
+
+"The explanation is simple, Mr. Cotter. I have no inclination for play
+myself, but I happened a short time since to fall in with a man who was
+well acquainted with all the various methods of card sharping. I thought
+that a knowledge of that might some day be useful, and I got him to
+put me up to a number of the tricks of card sharpers both at home and
+abroad. Having these fresh in my mind, and seeing that your son was
+playing with a man whose reputation I knew to be bad, I naturally
+concentrated my attention upon him, and was not long in discovering that
+he had a confederate standing behind your son's chair. Being a stranger
+in the place, I could not denounce him, but the next night I set two
+friends to watch that method of cheating, while I kept my eyes fixed on
+Emerson's hands. As I anticipated, there was nothing suspicious about
+his movements so long as play was comparatively low, for the advantage
+that he gained from his confederate enabled him to be sure of winning in
+the long run; it was only in the last game, which was a high one, that,
+as he knew that your son had a strong hand, he was tempted to stock
+his hand with false cards; and watching closely, I had no difficulty in
+detecting his method."
+
+"Well, sir, you have, at any rate, laid us both under the deepest
+obligation. Is there any possible way in which we can show our
+gratitude?"
+
+Mark thought for a moment.
+
+"In one way you might do me a favor, Mr. Cotter. A ward of my father's,
+who will inherit some property when she comes of age, is at present
+finishing her education in town, and is living with a lady who has
+been her friend and companion since childhood. I have a good many
+acquaintances, but they are all bachelors; and having been living down
+at my father's place, near Reigate, for so many years, the ladies have
+no acquaintances in London. They live at Islington, and their life is
+a very dull one. I am anxious, for several reasons, that the young lady
+should have the advantage of going somewhat into society. Hitherto I
+have had no means of introducing her. If it is not too much to ask, Mr.
+Cotter, I should be extremely glad and obliged if Mrs. Cotter would call
+on them and give them an introduction into society. The lady with my
+father's ward is the widow of a captain in the Indian Army, and is in
+all ways a very charming person, and has been at the head of my father's
+establishment for the last twelve years."
+
+"With the greatest pleasure in the world, Mr. Thorndyke. I am only sorry
+that it is so slight a thing that you ask of me. I have thought it
+but right to tell my wife what has passed, and I had difficulty in
+persuading her not to come with me this evening to also express her
+gratitude to you. She will be pleased indeed to call upon your friends
+at once, and I am sure she will do so tomorrow. I was going to ask you
+to dine with us, and I hope that you will do so. We shall have no one
+else, and I hope that you will be able to arrange to meet your friends
+at our house a few days later."
+
+The next morning Mark called on Mrs. Cunningham.
+
+"I think you will have a visitor today," he said. "It has happened that
+I have been able to do a service to the son of Mr. Cotter, a wealthy
+banker. I am going to dine there this evening. He asked me about my
+friends in London, and I mentioned that my only lady friends were you
+and Millicent. He asked a few questions as to where you were living, and
+so on, and said that his wife would have much pleasure in calling and
+introducing Millicent into society. As your life is very dull here, and
+it is clearly very desirable that Millicent should go into society, I
+gladly accepted the offer, and I believe that she will call today."
+
+"That will be very nice indeed, Mark. Millicent is not complaining, but
+she must have felt it very dull. I have even felt it so myself after the
+cheerful society we had at home."
+
+"I don't know that I shall like it," Millicent said doubtfully.
+
+"Oh, yes, you will, Millicent; and besides, it will be good for you. It
+is not natural for a girl of your age to be here without friends, and I
+shall be very glad to know that you are going to mix a little with other
+people."
+
+Mrs. Cotter called that afternoon, and three days later Mark met Mrs.
+Cunningham and Millicent at a dinner party at the banker's, and Mrs.
+Cotter introduced them very warmly to several of her friends, with the
+result that in a very short time they were frequently invited out, while
+they became very intimate with the banker and his wife, and often spent
+the day there.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV.
+
+
+Some little time after this Mark was intrusted by his chief with the
+work of discovering a man who had committed a very atrocious murder, and
+was, it was tolerably certain, hiding in the slums of Westminster. It
+was the first business of the kind that had been confided to him, and he
+was exceedingly anxious to carry it out successfully. He dressed himself
+as a street hawker, and took a small lodging in one of the lanes, being
+away the greater portion of the day ostensibly on his business, and
+of an evening dropped into some of the worst public houses in the
+neighborhood. He was at first viewed with some suspicion, but it was not
+long before he became popular. He let it be understood that he had got
+into trouble down in the country, and that he was quite ready to take
+part in any job that promised to be profitable. But he principally
+owed his popularity to the fact that the bully of the locality picked
+a quarrel with him, and, to the astonishment of those present, Mark
+invited him to go outside.
+
+"You had better make it up with him, mate," a man sitting by his side
+whispered. "He was in the prize ring at one time, and thrashed big Mike
+Hartley at Kennington. He had to give it up owing to having fought a
+cross. He would kill you in five minutes."
+
+"I will chance that," Mark said quietly, as he moved towards the door.
+"I don't think that he is stronger than I am, and I can use my fists a
+bit, too."
+
+By the time they had taken off their upper garments a crowd had
+assembled. The news that a hawker was going to stand up against
+Black Jim circulated rapidly, and caused intense excitement. To the
+astonishment of the spectators, the bully from the first had not a
+shadow of a chance, and at the end of the third round was carried away
+senseless, while the hawker had not received a scratch. A few days later
+Mark, who, on the strength of his prowess, had had two or three hints
+that he could be put up to a good thing if he was inclined to join, was
+going down to Westminster when two men stopped and looked after him.
+
+"I tell you, Emerson, that is the fellow. I could swear to him anywhere.
+What he is got up like that for I cannot tell you, but I should not be
+surprised if he is one of that Bow Street gang. He called himself Mark
+Thorndyke, and Chetwynd said that he was a gentleman of property; but
+that might have been part of the plant to catch us. I have never been
+able to understand how a raw countryman could have caught you palming
+that card. I believe that fellow is a Bow Street runner; if so, it is
+rum if we cannot manage to get even with him before we go. It seemed
+to me that luck had deserted us altogether; but this looks as if it was
+going to turn again. Let's go after him."
+
+Keeping some fifty yards behind him, they watched Mark to his lodgings,
+waited until he came out again, and followed him to a public house.
+
+"He is acting as a detective, sure enough," Emerson said. "The question
+is, what are we to do next?"
+
+In half an hour Mark came out again. Several people nodded to him as he
+passed them, but they saw a big man, who happened to be standing under
+a lamp, turn his back suddenly as Mark approached him, and, after he had
+passed, stand scowling after him, and muttering deep curses. Flash
+at once went up to him. "Do you know who that fellow is, my man?" The
+fellow turned savagely upon him.
+
+"I don't know who he is; but what is that to you?"
+
+"He is not a friend of ours," Flash said quietly; "quite the contrary.
+We have known him when he was not got up like this, and we are rather
+curious to know what he is doing here."
+
+"Do you mean that?"
+
+"I do; I owe the fellow a grudge."
+
+"So do I," the man growled. "Just step up this next turning; there won't
+be anyone about there. Now, then, what do yer want to know?"
+
+"I want to know who he is."
+
+"Well, he calls himself a hawker; but my idea of him is he is one of the
+fancy, perhaps a west countryman, who is keeping dark here till he can
+get a match on. I have been a prize fighter myself, but he knocked me
+out in three rounds the other day."
+
+"Well, the last time I saw him," Flash said, "he was dressed as a swell.
+My idea of him is, he is a Bow Street runner, and he is got up like this
+to lay his hands on some of the fellows down here."
+
+"You don't mean it!" the man said with a deep oath. "Then I can tell you
+he has come to the wrong shop. I have only got to whisper it about, and
+his life would not be worth an hour's purchase. I had meant to stick
+a knife in him on the first opportunity, but this will save me the
+trouble."
+
+"Well, you can have your revenge and five guineas besides," Flash said.
+"But we must be there at the time. I should like him to know that I was
+at the bottom of his being caught."
+
+They stood talking together for a few minutes, and then separated, Flash
+and his companion going back to a quiet lodging they had taken until
+they could finish their arrangements for disposing of their furniture
+and belongings before going abroad, while at the same time they finished
+plucking a country greenhorn they had met at a coffee house. Two days
+later, wrapped up in great coats, and with rough caps pulled down over
+their eyes, they entered the thieves' resort half an hour before Mark's
+usual time of getting there. A larger number of men than usual were
+assembled, and among them was Black Jim. The men were all talking
+excitedly, and were evidently furious at the news that the pugilist had
+just told them.
+
+"Those are the gents that have given me the office," he said, as Flash
+and his companion entered. "They can tell yer he is one of that cursed
+Bow Street lot."
+
+"That is right enough, my men," Flash said. "He and four of his mates
+broke into a place where we were having a bit of play, three weeks
+since, marched us all away to Bow Street, and shut the place up. I don't
+know what he is down here for, but you may be sure that it's for no good
+to some of you. We owe him a heavy one ourselves. He came spying on us
+dressed up as a swell and spoilt our game, and got the darbies put on
+us, and we have sworn to get even with him."
+
+"You will get even, don't you fear," one of the men growled, "and more
+than even, strike me blind if you don't."
+
+"Look here, lads," Flash said. "There is one thing I say--don't use your
+knives on him; remember he is a runner, and no doubt his chief knows all
+that he is doing, and no doubt ordered him to come here. There will be
+a big search, you may be sure, when he don't turn up to make his report.
+So don't let's have any bloodshed. Let the thing be done quietly."
+
+"We can chuck his body into the river," one said.
+
+"Yes, but if it is picked up with half a dozen holes in it, you may be
+sure that they will be down here, and like enough every man who has used
+this place will be arrested; you know that when there are twenty men in
+a job the chances are that one will slip his neck out of the halter by
+turning King's evidence."
+
+An angry growl went round the room.
+
+"Well, you know well enough it is so, it is always the case; besides, we
+ought to give him a little time to prepare himself. My idea is that the
+best plan will be to bind and gag him first, then we can hold a little
+court over him, and let him know what is coming. An hour later, when the
+place gets a bit quiet, we can carry him down to the river--it is not
+above fifty yards away--tie a heavy weight round his neck, cut his cords
+the last thing, and chuck him over; if his body is found, it will be
+thought it is that of some chap tired of life who took pains to drown
+himself pretty quickly, and there won't be any fuss over him, and there
+will be nothing to come upon any of you fellows for."
+
+There was a general murmur of assent. Several of those present had
+already committed themselves to some extent with the supposed hawker,
+and were as eager as Flash himself that he should be killed; still,
+all felt that it was as well that it should be managed with the least
+possible risk of discovery, for while an ordinary man could be put
+out of the way without any trouble arising, the fact that he was a Bow
+Street runner added enormously to the risk of the discovery of his fate.
+
+There was a little talk, and then two of the men went out and brought
+back a couple of strong ropes. A few minutes after their return Mark
+Thorndyke came in. He paused as he entered the room, in surprise at the
+silence that reigned, for he was accustomed to be greeted with friendly
+exclamations. However, as he walked in the door closed, and then
+suddenly, with shouts of "Down with the spy!" the men sprang from their
+seats and made a sudden rush at him. For a minute the struggle was
+tremendous; man after man went down under Mark's blows, others clung
+onto him from behind, a rope was passed round his legs and pulled, and
+he fell down with a crash, bringing down five or six of his assailants;
+a minute later he was gagged and bound.
+
+While the struggle was going on no one noticed that a Lascar's face was
+pressed against the window; it disappeared as soon as Mark fell, and
+ten minutes later a dark faced sailor ran into Gibbons'; it was a quiet
+evening at Ingleston's, and Gibbons, after smoking a pipe with half a
+dozen of the pugilists, had just returned.
+
+"Hallo," he said, as he opened the door, "what the deuce do you want?"
+
+The man was for a moment too breathless to answer.
+
+"You know Mr. Thorndyke," he said at last, in very fair English.
+
+"Yes, I know him. Well, what of him?"
+
+"He has been attacked by a number of thieves in a public house near the
+river, at Westminster, and he will be murdered unless you go with others
+to help him."
+
+"What the deuce was he doing there?" Gibbons muttered, and then, seizing
+his cap, said to the Lascar,
+
+"Come along with me; it aint likely that we shall be in time, but we
+will try, anyhow."
+
+He ran to Ingleston's.
+
+"Come along, Ingleston," he exclaimed, "and all of you. You all know
+Mr. Thorndyke. This man says he has been attacked by a gang down at
+Westminster, and will be murdered. I am afraid we shan't be in time, but
+it is worth trying."
+
+The prize fighters all leaped to their feet. Mark had sparred with
+several of them, and, being open handed and friendly, was generally
+liked. In a moment, headed by Ingleston and Gibbons, they started at the
+top of their speed, and in less than a quarter of an hour were at bank
+side.
+
+"That is the house," the sailor said, pointing to the public, where a
+red blind had been lowered at the window, and two men lounged outside
+the door to tell any chance customer that might come along he was not
+wanted there at present.
+
+Inside a mock trial had been going on, and Mark had been sentenced to
+death as a spy, not a voice being raised in his defense. As soon as he
+had been lifted up and seated so that he could see the faces of those
+present, he recognized the two gamblers, and saw at once that his fate
+was sealed; even had they not been there the chance of escape would have
+been small. The fact that one of the detectives had been caught under
+circumstances when there was but slight chance of its ever being known
+how he came to his end, was in itself sufficient to doom him. Several
+of the men present had taken him into their confidence, and he had
+encouraged them to do so, not that he wanted to entrap them, or that he
+intended to do so, but in order to obtain a clew through them as to the
+hiding place of the man he was in search of.
+
+The savage exultation on the faces of the two gamblers, however, was
+sufficient to extinguish any ray of hope. He felt sure at once that they
+had been the authors of his seizure, and that no thought of mercy would
+enter the minds of these two scoundrels whose plans he had frustrated,
+whose position he had demolished, and to whom he had caused the loss of
+a large sum of money. Neither Flash nor Emerson would have taken share
+in a crime known to so many had they not been on the point of leaving
+England. Their names were known to no one there, and even should some of
+these afterwards peach they would at least be safe. Mark had been asked
+whether he could deny that he was a member of the detective force, and
+had shaken his head. Even if he had told a lie, which he would not do,
+the lie would have been a useless one. No one would have believed it,
+for the two gamblers would have been witnesses that he was so.
+
+He had been placed in one corner of the room, so that what light there
+was would not fall on his face, and had anyone entered they would not
+have noticed that he was gagged. One, indeed, had suggested that it
+would be better to lay him under one of the benches, but Black Jim said,
+with a brutal laugh:
+
+"No, no; it is better that we should keep sight of him, and if anyone
+asks a question of course we can say that the gentleman has the
+toothache."
+
+Presently Flash spoke to the ruffian in a low voice.
+
+"Yes, I think you are right," he replied. "Look here," he went on,
+raising his voice. "There is no occasion to have such a lot in this
+business; Jake Watson, Bill the Tinker, and me are quite enough to carry
+him to his bed. I reckon the rest had better make themselves scarce when
+the times comes, go home, and keep their mouths shut. I need not say
+that anyone who lets his tongue wag about it is likely to come to a
+worse end than this bloodhound. We will have another glass of grog
+before you turn out; the streets won't be quiet for another hour
+yet, and there is another guinea of this worthy hawker's to be spent.
+Summers, make another big bowl of punch. Don't put so much water in it
+as you did in the last."
+
+The landlord, a notorious ruffian, was just coming into the room with a
+huge bowl when there was the sound of a scuffle outside.
+
+"You had better see what is up," Black Jim said, and two of the men
+nearest the door unbarred and opened it. As they did so there was a
+rush, and eight powerful men ran in, knocking to the floor those who had
+opened the door. The rest sprang to their feet; Gibbons looked round,
+and as his eye fell upon Mark, who had, the moment the men inside rose,
+got into a standing position, Gibbons launched himself towards him,
+striking four of the ruffians who endeavored to stop him to the ground
+with his crushing blows.
+
+"This way," he shouted to his friends. "Ingleston and Tring, do you keep
+the door."
+
+The moment the six men had closed round Mark, one of them, taking
+out his knife, cut the cords, removed the bandage from his mouth, and
+extricated the gag. The name of the two prize fighters had created
+something like a panic among the crowd, which had increased when one of
+them shouted, "It is Charley Gibbons."
+
+Flash and Emerson sprang to their feet with the rest, and the latter
+shouted, "Go at them, men; there are only eight of them, and we are
+twenty. Knife them, or you will all hang for this job."
+
+The knowledge of their danger was evident to all the men, and, nerved by
+desperation, they rushed at the prize fighters; but the eight were now
+nine, and each of them in a fray of this kind was equal to half a dozen
+ordinary men. Scarce a word was spoken, but the sound of crushing blows
+and scuffling, and an occasional, oath, made a confused din in the half
+lighted room. Mark burst his way through his assailants to the spot
+where Flash and Emerson were standing, somewhat in the rear of the
+crowd, for they had been sitting at the other end of the room. Flash had
+a pistol in his hand, but the man who was standing in front of him was
+struck with such violence that he fell backwards, knocking Emerson
+to the ground and almost upsetting Flash, and before the latter could
+steady himself Mark struck him with all his force under the chin. A
+moment later the landlord blew out the two candles, and in the darkness
+the ruffians made a dash for the door, carried Tring and Ingleston off
+their feet, and rushed out into the lane.
+
+"If the man who blew those candles out don't light them again at once,"
+Gibbons shouted, "I, Charley Gibbons, tell him that I will smash him and
+burn this place over his head; he had best be quick about it."
+
+The landlord, cowed with the threat, soon returned with a candle from
+the kitchen, and lit those that he had extinguished.
+
+"Well, Mr. Thorndyke, we just arrived in time, I fancy," Gibbons said.
+
+"You have saved my life, Gibbons--you and the others. How you got to
+know that I was here I cannot imagine. I would have been a dead man
+in another half hour if you had not arrived. I thank you all from the
+bottom of my heart."
+
+"That is all right, sir," Gibbons said. "It is a pleasure to give such
+scoundrels as these a lesson. Is anyone hurt? I fancy I have got a
+scratch or two."
+
+Several of the men had been cut with knives, but the blows had been
+given so hurriedly that no one was seriously injured. Twelve men lay on
+the ground.
+
+"Now sir, what shall we do with these fellows?"
+
+"I should say we had better leave them alone, Gibbons. I don't want any
+row over the affair. It is the work of these two fellows here. I think I
+pretty well settled one of them."
+
+Gibbons stooped over Flash.
+
+"You have broken his jaw, sir; but he will come round in time. I believe
+this other fellow is only shamming. I don't see any of our handiwork
+upon his face. The others have all got as much as they want, I think,"
+and taking a candle he looked at their faces. "There is not one of them
+who will want to show up for a week or so," he said, "and there are two
+or three who will carry the marks to their graves. Well, sir, if you
+don't want anything done to them, the sooner we are off the better.
+Those fellows who got away may bring a lot of others down upon us. As
+long as it is only fists, we could march through Westminster; but as
+they would have knives, it is just as well to get out of it before there
+is any trouble. You are got up in a rum way, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"Yes; I will tell you about it afterwards. I agree with you that we had
+best be moving at once."
+
+But the men who had fled were too glad to have made their escape to
+think of anything but to make for their dens as quick as possible,
+and the party passed through the lanes into the open space in front of
+Parliament House without interruption.
+
+"We will go up to your place, Ingleston, and talk it over there," Mark
+said. "You can get those cuts bound up, and I shall be very glad to
+get a drink. That thing they shoved into my mouth hurt my tongue a good
+deal, and I have not gone through a pleasant half hour, I can tell you."
+
+He walked up past Whitehall with Gibbons and Ingleston, the others
+going in pairs, so as not to attract attention. As soon as they reached
+Ingleston's place, the latter told the man in the bar to put the
+shutters up, led the way into the bar parlor, and mixed a large bowl of
+punch.
+
+"Now, Gibbons, in the first place," Mark said, after quenching his
+thirst, "how did you know of my being in danger?"
+
+"Well, sir, a black sailor chap ran into my place suddenly and told me."
+
+"Do you mean a colored man, Gibbons?"
+
+"Yes, sir, one of those Lascar chaps you see about the docks. I did not
+ask any questions, but ran as hard as I could. I had only left here five
+minutes before, and knew that Tring and some of the others would still
+be here. They did not lose a moment, and off we went. The sailor chap he
+kept ahead. I tried to come up to him two or three times to get to know
+something about it, but he always seemed to quicken his pace when I was
+coming up, and I soon got too blown to want to do much talking. He led
+us to the door, and after that I saw nothing more of him. What became
+of him I don't know. I expect he was better at running than he was at
+fighting."
+
+"It is curious," Mark said thoughtfully. "He might have been in the
+place when I went in, and slipped out while I was making a fight for it.
+I have seen a Lascar several times while I have been down there. I dare
+say it was the same man, though why he should take such trouble for the
+sake of a stranger I don't know. There seems to be a good many of them
+about, for now I think of it, I have run against them several times
+wherever I have been in town."
+
+"Now, sir, what did they want to kill you for?"
+
+"Well, Gibbons, it happened in this way. My father, you know, was
+murdered by a man who had a grudge against him, and who is both a
+highwayman and a house breaker."
+
+"They don't often go together," Ingleston said. "The highwaymen
+generally look down upon the burglars and keep themselves to
+themselves."
+
+"I hew they do, Ingleston; but this fellow has been a convict, and is
+not particular what he turns his hand to. The detectives have been
+after him for a long time, but have failed, and I determined to take the
+matter up myself, and ever since I have been up here I have been hunting
+about in the worst quarters of the town. The people of Bow Street have
+aided me in every way they could, and I suppose some of these men have
+seen me go in or out of the place. Of course, when I am going into these
+bad quarters, I put on a disguise and manage to get in with some of
+these thieves, and so to try to get news of him through them. Three
+weeks ago I decided to try Westminster. I was getting on uncommonly well
+there, principally because I gave a tremendous thrashing to a fellow
+they call Black Jim. He has been a prize fighter."
+
+"I know him," Tring said; "it was the fellow that was kicked out for
+selling a fight. He was not a bad man with his fists, either; but I
+expect you astonished him, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"Yes, I knocked him out of time in three rounds. Well, he has been a
+bully down there, and everyone was very glad he was taken down. After
+that I got to know several of the worst lot down there. They fancied
+that I was one of themselves, and several of them made proposals to me
+to join them, and, of course, I encouraged the idea in hopes of coming
+upon the man that I was after. Then some fellow in the street recognized
+me, I suppose, and denounced me to the rest as being one of the runners.
+I suppose he told them this evening, before I went in.
+
+"The place was a regular thieves' den, which, of course, was why I
+went there. Naturally they were furious, especially those who had been
+proposing to me to join them. Anyhow, they had evidently settled among
+themselves that I was to be put out of the way, and directly I went in I
+was attacked. I knocked down a few of them, but they jumped on my back,
+and one of them managed to get a rope round my legs, and down I went
+with three or four of them, and before I could get up again they had
+tied and gagged me. Then they held a sort of court. Man after man got up
+and said that I had been drawing them on to find out what they were up
+to, and had agreed to join them, of course with the intention of getting
+them caught in the act, and two got up and said that they knew me as one
+of the runners. They all agreed that I must be put out of the way.
+
+"I suppose, as the landlord did not want blood spilt in his house, they
+did not knife me at once; however, they told me that they had decided
+that as soon as the coast was clear I should be carried down to the
+river, and chucked in, with an old anchor tied to my neck. I had just
+a gleam of hope a short time before you came in, for then it had been
+settled that it was just as well no more should be engaged in the affair
+than was necessary, and that Black Jim, with two others, whom I had
+been talking to, and the two men who had told them that I was a runner,
+should manage it, and the rest were to go off to their homes.
+
+"I had been all the time trying to loosen my ropes, and had got one of
+my hands nearly free, and I thought that if they waited another half
+hour I might have got them both free, and been able to make a bit of a
+fight of it, though I had very little hope of getting my legs free.
+
+"However, I had my eye on the knife of the man who was sitting next to
+me, and who was one of those who was to stay. I thought that if I had my
+hands free, I could snatch his knife, settle him, and then cut the ropes
+from my legs; that done, I could, I think, have managed Black Jim and
+the others. As for the men who denounced me, they were small men, and I
+had no fear of them in a fight, unless; as I thought likely enough, they
+might have pistols. One of them is the fellow whose jaw I broke; I hit
+him hard, for he had a pistol in his hand."
+
+"There is no doubt you hit him hard," Gibbons said dryly. "He looked a
+better sort than the rest."
+
+"Yes, the fellow was a card sharper whom I once detected at cheating;
+and so was the one who was lying next to him, the man whom you said you
+thought was shamming."
+
+By this time the men's wounds were all bandaged up. Mark told them that
+he would be round there again in the morning, and hoped that they would
+all be there.
+
+"I shall go home at once, and turn in," he said. "Straining at those
+cords has taken the skin off my wrists, and I feel stiff all over; it
+will be a day or two, Gibbons, before I am able to put the gloves on
+again. I wish I could find that Lascar; I owe him a heavy debt."
+
+As Mark made his way home he thought a good deal about the colored
+sailor. If the man had been in the den the ruffians would hardly have
+ventured to have attacked him in the presence of a stranger. Of course,
+he might have been passing, and have seen the fray through the window,
+but in that case he would run to the nearest constable. How could he
+know anything about his habits, and why should he have gone to Gibbons
+for assistance? That, and the fact that he had so often observed
+Lascars in the places he had gone to, certainly looked as if he had been
+watched, and if so, it could only be connected with those diamonds. It
+was a curious thing altogether.
+
+The next morning he went early to Bow Street. As soon as the chief came
+he related the events of the previous evening, and told him that it was
+Flash and Emerson who had denounced him.
+
+"I know the place," the officer said. "It is one of the worst thieves'
+dens in London. However, it is just as well you decided not to take any
+steps. Of course, all the fellows would have sworn that they did not
+intend to do any harm, but that Flash had put them up to frightening
+you, and I doubt whether any jury would have convicted. As to the other
+men, we know that they are all thieves, and some of them worse; but the
+mere fact that they proposed to you to join in their crimes won't do,
+as no actual crime was committed. However, I shall have the gang closely
+watched, and, at any rate, you had better leave Westminster alone;
+someone else must take up the work of looking for that man you were
+on the watch for. Anyhow, you had best take a week's rest; there is
+no doubt you have had a very narrow escape. It is strange about that
+Lascar; he might not have cared for going in to take part in the fray,
+but you would have thought that he would have waited outside to get a
+reward for bringing those men to your rescue."
+
+As Mark did not care to tell about the diamonds till the time came for
+getting them, he made no reply, beyond expressing an agreement with the
+chief's surprise at the man not having remained to the end of the fray.
+On leaving Bow Street he went up to Ingleston's. The men who had rescued
+him the night before were gathered there; and he presented each of them
+with a check for twenty-five guineas.
+
+"I know very well," he said, "that you had no thought of reward when you
+hurried down to save me, but that is no reason why I should not show my
+gratitude to you for the service you have rendered me; some of you might
+very well have been seriously hurt, if not killed, by their knives. At
+any rate, I insist upon you taking it; money is always useful, you know,
+and it is not often so well earned as this."
+
+The men were greatly pleased, and Tring said:
+
+"Well, sir, if you get into another scrape you may be sure that you can
+count upon us."
+
+"I shall try and not get into any more," Mark laughed. "This has been
+a good deal more serious than I had bargained for, and I shall be very
+careful in the future."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV.
+
+
+"The burglary season seems to have recommenced in earnest," Mark's chief
+said some nine months after he had been at work. "For a time there had
+been a lull, as you know, but I have had three reports this week, and it
+strikes me that they are by the same hand as before; of course I may be
+mistaken, but they are done in a similar way, the only difference being
+that there is ground for believing that only one man is engaged in them.
+I fancy the fellow that you are after has either been away from London
+for some time, or has been keeping very quiet. At any rate, we have
+every ground for believing that he keeps himself aloof from London
+thieves, which is what I should expect from such a man. If one has nerve
+enough to do it, there is nothing like working singly; when two or
+three men are engaged, there is always the risk of one being caught
+and turning Queen's evidence, or of there being a quarrel, and of his
+peaching from revenge.
+
+"If your man has been away from town, he has certainly not been working
+any one district; of course, one gets the usual number of reports from
+different quarters; but although burglaries are frequent enough, there
+has been no complaint of a sudden increase of such crimes as there would
+have been judging from the numerous daring attempts here, had Bastow
+been concerned; therefore I feel sure that he has been living quietly.
+He would have his mate's share--that man you shot, you know--of the
+plunder they made together; he would know that after that affair at your
+place there would be a vigilant hunt for him, and it is likely enough
+that he has retired altogether from business for a time.
+
+"However, men of that sort can never stand a quiet life long, and are
+sure sooner or later to take to their trade again, if only for the sake
+of its excitement. Now that the burglaries have begun again, I shall
+be glad if you will devote yourself entirely to this business. You have
+served a good apprenticeship, and for our sake as well as yours I should
+be glad for you to have it in hand."
+
+"I shall be very pleased to do so, sir. Although we do not know where he
+is to be found, I think I can say that it is not in the slums of
+London; it seems to me that he may be quietly settled as an eminently
+respectable man almost under our noses; he may show himself occasionally
+at fashionable resorts, and may be a regular attendant at horse races.
+
+"He would not run any appreciable risk in doing so, for his face is
+quite unknown to anyone except the constables who were present at his
+trial, and even these would scarcely be likely to recognize him, for he
+was then but eighteen, while he is now six or seven and twenty, and no
+doubt the life he has led must have changed him greatly."
+
+"I quite agree with you," the chief said. "After the first hunt for him
+was over, he might do almost anything without running much risk. Well,
+I put the matter in your hands, and leave it to you to work out in your
+own way; you have given ample proof of your shrewdness and pluck, and
+in this case especially I know that you will do everything that is
+possible. Of course you will be relieved of all other duties, and if it
+takes you months before you can lay hands upon him, we shall consider it
+time well spent, if you succeed at last. From time to time change your
+quarters, but let me know your address, so that, should I learn anything
+that may be useful, I can communicate with you at once. You had better
+take another name than that by which you are known in the force. I shall
+be glad if, after thinking the matter over, you will write me a few
+lines stating what you propose to do in the first place."
+
+Mark went back to his lodgings, and sat there for some time, thinking
+matters over. His first thought was to attend the races for a time, but
+seeing the number of people there, and his own ignorance of Bastow's
+appearance, he abandoned the idea, and determined to try a slower but
+more methodical plan. After coming to that conclusion he put on his hat
+and made his way to Mrs. Cunningham's.
+
+"Well, Mr. Constable," Millicent said saucily, as he entered, "any fresh
+captures?"
+
+"No, I think that I have for the present done with that sort of thing; I
+have served my apprenticeship, and am now setting up on my own account."
+
+"How is that, Mark?"
+
+"There is reason to believe that Bastow has begun his work again near
+London. As I have told you, it is absolutely certain that he is not
+hiding in any of the places frequented by criminals here, and there
+is every reason for supposing that he has been leading a quiet life
+somewhere, or that he has been away in the country. As long as that was
+the case, there was nothing to be done; but now that he seems to have
+set to work again, it is time for me to be on the move. I have seen the
+chief this morning, and he has released me from all other' duty, and
+given me carte blanche to work in my own way."
+
+"Then why don't you leave the force altogether, Mark? You know that I
+have always thought it hateful that you should be working under orders,
+like any other constable."
+
+"Of course, women don't like to be under orders, Millicent; but men are
+not so independent, and are quite content to obey those who are well
+qualified to give orders. I have had a very interesting time of it."
+
+"Very interesting!" she said scornfully. "You have nearly been killed
+or shot half a dozen times; you have been obliged to wear all sorts of
+dirty clothes, to sleep in places where one would not put a dog, and
+generally to do all sorts of things altogether unbecoming in your
+position."
+
+"My dear, I have no particular position," he laughed, and then went on
+more seriously: "My one position at present is that of avenger of
+my father's murder, and nothing that can assist me in the task is
+unbecoming to me; but, as I said, it has been interesting, I may almost
+say fascinating, work. I used to be fond of hunting, but I can tell you
+that it is infinitely more exciting to hunt a man than it is to hunt a
+fox. You are your own hound, you have to pick up the scent, to follow
+it up, however much the quarry may wind and double, and when at last you
+lay your hand upon his shoulder and say, 'In the King's name,' there is
+an infinitely keener pleasure than there is when the hounds run down
+the fox. One sport is perhaps as dangerous as the other: in the one case
+your horse may fail at a leap and you may break your neck, in the other
+you may get a bullet in your head; so in that respect there is not much
+to choose between man and fox hunting. There is the advantage, though,
+that in the one you have to depend upon your horse's strength, and in
+the other on your own courage."
+
+"I know that you are an enthusiast over it, Mark, and I can fancy that
+if I were a big strong man, as you are, I might do the same; but if you
+are going now to try by yourself, why should you not leave the force
+altogether?"
+
+"Because, in the first place, I shall get all the information they
+obtain, and can send for any assistance that I may require. In the next
+place, by showing this little staff with its silver crown, I show that
+I am a Bow Street runner, and can obtain information at once from all
+sorts of people which I could not get without its aid."
+
+"Well, I won't say anything more against it, Mark. How are you going to
+begin?"
+
+"I mean to go the round of all the places near London--say, within ten
+miles. I shall stay from a week to a fortnight in each, take a quiet
+lodging, give out that I am on the lookout for a small house with a
+garden, and get to talk with people of all kinds."
+
+"But I cannot see what you have to inquire for."
+
+"I imagine that Bastow will have taken just the sort of house that I am
+inquiring for, and in the course of my questions I may hear of someone
+living in just that sort of way--a retired life, not making many
+friends, going up to London sometimes, and keeping, perhaps, a deaf old
+woman as a servant, or perhaps a deaf old man--someone, you see, who
+would not be likely to hear him if he came home in the middle of the
+night, or in the early morning. Once I hear of such a man, I should
+ascertain his age, and whether generally he agreed in appearance with
+what Bastow is likely to be by this time, then get down one of the
+constables who was at the trial, and take his opinion on the subject,
+after which we should only have to watch the house at night and pounce
+upon him as he came back from one of his excursions. That is the broad
+outline of my plan. I cannot help thinking that in the long run I shall
+be able to trace him, and of course it will make it all the easier if he
+takes to stopping coaches or committing murderous burglaries."
+
+"Then I suppose we are not going to see you often, Mark?"
+
+"Well, not so often as you have done, Millicent, for some time, at any
+rate. I shall not be more than five or six miles away, and I shall often
+ride into town for the evening, and return late with some sort of hope
+that I may be stopped on the road again; it would save me a world of
+trouble, you see, if he would come to me instead of my having to find
+him."
+
+"Which side of London are you going to try first?"
+
+"The south side, certainly; there are a score of places that would be
+convenient to him--Dulwich, Clapham, Tooting, Wimbledon, Stockwell; the
+list is a long one. I should say Wimbledon was about the most distant,
+and I should think that he would not go so far as that; if he only acted
+as a highwayman he might be as far off as Epsom; but if he is really the
+man concerned in these burglaries he must be but a short distance away.
+He would hardly risk having to ride very far with the chance of coming
+upon the patrols. I think that I shall begin at Peckham; that is a
+central sort of position, and from there I shall work gradually west;
+before I do so perhaps I shall try Lewisham. He is likely, in any case,
+to be quite on the outskirts of any village he may have settled in, in
+order that he may ride in and out at any hour without his coming and
+going being noticed."
+
+"You certainly seem to have thought it over in all ways, Mark; you
+almost infect me with your ardor, and make me wish that I was a man and
+could help you."
+
+"You are much nicer as you are, Millicent."
+
+The girl tossed her head in disdain at the compliment.
+
+"It is all very well, Mark," she went on, ignoring his speech, "but it
+seems to me that in finding out things a woman would be able to do
+just as much as a man; she can gossip with her neighbors and ask about
+everyone in a place quite as well, if not better, than a man."
+
+"Yes I don't doubt that," Mark laughed, "and if I want your aid I shall
+have no hesitation in asking for it. Until then I hope you will go on
+with your painting and harping steadily, like a good little girl."
+
+"I am nearly eighteen, sir, and I object to be called a good little
+girl."
+
+"Well, if I were to say a good young woman you would not like it."
+
+"No, I don't think I should. I don't know why, but when anyone says a
+girl is a good young woman or a nice young woman, there always seems
+something derogatory about it; it is almost as bad as saying she is a
+very respectable young person, which is odious."
+
+"Then, you see," he went on, "you are quite getting on in society; since
+Mr. Cotter's introduction to Mrs. Cunningham and his mother's subsequent
+call you have got to know a good many people and go about a good deal."
+
+"Yes, it has been more lively of late," she admitted. "At first it was
+certainly monstrously dull here, and I began to think that we should
+have to change our plans and go down again to Weymouth, and settle there
+for a time. Now I am getting contented; but I admit, even at the risk of
+making you conceited, that we shall certainly miss you very much, as
+you have been very good, considering how busy you have been, to come in
+three or four evenings every week for a chat."
+
+"There has been nothing very good about it, Millicent; it has been very
+pleasant to me; it is like a bit of old times again when I am here with
+you two, and seem to leave all the excitement of one's work behind as I
+come in at the door."
+
+"I wonder whether the old time will ever come back again, Mark?" she
+said sadly.
+
+"It never can be quite the old time again, but when you are back at the
+old place it may be very near it."
+
+She looked at him reproachfully.
+
+"You think that I shall change my mind, Mark, but at heart you know
+better. The day I am one and twenty I hope to carry out my intentions."
+
+"Well, as I have told you before, Millicent, I cannot control your
+actions, but I am at least master of my own. You can give away Crowswood
+to whom you like, but at least you cannot compel me to take it. Make it
+over to one of the hospitals if you like--that is within your power; but
+it is not in your power to force me into the mean action of enriching
+myself because you have romantic notions in your mind. I should scorn
+myself were I capable of doing such an action. I wonder you think so
+meanly of me as to suppose for a moment that I would do so."
+
+"It is a great pity my father did not leave the property outright to
+your father, then all this bother would have been avoided," she said
+quietly. "I should still have had plenty to live upon without there
+being any fear of being loved merely for my money."
+
+"It would have been the same thing if he had," Mark said stubbornly.
+"My father would not have taken it, and I am sure that I should not have
+taken it after him; you are his proper heiress. I don't say if he had
+left a son, and that son had been a second Bastow, that one would have
+hesitated, for he would probably have gambled it away in a year, the
+tenants might have been ruined, and the village gone to the dogs.
+Every man has a right to disinherit an unworthy son, but that is a very
+different thing from disinheriting a daughter simply from a whim. Well,
+don't let us talk about it any more, Millicent. It is the only thing
+that we don't agree about, and therefore it is best left alone."
+
+The next day Mark established himself at an inn in Peckham, and for six
+weeks made diligent inquiries, but without success. There were at least
+a dozen men who lived quietly and rode or drove to their business in
+town. Many of them were put aside as needing no investigation, having
+been residents there for years. Some of the others he saw start or
+return, but none of them corresponded in any way with the probable
+appearance of the man for whom he was in search. During this time he
+heard of several private coaches being held up on the road between Epsom
+and London, and three burglaries took place at Streatham.
+
+He then moved to Stockwell. Before proceeding there he had his horse
+up again from Crowswood, and rode into Stockwell from the west. He was
+dressed now as a small country squire, and had a valise strapped behind
+his saddle. The inn there was a busy one.
+
+"I want a room," he said, as he alighted. "I shall probably stay here a
+few days."
+
+Presently he had a talk with the landlord.
+
+"I am on the lookout," he said, "for a little place near town. I have
+come in for a small estate in the country, but I have no taste for
+farming, and want to be within easy reach of town, and at the same
+time to have a place with a paddock where I can keep my horse and live
+quietly. I don't much care whether it is here or anywhere else within
+a few miles of town, and I intend to ride about and see if I can find a
+place that will suit me. I do not want to be nearer the town than this,
+for I have not money enough to go the pace; still, I should like to be
+near enough to ride or walk in whenever I have a fancy for it."
+
+"I understand, sir. Of course there are plenty of places round here,
+at Clapham and Tooting, and I may say Streatham, but most of them are
+a deal too large for a bachelor, still I have no doubt you would find a
+place to suit you without much difficulty. These sort of places are most
+in request by London tradesmen who have given up business and want to
+get a little way out of town and keep a gig. I should say there must be
+a score of such people living round here. I am often asked about such
+places, but I don't know of one to let just at the present moment.
+
+"Still, there ought to be, for of late people have not cared so much
+to come out here; there has been such a scare owing to highwaymen and
+burglars, that men with wives and families don't fancy settling out of
+town, though there aint much work about it, for to every one house that
+is broken into there are thousands that are not, and besides, the houses
+that these fellows try are large places, where there is plenty of silver
+plate and a few gold watches, and perhaps some money to be had."
+
+Mark soon made the acquaintance of the stablemen, and a few pints of
+beer put them on good terms with him. Every day he took rides round the
+neighborhood, going out early, stabling his horse, and after having a
+chat with the ostlers, strolling round the place. Clapham, Ewell, and
+Streatham were also visited.
+
+"I know of a place that would just suit you," the ostler at the
+Greyhound at Streatham said to him, on the occasion of his third visit
+there; "but it is let; my old mother is the gentleman's housekeeper.
+He took the place through me, for he rode up just as you have done, one
+afternoon, nigh a year ago. He was from town, he was; he told me that
+he had been going the pace too hard, and had to pull in, and wanted a
+little place where he could keep his horse and live quiet for a time. I
+told him of a place that I thought would suit him just outside the town,
+and he called in the next day and told me he had taken it. 'Now,' he
+said, 'I want a woman as house keeper; an old woman, you know. I cannot
+be bothered with a young one. If you speak a civil word to a wench she
+soon fancies you are in love with her. I want one who can cook a chop or
+a steak, fry me a bit of bacon, and boil an egg and keep the place tidy.
+I intend to look after my horse myself.'
+
+"'Well, sir,' I said, 'there is my old mother. She is a widow, and it
+is as much as she can do to keep off the parish. She is reckoned a tidy
+cook and a good cleaner, and she could keep herself well enough if it
+wasn't that she is so hard of hearing that many people don't care to
+employ her.'
+
+"'I don't care a rap about that,' he said. 'I shall not need to talk to
+her except to tell her what I will have for dinner, and if she is deaf
+she won't want to be away gossiping. Does she live near here?'
+
+"'She lives in the town,' I said. 'I can fetch her down in half an
+hour.'
+
+"'That will do,' says he. 'I am going to have lunch. When I have, done I
+will come out and speak with her.'
+
+"Well, sir, he engaged her right off, and he tipped me a guinea for
+finding the place for him, and there he has been ever since. It was a
+lucky job for mother, for she says there never was a gentleman that gave
+less trouble. He is a wonderful quiet man, and in general stops at home
+all the day smoking and reading. He has a boy comes in two or three
+times a week to work in the garden. Sometimes of an evening he rides up
+to town. I expect he cannot keep away from the cards altogether."
+
+"Is he an elderly man?" Mark asked.
+
+"Lor', no, sir; under thirty, I should say. He is a free handed sort of
+chap, and though he aint particular about his eating, he likes a bottle
+of good wine, the old woman says, even if it is only with a chop. He
+never rides past here and I happen to be outside without tossing me a
+shilling to drink his health."
+
+Mark went into the house and ordered lunch. It would not have done to
+have asked any more questions or to have shown any special interest in
+the matter, but he felt so excited that he could not have avoided doing
+so had he waited longer with the ostler. After he had finished his meal
+he strolled out again into the stable yard.
+
+"Well," he said to the ostler, "can't you put me up to another good
+thing, just as you told that gentleman you were speaking to me about?"
+
+"There are two or three places that I know of that might suit you, sir.
+There is a house on the hill. I know that it has got a paddock, but I
+don't know how big it is; it is in general known as Hawleys--that is the
+name of the last people who lived there. Anyone will tell you which is
+the house. Then there is another place. You turn to the right the third
+turning on the hill; it stands by itself two or three hundred yards
+down; it has got a goodish bit of ground. There is only one house beyond
+it; that is the one where my mother lives. That was an old farm once,
+but this was built later. I believe the ground belonged to the farm. You
+will know it by a big tree in front of it; it stands back forty feet or
+so from the road."
+
+"Where does the road lead to?"
+
+"Well, sir, it aint much of a road beyond the next house; it is only
+a lane, but you can get through that way into the main road, through
+Tooting down into Balham, and on to Wimbledon."
+
+"'I think I will go and have a look at both those places," Mark said.
+
+"Will you take your horse, sir?"
+
+"No; I suppose it is not much above half a mile?"
+
+"About that, sir."
+
+"Then I will walk; I shall not be likely to find anyone to hold my horse
+there."
+
+Mark had no difficulty in finding the house. It looked as if it had been
+untenanted for some time, and in the window was a notice that for keys
+and information applications were to be made at a shop in the High
+Street. Well pleased to find that there was no one in the house, Mark
+entered the gate and passed round into what at one time had been a
+kitchen garden behind it; at the bottom of this was a field of three or
+four acres.
+
+The ground was separated by a hedge from that of the house beyond. This
+was fully a hundred yards away. A well bred horse was grazing in the
+field, a man smoking a pipe was watching a boy doing gardening work
+behind the house. Mark remained for nearly an hour concealed behind
+the hedge in hopes that he would come nearer. At the end of that time,
+however, he went into the house, and after waiting another ten minutes
+Mark also left, resisting the temptation to walk along the road and take
+a closer look at it, for he felt that such a step would be dangerous,
+for should the man notice anyone looking at the place his suspicions
+might be aroused.
+
+It was evident that the lane was very little used; in many cases the
+grass grew across it. There were marks of horses' feet, but none of
+wheels, and he concluded that when going up to town the man came that
+way and rode quietly through Streatham, for the hoof prints all pointed
+in that direction, and that on his return at night he came up the lane
+from the other road.
+
+"Well, master, what do you think of the houses?" the ostler asked on his
+return to the inn.
+
+"I have only been to the one in the lane that you spoke of, for I want
+to get back to town. I had a good look at it, but it is rather a dreary
+looking place, and evidently wants a lot of repairs before it can
+be made comfortable. The next time that I am down I will look at the
+other."
+
+Mounting his horse, he rode at a rapid pace into London, and dismounted
+at Bow Street.
+
+"You have news, I see, Mr. Thorndyke," the chief said when he entered.
+
+"I have, sir; I believe that I have marked the man down; at any rate, if
+it is not he, it is a criminal of some sort--of that I have no doubt."
+
+"That is good news indeed," the chief said. "Now tell me all about it."
+
+Mark repeated the story the ostler had told him, and the result of his
+own observations.
+
+"You see," he said, "the man, whether Bastow or not, has clearly taken
+the place for the purpose of concealment, for he can approach it by
+the lane, which is a very unfrequented one, on his return from his
+expeditions. He has taken on a deaf old woman who will not hear him ride
+in at night, and will have no idea at what hours he comes home. Riding
+out through the main street in the afternoon he would excite no notice,
+and the story to the ostler would very well account for his taking the
+house and for his habit of coming up here of an afternoon and returning
+late. I thought it best to come back and tell you, and I will adopt any
+plan that you suggest for his capture."
+
+"You say that he has been there for nearly a year?"
+
+"About a year, the ostler said."
+
+"Then one of my men, at least, must have been very careless not to
+have found him out long ago. Let me see;" and he took down a volume of
+reports. "Streatham. Tomlinson has been here a fortnight making every
+inquiry. 'No man of suspicious appearance or of unknown antecedents
+here.'
+
+"Humph! That is not the first time that Tomlinson has failed altogether
+in his duty. However, that does not matter for the moment. What is your
+own idea, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"My idea is that a couple of good men should go down with me to
+Streatham, and that we should be always on the watch in High Street
+until we see him ride past. Directly it is dark we will go to his house,
+fasten the old woman up, and search it thoroughly. If we find stolen
+property so much the better; but in any case we shall wait inside the
+house until he returns, and as he comes in throw ourselves upon him
+before he has time to draw a pistol. I should say it would be as well
+the men should go down in a trap. There is an empty house next door, and
+when we go to search the place we can leave the horse and trap inside
+the gate. Directly we have him secure we can fetch up the trap, put him
+in, and one of the men and myself can drive him back here, leaving the
+other in charge of the house, which can then be searched again next
+day."
+
+"I think that will be a very good plan, and will avoid all unnecessary
+fuss. I will send Malcolm and Chester down with you tomorrow. Where will
+you meet them?"
+
+"I should say that they had better put up at the Greyhound. I don't
+suppose he will go out until six or seven o'clock, but they had better
+be there earlier. One should station himself in the main street, the
+other concealing himself somewhere beyond the fellow's house, for it is
+likely enough that sometimes he may take the other way. I will go down
+to the Greyhound at six, and will wait there until one of them brings me
+news that he has left."
+
+"I think you had better come in in the morning, and give your
+instructions to the men; there will be less fear of any mistake being
+made. I should say you had better put your horse up and come here on
+foot; one can never be too careful when one is dealing with so crafty
+a rogue as this; he certainly does not work with an accomplice, but for
+all that he may have two or three sharp boys in his pay, and they may
+watch this place by turns and carry him news of any stir about the
+office."
+
+"I will walk in," Mark replied. "It is no distance from Stockwell."
+
+Mark slept but little that night. He had believed all along that he
+should be finally successful, but the discovery had come so suddenly
+that it had taken him completely by surprise. It might not be the man,
+and he tried hard to persuade himself that the chances were against his
+being so, so that he should not feel disappointed should it turn out
+that it was some other criminal, for that the man was a criminal he had
+not a shadow of doubt.
+
+The next morning he was at the office early. The chief arrived half an
+hour later, and the two officers were at once called in.
+
+"You will go with Mr. Thorndyke," the chief said, "and he will give you
+instructions. The capture is a very important one, and there must be no
+mistake made. We believe the man to be Bastow. I think you were present
+at his trial, Chester; he escaped from Sydney Convict Prison some
+three years ago, and is, I believe, the author of many of the highway
+robberies and burglaries that have puzzled us so. Of course, you will
+take firearms, but if he is alone you will certainly have no occasion
+to use them, especially as you will take him completely by surprise.
+You will order a gig from Morden, and leave here about three o'clock. I
+should say you had better get up as two countrymen who have been up
+to market. However, Mr. Thorndyke will explain the whole matter to you
+fully."
+
+Mark then went off with the two officers to a private room, and went
+into the whole matter with them.
+
+"I think, Chester," he said, "that you had better watch in the High
+Street, because you know the man. At least, you have seen him, and may
+recognize him again."
+
+"I think I should know him, however much he has changed. I took
+particular notice of him at the trial, and thought what a hardened
+looking young scamp he was. It is very seldom I forget a face when once
+I have a thorough look at it, and I don't think I am likely to forget
+his."
+
+"Malcolm, I think you cannot do better than take your place in the
+garden of the house next to his; it is a place that has stood empty for
+many months, and there is no chance of anyone seeing you. His paddock
+comes up to the garden, and you can, by placing yourself in the corner,
+see him as he comes out into the lane. As soon as you see that he has
+gone, come back to the Greyhound with the news. I shall be there, and
+you will pick up Chester in the High Street as you come along; of course
+you won't pretend to know me, but the mere fact of your coming back will
+be enough to tell me that he has gone. As soon as it gets dark we will
+pay our reckoning, and drive off in the gig, leaving it in the drive in
+front of the house this side of his. I shall have strolled off before,
+and shall be waiting for you there. If he does not come out by ten
+o'clock we can give it up for tonight. You had better say that you have
+changed your mind, and will take beds at the Greyhound; and the next
+morning drive off in your gig and put up again at the inn at the other
+end of the town, the White Horse. I will come over again at two o'clock
+in the afternoon. You will bring handcuffs, and you had better also
+bring a stout rope to tie him with."
+
+When every detail had been arranged, Mark strolled to Dick Chetwynd's
+lodgings.
+
+"Well, Mark what has become of you? I have not seen you for the last two
+months, and I hear that you have not been near Ingleston's crib since I
+saw you."
+
+"No, I have been away on business. You know I told you that I was
+spending much of my time in endeavoring to hunt down my father's
+murderer. I can tell you now that I have been working all the time with
+the Bow Street people, and I think I know every thieves' slum in London
+as well as any constable in the town."
+
+"You don't say so, Mark! Well, I should not like such work as that. The
+prize fighters are a pretty rough lot, but to go to such dens as those
+is enough to make one shudder. But that does not explain where you have
+been now."
+
+"No. Well, having persuaded myself at last that his headquarters were
+not in town, I have been trying the villages round, and I believe that I
+have laid my hands on him at last."
+
+"You don't say so, Mark! Well, I congratulate you heartily, both on your
+having caught the fellow and for having got rid of such horrid work.
+Where is he? Have you got him lodged in jail?"
+
+"No, we are going to capture him tonight; or if not tonight, tomorrow
+night. Two of the Bow Street officers are going down with me, and we
+shall have him as he comes home from one of his expeditions either on
+the highway or as a house breaker. If he does not go this evening we
+shall wait until tomorrow, but at any rate, the first time that he goes
+out we shall have him."
+
+"I have got a special engagement for this evening, Mark, or I would
+offer to go with you and lend you a hand, if necessary."
+
+"There is no occasion for that, Dick. We shall take the fellow by
+surprise as he goes into his own house, and have him handcuffed before
+he can draw a pistol. Then, when we have got him fairly tied up, we
+shall put him into a light cart that we shall have handy, and bring him
+straight to Bow Street. To tell you the truth, I am so excited over the
+thought that I do not know how I should have got through the day if I
+had not come in to have a chat with you."
+
+"I can quite understand that, old fellow. Well, the best thing we can do
+is to take a stroll out and look at the fashions. It is early yet, but
+just at present it is all the rage to turn out early. It will do me
+good too, for I was at Ingleston's last night, and the smoke and row has
+given me a headache. I shall really have to give up going there, except
+when there is an important fight on. It is too much to stand, and the
+tobacco is so bad that I am obliged to keep a suit of clothes for the
+purpose. Let us be off at once."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI.
+
+
+At four o'clock Mark put up his horse at the Greyhound, and chatted for
+a quarter of an hour with the ostler, who had been making inquiries,
+and had heard of one or two other houses in the neighborhood which were
+untenanted. Mark then strolled up the town, exchanging a passing
+glance with Chester, who, in a velveteen coat, low hat and gaiters, was
+chatting with a wagoner going with a load of hay for the next morning's
+market in London. He turned into an inn, called for a pint of the best
+port, and sat down in the parlor at a table close to the window, so that
+he could see all who went up or down. He entered into conversation with
+two or three people who came in, and so passed the time till seven, when
+he felt too restless to sit still longer, and went out into the street.
+
+When he was halfway to the Greyhound he heard the sound of a horse's
+hoofs behind him, and saw a quietly dressed man coming along at an easy
+trot. Had it not been that he recognized the horse, he could not have
+felt sure that its rider was the man whose coming he had been waiting
+for, there being nothing in his appearance that would excite the
+slightest suspicion that he was other than a gentleman of moderate means
+and quiet taste, either returning from a ride or passing through on his
+way to town. He had a well built and active figure, carried himself with
+the ease of a thorough horseman, and nodded to one or two persons of his
+acquaintance, and checking his horse at the principal butcher's, ordered
+some meat to be sent in that evening.
+
+Mark could trace no resemblance in the face to that of the young fellow
+he remembered. It was a quiet and resolute one. If this were Bastow,
+he had lost the sneering and insolent expression that was so strongly
+impressed on his memory. It might be the man, but if so, he was greatly
+changed. Mark's first impression was that it could not be Bastow; but
+when he thought over the years of toil and confinement in the convict
+prison, the life he had led in the bush, and the two years he had passed
+since he returned home, he imagined that the insolence of youth might
+well have disappeared, and been succeeded by the resolute daring and
+dogged determination that seemed to be impressed on this fellow's face.
+
+Mark paused fifty yards before he reached the inn. In a few minutes he
+saw Chester coming along. There was no one else in sight.
+
+"Is it Bastow?" he asked, as the officer came up.
+
+"It's Bastow sure enough, sir. But he is so changed that if I had not
+had him in my mind I should not have recognized him. I calculate that a
+man who has gone through what he has would have lost the expression he
+had as a boy. He must have learnt a lot in the convict prison, and
+the fact that he headed the mutiny and escaped from the searchers and
+managed to get home showed that he must have become a resolute and
+desperate man. All those burglaries, and the way in which he has several
+times stopped coaches single handed, show his nerve and coolness. I had
+all that in my mind as he came along, and his face was pretty much as I
+expected to see it. He is a cool hand, and I can understand how he has
+given us the slip so long. There is none of the shifty look about his
+eyes that one generally sees in criminals, no glancing from side to
+side; he rode with the air of a man who had a right to be where he was,
+and feared no one. He will be an awkward customer to tackle if we do not
+take him by surprise."
+
+"Yes, I agree with you there. However, he won't have much chance of
+using either his pistols or his strength. Here is Malcolm coming, so I
+will walk away for a few minutes, and let you go in first. You can tell
+the ostler now that you will have your horse put in at nine o'clock. I
+have been thinking, by the way, that we had better take the trap round
+behind the house instead of leaving it in the drive. The man may come
+back this way, and if so, he might hear the horse stamp or make some
+movement, and that would at once put him on his guard."
+
+As the officers entered the inn Mark went into the yard and told the
+ostler that he had met some friends, and should let his horse remain
+there for the night.
+
+"It is possible that they may drive me into the town in the morning," he
+said; "and I shall very likely send a man down for the horse."
+
+At a quarter to nine he went out again, and walked to the house he had
+before visited; in ten minutes he heard the sound of wheels, threw open
+the gate, and the men, jumping down, led the horse in.
+
+"You may as well take him out of the trap," he said. "We cannot very
+well get that round the house, but there is no difficulty about taking
+the horse."
+
+The officers had brought a halter and a nosebag full of corn. The horse
+was fastened to a tree with soft ground round it, the nosebag put on,
+and a horse cloth thrown over its back; then Mark and his two companions
+went out into the lane, and in a couple of minutes entered the next
+gate, treading lightly, and going round to the back of the house.
+
+A light burned in the kitchen, and an old woman could be seen knitting.
+They lifted the latch and walked in. Dropping her knitting, she rose
+with an exclamation of terror.
+
+Mark advanced alone.
+
+"Do not be frightened," he said; "we are not going to do you any harm."
+He took out his little ebony staff. "We are constables," he went on,
+"and have orders to search this house. We must secure you, but you will
+be released in the morning. Now, which is your room?"
+
+In spite of Mark's assurance, the old woman was almost paralyzed with
+terror. However, the two constables assisted her up to her room, and
+there secured her with a rope, taking care that it was not so tightly
+bound as to hurt her. Then they placed a gag in her mouth, and left her.
+
+"Now let us search his room in the first place," Mark said, when they
+came downstairs again. "I hardly expect we shall find anything. You may
+be sure that he will have taken great pains to hide away any booty that
+he may have here, and that it will need daylight and a closer search
+than we can give the place now, before we find anything."
+
+The search of the house was indeed fruitless. They cut open the bed,
+prized up every loose board in the bedroom and the parlor, lifted the
+hearth stone, tapped the walls, and searched every drawer; then, taking
+a lantern, went out into the stable. The officers were both accustomed
+to look for hiding places, and ran their hands along on the top of the
+walls, examining the stone flooring and manger.
+
+"That is a very large corn bin," Mark said, as he looked round, when
+they desisted from the search.
+
+"You are right, sir. We will empty it."
+
+There were two or three empty sacks on the ground near it, and they
+emptied the corn into these, so that there should be no litter about.
+Chester gave an exclamation of disappointment as they reached the
+bottom. Mark put his hand on the bin and gave it a pull.
+
+"It is just as I thought," he said. "It is fastened down. I saw an ax in
+the woodshed, Malcolm; just fetch it here."
+
+While the man was away Mark took the lantern and examined the bottom
+closely. "We shan't want the ax," he said, as he pointed out to Chester
+a piece of string that was apparently jammed in the form of a loop
+between the bottom and side. "Just get in and clear those few handfuls
+of corn out. I think you will see that it will pull up then."
+
+There was, however, no movement in the bottom when Mark pulled at the
+loop.
+
+"Look closely round outside," he said, handing Malcolm, who had
+now returned, the lantern. "I have no doubt that there is a catch
+somewhere."
+
+In a minute or two the constable found a small ring between two of the
+cobblestones close to the foot of the wall. He pulled at it, and as
+he did so Mark felt the resistance to his pull cease suddenly, and the
+bottom of the bin came up like a trapdoor.
+
+"That is a clever hiding place," he said. "If I had not happened to
+notice that the bin was fixed we might have had a long search before we
+found it here."
+
+Below was a square hole, the size of the bin; a ladder led down into it.
+Mark, with a lantern, descended. Four or five sacks piled on each other
+lay at the bottom, leaving just room enough for a man to stand beside
+them.
+
+"The top one is silver by the feel," he said, "not yet broken up; these
+smaller sacks are solid. I suppose it is silver that has been melted
+down. This--" and he lifted a bag some eighteen inches deep, opened it,
+and looked in "--contains watches and jewels. Now I think we will leave
+things here for the present, and put everything straight. He may be back
+before long."
+
+Mark ascended, the bottom of the trap was shut down again, the corn
+poured in, and the bags thrown down on the spot from which they had been
+taken. They returned to the house, shut the door, and extinguished the
+light.
+
+"That has been a grand find," he said; "even if this is not Bastow, it
+will be a valuable capture."
+
+"That it will, Mr. Thorndyke. I have no doubt that this fellow is
+the man we have been in search of for the last eighteen months; that
+accounts for our difficulty in laying hold of him. He has been too
+crafty to try to sell any of his plunder, so that none of the fences
+have known anything about him. No doubt he has taken sufficient cash to
+enable him to live here quietly. He intended some time or other to melt
+down all the rest of the plate and to sell the silver, which he could do
+easily enough. As for the watches and jewels, he could get rid of them
+abroad."
+
+"No doubt that is what he intended," Mark agreed. "It is not often these
+fellows are as prudent as he has been; if they were, your work would be
+a good deal more difficult than it is."
+
+"You are right, sir; I don't know that I ever heard of such a case
+before. The fellow almost deserves to get away."
+
+"That would be rewarding him too highly for his caution," Mark laughed.
+"He is a desperate villain, and all the more dangerous for being a
+prudent one. Now, I think one of us had better keep watch at the gate by
+turns. We shall hear him coming in plenty of time to get back here and
+be in readiness for him. We must each understand our part thoroughly.
+I will stand facing the door. It is possible that he may light that
+lantern we saw hanging in the stable, but I don't think it likely he
+will do so; he will take off the saddle, and either take the horse in
+there--there is plenty of food in the manger--or else turn it out into
+the paddock. As he comes in I will throw my arms round him and you will
+at once close in, one on each side, each catch an arm tightly, handcuff
+him, and take the pistols from his belt. Don't leave go of his arms
+until I have lit the candle; he may have another pistol inside his coat,
+and might draw it."
+
+It was now one o'clock, and half an hour later Malcolm, who was at the
+gate, came in quietly and said he could hear a horse coming along the
+lane.
+
+"Which way, Malcolm?"
+
+"Tooting way."
+
+"That is all right. I have been a little nervous lest if he came
+the other way our horse might make some slight noise and attract his
+attention; that was our only weak point."
+
+They had already ascertained that the front door was locked and bolted,
+and that he must therefore enter through the kitchen. They heard the
+horse stop in front, a moment later the gate was opened, and through
+the window they could just make out the figure of a man leading a horse;
+then the stable door opened, and they heard a movement, and knew that
+the horse was being unsaddled; they heard it walk into the stable, the
+door was shut behind it, and a step approached the back door. It was
+opened, and a voice said with an oath, "The old fool has forgotten to
+leave a candle burning;" then he stepped into the kitchen.
+
+In an instant there was a sound of a violent struggle, deep oaths and
+curses, two sharp clicks, then all was quiet except heavy breathing and
+the striking of flint on a tinderbox; there was the blue glare of the
+sulphur match, and a candle was lighted. Mark then turned to the man who
+was standing still grasped in the hands of his two captors.
+
+"Arthur Bastow," he said, producing his staff, "I arrest you in the
+King's name, as an escaped convict, as a notorious highwayman and house
+breaker."
+
+As his name was spoken the man started, then he said quietly:
+
+"You have made a mistake this time, my men; my name is William Johnson;
+I am well known here, and have been a quiet resident in this house for
+upwards of a year."
+
+"A resident, but not a quiet resident, Bastow. I don't think we are
+mistaken; but even if you can prove that you are not Bastow, but William
+Johnson, a man of means and family, we have evidence enough upon the
+other charges. We have been in search of you for a long time, and have
+got you at last. You don't remember me, though it is but eighteen months
+since we met; but I fancy that I then left a mark upon you that still
+remains on your shoulder. I am Mark Thorndyke, and you will understand
+now why I have hunted you down."
+
+"The game is not finished yet," the man said recklessly. "The hunting
+down will be the other way next time, Mark Thorndyke."
+
+"I don't think so. Now, Chester, you may as well tie his feet together,
+and then search him. When that is done I will look after him while you
+fetch the trap round."
+
+In his pockets were found two gold watches, forty-eight pounds in gold,
+and a hundred pounds in bank notes.
+
+"We shall hear where this comes from tomorrow," Malcolm said, as he laid
+them on the table; "it will save us the trouble of getting evidence from
+Australia."
+
+The prisoner was placed in a chair, and then the two officers went out
+to fetch the trap round.
+
+"So you have turned thief catcher, have you?" he said in a sneering
+tone, that recalled him to Mark's memory far more than his face had
+done, "and you carry a Bow Street staff about with you, and pretend to
+belong to the force: that is a punishable offense, you know."
+
+"Yes, it would be if I had no right to use it," Mark said quietly; "but
+it happens that I have a right, having been for a year and a half in the
+force. I joined it solely to hunt you down, and now that I have done so
+my resignation will be sent in tomorrow."
+
+"And how is the worthy squire?"
+
+Mark started to his feet, and seized one of the pistols lying before
+him.
+
+"You villain!" he exclaimed, "I wonder you dare mention his name--you,
+his murderer."
+
+"It was but tit for tat," the man said coolly; "he murdered me, body and
+soul, when he sent me to the hulks. I told him I would be even with him.
+I did not think I had hit him at the time, for I thought that if I had
+you would have stopped with him, and would not have chased me across the
+fields."
+
+"You scoundrel!" Mark said. "You know well enough that you came back,
+stole into his room, and stabbed him."
+
+Bastow looked at him with a puzzled expression.
+
+"I don't know what you are talking about," he said. "I fired at him
+through the window--I don't mind saying so to you, because there are no
+witnesses--and saw him jump up, but I fancied I had missed him. I
+saw you bolt out of the room, and thought it better to be off at once
+instead of taking another shot. You gave me a hard chase. It was lucky
+for you that you did not come up with me, for if you had done so I
+should have shot you; I owed you one for having killed as good a comrade
+as man ever had, and for that bullet you put in my shoulder before. If
+I had not been so out of breath that I could not feel sure of my aim I
+should have stopped for you, but I rode straight to town."
+
+"A likely story," Mark said shortly. "What, you will pretend that there
+were two murderers hanging round the house that night?--a likely tale
+indeed."
+
+"I tell you that if your father was killed by a knife or dagger, I had
+nothing to do with it," the man said. "I am obliged to the man, whoever
+he was. I had intended to go down again to Reigate to finish the job
+myself; I should scarcely have missed a second time. So it is for that
+you hunted me down? Well, I don't blame you; I never forgive an injury,
+and I see your sentiments are mine. Whether I killed your father or not
+makes no difference; he was killed, that is the principal point; if I
+was going to be put on my trial for that I could prove that at eight
+o'clock I was in a coffee house in Covent Garden. I purposely kicked
+up a row there, and was turned out, so that if I were charged with that
+shooting affair I could prove that I was in London that evening."
+
+"I can't quite believe that," Mark said; "a fast horse would have
+brought you up to town in an hour and a half, and another fast horse
+would have taken you back again as quickly; so you might have been in
+London at eight and back again at Crowswood by half past twelve or one,
+even if you stopped a couple of hours at a coffee house. However, you
+won't be tried for that. Those things on the table and the contents of
+that corn bin are enough to hang you a dozen times."
+
+"Curse you! have you found that out?" Bastow exclaimed furiously.
+
+"We have," Mark replied. "It would have been wiser if you had got rid
+of your things sooner. It was a clever hiding place, but it is always
+dangerous to keep such things by you, Bastow."
+
+The man said no more, but sat quietly in his chair until they heard
+the vehicle stop outside the gate. Then the two constables came in,
+and lifting Bastow, carried him out and placed him in the bottom of the
+cart.
+
+"You can loose the old woman now, Malcolm," Mark said as he took his
+seat and gathered the reins in his hand. "By eleven o'clock, no doubt,
+one of the others will be down with the gig again, and you can empty
+out the contents of that hole, and bring them up with you. I don't think
+that it will be of any use searching further. You might have a good look
+all round before you come away. There may be some notes stowed away,
+though it is likely enough that they have been sent away by post to some
+receiver abroad."
+
+For some time after starting they could hear the prisoner moving about
+uneasily in the straw.
+
+"I suppose there is no fear of his slipping out of those handcuffs,
+Chester?"
+
+"Not a bit; they are full tight for him. I expect that that is what is
+making him uncomfortable."
+
+Presently the movement ceased.
+
+"He is still enough now, Mr. Thorndyke. I should not be at all surprised
+if he has dropped off to sleep. He is hardened enough to sleep while the
+gibbet was waiting for him."
+
+It was four o'clock in the morning when they drove up at Bow Street. Two
+constables on duty came out to the cart.
+
+"We have got a prisoner, Inspector," Chester said. "He is the man we
+have been looking for so long. I fancy we have got all the swag that has
+been stolen for the last eighteen months--bags of jewels and watches,
+and sacks of silver. He is handcuffed, and his legs are tied, so we must
+carry him in."
+
+The officer fetched out a lantern. The other constable helped him to let
+down the backboard of the cart.
+
+"Now, Bastow, wake up," Chester said. "Here we are."
+
+But there was no movement!
+
+"He is mighty sound asleep," the constable said.
+
+"Well, haul him out;" and, taking the man by the shoulders, they pulled
+him out from the cart.
+
+"There is something rum about him," the constable said; and as they
+lowered his feet to the pavement his head fell forward, and he would
+have sunk down if they had not supported him.
+
+The Inspector raised the lantern to his face.
+
+"Why, the man is dead," he said.
+
+"Dead!" Chester repeated incredulously.
+
+"Aye, that he is. Look here;" and he pointed to a slim steel handle some
+three inches long, projecting over the region of the heart. "You must
+have searched him very carelessly, Chester. Well, bring him in now."
+
+They carried him into the room, where two candles were burning. Mark
+followed them. The inspector pulled out the dagger. It was but four
+inches long, with a very thin blade. The handle was little thicker than
+the blade itself. Mark took it and examined it.
+
+"I have not a shadow of doubt that this is the dagger with which he
+murdered my father. The wound was very narrow, about this width, and the
+doctor said that the weapon that had been used was certainly a foreign
+dagger."
+
+"I don't think this is a foreign dagger," the Inspector said on
+examining it, "although it may be the one that was used, as you say,
+Mr. Thorndyke. It has evidently been made to carry about without being
+observed."
+
+He threw back the dead man's coat.
+
+"Ah, here is where it was kept. You see, the lining has been sewn to the
+cloth, so as to make a sheath down by the seam under the arm. I expect
+that, knowing what would happen if he were caught, he had made up his
+mind to do it all along. Well, I don't know that you are to be so much
+blamed, Chester, for, passing your hand over his clothes, you might very
+well miss this, which is no thicker than a piece of whalebone. Well,
+well, he has saved us a good deal of trouble. You say you have got most
+of the booty he has collected?"
+
+"I don't know that we have got all of it, sir, but we have made a very
+big haul, anyhow; it was a cunningly contrived place. There was a big
+corn bin in the stable, and when we had emptied out the corn it seemed
+empty. However, Mr. Thorndyke discovered that the bin was fixed. Then we
+found that the bottom was really a trap door, and under it was a sort of
+well in which were sacks and bags. One of the sacks was full of unbroken
+silver, two others contained silver ingots, things that he had melted
+down, and there was a large bag full of watches and jewels. In his
+pocket we found a hundred pounds in bank notes, about fifty guineas, and
+a couple of gold watches."
+
+"That he must have got tonight from the Portsmouth coach; we heard half
+an hour ago that it had been stopped near Kingston, the coachman shot,
+and the passengers robbed. It will be good news to some of them that
+we have got hold of their valuables. Well, Mr. Thorndyke, I have to
+congratulate you most heartily on the skill with which you have ferreted
+out a man who had baffled us for so long, and had become a perfect
+terror to the south of London. No doubt we shall be able to trace
+a great portion of the property in that sack. The capture has been
+splendidly effected."
+
+"You will understand," Mark said, "that I do not wish my name to appear
+in the matter at all. I have, as you know, been actuated by private
+reasons only in my search, and I see no occasion why my name should
+be mentioned; the evidence of Chester and Malcolm will be ample. From
+information received, they went down to this place, searched it in
+his absence, discovered the stolen goods, and captured them. Having
+handcuffed and bound him, one drove him up to town, the other remaining
+to guard the treasure. On his way he got at this hidden dagger and
+stabbed himself. My evidence would not strengthen the case at all."
+
+"No, I don't see that it will be necessary to call you, Mr. Thorndyke.
+The discovery of this hidden booty and the proceeds of the coach robbery
+would be quite sufficient. Beyond the coroner's inquest there will be no
+inquiry. Had it been otherwise it might probably have been necessary to
+call you at the trial. However, as it is, it will save a lot of trouble;
+now we shall only need to find the owners of these bank notes. I will
+send off a cart for the things as early as I can get one, and will send
+a couple of constables round to the houses where burglaries have
+been committed to request the owners to come over and see if they can
+identify any of their property; and those who do so can attend the
+inquest tomorrow, though I don't suppose they will be called. The chief
+will be mightily pleased when he hears what has taken place, for he has
+been sadly worried by these constant complaints, and I fancy that
+the authorities have been rather down upon him on the subject. The
+announcement that the career of this famous robber has been brought to
+an end will cause quite a sensation, and people round the commons on the
+south side will sleep more quietly than they have done lately. I expect
+that if he had not put an end to himself we should have had to send him
+across to Newington today, for of course it is a Surrey business, though
+we have had the luck to take him. I suppose we shall not see much of you
+in the future, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"No indeed," Mark said. "My business is done, and I shall send in my
+resignation this morning. I don't regret the time that I have spent over
+it; I have learned a great deal, and have seen a lot of the shady side
+of life, and have picked up experience in a good many ways."
+
+Mark, after requesting the Inspector to find a man to go over to
+Streatham and bring back his horse, and writing an order to the ostler
+to deliver it, walked across to his lodgings. Upon the whole, he was
+not sorry that Bastow had taken the matter into his own hands; he had,
+certainly, while engaged in the search, looked forward to seeing him in
+the dock and witnessing his execution, but he now felt that enough had
+been done for vengeance, and that it was as well that the matter had
+ended as it had. He was wearied out with the excitement of the last
+forty-eight hours. It was one o'clock when he awoke, and after dressing
+and going into Covent Garden to lunch at one of the coffee houses, he
+made his way up to Islington.
+
+"Taking a day's holiday?" Millicent asked as he came in.
+
+"Well, not exactly, Millicent; I have left school altogether."
+
+"Left school, Mark? Do you mean that you have decided that it is of no
+use going on any longer?"
+
+"I have given it up because I have finished it. Arthur Bastow was
+captured last night, and committed suicide as he was being taken to the
+station."
+
+An exclamation of surprise broke from Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent.
+
+"It seems horrid to be glad that anyone has taken his own life," the
+latter said; "but I cannot help feeling so, for as long as he lived I
+should never have considered that you were safe, and besides, I suppose
+there is no doubt that if he had not killed himself he would have been
+hung."
+
+"There is not a shadow of doubt about that," Mark replied. "We found
+the proceeds of a vast number of robberies at his place, and also in
+his pockets the money he had taken from the passengers of the Portsmouth
+coach an hour before we captured him. So that putting aside that
+Australian business altogether, his doom was sealed."
+
+"Now, please, tell us all about it," Mrs. Cunningham said. "But first
+let us congratulate you most warmly not only on the success of your
+search, but that the work is at an end."
+
+"Yes, I am glad it is over. At first I was very much interested; in
+fact, I was intensely interested all along, and should have been for
+however long it had continued. But, at the same time, I could do nothing
+else, and one does not want to spend one's whole life as a detective.
+At last it came about almost by chance, and the only thing I have to
+congratulate myself upon is that my idea of the sort of place he would
+have taken was exactly borne out by fact."
+
+And Mark then gave them a full account of the manner in which the
+discovery had been made and the capture effected.
+
+"You see, Millicent, I followed your injunction, and was very careful.
+Taking him by surprise as I did, I might have managed it single handed,
+but with the aid of two good men it made a certainty of it, and the
+whole thing was comfortably arranged."
+
+"I think you have done splendidly, Mark," Mrs. Cunningham said. "It was
+certainly wonderful that you should have found him doing exactly what
+you had guessed, even down to the deaf servant. Well, now that is done
+and over, what do you think of doing next?"
+
+"I have hardly thought about that," he replied; "but, at any rate, I
+shall take a few weeks' holiday, and I suppose after that I shall settle
+down to the search for my uncle's treasure. I am afraid that will be
+a much longer and a vastly more difficult business than this has been.
+Here there were all sorts of clews to work upon. Bastow ought to have
+been captured months ago, but in this other affair, so far, there is
+next to nothing to follow up. We don't even know whether the things are
+in India or in England. I believe they will be found, but that it will
+be by an accident. Besides, I fancy that we shall hear about them when
+you come of age, Millicent. There was to have been no change till that
+time, and I cannot help thinking that Uncle George must have made some
+provisions by which we should get to know about them in the event of
+his death without his having an opportunity of telling anyone where they
+are.
+
+"He might have been killed in battle; he might have been drowned on his
+way home. He had thought the whole matter over so thoroughly, I do think
+the possibilities of this could not have escaped him. As I told you,
+Mr. Prendergast made inquiries of all the principal bankers and Indian
+agents here, and altogether without success. After he had done that, I
+got a list of all the leading firms in Calcutta and Madras, and wrote to
+them, and all the replies were in the negative. It is true that does
+not prove anything absolutely. Eighteen years is a long time, and the
+chances are that during those years almost every head of a firm would
+have retired and come home. Such a matter would only be likely to be
+known to the heads; and if, as we thought likely, the box or chest was
+merely forwarded by a firm there to England, the transaction would
+not have attracted any special attention. If, upon the other hand, it
+remained out there it might have been put down in a cellar or store, and
+have been lying there ever since, altogether forgotten."
+
+"I don't see myself why you should bother any more about it; perhaps,
+as you say, it will turn up of itself when I come of age. At any rate, I
+should say it is certainly as well to wait till then and see if it does,
+especially as you acknowledge that you have no clew whatever to work
+on. It is only three more years, for I am eighteen next week, and it
+certainly seems to me that it will be very foolish to spend the next
+three years in searching about for a thing that may come to you without
+any searching at all."
+
+"Well, I will think it over."
+
+"You see, you really don't want the money, Mark," she went on.
+
+"No, I don't want it particularly, Millicent; but when one knows that
+there is something like 50,000 pounds waiting for one somewhere, one
+would like to get it. Your father worked for twenty years of his life
+accumulating it for us, and it seems to me a sort of sacred duty to see
+that his labor has not all been thrown away."
+
+Millicent was silent.
+
+"It is very tiresome," she said presently. "Of course my father
+intended, as you say, that his savings should come to us, but I am sure
+he never meant that they should be a bother and a trouble to us."
+
+"I don't see why they should ever be that, Millicent. As it is we have
+both sufficient for anything any man or woman could reasonably want, and
+neither of us need fret over it if the treasure is never found. Still,
+he wished us to have it, and it is properly ours, and I don't want it to
+go to enrich someone who has not a shadow of a right to it."
+
+On the following morning Mark went to attend the inquest on Bastow. He
+did not go into the court, however, but remained close at hand in the
+event of the coroner insisting upon his being called. However, the two
+men only spoke casually in their evidence of their comrade Roberts, who
+had been also engaged in the capture. One of the jurymen suggested that
+he should also be called, but the coroner said:
+
+"I really cannot see any occasion for it; we are here to consider how
+the deceased came by his death, and I think it must be perfectly clear
+that he came by it by his own act. You have heard how he was captured,
+that the spoils of the coach that he had just rifled were found upon
+him, and that the booty he had been acquiring from his deeds for months
+past also was seized; therefore, as the man was desperate, and knew
+well enough that his life was forfeited, there was ample motive for
+his putting an end to his wretched existence. I really do not think,
+gentlemen, that it is worth while to waste your time and mine by going
+into further evidence."
+
+Finally, a verdict of felo de se was returned, with a strong expression
+of the jury's admiration of the conduct of constables Malcolm, Chester,
+and Roberts, who had so cleverly effected the capture of the man who had
+so long set the law at defiance.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII.
+
+
+Four days later Mark, on his return from dinner, found Philip Cotter
+sitting in his room waiting for him. They had met on the previous
+evening, and Cotter had expressed his intention of calling upon him the
+next day.
+
+"I am here on a matter of business, Thorndyke," the latter said as they
+shook hands.
+
+"Of business!" Mark repeated.
+
+"Yes. You might guess for a year, and I don't suppose that you would hit
+it. It is rather a curious thing. Nearly twenty years ago--"
+
+"I can guess it before you go any further," Mark exclaimed, leaping up
+from the seat that he had just taken. "Your people received a box from
+India."
+
+"That is so Mark; although how you guessed it I don't know."
+
+"We have been searching for it for years," Mark replied. "Our lawyer,
+Prendergast, wrote to you about that box; at least, he wrote to you
+asking if you had any property belonging to Colonel Thorndyke, and your
+people wrote to say they hadn't."
+
+"Yes, I remember I wrote to him myself. Of course that was before you
+did me that great service, and I did not know your name, and we had not
+the name on our books. What is in the box?"
+
+"Jewels worth something like fifty thousand pounds."
+
+"By Jove, I congratulate you, old fellow; that is to say, if you have
+the handling of it. Well, this is what happened. The box was sent to
+us by a firm in Calcutta, together with bills for 50,000 pounds. The
+instructions were that the money was to be invested in stock, and that
+we were to manage it and to take 100 pounds a year for so doing. The
+rest of the interest of the money was to be invested. The box was a very
+massive one, and was marked with the letters XYZ. It was very carefully
+sealed. Our instructions were that the owner of the box and the money
+might present himself at any time."
+
+"And that the proof of his ownership was to be that he was to use the
+word 'Masulipatam,'" Mark broke in, "and produce a gold coin that would,
+probably--though of this I am not certain--correspond with the seals."
+
+He got up and went to the cabinet which he had brought up with him from
+Crowswood, unlocked it, and produced the piece of paper and the coin.
+
+"Yes, that looks like the seal, Thorndyke. At any rate, it is the same
+sort of thing. Why on earth didn't you come with it before, and take the
+things away?"
+
+"Simply because I did not know where to go to. My uncle was dying
+when he came home, and told my father about the treasure, but he died
+suddenly, and my father did not know whether it was sent to England or
+committed to someone's charge in India, or buried there. We did the only
+thing we could, namely, inquired at all the banks and agents here and
+at all the principal firms in Madras and Calcutta to ask if they had in
+their possession any property belonging to the late Colonel Thorndyke."
+
+"You see, we did not know," Cotter went on, "any more than Adam, to whom
+the box belonged. Fortunately, the agent sent in his communication a
+sealed letter, on the outside of which was written, 'This is to remain
+unopened, but if no one before that date presents himself with the token
+and password, it is to be read on the 18th of August, 1789.' That was
+yesterday, you know."
+
+"Yes, that was my cousin's eighteenth birthday. We thought if my uncle
+had left the box in anyone's charge he would probably have given him
+some such instructions, for at that time there was hard fighting in
+India, and he might have been killed any day, and would therefore
+naturally have made some provisions for preventing the secret dying with
+him."
+
+"We did not think of it until this morning early, though we have been
+rather curious over it ourselves. When we opened it, inside was another
+letter addressed 'To be delivered to John Thorndyke, Esquire, at
+Crawley, near Hastings, or at Crowswood, Reigate, or in the event of his
+death to his executors.'"
+
+"I am one of his executors," Mark said; "Mr. Prendergast, the lawyer,
+is the other. I think I had better go round to him tomorrow and open the
+letter there."
+
+"Oh, I should think you might open it at once, Thorndyke. It will
+probably only contain instructions, and, at any rate, as you have the
+coin and the word, you could come round tomorrow morning and get the
+chest out if you want it."
+
+"I won't do that," Mark said; "the coffer contains gems worth over
+50,000 pounds, and I would very much rather it remained in your keeping
+until I decide what to do with it. How large is it?"
+
+"It is a square box, about a foot each way; and it is pretty heavy,
+probably from the setting of the jewels. Well, anyhow, I am heartily
+glad, Thorndyke. I know, of course, that you are well off, still 100,000
+pounds--for the money has doubled itself since we had it--to say nothing
+of the jewels, is a nice plum to drop into anyone's mouth."
+
+"Very nice indeed, although only half of it comes to me under my uncle's
+will. To tell you the truth, I am more glad that the mystery has been
+solved than at getting the money; the affair was a great worry to my
+father, and has been so to me. I felt that I ought to search for the
+treasure, and yet the probability of finding it seemed so small that I
+felt the thing was hopeless, and that really the only chance was that my
+uncle would have taken just the course he did, and have fixed some date
+when the treasure should be handed over, if not asked for. I rather
+fancied that it would not have been for another three years, for that is
+when my cousin comes of age."
+
+"What cousin do you mean?" Philip Cotter asked. "I did not know you had
+one."
+
+"Well, that is at present a secret, Cotter--one of the mysteries
+connected with my uncle's will. For myself, I would tell it in the
+market place tomorrow, but she wishes it to be preserved at present; you
+shall certainly know as soon as anyone. By the way, I have not seen
+you at Mrs. Cunningham's for the last week, and you used to be a pretty
+regular visitor."
+
+"No," the young man said gloomily; "I don't mind telling you that Miss
+Conyers refused me a fortnight ago. I never thought that I had much
+chance, but I had just a shadow of hope, and that is at an end now."
+
+"Perhaps in the future--" Mark suggested for the sake of saying
+something.
+
+"No; I said as much as that to her, and she replied that it would
+always be the same, and I gathered from her manner, although she did not
+exactly say so, that there was someone else in the case, and yet I have
+never met anyone often there."
+
+"Perhaps you are mistaken," Mark said.
+
+"Well, whether or not, there is clearly no hope for me. I am very sorry,
+but it is no use moping over it. My father and mother like her so much,
+and they are anxious for me to marry and settle down; altogether, it
+would have been just the thing. I do not know whether she has any money,
+and did not care, for of course I shall have plenty. I shall be a junior
+partner in another six months; my father told me so the other day. He
+said that at one time he was afraid that I should never come into the
+house, for that it would not have been fair to the others to take such
+a reckless fellow in, but that I seemed to have reformed so thoroughly
+since that affair that if I continued so for another six months they
+should have no hesitation in giving me a share."
+
+It was too late to go up to Islington that evening. In the morning Mark
+went with the still unopened letter to the solicitor's. The old lawyer
+congratulated him most heartily when he told him of the discovery that
+he had made.
+
+"I am glad indeed, Mark; not so much for the sake of the money, but
+because I was afraid that that confounded treasure was going to unsettle
+your life. When a man once begins treasure hunting it becomes a sort of
+craze, and he can no more give it up than an opium smoker can the use
+of the drug. Thank goodness, that is over; so the capital amount is
+doubled, and you are accordingly worth 70,000 pounds more than you were
+this time yesterday--a fine windfall! Now let us see what your uncle
+says."
+
+He broke the seal. The letter was a short one, and began:
+
+"My DEAR JOHN:
+
+"If you have not, before you receive this, got my treasure, you will get
+it on the 18th or 19th of August, 17??89. I have made a will which will
+give you full instructions what to do with it. I may say, though, that I
+have left it between a little daughter who was born six months ago, and
+your son Mark. My own intentions are to stop out here until I get the
+rank of general, and I have taken the measures that I have done in case
+a bullet or a sharp attack of fever carries me off suddenly. I hope that
+you will have carried out the provisions of my will, and I hope also
+that I shall have come home and talked the whole matter over with you
+before I go under.
+
+"Your affectionate brother."
+
+"A singular man," Mr. Prendergast said, as he laid the letter down on
+the table beside him. "What trouble these crotchety people do give!
+I suppose you have altogether put aside that folly of his about the
+jewels?"
+
+"Well, no, I can't say that I have, Mr. Prendergast. Do you know that
+I have a fancy--it may only be a fancy, but if so, I cannot shake it
+off--that I am watched by Lascars. There was one standing at the corner
+of the street as I came up this morning, and again and again I have
+run across one. It is not always the same man, nor have I any absolute
+reasons for believing that they are watching me; still, somehow or
+other, I do come across them more frequently than seems natural."
+
+"Pooh, nonsense, Mark! I should have thought that you were too sensible
+a fellow to have such ridiculous fancies in your head."
+
+"Of course, I should never have thought of such a thing, Mr.
+Prendergast, if it had not been for what my father told me, that my
+uncle was desperately in earnest about it, and had an intense conviction
+that someone watched his every movement."
+
+"Don't let us talk of such folly any longer," the lawyer said irritably.
+"Now that you have got the money, the best thing you can do is to go at
+once and carry out what was the wish both of your father and your uncle,
+and ask your cousin to marry you; that will put an end to the whole
+business, and I can tell you that I am positively convinced that the
+day she gets twenty-one she will renounce the property, and that if you
+refuse to take it she will pass it over to some hospital or other. You
+cannot do better than prevent her from carrying out such an act of folly
+as that, and the only way that I can see is by your marrying her. I
+gathered from what you said when I gave you the same advice at Reigate
+that you liked her and should have done it had it not been for her
+coming into the estate instead of you. Well, you are now in a position
+to ask her to marry you without the possibility of its being supposed
+that you are a fortune hunter."
+
+"I will think about it, Mr. Prendergast. Of course this money does make
+a considerable difference in my position; however, I shall do nothing
+until I have got the jewels off my hands."
+
+"Well, a couple of days will manage that," the lawyer said; "you have
+only got to take the box to a first class jeweler, and get him to value
+the things and make you an offer for the whole of them."
+
+Mark did not care to press the subject, and on leaving went to Cotter's
+Bank. He was at once shown into his friend's room, and the latter took
+him to his father.
+
+"It is curious, Mr. Thorndyke," the latter said heartily, "that we
+should have been keeping your money all this time without having the
+slightest idea that it belonged to you. We are ready at once to pay it
+over to your order, for if you pronounce the word you know of, and I
+find that the coin you have corresponds with the seal on the box, the
+necessary proof will be given us that you have authority to take it
+away. I have had the box brought up this morning, so that we can compare
+the seal."
+
+The box was taken out of the strong safe, and it was at once seen that
+the coin corresponded with the seals.
+
+"I will leave it with you for the present, Mr. Cotter; it contains a
+large amount of jewels, and until I have decided what to do with them I
+would rather leave them; it would be madness to have 50,000 pounds worth
+of gems in a London lodging, even for a single night. As to the money,
+that also had better remain as it is at present invested. As I told your
+son--that and the jewels are the joint property of myself and another. I
+dare say that in a few days half of the money will be transferred to
+the name of the other legatee; that can be easily done. I shall get
+my lawyer, Mr. Prendergast, to call upon you, Mr. Cotter. I suppose it
+would be better that some legal proof that we are entitled to the money
+should be given."
+
+"I shall be glad to see him and to take his instructions," the banker
+said; "but in point of fact I regard the property as yours; I have
+nothing to do with wills or other arrangements. I simply received
+the box and the cash with an order that they should be delivered to
+whomsoever should come with the word 'Masulipatam' and a coin to match
+the seals. That you have done, and with subsequent dispositions I have
+no concern. I shall be happy to keep this box for you as long as you
+should think proper; and I have also written out an acknowledgement
+that I hold securities of the value, at the closing prices yesterday, of
+103,000 pounds 16 shillings," and he handed the paper to Mark.
+
+As the latter left the bank he looked up and down the street, and
+muttered an angry exclamation as he caught sight of a rough looking
+fellow just turning a corner into a side street. The glance was so
+momentary a one that he could not say whether the man was a colored
+seaman; but he certainly thought that he was a Lascar.
+
+"I am going to have trouble about that bracelet," he said to himself,
+as he hailed a hackney coach and told him to drive to Islington. "I am
+convinced that the Colonel was right, and that there are some men over
+in this country with the fixed purpose of seeing what is done with those
+jewels, and obtaining them if possible. How they could tell that they
+were deposited at Cotter's beats me altogether. It may be indeed that
+they really knew nothing about it, and have simply been watching me.
+They can hardly have been watching me for the last nine months, and yet,
+curiously enough, though I have never given the matter a thought since,
+Charley Gibbons said that it was a dark colored man who brought the news
+that took them to my rescue and saved my life. I have often run against
+Lascars, and if they have taken this trouble all along, now that they
+have seen me come out of the bank, I shall be watched night and day.
+
+"It is a creepy sort of idea. I should not be afraid of any number of
+them if they attacked me openly; but there is no saying what they might
+do. I wish Ramoo had been here. I would have consulted him about it; but
+as I got a letter from him only last week saying that he had, on the day
+of writing it, arrived in Calcutta, it is of no use wishing that. At any
+rate, I cannot do better than stick to the plan that my uncle sketched
+out, and take them across to Amsterdam. It would be very unfair to take
+them to any jeweler here. He might have them in his possession for a
+week or ten days before he made me any definite offer for them, and
+during that time I would not give a fig for his life. If I distribute
+the stones at Amsterdam they would hardly set about attacking twelve
+diamond merchants one after another. Well, at any rate, I must say
+nothing about the affair to Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham. It was bad
+enough my running risks in the pursuit of Bastow; but this would be ten
+times worse, and I know Millicent would be for letting the things remain
+for good at the banker's. But I have no idea of allowing myself to be
+frightened by two or three black scoundrels into throwing away 50,000
+pounds."
+
+Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent were sitting in their bonnets in the
+parlor.
+
+"Here you are at last, sir," the girl said. "Another five minutes, and
+we should have gone out. You told us that you would come early, and
+now it is twelve o'clock; and you are generally so punctual in your
+appointments. What have you got to say for yourself?"
+
+"A good many things have happened since then, Millicent. Last night your
+friend Mr. Cotter called upon me."
+
+"Why do you say my friend? He was your friend, and it was entirely
+through you that we knew him at all."
+
+"Well, we will say 'our friend,' Millicent; and he made a communication
+to me that this morning I had to go to Mr. Prendergast and make a
+communication to him."
+
+"What do you mean by your communications?" Millicent asked, laughing.
+"You are quite mysterious, Mark."
+
+"And then I had to go," he went on, without heeding her interruption,
+"to Cotter's Bank, where I saw both our friend and his father, and there
+is the result of these communications and that interview;" and he threw
+the paper to her.
+
+"What does it mean?" she asked in astonishment, after glancing through
+it.
+
+"It means, dear, that your father took exactly the precautions I thought
+he would take, and after sending his money and jewels home, he sent a
+sealed letter to the firm with whom he deposited them, which happened to
+be Cotter's, with instructions that should no one present himself with
+the word and coin by the 18th of August, 1789--that is to say, on your
+eighteenth birthday--the envelope should be opened; it was so opened,
+and it contained a letter that was to be sent to my father, or, in the
+case of his death before that date, to his executors."
+
+"How wonderful!" the girl said. "I had quite given up all idea of it.
+But how is it that it came to be so much? Have they sold the jewels?"
+
+"No, you see it is the compound interest going on for seventeen years,
+and perhaps some rise in the value of the securities, that has doubled
+the original sum invested. As for the jewels, I have left them at the
+bank; I should not care about having 50,000 pounds worth of such things
+in my rooms and I should not think that you would like to have them
+here, either."
+
+"Certainly not," Mrs. Cunningham said emphatically; "you did quite
+right, Mark. I don't think I could sleep, even if you had half a dozen
+of your detective friends posted round the house."
+
+"Still I suppose we shall have a chance of seeing them?" Millicent said.
+
+"Certainly. I can make an appointment with Philip Cotter for you to see
+them at the bank; or if I take them to a jeweler to value, you could
+see them there. But I should think that the bank would be the best. I am
+sure that Cotter would put his room at your disposal, and, of course,
+if you would like to have some of them for yourself you could select
+any you liked, but I expect that they won't look much in their present
+settings; the Indian jewelers have not the knack of setting off gems.
+However, there is no hurry about them one way or another. The money,
+I have told Cotter's father, shall, for the present, remain as it
+is invested; it is all in the Funds, Cotter said, for although the
+instructions were that it was to be put into good securities, he did
+not feel justified under the peculiar circumstances in going outside
+Government stock. Mr. Prendergast is quite of opinion that it would be
+better to make no change until you come of age. I did not know whether
+you would wait till then, for some purpose or other you might want to
+use some of it."
+
+Millicent shrugged her shoulders.
+
+"I think I would much rather have had just the money I had before, Mark;
+all this will be a great nuisance, I am sure. I think there ought to be
+a law against women having more than 20,000 pounds, whether in money or
+in land."
+
+Mark laughed.
+
+"It would be a bad thing for spendthrift young noblemen, Millicent. How
+are they to pay off their debts and mortgages if there were no heiresses
+ready to do so in exchange for a title?"
+
+"It would be a good thing for them, I consider," the girl said
+indignantly. "In the first place, they would not impoverish themselves
+if they knew that there was no way of building up their fortune again,
+and in the next place, if they did ruin themselves they would have to
+either set to work to earn an honest living or blow out their brains,
+if they have any to blow out. I can assure you that I don't feel at all
+exultant at getting all this money, and I think that my father was quite
+right in wishing that I should know nothing about it until I married;
+but, on the other hand, I am heartily glad, more glad than I can say,
+Mark, that you have come into your share."
+
+"I am glad for one reason, Millicent; that is, that this must put an end
+to the ridiculous idea you have of giving up Crowswood. Your father has
+made me rich beyond anything I could possibly have expected from him.
+I suddenly find myself a wealthy man, and I can buy another estate for
+myself worth more than Crowswood if inclined to settle down as a squire;
+therefore your theory that I have been disappointed in not inheriting
+what I thought was my father's estate falls to the ground altogether. In
+no case would I ever have accepted your sacrifice. If you had liked to
+hand it over to St. Bartholomew's or Guy's Hospital, or to give it away
+to any other charity, I would not have prevented you, but I would never
+have accepted it for myself. Now, thank goodness, the question cannot
+arise; for you must see that, even looking at the matter from a purely
+business point of view, I have benefited to an enormous and altogether
+unexpected extent by your father's will, and if any contest between us
+could arise it should be on the ground that he has acted unfairly to you
+by giving me so large a proportion of the money that, in the course of
+nature, you should have inherited. It was not even as if he had known
+and liked me, for I was but four years old at the time he wrote the
+letter saying that I was to share the money and jewels with you."
+
+"You are very obstinate and very disagreeable, Mark," she said, with
+tears in her eyes.
+
+"I think the obstinacy has been principally on your side, Millicent;
+though certainly I should not think of saying that you have been
+disagreeable. It has been an excess of kindheartedness on your part,
+and you have resolutely closed your eyes to the fact that, had I been
+willing to take advantage of your generosity, I should have lacked the
+courage to do so, for I should have been pointed at wherever I went,
+as a mean fellow who took advantage of his little cousin's romantic
+generosity. Pray, dear, let us say no more about it. We are two rich
+young people; we have both an estate; yours, I grant, is the larger,
+but if I choose I can increase mine, until it is quite as large as
+Crowswood. We can be better friends than we have been for the last year,
+because this point of dispute has always stood between us and made us
+uncomfortable. Now you will have to think over what you would like done,
+and whether you wish any change made in your manner of living."
+
+"Did you tell Mr. Cotter," Millicent laughed, after a pause, "that I had
+a half share in the money?"
+
+"No, that was a matter for you to decide, not for me. I told him that
+I was only a half shareholder, but there was no necessity to say who
+it was who had the other half. When I was talking to Philip Cotter, the
+words 'my cousin' slipped out, but he did not associate it in any way
+with you. It might have been the son of another brother or of a sister
+of my father's."
+
+"In that case, then, we will certainly make no change, will we, Mrs.
+Cunningham?"
+
+"I think, Millicent, that Mr. Prendergast and Mark will probably be of
+opinion that you ought now to be introduced regularly into society. The
+fact that you are a rich heiress might, as your father so much wished,
+remain a secret. But it is one thing having this blazoned about and
+quite another for you to be living quietly here, where, with the
+exception of Mr. Cotter and a few other friends, you have no society
+whatever. Certainly it was not the wish of your father that you should
+remain unmarried. You are quite pretty and nice enough to be sought for
+yourself alone, and I must say that I think, now that you have finished
+with your various masters, it would be well that you should go out a
+good deal more, and that as a first step we should go down to Bath this
+year instead of paying another visit to Weymouth, as we had arranged."
+
+"I don't want any change at all, Mrs. Cunningham. If I am to get married
+I shall be married; if I am not I shall not fret about it."
+
+"But for all that, Millicent," Mark said, "Mrs. Cunningham is right.
+We quite agree that there is no occasion whatever for you to go about
+labeled 'A good estate and over 70,000 pounds in cash,' but I do think
+that it is right that you should go into society. With the exception of
+Philip Cotter, Dick Chetwynd, and two or three other of my friends, you
+really know very few people. You have now gone out of mourning, and I
+think that Mrs. Cunningham's proposal that you should go down to Bath
+is a very good one. I shall not be sorry for a change myself, for I have
+been engrossed in my work for a long time now. I can go down a day or
+two before you, and get you comfortable lodgings, and will myself
+stay at a hotel. Although I have no intimate friends beyond those from
+Reigate, I know a large number of men of fashion from meeting them at
+the boxing schools and other places, and could introduce you both, and
+get you into society."
+
+"I am altogether opposed to the idea," Millicent said decidedly. "You
+want to trot me out like a horse for sale."
+
+"No, Millicent," Mark said calmly. "I only want you to have the same
+advantages that other girls have, neither more nor less, and for you
+to enjoy yourself as others do. There is nothing undignified or
+objectionable about that, especially as we are agreed that nothing shall
+be said about your fortune. Well, we will think it over. Mr. Prendergast
+and I certainly do not wish to act as tyrants, and there is no occasion
+to come to a decision in a hurry. We have only discovered our good
+fortune today, and can scarcely appreciate the difference that it will
+make to us. We can think over what will be for the best at our leisure,
+and see if we cannot hit upon some plan that will be agreeable to you."
+
+"Thank you, Mark," she said gratefully. "I am afraid that you must think
+me very disagreeable and cross; but though you, as a man, have not the
+same sort of feelings, I can assure you that I feel all this money and
+so on to be a heavy burden; and were it not for your sake I could wish
+heartily that this treasure had never been discovered at all."
+
+"I can quite understand that," he said quietly. "At the present moment,
+even, I do not see that it will be of much advantage to me; but it may
+be that some day I shall see it in a different light. It has come upon
+me almost as suddenly as it has upon you. I thought that after I had
+finished with the Bastow affair I should set to work to find out this
+treasure, and that it would probably take me out to India, occupy me
+there for some time, and that afterwards I might travel through other
+places, and be away from England three or four years. Now the matter
+is altogether altered, and I shall be some time before I form any fresh
+plans. In fact, these must depend upon circumstances."
+
+Mrs. Cunningham had left the room two or three minutes before, thinking
+that Mark might be able to talk her charge into a more reasonable state
+of mind were he alone with her, and he added:
+
+"Of one circumstance in particular."
+
+She looked up inquiringly.
+
+"Well, Millicent, it depends a great deal upon you. I know you think
+that all that has happened during the past year has been a little hard
+upon you, and I thoroughly agree with you; you were fond of Crowswood,
+and were very happy there, and the change to this somewhat dull house,
+just at a time when you are of an age to enjoy pleasure, has been a
+trial. Then, too, there has been this question of the estate upon your
+mind. But you must remember it has been somewhat of a trial to me also.
+I grant that I have had plenty of occupation which has been in every way
+beneficial to me, and have not at all lamented leaving the country, but
+in one respect it has been a trial. I don't know whether it ever entered
+your mind, before that sad time at home, that I was getting to care for
+you in a very different way to that in which I had done before.
+
+"My father, I think, observed it, for he threw out a very plain hint
+once that he would very gladly see us coming together. However, I never
+spoke of it to you. I was young and you were young. It seemed to me that
+there was plenty of time, and that, moreover, it would not be fair for
+me to speak to you until you had had the opportunity of going out and of
+seeing other men. Then came the evening before his death, when my father
+told me how matters really stood, and he again said that there was a way
+by which all trouble could be obviated. But I saw that it was not so,
+and that the hope I had entertained must be put aside. I had never told
+you I loved you when I seemed to be the heir of the property and you
+only the daughter of an old comrade of his, and I saw that were I to
+speak now, when you were the heiress, it could not but appear to you
+that it was the estate and not you that I wanted, and I felt my lips
+were sealed forever. Mr. Prendergast said that day when he came down to
+the funeral, and you told him that you would not take the property, that
+it might be managed in another way, and you said that you did not want
+to be married for your money; so you see you saw it in exactly the same
+light as I did.
+
+"My first thought this morning, when Mr. Cotter told me that the money
+had mounted up to over 100,000 pounds, was that it would unseal my
+lips. You were still better off than I was, but the difference was now
+immaterial. I was a rich man, and had not the smallest occasion to marry
+for money. Whether I married a girl without a penny, or an heiress,
+could make but little difference to me, as I have certainly no ambition
+to become a great landowner. I still think that it would have been more
+fair to you to give you the opportunity of seeing more of the society of
+the world before speaking to you, but you see you are opposed to that,
+and therefore it would be the same did I wait patiently another year,
+which I don't think I should be able to do. I love you, Millicent. It
+is only during the past eighteen months, when I have thought that I
+had lost you, that I have known how much I love you, and how much my
+happiness depends upon you. I can truly say that were you penniless, it
+would make no shadow of difference to me. It is no longer a question of
+arranging matters comfortably: it is a question of love. The estate is
+nothing to me. It never has been anything, and it does not count at all
+in the scale. I hope that you will put it altogether out of your mind in
+giving me an answer; and that if you cannot say as truly and wholly as I
+do, 'I love you,' that you will say as frankly as you have always spoken
+to me, 'I love you very much as a cousin, Mark, but not in that way.'"
+
+The girl had sat perfectly quiet while he was speaking.
+
+He was standing before her now, and he took one of her hands.
+
+"I love you, dear; I love you with all my heart. Do you love me?"
+
+Then she looked up and rose to her feet, and placed both hands upon his
+shoulders.
+
+"As you love me, so I love you, Mark."
+
+After that, conversation languished till Mrs. Cunningham came into the
+room, five minutes later.
+
+"We have come to the conclusion, Mrs. Cunningham," he said, "that there
+will be no necessity for the visit to Bath. Millicent is otherwise
+provided for; she has promised to be my wife."
+
+"I am glad, Mark, glad indeed!" and she took Millicent in her arms and
+kissed her tenderly. "I have all along hoped for it, but I began to
+be afraid that you were both such obstinate young people that it would
+never come about. I know that your father wished it, Mark, and he told
+me that his brother had said that it would be a good arrangement if
+some day you should come to like each other. I have guessed for the last
+year, and, indeed, before then, that Millicent would not say 'No' if you
+ever asked her; but this stupid estate seemed to stand in the way. Of
+late, I have even come to hope that the obstinate girl would keep to her
+intention, and that if, as I knew would be the case, you refused to take
+the estate, she would give it away to some charity. In that case, there
+could be nothing to prevent your speaking; and even then you would have
+been between you very fairly equipped with this world's goods. However,
+the present is a far better solution, and the discovery of the treasure
+has saved you from three years' waiting before things were straightened
+out. I feel as if I were her mother, Mark, having had her in my charge
+since she was a baby; and as she grew up it became my fondest hope to
+see you united some day, and I think that I am almost as pleased that my
+hope has been fulfilled as you are yourselves."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII.
+
+
+After thinking over the best way in which to set about the work of
+carrying the diamonds to Amsterdam, Mark decided upon asking the advice
+of his late chief. The latter said, as Mark entered his room:
+
+"I did not expect to see you here again, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"Well, sir, I have come to ask your' advice about another matter
+altogether."
+
+"What is it now?"
+
+"I have to convey a diamond bracelet of very great value across to
+Amsterdam. I have reasons to believe that there is a plot to seize it
+on the way, and that the men engaged will hesitate at nothing to achieve
+their object. Under these circumstances I should be very much obliged
+if you will tell me what would be the best course to pursue. I must say
+that the bracelet is, with many other jewels, in a strong teak box of
+about a foot square, at present in the possession of our bankers; they
+were brought from India by my uncle. I imagine that the rest of the
+jewels are of comparatively little importance in the eyes of these men,
+though doubtless they would take them also if they lay their hands on
+them. The bracelet, however, is of special interest to them, not so
+much for its intrinsic value, as because it was stolen from one of their
+sacred idols.
+
+"This was about twenty years ago; but I have reason to believe that the
+search for it on the part of some Hindoos connected with the temple has
+never ceased. The soldier who took it was murdered; his comrade, into
+whose hands they next passed, was also murdered. They next came to my
+uncle, who forwarded it at once to England. His bungalows were searched
+again and again, until probably the fellows came to the conclusion that
+he must have either buried it or sent it away. Nevertheless, to the day
+of his death he was firmly convinced that he was closely followed, and
+every movement watched. He warned my father solemnly that he too would
+be watched, but as far as we know it was not so; at any rate, we had no
+reason to suppose that the house was ever entered. On the other hand, I
+am convinced I have been watched more or less closely ever since I came
+up to town, and as I came out from the bank yesterday I saw a man--a
+colored fellow, I believe--on the watch.
+
+"My uncle said that my life would not be worth an hour's purchase so
+long as I had the bracelet in my possession, and advised that it should
+be taken straight over to Amsterdam, broken up, and the diamonds sold
+singly to the merchants there."
+
+"It is a curious story, Mr. Thorndyke. I own to ignorance of these
+Indian thieves and their ways, but it certainly seems extraordinary that
+so hopeless a quest should be kept up for so long a time. You are sure
+that it is not fancy on your part that you have been watched? I know you
+are not the sort of man to take fancies in your head, but as you have
+had the matter so strongly impressed upon you, you might naturally have
+been inclined to think this would be the case when it was not so."
+
+"No, I don't think there is any chance of my being mistaken. It is only
+of late that I have thought about it, but when I did so and thought over
+what had passed since I came to London, I recalled the fact that I had
+very often come across foreign seamen; sometimes they were Lascars, at
+others they might have been Italian or Spanish seamen; and you see,
+sir, it was, as I told you at the time, some foreign sailor who came
+and informed Gibbons that I had fallen into the hands of a gang of
+criminals, and that I should certainly be killed if I was not rescued
+immediately. Gibbons at once got together half a dozen fighting men,
+and, as you know, rescued me just in time. It was extraordinary that the
+man never came forward to obtain any reward."
+
+"That was a friendly act, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"Yes, I have no reason to suppose that these men would be hostile to me
+personally. I was not the thief, I was simply the person who happened to
+be in possession, or rather, might come into possession of the bracelet.
+From the close watch they had kept, they were, I imagine, well aware
+that I had not got it, but may have thought, and doubtless did think,
+that I had some clew to its hiding place, and should sooner or later
+get it. With my death the clew might be finally lost, and my life was
+consequently of extreme importance to them, and therefore they took
+steps to have me rescued, and the fact that they learned this and knew
+how friendly I was with Gibbons shows how close was the watch kept over
+me. No doubt, had Gibbons refused to help them, they would have come
+here at once."
+
+"Certainly, after what you say it would seem that your conjecture is
+right, and in this case, if I were you, I should take the bracelet out
+of the case and conceal it about me. I would not fetch it myself from
+the bank."
+
+"I don't think I should be much safer so," Mark said thoughtfully.
+"In the first place, I must go to the bank to get them, and I might be
+murdered merely on the supposition that I had brought the bracelet away.
+In the next place, even if I got to Amsterdam safely and got rid of the
+bracelet and returned unnoticed by them, a fresh danger would arise when
+I got the other gems into my possession, for they could not be certain
+whether the diamonds were still among them or not."
+
+"I should hardly think that would be the case if they watch you as
+strictly as you believe. Even if none of them accompanied you, they
+would soon find out what diamond merchants you went to, and the leader
+might call upon these men, stating that he was commissioned to purchase
+some diamonds of exceptional value for an Eastern Prince, in which case
+he would be sure to obtain sight of them.
+
+"If I had your business to perform, I would not go near the bank again,
+but would send some friend I could trust to go and open the box, and
+take out the bracelet, and make it into a small parcel. He should hand
+it to you privately, as you are on your way to embark for Amsterdam.
+Then I would take with me one or two of my men, and, say, a couple of
+your prize fighters, and with such a guard you ought to be fairly safe."
+
+"I think that is a capital plan," Mark said, "and if I don't go to the
+bank there will be nothing to lead them to suppose that I have taken
+them out, or that I am just going across to Holland."
+
+Mark then went straight to Dick Chetwynd's lodgings.
+
+"I want you to do me a service, Dick," he said.
+
+"With pleasure, Mark. What sort of service is it? If it is anything in
+my power, you know that you can absolutely rely upon me. You are not
+going to fight a duel, are you, and want a second?"
+
+"No; quite another sort of business. I will tell you shortly what it is.
+I have to convey an extremely valuable diamond bracelet to Amsterdam,
+and I have reason to believe that there will be an attempt to murder me,
+and to carry off the jewels before I can dispose of them. It happened in
+this way;" and he then related the history of the diamonds, the reason
+he was followed, and the suggestions that the Chief of the Bow Street
+detectives had given him.
+
+"That is all right," Dick said, when he concluded. "It is a rum
+business, but certainly I will do what you ask me; and, what is more, I
+will go over with you to Amsterdam, and see the thing through. It is an
+interesting business, if it is a queer one."
+
+"You know Philip Cotter?"
+
+"Of course, Mark; why, I have met him with you several times."
+
+"I will give you a note to ask him to allow you to open the case, and
+to take from it the bracelet; I don't know whether it is a regular
+gold mounted bracelet, or simply some diamonds that have been fastened
+together as a necklace; however, I suppose you are sure to recognize
+them; they are altogether exceptional stones, and will certainly be done
+up in a packet by themselves, whatever the others may be. Say that you
+will call in and take them away some other time, of which I will give
+him notice by letter. I will write the note now, and if you can spare
+time to go there today, all the better, for I shall be glad to get the
+business over; then I will come again tomorrow morning, and we will
+arrange the details of the plan. I will look in the shipping list, and
+see what vessels are sailing for Amsterdam. When we have fixed on one,
+it will be best for you to take our passages under any names you like,
+so that they are not our own. The detectives will take their passages
+separately, and so will Gibbons and whoever else goes with us."
+
+"I will go at once, Mark."
+
+"Don't go straight there, Dick; if these fellows are dogging my
+footsteps everywhere, and saw me coming here, they might take it into
+their heads to follow you."
+
+"Oh, they can never be doing all that sort of thing; that's too much to
+believe. However, to please you, I will go into my club for a quarter of
+an hour. Shall I come round to your rooms this evening, or will you come
+here?"
+
+"I think I will put off our meeting altogether until tomorrow morning. I
+have an engagement this evening that I cannot very well get out of."
+
+"All right, Mark, just as you please. What time will you come round in
+the morning?"
+
+"About the time you have finished breakfast. I will go now, and have a
+look at the shipping list."
+
+They parted at the door, and Mark went to the coffee house where
+shipping matters were specially attended to, and where master mariners
+might often be met, conversing together, or with ship owners or
+merchants. On going through the list, he found that the fast sailing
+brig, Essex, of 204 tons, and mounting eight guns, would sail for
+Amsterdam in three days' time, and would take in goods for that place,
+and, should sufficient freight be obtained, for any other Dutch port.
+It was also announced that she had good accommodation for passengers.
+Information as to cargo could be obtained from her owners, on Tower
+Hill, or from the captain on board, between the hours of ten and twelve.
+Then, in small type, it was stated that the Essex was at present lying
+in the outside tier nearly opposite Anderson's wharf.
+
+Mark made a note of all these particulars in his pocketbook, and then
+went to Ingleston's public house.
+
+"Morning, Mr. Thorndyke," the man said; "haven't seen yer for the last
+month or so."
+
+"No; I have been out of town. Do you expect Gibbons in here this
+morning?"
+
+"It is about his time, sir, when he has nothing in particular to see
+about. Like a turn with the mauleys this morning?"
+
+"Not this morning, Ingleston. I have got some engagements for the next
+day or two where I could not very well show myself with a black eye or a
+swelled nose; you have given me a good many of both."
+
+"Well, Mr. Thorndyke, when one stands up against a man who is as strong
+as one's self, and a mighty quick and hard hitter, you have got to hit
+sharp and quick too. You know my opinion, that there aint half a dozen
+men in the country could lick you if you had a proper training."
+
+"I suppose you couldn't get away for a week, or maybe two?" he said.
+
+"Lor' bless you, no, sir. Who would there be to keep order here at
+night? When I first came here I had not given up the ring, and I fought
+once or twice afterwards. But, Lor' bless you, I soon found that I had
+got either to give up the pub or the ring, and as I was doing a tidy
+business here, I thought it best to retire; since then business has
+grown. You see, boxing is more fashionable than it used to be, and
+there are very few nights when one don't have a dozen Corinthians in
+here--sometimes there are twice as many--either to see some of the new
+hands put on the mauleys, and judge for themselves how they are going to
+turn out, or maybe to arrange for a bout between some novice they fancy
+and one of the west countrymen. No, sir, I could not do it anyhow; I
+should not like to be away even for one night, though I know Gibbons
+would look after things for me; as for being away for a week, I could
+not do it for any money. No, sir, my fight with Jackson last year was
+the last time I shall ever go into the ring. I was a fool to go in for
+that, but I got taunted into it. I never thought that I should lick him,
+though, as you know, sir, I have licked a good many good men in my time,
+but Jackson is an out and out man, and he has got a lot more science
+than I ever had; my only chance was that I could knock him out of time
+or wear him down; but he was too quick on his pins for me to do the
+former. Ah, Gibbons, here is Mr. Thorndyke. He wants to see you; you had
+best go into my room behind the bar."
+
+"Want to get hold of a fresh hand, Mr. Thorndyke?" Gibbons asked when
+they had sat down by the fire.
+
+"No, Gibbons, it is another business altogether. Have you got anything
+particular to keep you in town for the next fortnight? It may not be
+over a week, but it may be over a fortnight."
+
+"No, sir," the man said, after taking three or four draws at his long
+pipe. "No, sir; they won't want the ropes and stakes for another three
+weeks, so I am your man if you want me. What, is it for, sir?"
+
+"Well, it is rather a curious affair, Gibbons. I have to take a very
+valuable bracelet over to Amsterdam, to sell there, and I have very
+strong reasons for believing that if some fellows get an inkling of it
+they will try to put me out of the way, and get hold of the diamonds. I
+want a couple of good men to go with me."
+
+"Well sir, I should say you and me could lick a dozen ordinary chaps,
+without thinking anything of it."
+
+"I dare say we could, Gibbons, in a stand up fight without weapons, but
+I fancy these fellows will not try that. They are foreigners, and the
+first thing they would try would be to put a dagger between my shoulders
+as I walked up and down on deck at night, or, more likely still, creep
+into my cabin and stab me while I was asleep. If the voyage were only to
+last one night I might sit up, pistol in hand, but if the wind is foul
+we might be a week. We are a pretty strong party. Mr. Chetwynd--you know
+him--is going with me; there will also be two runners from Bow Street,
+and I want you to take another good man with you. Of course, on board
+we shall separate. The Bow Street men will watch the passengers, and you
+and your mate will smoke your pipes and keep yourselves ready to join
+in if you see there is going to be a row. But I rather think that the
+passage will be a quiet one. At Amsterdam, until I have got rid of the
+diamonds I certainly should not care about going out into the street
+after nightfall without having you close behind me."
+
+"All right, sir. I should say Tom Tring would be as good a man as one
+could get at the job. What is the money to be, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"Well, what do you think yourself, Gibbons?"
+
+"I take it you pay all expenses, sir?"
+
+"Yes, everything."
+
+"Would five and twenty guineas a head be too much?"
+
+"No; I will do better than that. I will give you five and twenty guineas
+each when we get to Amsterdam, and I will give you another twenty-five
+each if I come back here safe and sound."
+
+"Well, I call that handsome. One could not want more, and you can rely
+on it that Tring will jump at the offer. He has not been able to get a
+fight on lately, and he is rather in low water."
+
+"Well, you will both get up as quiet traders. I don't know what other
+passengers there may be, but I don't want them to know that you belong
+to the fancy."
+
+"I twig, sir. We will get up quiet like."
+
+"Then I want you tomorrow morning, Gibbons, to go down to Holmes
+& Moore, No. 67 Tower Street, and take two first class tickets to
+Amsterdam on board the Essex, which sails on Saturday. I don't know what
+the passage money will be, but this is sure to be enough; and we can
+settle accounts afterwards. You will find out what time of day she will
+start."
+
+"All right, governor. I suppose you will be here again before that?"
+
+"No, I don't suppose I shall, unless there is some change in the
+arrangements. If for any reasons Tring cannot go with you, you will
+get somebody else instead. You are sure that you quite understand
+your instructions? Here is the name and address of the people in Tower
+Street."
+
+"All right, sir. You may make sure that when you go down to the ship you
+will see the two of us on board."
+
+It needed but a few minutes at Bow Street to inform the chief of the
+arrangements that had been made.
+
+"I have told off Chester and Malcolm; one of them shall go down and
+take their tickets. Of course, they will take their passages in the fore
+cabin, as the danger, if there is danger, may come from there, and you
+will have your other two men with you aft. I fancy myself that there is
+hardly any chance of your being in any way troubled while on board.
+It will be considered that there will be a vastly greater chance of
+carrying out any plan they may have formed at Amsterdam than there would
+be on board a ship; you see, if there were any struggle whatever on
+board there would be no escape for them.
+
+"For myself, of course I cannot give any opinion worth having in a
+matter so different from anything we have to do with here, and I should
+have unhesitatingly scoffed at the idea of anyone watching the movements
+of people for a long number of years in order to obtain the possession
+of jewels, however valuable. However, your uncle was well acquainted
+with the habits of Hindoos, and was not a man to be lightly alarmed;
+you yourself, after your year with us, should not be deceived in such
+a matter as being yourself followed; under these circumstances you
+are quite right to take every precaution, and as you pay well for
+the services of our two men, even if I had no belief whatever in the
+existence of danger to you, I should not feel justified in refusing to
+let you have them."
+
+Having arranged these matters, Mark spent the rest of his time that day
+and the next at Islington.
+
+"I am going across to Amsterdam on Saturday with a diamond bracelet to
+sell there."
+
+Millicent looked at him in reproachful surprise.
+
+"Why, surely, Mark, there can be no hurry about that. I think you might
+have stayed a little longer before running away."
+
+"I should do so, you may be quite sure, Millicent, if I consulted my own
+inclinations, but I am bearing out your father's wishes. This bracelet
+is the most valuable of all the things he had, and I believe that it has
+some sort of history attached to it. He told my father that he had
+sent all the gems home principally to get these diamonds out of his
+possession; he said that as soon as my father got hold of the things, he
+was to take the diamonds straight over to Amsterdam and sell them there,
+for he considered that they were much too valuable to be kept in the
+house, and that it was possible that some of the Hindoos might endeavor
+to get possession of them. At the time he spoke he believed that my
+father would, at his death, go to the bank and get the jewels, as of
+course he would have done if he had known where to find them. My
+father promised him that they should be taken to Amsterdam at once; and
+although so many years have passed since his death, I think I am bound
+to carry out that promise."
+
+"I have never been able to understand, Mark, how it was that my father,
+when he gave all these instructions about me and these jewels and so on,
+did not at the same time tell uncle where to find them."
+
+"It was a fancy of his; he was in very bad health, and he thought so
+much over these diamonds that it had become almost a sort of mania with
+him that not only was there danger in their possession, but that he
+was watched night and day wherever he went. He thought, even, if he
+whispered where the hiding place was to be discovered it might be heard;
+therefore he deferred telling it until too late. Of course all this
+was but a fancy on his part, although it is probable enough that the
+possession of the diamonds was a source of danger in India, and might
+have been a source of danger here had any thieves known that such
+valuable gems were kept in a private house or carried about. At any
+rate, I shall be glad to be free of the responsibility; and although,
+naturally, I don't like leaving you at the present time, I think it best
+to carry out your father's instructions at once, and to get them off
+my mind altogether. Dick Chetwynd is going with me, so it will be a
+pleasant little trip."
+
+"Well, I am glad he is going with you, Mark; for although I know well
+enough that they could never be watching for those diamonds to turn
+up all these years, I feel sure I should fidget and worry if you were
+alone. You are not going to take the others with you?"
+
+"No, only this particular bracelet. None of the others are exceptionally
+valuable, so far as I know. At any rate, your father did not specially
+allude to them. I have no doubt that there are some really valuable
+jewels among them, for my uncle prided himself on being a judge of
+precious stones, and as he invested a large amount of money in them,
+they are, no doubt, worth a great deal. Still, I don't suppose there
+will be any difficulty in selling them here, and, at any rate, I don't
+want to be delayed at Amsterdam by having to sell perhaps fifty or a
+hundred pieces of jewelry; any time will do for that. I fancy that I
+ought to be able to dispose of the bracelet in three or four days at the
+outside. I have got from Bow Street a list of all the principal diamond
+merchants in Amsterdam. That is a matter of great interest to the force,
+as almost all precious stones stolen in this country are sent across
+there, and if there is any special jewel robbery we send over a list of
+all the articles taken to the merchants there. As a rule, that would
+not prevent their dealing in them, but there are some who will not touch
+things that have been dishonestly come by, and we occasionally get hints
+that enable us to lay hands upon thieves over there."
+
+"I hate to hear you say 'the force,' Mark, just as if you were still a
+detective; it is bad enough that you should have belonged to it, even
+for the purpose you did; but you have done with it now."
+
+"Yes; but, you see, it is rather difficult to get out of the habit when
+one has been for over a year constantly at work at a thing. This will be
+my last absence on business, Millicent; henceforward I shall be able to
+be always with you."
+
+"Well, now that I know what you have been doing all this time, Mark, I
+must admit that you have been very good to have been with us as much as
+you have. I often used to wonder how you passed your time. Of course I
+knew that you were trying to find that man out, but it did not seem to
+me that you could be always at that, and I never dreamt that you had
+become a regular detective. I am very glad I did not know it till a
+short time before you gave it up. In the first place, I should have
+been horrified, and, in the second place, I should have been constantly
+uneasy about you. However, as this is to be the last time, I will let
+you go without grumbling."
+
+"By the way, Millicent, what do you wish me to say about our engagement?
+I don't see that there is the slightest occasion for us to keep up the
+farce of your being Miss Conyers any longer. You cannot be married under
+a false name, you know, and now that you have escaped what your father
+was so afraid of, and are going to be married for love and not for
+money, I don't see why there should be any more mystery about it."
+
+"But how would you account for my having been called Conyers all this
+time?"
+
+"I should simply tell the truth; that your father, having a great fear
+that you might be married for money, left the estate to my father, to
+be held by him until you came of age, and that it was at his particular
+request that you were brought up simply as his ward, and dropped the
+family name and passed by your two Christian names. I should say that
+we have all been aware for a long time of the facts of the case, and
+I should also say that your father had left a very large fortune in
+addition to the estate between us, and had expressed a hope that we
+should, when the time came, marry each other."
+
+"Then people will think that we have only married to keep the fortune
+together, Mark."
+
+"Well, my dear, I don't suppose there are a great many people who will
+be interested in the matter, and those who get to know you will see at
+once that as far as I am concerned, there was no great difficulty in
+falling in with your father's ideas, while, on the other hand, they may
+consider that you made a noble sacrifice of yourself in agreeing to the
+plan."
+
+"Nonsense, sir. I am not going to flatter you, as no doubt you expect;
+but, at any rate, I am perfectly content with my share of the bargain."
+
+"Well, there is one thing, Millicent; all who knew us down at Reigate
+will say that it is a very sensible arrangement, and will be glad to
+know that I shall retain the estate they have hitherto considered to be
+mine. Well, then, you agree to my mentioning to my intimate friends that
+you are my cousin, and that we are engaged?"
+
+"Yes, I suppose it is the best thing, Mark, and, as you say, I must
+marry under my proper name, and it is just as well to get the talk
+over down at Reigate now, as for it all to come as a wonder when we are
+married."
+
+"When is that going to be, Millicent?"
+
+"Oh, I don't know; of course it will be a long time before we even think
+of that."
+
+"I beg your pardon, I am thinking of it now, and I can see no reason
+whatever why it should be delayed. We know each other well enough, I
+should think, and there is no probability of our changing our minds on
+discovering all sorts of faults, that we never dreamt, in each other.
+I may be away for a fortnight, and I would suggest that you had better
+make your preparations at once, so that we can be married a fortnight
+after I come back."
+
+"You say that there is no fear of our discovering faults in each other.
+I can assure you that I have just discovered a very serious fault,
+namely, that you are altogether too masterful, too bent upon having your
+own way. I know you always were so when you were a boy, but I hoped
+you had grown out of it; now I see that I was altogether mistaken.
+Seriously, Mark, your proposal is absurd."
+
+"Where does the absurdity come in, Millicent?"
+
+"Well, everywhere," she said gravely.
+
+"Which in the present case means nowhere," he said. "Do you mean to tell
+me, Millicent, that in this town there are not a hundred dressmakers,
+each of whom could turn you out a wedding dress and as many other
+garments as you can possibly require in the course of a month, or even
+if that effort were too stupendous, that you could not divide the work
+among a dozen of them?"
+
+"Well, I don't say that could not be done," Millicent admitted
+reluctantly.
+
+"Well, what other objection is there?"
+
+"Well, you see, one does not, like to be bustled in such a matter as
+this, Mark. One likes to think it all over and to realize it to one's
+self."
+
+"Well, dear, you will have a fortnight while I am away to think and to
+realize as much as you like. I can see no advantage myself in waiting
+a single day longer than there is a necessity for; I have been for the
+last year coming here merely as a visitor, and I want to take possession
+of you and have you all to myself. I suppose Mrs. Cunningham will be
+coming in presently, and I will put the matter to her. If she says you
+cannot be ready in a month I must give you another week, but I don't
+think that she will say so. By the way, how about her?"
+
+"I was thinking of that last night, Mark. It would be very lonely for
+her to live by herself now, and you see she has always been as a mother
+to me."
+
+"Quite so, dear; and I am sure that I should have no objection to her
+coming back to Crowswood, and living there as a friend, and helping you
+in the housekeeping."
+
+"Thank you very much, Mark; I should like that in every way. You see, I
+know nothing whatever about housekeeping; and besides, when you are
+out, it would be a great thing to have her with me, for it would be very
+lonely by myself in that big house."
+
+"Well, we will have her there, by all means, dear, if she likes to come;
+you had better talk it over with her. Ah! here she is.
+
+"We were just talking over the time it will take Millicent to get
+ready," he said, "and I shall be glad of your opinion. I have been
+telling her that I am going away for a fortnight, and have proposed that
+the marriage should come off a fortnight later. I cannot see any use in
+delay, and she does not either; at least, I suppose not, for the only
+objection she has advanced is that there will be but a short time in
+which to get her things ready. That strikes me as being all nonsense.
+I could get things ready for ten weddings in that time. What do you
+think?"
+
+"I see no reason for delay," Mrs. Cunningham said; "and assuredly a
+month ought to be sufficient to get everything made."
+
+"Thank you, Mrs. Cunningham; then we can consider that settled,
+Millicent!"
+
+"I call this tyranny, Mrs. Cunningham," Millicent protested. "He says
+he proposes that we shall be married in a month; it is not a proposal at
+all, it is an order. If he had wanted me in such a hurry he might have
+said so a year ago, and now that he has made up his mind at last, he
+wants everything done in a hurry."
+
+"It is the nature of men, my dear; they are all alike in that respect.
+I think you had better make up your mind to it, especially as I have no
+doubt in this case the order is not a very unpleasant one."
+
+"You are too bad, Mrs. Cunningham," Millicent said. "I made sure that I
+should find you on my side, and it seems you have gone over altogether
+to the enemy."
+
+"Where are you going to?" asked Mrs. Cunningham of Mark.
+
+"I am going across to Amsterdam to sell that bracelet. My uncle
+expressed a particular wish to my father that he should do so
+immediately it came into his possession. Dick Chetwynd is going over
+with me, and if the weather is fair it will be a pleasant trip."
+
+"Where are you thinking of going after the marriage?"
+
+"We have not talked it over yet. My own idea is that, as neither of
+us has been abroad, we might as well take this opportunity for seeing
+something of the Continent. Of course we cannot go to France, things are
+in too disturbed a state there; but we might go to Brussels, and then
+into Germany, and perhaps as far as Vienna, and then down into Italy;
+but of course, if Millicent prefers it, we will simply take a tour
+through England and Scotland."
+
+"Oh, I am glad that I am to have some voice in the matter," Millicent
+said. "However, I should like the tour you propose very much, Mark. I
+have often thought that I should like to see Italy above all places."
+
+"Well, then, we will consider that settled. And now, what are you going
+to do for today?"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX.
+
+
+The Essex was to sail at eleven o'clock. Half an hour before that
+time Mark's hackney coach drew up at the wharf. Ten minutes later Dick
+Chetwynd, who had, like Mark, driven by a circuitous route, and had made
+several stoppages, joined him, and as they shook hands slipped a parcel
+into his hand, and this Mark at once pocketed, and buttoned his coat up
+tightly; then hailing a boat, they went on board together; they had sent
+their luggage on the previous evening. On getting on board Mark saw the
+two prize fighters walking up and down the deck aft. They were quietly
+dressed, and save for their size would have attracted no attention,
+and would have been taken for two countrymen on their way to Holland on
+business.
+
+The two detectives were seated forward, their appearance being that of
+two quiet business men, commercial travelers or small traders. The two
+friends first went below, and saw to the cabin which they were to share,
+and found their luggage was all there. Then they returned on deck. Four
+or five other passengers were standing watching the last bales of goods
+coming on board. The tide was just on the turn, and a quarter of an hour
+later the warps were thrown off, and some of the sails hoisted, and the
+Essex began to move through the water.
+
+"Look there, Dick!" Mark exclaimed. "Do you see that boat lying on its
+oars in the middle of the stream? That man sitting in the stern is a
+foreigner, either from Southern Europe or from India."
+
+"He is certainly a dark man, Mark. Still, that may be only a
+coincidence."
+
+"It is rather a curious one," Mark said. "We are too far off to see
+his features, but he is apparently watching us off. There, the oars are
+dipping into the water, now he sees that we are fairly under way."
+
+"Well, Mark, I shall begin to think that you are right. I am bound to
+say that hitherto I thought that it was ridiculous to suppose that
+you could have been watched as you thought, and that you had got these
+diamonds on your brain till you had really become fanciful. However, it
+certainly looks as if you were right; but even if you were, how on earth
+could they have found out that we were going by this ship?"
+
+"That is more than I can tell; if they have been watching me they must
+have known that I was intimate with you; they have seen me come out of
+Cotter's Bank, and afterwards enter your lodgings; they would feel sure
+that I had heard that there would be danger connected with the diamonds,
+and might suppose that I should get some friend to take them from the
+bank, and may have followed your movements as well as mine. In that case
+they would have found out that you also went to Cotter's Bank; may have
+followed you to Tower Street, and found out that you had taken a passage
+for two to Amsterdam. They may again have seen you go to the bank this
+morning and have guessed that you had the diamonds about you, and then
+seeing us together on the wharf would feel pretty certain that it was
+so. One of them may have hired that boat and watched the Essex to see
+that neither of us went on shore again."
+
+"Now they see that we are off they will know that their game is up,"
+Chetwynd said.
+
+"I am not so sure of that, Dick; there are craft going every day to
+Antwerp and Flushing, and for anything we know some of them may be on
+board a craft already dropping down like ourselves by this tide. But
+even if we had twelve hours' start, by landing, say at Flushing, they
+would have time to cross by land to Amsterdam and get there before us."
+
+"Yes, I suppose they would; anyhow, it is pretty certain that we shall
+not be troubled on the voyage."
+
+"Yes, I never thought there was much danger of that, because even if
+they were on board they would see that you and I, being always together,
+could not be got rid of without an alarm being given."
+
+Not until they were passing Greenwich did either of the detectives come
+near Mark, then as he and Dick were standing by the bulwarks, looking
+at the hospital, Chester strolled across the deck and, pointing to the
+building as if asking him some question about it, said:
+
+"There is a colored man forward, dressed as a sailor."
+
+"Is that so?" Mark said. "I see no one aft here who looks suspicious,
+and I don't think they will try anything till we get to Amsterdam. There
+was a colored man in a boat watching us as we set sail."
+
+"I saw him, sir. Can he get to Amsterdam before us?"
+
+"Yes, I have no doubt he can; if he lands at Flushing or Antwerp, and
+takes a post chaise or a diligence, I should say he could get there
+twenty-four hours before us. Certainly he could do so if he landed at
+The Hague, as we have to go a long way round to get into the Zuyder Zee.
+That is where the real danger will be; still you had better keep a sharp
+lookout on the man forward."
+
+No more was said. Mark was not long in getting into conversation with
+the other passengers aft, and later on strolled forward with Dick,
+asking the sailors some questions as to what sort of passage they were
+likely to have, and how the wind suited. The men agreed that unless the
+wind shifted they would not be likely to make a quick passage.
+
+"The wind is northeasterly," one of them said. "We can only just lay
+our course now, and it will be dead against us in some of the reaches.
+Still, I think we shall manage to make down to sea with only a tack or
+two, but when we are once fairly out of the river it will be a long leg
+and a short one, and going up round the Texel it will be dead against
+us. Except that it would be a bit worse if it had a little more east
+in it, it is about as foul a wind as we could have, and I don't see any
+sign of a change, worse luck."
+
+Presently, moving about among them, he got next to Gibbons.
+
+"I don't think we shall have any trouble on board," he said; "if there
+is any, it will be after we have landed. But you can keep an eye on that
+foreign sailor standing alone there up in the bows."
+
+"All right, sir; if you like, I can manage to get into a quarrel with
+him, and can warrant that he won't get out of his berth before it is
+time to go ashore."
+
+"No, I would leave him alone, Gibbons; as long as he is forward he can
+do no harm; but if you see him working his way aft, after it gets dark,
+it will do him no harm if you manage to stumble against him and give him
+a clout on the head."
+
+"All right, sir; if I hit him once he won't want another. The fellow
+seems quiet enough, and as far as strength goes he don't look stronger
+than a girl."
+
+After chatting for some time longer Mark and Dick Chetwynd went aft
+again. The Essex did not put into any intermediate port, and it was only
+on the sixth day after sailing that she approached Amsterdam. The voyage
+had passed off without any incident except that at nine o'clock one
+evening there had been a slight noise on deck and the sound of a fall.
+The friends went up at once. Several of the sailors had run aft, and
+Gibbons was explaining matters to them.
+
+"I was walking up and down the deck," he said, "when I saw this chap
+staring down through the skylight, and I said to him, 'I don't call it
+good manners to be prying down into your betters' cabin.' He did not
+answer or move, so I gave him a push, when he turned upon me like a wild
+cat, and drew his knife from his girdle. There it is, on the other side
+of the deck. As I did not want daylight put into me, I just knocked him
+down."
+
+"Served him right," one of the sailors said. "He had no right to come
+aft at all, and if he drew his knife on you, you were quite right in
+laying him out. But you must have hit him mighty hard, for you have
+knocked the life pretty near out of him. Well, we may as well carry him
+forward and throw a bucket of water over him. That is the worst of these
+foreign chaps; they are always so ready with their knives. However, I
+don't think he will be likely to try his hand on an Englishman again."
+
+Mark and his friend went below again. In the morning Mark asked one of
+the sailors if the foreigner was much hurt.
+
+"Well, he is a good bit hurt, sir. That big chap looks as strong as a
+bullock, and his blow has flattened the foreign chap's nose. He cannot
+see out of his eyes this morning, and is keeping his bunk. They cannot
+stand a blow, those foreign chaps; but I don't suppose that any of us
+would have stood such a blow as that, without feeling it pretty heavy.
+The man who hit him is quite sorry this morning that he hit him quite so
+hot, but, as he says, when a fellow draws a knife on you, you have not
+got much time for thinking it over, and you have got to hit quick and
+hard. I told him he needn't be sorry about it. I consider when a fellow
+draws a knife that hanging aint too bad for him, whether he gets it into
+a man or not."
+
+There was a growl of assent from two or three sailors standing round,
+for in those days the use of the knife was almost unknown in England,
+and was abhorrent to Englishmen, both as being cowardly and unfair, and
+as being a purely foreign crime.
+
+"It will be dark before we get alongside," Mark said to the two
+detectives. "Do you two walk first; we will keep just behind you, and
+the others shall follow as close as they can keep to us. If anyone is
+looking out for us they will see that we are a strong party, and that it
+would be no good to attack us, for even if they were to stab me it would
+not be possible to search me for the diamonds when I am with a party
+like this."
+
+It was indeed quite dark when the brig brought up outside a tier of
+vessels lying by the wharf. A few oil lamps burning by the quay showed
+that there were a good many people still sauntering about. The party
+waited until the rest of the passengers had landed. They learned from
+one of those who knew the place that the hotel to which they were going
+was but three or four hundred yards away, and obtained directions how to
+find it.
+
+"Now we will go," Mark said. "Gibbons, you had better keep a sharp
+lookout on your own account. That fellow you knocked down may try to put
+a knife into you."
+
+"I will keep a sharp lookout, sir, never you fear."
+
+"I think, Tring, you had better watch Gibbons; he is more in danger than
+I am. Have you seen the man go on shore?"
+
+"Yes, he was the very first to cross onto the next vessel," Tring said.
+
+The loungers on the quay had gathered together to watch the passengers
+as they left the ship, and by the dim light from one of the oil lamps it
+could be seen that the majority of them were of the roughest class.
+As they were passing through them a man with a cry of rage sprang at
+Gibbons with an uplifted knife. Tring's fist struck him under the ear as
+he was in the act of striking, and he fell like a log. There was a cry
+of "Down with them!" and a rush of a score of men, most of whom were
+armed with heavy bludgeons.
+
+The party was at once broken up, heavy blows were exchanged, the two
+pugilists rolling their assailants over like ninepins, but receiving
+several heavy blows from their assailants' clubs. A rush of five or
+six men separated Mark from the others. Those in front of him he struck
+down, but a moment later received a tremendous blow on the back of the
+head which struck him to the ground unconscious. His companions were all
+too busy defending themselves against their assailants to notice what
+had been done, and as the attack had taken place in the center of the
+roadway behind the quay, there was no lamp, and the fight was taking
+place in almost total darkness.
+
+By this time many people had run up at the sound of the fray. A minute
+later there was a cry that the watch were coming, and four or five men
+with lanterns emerged from one of the streets leading down to the quays,
+and hurried towards the spot. The fight at once ceased, the men who had
+attacked mingled with the crowd, and when the watch came up they found
+the five Englishmen clustered together and ten or twelve men lying on
+the ground.
+
+The instant that the fight had ceased Dick Chetwynd asked, "Where is Mr.
+Thorndyke?"
+
+No answer was given. The other four men simultaneously uttered
+exclamations of alarm. The crowd was thinning fast as the watch came up.
+
+"What is all this about?" one of them asked in Dutch.
+
+"Do any of you speak English?" Dick asked.
+
+"I do," one of them said.
+
+"We landed five minutes ago from that craft," continued Dick, "and as we
+came across we were attacked by a band of ruffians. An Englishman, one
+of our party, is missing."
+
+"Whose bodies are these?" the watchman asked, raising his lantern and
+pointing to them.
+
+"Perhaps Mr. Thorndyke is among them," Dick Chetwynd said.
+
+The fallen figures were examined by the light of the lanterns. Mark was
+not among them. The watchmen uttered an exclamation of astonishment as
+they looked at the men's faces.
+
+"What did you strike them with?" the one who spoke first asked.
+
+"Struck them with our fists, of course," Gibbons replied. "They will do
+well enough; you need not bother about them, they will come round again
+presently. The question is, Where is Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+The whole of the lookers on had dispersed, each fearing that he might be
+charged with taking part in the outrage.
+
+"This is a very serious matter," Chetwynd said. "We have every reason
+to believe that the attack was premeditated, for the gentleman who is
+missing was known to have some valuables on him; all these fellows ought
+to be taken and locked up and made to give an account of themselves. We
+are going to the Hotel d'Hollande where you can find us at any time. I
+dare say some of these scoundrels are known to you, and that may give
+you a clew as to where Mr. Thorndyke is.
+
+"I have but little hope that he will be found alive; no doubt he has
+been stabbed and his body carried off so that they can search his
+clothes at their leisure. We came in a strong party to prevent the risk
+of an attack upon Mr. Thorndyke. Here is my card. It is of no use our
+attempting to search by ourselves, but if you will get these fellows
+taken to the watch house, and will call at the hotel, we will join your
+party and help you to search the places you think he has most likely
+been taken to."
+
+"I think, sir, you had better come with me to the watch house, and see
+the Lieutenant, and tell him what has happened."
+
+"I will just take my friends to the hotel, and shall be back from there
+before you have got men to take these fellows away. If you go to one of
+those ships and borrow a bucket, empty it over each of them; you will
+find that will bring them to!"
+
+As soon as they arrived at the hotel Dick ordered a private sitting room
+and five bedrooms.
+
+"We have made a terrible mess of this, lads," he said gloomily. "I don't
+say that it is any of our faults, but it is a horrible affair. I have
+not the least doubt that Mr. Thorndyke has been killed, and it is no
+satisfaction to us that we have pretty nearly done for a dozen of those
+scoundrels."
+
+"I would not have had it happen for a hundred pounds, nor a thousand,
+sir. If there had been daylight we could have licked a score of them in
+spite of their bludgeons, but they came with such a rush at us that we
+got separated before we knew where we were. I don't think that it was
+our fault. I feel as much ashamed as if I had thrown up the sponge in
+the ring at the end of the first round. To think that we came over here,
+four of us, and yourself, sir, on purpose to take care of Mr. Thorndyke,
+all well save a few knocks with those sticks, and Mr. Thorndyke killed
+and carried off before we have been on shore five minutes. A better
+young fellow I never put on the gloves with;" and Gibbons passed the
+back of his hand across his eyes.
+
+"Well, I must be off now," Chetwynd said. "I feel heartbroken over it.
+I have known him since we were boys together; and what makes it worse
+is that only three days ago he became engaged to be married. How we are
+going to take the news back God only knows!"
+
+As he hurried down the street towards the wharf he saw a number of
+lanterns coming towards him, and ten or twelve watchmen came along
+escorting the prisoners, many of whose faces were covered with blood;
+then came four other watchmen carrying a body on a stretcher.
+
+"One of them is dead," the watchman who had before spoken said to Dick.
+"A foreign seaman, a Lascar I should say, from his color; we found an
+open knife by his side."
+
+"That is the man who began the fray," Chetwynd said. "He was on the
+point of stabbing one of my companions when another hit him under the
+ear."
+
+"What!" the watchman said. "He must have been hit like the kick of a
+horse. All these prisoners seem to have been struck but once; two of
+them cannot speak. I think their jaws are broken; four of them have
+broken noses, and another has had all his front teeth knocked out, while
+the others are nearly as bad."
+
+"I see you have brought with you some of their bludgeons," Dick said,
+pointing to one of the watchmen carrying a great bundle of sticks over
+his shoulder.
+
+"Yes, sir, twenty-three of them; it certainly seems to show that it
+was a planned thing. Most of these fellows' faces are so bruised that
+I cannot say who they are at present, but two or three are known as the
+worst ruffians in the city, and I have no doubt we shall find that they
+all belong to the same gang."
+
+By this time they had arrived at the watch house, a building of
+considerable size; the prisoners were first lodged in a strong room with
+barred windows and very heavy doors, and then the watchman went with
+Chetwynd to the Lieutenant's room. The officer had just returned, having
+hurried down with a reinforcement to the wharf as soon as he had heard
+of the fray, and tried to obtain some information from the people who
+had gathered round, attracted by the lanterns of the watch. He had
+already learned from the watchmen all they knew about the affair. As he
+spoke English well, he at once addressed Dick:
+
+"This is a serious affair, sir."
+
+"A very serious affair, for, indeed, I am afraid that my dearest friend
+has been murdered."
+
+"Will you kindly give me the particulars?" the officer said, sitting
+down to the table with a pen in his hand.
+
+Dick Chetwynd told him the story of how Mr. Thorndyke, having some very
+valuable jewels that he wished to dispose of, and believing that he
+would be attacked by a band of robbers, had asked him to accompany him,
+and had brought four detective officers and pugilists to protect him
+against any sudden attack.
+
+"Ah, that accounts for the terrible blows that these fellows received,"
+the officer said. "And your friend; was he a strong man?"
+
+"He was a man exceptionally strong, and a match for either of the
+pugilists that he brought over. I have no doubt that he was stabbed,
+though of course he might have been brought down by a blow from one of
+the bludgeons. He must have been completely insensible when carried off.
+
+"The watchman here tells me that three or four of these ruffians are
+known, and perhaps if you will give orders for the blood to be washed
+off the others' faces some more may be recognized and prove an aid in
+enabling you to form an idea where Mr. Thorndyke has been carried. I
+trust that you will send out a party to search for him. I and the four
+men with me will gladly join them, and may be of use if any resistance
+is offered."
+
+The Lieutenant at once gave orders to the watchman to go down and see
+that the prisoners all washed their faces. As soon as he returned with
+the report that this was done the officer went down with Dick Chetwynd
+to examine them. Three or four of the men with lanterns also went in.
+Eight out of eleven men were recognized; the other three, whose features
+were so swollen that they could not see out of their eyes, could not be
+made out, but their companions, on being questioned, gave their names.
+
+"They all belong to a gang of wharf thieves and plunderers. They live
+in a slum near the water. I will have men posted in the lanes leading
+to it, and will myself go with you to see that a search is made of every
+house; but first I will try to find out from these fellows where he was
+to be taken.
+
+"Now, my men," he said, "anyone of you who will tell me where one of the
+party you attacked was to be taken to will find things made easy for him
+at his trial."
+
+None of the men spoke for a minute, and then one said:
+
+"We know nothing about it; how should we, when we were all knocked
+stupid?"
+
+"No, but you might know where he was to be taken."
+
+"I know nothing about that. We all got word to mind we were on the wharf
+when a brig, that was seen coming up, came alongside, and that we were
+to have a hundred francs each for attacking some passengers as they
+landed. Six of them came along together, and one said, 'These are the
+men.' A black sailor came up first and spoke to two or three men in some
+foreign language. I don't know who the men were; it was too dark to see
+their faces. It was one of them who gave the order. It seemed an easy
+job enough when there were twenty-five of us with heavy sticks, but it
+didn't turn out so. I only know that I hit one big fellow a blow that
+ought to have knocked him down, and the next moment there was a crash,
+and I don't know anything more about it until a lot of water was thrown
+over me and one of the watch helped me to my feet. I don't know whether
+the others know more than I do, but I don't think they do."
+
+All the others protested at once that they were equally ignorant. They
+had gone to earn a hundred francs. They had been told that the money was
+all right, but who found it or who were the men to be attacked they had
+not the least idea.
+
+"How was it that you all had these bludgeons--there were no knives found
+on any of you?"
+
+The man who spoke before said:
+
+"The order was 'No knives,' and before we went down to the wharf each
+of us was searched and a stick given to us. I suppose from that, that
+whoever paid for the job didn't want blood to be shed; it suited us well
+enough, for it was a job there was sure to be a row over, and I don't
+suppose any of us wanted to put his head in a noose. I know that we all
+said to each other as we went out that it did not want such sticks as we
+had to give a man a thrashing, but the man who hired us, whoever he was,
+knew his customers better than we did."
+
+The officer translated the man's words as they were spoken to Dick, and
+on hearing the last speech, the latter said:
+
+"Then there is still hope that Thorndyke may only have been stunned;
+that is a greater reason for our losing no time in looking for him, for
+I am afraid that they won't hesitate to kill him when they have got him
+hidden away."
+
+"I expect," the Lieutenant said, "they thought that if any of the watch
+came upon them as they were carrying him off, they might be at once
+arrested if it was found that they were carrying a dead man, whilst if
+he were only stunned they would say that it was a drunken comrade who
+had fallen and knocked his head against something. I agree with you,
+sir; we had better start on our search at once."
+
+"Will you pass the Hotel d'Hollande? If not, I will run and bring my
+men."
+
+"Yes, I will go that way; it will be no further."
+
+Dick walked on fast.
+
+"We have no news of him," he said, as he entered the room where the four
+men were anxiously awaiting him, "but we and the watch are now going to
+search the slums where the men who were taken prisoners all live; come
+down now, and I will tell you what I have learned, before the others
+come up.
+
+"There is reason for believing that he was not stabbed," he went on, as
+they reached the street, "for the men all say that they were armed only
+with clubs, and that the strictest orders were given that none were to
+carry knives, therefore there is little doubt that he was at the time
+only stunned. But I am bound to say that this gives me very small ground
+for hoping that we may find him alive. I fear they only stunned him, so
+that they might carry him safely to their haunts, for if stopped
+they could say that it was a drunken comrade, who had fallen and hurt
+himself. I fear that when they get him into one of their dens they will
+make short work of him, therefore it is clear that there is not a moment
+to be lost. Ah, here comes the watch."
+
+There were eight men with the Lieutenant.
+
+"I have already sent off ten others," he said as he joined Chetwynd, "to
+watch the lanes, and let no one go in or out. I thought it best not to
+lose a moment about that, for when the men see that we have learned
+from the others where the gang came from, and have closed the avenues
+of escape, they will hesitate about murdering their prisoner if he was
+still alive when my men got there."
+
+In a quarter of an hour they arrived at the end of a narrow lane, where
+two watchmen were standing with lanterns.
+
+"You have seen nor heard nothing?" the Lieutenant asked him.
+
+"No, sir, we have not seen a man moving in the lane."
+
+"There is just one hope that we might be in time," the Lieutenant said,
+as he went on down the lane, "and that is, that the fellows when they
+gather will be so dismayed at finding that nearly half their number are
+missing, and knowing that some of them are pretty sure to make a clean
+breast of it, they will hesitate to complete their crime. It is one
+thing to rob a man in the streets, quite another to murder him in cold
+blood. There is likely to be a good deal of difference of opinion among
+them, some of the more desperate being in favor of carrying the thing
+through, but others are sure to be against it, and nothing may have been
+done. You may be sure that the sight of my men at the end of the lanes
+will still further alarm them. I have no doubt the news that we have
+surrounded the district has already been circulated, and that if alive
+now he is safe, for they will think it is better to suffer a year or
+two's imprisonment than to be tried for murder. We are sure to make some
+captures, for it is probable that several of the others will bear marks
+of the fight. Each man we take we will question separately; one or other
+of them is pretty safe to be ready to say where your friend was taken to
+if I promise him that he shan't be prosecuted."
+
+Every house in the district was searched from top to bottom. Six
+men; with cut and bruised faces, were found shamming sleep, and were
+separately questioned closely; all declared that they knew nothing
+whatever of anyone being carried there.
+
+"It is of no use your denying your share in the affair," the Lieutenant
+said. "Your comrades have confessed that there were twenty-five of you
+hired to carry out this, and that you received a hundred francs each.
+Now, if this gentleman is not found, it will be a hanging matter for
+some of you, and you had better tell all you know. If you will tell us
+where he is, I will promise that you shan't be included in the list of
+those who will be prosecuted."
+
+The reply, although put in different words, was identical with that of
+the prisoners.
+
+"We had nothing to do with carrying him off; we were hired only to
+knock the men down who were pointed out to us; not a word was said about
+carrying them off. He may have been carried off, that we cannot say, but
+he has certainly not been brought here, and none of us had anything to
+do with it."
+
+Morning was breaking before the search was concluded. The detectives,
+accustomed as they were to visit the worst slums of London, were
+horrified at the crowding, the squalor, and the misery of the places
+they entered.
+
+"My opinion. Mr. Chetwynd," Gibbons growled, "is that the best thing to
+do would be to put a score of soldiers at the end of all these lanes,
+and then to burn the whole place down, and make a clean sweep of it. I
+never saw such a villainous looking crew in all my life. I have been
+in hopes all along that some of them would resist; it would have been a
+real pleasure to have let fly at them."
+
+"They are a villainous set of wretches, Gibbons, but they may not be all
+criminals."
+
+"Well; I don't know, sir; but I know that if I were on a jury, and any
+of the lot were in the dock, I should not want to hear any evidence
+against them; their faces are enough to hang them."
+
+At last the search was over, and they were glad indeed when they emerged
+from the lanes and breathed the pure air outside, for all the Englishmen
+felt sick at the poisonous air of the dens they had entered. The
+prisoners, as they were taken, had been sent off to the watch house.
+
+"I begin to think that the story these fellows tell is a true one, Mr.
+Chetwynd," the Lieutenant said, "and that they had nothing to do with
+carrying your friend off. In the first place, they all tell the same
+story: that in itself would not be much, as that might have been settled
+beforehand; but it is hardly likely that one of the lot would not have
+been ready to purchase his life by turning on the others. There is very
+little honor among thieves; and as they know that we have taken their
+mates--for no doubt we were watched as we marched them up the town--they
+would make sure that someone would turn traitor, and would think they
+might as well be beforehand. I fancy that the men, whoever they are,
+who hired this gang to attack you, carried out that part of the business
+themselves."
+
+"I am afraid that is so," Dick agreed; "and I fear in that case that he
+is in even worse hands than if these ruffians here had taken him."
+
+"Well, sir, can you furnish us with any clew?"
+
+"The only clew is that they were most probably dark men. That man who
+was killed was undoubtedly one of them. I should say that they would
+probably be got up as foreign sailors."
+
+"Well, that is something to go upon, at any rate. I will send round men
+at once to all the places by the quays where sailors board, and if three
+or four of them have been together at any place we are sure to hear of
+it, and the moment I have news I will send to your hotel."
+
+"Thank you; I don't see that we can be of any use at present, but you
+will find us ready to turn out again the moment we hear that you have
+news."
+
+When the party returned to the hotel they sat talking the matter over
+for upwards of an hour. All were greatly discouraged, for they had
+little hope indeed of ever learning what had become of Mark. As they had
+started out Dick had told the night porter that he could not say what
+time they might return, but that before the house closed he must have a
+couple of bottles of spirits and some tumblers sent up to their sitting
+room, together with some bread and cold meat, for that they might not
+return until morning, and would need something before they went to bed,
+as they had had nothing since their dinner, at one o'clock.
+
+"It wants something to take the taste of that place out of one's mouth,"
+Tring said to Dick, as, directly they entered, he poured some spirits
+into the glasses. "I feel as queer as if I had been hocussed."
+
+All, indeed, were feeling the same, and it was not until they had eaten
+their supper and considerably lowered the spirits in the two bottles
+that they began to talk. The two detectives were the principal speakers,
+and both of these were of opinion that the only shadow of hope remaining
+rested upon Mark himself.
+
+"Unless they finished him before he came round," Malcolm said, "they
+would find him an awkward customer to deal with. Mr. Thorndyke has got
+his head screwed on right, and if, as you say, they are Indians, Mr.
+Chetwynd, I should think that if he once comes fairly round, unless he
+is tied up, he will be a match for them, even with their knives. That is
+the only chance I see. Even if the watch do find out that three or four
+foreign sailors have been at one of the boarding houses and did not turn
+up last night, I don't think we shall be much nearer. They will probably
+only have carried him some distance along the wharf, got to some quiet
+place where there is a big pile of wood, or something of that sort, then
+put a knife into him, searched for the diamonds, which you may be sure
+they would find easily enough wherever he had hidden them, and then make
+off, most likely for Rotterdam or The Hague; they could be at either of
+these places by this time, and will mostly likely divide the diamonds
+and get on board different craft, bound for London or Hull, or indeed
+any other port, and then ship for India. From what Mr. Thorndyke said
+they did not want the diamonds to sell, but only to carry back to some
+temple from which they were stolen twenty years ago."
+
+Chester was of precisely the same opinion.
+
+"I am afraid, Mr. Chetwynd," he added, as they rose to go to their rooms
+for two or three hours' sleep, "the only news that we shall get in the
+morning is that Mr. Thorndyke's body has been found."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX.
+
+
+At ten o'clock a constable came with a message from the Lieutenant to
+Mr. Chetwynd that he would be glad if he would come down to the watch
+house. Dick did not wake the others, but freshening himself up by
+pouring a jug of water over his head, went at once with the constable.
+
+"Have you news?" he asked eagerly as he entered.
+
+"Yes, the men returned an hour ago. At four of the houses they went to
+a foreign sailor had been lodging there for the last day or so, but
+yesterday afternoon all had paid their reckoning and left. Then the idea
+struck me that it would be as well to ask if they had been seen on the
+quays, and I sent off a fresh batch of men to make inquiries. A quarter
+of an hour ago one of them came back with the news that he had learned
+from a sailor that he had noticed a dark colored foreigner, whom he took
+to be a Lascar sailor, talking to a boatman, and that they had rowed off
+together to a barge anchored a short way out; he did not notice anything
+more about him.
+
+"Now, I should not be at all surprised if the fellow went off to arrange
+with the bargeman for a passage for himself and four or five comrades to
+some port or other, it might be anywhere. It would make no difference to
+them where the barge was bound for. No doubt he saw the man again after
+the brig was sighted, and told him that they should come on board soon
+after it got dark, and told him to have the boat at the stairs. You
+see, in that case they might not have carried Mr. Thorndyke above fifty
+yards. They would probably get him on board as one of their party who
+had been drunk. The barge, no doubt, got under way about nine o'clock,
+which is the hour when the tide was high last night, and during the
+night the Indians could easily drop your friend overboard--and may
+even have done so before they got under way, which would have been the
+easiest thing to do. There would have been no one at the helm, and they
+could have chosen a moment when the crew, probably only three, were
+below. I am afraid that this is not a cheering lookout, but I have
+little doubt that it is the correct one.
+
+"I have told my men to find out what barge was lying at the spot the
+sailor pointed out, and if we discover her name, which we are likely to
+be able to do, there will be no difficulty in finding out to whom she
+belongs and where she was bound for. Then we can follow it up; though
+there is little likelihood of our finding the murderers still on board."
+
+"Thank you very much for the pains that you are taking, sir," Dick said.
+"I am afraid that there is no shadow of hope of finding my poor friend
+alive. I have no doubt that the thing has happened exactly as you
+suggest; the whole course of the affair shows how carefully it was
+planned, and I have no hope that any scruple about taking life would be
+felt by them for a moment. I will go back to the hotel, and I shall be
+obliged if you will let me know as soon as you obtain any clew as to the
+barge."
+
+An hour and a half later the officer himself came round to the room
+where Dick Chetwynd and the two pugilists were sitting. The detectives
+had started out to make inquiries on their own account, taking with them
+a hanger on at the hotel who spoke English.
+
+"The barge's name was the Julie," he said; "she has a cargo on board for
+Rotterdam."
+
+"I think the best thing would be to take a carriage, and drive there at
+once," Dick said.
+
+"You can do that, sir, but I don't think you will be there before the
+barge; they have something like eighteen hours' start for you, and the
+wind has been all the time in the east. I should say that they would be
+there by eight o'clock this morning."
+
+"No, I don't know that it would be of any use, but at least it would be
+doing something. I suppose we could be there in four hours?"
+
+"From that to five; but even if the barge were delayed, and you got
+there first, which is very unlikely, I do not think that there would be
+the remotest chance of finding those villains on board. I reckon they
+would, as we agreed, launch the body overboard even before they got
+under way here, and they may either have landed again before the craft
+got under way, pretending that they had changed their minds, and then
+walked across to The Hague or to Haarlem, or have gone on with the barge
+for two hours, or even until daybreak. If by that time they were near
+Rotterdam, they may have stayed on board till they got there; if not,
+they may have landed, and finished the journey on foot, but they would
+certainly not have stopped on board after six or seven o'clock this
+morning. They would calculate that possibly we might get on their track
+at an early hour this morning, and set out in pursuit at once.
+
+"However, it will doubtless be a satisfaction to you to be moving,
+and at least you will be able to overhaul the barge when you get to
+Rotterdam, and to hear what the boatmen say. The chances are they will
+not even have noticed that one of the men who came on board was missing.
+The men may very well have made up a long bundle, carried it on shore
+with them, or three of them may have carried a fourth ashore; and in the
+dark the bargemen were unlikely to have noticed that the number was less
+than when they came on board. However, it will be something for you to
+find out when and where the fellows landed."
+
+"Yes; I should certainly like to lay hands on them, though I am afraid
+we should find it very hard to prove that they had anything to do with
+this affair."
+
+"I think that also, Mr. Chetwynd. Morally, we may feel absolutely
+certain; but, unless the boatmen noticed that one of their number was
+missing when they landed, we have at present no evidence to connect them
+with it."
+
+"We will set out as soon as my other two men return. I told them to be
+back soon after twelve. I will write to you this evening from Rotterdam.
+Ah! here are the men."
+
+The door opened, and, to the stupefaction of the party, Mark Thorndyke
+entered the room.
+
+"Good Heavens, Mark!" Dick exclaimed, springing forward and seizing
+his hand, "is it really you alive in the flesh? We had given you up for
+dead. We have been searching the town for you all night, and were just
+going to set out for Rotterdam in search of a barge on which we believed
+you were carried. Why, it seems almost a miracle!"
+
+The two prize fighters also came forward, and shook hands with a
+pressure that would have made most men shrink.
+
+"I am as glad, Mr. Thorndyke," Gibbons said, "as if anyone had given me
+a thousand pounds. I have never quite given up hope, for, as I said to
+Mr. Chetwynd, if you got but a shadow of a chance, you would polish off
+those nigger fellows in no time; but I was afraid that they never would
+give you a chance. Well, I am glad, sir."
+
+"Mark, this is the Lieutenant of the watch here," Dick said. "He has
+been most kind, and has himself headed the search that has been made for
+you all night. Now tell us all about it."
+
+"First of all give me something to drink, for, except some water, I have
+had nothing since dinner yesterday. You are right, Dick; it is almost a
+miracle, even to me, that I am here. I would not have given a penny for
+my chance of life, and I can no more account for the fact that I am here
+than you can."
+
+Mark drank off a tumbler of weak spirits and water that Gibbons poured
+out for him. Chetwynd rang the bell, and ordered lunch to be brought
+up at once. Just at this moment the two detectives came in, and were
+astonished and delighted at finding Mark there.
+
+"Now," he said, "I will tell you as much as I know, which is little
+enough. When I came to my senses I found myself lying on the deck of a
+craft of some sort; it was a long time before I could at all understand
+how I got there. I think it was the pain from the back of my head that
+brought it to my mind that I must have been knocked down and stunned in
+that fight; for some time I was very vague in my brain as to that, but
+it all came back suddenly, and I recalled that we had all got separated.
+I was hitting out, and then there was a crash. Yes, I must have been
+knocked down and stunned, and I could only suppose that in the darkness
+and confusion I had been carried off and taken on board without any of
+you missing me; my hands and feet were tied, and there was something
+shoved into my mouth that prevented me from speaking.
+
+"I should think that it must have been an hour before I quite recovered
+my senses, and got the thing fairly into my mind. Then a man with a
+knife leant over me, and made signs that if I spoke he would stab me,
+and another took the gag out of my mouth and poured some water down my
+throat, and then put it in again. I saw that he was a dark colored man,
+and I then understood it all; it was those Hindoos who had got up the
+attack upon us and had carried me off. I had no doubt they had got the
+diamonds I had sewn up in the waistband of my trousers.
+
+"I wondered why they were keeping me, but was sure they would stab
+me presently and throw me overboard. I knew that they had killed two
+soldiers for the sake of the diamonds, and if it hadn't been that they
+had given me the water, I should not have had a shadow of doubt about my
+fate."
+
+"I puzzled over why they should have done so, and came to the conclusion
+that they dared not do it on board, because of the crew, and that they
+intended to take me on shore somewhere, and there dispose of me. I made
+many attempts to loosen my ropes, but they would not give the slightest.
+At last I think I dozed off for a time. After I had had the water they
+drew a blanket or something of that sort over me. It had been there
+before, but it had only been pulled up as high as my nose, and I felt
+sure that it was only done to prevent the Dutchmen on the boat seeing
+that I was bound and gagged; this time they pulled it right over my
+face. When they took it off again I could see it was nearly morning, for
+there was a faint light in the sky. They were moving about on the deck,
+and presently I saw one of the sailors get into the boat and pull it
+along, hand over hand, by the rail, until he was close to me. Then four
+Lascar sort of chaps--I could scarcely make out their features--lifted
+me and lowered me into the boat and got in themselves.
+
+"I did not attempt to struggle. No doubt they had made up some tale
+that I was mad or something of that sort, and I thought that I had best
+pretend to be quiet and peaceable till I could see some sort of chance
+of making a fight for it. It was but a few yards from the shore. The man
+lifted me out onto the bank, and the sailor then started to row back
+to the barge; they carried me a few yards away, and then laid me face
+downwards on some grass. Now, I thought to myself, it is all over; they
+are going to stab me and make off. To my surprise I felt they were
+doing something--I could not make out what--to the ropes; then there
+was quiet. I lay there I should think for half an hour, wondering why
+on earth they did not finish me. At last I made up my mind to move,
+and turned round onto my back. As I lay there I could see no one, and,
+raising my head, looked round. To my amazement I found that I was alone.
+It was now almost light, and as I craned my head in all directions I
+assured myself that they had gone; then I began to try again at the
+ropes.
+
+"To my surprise I found that they were much looser than they were
+before, although still tight enough to give me nearly an hour's work
+before I got my hands free. Then it took me almost as long to get
+the ropes off my legs, for they had knotted them in such a fearfully
+intricate way that it was a long time before I could even discover where
+the ends were. At last I finished the job, stood up, and looked round. A
+quarter of a mile off there was a good sized town, but not a soul could
+I see.
+
+"Till now I had hardly thought of the diamonds; I put my hands to my
+waistband and found, as I expected, that they were gone. I think I felt
+nothing but pleasure: the confounded things had given trouble enough,
+and I was well rid of them. Why they should have spared my life I could
+not imagine. If they had finished me, which they could have done without
+any risk to themselves when they got me ashore, they could have gone off
+with the diamonds without the slightest fear of pursuit, while now there
+was, of course, a chance that I might follow and recognize them."
+
+"Would you know them again?" the Lieutenant interrupted.
+
+"Not in the slightest; it was light enough to see that they were dark,
+but from the time the boat came along the blanket was over my head,
+and except when they gave me the water I had no chance of seeing any
+of their features. Still, if I had gone straight to the town I saw and
+reported the matter to the authorities and sent mounted men to all the
+ports to warn them not to let any colored men embark, I might have given
+them a lot of trouble, but I don't suppose any of them would ever have
+been caught. After the craft they had shown in the whole matter, it is
+certain that they would have laid their plans for escape so well
+that the law would never have laid hands upon them. I put my hand
+mechanically to my watch to see the time, and to my astonishment
+discovered that I still had it in my pocket, and was equally surprised
+to find that the money in my trousers' pockets was also untouched. The
+watch had, of course, stopped. I first of all went down to the water and
+had a good wash; then I proceeded to the town, and, going to a hotel,
+ordered breakfast."
+
+"Why, I thought you said that you had had nothing to eat, Mark."
+
+"Yes? Well, I had forgotten all about that breakfast. The people looked
+a good deal surprised at an Englishman walking in in that way. While
+I was eating my breakfast two men--who were, I suppose, authorities of
+some kind--who spoke English, came and questioned me. As I had made up
+my mind to say nothing more about the affair, I merely told them that I
+had come for a sail from Amsterdam, and that I wanted a carriage to take
+me back. They were evidently astonished at my choosing a dark night for
+such a trip, but I said that I had some curiosity to see how the boatmen
+navigated their vessel when there were no lighthouses or anything to
+steer by. They asked a few more questions, and then went away, evidently
+thinking that I was a little mad. However, they must have spoken to the
+landlord, who in a short time made signs that the carriage was at the
+door.
+
+"I had avoided asking the men either the name of the place or how far
+it was from any big town, because that would have made the whole affair
+more singular. It was a quarter past eight when I started, and beyond
+the fact that I know by the sun we came pretty nearly due east, I have
+not the slightest idea of the road. The coachman could not speak a word
+of English. I should say we came about seven miles an hour and stopped
+once to bait the horses, so I suppose that it must have been between
+four and five miles from Rotterdam when I landed."
+
+Lunch had by this time been laid on the table, and at Dick's invitation
+the Lieutenant joined them.
+
+"It is an extraordinary story!" he said. "That your life should have
+been spared is altogether beyond my comprehension, still more so why
+they should have left you your money and watch."
+
+"The whole story is extraordinary," Dick Chetwynd said; "for we have
+every reason to believe that those fellows, or at least one or two of
+them, have been patiently watching for a chance of carrying off those
+diamonds for twenty years. When my friend told me of it ten days ago I
+did not believe that it could be possible; but he has certainly shown
+that he was correct in his opinion."
+
+Mark then related the history of the jewels, surprising the pugilists
+and detectives as much as the Lieutenant.
+
+"It is extraordinary indeed," the latter said. "I should not have
+believed it possible that men would devote so many years to such a
+purpose, nor that they could have succeeded in tracing the diamonds in
+spite of the precaution taken by your uncle, and afterwards by yourself.
+It would seem that from the time he landed in England he, and after him
+your father and yourself, must have been watched almost night and day.
+I can understand now why they did not take your watch and money.
+They evidently acted from a sort of religious enthusiasm, and were no
+ordinary thieves, but as evidently they did not hesitate to kill, I
+cannot understand why they should have added to their risks by sparing
+you."
+
+"No, that is what puzzles me," Mark agreed. "I was thinking it over
+while we were driving here. Now let me hear about the fight, Dick. How
+did you all come out of it?"
+
+"As well as could be expected. Gibbons and Tring both got some heavy
+blows with the cudgels, as indeed we all did more or less, but they did
+great execution. Eleven fellows were left senseless on the ground, and
+one of them, that black fellow who came over with us, was killed. The
+other ten are all in prison. All of us did our best, and managed to
+leave our mark on eight others, who were in consequence picked out, and
+are also in jail."
+
+Dick went on to relate the particulars of the search.
+
+"You see, our friend here had traced you to the barge and found out her
+destination, and if you had come ten minutes later you would have found
+that we had all just started for Rotterdam. I was only waiting for
+Chester and Malcolm to return to set out. I am sorry, Mark, that you
+have lost your diamonds; not so much because they are gone, for I can
+well understand you to be thoroughly glad to be rid of such dangerous
+articles, but because they have carried them off in our teeth, after we
+have been specially retained to protect you. I certainly thought that
+with such a bodyguard you were absolutely safe from any number of
+Hindoos."
+
+"Yes, we made a regular mess of it, Mr. Thorndyke," Gibbons said. "I
+never felt so certain of winning a battle as I did that you would not
+be touched as long as we were looking after you. Tring and I, if we had
+been asked, would have said that we could each have taken on a dozen
+foreigners easily. Mr. Chetwynd is handy with his fists too, though he
+hasn't your weight and reach, and your two other friends are both pretty
+well accustomed to deal with rough customers. As for Tring and me, it
+makes one feel small to know that we have been bested by a handful of
+niggers, or Hindoos, or whatever the chaps are, whom a good sized boy of
+twelve ought to be able to polish off."
+
+"Now, Mark, what is to be done next?" Dick Chetwynd asked.
+
+"The next thing will be to get back as soon as we can, Dick. I, for one,
+have had enough of Holland to last me for a lifetime."
+
+"I am afraid, gentlemen," the Lieutenant said, "you will have to wait
+a day or two before you can leave. I have nineteen men in prison, and
+there will be a meeting of magistrates this afternoon. Now you have come
+back, Mr. Thorndyke, the charge against them won't be as serious as
+it would have been before, but they are guilty of a desperate and
+premeditated assault upon six passengers on their arrival here; they
+have already admitted that they were paid for their work; and as among
+them are some of the worst characters in the city, you may be sure that
+now we have got them fairly in our hands we shall not let them go. It is
+so simple an affair that the investigation ought not to take long, but
+we shall want to find out, if we can, who acted as the intermediary
+between the Hindoos and the prisoners. I should think that two meetings
+ought to be sufficient for the present, but I am afraid that there may
+then be a long remand, and that you will either have to remain here or
+to come over again."
+
+"It would be a horrible nuisance," Dick said; "still it would be better
+to come back again than to wait here indefinitely, and anyhow I don't
+suppose it would be necessary for all of us to come back again."
+
+"I should not mind if it could be arranged for me to be here again in a
+month's time," Mark agreed, "for, to tell you the truth, I am going to
+be married in less than three weeks, and as I had intended to come to
+Brussels, and afterwards to travel for a while, I could make a visit
+here without greatly putting myself out."
+
+"I will try and arrange that, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"I shall be glad," Mark said, "if you can manage to get the men
+sentenced without going into the question of the diamonds at all, and
+treat the matter as a mere attempt at robbery. It surely would not be
+necessary to bring the question of my being carried away into the matter
+at all; I can give evidence that I was knocked down and stunned, and
+that I was robbed of some jewels that I had about me, which were the
+object of the attack."
+
+"I think we should have to admit that," the Lieutenant said; "it must
+come out that the attack was an organized one."
+
+"Well, if it must, it must," Mark said reluctantly; "but then, you see,
+no end of questions would be asked, and the thing might be delayed while
+a search is being made for the men who stole the bracelet."
+
+"Well, we will keep it out of the inquiry if we can," the Lieutenant
+said. "The meeting will be at three o'clock. I will send a man to take
+you to the Town Hall."
+
+At the appointed hour the party proceeded to the court, and the eighteen
+prisoners, under a strong guard, having been brought in, six magistrates
+took their places on the bench; the rest of the court was crowded, the
+fray on the wharf and the number of captures having created quite a
+stir in the city. They had arranged that Tring should first give
+his evidence, which he did, the Lieutenant of the watch acting as
+interpreter, though most of the magistrates understood English. The
+appearance of the prisoners created quite a sensation in the court, for
+the injuries that they had received were now even more conspicuous than
+they had been when they were first captured; some of them had to be led
+into court, their eyes being completely closed, others had their heads
+bandaged, and all showed signs of tremendous punishment. Tring related
+that he, with five others, had come ashore together; one of his
+companions had a row on board a ship they had crossed in, with a
+Lascar sailor, who was a passenger, and they kept together as they were
+crossing the wharf, thinking that possibly the man might attempt to stab
+his companion.
+
+"I was walking behind him," Tring went on, "when the Lascar jumped
+suddenly out from among the men standing about, and was about to stab my
+companion, when I hit him just in time, and he went down; then there was
+a rush, and we all got separated, and did as well as we could until the
+watch came up; that is all that I know about it."
+
+"Is the Lascar among the prisoners?" one of the magistrates asked the
+Lieutenant of the watch.
+
+"No, sir, when picked up by one of my men he was found to be dead; the
+blow had apparently killed him instantly."
+
+The other five then gave their evidence; it was similar to that of
+Tring, save that being in front of him they knew nothing of the attack
+by the Lascar. All they knew about it was that there was a sudden
+rush upon them by a number of men armed with bludgeons, that they were
+separated, and that each defended himself until the guard came up.
+
+Some of the watch then gave evidence, and told how on arriving at
+the spot eleven of the prisoners were found lying senseless; how, on
+recovering, they were all taken to the watch house, where several of
+them were recognized as notoriously bad characters; they had admitted
+that they were paid to make the attack, which was apparently the result
+of the private enmity of some person or persons unknown to one or more
+of those attacked.
+
+The Lieutenant then related the steps that he had taken to capture
+others connected with the attack, and that he found eight men bearing
+marks of the fray, and that all these were also notorious characters,
+and associates of the prisoners first taken. The first witnesses were
+again questioned; five of them said that, so far as they knew, they had
+no personal enemies. Mark, who was the last to get into the witness box,
+said that he himself had no enemies, but that an uncle of his, who was
+in the British Indian service, had a sort of feud with some members of
+a sect there on account of some jewels that he had purchased, and which
+had, they declared, been stolen from a temple. Two soldiers through
+whose hands these things had passed, had been successively killed by
+them, and his uncle had to the day of his death believed that their
+vengeance would one day fall upon him.
+
+"I can only suppose," continued Mark, "that I have inherited the enmity
+they bore him, as I inherited the jewels, and that the attack was really
+designed solely against me, and the consequences might have been
+fatal to me had it not been for the strength and courage of my fellow
+passengers."
+
+"Did they come with you for your protection, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"To some extent, yes. The fact is, that I have for some time been
+convinced that I was followed about by natives of India, and remembering
+what my uncle had said on the subject, I became to some degree
+apprehensive, and thought it as well to leave London for a short time.
+That this attack was really instigated by the men I have no doubt
+whatever, since, as you have heard, it was begun by a Lascar, who tried
+to stab one of my companions and who received a knockdown blow that
+caused his death from one of the others. It is a well known fact that
+these people will cherish for many years a determination to avenge any
+injury. However, I hope that after the failure of this attempt upon my
+life I shall hear no more of them."
+
+"Were any knives found on the prisoners?" the magistrates asked the
+Lieutenant of the watch.
+
+"No, sir; all carried clubs. And they told me that they had been
+especially ordered not to take knives, and had indeed been searched
+before they came out."
+
+"What impression do you gather from that, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"My impression is, sir, that they desired to overpower those with me and
+to beat them down, in order to carry out their revenge upon me."
+
+After some consultation the magistrate who had before spoken said:
+
+"The prisoners will be remanded. It is necessary that we should find out
+who was the chief culprit who bribed this gang."
+
+As soon as the prisoners were taken out of court Mark slipped across to
+the magistrates, accompanied by the Lieutenant as interpreter.
+
+"I hope, gentlemen, that our presence here will not be necessary, for it
+would be a matter of extreme inconvenience. I may say that my marriage
+is fixed for today three weeks, hence you can well imagine that I want
+to return as soon as possible. Two of the men are, as you have heard,
+Bow Street officers, whose presence could not well be spared."
+
+The magistrates again consulted together.
+
+"Your evidence has all been taken down by the clerk of the court.
+Certainly we should not require your presence at the remand; but whether
+we should do so at the trial would, of course, depend upon whether these
+men all own their guilt, which, having been taken red handed, it is
+likely enough they will do. We will consent, therefore, to your leaving,
+if you will give us an undertaking to return for the trial if your
+presence is necessary, and that you will bring with you the man who
+struck down the Lascar who commenced the fray, and one of the others."
+
+"That I will do willingly," Mark replied. "We are much obliged to
+you for your consideration. I shall be traveling for a time after my
+marriage; but I will as I pass through Belgium after my marriage give
+you the route I intend to take and the address at which letters will
+find me, and if you send me a sufficiently long notice I will at once
+return for the trial."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXI.
+
+
+"You managed that very well, Mark," Dick said. "You kept well within the
+limits of truth without bringing the real facts of the attack upon us
+into the case."
+
+"Well, you see, Dick, after working as a detective, one gets into the
+way of telling stories with the smallest amount of deviation possible
+from the truth. What will these fellows get done to them, Lieutenant?"
+
+"I should say that they will get two or three years imprisonment; the
+only charge now is rioting and assault. It is lucky for them that they
+had clubs instead of knives, for that would have brought the matter
+under the head of attempted murder. The matter of the gems was not
+important in the case, but there is sure to be a great fuss and search
+for the missing Indians. I suppose you will soon be off home now?"
+
+"Yes, I shall find out tonight what vessel leaves for England tomorrow,
+and take a berth in the first that sails for London. It is too late to
+think of starting this evening, and indeed I feel that I want a long
+night's rest, for I did not sleep much last night, and have not quite
+recovered from that crack on my head."
+
+On his return to the hotel Mark sent out a man to inquire at the
+shipping offices, and finding that a bark would sail at nine o'clock
+the next morning, they went down and took berths, and sailed in her next
+day. The voyage home was a rapid one, for the wind blew steadily from
+the east, and the vessel made the passage to the mouth of the river in
+two days, and the next took them up to London.
+
+"I will call round tomorrow or next day, Gibbons, with the checks for
+you both," Mark said as he prepared to go ashore.
+
+"No, sir. We are both of one mind that we could not take them. We went
+over to prevent you being robbed of those sparklers, and to see that you
+came to no harm. Well, the things are lost, and you got knocked down
+and carried away. It is no thanks to us that you are alive now. It is a
+mortifying job, that with two detectives to watch over things and with
+us to fight we should have been fairly beat by a few black niggers."
+
+"If there had been any bungling on your part, Gibbons, there might be
+something in what you say, but no one could have foreseen that before we
+had been on shore two minutes we should have been attacked in that way.
+You both did all that men could do, as was shown by the condition of
+the fellows who were taken. I was just as much separated from you as you
+were from me, and the fact that we were surprised as we were is really
+due to my not determining to stay on board until the morning, which I
+could no doubt have done with the captain's permission. It never struck
+me for a moment that we should be attacked in force. I thought it
+probable that an attempt at assassination would be made, but it
+certainly did not seem probable that it would be attempted while you
+were all with me. You are not in the slightest degree to blame, for
+your part of the agreement was carried out to my satisfaction. I shall
+certainly carry out mine, as I have arrived home safe and sound."
+
+"Well, governor, it is very good of you; but I tell you it will go
+against the grain for us to take your money."
+
+On landing, Mark parted with Dick Chetwynd, who had arranged to drop
+Mark's bag at his lodgings on his way home, and at once took a hackney
+coach to Islington. Millicent gave a cry of delight as he entered the
+room.
+
+"You are back earlier than I expected, Mark. You told me before you
+started that the wind was in the east, and that you might be a long time
+getting to Amsterdam unless it changed. I have been watching the vane on
+the church, and it has been pointing east ever since.
+
+"Well, you have sold the diamonds, I hope?" she said, after the first
+greeting was over.
+
+"No; I have bad news for you, Millicent; the jewels have been stolen."
+
+"Well it does not make much difference, Mark. We have much more than
+enough without them, so don't bother yourself in the least. How did it
+happen?"
+
+"Well, it is rather a long story. I will tell it you when Mrs.
+Cunningham is here, so as not to have to go over it twice. How are the
+dresses getting on?"
+
+"I suppose they are getting on all right," she said. "I have done
+nothing for the last two days but try them on. You see, we put them
+out to three milliners, and they all three seem to reach the same point
+together, and I start after breakfast, and it takes about two hours at
+each place. You don't know what trouble you have given me by hurrying
+things on so unreasonably."
+
+"Well, it is better to have it all done and over," he said, "than to
+have the thing hanging over you for a couple of months."
+
+"That is what Mrs. Cunningham says. Now I want to hear about your
+adventures, and I will call her down."
+
+
+"Only think, Mrs. Cunningham," Millicent said presently, with a laugh,
+after she had returned with her, "this silly boy has actually let the
+diamonds be stolen from him."
+
+
+"No, really, Millicent!"
+
+"Yes, indeed. Fancy his not being fit to be trusted to look after them!
+However, I tell him it is of no consequence. I don't know how they went.
+He would not tell me the story until you came down."
+
+"I am sorry to say it is true, Mrs. Cunningham, although I can assure
+you that I really cannot blame myself for either carelessness or
+stupidity. I knew when I started that there was a very great risk, and
+took what seemed to me every possible precaution, for in addition to
+Dick Chetwynd going with me, I took two detectives from Bow Street and
+two prize fighters."
+
+Exclamations of surprise broke from both ladies.
+
+"And yet, in spite of all that, these things were stolen," Millicent
+said. "How on earth did they do it? I should have sewn them up in my
+pockets inside my dress."
+
+"I sewed them up in the waistband of my trousers, Millicent, and yet
+they managed, in spite of us, to steal them. And now I must begin by
+telling you the whole history of those diamonds, and you will understand
+why I thought it necessary to take a strong party with me."
+
+He then told them, repeating the history the Colonel had given his
+father of the diamonds, and the conviction that he had, that he had been
+followed by Hindoos, and the instructions he had given for the disposal
+of the bracelet.
+
+"As you know," he said, "nothing happened to confirm my uncle's belief
+that there were men over here in search of the diamonds during my
+father's life, but since then I have come to the same conclusion that he
+had, and felt positive that I was being constantly followed wherever I
+went. As soon as I heard where the treasure was I began to take every
+precaution in my power. I avoided going to the bank after my first visit
+there, and, as you know, would not bring the things for you to look
+at. I got Dick Chetwynd to go there, open the case, and take out these
+diamonds. He did not bring them away with him, but fetched them from
+there the morning we started. He went down and took the passage for us
+both at the shipping office, and the pugilists and the detectives each
+took passages for themselves, so that I hoped, however closely I was
+followed, they would not learn that I was taking them to Amsterdam."
+
+"It was very wrong, Mark; very wrong indeed," Millicent broke in. "You
+had no right to run such a terrible risk; it would have been better for
+you to have taken the diamonds and thrown them into the Thames."
+
+"That would not have improved matters," he said; "the Indians would not
+have known that I had got rid of them, and would have continued their
+efforts to find them, and I should always have been in danger instead
+of getting it over once for all. However, I did not think that there was
+any danger, going over as I did, with two of the best prize fighters
+in England, to say nothing of the detectives, who were the men who
+were with me when I caught Bastow. The only danger was that I might be
+stabbed; but, as they would know, it was no use their stabbing me unless
+they could search me quietly, and that they could not do unless I was
+alone and in some lonely neighborhood, and I had made up my mind not to
+stir out unless the whole party were with me. I found out, when we got
+on board that in spite of all the precautions I had taken, they had
+discovered that I was going to sail for Amsterdam, which they could only
+have done by following Dick as well as myself. There was a dark faced
+foreign sailor, who, I had no doubt, was a Hindoo, already on board, and
+I saw another in a boat watching us start; this was unpleasant, but as
+I felt sure that they could not have known that I had with me detectives
+and pugilists, I still felt that they would be able to do nothing when I
+got to Amsterdam."
+
+Then he told them the whole story of the attack, of his being carried
+away, and of his unexpected release; of the search that had been made
+for him and the arrest of eighteen of his assailants. Millicent grew
+pale as he continued, and burst into tears when she heard of his being a
+prisoner in the hands of the Hindoos.
+
+"I shall never let you go out of my sight again, Mark!" she exclaimed
+when he had finished. "It was bad enough before when you were searching
+for that man here, and I used to be terribly anxious; but that was
+nothing to this."
+
+"Well, there is an end of it now, Millicent; the men have got the
+diamonds, and will soon be on their way to India, if they have not
+started already."
+
+"Nasty things!" she said; "I shall never like diamonds again: they will
+always remind me of the terrible danger that you have run. Isn't it
+extraordinary that for twenty years four or five men should be spending
+their lives waiting for a chance of getting them back!"
+
+"I do not expect there were so many as that; probably there was only
+one. He would have no difficulty in learning that my father had not
+received any extraordinary gems from my uncle, and probably supposed
+that they would not be taken out from wherever they might be until you
+came of age. After the death of my father he might suppose that I should
+take them out, or that, at any rate, I should go to whoever had them,
+and see that they were all right, and he then, perhaps, engaged half a
+dozen Lascars--there are plenty of them at the docks--and had me watched
+wherever I went; and, do you know, that I believe I once owed my life to
+them."
+
+"How was that, Mark?"
+
+"Well, I was captured by some fellows who suspected me to be a Bow
+Street runner, and I think that it would have gone very hard with me
+if a party of five or six prize fighters had not broken into the house,
+pretty nearly killed the men in whose hands I was, and rescued me. They
+said that they had heard of my danger from a foreign sailor who called
+at Gibbons', with whom I was in the habit of boxing, and told him about
+it. You see, until they learned where the jewels were, my life was
+valuable to them, for possibly I was the only person who knew where they
+were hidden; so really I don't think I have any reason for bearing a
+grudge against them. They saved my life in the first place, and spared
+it at what was a distinct risk to themselves. On the other hand, they
+were content with regaining the bracelet, not even, as I told you,
+taking my watch or purse. You see, with them it was a matter of
+religion. They had no animosity against me personally, but I have no
+doubt they would have stabbed me without the slightest compunction had
+there been no other way of getting the things. Still, I think that I owe
+a debt of gratitude to them rather than the reverse, and, after all, the
+loss of the bracelet is not a serious one to us."
+
+"I am glad it is gone," Millicent said. "You say it had already caused
+the death of two men, and if you had succeeded in selling it I can't
+help thinking that the money would have brought ill fortune to us. I am
+heartily glad that the diamonds are gone, Mark. I suppose they were very
+handsome?"
+
+"They were magnificent," he said. "Dick and Cotter both agreed that they
+had never seen their equal, and I fancy that they must have been worth a
+great deal more than your father valued them at."
+
+"Well, it does not matter at all. There is no history attached to the
+others, I hope, Mark?"
+
+"Not in any way, dear. They were bought, as the Colonel told my father,
+in the ordinary course of things, and some, no doubt, were obtained at
+the capture of some of the native princes' treasuries; but it was solely
+on account of this bracelet that he had any anxiety. You can wear all
+the others, if you have a fancy for keeping them, without a shadow of
+risk."
+
+"No, Mark, we will sell them every one. I don't think that I shall ever
+care to wear any jewels again; and if I am ever presented at court and
+have to do so, I would rather that you should buy some new ones fresh
+from a jeweler's shop than wear anything that has come from India."
+
+"To-morrow you shall both go to the bank with me to see them, and then I
+will take them to some first-class jeweler's and get him to value them."
+
+The visit was paid next day. Both Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham were
+somewhat disappointed at the jewels.
+
+"It is hardly fair to see them like this," Philip Cotter said. "They
+would look very different if reset. No Indian jewels I have ever seen
+show to advantage in their native settings; but many of the stones are
+very large, and without knowing anything about them I should say that
+they are worth the 50,000 pounds at which you say Colonel Thorndyke
+valued them. He was not likely to be mistaken. He was evidently a judge
+of these matters, and would hardly be likely to be far wrong."
+
+"We will go with you to the jeweler's, Mark," Millicent said. "In the
+first place, I shall not feel quite comfortable until I know that they
+are out of your hands, and in the next place I should like to hear what
+he thinks of them."
+
+"I have a number of Indian jewels that I wish you to value for me," Mark
+said, as, carrying the case, he entered the jeweler's shop. "They were
+collected by Colonel Thorndyke, an uncle of mine, during service in
+India."
+
+The jeweler took them with him into a room behind the shop. The case was
+opened, and the man took out sixty-eight small parcels it contained, and
+opened them one after the other.
+
+"I shall need a very careful examination of these before I can form any
+estimate of their value," he said, after inspecting some of the more
+important pieces of jewelry carefully. "They are a most magnificent
+collection, and had they been properly cut in the first place they would
+have been worth a very large sum. Unfortunately, the Indian princes
+think more of size than of lustre, and have their stones cut very much
+too flat to show off their full brilliancy. Some of these large ones I
+should certainly advise to be recut, for what they will lose in weight
+they will gain in beauty and value. However, sir, I will go through them
+and give you an estimate of the selling value of each piece. I need not
+say that they ought all to be reset in the prevailing fashion; but
+the gold, which is in some cases unnecessarily massive, will go some
+distance towards defraying the expense."
+
+"When shall I call again?" Mark asked.
+
+"I should be glad if you can give me a week," the jeweler said. "Some
+of the things, for instance that great pearl necklace, I could appraise
+without much difficulty, but all the gems must be taken out of their
+settings before I could form a fair idea of their value."
+
+"Then I will call in a week's time," Mark said. "I am in no particular
+hurry about them, but I would rather that they were in your care than
+mine."
+
+"Yes, if the cracksmen got word that there was such a collection as this
+in any private house it would need a couple of men with pistols to keep
+guard over them."
+
+A week later Mark again called.
+
+"I have the list ready for you, sir; you will see that they are not
+marked according to their setting, but according to their size and
+value. Thus, you see, the largest stones are priced separately; the
+smaller ones are in groups according to their weight. The total comes
+to 42,000 pounds. I do not know whether that at all equals your
+expectations. I may say that I have shown the stones to two or three of
+our principal diamond merchants, and that the prices I have put down are
+those at which they would be willing to buy them; possibly some would be
+worth more. I had the merchants here together, and they spent some hours
+going through them, and the sums put down are those at which one or
+other were willing to purchase."
+
+"It quite answers my expectations," Mark said. "My uncle's estimate,
+indeed, was somewhat higher, but doubtless he judged them at the price
+which they would fetch in India. Well, sir, I authorize you to close
+with the offers, and to dispose of them for me. I will give you a
+written authority to do so. In the meantime, I wish to buy a suite of
+jewels as a wedding present, a tiara, necklace, and bracelets; but I do
+not want any diamonds to be among them."
+
+"I am afraid I have nothing in stock without diamonds; of course, I have
+both necklaces and bracelets of almost any stones that you might select,
+but I have no complete set without diamonds; the effect would be somber,
+and few ladies would like them."
+
+"We have some unpleasant associations with diamonds," Mark said, "and
+on that point I am quite determined; but if you used pearls instead of
+diamonds the effect might be as good. I don't care whether the stones
+are emeralds or rubies; at any rate, I should like to see some, and then
+perhaps you might be able to make me a set on the same model."
+
+Several superb sets were brought in; Mark selected one of emeralds and
+diamonds.
+
+"What would be the price of this set?" he asked.
+
+"That set is 6000 pounds, sir; the stones are exceptionally fine ones;
+but if you substituted pearls of equal size for the diamonds, it would
+cost considerably less; I could not give you the exact price until it is
+made, but I should say that it would be about 4500 pounds."
+
+"Very well, then, I will take that. How long will it be making?"
+
+"I should not like to say less than three months at the earliest; it
+will require some time to collect as fine a set of emeralds as these.
+Indeed, I think that most probably I shall use these emeralds, or the
+greater part of them, and collect others to take their places at my
+leisure. I do not know whether the best plan would not be to take the
+diamonds out and substitute pearls; there would be no difficulty in
+getting them, and in that case I might have it ready for you in a
+month."
+
+"I think that will be the best plan; but you need not be in any
+particular hurry about them. My marriage will take place in less than
+a fortnight, and after that I shall probably be three or four months
+before I return to London. I will get you to keep the things until I
+come back."
+
+"I have sold the jewels, Millicent," he said, when he returned to
+Islington; "the jeweler has found purchasers for them all, and the total
+comes to 42,000 pounds."
+
+"Whatever shall we do with all our money, Mark?"
+
+"I rather wonder myself, dear. However, there is one thing, there are
+always plenty of people who will be glad to relieve us of anything that
+we don't want. I can tell you that in the course of my search for Bastow
+I have seen an amount of poverty and misery such as I never dreamt of,
+and I certainly should like to do something to relieve it. The best
+thing that I know of would be to give a handsome sum to three or four
+of the great hospitals. I don't know of any better means of helping the
+very poor."
+
+"Suppose, Mark," the girl said, putting her hand on his arm, "we give
+this 42,000 pounds as a thank offering. We never expected to get it,
+and my father's jewels have nearly cost you your life. We have such an
+abundance without that, I should like, above all things, to give this
+money away."
+
+"I think that is an excellent plan, Millicent, and a very happy thought
+on your part. We cannot do it now, as we have not yet got the money, but
+as soon as we do we will send off checks for 10,000 guineas each to St.
+Bartholomew's, Guy's, and St. Thomas'--those are the three principal
+ones; the others we can settle afterwards. But I should say that the
+Foundling would be as good as any, and I believe that they are rather
+short of funds at present; then there is the London Mendicity Society,
+and many other good charities. Perhaps it would be better to divide the
+whole among eight of them instead of four; but we need not settle that
+until we return."
+
+"Do you think we shall have to go to this horrid Amsterdam, Mark?"
+
+"I hope not, dear; but I shall no doubt hear from the Lieutenant of the
+watch during the next week or ten days."
+
+When the letter came it was satisfactory. The prisoners, seeing the
+hopelessness of any defense, had all admitted their guilt, and the name
+of the man who had dealt with them had also been given up. Except in his
+case there would be no trial. The others would have sentences passed
+on them at once, and three, who had been promised comparatively slight
+punishment, would go into the box to give evidence against the man
+who had engaged them. Before starting for Holland Mark had consulted
+Millicent as to whether she would prefer being married in London or at
+Crowswood. She had replied:
+
+"I should greatly prefer Crowswood, Mark. Here we know no one, there we
+should be among all our friends; certainly if we don't go we must get
+Mr. Greg to come up and marry us here. I am sure he would feel very
+disappointed if anyone else were asked. At the same time I should not
+like to go home. When we come back from our trip it will be different;
+but it would be a great trial now, and however happy we might be, I
+should feel there was a gloom over the house."
+
+"I quite agree with you, Millicent. When we come back we can see about
+entirely refurnishing it, and, perhaps, adding some rooms to it, and we
+need not go down until a complete change has been made. We shall be able
+to manage it somehow or other, and I quite agree with you that anything
+will be better than going back to the house for a day or two before the
+wedding."
+
+On the voyage back from Holland Mark had talked the matter over with
+Dick Chetwynd, and said that he thought of taking rooms for Mrs.
+Cunningham and Millicent at Reigate, and stopping at the hotel himself,
+and having the wedding breakfast there.
+
+"Of course, Dick, you will be my best man."
+
+"I should think so," Dick laughed. "Why, if you had asked anyone else
+I should have made a personal matter of it with him, and have given
+him the option of resigning the position or going out with me. But your
+other plans are foolish, and I shall take the matter into my own hands;
+I shall insist upon the two ladies coming down to the Park, and I will
+get my aunt to come and preside generally over things. I shall fill up
+the house with bridesmaids, and shall have a dance the evening before.
+You can put up at the hotel if you like, but you know very well that
+there are a dozen houses where they will be delighted to have you; there
+is no doubt that when they know what is coming off you will get a dozen
+invitations, and then after church all those invited will drive off to
+the Park to the wedding breakfast. After that is over you can start in a
+post chaise to Canterbury or Dover, wherever you may decide to make your
+first halt."
+
+"But, my dear Dick, I could not put you to all this trouble!"
+
+"Nonsense, man. I should enjoy it immensely; besides, I shall be really
+glad of a good reason to try and open the doors of the Park again. I
+have been there very little since my father's death, and I think I shall
+make it my headquarters in future. I am getting rather tired of bachelor
+life in London, and must look out for a wife; so nothing could be more
+appropriate than this idea. Don't bother yourself any further about
+it. I shall ride down and establish myself there tomorrow, and spend
+a couple of days in driving round to our friends and in sending out
+invitations. I shall still have nearly a fortnight for making
+all preparations. Why, it will cause quite an excitement in the
+neighborhood! I shall be hailed as a benefactor, and I shall let
+everyone know that your father's ward was really your cousin, but that
+by the will of her father she was to drop her surname until she came of
+age; and that until that time your father was to have the entire control
+of the property. I shall add that although the estate, of course, is
+hers, your uncle has left you a very big fortune, and that nothing could
+be more suitable in all respects than the marriage."
+
+"That will do excellently, Dick; that will be quite enough, without
+going into details at all. You can mention that we intend to have the
+house entirely refurnished, and on the return from our wedding trip
+abroad to settle there. I am sure I am extremely obliged to you for your
+offer, which will certainly clear away all sorts of small difficulties."
+
+A day or two after his return Mark wrote to Mr. Greg telling him the
+relations in which Millicent and he stood to each other, and of the near
+approach of their marriage. He said that Millicent would be married from
+Dick Chetwynd's, but that it would be at Crowswood church. In return he
+received a warm letter of congratulation from the Rector, telling him
+that the news was in every respect delightful, and that his wife and
+the children were in a state of the highest excitement, not only at the
+marriage, but at their coming down to reside again at Crowswood.
+
+"The village," he said, "will be scarcely less pleased than I am, for
+though everything goes on as you ordered, and the people get their milk,
+broths, and jellies as before, they don't look at it as the same thing
+as it was in the old days. I cannot say that the news of your engagement
+to Miss Conyers--I ought to say Miss Thorndyke--is surprising, for I had
+thought that it would be quite the natural thing for you to fall in love
+with each other, and, indeed, my wife declares that she saw it coming
+on distinctly during the last few months before you left here. Your
+postscript saying that Bastow had been captured and had committed
+suicide gave me a distinct feeling of relief, for no one could tell
+whether the deadly enmity that he felt for your father might not extend
+to you. I have cut this note rather short, but I have just heard the
+door shut, and I am quite sure that my wife has gone down to tell the
+good news in the village, and I really cannot deny myself the pleasure
+of telling some of the people myself, and seeing their faces brighten up
+at the news."
+
+As Dick had foretold would be the case, Mark received a very warm
+letter from Sir Charles Harris, congratulating him upon his approaching
+marriage, and insisting upon his taking up his quarters with him.
+
+"I am sending a man down with this to hand it to the guard as the up
+coach goes through the town. Chetwynd told me that his call on me was
+the first he had paid, so I feel fairly confident that I shall forestall
+the rest of your friends, and that you will give me the pleasure of your
+company."
+
+Mark wrote back accepting the invitation at once, which enabled him to
+decline half a dozen others without the necessity of making a choice.
+Everything turned out as arranged. Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham went
+down in a post chaise, two days before the wedding, and Mark drove down
+in his gig with them. Dick Chetwynd met them on horseback just outside
+Reigate, and escorted the ladies to his house, Mark driving on to that
+of Sir Charles Harris. Millicent found the house full of her special
+friends, whom she had asked to be her bridesmaids. She was almost
+bewildered by the warmth of their welcome, and overpowered by the
+questions poured upon her.
+
+"The news quite took all our breath away, Millicent," one of them said.
+"It seems extraordinary that you should have been Miss Thorndyke all the
+time, though I don't think that any of us were at all surprised that you
+should take the name now; you must have been surprised when you heard
+that you were the heiress of Crowswood."
+
+"I was a great deal more disgusted than surprised," she said rather
+indignantly. "I did not think that it was fair at all that I should step
+into Mark's shoes."
+
+"Well, it has all come right now, Millicent, and I dare say you thought
+that it would, even then."
+
+"I can assure you that I did not; quite the contrary, I thought that it
+never would come right. I was very unhappy about it for a time."
+
+"Now, young ladies," Dick Chetwynd laughed, "will you please take Mrs.
+Cunningham and Miss Thorndyke up to their rooms? I don't suppose I shall
+see any more of you before dinner time; there are those trunks to be
+opened and examined, talked over, and admired. Mind, I have fifteen
+more, for the most part men, coming to dinner, so those of you who
+aspire to follow Miss Thorndyke's example had best prepare yourselves
+for conquest."
+
+The ball on the following evening was a great success. Dick had
+determined that it should be a memorable one, and there was a consensus
+of opinion that it was the most brilliant that had taken place in that
+part of the country for many years.
+
+Crowswood church and village presented a most festive appearance on
+the following day; there was not a cottage that had not great posies of
+flowers in its windows, and that had not made some sort of attempt
+at decoration with flags or flowers. A huge arch of evergreens, with
+sheaves of wheat and flowers, had been erected on the top of the hill,
+and every man, woman, and child turned out in their best, and cheered
+lustily, first, when Mark drove up in his gig, and equally lustily when
+the Chetwynd carriage, drawn by four gray horses, dashed up, preceded
+by a large number of others with the bridesmaids and friends. The church
+was already crowded, and Mr. Greg was visibly moved at seeing the son
+and niece of the man to whom he owed his living made man and wife.
+When the wedding breakfast, at which more than fifty sat down, and
+the necessary toasts were over, Mr. and Mrs. Thorndyke started for
+Canterbury.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXII.
+
+
+It was not until Easter that Mark Thorndyke and his wife returned to
+England. They had spent the greater portion of that time in Italy,
+lingering for a month at Venice, and had then journeyed quietly
+homewards through Bavaria and Saxony; They were in no hurry, as before
+starting on their honeymoon Mark had consulted an architect, had told
+him exactly what he wanted, and had left the matter in his hands. Mrs.
+Cunningham had from time to time kept them informed how things were
+going on. The part of the house in which the Squire's room had been
+situated was entirely pulled down, and a new wing built in its stead.
+Millicent had been specially wishful that this should be done.
+
+"I don't know that I am superstitious, Mark," she had said, "but I do
+think that when a murder has taken place in a house it is better to make
+a complete change. The servants always think they see or hear something.
+That part of the house is avoided, and it is difficult to get anyone to
+stay there. I think it is very much more important to do that than it
+is to get the house refurnished; we can do anything in that way you
+like when we get back, but I should certainly like very much to have the
+great alteration made before we return."
+
+The architect was a clever one, and the house, which was some two
+hundred years old, was greatly improved in appearance by the new wing,
+which was made to harmonize well with the rest, but was specially
+designed to give as much variety as possible to the general outline.
+Millicent uttered an exclamation of pleasure when they first caught a
+glimpse of the house. As they rode through the village they were again
+welcomed as heartily as they were on their wedding day. Mrs. Cunningham
+received them; she had been established there for a month, and had
+placed the house entirely on its old footing. They first examined the
+new portion of the house, and Millicent was greatly pleased with the
+rooms that had been prepared for them, Mark having requested Mrs.
+Cunningham to put the furnishing into the hands of the best known firm
+of the day.
+
+"I have asked," Mrs. Cunningham said, "the Rector and his wife and
+Mr. Chetwynd to dine with us this evening; they can scarcely be termed
+company, and I thought that you might find it pleasant to have these old
+friends here the first evening. There is a letter for you on the library
+table, Mark; it may almost be called a packet; it has been here nearly a
+month."
+
+In our days a newly married couple would find on their return from
+foreign travel basketfuls of letters, circulars, and catalogues from
+tradesmen of all kinds; happily, our forefathers were saved from these
+inflictions, and Mark at once went to the library with almost a feeling
+of surprise as to who could have written to him. He saw at once that
+it was a ship's letter, for on the top was written, "Favored by the
+Surinam."
+
+"Why, it is Ramoo's writing. I suppose he gave it to someone he knew,
+and that instead of its being put in the mail bag in India, he brought
+it on with him. What a tremendously long epistle!" he exclaimed,
+glancing his eye down the first page, and then a puzzled expression came
+across his face; he sat down and began to read from the first slowly and
+carefully.
+
+"HONORED SAHIB:
+
+"I do not know why I should write to tell you the true history of all
+these matters. I have thought it over many times, but I feel that it
+is right that you should know clearly what has happened, and how it has
+come about, and more especially that you should know that you need never
+fear any troubles such as those that have taken place. I am beginning
+to write this while we are yet sailing, and shall send it to you by
+ship from the Cape, or if it chances that we meet any ship on her way to
+England, our letters may be put on board her."
+
+"Why, this letter must be more than a year old," Mark said to himself.
+There was no date to the letter, but, turning to the last sheet, he saw
+as a postscript after the signature the words, "January 26th.--A ship,
+the Surinam, is lying a short distance from us, and will take our
+letters to England."
+
+"Yes, it must be a year old; but what he means by the way he begins is
+more than I can imagine;" and he turned back to the point at which he
+had broken off.
+
+"I would tell it you in order as it happened. I, Ramoo, am a Brahmin.
+Twenty years ago I was the head priest of a great temple. I shall not
+say where the temple was; it matters not in any way. There was fighting,
+as there is always fighting in India. There were Company's Sepoys and
+white troops, and one night the most sacred bracelet of the great god of
+our temple was stolen."
+
+"Good Heavens!" Mark exclaimed, laying down the letter. "Then it has
+been Ramoo who has all this time been in pursuit of the diamonds; and to
+think that my uncle never even suspected him!"
+
+Then suddenly he continued, "now I understand why it was my life was
+spared by those fellows. By Jove, this is astounding!" Then he took up
+the letter again.
+
+"Two of the Brahmins under me had observed, at a festival the day before
+the bracelet was lost, a white soldier staring at it with covetous eyes.
+One of them was in charge of the temple on the night when it was stolen,
+and on the day following he came to me, and said, 'I desire to devote my
+life to the recovery of the jewels of the god. Bondah will go with me;
+we will return no more until we bring them back.' 'It is good,' I said;
+'the god must be appeased, or terrible misfortunes may happen.' Then we
+held a solemn service in the temple. The two men removed the caste marks
+from their foreheads, prostrated themselves before the god, and went
+out from amongst us as outcasts until the day of their death. Two months
+later a messenger came from the one who had spoken to me, saying that
+they had found the man, but had for a long time had no opportunity of
+finding the bracelet. Then Bondah had met him in a lonely place, and
+had attacked him. Bondah had lost his life, but the soldier was, though
+sorely wounded, able to get back to his regiment. He had died, but he
+had, the writer was convinced, passed the jewels on to a comrade, whom
+he would watch. Then I saw that one man was not sufficient for such a
+task. Then I, too, the Chief Brahmin of the temple, saw that it was my
+duty to go forth also.
+
+"I laid the matter before the others, and they said, 'You are right; it
+is you who, as the chief in the service of the god, should bring back
+his jewels.' So again there was a service, and I went forth as an
+outcast and a wanderer, knowing that I must do many things that were
+forbidden to my caste; that I must touch unclean things, must eat
+forbidden food, and must take life if needs be. You, sahib, cannot
+understand how terrible was the degradation to me, who was of the purest
+blood of the Brahmins. I had taken the most solemn vows to devote my
+life to this. I knew that, whether successful or not, although I might
+be forgiven my offense by the god, yet that never again could I recover
+my caste, even though the heaviest penances were performed. Henceforth,
+I must stand alone in the world, without kindred, without friends,
+without help, save such as the god might give me in the search.
+
+"I was rich. The greater part of my goods I gave to the temple, and yet
+retained a considerable sum, for I should need money to carry out my
+quest, and after I had accomplished it I should hand over what remained
+for the benefit of the poor. I should myself become a fakir. I want you
+to understand, sahib, that henceforth I had but one object in life, a
+supreme one, to accomplish, in which nothing must stand in my way, and
+that what would be in others a crime was but a sacrifice on my part,
+most acceptable to the god. I journeyed down to the place where my
+comrade was, dressed as one of the lowest class, even as a sweeper, and
+he and I strove by all the means in our power to discover what this man
+had done with the jewels. Night after night we crawled into his tent. We
+searched his bed and his clothes. With sharp rods we tried every inch of
+the soil, believing that he had hidden the diamonds underground, but we
+failed.
+
+"There my comrade said, 'I must give my life to find out where he hides
+these things. I will watch night after night by the door of his tent,
+and if he comes out I will stab him; it shall be a mortal wound, but
+I will not kill him outright. Before he dies he will doubtless, as the
+other did, pass the jewels on to some comrade, and then it will be for
+you to follow him up.' 'It is good,' I said. 'This man may have hidden
+them away somewhere during the time they have marched through the
+country. In spite of the watch you have kept he may have said to
+himself, "I will return, though it be years hence." Your plan is good,'
+I said. 'I envy you. 'Tis better to die thus than to live in sin as we
+are doing.'
+
+"That evening the man was stabbed, but an officer running up killed my
+comrade. The soldier was taken to the hospital, and I lay down beside
+the tent with my eye to a slit that I had cut, and watched till morning.
+
+"Then I took my broom and swept the ground. I had not been hired as one
+of the camp sweepers, and so could move about and sweep where I chose.
+No one ever asked me any questions. The soldiers heeded me no more than
+if I had been a dog, and, of course, supposed that I was acting by the
+order of the head of the sweepers. Presently I saw one of the servants
+of the hospital go across to the tent of the officer who had killed my
+comrade. He came over and went into the hospital tent. I felt sure that
+it was the wounded man who had sent for him. He was in there some time.
+Presently a soldier came out and went to the tent of the wounded man,
+and returned bringing a musket. Then I said to myself, 'The god has
+blinded us. He wills that we shall go through many more toils before we
+regain the bracelet.' Doubtless the man had carried the bracelet in his
+musket all the time, and we, blind that we were, had never thought of
+it.
+
+"Presently the officer came out again. I noticed that as he did so he
+looked round on all sides as if to see if he were watched. Then I knew
+that it was as I had thought: the soldier had given the bracelet to him.
+At this I was pleased; it would be far more easy to search the tent of
+an officer than of a soldier, who sleeps surrounded by his comrades. I
+thought that there was no hurry now; it would need but patience, and
+I should be sure to find them. I had not calculated that he would
+have better opportunities than the soldier for going about, and that,
+doubtless, the soldier had warned him of his danger. Two hours later the
+officer mounted his horse and rode towards the camp of another regiment,
+a mile and a quarter away. There was nothing in that; but I watched for
+his return all that day and all that night, and when he did not come
+back, I felt that he was doing something to get rid of the diamonds.
+
+"He was away three days, and when he returned I was almost sure that he
+had not the diamonds about him. As he had ridden off he had looked about
+just as he had when he left the hospital: he was uneasy, just as if he
+was watched; now he was uneasy no longer. Then I knew that my search
+would be a long one, and might fail altogether. I went away, and for
+three months I prayed and fasted; then I returned. I bought different
+clothes, I painted my forehead with another caste mark, then I bought
+from the servant of an officer in another regiment his papers of
+service: recommendations from former masters. Then I went to the
+officer--you will guess, sahib, that it was the Major, your uncle--and I
+paid his servant to leave his service, and to present me as a brother
+of his who had been accustomed to serve white sahibs, and was, like
+himself, a good servant; so I took his place.
+
+"He was a good master, and I came to love him, though I knew that I
+might yet have to kill him. You have heard that I saved his life three
+times; I did so partly because I loved him, but chiefly because his life
+was most precious to me, for if he had died I should have lost all clew
+to the bracelet. I had, of course, made sure that he had not got
+them with him; over and over again I searched every article in his
+possession. I ripped open his saddle lest they might be sewn up in its
+stuffing. All that could be done I did, until I was quite sure that he
+had not got them. He, on his part, came to like me. He thought that I
+was the most faithful of servants, and after the last time I saved his
+life he took me with him everywhere. He went down to Madras, and was
+married there. I watched his every movement. After that he went down
+frequently. Then a child was born, and six months afterwards his wife
+died.
+
+"The regiment was stationed at the fort. At that time he was at many
+places--the governor's, the other officer sahibs', the merchants', and
+others'. I could not follow him, but I was sure by his manner that he
+had not taken back the bracelet from whoever he had sent it to. I knew
+him so well by this time that I should have noticed any change in his
+manner in a moment. At last the child went away in the charge of
+Mrs. Cunningham. I bribed the child's ayah, and she searched Mrs.
+Cunningham's boxes and every garment she had, and found no small sealed
+parcel or box amongst them. Three years more passed. By this time the
+Colonel treated me more as a friend than as a servant. He said one day,
+laughing, 'It is a long time since my things have been turned topsy
+turvy, Ramoo. I think the thieves have come to the conclusion that I
+have not got what they are looking for.' 'What is that, sahib?' I asked.
+'Some special jewels,' he said. 'They are extremely valuable. But I have
+got them and a lot of other things so safely stowed that no one will
+ever find them unless I give them the clew.' 'But suppose you are
+killed, sahib,' I said; 'your little daughter will never get the
+things.' 'I have provided for that,' he answered. 'If I am killed I have
+arranged that she shall know all about it either when she comes to the
+age of eighteen or twenty-one.'
+
+"A few weeks after that he was wounded very badly. I nursed him night
+and day for weeks, and when he came to England he brought me with him.
+As you know, sahib, he died. When he was in London he went to see Mrs.
+Cunningham and the child, and several times to the office of the lawyer
+who attended your father's funeral. Then he came down to your father,
+and I know he had long and earnest conversations with him. I did all I
+could to listen, but the Colonel always had the windows and doors shut
+before he began to speak. I could see that your father was troubled.
+Then the Colonel died. After his death I could never find his snuff box;
+he had carried it about with him for some years; once or twice I had
+examined it, but it was too small for the diamonds to be hidden in. I
+suppose that he had given it to the sahib, your father, but as I could
+never find it I guessed that there was some mystery attached to it,
+though what I could not tell.
+
+"Then your father took me down to Crowswood with him, and Mrs.
+Cunningham and the little girl came down. I was surprised to find that
+your father seemed to be master of the estate, and that no one thought
+anything of the child, whose name had been changed. I spoke one day to
+Mrs. Cunningham about it; your father seemed to me a just and good man,
+and I could not believe that he was robbing his brother's daughter. Mrs.
+Cunningham told me that the Colonel did not wish her to be known as an
+heiress, and that he had left the estate to his brother until she came
+of age. Your father was as good a master as the Colonel had been.
+I watched and watched, and once or twice I overheard him talking to
+himself in the library, and discovered that your father himself was
+altogether ignorant of the hiding place of the property that the Colonel
+had mentioned in his will. I knew then that I should have to wait until
+the child was either eighteen or twenty-one.
+
+"It was a long time, but I had learnt to be patient. I was not unhappy;
+I loved your father, I loved the Colonel's little daughter; and I was
+very fond of you. All these things were small to me in comparison to my
+vow and the finding the jewels of the god, but they shortened the years
+of waiting. Then a year before the young mistress was eighteen came the
+shot through the window. I did not know who had fired it, but I saw that
+your father's life was in danger, and I said to myself, 'He will tell
+the young sahib what he knows about the bracelet.' After you had gone
+into the library I opened the door quietly, and listened. I could hear
+much that was said, but not all. I heard him say something about a snuff
+box, and some means of finding the lost things being hidden in it, and
+that he had kept them all these years in a secret hiding place, which he
+described. You were to search for the diamonds, and I guessed from that
+that he did not know what he was to be told when the young memsahib came
+of age, or perhaps when she was eighteen. It was not until I had thought
+over what I heard that I came to the conclusion that if I could find the
+things he spoke of I might be able to find the jewels. By that time your
+father had gone to bed. I was foolish not to have been patient, but
+my blood boiled after waiting for eighteen or nineteen years. The god
+seemed to have sent me the chance, and it seemed to me that I should
+take it at once. I knew that he generally slept with his window open,
+and it seemed to me that it would be easy to slip in there and to get
+those things from the cabinet. I knew where the ladder was kept. I took
+a file from the tool chest and cut the chain."
+
+Here Mark dropped the letter in horror.
+
+"Good Heavens!" he exclaimed. "Then Bastow spoke truly, and he was not
+my father's murderer! Never did a single suspicion of Ramoo enter my
+head. This is appalling; but I cannot read any more now. It is time for
+me to go and dress for dinner."
+
+"Is anything the matter with you, Mark?" Millicent asked anxiously, as
+she met him in the drawing room; "you look as white as a sheet."
+
+"I have been reading Ramoo's letter, and he has told me some things that
+have surprised and shocked me. I will tell you about them after dinner,
+dear. It is a long story, but you won't have to wait until Dick and the
+Gregs are gone. They are interested in all that interests us, and shall
+hear the letter read. No; I think I will ask them and Dick to come in
+the morning. I should not like anything to sadden the first evening of
+our coming home."
+
+"Then it is something sad."
+
+"Yes, but it does not affect us, though it does affect Ramoo. Now clear
+your brow, dear, and dismiss the subject from your mind, else our guests
+will fancy that our marriage has not been altogether so satisfactory as
+they had hoped."
+
+"As if they could think such a thing as that, Mark," she said
+indignantly. "But there is the sound of wheels; it is Mr. Chetwynd's
+gig."
+
+The three visitors all came in together, having met at the door. Mark,
+with a great effort, put aside the letter from his mind, and a cheerful
+evening was spent. They had much to tell of their travels, many
+questions to ask about the parish and their mutual friends and the
+neighborhood generally, and when they rose to go Mark said:
+
+"Would you mind riding over again tomorrow morning, Dick? I have a
+letter to read to you that will interest you greatly."
+
+"Certainly. What time shall I be here?"
+
+"Say at eleven o'clock. It is a long epistle, and will take us an hour
+to get through; after that we can stroll round, and, of course, you will
+stop to lunch.
+
+"I should be glad if you and Mrs. Greg can come over too," he added,
+turning to the Rector; "you will be much interested also in the matter."
+
+
+The next day the party met in the library at the hour named. "I may tell
+you, Mr. Greg, that I specially asked you and your wife here because
+this letter throws some light on Arthur Bastow's connection with my
+father's murder; you were friends with his father, and I think you ought
+to know. As to you, Dick, the letter will interest you from beginning to
+end, and will surprise as much as it will interest you."
+
+"Even I don't know what it is, Mrs. Greg," Millicent said. "I know it
+quite upset Mark yesterday, but he said he would sooner I did not know
+anything about it until today, as he did not want me to be saddened on
+the first evening of our return home. Now, please go on, Mark; you have
+said quite enough to excite us all."
+
+Mark had read but a short distance when Dick Chetwynd exclaimed:
+
+"Then Ramoo was at the bottom of that Indian business, after all. I
+almost wonder you never suspected it, Mark."
+
+"Well, I hardly could do so," Mark said, "when my uncle was so fond of
+him, and he had served him so faithfully."
+
+As he approached the point at which he had laid down the letter on the
+previous evening, Millicent's color faded.
+
+Suddenly an exclamation of horror broke from her when he read the last
+line.
+
+"Oh, Mark," she said, with quivering lips, "don't say it was Ramoo. He
+always seemed so kind and good."
+
+"It was here I stopped last night," he said, "but I fear there can be no
+doubt about it. I must say that it is evident from this letter, that
+no thought of doing my father harm was in his mind when he placed that
+ladder against the window. Now I will go on."
+
+The letter continued as follows:
+
+"Having placed the ladder, I clambered to the window and quietly entered
+the room. It was quite dark, but I knew the place of every piece of
+furniture so well that I was able to go without hesitation to the
+cabinet. Your father was speaking very slowly and distinctly when he
+told you how it was to be opened, and I was able to do it easily, but
+I did not know that the back opened with a sharp click, and the noise
+startled me and woke your father. In an instant he was out of bed and
+seized me by the throat. Now, he was a much stronger man than I was. I
+struggled in vain. I felt that in a moment I should become insensible;
+my vow and my duty to the god flashed across me, and scarce knowing what
+I did, I drew a little dagger I always carried, and struck blindly.
+He fell, and I fell beside him. For a time I was insensible. When I
+recovered I was seized with the bitterest remorse that I had killed one
+I loved, but I seemed to hear the voice of the god saying, 'You have
+done well, Ramoo. I am your great master, and you are bound to my
+service.'
+
+"I got up almost blindly, felt in the cabinet, and found a coin and a
+piece of paper, and a feeling of exultation came over me that, after
+nearly twenty years, I should succeed in carrying out my vow and taking
+his bracelet back to the god. I descended the ladder, crept in the back
+door by which I had come out, went up to my room, where I had kept a
+light burning, and examined my treasures. Then I saw that all had been
+in vain. They were doubtless a key to the mystery, but until a clew was
+given they were absolutely useless. I sat for hours staring at them. I
+would have gone back and replaced them in the cabinet and left all as
+it had been before, but I dared not enter the room again. The next day I
+heard you say that you suspected that the talk with your father had been
+overheard, and that the man who had earlier in the evening before shot
+at him had returned, and while listening had heard something said about
+the hiding place, and thought that he would find some sort of treasure
+there. I thought that in the talk your father might have told you how
+to use these things, though I had not caught it, and it was therefore
+important that you should have them back again, so I went into the room
+after the inquest was over, and placed the things in their hiding place
+again.
+
+"Then, thinking it over, I determined to leave your service. You would
+be trying to find the treasure, and I must watch you, and this I could
+not do as long as I was a house servant; so I came up to London, and you
+thought I had sailed for India, but I did not go. I hired four Lascars,
+men of my own religion, and paid them to watch every movement that you
+made, to see where you visited and where you went. I paid them well,
+and they served me well; it was so that I was able to bring those men
+to your help when but for that you would have lost your life. It was for
+this to some extent that I had you followed; for I soon found out that
+you were on the search for the man who had fired through the window, and
+who you believed had killed your father, rather than for the jewels. I
+knew that you might run into danger, and partly because I loved you, and
+partly because it was possible that it would be essential for that coin
+and piece of paper to be produced in order that the treasure might be
+obtained, I kept guard over you.
+
+"When the 18th of August approached we were all on the watch. I felt
+sure that you would take every possible precaution while you had the
+bracelet in your possession. We knew who were your principal friends,
+the banker's son and Mr. Chetwynd. On the 18th of August everything went
+on as usual. On the following day the banker's son came to you, and as
+soon as he left you, you went to the lawyer's, and afterwards to the
+banker's. I felt sure now that it was at that bank that the jewels had
+been placed, and that you had been waiting till the young memsahib's
+birthday for the news that they might be taken out; then you went to Mr.
+Chetwynd's, and he went to the bank. I had no doubt that he was to take
+them out for you, and after that one of the men never took his eyes off
+him when he was outside of his house. Afterwards you went to the place
+where the men used to fight, and the man who was watching you went in,
+and had beer, and saw you talking with the big man you used to fight
+with, in the parlor behind the bar. The watcher went out to follow you,
+but left another to watch this man. We found that both Mr. Chetwynd and
+he went to a shipping office in Tower Street, and we then guessed that
+you intended to take the bracelet at once across the sea.
+
+"I went myself and found out that a vessel was sailing in two days to
+Amsterdam. I took a passage for a man in the cheap cabin, and asked to
+look at the list of passengers, as I believed that some friend would
+be sailing by her; there were two men's names down together in one
+handwriting among the first class passengers, and I guessed that these
+were you and Mr. Chetwynd. I also saw the name of the big man, which I
+had heard long before, down in the list of passengers, and another
+name next to his in the same handwriting. I did not know his name, but
+guessed that it was another of the fighting men, and that they were
+going to look after you until you had got rid of the diamonds. On the
+morning that she was to sail one of the Lascars was on board; I thought
+it possible that in order to throw anyone who might be following you off
+your scent you might at the last moment go ashore, and that Mr. Chetwynd
+might take the diamonds over, so I watched, and saw you on the deck with
+your friend.
+
+"I and the other three Lascars then took passage that evening in a craft
+for Rotterdam, and got to Amsterdam two days before your ship arrived;
+we went to different houses, and going separately into the worst parts
+of the town, soon found a man who kept a gambling den, and who was a
+man who could be trusted. I offered him a thousand francs to collect
+twenty-five men, who were to be paid a hundred francs each, and to be
+ready, if your ship arrived after dark, to attack two passengers I would
+point out to them. I did not want you to be hurt, so bargained that all
+knives were to be left behind, and that he was to supply the men only
+with clubs. If the ship came in in daylight you were to be attacked the
+first time you went out after dark. You know how that was carried out.
+You had two more men with you than I had expected; but I thought that
+with a sudden rush you might all be separated. You know the rest. The
+moment you were knocked down I and three others carried you to a boat.
+It had been lying near the stairs, and we took you off to the barge in
+which I had arranged you should be taken to Rotterdam.
+
+"We told them that you were a drunken man who had been stunned in a
+fight in a public house. As soon as we were off, I searched you and
+found the diamonds. Then, as you know, we put you ashore. We all
+crossed to England that night. Two days later I sailed in this ship, the
+Brahmapootra. I am not afraid of telling you this, because I know that
+the diamonds will not shine on the god's arm until all fear of search
+and inquiry are over. My task will be done when I hand them over to the
+man who holds the office I once held; then I shall bear the penances
+imposed on me for having broken my caste in every way, and for having
+taken life, and for the rest of my days I shall wander as a fakir
+through India. I shall be supported by the knowledge that I have done my
+duty to my god, and have sacrificed all in his service, but it will ever
+be a grief to me that in so doing it was necessary to sacrifice the life
+of one who had ever shown me kindness. You may wonder why I have written
+this, but I felt that I must own the truth to you, and that you should
+know that if in the course of my duty to the god it was my misfortune
+to slay your father, I have twice saved your life, just as three times I
+saved that of the Colonel Sahib, your uncle."
+
+There was silence for some little time after Mark had finished reading.
+
+"It is a strange story indeed," Mr. Greg said, "but it is not for us
+to judge the man. He has acted according to his lights, and none can do
+more. He sacrificed himself and his life solely to the service of his
+god, well knowing that even were he successful, his reward would be
+penance and suffering, and a life of what cannot but be misery to a
+man brought up, as he has been, to consider himself of the highest and
+holiest rank of the people. I think, Mark, we need neither say nor think
+anything harshly of him."
+
+"Certainly not," Mark agreed. "I can understand that according to his
+view of the matter anything that stood between him and his goal was but
+an obstacle to be swept aside; assuredly there was no premeditation in
+the killing of my father. I have no doubt that the man was attached to
+him, and that he killed him not to save his own life, but in order that
+his mission might be carried out."
+
+"Quite so, Mark; it was done in the same spirit, if I may say so, that
+Abraham would have sacrificed his son at the order of his God. What
+years of devotion that man has passed through! Accustomed, as you see,
+to a lofty position, to the respect and veneration of those around him,
+he became a servant, and performed duties that were in his opinion not
+only humiliating, but polluting and destructive to his caste, and which
+rendered him an outcast even among the lowest of his people. Do you not
+think so, Mrs. Thorndyke?"
+
+Millicent, who was crying quietly, looked up.
+
+"I can only think of him as the man who twice saved Mark's life," she
+said.
+
+"I understand why you have wished to tell me this story," the Rector
+went on to Mark. "You wish me to know that Arthur Bastow did not add
+this to his other crimes; that he was spared from being the murderer of
+your father, but from no want of will on his part; and, as we know, he
+killed many others, the last but an hour or two before he put an end to
+his own life; still I am glad that this terrible crime is not his. It
+seemed to be so revolting and unnatural. It was the Squire's father who
+had given the living to his father, and the Squire himself had been his
+friend in the greatest of his trials, and had given him a shelter and a
+home in his old age. I am glad, at least, that the man, evil as he was,
+was spared this last crime of the grossest ingratitude."
+
+"Well, Mark," Dick Chetwynd said cheerfully, in order to turn the
+subject, "I am heartily glad that we have got to the bottom of this
+jewel mystery. I have been puzzling over it all the time that you have
+been away, and I have never been able to understand how, in spite of
+the precautions that we took, they should have found out that the jewels
+were at Cotter's, and that you had them on board with you, and, above
+all, why they spared your life when they could so easily and safely
+have put you out of the way. It is certainly strange that while you were
+thinking over everything connected with the jewels, the idea that Ramoo
+was the leading spirit in the whole business should never once have
+occurred to you."
+
+A month later, when Mark went up to town, he called at Leadenhall
+Street.
+
+"Of course, you have not heard of the arrival of the Brahmapootra at
+Madras yet. May I ask when she left the Cape?"
+
+"She never left the Cape, sir," the clerk replied, "and there are very
+grave fears for her safety. She spoke the Surinam and gave her mails
+for England when the latter was eight days out from the Cape, and the
+Surinam reported that a day later she encountered a terrible gale, lost
+several spars, and narrowly escaped being blown onto the African coast.
+Since then we have had no news of the Brahmapootra. A number of Indiamen
+have arrived since; the latest came in only yesterday, and up to the
+time when she left no news had been received of the ship. Three small
+craft had been sent up the coast weeks before to make inquiries for her,
+but had returned without being able to obtain any intelligence, and had
+seen no wreckage on the coast, although they had gone several hundred
+miles beyond where she had spoken the Surinam, therefore there can be
+little doubt that she foundered with all hands during the gale. You had
+no near relatives on board, I hope, sir?"
+
+"No near relatives, but there was one on board in whom I was greatly
+interested. Here is my card; I should feel greatly obliged if you would
+write me a line should you hear anything of her."
+
+"I will do so, sir. We have had innumerable inquiries from friends and
+relatives of those on board, and although of late we have been obliged
+to say that there can no longer be any hope that she will ever be heard
+of, not a day passes but many persons still come in to inquire."
+
+No letter ever came to Mark; no news was ever heard of the Brahmapootra.
+Ramoo's sacrifice was in vain, and never again did the diamond bracelet
+glisten on the arm of the idol in the unknown temple.
+
+
+
+THE END.
+
+
+
+
+
+End of Project Gutenberg's Colonel Thorndyke's Secret, by G. A. Henty
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET ***
+
+***** This file should be named 8155.txt or 8155.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/8/1/5/8155/
+
+Produced by Martin Robb
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/8155.zip b/8155.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..004774a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/8155.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a5f1ccf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #8155 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/8155)
diff --git a/old/thorn10.txt b/old/thorn10.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f87776b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/thorn10.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,13937 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of Colonel Thorndyke's Secret, by G. A. Henty
+#18 in our series by G. A. Henty
+
+Copyright laws are changing all over the world. Be sure to check the
+copyright laws for your country before downloading or redistributing
+this or any other Project Gutenberg eBook.
+
+This header should be the first thing seen when viewing this Project
+Gutenberg file. Please do not remove it. Do not change or edit the
+header without written permission.
+
+Please read the "legal small print," and other information about the
+eBook and Project Gutenberg at the bottom of this file. Included is
+important information about your specific rights and restrictions in
+how the file may be used. You can also find out about how to make a
+donation to Project Gutenberg, and how to get involved.
+
+
+**Welcome To The World of Free Plain Vanilla Electronic Texts**
+
+**eBooks Readable By Both Humans and By Computers, Since 1971**
+
+*****These eBooks Were Prepared By Thousands of Volunteers!*****
+
+
+Title: Colonel Thorndyke's Secret
+
+Author: G. A. Henty
+
+Release Date: May, 2005 [EBook #8155]
+[Yes, we are more than one year ahead of schedule]
+[This file was first posted on June 21, 2003]
+
+Edition: 10
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ASCII
+
+*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Martin Robb
+
+
+
+
+Colonel Thorndyke's Secret
+by G. A. Henty.
+
+
+
+PUBLISHER'S INTRODUCTION.
+
+
+"Colonel Thorndyke's Secret" is a story so far out of the ordinary
+that it will not be inappropriate to speak a few words regarding
+the tale and its unusually successful author, Mr. George Alfred
+Henty.
+
+The plot of the story hinges upon the possession of a valuable
+bracelet, of diamonds, stolen from a Hindoo idol by a British
+soldier in India. This bracelet falls into the possession of Colonel
+Thorndyke, who, shortly afterward, is sent home to England because
+of his wounds. The secret concerning the bracelet is told to the
+Colonel's brother, a country squire, and the treasure is left to
+younger members of the Thorndyke family.
+
+As is well known today, the theft of anything from a Hindoo temple
+is considered an extraordinary crime in India, and when this occurs
+it becomes a religious duty for one or more persons to hunt down
+the thief and bring back the property taken from the heathen god.
+
+The members of the Thorndyke family soon learn that they are being
+watched. But this is at a time when highwaymen are numerous in
+this part of England, and they cannot determine whether the work
+is that of the "knights of the roads" or that of the Lascars after
+the famous bracelet. A mysterious death follows, and the younger
+members of the family are almost stunned, not knowing what will
+happen next. They would give the bracelet up, but do not know where
+it is hidden, the secret having been in the sole possession of the
+member now dead. In this quandary the young hero of the tale rises
+to the occasion and determines to join the London police force and
+become a detective, with the hope of ultimately clearing up the
+mystery. Thrilling adventures of a most unusual kind follow, and
+at last something of the mystery is explained. The bracelet and.
+other jewelry are unearthed, and it is decided to take the bracelet
+to Amsterdam and offer it to the diamond cutters at that place.
+But the carrying of the bracelet is both difficult and dangerous.
+How the mission is brought to a conclusion, and what part the
+Lascars played in the final adventure, will be found in the pages
+that follow.
+
+It can truthfully be said that Mr. Henty is easily the most
+popular of all English story tellers, his books for boys enjoying
+a circulation of from a hundred and fifty thousand to two hundred
+and fifty thousand per year. His tales are all clean, and although
+some are full of exciting situations and thrilling to the last
+degree, they are of a high moral tone, while the English employed
+is of the best.
+
+The present story is of peculiar value as giving a good insight
+into country and town life in England over a hundred years ago, when
+railways and telegraph lines were unknown and when the "knights of
+the road" were apt to hold up any stagecoach that happened to come
+along. It also gives a truthful picture of the dark and underhanded
+work accomplished at times by those of East Indian blood, especially
+when on what they consider a religious mission.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I.
+
+
+Squire Thorndyke, of the Manor House of Crawley, was, on the 1st
+of September; 1782, walking up and down the little terrace in front
+of the quaint old house in an unusually disturbed mood. He was a
+man of forty three or four, stoutly and strongly built, and inclined
+to be portly. Save the loss of his wife four years before, there
+had been but little to ruffle the easy tenor of his life. A younger
+son, he had, at his mother's death, when he was three and twenty,
+come in for the small estate at Crawley, which had been her jointure.
+
+For ten years he had led a life resembling that of most of his
+neighbors; he had hunted and shot, been a regular attendant at any
+main of cocks that was fought within fifteen miles of Crawley, had
+occasionally been up to London for a week or two to see the gay
+doings there. Of an evening he had generally gone down to the inn,
+where he talked over, with two or three of his own condition and
+a few of the better class of farmers, the news of the day, the war
+with the French, the troubles in Scotland, the alarming march of
+the Young Pretender, and his defeat at Culloden--with no very
+keen interest in the result, for the Southern gentry and yeomen,
+unlike those in the North, had no strong leanings either way. They
+had a dull dislike for Hanoverian George, but no great love for the
+exiled Stuarts, whose patron, the King of France, was an enemy of
+England.
+
+More often, however, their thoughts turned upon local topics--the
+holding up of the coach of Sir James Harris or Squire Hamilton by
+highwaymen; the affray between the French smugglers and the Revenue
+men near Selsea Bill or Shoreham; the delinquencies of the poaching
+gangs; the heaviness of the taxes, and the price of corn.
+
+At the age of thirty-three Squire Thorndyke married the daughter
+of a neighboring landowner; a son was born and three years later
+Mrs. Thorndyke died. Since then the Squire had led a more retired
+life; he still went down to smoke his pipe at the inn parlor,
+but he gave up his visits to town; and cock fights, and even bull
+baiting, were no longer attractions to him. He was known as a good
+landlord to the three or four farmers who held land under him; was
+respected and liked in the village, where he was always ready to
+assist in cases of real distress; was of an easygoing disposition
+and on good terms with all his neighbors.
+
+But today he was unusually disturbed in his mind. A messenger had
+ridden up two hours before with a letter from London. It was as
+follows:
+
+"MY DEAR BROTHER JOHN:
+
+"You will be surprised indeed at this letter from me, who, doubtless,
+you suppose to be fighting in India. I have done with fighting,
+and am nearly done with life. I was shot in the battle of Buxar,
+eighteen months ago. For a time the surgeons thought that it was
+going to be fatal; then I rallied, and for some months it seemed
+that, in spite of the ball that they were never able to find, I was
+going to get over it, and should be fit for service again. Then I
+got worse; first it was a cough, then the blood used to come up,
+and they said that the only chance for me was to come home. I did
+not believe it would be of any use, but I thought that I would
+rather die at home than in India, so home I came, and have now been
+a week in London.
+
+"I thought at first of going down to my place at Reigate, and having
+you and your boy there with me; but as I have certainly not many
+weeks, perhaps not many days, to live, I thought I would come down
+to you; so the day after you receive this letter I shall be with
+you. I shall not bring my little girl down; I have left her in good
+hands, and I shall only bring with me my Hindoo servant. He will
+give you no trouble--a mat to sleep on, and a little rice to eat,
+will satisfy his wants; and he will take the trouble of me a good
+deal off your hands. He was a Sepoy in my regiment, and has always
+evinced the greatest devotion for me. More than once in battle
+he has saved my life, and has, for the last three years, been my
+servant, and has nursed me since I have been ill as tenderly as a
+woman could have done. As I shall have time to tell you everything
+when I arrive, I will say no more now."
+
+The news had much affected John Thorndyke. His brother George was
+five years his senior, and had gone out as a cadet in the company's
+service when John was but thirteen, and this was his first home
+coming. Had it not been for a portrait that had been taken of him in
+his uniform just before he sailed, John would have had but little
+remembrance of him. In that he was represented as a thin, spare
+youth, with an expression of quiet determination in his face. From
+his father John had, of course, heard much about him.
+
+"Nothing would satisfy him but to go out to India, John. There was,
+of course, no occasion for it, as he would have this place after
+me--a fine estate and a good position: what could he want more?
+But he was a curious fellow. Once he formed an opinion there was
+no persuading him to change it. He was always getting ideas such
+as no one else would think of; he did not care for anything that
+other people cared for; never hunted nor shot. He used to puzzle me
+altogether with his ways, and, 'pon my word, I was not sorry when
+he said he would go to India, for there was no saying how he might
+have turned out if he had stopped here. He never could do anything
+like anybody else: nothing that he could have done would have
+surprised me.
+
+"If he had told me that he intended to be a play actor, or a Jockey,
+or a private, or a book writer, I should not have been surprised.
+Upon my word, it was rather a relief to me when he said, 'I
+have made up my mind to go into the East India Service, father. I
+suppose you can get me a cadetship?' At least that was an honorable
+profession; and I knew, anyhow, that when he once said 'I have
+made up my mind, father,' no arguments would move him, and that if
+I did not get him a cadetship he was perfectly capable of running
+away, going up to London, and enlisting in one of their white
+regiments."
+
+John Thorndyke's own remembrances were that his brother had always
+been good natured to him, that he had often told him long stories
+about Indian adventures, and that a short time before he went away,
+having heard that he had been unmercifully beaten by the schoolmaster
+at Reigate for some trifling fault, he had gone down to the town,
+and had so battered the man that the school had to be closed for
+a fortnight. They had always kept up a correspondence. When he
+received the news of his father's death George had written to him,
+begging him to go down to Reigate, and to manage the estate for
+him.
+
+"Of course," he said, "you will draw its income as long as you are
+there. I mayn't be back for another twenty years; one gets rich
+out here fast, what with plunder and presents and one thing and
+another, and it is no use to have money accumulating at home, so
+just live on the place as if it were your own, until I come home
+to turn you out."
+
+John had declined the offer.
+
+"I am very well where I am," he wrote, "and the care of the estate
+would be a horrible worry to me; besides, I have just married, and
+if I ever have any children they would be brought up beyond their
+station. I have done what I can for you. I have seen the family
+lawyers, who have engaged a man who has been steward to Sir John
+Hieover, and looked after the estate during his son's minority.
+But the young blade, on coming of age, set to work to make ducks
+and drakes of the property, and Newman could not bear to see the
+estate going to the Jews, so, as luck would have it, he resigned
+a month ago, and has been appointed steward at Reigate. Of course,
+if you don't like the arrangement you must write and say so. It will
+be a year before I get your answer, and he has only been engaged
+for certain for that time; it must lie with you as to permanent
+arrangement."
+
+So Newman had taken charge of the Reigate estate, and had continued
+to manage it ever since, although George had written home in great
+displeasure at his offer being refused.
+
+Inside the Manor the bustle of preparations was going on; the spare
+room, which had not been used for many years, was being turned
+out, and a great fire lighted to air it. John Thorndyke had sent
+a letter by the returning messenger to a friend in town, begging
+him to go at once to Leadenhall Street and send down a supply
+of Indian condiments for his brother's use, and had then betaken
+himself to the garden to think the matter over. The next day a
+post chaise arrived, bringing the invalid and his colored servant,
+whose complexion and Indian garb struck the maids with an awe not
+unmingled with alarm. John Thorndyke could hardly believe that the
+bent and emaciated figure was that of his brother, but he remembered
+the voice when the latter said, holding out his hand to him:
+
+"Well, brother John, here I am, what is left of me. Gracious, man,
+who would have thought that you were going to grow up such a fine
+tall fellow? You are more fitted to be a soldier than I am. No,
+don't try to help me out; Ramoo will do that--he is accustomed
+to my ways, and I would as soon trust myself to a rogue elephant
+as to you."
+
+"I am sorry to see you looking so bad, brother George."
+
+"What must be must. I have had my fling; and after thirty years
+of marching and fighting, I have no right to grumble if I am laid
+upon my back at last."
+
+Leaning on Ramoo's arm, Colonel Thorndyke made his way into the
+house, and when the Hindoo had arranged the cushions of the sofa,
+took his place there in a half reclining position.
+
+"I am not always as bad as this, John," he said; "the jolting
+of your confounded roads has been too much for me. If I were the
+King I would hang every fellow who had anything to do with them--
+contractors, boards of county magistrates, and the whole lot. If I
+had known what it was going to be like I would have hired a sedan
+chair, and had myself carried down. That is what I have been doing
+in London; but I would rather have had an Indian palkee, that one
+could have lain down comfortably in."
+
+"What shall I get you first, George? I have got some lemons."
+
+"I want something better than lemons, John. Have you any Burgundy
+handy?"
+
+"Yes, plenty."
+
+"If you give a bottle to Ramoo he will know how much water I want."
+
+Here the servants entered with a tray with a chicken and a dish of
+kidneys.
+
+"I sent up yesterday for some of the Indian things that you are
+accustomed to, George, but they have not come down yet."
+
+"I brought a store down with me. This will do capitally for the
+present. Ramoo will do the cooking for me in future. He need not
+go into the kitchen to scare the maids. I could see they looked at
+him as if he had been his infernal majesty, as he came in. He can
+do it anywhere; all he wants is an iron pot with some holes in it,
+and some charcoal. He can squat out there on the veranda, or, if
+it is bad weather, any shed will do for him.
+
+"Well, it is nice to be home again, John," he went on, after he had
+eaten a few mouthfuls of chicken and drunk a tumbler of Burgundy
+and water. "I am glad to be back, now I am here, though I dare say
+I should not have come home for another ten years if it had not
+been for this rascally bullet. Where is your boy?"
+
+"He is away at school."
+
+"Well, I think I will go up to bed at once, if you don't mind,
+John. I shall be fitter to talk in the morning."
+
+The next day, indeed, Colonel Thorndyke was materially better. His
+voice was stronger and more cheery, and when he came down after
+breakfast he took his seat in an easy chair instead of on the sofa.
+
+"Now, brother," he said, "we will have a cozy chat. There are several
+things I want done, but the chief of these is that when I am gone
+you should go down to Reigate, as I wanted you to do ten years
+ago. I want you to seem to be its master, as well as be its master,
+until Millicent comes of age, if not longer. Her name is Millicent
+Conyers Thorndyke. I wish her to be called Millicent Conyers, and
+to appear as your ward, and not as your niece and heiress of the
+property. If there is one thing in the world I have a greater horror
+of than another, it is of a girl being married for her money. I
+don't suppose that anyone knows that I have a daughter--at any
+rate, none beyond a few Indian chums. She was sent home with an
+ayah under the charge of the widow of a comrade of mine. I had been
+away for months, and only went back to Calcutta in time to see her
+mother die. So that is all right."
+
+"I could not do such a thing as that, George. I should be living
+under false colors. It is not that I mind so much leaving here
+and looking after the child's interest at Reigate, but I could not
+possibly take possession of the place as its owner when I should
+not be so. Besides, there are other objections. Mark would grow up
+supposing himself to be the heir."
+
+"Mark will be all right. I have, since I have been in London,
+signed a will, leaving the rest of my fortune between them. I had
+it drawn up by our father's solicitors, relying upon your consent
+to do what I asked you. I have explained the matter to them, and
+given them the assignment, or whatever they call it, of the Reigate
+estate to you, until my daughter comes of age, appointing them her
+guardians should you die before that. Thus, you will be placed in
+a proper position; and should it be known by any means that the
+child is my daughter, that deed will still be a proof that you
+are carrying out my wishes, and are absolute master of the estate
+until she comes of age."
+
+"I must think it all over, George. It is a singular proposal, and
+I own I would rather things went on in their regular course."
+
+"Yes, yes, I understand that, John; but you see I have altogether
+set my mind on this matter. I want to know that my girl is not going
+to be married for her money; and, at any rate, that deed makes you
+master of the Reigate estates for the next thirteen years; so the
+only thing that I really want of you is to let the girl be called
+your ward instead of your niece, and that she and everyone else
+shall be in ignorance that she is an heiress. So far from doing
+the girl a wrong, you will be doing her a benefit; and as I have
+explained the whole matter to our lawyers, no one can possibly think
+that the thing has been done from any motive whatever except that
+of affording me satisfaction."
+
+"I will think the matter over," John repeated. "Of course, brother,
+it has been in your mind for some time, but it comes altogether
+fresh to me, and I must look at it in every light. For myself,
+I have no wish at all to become master of our father's estate. I
+have been going in one groove for the last twenty years, and don't
+care about changing it. You wished me to do so ten years ago, and
+I declined then, and the ten years have not made me more desirous
+of change than I was before."
+
+"All right; think it over. Please send Ramoo in to me; I have tired
+myself in talking."
+
+John Thorndyke smoked many churchwarden pipes in the little arbor
+in his garden that day. In the afternoon his brother was so weak
+and tired that the subject of the conversation was not reverted
+to. At eight o'clock the Colonel went off to bed. The next morning,
+after breakfast, he was brighter again.
+
+"Well, John, what has come of your thinking?" he asked.
+
+"I don't like it, George."
+
+"You mayn't like it, John, but you will do it. I am not going to
+have my girl run after by ruined spendthrifts who want her money
+to repair their fortunes; and I tell you frankly, if you refuse I
+shall go up to town tomorrow, and I shall make a new will, leaving
+all my property to your son, subject to a life annuity of 200 pounds
+a year to the child, and ordering that, in the event of his dying
+before he comes of age, or of refusing to accept the provisions
+of the will, or handing any of the property or money over to my
+daughter, the whole estate, money, jewels, and all, shall go to
+the London hospitals, subject, as before, to the annuity.
+
+"Don't be an ass, brother John. Do you think that I don't know what
+I am doing? I have seen enough of the evils of marrying for money
+out in India. Every ship that comes out brings so many girls sent
+out to some relation to be put on the marriage market, and marrying
+men old enough to be pretty nearly their grandfathers, with the
+natural consequence that there is the devil to pay before they
+have been married a year or two. Come, you know you will do it;
+why not give in at once, and have done with it? It is not a bad
+thing for you, it will be a good thing for your boy, it will save
+my girl from fortune hunters, and enable me to die quietly and
+comfortably."
+
+"All right, George, I will do it. Mind, I don't do it willingly,
+but I do it for your sake."
+
+"That is right," Colonel Thorndyke said, holding out his thin bronzed
+hand to his brother; "that is off my mind. Now, there is only one
+other thing--those confounded jewels. But I won't talk about them
+now."
+
+It was not indeed till three or four days later that the Colonel
+again spoke to his brother on any than ordinary matters. He had
+indeed been very weak and ailing. After breakfast, when, as usual,
+he was a little stronger and brighter than later in the day, he
+said to his brother suddenly:--
+
+"I suppose there are no hiding places in this room?"
+
+"Hiding places! What do you mean, George?"
+
+"Places where a fellow could hide up and hear what we are talking
+about."
+
+"No, I don't think so," the Squire replied, looking round vaguely.
+"Such an idea never occurred to me. Why do you ask?"
+
+"Because, John, if there is such a thing as a hiding place, someone
+will be sure to be hiding there. Where does that door lead to?"
+
+"It doesn't lead anywhere; it used to lead into the next room, but
+it was closed up before my time, and turned into a cupboard, and
+this door is permanently closed."
+
+"Do you mind stepping round into the next room and seeing if anyone
+is in the cupboard?"
+
+Thinking that his brother was a little light headed, John Thorndyke
+went into the next room, and returned, saying gravely that no one
+was there.
+
+"Will you look behind the curtains, John, and under this sofa, and
+everywhere else where even a cat could be hidden? That seems all
+right," the Colonel went on, as his brother continued the search.
+"You know there is a saying that walls have ears, and I am not
+sure that it is not so. I have been haunted with the feeling that
+everything I did was watched, and that everything I said was listened
+to for years; and I can tell you it is a devilishly unpleasant
+thought. Draw your chair quite close to me. It is about my jewels,
+John. I always had a fancy for jewels--not to wear them, but to
+own them. In my time I have had good opportunities in that way, both
+in the Madras Presidency and in the Carnatic. In the first place,
+I have never cared for taking presents in money, but I have never
+refused jewels; and what with Rajahs and Nabobs and Ministers that
+one had helped or done a good turn to somehow, a good deal came to
+me that way.
+
+"Then I always made a point of carrying money with me, and after
+a defeat of the enemy or a successful siege, there was always lots
+of loot, and the soldiers were glad enough to sell anything in the
+way of jewels for a tithe of their value in gold. I should say if
+I put the value of the jewels at 50,000 pounds I am not much wide
+of the mark. That is all right, there is no bother about them;
+the trouble came from a diamond bracelet that I got from a soldier.
+We were in camp near Tanjore. I was officer of the day. I had
+made my rounds, and was coming back to my quarters, when I saw a
+soldier coming out of a tent thirty or forty yards away. It was a
+moonlight night, and the tent was one belonging to a white Madras
+regiment. Suddenly, I saw another figure, that had been lying down
+outside the tent, rise. I saw the flash of the moonlight on steel;
+then there was a blow, and the soldier fell. I drew my sword and
+rushed forward.
+
+"The native--for I could see that it was a native--was bending
+over the man he had stabbed. His back was towards me, and on the
+sandy soil he did not hear my footsteps until I was close to him;
+then he sprang up with a cry of fury, and leaped on me like a
+tiger. I was so taken by surprise that before I could use my sword
+the fellow had given me a nasty stab on the shoulder; but before
+he could strike again I had run him through. By this time several
+other, men ran out of the tent, uttering exclamations of rage at
+seeing their fallen comrade.
+
+"'What is it, sir?' they asked me.
+
+"'This scoundrel, here, has stabbed your comrade,' I said. 'He did
+not see me coming, and I ran up just as he was, I think, rifling
+him for booty. He came at me like a wild cat, and has given me a
+nasty stab. However, I have put an end to his game. Is your comrade
+dead?'
+
+"'No, sir, he is breathing still; but I fancy there is little chance
+for him.'
+
+"'You had better carry him to the hospital tent at once; I will
+send a surgeon there.'
+
+"I called the regimental surgeon up, and went with him to the
+hospital tent, telling him what had happened. He shook his head after
+examining the man's wound, which was fairly between the shoulders.
+
+"'He may live a few hours, but there is no chance of his getting
+better.'
+
+"'Now,' I said, 'you may as well have a look at my wound, for the
+villain stabbed me too.'
+
+"'You have had a pretty narrow escape of it,' he said, as he
+examined it. 'If he had struck an inch or two nearer the shoulder
+the knife would have gone right into you; but you see I expect he
+was springing as he struck, and the blow fell nearly perpendicularly,
+and it glanced down over your ribs, and made a gash six inches long.
+There is no danger. I will bandage it now, and tomorrow morning I
+will sew the edges together, and make a proper job of it.'
+
+"In the morning one of the hospital attendants came to me and said
+the soldier who had been wounded wanted to speak to me. The doctor
+said he would not live long. I went across to him. He was on a bed
+some little distance from any of the others, for it was the healthy
+season, and there were only three or four others in the tent.
+
+"'I hear, Major Thorndyke,' he said in a low voice, 'that you
+killed that fellow who gave me this wound, and that you yourself
+were stabbed.'
+
+"'Mine is not a serious business, my man,' I said. 'I wish you had
+got off as easily.'
+
+"'I have been expecting it, sir,' he said; 'and how I came to be
+fool enough to go outside the tent by myself I cannot think. I was
+uneasy, and could not sleep; I felt hot and feverish, and came out
+for a breath of fresh air. I will tell you what caused it, sir.
+About two years ago a cousin of mine, in one of the King's regiments,
+who was dying, they said, of fever (but I know the doctors thought
+he had been poisoned), said to me, "Here are some things that
+will make your fortune if ever you get to England; but I tell you
+beforehand, they are dangerous things to keep about you. I fancy
+that they have something to do with my being like this now. A year
+ago I went with some others into one of their great temples on
+a feast day. Well, the god had got on all his trinkets, and among
+them was a bracelet with the biggest diamonds I ever saw. I did not
+think so much of it at the time, but I kept on thinking of them
+afterwards, and it happened that some months after our visit we
+took the place by storm. I made straight for the temple, and I got
+the jewels. It don't matter how I got them--I got them. Well,
+since that I have never had any peace; pretty near every night one
+or other of our tents was turned topsy turvy, all the kits turned
+out, and even the ground dug up with knives. You know how silently
+Indian thieves can work. However, nothing was ever stolen, and as
+for the diamonds, at the end of every day's march I always went
+out as soon as it was quite dark, and buried the bracelet between
+the tent pegs; it did not take a minute to do. When we moved, of
+course, I took it up again. At last I gave that up, for however
+early I turned out in the morning there was sure to be a native
+about. I took then to dropping it down the barrel of my gun; that
+way I beat them. Still, I have always somehow felt myself watched,
+and my tent has been disturbed a great deal oftener than any of
+the others. I have had half a mind to throw the things away many
+a time, but I could not bring myself to do it."
+
+"'Well, sir, I have carried the bracelet ever since. I have done
+as he did, and always had it in my musket barrel--When we had
+fighting to do I would drop it out into my hand and slip it into
+my ammunition pouch; but I know that I have always been followed,
+just as Bill was. I suppose they found out that I went to see him
+before he died. Anyhow, my tent has been rummaged again and again.
+I have no doubt that fellow whom you killed last night had been
+watching me all the time, and thought that I had come out to hide
+the things. However, there they are, sir. One of my mates brought
+my musket here a quarter of an hour ago, and emptied the barrel
+out for me. Now, sir, you did your best to save my life last night,
+and you killed that fellow who did for me, and you pretty nearly
+got killed yourself. I have got no one else I could give the things
+to, and if I were to give them to one of my mates in the regiment
+they would probably cost him his life, as they have cost me mine.
+But you will know what to do with the things; they are worth a lot
+of money if you can get them home. Mind, sir, you have got to be
+careful. I have heard tales of how those priests will follow up
+a temple jewel that has been lost for years, and never give it up
+until they get it back again.'
+
+"'I ought to give it up,' I said.
+
+"'You don't know where it came from, sir,' he replied. 'I was one
+of a party of convalescents who were sent up just before that fight,
+and my own regiment was not there: it might have been here, and it
+might have been in the Carnatic. Bill never told me, and I have no
+more idea than a babe unborn.'
+
+"The gems were certainly magnificent; and though I knew well enough
+that these untiring Brahmins would not be long in guessing that the
+things had come into my possession, I took the bracelet. I thought,
+anyhow, that I might have a few hours' start; the fellow I had
+killed might, of course, have one or two others with him, but I had
+to risk that. I got leave an hour later, and went down to Madras,
+and got them put into a place of safety. That I was watched all
+the time I was in India afterwards I have no doubt, but no attempts
+were made to assassinate me. They would have known that I went
+straight away, but whether I had buried them somewhere on the road,
+or had given them to someone's care at Madras they could not know,
+and there was, therefore, nothing for them to do but to wait till
+I made a move.
+
+"I have no doubt whatever that they came over in the same ship
+with me. Two or three times during the week I was in London I saw
+colored men in the street outside the hotel. Once it was a Lascar
+seaman, another time a dark looking sailor in European clothes: he
+might pass for a Spaniard. Several times as I was going about in a
+sedan chair I looked out suddenly, and each time there was a dark
+face somewhere in the street behind. I had a letter this morning
+from the lawyer, and he mentioned that two days ago his offices
+had been broken into, and every strong box and drawer forced open,
+but that, curiously enough, they could not find that anything had
+been stolen, though in the cashier's box there were 30 pounds in
+gold. Of course it was my friends. I have no doubt that one or two
+of them have followed me down here; and for anything I know they
+may be lurking somewhere in your garden at the present moment--
+that is, if they are not standing beside us in this room."
+
+John Thorndyke looked round with an uncomfortable feeling.
+
+"How do you mean, George?"
+
+"I mean some of those Indian fellows can do all sorts of wonderful
+conjuring tricks. I have seen them go up into the air on a rope
+and never come down again, and for aught I know they may be able to
+render themselves invisible. Seriously, I think that it is likely
+as not."
+
+"Well, and where are the things to be found now, George?"
+
+"That I won't tell you, John. Before I go I will whisper it in your
+ear, and give you the means of finding them, but not till then.
+No, I will write it down on a piece of paper, and slip it into your
+hand. As soon as you get out of the room you glance at it, and then
+put the piece of paper into your mouth, chew it up and swallow it.
+I tell you I dare not even whisper it; but whatever you do, take
+no steps in the matter until your son comes of age."
+
+"There can surely be no danger in another twelve years, George;
+they will have given up the search long before that."
+
+
+"Not they," the Colonel said emphatically. "If they die others will
+take their places: it is a sacred business with them. My advice to
+you is, either sell them directly you get them into your hands, or
+go straight to Amsterdam and sell them there to one of the diamond
+cutters, who will turn them out so that they will be altered beyond
+all recognition. Don't sell more than two stones at most to any
+one man; then they will never come out as a bracelet again, and
+the hunt will be over."
+
+
+"I would almost rather leave them alone altogether, George."
+
+"Well, they are worth 50,000 pounds if they are worth a penny, and
+a great deal more I should say; but you cannot leave them alone
+without leaving everything alone, for all my gems are with them,
+and 52,000 pounds in gold. Of course, if you like you can, when
+you get the box, pick those diamonds out and chuck them away, but
+if you do you must do it openly, so that anyone watching you may
+see you do it, otherwise the search will go on."
+
+Two days later, as Ramoo was helping the Colonel to the sofa, the
+latter was seized with a violent fit of coughing, then a rush of
+blood poured from his lips. His brother and Ramoo laid him on the
+sofa almost insensible.
+
+"Run and get some water, Ramoo," John Thorndyke said.
+
+As Ramoo left the room the Colonel feebly placed his snuffbox in
+his brother's hand with a significant glance; then he made several
+desperate efforts to speak, and tried to struggle up into a sitting
+position; another gush of blood poured from him, and as it ceased
+he fell back dead.
+
+John Thorndyke was bitterly grieved at the death of his brother,
+and it was not until he went up to his room that night that he
+thought of the snuffbox that he had dropped into his pocket as his
+brother handed it to him. He had no doubt that it contained the
+instructions as to the treasure. It was of Indian manufacture. He
+emptied the snuff from it, but it contained nothing else. He was
+convinced that the secret must be hidden there, and after in vain
+endeavoring to find a spring, he took a poker and hammered it,
+and as it bent a spring gave way, and showed a very shallow false
+bottom.
+
+In this was a thin gold coin, evidently of considerable antiquity,
+and a small piece of paper, on which was written the word "Masulipatam."
+John Thorndyke looked at it in bewilderment; that it was connected
+with the secret he felt certain, but alone it was absolutely
+useless. Doubtless his brother had intended to give him the key of
+the riddle, when he had so desperately striven to speak. After in
+vain thinking the matter over he said:
+
+"Well, thank goodness; there is nothing to be done about the matter
+for another thirteen or fourteen years; it is of no use worrying
+about it now." He went to an old fashioned cabinet, and placed the
+coin and piece of paper in a very cunningly devised secret drawer.
+The next morning he went out into the garden and dropped the battered
+snuffbox into the well, and then dismissed the subject from his
+mind.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+
+Standing some two miles out of Reigate is the village of Crowswood,
+a quiet place and fairly well to do, thanks in no small degree to
+Squire Thorndyke, who owned the whole of the, parish, and by whom
+and his tenants the greater portion of the village were employed.
+Greatly had the closing of the Manor House, after the death of old
+Squire Thorndyke, been felt. There were no more jellies, soups, and
+other comforts to be looked for in time of sickness, no abatement
+of rent when the breadwinner was sick or disabled, no check to
+the drunkards, whom the knowledge that they would be turned out of
+their cottage at a week's notice kept in some sort of order. When,
+therefore, after ten years of absence of all government, John
+Thorndyke, after the death of his brother, the Colonel, came down
+and took possession, he found the place sadly changed from what
+it had been when he had left it twenty years before. His first act
+was to dismiss Newman; who, completely unchecked, had, he found,
+been sadly mismanaging affairs. It was not long, however, before
+his hand made itself felt. Two out of the three public houses were
+shut up in six months, a score of their habitual frequenters had,
+weeks before, been turned out of their houses, an order had been
+issued that unless a cottage was kept in good order and the garden
+bright and blooming with flowers in the summer a fresh tenant would
+be found for it. Every child must be sent to the village school;
+the Squire was ready to do what there was to be done in the way of
+thatching and whitewashing, repairing palings and painting doors
+and windows, but, as he told the people, the village had to be kept
+clean and decent, and anyone who would not conform to the rules
+was at liberty to leave without a day's notice.
+
+Many of the villagers grumbled under their breath, but public opinion
+was, on the whole, favorable. There was someone to look after them
+now, someone who would see that the greater portion of the wages
+was not spent at the alehouse, who would take an interest in
+the people, and would lend a helping hand in bad times. There was
+a feeling of regret that the Squire was a widower, but the post
+of visitor and almoner was well supplied by the lady who acted as
+companion and governess to the Squire's little ward and regulated
+the affairs of his household.
+
+John Thorndyke had never had much occasion for the display of energy
+before, but he had an abundance of it, although hitherto latent.
+He had come into this business against his will, but he took it up
+with a determination to do well in it. The income was legally his
+until his niece came of age, but he was determined he would take
+nothing out of the estate beyond the necessary expenses of the
+position, and that all surplus should be expended in improving it
+in every way possible, so that he could hand it over to her in the
+most perfect condition. Therefore, when he came into possession
+he made a close inspection of the farms, with their houses, barns,
+and other tenements. Where he saw that the men were doing their best,
+that the hedges and fields were in good order, he did everything
+that was necessary without a word; but where there were slovenly
+farming and signs of neglect and carelessness, he spoke out his
+mind sharply.
+
+"This has all got to be amended," he said. "What must be done I
+will do, but unless I see things well kept up, the fences in good
+order, the hedges cut, the cattle in good condition, and everything
+going on as it ought to be, out you go next Christmas. The estate
+at present is a disgrace to the county, but it shall not be so any
+longer if I can help it. I shall do my share, and anyone who is not
+prepared to do the same had better look out for another holding at
+once."
+
+No one rejoiced more at the coming home of the Squire than Mr.
+Bastow, the Rector. He had had a pleasant time of it during the
+life of the old Squire. He was always a welcome guest at the house;
+Mr. Thorndyke had been ever ready to put his hand into his pocket
+for any repairs needed for the church, and bore on his shoulders
+almost the entire expense of the village school. In the latter
+respect there had been no falling off, he having given explicit
+instructions to his solicitors to pay his usual annual subscriptions
+to the school until his son's return from India. But with the death
+of the Squire the Rector had gradually lost all authority in the
+village.
+
+For a time force of habit had had its effect, but as this wore
+out and the people recognized that he had no real authority things
+went from bad to worse. Drunken men would shout jeeringly as they
+passed the Rectory on their way home from the alehouse; women
+no longer feared reproof for the untidiness of their houses and
+children; the school was half emptied and the church almost wholly
+so.
+
+For seven or eight years Mr. Bastow had a hard time of it. It
+was, then, both with pleasure as an old friend, and with renewed
+hopefulness for the village, that he visited John Thorndyke on his
+return. The change in the state of affairs was almost instantaneous.
+As soon as it became known that the Rector was backed, heart and
+soul, by the Squire's authority, and that a complaint from him was
+followed the next day by a notice to quit at the end of a week,
+his own authority was established as firmly as it had been in the
+old Squire's time, and in a couple of years Crowswood became quite
+a model village. Every garden blossomed with flowers; roses and
+eglantine clustered over the cottages, neatness and order prevailed
+everywhere.
+
+The children were tidily dressed and respectful in manner, the
+women bright and cheerful, and the solitary alehouse remaining had
+but few customers, and those few were never allowed to transgress
+the bounds of moderation. The Squire had a talk with the landlord
+a fortnight after his arrival.
+
+"I am not going to turn you out, Peters," he said. "I hear that
+you make some efforts to keep your house decently; the other two I
+shall send packing directly their terms are up. Whether you remain
+permanently must depend upon yourself. I will do up your house for
+you, and build a bar parlor alongside, where quiet men can sit and
+smoke their pipes and talk and take their beer in comfort, and have
+liberty to enjoy themselves as long as their enjoyment does not
+cause annoyance to other people or keep their wives and children in
+rags. I will do anything for you if I find the place well conducted;
+but I warn you that I will have no drunkenness. A man who, to my
+knowledge, gets drunk twice, will not get drunk a third time in
+this parish, and if you let men get drunk here it is your fault as
+much as theirs. Now we understand each other."
+
+Things once placed on a satisfactory footing, the Squire had but
+little more trouble, and it soon came to be understood that he was
+not to be trifled with, and that Crowswood was no longer a place
+for the idle or shiftless. Two or three of the farmers left at the
+termination of their year, but better men took their places, and
+John Thorndyke, having settled matters to his satisfaction, now
+began to attend more to other affairs. He had been, when he first
+came back, welcomed with great heartiness by all the gentry of the
+neighborhood; his father had been a popular man, and young Thorndyke
+had been regarded as a pleasant young fellow, and would in any case
+have been welcomed, if only because Crowswood had become a nuisance
+to the whole district. It was, indeed, a sort of rendezvous for
+poachers and bad characters, it was more than suspected that gangs
+of thieves and burglars made it their headquarters, and that even
+highwaymen found it a convenient and quiet resort.
+
+Thus, then, the transformation effected within a few months of Mr.
+Thorndyke's return caused general and lively satisfaction, and a
+year later he was put on the Commission of the Peace, and became
+one of the most regular attendants at the Bench of Magistrates.
+Reluctantly as he had taken up his present position, he found it,
+as time went on, a pleasant one. He had not been conscious before
+that time hung somewhat heavily on his hands, but here he had
+duties to perform and ample employment. His nature was naturally
+somewhat a masterful one, and both as a magistrate and a landlord
+he had scope and power of action. Occasionally he went up to London,
+always driving his gig, with a pair of fast trotting horses, and
+was known to the frequenters of the coffee houses chiefly patronized
+by country gentlemen. Altogether, John Thorndyke became quite a
+notable person in the district, and men were inclined to congratulate
+themselves upon the fact that he, and not the Indian officer, his
+brother, had come into the estate.
+
+The idea of an old Indian officer in those days was that he was
+almost of necessity an invalid, and an irritable one, with a liver
+hopelessly deranged, a yellow complexion, and a hatred of the
+English climate. The fact that, instead of leaving the army and
+coming home at his father's death, George Thorndyke had chosen to
+remain abroad and leave the estate to the management of agents, had
+specially prejudiced him in the eyes of the people of that part,
+and had heightened the warmth with which they had received his
+brother. John Thorndyke had upon the occasion, of his first visit
+to the family solicitors spoken his mind with much freedom as to
+the manner in which Newman had been allowed a free hand.
+
+"Another ten years," he said, "and there would not have been
+a cottage habitable on the estate, nor a farm worth cultivating.
+He did absolutely nothing beyond collecting the rents. He let the
+whole place go to rack and ruin. The first day I arrived I sent him
+out of the house, with a talking to that he won't forget as long
+as he lives."
+
+"We never heard any complaints about him, Mr. Thorndyke, except
+that I think we did once hear from the Rector of the place that
+his conduct was not satisfactory. I remember that we wrote to him
+about it, and he said that the Rector was a malignant fellow, on
+bad terms with all his parishioners."
+
+"If I had the scoundrel here," John Thorndyke said with indignation, "I
+would let him have a taste of the lash of my dog whip. You should
+not have taken the fellow's word; you should have sent down someone
+to find out the true state of things. Why, the place has been an
+eyesore to the whole neighborhood, the resort of poaching, thieving
+rascals; by gad, if my brother George had gone down there I don't
+know what would have happened! It will cost a couple of years' rent
+to get things put straight."
+
+When the Squire was at home there was scarce an evening when the
+Rector did not come up to smoke a pipe and take his glass of old
+Jamaica or Hollands with him.
+
+"Look here, Bastow," the latter said, some three years after his
+return, "what are you going to do with that boy of yours? I hear bad
+reports of him from everyone; he gets into broils at the alehouse,
+and I hear that he consorts with a bad lot of fellows down at
+Reigate. One of my tenants--I won't mention names--complained
+to me that he had persecuted his daughter with his attentions. They
+say, he was recognized among that poaching gang that had an affray
+with Sir James Hartrop's keepers. The thing is becoming a gross
+scandal."
+
+"I don't know what to do about him, Squire; the boy has always
+been a trouble to me. You see, before you came home, he got into
+bad hands in the village here. Of course they have all gone, but
+several of them only moved as far as Reigate, and he kept up their
+acquaintance. I thrashed him again and again, but he has got beyond
+that now, you see; he is nearly eighteen, and openly scoffs at my
+authority. Upon my word, I don't know what to do in the matter."
+
+"He is growing up a thorough young ruffian," the Squire said
+indignantly, "and one of these mornings I expect to see him brought
+up before us charged with some serious offense. We had to fine him
+last week for being drunk and making a disturbance down at Reigate.
+Why do you let him have money? You may have no authority over him;
+but at least you should refuse to open your purse to him. Don't
+you see that this sort of thing is not only a disgrace to him, but
+very prejudicial to the village? What authority can you have for
+speaking against vice and drunkenness, when your son is constantly
+intoxicated?"
+
+"I see that, Squire--none better; and I have thought of resigning
+my cure."
+
+"Stuff and nonsense, Parson! If the young fellow persists in his
+present course he must leave the village, that is clear enough;
+but that is no reason why you should. The question is what is to
+be done with him? The best thing he could do would be to enlist. He
+might be of some service to his country, in India or the American
+Colonies, but so far as I can see he is only qualifying himself
+for a jail here."
+
+"I have told him as much, Squire," Mr. Bastow said, in a depressed
+voice, "and he has simply laughed in my face, and said that he was
+very comfortable where he was, and had no idea whatever of moving."
+
+"What time does he go out in the morning?" John Thorndyke asked
+abruptly.
+
+"He never gets up till twelve o'clock, and has his breakfast when
+I take my dinner."
+
+"Well, I will come in tomorrow morning and have a talk with him
+myself."
+
+The next day the Squire rode up to the door of the Rectory soon
+after one o'clock. Mr. Bastow had just finished his meal; his son,
+a young fellow of between seventeen and eighteen, was lolling in
+an easy chair.
+
+"I have come in principally to speak to you, young sir," John
+Thorndyke said quietly. "I have been asking your father what you
+intend to do with yourself. He says he does not know."
+
+The young fellow looked up with an air of insolent effrontery.
+
+"I don't know that it is any business of yours, Mr. Thorndyke, what
+I do with myself."
+
+"Oh, yes, it is," the Squire replied. "This village and the people
+in it are mine. You are disturbing the village with your blackguard
+conduct; you are annoying some of the girls on the estate, and
+altogether you are making yourself a nuisance. I stopped at the
+alehouse as I came here, and have ordered the landlord to draw no
+more liquor for you, and unless you amend your conduct, and that
+quickly, I will have you out of the village altogether."
+
+"I fancy, Mr. Thorndyke, that, even as a justice of the peace, you
+have not the power to dictate to my father who shall be the occupant
+of this house."
+
+"What you say is perfectly true; but as you make your father's life
+a burden to him, and he is desirous of your absence, I can and will
+order the village constable to remove you from his house by force,
+if necessary."
+
+The young fellow cast an evil glance at his father. "He has not
+been complaining, has he?" he said, with a sneer.
+
+"He has not, sir," John Thorndyke said indignantly. "It is I who
+have been complaining to him, and he admits that you are altogether
+beyond his authority. I have pointed out to him that he is in no
+way obliged to support you at your age in idleness and dissipation,
+and that it were best for him and all concerned that he should
+close his doors to you. I don't want to have to send the son of my
+old friend to prison, but I can see well enough that that is what
+it will come to if you don't give up your evil courses. I should
+think you know by this time that I am a man of my word. I have
+taken some pains to purge this village of all bad characters, and
+I do not intend to have an exception made of the son of the clergyman,
+who, in his family as well as in his own person, is bound to set
+an example."
+
+"Well, Mr. Thorndyke, I utterly decline to obey your orders or to
+be guided by your advice."
+
+"Very well, sir," the magistrate said sternly. "Mr. Bastow, do I
+understand that you desire that your son shall no longer remain an
+inmate of your house?"
+
+"I do," the clergyman said firmly; "and if he does so I have no
+other course before me but to resign my living; my position here
+has become absolutely unbearable."
+
+"Very well, sir, then you will please lock your doors tonight, and
+if he attempts to enter, I, as a magistrate, should know how to
+deal with him. Now, young sir, you understand your position; you
+may not take my advice, nevertheless, I shall give it you. The best
+thing you can do is to take your place for town on the outside of
+the coach that comes through Reigate this afternoon, and tomorrow
+morning proceed either to the recruiting officer for His Majesty's
+service, or to that for the East India Company's. You have health
+and strength, you will get rid at once of your bad associates, and
+will start afresh in a life in which you may redeem your past and
+be useful to your king and country."
+
+Young Bastow smiled.
+
+"Thanks," he said sarcastically. "I have my own plans, and shall
+follow them."
+
+"I would think, Mr. Bastow," the Squire said quietly, "it would
+just be as well for you to come home with me. I don't think that
+the leave taking is likely to be an affectionate one."
+
+The Rector rose at once.
+
+"I will come with you, Squire. I may tell you now, what I have not
+told you before, that my son has more than once raised his hand
+against me, and that I do not care to be left alone with him."
+
+"I judged him capable even of that, Mr. Bastow."
+
+"Goodby, Arthur," his father said. "My heart is ready to break
+that it has come to this; but for both our sakes it is better so.
+Goodby, my son, and may Heaven lead you to better ways! If ever
+you come to me and say, 'Father, I have turned over a new leaf, and
+heartily repent the trouble I have caused you,' you will receive
+a hearty welcome from me, and no words of reproach for the past."
+
+The young man paid no attention to the offered hand, but laughed
+scornfully.
+
+"You have not got rid of me yet," he said. "As for you, Squire
+Thorndyke, I shall not forget your meddlesome interference, and
+some day, maybe, you will be sorry for it."
+
+"I think not," John Thorndyke said gravely. "I am doing my duty to
+the village, and still more I am doing my duty to an old friend,
+and I am not likely ever to feel any regret that I have so acted.
+Now, Parson, let's be off."
+
+After leaving the house with the clergyman, the Squire stopped at
+the house of Knapp, the village constable; and said a few words to
+him, then, leading his horse, walked home with Mr. Bastow.
+
+"Don't be cast down, old friend," he said. "It is a terrible trial
+to you; but it is one sharp wrench, and then it will be over.
+Anything is better than what you must have been suffering for some
+time."
+
+"I quite feel that, Squire; my life has indeed been intolerable of
+late. I had a painful time before, but always looked forward with
+hope to your brother coming home. Since you returned, and matters
+in the parish have been put straight, this trouble has come in to
+take the place of the other, and I have felt that I would rather
+resign and beg for charity than see my son going from bad to worse,
+a scandal to the parish, and a hindrance to all good work."
+
+"It is a bad business, Bastow, and it seems to me that two or
+three years in prison would be the best thing for him, as he will
+not take up the only trade open to him. At any rate, it would
+separate him from his evil associates, and give you peace while he
+is behind the bars. Where does he get his money?"
+
+"That I know not, Squire. He takes some from me--it used to be
+done secretly, now it is done with threats, and, as I told you,
+with violence--but that would not account for his always having
+money. He must get it somewhere else, for when I have paid my bills,
+as I always do the hour that I receive money, there is but little
+over for him to take. He is often away all night, sometimes for
+two or three days together, and I dare not think what he does with
+himself; but certainly he gets money somehow, and I am afraid that
+I cannot hope it is honestly obtained."
+
+"I do not well see how it can be," the Squire agreed.
+
+"If I had before known as much as you tell me now, I would have
+taken some steps to have him watched, and to nip the matter before
+it went too far. Do you think that he will take your notice, and
+come no more to the house?"
+
+Mr. Bastow shook his head.
+
+"I fear that the only effect will be to make him worse, even when
+he was quite a small boy punishment only had that effect with
+him. He will come back tonight probably half drunk, and certainly
+furious at my having ventured to lay the case before you."
+
+"You must lock the doors and bar the windows."
+
+"I did that when he first took to being out at night, but he always
+managed to get in somehow."
+
+"Well, it must be all put a stop to, Bastow; and I will come back
+With you this evening, and if this young rascal breaks into the
+house I will have him down at Reigate tomorrow on the charge of
+house breaking; or, at any rate, I will threaten to do so if he
+does not give a promise that he will in future keep away from you
+altogether."
+
+"I shall be glad, at any rate, if you will come down, Squire, for,
+to say the truth, I feel uneasy as to the steps he may take in his
+fury at our conversation just now."
+
+John Thorndyke took down from a wall a heavy hunting whip, as he
+went out with the parson at nine o'clock. He had in vain endeavored
+to cheer his old friend as they sat over their steaming glasses of
+Jamaica. The parson had never been a strong man; he was of a kindly
+disposition, and an unwearied worker when there was an opportunity
+for work, but he had always shrunk from unpleasantness, and was
+ready to yield rather than bring about trouble. He had for a long
+time suffered in silence, and had not the Squire himself approached
+the subject of his son's delinquencies, he would have never opened
+his mouth about it. Now, however, that he had done so, and the
+Squire had taken the matter in hand, and had laid down what was to
+be done, though he trembled at the prospect, he did not even think
+of opposing his plan, and indeed could think of no alternative for
+it.
+
+"I have told John Knapp to be here," the Squire said, as they
+reached the house. "It is just as well that he should be present
+if your son comes back again. He is a quiet, trustworthy fellow,
+and will keep his mouth shut if I tell him."
+
+Mr. Bastow made no reply. It was terrible to him that there should
+be another witness to his son's conduct, but he saw that the Squire
+was right. An old woman opened the door.
+
+"Are all the shutters closed and barred?" John Thorndyke asked her.
+
+"Yes, sir; I always sees to that as soon as it gets dark."
+
+"Very well; you can go to bed now, Elisa," her master said. "Is
+John Knapp here?"
+
+"Yes, he came an hour ago, and is sitting in the kitchen."
+
+"I will call him in myself when I want to speak to him."
+
+As soon as the old servant had gone upstairs the Squire went into
+the kitchen, Mr. Bastow having gone to the cellar to fetch up
+a bottle of old brandy that was part of a two dozen case given to
+him by the old Squire fifteen years before.
+
+"Do you go round the house, John, and see that everything is properly
+fastened up. I see that you have got a jug of beer there. You had
+better get a couple of hours' sleep on that settle. I shall keep
+watch, till I am sleepy, and then I will call you. Let me know if
+you find any of the doors or windows unbarred."
+
+Five minutes later the constable knocked at the door of the parlor.
+"The door opening into the stable yard was unbarred, Squire."
+
+"I thought it likely that it would be so, Knapp. You have made it
+fast now, I suppose? That is right. Now lie down and get an hour or
+two of sleep; it is scarce likely that he will be back until late.
+
+"That was the old woman, of course," he went on to his companion,
+when the door closed behind the constable. "I thought it likely
+enough that he might tell her to leave a way for him to come in.
+You told me that she had been with you a good many years. I dare
+say she has left that door unbarred for him many a time. I should
+advise you to get a man to sleep in the house regularly; there
+are plenty of fellows who will be glad to do it for a shilling or
+two a week, and I do not think that it is safe for you to be here
+alone."
+
+An hour later he said to the Rector: "Now, Bastow, you had best go
+to bed. I have taken the matter into my own hands, and will carry
+it through. However, I won't have him taken away without your being
+present, and will call you when we want you. Of course, if he will
+give a solemn promise not to molest you, and, even if he won't
+enlist, to leave this part of the country altogether, I shall let
+him off."
+
+"There is one thing, Mr. Thorndyke, that I have not told you," the
+Rector said hesitatingly. "Sometimes, when he comes home late, he
+brings someone with him; I have heard voices downstairs. I have
+never seen who it was--for what could I have done if I went down?
+--but I have heard horses brought round to the stable yard, and
+heard them ride away:"
+
+"It is just as well you told me," the Squire said dryly. "If you
+had told me this evening at the house, I would have dropped a brace
+of pistols into my pocket. However, this hunting crop is a good
+weapon; but I don't suppose they will show fight, even if anyone
+is with him. Besides, Knapp has a stout oaken cudgel with him--
+I noticed it standing against his chair as I went in--and as he
+is a strong active fellow, and we shall have the advantage of a
+surprise, I fancy we should be a match even for three or four of
+them."
+
+At one o'clock the Squire roused John Knapp. "It is one o'clock,
+John; now take off your boots. I don't want him to know that there
+is anyone in the house till we get hold of him. I am going to lie
+down on the sofa in the parlor. The moment you hear footsteps you
+come and wake me."
+
+The clock in the kitchen had just struck two when the constable
+shook John Thorndyke. "There are two horses just coming into the
+yard."
+
+"All right. I opened a window in the room looking down into the
+yard before I lay down. I will go up and see what they are going
+to do. If they try to break in anywhere down here, do you come at
+once quietly up to me."
+
+The Squire had taken off his boots before he lay down, and, holding
+his heavy hunting crop in his hand, he went quietly upstairs. As
+he went to the window he heard Arthur Bastow say angrily:
+
+"Confound the old woman! she has locked the door; she has never
+played me that trick before. There is a ladder in the stable, and
+I will get in at that window up there and open it for you. Or you
+may as well come up that way, too, and then you can stow the things
+away in my room at once, and have done with it."
+
+The Squire went hastily down.
+
+"Come upstairs, Knapp," he whispered to the constable. "There are
+three of them, and I fancy the two mounted men are highwaymen. Let
+them all get in, keeping yourself well back from the window. The
+moon is round on the other side of the house, but it will be light
+enough for us to see them as they get in. I will take the last
+fellow, and I will warrant that he will give no trouble; then I
+will fall upon the second, and do you spring on young Bastow. The
+two highwaymen are sure to have pistols, and he may have some also.
+Give him a clip with that cudgel of yours first, then spring on
+him, and hold his arms tightly by his side. If I call you give him
+a back heel and throw him smartly, and then come to my aid. I don't
+think I shall want it, but it is as well to prepare for everything."
+
+They went upstairs and took their places, one on each side of the
+window, standing three or four feet back. Just as they took up their
+positions the top of the stable ladder appeared above the sill of
+the window. Half a minute later young Bastow's head appeared, and
+he threw up the sash still higher, and stepped into the room; then
+he turned and helped two men in, one after the other.
+
+"Follow me," he said, "then you won't tumble over the furniture."
+
+As they turned, the heavy handle of John's Thorndyke's whip fell
+with tremendous force on the head of the last man.
+
+"What the devil is that?" the other exclaimed, snatching out a
+pistol and turning round, as the falling body struck him, but he
+got no further. Again the heavy whip descended, this time on his
+right arm; it dropped useless by his side, and the pistol fell
+from his hand. Then John Thorndyke fell upon him and bore him to
+the ground, snatched the other pistol from his belt, and held it
+to his head.
+
+"Now, my man," he said quietly, "if you don't surrender I will blow
+out your brains."
+
+"I surrender," the man moaned. "I believe that you have broken my
+arm. Curse you, whoever you are."
+
+The struggle between John Knapp and young Bastow was soon over.
+The young fellow was lithe and sinewy, but he was no match for the
+constable, who, indeed, had almost overpowered him before he was
+aware what had happened.
+
+"Has he got pistols, Knapp?" the Squire asked.
+
+"Yes, sir, a brace of them; I have got them both safely in my
+pocket. There," he went on, as a sharp click was heard, "I have
+got the darbys on him. Now shall I help you, sir?"
+
+"You had better run downstairs first and light a couple of candles
+at the kitchen fire: you will find a pair standing on the parlor
+table. Don't be long about it; the first fellow I hit was stunned,
+and he may come round any moment."
+
+"I will make sure of him before I go, Squire. I have got another
+pair of darbys in my pocket."
+
+As soon as he had fastened these upon the wrists of the insensible
+man he ran downstairs, and in a minute returned with the candles.
+
+"I am glad that you are back," the Squire said. "I was afraid that
+young rascal would try to escape."
+
+"I took good care of that, Squire; you see I put one of his arms
+round the bedpost before I slipped the darbys on, and he cannot get
+away unless he takes the whole bed with him; and as I don't think
+he would get it out either by the window or the door, he is as
+safe here as he would be in Newgate. What is the next thing to do,
+Squire?"
+
+"You had better tie this fellow's legs. I will leave you a candle
+here, and you can keep guard over them while I go and wake Mr.
+Bastow."
+
+The Rector needed no waking; he was walking up and down his room in
+great distress. He had not undressed, but had thrown himself upon
+his bed.
+
+"What has happened, Thorndyke?" he asked as the Squire entered.
+"I heard two heavy falls, and I felt that something terrible had
+taken place."
+
+"Well, it has been a serious matter--very serious. That unfortunate
+son of yours is not hurt, but I don't know but that the best thing
+that could have happened would have been for him to have got a
+bullet through his head. He brought home with him two men who are,
+I have little doubt, highwaymen; anyhow, they each had a brace of
+pistols in their belt, and from what he said I think they have been
+stopping a coach. At any rate, they have something with them that
+they were going to hide here, and I fancy it is not the first time
+that it has been done. I don't expect your son had anything to do
+with the robbery, though he was carrying a brace of pistols, too;
+however, we have got them all three.
+
+"Now, you see, Bastow, this takes the affair altogether out
+of our hands. I had hoped that when we caught your son in the act
+of breaking into your house after you had ordered him from it, we
+should be able to frighten him into enlisting, or, at any rate,
+into promising to disturb you no more, for even if we had taken him
+before the bench, nothing could have been done to him, for under
+such circumstances his re-entering the house could not be looked
+upon as an act of burglary. As it is, the affair is altogether
+changed. Even if I wished to do so, as a magistrate I could not
+release those two highwaymen; they must appear as prisoners in
+court. I shall hear down in the town tomorrow morning what coach
+has been stopped, and I have no doubt that they have on them the
+proceeds of the robbery. Your son was consorting with and aiding
+them, and acting as a receiver of stolen goods, and as you have heard
+horses here before it is probable that when his room is thoroughly
+searched we shall come upon a number of articles of the same sort.
+I am sorry that I ever meddled in the matter; but it is too late
+for that now. You had better come downstairs with me, and we will
+take a turn in the garden, and try to see what had best be done."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+
+John Thorndyke opened the shutters of the parlor window, and
+stepped out into the garden alone, for the Rector was too unnerved
+and shattered to go out with him, but threw himself on the sofa,
+completely prostrated. Half an hour later the Squire re-entered the
+room. The morning was just beginning to break. Mr. Bastow raised
+his head and looked sadly at him.
+
+"I can see no way out of it, old friend. Were it not that he is in
+charge of the constable, I should have said that your only course
+was to aid your son to escape; but Knapp is a shrewd fellow as well
+as an honest one. You cannot possibly get your son away without
+his assistance, for he is handcuffed to the bed, and Knapp, in so
+serious a matter as this, would not, I am sure, lend himself to
+an escape. I have no doubt that with my influence with the other
+magistrates, and, indeed, on the circumstances of the case, they
+will commit him on a minor charge only, as the passengers of the
+coach will, I hope, give evidence that it was stopped by mounted
+men alone. I think, therefore, that he would only be charged with
+consorting with and aiding the highwaymen after the event, and of
+aiding them to conceal stolen goods--that is, if any are found
+in his room.
+
+"That much stolen property has been hidden there, there is little
+reason to doubt, but it may have been removed shortly afterwards.
+It was, of course, very convenient for them to have some place
+where they could take things at once, and then ride on quietly to
+London the next day, for, if arrested; nothing would be found upon
+them, and it would be impossible to connect them with the robbery.
+Later on they might come back again and get them from him. Of
+course, if nothing is found in his room, we get rid of the charge
+of receiving altogether, and there would be nothing but harboring,
+aiding, and abetting--a much less serious business. Look here,
+old friend, I will strain a point. I will go out into the garden
+again and walk about for an hour, and while I am out, if you should
+take advantage of my absence to creep up to your son's room and to
+search it thoroughly, examining every board of the floor to see if
+it is loose, and should you find anything concealed, to take it and
+hide it, of course I cannot help it. The things, if there are any,
+might secretly be packed up by you in a box and sent up to Bow Street,
+with a line inside, saying that they are proceeds of robbery, and
+that you hope the owners will be traced and their property restored
+to them. Not, of course, in your own hand, and without a signature.
+There might be some little trouble in managing it, but it could,
+no doubt, be done."
+
+John Thorndyke went out into the garden without another word. The
+hour was nearly up when Mr. Bastow came out; he looked ten years
+older than he had done on the previous day. He wrung his friend's
+hand.
+
+"Thank God I have been up there," he said. "I do not think they
+will find anything."
+
+"Say nothing about it, Bastow; I don't want to know whether you
+found anything. Now I am going to fetch two or three of the men from
+the village, to get them to aid the constable in keeping guard, and
+another to go up to the house at once and order a groom to saddle
+one of my horses and bring it here."
+
+As it was now past five o'clock, and the Squire found most of the
+men getting up, he sent one off to the house with the message, and
+returned with two others to the Rectory. He told them briefly that
+two highwaymen had been arrested during the night, and that as young
+Mr. Bastow was in their company at the time, it had been necessary
+as a matter of form to arrest him also. He went upstairs with them.
+
+"I have brought up two men to sit with you, Knapp, until the Reigate
+constables come up. You can take those handcuffs off Mr. Bastow,
+but see that he does not leave the room, and do you yourself sit
+in a chair against the door, and place one of these men at the
+window. How about others?"
+
+"The man you hit first, Squire, did not move until a quarter of
+an hour ago; he has been muttering to himself since, but I don't
+think he is sensible. The other one has been quiet enough, but
+there is no doubt that his arm is broken."
+
+"I am going to ride down to Reigate at once, and will bring back
+a surgeon with me."
+
+"You will repent this night's business, Thorndyke!" Arthur Bastow
+said threateningly.
+
+"I fancy that you will repent it more than I shall, Bastow; it is
+likely that you will have plenty of time to do so."
+
+It was not long before the groom with the horse arrived. John
+Thorndyke rode at a gallop down to Reigate, and first called on
+the head constable.
+
+"Dawney," he said, as the man came down, partially dressed, at his
+summons, "has anything taken place during the night?"
+
+"Yes, Squire, the up coach was stopped a mile before it got here,
+and the passengers robbed. It was due here at one, and did not come
+in till half an hour later. Of course I was sent for. The guard was
+shot. There were two of the fellows. He let fly with his blunderbuss,
+but he does not seem to have hit either of them, and one rode up
+and shot him dead; then they robbed all the passengers. They got
+six gold watches, some rings, and, adding up the amounts taken from
+all the passengers, about a hundred and fifty pounds in money."
+
+"Well, I fancy I have got your two highwaymen safe, _Dawney."
+
+"You have, sir?" the constable said in astonishment.
+
+"Yes. I happened to be at the Rectory. Mr. Bastow had had a quarrel
+with his son, and had forbidden him the house."
+
+The constable shook his head. "I am afraid he is a very bad one,
+that young chap."
+
+"I am afraid he is, Dawney. However, his father was afraid that he
+might come in during the night and make a scene, so I said I would
+stop with him, and I took our village constable with me. At two
+o'clock this morning the young fellow came with two mounted men,
+who, I have no doubt, were highwaymen. We had locked up down below.
+Bastow took a ladder, and the three got in at a bedroom window
+on the first floor. Knapp and I were waiting for them there, and,
+taking them by surprise, succeeded in capturing them before the
+highwaymen could use their pistols. The constable and two men are
+looking after them, but as one has not got over a knock I gave him
+on the head, and the other has a broken arm, there is little fear
+of their making their escape. You had better go up with two of your
+men, and take a light cart with you with some straw in the bottom,
+and bring them all down here. I will ride round myself to Mr.
+Chetwynde, Sir Charles Harris, and Mr. Merchison, and we will sit
+at twelve o'clock. You can send round a constable with the usual
+letters to the others, but those three will be quite enough for
+the preliminary examination."
+
+"Well, Squire, that is good news indeed. We have had the coach held
+up so often within five miles of this place during the past three
+months, that we have been getting quite a bad name. And to think
+that young Bastow was in it! I have heard some queer stories about
+him, and fancied before long I should have to put my hand upon his
+shoulder; but I didn't expect this."
+
+"There is not a shadow of proof that he had anything to do with
+the robbery, Dawney, but he will have difficulty in proving that
+he did not afterwards abet them. It is serious enough as it is,
+and I am terribly grieved for his father's sake."
+
+"Yes, sir; I have always heard him spoken of as a kind gentleman,
+and one who took a lot of trouble whenever anyone was sick. Well,
+sir, I will be off in twenty minutes. I will run round at once
+and send Dr. Hewett up to the Rectory, and a man shall start on
+horseback at seven o'clock with the summons to the other magistrates."
+
+John Thorndyke rode round to his three fellow magistrates, who,
+living nearest to the town, were most regular in their attendance
+at the meetings. They all listened in surprise to his narrative,
+and expressed great pleasure at hearing that the men who had been
+such a pest to the neighborhood, and had caused them all personally
+a great deal of trouble, had been captured. All had heard tales, too,
+to Arthur Bastow's disadvantage, and expressed great commiseration
+for his father. They agreed to meet at the court half an hour before
+business began, to talk the matter over together.
+
+"It is out of the question that we can release him on bail," the
+gentleman who was chairman of the bench said. "Quite so," John
+Thorndyke agreed. "In the first place, the matter is too serious;
+and in the next, he certainly would not be able to find bail; and
+lastly, for his father's sake, it is unadvisable that he should be
+let out. At the same time, it appears to me that there is a broad
+distinction between his case and the others. I fear that there can
+be no question that he had prior acquaintance with these men, and
+that he was cognizant of the whole business; something I heard
+him say, and which, to my regret, I shall have to repeat in court,
+almost proves that he was so. Still, let us hope none of the stolen
+property will be found upon him; whether they had intended to pass
+it over to his care or not is immaterial. If they had not done so,
+I doubt whether he could be charged with receiving stolen goods, and
+we might make the charge simply one of aiding these two criminals,
+and of being so far an accessory after the crime.
+
+"If we could soften it down still further I should, for his father's
+sake, be glad; but as far as he himself is concerned, I would do
+nothing to lighten his punishment. He is about as bad a specimen
+of human nature as I ever came across. His father is in bodily fear
+of him. I saw the young fellow yesterday, and urged him to enlist,
+in order to break himself loose from the bad companionship he had
+fallen into. His reply was insolent and defiant in the highest
+degree, and it was then that in his father's name I forbade him
+the house, and as his father was present he confirmed what I said,
+and told him that he would not have anything more to do with him.
+This affair may do him good, and save his neck from a noose. A few
+years at the hulks or a passage to Botany Bay will do him no harm;
+and, at any rate, his father will have rest and peace, which he
+never would have if he remained here."
+
+A somewhat similar conversation took place at each house. John
+Thorndyke breakfasted at Sir Charles Harris', the last of the three
+upon whom he called, and then mounting rode back to Reigate.
+
+"We have found the plunder on them," the head constable said, coming
+out of the lockup as he drew rein before it, "and, fortunately for
+young Bastow, nothing was found upon him."
+
+"How are the two men?"
+
+"The fellow you hit first is conscious now, sir, but very weak. The
+doctor says that if he hadn't had a thick hat on, your blow would
+have killed him to a certainty. The other man's arm is set and
+bandaged, and he is all right otherwise. We shall be able to have
+them both in court at twelve o'clock."
+
+The Squire rode up to his house. He was met at the door by his son,
+in a state of great excitement.
+
+"Is it all true, father? The news has come from the village that
+you have killed two men, and that they and Arthur Bastow have all
+been taken away in a cart, guarded by constables."
+
+"As usual, Mark, rumor has exaggerated matters. There are no
+dead men; one certainly got a crack on the head that rendered him
+insensible for some time, and another's arm is broken."
+
+"And are they highwaymen, father? They say that two horses were
+fastened behind the cart."
+
+"That is what we are going to try, Mark. Until their guilt is
+proved, no one knows whether they are highwaymen or not."
+
+"And why is Arthur Bastow taken, father?"
+
+"Simply because he was in company with the others. Now, you need
+not ask any more questions, but if you like to get your pony saddled
+and ride down with me to Reigate at eleven o'clock, I will get you
+into the courthouse, and then you will hear all about it."
+
+At greater length the Squire went into the matter with Mrs.
+Cunningham, his lady housekeeper, and his ward's governess.
+
+"It is a bad business, Mr. Thorndyke," she said, "and must be
+terrible for poor Mr. Bastow."
+
+"Yes, it is a bad business altogether, except that it will rid him
+of this young rascal. If I were in his place I should be ready to
+suffer a good deal to obtain such a riddance."
+
+"I suppose that you won't sit upon the bench today?"
+
+"No; at least I shall take no part in the deliberations. I shall,
+of course, give evidence. The affair is not likely to last very long;
+my story will take the longest to tell. Knapp's will be confirmatory
+of mine, and the Reigate constable will depose to finding the
+watches, rings, and money upon them; then, of course, the case
+will be adjourned for the attendance of the coachman and some of
+the passengers. I don't suppose they will be able to swear to their
+identity, for no doubt they were masked. But that is immaterial;
+the discovery of the stolen property upon them will be sufficient
+to hang them. No doubt we shall have some Bow Streets runners down
+from town tomorrow or next day, and they will most likely be able
+to say who the fellows are."
+
+"Will Mr. Bastow have to give evidence against his son?"
+
+"Not before us, I think; but I imagine he will have to appear at
+the trial."
+
+"It will be terrible for him."
+
+"Yes, terrible. I sincerely hope that they will not summon him, but
+I am afraid that there is very little doubt about it; they are sure
+to want to know about his son's general conduct, though possibly
+the testimony on that point of the constable at Reigate will be
+sufficient. My own hope is that he will get a long sentence; at
+any rate, one long enough to insure his not coming back during his
+father's lifetime. If you had seen his manner when we were talking
+to him yesterday, you would believe that he is capable of anything.
+I have had a good many bad characters before me during the year and
+a half that I have sat upon the bench, but I am bound to say that
+I never saw one who was to my eyes so thoroughly evil as this young
+fellow. I don't think," he added with a smile, "that I should feel
+quite comfortable myself if he were acquitted; it will be a long
+time before I shall forget the expression of his face when he said
+to me this morning, 'You will repent this night's work, Thorndyke.'"
+
+"You don't mean that you think he would do you any harm, Mr.
+Thorndyke?"
+
+"Well, I should not care to meet him in a lonely place if he was
+armed and I was not. But you need not be nervous, Mrs. Cunningham,
+there is not the smallest chance of his being out for years; and
+by that time his blood will have had time to cool down, and he will
+have learnt, at any rate, that crimes cannot be committed in this
+country with impunity."
+
+"It is all very shocking," the lady said. "What will poor Mr. Bastow
+do? I should think that he would not like to remain as clergyman
+here, where everyone knows about it."
+
+"That must be for him to decide," the Squire said; "but if he wishes
+to resign I certainly shall not press him to continue to hold the
+living. He is a very old friend of mine. My father presented the
+living to him when I was nine or ten years old, and I may say I
+saw him daily up to the time when I went down into Sussex. If he
+resigns I should urge him to take up his residence here and to act
+as Mark's tutor; and he might also relieve you of some of Millicent's
+lessons. You have plenty to do in looking after the management of
+things in general. However, that is for the future."
+
+At eleven o'clock the Squire drove down to Reigate, taking Mark
+with him, as it would save all trouble about putting up the horse
+and pony. On arriving he handed Mark over to the head constable,
+and asked him to pass him into a seat in the courthouse, before
+the public were let in.
+
+Reigate was in a state of unusual excitement. That the coach should
+have been stopped and robbed was too common an event to excite much
+interest, but that two highwaymen should have been captured, and,
+as was rumored, a young gentleman brought in on a charge of being
+in connection with them, caused a thrill of excitement. Quite a
+small crowd was assembled before the courthouse, and the name of
+Squire Thorndyke passed from mouth to mouth.
+
+"There is some talk of his being mixed up with it in some way or
+other," one said. "I saw him myself ride in here, about half past
+five, and I wondered he was about so early. Some do say as he caught
+the two highwaymen single handed; but that don't stand to reason.
+Besides, what could he have been doing out at such an hour as that?
+He is a good landlord, and they say that Crowswood has been quite
+a different place since he came to be master. He is a tight hand
+as a magistrate, and cleared out half the village the first two
+or three months he was there; but he spent a mint of money on the
+place, and the people there say that they could not have a better
+master. Ah, here is Squire Chetwynd. He was sure to be here. There
+is Sir Charles' gig turning the corner. I expect most of them will
+be on the bench; they don't get such a case as this every day."
+
+"It may be there will be nothing for us to hear when the court
+opens," another said. "I hear both the fellows have been shot or
+knocked about so bad that they cannot be brought up. Of course the
+court cannot sit if they aint before it."
+
+"That is not so, Master Jones. I spoke to one of the constables
+half an hour ago--he lives next door to me--and he said that
+they would be well enough to appear. Neither of them have been
+shot, though they have been hurt pretty bad."
+
+All this added to the desire of those around to get into the court,
+and there was quite a rush when the doors were opened two minutes
+before twelve, and it was at once crammed, the constable having
+some difficulty in getting the doors shut, and in persuading those
+who could not get in that there was not standing room for another
+person. There was a buzz of talk in court until the door opened
+and six magistrates came in. It was observed that John Thorndyke
+did not seat himself with the others, but moved his chair a little
+apart from them, thus confirming the report that he was in some way
+connected with the matter, and did not intend to take any part in
+the decision. Then another door opened, and the three prisoners
+were brought in. The two first were pale and evidently weak; one
+had his head wrapped in bandages, the other had the right sleeve
+of his coat cut off, and his arm bandaged and supported by a sling.
+Both made a resolute effort to preserve a careless demeanor. The
+third, who was some years younger than the others, looked round
+with a smile on his lips, bowed to the magistrates with an air of
+insolent bravado when he was placed in the dock, and then leaned
+easily in the corner, as if indifferent to the whole business. A
+chair was placed between his comrades for the use of the man whose
+head was bandaged. Many among those present knew Arthur Bastow by
+sight, and his name passed from mouth to mouth; but the usher called
+loudly for silence, and then the magistrates' clerk rose.
+
+"William Smith and John Brown--at least, these are the names
+given--are charged with stopping the South Coast coach last night,
+killing the guard, and robbing the passengers; and Arthur Bastow
+is charged with aiding and abetting the other two prisoners, and
+with guilty knowledge of their crime."
+
+It was noticed by those who could see the prisoners' faces that,
+in spite of Bastow's air of indifference, there was an expression
+of anxiety on his face as the charge was read, and he undoubtedly
+felt relief as that against himself was mentioned. The first witness
+was John Knapp, and the constable stepped into the witness box.
+
+"What do you know of this business, Knapp?" the chairman asked.
+"Just tell it your own way."
+
+"I am constable of Crowswood, your honor, and yesterday Squire
+Thorndyke said to me--"
+
+"No, you must not tell it like that, Knapp; you must not repeat
+what another person said to you. You can say that from information
+received you did so and so."
+
+"Yes, your honor. From information received I went to the Rev. Mr.
+Bastow's house, at a quarter to nine last night. At nine o'clock
+Squire Thorndyke and the Parson came in together. They sent the
+servant up to bed, and then the Squire sent me round to examine the
+fastenings of the doors. I found that one back door had been left
+unfastened, and locked and bolted it. The Squire told me to lie
+down until one o'clock, and he would watch, and Mr. Bastow went up
+to bed."
+
+"Do you know of your own knowledge why these precautions were
+taken?"
+
+"Only from what I was told, your honor. At one o'clock the Squire
+woke me, and he lay down in the parlor, telling me to call him if
+I heard any movement outside. About two o'clock I heard two horses
+come into the Parson's yard. I called Squire Thorndyke, who went
+upstairs to an open window; presently someone came and tried the
+back door. I heard voices outside, but could not hear what was
+said. The Squire came down and called me upstairs. I went up and
+took my place at one side of the window, and the Squire took his on
+the other. I had this cudgel in my hand, and the Squire his riding
+whip. A ladder was put up against the window, and then someone came
+up, lifted the sash up high and got in. There was light enough for
+me to see it was young Mr. Bastow. Then the two other prisoners came
+up. When the third had got into the room Mr. Bastow said, 'Follow
+me, and then you won't tumble over the furniture.'"
+
+"How was it that they did not see you and Mr. Thorndyke?" the
+chairman asked.
+
+"We were standing well back, your honor. The moon was on the other
+side of the house. There was light enough for us to see them as
+they got in at the window, but where we were standing it was quite
+dark, especially to chaps who had just come in from the moonlight.
+As they moved, the Squire hit the last of them a clout on the head
+with his hunting crop, and down he went, as if shot. The man next
+to him turned, but I did not see what took place, for, as the Squire
+had ordered me, I made a rush at Mr. Bastow and got my arms round
+him pretty tight, so as to prevent him using his pistols, if he
+had any. He struggled hard, but without saying a word, till I got
+my heel behind his and threw him on his back. I came down on the
+top of him; then I got the pistols out of his belt and threw them
+on the bed, slipped the handcuffs onto one wrist, lifted him up a
+bit, and then shoved him up against the bedpost, and got the handcuff
+onto his other wrist, so that he could not shift away, having the
+post in between his arms.
+
+"Then I went to see if the Squire wanted any help, but he didn't.
+I first handcuffed the man whose head he had broken, and tied the
+legs of the other, and then kept guard over them till morning. When
+the constables came up from town we searched the prisoners, and on
+two of them found the watches, money, and rings. We found nothing
+on Mr. Bastow. I went with the head constable to Mr. Bastow's room
+and searched it thoroughly, but found nothing whatever there."
+
+The evidence created a great sensation in court. John Thorndyke
+had first intended to ask Knapp not to make any mention of the fact
+that Arthur Bastow was carrying pistols unless the question was
+directly put to him. But the more he had thought over the matter,
+the more convinced was he that the heavier the sentence the better
+it would be for the Rector; and when he had heard from the latter
+that there was nothing left in his son's room that could be brought
+against him, and that he could not be charged with the capital
+crime of being a receiver, he thought it best to let matters take
+their course.
+
+The head constable was the next witness. He deposed to the finding
+of the articles produced upon the two elder prisoners and the
+unsuccessful search of the younger prisoner's room.
+
+"You did not search the house further?" the chairman inquired.
+
+"No, sir; I wanted to get the prisoners down here as fast as I
+could, seeing that two of them were seriously hurt."
+
+The chairman nodded.
+
+"You will, of course, make a careful search of the whole house,
+constable."
+
+"Yes, sir; I left one of my men up there with instructions to allow
+no one to go upstairs until I returned."
+
+"Quite right."
+
+John Thorndyke was the next witness, and his evidence cleared up
+what had hitherto been a mystery to the general body of the public,
+as to how he and the constable happened to be in the house on
+watch when the highwaymen arrived. The most important part of his
+evidence was the repetition of the words young Bastow had used as
+he mounted the ladder, as they showed that it was arranged between
+the prisoners that the stolen goods should be hidden in the house.
+The Squire was only asked one or two questions.
+
+"I suppose, Mr. Thorndyke, that you had no idea whatever that the
+younger prisoner would be accompanied by anyone else when he returned
+home?"
+
+"Not the slightest," the Squire replied. "I was there simply to
+prevent this unfortunate lad from entering the house, when perhaps
+he might have used violence towards his father. My intention was
+to seize him if he did so, and to give him the choice of enlisting,
+as I had urged him to do, or of being brought before this bench for
+breaking into his father's house. I felt that anything was better
+than his continuing in the evil courses on which he seemed bent."
+
+"Thank you, Mr. Thorndyke. I must compliment you in the name of my
+brother magistrates, and I may say of the public, for the manner
+in which you, at considerable risk to yourself, have effected the
+capture of the two elder prisoners."
+
+After consulting with the others the head constable was recalled.
+
+"Do you know anything about the character of the youngest prisoner?"
+
+"Yes, sir. We have had our eye upon him for some time. He was
+brought before your honors a week ago charged with being drunk and
+disorderly in this town, and was fined 5 pounds. He is constantly
+drinking with some of the worst characters in the place, and is
+strongly suspected of having been concerned in the fray between
+the poachers and Sir Charles Harris' gamekeepers. Two of the latter
+said that they recognized him amongst the poachers, but as they
+both declined to swear to him we did not arrest him."
+
+John Knapp was then recalled, and testified to Bastow's drinking
+habits, and that the landlord of the alehouse at Crowswood had been
+ordered by the Squire not to draw any liquor for him in future on
+pain of having the renewal of his license refused.
+
+"Have you any more witnesses to call?" the chairman asked the head
+constable.
+
+"Not at present, your honor. We have sent up to town, and on the
+next occasion the coachman will be called to testify to the shooting
+of the guard, and we hope to have some of the passengers there to
+identify the articles stolen from them."
+
+"It will be necessary that the Rev. Mr. Bastow should be here. He
+need not be called to give evidence unless we think it to be of
+importance, but he had better be in attendance. The prisoners are
+remanded until this day week."
+
+An hour later the three prisoners, handcuffed, were driven under
+an escort of three armed constables to Croydon Jail. When again
+brought up in court the passengers on the coach identified the
+articles taken from them; the coachman gave evidence of the stopping
+of the coach, and of the shooting of the guard. The head constable
+testified that he had searched the Rectory from top to bottom, and
+found nothing whatever of a suspicious nature. None of the passengers
+were able to testify to the two elder prisoners as the men who had
+robbed them, as these had been masked, but the height and dress
+corresponded to those of the prisoners; and the two Bow Street
+runners then came forward, and gave evidence that the two elder
+prisoners were well known to them. They had long been suspected of
+being highwaymen, and had several times been arrested when riding
+towards London on occasions when a coach had been stopped the night
+before, but no stolen goods had ever been found upon them, and in
+no case had the passengers been able to swear to their identity.
+One was known among his associates as "Galloping Bill," the other
+as the "Downy One." At the conclusion of the evidence the three
+prisoners were formally committed for trial, the magistrates having
+retired in consultation for some time upon the question of whether
+the charge of receiving stolen goods ought to be made against Arthur
+Bastow.
+
+"I think, gentlemen," the chairman said, after a good deal had been
+urged on both sides of the question, "in this case we can afford
+to take a merciful view. In the first place, no stolen goods were
+discovered upon him or in the house. There is strong presumptive
+evidence of his intention, but intention is not a crime, and even
+were the evidence stronger than it is, I should be inclined to
+take a merciful view. There can be no doubt that the young fellow
+is thoroughly bad, and the bravado he has exhibited throughout the
+hearing is at once unbecoming and disgraceful; but we must remember
+that he is not yet eighteen, and that, in the second place, he is
+the son of a much respected clergyman, who is our neighbor. The
+matter is serious enough for him as it stands, and he is certain
+to have a very heavy sentence.
+
+"Mr. Thorndyke, who takes no part in our deliberations, is most
+anxious that the prisoner's father should be spared the agony of
+his son being placed on trial on a capital charge, though I do not
+think that there would be the smallest chance of his being executed,
+for the judges would be certain to take his youth into consideration.
+Had there been prima facie evidence of concealment, we must have
+done our duty and sent him to trial on that charge; but as there is
+no such evidence, I think that it will be in all respects better to
+send him on a charge on which the evidence is as clear as noonday.
+Moreover, I think that Mr. Thorndyke's wishes should have some weight
+with us, seeing that it is entirely due to him that the important
+capture of these highwaymen, who have long been a scourge to this
+neighborhood, has been effected."
+
+Mr. Bastow had not been called as a witness. John Thorndyke
+had brought him down to Reigate in a closed carriage, and he had
+waited in the justices' room while the examination went on; but
+the magistrates agreed that the evidence given was amply sufficient
+for them to commit upon without given him the pain of appearing.
+John Thorndyke had taken him to another room while the magistrates
+were consulting together, and when he heard the result drove him
+back again.
+
+"I have fully made up my mind to resign my living, Thorndyke.
+I could not stand up and preach to the villagers of their duties
+when I myself have failed so signally in training my own son; nor
+visit their houses and presume to lecture them on their shortcomings
+when my son is a convicted criminal."
+
+"I quite see that, old friend," the Squire said. "And I had no
+doubt but that you would decide on this course. I will try not to
+persuade you to change your decision, for I feel that your power of
+usefulness is at an end as far as the village is concerned. May I
+ask what you propose to do? I can hardly suppose that your savings
+have been large."
+
+"Two years ago I had some hundreds laid by, but they have dwindled
+away to nothing; you can understand how. For a time it was given
+freely, then reluctantly; then I declared I would give no more, but
+he took it all the same--he knew well enough that I could never
+prosecute him for forgery."
+
+"As bad as that, eh?" Thorndyke said sternly. "Well, we won't talk
+further of him now; what I propose is that you should take up your
+abode at the Hall. I am not satisfied with the school where Mark
+has been for the last two years, and I have been hesitating whether
+to get a private tutor for him or to send him to one of the public
+schools. I know that that would be best, but I could not bring
+myself to do so. I have some troubles of my own that but two or
+three people know of, and now, that everything is going on smoothly
+on the estate and in the village, I often feel dull, and the boy's
+companionship does me much good; and as he knows many lads of his
+own age in the neighborhood now, I think that he would do just as
+well at home.
+
+"He will be taking to shooting and hunting before long, and if he
+is to have a tutor, there is no one I should like to have better
+than yourself. You know all the people, and we could talk comfortably
+together of an evening when the house is quiet. Altogether, it will
+be an excellent arrangement for me. You would have your own room,
+and if I have company you need not join us unless you like. The
+house would not seem like itself without you, for you have been
+associated with it as long as I can remember. As to your going out
+into the world at the age of sixty, it would be little short of
+madness. There--you need not give me an answer now," he went on,
+seeing that the Rector was too broken down to speak; "but I am sure
+that when you think it over you will come to the same conclusion
+as I do, that it will be the best plan possible for us both."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+
+The trial of the two highwaymen and Arthur Bastow came off in due
+course. The evidence given was similar to that offered at Reigate,
+the only addition being that Mr. Bastow was himself put into the
+box. The counsel for the prosecution said: "I am sorry to have to
+call you, Mr. Bastow. We all feel most deeply for you, and I will
+ask you only two or three questions. Was your son frequently out
+at night?"
+
+"He was."
+
+"Did you often hear him return?"
+
+"Yes; I seldom went to sleep until he came back."
+
+"Had you any reason to suppose that others returned with him?"
+
+"I never saw any others."
+
+"But you might have heard them without seeing them. Please tell us
+if you ever heard voices."
+
+"Yes, I have heard men's voices," the clergyman said reluctantly,
+in a low voice.
+
+"One more question, and I have done. Have you on some occasions
+heard the sound of horses' hoofs in your yard at about the time
+that your son came in?"
+
+Mr. Bastow said in a low voice: "I have."
+
+"Had you any suspicion whatever of the character of your son's
+visitors?"
+
+"None whatever. I supposed that those with him were companions with
+whom he had been spending the evening."
+
+Mr. Bastow had to be assisted from the witness box, so overcome
+was he with the ordeal. He had not glanced at his son while giving
+his evidence. The latter and his two fellow prisoners maintained
+throughout the trial their expression of indifference. The two
+highwaymen nodded to acquaintances they saw in the body of the
+court, smiled at various points in the evidence, and so conducted
+themselves that there were murmured exclamations of approval of
+their gameness on the part of the lower class of the public. The
+jury, without a moment's hesitation, found them all guilty of the
+offenses with which they were charged. Bastow was first sentenced.
+
+"Young man," the judge said, "young as you are, there can be no
+doubt whatever in the minds of anyone who has heard the evidence
+that you have been an associate with these men who have been found
+guilty of highway robbery accompanied by murder. I consider that a
+merciful view was taken of your case by the magistrates who committed
+you for trial, for the evidence of your heartbroken father, on
+whose gray hairs your conduct has brought trouble and disgrace,
+leaves no doubt that you have for some time been in league with
+highwaymen, although not actually participating in their crime.
+The words overheard by Mr. Thorndyke show that you were prepared
+to hide their booty for them, and it is well for you that you
+were captured before this was done, and that no proceeds of other
+robberies were found in the house. The evidence of the Bow Street
+officers show that it had for some time been suspected that these
+men had an accomplice somewhere in the neighborhood of Reigate,
+for although arrested several times under circumstances forming a
+strong assumption of their guilt, nothing was ever found upon them.
+There can now be little, doubt who their accomplice was. Had you
+been an older man I should have sentenced you to transportation for
+life, but in consideration of your youth, I shall take the milder
+course of sentencing you to fifteen years' transportation."
+
+The capital sentence was then passed in much fewer words upon the
+two highwaymen. As they were leaving the dock Bastow turned, and
+in a clear voice said to John Thorndyke, who had been accommodated
+with a seat in the well of the court:
+
+"I have to thank you, Thorndyke, for this. I will pay off my debt
+some day, you make take your oath."
+
+"A sad case, Mr. Thorndyke--a sad case," the judge, who had
+greatly complimented the Squire on his conduct, said to him as he
+was disrobing afterwards. "I don't know that in all my experience
+I ever saw such a hardened young villain. With highwaymen it is a
+point of honor to assume a gayety of demeanor on such occasions;
+but to see a boy of eighteen, never before convicted, exhibiting
+such coolness and effrontery is quite beyond my experience. I
+suppose his record is altogether bad?"
+
+"Altogether," the Squire said. "His father has, during the last
+two years, been quite broken by it; he owned to me that he was
+in bodily fear of the lad, who had on several occasions assaulted
+him, had robbed him of his savings by means of forgery, and was
+so hopelessly bad that he himself thought with me that the only
+possible hope for him was to get him to enlist. I myself recommended
+the East India Company's service, thinking that he would have less
+opportunity for crime out there, and that there would be a strong
+chance that either fever or a bullet would carry him off, for
+I own that I have not the slightest hope of reformation in such a
+character."
+
+"I would have given him transportation for life if I had known all
+this," the judge said. "However, it is not likely that he will ever
+come back again--very few of them do; the hulks are not the most
+healthy places in the world, and they have a pretty rough way with
+men who give them trouble, as this young fellow is likely to do."
+
+Mr. Bastow, as soon as he had given his evidence, had taken
+a hackney coach to the inn where he and the Squire had put up on
+their arrival in town the evening before, and here, on his return,
+John Thorndyke found him. He was lying on his bed in a state of
+prostration.
+
+"Cheer up, Bastow," he said, putting his hand upon the Rector's
+shoulder. "The sentence is fifteen years, which was the very amount
+I hoped that he would get. The more one sees of him the more hopeless
+it is to expect that any change will ever take place in him; and
+it is infinitely better that he should be across the sea where his
+conduct, when his term is over, can affect no one. The disgrace,
+such as it is, to his friends, is no greater in a long term than in
+a short one. Had he got off with four or five years' imprisonment,
+he would have been a perpetual trouble and a source of uneasiness,
+not to say alarm; and even had he left you alone we should always
+have been in a state of dread as to his next offense. Better that
+he should be out in the colonies than be hung at Tyburn."
+
+"How did he take the sentence?"
+
+"With the same bravado he had shown all through, and as he went out
+of the dock addressed a threat to me, that, under the circumstances,
+I can very well afford to despise. Now, if you will take my advice,
+you will drink a couple of glasses of good port, and then go to
+bed. I will see to your being awakened at seven o'clock, which will
+give us time to breakfast comfortably, and to make a start at nine."
+
+"I would rather not have the wine," the Rector said feebly.
+
+"Yes, but you must take what is good for you. I have ordered up a
+bottle of the landlord's best, and must insist upon your drinking
+a couple of glasses with me. I want it almost as much as you do,
+for the atmosphere of that court was enough to poison a dog. I have
+got the taste of it in my mouth still."
+
+With much reluctance the Rector accompanied him to the private sitting
+room that the Squire had engaged. He sat down almost mechanically
+in an easy chair. The Squire poured out the wine, and handed him a
+glass. Mr. Bastow at first put it to his lips without glancing at
+it, but he was a connoisseur in wine, and the bouquet of the port
+appealing to his latent senses, he took a sip, and then another,
+appreciatingly.
+
+"The landlord said it was first rate, and he is not far wrong,"
+John Thorndyke remarked, as he set down his own glass.
+
+"Yes, it is a fine vintage, and in perfect condition," Mr. Bastow
+agreed. "I have drunk nothing better for years, though you have
+some fine bins."
+
+"I would take a biscuit, if I were you, before I took another glass,"
+the Squire said, helping himself from a plate on the table. "You
+have had nothing to eat today, and you want something badly. I have
+a dish of kidneys coming up in half an hour; they cook them well
+here."
+
+The Rector ate a biscuit, mechanically sipped another glass of
+wine, and was even able to eat a kidney when they were brought up.
+Although September was not yet out, the Squire had a fire lighted
+in the room, and after the meal was over, and two steaming tumblers
+of punch were placed upon the table, he took a long pipe from the
+mantel, filled and lighted it, then filled another, and handed it
+to the Rector, at the same time holding out a light to him.
+
+"Life has its consolations," he said. "You have had a lot of troubles
+one way and another, Bastow, but we may hope that they are all over
+now, and that life will go more smoothly and easily with you. We
+had better leave the past alone for the present. I call this snug:
+a good fire, a clean pipe, a comfortable chair, and a steaming bowl
+at one's elbow."
+
+The Rector smiled faintly.
+
+"It seems unnatural--" he began.
+
+"Not at all, not at all," the Squire broke in. "You have had a tremendous
+load on your mind, and now it is lifted off; the thundercloud has
+burst, and though damage has been done, one is thankful that it
+is no worse. Now I can talk to you of a matter that has been on my
+mind for the last three weeks. What steps do you think that I ought
+to take to find a successor for you? It is most important to have
+a man who will be a real help in the parish, as you have been, would
+pull with one comfortably, and be a pleasant associate. I don't
+want too young a fellow, and I don't want too old a one. I have
+no more idea how to set about it than a child. Of course, I could
+ask the Bishop to appoint, but I don't know that he would appoint
+at all the sort of man I want. The living is only worth 200 pounds
+a year and the house--no very great catch; but there is many a
+man that would be glad to have it."
+
+"I have been thinking it over, too, Thorndyke, when I could bring
+my mind to consider anything but my own affairs. How would Greg
+do? He has been taking duty for me since I could not do it myself.
+I know that he is a hard working fellow, and he has a wife and
+a couple of children; his curacy is only 70 pounds a year, and it
+would be a perfect godsend, for he has no interest in the Church,
+and he might be years without preferment."
+
+"I should think he would do very well, Bastow. Yes, he reads well,
+which I own I care for that a good deal more than for the preaching;
+not that I have anything to say against that. He gives sound and
+practical sermons, and they have the advantage of being short,
+which is a great thing. In the first place, it is good in itself,
+and in the second, specially important in a village congregation,
+where you know very well every woman present is fidgeting to get
+home to see that the pot is not boiling over, and the meat in the
+oven is not burnt. Yes, I will go down tomorrow afternoon and ask
+him if he would like the living. You were talking of selling the
+furniture; how much do you suppose it is worth?"
+
+"I don't suppose it will fetch above seventy or eighty pounds; it
+is solid and good, but as I have had it in use nearly forty years,
+it would not go for much."
+
+"Well, let us say a hundred pounds," the Squire said. "I will
+give you a check for it. I dare say Greg will find it difficult to
+furnish, and he might have to borrow the money, and the debt would
+be a millstone round his neck, perhaps, for years, so I will hand
+it over with the Rectory to him."
+
+So they talked for an hour or two on village matters, and the Squire
+was well pleased, when his old friend went up to bed, that he had
+succeeded in diverting his thoughts for a time from the painful
+subject that had engrossed them for weeks.
+
+"You have slept well," he said, when they met at breakfast, "I can
+see by your face."
+
+"Yes, I have not slept so soundly for months. I went to sleep as
+soon as my head touched the pillow, and did not awake until the
+chambermaid knocked at the door."
+
+"That second glass of punch did it, Bastow. It is a fine morning;
+we shall have a brisk drive back. I am very glad that I changed my
+mind and brought the gig instead of the close carriage."
+
+In the afternoon the Squire drove into Reigate. He found the curate
+at home, and astonished and delighted him by asking him if he would
+like the living of Crowswood. It came altogether as a surprise to
+him, for the Rector's intentions to resign had not been made public,
+and it was supposed in the village that he was only staying at
+the Squire's until this sad affair should be over. Greg was a man
+of seven or eight and twenty, had graduated with distinction at
+Cambridge, but, having no influence, had no prospects of promotion,
+and the offer almost bewildered him.
+
+"I should be grateful indeed, Mr. Thorndyke," he said. "It would
+be a boon to us. Will you excuse me for a moment?"
+
+And opening a door, he called for his wife, who was trying to keep
+the two children quiet there, having retired with them hastily when
+Mr. Thorndyke was announced.
+
+"What do you think, Emma?" her husband said excitedly, as she came
+into the room. "Mr. Thorndyke has been good enough to offer me the
+living of Crowswood."
+
+Then he recovered himself. "I beg your pardon, sir, for my
+unmannerliness in not first introducing my wife to you."
+
+"It was natural that you should think of telling her the news first
+of all," the Squire said courteously. "Madam, I am your obedient
+servant, and I hope that soon we shall get to know each other well.
+I consider it of great importance that the Squire of a parish and
+the Rector should work well together, and see a great deal of each
+other. I don't know whether you are aware, Mr. Greg, that the living
+is worth 200 pounds a year, besides which there is a paddock of
+about ten acres, which is sufficient for the keep of a horse and
+cow. The Rectory is a comfortable one, and I have arranged with
+Mr. Bastow that he shall leave his furniture for the benefit of
+his successor. It will include linen, so that you will be put to
+no expense whatever in moving in. I have known these first expenses
+to seriously cripple the usefulness of a clergyman when appointed
+to a living."
+
+"That is good of you indeed, Mr. Thorndyke," the curate said. "We
+have been living in these lodgings since we first came here, and
+it will indeed make matters easy to have the question of furniture
+so kindly settled for us."
+
+"Will your Rector be able to release you shortly?"
+
+"I have no doubt that he will do that at once. His son has just
+left Oxford and taken deacon's orders; and the Rector told me the
+other day that he should be glad if I would look out for another
+curacy, as he wanted to have his son here with him. He spoke very
+kindly, and said that he should make no change until I could hear
+of a place to suit me. His son has been assisting him for the last
+month, since I took the services at Crowswood, and I am sure he
+would release me at once."
+
+"Then I should be glad if you will move up as soon as possible to
+the Rectory. I know nothing about the necessary forms, but I suppose
+that Mr. Bastow will send in his resignation to the Bishop, and
+I shall write and tell him that I have appointed you, and you can
+continue to officiate as you have done lately until you can be
+formally inducted as the Rector. Perhaps you would not mind going
+round to your Rector at once and telling him of the offer you have
+had. I have one or two matters to do in the town, and will call
+again in three quarters of an hour. I shall be glad to tell Mr.
+Bastow that you will come into residence at once."
+
+On returning at the appointed time he found that the curate had
+returned.
+
+"Mr. Pilkington was very kind, and evidently very pleased; he
+congratulated me most warmly, and I can come up at once. We don't
+know how to thank you enough, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"I don't want any thanks, I can assure you, Mr. Greg. Tomorrow I
+will send a couple of women in from the village to get the place
+in order, and no doubt Mr. Bastow will want to take away a few
+things. He is going to remain with me as tutor to my son. I am sure
+you and I will get on very well together, and I only hope that your
+sermons will be no longer when you are Rector than they have been
+while you have been assisting us. Long sermons may do for a town
+congregation, but in my opinion they are a very serious mistake
+in the case of a village one. By the way, I think it would be as
+well for you to get a servant here, and that before you go up. Mr.
+Bastow's servant was an old woman, and in a case like this I always
+think it is better not to take one's predecessor's servant. She
+generally resents any change, and is always quoting how her last
+master had things. I mention this before you go, because she is
+sure to ask to stay on, and it is much easier to say that you are
+bringing a servant with you than to have to tell her she is too
+old or too fat. Don't you think so, Mrs. Greg?"
+
+"Yes, I think it will be much better, Mr. Thorndyke. Even if I cannot
+hear of one likely to suit us permanently, I will take someone as
+a stop gap. One can easily change afterwards."
+
+"The old woman will do very well," the Squire said. "She has two
+married daughters in the village, and with a shilling or two from
+the parish she will manage comfortably. At any rate we shall look
+after her, and I have no doubt Mr. Bastow will make her an allowance."
+
+Never were a pair more delighted than Parson Greg and his wife
+when two days later they took possession of their new home. Half
+a dozen women had been at work the day before, and everything was
+in perfect order. To Mrs. Greg's relief she found that the old
+servant had already gone, the Squire having himself informed her
+that Mrs. Greg would bring her own maid with her. Mr. Bastow said
+that he would allow her half a crown a week as long as she lived,
+and the Squire added as much more, and as the woman had saved
+a good deal during her twenty years' service with the Rector, she
+was perfectly satisfied.
+
+"It is a good thing that she should be content," the Squire said
+to Mr. Bastow. "She has a lot of connections in the village, and if
+she had gone away with a sense of grievance she might have created
+a good deal of ill feeling against your successor, and I am very
+anxious that he should begin well. I like the young fellow, and I
+like his wife."
+
+"We are fortunate, indeed, Ernest," Mrs. Greg said the following
+morning, as with the children, two and three years old, they went
+out into the garden; where the trees were laden with apples, pears,
+and plums. "What a change from our little rooms in Reigate. I should
+think that anyone ought to be happy indeed here."
+
+"They ought to be, Emma, but you see Mr. Bastow had trouble enough;
+and it should be a lesson to us, dear, to look very closely after
+the boys now they are young, and see that they don't make bad
+acquaintances."
+
+"From what we hear of the village, there is little fear of that;
+the mischief must have begun before Mr. Thorndyke came down, when
+by all accounts things had altogether gone to the bad here, and of
+course young Bastow must have had an exceptionally evil disposition,
+Ernest."
+
+"Yes, no doubt; but his father could not have looked after him
+properly. I believe, from what I hear, that Bastow was so dispirited
+at his powerlessness to put a stop to the state of things here,
+that, except to perform service, he seldom left the house, and
+the boy no doubt grew up altogether wild. You know that I was in
+court on the second day of the examination, and the young fellow's
+insolence and bearing astonished and shocked me. Happily, we have
+the Squire here now to back us up, the village has been completely
+cleared of all bad characters, and is by all accounts quite a model
+place, and we must do our best to keep it so."
+
+The news of the change at the Rectory naturally occasioned a great
+deal of talk. At first there was a general feeling of regret that
+Mr. Bastow had gone, and yet it was felt that he could not have
+been expected to stay; the month's experience that they had had of
+the new parson had cleared the way for him. He and his wife soon
+made themselves familiar with the villagers, and being bright
+young people, speedily made themselves liked. The Squire and Mrs.
+Cunningham called the first afternoon after their arrival.
+
+"You must always send up if anything is wanted, Mr. Greg; whenever
+there is any illness in the village we always keep a stock of
+soups and jellies, and Mrs. Cunningham is almoner in general. Is
+there anything that we can do for you? If so, let me know without
+hesitation."
+
+"Indeed, there is nothing, Mr. Thorndyke. It is marvelous to us
+coming in here and finding everything that we can possibly want."
+
+"You will want a boy for your garden; and you cannot do better than
+take young Bill Summers. He was with me for a bit last year, when
+the boy I have now was laid up with mumps or something of that
+sort, and he was very favorably reported on as being handy in the
+garden, able to milk a cow, and so on. By the way, Mrs. Greg, I
+have taken the liberty of sending down a cow in milk. I expect she
+is in your meadow now. I have seven or eight of them, and if you
+will send her back when her milk fails I will send down another."
+
+"You are too kind altogether, Mr. Thorndyke!" Mrs. Greg exclaimed.
+
+"Not at all. I want to see things comfortable here, and you will
+find it difficult to get on without a cow. I keep two or three for
+the special use of the village. I make them pay for it, halfpenny
+a pint; it is better to do that than to give it. It is invaluable
+for the children; and I don't think in all England you see rosier
+and healthier youngsters than those in our schools. You will
+sometimes find milk useful for puddings and that sort of thing for
+the sick; and they will appreciate it all the more than if they
+had to look solely to us for their supply."
+
+"How is Mr. Bastow, sir?"
+
+"He is better than could be expected. He himself proposed this
+morning that my boy Mark should begin his studies at once; and,
+indeed, now that the worst is over and he has got rid of the load
+of care on his shoulders, I hope that we shall have him bright and
+cheerful again before long."
+
+Such was indeed the case. For some little time Mr. Bastow avoided
+the village, but John Thorndyke got him to go down with him to
+call upon Mr. Greg, and afterwards to walk through it with him. At
+first he went timidly and shrinkingly, but the kindly greetings of
+the women he met, and the children stopping to pull a forelock or
+bob a courtesy as of old, gradually cheered him up, and he soon
+got accustomed to the change, and would of an afternoon go down to
+the village and chat with the women, after he had ascertained that
+his successor had no objection whatever, and was, indeed, pleased
+that he still took an interest in his former parishioners. Mark
+was at first disappointed at the arrangement, for he had looked
+forward to going to a public school. His father, however, had no
+great trouble in reconciling him to it.
+
+"Of course, Mark," he said, "there are advantages in a public
+school. I was never at one myself, but I believe that, though the
+discipline is pretty strict, there is a great deal of fun and sport,
+and you may make desirable acquaintances. Upon the other hand,
+there are drawbacks. In the first place, the majority of the boys
+are sons of richer men than I am. I don't know that that would
+matter much, but it would give you expensive habits, and perhaps
+make you fonder of London life than I should care about. In the next
+place, you see, you would be at school when the shooting begins,
+and you are looking forward to carrying a gun next year. The same
+with hunting. You know I promised that this year you should go to
+the meets on your pony, and see as much of them as you can, and of
+course when you were at school you would only be able to indulge
+in these matters during your holidays; and if a hard frost set in,
+as is the case three times out of four, just as you came home, you
+would be out of it altogether.
+
+"I must say I should like you to have a real love of field sports
+and to be a good shot and a good rider. A man, however wide his
+acres may be, is thought but little of in the country if he is not
+a good sportsman; and, moreover, there is nothing better for developing
+health and muscles than riding, and tramping over the fields with
+a gun on your shoulder; and, lastly, you must not forget, Mark,
+that one of my objects in making this arrangement is to keep Mr.
+Bastow with us. I am sure that unless he thought that he was making
+himself useful he would not be content to remain here; and at his
+age, you know, it would be hard for him to obtain clerical employment."
+
+"All right, father. I see that the present plan is the best, and that
+I should have but little sport if I went away to school. Besides,
+I like Mr. Bastow very much, and I am quite sure that I shan't get
+so many whackings from him as I used to do from old Holbrook."
+
+"I fancy not, Mark," his father said with a smile. "I am not against
+wholesome discipline, but I think it can be carried too far; at
+any rate, I hope you will be just as obedient to Mr. Bastow as if
+he always had a cane on the table beside him."
+
+Mark, therefore, went to work in a cheerful spirit, and soon found
+that he made more progress in a week under Mr. Bastow's gentle
+tuition than he had done in a month under the vigorous discipline
+of his former master. Mr. and Mrs. Greg dined regularly at the
+Squire's once a week.
+
+"Have you had that Indian servant of yours long, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+Mrs. Greg asked one day. "He is a strange looking creature. Of
+course, in the daytime, when one sees him about in ordinary clothes,
+one does not notice him so much; but of an evening, in that Eastern
+costume of his, he looks very strange."
+
+"He was the servant of the Colonel, my brother," the Squire replied.
+"He brought him over from India with him. The man had been some
+years in his service, and was very attached to him, and had saved
+his life more than once, he told me. On one occasion he caught a
+cobra by the neck as it was about to strike my brother's hand as
+he sat at table; he carried it out into the compound, as George
+called it, but which means, he told me, garden, and there let it
+escape. Another time he caught a Thug, which means a sort of robber
+who kills his victims by strangling before robbing them. They are
+a sort of sect who regard strangling as a religious action, greatly
+favored by the bloodthirsty goddess they worship. He was in the
+act of fastening the twisted handkerchief, used for the purpose,
+round my brother's neck, when Ramoo cut him down. The closest shave,
+though, was when George, coming down the country, was pounced upon
+by a tiger and carried off. Ramoo seized a couple of muskets from
+the men, and rushed into the jungle after him, and coming up with
+the brute killed him at the first shot. George escaped with a broken
+arm and his back laid open by a scratch of the tiger's claws as it
+first seized him.
+
+"So at George's death I took Ramoo on, and have found him a most
+useful fellow. Of course, I was some little time before I became
+accustomed to his noiseless way of going about, and it used to
+make me jump when I happened to look round, and saw him standing
+quietly behind me when I thought I was quite alone. However, as
+soon as I became accustomed to him, I got over all that, and now
+I would not lose him for anything; he seems to know instinctively
+what I want. He is excellent as a waiter and valet; I should feel
+almost lost without him now; and the clumping about of an English
+man servant would annoy me as much as his noiseless way of going
+about did at first. He has come to speak English very fairly. Of
+course, my brother always talked to him in his own tongue; still, he
+had picked up enough English for me to get on with; now he speaks
+it quite fluently. When I have nothing whatever for him to do he
+devotes himself to my little ward. She is very fond of him, and it
+is quite pretty to see them together in the garden. Altogether, I
+would not part with him for anything."
+
+For some years life passed uneventfully at Crowswood. It was seldom
+indeed that the Squire's authority was needed to set matters right
+in the village. The substitution of good farmers for shiftless
+ones in some of the farms, and the better cultivation generally,
+had given more employment; and as John Thorndyke preferred keeping
+two or three cottages shut up rather than have them occupied by
+men for whom no work could be found, it was rare indeed that there
+were any complaints of scarcity of work, except, indeed, on the
+part of the Rector, who declared that, what with the healthiness
+of the village and the absence of want, his occupation, save for
+the Sunday duty, was a sinecure. Mr. Bastow was more happy and
+much brighter than he had been for many years. The occupation of
+teaching suited him, and he was able to make the work pleasant to
+his pupil as well as to himself; indeed, it occupied but a small
+portion of the day, the amount of learning considered necessary
+at the time not being extensive. A knowledge of Greek was thought
+quite superfluous for a country gentleman. Science was in its
+infancy, mathematics a subject only to be taken up by those who wanted
+to obtain a college fellowship. Latin, however, was considered an
+essential, and a knack of apt quotation from the Latin poets an
+accomplishment that every man who was a member of society or aspired
+to enter Parliament was expected to possess. Thus Mark Thorndyke's
+lessons lasted but two or three hours a day, and the school term
+was a movable period, according to the season of the year and the
+engagements of the Squire and Mark. In winter the evening was the
+time, so that the boy shot with his father, or rode to the hounds,
+or, as he got older, joined in shooting parties at the houses of
+neighbors.
+
+In summer the work was done in the morning, but was not unfrequently
+broken. Mark went off at a very early hour to drive perhaps some
+twenty miles with his great chum, Dick Chetwynd, for a long day's
+fishing, or to see a main of cocks fought or a fight between the
+champions of two neighboring villages, or perhaps some more important
+battle.
+
+When Millicent Conyers was ten years old she came regularly into the
+study, sitting curled up in a deep chair, getting up her lessons
+while Mark did his, and then changing seats with him while he
+learned his Horace or Ovid by heart. At this time she looked up
+greatly to him, and was his companion whenever he would allow her
+to be, fetched and carried for him, and stood almost on a level
+with his dogs in his estimation. Five years later, when Mark was
+eighteen, these relations changed somewhat. He now liked to have
+her with him, not only when about the house and garden, but when
+he took short rides she cantered along on her pony by his side. She
+was a bright faced girl, full of life and fun, and rejoicing in a
+far greater amount of freedom than most girls of her age and time.
+
+"It is really time that she should learn to comport herself more
+staidly, instead of running about like a wild thing," Mrs. Cunningham
+said, one day, as she and the Squire stood after breakfast looking
+out of the open window at Mark and Millicent.
+
+"Time enough, my dear lady, time enough. Let her enjoy life while
+she can. I am not in favor of making a young kitten behave like an
+old tabby; every creature in nature is joyful and frolicsome while
+it is young. She is as tall and as straight as any of her friends
+of the same age, and looks more healthy; she will tame down in
+time, and I dare say walk and look as prim and demure as they do.
+I was watching them the other day when there was a party of them
+up here, and I thought the difference was all to her advantage.
+She looked a natural, healthy girl; they looked like a set of
+overdressed dolls, afraid to move or to talk loud, or to stretch
+their mouths when they smile; very ladylike and nice, no doubt, but
+you will see Millicent will throw them into the shade when she is
+once past the tomboy age. Leave her alone, Mrs. Cunningham; a girl
+is not like a fruit tree, that wants pruning and training from its
+first year; it will be quite time to get her into shape when she
+has done growing."
+
+John Thorndyke had occasionally made inquiries of Mr. Bastow as
+to the whereabouts of his son. At the time the sentence was passed
+transportation to the American colonies was being discontinued,
+and until other arrangements could be made hulks were established
+as places of confinement and punishment; but a few months later
+Arthur Bastow was one of the first batch of convicts sent out to
+the penal settlement formed on the east coast of Australia. This
+was intended to be fixed at Botany Bay, but it having been found
+that this bay was open and unsheltered, it was established at
+Sydney, although for many years the settlement retained in England
+the name of the original site. As the condition of the prisoners
+kept in the hulks was deplorable, the Squire had, through the
+influence of Sir Charles Harris, obtained the inclusion of Bastow's
+name among the first batch of those who were to sail for Australia.
+Mr. Bastow obtained permission to see his son before sailing, but
+returned home much depressed, for he had been assailed with such
+revolting and blasphemous language by him that he had been forced
+to retire in horror at the end of a few minutes.
+
+"We have done well in getting him sent off," the Squire said, when
+he heard the result of the interview. "In the first place, the
+demoralizing effect of these hulks is quite evident, and it may be
+hoped that in a new country, where there can be no occasion for the
+convicts to be pent up together, things may be better; for although
+escapes from the hulks are not frequent, they occasionally take
+place, and had he gained his liberty we should have had an anxious
+time of it until he was re-arrested, whereas out there there is
+nowhere to go to, no possibility of committing a crime. It is not
+there as it was in the American colony. Settlements may grow up in
+time, but at present there are no white men whatever settled in
+the district; and the natives are, they say, hostile, and were a
+convict to escape he would almost certainly be killed, and possibly
+eaten. No doubt by the time your son has served his sentence
+colonies will be established out there, and he may then be disposed
+to settle there, either on a piece of land of which he could no
+doubt take up or in the service of one of the colonists."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V.
+
+
+The scene in the convict yard at Sydney, five years after its
+foundation as a penal settlement, was not a pleasant one to the
+lover of humanity. Warders armed to the teeth were arranging gangs
+that were to go out to labor on the roads. Many of the convicts had
+leg irons, but so fastened as to be but slight hindrance to their
+working powers, but the majority were unironed. These were the
+better behaved convicts; not that this would be judged from their
+faces, for the brutalizing nature of the system and the close
+association of criminals had placed its mark on all, and it would
+have been difficult for the most discriminating to have made any
+choice between the most hardened criminals and those who had been
+sent out for what would now be considered comparatively trivial
+offenses. The voyage on board ship had done much to efface distinctions,
+the convict life had done more, and the chief difference between
+the chained and unchained prisoners was that the latter were men of
+more timid disposition than many of their companions, and therefore
+less disposed to give trouble that would entail heavy punishment.
+But it was only the comparatively well conducted men who were
+placed upon road work; the rest were retained for work inside the
+jail, or were caged in solitary confinement. Each morning a number,
+varying from half a dozen to a dozen, were fastened up and flogged,
+in some cases with merciless severity, but it was seldom that a
+cry was uttered by these, the most brutal ruffians of the convict
+herd. This spectacle was just over: it was conducted in public
+for the edification of the rest, but, judging from the low laughs
+and brutal jests, uttered below the breath, it signally failed in
+producing the desired impression. Two of those who had suffered
+the severest punishment were now putting on their coarse woolen
+garments over their bloodstained shoulders; both were comparatively
+young men.
+
+"I shall not stand this much longer," one muttered. "I will brain
+a warder, and get hung for it. One can but die once, while one can
+get flogged once a week."
+
+"So would I," the other said bitterly; "but I have some scores to
+settle in England, and I am not going to put my head in a noose
+until I have wiped them out. The sooner we make arrangements to
+get back there the better."
+
+"Yes, we have talked of this before," the other said, "and I quite
+agreed with you that if we all had the pluck of men we ought to
+be able to overpower the warders, in spite of their firearms. Of
+course some of us would get killed, but no one would mind that if
+there was but the remotest chance of getting away. The question
+is what we should do with ourselves when we were once outside
+the prison. Of course I know that there are two or three hundred
+settlers, but there would not be much to be got out of them, and
+life among those black fellows, even if they were civil to us,
+which I don't suppose they would be, would not be worth having."
+
+"We might not have to stay there long; ships with stores or settlers
+arrive occasionally, and if a lot of us got away we might seize one
+by force, turn pirates for a bit, and when we are tired of that
+sail to some South American port, sell our capture, and make our
+way home to England. If we were not strong enough to take her, we
+could hide up on board her; we should be sure to find some fellow
+who for a pound or two would be willing to help us. The thing can
+be done if we make up our minds to do it, and I for one have made
+up my mind to try. I haven't chalked out a plan yet, but I am
+convinced that it is to be done."
+
+"I am with you, whatever it is," the other said; "and I think there
+are twenty or thirty we could rely on. I don't say there are more
+than that, because there are a lot of white livered cusses among
+them who would inform against us at once, so as to get their own
+freedom as a reward for doing so. Well, we will both think it over,
+mate, and the sooner the better."
+
+The two men who were thus talking together were both by birth
+above the common herd of convicts, and had gained a considerable
+ascendency over the others because of their reckless indifference
+to punishment and their defiance of authority. Few of the men knew
+each other's real names; by the officials they were simply known
+by numbers, while among themselves each had a slang name generally
+gained on board ship.
+
+Separation there had, of course, been impossible, and when fastened
+down below each had told his story with such embellishments as he
+chose to give it, and being but little interfered with by their
+guards, save to insure the impossibility of a mutiny, there had
+been fights of a desperate kind. Four or five dead bodies had been
+found and thrown overboard, but as none would testify as to who had
+been the assailants none were punished for it; and so the strongest
+and most desperate had enforced their authority over the others,
+as wild beasts might do, and by the time they had reached their
+destination all were steeped much deeper in wickedness and brutalism
+than when they set sail.
+
+The two men who were speaking together had speedily become chums,
+and, though much younger than the majority of the prisoners, had
+by their recklessness and ferocity established an ascendency among
+the others. This ascendency had been maintained after their arrival
+by their constant acts of insubordination, and by their apparent
+indifference to the punishment awarded them. At night the convicts
+were lodged in wooden buildings, where, so long as they were not
+riotous, they were allowed to talk and converse freely, as indeed
+was the case when their work for the day was done.
+
+As to any attempt at escape, the authorities had but small anxiety,
+for until the arrival of the first settlers, three years after that
+of the convicts, there was nowhere a fugitive could go to, no food
+to be obtained, no shelter save among the blacks, who were always
+ready for a reward of tobacco and spirits to hand them over at
+once to the authorities. The case had but slightly changed since
+the settlement began to grow. It was true that by stealing sheep or
+driving off a few head of cattle a fugitive might maintain himself
+for a time, but even if not shot down by the settlers or patrols,
+he would be sure before long to be brought in by the blacks.
+
+The experiment had already been tried of farming our better
+conducted convicts to the settlers, and indeed it was the prospect
+of obtaining such cheap labor that had been the main inducement
+to many of the colonists to establish themselves so far from
+home, instead of going to America. As a whole the system worked
+satisfactorily; the men were as much prisoners as were the inmates
+of the jail, for they knew well enough that were they to leave the
+farmers and take to the bush they would remain free but a short
+time, being either killed or handed over by the blacks, and in the
+latter case they would be severely punished and set to prison work
+in irons, with labor very much more severe than that they were
+called upon to do on the farms.
+
+Some little time after the conversation between the two convicts
+the prison authorities were congratulating themselves upon the fact
+that a distinct change had taken or was taking place in the demeanor
+of many of the men who had hitherto been the most troublesome, and
+they put it down to the unusually severe floggings that had been
+inflicted on the two most refractory prisoners in the establishment.
+When in the prison yard or at work they were more silent than
+before, and did their tasks doggedly and sullenly; there was no open
+defiance to the authorities, and, above all, a marked cessation of
+drunkenness from the spirits smuggled into the place.
+
+Only the two originators were aware of the extent of the plot;
+for they had agreed that only by keeping every man in ignorance as
+to who had joined it could they hope to escape treachery. In the
+first place, they had taken into their confidence a dozen men on
+whom they could absolutely rely. Beyond this they had approached
+the others singly, beginning by hinting that there was a plot for
+escape, and that a good many were concerned, and telling them that
+these had bound themselves together by a solemn oath to kill any
+traitor, even if hanged for it.
+
+"No one is to know who is in it and who is not," the leaders said
+to each recruit. "Every new man will be closely watched by the
+rest, and if he has any communication privately with a warder or
+any other official he will be found strangled the next morning;
+no one will know who did it. Even if he succeeded in eluding the
+vigilance of his comrades at the time, it would soon be known; for
+if indulgence of any kind was shown towards one man, or he was
+relieved from his ordinary work, or even freed altogether and suddenly,
+he would be a dead man in twenty-four hours, for we have friends
+outside among the ticket of leave men who have bound themselves to
+kill at once any man set free."
+
+To the question, "What do you intend to do when we get off?" the
+answer was, "We shall go straight to the bush, so as to avoid a
+fight with the soldiers, in the first place; then we shall join that
+night, and drive off all the cattle and sheep from the settlements,
+take possession of every firearm found in the houses, then move
+off a couple of hundred miles or so into the bush, and establish
+a settlement of our own.
+
+"Of course, we shall take horses and clothes and any spirits and
+food we may find. If the soldiers pursue us, we will fight them;
+but as there are only three or four companies of them, and we shall
+be eight hundred strong, we shall very soon show them that they
+had better leave us alone.
+
+"Oh, yes, no doubt they will send more soldiers out from England,
+but it will be over a year before they can get here; and we propose
+after we have done with the fellows here to break up into parties
+of twenty and thirty, dividing the sheep and cattle among us, and
+each party going where it will. The place is of tremendous size,
+as big as a dozen Englands, they say, and each party will fix a
+place it fancies, where there is good water and a river with fish
+and so on, and we may live all our lives comfortably, with just
+enough work to raise potatoes and corn, and to watch our stock
+increasing. Anyhow, we might calculate on having some years of
+peace and freedom, and even if in the end they searched us all out,
+which would be very unlikely, they could but bring us back, hang a
+few, and set the rest to work again; but we think that they would
+most likely leave us alone altogether, quite satisfied with having
+got rid of us."
+
+"Those who liked it could, no doubt, take wives among the blacks.
+The convict women who are out on service with the settlers would,
+you may be sure, join us at once, and an enterprising chap who
+preferred a white woman to a black could always make his way down
+here and persuade one to go off with him to his farm. That is the
+general plan; if many get tired of the life they have only to come
+down to Sydney, hide up near the place on some dark night, and go
+down to the port, seize a ship, and make off in her, compelling the
+officers and sailors to take them and land them at any port they
+fancy, either in Chili, Peru, or Mexico, or, if they like, sail
+west and make for Rio or Buenos Ayres or one of the West Indian
+islands. As to when it is going to be done, or how it is going to
+be done, no one will be told till it is ready to be carried out. We
+have not settled that ourselves, and thus one who was fool enough
+to risk certain death could tell the Governor no more than that
+there was a plot on hand, and that the man who had sworn him in
+was concerned in it."
+
+So one by one every man in the prison was sworn by a terrible oath
+to secrecy, to watch his companions, and to report anything that
+looked suspicious. Many joined willingly, the prospect of relief,
+even should it only be temporary, being too fascinating to be
+resisted. Some joined against their, will, fearing that a refusal
+to do so would be punished by death; and the fact that two or three
+men were found strangled in bed had a very great effect in inducing
+others to join in the plot.
+
+These deaths caused some uneasiness to the authorities. Their
+utmost endeavors failed to discover who were the perpetrators of
+these murders; and even when everyone in the same hut was flogged
+to obtain information, not one opened his lips.
+
+One night the word was passed round that the time had come. One only
+in each hut was familiar with the details, and he gave instructions
+to each man individually as to what he was to do. The date had been
+determined by the fact that the time which they had been sentenced
+to wear irons had terminated the day before, and their unusually
+subdued and quiet demeanor having carried them through the interval
+without, as usual, fresh punishments being awarded them before the
+termination of the former one.
+
+In the morning the whole of the convicts were drawn up to witness
+the flogging of the inmates of one of the huts, where a man had
+been found strangled the morning before. The first prisoner was
+taken to the triangle, stripped to the waist, and tied up. There
+was a dead silence in the ranks of the convicts, but as the first
+blow fell upon his shoulders there was a loud yell, and simultaneously
+the whole ranks broke up, and a number of men sprang upon each of
+the warders, wrested their muskets from them, and threw them to the
+ground. Then there was a rush towards the Governor and officers,
+who were assembled in front of the stone house that faced the open
+end of the square. Firing their pistols, these at once took refuge
+in the house, three or four falling under the scattered fire that
+was opened as soon as the muskets of the warders fell into the
+hands of the convicts.
+
+Directly the doors were closed the officers appeared at the windows,
+and opened a rifle fire upon the convicts, as did the guards near
+the gate. As comparatively few of the convicts had muskets, they
+began to waver at once. But, headed by the two ringleaders, the
+armed party rushed at the guard, shot them down, and threw open
+the gate.
+
+Then an unexpected thing occurred. The soldiers from the barracks
+happened to be marching down to do target practice on the shore,
+and were passing the convict prison when the firing broke out. They
+were at once halted, and ordered to load, and as the convicts, with
+exultant shouts, poured through the gate they saw a long line of
+soldiers, with leveled muskets, facing them.
+
+"At them!" one of the leaders shouted. "It is too late to draw back
+now. We have got to break through them."
+
+Many of the convicts ran back into the yard; but those armed with
+muskets, the more desperate of the party, followed their leaders.
+A moment later a heavy volley rang out, and numbers of the convicts
+fell. Their two leaders, however, and some twenty of their followers,
+keeping in a close body, rushed at the line of soldiers with clubbed
+muskets, and with the suddenness and fury of the rush burst their
+way through the line, and then scattering, fled across the country,
+pursued by a dropping fire of musketry.
+
+The officers in command, seeing that but a fraction had escaped,
+ordered one company to pursue, and marched the rest into the prison
+yard. It was already deserted; the convicts had scattered to their
+huts, those who had arms throwing them away. Dotted here and there
+over the square were the bodies of eight or ten convicts and as
+many warders, whose skulls had been smashed in by their infuriated
+assailants as soon as they had obtained possession of their muskets.
+Close to the gate lay the six soldiers who had furnished the guard;
+these were all dead or mortally wounded.
+
+The Governor and the officials issued from the house as soon as
+the soldiers entered the yard. The first step to do was to turn
+all the convicts out of the huts and to iron them. No resistance
+was attempted, the sight of the soldiers completely cowing the
+mutineers. When the bodies of the convicts that had fallen were
+counted and the roll of the prisoners called over, it was found that
+eighteen were missing, and of these six were during the course of
+the next hour or two brought in by the soldiers who had gone in
+pursuit of them. The rest had escaped.
+
+The convicts were all questioned separately, and the tales they
+told agreed so closely that the Governor could not doubt that they
+were speaking the truth. All had been sworn in by one of two men,
+and knew nothing whatever of what was intended to be done that day,
+until after they were locked up on the evening previous. Each of
+those in the huts had received his instructions the night before
+from the one man.
+
+There were eighteen huts, each containing fifteen convicts. Of the
+men who had given instructions six had fallen outside the gate,
+together with sixteen others; five had been overtaken and brought
+in; altogether, twelve were still at large. Among these were
+the two leaders. The next day six of the prisoners were tried
+and executed. The rest were punished only by a reduction in their
+rations; sentence of death was at the same time passed upon the
+twelve still at large, so as to save the trouble of a succession
+of trials as they were caught and brought in.
+
+The two leaders had kept together after they had broken through
+the line of soldiers.
+
+"Things have gone off well," one said as they ran through. "Those
+soldiers nearly spoilt it all."
+
+"Yes, that was unlucky," the other agreed; "but so far as we are
+concerned, which is all we care about, I think things have turned
+out for the best."
+
+Nothing more was said until they had far outstripped their pursuers,
+hampered as these were by their uniforms and belts.
+
+"You mean that it is not such a bad thing that they have not all
+got away?"
+
+"Yes, that is what I mean. It is all very well to tell them about
+driving off the sheep and cattle and horses, and going to start a
+colony on our own account, but the soldiers would have been up to
+us before we had gone a day's journey. Most of the fellows would
+have bolted directly they saw them. As it is, I fancy only about a
+dozen have got away, perhaps not as many as that, and they are all
+men that one can rely upon. One can feed a dozen without difficulty
+--a sheep a day would do it--and by giving a turn to each of
+the settlers, the animals won't be missed. Besides, we shall want
+money if we are ever to get out of this cursed country. It would
+not be difficult to get enough for you and me, but when it comes to
+a large number the sack of the whole settlement would not go very
+far.
+
+"My own idea is that we had best join the others tonight, kill
+a few sheep, and go two or three days' march into the bush, until
+the heat of the pursuit is over. We are a11 armed, the blacks would
+not venture to attack us, and the soldiers would not be likely to
+pursue us very far. In a week or so, when we can assume that matters
+have cooled down a bit, we can come down again. We know all the
+shepherds, and even if they were not disposed to help us they would
+not dare to betray us, or report a sheep or two being missing.
+Of course, we shall have to be very careful to shift our quarters
+frequently. Those black trackers are sure to be sent out pretty
+often."
+
+"As long as we are hanging about the settlements there won't be
+much fear of our being bothered by the blacks. Of course, we shall
+have to decide later on whether it will be best for us to try and
+seize a ship, all of us acting together, or for us to get quietly
+on board one and keep under hatches until she is well away. That
+is the plan I fancy most."
+
+"So do I. In the first place the chances are that in the next two
+or three months at least half the fellows will be picked up. To
+begin with, several of them are sure to get hold of liquor and make
+attacks upon the settlers, in which case some of them, anyhow, are
+sure to get killed. In the next place, most of them were brought
+up as thieves in the slums of London, and will have no more idea
+of roughing it in a country like this than of behaving themselves
+if they were transported to a London drawing room. Therefore, I am
+pretty sure that at the end of three months we shall not be able
+to reckon on half of them. Well, six men are not enough to capture
+a ship, or, if they do capture it, to keep the crew under. One must
+sleep sometimes, and with only three or four men on deck we could
+not hope to keep a whole ship's crew at bay."
+
+"Then there is another reason. You and I, when we have got a decent
+rig out, could pass anywhere without exciting observation; while if
+we had half a dozen of the others, whatever their good qualities,
+they would be noticed at once by their villainous faces, and if
+questions were to be asked we should be likely to find ourselves
+in limbo again in a very short time. So I am all for working on
+our own account, even if the whole of the others were ready to back
+us; but, of course, we must keep on good terms with them all, and
+breathe no word that we think that each man had better shift for
+himself. Some of those fellows, if they thought we had any idea
+of leaving them, would go straight into Sydney and denounce us,
+although they would know that they themselves would be likely to
+swing at the same time."
+
+As none of the convicts were acquainted with the bush, they had been
+obliged to select as their rendezvous a hut two miles out of the
+town, where the convict gangs that worked on the road were in the
+habit of leaving their tools. On the way there the two men killed
+a couple of sheep from a flock whose position they had noticed
+before it became dark. These they skinned, cut off the heads, and
+left them behind, carrying the sheep on their shoulders to the
+meeting.
+
+"Is that you, Captain Wild?" a voice said as they approached.
+
+"Yes; Gentleman Dick is with me."
+
+"That is a good job. We had begun to think that the soldiers had
+caught you."
+
+"They would not have caught us alive, you may take your oath. How
+many are there of us here?"
+
+"Ten of us, Captain. I think that that is all there are."
+
+"That is enough for our purpose. Has anyone got anything to eat?"
+
+There was a deep growl in the negative.
+
+"Well, we have brought a couple of sheep with us, and as we have
+carried them something like a mile, you had better handle them by
+turns. We will strike off into the bush and put another three or
+four miles between us and the jail, and then light a fire and have
+a meal."
+
+Two of the men came forward and took the sheep. Then they turned
+off from the road, and taking their direction from a star, followed
+it for an hour.
+
+"I think we have got far enough now," the man called Captain Wild
+said. "You had better cut down the bushes, and we will make a fire."
+
+"But how are we to light it?" one of them exclaimed in a tone
+of consternation. "I don't suppose we have got flint and steel or
+tinder box among us."
+
+"Oh, we can manage that!" the Captain said. "Get a heap of dried
+leaves here first, then some wood, and we will soon have a blaze."
+
+His orders were obeyed. Some of the men had carried off the warders'
+swords as well as their muskets, and now used them for chopping
+wood. As soon as a small pile of dried leaves was gathered the
+Captain broke a cartridge and sprinkled half its contents among
+them, and then dropped the remainder into his musket. He flashed
+this off among the leaves, and a bright flame at once shot up, and
+in five minutes a fire was burning.
+
+One of the sheep was soon cut up, the meat hacked in slices from
+the bones, a ramrod was thrust through the pieces, and, supported
+by four sticks, was laid across the fire. Three other similarly
+laden spits were soon placed beside it, and in a short time the
+meat was ready for eating. Until a hearty meal had been made there
+was but little talking.
+
+"That is first rate," one of the men said, as he wiped his mouth
+with the back of his hand. "Now one only wants a pipe and bacca
+and a glass of grog, to feel comfortable."
+
+"Well, Captain, are you satisfied with the day's work?"
+
+"It would have been a grand day had it not been for the soldiers
+passing just at the time. As it is, Gentleman Dick and I have been
+agreeing that as far as we are all concerned it has not turned out
+so badly. There would have been a lot of difficulty in finding food
+if we had all got away, and some of those mealy mouthed fellows would
+have been sure to go back and peach on us at the first opportunity.
+A dozen is better than a hundred for the sort of life we are likely
+to lead for some time. We are strong enough to beat off any attack
+from the black fellows, and also to break into any of these settlers'
+houses.
+
+"We can, when we have a mind to, take a stray sheep now and then,
+or even a bullock would scarcely be missed, especially if our pals
+in the settlement will lend us a helping hand, which you may be
+sure they will do; in fact, they would know better than to refuse.
+Then a large party could be traced by those black trackers at a
+run, while a small one would not; especially if, as we certainly
+will do, we break up into twos and threes for a time. First of
+all, though, we must go well into the bush; at daybreak tomorrow
+morning we will drive off twenty sheep, and go right away a hundred
+miles, and wait there till matters have settled down. They will
+never take the troops out that distance after us. Then we can come
+back again, and hang about the settlement and take what we want. The
+wild blacks don't come near there, and we shall be safer in pairs
+than we should be if we kept together; and of course we could meet
+once a week or so to talk over our plans. We must borrow some whisky,
+flour, tea, tobacco, and a few other items from the settlers, but
+we had better do without them for this trip. I don't want to turn
+the settlers against us, for they have all got horses, and might
+combine with the troops to give chase, so it would be best to leave
+them alone, at any rate till we get back again. Another reason for
+treating them gently is that even if they did not join the troops
+they might get into a funk, and drive their sheep and horses down
+into Sydney, and then we should mighty soon get short of food. It
+will be quite time enough to draw upon them heavily when we make
+up our minds to get hold of a ship and sail away. Money would be
+of no use to us here, but we shall want it when we get to a port,
+wherever that port may be."
+
+"That sounds right enough, Captain," one of the convicts said,
+"and just at present nothing would suit me better than to get so
+far away from this place that I can lay on my back and take it easy
+for a spell."
+
+There was a general chorus of assent, and there being neither
+tobacco nor spirits, the party very soon stretched themselves off
+to sleep round the fire.
+
+In the morning they were up before daylight, and half an hour later
+arrived at one of the farms farthest from Sydney. Here they found
+a flock of a hundred sheep. The shepherd came to the door of his
+hut on hearing a noise.
+
+"You had best lie down and go to sleep for the next hour," the
+leader of the convicts said sharply. "We don't want to do an old
+pal any harm, and when you wake up in the morning and find the flock
+some twenty short, of course you won't have any idea what has come
+of them."
+
+The man nodded and went back into the hut and shut the door, and
+the convicts started for the interior, driving twenty sheep before
+them.
+
+During the first day's journey they went fast, keeping the sheep at
+a trot before them, and continuing their journey through the heat
+of the day.
+
+"I tell you what, Captain," one of the men said when they halted
+at sunset, "if we don't get to a water hole we shall have to give
+up this idea of going and camping in the bush. My mouth has been
+like an oven all day, and it is no use getting away from jail to
+die of thirst out here."
+
+There had been similar remarks during the day, and the two leaders
+agreed together that it would be madness to push further, and that,
+whatever the risk, they would have to return to the settlements
+unless they could strike water. As they were sitting moodily round
+the fire they were startled by a dozen natives coming forward into
+the circle of light. These held out their hands to say that their
+intentions were peaceful.
+
+"Don't touch your muskets!" Captain Wild exclaimed sharply, as
+some of the men were on the point of jumping to their feet. "The
+men are friendly, and we may be able to get them to guide us to
+water."
+
+The natives, as they came up, grinned and rubbed their stomachs,
+to show that they were hungry.
+
+"I understand," the Captain said; "you want a sheep, we want water;"
+and he held up his hand to his mouth and lifted his elbow as if in
+the act of drinking.
+
+In two or three minutes the natives understood what he wanted, and
+beckoned to the men to follow. The tired sheep were got onto their
+legs again, and half a mile away the party arrived at a pool in what
+in wet weather was the bed of a river. A sheep was at once handed
+over to the natives, and when the men had satisfied their thirst
+another sheep was killed for their own use.
+
+After a great deal of trouble the natives were made to understand
+that the white men wanted one of their party to go with them
+as a guide, and to take them always to water holes, and a boy of
+fifteen was handed over to them in exchange for two more sheep, and
+at daybreak the next morning they started again for the interior,
+feeling much exhilarated by the piece of luck that had befallen
+them. They traveled for four days more, and then, considering that
+the soldiers had ceased their pursuit long ago, they encamped for
+ten days, enjoying to the utmost their recovered freedom and their
+immunity from work of any kind. Then they returned to the neighborhood
+of the settlements, and broke up, as their leader proposed, into
+pairs.
+
+They had been there but a short time before the depredations committed
+roused the settlers to band themselves together. Every horse that
+could be spared was lent to the military, who formed a mounted
+patrol of forty men, while parties of infantry, guided by native
+trackers, were constantly on the scent for the convicts.
+
+"This is just what I expected," Captain Wild said to his lieutenant.
+"It was the choice of two evils, and I am not sure that the plan we
+chose was not the worst. We might have been quite sure that these
+fellows would not be able, even for a time, to give up their old
+ways. If they had confined themselves, as we have done, to taking
+a sheep when they wanted it, and behaving civilly when they went
+to one of the houses and begged for a few pounds of flour or tea,
+the settlers would have made no great complaint of us; they know
+what a hard time we have had, and you can see that some of the
+women were really sorry for us, and gave us more than we actually
+asked for. But it has not been so with the others. They had been
+breaking into houses, stealing every thing they could lay their
+hands upon, and in three or four cases shooting down men on the
+slightest provocation.
+
+"The money and watches were no good to them, but the brutes could
+not help stealing them; so here we are, and the settlement is like
+a swarm of angry bees, and this plan of handing over most of their
+horses to the military will end in all of us being hunted down
+if we stay here. Two were shot yesterday, and in another week we
+shall all either be killed or caught. There is nothing for it but
+to clear out. I am against violence, not on principle, but because
+in this case it sets people's backs up; but it cannot be helped
+now. We must get a couple of horses to ride, and a spare one to
+carry our swag. We must have half a sack of flour and a sheep--
+it is no use taking more than one, because the meat won't keep--
+and a good stock of tea and sugar. We must get a good supply of
+powder, if we can, some bullets and shot. We shall have to get our
+meat by shooting.
+
+"There is no time to be lost, and tonight we had better go to that
+settler's place nearest the town. He has got two of the best horses
+out here--at least so Redgrave, that shepherd I was talking
+to today, told me--and a well filled store of provisions. If he
+will let us have them without rumpus, all well and good; if not,
+it will be the worse for him. My idea is that we should ride two
+or three hundred miles along the coast until we get to a river,
+follow it up till we find a tidy place for a camp, and stop there
+for three or four months, then come back again and keep ourselves
+quiet until we find out that a ship is going to sail; then we
+will do a night among the farmhouses, and clean them out of their
+watches and money, manage to get on board, and hide till we are
+well out to sea. We must get a fresh fit out before we go on board;
+these clothes are neither handsome nor becoming. We must put on
+our best manners, and tell them that we are men who have served our
+full time, and want to get back, and that we were obliged to hide
+because we had not enough to pay our full passage money, but that
+we have enough to pay the cost of our grub, and are ready to pull
+at a rope and make ourselves useful in any way. If we are lucky we
+ought to get enough before we start to buy horses and set ourselves
+up well in business at home."
+
+"I think that is a very good plan," the other agreed, "and I am
+quite sure the sooner we make ourselves scarce here the better."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI.
+
+
+While arranging for young Bastow being sent out with the first
+batch of convicts John Thorndyke had been introduced to several of
+the officials of the Department, and called upon them at intervals
+to obtain news of the penal colony. Three years after its establishment
+a Crown colony had been opened for settlement in its vicinity. As
+the climate was said to be very fine and the country fertile, and
+land could be taken up without payment, the number who went out was
+considerable, there being the additional attraction that convicts
+of good character would be allotted to settlers as servants and
+farm hands.
+
+Six years after Arthur Bastow sailed the Squire learned that there
+had been a revolt among the convicts; several had been killed, and
+the mutiny suppressed, but about a dozen had succeeded in getting
+away. These had committed several robberies and some murders among
+the settlers, and a military force and a party of warders from the
+prison were scouring the country for them.
+
+"Of course, Mr. Thorndyke," the official said, "the Governor in
+his report does not gives us the names of any of those concerned
+in the matter; he simply says that although the mutiny was general,
+it was wholly the work of a small number of the worse class
+of prisoners. By worse class he means the most troublesome and
+refractory out there. The prisoners are not classified according to
+their original crimes. A poacher who has killed a game keeper, or
+a smuggler who has killed a revenue officer, may in other respects
+be a quiet and well conducted man, while men sentenced for
+comparatively minor offenses may give an immense deal of trouble.
+I will, however, get a letter written to the Governor, asking him
+if Arthur Bastow was among those who took part in the revolt, and
+if so what has become of him."
+
+It was more than a year before the reply came, and then the Governor
+reported that Arthur Bastow, who was believed to have been the
+leading spirit of the mutiny, was among those who had escaped, and
+had not yet been recaptured. It was generally believed that he had
+been killed by the blacks, but of this there was no actual proof.
+
+Mr. Bastow was much disturbed when he heard the news. "Suppose he
+comes back here, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"I won't suppose anything of the sort," the Squire replied. "I
+don't say that it would be altogether impossible, because now that
+vessels go from time to time to Sydney, he might, of course, be
+able to hide up in one of them, and not come on deck until she was
+well on her way, when, in all probability, he would be allowed to
+work his passage, and might be put ashore without any information
+being given to the authorities. I have no doubt that among the sailors
+there would be a good deal of sympathy felt for the convicts. No
+doubt they have a hard time of it, and we know that the gangs working
+on the roads are always ironed. Still, this is very unlikely, and
+the chances are all in favor of his being in hiding in the bush.
+
+"The shepherds and other hands on the farms are chiefly convicts,
+and would probably give him aid if he required it, and there would
+be no difficulty in getting a sheep, now and then, for, as all
+reports say, one of the chief troubles out there are the wild dogs,
+or dingoes, as they are called; any loss in that way would readily
+be put down to them. As to money, he would have no occasion for it;
+if he wanted it he would get it by robbing the settlers, he would
+know that if he came back here he would run the risk of being seized
+at once on landing or of being speedily hunted down as an escaped
+convict. I don't think that there is the slightest occasion for us
+to trouble ourselves about him."
+
+But though the Squire spoke so confidently, he felt by no means
+sure that Arthur Bastow would not turn up again, for his reckless
+audacity had made a great impression upon him. The proceeds of the
+robberies in the colony, in which he had no doubt played a part,
+would have furnished him with money with which he could bribe a
+sailor to hide him away and, if necessary, pay his passage money
+to England, when discovered on board, and perhaps maintain him
+when he got home until he could replenish his purse by some unlawful
+means. Lastly, the Squire argued that the fellow's vindictive
+nature and longing for revenge would act as an incentive to bring
+him back to London. He talked the matter over with Mark, who was
+now a powerful young fellow of twenty, who, of course, remembered
+the incidents attending Bastow's capture and trial.
+
+"I cannot help fancying that the fellow will come back, Mark."
+
+"Well, if he does, father, we must make it our business to lay him
+by the heels again. You managed it last time, and if he should turn
+up you may be sure I will help you to do it again."
+
+"Yes, but we may not hear of his having returned until he strikes
+a blow. At any rate, see that your pistols are loaded and close at
+hand at night."
+
+"They always are, father. There is no saying when a house like this,
+standing alone, and containing a good deal of plate and valuables,
+may be broken into."
+
+"Well, you might as well carry them always when you go out after
+dark. I shall speak to Knapp, and request him to let me know if he
+hears of a suspicious looking character--any stranger, in fact
+--being noticed in or about the village, and I shall have a talk
+with Simeox, the head constable at Reigate, and ask him to do the
+same. He is not the same man who was head at the time Bastow was up
+before us, but he was in the force then, and, as one of the constables
+who came up to take the prisoners down to Reigate, he will have
+all the facts in his mind. He is a sharp fellow, and though Bastow
+has no doubt changed a good deal since then, he would hardly fail
+to recognize him if his eye fell upon him. Of course we may be
+alarming ourselves unnecessarily, but there are several reasons
+why I should object strongly to be shot just at the present time."
+
+"Or at any other time, I should say, father," the young man said
+with a laugh.
+
+"I shall know him, Squire, safe enough," the head constable replied
+when John Thorndyke went down to see him on the following day; "but
+I should think that if he does come back to England he will hardly
+be fool enough to come down here. He was pretty well known in town
+before that affair, and everyone who was in the courthouse would
+be sure to have his face strongly impressed upon their minds. You
+may forget a man you have seen casually, but you don't forget one
+you have watched closely when he is in the dock with two others
+charged with murder. Five out of my six men were constables at
+that time, and would know him again the minute they saw him; but
+anyhow, I will tell them to keep a sharp lookout in the tramps'
+quarters, and especially over the two or three men still here that
+Bastow used to consort with. I should say that Reigate is the last
+place in the world where he would show his face."
+
+"I hope so," the Squire said. "He has caused trouble enough down
+here as it is; his father is getting an old man now, and is by no
+means strong, and fresh troubles of that kind would undoubtedly
+kill him."
+
+A month later the Reigate coach was stopped when a short distance
+out of the town by two highwaymen, and a considerable prize obtained
+by the robbers. Soon afterwards came news of private carriages being
+stopped on various commons in the South of London, and of several
+burglaries taking place among the houses round Clapham, Wandsworth,
+and Putney. Such events were by no means uncommon, but following
+each other in such quick succession they created a strong feeling
+of alarm among the inhabitants of the neighborhood. John Thorndyke,
+going up to town shortly afterwards, went to the headquarters of
+the Bow Street runners, and had a talk with their chief in reference
+especially to the stoppage of the Reigate coach. Mr. Chetwynd had
+lately died, and John Thorndyke had been unanimously elected by
+his fellow magistrates as chairman of the bench.
+
+"No, Mr. Thorndyke, we have no clew whatever. Our men have been
+keeping the sharpest watch over the fellows suspected of having
+a hand in such matters, but they all seem keeping pretty quiet at
+present, and none of them seem to be particularly flush with money.
+It is the same with these burglaries in the South of London. We
+are at our wits' end about them. We are flooded with letters of
+complaint from residents; but though the patrols on the common have
+been doubled and every effort made, we are as far off as ever. As
+far as the burglaries are concerned, we have every reason to think
+that they are the work of two or three new hands. The jobs are not
+neatly done, and certainly not with tools usually used by burglars.
+They seem to rely upon daring rather than skill. Anyhow, we don't
+know where to look for them, and are altogether at sea.
+
+"Of course it is as annoying to us as it is to anyone else; more
+so, because the Justices of the Peace are sending complaints to
+the Home Secretary, and he in turn drops on us and wants to know
+what we are doing. I have a sort of fancy myself the fellows who
+are stopping the coaches are the same as those concerned in the
+burglaries. I could not give you my reasons for saying so, except
+that on no occasion has a coach been stopped and a house broken
+into on the same night. I fancy that at present we shan't hear
+much more of them. They have created such alarm that the coaches
+carry with them two men armed with blunderbusses, in addition to
+the guards, and I should fancy that every householder sleeps with
+pistols within reach, and has got arms for his servants. At many
+of the large houses I know a watchman has been engaged to sit in
+the hall all night, to ring the alarm bell and wake the inmates
+directly he hears any suspicious sounds. Perhaps the fellows may
+be quiet for a time, for they must, during the last month, have got
+a wonderful amount of spoil. Maybe they will go west--the Bath
+road is always a favorite one with these fellows--maybe they will
+work the northern side of the town. I hope we shall lay hands upon
+them one day, but so far I may say frankly we have not the slightest
+clew."
+
+"But they must put their horses up somewhere?"
+
+"Yes, but unfortunately there are so many small wayside inns, that
+it is next to impossible to trace them. A number of these fellows
+are in alliance with the highwaymen. Some of them, too, have small
+farms in addition to their public house businesses, and the horses
+may be snugly put up there, while we are searching the inn stables
+in vain. Again, there are rogues even among the farmers themselves;
+little men, perhaps, who do not farm more than thirty or forty
+acres, either working them themselves, or by the aid of a hired
+man who lives perhaps at a village a mile away. To a man of this
+kind, the offer of a couple of guineas a week to keep two horses
+in an empty cowshed, and to ask no questions, is a heavy temptation.
+
+"We have got two clever fellows going about the country inquiring
+at all the villages whether two mounted men have lately been heard
+going through there late at night, or early in the morning, so as
+to narrow down the area to be searched, but nothing has come of it,
+although I am pretty sure that they must have three or four places
+they use in various directions. My men have picked up stories
+of horsemen being heard occasionally, but they come from various
+directions, and nowhere have they been noticed with any regularity.
+Besides, there are other knights of the road about, so we are no
+nearer than we were on that line of inquiry."
+
+A month later John Thorndyke had occasion to go up again to town.
+This time Mark accompanied him. Both carried pistols, as did the
+groom, sitting behind them. The Squire himself was but a poor shot,
+but Mark had practiced a great deal.
+
+"'Tis a good thing to be able to shoot straight, Mark," his father
+had said to him three years before. "I abhor dueling, but there is
+so much of it at present that any gentlemen might find himself in
+a position when he must either go out or submit to be considered a
+coward. Then, too, the roads are infested by highwaymen. For that
+reason alone it would be well that a man should be able to shoot
+straight. You should also practice sometimes at night, setting up
+some object at a distance so that you can just make out its outline,
+and taking a dozen shots at it. I know it is very difficult when
+you cannot see your own pistol, but you can soon learn to trust to
+your arm to come up to the right height and in the right direction.
+Of course you must wait until morning to find out where your bullet
+has gone."
+
+Two days after they had reached town the Squire received a letter
+from Mrs. Cunningham.
+
+"DEAR MR. THORNDYKE:
+
+"Knapp has been up this morning to tell me that a stranger dismounted
+yesterday at the alehouse, and while his horse was being fed he
+asked a few questions. Among others, he wished to be told if you
+were at home, saying that he had known you some fifteen years ago,
+when you lived near Hastings, and should like to have a talk with
+you again. In fact, he had turned off from the main road for the
+purpose. He seemed disappointed when he heard that you had gone up
+to town, and hearing that you might not be back for three or four
+days, said he should be coming back through Reigate in a week or
+ten days, and he dared say he should be able to find time to call
+again. Knapp did not hear about it until this morning; he asked the
+landlord about the man, and the landlord said he was about thirty,
+dark, and sparely built. He did not notice his horse particularly,
+seeing that it was such as a small squire or farmer might ride. He
+carried a brace of pistols in his holsters. The landlord was not
+prepossessed with his appearance, and it was that that made him
+speak to Knapp about him. I have told the men to unfasten the dogs
+every night, and I have asked Knapp to send up two trustworthy men
+to keep watch."
+
+"It may mean something, and it may not," the Squire said, as he
+handed the letter to Mark. "It is a suspicious looking circumstance;
+if the fellow had been honest he would surely have said something
+about himself. There is no doubt these housebreakers generally find
+out what chance there is of resistance, and, hearing that we were
+both away, may have decided on making an attempt. I have pretty
+well finished our business and ordered nearly all the provisions
+that Mrs. Cunningham requires. But I have to call at my lawyer's,
+and that is generally a longish business. It is half past two
+o'clock now; if we start from here at five we shall be down soon
+after eight, which will be quite soon enough. We shall have a
+couple of hours' drive in the dark, but that won't matter, we have
+got the lamps."
+
+"I am quite ready to start, father. I am engaged to sup with Reginald
+Ascot, but I will go over this afternoon and make my excuses."
+
+At five o'clock they started. "You have got your pistols in order,
+Mark?" the Squire asked, as they drove over London Bridge.
+
+"I have them handy, father, one in each pocket."
+
+"James, are your pistols charged?"
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+At six o'clock it was beginning to get dusk, and they stopped while
+the groom got down and lit the lamps; then they resumed their journey.
+They were within five miles of Reigate when suddenly two horsemen
+rode out from a side road with a shout of "Stand and deliver!"
+
+The Squire lashed the horses, and a moment later a pistol was fired,
+and the ball went through his hat. By the light of the lamps Mark
+saw the other man raise his hand, and, leveling his pistol, fired on
+the instant; then, as there was no reply to his shot, he discharged
+the second barrel at the first who had fired, and who had at
+once drawn another pistol. The two reports rang out almost at the
+same moment, but Mark's was a little the first. There was a sharp
+exclamation of pain from the highwayman, who wrenched round his
+horse and galloped down the lane from which he had issued, the
+groom sending two bullets after him.
+
+"Where is the other man?" Mark exclaimed, as his father reined in
+the horses.
+
+"Somewhere on the ground there, Mark; I saw him fall from his saddle
+as we passed him."
+
+"Is it any use pursuing the other, father? I am pretty sure I hit
+him."
+
+"I am quite sure you did, but it is no good our following; the side
+roads are so cut up by ruts that we should break a spring before we
+had gone a hundred yards. No, we will stop and look at this fellow
+who is unhorsed, Mark."
+
+The groom got down, and, taking one of the carriage lamps, proceeded
+to a spot where the highwayman's horse was standing. The man was
+already dead, the bullet having hit him a few inches above the
+heart.
+
+"He is dead, father."
+
+"I think you had better lift him up on the foot board behind; James
+can ride his horse. We will hand the body over to the constable
+at Reigate. He may know who he is, or find something upon him that
+may afford a clew that will lead to the capture of his companion."
+
+"No, I don't know him, Squire," the constable said as they stopped
+before his house and told him what had happened. "However, he
+certainly is dead, and I will get one of the men to help me carry
+him into the shed behind the courthouse. So you say that you think
+that the other is wounded?"
+
+"I am pretty sure he is. I heard him give an exclamation as my son
+fired."
+
+"That is good shooting, Mr. Mark," the constable said. "If every
+passenger could use his arms as you do there would soon be an end
+to stopping coaches. I will see what he has got about him, and will
+come up and let you know, Squire, the first thing in the morning."
+
+"I will send Knapp down," John Thorndyke said, as they drove
+homewards. "I am rather curious to know if this fellow is the same
+Mrs. Cunningham wrote about. I will tell him to take Peters along
+with him."
+
+"I hardly see that there can be any connection between the two.
+Highwaymen don't go in for house breaking. I think they consider
+that to be a lower branch of the profession."
+
+"Generally they do, no doubt, Mark; but you know I told you that the
+chief at Bow Street said that he had a suspicion that the highway
+robbers and the house breakers who have been creating so much alarm
+are the same men."
+
+"It is curious that they should have happened to light on us,
+father, if they were intending to break into our house."
+
+John Thorndyke made no reply, and in a few minutes drove up to the
+house. Their return, a couple of days before they were expected,
+caused great satisfaction to Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent. The
+former, however, had wisely kept from the girl the matter on which
+she had written to the Squire, and the suspicion she had herself
+entertained.
+
+"It is very dull without you both," Millicent said. "I was telling
+Mrs. Cunningham that I thought it would be a good thing, when you
+got back, for us two to take a run up to town for a week, just to
+let you see how dull the place is when two of us are away. You are
+looking quite serious, uncle. Is anything the matter?"
+
+"Happily nothing is the matter with us, dear, but we have had an
+adventure, and not a very pleasant one."
+
+"What was it?" the girl asked.
+
+"If you examine my hat closely, Millicent, it will tell you."
+
+The girl took up the hat from a chair on which he had put it, and
+brought it to the light. "There are two holes in it," she said.
+"Oh, Guardy, have you been shot at?"
+
+"It looks like it, dear. Two gentlemen highwaymen--at least, that
+is what I believe they call themselves--asked us pressingly to
+stop, and as we would not comply with their request, one fired at
+me, and, as you see, it was an uncommonly good shot. The other was
+about to fire when Mark's pistol put a stop to him, and his second
+barrel stopped the fellow who had fired first; he was hit, for we
+heard him give an exclamation of pain, but before any more shooting
+could be done he turned and rode off down a narrow lane where we
+could not follow."
+
+"And what became of the first?" Millicent asked with open eyes.
+
+"He was dead before we could get down to examine him; he will not
+disturb the King's peace again. It happened about four miles from
+home, so we brought him in and gave him and his horse into the
+charge of the constable at Reigate."
+
+"And you have really killed a man?" Millicent said, looking up with
+an awestruck expression to Mark.
+
+"Well, as the man would have killed us if I hadn't, I cannot say,
+Millicent, that his death weighs in any way heavily on my mind. If
+he were as good a shot as the other, my father's life would not have
+been worth much, for as we were driving fast, he was not above half
+as far away as the other had been when he fired. Just the same, I
+suppose, as it would be in a battle; a man is going to shoot you,
+and you shoot him first, and I don't suppose it ever troubles you
+afterwards."
+
+"Of course I don't mean that I blame you, Mark; but it does seem
+shocking."
+
+"I don't suppose you would think that, Millicent, if a burglar, who
+had taken one shot at you and was about to finish you with another,
+was cut short in the operation by a shot from my pistol. I believe
+that your relief and thankfulness would be so great that the idea
+that it was a shocking thing for me to do would not as much as
+enter your head."
+
+"I wish you had shot the other man as well as the one you did,
+Mark," the Squire said, as he walked with his son down to Reigate
+to attend the inquest the next morning on the man he had brought
+in. Mark looked at his father in surprise.
+
+"There is no doubt I hit him, father," he said; "but I should not
+think that he will be likely to trouble us again."
+
+"I wish I felt quite sure of that. Do you know that I have a strong
+suspicion that it was Arthur Bastow?"
+
+Mark had, of course, heard of Bastow's escape, but had attached
+no great importance to it. The crime had taken place nearly eight
+years before, and although greatly impressed at the time by the ill
+doings of the man, the idea that he would ever return and endeavor
+to avenge himself on his father for the part he had taken had not
+occurred to him. Beyond mentioning his escape, the Squire had never
+talked to him on the subject.
+
+"It was he who bade us stand and deliver, and the moment he spoke
+the voice seemed familiar to me, and, thinking it over, I have an
+impression that it was his. I may be mistaken, for I have had him
+in my mind ever since I heard that he had escaped, and may therefore
+have connected the voice with him erroneously, and yet I cannot but
+think that I was right. You see, there are two or three suspicious
+circumstances. In the first place, there was this man down here making
+inquiries. Knapp went down early this morning with the innkeeper,
+and told me before breakfast that Peters at once recognized the
+fellow you shot as the man who had made the inquiries. Now, the
+natural result of making inquiries would have been that the two men
+would the next evening have broken into the house, thinking that
+during our absence they would meet with no resistance. Instead of
+doing this they waylaid us on the road, which looks as if it was
+me they intended to attack, and not the house."
+
+"But how could they have known that it was us, father? It is certainly
+singular that one of the two men should have been the fellow who
+was up at the inn, but it may be only a matter of coincidence."
+
+"I don't know, Mark; I don't say that singular coincidences don't
+occur, but I have not much faith in them. Still, if they were
+journeying down to attack the house last night they would hardly have
+stopped travelers by the way when there was a rich booty awaiting
+them, as they evidently believed there was, or that man would not
+have come down specially to make inquiries. My own impression is
+that when they heard that we should return in two or three days one
+of them watched us in London, and as soon as they learned that we
+were to start for home at five o'clock they came down here to stop
+us. They would hardly have done that merely to get our watches and
+what money we had in our pockets."
+
+"No, I should think not, father; but they might be friends of men
+who have got into trouble at Reigate, and, as you are chairman
+of the bench, may have had a special grudge against you for their
+conviction."
+
+"That is, of course, possible, and I hope that it is so."
+
+"But even if Arthur Bastow had escaped, father, why should he come
+back to England, where he would know that he might be arrested
+again, instead of staying quietly out in Australia?"
+
+"There are two reasons. In the first place the life out there would
+not be a quiet one; there would be nothing for him but to attack
+and rob the settlers, and this, as they are sure to be armed, is a
+pretty dangerous business. Then there are perils from the blacks,
+and lastly, such a life would be absolutely devoid of comfort,
+and be that of a hunted dog; living always in the bush, scarcely
+venturing to sleep lest he should be pounced upon either by the
+armed constables of the colony or by the blacks. It is not as if
+the country were extensively populated; there are not a very large
+number of settlers there yet, and therefore very small scope for
+robbers. These people would keep very little money with them, and
+the amount of plunder to be got would be small indeed. Therefore,
+I take it that the main object of any escaped convict would be to
+get away from the place.
+
+"That is one of the reasons why the fellow might come back to
+England in spite of the risks. The other is that I believe him to
+be so diabolically vindictive that he would run almost any peril
+in order to obtain revenge upon me or his father. Twice he has
+threatened me, the first time when we captured him, the second time
+as he left the court after he had received his sentence. I am not
+a coward, so far as I know, Mark, but I am as certain as I stand
+here that he meant what he said, and that, during these years of
+imprisonment and toil out there, he has been cherishing the thought
+of coming home some day and getting even with me. You see, he is
+said to have been the leader of this convict revolt. There is no
+doubting his daring, and to my mind the attack upon us last night,
+when they knew that they could have managed a successful robbery here,
+points to the fact that it was the result of personal animosity,
+and strengthens my belief that it was Arthur Bastow who called upon
+us to stand and deliver."
+
+"It is a very unpleasant idea, father."
+
+"Very unpleasant, and it seems to me that we should at any rate
+spare no pains in hunting the man you wounded down."
+
+"I will undertake that if you like. I have nothing particular to
+do, and it would be an excitement. You have a lot to keep you here."
+
+"I don't fancy that you will find it an excitement, Mark, for of
+course the detectives will do the hunting, but I should certainly
+be glad if you would take a letter for me to the head of the Detective
+Department, and tell him what I think, and my reasons for thinking
+so, and say that I offer a reward of a hundred pounds for the
+capture of the man who tried to stop us, and who was, we are certain,
+wounded by you. Unless he has some marvelously out of the way hiding
+place, it ought not to be difficult. A wounded man could scarcely
+lie hidden in the slums of London without it being known to a good
+many people, to some of whom a reward of the sum of a hundred pounds
+would be an irresistible temptation."
+
+By this time they had reached Reigate. The inquest did not last
+many minutes, and the jury without hesitation returned a verdict
+of justifiable homicide.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII.
+
+
+The next morning Mark went up to London.
+
+"Of course, Mr. Thorndyke," the chief at Bow Street said,
+"your father's suspicions as to the man's identity may or may not
+be justified; that, however, makes no difference to us. Here is a
+highwayman who has been wounded, and would certainly be a valuable
+capture: I will set my men to work at once; if he is in London they
+will get news of him before many days. My men in any case would do
+their duty, but your father's offer will certainly stimulate their
+energy. Where are you stopping?"
+
+"At the Bull, in Holborn."
+
+"Very well; I will be sure to let you know as soon as we get any
+clew to the man's identity."
+
+Mark remained in London a week, and at the end of that time
+he received a note from Bow Street saying that the superintendent
+wished to see him.
+
+"I am sorry that I have no news for you, Mr. Thorndyke," the officer
+said, when he called upon him. "Every place where such a man would
+be likely to be in hiding has been searched, and no clew whatever
+has been obtained. We shall now circulate notices of the reward
+throughout the country. If the man was at all severely hit, we may
+assume that he must be somewhere in the neighborhood of London,
+whereas, if the wound was a slight one, he might be able to go a
+long distance, and may be now in York, for aught we know. However,
+now that the search in London has terminated, I can really see no
+use in your staying here any longer; we will let you know directly
+we have any news."
+
+Three months later John Thorndyke received a letter from the
+Detective Office asking him to call the next time he came up to
+town, as although no news had been obtained that would lead to the
+man's immediate arrest, news had at any rate been obtained showing
+that he was alive. It happened that Mark was intending to go up
+on the following day, and his father asked him to call for him at
+Bow Street.
+
+"Well, Mr. Thorndyke, we have heard about your man, and that after
+we had quite abandoned the search. I had come to the conclusion
+that the wound you gave him had been a fatal one, and that he had
+been quietly buried by some of the people with whom he was connected.
+The discovery was, as half these discoveries generally are, the
+result of accident. Last week a gentleman entered the Bank and asked
+for change in gold for a fifty pound note. The cashier, looking
+at the number, found that it was one of those that had been stolen
+from a passenger by one of the south coaches several months ago. The
+gentleman was at once taken into a private office, and questioned
+as to how he had obtained the note. The account that he gave was
+that he was a surgeon in practice at Southampton. A gentleman had
+arrived there on a date which we found to be the day after that on
+which you were stopped; he was well dressed, and had the air of a
+gentleman; he had come down by coach, and was evidently very ill.
+He told the surgeon that he had been engaged in a duel, that the
+pistols had been discharged simultaneously, and that he had killed
+his man, but had himself been severely wounded. He said that the
+person whom he had killed had influential connections, and that it
+would be necessary for him to remain in seclusion for a time, and
+he asked him to take charge of his case, as he had ample means of
+paying him handsomely. The surgeon examined the wound, and found
+it to be indeed a serious one, and, as he thought, probably fatal.
+However, having no doubt as to the truth of the story, he had taken
+the gentleman in, and he remained under his charge until a week
+before he came up to town.
+
+"For the first month he had been dangerously ill, but he completely
+recovered. The surgeon had no reason whatever for doubting his
+patient being a gentleman; he was fashionably dressed, and had
+evidently changed his clothes after the duel, as there were no
+bloodstains upon them. He was, however, glad when he left, as his
+conversation did not please him from its cynical tone. The Bank
+sent to us directly the man presented the note, which he stated
+had been given to him in part payment for his medical services and
+the board and lodging of the patient; the total amount had been 75
+pounds, and the balance was paid in gold. As he was able to give
+several good references, and was identified by three gentlemen, he
+was, of course, released. I have no doubt whatever that the fellow
+he attended was your man. The surgeon said, whoever he was, he must
+have been a man of iron resolution to have made such a journey in
+the state he was.
+
+"No doubt he must have ridden straight to the place he used as his
+headquarters, where he had his wound roughly bandaged, changed his
+clothes, and had ridden in the morning to some point that the coach
+passed on its way to Southampton. Of course we obtained a minute
+description from the surgeon of the man's appearance. We found that
+the people at the coach office had no remembrance of there being
+anyone answering to that description among the persons who traveled
+by the coach, but of course that would not go for much, for over
+three months have elapsed.
+
+"When the coachman who had driven the down coach that day came up
+to town, we saw him, and he remembered perfectly that on or about
+that day he had picked up a passenger at Kingston--a gentleman
+who was in very weak health. There were only three inside passengers
+besides himself, and he had to be assisted into the coach. The way
+bill, on being turned up, showed that an inside passenger had been
+taken up at Kingston. I have already sent down men to make inquiries
+at every village in the district between Reigate and Kingston, and
+I trust that we shall lay hands on him, especially now we have got
+an accurate description of him, while before we were working in
+the dark in that respect."
+
+"What is the description, sir? My father is much interested on that
+point, for, as I believe I told you, he has a strong suspicion that
+the fellow is the man who was transported more than eight years
+ago to Australia, and who made his escape from the prison there."
+
+"Yes, I know. At first it appeared to me very improbable, but I am
+bound to say the description tallies very closely with that given
+of him. The surgeon took him to be nearly thirty; but after what
+he has gone through he may well look three or four years older than
+he is. He had light hair, rather small gray eyes, and a face that
+would have been good looking had it not been for its supercilious
+and sneering expression."
+
+"I can remember him," Mark said; "and that answers very closely to
+him. I should say that it is certainly Bastow, and my father made
+no mistake when he asserted that he recognized his voice."
+
+The officer added a note to the description in his register: "Strongly
+suspected of being Arthur Bastow, transported for connivance with
+highwaymen; was leader of a mutiny in convict jail of Sydney two
+years and a half ago. Made his escape."
+
+"There is no doubt," he went on, "that he is a desperate character.
+No doubt he is the man who has been concerned in most of these
+robberies in the southern suburbs. We must get hold of him if we
+can, and once we do so there will be an end of his travels, for the
+mutiny in prison and escape is a hanging business, putting aside
+the affairs since he got back. Well, sir, I hope he will give you
+and your father no more trouble."
+
+"I am sure I hope so," Mark said. "I suppose that the fellow who
+was shot was one of the men who escaped with him from the convict
+prison."
+
+"That is likely enough. Two would get home as easily as one, and
+the fact that they were both strangers here would account for the
+difficulty our men have had in their search for him. You see, we
+have had nothing whatever to go on. You must not be too sanguine
+about our catching the man in a short time: he is evidently a
+clever fellow, and I think it likely that once he got back he lost
+no time in getting away from this part of the country, and we are
+more likely to find him in the west or north than we are of laying
+hands on him here. We will send descriptions all over the country,
+and as soon as I hear of a series of crimes anywhere, I will send
+off two of my best men to help the local constables."
+
+On his return home Mark told his father what he had done.
+
+"I thought that I could not have been mistaken, Mark; we have
+got that rascal on our hands again. I hope now that they have got
+a description of him to go by, they will not be long before they
+catch him; but the way he escaped after being badly wounded shows
+that he is full of resources, and he may give them some trouble
+yet, if I am not mistaken. At any rate, I will have a talk with the
+Reigate constable, and tell him that there is very little doubt
+that the man who attacked us was Arthur Bastow, who has, as we have
+heard, escaped from Botany Bay, and that he had best tell his men
+to keep a sharp lookout for him, for that, owing to his animosity
+against us for his former capture and conviction, it is likely
+enough that sooner or later he will be in this neighborhood again.
+After his determined attempt at my life when pretending to rob
+us, I shall certainly not feel comfortable until I know that he is
+under lock and key."
+
+"I wish, Guardy, you would give up this magistrate's business,"
+Millicent said at dinner. "I am sure that it is worrying you, and
+I can't see why you should go on with it."
+
+"It does not worry me, as a rule, Millicent; indeed, I like the
+duty. Besides, every landowner of standing ought to take his share
+in public work. There are only two of the magistrates younger than
+I am, and whatever you may think of me, I feel myself capable of
+doing what work there is to do. When Mark gets a few years older
+I shall resign, and let him take my place on the bench. I own,
+though, that I should be glad if these highway robberies could be
+suppressed. Poaching and the ordinary offenses of drunkenness and
+assaults are disposed of without any trouble; but this stopping
+of the coaches, accompanied occasionally by the shooting of the
+coachman or guard, gives a great deal of trouble, and the worst of
+it is that we are practically powerless to put such crimes down.
+Nothing short of patrolling the roads in parties of three or four
+between sunset and sunrise would put a stop to them, and the funds
+at our disposal would not support such an expenditure."
+
+"It is a pity that you cannot get up a corps like the yeomanry, and
+call it the Mounted Constabulary," said Mark. "There are at least
+a dozen fellows I know who would, like myself, be glad to join it,
+and I dare say we could get a score of young farmers or farmers'
+sons."
+
+"It is not a bad idea, Mark, and I dare say that for a time the
+duty would be zealously performed, but before very long you would
+tire of it. A few wet nights or winter's cold, and you would cease
+to see the fun of it, especially as you may be sure that the news
+that the roads are well patrolled would soon come to the ears of
+these scoundrels, and they would cease to work in the district."
+
+"Perhaps you are right, sir; but I think that a few of us would
+stick to it."
+
+"Perhaps so, Mark, but I should be sorry to wager that the work
+would be thoroughly done. The first county or hunt ball, or even
+dinner party, more than half of them would be away. I don't say
+that you personally might not for some considerable time persist
+in patrolling the roads, for you have a sort of personal interest
+in the matter; but I would wager that before two months have passed
+you would find you were the only one who attended at the rendezvous
+regularly."
+
+A fortnight later the party were seated round the fire in the dusk.
+Mr. Bastow was sitting next to the Squire, and was in unusually good
+spirits. He had heard no word of what the Squire had discovered,
+nor dreamed that his son was again in England, still less that he
+was suspected of being one of the men who had endeavored to stop
+the Squire and his son on their drive from London. Suddenly there
+was the crack of a pistol outside, and a ball passed between him
+and the Squire. Without a word, Mark Thorndyke rushed to the door,
+seized a pistol from his riding coat, and, snatching up a heavy
+whip, dashed out into the garden.
+
+He was just in time to see a figure running at full speed, and he
+set off in pursuit. Good runner as he was, he gained but slightly
+at first, but after a time he drew nearer to the fugitive. The
+latter was but some sixty yards away when he leaped a hedge into
+a narrow lane. Mark followed without hesitation, but as he leaped
+into the road he heard a jeering laugh and the sharp sound of
+a horse's hoofs, and knew that the man he was pursuing had gained
+his horse and made off. Disgusted at his failure, he went slowly
+back to the house. The shutters had been put up.
+
+"I have lost him, father. He ran well to begin with, but I was
+gaining fast on him when he leaped into a narrow lane where he had
+left his horse, and rode off before I could get up to him. I need
+hardly say that there was no use attempting to follow on foot. He
+missed you all, did he not?"
+
+"Yes, Mark. It is not so easy to take an accurate aim when it is
+nearly dark. The bullet passed between myself and Mr. Bastow, and
+has buried itself in the mantelpiece."
+
+"Something ought to be done, Guardy," Millicent Conyers said
+indignantly. "It is shameful that people cannot sit in their own
+room without the risk of being shot at. What can it mean? Surely
+no one can have any enmity against you."
+
+"I hope not, my dear," John Thorndyke said lightly. "Some of the
+fellows we have sentenced may think that we were rather hard on them,
+but I do not think that any of them would feel it sufficiently to
+attempt to murder one; besides, Mark says that the fellow had a
+horse waiting for him, and none of our poachers would be likely to
+be the owner of a horse. It may be that the highwayman Mark shot
+at and wounded has come down to give us a fright. It is no use
+worrying about it now; in future we will have the shutters closed
+at sunset. It is hardly likely that the thing will be attempted
+again, and Mark's chase must have shown the fellow that the game
+is hardly worth the risk."
+
+"He might have shot you, Mark; you had no right to risk your life
+in that sort of way," the girl said to him, later, as they were
+seated together in front of the fire, while the Squire was reading
+the Gazette at the table, Mrs. Cunningham was working, and Mr.
+Bastow, who had been greatly shaken by the event, had retired to
+bed.
+
+"Do you think that he really meant to kill your father?"
+
+"I should imagine he did; a man would hardly run the risk of being
+hung merely for the pleasure of shooting. I would give a good deal
+if I had caught him, or better still, if I had shot him," said
+Mark. "However, I will make it my business to hunt the fellow down.
+After this evening's affair, we shall never feel comfortable until
+he is caught. I have no doubt that he is the fellow we have been
+hunting for the last four months. The people at Bow Street seem no
+good whatever; I will try if I cannot succeed better."
+
+"Don't do anything rash, Mark," said Millicent, in a low voice;
+"you have no right to put yourself in danger."
+
+"But our lives are in danger now, Millicent--in much greater
+danger than mine would be when looking out for him. But there seems
+no guarding against attacks like this; I mean to hunt him down, if
+it takes me a year. I have nothing special to do, and cannot employ
+my time more usefully."
+
+When the ladies went up to bed the Squire said:
+
+"Come into the library, Mark, and we will smoke a pipe, and have
+a talk over this business." He touched the bell. "Have you got a
+good fire in the library, Ramoo?"
+
+"Yes, sahib, very good."
+
+"Then take a bottle of number one bin of port there--and a couple
+of glasses."
+
+When they were quietly seated, glasses filled, and the long pipes
+alight, the Squire said: "I want to have a serious talk with you,
+Mark. What I am going to say will surprise you a good deal. I had
+not intended to tell you for another four years--that is to say,
+not until Millicent came of age--but after that affair tonight,
+I feel that my life is so uncertain that I ought not to delay letting
+you know the truth. I suppose you agree with me that it was Bastow
+who shot at me this evening?"
+
+"I have not the least doubt about that, father."
+
+"I will not say that he shot at me," the Squire said, "for he may
+have shot at his father; the villain is quite capable of that. It
+was his father who brought me upon him, and though I effected his
+capture eight years ago I don't suppose he cares which of us he
+killed. However, the point is not what he aimed at, but whether
+it was he, and that I take there is no doubt about. He missed me
+this time, but his next shot may be more successful, At any rate,
+I think that it is high time that I told you the story."
+
+And, beginning with the arrival of Colonel Thorndyke at his place,
+he repeated the conversation that he had had with him. Several
+times in the early portion of his narrative he was interrupted by
+exclamations of surprise from his son.
+
+"Then Millicent is really my uncle's heiress!" exclaimed Mark, when
+he heard the request the Colonel had made of the Squire.
+
+"That is so, Mark. She does not know it herself, and it was my
+brother's urgent wish that she should not know it until she came
+of age or until she married. I fought against it to the utmost, but
+it was his dying prayer, and I could not refuse it. My solicitor
+knows the facts of the matter, and so does Mrs. Cunningham, who
+brought Millicent over from India when she was only about a year
+old. I may say that I especially urged that it would not be fair
+to you to be brought up to consider yourself to be heir to the
+property, but he said:
+
+"'Putting aside the estate, I have a considerable fortune. In the
+first place, there are the accumulations of rent from the Reigate
+place. I have never touched them, and they have been going on for
+twelve years. In. the next place, the shaking of the pagoda tree
+has gone on merrily, and we all made a comfortable pile. Then I
+always made a point of carrying about with me two or three hundred
+pounds, and after the sacking of some of the palaces I could pick
+up jewels and things from the troops for a trifle, being able to
+pay money down. Even without the rents here, I have some 50,000
+pounds in money. I should think the jewels would be worth at least
+as much more, irrespective of a diamond bracelet which is, I fancy,
+worth more than the rest put together. It was stolen from the arm
+of some idol.' He then explained how he got it, and the manner
+in which he had placed it and the rest of his wealth in a secure
+position.
+
+"'Things stolen from a god are frightfully dangerous,' he said,
+'for the Brahmins or priests connected with the temples have been
+known to follow them up for years, and in nine cases out of ten they
+get possession of them again. Murder in such a case is meritorious,
+and I would not have them in the house here, were they ten times the
+value they are. I know that my clothes, my drawers, and everything
+belonging to me have been gone through at night a score of times.
+Nothing has been stolen, but, being a methodical man, I could
+generally see some displacement in the things that told me they had
+been disturbed, They gave it up for a time, but I haven't a shadow
+of a doubt that they have been watching me ever since, and they may
+be watching me now, for anything I know. Now, half of that fortune
+I have left by my will to your son; half to the girl. I will tell
+you where the things are the last thing before I die.
+
+"'Now, mind, you must be careful when you get them. When I am dead
+you are almost certain to be watched. You don't know what these
+fellows are. The things must remain where they are until your boy
+comes of age. Don't let him keep those diamonds an hour in his
+possession; let him pass them away privately to some man in whom
+he has implicit confidence, for him to take them to a jeweler's;
+let him double and turn and disguise himself so as to throw everyone
+that may be spying on him off his track. If you can manage it, the
+best way would be to carry them over to Amsterdam, and sell them
+there.'
+
+"I confess it seemed absurd, but it is a matter about which he
+would know a great deal more than I do, and he was convinced that
+not only was he watched, but that he owed his life simply to the
+fact that the fellows did not know where the diamonds were hidden,
+and that by killing him they would have lost every chance of
+regaining them.
+
+
+"So convinced was he of all this, that he would not tell me where
+he had stowed them away; he seemed to think that the very walls
+would hear us, and that these fellows might be hidden under the
+sofa, in a cupboard, or up the chimney, for aught I know. He told
+me that he would tell me the secret before he died; but death came
+so suddenly that he never had an opportunity of doing so. He made
+a tremendous effort in his last moment, but failed, and I shall
+never forget the anguish his face expressed when he found himself
+powerless to speak; however, he pressed his snuffbox into my hand
+with such a significant look that, being certain it contained some
+clew to the mystery, and being unable to find a hidden spring or
+a receptacle, I broke it open that night.
+
+"It contained a false bottom, and here are what I found in it. I
+stowed them away in a secret drawer in that old cabinet that stands
+by my bedside. It is in the bottom pigeonhole on the right hand
+side. I bought the cabinet at a sale, and found the spring of the
+secret drawer quite accidentally. I shall put the things back tonight,
+and you will know where to look for them. You press against the
+bottom and up against the top simultaneously, and the back then
+falls forward. The opening behind is very shallow, and will hold
+but two or three letters. But, however, it sufficed for this;" and
+he handed Mark the coin and slip of paper.
+
+"But what are these, father?"
+
+"These are the clews by which we are to obtain the treasure."
+
+As Mark examined them carefully the Squire stood up with his back
+to the fire, and looking round walked to the door and said: "I
+thought there was a draught somewhere; either Ramoo did not shut
+the door when he went out or it has come open again. It has done
+that once or twice before. When I go into town tomorrow I will
+tell Tucker to send a man up to take the lock off. Well, what do
+you make out of that?"
+
+"I can make out nothing," Mark replied. "No doubt the coin is
+something to be given to whoever is in charge of the treasure, and
+Masulipatam may be the place where it is hidden."
+
+"Yes, or it may be a password. It reminds one of the forty thieves
+business. You go and knock at the door of a cave, a figure armed
+to the teeth presents itself, you whisper in his ear 'Masulipatam,'
+he replies 'Madras,' or 'Calcutta,' or something of that sort, you
+take out the coin and show it to him, he takes out from some hidden
+repository a similar one, compares the two, and then leads you to
+an inner cave piled up with jewels."
+
+Mark laughed.
+
+"Well, it is no laughing matter, Mark," the Squire went on seriously.
+"The little comedy may not be played just as I have sketched it,
+but I expect that it is something of the kind. That coin has to be
+shown, and the word 'Masulipatam' spoken to the guardian, whoever
+he may be, of your uncle's treasure. But who that guardian may be
+or how he is to be found is a mystery. I myself have never tried
+to solve it. There was nothing whatever to go upon. The things may
+be in England or, it may be, anywhere in India. To me it looked an
+absolutely hopeless business to set about. I did not see how even
+a first step was to be taken, and as I had this estate and you and
+Millicent to look after, and was no longer a young man, I put the
+matter aside altogether. You are young, you have plenty of energy,
+and you have your life before you, and it is a matter of the greatest
+interest to you.
+
+"Possibly--very improbably, mind, still possibly--when Millicent
+comes of age and learns who she is, Mrs. Cunningham may be able to
+help you. I have no idea whether it is so. I have never spoken to
+her about this treasure of George's, but it is just possible that
+while he was in town before he came down to me he may have given
+her some instructions concerning it. Of course he intended to give
+me full particulars, but he could hardly have avoided seeing that,
+in the event of my death, perhaps suddenly before the time came for
+seeking the treasure, the secret would be lost altogether. Whether
+he has told her or his lawyer or not I cannot say, but I have all
+along clung to the hope that he took some such natural precaution.
+Unless that treasure is discovered, the only thing that will come
+to you is the half of the accumulated rents of this estate during
+the ten years between my father's death and George's; these rents
+were paid to our solicitors, and by them invested.
+
+"The rentals amount to about 2500 pounds a year, and of course
+there is interest to be added, so that I suppose there is now some
+25,000 pounds, for I had out 2000 pounds when I came here, to set
+matters straight. I had a great fight with the lawyers over it, but
+as I pointed out they had failed altogether to see that the agent
+did his duty, and that at least a couple of hundred a year ought to
+be expended in necessary repairs, I had a right to at least that
+sum to carry out the work that ought to be done from year to year.
+In addition to that sum I laid out about 1000 pounds a year for
+the first three years I was here; so that practically 5000 pounds
+was expended in rebuilding the village and doing repairs on the
+homesteads; that, however, is not the point now. Altogether, then,
+there is some 25,000 pounds to be divided between you and Millicent
+when she becomes mistress of this property.
+
+"According to the terms of my brother's will, I am still to remain
+here until she marries; when she does so I shall, of course, go back
+to my own little place; the income of that has been accumulating
+while I have been here, my only expenses having been for clothes. I
+have taken nothing out of this estate since I came here, and each
+year have paid to the solicitors all balances remaining after
+discharging the household expenses, these balances averaging 700
+or 800 pounds a year. Of course the income was absolutely left to
+me during the time I remained ostensible owner, but I had no wish
+to make money out of a trust that I assumed greatly against my will.
+That money is Millicent's; of course the house had to be kept up
+in proper style whether I were here or not. Had she at once come
+into possession, there must have been horses, and carriages, and so
+on. I don't say that I have not had all the expenses of our living
+saved; that I had no objection to; but I was determined at least
+not to take a penny put of the estate beyond those expenses. You
+see, Mark, you will have your 12,500 pounds anyhow, as soon as
+Millicent comes of age--not a bad little sum--so that even if
+you never hear anything more of this mysterious treasure you will
+not be penniless, or in anyway dependent upon me. At my death,
+of course, you will come into the Sussex place, with what savings
+there may be."
+
+"I am sure I have no reason to grumble, father," Mark said heartily.
+"Of course it came upon me at first as a surprise that Millicent
+was the heiress here, and it flashed through my mind for the moment
+that the best thing would be to take a commission in the army, or
+to follow my uncle's example, and get a cadetship in the Company's
+service. I have no doubt that I should have enjoyed life either way
+quite as much or possibly more than if I had gone on a good many
+years as heir to these estates, and afterwards as Squire. Of course,
+now I shall make it my business to see if it is possible to obtain
+some sort of clew to this treasure, and then follow it up; but
+the first thing to which I shall give my mind will be to hunt down
+Bastow. We shall never feel safe here as long as that fellow is
+alive, and that will be the first thing I shall devote myself to.
+After that I shall see about the treasure."
+
+"As to that, Mark, I cannot impress upon you too strongly what your
+uncle said. It may, of course, be a pure delusion on his part; but
+if he is right, and some of these Hindoo fellows are still on the
+watch to obtain that bracelet, you must use extraordinary precautions
+when you get it into your hands; he advised me to take it across
+to Amsterdam, and either get the stones recut or to sell them
+separately to different diamond merchants there. He said that my
+life would not be worth an hour's purchase as long as the stones
+were in my hands."
+
+"That rather looks, father, as if the things were somewhere in
+England; had they been in India, you would have had them some months
+in your hands before you could get them to Amsterdam."
+
+"I did not think of that before, Mark, and it is possible that you
+are right; but I don't know; he might have thought that it would
+be impossible for me to dispose of them at Madras or Calcutta, and
+may have assumed that I should at once deposit them in a bank to
+be forwarded with other treasure to England, or that I should get
+them packed away in the treasure safe in the ship I came back by,
+and that I should not really have them on my person till I landed
+in England, or until I took them from the Bank. Still, I see that
+your supposition is the most likely, and that they may all this time
+have been lying somewhere in London until I should present myself
+with a gold coin and the word 'Masulipatam.'"
+
+Suddenly Mark sprang to his feet, and pulled back the curtains
+across a window, threw it up, and leaped into the garden, and there
+stood listening for two or three minutes, with his pistol cocked
+in his hand. He stepped for a moment into the room again.
+
+"You had better put that light out, father or we may have another
+shot."
+
+"Did you hear anything, Mark?"
+
+"I thought I did, father. I may have been mistaken, but I certainly
+thought I heard a noise, and when I pulled the curtains aside the
+window was not shut by three or four inches. I will have a look
+through the shrubbery. That fellow may have come back again. Pull
+the curtains to after me."
+
+"I will go with you, Mark."
+
+"I would rather you didn't, father; it would only make me nervous.
+I shan't go into the shrubbery and give them a chance of getting
+first shot. I shall hide up somewhere and listen. It is a still
+night, and if there is anyone moving I am pretty sure to hear him."
+
+The Squire turned down the lamp, drew the curtains, and seated
+himself by the fire. It was three quarters of an hour before Mark
+returned. He shut the window, and fastened it carefully.
+
+"I fancy you must have been mistaken, Mark."
+
+"I suppose that shot through the window has made me nervous.
+I certainly did fancy I heard a noise there; it may have been a
+dead bough snapping, or something of that sort; and of course, the
+window being partly open, even though only three or four inches,
+any little noise would come in more plainly than it otherwise would
+do. However, everything has been perfectly quiet since I went out,
+and it is hardly likely indeed that the fellow would have returned
+so soon after the hot chase I gave him."
+
+"It is very stupid--the window being left open," the Squire said.
+"I shall question Martha about it in the morning; it was her duty
+to see that it was shut and fastened before drawing the curtains.
+Just at present one can scarcely be too careful. I don't mean
+to deny that whether there was a window open or not a burglar who
+wanted to get into the house could do so, still there is no use
+in making their work more easy for them. I know, as a rule, we are
+careless about such things; there has not been a burglary in this
+part for years, and until lately the front door has never been
+locked at night, and anyone could have walked in who wanted to. Of
+course the servants don't know that there is any reason for being
+more careful at present than usual.
+
+"I was thinking the other day of having shutters put to all these
+downstair rooms. Some of them have got them, and some have not;
+still, even with shutters, burglars can always get in if they want
+to do so. They have only to cut round the lock of a door or to make
+a hole in a panel to give them room to put an arm through and draw
+back a bolt, and the thing is done. I know that all the silver is
+locked up every night in the safe, for Ramoo sees to that, and I
+have never known him neglect anything under his charge. Well, Mark,
+I don't know that it is any use sitting up longer, we have plenty
+of time to talk the matter over; it is four years yet before Millicent
+comes of age, though, of course, there is nothing to prevent your
+setting out in quest of the treasure as soon as you like. Still,
+there is no hurry about it."
+
+"None whatever, father; but I don't mean to lose a day before I
+try to get on the track of that villain Bastow."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII.
+
+
+Mark was some hours before he went to sleep. The news that he had
+heard that evening was strange and startling. Full of health and
+strength, the fact that he was not, as he had always supposed, the
+heir to the estate troubled him not at all. The fact that in four
+years he would come in for some twelve thousand pounds was sufficient
+to prevent his feeling any uneasiness as to his future; and indeed
+in some respects it was not an unpleasant idea that, instead of
+being tied down to the estate, he should be able to wander at will,
+visit foreign countries, and make his own life.
+
+In one respect he was sorry. His father had in the last year hinted
+more than once that it would be a very nice arrangement if he were
+to make up a match with his ward; he had laughed, and said that
+there would be plenty of time for that yet. But the idea had been
+an agreeable one. He was very fond of Millicent--fond, perhaps;
+in a cousinly way at present; but at any rate he liked her far
+better than any of the sisters of his friends. Of course she was
+only seventeen yet, and there was plenty of time to think of marriage
+in another three years. Still, the thought occurred to him several
+times that she was budding out into a young woman, and every month
+added to her attractions. It was but the day before he had said to
+himself that there was no reason to wait as long as three years,
+especially as his father seemed anxious, and would evidently be glad
+were the match to take place. Now, of course, he said to himself,
+that was at an end. He had never given her any reason to suppose
+that he cared for her, and now that she was the heiress and he
+comparatively poor, she would naturally think that it was for the
+estate, and not for herself, that she was wooed. Then there was
+the question of this curiously lost treasure, with the mysterious
+clew that led to nothing. How on earth was he to set about the
+quest? He puzzled for a long time over this, till at last he fell
+asleep. He was roused by Ramoo entering the room.
+
+"What is it, Ramoo?"
+
+"Me not know, sahib. Massa Thorndyke's door shut. Me no able to
+make him hear."
+
+"That is curious, Ramoo," Mark said, jumping hastily out of bed.
+"I will be with you in a minute."
+
+He slipped on his trousers, coat, and slippers, and then accompanied
+Ramoo to his father's door. He knocked again and again, and each
+time more loudly, his face growing paler as he did so. Then he
+threw himself against the door, but it was solid and heavy.
+
+"Fetch me an ax, Ramoo," he said. "There is something wrong here."
+
+Ramoo returned in a short time with two men servants and with the
+ax in his hands. Mark took it, and with a few mighty blows split
+the woodwork, and then hurling himself against the door, it yielded.
+As he entered the room a cry broke from his lips. Within a pace
+or two of the bed the Squire lay on the ground, on his face, and
+a deep stain on the carpet at once showed that his death had been
+a violent one. Mark knelt by his side now, and touched him. The
+body was stiff and cold. The Squire must have been dead for some
+hours.
+
+"Murdered!" he said in a low voice; "my father has been murdered."
+
+He remained in horror struck silence for a minute or two; then he
+slowly rose to his feet.
+
+"Let us lay him on the bed," he said, and with the assistance of
+the three men he lifted and laid him there.
+
+"He has been stabbed," he murmured, pointing to a small cut in the
+middle of the deep stain, just over the heart.
+
+Ramoo, after helping to lift the Squire onto the bed, had slid down
+to the floor, and crouched there, sobbing convulsively. The two
+servants stood helpless and aghast. Mark looked round the room: the
+window was open. He walked to it. A garden ladder stood outside,
+showing how the assassin had obtained entrance. Mark stood rigid
+and silent, his hands tightly clenched, his breath coming slowly
+and heavily. At last he roused himself.
+
+"Leave things just as they are," he said to the men in a tone of
+unnatural calmness, "and fasten the door up again, and turn a table
+or something of that sort against it on the outside so that no one
+can come in. John, do you tell one of the grooms to saddle a horse
+and ride down into the town. Let him tell the head constable to
+come up at once, and also Dr. Holloway. Then he is to go on to Sir
+Charles Harris, tell him what has happened, and beg him to ride
+over at once.
+
+"Come, Ramoo," he said in a softer voice, "you can do no good here,
+poor fellow, and the room must be closed. It is a heavy loss to
+you too."
+
+The Hindoo rose slowly, the tears streaming down his face.
+
+"He was a good master," he said, "and I loved him just as I loved
+the Colonel, sahib. Ramoo would have given his life for him."
+
+With his hand upon Ramoo's shoulder, Mark left the room; he passed
+a group of women huddled together with blanched faces, at a short
+distance down the passage, the news that the Squire's door could
+not be opened and the sounds made by its being broken in having
+called them together. Mark could not speak. He silently shook his
+head and passed on. As he reached his room he heard shrieks and
+cries behind him, as the men informed them of what had taken place.
+On reaching his door, the one opposite opened, and Mrs. Cunningham
+in a dressing gown came out.
+
+"What is the matter, Mark, and what are these cries about?"
+
+"A dreadful thing has happened, Mrs. Cunningham; my father has been
+murdered in the night. Please tell Millicent."
+
+Then he closed the door behind him, threw himself on his bed, and
+burst into a passion of tears. The Squire had been a good father
+to him, and had made him his friend and companion--a treatment
+rare indeed at a time when few sons would think of sitting down
+in their father's presence until told to do so. Since he had left
+school, eight years before, they had been very much together. For
+the last two or three years Mark had been a good deal out, but in
+this his father had encouraged him.
+
+"I like to see you make your own friends, Mark, and go your own
+way," he used to say; "it is as bad for a lad to be tied to his
+father's coattail as at his mother's apron string. Get fresh ideas
+and form your own opinions. It will do for you what a public school
+would have done; make you self reliant, and independent."
+
+Still, of course, a great portion of his time had been with his
+father, and they often would ride round the estate together and
+talk to the tenants, or walk in the gardens and forcing houses.
+Generally Mark would be driven by his father to the meet if it took
+place within reasonable distance, his horse being sent on beforehand
+by a groom, while of an evening they would sit in the library,
+smoke their long pipes, and talk over politics or the American and
+French wars.
+
+All this was over. There was but one thing now that he could do for
+his father, and that was to revenge his death, and at the thought
+he rose from his bed impatiently and paced up and down the room.
+He must wait for a week, wait till the funeral was over, and then
+he would be on Bastow's track. If all other plans failed he would
+spend his time in coaches until at last the villain should try to
+stop one; but there must be other ways. Could he find no other he
+would apply for employment as a Bow Street runner, serve for a year
+to find out their methods, and acquaint himself with the places
+where criminals were harbored. It would be the one object of his
+life, until he succeeded in laying his hand on Bastow's shoulder.
+He would not shoot him if he could help it. He should prefer to see
+him in the dock, to hear the sentence passed on him, and to see it
+carried out. As to the treasure, it was not worth a thought till
+his first duty was discharged.
+
+Presently a servant brought him a cup of tea. He drank it mechanically,
+and then proceeded to dress himself. Sir Charles Harris would be
+here soon and the others; indeed, he had scarcely finished when he
+was told that the doctor from Reigate had just arrived, and that
+the constable had come up half an hour before. He at once went down
+to the library, into which the doctor had been shown.
+
+"You have heard what has happened," he said, as he shook hands
+silently. "I expect Sir Charles Harris here in half an hour. I
+suppose you will not go up till then?"
+
+"No, I think it will be best that no one should go in until he comes.
+I have been speaking to Simeox; he was going in, but I told him I
+thought it was better to wait. I may as well take the opportunity
+of going upstairs to see Mr. Bastow. I hear that he fainted when
+he heard the news, and that he is completely prostrate."
+
+"Two such shocks might well prove fatal to him," Mark said; "he
+has been weak and ailing for some time."
+
+"Two shocks?" the doctor repeated interrogatively.
+
+"Ah, I forgot you had not heard about the affair yesterday evening:
+a man fired at us through the window when we were sitting round
+the fire, before the candles were lit. The ball passed between my
+father's head and Mr. Bastow's; both had a narrow escape; the bullet
+is imbedded in the mantelpiece. I will have it cut out; it may be
+a useful item of evidence some day."
+
+"But what could have been the man's motive? Your father was
+universally popular."
+
+"Except with ill doers," Mark said. "I ran out and chased the
+fellow for half a mile, and should have caught him if he had not
+had a horse waiting for him in a lane, and he got off by the skin
+of his teeth. I hope that next time I meet him he will not be
+so lucky. Mr. Bastow was very much shaken, and went to bed soon
+afterwards. I am not surprised that this second shock should be too
+much for him. Will you go up and see him? I will speak to Simeox."
+
+The constable was out in the garden.
+
+"This is a terrible business, Mr. Thorndyke. I suppose, after what
+you told me, you have your suspicions?"
+
+"They are not suspicions at all--they are certainties. Did you
+hear that he tried to shoot my father yesterday evening?"
+
+"No, sir, I have heard nothing about it."
+
+Mark repeated the story of the attempt and pursuit.
+
+"Could you swear to him,' Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"No, there was not much light left; besides, as I have not seen
+him for the last eight years, I should certainly not be able to
+recognize him unless I had time to have a good look at him. Had it
+only been last night's affair it might have been anyone; but the
+shooting through the window was not the act of a thief, but of an
+assassin, who could only have been influenced by private enmity. I
+quite see that at present I have no legal evidence against. Bastow;
+I am not even in a position to prove that he is in the country,
+for it cannot be said that my father's belief that he recognized
+the voice of the man who said 'Stand and deliver!' is proof. I
+doubt if anyone could swear that, when he only heard three words,
+he was absolutely sure that it was the voice of a man he had not seen
+for some years. However, fortunately, that will make no difference;
+the man is, as I told you, wanted for his heading the mutiny in the
+convict prison at Sydney, which will be quite sufficient to hang
+him without this business. But I own that I should prefer that
+he were hung for my father's murder if we could secure sufficient
+evidence. Moreover, there is the attack upon us three or four
+months ago, and with the evidence of the surgeon who attended him
+as to his wound, that would be enough to hang him. But we have first
+got to catch him, and that I mean to make my business, however long
+the search may take me."
+
+"Was anything taken last night, sir?"
+
+"I don't know; I did not look. We shall see to that when we go
+upstairs. We may as well go indoors now; Sir Charles may be here
+in a few minutes, and I want to hear Dr. Holloway's report as to
+Mr. Bastow."
+
+"He does not suspect, I hope, sir?"
+
+"No, thank God; my father never mentioned to him anything he
+heard about his son, or his suspicions, therefore he has no reason
+to believe that the fellow is not still in the convict prison at
+Sydney. We shall keep it from him now, whatever happens; but it
+would, for his sake, be best that this shock should prove too much
+for him. He has had a very hard time of it altogether."
+
+"He is terribly prostrate," the doctor reported when Mark joined him.
+"I don't think that he will get over it. He is scarcely conscious
+now. You see, he is an old man, and has no reserve of strength to
+fall back upon. Your father has been such a good friend to him that
+it is not surprising the news should have been too much for him.
+I examined him at the Squire's request some months ago as to his
+heart's action, which was so weak that I told the Squire then that
+he might go off at any time, and I rather wonder that he recovered
+even temporarily from the shock."
+
+In a few minutes Sir Charles Harris drove up.
+
+"This is terrible news, my dear Mark," he said, as he leaped from
+his gig and wrung Mark's hand--"terrible. I don't know when I
+have had such a shock; he was a noble fellow in all respects, a warm
+friend, an excellent magistrate, a kind landlord, good all round.
+I can scarcely believe it yet. A burglar, of course. I suppose
+he entered the house for the purpose of robbery, when your father
+awoke and jumped out of bed, there was a tussle, and the scoundrel
+killed him; at least, that is what I gather from the story that
+the groom told me."
+
+"That is near it, Sir Charles, but I firmly believe that robbery
+was not the object, but murder; for murder was attempted yesterday
+evening," and he informed the magistrate of the shot fired through
+the window.
+
+"Bless me, you don't say so!" the magistrate exclaimed. "That alters
+the case altogether, and certainly would seem to make the act one
+of premeditated murder; and yet, surely, the Squire could not have
+had an enemy. Some of the men whom we have sentenced may have felt
+a grudge against him, but surely not sufficient to lead them to a
+crime like this."
+
+"I will talk of it with you afterwards, Sir Charles. I have the
+very strongest suspicions, although no absolute proofs. Now, will
+you first come upstairs? Doctor Holloway is here and Simeox, but
+no one has entered the room since I left it; I thought it better
+that it should be left undisturbed until you came."
+
+"Quite so; we will go up at once."
+
+An examination of the room showed nothing whatever that would afford
+the slightest clew. The Squire's watch was still in the watch pocket
+at the head of the bed, his purse was on a small table beside him;
+apparently nothing had been touched in the room.
+
+"If robbery was the object," Sir Charles said gravely, "it has
+evidently not been carried out, and it is probable that Mr. Thorndyke
+was partly woke by the opening of the window, and that he was not
+thoroughly aroused until the man was close to his bed; then he
+leapt out and seized him. Probably the stab was, as Dr. Holloway
+assures us, instantly fatal, and he may have fallen so heavily that
+the man, fearing that the house would be alarmed at the sound, at
+once fled, without even waiting to snatch up the purse. The whole
+thing is so clear that it is scarcely necessary to ask any further
+questions. Of course, there must be an inquest tomorrow. I should
+like when I go down to ask the gardener where he left the ladder
+yesterday. Have you examined the ground for footmarks?"
+
+"Yes, Sir Charles, but you see it was a pretty hard frost last
+night, and I cannot find any marks at all. The ground must have
+been like iron about the time when the ladder was placed there."
+
+The gardener, on being called in, said that the ladder was always
+hung up outside the shed at the back of the house; there was a chain
+round it, and he had found that morning that one of the links had
+been filed through.
+
+"The Squire was most particular about its being locked, as Mr. Mark
+knows, so that it could not be used by any ill disposed chaps who
+might come along at night. The key of the padlock was always hung
+on a nail round the other side of the shed. The Squire knew of it,
+and so did Mr. Mark and me; so that while it was out of the way of
+the eyes of a thief, any of us could run and get it and undo the
+padlock in a minute in case of fire or anything of that sort. I
+have not used the ladder, maybe, for a fortnight, but I know that
+it was hanging in its place yesterday afternoon."
+
+"I expect the fellow was prowling about here for some time," Mark
+said. "I was chatting with my father in the library when I thought
+I heard a noise, and I threw open the window, which had by some
+carelessness been left a little open, and went out, and listened
+for nearly an hour, but I could hear nothing, and put it down to
+the fact that I was nervous owing to what had happened early in
+the evening, and that the noise was simply fancy, or that the frost
+had caused a dry branch of one of the shrubs to crack."
+
+"How was it you did not notice the window was open as you went in?"
+
+"The curtains were drawn, sir. I glanced at that when I went into
+the room with my father. After being shot at once from outside,
+it was possible that we might be again; though I own that I did
+not for a moment think that the fellow would return after the hot
+chase that I gave him. I suppose after I went in he looked about
+and found the ladder; it is likely enough that he would have had
+a file with him in case he had any bars to cut through to get into
+the house, but to my mind it is more likely that he knew where to
+find the ladder without any looking for it; it has hung there as
+long as I can remember."
+
+"Yes, sir," the gardener said, "I have worked for the Squire ever
+since he came here, and the ladder was bought a week or two after
+he took me on, and the Squire settled where it should be hung,
+so that it might be handy either in case of fire or if wanted for
+a painting job. This aint the first ladder; we got a new one four
+years ago."
+
+"It is singular that the man should have known which was the window
+of your father's room."
+
+"Very singular," Mark said.
+
+Shortly after the doctor left, and Mark had a long talk with the
+magistrate in the library, and told him his reasons for suspecting
+that the murderer was Arthur Bastow.
+
+"It certainly looks like it," the magistrate said thoughtfully, after
+he had heard Mark's story, "though of course it is only a case of
+strong suspicion, and not of legal proof. Your father's recognition
+of the voice could have scarcely been accepted as final when he
+heard but three words, still the whole thing hangs together. The
+fellow was, I should say, capable of anything. I don't know that
+I ever had a prisoner before me whose demeanor was so offensive
+and insolent, and if it can be proved that Bastow is in England I
+should certainly accept your view of the case. He would probably
+have known both where the ladder was to be found and which was the
+window of your father's bedroom."
+
+"I should certainly think that he would know it, sir. The bedroom
+was the same that my grandfather used to sleep in, and probably
+during the years before we came here young Bastow would have often
+been over the house. The first year or two after we came he was
+often up here with his father, but I know that my father took such
+an objection to him, his manner and language were so offensive,
+that he would not have me, boy as I was--I was only about eleven
+when he came here--associate with him in the smallest degree.
+But during those two years he may very well have noticed where the
+ladder was."
+
+"Do you intend to say anything about all this tomorrow at the
+inquest, Mark?"
+
+"I don't think I shall do so," Mark said moodily. "I am certain
+of it myself, but I don't think any man would convict him without
+stronger evidence than I could give. However, that business in
+Australia will be sufficient to hang him."
+
+"I think you are right, Mark. Of course, if you do light upon any
+evidence, we can bring this matter up in another court; if not,
+there will be no occasion for you to appear in it at all, but leave
+it altogether for the authorities to prove the Sydney case against
+him; it will only be necessary for the constables who got up the
+other case against him to prove his sentence, and for the reports
+of the Governor of the jail to be read. There will be no getting
+over that, and he will be hung as a matter of course. It will be
+a terrible thing for his unhappy father."
+
+"I do not think that he is likely to come to know it, sir; the shock
+of the affair yesterday and that of this morning have completely
+prostrated him, and Dr. Holloway, who was up with him before you
+arrived, thinks that there is very little chance of his recovery."
+
+When the magistrate had left, Mark sent a request to Mrs. Cunningham
+that she would come down for a few minutes. She joined him in the
+drawing room.
+
+"Thank you for coming down," he said quietly. "I wanted to ask how
+you were, and how Millicent is."
+
+"She is terribly upset. You see, the Squire was the only father
+she had ever known; and had he been really so he could not have
+been kinder. It is a grievous loss to me also, after ten years of
+happiness here; but I have had but little time to think of my own
+loss yet, I have been too occupied in soothing the poor girl. How
+are you feeling yourself, Mark?"
+
+"I don't understand myself," he said. "I don't think that anyone
+could have loved his father better than I have done; but since I
+broke down when I first went to my room I seem to have no inclination
+to give way to sorrow. I feel frozen up; my voice does not sound to
+me as if it were my own; I am able to discuss matters as calmly as
+if I were speaking of a stranger. The one thing that I feel passionately
+anxious about is to set out on the track of the assassin."
+
+"There is nothing unusual in your state of feeling, Mark. Such a
+thing as this is like a wound in battle; the shock is so great that
+for a time it numbs all pain. I have heard my husband say that a
+soldier who has had his arm carried off by a cannon ball will fall
+from the shock, and when he recovers consciousness will be ignorant
+where he has been hit. It is so with you; probably the sense of
+pain and loss will increase every day as you take it in more and
+more. As for what you say about the murderer, it will undoubtedly
+be a good thing for you to have something to employ your thoughts
+and engage all your faculties as soon as this is all over. Is there
+anything that I can do?"
+
+"No, thank you; the inquest will be held tomorrow. I have sent
+down to Chatterton to come up this afternoon to make the necessary
+preparations for the funeral. Let me see, today is Wednesday, is
+it not? I seem to have lost all account of the time."
+
+"Yes, Wednesday."
+
+"Then I suppose the funeral will he on Monday or Tuesday. If there
+is any message that you want sent down to the town, one of the
+grooms will carry it whenever you wish."
+
+"Thank you; 'tis not worth sending particularly, any time will do,
+but I shall want to send a note to Mrs. Wilson presently, asking
+her to come up the first thing tomorrow morning."
+
+"He can take it whenever, you like, Mrs. Cunningham. I have nothing
+to send down for, as far as I know. I suppose you have heard that
+the doctor thinks very badly of Mr. Bastow?"
+
+"Yes. Ramoo is sitting with him now."
+
+"Then I think, if you will write your note at once, Mrs. Cunningham,
+I will send one down to Dr. Holloway, asking him to send an experienced
+nurse. He said he should call again this afternoon, but the sooner
+a nurse comes the better."
+
+That afternoon Mark wrote a letter to the family solicitors, telling
+them of what had taken place, and stating that the funeral would
+be on the following Tuesday, and asking them to send down a clerk
+with his father's will, or if one of the partners could manage to
+come down, he should greatly prefer it, in view of the explanations
+that would be necessary. He had already sent off a letter to the
+head of the Detective Department, asking him to send down one of
+his best men as soon as possible. Then he went out into the garden,
+and walked backwards and forwards for about two hours, and then
+returned to what he thought would be a solitary meal. Mrs. Cunningham,
+however, came down. She had thoughtfully had the large dining table
+pushed on one side, and a small one placed near the fire.
+
+"I thought it would be more comfortable," she said, "as there are
+only our two selves, just to sit here."
+
+He thanked her with a look. It was a nice little dinner, and Mark,
+to his surprise, ate it with an appetite. Except the cup of tea
+that he had taken in the morning, and a glass of wine at midday,
+he had touched nothing. Mrs. Cunningham was a woman of great tact,
+and by making him talk of the steps that he intended to take to
+hunt down the assassin, kept him from thinking.
+
+"Thank you very much, Mrs. Cunningham," he said, when the dinner
+was over. "I feel very much better."
+
+"I have brought down my work," she said, "and will sit here while
+you drink your wine and smoke a pipe. Millicent has gone to bed,
+completely worn out, and it will be pleasanter for us both to sit
+here than to be alone."
+
+Mark gladly agreed to the proposal. She turned the conversation
+now to India, and talked of her life there.
+
+"I was not out there very long," she said. "I was engaged to my
+husband when he first went out, and six years afterwards joined
+him there, and we were married. Your uncle, who was a major of
+his regiment, gave me away. My husband got his company six months
+afterwards, and was killed three years later. My pension as his widow
+was not a large one, and when your uncle offered me the charge of
+his daughter I was very glad to accept it. He gave some idea of
+his plans for her. I thought they were very foolish, but when I saw
+that his mind was thoroughly made up I did not attempt to dissuade
+him. He said that when he came home to England (and he had no
+idea when that would be) he should have me here, as head of his
+establishment, and it would be given out that the child was his
+ward. I hoped that he would alter his mind later on, but, as you
+know, he never did."
+
+"Well, of course, she will have to be told now," Mark said.
+
+"Do you think so? It seems to me that it were better that she would
+go as she is, at any rate, until she is twenty-one."
+
+"That would be quite impossible," Mark said decidedly. "How could
+I assume the position of master here? And even if I could, it would
+be a strange thing indeed for me to be here with a girl the age of
+my cousin, even with you as chaperon. You must see yourself that
+it would be quite impossible."
+
+"But how could she live here by herself?"
+
+"I don't think she could live here by herself," Mark said,
+"especially after what has happened. Of course, it has all got to
+be talked over, but my idea is that the place had better be shut
+up, and that you should take, in your own name, a house in London.
+I suppose she will want masters for the harp, and so on. For a time,
+at any rate, that would be the best plan, unless you would prefer
+some other place to London. We have done our best to carry out my
+uncle's wishes, but circumstances have been too strong for us, and
+it cannot be kept up any longer; but there is no reason, if you
+and she prefer it, why she should not be known, until you return
+here, by her present name. Of course the affair will create a
+great deal of talk down here, but in London no one will know that
+Millicent is an heiress, though it is hardly likely that you will
+make many acquaintances for a time."
+
+"Have you known it long, Mark? I thought that you were kept in
+ignorance of it."
+
+"I only heard it yesterday evening, Mrs. Cunningham; after that
+shot through the window my father thought I ought to know all about
+it, for the attempt might be repeated more successfully. He told
+me all about her, and about the treasure."
+
+"What treasure?" Mrs. Cunningham said. "I don't know what you mean."
+
+He then told her of the story his uncle had related, and how he
+had been prevented from giving full instructions for its discovery,
+the only clew being a gold coin and the word Masulipatam, and
+that this treasure had been left equally divided between him and
+Millicent by his will.
+
+"He told me that he should provide for you," Mrs. Cunningham remarked,
+"when I said that it would be unfair that you should be brought up
+believing yourself the heir. I never heard any more about it, but
+I am glad that it is so."
+
+"I fancy the chance of its coming to either of us is very small,"
+Mark said; "a coin and a word are not much to go upon. I have not
+the most remote idea what they mean, and whether the treasure is
+in England or in India, Heaven only knows."
+
+"Possibly, when he made the will, he may have told the solicitors
+where it was, and instructed them to keep it secret until the time
+that Millicent came into possession of the estate."
+
+"It is just possible he did so, Mrs. Cunningham, but the efforts
+he made to speak at the last moment would almost seem to show that
+he had not told them, for, if he had, the matter would have been
+of no vital importance one way or the other. Will Millicent be well
+enough to come down in the morning?"
+
+"I hope so."
+
+"I hope so, too; but, at any rate, keep her up in her room till the
+afternoon. The inquest will be at eleven o'clock, and it is better
+that she should not come down until everyone has gone away."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX.
+
+
+Directly after breakfast was over the next morning the Rector came
+in.
+
+"I would not come in yesterday, Mark," he said. "I knew that you
+would be best alone; and, indeed, I was myself so terribly upset
+by the news that I did not feel equal to it. I need not say how
+deeply I and my wife sympathize with you. Never did a kinder heart
+beat than your father's; never have I seen people so universally
+grieved as they are in the village. I doubt whether a man went to
+work yesterday, and as for the women, had it been a father they
+had lost they could not be more affected."
+
+"Yes, he will be greatly missed," Mark said unsteadily; "and, between
+ourselves--but this must go no further--I have a suspicion,
+amounting almost to a certainty, that the hand that dealt this blow
+is the same that caused the vacancy that brought you here."
+
+"Do you mean Arthur Bastow?" Mr. Greg said in amazement. "Why, I
+thought that he was transported for fifteen years."
+
+Then Mark told the Rector the inner history of the past six months,
+and of the report they had had from the officer at Bow Street of
+the personal appearance of the wounded man.
+
+"Other things are in favor of it," he went on. "My father's watch
+and purse were untouched, and a stranger on a dark night would be
+hardly likely to have discovered the ladder, or to have had a file
+in his pocket with which to cut through a link, though this might
+have been part of the apparatus of any burglar. Then, again, an
+ordinary man would hardly have known which was my father's bedroom,
+except, indeed, that he saw the light there after those in the
+ladies' rooms were extinguished; but, at any rate, he could not
+have told which was my father's and which was mine. But all this
+is, as I said, Mr. Greg, quite between ourselves. I had a long
+talk yesterday with Sir Charles Harris, and, as he said, there is
+no legal proof whatever, strong as the suspicion is; so I am going
+to say nothing on the subject at the inquest. The scoundrel's poor
+father is dying, happily in ignorance of all this. Dr. Holloway
+was up with him all night, and told me this morning before he drove
+off that it is very unlikely that he will get through the day."
+
+"It is all very terrible, Mark; but I cannot deny that everything
+points to the man. Surely no one else could have cut short so useful
+a life, for certainly no ordinary degree of hatred would drive a
+man, however brutal his nature, to commit such a crime, and to run
+the risk of hanging for it. Let us take a brisk walk in the garden
+for an hour--that will be the best thing for you. I will stop
+with you until the inquest is over, and then you had better come
+over and have lunch with us."
+
+"Thank you; I cannot do so," Mark said, "though I should like to.
+In the first place, Millicent will come downstairs this afternoon,
+and I should like to be in to meet her. Had it not been for that
+I might have come, as I can walk across the fields to the Rectory
+without passing through the village. There is another reason. I
+sent up yesterday by the coach a letter to be delivered at once by
+hand, and I expect a detective down here by one o'clock. I don't
+know that he will do any good; but at the same time it will give
+me something to do, and at present there is nothing I dread so much
+as sitting alone. Fortunately, yesterday evening Millicent went
+to bed at five o'clock, and Mrs. Cunningham sat with me all the
+evening, and her talk did me a great deal of good."
+
+The inquest occupied a very short time, the only point on which
+many questions were asked being as to the firing through the window.
+Mark stated that it was already so dark that although he was within
+fifty yards of the man when he mounted and rode off, he could not
+give any very distinct description of his figure. It struck him as
+being that of a man of medium height.
+
+"You have made out that the bullet was intended for pour father?"
+
+"I cannot say that, sir, it went between his head and that of Mr.
+Bastow, but it might have been meant for either."
+
+"Was your father impressed with the idea that it was an attempt to
+murder him?"
+
+"He naturally thought so. Mr. Bastow can assuredly have no enemies,
+while my father, as a magistrate, may have made some. He certainly
+thought it was an attempt to murder him, and was so impressed by
+the fact that when we went to the library later on he went into
+certain family matters with me that he had never communicated before,
+and which, had it not been for this, he would not have entered into
+for some years to come."
+
+"He had his opinion, then, as to who was his assailant?"
+
+"He had, sir, but as it was but an opinion, although there were
+several facts that seemed to justify the conviction, there was no
+proof whatever, and therefore I do not think myself justified in
+saying what that opinion was."
+
+"Do you entertain the same opinion yourself?"
+
+"I do," Mark said emphatically; "but until I can obtain some evidence
+in support of what is really but a matter of opinion, and because,
+were I to give the name, it would lessen my chance of obtaining
+such evidence, I decline to mention the name."
+
+"You have no doubt that the author of the second attempt is the
+same as that of the first?"
+
+"Personally, I have no doubt whatever; it stands to reason that it
+is barely possible that two men could have, unknown to each other,
+made up their minds to murder my father on the same evening."
+
+The constable's evidence added nothing to that given by Mark. He
+had been down to the lane where the man pursued had mounted. The
+reins of the horse had apparently been thrown over a gatepost, and
+he thought it had been standing there for some little time, for
+there were marks where it had scraped the ground repeatedly. He had
+followed the marks of its hoofs for some distance; it had gone at
+a gallop for about half a mile, and then the pace had slackened
+into a trot. It continued until the lane fell into the main road,
+but beyond this he had been unable to distinguish it from the marks
+of the traffic in general.
+
+"You found no footprints whatever near the foot of the ladder, or
+anywhere else round the house?"
+
+"None whatever, sir."
+
+"There were no signs of any other window or door save that of Mr.
+Thorndyke's room being attempted?"
+
+"None at all, sir."
+
+There was but a short consultation between the jurors, who at once
+returned a verdict of "Willful murder by some person or persons
+unknown."
+
+Dr. Holloway had, after giving evidence, returned at once to Mr.
+Bastow's room. The only point of importance in his evidence was the
+statement that the wound must have been fatal at once, the heart
+itself having been penetrated. It had been inflicted by a dagger
+or a narrow bladed knife.
+
+"Do you mean that it was an unusually small dagger, Dr. Holloway?"
+
+"I should say it was a very fine dagger; not the sort of weapon that
+you would expect to find a highwayman carry, if he carried one at
+all, but rather a weapon of Spanish or Italian manufacture."
+
+"Not the sort of wound that a rapier would make?"
+
+"Yes, the wound itself might have been very well made by a light
+rapier, but there was a slight bruise on the flesh on each side of
+the wound, such a mark as might be made by the handle or guard of
+a dagger, and sufficiently plain to leave no doubt in my mind that
+it was so made."
+
+"Had the wound a downward course, or was it a straight thrust?"
+
+"A straight thrust," the doctor replied. "My idea is that the two
+men were grappling together, and that as Mr. Thorndyke was a very
+powerful man, his assailant, who probably was approaching the bed
+with the dagger in his hand, plunged it into him; had he struck
+at him I should certainly have expected the course of the wound to
+be downward, as I fancy a man very seldom thrusts straight with a
+dagger, as he would do with a rapier."
+
+When the inquest was over, Mark, going out into the hall, found
+the doctor waiting there for him.
+
+"Mr. Bastow breathed his last some ten minutes ago. I saw when I
+went up to him just before I gave my evidence that it was likely
+that he would die before I returned to the room."
+
+"I am very sorry," Mark said, "although I expected nothing else
+from what you told me: He was a very kind hearted man; no one could
+have had a kinder or more patient tutor than he was to me, while
+my father regarded him as a very dear and valued friend. I am
+expecting the undertaker here in a few minutes, and they can both
+be buried at the same time."
+
+It was late in the afternoon before Millicent came down with Mrs.
+Cunningham. The news of Mr. Bastow's death had set her tears flowing
+afresh; she had been very fond of him, and that he and the Squire
+should have been taken at once seemed almost beyond belief. She
+had, however, nerved herself to some degree of composure before she
+went down to meet Mark; but although she returned the pressure of
+his hand, she was unable for some time to speak. Mrs. Cunningham
+thought it best to speak first on the minor grief.
+
+"So Mr. Bastow has gone, Mark?"
+
+"Yes, Dr. Holloway thought very badly of him yesterday, and said
+that he had but very faint hope of his rallying. I cannot help
+thinking that it was best so. Of course, he was not a very old
+man, but he has for some years been a very feeble one, and now that
+Millicent and I have both given up our studies with him, I think
+that he would have felt that his work was done, and would have gone
+downhill very fast."
+
+"I think so, too," Mrs. Cunningham agreed. "I am sure that even had
+the Squire's death come quietly, in the course of nature, it would
+have been a terrible blow to him. He was fond of you and Millicent,
+but his affection for your father was a passion; his face always
+lit up when he spoke to him. I used to think sometimes that it was
+like an old dog with his master. It was quite touching to see them
+together. I think, Mark, with you, that it is best that it should
+be as it is."
+
+Gradually the conversation turned to other matters. Millicent was,
+however, unable to take any part in it, and half an hour later she
+held out her hand silently to Mark and left the room hurriedly.
+The next day she was better, and was able to walk for a time with
+Mark in the garden and talk more calmly about their mutual loss,
+for to her, no less than to Mark, the Squire had been a father.
+
+"'Tis strange to think that you are the Squire now, Mark," she said
+as they sat together in the dining room on the evening before the
+funeral.
+
+"You will think it stranger still, Millicent," he said, "when I
+tell you that I am not the Squire, and never shall be."
+
+She looked up in his face with wonder.
+
+"What do you mean, Mark?"
+
+"Well, dear, you will know tomorrow, as Mr. Prendergast, one of
+the family solicitors, is coming down; but I think it is as well
+to tell you beforehand. It has been a curious position all along.
+I never knew it myself till my father told me when we went into
+the library after the shot was fired. The news did not affect me
+one way or the other, although it surprised me a great deal. Like
+yourself, I have always supposed that you were my father's ward,
+the daughter of an old comrade of his brother's. Well, it is a
+curious story, Millicent. But there is no occasion for you to look
+frightened. The fact is you are my uncle's daughter and my cousin."
+
+"Oh, that is not very dreadful!" she exclaimed in a tone of relief.
+
+"Not dreadful at all," Mark said. "But you see it involves the fact
+that you are mistress of this estate, and not I."
+
+Millicent stood up suddenly with a little cry. "No, no, Mark, it
+cannot be! It would be dreadful, and I won't have it. Nothing could
+make me have it. What, to take the estate away from you when you
+have all along supposed it to be yours! How could I?"
+
+"But you see it never has been mine, my dear. Father might have
+lived another five-and-twenty years, and God knows I have never
+looked forward to succeeding him. Sit down and let me tell you the
+story. It was not my father's fault that he reigned here so long as
+master, it was the result of a whim of your father's. And although
+my father fought against it, he could not resist the dying prayer
+of my uncle."
+
+He then related the whole circumstances under which the girl had
+been brought up as Millicent Conyers, instead of Millicent Conyers
+Thorndyke, and how the estate had been left by Colonel Thorndyke's
+will to his brother until such time as Millicent should come of
+age, or marry, and how he had ordered that when that event took
+place the rest of his property in money and jewels was to be divided
+equally between Mark and herself.
+
+"It must not be, Mark," she said firmly. "You must take the estate,
+and we can divide the rest between us. What is the rest?"
+
+"To begin with," Mark said cheerfully, "there are 25,000 pounds,
+the accumulations of the rents of the estate after the death of my
+grandfather up to the time when the Colonel returned from India;
+and there are, besides, a few thousands, though I don't exactly
+know how many, that my father paid over to the solicitors as the
+surplus of the rents of the estates after paying all expenses of
+keeping up this house. He very properly considered that although
+he had accepted the situation at your father's earnest wish, he
+ought not to make money by doing so. If we put it down at 30,000
+pounds altogether, you see there is 15,000 pounds for each of us.
+A very nice sum for a young man to start life with, especially as
+I shall have my father's estate near Hastings, which brings in 500
+pounds a year; and as the rents of this have been accumulating for
+the last ten years, my share will be raised from 15,000 pounds to
+20,000 pounds. Besides this, there is the main bulk of the Colonel's
+fortune made in India. That seems to be worth about 100,000 pounds
+but I must own that the chance of getting it seems very small."
+
+"How is that, Mark?"
+
+Mark told her the whole story.
+
+"I mean to make it my business to follow the matter up," he said.
+"I think that the chance of ever finding it is very small. Still,
+it will give me an object to begin life with."
+
+"Oh, I hope that you will never find it!" she exclaimed. "From what
+you say it will be a terrible danger if you do get it."
+
+Mark smiled.
+
+"I hardly think so, Millicent. I cannot believe that people would
+be following up this thing for over fifteen years, for it was many
+years before the Colonel came home that he got possession of these
+diamonds. Even Hindoos would, I think, have got sick of such a
+hopeless affair long before this; but as they may ever since your
+father's death have been watching us, although it hardly seems
+possible, I shall follow out the Colonel's instructions, and get
+rid of those particular diamonds at once. I shall only keep them
+about me long enough to take them to Amsterdam and sell them there.
+The. Colonel said they were the finest diamonds that he ever saw,
+and that he really had no idea of what they were worth. However,
+that is for the future."
+
+"Mrs. Cunningham has known this all along, Mark?"
+
+"Not about the money affairs, but of course she knew that you were
+my cousin. She brought you from India, you see, and has known all
+along that the Colonel was your father. She knows it, and the family
+solicitors know it, but I believe no one else, except, perhaps,
+Ramoo. I am not sure .whether he was in uncle's service when
+you were sent over in Mrs. Cunningham's charge. He may know it or
+he may not, but certainly no one else does, except, as I say, the
+solicitors and myself. Possibly some other of the Colonel's old
+comrades knew that there was a child born; but if they were in
+England and happened to hear that my father had succeeded to the
+estate, they would, of course, suppose that the child had died."
+
+"Then," Millicent said, in a tone of relief, "there can be no
+reason why anyone else should know anything about it. I will see
+Mr. Prendergast when he comes down tomorrow, and beg him to say
+nothing about it; 15,000 pounds is quite enough for any girl; and
+besides, you say that my father's greatest wish was that I was not
+to be married for money, and after all the pains that have been
+taken, his wish will not be carried out if I am to be made owner
+of the estate."
+
+"You won't be able to persuade Mr. Prendergast to do that," Mark
+said, smiling. "It is his duty simply to carry out the provisions
+of your father's will, and to place you in possession of the estate;
+and if he would keep silence, which he certainly won't, you don't
+suppose that I would."
+
+"Then I shall hate you, Mark."
+
+"I don't think you will, Millicent, and I would rather that you
+did that than that you should despise me. At the present moment
+you may think that this estate would be only a burden to you, but
+some day when you marry you might see the matter in a different
+light."
+
+The girl looked at him reproachfully.
+
+"I should never think so!" she burst out. "What would you have me
+do? Live here in this great house, with only Mrs. Cunningham, while
+you are going about the world seeking for this treasure? Never!"
+
+"No, I don't think that it would be nice for you to do that,
+Millicent," Mark said. "Mrs. Cunningham and I have been talking
+it over. We thought that the best plan would be for her to take a
+house in London, and go there with you; you would have the advantages
+of good masters.
+
+"Then you were saying only a short time since that you would like
+to learn the harp and take lessons in painting. There would be
+time enough to think about what you would do with respect to this
+house afterward."
+
+"It is all horrible," Millicent said, bursting into tears, "and I
+shall always feel that I have robbed you."
+
+"But I don't feel so in the least," Mark urged. "I was not in the
+smallest degree put out when my father told me about it. I have
+always had a fancy for wandering about the world, as my uncle did,
+and doing something to distinguish myself, instead of settling
+down for life to be a country magistrate and a squire. Of course
+it came as a surprise, but I can assure you that it was not an
+altogether unpleasant one. What can a man want more than a nice
+little estate of 500 pounds a year and 20,000 pounds in money?"
+
+"It is all very well to say that, but as you said to me just now,
+you may see it in a different light some day."
+
+Then she sat thinking for some time. "At any rate," she went on
+at last, "I don't see why anyone should know about it now. If the
+house is to be shut up and you are going away, why need anyone
+know anything about it? My father's wish was that I should not have
+people making love to me just because I was an heiress; after all
+that has been done, it would be wicked to go against his wishes.
+I suppose the interest of this 15,000 pounds would be enough for
+Mrs. Cunningham and I to live comfortably on in London?"
+
+"Yes," Mark said; "it will, at 5 per cent, bring in 750 pounds a
+year."
+
+"Then I shall remain Millicent Conyers to the world. There is
+nothing to prevent that, is there?" she said almost defiantly.
+
+"No," he replied thoughtfully. "The rents of this estate might
+accumulate. I suppose the solicitors would see after that; and as
+I shall be away it will, of course, make no difference to me. Were
+I to stay in the neighborhood I could not consent to live as my
+father did, in a false position; but even then I might give out that
+the property had only been left to my father during his lifetime,
+and that it had now gone elsewhere, without saying whom it had gone
+to. However, as I shall be away there will be no occasion even
+for that. When the will is read there will be no one present but
+ourselves, and I don't see why its contents should not be kept a
+secret for a time; at any rate, we can ask Mr. Prendergast's opinion
+upon that subject."
+
+At this moment, Mrs. Cunningham coming into the room, Millicent
+ran to her and threw her arms round her neck.
+
+"He has made me most miserable," she said. "I thought I could not
+have been more miserable than I was before he told me all about
+it."
+
+"I knew that he was going to do so, and I was quite sure that you
+would not be pleased at the news. I have all along thought that
+it was a mistake on the part of your father; but as it was his
+decision, and not mine, I only had to carry out his wishes."
+
+"It is cruel," Millicent sobbed. "I don't mean it is cruel of my
+father; of course he could not have known, and he thought he was
+doing the best thing for my happiness, but it has all turned out
+wrong."
+
+"For the present you may think so, dear; but you must remember that
+up to the present time it has turned out well. I know that your
+uncle did not like it at first, but I think that he passed ten
+happy years here. It gave him a great power for doing good, and
+he worthily availed himself of it. We have all spent a happy time;
+he was universally liked and respected. I think all of us have
+benefited by it. It would not have been half as pleasant if it had
+been known that you, my child, were the real owner of the estate,
+and he was acting merely as your guardian. Let us hope that everything
+will turn out as well in future. Colonel Thorndyke told me that he
+had left a considerable sum in addition to the estates, and that
+this was to be divided between you and Mark; so you see your cousin
+will not go out into the world a beggar."
+
+"It is most of it lost," Millicent said with an hysterical laugh.
+"It is all hidden away, and no one can find it; everything has gone
+wrong together."
+
+"Well, I think, dear, that you had better go up to bed. I will go
+with you. At the present time this, of course, has come upon you
+as an additional shock. I would gladly have shielded you from it
+for a time if I could have done so, but you must have learned it
+tomorrow, and I quite agree with Mark that is was better that he
+should tell you this evening. I sent down to the town today to the
+doctor's and asked him to send me up a soothing draught, thinking
+that you might be upset by the news. I hope by the morning you will
+be able to look at matters more calmly."
+
+Some time later Mrs. Cunningham came down again.
+
+"She has cried herself to sleep," she said. "She is much grieved
+about this money being lost."
+
+"It is annoying; still I cannot help thinking that the Colonel
+must have taken some such precaution to prevent the treasure from
+being lost."
+
+"One would certainly think so," Mrs. Cunningham agreed; "the Colonel
+seemed to me a methodical man. I know that he had the reputation
+of being one of the most particular men in the service as to all
+petty details. His instructions to me before I left him were all very
+minute, and he gave me a sealed packet which he told me contained
+instructions and a copy of the register of his marriage and of
+Millicent's birth, and he said that in case of his death I was to
+take it to your father. He said that there was a letter inclosed
+in it to him, and also a copy of his will. The letter was directed
+to your father, and not to me. I handed it over to him when he asked
+me to come here. He told me afterwards that the letter contained
+the request that his brother lived to make personally to him--
+that the child should be brought up as his ward; and that he had
+handed the certificates to a lawyer, who had, however, received
+copies of them from the Colonel himself before he went down to see
+your father. So, as he took these precautions to insure his wishes
+being carried out in the event of his sudden death, I should think
+that he must have done something of the sort with regard to this
+treasure."
+
+"I should think that extremely likely, Mrs. Cunningham. I certainly
+had not thought of that before, and I hope that for Millicent's
+sake and my own it may turn out to be so. I can get on extremely
+well without it, but at the same time I don't pretend that 50,000
+pounds are to be despised."
+
+The next morning Mr. Prendergast, who had arrived at Reigate late
+the evening before, and had put up at an inn, came up to the house
+an hour before the time named for the funeral. He learned from
+Mark that he had already acquainted Millicent with her change of
+circumstances. A few minutes after he arrived, a servant told him
+that Miss Conyers would be glad if he would see her alone for a
+few minutes in the drawing room. Mark had already prepared him for
+her request.
+
+"Mark has told you that he told me about this hateful thing last
+night, I suppose, Mr. Prendergast?"
+
+"He has," the old lawyer said kindly; "and he tells me also that
+you are not at all pleased at the news."
+
+"Pleased! I should think not, Mr. Prendergast," she said indignantly.
+"I am not going to rob my cousin of what he has always been taught
+to think as his inheritance. It is abominable, I call it, and most
+unnatural."
+
+"But, my dear young lady, it is yours, and not his. I do not wish
+to discuss whether the arrangement was altogether a wise one, but
+I think that so far it has turned out well for all parties. Your
+estate has profited greatly by the management of your uncle, the
+tenants and all connected with it have benefited greatly, he himself
+has had active employment afforded him, of which he was fond. Your
+cousin has, I believe, enjoyed the advantages of the position,
+and has become acquainted with the best people in this part of the
+country, and will now obtain the benefit of something like 15,000
+pounds--a comfortable little sum, especially as he inherits, I
+believe, his father's property in Sussex. You yourself will have
+obtained what I cannot but consider the advantage of having been
+brought up without knowing that you were an heiress, and therefore
+without being spoiled, which is, in my opinion, the case with many
+young ladies in such a condition; therefore I cannot but think
+that, if unwise in its conception, the matter has so far worked out
+well. I am bound to say that Mr. Mark Thorndyke has been speaking
+to me very handsomely on the subject, and that he appears in no
+way disappointed at finding that you are the heiress of the estate,
+and is really concerned only at your unwillingness to accept the
+situation."
+
+"I wanted to know, Mr. Prendergast," she said, but in a tone that
+showed she was convinced by his manner that her request would be
+refused, "if you could arrange so that things would not be disturbed,
+and he should come into possession as his father's heir in the
+natural way."
+
+"But you see he is not his father's heir, Miss Thorndyke. His
+father only had the use, as we call it, of the property until you
+came of age, or marriage; it was not necessary for it to come to you
+on your coming of age, but only, as your father explained to me,
+in the event of your marriage; that is to say, it was not to become
+public that you were entitled to the estate until your marriage.
+If you married before you were twenty-one the property was then
+to come to you. If you did not your were to be informed of the
+circumstances or not, as Mr. Thorndyke might decide was best, but
+you were not to come into the property until you married. Your cousin
+was also to be informed when you came to the age of twenty-one,
+and as at that time he was to take his half share of the remainder
+of the property, he would then be able to arrange his life as he
+liked. If your uncle died, as unfortunately he has done, before
+you reached the age of twenty-one, you would then be placed in your
+proper position; but your father desired us to say to you that it
+was his wish, that if it could be arranged, your having succeeded
+to the ownership should not be publicly known until you divulged
+it to your husband after marriage. The other portions of the will
+must be carried out. This being only a request, you are at liberty
+to follow it or not as you may choose."
+
+"Certainly I should choose," the girl said. "After all this trouble
+to prevent my being run after as an heiress, it would be wicked
+to upset it all and to fly in the face of his wishes by setting up
+as mistress of this estate. Still you understand, Mr. Prendergast,
+that I don't mean to take it."
+
+The lawyer smiled indulgently. "There is one way in which it might
+be managed," he said. "Perhaps you can guess what it is?"
+
+A flush of color rose over the girl's face. "Don't say it, I beg
+of you, Mr. Prendergast. Mrs. Cunningham hinted at it this morning,
+and I told her that my own wish entirely agreed with that of my
+father, and that I was determined not to be married for money; and
+I am quite sure that Mark would be as unwilling as I am that the
+estate should change hands in that way. No, Mr. Prendergast, you
+must find some other way of doing it than that. Surely an estate
+cannot be forced upon anyone who is determined not to take it."
+
+"Well, we must think it over," Mr. Prendergast said quietly. "And
+now I think that it is time for me to join the others."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X.
+
+
+The funeral of Squire Thorndyke and Mr. Bastow was over, and all
+agreed they had never seen a more affecting spectacle than that at
+the churchyard when the two coffins were brought in. The distance
+was short, and the tenants had requested leave to carry the Squire's
+bier, while that of Mr. Bastow was borne by the villagers who had
+known and loved him. Behind followed all the magistrates and a great
+number of the gentry for miles round; the churchyard was crowded
+by every man, woman, and child in the village, and the women, as
+well as many of the men, wept unrestrainedly as the coffins passed
+by. Besides these, a large number of people from Reigate and the
+surrounding villages were present, attracted rather by the crime
+that had caused the death than by the loss of the Squire himself.
+The church was crowded, and it was with difficulty that Mr. Greg
+read the service. The Squire was laid by the side of his father,
+Mr. Bastow in the spot where many of his predecessors had slept
+before him.
+
+Mark had been greatly affected, not only by his own loss, but by
+the sight of the general grief among those for whom the Squire had
+done so much. Even Mr. Prendergast, who had taken part in many such
+functions over departed clients, was much moved by the scene.
+
+"I have been at many funerals," he said to Mark as they walked
+back to the Hall, "but I never have been at one that so affected
+me. No monument ever raised, sir, did such credit to him who was
+laid beneath it as the tears of those simple villagers."
+
+Mark did not reply; his heart was altogether too full to speak. As
+they entered the house he said, "The ladies will have their lunch
+upstairs, Mr. Prendergast; we may as well have ours at once, and
+then you can call them down if there is any business to be done."
+
+"That will not take long," the lawyer said. "I have brought down
+the wills of both your uncle the Colonel, and your father, and I
+think that it would be as well for me to read them both. That of
+your father is a very short and simple document, extending, indeed,
+only over a few lines. Your uncle's is longer and more complicated,
+but as you are well aware of the gist of it, it will take us but
+a short time to get through it."
+
+Mark took his meal in a perfunctory manner. For himself he would
+have eaten nothing, but he made an effort to do so in order to keep
+his guest company. When it was over he said:
+
+"We may as well go into the library at once, and I will send up
+for the ladies. It is as well to lose no time, for I know that you
+want to catch the afternoon coach up to town."
+
+Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent joined them in a minute or two, the
+girl looking very pale in her deep mourning.
+
+"I am about," Mr. Prendergast said quietly, "to read the wills of
+Colonel Thorndyke and Mr. John Thorndyke, and I will ask you, if
+there is any phrase that you do not understand, to stop me, and I
+will explain to you its purport."
+
+The three persons present were acquainted with the main provisions
+of the Colonel's will. It began by stating that, being determined
+that his daughter, Millicent Conyers Thorndyke, should not be
+married for her money, he hereby bequeathed to his brother, John
+Thorndyke, his estate in the parish of Crowswood, to be held by him
+until his daughter Millicent came to the age of twenty-one, or was
+married; if that marriage did not take place until she was over the
+age of twenty-one, so long was it to continue in John Thorndyke's
+possession, save and except that she was, on attaining the age of
+twenty-one, to receive from it an income of 250 pounds a year for
+her private use and disposal.
+
+"To Jane Cunningham, the widow of the late Captain Charles
+Cunningham, of the 10th Madras Native Infantry, should she remain
+with my daughter until the marriage of the latter, I bequeath an
+annuity of 150 pounds per annum, chargeable on the estate, and to
+commence at my daughter's marriage. All my other property in moneys,
+investments, jewels, and chattels of all sorts, is to be divided in
+equal portions between my daughter, Millicent Conyers Thorndyke, and
+my nephew, Mark Thorndyke. Should, however, my daughter die before
+marriage, I bequeath the said estate in the parish of Crowswood
+to my brother, John Thorndyke, for his life, and after him to his
+son Mark, and to the latter the whole of my other property of all
+kinds, this to take effect on the death of my daughter. Should my
+brother predecease the marriage or coming of age of my daughter, she
+is at once to come into possession of the said estate of Crowswood.
+In which case my nephew Mark and Mr. James Prendergast, of the
+firm of Hopwood & Prendergast, my solicitors, are to act as her
+trustees, and Mrs. Jane Cunningham and the said James Prendergast
+as her guardians."
+
+All this was, of course, expressed in the usual legal language,
+but the purport was clear to those previously acquainted with its
+bearing, the only item that was new to them being the legacy to
+Mrs. Cunningham. John Thorndyke's testament was a short one. He left
+all his property to his son Mark, with the exception of a hundred
+pounds to his niece to buy a mourning ring or brooch or other
+ornament in memory of him, and fifty pounds to Mrs. Cunningham for
+a similar purpose, as a token of his great esteem for her character,
+and 200 pounds to Ramoo for his faithful services to his brother and
+himself. When the lawyer had folded up the wills Millicent said:
+
+"On my part, I have to say that I absolutely renounce the legacy
+of the estate in favor of my cousin Mark, who has always believed
+that it would be his."
+
+"And I as absolutely refuse to accept the sacrifice," Mark said.
+
+"My dear young lady," Mr. Prendergast said quietly, "at present,
+at any rate, you have no power whatever to take any action in the
+matter; you are, in the eye of the law, an infant, and until you
+come of age you have no power to execute any legal document whatever.
+Therefore you must perforce remain mistress of the estate until you
+attain the age of twenty-one. Many things may happen before that
+time; for example, you might marry, and in that case your husband
+would have a voice in the matter; you might die, in which case Mr.
+Mark Thorndyke would, without any effort on your part, come into
+possession of the estate. But, at any rate, until you reach the age
+of twenty-one your trustees will collect the rents of the estate
+on your behalf, and will hold the monies in trust for you, making,
+of course, such payments for your support and maintenance as are
+fit and proper for your condition."
+
+The tears came into Millicent's eyes as she resumed the seat from
+which she had risen, and she did not utter another word until Mr.
+Prendergast rose to leave.
+
+"I shall doubtless learn your wishes as to the future, Miss Thorndyke,
+from your cousin," he said. "I hope that you will not cherish any
+malice against me, and that when you think it over you will come
+to the conclusion that second thoughts are sometimes the wisest,
+and also that you should have some consideration for your father's
+wishes in a matter of this kind. He worked hard and risked his
+life to build up the fortune that he has left. He evidently thought
+greatly of your welfare, and was, above all things, anxious to
+insure your happiness. I am sure that on thinking it over you will
+see that you should not thwart his wishes."
+
+"My dear boy," he said to Mark, as they stood on the doorstep
+waiting for the carriage to come round, "the best plan by far in
+this business would be for the interests of your cousin and yourself
+to be identical. She is a very charming young lady, a little
+headstrong in this matter, perhaps, but I do not think that that
+is altogether unnatural."
+
+"That might have come about if it had not been for the property,
+Mr. Prendergast," Mark said, "but it cannot be now. If she and I
+had been engaged before all this happened the case would have been
+different; but you see yourself that now my lips are sealed, for
+it would seem as if I had not cared for her until she turned out
+to be an heiress."
+
+"You are a silly young couple," the lawyer said. "I can only hope
+that as you grow older you will grow wiser. Well, you had better
+come up and have a talk with me about the assets your uncle mentions
+in his will."
+
+"Then you don't know anything about them, sir?"
+
+"Nothing at all, except as to the accumulations in his absence. He
+mentioned vaguely that he was a wealthy man. I thought that, as a
+matter of course, he had told his brother all about it."
+
+"It is a curious business, sir, and I doubt if there will ever be
+anything besides the accumulations you speak of."
+
+"Bless me, you don't say so! Well, well, I always thought that it
+was the most foolish business that I ever heard of. However, you
+shall tell me all about it when you come up. I shall miss my coach
+unless I start."
+
+So saying, he shook Mark's hand, took his place in the gig, and
+was driven away. Millicent did not come downstairs again that day.
+
+"She is thoroughly upset," Mrs. Cunningham said, "and it would be
+best to let her have her own way for a time. I think the sooner
+I can get her away from here the better. The house is full of sad
+memories, and I myself feel shaken and in need of a change."
+
+"I can quite understand her feeling and yours, Mrs. Cunningham. I
+do hope you will be able to disabuse her mind of the idea that I
+have any shadow of feeling of regret that she instead of I has the
+estate, and please try to work upon her on the ground of her father's
+wishes. I could see that her face changed when Mr. Prendergast
+put the matter in that light, which I do not think had occurred to
+her before. I am thinking of going up to town in a couple of days;
+I was thinking of doing so tomorrow, but a day or so will make no
+difference. I propose that you both go with me, and that I then
+help you look for a house. Even if you don't get one at once, a
+week in London will be a change, and you can then, if you like, go
+somewhere for a time. Of course Bath would be too gay at present;
+but you might go to Tunbridge Wells, or, if she would like a
+seaside place, as she has never been near the sea since she was a
+baby, that would be the greatest change for her. You might go down
+for a month or two to Dover or Hastings. There is no occasion for
+you to settle down in London for a time. There is Weymouth, too, if
+you would like it better. I believe that that is a cheerful place
+without being too fashionable."
+
+"I think that will be an excellent plan," Mrs. Cunningham said.
+
+"If you like I will drive you up to town, and the luggage can go
+by the carrier; it is more pleasant than being shut up in a coach."
+
+"Much more cheerful, of course."
+
+"You will, of course, leave many of your things here, and the packing
+them up will give her something to do, and prevent her from brooding."
+
+"I think that is an excellent idea, Mark."
+
+Late in the afternoon Ramoo came in in his usual silent manner.
+The man had said but little during the past few days, but it was
+evident that he was grieving deeply, and he looked years older than
+he had done before that fatal night.
+
+"Of course, Ramoo, you will stay with me for the present. I hardly
+know what I shall be doing for a time, but I am sure that until I
+settle down, Miss Conyers will be very glad to have you with her."
+
+"No, sahib, Ramoo will return home to India. Ramoo is getting old;
+he was thirty when he entered the service of the Colonel, sahib; he
+is fifty now; he will go home to end his days; he has saved enough
+to live in comfort, and with what the lawyer sahib told him your
+father has left him he will be a rich man among his own people."
+
+"But you will find things changed, Ramoo, since you left; while here,
+you know, we all regard you as a friend rather than as a servant."
+
+"You are all very kind and good, sahib. Ramoo knows that he will
+meet no friends like those he has here, but he longs for the bright
+sun and blue sky of India, and though it will well nigh break his
+heart to leave the young missie and you, he feels that he must go."
+
+"All right, Ramoo. We shall all be very sorry to lose you, but
+I understand your longing to go home, and I know that you always
+feel our cold winters very trying; therefore I will not oppose your
+wishes. I shall be going up to town in two or three days, and will
+arrange to pay your legacy at once, and will inquire what vessels
+are sailing."
+
+Millicent was unfeignedly sorry when she heard of Ramoo's
+determination; she was very fond of him, for when as a child she
+first arrived at Crowswood he had been her companion whenever the
+Squire did not require his services, and would accompany her about
+the garden and grounds, listening to her prattle, carrying her on
+his shoulder, and obeying her behests. No doubt he knew that she
+was the daughter of his former master, and had to a certain extent
+transferred his allegiance from the sahib, whose life he had several
+times saved, to his little daughter. Still, she agreed with Mark
+that it was perhaps best that he should go. She and Mrs. Cunningham
+would find but little occasion for his services when established in
+London, and his swarthy complexion and semi-Eastern costume would
+attract attention, and perhaps trouble, when he went abroad--the
+population being less accustomed to Orientals then than at present
+--but still less would they know what to do with him were they
+for a time to wander about. Mark said at once that so long as he
+himself was engaged in the task that he had set himself, he could
+not take Ramoo with him, and as for his staying alone in the house
+when it was only in charge of a caretaker, it was not to be thought
+of.
+
+Although not inclined at the present time to agree with Mark in
+anything, Millicent could not but acknowledge that it were best that
+Ramoo should not be urged further to reconsider his determination,
+and she also fell in with his proposal that they should go up to
+London for a week, and then go down to Weymouth for a time, after
+which they would be guided by circumstances. Accordingly, two
+days later, Mark drove Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham up to London.
+A groom accompanied them on Mark's favorite horse. This was to be
+left in town for his use, and the groom was to drive the carriage
+back again. Comfortable rooms were obtained in a quiet inn for the
+ladies, while Mark put up at the Bull, saying that he would come
+every day to take them out.
+
+"Why did not Mark stay here, Mrs. Cunningham?" Millicent asked
+pettishly.
+
+"I suppose he thought it better that he should not do so; and I
+own that I think he was right."
+
+"When we were, as we supposed, no relation to each other," Millicent
+said, "we could be like brother and sister. Now that we find that
+we are cousins we are going to be stiff and ceremonious."
+
+"Not necessarily because you are cousins, Millicent. Before, you
+were his father's ward, and under his father's care; now you are a
+young lady on your own account. You must see that the position is
+changed greatly, and that what was quite right and proper before
+would not be at all right and proper now."
+
+Millicent shrugged her shoulders.
+
+"Oh, if Mark wishes to be distant and stiff he can certainly do so
+if he likes it. It makes no matter to me."
+
+"That is not at all fair, Millicent, and very unlike yourself. Had
+not Mark suggested his going to another inn, I should have suggested
+it myself."
+
+"Oh, yes; no doubt it is better," Millicent said carelessly. "He
+has several friends in town, and of course we cannot expect him to
+be devoting himself to us."
+
+Mrs. Cunningham raised her eyebrows slightly, but made no answer.
+Millicent was seldom wayward, but at present things had gone very
+hardly with her, and her friend felt that it would be better to leave
+her entirely to herself until her humor changed. In the morning,
+when Mark came round, Millicent announced that she felt tired with
+the drive of the previous day, and would prefer staying indoors. Mark
+looked a little surprised, more at the tone than at the substance
+of the words, for the manner in which she spoke showed that the
+excuse she had given was not her only reason for not going out.
+
+"Of course, I shall stay at home too," Mrs. Cunningham said quietly,
+as he glanced toward her inquiringly. "Millicent is unnerved and
+shaken, and perhaps it is just as well for her to have a day's
+complete rest."
+
+"Very well, Mrs. Cunningham; then I will, as I cannot be of any
+use to you, set about my own business for the day. I have already
+been round to the lawyer's, and have got a check for Ramoo's legacy.
+He will be up this afternoon, and I will go round to Leadenhall
+Street and find out what ships are sailing and when they start. I
+will come in this evening for a chat."
+
+Millicent sat without speaking for some minutes after he had left
+the room. Mrs. Cunningham, whose hands were always busy, took some
+work out of a bag and set to work at it industriously. Presently
+the girl said:
+
+"What business is this that Mark is going to occupy himself in?"
+
+"I do not know much about it," she replied. "But from a few words
+which he let drop I believe that he intends to devote himself to
+discovering and hunting down your uncle's murderer."
+
+The listless expression faded out at once of Millicent's face.
+
+"But surely, Mrs. Cunningham, that will be very dangerous work."
+
+"No doubt it will be dangerous work, but I don't think that that
+is likely to hinder Mark. The man, whoever he may be, is of course
+a desperate character, and not likely to be captured without making
+a fierce struggle for it."
+
+"Then he ought to put the matter in the hands of the proper
+authorities," Millicent said decidedly. "Of course such men are
+dangerous. Very likely, this man may have accomplices, and it is
+not against one only that Mark will have to fight. He has no right
+to risk his life in so desperate an adventure."
+
+Mrs. Cunningham smiled quietly over her work. The Squire had often
+confided to her how glad he would be if these two should some day
+come together. In that case the disclosure after marriage of the
+real facts of the case would cause no disturbance or difficulty. The
+estate would be theirs, and it would not matter which had brought
+it into the partnership; she had thoroughly agreed with him, but
+so far nothing had occurred to give any ground for the belief that
+their hopes would be fulfilled.
+
+Till within the last year Millicent had been little more than a
+child; she had looked up to Mark as she might have done to a big
+brother, as something most admirable, as one whose dictum was law.
+During the last year there had been some slight change, but more,
+perhaps, on Mark's part than on hers. He had consulted her wishes
+more, had asked instead of ordered, and had begun to treat her as
+if conscious that she was fast growing up into womanhood.
+
+Millicent herself scarcely seemed to have noticed this change. She
+was little more inclined to assert herself than before, but was
+ready to accompany him whenever he wished her to do so, or to see
+him go away without complaint, when it so pleased him; but the
+last week had made a rapid change in their position. Millicent had
+sprung almost at a bound into a young woman. She had come to think
+and resolve for herself; she was becoming wayward and fanciful;
+she no longer deferred to Mark's opinion, but held her own, and was
+capable of being vexed at his decisions. At any rate, her relations
+with Mark had changed rapidly, and Mrs. Cunningham considered this
+little outburst of pettishness to be a good omen for her hopes, and
+very much better than if they had continued on their old footing
+of affectionate cousins.
+
+Mark went back again to the lawyer's, and had a long talk with Mr.
+Prendergast over the lost treasure. The old lawyer scoffed at the
+idea that there could be any danger associated with the bracelet.
+
+"Men in India, I suppose, get fanciful," he said, "and imbibe some
+of the native superstitions. The soldier who got them from the man
+who stole them was stabbed. He might have been stabbed for a thousand
+reasons, but he had the bracelet on his mind. He was forever hiding
+it and digging it up, and fancying that someone was on his track,
+and he put down the attack as being made by someone connected with
+it. His manner impressed your uncle. He concealed the diamonds or
+sent them off somewhere, instantly. He never had any further trouble
+about them, but like many men who have a craze, fancied that he was
+being perpetually watched and followed. The unfortunate result of
+all this is that these jewels and the money that he accumulated
+during his service in India seem to be lost. A more stupid affair
+I never heard of.
+
+"Now, as to the clew, any reasonable man would have given full
+instructions as to how the treasure was to be found; or if he did
+not do that, would, at least, instead of carrying about an absurd
+coin and a scrap of paper with a name upon it, have written his
+instructions and put them in that ridiculous hiding place, or,
+more wisely still, would have instructed his solicitor fully on the
+subject. The amount of trouble given by men, otherwise perfectly
+sane, by cranks and fancies is astonishing. Here is something like
+100,000 pounds lost owing to a superstitious whim. As to your chance
+of finding the treasure, I regard it as small indeed. The things
+are hidden in India, in some old tomb, or other rubbishing place.
+Your uncle may have committed them to the charge of a native; he
+may have sent them to a banker at one of the great towns; he may
+have shipped them to England. He may have sent them to the North
+Pole for anything I know. How can one begin to search the universe?"
+
+"I thought, sir, that perhaps he might have sent them to some
+London Bank or agent, with instructions to hold them until claimed
+by him, and that perhaps an inquiry among such houses would lead
+to the discovery that they hold certain property forwarded by him."
+
+"Well; there is some sense in that suggestion," Prendergast grumbled,
+"and I suppose the first thing to be done will be to carry that
+out. If you wish, we will do it for you. They would be more likely
+to give the information, if they possess it, to a well known firm of
+solicitors like ourselves than to any private individual. Besides,
+if you were to go yourself, they would in each case want you to be
+identified before they would answer any question, whereas I should
+write a note to them in the firm's name, with our compliments,
+saying that we should be glad to know if the late Colonel Thorndyke,
+of whose will we are the executors, had any account at their firm
+or has deposited any property in their hands. There are not above
+five or six banks doing business with India, and as many agents
+in a large way of business; and if he did such a foolish thing, he
+would be certain to do it with some houses of good standing--if,
+indeed, anything can be taken as certain in the case of a gentleman
+with such extraordinary fancies and plans as his."
+
+"Thank you, Mr. Prendergast," Mark said, with a slight smile at
+the lawyer's irritability; "that will be clearing the ground to
+a certain extent. If that does not succeed, I think I shall go to
+India myself, and shall there make similar inquiries at all the
+principal establishments at Calcutta and Madras. Should I fail there,
+it seems to me that the only remaining plan will be to find out
+from the military authorities the place where my uncle's regiment
+was encamped on the day--we have the date on which the jewels
+were given to him--and to institute a minute search of all the
+old ruins within such a distance as he might have reached within
+a day's ride."
+
+"But you have no certainty that it was a ruin. He might have dug
+a hole under his tent and have buried the things there; he might
+have taken a shovel and buried them in a clump of bushes a quarter
+of a mile away. The thing is more and more ridiculous the more you
+look at it."
+
+"I see it is very difficult, sir, but one might narrow it down
+somewhat if one discovered the spot. Probably there are still native
+officers in the regiment who were there at the time. If so, they
+might possibly know who was my uncle's servant at the time. The man
+may be a pensioner, and in that case I might discover his address
+through the military authorities, and I could find out from him
+whether my uncle often rode out at night, what were his habits,
+and possibly where the tent stood, and so on."
+
+"Well," Mr. Prendergast said, "if you like to undertake a wild
+goose chase of this sort it is your business, and not mine; but I
+consider the idea is the most Utopian that I ever heard of. As to
+where the tent stood, is it likely that a man would remember to
+within a hundred yards where a tent stood fourteen years ago? Why,
+you might dig up acres and acres of ground and not be sure then
+that you had hit upon the right place."
+
+"There is one other circumstance, Mr. Prendergast," Mark said
+quietly, "that has to be taken into consideration, and which renders
+it improbable that these diamonds were hidden anywhere by my uncle
+himself at that time. He certainly spoke of the whole of this
+treasure collectively. It is morally certain that he would not
+carry all these jewels that he had been collecting about with him,
+and certainly not his treasure in money. He must, therefore, have
+sent these diamonds to the person, whoever he may be, who had the
+keeping of his other jewels and of his money. This certainly points
+to a bank."
+
+"There is a sensible conjecture. Yes, there is something in that.
+He certainly could not have carried about him 50,000 pounds in gold
+and as much in jewelry; it would have been the act of a madman, and
+Colonel Thorndyke, although eccentric and cranky, was not mad. But,
+on the other hand, he may have carried about a banker's passbook,
+or what is equivalent to it, for the amount that had been deposited
+with a native banker or agent, together with a receipt for the
+box containing the jewels, and this he might have hidden with the
+diamonds."
+
+"I don't think that he would have done that; there could have been
+no object for his putting the power of demanding his money and
+valuables out of his possession."
+
+"Well, well," the lawyer said testily, "it is of no use arguing now
+what he might or might not have done. A man who would have taken
+the trouble that he did to prevent his daughter knowing that she
+was an heiress, and fancied that he was followed about by black
+fellows, might do anything, reasonable or unreasonable, under the
+sun. At any rate, Mr. Thorndyke, I will carry out your instructions
+as to inquiries in London, and will duly inform you of the result;
+beyond that I must really decline to give any advice or opinion
+upon the matter, which is altogether beyond me."
+
+On leaving the lawyer's, Mark went to Bow Street, and related to
+the chief the circumstances attending his father's murder.
+
+"I have heard them from the man I sent down at your request, Mr.
+Thorndyke, and taking the attempt early in the evening and the
+subsequent murder, there can be no doubt that the affair was one
+of revenge, and not of robbery. Had the second attempt stood alone,
+robbery might have been the object; the mere fact that nothing
+was stolen in no way alters the case. Men are often seized with a
+certain panic after committing a murder, and fly at once without
+attempting to carry out their original purpose. Your father, no
+doubt, fell heavily, and the man might well have feared that the fall
+would be heard; but the previous attempt precludes the supposition
+that robbery was at the bottom of it. It points to a case of
+revenge, and certainly goes a very long way to support the theory
+that we talked over when I last saw you, that the highwayman
+who endeavored to stop you on the road, whom you wounded, and
+who afterwards went down to Southampton, was the escaped convict,
+Bastow. Since that time I have had a man making inquiries along the
+roads between Reigate and Kingston, but altogether without success.
+I should be glad to follow up any other line that you might suggest,
+and that might offer any reasonable possibility of success, but I
+must own that at present we are entirely off the scent."
+
+"I am thinking of devoting myself entirely to the quest. I have
+no occupation at present. I have an income amply sufficient for
+my wants, and for all expenses that I may incur, and I intend to
+devote, if necessary, some years of my life to hunting this man
+down. As your men have searched without success in the country,
+I think for the present my best plan will be to devote myself to
+learning something of the ways and haunts of the criminal classes
+of London, and it is with that object that I have come to you now.
+I should like, for some time, at any rate, to enter the detective
+force as an enrolled member. I should, of course, require no
+pay, but should be prepared to obey all orders and to do any work
+required, as any other member of the corps would do. I am strong,
+active, and have, I hope, a fair share of intelligence. I should
+not mind risking my life in carrying out any duty that you might
+assign to me. I presume that I need not always be on duty, and
+could, when not required, employ my time as I liked, and keep up
+my acquaintances in town. Should it be otherwise, however, I am
+perfectly ready to submit myself in all respects to your rule. I
+have a first rate horse and should be available for country duty,
+wherever you might think fit to send me. I should not desire any
+distinction to be made between me and the paid officers."
+
+"Your proposal is an altogether novel one, Mr. Thorndyke, but it
+is worthy of consideration. I have no doubt that you would make a
+very useful officer; the work is certainly interesting, though not
+without serious hazards. However, I will think the matter over,
+and if you will call in tomorrow you shall have my answer. We are
+always glad to have a new hand in the force, for the faces of our
+men are so well known among the criminal class that they are liable
+to be detected even under the cleverest disguises. There is work,
+too, upon which it is absolutely necessary that a gentleman should
+be employed, and in the event of your joining us, I should wish
+you to keep the matter strictly from all your acquaintances; and it
+would certainly be advantageous that you should, when disengaged,
+continue to mix with your friends and to mingle in society of all
+kinds as freely as possible. There is crime among the upper classes
+as well as among the lower, though of a different type; and as Mr.
+Thorndyke of Crowswood you would have far better opportunities of
+investigating some of these cases than any of my men would have.
+You would not object to take up such cases?"
+
+"Not at all, sir; that is, if it could be arranged that I should
+not do the actual work of making an arrest, or have to appear in
+court as a witness."
+
+"That could be managed," the chief said "When you have got to a
+certain point the matter of the final arrest could always be handed
+over to someone else, but as a rule we keep our officers in the
+background as much as possible, because at every trial the court
+is half full of men of the criminal class, and the faces of our men
+would soon be known to every one of them. Well, if you will call
+about ten o'clock tomorrow you shall have my answer; but I should
+advise you to think the matter well over before you see me again.
+The responsibilities as well as the dangers are great, and indeed
+in some of the work you would literally have to carry your life in
+your hand; and I can assure you that the task you would undertake
+is by no means a light one."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI.
+
+
+Mark called that evening, as he had promised, upon Mrs. Cunningham.
+
+"I hope that you feel all the better for your day's rest, Millicent,"
+he said.
+
+The girl looked quickly at him to see if there was any sarcasm
+in the question, but it was evident that the inquiry was made in
+earnest.
+
+"Yes, I feel better now," she said. "I have dozed a good deal
+today. I did not feel up to anything. Mrs. Cunningham's work has
+progressed wonderfully. I should say that she has done more today
+than she ordinarily finds time to do in a week. What have you been
+doing with yourself?"
+
+"I have been having a long talk with Mr. Prendergast about the lost
+treasure."
+
+"And of course he said that you would never find it, Mark?"
+
+"Well, yes, he distinctly expressed that opinion."
+
+"And afterwards?"
+
+"Afterwards I went to Bow Street and had a long talk also with the
+chief officer there."
+
+"I don't like the idea of your searching for this man, Mark. In
+the first place, I don't see why you should hope to succeed when
+the men whose business it is to do such work have failed. In the
+next place, I think that you may get into serious danger."
+
+"That I must risk, Millicent. I have already proved a better shot
+than he is, and I am quite ready to take my chance if I can but come
+upon him; that is the difficult part of the matter. I know that I
+shall need patience, but I have plenty of time before me, and have
+great hopes that I shall run him to earth at last."
+
+"But you would not know him if you saw him?"
+
+"I think I should," Mark said quietly; "at least, if he is the man
+that I suspect."
+
+"Then you do suspect someone?" Mrs. Cunningham said, laying down
+her work.
+
+"Yes, I know of no reason why you should not know it now. I suspect
+--indeed, I feel morally certain--that the man who murdered my
+father was Arthur Bastow."
+
+An exclamation of surprise broke from both his hearers, and they
+listened with horror while he detailed the various grounds that he
+had for his suspicions. They were silent for some time after he had
+brought his narrative to a conclusion, then Mrs. Cunningham said:
+
+"What a merciful release for Mr. Bastow that he should have died
+before this terrible thing came out! For after what you have told
+us I can hardly doubt that you are right, and that it is this wicked
+man who is guilty."
+
+"Yes, it was indeed providential," Mark said, "though I think that,
+feeble as he has been for some months, it might have been kept from
+him. Still, a word from a chance visitor, who did not associate
+Bastow the murderer with our dear old friend, might have enlightened
+him, and the blow would have been a terrible one indeed. It is
+true that, as it was, he died from the shock, but he did not know
+the hand that struck the blow."
+
+"Now that you have told me this," Millicent said, "I cannot blame
+you, Mark, for determining to hunt the man down. It seems even
+worse than it did before; it is awful to think that anyone could
+cherish revenge like that. Now tell me how you are going to set
+about it."
+
+"I have promised the chief officer that I will tell absolutely no
+one," he said. "I have a plan, and I believe that in time it must
+be successful. I know well enough that I could tell you both of it
+without any fear of its going further, but he asked me to promise,
+and I did so without reservation; moreover, I think that for some
+reasons it is as well that even you should not know it. As it is,
+you are aware that I am going to try, and that is all. If I were
+to tell you how, you might be picturing all sorts of imaginary
+dangers and worrying yourself over it, so I think that it will
+be much the best that you should remain in ignorance, at any rate
+for a time. I can say this, that I shall for the present remain
+principally in London, and I think that I am more likely to come
+upon a clew here than elsewhere."
+
+Millicent pouted, but Mrs. Cunningham said: "I think, perhaps, that
+you are right, Mark, and it is better that we should know nothing
+about it; we shall know that you are looking for a clew, but
+of course no danger can arise until you obtain it and attempt to
+arrest him. I feel sure that you will do nothing rash, especially
+as if any harm befell you he might escape unpunished, and therefore
+that when the time comes to seize him you will obtain such help
+as may be necessary, and will, if possible, arrest him at a moment
+when resistance is impossible."
+
+"Thank you, Mrs. Cunningham; I shall certainly spare no efforts
+in taking him that way, and would far rather he met his fate on a
+gibbet than by a bullet from my pistol."
+
+"I agree with you, Mark," Millicent said; "even hanging is too good
+for such a wicked man. When are you going to set about it?"
+
+"I hope to be able to begin tomorrow," he said. "I am impatient
+to be at work, even though I know perfectly well that it may be
+months before I can get on his track. I hope to get a good deal of
+information as to the habits of men of his kind from the Bow Street
+runners, and I have an appointment tomorrow morning to see their
+chief, who will give me every assistance in his power."
+
+"Then you will not be able to take us out?" Millicent said.
+
+"I trust to do so later on, but I cannot say how long I shall be
+engaged. However, I hope to get away so as to go out with you after
+lunch, and may possibly be able to postpone my getting regularly to
+work until after you have gone, so as to be able to devote myself
+to your service."
+
+"But what sort of work? I cannot make out how you are going to
+begin."
+
+"I can tell you this much, that to begin with I shall go in company
+with a constable to various places where such a man is likely to be
+found. It will take some time to acquaint myself with all these
+localities; the next step will be to find out, if possible, if anyone
+at all answering to his description is in the habit of coming there
+occasionally, and whom he visits; another thing will be to find
+out the places where receivers of stolen goods do their business,
+and to watch those with whom highwaymen are suspected of having
+dealings. All this, you see, will entail a lot of work, and require
+a very large amount of patience. Of course, if nothing whatever
+comes of such inquiries, I shall have to try quiet places in the
+suburbs; you must remember that this fellow during his time as
+a convict must have had opportunities of getting a vast amount of
+information likely to be useful to him, such as the addresses of men
+holding positions of apparent respectability, and yet in alliance
+with thieves. You may be sure that when he returned he took every
+imaginable pains to obtain a safe place of concealment before he
+began his work; my own opinion is that I am more likely to find
+him living quietly in a suburban cottage than in a London slum."
+
+Millicent was now thoroughly interested in the search. "It seems
+a great business, Mark, but going into it as thoroughly as you are
+doing I feel sure that you will succeed. I only wish that I could
+help you; but I could not do that, could I?" she asked wistfully.
+
+He saw that she was in earnest, and suppressed all semblance of a
+smile.
+
+"I am afraid, dear, that you would be a much greater source of
+embarrassment than of assistance to me," he said gravely. "This is
+essentially not a woman's work. I believe that women are sometimes
+employed in the detection of what we may call domestic crimes, but
+this is a different matter altogether."
+
+"I suppose so," she sighed; "but it will be very hard to be taking
+our ease down at Weymouth while we know that you are, day after
+day, wearing yourself out in tramping about making inquiries."
+
+"It will be no more fatiguing than tramping through the stubble
+round Crowswood after partridges, which I should probably be doing
+now if I were down there. By the way, before you go we shall have
+to talk over the question of shutting up the house. We had too much
+to think of to go into that before we came away, and I suppose I
+shall have to run down and arrange it all, if you have quite made
+up your mind that you don't mean to return for a year or two."
+
+"Decidedly our present idea is to have a few weeks at Weymouth,
+and then when we feel braced up to come back here and look for a
+house. Where are you likely to be, Mark?" Mrs. Cunningham asked.
+
+"I shall consult with Dick Chetwynd; he knows the town thoroughly,
+and is more up here than he is down in the country; he will recommend
+me to some lodging in a street that, without being the height of
+fashion, is at least passable. I have not the least wish to become
+a regular man about town, but I should like to go into good society.
+One cannot be at work incessantly."
+
+The next morning the chief of the detective department told Mark
+that he had decided to accept his offer.
+
+"As you will receive no pay," he said, "I shall regard you as a
+sort of volunteer. For the first two or three months you will spend
+your time in going about with one or other of my men on his work.
+They will be able to put you up to disguises. When you have once
+learned to know all the thieves' quarters and the most notorious
+receivers of stolen goods, you will be able to go about your work
+on your own account. All that I require is that you shall report
+yourself here twice a day. Should I have on hand any business for
+which you may appear to me particularly well suited, I shall request
+you to at once undertake it, and from time to time, when there is
+a good deal of business on hand, I may get you to aid one of my
+men who may require an assistant in the job on which he is engaged."
+
+"I am sure I am very much obliged to you, sir," Mark said, "and
+will, I can assure you, do my best in every way to assist your men
+in any business in which they may be engaged."
+
+"When will you begin?"
+
+"It is Saturday today, sir. I think I will postpone setting to
+until Monday week. My cousin and the lady in whose charge she is
+came up with me on Thursday, and will be leaving town the end of
+next week, and I should wish to escort them about while here. I will
+come on Monday morning ready for work. How had I better be dressed?"
+
+"I should say as a countryman. A convenient character for you to
+begin with will be that of a man who, having got into a poaching
+fray, and hurt a gamekeeper, has made for London as the best hiding
+place. You are quite uncertain about your future movements, but
+you are thinking of enlisting."
+
+"Very well, sir, I will get the constable at Reigate, who knows me
+well, to send me a suit. I might find it difficult to get all the
+things I want here."
+
+Accordingly, for the next week Mark devoted himself to the ladies.
+Millicent, in her interest in the work that he was about to undertake,
+had now quite got over her fit of ill temper, and the old cordial
+relations were renewed. On the Friday he saw them into the Weymouth
+coach, then sauntered off to his friend Chetwynd's lodgings.
+
+Ramoo had already sailed. On his arrival in town he had said that
+he should, if possible, arrange to go out as a steward.
+
+"Many men of my color who have come over here with their masters
+go back in that way," he said, in answer to Mark's remonstrances.
+"It is much more comfortable that way than as a passenger. If you
+go third class, rough fellows laugh and mock; if you go second
+class, men look as much as to say, 'What is that colored fellow
+doing here? This is no place for him.' Much better go as steward;
+not very hard work; very comfortable; plenty to eat; no one laugh
+or make fun."
+
+"Well, perhaps it would be best, when one comes to think of it,
+Ramoo; but I would gladly pay your passage in any class you like."
+
+"Ramoo go his own way, sahib," he said. "No pay passage money;
+me go to docks where boats are sailing, go on board and see head
+steward. Head steward glad enough to take good servant who is willing
+to work his way out, and ask for no wages. Head steward draw wages
+for him, and put wages in his own pocket. He very well satisfied."
+
+On Wednesday he came and told Mark that he had arranged to sail in
+the Nabob, and was to go on board early the next morning. He seemed
+a great deal affected, and Mark and Millicent were equally sorry
+to part with the faithful fellow.
+
+"Well, old man," Dick Chetwynd said, when Mark entered the room,
+where he was still at breakfast, "I was beginning to wonder whether
+you had gone to Reigate. Why, when I saw you last Friday you told
+me that you would look me up in a day or two."
+
+"I have been busy showing London to Mrs. Cunningham and Miss
+Conyers," he replied--for Millicent had insisted on keeping her
+former name, at any rate for the present--and Mark was somewhat
+glad that there had been no necessity for entering into any
+explanations. It was agreed that when he went down to discharge some
+of the servants and called upon his friends he should say nothing
+of the change in his position, but should assign as a motive that
+he intended to travel about for a long time, and that he felt he
+could not settle down in the lonely house, at any rate for two or
+three years; and therefore intended to diminish the establishment.
+
+"You will have some breakfast, Mark?"
+
+"No, thank you. I breakfasted two hours ago."
+
+"Then you still keep to your intention to stay in London for a
+while?"
+
+"Yes. I don't feel that I could bear the house alone" Mark replied.
+"You see, Mrs. Cunningham and my uncle's ward could not very well
+remain in a bachelor's home, and naturally, after what has happened,
+they would not like to do so, even if they could. They have gone
+down to Weymouth for a few weeks for a complete change; and Mrs.
+Cunningham talks of taking a house in town for a time. I am going
+to look for lodgings, and I want your advice as to the quarter
+likely to suit me."
+
+"Why not take up your abode here for a time? There is a vacant
+room, and I should be very glad to have you with me."
+
+"Thank you very much, Dick, but I should prefer being alone. You
+will have friends dropping in to see you, and at present I should
+be poor company. It will be some little time before I shall feel
+equal to society."
+
+"Of course, Mark. I always speak first and think afterwards, as
+you know pretty well by this time. Well, what sort of lodgings do
+you want?"
+
+"I want them to be in a good but not in a thoroughly fashionable
+street. In time, no doubt, I shall like a little society, and shall
+get you to introduce me to some of the quieter of your friends,
+and so gradually feel my way."
+
+"I will do all that sort of thing for you, Mark. As you know, I am
+not one of those who see much fun in gambling or drinking, though
+one must play a little to be in the fashion. Still, I never go
+heavily into it. I risk a few guineas and then leave it. My own
+inclinations lie rather towards sport, and in this I can indulge
+without being out of the fashion. All the tip top people now
+patronize the ring, and I do so in my small way too. I am on good
+terms with all the principal prize fighters, and put on the gloves
+with one or other of them pretty nearly every day. I have taken
+courses of lessons regularly from four or five of them, and I can
+tell you that I can hold my own with most of the Corinthians. It
+is a grand sport, and I don't know how I should get on without it;
+after the hard exercise I was accustomed to down in the country,
+it keeps one's muscles in splendid order, and I can tell you that
+if one happens to get into a fight in the streets, it is no light
+thing to be able to polish off an antagonist in a round or two
+without getting a mark on your face that would keep you a prisoner
+in your room for a week or more."
+
+"Yes, I should like very much to take lessons too, Dick; it is one
+of the things that I have always wished to do. I suppose one can
+do it of an evening, or any time you like?"
+
+"Yes, any hour suits those fellows. You ought to get either a heavy
+middleweight or a light heavyweight; you will be a heavyweight
+yourself by the time you have filled out. Let me think; what is
+your height--six feet one, if I remember rightly?"
+
+"Yes, that is about it."
+
+"Well, with your shoulders and long reach and activity, you ought
+to be something out of the way if you take pains, Mark. You see,
+I am barely five feet ten, and am something like two stone lighter
+than you are. I suppose you are not much under twelve stone and a
+half."
+
+"That is just about my weight; I weighed at the miller's only a
+fortnight ago."
+
+"Good. I will make some inquiries, and see who would be the best
+man to take you in hand to begin with. And now about lodgings.
+Well, I should say Essex Street, or any of those streets running
+down from the Strand, would suit you. The rooms in Essex Street are
+bigger than those in Buckingham Street, and you will find anything
+between the two in some of the others. I may as well saunter round
+there with you. Of course money is no object to you?"
+
+"No," Mark agreed, "but I don't want big rooms. I think a small
+one, when you are sitting by yourself, is more cozy and comfortable."
+
+Finally two rooms were taken in Villiers Street; they were of
+moderate size and handsomely furnished: the last tenant had fitted
+them out for himself, but had lived to enjoy them only three
+months, having at the end of that time been killed in a duel over
+a quarrel at cards.
+
+"Well, I think you are in luck, Mark; you might look through a good
+many streets before you would find rooms so fashionably furnished
+as these. I see he went in for driving; that is evident from these
+engravings on the walls."
+
+"They are common, gaudy looking things," Mark said, "and quite out
+of character with the furniture."
+
+"Not at all, as times go, Mark; it is quite the thing for a man
+to have prints showing his tastes, riding or driving, shooting or
+coaching, or the ring. If you don't like them you can take them
+down, or, what will be better, take them out of their frames and
+put some of the champions past and present up there instead."
+
+"I will see about it," Mark said with a laugh. "I may turn out a
+complete failure."
+
+"There is no fear of that, Mark; and as the ring is all the fashion
+now, I can assure you it would be considered in good taste, though
+I own that in point of art most of these things leave a good deal
+to be desired. Now that that important thing is settled, suppose
+you come and lunch with me in Covent Garden? I don't belong to a
+club yet, though I have got my name down at a couple of them, but
+as far as I can see they are slow sort of places unless you know
+a lot of people. The coffee houses are much more amusing; you see
+people of all sorts there--fellows like myself, who have no clubs
+to go to; country gentlemen up for a week; a few writers, who, by
+the way, are not the best customers of these places; men whom nobody
+knows, and men whom everybody knows. Of course, the best time to
+see them is of an evening."
+
+"Yes, I have generally been in of an evening when I have been up
+in towns Dick, and I have always been amused. However, I am quite
+ready to lunch there now, for I breakfasted early."
+
+"I have to make some calls this afternoon, Mark. At seven this
+evening I will look in at your lodgings, and you shall go along with
+me to Ingleston's in St. Giles'. It is one of the headquarters of
+the fancy, and Jack Needham, who taught me, is safe to be there,
+and he will tell me who he thinks is best for you to begin with."
+
+Accordingly, after taking luncheon, they separated, and Mark went
+to his inn.
+
+Ingleston's was at that time regarded as the headquarters of the
+fancy. At the back of the house was a large room, with benches
+rising behind each other to accommodate the spectators. Here, on
+the evenings when it was known that leading men would put on the
+gloves, peers of the realm would sit side by side with sporting
+butchers, and men of fashion back their opinion on a coming prize
+fight with ex-pugilists and publicans. A number of men were assembled
+in the bar; among these was Jack Needham.
+
+"Good evening, Mr. Chetwynd," the man said as they came up to him.
+"It's going to be a good night. Tring and Bob Pratt are going to
+have a round or two together, and Gibbons will put on the gloves
+with anyone who likes to take him on."
+
+"This gentleman is Mr. Thorndyke, a squire, Jack, whose place is
+near mine at Reigate. He has come up to town for a few months, and
+wants to learn how to use his mauleys. I told him that you would
+advise him as to who would be the best man for him to go to."
+
+"I can tell you better when I have seen him strip, sir. There is no
+one in the big room at present. It won't be open for half an hour.
+Ingleston keeps it shut as long as he can so as to give everyone
+a fair chance of a good place. If the gentleman will come in there
+with me I will have a look at him."
+
+Mark expressed his willingness to be looked at, and the man having
+gone and got the key of the room from Ingleston, went in with them
+and locked the door behind.
+
+"Now, sir, if you will strip to the waist I shall be better able
+to say who you should have as your teacher than I can now."
+
+Mark stripped, and the man walked round and round him, examining
+him critically.
+
+"He's a big 'un," he said to Dick when he had completed his
+examination. "He has got plenty of muscle and frame, and ought to
+be a tremendous hitter; he is about the figure of Gibbons, and if
+he goes in for it really, ought to make well nigh as good a man, if
+not quite. I don't think Bill would care about taking him up till
+he knows a bit about it. I tell you what, sir; you will be too big
+altogether for me by the time you get to be quick on your legs,
+and to use your strength, but if you like I will take you on for
+a month or so--say, two months; by that time I think you will be
+good enough to go to Gibbons. I will just call him in if you don't
+mind; he came in just before you."
+
+In a couple of minutes he came in with a man of similar height and
+somewhat similar figure to Mark.
+
+"This is Gibbons, sir, ex-champion, and like enough he might be
+champion now if he chose; as fine a boxer as ever stripped, but he
+is ring maker now to the P. C. and it suits him better to do that
+and to teach, than to have a chance of getting a battle once a year
+or so."
+
+"Have you a great many pupils, Gibbons?"
+
+The man shook his head.
+
+"I am too big, sir; gentlemen like to learn from someone about their
+own weight, or perhaps a bit lighter, and there are not many of
+them who would care to stand up against a man who has been champion,
+and so I have plenty of time on my hands. I am a hard hitter, too,
+even with the gloves; that is one reason why Jack had best take
+you on until you get a little handy with your fists. I do more in
+the dog fancier line than I do with boxing, but there is nothing
+I like better than getting the gloves on with an amateur who is
+likely to be a credit to me. That is my card, sir; you will find
+me in pretty nearly any time of the day, and I have got a place
+behind the house where I do teaching when I get a chance. It is
+handy in one way, because you can drop in and take a lesson any
+time you like."
+
+"That would suit me exceedingly well," Mark said; "and when I have
+had a couple of months with Needham I will come to you."
+
+Mark now put on his clothes again, and they went out together, and
+re-entered a few minutes later, when the door was open. The benches
+were soon crowded. Mark had been to several prize fights with Dick
+Chetwynd, had often boxed with him and other lads, and had had
+lessons from an ex-prize fighter at Reigate, and was therefore able
+to appreciate the science shown by the various men who confronted
+each other. The event of the evening was the contest between Tring
+and Bob Pratt; both were very powerful men, who were about to
+go into strict training for matches that had been made for them
+against two west countrymen, who were thought very highly of by
+their friends, and who were regarded as possible candidates for
+the championship.
+
+Bob Pratt was a stone heavier than his opponent, but far less active,
+and owed his position more to his ability to take punishment, and
+to hard hitting powers, than to his science. In the two rounds that
+were fought, Tring had the advantage, but the general opinion was
+that in the long run the other would wear him down. Both fought
+with good temper, and were warmly applauded as they shook hands at
+the finish.
+
+"I think I should back Tring in a fight," Mark said, as the meeting
+broke up, "but it is difficult to say, for he is in better condition
+than the other, and it may be that when both are thoroughly fit
+the heavy man might show more improvement than he would do."
+
+The hat was passed round at the conclusion: Every man dropped in
+his guinea, some more, it being understood that the collection was
+divided between the two men to pay the expenses of their training.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII.
+
+
+The next morning Mark commenced work in earnest, and for two months
+visited all the worst slums of London in company with one of the Bow
+Street men. Both were generally in disguise, but Mark's companion
+sometimes went openly to some of the houses inhabited by men well
+known as criminals. On such occasions Mark remained within call,
+ready to go in if assistance should be required; but there was
+small fear of this, the men who were visited were all personally
+known to the officer, and generally greeted him with "You aint
+wanting me, are you?"
+
+"Not at all; what I am wanting is a little information for which I
+shall be quite willing to pay the first man who enables us to lay
+hands on the gentleman I want to find." Then he would describe
+Bastow's appearance.
+
+"He has taken to the road, I fancy, and has given us a good deal
+of trouble; if it is the man I think it is, he has been away from
+London for some years, and came back eight or ten months ago."
+
+The reply was always to the same effect:
+
+"I don't know of such a man, and never heard of him. For my part, I
+would not split on a pal, not for anything; but I should not mind
+earning five guineas to put you on a cove who is not one of us.
+Besides, it aint only the money; you know, you might do me a good
+turn some day."
+
+"Quite so; well, I can tell you it is a good deal more than five
+guineas that would be earned if you could put me in the way of
+laying my hand on his shoulder. I don't think that he is living in
+town. I expect he is in some quiet neighborhood; still, if he is
+on the road, he must have a horse somewhere. You might ask among
+the stables, and find out whether anyone keeps a horse there who
+is in the habit of going out in the afternoon and not coming back
+until the next day. You have plenty of time upon your hands, and
+it would pay you well if you could bring me the information I want."
+
+The officer said to Mark at the end of two months: "These knights of
+the road don't often mix themselves up with the London housebreakers.
+The most likely men to be able to tell you about the doings of
+such a fellow would be receivers of stolen goods, but it would be
+dangerous to question any of them--they would be sure to put him
+on his guard. I will give you a list of some of them, and I should
+say that your best way would be to watch their places of an evening,
+from the time it gets dark till ten or eleven. Of course, it is
+just a chance. You may watch one place for a month and he may happen
+to go there the very day you have gone off to watch another crib.
+Still, there is just the chance, and I don't see that there is one
+any other way."
+
+During this time Mark had been taking a lesson every evening
+with Needham, and had surprised his teacher with the rapidity of
+his progress; he had said, the very evening before, when Mark had
+countered him with a blow that knocked him for two or three minutes
+senseless:
+
+"We have had enough of this, governor; you have got beyond me
+altogether, and I don't want another blow like that. You had better
+take on Gibbons now. You are too big altogether for me, and yet you
+don't fight like a heavyweight, for you are as quick on your pins
+as I am."
+
+Well pleased at having the day to himself and of having got clear
+of his work in the thieves' rookeries, Mark went the next morning
+to Gibbons' shop. His entry was hailed by a chorus of barking from
+dogs of all sorts and sizes, from the bulldog down to the ratting
+terrier.
+
+"Glad to see you, Mr. Thorndyke," Gibbons said, when he had silenced
+the barking. "I saw Jack last week, and he told me that he should
+hand you over to me pretty soon, for that you were getting beyond
+him altogether, and he thought that if you stuck to it you would
+give me all my work to do in another six months."
+
+"I finished with him last night, Gibbons, and I shall be ready to
+come for a lesson to you every morning, somewhere about this hour.
+I have brought my bag with my togs."
+
+"All right, sir, I am ready at once; the place is clear now behind.
+I have just been making it tidy, for we had a little ratting last
+night, one of my dogs against Sir James Collette's, fifty rats
+each; my dog beat him by three quarters of a minute."
+
+"You will never see me here at one of those businesses. I have no
+objection to stand up to a man my own size and give and take until
+we have had enough, but to see rats slaughtered when they have not
+a chance of making a fight of it is altogether out of my line."
+
+"Well, sir, I do not care about it myself; there are lots who do
+like it, and are ready to wager their money on it, and as it helps
+to sell my dogs, besides what I can win out of the event--it
+was a wager of twenty guineas last night--it aint for me to set
+myself up against it."
+
+Calling a boy to look after the shop, Gibbons went away into
+a wooden building in the back yard; it was about twenty-five feet
+square, and there were holes in the floor for the stakes, when a
+regular ring was made. The floor was strewn with clean sawdust; a
+number of boxing gloves hung by the wall.
+
+"There is the dressing room," Gibbons said, pointing to a door
+at the other end. When both were ready he looked Mark over. "Your
+muscles have thickened out a good bit, sir, since I saw you strip.
+Before another four years, if you keep on at it, you will be as big
+a man as I am. I am about eight years too old, and you are four
+years too young. You will improve every day, and I shan't. Now, sir,
+let us see what you can do. Jack tells me that you are wonderfully
+quick on your feet; there is the advantage you have of me. I am as
+strong as ever I was, I think, but I find that I cannot get about
+as I used to."
+
+He stood somewhat carelessly at first, but as they sparred for
+an opening he became more careful, and presently hit out sharply.
+Mark leaped back, and then, springing forward, struck out with his
+left; Gibbons only just stopped it and then countered, but Mark
+was out of reach again.
+
+"That is good enough," Gibbons said; "I can see Jack has taught you
+pretty nearly all there is to know. We will just take those hits
+again. You were right to get away from the first, but the second
+time you should have guarded with your left, and hit at my chin
+with your right. That jumping back game is first rate for avoiding
+punishment, but you have got to come in again to hit. You took me
+by surprise that time, and nearly got home, but you would not do
+it twice," and so the lesson went on for three quarters of an hour.
+
+"That will do for today, sir; I am getting blown, if you are not.
+Well, I can tell you I have never had a more promising pupil, and
+I have brought forward two or three of the best men in the ring;
+no wonder that Jack cannot do much with you. Give me six months,
+every day, and you should have a turn occasionally with other men,
+and I would back you for a hundred pounds against any man now in
+the ring."
+
+Three or four days later Mark received a message that the chief
+wanted to speak with him that afternoon, and he accordingly went
+down.
+
+"I've got a job for you, Mr. Thorndyke; it is just the sort of thing
+that will suit you. There is a house in Buckingham Street that we
+have had our eye on for some time; it is a gambling house, but with
+that we have nothing to do unless complaints are made, but we have
+had several complaints of late. It is a well got up place, and
+there are a good many men of title frequent it, but men of title
+are not always more honest than other people; anyhow, there are some
+rooks there, and several young fellows of means have been pigeoned
+and ruined. They are mighty particular who they let in, and there
+would be very little chance of getting my regular men in there.
+Now, you are a stranger in London, but you have friends here, and
+no doubt you could get introduced. We want to know if the play is
+fair; if it isn't, we would break the place up altogether. We know
+enough to do it now; but none of the poor beggars who have been
+ruined will come forward, and, indeed, haven't any idea, I think,
+that they have lost their money in anything but a run of bad luck.
+
+"One young fellow blew his brains out last week, and his father
+came here with a list of what are called debts of honor, which he
+found in his room. There they are, and the names of the men they
+are owed to; of course some of them have been fairly won, but I
+have a strong suspicion that those I have marked with a cross have
+not been. For instance, there is Sir James Flash, a fellow who was
+turned out of White's two years ago for sharp practice with cards;
+there is John Emerson, he is a man of good family, but all his
+friends have given him up long ago, and he has been living by his
+wits for the last five years. The others marked are all of the same
+sort. Now, what I want you to do is to become a frequenter of the
+place; of course you will have to play a little, and as you are a
+stranger I expect that they will let you win for a bit; but if not
+the old gentleman has placed 200 pounds in my hands for the expenses."
+
+"I could play with my own money," Mark said rather warmly.
+
+"You forget, Mr. Thorndyke," the chief said firmly, "that at the
+present moment you are a member of my force, and that you go to this
+place in that capacity, and not as Squire of Crowswood; therefore
+you must, if you please, do as I instruct you. The gentleman will
+be ready to pay that sum. As you see, the amounts entered here
+total up to nearly 10,000 pounds. He said that it will ruin him to
+pay that sum, but that he must do so rather than his son should be
+branded as a defaulter. I have advised him to write to all these
+people saying that it will take him some time to raise the money,
+but that he will see that nobody shall be a loser by his son's
+debts. I have told him in the meantime that I will endeavor to get
+proof that the play was not fair, and in that case he would, of
+course, refuse to pay any of the claims on that ground; and you
+may be sure that if unfair play was proved none of those concerned
+would dare to press their claims."
+
+"Then my function would be simply to watch?"
+
+"Yes, to watch, and to bring me word of anything you may observe.
+You see, without making a public scandal, if it could be found that
+a man was discovered cheating, and the way in which he was doing
+it, one would be able to put so strong a pressure on him, that
+not only might he be forced to abstain from going to any club, but
+would be frightened into giving up any IOUs he might hold."
+
+"I shall be glad to do the best I can, sir; but frankly I know next
+to nothing of cards, and should have but little chance of detecting
+anything that might be going on, when it must be done so cleverly
+that experienced gamblers, watching a man closely, fail to see
+anything wrong."
+
+"I quite understand that; but one of my men has made a study of
+the various methods employed by gamblers to cheat, and although it
+would take you years to learn how to do it yourself, a few hours'
+instruction from him would at least put you up to some of their
+methods, and enable you to know where to look for cheating. The
+man is now waiting in the next room, and if you will take two or
+three hours daily with him, say for a week, you ought to be able
+to detect the doings of these fellows when to others everything
+seems right and above board. You may have no inclination for cards,
+but knowledge of that sort is useful to anyone in society, here or
+anywhere else, and may enable him either to save his own pocket or
+to do a service to a friend."
+
+Mark was greatly interested in the tricks the man showed him. At
+first it seemed to him almost magical, after he himself had shuffled
+the cards and cut them the dealer invariably turned up a king. Even
+admitting he might have various places of concealment, pockets in
+the lining of the sleeve, in the inside of the coat, and in various
+other parts of the dress, in which cards could be concealed and
+drawn out by silken threads, it did not seem possible that this
+could be done with such quickness as to be unobserved. It was only
+when his teacher showed him, at first in the slowest manner, and
+then gradually increasing his speed, that he perceived that what
+seemed impossible was easy enough when the necessary practice and
+skill had been attained. The man was indeed an adept at a great
+variety of tricks by which the unsuspecting could be taken in.
+
+"I ought to know," he said. "I was for three years in a gambling
+house in Paris, where every other man was a sharper. I have been
+in places of the same sort in Belgium, Holland, Germany, and Italy.
+At first I was only a boy waiter, and as until evening there was
+nothing doing at these places, men would sometimes amuse themselves
+by teaching me tricks, easy ones to begin with, and when they saw
+I was sharp and quick handed they went on. After a time I began to
+work as a confederate, and at last on my own account; but I got
+disgusted with it at last. A young fellow shot himself at the table
+of the gambling house at Rome, and at another place I was nearly
+killed by a man who had lost heavily--do you see, it has left a
+broad scar right across my forehead?--so I gave it up.
+
+"I was in the French police for a time, and used to watch some
+of the lower hells. I was nearly killed there once or twice, and
+at last I came back here. My French chief gave me a letter to the
+chief, and I was taken on at once, for, talking as I do half a dozen
+languages, and being acquainted with most of the swell mobsmen of
+Paris, I was just the man who happened to be wanted here at the time.
+Since I came over I have done a good deal in the way of breaking
+up hells where sailors and others are plundered. But, you see,
+I cannot be used for the higher class of work; my nose has been
+broken, and I have half a dozen scars on my face. I hate the sight
+of cards now. I have seen so much of the ruin they do, and have,
+I am sorry to say, taken a hand so often in doing it, that save
+showing someone who would use the knowledge in the right way how the
+tricks are done, nothing would persuade me to touch them again.
+However, as a protection, the knowledge is as useful as it is
+dangerous when used the other way. It would take you ten years to
+learn to do these tricks yourself so well as to defy detection;
+but in a very short time, by learning where to keep your eyes, you
+would get to detect almost any of them.
+
+"You see, there are three methods of cheating: the first by hidden
+cards, the second by marked cards, the third simply by sleight of
+hand, this being generally used in connection with marked cards.
+These tricks require great skill and extreme delicacy of touch,
+for the marks, which are generally at the edge of the cards, are
+so slight as to be altogether imperceptible save to a trained hand.
+There are also marks on the back of the cards; these are done in the
+printing, and are so slight that, unless attention were attracted
+to them, no one would dream of their existence."
+
+In the course of a week's practice Mark learned where to look for
+cheating; he could not indeed follow the fingers of his instructor,
+for even when he knew what was going to be done, the movements were
+so rapid that his eye could not follow them, and in nine cases out
+of ten he was unable to say whether the coup had been accomplished
+or not; but he could see that there was a slight movement of the
+fingers that could only mean that something was being done.
+
+"It would be a good thing," he said one day, "if every young fellow
+before going out into the world were to have a course of such
+instruction as you are giving me; he would learn, at least, the
+absolute folly of sitting down to play cards with strangers. He would
+see that he could be robbed in fifty different ways, and would be
+at the absolute mercy of any sharper. I never had any inclination
+for gambling, but if I had been inclined that way you would have
+cured me of the passion for life."
+
+The week's instruction was lengthened to a fortnight, and at the
+end of that time Mark went to Dick Chetwynd.
+
+"Do you know, Dick," he said, "a gambling place in Buckingham
+Street?"
+
+"I know that there is a hell there, Mark, but I have never been in
+it. Why do you ask?"
+
+"I have rather a fancy to go there," he replied. "I hear that,
+although a good many men of fashion haunt the place, the crowd is
+rather a mixed one."
+
+"It has a bad name, Mark; I have heard some queer reports about
+it."
+
+"Yes, so have I. I should think that it is a very likely place for
+a man like Bastow to go to if he has any liking for play. Of course
+he would get up as a gentleman. At any rate, I have been making
+what inquiries I can in some of the thieves' quarters, and have
+come to the conclusion that he is not likely to have taken up his
+abode there, and I don't think I can do better than make a round
+of some of these doubtful houses. I should like to begin with this,
+and then work downwards."
+
+"Well, I dare say I could manage it, Mark; I know half a dozen men
+who play there; they say there is more fun and excitement to be got
+than at White's or Crockford's, or any of those places. Some men,
+of course, play high, but a good many who go there only risk a few
+guineas; some go because it is the proper thing at present for a
+man about town either to play or to bet on horses or cock fights,
+or to patronize the ring; and, after all, it is easier to stroll
+for an hour or two of an evening into comfortable rooms, where you
+meet a lively set and there is champagne always going, than it is
+to attend races or prize fights."
+
+Very few days passed that Mark did not go in for half an hour's chat
+with his friend, and two days after this conversation Dick said:
+
+"By the way, Mark, I have arranged for us to go to that hell tonight;
+young Boldero, who is a member of my club, told me some time ago
+that he played there sometimes. I met him yesterday evening, and
+said that I had a fancy to go and have a look at it, and that a
+friend of mine from the country also wanted to go; he said at once
+that he would take us there.
+
+"'I should advise you not to play much, Chetwynd,' he said;
+'sometimes they play uncommonly high, and there are some fellows
+who have wonderful luck. Of course, on ordinary occasions, when
+the play is low, you could stake a few guineas there as well as
+elsewhere, but when really high play is on we small fish always
+stand out. All I can say is that I have never seen anything that
+savors of foul play in the smallest degree; but you understand
+how it is, if one man happens to have a big run of luck, there are
+always fellows who go about hinting that there is something wrong
+in it. However, it is a jolly place to drop into, and, of course
+there is no occasion to play always, and if one loses one is likely
+to win on the next race or on the next fight.'"
+
+Accordingly that evening Mark met Boldero, whom he had once or twice
+before seen in Dick's company, and the three went together to the
+house in Buckingham Street. Boldero nodded to the doorkeeper as he
+went in, and they then proceeded upstairs and entered a handsome
+room, with comfortable sofas and chairs, on which a dozen men were
+seated, for the most part smoking. Several champagne bottles stood
+on the tables, and all who liked helped themselves. Boldero was
+known to several of those present, while two or three were also
+known to Dick. Boldero introduced them both to his friends. One
+of these was the Hon. John Emerson, a man of some five and thirty,
+with a languid air and a slight drawl.
+
+"Glad to make your acquaintance, sir," he said to Mark. "Have you
+been long in town?"
+
+"Two or three months only," Mark replied.
+
+"Is this your first visit here?"
+
+"Yes, this is my first visit to any place of the sort, but I thought
+that I should like to go the rounds before I went home again."
+
+"Quite so. Going to punt a few guineas, I suppose?"
+
+"Yes, I suppose that is the right thing to do."
+
+"Well, everyone who comes is expected to do a little that way;
+there is no occasion to play high."
+
+"Oh, I should not like to do that," Mark said innocently; "indeed,
+I know very little about cards."
+
+"Oh, that is quite immaterial so long as you only play games of
+chance; in fact, you don't want to know anything about them. You
+see others staking their money, some on one side of the table, and
+some on the other; you place your money whichever side you like,
+and take your chance. There is no skill in it. Some people play on
+what they call a system, but there is nothing in it; you have just
+as much chance if you put your money down blindfolded. If luck is
+with you, you win; if luck is against you, you lose."
+
+After chatting for a few minutes Mark went with his two companions
+upstairs. The room they now entered was furnished as a drawing room,
+except that in the middle was a table, round which some fifteen
+people were seated, while as many more looked on; round the room
+were several small tables, on which were packs of cards. These
+were for those who preferred to play piquet or ecarte, two or three
+couples being so engaged. Mark knew enough of cards to know that
+hazard was being played at the large table. There was an inner
+room, and Mark strolled across and looked in. It was at present
+untenanted; it contained a center table capable of holding four,
+and two or three small ones, with two chairs set in readiness to
+each.
+
+"That is where the heavy play goes on," Boldero said. "None of your
+four or five guineas wagers there, fifties and hundreds are nearer
+the mark, and I have seen a thousand wagered many a time. It is
+exciting work even looking on, I can tell you; what it must be for
+the players I cannot say, but I should think it must be frightful."
+
+Mark took up his stand at the hazard table, and after looking
+on for some little time began to play. Beginning with guineas, he
+gradually, as luck favored him, played five guineas, and after half
+an hour's play won fifty. Then luck turned, and in a few minutes
+he had lost all he won.
+
+"You ought to have stopped, Mark," Dick said reproachfully, as he
+stepped back from his place, which was at once filled by one who
+had been standing behind him.
+
+The play in the inner room had now begun, and Mark went in and joined
+those who were looking on. In half an hour one of the players had
+had enough, and a young man said to Emerson, who was standing on
+the other side of the table:
+
+"Now, Mr. Emerson, will you give me my revenge?"
+
+"I would really rather not, Mr. Cotter. The luck has been so one
+sided lately that I would rather leave it alone."
+
+"But it may turn tonight," the other said. "At any rate, I will
+try it, if you have no objection."
+
+There was a certain eagerness in the young man's voice that caused
+Mark to watch him closely. He was a good looking young fellow, but
+his face was not a strong one; and although he evidently tried to
+assume an appearance of indifference as he sat down, there was a
+nervous movement of his fingers. Mark took his place behind him as
+play began. The game was ecarte, and for a time Emerson lost.
+
+"I think the luck has changed, Mr. Cotter, but as we generally raise
+the stakes after playing for a bit, I am ready to do so. Shall we
+make it fifty pounds again?"
+
+"With pleasure," the young man said.
+
+He won the next two games, then for some time they won alternately.
+
+"Shall we say a hundred again?" he said.
+
+"As you like," Emerson replied. "We don't seem to get much forwarder
+either way at present."
+
+A considerable number of lookers on had now gathered round. So far
+Mark, although watching the fingers of the opposite player intently,
+had seen no sign whatever of unfair play. He now redoubled his
+attention. Cotter won the first game, his adversary the three next.
+Mark noticed now that after looking at his hand Emerson looked
+abstractedly, as if meditating before taking the next step; there
+was no expression in his face, but Mark fancied that his eyes rested
+for a moment on the man standing next to himself. He looked at his
+watch and then, as if finding the hour later than he had expected,
+moved away from his place, and presently joined Dick, who was
+standing with Boldero on the other side of the table.
+
+"Who is that man playing with Emerson?" he asked in a whisper.
+
+"He is the son of Cotter, the head of Cotter's Bank, in Lombard
+Street."
+
+As the men were standing two or three deep round the table, Mark
+could not see the table itself, but this mattered little, for his
+attention was entirely directed towards the man standing behind
+Cotter's chair. He saw that after glancing down at the young man's
+hand he looked across as if seeing what Emerson was going to do;
+sometimes his eyes dropped for an instant, at other times there
+was no such movement, and after noticing this four or five times,
+and noticing the course Emerson took, he had no doubt whatever in
+his own mind that the movement of the man's eyes was an intimation
+to Emerson of the nature of Cotter's hand. The young man had lost
+four games in succession; he had grown very pale, but showed no
+other signs of agitation. Presently he said:
+
+"You have your usual luck again; I will only play one more game
+tonight, but we may as well make it worth playing. Shall we say
+five hundred?"
+
+"At your service," Emerson replied.
+
+This time the face of the man standing behind Cotter's chair was
+immovable, and Mark, placing himself behind a short man and straining
+his head forward, saw that Cotter scored four. The next time there
+was still no sign. Emerson showed a king and scored it, and then
+won every trick and the game.
+
+"That makes nine hundred pounds," the young man said quietly,
+writing an IOU for that amount and handing it to Emerson. There was
+a general movement of the spectators, and two fresh players took
+the seats vacated by the late antagonists.
+
+"Who was the man standing behind Cotter's chair?" Mark asked Boldero.
+
+"That is Sir James Flash. He is just going to play, you see; it is
+sure to be another hot game, and an interesting one."
+
+"Well, I think I will go," Mark said; "the heat of the room has
+given me a bit of a headache. I will see you tomorrow, Dick."
+
+"Good night, old man," Chetwynd said; and, shaking hands with
+Boldero, Mark went downstairs immediately after Cotter. The latter
+went into the room below, drank off a tumbler of champagne, and
+then went down, took his hat, and went out. Mark followed him for a
+short distance, and joined him as soon as he got up into the Strand.
+
+"Mr. Cotter," he said, "I have not the pleasure of knowing you
+personally, and I must introduce myself. My name is Mark Thorndyke,
+and I am the owner of an estate close to Reigate. Would you mind
+my exchanging a few words with you?"
+
+Cotter looked up, and was about to give a flat refusal, but the
+expression of Mark's face was so friendly and pleasant that he
+changed his mind and said in a hard voice:
+
+"I really do not know what you can have to say to me, Mr. Thorndyke,
+but of course I can hardly refuse to hear you."
+
+They walked across the road and turned up a quiet street.
+
+"For certain reasons it is not necessary for me to explain," Mark
+said, "I went to that place for the first time tonight, and I
+watched the play between you and Mr. Emerson."
+
+"It does not matter, sir; I lost, and I am not going there again."
+
+"I hope, on the contrary, that you will go there again, Mr. Cotter.
+If I mistake not, from what I heard, you have lost considerable
+sums to that man."
+
+"I imagine, sir, that that is no business of a stranger."
+
+"In no way personally," Mark replied, not heeding the angry ring in
+the voice, "but as an honest man it does concern me. I am absolutely
+convinced, sir, that that money has not been won from you fairly."
+
+The young man gave a start.
+
+"Impossible!" he said shortly. "Mr. Emerson is a man of good family
+and a gentleman."
+
+"He is a man of good family, I admit, but certainly not a gentleman;
+his antecedents are notorious."
+
+"I have never heard a word against him; he is intimate with Sir
+James Flash and other gentlemen of position."
+
+"I am not surprised, that you have not heard of it; it was probably
+to the interest of several persons that you should not do so. Nor
+do I suppose that you are aware that Sir James Flash was himself
+expelled from White's for cheating at cards."
+
+"Impossible!" Mr. Cotter replied.
+
+"I can assure you of the fact," Mark said quietly. "Probably you
+have among your acquaintances some members of White's. I am sure
+if you ask them they will confirm the fact. Now, sir, I can assure
+you that I have no interest in this matter, save to prevent a
+gentleman from being ruined by blacklegs. May I ask how much you
+owe to Mr. Emerson and Sir James Flash?"
+
+The young man hesitated. "I believe you, sir," he said at last. "They
+hold my IOUs for 29,000 pounds. I need hardly say it is absolute
+ruin. My intention is to make a clean breast to my father about it
+tomorrow morning. My father will give me the money, in the first
+place because he loves me and would save my name from disgrace, and
+in the second because were I posted as a defaulter it would strike
+a severe blow at the credit of the bank. So he will give me the
+money, but he will bid me leave his house forever. That will matter
+little, for I shall pay the money, and tomorrow night I shall blow
+out my brains."
+
+"Well, sir, if you will follow my advice you will neither pay
+the money nor blow out your brains. I saw enough tonight to feel
+absolutely certain that you have been cheated. Sir James Flash stood
+behind you, and was, I am sure, signaling your hand to Emerson. I
+believe that Emerson played fair otherwise, until the last game,
+but I am convinced that he then cheated. You had good hands, but
+he had better; and although I did not see him cheat--for I was
+on the other side of the table--I am convinced that he did so.
+Now, sir, I advise you to go in as usual tomorrow evening, and to
+play, raising your stakes as you did tonight. When the times comes
+I will expose him. Should I not be able to detect him we must try
+another night. I am so much convinced that this is the case, and
+that I shall succeed, that whether you play one night or three I
+will guarantee that you shall be no loser, but will, on the honor
+of a gentleman, place in your hands the amount of your losses; so
+that you will not have to ask your father for a check larger than
+you would do if you confessed to him tomorrow morning. I only ask
+in return that you, on your part, will give me your word of honor
+that you will never touch a card again after you rise from the
+table."
+
+"I cannot accept so generous an offer from a stranger," Cotter said
+in a low tone.
+
+"I do not think that it is generous," Mark replied quietly, "because
+I am perfectly convinced that I shall not have to pay at all. Have
+you any other IOUs out?"
+
+"I have given them for about 5000 pounds, but that is not in addition
+to the 29,000 pounds. Emerson told me that as he knew that I should
+have difficulty in paying them at the present moment, he had taken
+them up, and held them with his own."
+
+"Will you give me the names of the persons to whom you gave them
+in the first place?"
+
+"Certainly;" and he mentioned three names, all of which stood with
+a black cross against them on Mark's list.
+
+"Thank you. Then you will go tomorrow night again?"
+
+"Yes; and I swear to you that I will never touch a card afterwards."
+
+"I don't think that you need fear," Mark said. "I have not been
+long in London, but I happen to have been shown a good many of the
+tricks that these blacklegs play on greenhorns, which will account
+for my having noticed what has never been observed by the honest
+portion of the men who frequent the place. Now I will say good
+night, sir. I shall be behind your chair or his tomorrow night."
+
+"I don't know what to say," Cotter said hesitatingly.
+
+"There is no occasion to say anything; it is the duty of every
+honest man to interfere if he sees another honest man being robbed,
+and that is my sole object in this matter. Good night;" and turning
+round, he walked rapidly away.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII.
+
+
+The next morning, before going round to Gibbons', Mark saw his
+chief and told him of what had taken place on the previous evening.
+
+"I certainly did not think that you would succeed so soon; you
+believe that you will be able fairly to expose these fellows?"
+
+"I have no doubt whatever that I shall be able to expose one of
+them; and I have equally no doubt that if the others are arrested,
+either false cards or pockets for cards will be found upon them.
+What do you wish me to do, sir? I can, of course, expose any fellow
+I catch at it, but can do nothing about the others."
+
+"I must have more than one captured," the chief said. "At even the
+most irreproachable club there may be one blackleg, but if it is
+clear that this place is the haunt of blacklegs we can break it.
+There are half a dozen Acts that apply; there is the 11th Act of
+Henry VIII, statute 33, cap. 9, which prohibits the keeping of any
+common house for dice, cards, or any unlawful game. That has never
+been repealed, except that gaming houses were licensed in 1620.
+What is more to the point is that five Acts of George II, the.
+9th, 12th, 13th, 18th, and 30th, impose penalties upon the keepers
+of public houses for permitting gambling, and lay heavy penalties
+upon hazard, roulette, and other gambling games, on the keepers of
+gambling houses and those who play there. Having received complaints
+of several young men being rooked in the place, we can, if we
+prove that some of its frequenters are blacklegs, shut the place up
+altogether. We should do it quietly, and without fuss, if possible;
+but if we shut it up several others of the same sort will be certain
+to close their doors. But mind, there will probably be a desperate
+row, and you had better take pistols with you. I will have four
+men close at hand from ten o'clock till the time the place closes,
+and if they hear a scrimmage, or you fire a pistol out of the window,
+they will rush in and seize all engaged in the row, and march them
+to the lock up. Of course you will have to be included."
+
+Mark then went to Chetwynd.
+
+"Well, what did you think of it last night?"
+
+"Well, I own that it went against my grain to see that young fellow
+being victimized by a sharper."
+
+"My dear Mark, you must not use such language as that. I fancy
+from what I have heard that the Honorable John is not altogether
+an estimable character, but to call him a sharper is going too far
+altogether."
+
+"I don't think that it is, for from what I saw last night I am
+pretty well convinced that he did not play fair. I mean to go again
+tonight."
+
+"But why on earth should you mix yourself up in such an affair,
+Mark? It is no business of yours; you are not an habitue of the
+place. Above all, it is extremely unlikely that you are right.
+There were some shady people there, no doubt, but there were also
+a good many gentlemen present, and as you know nothing of cards,
+as far as I know, it is the most unlikely thing in the world that
+you should find out that Emerson cheated when no one else noticed
+it."
+
+"It is my business; it is the duty of every honest man to see that
+a poor lad like that should not be eaten up by a shark like Emerson.
+I don't care if there is a shindy over it. I shall not interfere
+unless I can prove that the man is cheating, in which case no man
+of honor would go out with him. I shall be glad if you and Boldero
+would go with me again this evening. I am not known there, and
+you are to a good many men, and Boldero to many more. I only want
+that, if I get into a row, you should testify to the fact that I am
+a gentleman, and ordinarily sane. If there is a row you will have
+an opportunity of seeing how much I have benefited by my lessons."
+
+"Yes, I heard you were making tremendous progress. Jack Needham
+told me a month ago that you had knocked him out of time, and I went
+into Gibbons' yesterday morning with a man who wanted to buy a dog,
+and he told me that he considered that it was a great misfortune
+that you were an amateur, for that you only required another six
+months' practice, and he would then be ready to back you for a
+hundred pounds against any man in the ring. But about this affair,
+Mark. Are you really in earnest?"
+
+"I am, Dick, thoroughly in earnest; so would you be if you had
+spoken to Cotter last night, as I did. I tell you that if I had
+not given him a little hope that the thing might come out right,
+he would have blown out his brains today."
+
+"Well, Mark, if you have set your mind on it, of course I will stick
+to you, though I have some doubts whether Cotter has any brains
+to speak of to blow out, else he would not be mad enough to back
+himself against Emerson and other men whom Boldero tells me he has
+been playing with."
+
+"He has made an ass of himself, no doubt, Dick; but I fancy a good
+many fellows do that at one time or other of their lives, though
+not, I grant, always in the same way."
+
+"Well, I will go, Mark. I need not ask Boldero, for he told me
+that he should look in again at ten o'clock this evening, for he
+thought that another night's play would probably bring Cotter to
+the end of his tether."
+
+Accordingly a little before ten they walked into the gambling house
+together.
+
+"Now, Dick, I want you, as soon as you sit down, to take your place
+in the front line within a yard or two of Emerson. I don't want you
+to be just behind him, but a short distance away; and I want you
+to keep your eye upon Sir James Flash, who, if I am not mistaken,
+will take up the same position that he did last night, near enough
+to Cotter to see his hand. You will remark, I have no doubt, as
+I did last night, that whenever Cotter has a bad hand, Flash will
+either close his eyes, or put his hand up to his mouth and stroke
+his mustache, or make some sign of that sort. When Cotter has a
+good hand he will stand perfectly still or look about the room. At
+any rate, he will make no sign--that, of course, is a guide to
+Emerson whether to propose or to refuse to allow Cotter to do so. I
+need not point out to you what a tremendous advantage the knowledge
+whether an opponent's hand is good or not gives him. Of course,
+while watching an hour's play I can only know that Flash was making
+signs, and that when he did so Cotter's hand was a bad one. It
+is possible that the manner in which the sign was made, either by
+closing his eye or twisting his mustache, or so on, may have been an
+intimation as to the suit in which Cotter was strongest or weakest."
+
+"By Jove, this is a serious thing, Mark."
+
+"It is a serious thing. I don't want you to get into a row with the
+fellow. I should like you to give me a nod when you have satisfied
+yourself that I was not mistaken. I will take upon myself to denounce
+the fellow, and to say what I noticed yesterday and you can back
+me up by saying that you saw the same thing. I have no doubt that
+I shall be able to convince every decent man there that my charge
+is well founded. I am going to watch Emerson. With the help he gets
+from Flash, he won't risk anything by cheating until it comes to a
+big stake like the last game yesterday, in which case, if Cotter's
+hand happens to be a strong one, he is likely to do so, and I fancy
+if he does I shall be able to catch him at it. You had better keep
+Boldero near you. You can whisper to him what you are watching Flash
+for, and get him to do so too; as, if I catch Emerson cheating,
+there is likely to be a row; he can lend a hand if necessary,
+and, at any rate, his joining in with you will suffice to show his
+friends that the thing is genuine."
+
+"All right, Mark. I am interested in the matter now, and am ready
+for anything."
+
+Soon after ten Cotter and Emerson again sat down, and, as usual,
+a lot of spectators gathered round the table. The game resembled
+the one on the previous evening. Mark placed himself' by the side
+of Cotter, a stranger stood immediately behind his chair, another
+member of the club was on the other side, and Sir James Flash stood
+partly behind him, so that although somewhat in the background he
+could obtain a view between their heads of Cotter's cards. Mark
+saw to his satisfaction that Dick and Boldero had secured the exact
+position that he wished them to take. For the first few games the
+play was even, and Dick began to think that Mark had been mistaken,
+for Flash appeared to take little interest in the game, and made
+no sign how Emerson should proceed.
+
+As soon as the stake rose to a hundred again he distinctly saw
+Flash close his eyes and play with his mustache; he called Boldero's
+attention to the fact, and found the latter, who had also been
+watching, had noticed it. By the time a few games had been played
+he verified Mark's assertion that these signs were signals that
+Cotter's hand was a bad one, and in each case Emerson played without
+giving his opponent the opportunity of discarding and taking in
+fresh cards. He and Dick nodded quietly to Mark, who had satisfied
+himself that so far Emerson had not cheated in any other way. As
+on the previous evening, Cotter, after losing five or six hundred
+pounds, proposed a final game of five hundred. Mark bent down his
+head, so that the intentness of his gaze should not be noticed,
+but from under his eyebrows he watched Emerson's every movement;
+suddenly he placed a foot on the edge of the chair of the man
+sitting in front of him, and with a sudden spring leaped upon the
+table, seized Emerson's hand, and held it up to the full length of
+his arm.
+
+"Gentlemen," he shouted, "this fellow is cheating; there is a card
+in his hand which he has just brought from under the table."
+
+In a moment there was a dead silence of surprise; then Mark forced
+the hand open and took Emerson's card, which he held up.
+
+"There, you see, gentleman; it is a king."
+
+Then a Babel of sounds arose, a dozen hands were laid upon Emerson,
+who was pulled back from his chair and thrown down on a sofa, while
+hands were run over his coat, waistcoat, and breeches.
+
+"Here they are!" a man shouted, and held a dozen cards over his
+head.
+
+The place of concealment had been cleverly chosen; the breeches
+apparently buttoned closely at the knee, but in reality they were
+loose enough to enable a finger and thumb to be passed between them
+and the stocking, and in the lining of the breeches was a pocket
+in which the cards had been placed, being held there by two pieces
+of whalebone, that closed the pocket. The searchers, among whom
+were Dick and Boldero, did not have it all their own way; four or
+five men rushed upon them, and endeavored to pull them off Emerson.
+The din of voices was prodigious, but Mark, still standing on the
+table, stilled it for a moment by shouting:
+
+"The scoundrel has an accomplice, who this evening and yesterday
+has been signaling the strength of the cards in Mr. Cotter's hands."
+
+"Who is he?" was shouted over the room.
+
+"It is Sir James Flash," Mark said. "I denounce him as a cheat and
+a sharper."
+
+As pale as death, Flash rushed to the table.
+
+"I don't know who you are, sir," he said, in a tone of concentrated
+rage, "but you are a liar, and you shall answer for this in the
+morning."
+
+"I will answer to any gentleman that calls me to account," Mark said,
+in a ringing voice, "but I don't meet a man who has been expelled
+from White's for cheating, and who I have no doubt is well stocked
+with cards at the present moment, in readiness for the victim that
+he is next going to meet after the plucking of Mr. Cotter has been
+done. Now, gentlemen, search him and see if I am wrong; if I am I
+will apologize for that part of my accusation."
+
+Flash drew a pistol from his pocket, but in an instant his arm was
+seized by those standing round him, and it exploded harmlessly.
+Among those who seized Flash was the man who had played with him
+the previous evening. In spite of his struggles and curses, and
+the efforts of his friends to rescue him, he too was thrown down
+and eight court cards were found concealed in his sleeve. The uproar
+while this was going on had been tremendous, but it was suddenly
+stilled as four men in dark clothes entered the room. Each held
+in his hand the well known symbol of his office, the little ebony
+staff surmounted by a silver crown.
+
+"I arrest all present in the name of the king," one said, "for
+breaking the laws against gambling, and for brawling and the use
+of firearms. Now, gentlemen, resistance is useless; I must request
+that you each give me your card, and your word of honor that you
+will appear at Bow Street tomorrow morning."
+
+"What is all this about, sir?" he asked Mark, who was still standing
+on the table.
+
+"Two fellows here have been caught cheating."
+
+"What is your name and address, sir?"
+
+"My name is Mark Thorndyke, and I am a landed gentleman at Reigate;
+my friends Mr. Chetwynd and Mr. Boldero will bear this out."
+
+"Who are the two men?" the constable asked.
+
+"The two fellows with torn clothes," Mark said. "They are Mr.
+Emerson and Sir James Flash."
+
+"You are certain of the charge that you are making?"
+
+"Quite certain; the cards have been found hidden upon them."
+
+"Yes, yes!" a score of voices shouted; "they have been caught in
+the act of cheating."
+
+"Take those two men into custody," the constable said to two of
+his companions.
+
+"Who fired that pistol?" he went on.
+
+A number of voices shouted:
+
+"Sir James Flash; he attempted to murder Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+The constable nodded to the man who had laid his hands on Sir James
+Flash, and in a moment a pair of handcuffs closed on his wrists.
+
+"You shall repent this!" Flash exclaimed furiously.
+
+"Calm yourself, Sir James," the constable said calmly. "We know
+our duty, and do it whether a man is a peer or a peasant; you are
+accused of card sharping and an attempted murder."
+
+"What is your address in town, Mr. Thorndyke?" he asked.
+
+"18 Villiers Street."
+
+"Is there any charge against anyone else here? A good many of you
+seem to have your clothes torn and disarranged."
+
+"Some fellows attempted to rescue Emerson and Flash while we were
+searching them; for what reason we can all pretty well imagine."
+
+"I shall require the names in the morning of your assailants," the
+constable said; "it looks very much as if they were confederates of
+the two prisoners. Now, gentlemen, you can all leave. This house is
+closed, and will not be opened again until this affair is thoroughly
+investigated."
+
+In five minutes the house was deserted.
+
+"How can I thank you, Mr. Thorndyke?" Cotter, who was one of those
+who had seized Flash's arm, diverted his aim and searched him,
+said, when they got outside the house. "You have saved my life. It
+did not seem possible to me that you could succeed in showing that
+I was being cheated, and I had firmly resolved that, instead of
+allowing you to suffer loss, I would tomorrow morning make a clean
+breast of the whole affair to my father, as I had intended to have
+done this morning."
+
+"If I might advise you, Mr. Cotter, I should say, carry out your
+intention as far as making a clean breast of it is concerned.
+Happily, you are free from debt, as those IOUs are worthless, for
+they were obtained from you by cheating, therefore you have no
+demand to make upon his purse. The police will, I have no doubt,
+endeavor to keep this thing quiet, but your name may come out, and
+it would be far better that your father should hear this story from
+you than elsewhere; and your assurance that you will never touch a
+card again, and the heavy lesson that you have had, will doubtless
+induce him to look at the matter leniently. It will, no doubt, be
+a painful story to tell, but it will be far better told by you."
+
+"I will do it, sir; as you say, the lesson has been a heavy one,
+and henceforth my father shall have no reason to complain of me.
+May I call and see you tomorrow evening?"
+
+"Certainly. I shall be at home from seven to eight, after which
+hour I have an engagement. Good night."
+
+Cotter walked on, and Mark fell back, and joined Dick and Boldero,
+who had fallen behind when they saw him speaking to Cotter.
+
+"Well, Mark, I congratulate you," Dick Chetwynd said. "You did it
+wonderfully, though how on earth you knew that fellow had a card
+in his hand is more than I can guess."
+
+"I felt sure he was going to cheat," Mark said quietly; "I saw that
+Cotter's hand was a very strong one, and knew that Emerson would
+be aware that it was so, because he would receive no signal from
+Flash, therefore this was the time, if any, that he would cheat. He
+had been playing with both hands upon the table. I saw him withdraw
+one, there was a little pause, and then it came up again, and I had
+not a doubt in the world that there was a card in it, and that it
+had been hidden somewhere in his breeches, which is one of the best
+places of concealment, for his hand being under the table while
+getting at the card, no one present who was not behind the scenes,
+as I was, could detect him doing it."
+
+"The wonder to me is," Boldero said, "that while there were a number
+of men looking on closely, for Emerson has long been suspected of
+not playing fair, you, just fresh from the country, if I may say
+so, should have spotted him."
+
+"That is easily explained," Mark said. "Not wishing to fall a victim,
+I have of late been put up to a great many of these sharpers' tricks
+by a man who at one time had been in the trade himself."
+
+"That was a capital idea, Mark," Dick said. "I wish you would
+introduce me to him."
+
+"I won't do that, Dick, but I shall be very glad to teach you all
+I know myself about it; but I fancy that after this you will be in
+no great hurry to enter a gambling hell again."
+
+"That is so, Mark. I have never had any great inclination for
+play; but after this you may be quite sure that I will light shy
+of cards altogether. Still, I shall be glad if you will put me up
+to some of these tricks, for I may be able to some day save a victim
+of card sharpers, as you have done this evening."
+
+The next morning, when those who had been present at the scene of
+the previous evening arrived at the office of the detectives in
+Bow Street, they were shown into some private rooms, and asked to
+wait. Cotter, Mark, and his two friends first had an interview with
+the chief.
+
+"You will understand," the latter said, "that this is an altogether
+informal affair. I propose you first tell me your story as briefly
+as possible."
+
+This was done.
+
+"Now, Mr. Cotter. I take it that you do not wish to prosecute?"
+
+"Certainly not. I would, in fact, give anything rather than appear
+in it."
+
+"You have said that, in addition to the IOUs that you have given
+to the two men caught cheating, they hold others to the amount
+of some five or six thousand pounds, given by you to three other
+frequenters of the club. In fact, these papers have been found in
+Emerson's pocketbook; he told you, I believe, that he had taken them
+up, so that you should not be inconvenienced by them. I understand,
+then, that you will be quite content if you get these IOUs back
+again; those given to Emerson and Flash are, of course, worthless.
+After what has happened, they could not be presented, but probably
+you might have trouble about the others, for, though I have no
+doubt that the whole of the men were in league together, we have
+no means of absolutely proving it."
+
+"I shall be more than content, sir; I have no wish to prosecute."
+
+"We are glad," the chief said, "to be able to close a dangerous
+place; and as the exposure will put a stop to the career of these
+two men, and no doubt alarm a good many others, we don't care about
+taking the matter into court. Such gross scandals as this are best
+kept quiet, when there is no object in ventilating them. Therefore,
+gentlemen, as Mr. Cotter is willing to do so, we shall let the
+matter drop. I shall be obliged if you will step into the next
+room, however, until I have seen these three men."
+
+When they had left, the three were brought in.
+
+"You have been concerned, sirs," the chief said sternly, "in winning
+large sums of money from the Hon. William Denton, from Mr. James
+Carew, from Mr. William Hobson, and others; in all of these cases
+the two men caught cheating last night were also concerned. You all
+hold notes of hand of Mr. Hobson. I shall advise that gentleman's
+father to refuse to pay those notes, and promise him that if any
+further request for payment is made I will furnish him with such
+particulars for publication as will more than justify him in the
+eyes of the world in refusing to honor them. You, as well as Mr.
+Emerson and Sir James Flash, have won large sums from Mr. Cotter,
+and the fact that the IOUs he gave you were found on Mr. Emerson
+points very strongly to their being in confederacy with you in the
+matter; at any rate, they point so strongly that, whether a jury would
+convict or not on the evidence that we shall be able to lay before
+them, there can be no question whatever as to what the opinion of
+men of honor will be. These IOUs are in our hands. Mr. Cotter does
+not desire to pursue the case; he will, however, refuse absolutely
+to pay those IOUs, and in doing so he will have the approval of
+all honorable men. That being so, the IOUs are absolutely useless
+to you, and if you will agree to my tearing them up now, he has
+most kindly consented to let the matter drop in your cases."
+
+The three men, who had all turned very white when he was speaking,
+now protested angrily against imputations being made on their honor.
+
+"Well, sirs," the officer said, "in that case the matter can, of
+course, go on. You know best what the feeling will be as to these
+IOUs. They will form an important item of evidence against you, you
+will see. As the matter stands, either you gave them to Emerson to
+collect for you, without any money passing between you--a very
+strange procedure, which you will find it difficult to explain--
+or else he gave you the coin for them, and you passed them over to
+him, and have, therefore, parted with all claim on Mr. Cotter on
+your own account. Of course I impound them with the other IOUs as
+proof of a conspiracy between you. Now, sirs, am I to tear them up
+or not?"
+
+The three men looked at each other, and then one of them said:
+
+"We protest altogether against the assertion, sir, but at the same
+time, as there can be little doubt that Emerson and Sir James Flash
+have played unfairly, and we do not wish any association of our
+names with theirs, we are perfectly willing that the IOUs, which,
+under the circumstances, we should never have dreamt of presenting,
+should be destroyed."
+
+"I think that you have chosen wisely," the chief said dryly. "It
+is a pity that you did not do so at first. These are the IOUs he
+gave to one or other of you. Perhaps it would be pleasanter for
+you to destroy them yourselves."
+
+The three men took the papers with their names on them and tore
+them up.
+
+"Thank you," he went on sarcastically. "That will place you in a
+better position. You will be able to tell your friends that you felt
+so indignant at the manner in which Mr. Cotter had been swindled
+by Emerson and Flash that you at once destroyed his IOUs for the
+sums that you had won of him. But, gentlemen,"--he spoke sternly
+now,--"remember that we have a long list against you, and that
+the next victim, or let us say his father, might be more disposed
+to push matters to their full length than is Mr. Cotter. Remember,
+also, that we keep ourselves acquainted with what is going on, and
+that should trouble arise we shall produce all the complaints that
+have been made against you, and shall also mention your connection
+with this affair, in which, as I understand, you all did your best
+to prevent those two fellows from being searched."
+
+Without saying another word the three men went out of the room,
+too crestfallen to make even an attempt at keeping up their air of
+indignation. The others were then called in.
+
+"I am sorry, gentlemen," he said, "that you have had the trouble of
+coming here, for the gentleman swindled has declined to prosecute
+the swindlers, and you will understand that he is somewhat anxious
+that his name should not appear in the matter. Fortunately, as
+instead of paying in cash he gave IOUs for his losses, he will not
+be a loser to any large amount by these transactions. I may say
+that the proprietor of the hell has been there this morning, and
+to avoid trouble he has consented to close his place for good. I
+have only to remark that I should advise you, gentlemen, in future,
+only to indulge in gambling in places where you may be fairly assured
+of the character of the men you play with. I think, in conclusion,
+that you may all feel grateful to Mr. Cotter for refusing to prosecute.
+It has saved you from having to appear in court as witnesses in so
+utterly disreputable an affair."
+
+There was a general murmur of assent, and in a minute or two the
+room was clear. Flash and Emerson were then brought in, with a
+constable on each side of them.
+
+"Mr. Cotter has, I regret to say, declined to prosecute, and Mr.
+Thorndyke has done the same with regard to Sir James Flash's use
+of his pistol. You have, therefore, escaped the punishment due to
+swindlers at cards. It is the less matter, as you are not likely
+to have an opportunity of making fresh victims, for the story will
+be known by this afternoon in every club in London. These IOUs will
+be of no use to you--they are not worth the paper on which they
+are written. However, I shall take it upon myself to hand them back
+to Mr. Cotter, to prevent the possibility of their getting into
+other hands and giving him trouble.
+
+"You can unlock those handcuffs, constable; these men are at
+liberty to go, and if they will take my advice they will lose no
+time in crossing the water and establishing themselves somewhere
+where their talents are likely to be better appreciated than they
+are here. They can go; one of you can call a hackney coach for
+them if they wish it. They will scarcely care to walk with their
+garments in their present condition."
+
+Then the chief went into the next room.
+
+"There is an end of that affair, Mr. Cotter. Here are the IOUs you
+gave to those two swindlers. Those you gave to the other three men,
+who were no doubt their confederates, have been torn up by them
+in my presence. They declare that after seeing how shamefully you
+had been victimized they had not the slightest idea of ever presenting
+them."
+
+"I am sure that I am extremely grateful to you," Cotter said. "I
+know that I have behaved like a madman, and that I don't deserve
+to have got off as I have done. It will be a lesson to me for life,
+I can assure you."
+
+On leaving, Dick Chetwynd walked for some distance with Mark--as
+far as Gibbons' place in St. Giles.
+
+"There is one thing which I cannot understand," he said, "and that
+is how it was that the constables happened to be so close at hand,
+just at the time they were wanted."
+
+"Well, you see, Dick, my relations with Bow Street are just at
+present of a somewhat close nature, for they are aiding me in the
+search that I told you that I was making for my father's murderer.
+The consequence was that I had only to mention to the chief that I
+fancied I had detected cheating at that place, and that there was
+a likelihood of a row there last night, and he at once said he
+would send four men, to come in if they heard a rumpus; and he was,
+indeed, rather glad of an opportunity for breaking up the place,
+concerning which he had had several complaints of young men being
+plucked to the last feather. Well, it was lucky they came. I don't
+say that it would have made any difference, because I think our
+side was a great deal stronger than they were, still it would have
+led to a nasty row, and perhaps to half a dozen duels afterwards.
+Well, I will say goodby now. I am very glad that the affair has been
+dropped; it would not have mattered so much to me, as I am single
+and my own master, but there were a good many men there who would
+have been ready to have paid up handsomely rather than that their
+names should appear in connection with a row at a gambling house."
+
+At seven o'clock in the evening Philip Cotter called at Mark's
+lodgings, accompanied by his father, who, as he came in with him,
+advanced at once to Mark and shook him warmly by the hand.
+
+"My son has told me everything, Mr. Thorndyke," he said, "and I
+cannot thank you sufficiently for the noble part you took in rescuing
+him from the terrible effects of his folly. I have been down here
+twice this afternoon, for I felt that I could not rest until I had
+shaken you by the hand. It is not the question of money so much,
+though that would have been a serious loss to me, but it is the
+saving of my son's life, and the saving of the honor of our name."
+
+"I am glad indeed to have been of service, Mr. Cotter, and I trust
+that you have consented to forgive the folly that he has committed,
+and which I feel sure will never be repeated."
+
+"Yes. It was a heavy blow to me, Mr. Thorndyke, when Philip told
+me; but as he has sworn most solemnly never to touch a card again,
+and as I feel sure that the lesson cannot but be a useful one to
+him all his life, I have agreed to say no more about it, and let
+the matter drop altogether. He has been fortunate to have escaped
+so easily. He has told me of the noble offer you made to pay his
+losses if you should not be able to prove that he was being cheated."
+
+"I was not committing myself heavily," Mark said with a smile. "I
+had seen enough to be absolutely certain, and was sure that I should
+be able to bring it home to them."
+
+"But it was at a considerable risk to yourself, Mr. Thorndyke. As
+it was, you had a narrow escape of being shot."
+
+"Not a very narrow escape," Mark replied. "With so many men standing
+round him and their attention called to him, it was certain that
+he would be seized before he could take aim at me. I had pistols
+in my pocket, and was prepared to fire in an instant, but I saw at
+once that there was no occasion for that."
+
+"But I cannot imagine how you should have detected the cheating,"
+the banker said. "You are younger than my son, and he said that
+you told him that you had only recently come up to London. It is
+astonishing that while experienced players should never have noticed
+that anything was wrong you should have discovered it."
+
+"The explanation is simple, Mr. Cotter. I have no inclination for
+play myself, but I happened a short time since to fall in with a
+man who was well acquainted with all the various methods of card
+sharping. I thought that a knowledge of that might some day be
+useful, and I got him to put me up to a number of the tricks of card
+sharpers both at home and abroad. Having these fresh in my mind,
+and seeing that your son was playing with a man whose reputation
+I knew to be bad, I naturally concentrated my attention upon him,
+and was not long in discovering that he had a confederate standing
+behind your son's chair. Being a stranger in the place, I could not
+denounce him, but the next night I set two friends to watch that
+method of cheating, while I kept my eyes fixed on Emerson's hands.
+As I anticipated, there was nothing suspicious about his movements
+so long as play was comparatively low, for the advantage that he
+gained from his confederate enabled him to be sure of winning in
+the long run; it was only in the last game, which was a high one,
+that, as he knew that your son had a strong hand, he was tempted
+to stock his hand with false cards; and watching closely, I had no
+difficulty in detecting his method."
+
+"Well, sir, you have, at any rate, laid us both under the deepest
+obligation. Is there any possible way in which we can show our
+gratitude?"
+
+Mark thought for a moment.
+
+"In one way you might do me a favor, Mr. Cotter. A ward of my
+father's, who will inherit some property when she comes of age,
+is at present finishing her education in town, and is living with
+a lady who has been her friend and companion since childhood. I have
+a good many acquaintances, but they are all bachelors; and having
+been living down at my father's place, near Reigate, for so many
+years, the ladles have no acquaintances in London. They live at
+Islington, and their life is a very dull one. I am anxious, for
+several reasons, that the young lady should have the advantage
+of going somewhat into society. Hitherto I have had no means of
+introducing her. If it is not too much to ask, Mr. Cotter, I should
+be extremely glad and obliged if Mrs. Cotter would call on them and
+give them an introduction into society. The lady with my father's
+ward is the widow of a captain in the Indian Army, and is in all
+ways a very charming person, and has been at the head of my father's
+establishment for the last twelve years."
+
+"With the greatest pleasure in the world, Mr. Thorndyke. I am only
+sorry that it is so slight a thing that you ask of me. I have thought
+it but right to tell my wife what has passed, and I had difficulty
+in persuading her not to come with me this evening to also express
+her gratitude to you. She will be pleased indeed to call upon
+your friends at once, and I am sure she will do so tomorrow. I was
+going to ask you to dine with us, and I hope that you will do so.
+We shall have no one else, and I hope that you will be able to
+arrange to meet your friends at our house a few days later."
+
+The next morning Mark called on Mrs. Cunningham.
+
+"I think you will have a visitor today," he said. "It has happened
+that I have been able to do a service to the son of Mr. Cotter,
+a wealthy banker. I am going to dine there this evening. He asked
+me about my friends in London, and I mentioned that my only lady
+friends were you and Millicent. He asked a few questions as to where
+you were living, and so on, and said that his wife would have much
+pleasure in calling and introducing Millicent into society. As
+your life is very dull here, and it is clearly very desirable that
+Millicent should go into society, I gladly accepted the offer, and
+I believe that she will call today."
+
+"That will be very nice indeed, Mark. Millicent is not complaining,
+but she must have felt it very dull. I have even felt it so myself
+after the cheerful society we had at home."
+
+"I don't know that I shall like it," Millicent said doubtfully.
+
+"Oh, yes, you will, Millicent; and besides, it will be good for
+you. It is not natural for a girl of your age to be here without
+friends, and I shall be very glad to know that you are going to
+mix a little with other people."
+
+Mrs. Cotter called that afternoon, and three days later Mark met
+Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent at a dinner party at the banker's, and
+Mrs. Cotter introduced them very warmly to several of her friends,
+with the result that in a very short time they were frequently
+invited out, while they became very intimate with the banker and
+his wife, and often spent the day there.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV.
+
+
+Some little time after this Mark was intrusted by his chief with
+the work of discovering a man who had committed a very atrocious
+murder, and was, it was tolerably certain, hiding in the slums of
+Westminster. It was the first business of the kind that had been
+confided to him, and he was exceedingly anxious to carry it out
+successfully. He dressed himself as a street hawker, and took a
+small lodging in one of the lanes, being away the greater portion
+of the day ostensibly on his business, and of an evening dropped
+into some of the worst public houses in the neighborhood. He was
+at first viewed with some suspicion, but it was not long before
+he became popular. He let it be understood that he had got into
+trouble down in the country, and that he was quite ready to take
+part in any job that promised to be profitable. But he principally
+owed his popularity to the fact that the bully of the locality picked
+a quarrel with him, and, to the astonishment of those present, Mark
+invited him to go outside.
+
+"You had better make it up with him, mate," a man sitting by his
+side whispered. "He was in the prize ring at one time, and thrashed
+big Mike Hartley at Kennington. He had to give it up owing to having
+fought a cross. He would kill you in five minutes."
+
+"I will chance that," Mark said quietly, as he moved towards the
+door. "I don't think that he is stronger than I am, and I can use
+my fists a bit, too."
+
+By the time they had taken off their upper garments a crowd had
+assembled. The news that a hawker was going to stand up against
+Black Jim circulated rapidly, and caused intense excitement. To
+the astonishment of the spectators, the bully from the first had
+not a shadow of a chance, and at the end of the third round was
+carried away senseless, while the hawker had not received a scratch.
+A few days later Mark, who, on the strength of his prowess, had
+had two or three hints that he could be put up to a good thing if
+he was inclined to join, was going down to Westminster when two
+men stopped and looked after him.
+
+"I tell you, Emerson, that is the fellow. I could swear to him
+anywhere. What he is got up like that for I cannot tell you, but
+I should not be surprised if he is one of that Bow Street gang.
+He called himself Mark Thorndyke, and Chetwynd said that he was a
+gentleman of property; but that might have been part of the plant
+to catch us. I have never been able to understand how a raw countryman
+could have caught you palming that card. I believe that fellow is
+a Bow Street runner; if so, it is rum if we cannot manage to get
+even with him before we go. It seemed to me that luck had deserted
+us altogether; but this looks as if it was going to turn again.
+Let's go after him."
+
+Keeping some fifty yards behind him, they watched Mark to his
+lodgings, waited until he came out again, and followed him to a
+public house.
+
+"He is acting as a detective, sure enough," Emerson said. "The
+question is, what are we to do next?"
+
+In half an hour Mark came out again. Several people nodded to
+him as he passed them, but they saw a big man, who happened to be
+standing under a lamp, turn his back suddenly as Mark approached him,
+and, after he had passed, stand scowling after him, and muttering
+deep curses. Flash at once went up to him. "Do you know who that
+fellow is, my man?" The fellow turned savagely upon him.
+
+"I don't know who he is; but what is that to you?"
+
+"He is not a friend of ours," Flash said quietly; "quite the
+contrary. We have known him when he was not got up like this, and
+we are rather curious to know what he is doing here."
+
+"Do you mean that?"
+
+"I do; I owe the fellow a grudge."
+
+"So do I," the man growled. "Just step up this next turning; there
+won't be anyone about there. Now, then, what do yer want to know?"
+
+"I want to know who he is."
+
+"Well, he calls himself a hawker; but my idea of him is he is one
+of the fancy, perhaps a west countryman, who is keeping dark here
+till he can get a match on. I have been a prize fighter myself,
+but he knocked me out in three rounds the other day."
+
+"Well, the last time I saw him," Flash said, "he was dressed as a
+swell. My idea of him is, he is a Bow Street runner, and he is got
+up like this to lay his hands on some of the fellows down here."
+
+"You don't mean it!" the man said with a deep oath. "Then I can
+tell you he has come to the wrong shop. I have only got to whisper
+it about, and his life would not be worth an hour's purchase. I had
+meant to stick a knife in him on the first opportunity, but this
+will save me the trouble."
+
+"Well, you can have your revenge and five guineas besides," Flash
+said. "But we must be there at the time. I should like him to know
+that I was at the bottom of his being caught."
+
+They stood talking together for a few minutes, and then separated,
+Flash and his companion going back to a quiet lodging they had
+taken until they could finish their arrangements for disposing of
+their furniture and belongings before going abroad, while at the same
+time they finished plucking a country greenhorn they had met at a
+coffee house. Two days later, wrapped up in great coats, and with
+rough caps pulled down over their eyes, they entered the thieves'
+resort half an hour before Mark's usual time of getting there. A
+larger number of men than usual were assembled, and among them was
+Black Jim. The men were all talking excitedly, and were evidently
+furious at the news that the pugilist had just told them.
+
+"Those are the gents that have given me the office," he said, as
+Flash and his companion entered. "They can tell yer he is one of
+that cursed Bow Street lot."
+
+"That is right enough, my men," Flash said. "He and four of his
+mates broke into a place where we were having a bit of play, three
+weeks since, marched us all away to Bow Street, and shut the place
+up. I don't know what he is down here for, but you may be sure that
+it's for no good to some of you. We owe him a heavy one ourselves.
+He came spying on us dressed up as a swell and spoilt our game,
+and got the darbies put on us, and we have sworn to get even with
+him."
+
+"You will get even, don't you fear," one of the men growled, "and
+more than even, strike me blind if you don't."
+
+"Look here, lads," Flash said. "There is one thing I say--don't
+use your knives on him; remember he is a runner, and no doubt his
+chief knows all that he is doing, and no doubt ordered him to come
+here. There will be a big search, you may be sure, when he don't
+turn up to make his report. So don't let's have any bloodshed. Let
+the thing be done quietly."
+
+"We can chuck his body into the river," one said.
+
+"Yes, but if it is picked up with half a dozen holes in it, you
+may be sure that they will be down here, and like enough every man
+who has used this place will be arrested; you know that when there
+are twenty men in a job the chances are that one will slip his neck
+out of the halter by turning King's evidence."
+
+An angry growl went round the room.
+
+"Well, you know well enough it is so, it is always the case; besides,
+we ought to give him a little time to prepare himself. My idea is
+that the best plan will be to bind and gag him first, then we can
+hold a little court over him, and let him know what is coming. An
+hour later, when the place gets a bit quiet, we can carry him down
+to the river--it is not above fifty yards away--tie a heavy
+weight round his neck, cut his cords the last thing, and chuck him
+over; if his body is found, it will be thought it is that of some
+chap tired of life who took pains to drown himself pretty quickly,
+and there won't be any fuss over him, and there will be nothing to
+come upon any of you fellows for."
+
+There was a general murmur of assent. Several of those present
+had already committed themselves to some extent with the supposed
+hawker, and were as eager as Flash himself that he should be killed;
+still, all felt that it was as well that it should be managed with
+the least possible risk of discovery, for while an ordinary man
+could be put out of the way without any trouble arising, the fact
+that he was a Bow Street runner added enormously to the risk of
+the discovery of his fate.
+
+There was a little talk, and then two of the men went out and
+brought back a couple of strong ropes. A few minutes after their
+return Mark Thorndyke came in. He paused as he entered the room,
+in surprise at the silence that reigned, for he was accustomed to
+be greeted with friendly exclamations. However, as he walked in
+the door closed, and then suddenly, with shouts of "Down with the
+spy!" the men sprang from their seats and made a sudden rush at
+him. For a minute the struggle was tremendous; man after man went
+down under Mark's blows, others clung onto him from behind, a rope
+was passed round his legs and pulled, and he fell down with a crash,
+bringing down five or six of his assailants; a minute later he was
+gagged and bound.
+
+While the struggle was going on no one noticed that a Lascar's
+face was pressed against the window; it disappeared as soon as Mark
+fell, and ten minutes later a dark faced sailor ran into Gibbons';
+it was a quiet evening at Ingleston's, and Gibbons, after smoking
+a pipe with half a dozen of the pugilists, had just returned.
+
+"Hallo," he said, as he opened the door, "what the deuce do you
+want?"
+
+The man was for a moment too breathless to answer.
+
+"You know Mr. Thorndyke," he said at last, in very fair English.
+
+"Yes, I know him. Well, what of him?"
+
+"He has been attacked by a number of thieves in a public house near
+the river, at Westminster, and he will be murdered unless you go
+with others to help him."
+
+"What the deuce was he doing there?" Gibbons muttered, and then,
+seizing his cap, said to the Lascar,
+
+"Come along with me; it aint likely that we shall be in time, but
+we will try, anyhow."
+
+He ran to Ingleston's.
+
+"Come along, Ingleston," he exclaimed, "and all of you. You all
+know Mr. Thorndyke. This man says he has been attacked by a gang
+down at Westminster, and will be murdered. I am afraid we shan't
+be in time, but it is worth trying."
+
+The prize fighters all leaped to their feet. Mark had sparred with
+several of them, and, being open handed and friendly, was generally
+liked. In a moment, headed by Ingleston and Gibbons, they started
+at the top of their speed, and in less than a quarter of an hour
+were at bank side.
+
+"That is the house," the sailor said, pointing to the public, where
+a red blind had been lowered at the window, and two men lounged
+outside the door to tell any chance customer that might come along
+he was not wanted there at present.
+
+Inside a mock trial had been going on, and Mark had been sentenced
+to death as a spy, not a voice being raised in his defense. As
+soon as he had been lifted up and seated so that he could see the
+faces of those present, he recognized the two gamblers, and saw
+at once that his fate was sealed; even had they not been there the
+chance of escape would have been small. The fact that one of the
+detectives had been caught under circumstances when there was but
+slight chance of its ever being known how he came to his end, was
+in itself sufficient to doom him. Several of the men present had
+taken him into their confidence, and he had encouraged them to do
+so, not that he wanted to entrap them, or that he intended to do
+so, but in order to obtain a clew through them as to the hiding
+place of the man he was in search of.
+
+The savage exultation on the faces of the two gamblers, however,
+was sufficient to extinguish any ray of hope. He felt sure at once
+that they had been the authors of his seizure, and that no thought
+of mercy would enter the minds of these two scoundrels whose plans
+he had frustrated, whose position he had demolished, and to whom
+he had caused the loss of a large sum of money. Neither Flash nor
+Emerson would have taken share in a crime known to so many had they
+not been on the point of leaving England. Their names were known to
+no one there, and even should some of these afterwards peach they
+would at least be safe. Mark had been asked whether he could deny
+that he was a member of the detective force, and had shaken his
+head. Even if he had told a lie, which he would not do, the lie
+would have been a useless one. No one would have believed it, for
+the two gamblers would have been witnesses that he was so.
+
+He had been placed in one corner of the room, so that what light
+there was would not fall on his face, and had anyone entered they
+would not have noticed that he was gagged. One, indeed, had suggested
+that it would be better to lay him under one of the benches, but
+Black Jim said, with a brutal laugh:
+
+"No, no; it is better that we should keep sight of him, and if
+anyone asks a question of course we can say that the gentleman has
+the toothache."
+
+Presently Flash spoke to the ruffian in a low voice.
+
+"Yes, I think you are right," he replied. "Look here," he went on,
+raising his voice. "There is no occasion to have such a lot in this
+business; Jake Watson, Bill the Tinker, and me are quite enough to
+carry him to his bed. I reckon the rest had better make themselves
+scarce when the times comes, go home, and keep their mouths shut.
+I need not say that anyone who lets his tongue wag about it is
+likely to come to a worse end than this bloodhound. We will have
+another glass of grog before you turn out; the streets won't be
+quiet for another hour yet, and there is another guinea of this
+worthy hawker's to be spent. Summers, make another big bowl of
+punch. Don't put so much water in it as you did in the last."
+
+The landlord, a notorious ruffian, was just coming into the room
+with a huge bowl when there was the sound of a scuffle outside.
+
+"You had better see what is up," Black Jim said, and two of the
+men nearest the door unbarred and opened it. As they did so there
+was a rush, and eight powerful men ran in, knocking to the floor
+those who had opened the door. The rest sprang to their feet;
+Gibbons looked round, and as his eye fell upon Mark, who had, the
+moment the men inside rose, got into a standing position, Gibbons
+launched himself towards him, striking four of the ruffians who
+endeavored to stop him to the ground with his crushing blows.
+
+"This way," he shouted to his friends. "Ingleston and Tring, do
+you keep the door."
+
+The moment the six men had closed round Mark, one of them, taking
+out his knife, cut the cords, removed the bandage from his mouth,
+and extricated the gag. The name of the two prize fighters had
+created something like a panic among the crowd, which had increased
+when one of them shouted, "It is Charley Gibbons."
+
+Flash and Emerson sprang to their feet with the rest, and the latter
+shouted, "Go at them, men; there are only eight of them, and we
+are twenty. Knife them, or you will all hang for this job."
+
+The knowledge of their danger was evident to all the men, and,
+nerved by desperation, they rushed at the prize fighters; but the
+eight were now nine, and each of them in a fray of this kind was
+equal to half a dozen ordinary men. Scarce a word was spoken, but
+the sound of crushing blows and scuffling, and an occasional, oath,
+made a confused din in the half lighted room. Mark burst his way
+through his assailants to the spot where Flash and Emerson were
+standing, somewhat in the rear of the crowd, for they had been
+sitting at the other end of the room. Flash had a pistol in his
+hand, but the man who was standing in front of him was struck with
+such violence that he fell backwards, knocking Emerson to the ground
+and almost upsetting Flash, and before the latter could steady
+himself Mark struck him with all his force under the chin. A moment
+later the landlord blew out the two candies, and in the darkness
+the ruffians made a dash for the door, carried Tring and Ingleston
+off their feet, and rushed out into the lane.
+
+"If the man who blew those candles out don't light them again at
+once," Gibbons shouted, "I, Charley Gibbons, tell him that I will
+smash him and burn this place over his head; he had best be quick
+about it."
+
+The landlord, cowed with the threat, soon returned with a candle
+from the kitchen, and lit those that he had extinguished.
+
+"Well, Mr. Thorndyke, we just arrived in time, I fancy," Gibbons
+said.
+
+"You have saved my life, Gibbons--you and the others. How you
+got to know that I was here I cannot imagine. I would have been a
+dead man in another half hour if you had not arrived. I thank you
+all from the bottom of my heart."
+
+"That is all right, sir," Gibbons said. "It is a pleasure to give
+such scoundrels as these a lesson. Is anyone hurt? I fancy I have
+got a scratch or two."
+
+Several of the men had been cut with knives, but the blows had
+been given so hurriedly that no one was seriously injured. Twelve
+men lay on the ground.
+
+"Now sir, what shall we do with these fellows?"
+
+"I should say we had better leave them alone, Gibbons. I don't
+want any row over the affair. It is the work of these two fellows
+here. I think I pretty well settled one of them."
+
+Gibbons stooped over Flash.
+
+"You have broken his jaw, sir; but he will come round in time. I
+believe this other fellow is only shamming. I don't see any of our
+handiwork upon his face. The others have all got as much as they
+want, I think," and taking a candle he looked at their faces.
+"There is not one of them who will want to show up for a week or
+so," he said, "and there are two or three who will carry the marks
+to their graves. Well, sir, if you don't want anything done to them,
+the sooner we are off the better. Those fellows who got away may
+bring a lot of others down upon us. As long as it is only fists,
+we could march through Westminster; but as they would have knives,
+it is just as well to get out of it before there is any trouble.
+You are got up in a rum way, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"Yes; I will tell you about it afterwards. I agree with you that
+we had best be moving at once."
+
+But the men who had fled were too glad to have made their escape to
+think of anything but to make for their dens as quick as possible,
+and the party passed through the lanes into the open space in front
+of Parliament House without interruption.
+
+"We will go up to your place, Ingleston, and talk it over there,"
+Mark said. "You can get those cuts bound up, and I shall be very
+glad to get a drink. That thing they shoved into my mouth hurt my
+tongue a good deal, and I have not gone through a pleasant half
+hour, I can tell you."
+
+He walked up past Whitehall with Gibbons and Ingleston, the others
+going in pairs, so as not to attract attention. As soon as they
+reached Ingleston's place, the latter told the man in the bar to
+put the shutters up, led the way into the bar parlor, and mixed a
+large bowl of punch.
+
+"Now, Gibbons, in the first place," Mark said, after quenching his
+thirst, "how did you know of my being in danger?"
+
+"Well, sir, a black sailor chap ran into my place suddenly and told
+me."
+
+"Do you mean a colored man, Gibbons?"
+
+"Yes, sir, one of those Lascar chaps you see about the docks. I
+did not ask any questions, but ran as hard as I could. I had only
+left here five minutes before, and knew that Tring and some of the
+others would still be here. They did not lose a moment, and off
+we went. The sailor chap he kept ahead. I tried to come up to him
+two or three times to get to know something about it, but he always
+seemed to quicken his pace when I was coming up, and I soon got
+too blown to want to do much talking. He led us to the door, and
+after that I saw nothing more of him. What became of him I don't
+know. I expect he was better at running than he was at fighting."
+
+"It is curious," Mark said thoughtfully. "He might have been in the
+place when I went in, and slipped out while I was making a fight
+for it. I have seen a Lascar several times while I have been down
+there. I dare say it was the same man, though why he should take
+such trouble for the sake of a stranger I don't know. There seems
+to be a good many of them about, for now I think of it, I have run
+against them several times wherever I have been in town."
+
+"Now, sir, what did they want to kill you for?"
+
+"Well, Gibbons, it happened in this way. My father, you know, was
+murdered by a man who had a grudge against him, and who is both a
+highwayman and a house breaker."
+
+"They don't often go together," Ingleston said. "The highwaymen
+generally look down upon the burglars and keep themselves to
+themselves."
+
+"I hew they do, Ingleston; but this fellow has been a convict, and
+is not particular what he turns his hand to. The detectives have
+been after him for a long time, but have failed, and I determined
+to take the matter up myself, and ever since I have been up here
+I have been hunting about in the worst quarters of the town. The
+people of Bow Street have aided me in every way they could, and I
+suppose some of these men have seen me go in or out of the place.
+Of course, when I am going into these bad quarters, I put on a
+disguise and manage to get in with some of these thieves, and so
+to try to get news of him through them. Three weeks ago I decided
+to try Westminster. I was getting on uncommonly well there, principally
+because I gave a tremendous thrashing to a fellow they call Black
+Jim. He has been a prize fighter."
+
+"I know him," Tring said; "it was the fellow that was kicked out
+for selling a fight. He was not a bad man with his fists, either;
+but I expect you astonished him, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"Yes, I knocked him out of time in three rounds. Well, he has been
+a bully down there, and everyone was very glad he was taken down.
+After that I got to know several of the worst lot down there. They
+fancied that I was one of themselves, and several of them made
+proposals to me to join them, and, of course, I encouraged the idea
+in hopes of coming upon the man that I was after. Then some fellow
+in the street recognized me, I suppose, and denounced me to the rest
+as being one of the runners. I suppose he told them this evening,
+before I went in.
+
+"The place was a regular thieves' den, which, of course, was why
+I went there. Naturally they were furious, especially those who
+had been proposing to me to join them. Anyhow, they had evidently
+settled among themselves that I was to be put out of the way, and
+directly I went in I was attacked. I knocked down a few of them,
+but they jumped on my back, and one of them managed to get a rope
+round my legs, and down I went with three or four of them, and
+before I could get up again they had tied and gagged me. Then they
+held a sort of court. Man after man got up and said that I had been
+drawing them on to find out what they were up to, and had agreed
+to join them, of course with the intention of getting them caught
+in the act, and two got up and said that they knew me as one of
+the runners. They all agreed that I must be put out of the way.
+
+"I suppose, as the landlord did not want blood spilt in his house,
+they did not knife me at once; however, they told me that they had
+decided that as soon as the coast was clear I should be carried
+down to the river, and chucked in, with an old anchor tied to my
+neck. I had just a gleam of hope a short time before you came in,
+for then it had been settled that it was just as well no more should
+be engaged in the affair than was necessary, and that Black Jim,
+with two others, whom I had been talking to, and the two men who
+had told them that I was a runner, should manage it, and the rest
+were to go off to their homes.
+
+"I had been all the time trying to loosen my ropes, and had got one
+of my hands nearly free, and I thought that if they waited another
+half hour I might have got them both free, and been able to make a
+bit of a fight of it, though I had very little hope of getting my
+legs free.
+
+"However, I had my eye on the knife of the man who was sitting next
+to me, and who was one of those who was to stay. I thought that
+if I had my hands free, I could snatch his knife, settle him, and
+then cut the ropes from my legs; that done, I could, I think, have
+managed Black Jim and the others. As for the men who denounced me,
+they were small men, and I had no fear of them in a fight, unless;
+as I thought likely enough, they might have pistols. One of them is
+the fellow whose jaw I broke; I hit him hard, for he had a pistol
+in his hand."
+
+"There is no doubt you hit him hard," Gibbons said dryly. "He looked
+a better sort than the rest."
+
+"Yes, the fellow was a card sharper whom I once detected at cheating;
+and so was the one who was lying next to him, the man whom you said
+you thought was shamming."
+
+By this time the men's wounds were all bandaged up. Mark told them
+that he would be round there again in the morning, and hoped that
+they would all be there.
+
+"I shall go home at once, and turn in," he said. "Straining at
+those cords has taken the skin off my wrists, and I feel stiff all
+over; it will be a day or two, Gibbons, before I am able to put
+the gloves on again. I wish I could find that Lascar; I owe him a
+heavy debt."
+
+As Mark made his way home he thought a good deal about the colored
+sailor. If the man had been in the den the ruffians would hardly
+have ventured to have attacked him in the presence of a stranger.
+Of course, he might have been passing, and have seen the fray
+through the window, but in that case he would run to the nearest
+constable. How could he know anything about his habits, and why
+should he have gone to Gibbons for assistance? That, and the fact
+that he had so often observed Lascars in the places he had gone to,
+certainly looked as if he had been watched, and if so, it could only
+be connected with those diamonds. It was a curious thing altogether.
+
+The next morning he went early to Bow Street. As soon as the chief
+came he related the events of the previous evening, and told him
+that it was Flash and Emerson who had denounced him.
+
+"I know the place," the officer said. "It is one of the worst
+thieves' dens in London. However, it is just as well you decided
+not to take any steps. Of course, all the fellows would have sworn
+that they did not intend to do any harm, but that Flash had put
+them up to frightening you, and I doubt whether any jury would have
+convicted. As to the other men, we know that they are all thieves,
+and some of them worse; but the mere fact that they proposed to you
+to join in their crimes won't do, as no actual crime was committed.
+However, I shall have the gang closely watched, and, at any rate,
+you had better leave Westminster alone; someone else must take up
+the work of looking for that man you were on the watch for. Anyhow,
+you had best take a week's rest; there is no doubt you have had a
+very narrow escape. It is strange about that Lascar; he might not
+have cared for going in to take part in the fray, but you would
+have thought that he would have waited outside to get a reward for
+bringing those men to your rescue."
+
+As Mark did not care to tell about the diamonds till the time came
+for getting them, he made no reply, beyond expressing an agreement
+with the chief's surprise at the man not having remained to the
+end of the fray. On leaving Bow Street he went up to Ingleston's.
+The men who had rescued him the night before were gathered there;
+and he presented each of them with a check for twenty-five guineas.
+
+"I know very well," he said, "that you had no thought of reward
+when you hurried down to save me, but that is no reason why I should
+not show my gratitude to you for the service you have rendered
+me; some of you might very well have been seriously hurt, if not
+killed, by their knives. At any rate, I insist upon you taking
+it; money is always useful, you know, and it is not often so well
+earned as this."
+
+The men were greatly pleased, and Tring said:
+
+"Well, sir, if you get into another scrape you may be sure that
+you can count upon us."
+
+"I shall try and not get into any more," Mark laughed. "This has
+been a good deal more serious than I had bargained for, and I shall
+be very careful in the future."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV.
+
+
+"The burglary season seems to have recommenced in earnest," Mark's
+chief said some nine months after he had been at work. "For a time
+there had been a lull, as you know, but I have had three reports
+this week, and it strikes me that they are by the same hand as
+before; of course I may be mistaken, but they are done in a similar
+way, the only difference being that there is ground for believing
+that only one man is engaged in them. I fancy the fellow that you
+are after has either been away from London for some time, or has
+been keeping very quiet. At any rate, we have every ground for
+believing that he keeps himself aloof from London thieves, which
+is what I should expect from such a man. If one has nerve enough
+to do it, there is nothing like working singly; when two or three
+men are engaged, there is always the risk of one being caught and
+turning Queen's evidence, or of there being a quarrel, and of his
+peaching from revenge.
+
+"If your man has been away from town, he has certainly not been
+working any one district; of course, one gets the usual number
+of reports from different quarters; but although burglaries are
+frequent enough, there has been no complaint of a sudden increase
+of such crimes as there would have been judging from the numerous
+daring attempts here, had Bastow been concerned; therefore I feel
+sure that he has been living quietly. He would have his mate's
+share--that man you shot, you know--of the plunder they made
+together; he would know that after that affair at your place there
+would be a vigilant hunt for him, and it is likely enough that he
+has retired altogether from business for a time.
+
+"However, men of that sort can never stand a quiet life long, and
+are sure sooner or later to take to their trade again, if only
+for the sake of its excitement. Now that the burglaries have begun
+again, I shall be glad if you will devote yourself entirely to this
+business. You have served a good apprenticeship, and for our sake
+as well as yours I should be glad for you to have it in hand."
+
+"I shall be very pleased to do so, sir. Although we do not know
+where he is to be found, I think I can say that it is not in the
+slums of London; it seems to me that he may be quietly settled as
+an eminently respectable man almost under our noses; he may show
+himself occasionally at fashionable resorts, and may be a regular
+attendant at horse races.
+
+"He would not run any appreciable risk in doing so, for his face
+is quite unknown to anyone except the constables who were present
+at his trial, and even these would scarcely be likely to recognize
+him, for he was then but eighteen, while he is now six or seven
+and twenty, and no doubt the life he has led must have changed him
+greatly."
+
+"I quite agree with you," the chief said. "After the first hunt
+for him was over, he might do almost anything without running much
+risk. Well, I put the matter in your hands, and leave it to you
+to work out in your own way; you have given ample proof of your
+shrewdness and pluck, and in this case especially I know that you
+will do everything that is possible. Of course you will be relieved
+of all other duties, and if it takes you months before you can
+lay hands upon him, we shall consider it time well spent, if you
+succeed at last. From time to time change your quarters, but let
+me know your address, so that, should I learn anything that may
+be useful, I can communicate with you at once. You had better take
+another name than that by which you are known in the force. I shall
+be glad if, after thinking the matter over, you will write me a
+few lines stating what you propose to do in the first place."
+
+Mark went back to his lodgings, and sat there for some time, thinking
+matters over. His first thought was to attend the races for a time,
+but seeing the number of people there, and his own ignorance of
+Bastow's appearance, he abandoned the idea, and determined to try
+a slower but more methodical plan. After coming to that conclusion
+he put on his hat and made his way to Mrs. Cunningham's.
+
+"Well, Mr. Constable," Millicent said saucily, as he entered, "any
+fresh captures?"
+
+"No, I think that I have for the present done with that sort of
+thing; I have served my apprenticeship, and am now setting up on
+my own account."
+
+"How is that, Mark?"
+
+"There is reason to believe that Bastow has begun his work again
+near London. As I have told you, it is absolutely certain that he
+is not hiding in any of the places frequented by criminals here,
+and there is every reason for supposing that he has been leading a
+quiet life somewhere, or that he has been away in the country. As
+long as that was the case, there was nothing to be done; but now
+that he seems to have set to work again, it is time for me to be on
+the move. I have seen the chief this morning, and he has released
+me from all other' duty, and given me carte blanche to work in my
+own way."
+
+"Then why don't you leave the force altogether, Mark? You know that
+I have always thought it hateful that you should be working under
+orders, like any other constable."
+
+"Of course, women don't like to be under orders, Millicent; but
+men are not so independent, and are quite content to obey those who
+are well qualified to give orders. I have had a very interesting
+time of it."
+
+"Very interesting!" she said scornfully. "You have nearly been
+killed or shot half a dozen times; you have been obliged to wear
+all sorts of dirty clothes, to sleep in places where one would
+not put a dog, and generally to do all sorts of things altogether
+unbecoming in your position."
+
+"My dear, I have no particular position," he laughed, and then went
+on more seriously: "My one position at present is that of avenger
+of my father's murder, and nothing that can assist me in the task
+is unbecoming to me; but, as I said, it has been interesting, I may
+almost say fascinating, work. I used to be fond of hunting, but I
+can tell you that it is infinitely more exciting to hunt a man than
+it is to hunt a fox. You are your own hound, you have to pick up
+the scent, to follow it up, however much the quarry may wind and
+double, and when at last you lay your hand upon his shoulder and
+say, 'In the King's name,' there is an infinitely keener pleasure
+than there is when the hounds run down the fox. One sport is
+perhaps as dangerous as the other: in the one case your horse may
+fail at a leap and you may break your neck, in the other you may
+get a bullet in your head; so in that respect there is not much to
+choose between man and fox hunting. There is the advantage, though,
+that in the one you have to depend upon your horse's strength, and
+in the other on your own courage."
+
+"I know that you are an enthusiast over it, Mark, and I can fancy
+that if I were a big strong man, as you are, I might do the same;
+but if you are going now to try by yourself, why should you not
+leave the force altogether?"
+
+"Because, in the first place, I shall get all the information they
+obtain, and can send for any assistance that I may require. In the
+next place, by showing this little staff with its silver crown, I
+show that I am a Bow Street runner, and can obtain information at
+once from all sorts of people which I could not get without its
+aid."
+
+"Well, I won't say anything more against it, Mark. How are you
+going to begin?"
+
+"I mean to go the round of all the places near London--say,
+within ten miles. I shall stay from a week to a fortnight in each,
+take a quiet lodging, give out that I am on the lookout for a small
+house with a garden, and get to talk with people of all kinds."
+
+"But I cannot see what you have to inquire for."
+
+"I imagine that Bastow will have taken just the sort of house that
+I am inquiring for, and in the course of my questions I may hear
+of someone living in just that sort of way--a retired life, not
+making many friends, going up to London sometimes, and keeping,
+perhaps, a deaf old woman as a servant, or perhaps a deaf old man
+--someone, you see, who would not be likely to hear him if he came
+home in the middle of the night, or in the early morning. Once I
+hear of such a man, I should ascertain his age, and whether generally
+he agreed in appearance with what Bastow is likely to be by this
+time, then get down one of the constables who was at the trial,
+and take his opinion on the subject, after which we should only
+have to watch the house at night and pounce upon him as he came
+back from one of his excursions. That is the broad outline of my
+plan. I cannot help thinking that in the long run I shall be able
+to trace him, and of course it will make it all the easier if he
+takes to stopping coaches or committing murderous burglaries."
+
+"Then I suppose we are not going to see you often, Mark?"
+
+"Well, not so often as you have done, Millicent, for some time, at
+any rate. I shall not be more than five or six miles away, and I
+shall often ride into town for the evening, and return late with
+some sort of hope that I may be stopped on the road again; it
+would save me a world of trouble, you see, if he would come to me
+instead of my having to find him."
+
+"Which side of London are you going to try first?"
+
+"The south side, certainly; there are a score of places that would
+be convenient to him--Dulwich, Clapham, Tooting, Wimbledon,
+Stockwell; the list is a long one. I should say Wimbledon was about
+the most distant, and I should think that he would not go so far
+as that; if he only acted as a highwayman he might be as far off
+as Epsom; but if he is really the man concerned in these burglaries
+he must be but a short distance away. He would hardly risk having
+to ride very far with the chance of coming upon the patrols. I think
+that I shall begin at Peckham; that is a central sort of position,
+and from there I shall work gradually west; before I do so perhaps
+I shall try Lewisham. He is likely, in any case, to be quite on the
+outskirts of any village he may have settled in, in order that he
+may ride in and out at any hour without his coming and going being
+noticed."
+
+"You certainly seem to have thought it over in all ways, Mark;
+you almost infect me with your ardor, and make me wish that I was
+a man and could help you."
+
+"You are much nicer as you are, Millicent."
+
+The girl tossed her head in disdain at the compliment.
+
+"It is all very well, Mark," she went on, ignoring his speech, "but
+it seems to me that in finding out things a woman would be able
+to do just as much as a man; she can gossip with her neighbors and
+ask about everyone in a place quite as well, if not better, than
+a man."
+
+"Yes I don't doubt that," Mark laughed, "and if I want your aid I
+shall have no hesitation in asking for it. Until then I hope you
+will go on with your painting and harping steadily, like a good
+little girl."
+
+"I am nearly eighteen, sir, and I object to be called a good little
+girl."
+
+"Well, if I were to say a good young woman you would not like it."
+
+"No, I don't think I should. I don't know why, but when anyone says
+a girl is a good young woman or a nice young woman, there always
+seems something derogatory about it; it is almost as bad as saying
+she is a very respectable young person, which is odious."
+
+"Then, you see," he went on, "you are quite getting on in society;
+since Mr. Cotter's introduction to Mrs. Cunningham and his mother's
+subsequent call you have got to know a good many people and go
+about a good deal."
+
+"Yes, it has been more lively of late," she admitted. "At first it
+was certainly monstrously dull here, and I began to think that we
+should have to change our plans and go down again to Weymouth, and
+settle there for a time. Now I am getting contented; but I admit,
+even at the risk of making you conceited, that we shall certainly
+miss you very much, as you have been very good, considering how
+busy you have been, to come in three or four evenings every week
+for a chat."
+
+"There has been nothing very good about it, Millicent; it has been
+very pleasant to me; it is like a bit of old times again when I am
+here with you two, and seem to leave all the excitement of one's
+work behind as I come in at the door."
+
+"I wonder whether the old time will ever come back again, Mark?"
+she said sadly.
+
+"It never can be quite the old time again, but when you are back
+at the old place it may be very near it."
+
+She looked at him reproachfully.
+
+"You think that I shall change my mind, Mark, but at heart you know
+better. The day I am one and twenty I hope to carry out my intentions."
+
+"Well, as I have told you before, Millicent, I cannot control your
+actions, but I am at least master of my own. You can give away
+Crowswood to whom you like, but at least you cannot compel me to
+take it. Make it over to one of the hospitals if you like--that
+is within your power; but it is not in your power to force me
+into the mean action of enriching myself because you have romantic
+notions in your mind. I should scorn myself were I capable of doing
+such an action. I wonder you think so meanly of me as to suppose
+for a moment that I would do so."
+
+"It is a great pity my father did not leave the property outright
+to your father, then all this bother would have been avoided," she
+said quietly. "I should still have had plenty to live upon without
+there being any fear of being loved merely for my money."
+
+"It would have been the same thing if he had," Mark said stubbornly.
+"My father would not have taken it, and I am sure that I should
+not have taken it after him; you are his proper heiress. I don't
+say if he had left a son, and that son had been a second Bastow,
+that one would have hesitated, for he would probably have gambled
+it away in a year, the tenants might have been ruined, and the
+village gone to the dogs. Every man has a right to disinherit an
+unworthy son, but that is a very different thing from disinheriting
+a daughter simply from a whim. Well, don't let us talk about it any
+more, Millicent. It is the only thing that we don't agree about,
+and therefore it is best left alone."
+
+The next day Mark established himself at an inn in Peckham, and
+for six weeks made diligent inquiries, but without success. There
+were at least a dozen men who lived quietly and rode or drove to
+their business in town. Many of them were put aside as needing no
+investigation, having been residents there for years. Some of the
+others he saw start or return, but none of them corresponded in
+any way with the probable appearance of the man for whom he was in
+search. During this time he heard of several private coaches being
+held up on the road between Epsom and London, and three burglaries
+took place at Streatham.
+
+He then moved to Stockwell. Before proceeding there he had his horse
+up again from Crowswood, and rode into Stockwell from the west. He
+was dressed now as a small country squire, and had a valise strapped
+behind his saddle. The inn there was a busy one.
+
+"I want a room," he said, as he alighted. "I shall probably stay
+here a few days."
+
+Presently he had a talk with the landlord.
+
+"I am on the lookout," he said, "for a little place near town. I
+have come in for a small estate in the country, but I have no taste
+for farming, and want to be within easy reach of town, and at the
+same time to have a place with a paddock where I can keep my horse
+and live quietly. I don't much care whether it is here or anywhere
+else within a few miles of town, and I intend to ride about and
+see if I can find a place that will suit me. I do not want to be
+nearer the town than this, for I have not money enough to go the
+pace; still, I should like to be near enough to ride or walk in
+whenever I have a fancy for it."
+
+"I understand, sir. Of course there are plenty of places round here,
+at Clapham and Tooting, and I may say Streatham, but most of them
+are a deal too large for a bachelor, still I have no doubt you
+would find a place to suit you without much difficulty. These sort
+of places are most in request by London tradesmen who have given up
+business and want to get a little way out of town and keep a gig.
+I should say there must be a score of such people living round
+here. I am often asked about such places, but I don't know of one
+to let just at the present moment.
+
+"Still, there ought to be, for of late people have not cared so much
+to come out here; there has been such a scare owing to highwaymen
+and burglars, that men with wives and families don't fancy settling
+out of town, though there aint much work about it, for to every
+one house that is broken into there are thousands that are not,
+and besides, the houses that these fellows try are large places,
+where there is plenty of silver plate and a few gold watches, and
+perhaps some money to be had."
+
+Mark soon made the acquaintance of the stablemen, and a few pints
+of beer put them on good terms with him. Every day he took rides
+round the neighborhood, going out early, stabling his horse, and
+after having a chat with the ostlers, strolling round the place.
+Clapham, Ewell, and Streatham were also visited.
+
+"I know of a place that would just suit you," the ostler at the
+Greyhound at Streatham said to him, on the occasion of his third
+visit there; "but it is let; my old mother is the gentleman's
+housekeeper. He took the place through me, for he rode up just as
+you have done, one afternoon, nigh a year ago. He was from town,
+he was; he told me that he had been going the pace too hard, and
+had to pull in, and wanted a little place where he could keep his
+horse and live quiet for a time. I told him of a place that I thought
+would suit him just outside the town, and he called in the next
+day and told me he had taken it. 'Now,' he said, 'I want a woman
+as house keeper; an old woman, you know. I cannot be bothered with
+a young one. If you speak a civil word to a wench she soon fancies
+you are in love with her. I want one who can cook a chop or a steak,
+fry me a bit of bacon, and boil an egg and keep the place tidy. I
+intend to look after my horse myself.'
+
+"'Well, sir,' I said, 'there is my old mother. She is a widow, and
+it is as much as she can do to keep off the parish. She is reckoned
+a tidy cook and a good cleaner, and she could keep herself well
+enough if it wasn't that she is so hard of hearing that many people
+don't care to employ her.'
+
+"'I don't care a rap about that,' he said. 'I shall not need to talk
+to her except to tell her what I will have for dinner, and if she
+is deaf she won't want to be away gossiping. Does she live near
+here?'
+
+"'She lives in the town,' I said. 'I can fetch her down in half an
+hour.'
+
+"'That will do,' says he. 'I am going to have lunch. When I have,
+done I will come out and speak with her.'
+
+"Well, sir, he engaged her right off, and he tipped me a guinea
+for finding the place for him, and there he has been ever since.
+It was a lucky job for mother, for she says there never was a
+gentleman that gave less trouble. He is a wonderful quiet man, and
+in general stops at home all the day smoking and reading. He has
+a boy comes in two or three times a week to work in the garden.
+Sometimes of an evening he rides up to town. I expect he cannot
+keep away from the cards altogether."
+
+"Is he an elderly man?" Mark asked.
+
+"Lor', no, sir; under thirty, I should say. He is a free handed
+sort of chap, and though he aint particular about his eating, he
+likes a bottle of good wine, the old woman says, even if it is only
+with a chop. He never rides past here and I happen to be outside
+without tossing me a shilling to drink his health."
+
+Mark went into the house and ordered lunch. It would not have
+done to have asked any more questions or to have shown any special
+interest in the matter, but he felt so excited that he could not
+have avoided doing so had he waited longer with the ostler. After
+he had finished his meal he strolled out again into the stable
+yard.
+
+"Well," he said to the ostler, "can't you put me up to another
+good thing, just as you told that gentleman you were speaking to
+me about?"
+
+"There are two or three places that I know of that might suit you,
+sir. There is a house on the hill. I know that it has got a paddock,
+but I don't know how big it is; it is in general known as Hawleys
+--that is the name of the last people who lived there. Anyone will
+tell you which is the house. Then there is another place. You turn
+to the right the third turning on the hill; it stands by itself two
+or three hundred yards down; it has got a goodish bit of ground.
+There is only one house beyond it; that is the one where my mother
+lives. That was an old farm once, but this was built later. I
+believe the ground belonged to the farm. You will know it by a big
+tree in front of it; it stands back forty feet or so from the road."
+
+"Where does the road lead to?"
+
+"Well, sir, it aint much of a road beyond the next house; it is
+only a lane, but you can get through that way into the main road,
+through Tooting down into Balham, and on to Wimbledon."
+
+"'I think I will go and have a look at both those places," Mark
+said.
+
+"Will you take your horse, sir?"
+
+"No; I suppose it is not much above half a mile?"
+
+"About that, sir."
+
+"Then I will walk; I shall not be likely to find anyone to hold my
+horse there."
+
+Mark had no difficulty in finding the house. It looked as if it
+had been untenanted for some time, and in the window was a notice
+that for keys and information applications were to be made at a shop
+in the High Street. Well pleased to find that there was no one in
+the house, Mark entered the gate and passed round into what at one
+time had been a kitchen garden behind it; at the bottom of this
+was a field of three or four acres.
+
+The ground was separated by a hedge from that of the house beyond.
+This was fully a hundred yards away. A well bred horse was grazing
+in the field, a man smoking a pipe was watching a boy doing gardening
+work behind the house. Mark remained for nearly an hour concealed
+behind the hedge in hopes that he would come nearer. At the end
+of that time, however, he went into the house, and after waiting
+another ten minutes Mark also left, resisting the temptation to
+walk along the road and take a closer look at it, for he felt that
+such a step would be dangerous, for should the man notice anyone
+looking at the place his suspicions might be aroused.
+
+It was evident that the lane was very little used; in many cases
+the grass grew across it. There were marks of horses' feet, but
+none of wheels, and he concluded that when going up to town the
+man came that way and rode quietly through Streatham, for the hoof
+prints all pointed in that direction, and that on his return at
+night he came up the lane from the other road.
+
+"Well, master, what do you think of the houses?" the ostler asked
+on his return to the inn.
+
+"I have only been to the one in the lane that you spoke of, for I
+want to get back to town. I' had a good look at it, but it is rather
+a dreary looking place, and evidently wants a lot of repairs before
+it can be made comfortable. The next time that I am down I will
+look at the other."
+
+Mounting his horse, he rode at a rapid pace into London, and
+dismounted at Bow Street.
+
+"You have news, I see, Mr. Thorndyke," the chief said when he
+entered.
+
+"I have, sir; I believe that I have marked the man down; at any
+rate, if it is not he, it is a criminal of some sort--of that I
+have no doubt."
+
+"That is good news indeed," the chief said. "Now tell me all about
+it."
+
+Mark repeated the story the ostler had told him, and the result of
+his own observations.
+
+"You see," he said, "the man, whether Bastow or not, has clearly
+taken the place for the purpose of concealment, for he can approach
+it by the lane, which is a very unfrequented one, on his return
+from his expeditions. He has taken on a deaf old woman who will not
+hear him ride in at night, and will have no idea at what hours he
+comes home. Riding out through the main street in the afternoon
+he would excite no notice, and the story to the ostler would very
+well account for his taking the house and for his habit of coming
+up here of an afternoon and returning late. I thought it best to
+come back and tell you, and I will adopt any plan that you suggest
+for his capture."
+
+"You say that he has been there for nearly a year?"
+
+"About a year, the ostler said."
+
+"Then one of my men, at least, must have been very careless not to
+have found him out long ago. Let me see;" and he took down a volume
+of reports. "Streatham. Tomlinson has been here a fortnight making
+every inquiry. 'No man of suspicious appearance or of unknown
+antecedents here.'
+
+"Humph! That is not the first time that Tomlinson has failed altogether
+in his duty. However, that does not matter for the moment. What is
+your own idea, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"My idea is that a couple of good men should go down with me to
+Streatham, and that we should be always on the watch in High Street
+until we see him ride past. Directly it is dark we will go to his
+house, fasten the old woman up, and search it thoroughly. If we
+find stolen property so much the better; but in any case we shall
+wait inside the house until he returns, and as he comes in throw
+ourselves upon him before he has time to draw a pistol. I should
+say it would be as well the men should go down in a trap. There is
+an empty house next door, and when we go to search the place we
+can leave the horse and trap inside the gate. Directly we have him
+secure we can fetch up the trap, put him in, and one of the men
+and myself can drive him back here, leaving the other in charge of
+the house, which can then be searched again next day."
+
+"I think that will be a very good plan, and will avoid all unnecessary
+fuss. I will send Malcolm and Chester down with you tomorrow. Where
+will you meet them?"
+
+"I should say that they had better put up at the Greyhound. I
+don't suppose he will go out until six or seven o'clock, but they
+had better be there earlier. One should station himself in the main
+street, the other concealing himself somewhere beyond the fellow's
+house, for it is likely enough that sometimes he may take the other
+way. I will go down to the Greyhound at six, and will wait there
+until one of them brings me news that he has left."
+
+"I think you had better come in in the morning, and give your
+instructions to the men; there will be less fear of any mistake
+being made. I should say you had better put your horse up and come
+here on foot; one can never be too careful when one is dealing
+with so crafty a rogue as this; he certainly does not work with an
+accomplice, but for all that he may have two or three sharp boys
+in his pay, and they may watch this place by turns and carry him
+news of any stir about the office."
+
+"I will walk in," Mark replied. "It is no distance from Stockwell."
+
+Mark slept but little that night. He had believed all along that
+he should be finally successful, but the discovery had come so
+suddenly that it had taken him completely by surprise. It might not
+be the man, and he tried hard to persuade himself that the chances
+were against his being so, so that he should not feel disappointed
+should it turn out that it was some other criminal, for that the
+man was a criminal he had not a shadow of doubt.
+
+The next morning he was at the office early. The chief arrived half
+an hour later, and the two officers were at once called in.
+
+"You will go with Mr. Thorndyke," the chief said, "and he will give
+you instructions. The capture is a very important one, and there
+must be no mistake made. We believe the man to be Bastow. I think
+you were present at his trial, Chester; he escaped from Sydney
+Convict Prison some three years ago, and is, I believe, the author
+of many of the highway robberies and burglaries that have puzzled
+us so. Of course, you will take firearms, but if he is alone you
+will certainly have no occasion to use them, especially as you will
+take him completely by surprise. You will order a gig from Morden,
+and leave here about three o'clock. I should say you had better
+get up as two countrymen who have been up to market. However, Mr.
+Thorndyke will explain the whole matter to you fully."
+
+Mark then went off with the two officers to a private room, and
+went into the whole matter with them.
+
+"I think, Chester," he said, "that you had better watch in the High
+Street, because you know the man. At least, you have seen him, and
+may recognize him again."
+
+"I think I should know him, however much he has changed. . I took
+particular notice of him at the trial, and thought what a hardened
+looking young scamp he was. It is very seldom I forget a face when
+once I have a thorough look at it, and I don't think I am likely
+to forget his."
+
+"Malcolm, I think you cannot do better than take your place in
+the garden of the house next to his; it is a place that has stood
+empty for many months, and there is no chance of anyone seeing
+you. His paddock comes up to the garden, and you can, by placing
+yourself in the corner, see him as he comes out into the lane. As
+soon as you see that he has gone, come back to the Greyhound with
+the news. I shall be there, and you will pick up Chester in the
+High Street as you come along; of course you won't pretend to know
+me, but the mere fact of your coming back will be enough to tell me
+that he has gone. As soon as it gets dark we will pay our reckoning,
+and drive off in the gig, leaving it in the drive in front of the
+house this side of his. I shall have strolled off before, and shall
+be waiting for you there. If he does not come out by ten o'clock
+we can give it up for tonight. You had better say that you have
+changed your mind, and will take beds at the Greyhound; and the
+next morning drive off in your gig and put up again at the inn at
+the other end of the town, the White Horse. I will come over again
+at two o'clock in the afternoon. You will bring handcuffs, and you
+had better also bring a stout rope to tie him with."
+
+When every detail had been arranged, Mark strolled to Dick Chetwynd's
+lodgings.
+
+"Well, Mark what has become of you? I have not seen you for the
+last two months, and I hear that you have not been near Ingleston's
+crib since I saw you."
+
+"No, I have been away on business. You know I told you that I was
+spending much of my time in endeavoring to hunt down my father's
+murderer. I can tell you now that I have been working all the time
+with the Bow Street people, and I think I know every thieves' slum
+in London as well as any constable in the town."
+
+"You don't say so, Mark! Well, I should not like such work as that.
+The prize fighters are a pretty rough lot, but to go to such dens
+as those is enough to make one shudder. But that does not explain
+where you have been now."
+
+"No. Well, having persuaded myself at last that his headquarters
+were not in town, I have been trying the villages round, and I
+believe that I have laid my hands on him at last."
+
+"You don't say so, Mark! Well, I congratulate you heartily, both
+on your having caught the fellow and for having got rid of such
+horrid work. Where is he? Have you got him lodged in jail?"
+
+"No, we are going to capture him tonight; or if not tonight, tomorrow
+night. Two of the Bow Street officers are going down with me, and
+we shall have him as he comes home from one of his expeditions
+either on the highway or as a house breaker. If he does not go this
+evening we shall wait until tomorrow, but at any rate, the first
+time that he goes out we shall have him."
+
+"I have got a special engagement for this evening, Mark, or I would
+offer to go with you and lend you a hand, if necessary."
+
+"There is no occasion for that, Dick. We shall take the fellow by
+surprise as he goes into his own house, and have him handcuffed
+before he can draw a pistol. Then, when we have got him fairly tied
+up, we shall put him into a light cart that we shall have handy,
+and bring him straight to Bow Street. To tell you the truth, I am
+so excited over the thought that I do not know how I should have
+got through the day if I had not come in to have a chat with you."
+
+"I can quite understand that, old fellow. Well, the best thing
+we can do is to take a stroll out and look at the fashions. It is
+early yet, but just at present it is all the rage to turn out early.
+It will do me good too, for I was at Ingleston's last night, and
+the smoke and row has given me a headache. I shall really have to
+give up going there, except when there is an important fight on. It
+is too much to stand, and the tobacco is so bad that I am obliged
+to keep a suit of clothes for the purpose. Let us be off at once."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI.
+
+
+At four o'clock Mark put up his horse at the Greyhound, and chatted
+for a quarter of an hour with the ostler, who had been making
+inquiries, and had heard of one or two other houses in the neighborhood
+which were untenanted. Mark then strolled up the town, exchanging
+a passing glance with Chester, who, in a velveteen coat, low hat
+and gaiters, was chatting with a wagoner going with a load of hay
+for the next morning's market in London. He turned into an inn,
+called for a pint of the best port, and sat down in the parlor
+at a table close to the window, so that he could see all who went
+up or down. He entered into conversation with two or three people
+who came in, and so passed the time till seven, when he felt too
+restless to sit still longer, and went out into the street.
+
+When he was halfway to the Greyhound he heard the sound of a horse's
+hoofs behind him, and saw a quietly dressed man coming along at an
+easy trot. Had it not been that he recognized the horse, he could
+not have felt sure that its rider was the man whose coming he had
+been waiting for, there being nothing in his appearance that would
+excite the slightest suspicion that he was other than a gentleman
+of moderate means and quiet taste, either returning from a ride or
+passing through on his way to town. He had a well built and active
+figure, carried himself with the ease of a thorough horseman, and
+nodded to one or two persons of his acquaintance, and checking his
+horse at the principal butcher's, ordered some meat to be sent in
+that evening.
+
+Mark could trace no resemblance in the face to that of the young
+fellow he remembered. It was a quiet and resolute one. If this were
+Bastow, he had lost the sneering and insolent expression that was
+so strongly impressed on his memory. It might be the man, but if
+so, he was greatly changed. Mark's first impression was that it
+could not be Bastow; but when he thought over the years of toil
+and confinement in the convict prison, the life he had led in the
+bush, and the two years he had passed since he returned home, he
+imagined that the insolence of youth might well have disappeared,
+and been succeeded by the resolute daring and dogged determination
+that seemed to be impressed on this fellow's face.
+
+Mark paused fifty yards before he reached the inn. In a few minutes
+he saw Chester coming along. There was no one else in sight.
+
+"Is it Bastow?" he asked, as the officer came up.
+
+"It's Bastow sure enough, sir. But he is so changed that if I had
+not had him in my mind I should not have recognized him. I calculate
+that a man who has gone through what he has would have lost the
+expression he had as a boy. He must have learnt a lot in the convict
+prison, and the fact that he headed the mutiny and escaped from the
+searchers and managed to get home showed that he must have become
+a resolute and desperate man. All those burglaries, and the way
+in which he has several times stopped coaches single handed, show
+his nerve and coolness. I had all that in my mind as he came along,
+and his face was pretty much as I expected to see it. He is a cool
+hand, and I can understand how he has given us the slip so long.
+There is none of the shifty look about his eyes that one generally
+sees in criminals, no glancing from side to side; he rode with the
+air of a man who had a right to be where he was, and feared no one.
+He will be an awkward customer to tackle if we do not take him by
+surprise."
+
+"Yes, I agree with you there. However, he won't have much chance of
+using either his pistols or his strength. Here is Malcolm coming,
+so I will walk away for a few minutes, and let you go in first.
+You can tell the ostler now that you will have your horse put in at
+nine o'clock. I have been thinking, by the way, that we had better
+take the trap round behind the house instead of leaving it in the
+drive. The man may come back this way, and if so, he might hear
+the horse stamp or make some movement, and that would at once put
+him on his guard."
+
+As the officers entered the inn Mark went into the yard and told
+the ostler that he had met some friends, and should let his horse
+remain there for the night.
+
+"It is possible that they may drive me into the town in the morning,"
+he said; "and I shall very likely send a man down for the horse."
+
+At a quarter to nine he went out again, and walked to the house he
+had before visited; in ten minutes he heard the sound of wheels,
+threw open the gate, and the men, jumping down, led the horse in.
+
+"You may as well take him out of the trap," he said. "We cannot
+very well get that round the house, but there is no difficulty
+about taking the horse."
+
+The officers had brought a halter and a nosebag full of corn. The
+horse was fastened to a tree with soft ground round it, the nosebag
+put on, and a horse cloth thrown over its back; then Mark and his
+two companions went out into the lane, and in a couple of minutes
+entered the next gate, treading lightly, and going round to the
+back of the house.
+
+A light burned in the kitchen, and an old woman could be seen
+knitting. They lifted the latch and walked in. Dropping her knitting,
+she rose with an exclamation of terror.
+
+Mark advanced alone.
+
+"Do not be frightened," he said; "we are not going to do you any
+harm." He took out his little ebony staff. "We are constables,"
+he went on, "and have orders to search this house. We must secure
+you, but you will be released in the morning. Now, which is your
+room?"
+
+In spite of Mark's assurance, the old woman was almost paralyzed
+with terror. However, the two constables assisted her up to her
+room, and there secured her with a rope, taking care that it was
+not so tightly bound as to hurt her. Then they placed a gag in her
+mouth, and left her.
+
+"Now let us search his room in the first place," Mark said, when
+they came downstairs again. "I hardly expect we shall find anything.
+You may be sure that he will have taken great pains to hide away
+any booty that he may have here, and that it will need daylight
+and a closer search than we can give the place now, before we find
+anything."
+
+The search of the house was indeed fruitless. They cut open the bed,
+prized up every loose board in the bedroom and the parlor, lifted
+the hearth stone, tapped the walls, and searched every drawer; then,
+taking a lantern, went out into the stable. The officers were both
+accustomed to look for hiding places, and ran their hands along on
+the top of the walls, examining the stone flooring and manger.
+
+"That is a very large corn bin," Mark said, as he looked round,
+when they desisted from the search.
+
+"You are right, sir. We will empty it."
+
+There were two or three empty sacks on the ground near it, and
+they emptied the corn into these, so that there should be no litter
+about. Chester gave an exclamation of disappointment as they reached
+the bottom. Mark put his hand on the bin and gave it a pull.
+
+"It is just as I thought," he said. "It is fastened down. I saw an
+ax in the woodshed, Malcolm; just fetch it here."
+
+While the man was away Mark took the lantern and examined the bottom
+closely. "We shan't want the ax," he said, as he pointed out to
+Chester a piece of string that was apparently jammed in the form
+of a loop between the bottom and side. "Just get in and clear those
+few handfuls of corn out. I think you will see that it will pull
+up then."
+
+There was, however, no movement in the bottom when Mark pulled at
+the loop.
+
+"Look closely round outside," he said, handing Malcolm, who had
+now returned, the lantern. "I have no doubt that there is a catch
+somewhere."
+
+In a minute or two the constable found a small ring between two
+of the cobblestones close to the foot of the wall. He pulled at
+it, and as he did so Mark felt the resistance to his pull cease
+suddenly, and the bottom of the bin came up like a trapdoor.
+
+"That is a clever hiding place," he said. "If I had not happened
+to notice that the bin was fixed we might have had a long search
+before we found it here."
+
+Below was a square hole, the size of the bin; a ladder led down
+into it. Mark, with a lantern, descended. Four or five sacks piled
+on each other lay at the bottom, leaving just room enough for a
+man to stand beside them.
+
+"The top one is silver by the feel," he said, "not yet broken up;
+these smaller sacks are solid. I suppose it is silver that has
+been melted down. This--" and he lifted a bag some eighteen inches
+deep, opened it, and looked in "--contains watches and jewels.
+Now I think we will leave things here for the present, and put
+everything straight. He may be back before long."
+
+Mark ascended, the bottom of the trap was shut down again, the corn
+poured in, and the bags thrown down on the spot from which they
+had been taken. They returned to the house, shut the door, and
+extinguished the light.
+
+"That has been a grand find," he said; "even if this is not Bastow,
+it will be a valuable capture."
+
+"That it will, Mr. Thorndyke. I have no doubt that this fellow is
+the man we have been in search of for the last eighteen months;
+that accounts for our difficulty in laying hold of him. He has been
+too crafty to try to sell any of his plunder, so that none of the
+fences have known anything about him. No doubt he has taken sufficient
+cash to enable him to live here quietly. He intended some time or
+other to melt down all the rest of the plate and to sell the silver,
+which he could do easily enough. As for the watches and jewels, he
+could get rid of them abroad."
+
+"No doubt that is what he intended," Mark agreed. "It is not often
+these fellows are as prudent as he has been; if they were, your
+work would be a good deal more difficult than it is."
+
+"You are right, sir; I don't know that I ever heard of such a case
+before. The fellow almost deserves to get away."
+
+"That would be rewarding him too highly for his caution," Mark
+laughed. "He is a desperate villain, and all the more dangerous for
+being a prudent one. Now, I think one of us had better keep watch
+at the gate by turns. We shall hear him coming in plenty of time to
+get back here and be in readiness for him. We must each understand
+our part thoroughly. I will stand facing the door. It is possible
+that he may light that lantern we saw hanging in the stable, but I
+don't think it likely he will do so; he will take off the saddle,
+and either take the horse in there--there is plenty of food in
+the manger--or else turn it out into the paddock. As he comes in
+I will throw my arms round him and you will at once close in, one
+on each side, each catch an arm tightly, handcuff him, and take
+the pistols from his belt. Don't leave go of his arms until I have
+lit the candle; he may have another pistol inside his coat, and
+might draw it."
+
+It was now one o'clock, and half an hour later Malcolm, who was
+at the gate, came in quietly and said he could hear a horse coming
+along the lane.
+
+"Which way, Malcolm?"
+
+"Tooting way."
+
+"That is all right. I have been a little nervous lest if he came
+the other way our horse might make some slight noise and attract
+his attention; that was our only weak point."
+
+They had already ascertained that the front door was locked and
+bolted, and that he must therefore enter through the kitchen. They
+heard the horse stop in front, a moment later the gate was opened,
+and through the window they could just make out the figure of a
+man leading a horse; then the stable door opened, and they heard a
+movement, and knew that the horse was being unsaddled; they heard
+it walk into the stable, the door was shut behind it, and a step
+approached the back door. It was opened, and a voice said with an
+oath, "The old fool has forgotten to leave a candle burning"; then
+he stepped into the kitchen.
+
+In an instant there was a sound of a violent struggle, deep oaths
+and curses, two sharp clicks, then all was quiet except heavy
+breathing and the striking of flint on a tinderbox; there was the
+blue glare of the sulphur match, and a candle was lighted. Mark
+then turned to the man who was standing still grasped in the hands
+of his two captors.
+
+"Arthur Bastow," he said, producing his staff, "I arrest you in
+the King's name, as an escaped convict, as a notorious highwayman
+and house breaker."
+
+As his name was spoken the man started, then he said quietly:
+
+"You have made a mistake this time, my men; my name is William
+Johnson; I am well known here, and have been a quiet resident in
+this house for upwards of a year."
+
+"A resident, but not a quiet resident, Bastow. I don't think we
+are mistaken; but even if you can prove that you are not Bastow,
+but William Johnson, a man of means and family, we have evidence
+enough upon the other charges. We have been in search of you for a
+long time, and have got you at last. You don't remember me, though
+it is but eighteen months since we met; but I fancy that I then
+left a mark upon you that still remains on your shoulder. I am Mark
+Thorndyke, and you will understand now why I have hunted you down."
+
+"The game is not finished yet," the man said recklessly. "The
+hunting down will be the other way next time, Mark Thorndyke."
+
+"I don't think so. Now, Chester, you may as well tie his feet
+together, and then search him. When that is done I will look after
+him while you fetch the trap round."
+
+In his pockets were found two gold watches, forty-eight pounds in
+gold, and a hundred pounds in bank notes.
+
+"We shall hear where this comes from tomorrow," Malcolm said, as
+he laid them on the table; "it will save us the trouble of getting
+evidence from Australia."
+
+The prisoner was placed in a chair, and then the two officers went
+out to fetch the trap round.
+
+"So you have turned thief catcher, have you?" he said in a sneering
+tone, that recalled him to Mark's memory far more than his face
+had done, "and you carry a Bow Street staff about with you, and
+pretend to belong to the force: that is a punishable offense, you
+know."
+
+"Yes, it would be if I had no right to use it," Mark said quietly;
+"but it happens that I have a right, having been for a year and
+a half in the force. I joined it solely to hunt you down, and now
+that I have done so my resignation will be sent in tomorrow."
+
+"And how is the worthy squire?"
+
+Mark started to his feet, and seized one of the pistols lying before
+him.
+
+"You villain!" he exclaimed, "I wonder you dare mention his name
+--you, his murderer."
+
+"It was but tit for tat," the man said coolly; "he murdered me,
+body and soul, when he sent me to the hulks. I told him I would
+be even with him. I did not think I had hit him at the time, for
+I thought that if I had you would have stopped with him, and would
+not have chased me across the fields."
+
+"You scoundrel!" Mark said. "You know well enough that you came
+back, stole into his room, and stabbed him."
+
+Bastow looked at him with a puzzled expression.
+
+"I don't know what you are talking about," he said. "I fired at
+him through the window--I don't mind saying so to you, because
+there are no witnesses--and saw him jump up, but I fancied I had
+missed him. I saw you bolt out of the room, and thought it better
+to be off at once instead of taking another shot. You gave me a
+hard chase. It was lucky for you that you did not come up with me,
+for if you had done so I should have shot you; I owed you one for
+having killed as good a comrade as man ever had, and for that bullet
+you put in my shoulder before. If I had not been so out of breath
+that I could not feel sure of my aim I should have stopped for you,
+but I rode straight to town."
+
+"A likely story," Mark said shortly. "What, you will pretend that
+there were two murderers hanging round the house that night?--a
+likely tale indeed."
+
+"I tell you that if your father was killed by a knife or dagger,
+I had nothing to do with it," the man said. "I am obliged to the
+man, whoever he was. I had intended to go down again to Reigate
+to finish the job myself; I should scarcely have missed a second
+time. So it is for that you hunted me down? Well, I don't blame
+you; I never forgive an injury, and I see your sentiments are
+mine. Whether I killed your father or not makes no difference; he
+was killed, that is the principal point; if I was going to be put
+on my trial for that I could prove that at eight o'clock I was in
+a coffee house in Covent Garden. I purposely kicked up a row there,
+and was turned out, so that if I were charged with that shooting
+affair I could prove that I was in London that evening."
+
+"I can't quite believe that," Mark said; "a fast horse would have
+brought you up to town in an hour and a half, and another fast horse
+would have taken you back again as quickly; so you might have been
+in London at eight and back again at Crowswood by half past twelve
+or one, even if you stopped a couple of hours at a coffee house.
+However, you won't be tried for that. Those things on the table and
+the contents of that corn bin are enough to hang you a dozen times."
+
+"Curse you! have you found that out?" Bastow exclaimed furiously.
+
+"We have," Mark replied. "It would have been wiser if you had got
+rid of your things sooner. It was a clever hiding place, but it is
+always dangerous to keep such things by you, Bastow."
+
+The man said no more, but sat quietly in his chair until they heard
+the vehicle stop outside the gate. Then the two constables came in,
+and lifting Bastow, carried him out and placed him in the bottom
+of the cart.
+
+"You can loose the old woman now, Malcolm," Mark said as he took
+his seat and gathered the reins in his hand. "By eleven o'clock,
+no doubt, one of the others will be down with the gig again, and
+you can empty out the contents of that hole, and bring them up with
+you. I don't think that it will be of any use searching further.
+You might have a good look all round before you come away. There
+may be some notes stowed away, though it is likely enough that they
+have been sent away by post to some receiver abroad."
+
+For some time after starting they could hear the prisoner moving
+about uneasily in the straw.
+
+"I suppose there is no fear of his slipping out of those handcuffs,
+Chester?"
+
+"Not a bit; they are full tight for him. I expect that that is what
+is making him uncomfortable."
+
+Presently the movement ceased.
+
+"He is still enough now, Mr. Thorndyke. I should not be at all
+surprised if he has dropped off to sleep. He is hardened enough to
+sleep while the gibbet was waiting for him."
+
+It was four o'clock in the morning when they drove up at Bow Street.
+Two constables on duty came out to the cart.
+
+"We have got a prisoner, Inspector," Chester said. "He is the man
+we have been looking for so long. I fancy we have got all the swag
+that has been stolen for the last eighteen months--bags of jewels
+and watches, and sacks of silver. He is handcuffed, and his legs
+are tied, so we must carry him in."
+
+The officer fetched out a lantern. The other constable helped him
+to let down the backboard of the cart.
+
+"Now, Bastow, wake up," Chester said. "Here we are."
+
+But there was no movement!
+
+"He is mighty sound asleep," the constable said.
+
+"Well, haul him out;" and, taking the man by the shoulders, they
+pulled him out from the cart.
+
+"There is something rum about him," the constable said; and as
+they lowered his feet to the pavement his head fell forward, and
+he would have sunk down if they had not supported him.
+
+The Inspector raised the lantern to his face.
+
+"Why, the man is dead," he said.
+
+"Dead!" Chester repeated incredulously.
+
+"Aye, that he is. Look here;" and he pointed to a slim steel handle
+some three inches long, projecting over the region of the heart.
+"You must have searched him very carelessly, Chester. Well, bring
+him in now."
+
+They carried him into the room, where two candles were burning.
+Mark followed them. The inspector pulled out the dagger. It was
+but four inches long, with a very thin blade. The handle was little
+thicker than the blade itself. Mark took it and examined it.
+
+"I have not a shadow of doubt that this is the dagger with which he
+murdered my father. The wound was very narrow, about this width,
+and the doctor said that the weapon that had been used was certainly
+a foreign dagger."
+
+"I don't think this is a foreign dagger," the Inspector said on
+examining it, "although it may be the one that was used, as you say,
+Mr. Thorndyke. It has evidently been made to carry about without
+being observed."
+
+He threw back the dead man's coat.
+
+"Ah, here is where it was kept. You see, the lining has been sewn
+to the cloth, so as to make a sheath down by the seam under the
+arm. I expect that, knowing what would happen if he were caught,
+he had made up his mind to do it all along. Well, I don't know that
+you are to be so much blamed, Chester, for, passing your hand over
+his clothes, you might very well miss this, which is no thicker
+than a piece of whalebone. Well, well, he has saved us a good deal
+of trouble. You say you have got most of the booty he has collected?"
+
+"I don't know that we have got all of it, sir, but we have made a
+very big haul, anyhow; it was a cunningly contrived place. There
+was a big corn bin in the stable, and when we had emptied out the
+corn it seemed empty. However, Mr. Thorndyke discovered that the
+bin was fixed. Then we found that the bottom was really a trap door,
+and under it was a sort of well in which were sacks and bags. One
+of the sacks was full of unbroken silver, two others contained silver
+ingots, things that he had melted down, and there was a large bag
+full of watches and jewels. In his pocket we found a hundred pounds
+in bank notes, about fifty guineas, and a couple of gold watches."
+
+"That he must have got tonight from the Portsmouth coach; we
+heard half an hour ago that it had been stopped near Kingston, the
+coachman shot, and the passengers robbed. It will be good news to
+some of them that we have got hold of their valuables. Well, Mr.
+Thorndyke, I have to congratulate you most heartily on the skill
+with which you have ferreted out a man who had baffled us for so
+long, and had become a perfect terror to the south of London. No
+doubt we shall be able to trace a great portion of the property in
+that sack. The capture has been splendidly effected."
+
+"You will understand," Mark said, "that I do not wish my name to
+appear in the matter at all. I have, as you know, been actuated
+by private reasons only in my search, and I see no occasion why my
+name should be mentioned; the evidence of Chester and Malcolm will
+be ample. From information received, they went down to this place,
+searched it in his absence, discovered the stolen goods, and captured
+them. Having handcuffed and bound him, one drove him up to town,
+the other remaining to guard the treasure. On his way he got at this
+hidden dagger and stabbed himself. My evidence would not strengthen
+the case at all."
+
+"No, I don't see that it will be necessary to call you, Mr.
+Thorndyke. The discovery of this hidden booty and the proceeds of
+the coach robbery would be quite sufficient. Beyond the coroner's
+inquest there will be no inquiry. Had it been otherwise it might
+probably have been necessary to call you at the trial. However, as
+it is, it will save a lot of trouble; now we shall only need to
+find the owners of these bank notes. I will send off a cart for
+the things as early as I can get one, and will send a couple of
+constables round to the houses where burglaries have been committed
+to request the owners to come over and see if they can identify
+any of their property; and those who do so can attend the inquest
+tomorrow, though I don't suppose they will be called. The chief
+will be mightily pleased when he hears what has taken place, for
+he has been sadly worried by these constant complaints, and I fancy
+that the authorities have been rather down upon him on the subject.
+The announcement that the career of this famous robber has been
+brought to an end will cause quite a sensation, and people round
+the commons on the south side will sleep more quietly than they have
+done lately. I expect that if he had not put an end to himself we
+should have had to send him across to Newington today, for of course
+it is a Surrey business, though we have had the luck to take him.
+I suppose we shall not see much of you in the future, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"No indeed," Mark said. "My business is done, and I shall send in
+my resignation this morning. I don't regret the time that I have
+spent over it; I have learned a great deal, and have seen a lot
+of the shady side of life, and have picked up experience in a good
+many ways."
+
+Mark, after requesting the Inspector to find a man to go over
+to Streatham and bring back his horse, and writing an order to
+the ostler to deliver it, walked across to his lodgings. Upon the
+whole, he was not sorry that Bastow had taken the matter into his
+own hands; he had, certainly, while engaged in the search, looked
+forward to seeing him in the dock and witnessing his execution,
+but he now felt that enough had been done for vengeance, and that
+it was as well that the matter had ended as it had. He was wearied
+out with the excitement of the last forty-eight hours. It was one
+o'clock when he awoke, and after dressing and going into Covent
+Garden to lunch at one of the coffee houses, he made his way up to
+Islington.
+
+"Taking a day's holiday?" Millicent asked as he came in.
+
+"Well, not exactly, Millicent; I have left school altogether."
+
+"Left school, Mark? Do you mean that you have decided that it is
+of no use going on any longer?"
+
+"I have given it up because I have finished it. Arthur Bastow was
+captured last night, and committed suicide as he was being taken
+to the station."
+
+An exclamation of surprise broke from Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent.
+
+"It seems horrid to be glad that anyone has taken his own life,"
+the latter said; "but I cannot help feeling so, for as long as he
+lived I should never have considered that you were safe, and besides,
+I suppose there is no doubt that if he had not killed himself he
+would have been hung."
+
+"There is not a shadow of doubt about that," Mark replied. "We found
+the proceeds of a vast number of robberies at his place, and also
+in his pockets the money he had taken from the passengers of the
+Portsmouth coach an hour before we captured him. So that putting
+aside that Australian business altogether, his doom was sealed."
+
+"Now, please, tell us all about it," Mrs. Cunningham said. "But
+first let us congratulate you most warmly not only on the success
+of your search, but that the work is at an end."
+
+"Yes, I am glad it is over. At first I was very much interested;
+in fact, I was intensely interested all along, and should have been
+for however long it had continued. But, at the same time, I could
+do nothing else, and one does not want to spend one's whole life as
+a detective. At last it came about almost by chance, and the only
+thing I have to congratulate myself upon is that my idea of the
+sort of place he would have taken was exactly borne out by fact."
+
+And Mark then gave them a full account of the manner in which the
+discovery had been made and the capture effected.
+
+"You see, Millicent, I followed your injunction, and was very
+careful. Taking him by surprise as I did, I might have managed it
+single handed, but with the aid of two good men it made a certainty
+of it, and the whole thing was comfortably arranged."
+
+"I think you have done splendidly, Mark," Mrs. Cunningham said.
+"It was certainly wonderful that you should have found him doing
+exactly what you had guessed, even down to the deaf servant. Well,
+now that is done and over, what do you think of doing next?"
+
+"I have hardly thought about that," he replied; "but, at any rate,
+I shall take a few weeks' holiday, and I suppose after that I shall
+settle down to the search for my uncle's treasure. I am afraid
+that will be a much longer and a vastly more difficult business
+than this has been. Here there were all sorts of clews to work upon.
+Bastow ought to have been captured months ago, but in this other
+affair, so far, there is next to nothing to follow up. We don't
+even know whether the things are in India or in England. I believe
+they will be found, but that it will be by an accident. Besides, I
+fancy that we shall hear about them when you come of age, Millicent.
+There was to have been no change till that time, and I cannot help
+thinking that Uncle George must have made some provisions by which
+we should get to know about them in the event of his death without
+his having an opportunity of telling anyone where they are.
+
+"He might have been killed in battle; he might have been drowned on
+his way home. He had thought the whole matter over so thoroughly,
+I do think the possibilities of this could not have escaped him.
+As I told you, Mr. Prendergast made inquiries of all the principal
+bankers and Indian agents here, and altogether without success.
+After he had done that, I got a list of all the leading firms in
+Calcutta and Madras, and wrote to them, and all the replies were in
+the negative. It is true that does not prove anything absolutely.
+Eighteen years is a long time, and the chances are that during
+those years almost every head of a firm would have retired and come
+home. Such a matter would only be likely to be known to the heads;
+and if, as we thought likely, the box or chest was merely forwarded
+by a firm there to England, the transaction would not have attracted
+any special attention. If, upon the other hand, it remained out
+there it might have been put down in a cellar or store, and have
+been lying there ever since, altogether forgotten."
+
+"I don't see myself why you should bother any more about it; perhaps,
+as you say, it will turn up of itself when I come of age. At any
+rate, I should say it is certainly as well to wait till then and
+see if it does, especially as you acknowledge that you have no clew
+whatever to work on. It is only three more years, for I am eighteen
+next week, and it certainly seems to me that it will be very foolish
+to spend the next three years in searching about for a thing that
+may come to you without any searching at all."
+
+"Well, I will think it over."
+
+"You see, you really don't want the money, Mark," she went on.
+
+"No, I don't want it particularly, Millicent; but when one knows
+that there is something like 50,000 pounds waiting for one somewhere,
+one would like to get it. Your father worked for twenty years of
+his life accumulating it for us, and it seems to me a sort of sacred
+duty to see that his labor has not all been thrown away."
+
+Millicent was silent.
+
+"It is very tiresome," she said presently. "Of course my father
+intended, as you say, that his savings should come to us, but I am
+sure he never meant that they should be a bother and a trouble to
+us."
+
+"I don't see why they should ever be that, Millicent. As it is we
+have both sufficient for anything any man or woman could reasonably
+want, and neither of us need fret over it if the treasure is never
+found. Still, he wished us to have it, and it is properly ours, and
+I don't want it to go to enrich someone who has not a shadow of a
+right to it."
+
+On the following morning Mark went to attend the inquest on Bastow.
+He did not go into the court, however, but remained close at hand
+in the event of the coroner insisting upon his being called. However,
+the two men only spoke casually in their evidence of their comrade
+Roberts, who had been also engaged in the capture. One of the jurymen
+suggested that he should also be called, but the coroner said:
+
+"I really cannot see any occasion for it; we are here to consider
+how the deceased came by his death, and I think it must be perfectly
+clear that he came by it by his own act. You have heard how he was
+captured, that the spoils of the coach that he had just rifled were
+found upon him, and that the booty he had been acquiring from his
+deeds for months past also was seized; therefore, as the man was
+desperate, and knew well enough that his life was forfeited, there
+was ample motive for his putting an end to his wretched existence.
+I really do not think, gentlemen, that it is worth while to waste
+your time and mine by going into further evidence."
+
+Finally, a verdict of felo de se was returned, with a strong
+expression of the jury's admiration of the conduct of constables
+Malcolm, Chester, and Roberts, who had so cleverly effected the
+capture of the man who had so long set the law at defiance.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII.
+
+
+Four days later Mark, on his return from dinner, found Philip Cotter
+sitting in his room waiting for him. They had met on the previous
+evening, and Cotter had expressed his intention of calling upon
+him the next day.
+
+"I am here on a matter of business, Thorndyke," the latter said as
+they shook hands.
+
+"Of business!" Mark repeated.
+
+"Yes. You might guess for a year, and I don't suppose that you would
+hit it. It is rather a curious thing. Nearly twenty years ago--"
+
+"I can guess it before you go any further," Mark exclaimed, leaping
+up from the seat that he had just taken. "Your people received a
+box from India."
+
+"That is so Mark; although how you guessed it I don't know."
+
+"We have been searching for it for years," Mark replied. "Our lawyer,
+Prendergast, wrote to you about that box; at least, he wrote to
+you asking if you had any property belonging to Colonel Thorndyke,
+and your people wrote to say they hadn't."
+
+"Yes, I remember I wrote to him myself. Of course that was before
+you did me that great service, and I did not know your name, and
+we had not the name on our books. What is in the box?"
+
+"Jewels worth something like fifty thousand pounds."
+
+"By Jove, I congratulate you, old fellow; that is to say, if you
+have the handling of it. Well, this is what happened. The box was
+sent to us by a firm in Calcutta, together with bills for 50,000
+pounds. The instructions were that the money was to be invested
+in stock, and that we were to manage it and to take 100 pounds a
+year for so doing. The rest of the interest of the money was to be
+invested. The box was a very massive one, and was marked with the
+letters XYZ. It was very carefully sealed. Our instructions were
+that the owner of the box and the money might present himself at
+any time."
+
+"And that the proof of his ownership was to be that he was to use
+the word 'Masulipatam,'" Mark broke in, "and produce a gold coin
+that would, probably--though of this I am not certain--correspond
+with the seals."
+
+He got up and went to the cabinet which he had brought up with him
+from Crowswood, unlocked it, and produced the piece of paper and
+the coin.
+
+"Yes, that looks like the seal, Thorndyke. At any rate, it is the
+same sort of thing. Why on earth didn't you come with it before,
+and take the things away?"
+
+"Simply because I did not know where to go to. My uncle was dying
+when he came home, and told my father about the treasure, but he
+died suddenly, and my father did not know whether it was sent to
+England or committed to someone's charge in India, or buried there.
+We did the only thing we could, namely, inquired at all the banks
+and agents here and at all the principal firms in Madras and Calcutta
+to ask if they had in their possession any property belonging to
+the late Colonel Thorndyke."
+
+"You see, we did not know," Cotter went on, "any more than Adam,
+to whom the box belonged. Fortunately, the agent sent in his
+communication a sealed letter, on the outside of which was written,
+'This is to remain unopened, but if no one before that date presents
+himself with the token and password, it is to be read on the 18th
+of August, 1789.' That was yesterday, you know."
+
+"Yes, that was my cousin's eighteenth birthday. We thought if my
+uncle had left the box in anyone's charge he would probably have
+given him some such instructions, for at that time there was hard
+fighting in India, and he might have been killed any day, and would
+therefore naturally have made some provisions for preventing the
+secret dying with him."
+
+"We did not think of it until this morning early, though we have
+been rather curious over it ourselves. When we opened it, inside
+was another letter addressed 'To be delivered to John Thorndyke,
+Esquire, at Crawley, near Hastings, or at Crowswood, Reigate, or
+in the event of his death to his executors.'"
+
+"I am one of his executors," Mark said; "Mr. Prendergast, the
+lawyer, is the other. I think I had better go round to him tomorrow
+and open the letter there."
+
+"Oh, I should think you might open it at once, Thorndyke. It will
+probably only contain instructions, and, at any rate, as you have
+the coin and the word, you could come round tomorrow morning and
+get the chest out if you want it."
+
+"I won't do that," Mark said; "the coffer contains gems worth over
+50,000 pounds, and I would very much rather it remained in your
+keeping until I decide what to do with it. How large is it?"
+
+"It is a square box, about a foot each way; and it is pretty heavy,
+probably from the setting of the jewels. Well, anyhow, I am heartily
+glad, Thorndyke. I know, of course, that you are well off, still
+100,000 pounds--for the money has doubled itself since we had
+it--to say nothing of the jewels, is a nice plum to drop into
+anyone's mouth."
+
+"Very nice indeed, although only half of it comes to me under my
+uncle's will. To tell you the truth, I am more glad that the mystery
+has been solved than at getting the money; the affair was a great
+worry to my father, and has been so to me. I felt that I ought
+to search for the treasure, and yet the probability of finding it
+seemed so small that I felt the thing was hopeless, and that really
+the only chance was that my uncle would have taken just the course
+he did, and have fixed some date when the treasure should be handed
+over, if not asked for. I rather fancied that it would not have
+been for another three years, for that is when my cousin comes of
+age."
+
+"What cousin do you mean?" Philip Cotter asked. "I did not know
+you had one."
+
+"Well, that is at present a secret, Cotter--one of the mysteries
+connected with my uncle's will. For myself, I would tell it in the
+market place tomorrow, but she wishes it to be preserved at present;
+you shall certainly know as soon as anyone. By the way, I have not
+seen you at Mrs. Cunningham's for the last week, and you used to
+be a pretty regular visitor."
+
+"No," the young man said gloomily; "I don't mind telling you that
+Miss Conyers refused me a fortnight ago. I never thought that I
+had much chance, but I had just a shadow of hope, and that is at
+an end now."
+
+"Perhaps in the future--" Mark suggested for the sake of saying
+something.
+
+"No; I said as much as that to her, and she replied that it would
+always be the same, and I gathered from her manner, although she
+did not exactly say so, that there was someone else in the case,
+and yet I have never met anyone often there."
+
+"Perhaps you are mistaken," Mark said.
+
+"Well, whether or not, there is clearly no hope for me. I am very
+sorry, but it is no use moping over it. My father and mother like
+her so much, and they are anxious for me to marry and settle down;
+altogether, it would have been just the thing. I do not know whether
+she has any money, and did not care, for of course I shall have
+plenty. I shall be a junior partner in another six months; my father
+told me so the other day. He said that at one time he was afraid
+that I should never come into the house, for that it would not have
+been fair to the others to take such a reckless fellow in, but that
+I seemed to have reformed so thoroughly since that affair that if
+I continued so for another six months they should have no hesitation
+in giving me a share."
+
+It was too late to go up to Islington that evening. In the morning
+Mark went with the still unopened letter to the solicitor's. The
+old lawyer congratulated him most heartily when he told him of the
+discovery that he had made.
+
+"I am glad indeed, Mark; not so much for the sake of the money,
+but because I was afraid that that confounded treasure was going
+to unsettle your life. When a man once begins treasure hunting
+it becomes a sort of craze, and he can no more give it up than an
+opium smoker can the use of the drug. Thank goodness, that is over;
+so the capital amount is doubled, and you are accordingly worth
+70,000 pounds more than you were this time yesterday--a fine
+windfall! Now let us see what your uncle says."
+
+He broke the seal. The letter was a short one, and began:
+
+"My DEAR JOHN:
+
+"If you have not, before you receive this, got my treasure, you
+will get it on the 18th or 19th of August, 17??89. I have made a
+will which will give you full instructions what to do with it. I
+may say, though, that I have left it between a little daughter who
+was born six months ago, and your son Mark. My own intentions are
+to stop out here until I get the rank of general, and I have taken
+the measures that I have done in case a bullet or a sharp attack
+of fever carries me off suddenly. I hope that you will have carried
+out the provisions of my will, and I hope also that I shall have
+come home and talked the whole matter over with you before I go
+under.
+
+"Your affectionate brother."
+
+"A singular man," Mr. Prendergast said, as he laid the letter down
+on the table beside him. "What trouble these crotchety people do
+give! I suppose you have altogether put aside that folly of his
+about the jewels?"
+
+"Well, no, I can't say that I have, Mr. Prendergast. Do you know
+that I have a fancy--it may only be a fancy, but if so, I cannot
+shake it off--that I am watched by Lascars. There was one standing
+at the corner of the street as I came up this morning, and again
+and again I have run across one. It is not always the same man, nor
+have I any absolute reasons for believing that they are watching
+me; still, somehow or other, I do come across them more frequently
+than seems natural."
+
+"Pooh, nonsense, Mark! I should have thought that you were too
+sensible a fellow to have such ridiculous fancies in your head."
+
+"Of course, I should never have thought of such a thing, Mr.
+Prendergast, if it had not been for what my father told me, that
+my uncle was desperately in earnest about it, and had an intense
+conviction that someone watched his every movement."
+
+"Don't let us talk of such folly any longer," the lawyer said
+irritably. "Now that you have got the money, the best thing you can
+do is to go at once and carry out what was the wish both of your
+father and your uncle, and ask your cousin to marry you; that
+will put an end to the whole business, and I can tell you that I
+am positively convinced that the day she gets twenty-one she will
+renounce the property, and that if you refuse to take it she will
+pass it over to some hospital or other. You cannot do better than
+prevent her from carrying out such an act of folly as that, and the
+only way that I can see is by your marrying her. I gathered from
+what you said when I gave you the same advice at Reigate that you
+liked her and should have done it had it not been for her coming
+into the estate instead of you. Well, you are now in a position to
+ask her to marry you without the possibility of its being supposed
+that you are a fortune hunter."
+
+"I will think about it, Mr. Prendergast. Of course this money does
+make a considerable difference in my position; however, I shall do
+nothing until I have got the jewels off my hands."
+
+"Well, a couple of days will manage that," the lawyer said; "you
+have only got to take the box to a first class jeweler, and get him
+to value the things and make you an offer for the whole of them."
+
+Mark did not care to press the subject, and on leaving went to
+Cotter's Bank. He was at once shown into his friend's room, and
+the latter took him to his father.
+
+"It is curious, Mr. Thorndyke," the latter said heartily, "that we
+should have been keeping your money all this time without having
+the slightest idea that it belonged to you. We are ready at once to
+pay it over to your order, for if you pronounce the word you know
+of, and I find that the coin you have corresponds with the seal
+on the box, the necessary proof will be given us that you have
+authority to take it away. I have had the box brought up this
+morning, so that we can compare the seal."
+
+The box was taken out of the strong safe, and it was at once seen
+that the coin corresponded with the seals.
+
+"I will leave it with you for the present, Mr. Cotter; it contains
+a large amount of jewels, and until I have decided what to do with
+them I would rather leave them; it would be madness to have 50,000
+pounds worth of gems in a London lodging, even for a single night.
+As to the money, that also had better remain as it is at present
+invested. As I told your son--that and the jewels are the joint
+property of myself and another. I dare say that in a few days half
+of the money will be transferred to the name of the other legatee;
+that can be easily done. I shall get my lawyer, Mr. Prendergast, to
+call upon you, Mr. Cotter. I suppose it would be better that some
+legal proof that we are entitled to the money should be given."
+
+"I shall be glad to see him and to take his instructions," the
+banker said; "but in point of fact I regard the property as yours;
+I have nothing to do with wills or other arrangements. I simply
+received the box and the cash with an order that they should be
+delivered to whomsoever should come with the word 'Masulipatam' and
+a coin to match the seals. That you have done, and with subsequent
+dispositions I have no concern. I shall be happy to keep this box
+for you as long as you should think proper; and I have also written
+out an acknowledgement that I hold securities of the value, at the
+closing prices yesterday, of 103,000 pounds 16 shillings," and he
+handed the paper to Mark.
+
+As the latter left the bank he looked up and down the street, and
+muttered an angry exclamation as he caught sight of a rough looking
+fellow just turning a corner into a side street. The glance was so
+momentary a one that he could not say whether the man was a colored
+seaman; but he certainly thought that he was a Lascar.
+
+"I am going to have trouble about that bracelet," he said to himself,
+as he hailed a hackney coach and told him to drive to Islington.
+"I am convinced that the Colonel was right, and that there are some
+men over in this country with the fixed purpose of seeing what is
+done with those jewels, and obtaining them if possible. How they
+could tell that they were deposited at Cotter's beats me altogether.
+It may be indeed that they really knew nothing about it, and have
+simply been watching me. They can hardly have been watching me
+for the last nine months, and yet, curiously enough, though I have
+never given the matter a thought since, Charley Gibbons said that
+it was a dark colored man who brought the news that took them to
+my rescue and saved my life. I have often run against Lascars, and
+if they have taken this trouble all along, now that they have seen
+me come out of the bank, I shall be watched night and day.
+
+"It is a creepy sort of idea. I should not be afraid of any number
+of them if they attacked me openly; but there is no saying what
+they might do. I wish Ramoo had been here. I would have consulted
+him about it; but as I got a letter from him only last week saying
+that he had, on the day of writing it, arrived in Calcutta, it
+is of no use wishing that. At any rate, I cannot do better than
+stick to the plan that my uncle sketched out, and take them across
+to Amsterdam. It would be very unfair to take them to any jeweler
+here. He might have them in his possession for a week or ten days
+before he made me any definite offer for them, and during that time
+I would not give a fig for his life. If I distribute the stones
+at Amsterdam they would hardly set about attacking twelve diamond
+merchants one after another. Well, at any rate, I must say nothing
+about the affair to Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham. It was bad enough
+my running risks in the pursuit of Bastow; but this would be ten
+times worse, and I know Millicent would be for letting the things
+remain for good at the banker's. But I have no idea of allowing
+myself to be frightened by two or three black scoundrels into
+throwing away 50,000 pounds."
+
+Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent were sitting in their bonnets in the
+parlor.
+
+"Here you are at last, sir," the girl said. "Another five minutes,
+and we should have gone out. You told us that you would come early,
+and now it is twelve o'clock; and you are generally so punctual in
+your appointments. What have you got to say for yourself?"
+
+"A good many things have happened since then, Millicent. Last night
+your friend Mr. Cotter called upon me."
+
+"Why do you say my friend? He was your friend, and it was entirely
+through you that we knew him at all."
+
+"Well, we will say 'our friend,' Millicent; and he made a communication
+to me that this morning I had to go to Mr. Prendergast and make a
+communication to him."
+
+"What do you mean by your communications?" Millicent asked, laughing.
+"You are quite mysterious, Mark."
+
+"And then I had to go," he went on, without heeding her interruption,
+"to Cotter's Bank, where I saw both our friend and his father, and
+there is the result of these communications and that interview;"
+and he threw the paper to her.
+
+"What does it mean?" she asked in astonishment, after glancing
+through it.
+
+"It means, dear, that your father took exactly the precautions I
+thought he would take, and after sending his money and jewels home,
+he sent a sealed letter to the firm with whom he deposited them,
+which happened to be Cotter's, with instructions that should no
+one present himself with the word and coin by the 18th of August,
+1789--that is to say, on your eighteenth birthday--the envelope
+should be opened; it was so opened, and it contained a letter that
+was to be sent to my father, or, in the case of his death before
+that date, to his executors."
+
+"How wonderful!" the girl said. "I had quite given up all idea of
+it. But how is it that it came to be so much? Have they sold the
+jewels?"
+
+"No, you see it is the compound interest going on for seventeen
+years, and perhaps some rise in the value of the securities, that
+has doubled the original sum invested. As for the jewels, I have
+left them at the bank; I should not care about having 50,000 pounds
+worth of such things in my rooms and I should not think that you
+would like to have them here, either."
+
+"Certainly not," Mrs. Cunningham said emphatically; "you did quite
+right, Mark. I don't think I could sleep, even if you had half a
+dozen of your detective friends posted round the house."
+
+"Still I suppose we shall have a chance of seeing them?" Millicent
+said.
+
+"Certainly. I can make an appointment with Philip Cotter for you
+to see them at the bank; or if I take them to a jeweler to value,
+you could see them there. But I should think that the bank would
+be the best. I am sure that Cotter would put his room at your
+disposal, and, of course, if you would like to have some of them
+for yourself you could select any you liked, but I expect that
+they won't look much in their present settings; the Indian jewelers
+have not the knack of setting off gems. However, there is no hurry
+about them one way or another. The money, I have told Cotter's
+father, shall, for the present, remain as it is invested; it is
+all in the Funds, Cotter said, for although the instructions were
+that it was to be put into good securities, he did not feel justified
+under the peculiar circumstances in going outside Government stock.
+Mr. Prendergast is quite of opinion that it would be better to make
+no change until you come of age. I did not know whether you would
+wait till then, for some purpose or other you might want to use
+some of it."
+
+Millicent shrugged her shoulders.
+
+"I think I would much rather have had just the money I had before,
+Mark; all this will be a great nuisance, I am sure. I think there
+ought to be a law against women having more than 20,000 pounds,
+whether in money or in land."
+
+Mark laughed.
+
+"It would be a bad thing for spendthrift young noblemen, Millicent.
+How are they to pay off their debts and mortgages if there were no
+heiresses ready to do so in exchange for a title?"
+
+"It would be a good thing for them, I consider," the girl
+said indignantly. "In the first place, they would not impoverish
+themselves if they knew that there was no way of building up their
+fortune again, and in the next place, if they did ruin themselves
+they would have to either set to work to earn an honest living or
+blow out their brains, if they have any to blow out. I can assure
+you that I don't feel at all exultant at getting all this money,
+and I think that my father was quite right in wishing that I should
+know nothing about it until I married; but, on the other hand, I am
+heartily glad, more glad than I can say, Mark, that you have come
+into your share."
+
+"I am glad for one reason, Millicent; that is, that this must put
+an end to the ridiculous idea you have of giving up Crowswood.
+Your father has made me rich beyond anything I could possibly have
+expected from him. I suddenly find myself a wealthy man, and I can
+buy another estate for myself worth more than Crowswood if inclined
+to settle down as a squire; therefore your theory that I have
+been disappointed in not inheriting what I thought was my father's
+estate falls to the ground altogether. In no case would I ever have
+accepted your sacrifice. If you had liked to hand it over to St.
+Bartholomew's or Guy's Hospital, or to give it away to any other
+charity, I would not have prevented you, but I would never have
+accepted it for myself. Now, thank goodness, the question cannot
+arise; for you must see that, even looking at the matter from
+a purely business point of view, I have benefited to an enormous
+and altogether unexpected extent by your father's will, and if any
+contest between us could arise it should be on the ground that he
+has acted unfairly to you by giving me so large a proportion of the
+money that, in the course of nature, you should have inherited. It
+was not even as if he had known and liked me, for I was but four
+years old at the time he wrote the letter saying that I was to
+share the money and jewels with you."
+
+"You are very obstinate and very disagreeable, Mark," she said,
+with tears in her eyes.
+
+"I think the obstinacy has been principally on your side, Millicent;
+though certainly I should not think of saying that you have been
+disagreeable. It has been an excess of kindheartedness on your
+part, and you have resolutely closed your eyes to the fact that,
+had I been willing to take advantage of your generosity, I should
+have lacked the courage to do so, for I should have been pointed at
+wherever I went, as a mean fellow who took advantage of his little
+cousin's romantic generosity. Pray, dear, let us say no more about
+it. We are two rich young people; we have both an estate; yours,
+I grant, is the larger, but if I choose I can increase mine, until
+it is quite as large as Crowswood. We can be better friends than
+we have been for the last year, because this point of dispute has
+always stood between us and made us uncomfortable. Now you will
+have to think over what you would like done, and whether you wish
+any change made in your manner of living."
+
+"Did you tell Mr. Cotter," Millicent laughed, after a pause, "that
+I had a half share in the money?"
+
+"No, that was a matter for you to decide, not for me. I told him
+that I was only a half shareholder, but there was no necessity to
+say who it was who had the other half. When I was talking to Philip
+Cotter, the words 'my cousin' slipped out, but he did not associate
+it in any way with you. It might have been the son of another
+brother or of a sister of my father's."
+
+"In that case, then, we will certainly make no change, will we,
+Mrs. Cunningham?"
+
+"I think, Millicent, that Mr. Prendergast and Mark will probably
+be of opinion that you ought now to be introduced regularly into
+society. The fact that you are a rich heiress might, as your father
+so much wished, remain a secret. But it is one thing having this
+blazoned about and quite another for you to be living quietly here,
+where, with the exception of Mr. Cotter and a few other friends,
+you have no society whatever. Certainly it was not the wish of your
+father that you should remain unmarried. You are quite pretty and
+nice enough to be sought for yourself alone, and I must say that
+I think, now that you have finished with your various masters, it
+would be well that you should go out a good deal more, and that as
+a first step we should go down to Bath this year instead of paying
+another visit to Weymouth, as we had arranged."
+
+"I don't want any change at all, Mrs. Cunningham. If I am to get
+married I shall be married; if I am not I shall not fret about it."
+
+"But for all that, Millicent," Mark said, "Mrs. Cunningham is
+right. We quite agree that there is no occasion whatever for you
+to go about labeled 'A good estate and over 70,000 pounds in cash,'
+but I do think that it is right that you should go into society.
+With the exception of Philip Cotter, Dick Chetwynd, and two or three
+other of my friends, you really know very few people. You have now
+gone out of mourning, and I think that Mrs. Cunningham's proposal
+that you should go down to Bath is a very good one. I shall not
+be sorry for a change myself, for I have been engrossed in my work
+for a long time now. I can go down a day or two before you, and get
+you comfortable lodgings, and will myself stay at a hotel. Although
+I have no intimate friends beyond those from Reigate, I know a large
+number of men of fashion from meeting them at the boxing schools
+and other places, and could introduce you both, and get you into
+society."
+
+"I am altogether opposed to the idea," Millicent said decidedly.
+"You want to trot me out like a horse for sale."
+
+"No, Millicent," Mark said calmly. "I only want you to have the
+same advantages that other girls have, neither more nor less, and
+for you to enjoy yourself as others do. There is nothing undignified
+or objectionable about that, especially as we are agreed that
+nothing shall be said about your fortune. Well, we will think it
+over. Mr. Prendergast and I certainly do not wish to act as tyrants,
+and there is no occasion to come to a decision in a hurry. We have
+only discovered our good fortune today, and can scarcely appreciate
+the difference that it will make to us. We can think over what will
+be for the best at our leisure, and see if we cannot hit upon some
+plan that will be agreeable to you."
+
+"Thank you, Mark," she said gratefully. "I am afraid that you must
+think me very disagreeable and cross; but though you, as a man,
+have not the same sort of feelings, I can assure you that I feel
+all this money and so on to be a heavy burden; and were it not for
+your sake I could wish heartily that this treasure had never been
+discovered at all."
+
+"I can quite understand that," he said quietly. "At the present
+moment, even, I do not see that it will be of much advantage to me;
+but it may be that some day I shall see it in a different light. It
+has come upon me almost as suddenly as it has upon you. I thought
+that after I had finished with the Bastow affair I should set to
+work to find out this treasure, and that it would probably take me
+out to India, occupy me there for some time, and that afterwards I
+might travel through other places, and be away from England three
+or four years. Now the matter is altogether altered, and I shall
+be some time before I form any fresh plans. In fact, these must
+depend upon circumstances."
+
+Mrs. Cunningham had left the room two or three minutes before,
+thinking that Mark might be able to talk her charge into a more
+reasonable state of mind were he alone with her, and he added:
+
+"Of one circumstance in particular."
+
+She looked up inquiringly.
+
+"Well, Millicent, it depends a great deal upon you. I know you think
+that all that has happened during the past year has been a little
+hard upon you, and I thoroughly agree with you; you were fond
+of Crowswood, and were very happy there, and the change to this
+somewhat dull house, just at a time when you are of an age to enjoy
+pleasure, has been a trial. Then, too, there has been this question
+of the estate upon your mind. But you must remember it has been
+somewhat of a trial to me also. I grant that I have had plenty of
+occupation which has been in every way beneficial to me, and have
+not at all lamented leaving the country, but in one respect it
+has been a trial. I don't know whether it ever entered your mind,
+before that sad time at home, that I was getting to care for you
+in a very different way to that in which I had done before.
+
+"My father, I think, observed it, for he threw out a very plain hint
+once that he would very gladly see us coming together. However, I
+never spoke of it to you. I was young and you were young. It seemed
+to me that there was plenty of time, and that, moreover, it would
+not be fair for me to speak to you until you had had the opportunity
+of going out and of seeing other men. Then came the evening before
+his death, when my father told me how matters really stood, and
+he again said that there was a way by which all trouble could be
+obviated. But I saw that it was not so, and that the hope I had
+entertained must be put aside. I had never told you I loved you when
+I seemed to be the heir of the property and you only the daughter
+of an old comrade of his, and I saw that were I to speak now,
+when you were the heiress, it could not but appear to you that it
+was the estate and not you that I wanted, and I felt my lips were
+sealed forever. Mr. Prendergast said that day when he came down to
+the funeral, and you told him that you would not take the property,
+that it might be managed in another way, and you said that you did
+not want to be married for your money; so you see you saw it in
+exactly the same light as I did.
+
+"My first thought this morning, when Mr. Cotter told me that the
+money had mounted up to over 100,000 pounds, was that it would unseal
+my lips. You were still better off than I was, but the difference
+was now immaterial. I was a rich man, and had not the smallest
+occasion to marry for money. Whether I married a girl without a
+penny, or an heiress, could make but little difference to me, as I
+have certainly no ambition to become a great landowner. I still think
+that it would have been more fair to you to give you the opportunity
+of seeing more of the society of the world before speaking to you,
+but you see you are opposed to that, and therefore it would be the
+same did I wait patiently another year, which I don't think I should
+be able to do. I love you, Millicent. It is only during the past
+eighteen months, when I have thought that I had lost you, that I
+have known how much I love you, and how much my happiness depends
+upon you. I can truly say that were you penniless, it would make no
+shadow of difference to me. It is no longer a question of arranging
+matters comfortably: it is a question of love. The estate is nothing
+to me. It never has been anything, and it does not count at all in
+the scale. I hope that you will put it altogether out of your mind
+in giving me an answer; and that if you cannot say as truly and
+wholly as I do, 'I love you,' that you will say as frankly as you
+have always spoken to me, 'I love you very much as a cousin, Mark,
+but not in that way.'"
+
+The girl had sat perfectly quiet while he was speaking.
+
+He was standing before her now, and he took one of her hands.
+
+"I love you, dear; I love you with all my heart. Do you love me?"
+
+Then she looked up and rose to her feet, and placed both hands upon
+his shoulders.
+
+"As you love me, so I love you, Mark."
+
+After that, conversation languished till Mrs. Cunningham came into
+the room, five minutes later.
+
+"We have come to the conclusion, Mrs. Cunningham," he said, "that
+there will be no necessity for the visit to Bath. Millicent is
+otherwise provided for; she has promised to be my wife."
+
+"I am glad, Mark, glad indeed!" and she took Millicent in her
+arms and kissed her tenderly. "I have all along hoped for it, but
+I began to be afraid that you were both such obstinate young people
+that it would never come about. I know that your father wished it,
+Mark, and he told me that his brother had said that it would be a
+good arrangement if some day you should come to like each other.
+I have guessed for the last year, and, indeed, before then, that
+Millicent would not say 'No' if you ever asked her; but this stupid
+estate seemed to stand in the way. Of late, I have even come to
+hope that the obstinate girl would keep to her intention, and that
+if, as I knew would be the case, you refused to take the estate,
+she would give it away to some charity. In that case, there could
+be nothing to prevent your speaking; and even then you would have
+been between you very fairly equipped with this world's goods.
+However, the present is a far better solution, and the discovery of
+the treasure has saved you from three years' waiting before things
+were straightened out. I feel as if I were her mother, Mark, having
+had her in my charge since she was a baby; and as she grew up it
+became my fondest hope to see you united some day, and I think that
+I am almost as pleased that my hope has been fulfilled as you are
+yourselves."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII.
+
+
+After thinking over the best way in which to set about the work of
+carrying the diamonds to Amsterdam, Mark decided upon asking the
+advice of his late chief. The latter said, as Mark entered his
+room:
+
+"I did not expect to see you here again, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"Well, sir, I have come to ask your' advice about another matter
+altogether."
+
+"What is it now?"
+
+"I have to convey a diamond bracelet of very great value across to
+Amsterdam. I have reasons to believe that there is a plot to seize
+it on the way, and that the men engaged will hesitate at nothing
+to achieve their object. Under these circumstances I should be very
+much obliged if you will tell me what would be the best course to
+pursue. I must say that the bracelet is, with many other jewels,
+in a strong teak box of about a foot square, at present in the
+possession of our bankers; they were brought from India by my uncle.
+I imagine that the rest of the jewels are of comparatively little
+importance in the eyes of these men, though doubtless they would take
+them also if they lay their hands on them. The bracelet, however,
+is of special interest to them, not so much for its intrinsic value,
+as because it was stolen from one of their sacred idols.
+
+"This was about twenty years ago; but I have reason to believe
+that the search for it on the part of some Hindoos connected with
+the temple has never ceased. The soldier who took it was murdered;
+his comrade, into whose hands they next passed, was also murdered.
+They next came to my uncle, who forwarded it at once to England.
+His bungalows were searched again and again, until probably the
+fellows came to the conclusion that he must have either buried it or
+sent it away. Nevertheless, to the day of his death he was firmly
+convinced that he was closely followed, and every movement watched.
+He warned my father solemnly that he too would be watched, but
+as far as we know it was not so; at any rate, we had no reason to
+suppose that the house was ever entered. On the other hand, I am
+convinced I have been watched more or less closely ever since I
+came up to town, and as I came out from the bank yesterday I saw
+a man--a colored fellow, I believe--on the watch.
+
+"My uncle said that my life would not be worth an hour's purchase
+so long as I had the bracelet in my possession, and advised that
+it should be taken straight over to Amsterdam, broken up, and the
+diamonds sold singly to the merchants there."
+
+"It is a curious story, Mr. Thorndyke. I own to ignorance of these
+Indian thieves and their ways, but it certainly seems extraordinary
+that so hopeless a quest should be kept up for so long a time.
+You are sure that it is not fancy on your part that you have been
+watched? I know you are not the sort of man to take fancies in your
+head, but as you have had the matter so strongly impressed upon
+you, you might naturally have been inclined to think this would be
+the case when it was not so."
+
+"No, I don't think there is any chance of my being mistaken. It is
+only of late that I have thought about it, but when I did so and
+thought over what had passed since I came to London, I recalled the
+fact that I had very often come across foreign seamen; sometimes
+they were Lascars, at others they might have been Italian or Spanish
+seamen; and you see, sir, it was, as I told you at the time, some
+foreign sailor who came and informed Gibbons that I had fallen
+into the hands of a gang of criminals, and that I should certainly
+be killed if I was not rescued immediately. Gibbons at once got
+together half a dozen fighting men, and, as you know, rescued me
+just in time. It was extraordinary that the man never came forward
+to obtain any reward."
+
+"That was a friendly act, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"Yes, I have no reason to suppose that these men would be hostile
+to me personally. I was not the thief, I was simply the person who
+happened to be in possession, or rather, might come into possession
+of the bracelet. From the close watch they had kept, they were, I
+imagine, well aware that I had not got it, but may have thought,
+and doubtless did think, that I had some clew to its hiding place,
+and should sooner or later get it. With my death the clew might be
+finally lost, and my life was consequently of extreme importance
+to them, and therefore they took steps to have me rescued, and
+the fact that they learned this and knew how friendly I was with
+Gibbons shows how close was the watch kept over me. No doubt, had
+Gibbons refused to help them, they would have come here at once."
+
+"Certainly, after what you say it would seem that your conjecture is
+right, and in this case, if I were you, I should take the bracelet
+out of the case and conceal it about me. I would not fetch it myself
+from the bank."
+
+"I don't think I should be much safer so," Mark said thoughtfully.
+"In the first place, I must go to the bank to get them, and I
+might be murdered merely on the supposition that I had brought the
+bracelet away. In the next place, even if I got to Amsterdam safely
+and got rid of the bracelet and returned unnoticed by them, a fresh
+danger would arise when I got the other gems into my possession,
+for they could not be certain whether the diamonds were still among
+them or not."
+
+"I should hardly think that would be the case if they watch you
+as strictly as you believe. Even if none of them accompanied you,
+they would soon find out what diamond merchants you went to, and the
+leader might call upon these men, stating that he was commissioned
+to purchase some diamonds of exceptional value for an Eastern
+Prince, in which case he would be sure to obtain sight of them.
+
+"If I had your business to perform, I would not go near the bank
+again, but would send some friend I could trust to go and open the
+box, and take out the bracelet, and make it into a small parcel. He
+should hand it to you privately, as you are on your way to embark
+for Amsterdam. Then I would take with me one or two of my men,
+and, say, a couple of your prize fighters, and with such a guard
+you ought to be fairly safe."
+
+"I think that is a capital plan," Mark said, "and if I don't go to
+the bank there will be nothing to lead them to suppose that I have
+taken them out, or that I am just going across to Holland."
+
+Mark then went straight to Dick Chetwynd's lodgings.
+
+"I want you to do me a service, Dick," he said.
+
+"With pleasure, Mark. What sort of service is it? If it is anything
+in my power, you know that you can absolutely rely upon me. You
+are not going to fight a duel, are you, and want a second?"
+
+"No; quite another sort of business. I will tell you shortly what
+it is. I have to convey an extremely valuable diamond bracelet to
+Amsterdam, and I have reason to believe that there will be an attempt
+to murder me, and to carry off the jewels before I can dispose of
+them. It happened in this way;" and he then related the history of
+the diamonds, the reason he was followed, and the suggestions that
+the Chief of the Bow Street detectives had given him.
+
+"That is all right," Dick said, when he concluded. "It is a rum
+business, but certainly I will do what you ask me; and, what is more,
+I will go over with you to Amsterdam, and see the thing through.
+It is an interesting business, if it is a queer one."
+
+"You know Philip Cotter?"
+
+"Of course, Mark; why, I have met him with you several times."
+
+"I will give you a note to ask him to allow you to open the case,
+and to take from it the bracelet; I don't know whether it is a
+regular gold mounted bracelet, or simply some diamonds that have
+been fastened together as a necklace; however, I suppose you are
+sure to recognize them; they are altogether exceptional stones,
+and will certainly be done up in a packet by themselves, whatever
+the others may be. Say that you will call in and take them away
+some other time, of which I will give him notice by letter. I will
+write the note now, and if you can spare time to go there today,
+all the better, for I shall be glad to get the business over; then
+I will come again tomorrow morning, and we will arrange the details
+of the plan. I will look in the shipping list, and see what vessels
+are sailing for Amsterdam. When we have fixed on one, it will
+be best for you to take our passages under any names you like, so
+that they are not our own. The detectives will take their passages
+separately, and so will Gibbons and whoever else goes with us."
+
+"I will go at once, Mark."
+
+"Don't go straight there, Dick; if these fellows are dogging my
+footsteps everywhere, and saw me coming here, they might take it
+into their heads to follow you."
+
+"Oh, they can never be doing all that sort of thing; that's too
+much to believe. However, to please you, I will go into my club
+for a quarter of an hour. Shall I come round to your rooms this
+evening, or will you come here?"
+
+"I think I will put off our meeting altogether until tomorrow
+morning. I have an engagement this evening that I cannot very well
+get out of."
+
+"All right, Mark, just as you please. What time will you come round
+in the morning?"
+
+"About the time you have finished breakfast. I will go now, and
+have a look at the shipping list."
+
+They parted at the door, and Mark went to the coffee house where
+shipping matters were specially attended to, and where master
+mariners might often be met, conversing together, or with ship
+owners or merchants. On going through the list, he found that the
+fast sailing brig, Essex, of 204 tons, and mounting eight guns,
+would sail for Amsterdam in three days' time, and would take in
+goods for that place, and, should sufficient freight be obtained,
+for any other Dutch port. It was also announced that she had good
+accommodation for passengers. Information as to cargo could be
+obtained from her owners, on Tower Hill, or from the captain on
+board, between the hours of ten and twelve. Then, in small type,
+it was stated that the Essex was at present lying in the outside
+tier nearly opposite Anderson's wharf.
+
+Mark made a note of all these particulars in his pocketbook, and
+then went to Ingleston's public house.
+
+"Morning, Mr. Thorndyke," the man said; "haven't seen yer for the
+last month or so."
+
+"No; I have been out of town. Do you expect Gibbons. in here this
+morning?"
+
+"It is about his time, sir, when he has nothing in particular to
+see about. Like a turn with the mauleys this morning?"
+
+"Not this morning, Ingleston. I have got some engagements for the
+next day or two where I could not very well show myself with a
+black eye or a swelled nose; you have given me a good many of both."
+
+"Well, Mr. Thorndyke, when one stands up against a man who is as
+strong as one's self, and a mighty quick and hard hitter, you have
+got to hit sharp and quick too. You know my opinion, that there
+aint half a dozen men in the country could lick you if you had a
+proper training."
+
+"I suppose you couldn't get away for a week, or maybe two?" he
+said.
+
+"Lor' bless you, no, sir. Who would there be to keep order here
+at night? When I first came here I had not given up the ring, and
+I fought once or twice afterwards. But, Lor' bless you, I soon
+found that I had got either to give up the pub or the ring, and
+as I was doing a tidy business here, I thought it best to retire;
+since then business has grown. You see, boxing is more fashionable
+than it used to be, and there are very few nights when one don't
+have a dozen Corinthians in here--sometimes there are twice as
+many--either to see some of the new hands put on the mauleys,
+and judge for themselves how they are going to turn out, or maybe
+to arrange for a bout between some novice they fancy and one of
+the west countrymen. No, sir, I could not do it anyhow; I should
+not like to be away even for one night, though I know Gibbons would
+look after things for me; as for being away for a week, I could
+not do it for any money. No, sir, my fight with Jackson last year
+was the last time I shall ever go into the ring. I was a fool to
+go in for that, but I got taunted into it. I never thought that
+I should lick him, though, as you know, sir, I have licked a good
+many good men in my time, but Jackson is an out and out man, and
+he has got a lot more science than I ever had; my only chance was
+that I could knock him out of time or wear him down; but he was
+too quick on his pins for me to do the former. Ah, Gibbons, here
+is Mr. Thorndyke. He wants to see you; you had best go into my room
+behind the bar."
+
+"Want to get hold of a fresh hand, Mr. Thorndyke?" Gibbons asked
+when they had sat down by the fire.
+
+"No, Gibbons, it is another business altogether. Have you got
+anything particular to keep you in town for the next fortnight? It
+may not be over a week, but it may be over a fortnight."
+
+"No, sir," the man said, after taking three or four draws at
+his long pipe. "No, sir; they won't want the ropes and stakes for
+another three weeks, so I am your man if you want me. What, is it
+for, sir?"
+
+"Well, it is rather a curious affair, Gibbons. I have to take
+a very valuable bracelet over to Amsterdam, to sell there, and I
+have very strong reasons for believing that if some fellows get an
+inkling of it they will try to put me out of the way, and get hold
+of the diamonds. I want a couple of good men to go with me."
+
+"Well sir, I should say you and me could lick a dozen ordinary
+chaps, without thinking anything of it."
+
+"I dare say we could, Gibbons, in a stand up fight without weapons,
+but I fancy these fellows will not try that. They are foreigners,
+and the first thing they would try would be to put a dagger between
+my shoulders as I walked up and down on deck at night, or, more
+likely still, creep into my cabin and stab me while I was asleep.
+If the voyage were only to last one night I might sit up, pistol in
+hand, but if the wind is foul we might be a week. We are a pretty
+strong party. Mr. Chetwynd--you know him--is going with me;
+there will also be two runners from Bow Street, and I want you
+to take another good man with you. Of course, on board we shall
+separate. The Bow Street men will watch the passengers, and you and
+your mate will smoke your pipes and keep yourselves ready to join
+in if you see there is going to be a row. But I rather think that
+the passage will be a quiet one. At Amsterdam, until I have got rid
+of the diamonds I certainly should not care about going out into
+the street after nightfall without having you close behind me."
+
+"All right, sir. I should say Tom Tring would be as good a man as
+one could get at the job. What is the money to be, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"Well, what do you think yourself, Gibbons?"
+
+"I take it you pay all expenses, sir?"
+
+"Yes, everything."
+
+"Would five and twenty guineas a head be too much?"
+
+"No; I will do better than that. I will give you five and twenty
+guineas each when we get to Amsterdam, and I will give you another
+twenty-five each if I come back here safe and sound."
+
+"Well, I call that handsome. One could not want more, and you can
+rely on it that Tring will jump at the offer. He has not been able
+to get a fight on lately, and he is rather in low water."
+
+"Well, you will both get up as quiet traders. I don't know what
+other passengers there may be, but I don't want them to know that
+you belong to the fancy."
+
+"I twig, sir. We will get up quiet like."
+
+"Then I want you tomorrow morning, Gibbons, to go down to Holmes
+& Moore, No. 67 Tower Street, and take two first class tickets to
+Amsterdam on board the Essex, which sails on Saturday. I don't know
+what the passage money will be, but this is sure to be enough; and
+we can settle accounts afterwards. You will find out what time of
+day she will start."
+
+"All right, governor. I suppose you will be here again before that?"
+
+"No, I don't suppose I shall, unless there is some change in the
+arrangements. If for any reasons Tring cannot go with you, you will
+get somebody else instead. You are sure that you quite understand
+your instructions? Here is the name and address of the people in
+Tower Street."
+
+"All right, sir. You may make sure that when you go down to the
+ship you will see the two of us on board."
+
+It needed but a few minutes at Bow Street to inform the chief of
+the arrangements that had been made.
+
+"I have told off Chester and Malcolm; one of them shall go down
+and take their tickets. Of course, they will take their passages
+in the fore cabin, as the danger, if there is danger, may come from
+there, and you will have your other two men with you aft. I fancy
+myself that there is hardly any chance of your being in any way
+troubled while on board. It will be considered that there will
+be a vastly greater chance of carrying out any plan they may have
+formed at Amsterdam than there would be on board a ship; you see,
+if there were any struggle whatever on board there would be no
+escape for them.
+
+"For myself, of course I cannot give any opinion worth having in
+a matter so different from anything we have to do with here, and I
+should have unhesitatingly scoffed at the idea of anyone watching
+the movements of people for a long number of years in order to
+obtain the possession of jewels, however valuable. However, your
+uncle was well acquainted with the habits of Hindoos, and was not
+a man to be lightly alarmed; you yourself, after your year with us,
+should not be deceived in such a matter as being yourself followed;
+under these circumstances you are quite right to take every
+precaution, and as you pay well for the services of our two men,
+even if I had no belief whatever in the existence of danger to you,
+I should not feel justified in refusing to let you have them."
+
+Having arranged these matters, Mark spent the rest of his time that
+day and the next at Islington.
+
+"I am going across to Amsterdam on Saturday with a diamond bracelet
+to sell there."
+
+Millicent looked at him in reproachful surprise.
+
+"Why, surely, Mark, there can be no hurry about that. I think you
+might have stayed a little longer before running away."
+
+"I should do so, you may be quite sure, Millicent, if I consulted
+my own inclinations, but I am bearing out your father's wishes.
+This bracelet is the most valuable of all the things he had, and
+I believe that it has some sort of history attached to it. He told
+my father that he had sent all the gems home principally to get
+these diamonds out of his possession; he said that as soon as my
+father got hold of the things, he was to take the diamonds straight
+over to Amsterdam and sell them there, for he considered that they
+were much too valuable to be kept in the house, and that it was
+possible that some of the Hindoos might endeavor to get possession
+of them. At the time he spoke he believed that my father would, at
+his death, go to the bank and get the jewels, as of course he would
+have done if he had known where to find them. My father promised
+him that they should be taken to Amsterdam at once; and although
+so many years have passed since his death, I think I am bound to
+carry out that promise."
+
+"I have never been able to understand, Mark, how it was that
+my father, when he gave all these instructions about me and these
+jewels and so on, did not at the same time tell uncle where to find
+them."
+
+"It was a fancy of his; he was in very bad health, and he thought
+so much over these diamonds that it had become almost a sort of
+mania with him that not only was there danger in their possession,
+but that he was watched night and day wherever he went. He thought,
+even, if he whispered where the hiding place was to be discovered
+it might be heard; therefore he deferred telling it until too
+late. Of course all this was but a fancy on his part, although it
+is probable enough that the possession of the diamonds was a source
+of danger in India, and might have been a source of danger here had
+any thieves known that such valuable gems were kept in a private
+house or carried about. At any rate, I shall be glad to be free of
+the responsibility; and although, naturally, I don't like leaving
+you at the present time, I think it best to carry out your father's
+instructions at once, and to get them off my mind altogether. Dick
+Chetwynd is going with me, so it will be a pleasant little trip."
+
+"Well, I am glad he is going with you, Mark; for although I know
+well enough that they could never be watching for those diamonds
+to turn up all these years, I feel sure I should fidget and worry
+if you were alone. You are not going to take the others with you?"
+
+"No, only this particular bracelet. None of the others are
+exceptionally valuable, so far as I know. At any rate, your father
+did not specially allude to them. I have no doubt that there are
+some really valuable jewels among them, for my uncle prided himself
+on being a judge of precious stones, and as he invested a large
+amount of money in them, they are, no doubt, worth a great deal.
+Still, I don't suppose there will be any difficulty in selling them
+here, and, at any rate, I don't want to be delayed at Amsterdam by
+having to sell perhaps fifty or a hundred pieces of jewelry; any
+time will do for that. I fancy that I ought to be able to dispose of
+the bracelet in three or four days at the outside. I have got from
+Bow Street a list of all the principal diamond merchants in Amsterdam.
+That is a matter of great interest to the force, as almost all
+precious stones stolen in this country are sent across there, and
+if there is any special jewel robbery we send over a list of all
+the articles taken to the merchants there. As a rule, that would
+not prevent their dealing in them, but there are some who will not
+touch things that have been dishonestly come by, and we occasionally
+get hints that enable us to lay hands upon thieves over there."
+
+"I hate to hear you say 'the force,' Mark, just as if you were
+still a detective; it is bad enough that you should have belonged
+to it, even for the purpose you did; but you have done with it
+now."
+
+"Yes; but, you see, it is rather difficult to get out of the habit
+when one has been for over a year constantly at work at a thing.
+This will be my last absence on business, Millicent; henceforward
+I shall be able to be always with you."
+
+"Well, now that I know what you have been doing all this time,
+Mark, I must admit that you have been very good to have been with
+us as much as you have. I often used to wonder how you passed your
+time. Of course I knew that you were trying to find that man out,
+but it did not seem to me that you could be always at that, and
+I never dreamt that you had become a regular detective. I am very
+glad I did not know it till a short time before you gave it up. In
+the first place, I should have been horrified, and, in the second
+place, I should have been constantly uneasy about you. However, as
+this is to be the last time, I will let you go without grumbling."
+
+"By the way, Millicent, what do you wish me to say about our
+engagement? I don't see that there is the slightest occasion for
+us to keep up the farce of your being Miss Conyers any longer. You
+cannot be married under a false name, you know, and now that you
+have escaped what your father was so afraid of, and are going to
+be married for love and not for money, I don't see why there should
+be any more mystery about it."
+
+"But how would you account for my having been called Conyers all
+this time?"
+
+"I should simply tell the truth; that your father, having a great
+fear that you might be married for money, left the estate to my
+father, to be held by him until you came of age, and that it was
+at his particular request that you were brought up simply as his
+ward, and dropped the family name and passed by your two Christian
+names. I should say that we have all been aware for a long time of
+the facts of the case, and I should also say that your father had
+left a very large fortune in addition to the estate between us,
+and had expressed a hope that we should, when the time came, marry
+each other."
+
+"Then people will think that we have only married to keep the
+fortune together, Mark."
+
+"Well, my dear, I don't suppose there are a great many people who
+will be interested in the matter, and those who get to know you
+will see at once that as far as I am concerned, there was no great
+difficulty in falling in with your father's ideas, while, on the
+other hand, they may consider that you made a noble sacrifice of
+yourself in agreeing to the plan."
+
+"Nonsense, sir. I am not going to flatter you, as no doubt you
+expect; but, at any rate, I am perfectly content with my share of
+the bargain."
+
+"Well, there is one thing, Millicent; all who knew us down at
+Reigate will say that it is a very sensible arrangement, and will
+be glad to know that I shall retain the estate they have hitherto
+considered to be mine. Well, then, you agree to my mentioning to
+my intimate friends that you are my cousin, and that we are engaged?"
+
+"Yes, I suppose it is the best thing, Mark, and, as you say, I must
+marry under my proper name, and it is just as well to get the talk
+over down at Reigate now, as for it all to come as a wonder when
+we are married."
+
+"When is that going to be, Millicent?"
+
+"Oh, I don't know; of course it will be a long time before we even
+think of that."
+
+"I beg your pardon, I am thinking of it now, and I can see no
+reason whatever why it should be delayed. We know each other well
+enough, I should think, and there is no probability of our changing
+our minds on discovering all sorts of faults, that we never dreamt,
+in each other. I may be away for a fortnight, and I would suggest
+that you had better make your preparations at once, so that we can
+be married a fortnight after I come back."
+
+"You say that there is no fear of our discovering faults in each
+other. I can assure you that I have just discovered a very serious
+fault, namely, that you are altogether too masterful, too bent
+upon having your own way. I know you always were so when you were
+a boy, but I hoped you had grown out of it; now I see that I was
+altogether mistaken. Seriously, Mark, your proposal is absurd."
+
+"Where does the absurdity come in, Millicent?"
+
+"Well, everywhere," she said gravely.
+
+"Which in the present case means nowhere," he said. "Do you mean
+to tell me, Millicent, that in this town there are not a hundred
+dressmakers, each of whom could turn you out a wedding dress and
+as many other garments as you can possibly require in the course
+of a month, or even if that effort were too stupendous, that you
+could not divide the work among a dozen of them?"
+
+"Well, I don't say that could not be done," Millicent admitted
+reluctantly.
+
+"Well, what other objection is there?"
+
+"Well, you see, one does not, like to be bustled in such a matter
+as this, Mark. One likes to think it all over and to realize it to
+one's self."
+
+"Well, dear, you will have a fortnight while I am away to think
+and to realize as much as you like. I can see no advantage myself
+in waiting a single day longer than there is a necessity for; I
+have been for the last year coming here merely as a visitor, and I
+want to take possession of you and have you all to myself. I suppose
+Mrs. Cunningham will be coming in presently, and I will put the
+matter to her. If she says you cannot be ready in a month I must
+give you another week, but I don't think that she will say so. By
+the way, how about her?"
+
+"I was thinking of that last night, Mark. It would be very lonely
+for her to live by herself now, and you see she has always been as
+a mother to me."
+
+"Quite so, dear; and I am sure that I should have no objection to
+her coming back to Crowswood, and living there as a friend, and
+helping you in the housekeeping."
+
+"Thank you very much, Mark; I should like that in every way. You
+see, I know nothing whatever about housekeeping; and besides, when
+you are out, it would be a great thing to have her with me, for it
+would be very lonely by myself in that big house."
+
+"Well, we will have her there, by all means, dear, if she likes to
+come; you had better talk it over with her. Ah! here she is.
+
+"We were just talking over the time it will take Millicent to get
+ready," he said, "and I shall be glad of your opinion. I have been
+telling her that I am going away for a fortnight, and have proposed
+that the marriage should come off a fortnight later. I cannot see
+any use in delay, and she does not either; at least, I suppose not,
+for the only objection she has advanced is that there will be but
+a short time in which to get her things ready. That strikes me as
+being all nonsense. I could get things ready for ten weddings in
+that time. What do you think?"
+
+"I see no reason for delay," Mrs. Cunningham said; "and assuredly
+a month ought to be sufficient to get everything made."
+
+"Thank you, Mrs. Cunningham; then we can consider that settled,
+Millicent!"
+
+"I call this tyranny, Mrs. Cunningham," Millicent protested. "He
+says he proposes that we shall be married in a month; it is not
+a proposal at all, it is an order. If he had wanted me in such a
+hurry he might have said so a year ago, and now that he has made
+up his mind at last, he wants everything done in a hurry."
+
+"It is the nature of men, my dear; they are all alike in that
+respect. I think you had better make up your mind to it, especially
+as I have no doubt in this case the order is not a very unpleasant
+one."
+
+"You are too bad, Mrs. Cunningham," Millicent said. "I made sure
+that I should find you on my side, and it seems you have gone over
+altogether to the enemy."
+
+"Where are you going to?" asked Mrs. Cunningham of Mark.
+
+"I am going across to Amsterdam to sell that bracelet. My uncle
+expressed a particular wish to my father that he should do so
+immediately it came into his possession. Dick Chetwynd is going over
+with me, and if the weather is fair it will be a pleasant trip."
+
+"Where are you thinking of going after the marriage?"
+
+"We have not talked it over yet. My own idea is that, as neither
+of us has been abroad, we might as well take this opportunity
+for seeing something of the Continent. Of course we cannot go to
+France, things are in too disturbed a state there; but we might go
+to Brussels, and then into Germany, and perhaps as far as Vienna,
+and then down into Italy; but of course, if Millicent prefers it,
+we will simply take a tour through England and Scotland."
+
+"Oh, I am glad that I am to have some voice in the matter,"
+Millicent said. "However, I should like the tour you propose very
+much, Mark. I have often thought that I should like to see Italy
+above all places."
+
+"Well, then, we will consider that settled. And now, what are you
+going to do for today?"
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX.
+
+
+The Essex was to sail at eleven o'clock. Half an hour before that
+time Mark's hackney coach drew up at the wharf. Ten minutes later
+Dick Chetwynd, who had, like Mark, driven by a circuitous route,
+and had made several stoppages, joined him, and as they shook hands
+slipped a parcel into his hand, and this Mark at once pocketed,
+and buttoned his coat up tightly; then hailing a boat, they went
+on board together; they had sent their luggage on the previous
+evening. On getting on board Mark saw the two prize fighters walking
+up and down the deck aft. They were quietly dressed, and save for
+their size would have attracted no attention, and would have been
+taken for two countrymen on their way to Holland on business.
+
+The two detectives were seated forward, their appearance being that
+of two quiet business men, commercial travelers or small traders.
+The two friends first went below, and saw to the cabin which they
+were to share, and found their luggage was all there. Then they
+returned on deck. Four or five other passengers were standing watching
+the last bales of goods coming on board. The tide was just on the
+turn, and a quarter of an hour later the warps were thrown off,
+and some of the sails hoisted, and the Essex began to move through
+the water.
+
+"Look there, Dick!" Mark exclaimed. "Do you see that boat lying
+on its oars in the middle of the stream? That man sitting in the
+stern is a foreigner, either from Southern Europe or from India."
+
+"He is certainly a dark man, Mark. Still, that may be only a
+coincidence."
+
+"It is rather a curious one," Mark said. "We are too far off to
+see his features, but he is apparently watching us off. There, the
+oars are dipping into the water, now he sees that we are fairly
+under way."
+
+"Well, Mark, I shall begin to think that you are right. I am bound
+to say that hitherto I thought that it was ridiculous to suppose
+that you could have been watched as you thought, and that you had
+got these diamonds on your brain till you had really become fanciful.
+However, it certainly looks as if you were right; but even if you
+were, how on earth could they have found out that we were going by
+this ship?"
+
+"That is more than I can tell; if they have been watching me
+they must have known that I was intimate with you; they have seen
+me come out of Cotter's Bank, and afterwards enter your lodgings;
+they would feel sure that I had heard that there would be danger
+connected with the diamonds, and might suppose that I should
+get some friend to take them from the bank, and may have followed
+your movements as well as mine. In that case they would have found
+out that you also went to Cotter's Bank; may have followed you to
+Tower Street, and found out that you had taken a passage for two
+to Amsterdam. They may again have seen you go to the bank this
+morning and have guessed that you had the diamonds about you, and
+then seeing us together on the wharf would feel pretty certain
+that it was so. One of them may have hired that boat and watched
+the Essex to see that neither of us went on shore again."
+
+"Now they see that we are off they will know that their game is
+up," Chetwynd said.
+
+"I am not so sure of that, Dick; there are craft going every day
+to Antwerp and Flushing, and for anything we know some of them may
+be on board a craft already dropping down like ourselves by this
+tide. But even if we had twelve hours' start, by landing, say at
+Flushing, they would have time to cross by land to Amsterdam and
+get there before us."
+
+"Yes, I suppose they would; anyhow, it is pretty certain that we
+shall not be troubled on the voyage."
+
+"Yes, I never thought there was much danger of that, because even
+if they were on board they would see that you and I, being always
+together, could not be got rid of without an alarm being given."
+
+Not until they were passing Greenwich did either of the detectives
+come near Mark, then as he and Dick were standing by the bulwarks,
+looking at the hospital, Chester strolled across the deck and,
+pointing to the building as if asking him some question about it,
+said:
+
+"There is a colored man forward, dressed as a sailor."
+
+"Is that so?" Mark said. "I see no one aft here who looks suspicious,
+and I don't think they will try anything till we get to Amsterdam.
+There was a colored man in a boat watching us as we set sail."
+
+"I saw him, sir. Can he get to Amsterdam before us?"
+
+"Yes, I have no doubt he can; if he lands at Flushing or Antwerp,
+and takes a post chaise or a diligence, I should say he could get
+there twenty-four hours before us. Certainly he could do so if he
+landed at The Hague, as we have to go a long way round to get into
+the Zuyder Zee. That is where the real danger will be; still you
+had better keep a sharp lookout on the man forward."
+
+No more was said. Mark was not long in getting into conversation
+with the other passengers aft, and later on strolled forward with
+Dick, asking the sailors some questions as to what sort of passage
+they were likely to have, and how the wind suited. The men agreed
+that unless the wind shifted they would not be likely to make a
+quick passage.
+
+"The wind is northeasterly," one of them said. "We can only just
+lay our course now, and it will be dead against us in some of the
+reaches. Still, I think we shall manage to make down to sea with
+only a tack or two, but when we are once fairly out of the river
+it will be a long leg and a short one, and going up round the Texel
+it will be dead against us. Except that it would be a bit worse if
+it had a little more east in it, it is about as foul a wind as we
+could have, and I don't see any sign of a change, worse luck."
+
+Presently, moving about among them, he got next to Gibbons.
+
+"I don't think we shall have any trouble on board," he said; "if
+there is any, it will be after we have landed. But you can keep an
+eye on that foreign sailor standing alone there up in the bows."
+
+"All right, sir; if you like, I can manage to get into a quarrel
+with him, and can warrant that he won't get out of his berth before
+it is time to go ashore."
+
+"No, I would leave him alone, Gibbons; as long as he is forward he
+can do no harm; but if you see him working his way aft, after it
+gets dark, it will do him no harm if you manage to stumble against
+him and give him a clout on the head."
+
+"All right, sir; if I hit him once he won't want another. The
+fellow seems quiet enough, and as far as strength goes he don't
+look stronger than a girl."
+
+After chatting for some time longer Mark and Dick Chetwynd went
+aft again. The Essex did not put into any intermediate port, and
+it was only on the sixth day after sailing that she approached
+Amsterdam. The voyage had passed off without any incident except
+that at nine o'clock one evening there had been a slight noise on
+deck and the sound of a fall. The friends went up at once. Several
+of the sailors had run aft, and Gibbons was explaining matters to
+them.
+
+"I was walking up and down the deck," he said, "when I saw this
+chap staring down through the skylight, and I said to him, 'I don't
+call it good manners to be prying down into your betters' cabin.'
+He did not answer or move, so I gave him a push, when he turned
+upon me like a wild cat, and drew his knife from his girdle. There
+it is, on the other side of the deck. As I did not want daylight
+put into me, I just knocked him down."
+
+"Served him right," one of the sailors said. "He had no right to
+come aft at all, and if he drew his knife on you, you were quite
+right in laying him out. But you must have hit him mighty hard, for
+you have knocked the life pretty near out of him. Well, we may as
+well carry him forward and throw a bucket of water over him. That
+is the worst of these foreign chaps; they are always so ready with
+their knives. However, I don't think he will be likely to try his
+hand on an Englishman again."
+
+Mark and his friend went below again. In the morning Mark asked
+one of the sailors if the foreigner was much hurt.
+
+"Well, he is a good bit hurt, sir. That big chap looks as strong
+as a bullock, and his blow has flattened the foreign chap's nose.
+He cannot see out of his eyes this morning, and is keeping his
+bunk. They cannot stand a blow, those foreign chaps; but I don't
+suppose that any of us would have stood such a blow as that, without
+feeling it pretty heavy. The man who hit him is quite sorry this
+morning that he hit him quite so hot, but, as he says, when a
+fellow draws a knife on you, you have not got much time for thinking
+it over, and you have got to hit quick and hard. I told him he
+needn't be sorry about it. I consider when a fellow draws a knife
+that hanging aint too bad for him, whether he gets it into a man
+or not."
+
+There was a growl of assent from two or three sailors standing
+round, for in those days the use of the knife was almost unknown
+in England, and was abhorrent to Englishmen, both as being cowardly
+and unfair, and as being a purely foreign crime.
+
+"It will be dark before we get alongside," Mark said to the two
+detectives. "Do you two walk first; we will keep just behind you,
+and the others shall follow as close as they can keep to us. If
+anyone is looking out for us they will see that we are a strong
+party, and that it would be no good to attack us, for even if
+they were to stab me it would not be possible to search me for the
+diamonds when I am with a party like this."
+
+It was indeed quite dark when the brig brought up outside a tier
+of vessels lying by the wharf. A few oil lamps burning by the quay
+showed that there were a good many people still sauntering about.
+The party waited until the rest of the passengers had landed. They
+learned from one of those who knew the place that the hotel to
+which they were going was but three or four hundred yards away,
+and obtained directions how to find it.
+
+"Now we will go," Mark said. "Gibbons, you had better keep a sharp
+lookout on your own account. That fellow you knocked down may try
+to put a knife into you."
+
+"I will keep a sharp lookout, sir, never you fear."
+
+"I think, Tring, you had better watch Gibbons; he is more in danger
+than I am. Have you seen the man go on shore?"
+
+"Yes, he was the very first to cross onto the next vessel," Tring
+said.
+
+The loungers on the quay had gathered together to watch the
+passengers as they left the ship, and by the dim light from one of
+the oil lamps it could be seen that the majority of them were of
+the roughest class. As they were passing through them a man with a
+cry of rage sprang at Gibbons with an uplifted knife. Tring's fist
+struck him under the ear as he was in the act of striking, and he
+fell like a log. There was a cry of "Down with them!" and a rush
+of a score of men, most of whom were armed with heavy bludgeons.
+
+The party was at once broken up, heavy blows were exchanged, the
+two pugilists rolling their assailants over like ninepins, but
+receiving several heavy blows from their assailants' clubs. A rush
+of five or six men separated Mark from the others. Those in front
+of him he struck down, but a moment later received a tremendous blow
+on the back of the head which struck him to the ground unconscious.
+His companions were all too busy defending themselves against
+their assailants to notice what had been done, and as the attack
+had taken place in the center of the roadway behind the quay, there
+was no lamp, and the fight was taking place in almost total darkness.
+
+By this time many people had run up at the sound of the fray. A
+minute later there was a cry that the watch were coming, and four
+or five men with lanterns emerged from one of the streets leading
+down to the quays, and hurried towards the spot. The fight at once
+ceased, the men who had attacked mingled with the crowd, and when
+the watch came up they found the five Englishmen clustered together
+and ten or twelve men lying on the ground.
+
+The instant that the fight had ceased Dick Chetwynd asked, "Where
+is Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+No answer was given. The other four men simultaneously uttered
+exclamations of alarm. The crowd was thinning fast as the watch
+came up.
+
+"What is all this about?" one of them asked in Dutch.
+
+"Do any of you speak English?" Dick asked.
+
+"I do," one of them said.
+
+"We landed five minutes ago from that craft," continued Dick,
+"and as we came across we were attacked by a band of ruffians. An
+Englishman, one of our party, is missing."
+
+"Whose bodies are these?" the watchman asked, raising his lantern
+and pointing to them.
+
+"Perhaps Mr. Thorndyke is among them," Dick Chetwynd said.
+
+The fallen figures were examined by the light of the lanterns.
+Mark was not among them. The watchmen uttered an exclamation of
+astonishment as they looked at the men's faces.
+
+"What did you strike them with?" the one who spoke first asked.
+
+"Struck them with our fists, of course," Gibbons replied. "They
+will do well enough; you need not bother about them, they will come
+round again presently. The question is, Where is Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+The whole of the lookers on had dispersed, each fearing that he
+might be charged with taking part in the outrage.
+
+"This is a very serious matter," Chetwynd said. "We have every
+reason to believe that the attack was premeditated, for the gentleman
+who is missing was known to have some valuables on him; all these
+fellows ought to be taken and locked up and made to give an account
+of themselves. We are going to the Hotel d'Hollande where you can
+find us at any time. I dare say some of these scoundrels are known
+to you, and that may give you a clew as to where Mr. Thorndyke is.
+
+"I have but little hope that he will be found alive; no doubt he
+has been stabbed and his body carried off so that they can search
+his clothes at their leisure. We came in a strong party to prevent
+the risk of an attack upon Mr. Thorndyke. Here is my card. It is
+of no use our attempting to search by ourselves, but if you will
+get these fellows taken to the watch house, and will call at the
+hotel, we will join your party and help you to search the places
+you think he has most likely been taken to."
+
+"I think, sir, you had better come with me to the watch house, and
+see the Lieutenant, and tell him what has happened."
+
+"I will just take my friends to the hotel, and shall be back from
+there before you have got men to take these fellows away. If you
+go to one of those ships and borrow a bucket, empty it over each
+of them; you will find that will bring them to!"
+
+As soon as they arrived at the hotel Dick ordered a private sitting
+room and five bedrooms.
+
+"We have made a terrible mess of this, lads," he said gloomily.
+"I don't say that it is any of our faults, but it is a horrible
+affair. I have not the least doubt that Mr. Thorndyke has been
+killed, and it is no satisfaction to us that we have pretty nearly
+done for a dozen of those scoundrels."
+
+"I would not have had it happen for a hundred pounds, nor a thousand,
+sir. If there had been daylight we could have licked a score of
+them in spite of their bludgeons, but they came with such a rush
+at us that we got separated before we knew where we were. I don't
+think that it was our fault. I feel as much ashamed as if I had
+thrown up the sponge in the ring at the end of the first round.
+To think that we came over here, four of us, and yourself, sir, on
+purpose to take care of Mr. Thorndyke, all well save a few knocks
+with those sticks, and Mr. Thorndyke killed and carried off before
+we have been on shore five minutes. A better young fellow I never
+put on the gloves with;" and Gibbons passed the back of his hand
+across his eyes.
+
+"Well, I must be off now," Chetwynd said. "I feel heartbroken over
+it. I have known him since we were boys together; and what makes it
+worse is that only three days ago he became engaged to be married.
+How we are going to take the news back God only knows!"
+
+As he hurried down the street towards the wharf he saw a number of
+lanterns coming towards him, and ten or twelve watchmen came along
+escorting the prisoners, many of whose faces were covered with
+blood; then came four other watchmen carrying a body on a stretcher.
+
+"One of them is dead," the watchman who had before spoken said to
+Dick. "A foreign seaman, a Lascar I should say, from his color; we
+found an open knife by his side."
+
+"That is the man who began the fray," Chetwynd said. "He was on the
+point of stabbing one of my companions when another hit him under
+the ear."
+
+"What!" the watchman said. "He must have been hit like the kick
+of a horse. All these prisoners seem to have been struck but once;
+two of them cannot speak. I think their jaws are broken; four of
+them have broken noses, and another has had all his front teeth
+knocked out, while the others are nearly as bad."
+
+"I see you have brought with you some of their bludgeons," Dick
+said, pointing to one of the watchmen carrying a great bundle of
+sticks over his shoulder.
+
+"Yes, sir, twenty-three of them; it certainly seems to show that
+it was a planned thing. Most of these fellows' faces are so bruised
+that I cannot say who they are at present, but two or three are
+known as the worst ruffians in the city, and I have no doubt we
+shall find that they all belong to the same gang."
+
+By this time they had arrived at the watch house, a building of
+considerable size; the prisoners were first lodged in a strong room
+with barred windows and very heavy doors, and then the watchman
+went with Chetwynd to the Lieutenant's room. The officer had just
+returned, having hurried down with a reinforcement to the wharf
+as soon as he had heard of the fray, and tried to obtain some
+information from the people who had gathered round, attracted by
+the lanterns of the watch. He had already learned from the watchmen
+all they knew about the affair. As he spoke English well, he at
+once addressed Dick:
+
+"This is a serious affair, sir."
+
+"A very serious affair, for, indeed, I am afraid that my dearest
+friend has been murdered."
+
+"Will you kindly give me the particulars?" the officer said, sitting
+down to the table with a pen in his hand.
+
+Dick Chetwynd told him the story of how Mr. Thorndyke, having some
+very valuable jewels that he wished to dispose of, and believing
+that he would be attacked by a band of robbers, had asked him to
+accompany him, and had brought four detective officers and pugilists
+to protect him against any sudden attack.
+
+"Ah, that accounts for the terrible blows that these fellows received,"
+the officer said. "And your friend; was he a strong man?"
+
+"He was a man exceptionally strong, and a match for either of the
+pugilists that he brought over. I have no doubt that he was stabbed,
+though of course he might have been brought down by a blow from
+one of the bludgeons. He must have been completely insensible when
+carried off.
+
+"The watchman here tells me that three or four of these ruffians
+are known, and perhaps if you will give orders for the blood to be
+washed off the others' faces some more may be recognized and prove
+an aid in enabling you to form an idea where Mr. Thorndyke has been
+carried. I trust that you will send out a party to search for him.
+I and the four men with me will gladly join them, and may be of
+use if any resistance is offered."
+
+The Lieutenant at once gave orders to the watchman to go down and see
+that the prisoners all washed their faces. As soon as he returned
+with the report that this was done the officer went down with Dick
+Chetwynd to examine them. Three or four of the men with lanterns
+also went in. Eight out of eleven men were recognized; the other
+three, whose features were so swollen that they could not see out
+of their eyes, could not be made out, but their companions, on
+being questioned, gave their names.
+
+"They all belong to a gang of wharf thieves and plunderers. They
+live in a slum near the water. I will have men posted in the lanes
+leading to it, and will myself go with you to see that a search is
+made of every house; but first I will try to find out from these
+fellows where he was to be taken.
+
+"Now, my men," he said, "anyone of you who will tell me where one
+of the party you attacked was to be taken to will find things made
+easy for him at his trial."
+
+None of the men spoke for a minute, and then one said:
+
+"We know nothing about it; how should we, when we were all knocked
+stupid?"
+
+"No, but you might know where he was to be taken."
+
+"I know nothing about that. We all got word to mind we were on the
+wharf when a brig, that was seen coming up, came alongside, and that
+we were to have a hundred francs each for attacking some passengers
+as they landed. Six of them came along together, and one said,
+'These are the men.' A black sailor came up first and spoke to
+two or three men in some foreign language. I don't know who the
+men were; it was too dark to see their faces. It was one of them
+who gave the order. It seemed an easy job enough when there were
+twenty-five of us with heavy sticks, but it didn't turn out so.
+I only know that I hit one big fellow a blow that ought to have
+knocked him down, and the next moment there was a crash, and I
+don't know anything more about it until a lot of water was thrown
+over me and one of the watch helped me to my feet. I don't know
+whether the others know more than I do, but I don't think they do."
+
+All the others protested at once that they were equally ignorant.
+They had gone to earn a hundred francs. They had been told that
+the money was all right, but who found it or who were the men to
+be attacked they had not the least idea.
+
+"How was it that you all had these bludgeons--there were no knives
+found on any of you?"
+
+The man who spoke before said:
+
+"The order was 'No knives,' and before we went down to the wharf
+each of us was searched and a stick given to us. I suppose from
+that, that whoever paid for the job didn't want blood to be shed;
+it suited us well enough, for it was a job there was sure to be a
+row over, and I don't suppose any of us wanted to put his head in
+a noose. I know that we all said to each other as we went out that
+it did not want such sticks as we had to give a man a thrashing,
+but the man who hired us, whoever he was, knew his customers better
+than we did."
+
+The officer translated the man's words as they were spoken to Dick,
+and on hearing the last speech, the latter said:
+
+"Then there is still hope that Thorndyke may only have been stunned;
+that is a greater reason for our losing no time in looking for him,
+for I am afraid that they won't hesitate to kill him when they have
+got him hidden away."
+
+"I expect," the Lieutenant said, "they thought that if any of the
+watch came upon them as they were carrying him off, they might be
+at once arrested if it was found that they were carrying a dead
+man, whilst if he were only stunned they would say that it was a
+drunken comrade who had fallen and knocked his head against something.
+I agree with you, sir; we had better start on our search at once."
+
+"Will you pass the Hotel d'Hollande? If not, I will run and bring
+my men."
+
+"Yes, I will go that way; it will be no further."
+
+Dick walked on fast.
+
+"We have no news of him," he said, as he entered the room where
+the four men were anxiously awaiting him, "but we and the watch
+are now going to search the slums where the men who were taken
+prisoners all live; come down now, and I will tell you what I have
+learned, before the others come up.
+
+"There is reason for believing that he was not stabbed," he went
+on, as they reached the street, "for the men all say that they were
+armed only with clubs, and that the strictest orders were given
+that none were to carry knives, therefore there is little doubt
+that he was at the time only stunned. But I am bound to say that
+this gives me very small ground for hoping that we may find him
+alive. I fear they only stunned him, so that they might carry him
+safely to their haunts, for if stopped they could say that it was
+a drunken comrade, who had fallen and hurt himself. I fear that
+when they get him into one of their dens they will make short work
+of him, therefore it is clear that there is not a moment to be
+lost. Ah, here comes the watch."
+
+There were eight men with the Lieutenant.
+
+"I have already sent off ten others," he said as he joined Chetwynd,
+"to watch the lanes, and let no one go in or out. I thought it best
+not to lose a moment about that, for when the men see that we have
+learned from the others where the gang came from, and have closed
+the avenues of escape, they will hesitate about murdering their
+prisoner if he was still alive when my men got there."
+
+In a quarter of an hour they arrived at the end of a narrow lane,
+where two watchmen were standing with lanterns.
+
+"You have seen nor heard nothing?" the Lieutenant asked him.
+
+"No, sir, we have not seen a man moving in the lane."
+
+"There is just one hope that we might be in time," the Lieutenant
+said, as he went on down the lane, "and that is, that the fellows
+when they gather will be so dismayed at finding that nearly half
+their number are missing, and knowing that some of them are pretty
+sure to make a clean breast of it, they will hesitate to complete
+their crime. It is one thing to rob a man in the streets, quite
+another to murder him in cold blood. There is likely to be a good
+deal of difference of opinion among them, some of the more desperate
+being in favor of carrying the thing through, but others are sure
+to be against it, and nothing may have been done. You may be sure
+that the sight of my men at the end of the lanes will still further
+alarm them. I have no doubt the news that we have surrounded the
+district has already been circulated, and that if alive now he is
+safe, for they will think it is better to suffer a year or two's
+imprisonment than to be tried for murder. We are sure to make some
+captures, for it is probable that several of the others will bear
+marks of the fight. Each man we take we will question separately;
+one or other of them is pretty safe to be ready to say where your
+friend was taken to if I promise him that he shan't be prosecuted."
+
+Every house in the district was searched from top to bottom. Six
+men; with cut and bruised faces, were found shamming sleep, and
+were separately questioned closely; all declared that they knew
+nothing whatever of anyone being carried there.
+
+"It is of no use your denying your share in the affair," the Lieutenant
+said. "Your comrades have confessed that there were twenty-five of
+you hired to carry out this, and that you received a hundred francs
+each. Now, if this gentleman is not found, it will be a hanging
+matter for some of you, and you had better tell all you know. If
+you will tell us where he is, I will promise that you shan't be
+included in the list of those who will be prosecuted."
+
+The reply, although put in different words, was identical with that
+of the prisoners.
+
+"We had nothing to do with carrying him off; we were hired only to
+knock the men down who were pointed out to us; not a word was said
+about carrying them off. He may have been carried off, that we
+cannot say, but he has certainly not been brought here, and none
+of us had anything to do with it."
+
+Morning was breaking before the search was concluded. The detectives,
+accustomed as they were to visit the worst slums of London, were
+horrified at the crowding, the squalor, and the misery of the places
+they entered.
+
+"My opinion. Mr. Chetwynd," Gibbons growled, "is that the best
+thing to do would be to put a score of soldiers at the end of all
+these lanes, and then to burn the whole place down, and make a clean
+sweep of it. I never saw such a villainous looking crew in all my
+life. I have been in hopes all along that some of them would resist;
+it would have been a real pleasure to have let fly at them."
+
+"They are a villainous set of wretches, Gibbons, but they may not
+be all criminals."
+
+"Well; I don't know, sir; but I know that if I were on a jury,
+and any of the lot were in the dock, I should not want to hear any
+evidence against them; their faces are enough to hang them."
+
+At last the search was over, and they were glad indeed when they
+emerged from the lanes and breathed the pure air outside, for all
+the Englishmen felt sick at the poisonous air of the dens they had
+entered. The prisoners, as they were taken, had been sent off to
+the watch house.
+
+"I begin to think that the story these fellows tell is a true one,
+Mr. Chetwynd," the Lieutenant said, "and that they had nothing to
+do with carrying your friend off. In the first place, they all tell
+the same story: that in itself would not be much, as that might
+have been settled beforehand; but it is hardly likely that one of
+the lot would not have been ready to purchase his life by turning
+on the others. There is very little honor among thieves; and as
+they know that we have taken their mates--for no doubt we were
+watched as we marched them up the town--they would make sure that
+someone would turn traitor, and would think they might as well be
+beforehand. I fancy that the men, whoever they are, who hired this
+gang to attack you, carried out that part of the business themselves."
+
+"I am afraid that is so," Dick agreed; "and I fear in that case
+that he is in even worse hands than if these ruffians here had
+taken him."
+
+"Well, sir, can you furnish us with any clew?"
+
+"The only clew is that they were most probably dark men. That man
+who was killed was undoubtedly one of them. I should say that they
+would probably be got up as foreign sailors."
+
+"Well, that is something to go upon, at any rate. I will send round
+men at once to all the places by the quays where sailors board,
+and if three or four of them have been together at any place we
+are sure to hear of it, and the moment I have news I will send to
+your hotel."
+
+"Thank you; I don't see that we can be of any use at present, but
+you will find us ready to turn out again the moment we hear that
+you have news."
+
+When the party returned to the hotel they sat talking the matter
+over for upwards of an hour. All were greatly discouraged, for they
+had little hope indeed of ever learning what had become of Mark. As
+they had started out Dick had told the night porter that he could
+not say what time they might return, but that before the house closed
+he must have a couple of bottles of spirits and some tumblers sent
+up to their sitting room, together with some bread and cold meat,
+for that they might not return until morning, and would need
+something before they went to bed, as they had had nothing since
+their dinner, at one o'clock.
+
+"It wants something to take the taste of that place out of one's
+mouth," Tring said to Dick, as, directly they entered, he poured
+some spirits into the glasses. "I feel as queer as if I had been
+hocussed."
+
+All, indeed, were feeling the same, and it was not until they had
+eaten their supper and considerably lowered the spirits in the
+two bottles that they began to talk. The two detectives were the
+principal speakers, and both of these were of opinion that the only
+shadow of hope remaining rested upon Mark himself.
+
+"Unless they finished him before he came round," Malcolm said, "they
+would find him an awkward customer to deal with. Mr. Thorndyke has
+got his head screwed on right, and if, as you say, they are Indians,
+Mr. Chetwynd, I should think that if he once comes fairly round,
+unless he is tied up, he will be a match for them, even with their
+knives. That is the only chance I see. Even if the watch do find
+out that three or four foreign sailors have been at one of the
+boarding houses and did not turn up last night, I don't think we
+shall be much nearer. They will probably only have carried him some
+distance along the wharf, got to some quiet place where there is a
+big pile of wood, or something of that sort, then put a knife into
+him, searched for the diamonds, which you may be sure they would
+find easily enough wherever he had hidden them, and then make off,
+most likely for Rotterdam or The Hague; they could be at either
+of these places by this time, and will mostly likely divide the
+diamonds and get on board different craft, bound for London or
+Hull, or indeed any other port, and then ship for India. From what
+Mr. Thorndyke said they did not want the diamonds to sell, but only
+to carry back to some temple from which they were stolen twenty
+years ago."
+
+Chester was of precisely the same opinion.
+
+"I am afraid, Mr. Chetwynd," he added, as they rose to go to their
+rooms for two or three hours' sleep, "the only news that we shall
+get in the morning is that Mr. Thorndyke's body has been found."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX.
+
+
+At ten o'clock a constable came with a message from the Lieutenant
+to Mr. Chetwynd that he would be glad if he would come down to the
+watch house. Dick did not wake the others, but freshening himself
+up by pouring a jug of water over his head, went at once with the
+constable.
+
+"Have you news?" he asked eagerly as he entered.
+
+"Yes, the men returned an hour ago. At four of the houses they
+went to a foreign sailor had been lodging there for the last day
+or so, but yesterday afternoon all had paid their reckoning and
+left. Then the idea struck me that it would be as well to ask if
+they had been seen on the quays, and I sent off a fresh batch of men
+to make inquiries. A quarter of an hour ago one of them came back
+with the news that he had learned from a sailor that he had noticed
+a dark colored foreigner, whom he took to be a Lascar sailor,
+talking to a boatman, and that they had rowed off together to
+a barge anchored a short way out; he did not notice anything more
+about him.
+
+"Now, I should not be at all surprised if the fellow went off to
+arrange with the bargeman for a passage for himself and four or
+five comrades to some port or other, it might be anywhere. It would
+make no difference to them where the barge was bound for. No doubt
+he saw the man again after the brig was sighted, and told him that
+they should come on board soon after it got dark, and told him to
+have the boat at the stairs. You see, in that case they might not
+have carried Mr. Thorndyke above fifty yards. They would probably
+get him on board as one of their party who had been drunk. The
+barge, no doubt, got under way about nine o'clock, which is the
+hour when the tide was high last night, and during the night the
+Indians could easily drop your friend overboard--and may even
+have done so before they got under way, which would have been the
+easiest thing to do. There would have been no one at the helm, and
+they could have chosen a moment when the crew, probably only three,
+were below. I am afraid that this is not a cheering lookout, but
+I have little doubt that it is the correct one.
+
+"I have told my men to find out what barge was lying at the spot
+the sailor pointed out, and if we discover her name, which we are
+likely to be able to do, there will be no difficulty in finding
+out to whom she belongs and where she was bound for. Then we can
+follow it up; though there is little likelihood of our finding the
+murderers still on board."
+
+"Thank you very much for the pains that you are taking, sir,"
+Dick said. "I am afraid that there is no shadow of hope of finding
+my poor friend alive. I have no doubt that the thing has happened
+exactly as you suggest; the whole course of the affair shows how
+carefully it was planned, and I have no hope that any scruple about
+taking life would be felt by them for a moment. I will go back to
+the hotel, and I shall be obliged if you will let me know as soon
+as you obtain any clew as to the barge."
+
+An hour and a half later the officer himself came round to the
+room where Dick Chetwynd and the two pugilists were sitting. The
+detectives had started out to make inquiries on their own account,
+taking with them a hanger on at the hotel who spoke English.
+
+"The barge's name was the Julie," he said; "she has a cargo on
+board for Rotterdam."
+
+"I think the best thing would be to take a carriage, and drive
+there at once," Dick said.
+
+"You can do that, sir, but I don't think you will be there before
+the barge; they have something like eighteen hours' start for you,
+and the wind has been all the time in the east. I should say that
+they would be there by eight o'clock this morning."
+
+"No, I don't know that it would be of any use, but at least it would
+be doing something. I suppose we could be there in four hours?"
+
+"From that to five; but even if the barge were delayed, and you
+got there first, which is very unlikely, I do not think that there
+would be the remotest chance of finding those villains on board.
+I reckon they would, as we agreed, launch the body overboard even
+before they got under way here, and they may either have landed again
+before the craft got under way, pretending that they had changed
+their minds, and then walked across to The Hague or to Haarlem, or
+have gone on with the barge for two hours, or even until daybreak.
+If by that time they were near Rotterdam, they may have stayed on
+board till they got there; if not, they may have landed, and finished
+the journey on foot, but they would certainly not have stopped on
+board after six or seven o'clock this morning. They would calculate
+that possibly we might get on their track at an early hour this
+morning, and set out in pursuit at once.
+
+"However, it will doubtless be a satisfaction to you to be moving,
+and at least you will be able to overhaul the barge when you get to
+Rotterdam, and to hear what the boatmen say. The chances are they
+will not even have noticed that one of the men who came on board
+was missing. The men may very well have made up a long bundle,
+carried it on shore with them, or three of them may have carried a
+fourth ashore; and in the dark the bargemen were unlikely to have
+noticed that the number was less than when they came on board.
+However, it will be something for you to find out when and where
+the fellows landed."
+
+"Yes; I should certainly like to lay hands on them, though I am
+afraid we should find it very hard to prove that they had
+anything to do with this affair." /
+
+"I think that also, Mr. Chetwynd. Morally, we may feel absolutely
+certain; but, unless the boatmen noticed that one of their number
+was missing when they landed, we have at present no evidence to
+connect them with it."
+
+"We will set out as soon as my other two men return. I told them
+to be back soon after twelve. I will write to you this evening from
+Rotterdam. Ah! here are the men."
+
+The door opened, and, to the stupefaction of the party, Mark
+Thorndyke entered the room.
+
+"Good Heavens, Mark!" Dick exclaimed, springing forward and seizing
+his hand, "is it really you alive in the flesh? We had given you
+up for dead. We have been searching the town for you all night, and
+were just going to set out for Rotterdam in search of a barge on
+which we believed you were carried. Why, it seems almost a miracle!"
+
+The two prize fighters also came forward, and shook hands with a
+pressure that would have made most men shrink.
+
+"I am as glad, Mr. Thorndyke," Gibbons said, "as if anyone had
+given me a thousand pounds. I have never quite given up hope, for,
+as I said to Mr. Chetwynd, if you got but a shadow of a chance, you
+would polish off those nigger fellows in no time; but I was afraid
+that they never would give you a chance. Well, I am glad, sir."
+
+"Mark, this is the Lieutenant of the watch here," Dick said. "He
+has been most kind, and has himself headed the search that has been
+made for you all night. Now tell us all about it."
+
+"First of all give me something to drink, for, except some water,
+I have had nothing since dinner yesterday. You are right, Dick; it
+is almost a miracle, even to me, that I am here. I would not have
+given a penny for my chance of life, and I can no more account for
+the fact that I am here than you can."
+
+Mark drank off a tumbler of weak spirits and water that Gibbons
+poured out for him. Chetwynd rang the bell, and ordered lunch to
+be brought up at once. Just at this moment the two detectives came
+in, and were astonished and delighted at finding Mark there.
+
+"Now," he said, "I will tell you as much as I know, which is little
+enough. When I came to my senses I found myself lying on the deck
+of a craft of some sort; it was a long time before I could at all
+understand how I got there. I think it was the pain from the back
+of my head that brought it to my mind that I must have been knocked
+down and stunned in that fight; for some time I was very vague in
+my brain as to that, but it all came back suddenly, and I recalled
+that we had all got separated. I was hitting out, and then there
+was a crash. Yes, I must have been knocked down and stunned, and
+I could only suppose that in the darkness and confusion I had been
+carried off and taken on board without any of you missing me; my
+hands and feet were tied, and there was something shoved into my
+mouth that prevented me from speaking.
+
+"I should think that it must have been an hour before I quite
+recovered my senses, and got the thing fairly into my mind. Then a
+man with a knife leant over me, and made signs that if I spoke he
+would stab me, and another took the gag out of my mouth and poured
+some water down my throat, and then put it in again. I saw that he
+was a dark colored man, and I then understood it all; it was those
+Hindoos who had got up the attack upon us and had carried me off.
+I had no doubt they had got the diamonds I had sewn up in the
+waistband of my trousers.
+
+"I wondered why they were keeping me, but was sure they would stab
+me presently and throw me overboard. I knew that they had killed
+two soldiers for the sake of the diamonds, and if it hadn't been
+that they had given me the water, I should not have had a shadow
+of doubt about my fate."
+
+"I puzzled over why they should have done so, and came to the
+conclusion that they dared not do it on board, because of the crew,
+and that they intended to take me on shore somewhere, and there
+dispose of me. I made many attempts to loosen my ropes, but they
+would not give the slightest. At last I think I dozed off for a
+time. After I had had the water they drew a blanket or something of
+that sort over me. It had been there before, but it had only been
+pulled up as high as my nose, and I felt sure that it was only
+done to prevent the Dutchmen on the boat seeing that I was bound
+and gagged; this time they pulled it right over my face. When they
+took it off again I could see it was nearly morning, for there
+was a faint light in the sky. They were moving about on the deck,
+and presently I saw one of the sailors get into the boat and pull
+it along, hand over hand, by the rail, until he was close to me.
+Then four Lascar sort of chaps--I could scarcely make out their
+features--lifted me and lowered me into the boat and got in
+themselves.
+
+"I did not attempt to struggle. No doubt they had made up some
+tale that I was mad or something of that sort, and I thought that
+I had best pretend to be quiet and peaceable till I could see some
+sort of chance of making a fight for it. It was but a few yards
+from the shore. The man lifted me out onto the bank, and the sailor
+then started to row back to the barge; they carried me a few yards
+away, and then laid me face downwards on some grass. Now, I thought
+to myself, it is all over; they are going to stab me and make off.
+To my surprise I felt they were doing something--I could not
+make out what--to the ropes; then there was quiet. I lay there
+I should think for half an hour, wondering why on earth they did
+not finish me. At last I made up my mind to move, and turned round
+onto my back. As I lay there I could see no one, and, raising my
+head, looked round. To my amazement I found that I was alone. It
+was now almost light, and as I craned my head in all directions
+I assured myself that they had gone; then I began to try again at
+the ropes.
+
+"To my surprise I found that they were much looser than they were
+before, although still tight enough to give me nearly an hour's work
+before I got my hands free. Then it took me almost as long to get
+the ropes off my legs, for they had knotted them in such a fearfully
+intricate way that it was a long time before I could even discover
+where the ends were. At last I finished the job, stood up, and
+looked round. A quarter of a mile off there was a good sized town,
+but not a soul could I see.
+
+"Till now I had hardly thought of the diamonds; I put my hands
+to my waistband and found, as I expected, that they were gone. I
+think I felt nothing but pleasure: the confounded things had given
+trouble enough, and I was well rid of them. Why they should have
+spared my life I could not imagine. If they had finished me, which
+they could have done without any risk to themselves when they got
+me ashore, they could have gone off with the diamonds without the
+slightest fear of pursuit, while now there was, of course, a chance
+that I might follow and recognize them."
+
+"Would you know them again?" the Lieutenant interrupted.
+
+"Not in the slightest; it was light enough to see that they were
+dark, but from the time the boat came along the blanket was over
+my head, and except when they gave me the water I had no chance
+of seeing any of their features. Still, if I had gone straight to
+the town I saw and reported the matter to the authorities and sent
+mounted men to all the ports to warn them not to let any colored
+men embark, I might have given them a lot of trouble, but I don't
+suppose any of them would ever have been caught. After the craft
+they had shown in the whole matter, it is certain that they would
+have laid their plans for escape so well that the law would never
+have laid hands upon them. I put my hand mechanically to my watch
+to see the time, and to my astonishment discovered that I still
+had it in my pocket, and was equally surprised to find that the
+money in my trousers' pockets was also untouched. The watch had,
+of course, stopped. I first of all went down to the water and had
+a good wash; then I proceeded to the town, and, going to a hotel,
+ordered breakfast."
+
+"Why, I thought you said that you had had nothing to eat, Mark."
+
+"Yes? Well, I had forgotten all about that breakfast. The people
+looked a good deal surprised at an Englishman walking in in that
+way. While I was eating my breakfast two men--who were, I suppose,
+authorities of some kind--who spoke English, came and questioned
+me. As I had made up my mind to say nothing more about the affair,
+I merely told them that I had come for a sail from Amsterdam,
+and that I wanted a carriage to take me back. They were evidently
+astonished at my choosing a dark night for such a trip, but I said
+that I had some curiosity to see how the boatmen navigated their
+vessel when there were no lighthouses or anything to steer by. They
+asked a few more questions, and then went away, evidently thinking
+that I was a little mad. However, they must have spoken to the
+landlord, who in a short time made signs that the carriage was at
+the door.
+
+"I had avoided asking the men either the name of the place or how
+far it was from any big town, because that would have made the whole
+affair more singular. It was a quarter past eight when I started,
+and beyond the fact that I know by the sun we came pretty nearly
+due east, I have not the slightest idea of the road. The coachman
+could not speak a word of English. I should say we came about seven
+miles an hour and stopped once to bait the horses, so I suppose
+that it must have been between four and five miles from Rotterdam
+when I landed."
+
+Lunch had by this time been laid on the table, and at Dick's
+invitation the Lieutenant joined them.
+
+"It is an extraordinary story!" he said. "That your life should
+have been spared is altogether beyond my comprehension, still more
+so why they should have left you your money and watch."
+
+"The whole story is extraordinary," Dick Chetwynd said; "for we
+have every reason to believe that those fellows, or at least one or
+two of them, have been patiently watching for a chance of carrying
+off those diamonds for twenty years. When my friend told me of it
+ten days ago I did not believe that it could be possible; but he
+has certainly shown that he was correct in his opinion."
+
+Mark then related the history of the jewels, surprising the pugilists
+and detectives as much as the Lieutenant.
+
+"It is extraordinary indeed," the latter said. "I should not have
+believed it possible that men would devote so many years to such a
+purpose, nor that they could have succeeded in tracing the diamonds
+in spite of the precaution taken by your uncle, and afterwards by
+yourself. It would seem that from the time he landed in England
+he, and after him your father and yourself, must have been watched
+almost night and day. I can understand now why they did not take
+your watch and money. They evidently acted from a sort of religious
+enthusiasm, and were no ordinary thieves, but as evidently they
+did not hesitate to kill, I cannot understand why they should have
+added to their risks by sparing you."
+
+"No, that is what puzzles me," Mark agreed. "I was thinking it
+over while we were driving here. Now let me hear about the fight,
+Dick. How did you all come out of it?"
+
+"As well as could be expected. Gibbons and Tring both got some
+heavy blows with the cudgels, as indeed we all did more or less,
+but they did great execution. Eleven fellows were left senseless on
+the ground, and one of them, that black fellow who came over with
+us, was killed. The other ten are all in prison. All of us did our
+best, and managed to leave our mark on eight others, who were in
+consequence picked out, and are also in jail."
+
+Dick went on to relate the particulars of the search.
+
+"You see, our friend here had traced you to the barge and found out
+her destination, and if you had come ten minutes later you would
+have found that we had all just started for Rotterdam. I was only
+waiting for Chester and Malcolm to return to set out. I am sorry,
+Mark, that you have lost your diamonds; not so much because they
+are gone, for I can well understand you to be thoroughly glad to
+be rid of such dangerous articles, but because they have carried
+them off in our teeth, after we have been specially retained to
+protect you. I certainly thought that with such a bodyguard you
+were absolutely safe from any number of Hindoos."
+
+"Yes, we made a regular mess of it, Mr. Thorndyke," Gibbons said.
+"I never felt so certain of winning a battle as I did that you would
+not be touched as long as we were looking after you. Tring and I,
+if we had been asked, would have said that we could each have taken
+on a dozen foreigners easily. Mr. Chetwynd is handy with his fists
+too, though he hasn't your weight and reach, and your two other
+friends are both pretty well accustomed to deal with rough customers.
+As for Tring and me, it makes one feel small to know that we have
+been bested by a handful of niggers, or Hindoos, or whatever the
+chaps are, whom a good sized boy of twelve ought to be able to
+polish off."
+
+"Now, Mark, what is to be done next?" Dick Chetwynd asked.
+
+"The next thing will be to get back as soon as we can, Dick. I,
+for one, have had enough of Holland to last me for a lifetime."
+
+"I am afraid, gentlemen," the Lieutenant said, "you will have
+to wait a day or two before you can leave. I have nineteen men in
+prison, and there will be a meeting of magistrates this afternoon.
+Now you have come back, Mr. Thorndyke, the charge against them won't
+be as serious as it would have been before, but they are guilty of
+a desperate and premeditated assault upon six passengers on their
+arrival here; they have already admitted that they were paid for
+their work; and as among them are some of the worst characters in
+the city, you may be sure that now we have got them fairly in our
+hands we shall not let them go. It is so simple an affair that the
+investigation ought not to take long, but we shall want to find
+out, if we can, who acted as the intermediary between the Hindoos
+and the prisoners. I should think that two meetings ought to be
+sufficient for the present, but I am afraid that there may then be
+a long remand, and that you will either have to remain here or to
+come over again."
+
+"It would be a horrible nuisance," Dick said; "still it would be
+better to come back again than to wait here indefinitely, and anyhow
+I don't suppose it would be necessary for all of us to come back
+again."
+
+"I should not mind if it could be arranged for me to be here again
+in a month's time," Mark agreed, "for, to tell you the truth, I am
+going to be married in less than three weeks, and as I had intended
+to come to Brussels, and afterwards to travel for a while, I could
+make a visit here without greatly putting myself out."
+
+"I will try and arrange that, Mr. Thorndyke."
+
+"I shall be glad," Mark said, "if you can manage to get the men
+sentenced without going into the question of the diamonds at all,
+and treat the matter as a mere attempt at robbery. It surely would
+not be necessary to bring the question of my being carried away into
+the matter at all; I can give evidence that I was knocked down and
+stunned, and that I was robbed of some jewels that I had about me,
+which were the object of the attack."
+
+"I think we should have to admit that," the Lieutenant said; "it
+must come out that the attack was an organized one."
+
+"Well, if it must, it must," Mark said reluctantly; "but then,
+you see, no end of questions would be asked, and the thing might
+be delayed while a search is being made for the men who stole the
+bracelet."
+
+"Well, we will keep it out of the inquiry if we can," the Lieutenant
+said. "The meeting will be at three o'clock. I will send a man to
+take you to the Town Hall."
+
+At the appointed hour the party proceeded to the court, and the
+eighteen prisoners, under a strong guard, having been brought in,
+six magistrates took their places on the bench; the rest of the
+court was crowded, the fray on the wharf and the number of captures
+having created quite a stir in the city. They had arranged that
+Tring should first give his evidence, which he did, the Lieutenant
+of the watch acting as interpreter, though most of the magistrates
+understood English. The appearance of the prisoners created quite
+a sensation in the court, for the injuries that they had received
+were now even more conspicuous than they had been when they were
+first captured; some of them had to be led into court, their eyes
+being completely closed, others had their heads bandaged, and all
+showed signs of tremendous punishment. Tring related that he, with
+five others, had come ashore together; one of his companions had
+a row on board a ship they had crossed in, with a Lascar sailor,
+who was a passenger, and they kept together as they were crossing
+the wharf, thinking that possibly the man might attempt to stab
+his companion.
+
+"I was walking behind him," Tring went on, "when the Lascar jumped
+suddenly out from among the men standing about, and was about to
+stab my companion, when I hit him just in time, and he went down;
+then there was a rush, and we all got separated, and did as well
+as we could until the watch came up; that is all that I know about
+it."
+
+"Is the Lascar among the prisoners?" one of the magistrates asked
+the Lieutenant of the watch.
+
+"No, sir, when picked up by one of my men he was found to be dead;
+the blow had apparently killed him instantly."
+
+The other five then gave their evidence; it was similar to that
+of Tring, save that being in front of him they knew nothing of the
+attack by the Lascar. All they knew about it was that there was
+a sudden rush upon them by a number of men armed with bludgeons,
+that they were separated, and that each defended himself until the
+guard came up.
+
+Some of the watch then gave evidence, and told how on arriving at
+the spot eleven of the prisoners were found lying senseless; how,
+on recovering, they were all taken to the watch house, where several
+of them were recognized as notoriously bad characters; they had
+admitted that they were paid to make the attack, which was apparently
+the result of the private enmity of some person or persons unknown
+to one or more of those attacked.
+
+The Lieutenant then related the steps that he had taken to capture
+others connected with the attack, and that he found eight men
+bearing marks of the fray, and that all these were also notorious
+characters, and associates of the prisoners first taken. The first
+witnesses were again questioned; five of them said that, so far
+as they knew, they had no personal enemies. Mark, who was the last
+to get into the witness box, said that he himself had no enemies,
+but that an uncle of his, who was in the British Indian service,
+had a sort of feud with some members of a sect there on account of
+some jewels that he had purchased, and which had, they declared,
+been stolen from a temple. Two soldiers through whose hands these
+things had passed, had been successively killed by them, and his
+uncle had to the day of his death believed that their vengeance
+would one day fall upon him.
+
+"I can only suppose," continued Mark, "that I have inherited the
+enmity they bore him, as I inherited the jewels, and that the attack
+was really designed solely against me, and the consequences might
+have been fatal to me had it not been for the strength and courage
+of my fellow passengers."
+
+"Did they come with you for your protection, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"To some extent, yes. The fact is, that I have for some time
+been convinced that I was followed about by natives of India, and
+remembering what my uncle had said on the subject, I became to
+some degree apprehensive, and thought it as well to leave London
+for a short time. That this attack was really instigated by the men
+I have no doubt whatever, since, as you have heard, it was begun by
+a Lascar, who tried to stab one of my companions and who received
+a knockdown blow that caused his death from one of the others. It
+is a well known fact that these people will cherish for many years
+a determination to avenge any injury. However, I hope that after
+the failure of this attempt upon my life I shall hear no more of
+them."
+
+"Were any knives found on the prisoners?" the magistrates asked
+the Lieutenant of the watch.
+
+"No, sir; all carried clubs. And they told me that they had been
+especially ordered not to take knives, and had indeed been searched
+before they came out."
+
+"What impression do you gather from that, Mr. Thorndyke?"
+
+"My impression is, sir, that they desired to overpower those with
+me and to beat them down, in order to carry out their revenge upon
+me."
+
+After some consultation the magistrate who had before spoken said:
+
+"The prisoners will be remanded. It is necessary that we should
+find out who was the chief culprit who bribed this gang."
+
+As soon as the prisoners were taken out of court Mark slipped across
+to the magistrates, accompanied by the Lieutenant as interpreter.
+
+"I hope, gentlemen, that our presence here will not be necessary,
+for it would be a matter of extreme inconvenience. I may say that
+my marriage is fixed for today three weeks, hence you can well
+imagine that I want to return as soon as possible. Two of the men
+are, as you have heard, Bow Street officers, whose presence could
+not well be spared."
+
+The magistrates again consulted together.
+
+"Your evidence has all been taken down by the clerk of the court.
+Certainly we should not require your presence at the remand; but
+whether we should do so at the trial would, of course, depend upon
+whether these men all own their guilt, which, having been taken
+red handed, it is likely enough they will do. We will consent,
+therefore, to your leaving, if you will give us an undertaking to
+return for the trial if your presence is necessary, and that you
+will bring with you the man who struck down the Lascar who commenced
+the fray, and one of the others."
+
+"That I will do willingly," Mark replied. "We are much obliged to
+you for your consideration. I shall be traveling for a time after
+my marriage; but I will as I pass through Belgium after my marriage
+give you the route I intend to take and the address at which letters
+will find me, and if you send me a sufficiently long notice I will
+at once return for the trial."
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXI.
+
+
+"You managed that very well, Mark," Dick said. "You kept well within
+the limits of truth without bringing the real facts of the attack
+upon us into the case."
+
+"Well, you see, Dick, after working as a detective, one gets into
+the way of telling stories with the smallest amount of deviation
+possible from the truth. What will these fellows get done to them,
+Lieutenant?"
+
+"I should say that they will get two or three years imprisonment;
+the only charge now is rioting and assault. It is lucky for them
+that they had clubs instead of knives, for that would have brought
+the matter under the head of attempted murder. The matter of the
+gems was not important in the case, but there is sure to be a great
+fuss and search for the missing Indians. I suppose you will soon
+be off home now?"
+
+"Yes, I shall find out tonight what vessel leaves for England
+tomorrow, and take a berth in the first that sails for London. It
+is too late to think of starting this evening, and indeed I feel
+that I want a long night's rest, for I did not sleep much last
+night, and have not quite recovered from that crack on my head."
+
+On his return to the hotel Mark sent out a man to inquire at the
+shipping offices, and finding that a bark would sail at nine o'clock
+the next morning, they went down and took berths, and sailed in
+her next day. The voyage home was a rapid one, for the wind blew
+steadily from the east, and the vessel made the passage to the
+mouth of the river in two days, and the next took them up to London.
+
+"I will call round tomorrow or next day, Gibbons, with the checks
+for you both," Mark said as he prepared to go ashore.
+
+"No, sir. We are both of one mind that we could not take them. We
+went over to prevent you being robbed of those sparklers, and to
+see that you came to no harm. Well, the things are lost, and you
+got knocked down and carried away. It is no thanks to us that you
+are alive now. It is a mortifying job, that with two detectives to
+watch over things and with us to fight we should have been fairly
+beat by a few black niggers."
+
+"If there had been any bungling on your part, Gibbons, there might
+be something in what you say, but no one could have foreseen that
+before we had been on shore two minutes we should have been attacked
+in that way. You both did all that men could do, as was shown by
+the condition of the fellows who were taken. I was just as much
+separated from you as you were from me, and the fact that we were
+surprised as we were is really due to my not determining to stay
+on board until the morning, which I could no doubt have done with
+the captain's permission. It never struck me for a moment that we
+should be attacked in force. I thought it probable that an attempt
+at assassination would be made, but it certainly did not seem
+probable that it would be attempted while you were all with me.
+You are not in the slightest degree to blame, for your part of the
+agreement was carried out to my satisfaction. I shall certainly
+carry out mine, as I have arrived home safe and sound."
+
+"Well, governor, it is very good of you; but I tell you it will go
+against the grain for us to take your money."
+
+On landing, Mark parted with Dick Chetwynd, who had arranged to
+drop Mark's bag at his lodgings on his way home, and at once took
+a hackney coach to Islington. Millicent gave a cry of delight as
+he entered the room.
+
+"You are back earlier than I expected, Mark. You told me before
+you started that the wind was in the east, and that you might be
+a long time getting to Amsterdam unless it changed. I have been
+watching the vane on the church, and it has been pointing east ever
+since.
+
+"Well, you have sold the diamonds, I hope?" she said, after the
+first greeting was over.
+
+"No; I have bad news for you, Millicent; the jewels have been
+stolen."
+
+"Well it does not make much difference, Mark. We have much more
+than enough without them, so don't bother yourself in the least.
+How did it happen?"
+
+"Well, it is rather a long story. I will tell it you when Mrs.
+Cunningham is here, so as not to have to go over it twice. How are
+the dresses getting on?"
+
+"I suppose they are getting on all right," she said. "I have done
+nothing for the last two days but try them on. You see, we put them
+out to three milliners, and they all three seem to reach the same
+point together, and I start after breakfast, and it takes about two
+hours at each place. You don't know what trouble you have given me
+by hurrying things on so unreasonably."
+
+"Well, it is better to have it all done and over," he said, "than
+to have the thing hanging over you for a couple of months."
+
+"That is what Mrs. Cunningham says. Now I want to hear about your
+adventures, and I will call her down."
+
+
+"Only think, Mrs. Cunningham," Millicent said presently, with a
+laugh, after she had returned with her, "this silly boy has actually
+let the diamonds be stolen from him."
+
+
+"No, really, Millicent!"
+
+"Yes, indeed. Fancy his not being fit to be trusted to look after
+them! However, I tell him it is of no consequence. I don't know
+how they went. He would not tell me the story until you came down."
+
+"I am sorry to say it is true, Mrs. Cunningham, although I can
+assure you that I really cannot blame myself for either carelessness
+or stupidity. I knew when I started that there was a very great
+risk, and took what seemed to me every possible precaution, for
+in addition to Dick Chetwynd going with me, I took two detectives
+from Bow Street and two prize fighters."
+
+Exclamations of surprise broke from both ladies.
+
+"And yet, in spite of all that, these things were stolen," Millicent
+said. "How on earth did they do it? I should have sewn them up in
+my pockets inside my dress."
+
+"I sewed them up in the waistband of my trousers, Millicent, and
+yet they managed, in spite of us, to steal them. And now I must
+begin by telling you the whole history of those diamonds, and you
+will understand why I thought it necessary to take a strong party
+with me."
+
+He then told them, repeating the history the Colonel had given his
+father of the diamonds, and the conviction that he had, that he
+had been followed by Hindoos, and the instructions he had given
+for the disposal of the bracelet.
+
+"As you know," he said, "nothing happened to confirm my uncle's
+belief that there were men over here in search of the diamonds
+during my father's life, but since then I have come to the same
+conclusion that he had, and felt positive that I was being constantly
+followed wherever I went. As soon as I heard where the treasure
+was I began to take every precaution in my power. I avoided going
+to the bank after my first visit there, and, as you know, would
+not bring the things for you to look at. I got Dick Chetwynd to
+go there, open the case, and take out these diamonds. He did not
+bring them away with him, but fetched them from there the morning
+we started. He went down and took the passage for us both at the
+shipping office, and the pugilists and the detectives each took
+passages for themselves, so that I hoped, however closely I was
+followed, they would not learn that I was taking them to Amsterdam."
+
+"It was very wrong, Mark; very wrong indeed," Millicent broke in.
+"You had no right to run such a terrible risk; it would have been
+better for you to have taken the diamonds and thrown them into the
+Thames."
+
+"That would not have improved matters," he said; "the Indians would
+not have known that I had got rid of them, and would have continued
+their efforts to find them, and I should always have been in danger
+instead of getting it over once for all. However, I did not think
+that there was any danger, going over as I did, with two of the
+best prize fighters in England, to say nothing of the detectives,
+who were the men who were with me when I caught Bastow. The only
+danger was that I might be stabbed; but, as they would know, it
+was no use their stabbing me unless they could search me quietly,
+and that they could not do unless I was alone and in some lonely
+neighborhood, and I had made up my mind not to stir out unless the
+whole party were with me. I found out, when we got on board that
+in spite of all the precautions I had taken, they had discovered
+that I was going to sail for Amsterdam, which they could only have
+done by following Dick as well as myself. There was a dark faced
+foreign sailor, who, I had no doubt, was a Hindoo, already on board,
+and I saw another in a boat watching us start; this was unpleasant,
+but as I felt sure that they could not have known that I had with
+me detectives and pugilists, I still felt that they would be able
+to do nothing when I got to Amsterdam."
+
+Then he told them the whole story of the attack, of his being carried
+away, and of his unexpected release; of the search that had been
+made for him and the arrest of eighteen of his assailants. Millicent
+grew pale as he continued, and burst into tears when she heard of
+his being a prisoner in the hands of the Hindoos.
+
+"I shall never let you go out of my sight again, Mark!" she
+exclaimed when he had finished. "It was bad enough before when you
+were searching for that man here, and I used to be terribly anxious;
+but that was nothing to this."
+
+"Well, there is an end of it now, Millicent; the men have got the
+diamonds, and will soon be on their way to India, if they have not
+started already."
+
+"Nasty things!" she said; "I shall never like diamonds again: they
+will always remind me of the terrible danger that you have run. Isn't
+it extraordinary that for twenty years four or five men should be
+spending their lives waiting for a chance of getting them back!"
+
+"I do not expect there were so many as that; probably there was
+only one. He would have no difficulty in learning that my father
+had not received any extraordinary gems from my uncle, and probably
+supposed that they would not be taken out from wherever they might
+be until you came of age. After the death of my father he might
+suppose that I should take them out, or that, at any rate, I should
+go to whoever had them, and see that they were all right, and he
+then, perhaps, engaged half a dozen Lascars--there are plenty of
+them at the docks--and had me watched wherever I went; and, do
+you know, that I believe I once owed my life to them."
+
+"How was that, Mark?"
+
+"Well, I was captured by some fellows who suspected me to be a Bow
+Street runner, and I think that it would have gone very hard with
+me if a party of five or six prize fighters had not broken into
+the house, pretty nearly killed the men in whose hands I was,
+and rescued me. They said that they had heard of my danger from a
+foreign sailor who called at Gibbons', with whom I was in the habit
+of boxing, and told him about it. You see, until they learned where
+the jewels were, my life was valuable to them, for possibly I was
+the only person who knew where they were hidden; so really I don't
+think I have any reason for bearing a grudge against them. They saved
+my life in the first place, and spared it at what was a distinct
+risk to themselves. On the other hand, they were content with
+regaining the bracelet, not even, as I told you, taking my watch
+or purse. You see, with them it was a matter of religion. They had
+no animosity against me personally, but I have no doubt they would
+have stabbed me without the slightest compunction had there been no
+other way of getting the things. Still, I think that I owe a debt
+of gratitude to them rather than the reverse, and, after all, the
+loss of the bracelet is not a serious one to us."
+
+"I am glad it is gone," Millicent said. "You say it had already
+caused the death of two men, and if you had succeeded in selling
+it I can't help thinking that the money would have brought ill
+fortune to us. I am heartily glad that the diamonds are gone, Mark.
+I suppose they were very handsome?"
+
+"They were magnificent," he said. "Dick and Cotter both agreed that
+they had never seen their equal, and I fancy that they must have
+been worth a great deal more than your father valued them at."
+
+"Well, it does not matter at all. There is no history attached to
+the others, I hope, Mark?"
+
+"Not in any way, dear. They were bought, as the Colonel told my
+father, in the ordinary course of things, and some, no doubt, were
+obtained at the capture of some of the native princes' treasuries;
+but it was solely on account of this bracelet that he had any anxiety.
+You can wear all the others, if you have a fancy for keeping them,
+without a shadow of risk."
+
+"No, Mark, we will sell them every one. I don't think that I shall
+ever care to wear any jewels again; and if I am ever presented at
+court and have to do so, I would rather that you should buy some
+new ones fresh from a jeweler's shop than wear anything that has
+come from India."
+
+"To-morrow you shall both go to the bank with me to see them, and
+then I will take them to some first-class jeweler's and get him to
+value them."
+
+The visit was paid next day. Both Millicent and Mrs. Cunningham
+were somewhat disappointed at the jewels.
+
+"It is hardly fair to see them like this," Philip Cotter said.
+"They would look very different if reset. No Indian jewels I have
+ever seen show to advantage in their native settings; but many of
+the stones are very large, and without knowing anything about them
+I should say that they are worth the 50,000 pounds at which you say
+Colonel Thorndyke valued them. He was not likely to be mistaken. He
+was evidently a judge of these matters, and would hardly be likely
+to be far wrong."
+
+"We will go with you to the jeweler's, Mark," Millicent said. "In
+the first place, I shall not feel quite comfortable until I know
+that they are out of your hands, and in the next place I should
+like to hear what he thinks of them."
+
+"I have a number of Indian jewels that I wish you to value for me,"
+Mark said, as, carrying the case, he entered the jeweler's shop.
+"They were collected by Colonel Thorndyke, an uncle of mine, during
+service in India."
+
+The jeweler took them with him into a room behind the shop. The
+case was opened, and the man took out sixty-eight small parcels it
+contained, and opened them one after the other.
+
+"I shall need a very careful examination of these before I can
+form any estimate of their value," he said, after inspecting some
+of the more important pieces of jewelry carefully. "They are a
+most magnificent collection, and had they been properly cut in the
+first place they would have been worth a very large sum. Unfortunately,
+the Indian princes think more of size than of lustre, and have their
+stones cut very much too flat to show off their full brilliancy.
+Some of these large ones I should certainly advise to be recut, for
+what they will lose in weight they will gain in beauty and value.
+However, sir, I will go through them and give you an estimate of
+the selling value of each piece. I need not say that they ought
+all to be reset in the prevailing fashion; but the gold, which is
+in some cases unnecessarily massive, will go some distance towards
+defraying the expense."
+
+"When shall I call again?" Mark asked.
+
+"I should be glad if you can give me a week," the jeweler said.
+"Some of the things, for instance that great pearl necklace, I could
+appraise without much difficulty, but all the gems must be taken out
+of their settings before I could form a fair idea of their value."
+
+"Then I will call in a week's time," Mark said. "I am in no
+particular hurry about them, but I would rather that they were in
+your care than mine."
+
+"Yes, if the cracksmen got word that there was such a collection
+as this in any private house it would need a couple of men with
+pistols to keep guard over them."
+
+A week later Mark again called.
+
+"I have the list ready for you, sir; you will see that they are
+not marked according to their setting, but according to their size
+and value. Thus, you see, the largest stones are priced separately;
+the smaller ones are in groups according to their weight. The total
+comes to 42,000 pounds. I do not know whether that at all equals
+your expectations. I may say that I have shown the stones to two
+or three of our principal diamond merchants, and that the prices
+I have put down are those at which they would be willing to buy
+them; possibly some would be worth more. I had the merchants here
+together, and they spent some hours going through them, and the sums
+put down are those at which one or other were willing to purchase."
+
+"It quite answers my expectations," Mark said. "My uncle's estimate,
+indeed, was somewhat higher, but doubtless he judged them at the
+price which they would fetch in India. Well, sir, I authorize you
+to close with the offers, and to dispose of them for me. I will
+give you a written authority to do so. In the meantime, I wish to
+buy a suite of jewels as a wedding present, a tiara, necklace, and
+bracelets; but I do not want any diamonds to be among them."
+
+"I am afraid I have nothing in stock without diamonds; of course,
+I have both necklaces and bracelets of almost any stones that you
+might select, but I have no complete set without diamonds; the
+effect would be somber, and few ladies would like them."
+
+"We have some unpleasant associations with diamonds," Mark said,
+"and on that point I am quite determined; but if you used pearls
+instead of diamonds the effect might be as good. I don't care
+whether the stones are emeralds or rubies; at any rate, I should
+like to see some, and then perhaps you might be able to make me a
+set on the same model."
+
+Several superb sets were brought in; Mark selected one of emeralds
+and diamonds.
+
+"What would be the price of this set?" he asked.
+
+"That set is 6000 pounds, sir; the stones are exceptionally fine
+ones; but if you substituted pearls of equal size for the diamonds,
+it would cost considerably less; I could not give you the exact
+price until it is made, but I should say that it would be about
+4500 pounds."
+
+"Very well, then, I will take that. How long will it be making?"
+
+"I should not like to say less than three months at the earliest;
+it will require some time to collect as fine a set of emeralds
+as these. Indeed, I think that most probably I shall use these
+emeralds, or the greater part of them, and collect others to take
+their places at my leisure. I do not know whether the best plan
+would not be to take the diamonds out and substitute pearls; there
+would be no difficulty in getting them, and in that case I might
+have it ready for you in a month."
+
+"I think that will be the best plan; but you need not be in any
+particular hurry about them. My marriage will take place in less
+than a fortnight, and after that I shall probably be three or four
+months before I return to London. I will get you to keep the things
+until I come back."
+
+"I have sold the jewels, Millicent," he said, when he returned to
+Islington; "the jeweler has found purchasers for them all, and the
+total comes to 42,000 pounds."
+
+"Whatever shall we do with all our money, Mark?"
+
+"I rather wonder myself, dear. However, there is one thing, there
+are always plenty of people who will be glad to relieve us of
+anything that we don't want. I can tell you that in the course of
+my search for Bastow I have seen an amount of poverty and misery such
+as I never dreamt of, and I certainly should like to do something
+to relieve it. The best thing that I know of would be to give a
+handsome sum to three or four of the great hospitals. I don't know
+of any better means of helping the very poor."
+
+"Suppose, Mark," the girl said, putting her hand on his arm, "we
+give this 42,000 pounds as a thank offering. We never expected
+to get it, and my father's jewels have nearly cost you your life.
+We have such an abundance without that, I should like, above all
+things, to give this money away."
+
+"I think that is an excellent plan, Millicent, and a very happy
+thought on your part. We cannot do it now, as we have not yet got
+the money, but as soon as we do we will send off checks for 10,000
+guineas each to St. Bartholomew's, Guy's, and St. Thomas'--those
+are the three principal ones; the others we can settle afterwards.
+But I should say that the Foundling would be as good as any, and I
+believe that they are rather short of funds at present; then there
+is the London Mendicity Society, and many other good charities.
+Perhaps it would be better to divide the whole among eight of them
+instead of four; but we need not settle that until we return."
+
+"Do you think we shall have to go to this horrid Amsterdam, Mark?"
+
+"I hope not, dear; but I shall no doubt hear from the Lieutenant
+of the watch during the next week or ten days."
+
+When the letter came it was satisfactory. The prisoners, seeing
+the hopelessness of any defense, had all admitted their guilt, and
+the name of the man who had dealt with them had also been given up.
+Except in his case there would be no trial. The others would have
+sentences passed on them at once, and three, who had been promised
+comparatively slight punishment, would go into the box to give
+evidence against the man who had engaged them. Before starting for
+Holland Mark had consulted Millicent as to whether she would prefer
+being married in London or at Crowswood. She had replied:
+
+"I should greatly prefer Crowswood, Mark. Here we know no one,
+there we should be among all our friends; certainly if we don't
+go we must get Mr. Greg to come up and marry us here. I am sure
+he would feel very disappointed if anyone else were asked. At the
+same time I should not like to go home. When we come back from our
+trip it will be different; but it would be a great trial now, and
+however happy we might be, I should feel there was a gloom over
+the house."
+
+"I quite agree with you, Millicent. When we come back we can see
+about entirely refurnishing it, and, perhaps, adding some rooms to
+it, and we need not go down until a complete change has been made.
+We shall be able to manage it somehow or other, and I quite agree
+with you that anything will be better than going back to the house
+for a day or two before the wedding."
+
+On the voyage back from Holland Mark had talked the matter over
+with Dick Chetwynd, and said that he thought of taking rooms for
+Mrs. Cunningham and Millicent at Reigate, and stopping at the hotel
+himself, and having the wedding breakfast there.
+
+"Of course, Dick, you will be my best man."
+
+"I should think so," Dick laughed. "Why, if you had asked anyone
+else I should have made a personal matter of it with him, and have
+given him the option of resigning the position or going out with
+me. But your other plans are foolish, and I shall take the matter
+into my own hands; I shall insist upon the two ladies coming down
+to the Park, and I will get my aunt to come and preside generally
+over things. I shall fill up the house with bridesmaids, and shall
+have a dance the evening before. You can put up at the hotel if you
+like, but you know very well that there are a dozen houses where
+they will be delighted to have you; there is no doubt that when
+they know what is coming off you will get a dozen invitations, and
+then after church all those invited will drive off to the Park to
+the wedding breakfast. After that is over you can start in a post
+chaise to Canterbury or Dover, wherever you may decide to make your
+first halt."
+
+"But, my dear Dick, I could not put you to all this trouble!"
+
+"Nonsense, man. I should enjoy it immensely; besides, I shall be
+really glad of a good reason to try and open the doors of the Park
+again. I have been there very little since my father's death, and
+I think I shall make it my headquarters in future. I am getting
+rather tired of bachelor life in London, and must look out for a
+wife; so nothing could be more appropriate than this idea. Don't
+bother yourself any further about it. I shall ride down and establish
+myself there tomorrow, and spend a couple of days in driving round
+to our friends and in sending out invitations. I shall still have
+nearly a fortnight for making all preparations. Why, it will cause
+quite an excitement in the neighborhood! I shall be hailed as a
+benefactor, and I shall let everyone know that your father's ward
+was really your cousin, but that by the will of her father she
+was to drop her surname until she came of age; and that until that
+time your father was to have the entire control of the property. I
+shall add that although the estate, of course, is hers, your uncle
+has left you a very big fortune, and that nothing could be more
+suitable in all respects than the marriage."
+
+"That will do excellently, Dick; that will be quite enough, without
+going into details at all. You can mention that we intend to have
+the house entirely refurnished, and on the return from our wedding
+trip abroad to settle there. I am sure I am extremely obliged to
+you for your offer, which will certainly clear away all sorts of
+small difficulties."
+
+A day or two after his return Mark wrote to Mr. Greg telling him
+the relations in which Millicent and he stood to each other, and of
+the near approach of their marriage. He said that Millicent would
+be married from Dick Chetwynd's, but that it would be at Crowswood
+church. In return he received a warm letter of congratulation
+from the Rector, telling him that the news was in every respect
+delightful, and that his wife and the children were in a state
+of the highest excitement, not only at the marriage, but at their
+coming down to reside again at Crowswood.
+
+"The village," he said, "will be scarcely less pleased than I
+am, for though everything goes on as you ordered, and the people
+get their milk, broths, and jellies as before, they don't look at
+it as the same thing as it was in the old days. I cannot say that
+the news of your engagement to Miss Conyers--I ought to say Miss
+Thorndyke--is surprising, for I had thought that it would be
+quite the natural thing for you to fall in love with each other,
+and, indeed, my wife declares that she saw it coming on distinctly
+during the last few months before you left here. Your postscript
+saying that Bastow had been captured and had committed suicide gave
+me a distinct feeling of relief, for no one could tell whether the
+deadly enmity that he felt for your father might not extend to you.
+I have cut this note rather short, but I have just heard the door
+shut, and I am quite sure that my wife has gone down to tell the good
+news in the village, and I really cannot deny myself the pleasure
+of telling some of the people myself, and seeing their faces brighten
+up at the news."
+
+As Dick had foretold would be the case, Mark received a very
+warm letter from Sir Charles Harris, congratulating him upon his
+approaching marriage, and insisting upon his taking up his quarters
+with him.
+
+"I am sending a man down with this to hand it to the guard as the
+up coach goes through the town. Chetwynd told me that his call on
+me was the first he had paid, so I feel fairly confident that I
+shall forestall the rest of your friends, and that you will give
+me the pleasure of your company."
+
+Mark wrote back accepting the invitation at once, which enabled
+him to decline half a dozen others without the necessity of making
+a choice. Everything turned out as arranged. Millicent and Mrs.
+Cunningham went down in a post chaise, two days before the wedding,
+and Mark drove down in his gig with them. Dick Chetwynd met them
+on horseback just outside Reigate, and escorted the ladies to his
+house, Mark driving on to that of Sir Charles Harris. Millicent
+found the house full of her special friends, whom she had asked
+to be her bridesmaids. She was almost bewildered by the warmth of
+their welcome, and overpowered by the questions poured upon her.
+
+"The news quite took all our breath away, Millicent," one of
+them said. "It seems extraordinary that you should have been Miss
+Thorndyke all the time, though I don't think that any of us were
+at all surprised that you should take the name now; you must have
+been surprised when you heard that you were the heiress of Crowswood."
+
+"I was a great deal more disgusted than surprised," she said rather
+indignantly. "I did not think that it was fair at all that I should
+step into Mark's shoes."
+
+"Well, it has all come right now, Millicent, and I dare say you
+thought that it would, even then."
+
+"I can assure you that I did not; quite the contrary, I thought
+that it never would come right. I was very unhappy about it for a
+time."
+
+"Now, young ladies," Dick Chetwynd laughed, "will you please take
+Mrs. Cunningham and Miss Thorndyke up to their rooms? I don't
+suppose I shall see any more of you before dinner time; there are
+those trunks to be opened and examined, talked over, and admired.
+Mind, I have fifteen more, for the most part men, coming to dinner,
+so those of you who aspire to follow Miss Thorndyke's example had
+best prepare yourselves for conquest."
+
+The ball on the following evening was a great success. Dick
+had determined that it should be a memorable one, and there was a
+consensus of opinion that it was the most brilliant that had taken
+place in that part of the country for many years.
+
+Crowswood church and village presented a most festive appearance
+on the following day; there was not a cottage that had not great
+posies of flowers in its windows, and that had not made some sort
+of attempt at decoration with flags or flowers. A huge arch of
+evergreens, with sheaves of wheat and flowers, had been erected on
+the top of the hill, and every man, woman, and child turned out in
+their best, and cheered lustily, first, when Mark drove up in his
+gig, and equally lustily when the Chetwynd carriage, drawn by four
+gray horses, dashed up, preceded by a large number of others with
+the bridesmaids and friends. The church was already crowded, and
+Mr. Greg was visibly moved at seeing the son and niece of the man
+to whom he owed his living made man and wife. When the wedding
+breakfast, at which more than fifty sat down, and the necessary
+toasts were over, Mr. and Mrs. Thorndyke started for Canterbury.
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXII.
+
+
+It was not until Easter that Mark Thorndyke and his wife returned to
+England. They had spent the greater portion of that time in Italy,
+lingering for a month at Venice, and had then journeyed quietly
+homewards through Bavaria and Saxony; They were in no hurry, as
+before starting on their honeymoon Mark had consulted an architect,
+had told him exactly what he wanted, and had left the matter in
+his hands. Mrs. Cunningham had from time to time kept them informed
+how things were going on. The part of the house in which the Squire's
+room had been situated was entirely pulled down, and a new wing
+built in its stead. Millicent had been specially wishful that this
+should be done.
+
+"I don't know that I am superstitious, Mark," she had said, "but
+I do think that when a murder has taken place in a house it is
+better to make a complete change. The servants always think they
+see or hear something. That part of the house is avoided, and it
+is difficult to get anyone to stay there. I think it is very much
+more important to do that than it is to get the house refurnished;
+we can do anything in that way you like when we get back, but I
+should certainly like very much to have the great alteration made
+before we return."
+
+The architect was a clever one, and the house, which was some two
+hundred years old, was greatly improved in appearance by the new wing,
+which was made to harmonize well with the rest, but was specially
+designed to give as much variety as possible to the general outline.
+Millicent uttered an exclamation of pleasure when they first caught
+a glimpse of the house. As they rode through the village they were
+again welcomed as heartily as they were on their wedding day. Mrs.
+Cunningham received them; she had been established there for a
+month, and had placed the house entirely on its old footing. They
+first examined the new portion of the house, and Millicent was
+greatly pleased with the rooms that had been prepared for them,
+Mark having requested Mrs. Cunningham to put the furnishing into
+the hands of the best known firm of the day.
+
+"I have asked," Mrs. Cunningham said, "the Rector and his wife and
+Mr. Chetwynd to dine with us this evening; they can scarcely be
+termed company, and I thought that you might find it pleasant to
+have these old friends here the first evening. There is a letter for
+you on the library table, Mark; it may almost be called a packet;
+it has been here nearly a month."
+
+In our days a newly married couple would find on their return from
+foreign travel basketfuls of letters, circulars, and catalogues
+from tradesmen of all kinds; happily, our forefathers were saved
+from these inflictions, and Mark at once went to the library with
+almost a feeling of surprise as to who could have written to him.
+He saw at once that it was a ship's letter, for on the top was
+written, "Favored by the Surinam."
+
+"Why, it is Ramoo's writing. I suppose he gave it to someone he
+knew, and that instead of its being put in the mail bag in India,
+he brought it on with him. What a tremendously long epistle!" he
+exclaimed, glancing his eye down the first page, and then a puzzled
+expression came across his face; he sat down and began to read from
+the first slowly and carefully.
+
+"HONORED SAHIB:
+
+"I do not know why I should write to tell you the true history of
+all these matters. I have thought it over many times, but I feel
+that it is right that you should know clearly what has happened,
+and how it has come about, and more especially that you should
+know that you need never fear any troubles such as those that have
+taken place. I am beginning to write this while we are yet sailing,
+and shall send it to you by ship from the Cape, or if it chances
+that we meet any ship on her way to England, our letters may be
+put on board her."
+
+"Why, this letter must be more than a year old," Mark said to himself.
+There was no date to the letter, but, turning to the last sheet, he
+saw as a postscript after the signature the words, "January 26th.
+--A ship, the Surinam, is lying a short distance from us, and will
+take our letters to England."
+
+"Yes, it must be a year old; but what he means by the way he begins
+is more than I can imagine;" and he turned back to the point at
+which he had broken off.
+
+"I would tell it you in order as it happened. I, Ramoo, am a Brahmin.
+Twenty years ago I was the head priest of a great temple. I shall
+not say where the temple was; it matters not in any way. There was
+fighting, as there is always fighting in India. There were Company's
+Sepoys and white troops, and one night the most sacred bracelet of
+the great god of our temple was stolen."
+
+"Good Heavens!" Mark exclaimed, laying down the letter. "Then it has
+been Ramoo who has all this time been in pursuit of the diamonds;
+and to think that my uncle never even suspected him!"
+
+Then suddenly he continued, "now I understand why it was my life
+was spared by those fellows. By Jove, this is astounding!" Then he
+took up the letter again.
+
+"Two of the Brahmins under me had observed, at a festival the day
+before the bracelet was lost, a white soldier staring at it with
+covetous eyes. One of them was in charge of the temple on the
+night when it was stolen, and on the day following he came to me,
+and said, 'I desire to devote my life to the recovery of the jewels
+of the god. Bondah will go with me; we will return no more until we
+bring them back.' 'It is good,' I said; 'the god must be appeased,
+or terrible misfortunes may happen.' Then we held a solemn service
+in the temple. The two men removed the caste marks from their
+foreheads, prostrated themselves before the god, and went out from
+amongst us as outcasts until the day of their death. Two months
+later a messenger came from the one who had spoken to me, saying that
+they had found the man, but had for a long time had no opportunity
+of finding the bracelet. Then Bondah had met him in a lonely place,
+and had attacked him. Bondah had lost his life, but the soldier
+was, though sorely wounded, able to get back to his regiment. He
+had died, but he had, the writer was convinced, passed the jewels
+on to a comrade, whom he would watch. Then I saw that one man was
+not sufficient for such a task. Then I, too, the Chief Brahmin of
+the temple, saw that it was my duty to go forth also.
+
+"I laid the matter before the others, and they said, 'You are right;
+it is you who, as the chief in the service of the god, should bring
+back his jewels.' So again there was a service, and I went forth
+as an outcast and a wanderer, knowing that I must do many things
+that were forbidden to my caste; that I must touch unclean things,
+must eat forbidden food, and must take life if needs be. You, sahib,
+cannot understand how terrible was the degradation to me, who was
+of the purest blood of the Brahmins. I had taken the most solemn
+vows to devote my life to this. I knew that, whether successful or
+not, although I might be forgiven my offense by the god, yet that
+never again could I recover my caste, even though the heaviest
+penances were performed. Henceforth, I must stand alone in the
+world, without kindred, without friends, without help, save such
+as the god might give me in the search.
+
+"I was rich. The greater part of my goods I gave to the temple, and
+yet retained a considerable sum, for I should need money to carry
+out my quest, and after I had accomplished it I should hand over
+what remained for the benefit of the poor. I should myself become
+a fakir. I want you to understand, sahib, that henceforth I had but
+one object in life, a supreme one, to accomplish, in which nothing
+must stand in my way, and that what would be in others a crime was
+but a sacrifice on my part, most acceptable to the god. I journeyed
+down to the place where my comrade was, dressed as one of the lowest
+class, even as a sweeper, and he and I strove by all the means in
+our power to discover what this man had done with the jewels. Night
+after night we crawled into his tent. We searched his bed and his
+clothes. With sharp rods we tried every inch of the soil, believing
+that he had hidden the diamonds underground, but we failed.
+
+"There my comrade said, 'I must give my life to find out where he
+hides these things. I will watch night after night by the door of
+his tent, and if he comes out I will stab him; it shall be a mortal
+wound, but I will not kill him outright. Before he dies he will
+doubtless, as the other did, pass the jewels on to some comrade,
+and then it will be for you to follow him up.' 'It is good,' I said.
+'This man may have hidden them away somewhere during the time they
+have marched through the country. In spite of the watch you have
+kept he may have said to himself, "I will return, though it be
+years hence." Your plan is good,' I said. 'I envy you. 'Tis better
+to die thus than to live in sin as we are doing.'
+
+"That evening the man was stabbed, but an officer running up killed
+my comrade. The soldier was taken to the hospital, and I lay down
+beside the tent with my eye to a slit that I had cut, and watched
+till morning.
+
+"Then I took my broom and swept the ground. I had not been hired as
+one of the camp sweepers, and so could move about and sweep where
+I chose. No one ever asked me any questions. The soldiers heeded
+me no more than if I had been a dog, and, of course, supposed that
+I was acting by the order of the head of the sweepers. Presently
+I saw one of the servants of the hospital go across to the tent of
+the officer who had killed my comrade. He came over and went into
+the hospital tent. I felt sure that it was the wounded man who had
+sent for him. He was in there some time. Presently a soldier came
+out and went to the tent of the wounded man, and returned bringing
+a musket. Then I said to myself, 'The god has blinded us. He wills
+that we shall go through many more toils before we regain the
+bracelet.' Doubtless the man had carried the bracelet in his musket
+all the time, and we, blind that we were, had never thought of it.
+
+"Presently the officer came out again. I noticed that as he did so
+he looked round on all sides as if to see if he were watched. Then
+I knew that it was as I had thought: the soldier had given the
+bracelet to him. At this I was pleased; it would be far more easy
+to search the tent of an officer than of a soldier, who sleeps
+surrounded by his comrades. I thought that there was no hurry now;
+it would need but patience, and I should be sure to find them.
+I had not calculated that he would have better opportunities than
+the soldier for going about, and that, doubtless, the soldier had
+warned him of his danger. Two hours later the officer mounted his
+horse and rode towards the camp of another regiment, a mile and
+a quarter away. There was nothing in that; but I watched for his
+return all that day and all that night, and when he did not come
+back, I felt that he was doing something to get rid of the diamonds.
+
+"He was away three days, and when he returned I was almost sure
+that he had not the diamonds about him. As he had ridden off he
+had looked about just as he had when he left the hospital: he was
+uneasy, just as if he was watched; now he was uneasy no longer.
+Then I knew that my search would be a long one, and might fail
+altogether. I went away, and for three months I prayed and fasted;
+then I returned. I bought different clothes, I painted my forehead
+with another caste mark, then I bought from the servant of an
+officer in another regiment his papers of service: recommendations
+from former masters. Then I went to the officer--you will guess,
+sahib, that it was the Major, your uncle--and I paid his servant
+to leave his service, and to present me as a brother of his who
+had been accustomed to serve white sahibs, and was, like himself,
+a good servant; so I took his place.
+
+"He was a good master, and I came to love him, though I knew that I
+might yet have to kill him. You have heard that I saved his life
+three times; I did so partly because I loved him, but chiefly because
+his life was most precious to me, for if he had died I should have
+lost all clew to the bracelet. I had, of course, made sure that
+he had not got them with him; over and over again I searched every
+article in his possession. I ripped open his saddle lest they might
+be sewn up in its stuffing. All that could be done I did, until I
+was quite sure that he had not got them. He, on his part, came to
+like me. He thought that I was the most faithful of servants, and
+after the last time I saved his life he took me with him everywhere.
+He went down to Madras, and was married there. I watched his every
+movement. After that he went down frequently. Then a child was
+born, and six months afterwards his wife died.
+
+"The regiment was stationed at the fort. At that time he was
+at many places--the governor's, the other officer sahibs', the
+merchants', and others'. I could not follow him, but I was sure by
+his manner that he had not taken back the bracelet from whoever he
+had sent it to. I knew him so well by this time that I should have
+noticed any change in his manner in a moment. At last the child
+went away in the charge of Mrs. Cunningham. I bribed the child's
+ayah, and she searched Mrs. Cunningham's boxes and every garment
+she had, and found no small sealed parcel or box amongst them.
+Three years more passed. By this time the Colonel treated me more
+as a friend than as a servant. He said one day, laughing, 'It is
+a long time since my things have been turned topsy turvy, Ramoo. I
+think the thieves have come to the conclusion that I have not got
+what they are looking for.' 'What is that, sahib?' I asked. 'Some
+special jewels,' he said. 'They are extremely valuable. But I have
+got them and a lot of other things so safely stowed that no one will
+ever find them unless I give them the clew.' 'But suppose you are
+killed, sahib,' I said; 'your little daughter will never get the
+things.' 'I have provided for that,' he answered. 'If I am killed
+I have arranged that she shall know all about it either when she
+comes to the age of eighteen or twenty-one.'
+
+"A few weeks after that he was wounded very badly. I nursed him
+night and day for weeks, and when he came to England he brought me
+with him. As you know, sahib, he died. When he was in London he
+went to see Mrs. Cunningham and the child, and several times to
+the office of the lawyer who attended your father's funeral. Then
+he came down to your father, and I know he had long and earnest
+conversations with him. I did all I could to listen, but the Colonel
+always had the windows and doors shut before he began to speak.
+I could see that your father was troubled. Then the Colonel died.
+After his death I could never find his snuff box; he had carried
+it about with him for some years; once or twice I had examined it,
+but it was too small for the diamonds to be hidden in. I suppose
+that he had given it to the sahib, your father, but as I could
+never find it I guessed that there was some mystery attached to
+it, though what I could not tell.
+
+"Then your father took me down to Crowswood with him, and Mrs.
+Cunningham and the little girl came down. I was surprised to find
+that your father seemed to be master of the estate, and that no
+one thought anything of the child, whose name had been changed. I
+spoke one day to Mrs. Cunningham about it; your father seemed to
+me a just and good man, and I could not believe that he was robbing
+his brother's daughter. Mrs. Cunningham told me that the Colonel
+did not wish her to be known as an heiress, and that he had left
+the estate to his brother until she came of age. Your father was
+as good a master as the Colonel had been. I watched and watched,
+and once or twice I overheard him talking to himself in the library,
+and discovered that your father himself was altogether ignorant of
+the hiding place of the property that the Colonel had mentioned in
+his will. I knew then that I should have to wait until the child
+was either eighteen or twenty-one.
+
+"It was a long time, but I had learnt to be patient. I was not
+unhappy; I loved your father, I loved the Colonel's little daughter;
+and I was very fond of you. All these things were small to me in
+comparison to my vow and the finding the jewels of the god, but
+they shortened the years of waiting. Then a year before the young
+mistress was eighteen came the shot through the window. I did not
+know who had fired it, but I saw that your father's life was in
+danger, and I said to myself, 'He will tell the young sahib what
+he knows about the bracelet.' After you had gone into the library
+I opened the door quietly, and listened. I could hear much that
+was said, but not all. I heard him say something about a snuff box,
+and some means of finding the lost things being hidden in it, and
+that he had kept them all these years in a secret hiding place,
+which he described. You were to search for the diamonds, and I
+guessed from that that he did not know what he was to be told when
+the young memsahib came of age, or perhaps when she was eighteen.
+It was not until I had thought over what I heard that I came to the
+conclusion that if I could find the things he spoke of I might be
+able to find the jewels. By that time your father had gone to bed.
+I was foolish not to have been patient, but my blood boiled after
+waiting for eighteen or nineteen years. The god seemed to have sent
+me the chance, and it seemed to me that I should take it at once.
+I knew that he generally slept with his window open, and it seemed
+to me that it would be easy to slip in there and to get those things
+from the cabinet. I knew where the ladder was kept. I took a file
+from the tool chest and cut the chain."
+
+Here Mark dropped the letter in horror.
+
+"Good Heavens!" he exclaimed. "Then Bastow spoke truly, and he was
+not my father's murderer! Never did a single suspicion of Ramoo
+enter my head. This is appalling; but I cannot read any more now.
+It is time for me to go and dress for dinner."
+
+"Is anything the matter with you, Mark?" Millicent asked anxiously,
+as she met him in the drawing room; "you look as white as a sheet."
+
+"I have been reading Ramoo's letter, and he has told me some things
+that have surprised and shocked me. I will tell you about them
+after dinner, dear. It is a long story, but you won't have to wait
+until Dick and the Gregs are gone. They are interested in all that
+interests us, and shall hear the letter read. No; I think I will
+ask them and Dick to come in the morning. I should not like anything
+to sadden the first evening of our coming home."
+
+"Then it is something sad."
+
+"Yes, but it does not affect us, though it does affect Ramoo. Now
+clear your brow, dear, and dismiss the subject from your mind, else
+our guests will fancy that our marriage has not been altogether so
+satisfactory as they had hoped."
+
+"As if they could think such a thing as that, Mark," she said
+indignantly. "But there is the sound of wheels; it is Mr. Chetwynd's
+gig."
+
+The three visitors all came in together, having met at the door.
+Mark, with a great effort, put aside the letter from his mind,
+and a cheerful evening was spent. They had much to tell of their
+travels, many questions to ask about the parish and their mutual
+friends and the neighborhood generally, and when they rose to go
+Mark said:
+
+"Would you mind riding over again tomorrow morning, Dick? I have
+a letter to read to you that will interest you greatly."
+
+"Certainly. What time shall I be here?"
+
+"Say at eleven o'clock. It is a long epistle, and will take us an
+hour to get through; after that we can stroll round, and, of course,
+you will stop to lunch.
+
+
+"I should be glad if you and Mrs. Greg can come over too," he
+added, turning to the Rector; "you will be much interested also in
+the matter."
+
+
+The next day the party met in the library at the hour named. "I may
+tell you, Mr. Greg, that I specially asked you and your wife here
+because this letter throws some light on Arthur Bastow's connection
+with my father's murder; you were friends with his father, and I
+think you ought to know. As to you, Dick, the letter will interest
+you from beginning to end, and will surprise as much as it will
+interest you."
+
+"Even I don't know what it is, Mrs. Greg," Millicent said. "I know
+it quite upset Mark yesterday, but he said he would sooner I did
+not know anything about it until today, as he did not want me to
+be saddened on the first evening of our return home. Now, please
+go on, Mark; you have said quite enough to excite us all."
+
+Mark had read but a short distance when Dick Chetwynd exclaimed:
+
+"Then Ramoo was at the bottom of that Indian business, after all.
+I almost wonder you never suspected it, Mark."
+
+"Well, I hardly could do so," Mark said, "when my uncle was so fond
+of him, and he had served him so faithfully."
+
+As he approached the point at which he had laid down the letter on
+the previous evening, Millicent's color faded.
+
+Suddenly an exclamation of horror broke from her when he read the
+last line.
+
+"Oh, Mark," she said, with quivering lips, "don't say it was Ramoo.
+He always seemed so kind and good."
+
+"It was here I stopped last night," he said, "but I fear there
+can be no doubt about it. I must say that it is evident from this
+letter, that no thought of doing my father harm was in his mind
+when he placed that ladder against the window. Now I will go on."
+
+The letter continued as follows:
+
+"Having placed the ladder, I clambered to the window and quietly
+entered the room. It was quite dark, but I knew the place of every
+piece of furniture so well that I was able to go without hesitation
+to the cabinet. Your father was speaking very slowly and distinctly
+when he told you how it was to be opened, and I was able to do it
+easily, but I did not know that the back opened with a sharp click,
+and the noise startled me and woke your father. In an instant
+he was out of bed and seized me by the throat. Now, he was a much
+stronger man than I was. I struggled in vain. I felt that in a
+moment I should become insensible; my vow and my duty to the god
+flashed across me, and scarce knowing what I did, I drew a little
+dagger I always carried, and struck blindly. He fell, and I fell
+beside him. For a time I was insensible. When I recovered I was
+seized with the bitterest remorse that I had killed one I loved, but
+I seemed to hear the voice of the god saying, 'You have done well,
+Ramoo. I am your great master, and you are bound to my service.'
+
+"I got up almost blindly, felt in the cabinet, and found a coin and
+a piece of paper, and a feeling of exultation came over me that,
+after nearly twenty years, I should succeed in carrying out my vow
+and taking his bracelet back to the god. I descended the ladder,
+crept in the back door by which I had come out, went up to my room,
+where I had kept a light burning, and examined my treasures. Then
+I saw that all had been in vain. They were doubtless a key to the
+mystery, but until a clew was given they were absolutely useless. I
+sat for hours staring at them. I would have gone back and replaced
+them in the cabinet and left all as it had been before, but I
+dared not enter the room again. The next day I heard you say that
+you suspected that the talk with your father had been overheard,
+and that the man who had earlier in the evening before shot at him
+had returned, and while listening had heard something said about the
+hiding place, and thought that he would find some sort of treasure
+there. I thought that in the talk your father might have told you
+how to use these things, though I had not caught it, and it was
+therefore important that you should have them back again, so I went
+into the room after the inquest was over, and placed the things in
+their hiding place again.
+
+"Then, thinking it over, I determined to leave your service. You
+would be trying to find the treasure, and I must watch you, and
+this I could not do as long as I was a house servant; so I came up
+to London, and you thought I had sailed for India, but I did not
+go. I hired four Lascars, men of my own religion, and paid them to
+watch every movement that you made, to see where you visited and
+where you went. I paid them well, and they served me well; it was
+so that I was able to bring those men to your help when but for
+that you would have lost your life. It was for this to some extent
+that I had you followed; for I soon found out that you were on the
+search for the man who had fired through the window, and who you
+believed had killed your father, rather than for the jewels. I knew
+that you might run into danger, and partly because I loved you, and
+partly because it was possible that it would be essential for that
+coin and piece of paper to be produced in order that the treasure
+might be obtained, I kept guard over you.
+
+"When the 18th of August approached we were all on the watch. I
+felt sure that you would take every possible precaution while you
+had the bracelet in your possession. We knew who were your principal
+friends, the banker's son and Mr. Chetwynd. On the 18th of August
+everything went on as usual. On the following day the banker's son
+came to you, and as soon as he left you, you went to the lawyer's,
+and afterwards to the banker's. I felt sure now that it was at
+that bank that the jewels had been placed, and that you had been
+waiting till the young memsahib's birthday for the news that they
+might be taken out; then you went to Mr. Chetwynd's, and he went
+to the bank. I had no doubt that he was to take them out for you,
+and after that one of the men never took his eyes off him when he
+was outside of his house. Afterwards you went to the place where
+the men used to fight, and the man who was watching you went in,
+and had beer, and saw you talking with the big man you used to
+fight with, in the parlor behind the bar. The watcher went out to
+follow you, but left another to watch this man. We found that both
+Mr. Chetwynd and he went to a shipping office in Tower Street,
+and we then guessed that you intended to take the bracelet at once
+across the sea.
+
+"I went myself and found out that a vessel was sailing in two days
+to Amsterdam. I took a passage for a man in the cheap cabin, and
+asked to look at the list of passengers, as I believed that some
+friend would be sailing by her; there were two men's names down
+together in one handwriting among the first class passengers, and
+I guessed that these were you and Mr. Chetwynd. I also saw the name
+of the big man, which I had heard long before, down in the list of
+passengers, and another name next to his in the same handwriting.
+I did not know his name, but guessed that it was another of the
+fighting men, and that they were going to look after you until you
+had got rid of the diamonds. On the morning that she was to sail
+one of the Lascars was on board; I thought it possible that in
+order to throw anyone who might be following you off your scent
+you might at the last moment go ashore, and that Mr. Chetwynd might
+take the diamonds over, so I watched, and saw you on the deck with
+your friend.
+
+"I and the other three Lascars then took passage that evening in
+a craft for Rotterdam, and got to Amsterdam two days before your
+ship arrived; we went to different houses, and going separately into
+the worst parts of the town, soon found a man who kept a gambling
+den, and who was a man who could be trusted. I offered him a
+thousand francs to collect twenty-five men, who were to be paid a
+hundred francs each, and to be ready, if your ship arrived after
+dark, to attack two passengers I would point out to them. I did not
+want you to be hurt, so bargained that all knives were to be left
+behind, and that he was to supply the men only with clubs. If the
+ship came in in daylight you were to be attacked the first time
+you went out after dark. You know how that was carried out. You
+had two more men with you than I had expected; but I thought that
+with a sudden rush you might all be separated. You know the rest.
+The moment you were knocked down I and three others carried you to
+a boat. It had been lying near the stairs, and we took you off to
+the barge in which I had arranged you should be taken to Rotterdam.
+
+"We told them that you were a drunken man who had been stunned
+in a fight in a public house. As soon as we were off, I searched
+you and found the diamonds. Then, as you know, we put you ashore.
+We all crossed to England that night. Two days later I sailed in
+this ship, the Brahmapootra. I am not afraid of telling you this,
+because I know that the diamonds will not shine on the god's arm
+until all fear of search and inquiry are over. My task will be
+done when I hand them over to the man who holds the office I once
+held; then I shall bear the penances imposed on me for having broken
+my caste in every way, and for having taken life, and for the rest
+of my days I shall wander as a fakir through India. I shall be
+supported by the knowledge that I have done my duty to my god, and
+have sacrificed all in his service, but it will ever be a grief to
+me that in so doing it was necessary to sacrifice the life of one
+who had ever shown me kindness. You may wonder why I have written
+this, but I felt that I must own the truth to you, and that you
+should know that if in the course of my duty to the god it was my
+misfortune to slay your father, I have twice saved your life, just
+as three times I saved that of the Colonel Sahib, your uncle."
+
+There was silence for some little time after Mark had finished
+reading.
+
+"It is a strange story indeed," Mr. Greg said, "but it is not for
+us to judge the man. He has acted according to his lights, and
+none can do more. He sacrificed himself and his life solely to the
+service of his god, well knowing that even were he successful, his
+reward would be penance and suffering, and a life of what cannot
+but be misery to a man brought up, as he has been, to consider
+himself of the highest and holiest rank of the people. I think,
+Mark, we need neither say nor think anything harshly of him."
+
+"Certainly not," Mark agreed. "I can understand that according
+to his view of the matter anything that stood between him and his
+goal was but an obstacle to be swept aside; assuredly there was
+no premeditation in the killing of my father. I have no doubt that
+the man was attached to him, and that he killed him not to save
+his own life, but in order that his mission might be carried out."
+
+"Quite so, Mark; it was done in the same spirit, if I may say so,
+that Abraham would have sacrificed his son at the order of his God.
+What years of devotion that man has passed through! Accustomed,
+as you see, to a lofty position, to the respect and veneration of
+those around him, he became a servant, and performed duties that were
+in his opinion not only humiliating, but polluting and destructive
+to his caste, and which rendered him an outcast even among the
+lowest of his people. Do you not think so, Mrs. Thorndyke?"
+
+Millicent, who was crying quietly, looked up.
+
+"I can only think of him as the man who twice saved Mark's life,"
+she said.
+
+"I understand why you have wished to tell me this story," the Rector
+went on to Mark. "You wish me to know that Arthur Bastow did not
+add this to his other crimes; that he was spared from being the
+murderer of your father, but from no want of will on his part;
+and, as we know, he killed many others, the last but an hour or two
+before he put an end to his own life; still I am glad that this
+terrible crime is not his. It seemed to be so revolting and unnatural.
+It was the Squire's father who had given the living to his father,
+and the Squire himself had been his friend in the greatest of his
+trials, and had given him a shelter and a home in his old age. I
+am glad, at least, that the man, evil as he was, was spared this
+last crime of the grossest ingratitude."
+
+"Well, Mark," Dick Chetwynd said cheerfully, in order to turn the
+subject, "I am heartily glad that we have got to the bottom of this
+jewel mystery. I have been puzzling over it all the time that you
+have been away, and I have never been able to understand how, in
+spite of the precautions that we took, they should have found out
+that the jewels were at Cotter's, and that you had them on board
+with you, and, above all, why they spared your life when they could
+so easily and safely have put you out of the way. It is certainly
+strange that while you were thinking over everything connected
+with the jewels, the idea that Ramoo was the leading spirit in the
+whole business should never once have occurred to you."
+
+A month later, when Mark went up to town, he called at Leadenhall
+Street.
+
+"Of course, you have not heard of the arrival of the Brahmapootra
+at Madras yet. May I ask when she left the Cape?"
+
+"She never left the Cape, sir," the clerk replied, "and there are
+very grave fears for her safety. She spoke the Surinam and gave
+her mails for England when the latter was eight days out from the
+Cape, and the Surinam reported that a day later she encountered
+a terrible gale, lost several spars, and narrowly escaped being
+blown onto the African coast. Since then we have had no news of the
+Brahmapootra. A number of Indiamen have arrived since; the latest
+came in only yesterday, and up to the time when she left no news
+had been received of the ship. Three small craft had been sent up
+the coast weeks before to make inquiries for her, but had returned
+without being able to obtain any intelligence, and had seen no
+wreckage on the coast, although they had gone several hundred miles
+beyond where she had spoken the Surinam, therefore there can be
+little doubt that she foundered with all hands during the gale.
+You had no near relatives on board, I hope, sir?"
+
+"No near relatives, but there was one on board in whom I was greatly
+interested. Here is my card; I should feel greatly obliged if you
+would write me a line should you hear anything of her."
+
+"I will do so, sir. We have had innumerable inquiries from friends
+and relatives of those on board, and although of late we have been
+obliged to say that there can no longer be any hope that she will
+ever be heard of, not a day passes but many persons still come in
+to inquire."
+
+No letter ever came to Mark; no news was ever heard of the
+Brahmapootra. Ramoo's sacrifice was in vain, and never again did
+the diamond bracelet glisten on the arm of the idol in the unknown
+temple.
+
+
+
+THE END.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+End of Project Gutenberg's Colonel Thorndyke's Secret, by G. A. Henty
+
+*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK COLONEL THORNDYKE'S SECRET ***
+
+This file should be named thorn10.txt or thorn10.zip
+Corrected EDITIONS of our eBooks get a new NUMBER, thorn11.txt
+VERSIONS based on separate sources get new LETTER, thorn10a.txt
+
+Produced by Martin Robb
+
+Project Gutenberg eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the US
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we usually do not
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+We are now trying to release all our eBooks one year in advance
+of the official release dates, leaving time for better editing.
+Please be encouraged to tell us about any error or corrections,
+even years after the official publication date.
+
+Please note neither this listing nor its contents are final til
+midnight of the last day of the month of any such announcement.
+The official release date of all Project Gutenberg eBooks is at
+Midnight, Central Time, of the last day of the stated month. A
+preliminary version may often be posted for suggestion, comment
+and editing by those who wish to do so.
+
+Most people start at our Web sites at:
+http://gutenberg.net or
+http://promo.net/pg
+
+These Web sites include award-winning information about Project
+Gutenberg, including how to donate, how to help produce our new
+eBooks, and how to subscribe to our email newsletter (free!).
+
+
+Those of you who want to download any eBook before announcement
+can get to them as follows, and just download by date. This is
+also a good way to get them instantly upon announcement, as the
+indexes our cataloguers produce obviously take a while after an
+announcement goes out in the Project Gutenberg Newsletter.
+
+http://www.ibiblio.org/gutenberg/etext03 or
+ftp://ftp.ibiblio.org/pub/docs/books/gutenberg/etext03
+
+Or /etext02, 01, 00, 99, 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92, 91 or 90
+
+Just search by the first five letters of the filename you want,
+as it appears in our Newsletters.
+
+
+Information about Project Gutenberg (one page)
+
+We produce about two million dollars for each hour we work. The
+time it takes us, a rather conservative estimate, is fifty hours
+to get any eBook selected, entered, proofread, edited, copyright
+searched and analyzed, the copyright letters written, etc. Our
+projected audience is one hundred million readers. If the value
+per text is nominally estimated at one dollar then we produce $2
+million dollars per hour in 2002 as we release over 100 new text
+files per month: 1240 more eBooks in 2001 for a total of 4000+
+We are already on our way to trying for 2000 more eBooks in 2002
+If they reach just 1-2% of the world's population then the total
+will reach over half a trillion eBooks given away by year's end.
+
+The Goal of Project Gutenberg is to Give Away 1 Trillion eBooks!
+This is ten thousand titles each to one hundred million readers,
+which is only about 4% of the present number of computer users.
+
+Here is the briefest record of our progress (* means estimated):
+
+eBooks Year Month
+
+ 1 1971 July
+ 10 1991 January
+ 100 1994 January
+ 1000 1997 August
+ 1500 1998 October
+ 2000 1999 December
+ 2500 2000 December
+ 3000 2001 November
+ 4000 2001 October/November
+ 6000 2002 December*
+ 9000 2003 November*
+10000 2004 January*
+
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been created
+to secure a future for Project Gutenberg into the next millennium.
+
+We need your donations more than ever!
+
+As of February, 2002, contributions are being solicited from people
+and organizations in: Alabama, Alaska, Arkansas, Connecticut,
+Delaware, District of Columbia, Florida, Georgia, Hawaii, Illinois,
+Indiana, Iowa, Kansas, Kentucky, Louisiana, Maine, Massachusetts,
+Michigan, Mississippi, Missouri, Montana, Nebraska, Nevada, New
+Hampshire, New Jersey, New Mexico, New York, North Carolina, Ohio,
+Oklahoma, Oregon, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island, South Carolina, South
+Dakota, Tennessee, Texas, Utah, Vermont, Virginia, Washington, West
+Virginia, Wisconsin, and Wyoming.
+
+We have filed in all 50 states now, but these are the only ones
+that have responded.
+
+As the requirements for other states are met, additions to this list
+will be made and fund raising will begin in the additional states.
+Please feel free to ask to check the status of your state.
+
+In answer to various questions we have received on this:
+
+We are constantly working on finishing the paperwork to legally
+request donations in all 50 states. If your state is not listed and
+you would like to know if we have added it since the list you have,
+just ask.
+
+While we cannot solicit donations from people in states where we are
+not yet registered, we know of no prohibition against accepting
+donations from donors in these states who approach us with an offer to
+donate.
+
+International donations are accepted, but we don't know ANYTHING about
+how to make them tax-deductible, or even if they CAN be made
+deductible, and don't have the staff to handle it even if there are
+ways.
+
+Donations by check or money order may be sent to:
+
+Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+PMB 113
+1739 University Ave.
+Oxford, MS 38655-4109
+
+Contact us if you want to arrange for a wire transfer or payment
+method other than by check or money order.
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation has been approved by
+the US Internal Revenue Service as a 501(c)(3) organization with EIN
+[Employee Identification Number] 64-622154. Donations are
+tax-deductible to the maximum extent permitted by law. As fund-raising
+requirements for other states are met, additions to this list will be
+made and fund-raising will begin in the additional states.
+
+We need your donations more than ever!
+
+You can get up to date donation information online at:
+
+http://www.gutenberg.net/donation.html
+
+
+***
+
+If you can't reach Project Gutenberg,
+you can always email directly to:
+
+Michael S. Hart <hart@pobox.com>
+
+Prof. Hart will answer or forward your message.
+
+We would prefer to send you information by email.
+
+
+**The Legal Small Print**
+
+
+(Three Pages)
+
+***START**THE SMALL PRINT!**FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS**START***
+Why is this "Small Print!" statement here? You know: lawyers.
+They tell us you might sue us if there is something wrong with
+your copy of this eBook, even if you got it for free from
+someone other than us, and even if what's wrong is not our
+fault. So, among other things, this "Small Print!" statement
+disclaims most of our liability to you. It also tells you how
+you may distribute copies of this eBook if you want to.
+
+*BEFORE!* YOU USE OR READ THIS EBOOK
+By using or reading any part of this PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
+eBook, you indicate that you understand, agree to and accept
+this "Small Print!" statement. If you do not, you can receive
+a refund of the money (if any) you paid for this eBook by
+sending a request within 30 days of receiving it to the person
+you got it from. If you received this eBook on a physical
+medium (such as a disk), you must return it with your request.
+
+ABOUT PROJECT GUTENBERG-TM EBOOKS
+This PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook, like most PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBooks,
+is a "public domain" work distributed by Professor Michael S. Hart
+through the Project Gutenberg Association (the "Project").
+Among other things, this means that no one owns a United States copyright
+on or for this work, so the Project (and you!) can copy and
+distribute it in the United States without permission and
+without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, set forth
+below, apply if you wish to copy and distribute this eBook
+under the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark.
+
+Please do not use the "PROJECT GUTENBERG" trademark to market
+any commercial products without permission.
+
+To create these eBooks, the Project expends considerable
+efforts to identify, transcribe and proofread public domain
+works. Despite these efforts, the Project's eBooks and any
+medium they may be on may contain "Defects". Among other
+things, Defects may take the form of incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
+intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged
+disk or other eBook medium, a computer virus, or computer
+codes that damage or cannot be read by your equipment.
+
+LIMITED WARRANTY; DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES
+But for the "Right of Replacement or Refund" described below,
+[1] Michael Hart and the Foundation (and any other party you may
+receive this eBook from as a PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm eBook) disclaims
+all liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including
+legal fees, and [2] YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE OR
+UNDER STRICT LIABILITY, OR FOR BREACH OF WARRANTY OR CONTRACT,
+INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE
+OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE
+POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
+
+If you discover a Defect in this eBook within 90 days of
+receiving it, you can receive a refund of the money (if any)
+you paid for it by sending an explanatory note within that
+time to the person you received it from. If you received it
+on a physical medium, you must return it with your note, and
+such person may choose to alternatively give you a replacement
+copy. If you received it electronically, such person may
+choose to alternatively give you a second opportunity to
+receive it electronically.
+
+THIS EBOOK IS OTHERWISE PROVIDED TO YOU "AS-IS". NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ARE MADE TO YOU AS
+TO THE EBOOK OR ANY MEDIUM IT MAY BE ON, INCLUDING BUT NOT
+LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A
+PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
+
+Some states do not allow disclaimers of implied warranties or
+the exclusion or limitation of consequential damages, so the
+above disclaimers and exclusions may not apply to you, and you
+may have other legal rights.
+
+INDEMNITY
+You will indemnify and hold Michael Hart, the Foundation,
+and its trustees and agents, and any volunteers associated
+with the production and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
+texts harmless, from all liability, cost and expense, including
+legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of the
+following that you do or cause: [1] distribution of this eBook,
+[2] alteration, modification, or addition to the eBook,
+or [3] any Defect.
+
+DISTRIBUTION UNDER "PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm"
+You may distribute copies of this eBook electronically, or by
+disk, book or any other medium if you either delete this
+"Small Print!" and all other references to Project Gutenberg,
+or:
+
+[1] Only give exact copies of it. Among other things, this
+ requires that you do not remove, alter or modify the
+ eBook or this "small print!" statement. You may however,
+ if you wish, distribute this eBook in machine readable
+ binary, compressed, mark-up, or proprietary form,
+ including any form resulting from conversion by word
+ processing or hypertext software, but only so long as
+ *EITHER*:
+
+ [*] The eBook, when displayed, is clearly readable, and
+ does *not* contain characters other than those
+ intended by the author of the work, although tilde
+ (~), asterisk (*) and underline (_) characters may
+ be used to convey punctuation intended by the
+ author, and additional characters may be used to
+ indicate hypertext links; OR
+
+ [*] The eBook may be readily converted by the reader at
+ no expense into plain ASCII, EBCDIC or equivalent
+ form by the program that displays the eBook (as is
+ the case, for instance, with most word processors);
+ OR
+
+ [*] You provide, or agree to also provide on request at
+ no additional cost, fee or expense, a copy of the
+ eBook in its original plain ASCII form (or in EBCDIC
+ or other equivalent proprietary form).
+
+[2] Honor the eBook refund and replacement provisions of this
+ "Small Print!" statement.
+
+[3] Pay a trademark license fee to the Foundation of 20% of the
+ gross profits you derive calculated using the method you
+ already use to calculate your applicable taxes. If you
+ don't derive profits, no royalty is due. Royalties are
+ payable to "Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation"
+ the 60 days following each date you prepare (or were
+ legally required to prepare) your annual (or equivalent
+ periodic) tax return. Please contact us beforehand to
+ let us know your plans and to work out the details.
+
+WHAT IF YOU *WANT* TO SEND MONEY EVEN IF YOU DON'T HAVE TO?
+Project Gutenberg is dedicated to increasing the number of
+public domain and licensed works that can be freely distributed
+in machine readable form.
+
+The Project gratefully accepts contributions of money, time,
+public domain materials, or royalty free copyright licenses.
+Money should be paid to the:
+"Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+If you are interested in contributing scanning equipment or
+software or other items, please contact Michael Hart at:
+hart@pobox.com
+
+[Portions of this eBook's header and trailer may be reprinted only
+when distributed free of all fees. Copyright (C) 2001, 2002 by
+Michael S. Hart. Project Gutenberg is a TradeMark and may not be
+used in any sales of Project Gutenberg eBooks or other materials be
+they hardware or software or any other related product without
+express permission.]
+
+*END THE SMALL PRINT! FOR PUBLIC DOMAIN EBOOKS*Ver.02/11/02*END*
+
diff --git a/old/thorn10.zip b/old/thorn10.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b80d57a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/thorn10.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/thorn10h.zip b/old/thorn10h.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..27d8f0a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/thorn10h.zip
Binary files differ